If include/generated/env.in does not exist, which is a typical case for
clean build, quiet_cmd_gen_envp command tries to delete this file
unconditionally.
This produces following warning during the build:
ENVP include/generated/env.in
rm: cannot remove 'include/generated/env.in': No such file or directory
Add '-f' option to the `rm` command to not complain if file does not
exist.
Fixes: f432eb6d8a ("env: Avoid using a leftover text-environment file")
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
colibri-imx6ull ethernet device is fec2, while the optional secondary
ethernet is fec1, update the ethernet aliases in the .dts file so that
ethaddr is set to fec2 and eth1addr to fec1.
Without this change the ethernet interfaces have a different
mac address between Linux and U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Francesco Dolcini <francesco.dolcini@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc6
Documentation:
* Move VxWorks and Plan 9 to HTML documentation
* Move all command man-pages to a separate directory
Test:
* Fix pylint errors
UEFI
* Fix build flags for initrddump.efi
QEMU
* Remove unused function to get RNG device
If include/generated/environment.h exists (perhaps leftover from a build
of another board) it is used, even if the board currently being built does
not have a text environment.
This causes a build error. Fix it by emptying the file if it should not be
there.
Fixes: https://source.denx.de/u-boot/u-boot/-/issues/9
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
It seems a copy'n'paste typo when tool had been introduced.
It has never had the 'exit' suffix in the file name. Hence,
the custom CFLAGS never been applied and, for example, BFD
linker complains:
LD lib/efi_loader/initrddump_efi.so
ld.bfd: lib/efi_loader/initrddump.o: warning: relocation in read-only section `.text.efi_main'
ld.bfd: warning: creating DT_TEXTREL in a shared object
Remove wrong 'exit' suffix from the custom CFLAGS variable.
Fixes: 65ab48d69d ("efi_selftest: provide initrddump test tool")
Fixes: 9c045a49a9 ("efi_loader: move dtbdump.c, initrddump.c to lib/efi_loader")
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
* Use f'' strings instead of .format().
* Correct sequence of imports.
* Remove a superfluous import.
* Add missing documentation.
* Replace yield by return.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This converts the existing README.plan9 to reST, and puts it under
the doc/usage/os directory.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present the doc only mentions Arm, PowerPC and x86. RISC-V support
has been added since VxWorks SR0650 support for a while, and U-Boot
supports loading a RISC-V VxWorks kernel too. Let's document it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This converts the existing README.vxworks to reST, and puts it under
the doc/usage/os directory.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently all shell command docs are put in the doc/usage root.
Let's group them into cmd/ sub-directory.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Provide human readable descriptions of the speed nodes instead of the name
of constants from the code as it is already done for 'mmc rescan'
command in commit 212f078496 ("doc: mmc rescan speed mode").
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The QEMU platform has a function defined to get the random number
generator(RNG) device. However, the RNG device can be obtained simply
by searching for a device belonging to the RNG uclass. Remove the
superfluous platform function defined for the QEMU platform for
getting the RNG device.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Fixes for 2 gateworks platforms, Edison platform, incorrectly showing
2 logos on LCD screens, not cleaning a generated environment file and
correct the CONFIG_SYS_IMMR Kconfig migration on a number of MPC85xx
platforms.
The SPL does not update the memory node with the dram size from EEPROM
but instead we can use get_ram_size which does a simple memory test
to determine the available RAM. Update PHYS_SDRAM_SIZE to 4GiB as that
is the max used on the Venice boards.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
When migrating SYS_IMMR, I didn't allow for boards to provide
non-default values here. This lead to an incorrect migration on the
platforms where CONFIG_SYS_IMMR is set to CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR and
CONFIG_SYS_CSSRBAR is NOT the same as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. Add
text to the prompt so that non-default values can be used and re-migrate
the platforms that have CONFIG_SYS_IMMR=CONFIG_SYS_CSSRBAR where
CONFIG_SYS_CSSRBAR != CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
Fixes: be7dbb60c5 ("Convert CONFIG_SYS_IMMR to Kconfig")
Reported-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
'make sifive_unamtched_defconfig; make clean; make' fails if file
include/generated/env.in exists. 'make clean' should remove all files that
stop building.
Add file include/generated/env.in to the clean target.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Currently, on imx6sabresd and gwventana boards, the company logo
and U-Boot logo are shown.
The correct behavior is to show only the company logo, if available,
and not both logos.
Reported-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Tested-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com> #gw_ventana
commit 7c84319af9c7 ("dm: gpio: Correct use of -ENODEV in drivers")
changed the return code for an I2C NAK from -ENODEV to -EREMOTEIO.
Update the gsc_i2c_read and gsc_i2c_write functions for this change
to properly retry the transaction on a NAK meaning the GSC is busy.
Fixes: 7c84319af9 ("dm: gpio: Correct use of -ENODEV in drivers")
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Enable ONFI detection to fix NAND chip configuration. Without this
the NAND oobsize will be wrong which leads to invalid ECC strength and
incompatibility with the previous configuration.
Fixes: 777f333c37 ("imx: ventana: enable dm for MTD and NAND")
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Previous u-boot code changed the default bch setting behavior and caused
backward compatible issue. This fix choose the legacy bch geometry back
again as the default option. If the minimum ecc strength that NAND chips
required need to be chosen, it can be enabled by either adding DT flag
"fsl,use-minimum-ecc" or CONFIG_NAND_MXS_USE_MINIMUM_ECC in configs. The
unused flag "fsl,legacy-bch-geometry" get removed.
Fixes: 51cdf83eea (mtd: gpmi: provide the option to use legacy bch geometry)
Fixes: 616f03daba (mtd: gpmi: change the BCH layout setting for large oob NAND)
Tested-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Tested-by: Sean Nyekjaer <sean@geanix.com>
Signed-off-by: Han Xu <han.xu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
The code was mistakenly initializing the input buffer twice.
Tested to be working on BeagleBone by adjusting CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN to
64MiB (probably works with less) and preparing uImage with:
cat arch/arm/boot/Image \
| zstd --ultra -22 --zstd=windowLog=22 \
> linux.bin.zst
mkimage -A arm -T kernel uImage -C zstd -d linux.bin.zst \
-a 0x80008000 -e 0x80008000
Without the windowLog restriction, bootm fails with a zstd decompression
error 7 (window too large), which I haven't troubleshooted.
There should be a bit more documentation on the feature...
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: 458b30af66 image: Update image_decomp() to avoid ifdefs
make sandbox_defconfig
make mrproper
make tests
fails with
../drivers/video/u_boot_logo.S: Assembler messages:
../drivers/video/u_boot_logo.S:5: Error: file not found: drivers/video/u_boot_logo.bmp
We have to delete the generated file.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current approach for setting the environment variables that
describe the memory layout runs the risk of overlapping with
reserved memory regions. Use the lmb code to derive the addresses
for these variables instead.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The firmware on larger NVMe drives needs more than 100ms to come up.
Change the timeout to 1s.
Signed-off-by: Hector Martin <marcan@marcan.st>
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide a unit test for
* efidebug boot add
* efidebug boot order
* bootefi bootmgr
* initrd via EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Up to now the initrddump.efi application has drained the input after
showing the prompt. This works for humans but leads to problems when
automating testing. If the input is drained, this should be done before
showing the prompt.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
initrddump.efi uses colored output and clear the screen. This is not
helpful for integration into Python tests. Allow specifying 'nocolor' in
the load option data to suppress color output and clearing the screen.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Commit f11513d997 ("net: phy: realtek: Add tx/rx delay config for
8211e") made the Realtek PHY driver honour the phy-mode DT property,
to set up the proper delay scheme for the RX and TX lines. A similar
change in the kernel revealed that those properties were mostly wrong.
The kernel DTs got updated over the last few months, but we were missing
out on the U-Boot version.
Just sync in the phy-mode properties from the mainline kernel,
v5.17-rc7, to avoid the breaking DT sync that late in the cycle.
This fixes Ethernet operation on the affected boards.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Commit 5bc4cd05d7 ("sunxi: move non-essential code out of s_init()")
moved the call to eth_init_board() from s_init() into board_init_f().
This means it's now only called from the SPL, which makes sense for
most of the other moved low-level functions. However the GMAC pinmux and
clock setup in eth_init_board() was not happy about that, so it broke
the sun7i GMAC.
Since Ethernet is of no use in the SPL anyway, just move the call into
board_init(), which is only run in U-Boot proper.
This fixes Ethernet operation for the A20 SoCs, which broke in
v2022.04-rc1, with the above mentioned commit.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Petr Štetiar <ynezz@true.cz> [a20-olinuxino-lime2]
Commit 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from
upstream Linux kernel") ported Linux's device-tree files for Armada 3720
SOCs. This broke SPI support on some Espressobin boards and results in
following U-Boot error:
Loading Environment from SPIFlash... jedec_spi_nor flash@0: unrecognized JEDEC id bytes: f7, 30, 0b
*** Warning - spi_flash_probe_bus_cs() failed, using default environment
Before that commit DT node for SPI was called 'spi-flash@0' and after
that commit it is called 'flash@0'. Before that commit 'spi-max-frequency'
was set to 50000000 and after it is 104000000.
Rename DT node 'spi-flash@0 in armada-3720-espressobin-u-boot.dtsi to
'flash@0' and set custom U-Boot 'spi-max-frequency' back to 50000000.
With this change SPI is working on Espressobin again and it is detected
with JEDEC ids ef, 60, 16 on our tested unit.
Loading Environment from SPIFlash... SF: Detected w25q32dw with page size 256 Bytes, erase size 4 KiB, total 4 MiB
OK
Note that it is unknown why spi-max-frequency with value 104000000 does not
work in U-Boot as it works fine with Linux kernel. Also note that in
defconfig file configs/mvebu_espressobin-88f3720_defconfig is set option
CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED=40000000 which is different value than in DT.
Fixes: 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from upstream Linux kernel")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
i2c changes for fixes-for-2022.04
- atsha204a-i2c.c
DTS and I2C fixes for Atmel ATSHA204 from Adrian
- i2c: fix always-true condition in i2c_probe_chip()
from Nikita
- eeprom: Do not rewrite EEPROM I2C bus with DM I2C enabled
from Marek
- clarify bootcount documentation fix from Michael
Commit 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from
upstream Linux kernel") ported Linux's device-tree files for Armada 3720
SOCs. This broke USB port on Turris MOX, because in Linux' DTS the bus
voltage supply is described as a `phy-supply` property of connector
node, a mechanism that is not supported in U-Boot yet.
For now, fix this by adding `vbus-supply` to usb3 node.
Fixes: 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from upstream Linux kernel")
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
With DM I2C, the EEPROM bus has been correctly configured in
eeprom_execute_command() already. Do not reconfigure it here
with hard-coded bus number again.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This patch replaces use fdtdec_get_addr with simpler dev_read_addr().
fdtdec_get_addr doesn't work properly on ZynqMP-based (64bit) system. Although
not confirmed, it could be related to the fact, that quoting the documentation,
"This variant hard-codes the number of cells used to represent the address and
size based on sizeof(fdt_addr_t) and sizeof(fdt_size_t)".
Signed-off-by: Adrian Fiergolski <adrian.fiergolski@fastree3d.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Once request is sent, and before receiving a response, the delay is required.
This patch fixes missing delay for before first response try.
Signed-off-by: Adrian Fiergolski <adrian.fiergolski@fastree3d.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc5
Documentation:
* Fix documentation of FIP creation for Amlogic boards
* Update Nokia RX-51 QEMU documentation
* Add Raspberry Pi documentation
UEFI:
* Fix booting via short form device paths
* Support short form device paths in 'efidebug boot add'
* Fix ESP detection for capsule updates
* Allow ACPI table usage even if device-tree exists - ignore DT
* OP-TEE based GetVariable(): return attributes when buffer too small
The tools dtbdump.efi and initrddump.efi are useful for Python testing even
if CONFIG_EFI_SELFTEST=n.
Don't clear the screen as it is incompatible with Python testing.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The block IO protocol may be installed on any handle. We should make
no assumption about the structure the handle points to.
efi_disk_is_system_part() makes an illegal widening cast from a handle
to a struct efi_disk_obj. Remove the function.
Fixes: Fixes: 41fd506842 ("efi_loader: disk: add efi_disk_is_system_part()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The GUID of partitions is sufficient for identification and will stay
constant in the lifetime of a boot option. The preceding path of the
device-path may change due to changes in the enumeration of devices.
Therefore it is preferable to use the short-form of device-paths in load
options. Adjust the 'efidebug boot add' command accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The boot manager must support loading from boot options using a short-form
device-path, e.g. one where the first element is a hard drive media path.
See '3.1.2 Load Options Processing' in UEFI specification version 2.9.
Fixes: 0e074d1239 ("efi_loader: carve out efi_load_image_from_file()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Let function efi_dp_find_obj() additionally check if a given protocol is
installed on the handle relating to the device-path.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
efi_dp_find_obj() should not return any handle with a partially matching
device path but the handle with the maximum matching device path.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Starting UEFI Spec 2.8 we must fill in the variable attributes when
GetVariable() returns EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL and Attributes is non-NULL.
This code was written with 2.7 in mind so let's move the code around a
bit and fill in the attributes EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL is returned
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
For targets that enable ACPI, we should not pass Device Trees into
the payload. However, our distro boot logic always passes the builtin
DT as an argument.
To make it easy to use ACPI with distro boot, let's just ignore the DT
argument to bootefi when ACPI is enabled. That way, we can successfully
distro boot payloads on ACPI enabled targets.
Signed-off-by: Alexander Graf <agraf@csgraf.de>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
It add documentation on licencing & provides links to the amlogic-boot-fip
pre-built files collections.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Fix documentation path in deprecated warning message about device
driver.
Signed-off-by: Johannes Krottmayer <krjdev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Fix documentation path in warning message about deprecated device driver.
Signed-off-by: Johannes Krottmayer <krjdev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
A comma at the end of a line gives sometimes strange
effects in combination with some code formatters,
so replace a comma by a semicolon in the sdram_rk3188.c
and sdram_rk3288.c files.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
U-Boot can be chainloaded from vendor firmware on ARM64 chromebooks from
a GPT partition (roughly the same as in doc/chromium/chainload.rst), but
an appropriate image header must be built-in to the U-Boot binary by
enabling LINUX_KERNEL_IMAGE_HEADER.
This header has a field for an image load offset from 2MiB alignment
which must also be customized through LNX_KRNL_IMG_TEXT_OFFSET_BASE.
Set it equal to SYS_TEXT_BASE by default for Rockchip boards, which
happens to make this offset zero and works fine on chromebook_kevin
both for chainloading and bare-metal use.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Remove double semi-colon that has been forgotten while adding the
driver. This is only a style fix since it doesn't change the
functionality of the driver.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
This is very useful to access the LibreComputer eMMC as removable
storage from a PC (e.g. like so `ums 0 mmc 0`). It has been tested as
working on my Renegade board.
Signed-off-by: Leonidas P. Papadakos <papadakospan at gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The current files and directories with wildcard patterns for
Rockchip patches in MAINTAINERS is not always complete.
Add the regex for DT related files and a generic regex for
catching some other forgotten cases, so that the maintainers
receive all Rockchip related patches.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Add support for Kevin, an RK3399-based convertible chromebook that is
very similar to Bob. This patch is mostly based on existing support for
Bob, with only minor changes for Kevin-specific things.
Unlike other Gru boards, coreboot sets Kevin's center logic to 925 mV,
so adjust it here in the dts as well. The rk3399-gru-kevin devicetree
has an unknown event code reference which has to be defined, set it
to the Linux counterpart. The new defconfig is copied from Bob with the
diffconfig:
DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE "rk3399-gru-bob" -> "rk3399-gru-kevin"
DEFAULT_FDT_FILE "rockchip/rk3399-gru-bob.dtb" -> "rockchip/rk3399-gru-kevin.dtb"
VIDEO_ROCKCHIP_MAX_XRES 1280 -> 2400
VIDEO_ROCKCHIP_MAX_YRES 800 -> 1600
+TARGET_CHROMEBOOK_KEVIN y
With this Kevin can boot from SPI flash to a usable U-Boot prompt on the
display with the keyboard working, but cannot boot into Linux for
unknown reasons.
eMMC starts in a working state but fails to re-init, microSD card works
but at a lower-than-expected speed, USB works but causes a hang on
de-init. There are known workarounds to solve eMMC and USB issues.
Cc: Marty E. Plummer <hanetzer@startmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[Alper: commit message, resync config with Bob, update MAINTAINERS,
add to Rockchip doc, add Kconfig help message, set regulator]
Co-developed-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch enables some configs that should be working on the Bob board,
based on what is observed to work on the Kevin board.
The Bob board uses an Embedded DisplayPort panel compatible with the
simple panel and Rockchip eDP drivers. Its backlight is controlled by
the Chromium OS Embedded Controller Pulse Width Modulator. Enable these
for the board.
Also set VIDEO_ROCKCHIP_MAX_{XRES,YRES} to 1280x800, the resolution of
its panel. This had to be done for the Kevin board, but it's untested if
this is actually necessary for Bob.
The Rockchip video driver needs to assert/deassert some resets, so also
enable the reset controller. RESET_ROCKCHIP defaults to y for this board
when DM_RESET=y, so it's enough to set that.
The Bob board has two USB 3.0 Type-C ports and one USB 2.0 Type-A port
on its right side. Enable the configs relevant to USB devices so these
can be used. This is despite a known issue with RK3399 boards where USB
de-init causes a hang, as there is a known workaround.
Some other rk3399-based devices enable support for the SoC's random
number generator in commit a475bef534 ("configs: rk3399: enable rng on
firefly/rock960/rockpro64"), as it can provide a KASLR seed when booting
using UEFI. Enable it for Bob as well.
The default misc_init_r() for Rockchip boards sets cpuid and ethernet
MAC address based on e-fuse block. A previous patch extends this on Gru
boards to set registers related to SoC IO domains as is necessary on
these boards. Enable this function and configs for it on Bob.
The microSD card slot on this board (and others based on Gru) is
connected to a GPIO controlled regulator (ppvar-sd-card-io), which must
be operable by U-Boot. Enable the relevant config option to allow this.
Bob boards also use the Winbond W25Q64DW SPI flash chip, enable support
for Winbond SPI flash chips in the board config so U-Boot can boot with
this chip.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds some devicetree settings for the Gru-based boards, based on
what works on a Kevin board.
Gru-based boards usually have an 8MiB SPI flash chip and boot from it.
Make the u-boot.rom file intended to be flashed on it match its size.
Add properties for booting from SPI, and only try to boot from SPI as
MMC and SD card don't seem to work in SPL yet.
The Chromium OS EC needs a delay between transactions so it can get
itself ready. Also it currently uses a non-standard way of specifying
the interrupt. Add these so that the EC works reliably.
The Rockchip Embedded DisplayPort driver is looking for a rockchip,panel
property to find the panel it should work on. Add the property for the
Gru-based boards.
The U-Boot GPIO controlled regulator driver only considers the
"enable-gpios" devicetree property, not the singular "enable-gpio" one.
Some devicetree source files have the singular form as they were added
to Linux kernel when it used that form, and imported to U-Boot as is.
Fix one instance of this in the Gru boards' devicetree to the form that
works in U-Boot.
The PWM controlled regulator driver complains that there is no init
voltage set for a regulator it drives, though it's not clear which one.
Set them all to the voltage levels coreboot sets them: 900 mV.
The RK3399 SoC needs to know the voltage level that some supplies
provides, including one fixed 1.8V audio-related regulator. Although
this synchronization is currently statically done in the board init
functions, a not-so-hypothetical driver that does this dynamically would
query the regulator only to get -ENODATA and be confused. Make sure
U-Boot knows this supply is at 1.8V by setting its limits to that.
Most of this is a reapplication of commit 08c85b57a5 ("rockchip: gru:
Add extra device-tree settings") whose changes were removed during a
sync with Linux at commit 167efc2c7a ("arm64: dts: rk3399: Sync
v5.7-rc1 from Linux"). Apply things to rk3399-gru-u-boot.dtsi instead so
they don't get lost again.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[Alper: move to -u-boot.dtsi, rewrite commit message, add more nodes]
Co-developed-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The RK3399 SoC needs to know the voltage value provided by some
regulators, which is done by setting relevant register bits. Configure
these the way other RK3399 boards do, but with the same values as are
set in the equivalent code in coreboot.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On RK3568, a register bit must be set to enable Enhanced Strobe.
However, it appears that the address of this register may differ from
vendor to vendor and should be read from the underlying MMC IP. Let the
Rockchip SDHCI driver read this address and set the relevant bit when
Enhanced Strobe configuration is requested.
The IP uses a custom mode select value (0x7) for HS400, use that instead
of the common but non-standard SDHCI_CTRL_HS400 value (0x5). Also add
some necessary DLL_STRBIN and DLL_TXCLK configuration for HS400.
Additionally, a bit signifying that the connected hardware is an eMMC
chip must be set to enable Data Strobe for HS400 and HS400ES modes. Also
make the driver set this bit as appropriate.
This is partly ported from Linux's Synopsys DWC MSHC driver which
happens to be the underlying IP. (drivers/mmc/host/sdhci-of-dwcmshc.c in
Linux tree).
Co-developed-by: Yifeng Zhao <yifeng.zhao@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Yifeng Zhao <yifeng.zhao@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
On RK3399, a register bit must be set to enable Enhanced Strobe.
Let the Rockchip SDHCI driver set it when Enhanced Strobe configuration
is requested. However, having it set makes the lower-speed modes stop
working and makes reinitialization fail, so let it be unset as needed in
set_control_reg().
This is mostly ported from Linux's Arasan SDHCI driver which happens
to be the underlying IP. (drivers/mmc/host/sdhci-of-arasan.c in Linux
tree).
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Delegate setting the Enhanced Strobe configuration to individual drivers
if they set a function for it. Return -ENOTSUPP if they do not, like
what the MMC uclass does.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Generic SDHCI driver received support for checking the busy status by
polling the DAT[0] level instead of waiting for the worst MMC switch time.
Unfortunately, it appears that this does not work for Xenon controllers
despite being a part of the standard SDHCI registers and the Armada 3720
datasheet itself telling that BIT(20) is useful for detecting the DAT[0]
busy signal.
I have tried increasing the timeout value, but I have newer managed to
catch DAT_LEVEL bits change from 0 at all.
This issue appears to hit most if not all SoC-s supported by Xenon driver,
at least A3720, A8040 and CN9130 have non working eMMC currently.
So, until a better solution is found drop the wait_dat0 OP for Xenon.
I was able to only test it on A3720, but it should work for others as well.
Fixes: 40e6f52454 ("drivers: mmc: Add wait_dat0 support for sdhci driver")
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
e-MMC and SD standards differ for some CID fields:
- 6 Byte Name - assigned by Manufacturer (SD 5 Byte)
- 1 Byte OEM - assigned by Jedec (SD 2 Byte)
See e-MMC standard (JEDEC Standard No. 84-B51), 7.2.3 (OID) and 7.2.4 (PNM)
Signed-off-by: Max Merchel <Max.Merchel@tq-group.com>
Signed-off-by: Markus Niebel <Markus.Niebel@ew.tq-group.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
After commit f132aab403 ("Revert "mmc: fsl_esdhc_imx: use
VENDORSPEC_FRC_SDCLK_ON to control card clock output""), it
involve issue in mmc_switch_voltage(), because of the special
design of usdhc.
For FSL_USDHC, it do not implement VENDORSPEC_CKEN/PEREN/HCKEN/IPGEN,
these are reserved bits(Though RM contain the definition of these bits,
but actually internal IC logic do not implement, already confirm with
IC team). Instead, use VENDORSPEC_FRC_SDCLK_ON to gate on/off the card
clock output. Here is the definition of this bit in RM:
[8] FRC_SDCLK_ON
Force CLK output active
Do not set this bit to 1 unless it is necessary. Also, make sure that
this bit is cleared when uSDHC’s clock is about to be changed (frequency
change, clock source change, or delay chain tuning).
0b - CLK active or inactive is fully controlled by the hardware.
1b - Force CLK active
In default, the FRC_SDCLK_ON is 0. This means, when there is no command
or data transfer on bus, hardware will gate off the card clock. But in
some case, we need the card clock keep on. Take IO voltage 1.8v switch
as example, after IO voltage change to 1.8v, spec require gate off the
card clock for 5ms, and gate on the clock back, once detect the card
clock on, then the card will draw the dat0 to high immediately. If there
is not clock gate off/on behavior, some card will keep the dat0 to low
level. This is the reason we fail in mmc_switch_voltage().
To fix this issue, and concern that this is only the fsl usdhc hardware
design limitation, set the bit FRC_SDCLK_ON in the beginning of the
wait_dat0() and clear it in the end. To make sure the 1.8v IO voltage
switch process align with SD specification.
For standard tuning process, usdhc specification also require the card
clock keep on, so also add these behavior in fsl_esdhc_execute_tuning().
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Tested-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Commit 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from
upstream Linux kernel") ported Linux's device-tree files for Armada 3720
SOCs. This broke network on Turris MOX, because the SOC's MDIO bus in
U-Boot currently isn't probed via DM as it's own device, but is
registered as part of mvneta's driver, which means that pinctrl
definitions are not parsed for the MDIO bus node. Also mvneta driver
does not consider "phy-handle" property, only "phy".
For now, fix this by adding armada-3720-turris-mox-u-boot.dtsi file
returning the MDIO to how it was defined previously.
A better solution (using proper mvmdio DM driver) is being work on, but
will need testing on various boards, and we need the bug fixed now for
the upcoming release.
Fixes: 0934dddc64 ("arm: a37xx: Update DTS files to version from upstream Linux kernel")
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
mtd: add NAND write protect support to stm32_fmc2_nand
stm32mp1 bsec: Add permanent lock write support
stm32mp1 bsec: Add dev in function description
cmd_stboard: Update test on misc_read() result
video: fix the check of return value of clk_set_rate in stm32_ltdc
DT: Alignment with kernel v5.17 for stm32mp15
DT: Add USB OTG pinctrl and regulator in SPL for DHCOR
DT: Move vdd_io extras into Avenger96 extras
DT: Add DFU support for DHCOM recovery
ram: stm32mp1: Unconditionally enable ASR
psci: Implement PSCI system suspend and DRAM SSR for stm32mp
The designware spi driver unconditionally uses polling.
The comment to spi_hw_init() also states that the function should disable
interrupts.
According to the DesignWare DW_apb_ssi Databook, value 0xff in IMR enables
all interrupts. Since we want to mask all interrupts write 0x0 instead.
On the canaan k210 board, pressing the reset button twice to reset the
board will run u-boot. If u-boot boots Linux without having SPI interrupts
masked, Linux will hang as soon as interrupts are enabled, because of an
interrupt storm.
Properly masking the SPI interrupts in u-boot allows us to successfully
boot Linux, even after resetting the board.
Fixes: 5bef6fd79f ("spi: Add designware master SPI DM driver used on SoCFPGA")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
[Niklas: rewrite commit message]
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
The Canaan Kendryte K210 SoC DW apb_ssi v4 spi controller is documented
to have a 32 word deep TX and RX FIFO, which spi_hw_init() detects.
However, when the RX FIFO is filled up to 32 entries (RXFLR = 32), an
RX FIFO overrun error occurs. Avoid this problem by force setting
fifo_len to 31.
Signed-off-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@opensource.wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Linux kernel fpioa pinctrl driver expects the sysctl phandle and the
power bit offset of the fpioa device to be specified as a single
property "canaan,k210-sysctl-power".
Replace the "canaan,k210-sysctl" and "canaan,k210-power-offset"
properties with "canaan,k210-sysctl-power" to satisfy the Linux kernel
requirements. This new property is parsed using the existing function
dev_read_phandle_with_args().
Signed-off-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@opensource.wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Linux drivers for many of the K210 peripherals depend on the power bus
clock to be specified. Add the missing clocks and their names to avoid
problems when booting Linux using u-boot DT.
Signed-off-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@opensource.wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
"kendryte" is the marketing name for the K210 RISC-V SoC produced by
Canaan Inc. Rather than "kendryte,k210", use the usual "canaan,k210"
vendor,SoC compatibility string format in the device tree files and
use the SoC name for file names.
With these changes, the device tree files are more in sync with the
Linux kernel DTS and drivers, making uboot device tree usable by the
kernel.
Signed-off-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@opensource.wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This patch configures U-Boot SPL for DHCOM SoM to permit DFU upload of
SPL and subsequent u-boot.itb for recovery or commissioning purposes.
The DFU usage procedure is identical to STM32MP1 DHCOR SoM, see commit
3919aa1722 ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add DFU support for DHCOR recovery") ,
except for switching the SoM into DFU mode. By default, the DHCOM SoM
has no dedicated mechanism for setting BOOTn straps into UART/USB mode,
therefore to enter DFU mode, the SoC must fail to boot from boot media
which can be selected by the BOOTn strap override mechanism first and
then fall back to DFU mode.
In case of a SoM with pre-populated BOOTn strap override button, power
the system off, remove microSD card (if applicable), hold down the BOOTn
strap override button located between eMMC and SoM edge connector, power
on the SoM. The SoC will fail to boot from SD card and fall back into
DFU mode.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Fix the following warning in SPL and make sure that even DTs which
enforce Vbus detection using u-boot,force-vbus-detection;, the DFU
in SPL will work.
dwc2-udc-otg usb-otg@49000000: prop pinctrl-0 index 0 invalid phandle
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Device tree alignment with Linux kernel v5.17-rc1
- ARM: dts: stm32: add pull-up to USART3 and UART7 RX pins
on STM32MP15 DKx boards
- ARM: dts: stm32: clean uart4_idle_pins_a node for stm32mp15
- ARM: dts: stm32: tune the HS USB PHYs on stm32mp15xx-dkx
- ARM: dts: stm32: tune the HS USB PHYs on stm32mp157c-ev1
- ARM: dts: stm32: fix stusb1600 pinctrl used on stm32mp157c-dk
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The clk_set_rate() function returns rate as an 'ulong' not
an 'int' and rate > 0 by default.
This patch avoids to display the associated warning when
the set rate function returns the new frequency.
Fixes: aeaf330649 ("video: stm32: stm32_ltdc: add bridge to display controller")
Signed-off-by: Gabriel Fernandez <gabriel.fernandez@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Update management of misc_read/misc_write, which now returns length of
data after the commit 8729b1ae2c ("misc: Update read() and write()
methods to return bytes xfered"): raise a error when the result is not
the expected length.
Fixes: 658fde8a36 ("board: stm32mp1: stboard: lock the OTP after programming")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add support of the permanent lock support in U-Boot proper
when BSEC is not managed by secure monitor (TF-A SP_MIN or OP-TEE).
This patch avoid issue with stm32key command and fuse command
on basic boot for this missing feature of U-Boot BSEC driver.
Reported-by: Johann Neuhauser <jneuhauser@dh-electronics.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Johann Neuhauser <jneuhauser@dh-electronics.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This patch adds the support of the WP# signal. WP will be disabled
before the first access to the NAND flash.
Signed-off-by: Christophe Kerello <christophe.kerello@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This saves about 12 kBytes image size and helps to stay within the
size limit.
Suggested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Soeren Moch <smoch@web.de>
Commit 90f262a695 ("vexpress64: Clean up BASE_FVP boot configuration")
cleaned up the usage of default address variables, but missed to update
the address for the kernel in the FVP's bootcmd definition.
Change ${kernel_addr} to read ${kernel_addr_r} to bring back the
automated boot for the fastmodel.
Also use "setenv" instead of the potentially ambiguous "set" on the way.
Fixes: 90f262a695 ("vexpress64: Clean up BASE_FVP boot configuration")
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Initialization and power on operations of links have been moved under the
link device in the Sierra SerDes driver. Also, the UCLASS of
sierra_phy_provider has been changed to UCLASS_MISC.
Therefore, fix the probing of SerDes0 instance accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Georgi Vlaev <g-vlaev@ti.com>
In commit 6f46c7441a ("phy: cadence: Sierra: Add a UCLASS_PHY device for
links"), a separate udevice of type UCLASS_PHY was created for each link.
Therefore, move the corresponding link operations under the link device.
Also, change the uclass of sierra phy to UCLASS_MISC as it is no longer the
phy device.
Fixes: 6f46c7441a ("phy: cadence: Sierra: Add a UCLASS_PHY device for links")
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Georgi Vlaev <g-vlaev@ti.com>
The Rockchip RK3399 eMMC PHY has to be power-cycled while changing its
clock speed to some higher speeds. This is dependent on the desired
SDHCI clock speed, and it looks like the PHY should be powered off while
setting the SDHCI clock in these cases.
Commit ac804143cf ("mmc: rockchip_sdhci: add phy and clock config for
rk3399") attempts to do this in the set_ios_post() hook by setting the
SDHCI clock once more while the PHY is turned off/on as necessary, as
the SDHCI framework does not provide a way to override how it sets its
clock. However, the commit breaks reinitializing the eMMC on a few
boards including chromebook_kevin and reportedly ROCKPro64.
This patch reworks the power cycling to utilize the SDHCI framework
slightly better (using the set_control_reg() hook to power off the PHY
and set_ios_post() hook to power it back on) which happens to fix the
issue, at least on a chromebook_kevin.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remap PCI I/O space to the bus address 0x0 in the Armada 37xx device-tree
in order to support legacy I/O port based cards which have hardcoded I/O
ports in low address space.
Some legacy PCI I/O based cards do not support 32-bit I/O addressing.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit 9e6d71d2b5 ("tools: kwboot: Allow to use -b without image path as
the last getopt() option") broke usage of kwboot with following arguments:
kwboot -t -B 115200 /dev/ttyUSB0 -b u-boot-spl.kwb
Fix parsing of option -b with optional argument again.
Fixes: 9e6d71d2b5 ("tools: kwboot: Allow to use -b without image path as the last getopt() option")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reported-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi at gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Call kwboot_open_tty() which baudrate value which was specified at the
command line by option -B. This function returns error if baudrate is not
supported by selected tty device.
Initial baudrate for image transfer is always 115200, so call
kwboot_tty_change_baudrate() with value 115200 immediately after
kwboot_open_tty() if baudrate specified by option -B is different than
115200.
This makes kwboot fail immediately, informing that baudrate is unsupported,
instead of failing only after the first part of image is already sent.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Custom baudrate different than 115200 may be specified only when kwboot is
not going to send boot/debug message pattern or when it is going to send
boot message pattern with image file (in which case baudrate change happens
after sending kwbimage header). BootROM detects boot/debug message pattern
only at baudrate 115200.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
dev_read_size() returns -EINVAL (-22) if the property "g-tx-fifo-size"
does not exist. If that's the case, we now keep the default value of 0.
Signed-off-by: Wolfgang Grandegger <wg@aries-embedded.de>
This enum is currently anonymous. Add a name so it can be used in the
code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc3-2
Documentation:
* Fix description for SiFive Unmatched
* Add libgnutls28-dev to build dependencies
UEFI
* Avoid possibly invalid GUID pointers for protocol interfaces
Other
* Serial console support for cls command
InstallProtocolInterface() is called with a pointer to the protocol GUID.
There is not guarantee that the memory used by the caller for the protocol
GUID stays allocated. To play it safe the GUID should be copied to U-Boot's
internal structures.
Reported-by: Joerie de Gram <j.de.gram@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Currently the cls command does not support the serial console
The screen can be cleared in the video uclass, the colored frame buffer
console, and the serial console by sending the same escape sequence.
This reduces the cls command to a single printf() statement on most
boards.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some sunxi boards ship with SPI flash, which allows booting through the
BootROM. We cover this functionality by a separate SPL "mini" driver.
Separately we have a proper DM_SPI driver for U-Boot proper, which
provides access to the SPI flash through the "sf" command. That allows
to update the firmware on the SPI flash, also to store the environment
there.
However only very few boards actually enable support for U-Boot proper,
even though that would work and the SPL part is configured.
Use the cleaned up configuration scheme to enable SPI flash on those
boards which mention a SPI flash in their .dts, or which use the SPL SPI
support.
Out of the box this would enable storing the environment on the SPI
flash, and allows people to read or write the flash from U-Boot, for
instance to update the SPI flash when booted via an SD card.
For this to actually work there must be a "spi0" alias in the DT, which
most boards are missing. But this should be addressed separately.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Now that sunxi uses CONFIG_SPI more sanely, and can also now properly
load the environment from SPI flash, let's enable the symbol that
actually considers the SPI flash when accessing the environment.
As this symbol depends on CONFIG_SPI, which we now only enable if the
board has a SPI flash, we can make if "default y" for all Allwinner
boards.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Currently we only support to load the environment from raw MMC or FAT
locations on Allwinner boards. With the advent of SPI flash we probably
also want to support using the environment there, so we need to become
a bit more flexible.
Change the environment priority function to take the boot source into
account. When booted from eMMC or SD card, we use FAT or MMC, if
configured, as before.
If we are booted from SPI flash, we try to use the environment from
there, if possible. The same is true for NAND flash booting, although
this is somewhat theoretical right now (as untested).
This way we can use the same image for SD and SPI flash booting, which
allows us to simply copy a booted image from SD card to the SPI flash,
for instance.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
To allow loading and storing the environment from SPI flash, adjust the
raw offset variables for Allwinner boards to make sense there.
U-Boot (including SPL and other blobs) is loaded from the beginning of
SPI flash, so move the environment location as far back as possible, to
not create unnecessary limits. As those offsets are shared with (now
mostly unused) raw MMC environment, we should respect the common one
megabyte limit, which also makes sense on SPI flash.
So limit the environment for those raw locations to 64KB, and place it
just below 1MB (@960KB).
Those values are currently unused, unless someone forcibly enables the
raw MMC environment. In this case it would break as of now, as the
current offset of 544KB is far too low for the current (arm64) U-Boot
proper.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Commit 7945caf22c ("arm: sunxi: Enable SPI/SPI-FLASH support for A64")
selected CONFIG_SPI by default on all Allwinner A64 boards, even though
only 4 out of the 14 A64 boards have a SPI flash chip. All other SoCs
had to manually select DM_SPI and friends, even though they are a
platform property (the sunxi SPI driver is DM_SPI only).
Clean this up to allow easy selection of SPI flash support in U-Boot
proper, by selecting DM_SPI and DM_SPI_FLASH *if* CONFIG_SPI is
selected, for *all* Allwinner SoCs. This simplifies the defconfig for
two Libretech boards already.
Also remove the forced CONFIG_SPI from the A64 Kconfig, instead let the
four boards which allow SPI booting select this explicitly.
Any board wishing to support SPI flash in U-Boot proper now just defines
CONFIG_SPI and CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_<vendor> in its defconfig, Kconfig takes
care of the rest.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Mechanically convert video_hw_init() function to UCLASS_VIDEO probe
callback and replace CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE by CONFIG_DM_VIDEO.
As framebuffer base address is setup by the bootloader which loads U-Boot,
set plat->base to that fixed framebuffer address.
This change was tested in qemu n900 machine and is working fine.
What does not work is CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO, seems to be buggy.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Since commit 5d94cbd1dc ("scripts: Makefile.lib: generate
dsdt_generated.c instead of dsdt.c"), the file generated
is named dsdt_generated.c instead of dsdt.c.
So all files .gitignore referencing dsdt.c should be
upated with dsdt_generated.c.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The stdout-path property in the device tree does not necessarily
point at a serial device. On machines such as the Apple M1 laptops
where the serial port isn't easy to access and users expect to see
console output on the integrated display stdout-path may point at
the device tree node for the framebuffer for example.
If stdout-path does not point at a node for a serial device, the
serial_check_stdout() will not find a bound device and will drop
down into code that attempts to use lists_bind_fdt() to bind a
device anyway. However, that fallback code does not check that
the uclass of the device is UCLASS_SERIAL. So if stdout-path points
at the framebuffer instead of the serial device it will return a
UCLASS_VIDEO device. Since the code that calls this function
expects the returned device to be a UCLASS_SERIAL device, U-Boot
will crash as soon as it attempts to send output to the console.
Add a check here to verify that the uclass of the bound device
really is UCLASS_SERIAL. If it isn't, serial_check_stdout() will
return an error and serial_find_console_or_panic() will use the
serial device with sequence number 0 as the console and all is fine.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When running against RC_OSC_32k, the watchdog may suffer from running
faster than expected, expiring earlier. The Linux kernel adds a 10%
margin to the timeout calculation by slowing down the read clock rate
accordingly. Do the same here, also to have comparable preset values
for both drivers.
Along this, fix the name of the local var holding to frequency - in Hz,
not kHz.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If Armada 37xx watchdog is started before U-Boot then CNTR_CTRL_ACTIVE bit
is set, U-Boot armada-37xx-wdt.c driver fails to initialize and so U-Boot
is unable to use or kick this watchdog.
Do not check for CNTR_CTRL_ACTIVE bit and always initialize watchdog. Same
behavior is implemented in Linux kernel driver.
This change allows to activate watchdog in firmware which loads U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Since commit 492ee6b8d0 ("watchdog: wdt-uclass.c: handle all DM
watchdogs in watchdog_reset()"), all the watchdog are started when
the config WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART.
To avoid a binary choice none/all, a property u-boot,noautostart
may be added in the watchdog node of the u-boot device tree to not
autostart this watchdog.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
I've been handling "inofficially" the watchdog related patches for a few
years now. Let's make this official and add a tree for it and also add
myself here in the MAINTAINERS file.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Since OpenSSL 1.1.0, EVP_MD_CTX_create() is EVP_MD_CTX_new()
EVP_MD_CTX_destroy() is EVP_MD_CTX_free()
EVP_MD_CTX_init() is EVP_MD_CTX_reset()
As there's no need to reset a newly created EVP_MD_CTX, moreover
EVP_DigestSignInit() does the reset, thus call to EVP_MD_CTX_init()
can be dropped.
As there's no need to reset an EVP_MD_CTX before it's destroyed,
as it will be reset by EVP_MD_CTX_free(), call to EVP_MD_CTX_reset()
is not needed and can be dropped.
Signed-off-by: Yann Droneaud <ydroneaud@opteya.com>
Based on looking at top contributors it was seen that top statistics from
top contributors don't include all contributions from different email
addresses. That's why I checked all top contributors are checked it.
git shortlog -n $START..$END -e -s
The patch is adding mapping for Bin Meng, Marek Vasut, Masahiro Yamada,
Michal Simek, Tom Rini, Wolfgang Denk.
And also use mapping for Stefan Roese and Wolfgang Denk to be properly
counted.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Acked-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If parameter -F is given but FIT support is missing, a NULL pointer might
dereferenced (Coverity CID 350249).
If incorrect parameters are given, provide a message and show usage.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Recent unrelated fixes (9876ae7db6) revealed that we were missing bits
from 2af181b53e in the IOT2050 dt. Add them, but only for main U-Boot.
SPL loads from QSPI only, thus cannot use DMA.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
We only want to call do_board_detect() if CONFIG_TI_I2C_BOARD_DETECT
is set. Same as done for am64.
This makes it possible to add a custom am65 based board design to
U-Boot that does not use this board detection mechanism.
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Public documents about BootROM of some Marvell SoCs are available in the
public Web Archive. Put this information into source code.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Testes proved that current kwboot version supports also Avanta SoCs.
It looks like that Avanta SoCs are using same kwbimage format as Armada.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Document -D, -b, -d, -q and -s options.
Add common examples how to use kwboot.
Add information about Armada 38x BootROM bug for debug console mode and how
to workaround it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add all supported Armada SoCs and document -b and -d options in usage.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Marvell BootROM recognize only '\b' byte as backspace. Use terminfo
for retrieving current backspace sequence and replace any occurrence of
backspace sequence by the '\b' byte.
Reading terminfo database is possible via tigetstr() function from system
library libtinfo.so.*. So link kwboot with -ltinfo.
Normally terminfo functions are in <term.h> system header file. But this
header file conflicts with U-Boot "termios_linux.h" header file. So declare
terminfo functions manually.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
-d option is currently broken. In most cases BootROM does not detect this
message pattern. For sending debug message pattern it is needed to do same
steps as for boot message pattern.
Implement sending debug message pattern via same separate thread like it is
for boot message pattern.
Checking if BootROM entered into UART debug mode is different than
detecting UART boot mode. When in boot mode, BootROM sends xmodem NAK
bytes. When in debug mode, BootROM activates console echo and reply back
every written byte (extept \r\n which is interpreted as executing command
and \b which is interpreting as removing the last sent byte).
So in kwboot, check that BootROM send back at least 4 debug message
patterns as a echo reply for debug message patterns which kwboot is sending
in the loop.
Then there is another observation, if host writes too many bytes (as
command) then BootROM command line buffer may overflow after trying to
execute such long command. To workaround this overflow, it is enough to
remove bytes from the input line buffer by sending 3 \b bytes for every
sent character. So do it.
With this change, it is possbile to enter into the UART debug mode with
kwboot -d option.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After BootROM successfully detects boot message pattern on UART it waits
until host stop sending data on UART. For example Armada 385 BootROM
requires that host does not send anything on UART at least 24 ms. If host
is still sending something then BootROM waits (possibly infinitely).
BootROM successfully detects boot message pattern if it receives it in
small period of time after power on.
So to ensure that host put BootROM into UART boot mode, host must send
continuous stream of boot message pattern with a small gap (for A385 at
least 24 ms) after series of pattern. But this gap cannot be too often or
too long to ensure that it does not cover whole BootROM time window when it
is detecting for boot message pattern.
Therefore it is needed to do following steps in cycle without any delay:
1. send series of boot message pattern over UART
2. wait until kernel transmit all data
3. sleep small period of time
At the same time, host needs to monitor input queue, data received on the
UART and checking if it contains NAK byte by which BootROM informs that
xmodem transfer is ready.
But it is not possible to wait until kernel transmit all data on UART and
at the same time in the one process to also wait for input data. This is
limitation of POSIX tty API and also by linux kernel that it does not
provide asynchronous function for waiting until all data are transmitted.
There is only synchronous variant tcdrain().
So to correctly implement this handshake on systems with linux kernel, it
is needed to use tcdrain() in separate thread.
Implement sending of boot message pattern in one thread and reading of
reply in the main thread. Use pthread library for threads.
This change makes UART booting on Armada 385 more reliable. It is possible
to start kwboot and power on board after minute and kwboot correctly put
board into UART boot mode.
Old implementation without separate thread has an issue that it read just
one byte from UART input queue and then it send 128 message pattern to the
output queue. If some noise was on UART then kwboot was not able to read
BootROM response as its input queue was just overflowed and kwboot was
sending more data than receiving.
This change basically fixed above issue too.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function kwboot_debugmsg() is always called with kwboot_msg_debug as msg
and function kwboot_bootmsg() with kwboot_msg_debug as msg. Function
kwboot_bootmsg() is never called with NULL msg.
Simplify, cleanup and remove dead code.
No functional change.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Variable msg_req_delay is set but never used. So completely remove it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Failure of kwboot_tty_send() and tcflush() functions is fatal, it does not
make sense to continue. So return error back to the caller like in other
places where are called these functions.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit 369e532691 ("ddr: marvell: a38x: allow board specific ODT
configuration") added the odt_config member to struct
mv_ddr_topology_map ahead of the clk_enable and ck_delay members. This
means that any boards that configured either of clk_enable or ck_delay
needed to have their board topology updated. This affects the x530 and
clearfog boards. Other A38x boards don't touch any of the trailing
members of mv_ddr_topology_map so don't need updating.
Fixes: 369e532691 ("ddr: marvell: a38x: allow board specific ODT configuration")
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Replace null pointer by pointer to device registers when calling
armada38x_rtc_write.
Signed-off-by: Francois Berder <fberder@outlook.fr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The a3700_fdt_fix_pcie_regions() function still computes nonsense.
It computes the fixup offset from the PCI address taken from the first
row of the "ranges" array, which means that:
- PCI address must equal CPU address (otherwise the computed fix offset
will be wrong),
- the first row must contain the lowest address.
This is the case for the default device-tree, which is why we didn't
notice it.
It also adds the fixup offset to all PCI and CPU addresses, which is
wrong.
Instead:
1) The fixup offset must be computed from the CPU address, not PCI
address.
2) The fixup offset must be computed from the row containing the lowest
CPU address, which is not necessarily contained in the first row.
3) The PCI address - the address to which the PCIe controller remaps the
address space as seen from the point of view of the PCIe device -
must be fixed by the fix offset in the same way as the CPU address
only in the special case when the CPU adn PCI addresses are the same.
Same addresses means that remapping is disabled, and thus if we
change the CPU address, we need also to change the PCI address so
that the remapping is still disabled afterwards.
Consider an example:
The ranges entries contain:
PCI address CPU address
70000000 EA000000
E9000000 E9000000
EB000000 EB000000
By default CPU PCIe window is at: E8000000 - F0000000
Consider the case when TF-A moves it to: F2000000 - FA000000
Until now the function would take the PCI address of the first entry:
70000000, and the new base, F2000000, to compute the fix offset:
F2000000 - 70000000 = 82000000, and then add 8200000 to all addresses,
resulting in
PCI address CPU address
F2000000 6C000000
6B000000 6B000000
6D000000 6D000000
which is complete nonsense - none of the CPU addresses is in the
requested window.
Now it will take the lowest CPU address, which is in second row,
E9000000, and compute the fix offset F2000000 - E9000000 = 09000000,
and then add it to all CPU addresses and those PCI addresses which
equal to their corresponding CPU addresses, resulting in
PCI address CPU address
70000000 F3000000
F2000000 F2000000
F4000000 F4000000
where all of the CPU addresses are in the needed window.
Fixes: 4a82fca8e3 ("arm: a37xx: pci: Fix a3700_fdt_fix_pcie_regions() function")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable ext4 write support in Turris Omnia's defconfig. Some users find
it useful.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use "MVPCIE_" prefix instead of generic "PCIE_" prefix for pci_mvebu.c
specific macros. Define offset macros for Root Port registers and use
standard register macros from pci.h when accessing Root Port registers.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Macro SELECT() is unused and struct mvebu_pcie field lane_mask is unused
too. Remove them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Sometimes kwboot after quitting terminal prints error message:
terminal: Bad address
This is caused by trying to call write() syscall with count of (size_t)-1
bytes.
When quit sequence is split into more read() calls then number of input
bytes (nin) at the end of cycle can underflow and be negative. Fix it.
Fixes: de7514046e ("tools: kwboot: Fix detection of quit esc sequence")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
First set of u-boot-atmel fixes for the 2022.04 cycle:
This fixes set includes only a single fix for the Ethernet on sama7g5ek
board which is broken at the moment.
The F1C100s DT contains the wrong compatible string for the watchdog,
which breaks reset functionality.
Updating the DT goes via the Linux tree, but to allow reset
functionality meanwhile (useful for development!), disable SYSRESET for
now, to let the old-fashioned watchdog driver kick in and provide the
reset_cpu() implementation.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Commit 88998f7775 ("arm: arm926ej-s: Add sunxi code") introduced
the ARM926 version of the code to save and restore some FEL state, to
be able to return to the BROM FEL code after the SPL has run.
However during review a change was made, that happened to mess up the
register restore part, so SCTLR and CPSR ended up with the wrong values,
breaking return to FEL.
Use the same offset that we actually save those registers to, to make
FEL booting actually work on the Lichee Pi Nano.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The SUNIV SoCs come with a sun6i-style SPI controller at the base address
of sun4i SPI controller. The module clock of the SPI controller is
missing which leaves us running directly from the AHB clock, which is
set to 200MHz.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
[Icenowy: Original implementation]
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <Mr.Bossman075@gmail.com>
[Jesse: adaptation to Upstream U-Boot]
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
In contrast to other Allwinner SoCs the F1C100s BROM does not store a
boot source indicator in the eGON header in SRAM. This leaves the SPL
guessing where we were exactly booted from, and for instance trying
the SD card first, even though we booted from SPI flash.
By inspecting the BROM code and by experimentation, Samuel found that the
top of the BROM stack contains unique pointers for each of the boot
sources, which we can use as a boot source indicator.
This patch removes the existing board_boot_order bodge and replace it
with a proper boot source indication function.
The only caveat is that this only works in the SPL, as the SPL header
gets overwritten with the exception vectors, once U-Boot proper takes
over. Always return MMC0 as the boot source, when called from U-Boot
proper, as a placeholder for now, until we find another way.
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <Mr.Bossman075@gmail.com>
Suggested-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Ensure there is a valid reset-gpio defined before using it.
Fixes: f9852acdce ("phy: nop-phy: Fix enabling reset")
Cc: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
This patch scans the cmdline from the Samsung SBL (second stage
bootloader) and stores the parameters board_id=N and lcdtype=N
in order to augment the DTB for different board and LCD types.
We then add a custom ft_board_setup() callback that will inspect
the DTB and patch it using the stored LCD type. At this point
we know which product we are dealing with, so using the passed
board_id we can also print the board variant for diagnostics.
We patch the Codina, Skomer and Kyle DTBs to use the right
LCD type as passed in lcdtype from the SBL.
This also creates an infrastructure for handling any other
Samsung U8500 board variants that may need a slightly augmented
DTB.
Cc: Markuss Broks <markuss.broks@gmail.com>
Cc: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Signed-off-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Support for Apple M1 Pro and Max will allow using a single binary for
all M1 SoCs. The M1 Pro/Max have a different memory layout. The RAM
start address is 0x100_0000_0000 instead of 0x8_0000_0000.
Replace the hardcoded memory layout with dynamic initialized
environment variables in board_late_init().
Tested on Mac Mini (2020) and Macbook Pro 14-inch (2021).
Signed-off-by: Janne Grunau <j@jannau.net>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
To make sure we get a working console as soon as possible in the SPL the
UART pins require to be configured earlier. This is especially
true for the pins of UART3, since the PDU001 board uses this UART for
the console by default.
Signed-off-by: Felix Brack <fb@ltec.ch>
The changes from commit 0dba45864b ("arm: Init the debug UART")
prevent the early debug UART from being initialized correctly.
To fix this we not just configure the pin multiplexer but add setting up
early clocks.
Signed-off-by: Felix Brack <fb@ltec.ch>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently -l option for mkimage and dumpimage ignores option -T and always
tries to autodetect image type.
With this change it is possible to tell mkimage and dumpimage to parse
image file as specific type (and not random autodetected type). This allows
to use mkimage -l or dumpimage -l as tool for validating image.
params.type for -l option is now by default initialized to zero
(IH_TYPE_INVALID) instead of IH_TYPE_KERNEL. imagetool_get_type() for
IH_TYPE_INVALID returns NULL, which is assigned to tparams. mkimage and
dumpimage code is extended to handle tparams with NULL for -l option. And
imagetool_verify_print_header() is extended to do validation via tparams if
is not NULL.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The BOOT_TARGET_DEVICES list for distro_bootcmd was hard-coded to assume
that all boot devices are available/enabled in the configuration,
thus ignoring the actual config settings. The config_distro_bootcmd.h
header file specifically has compile-time checks to detect such problems.
To allow disabling USB, SCSI, etc. in custom lx2160a board configs,
make it depend on the config settings and use only the enabled features.
Signed-off-by: Daniel Klauer <daniel.klauer@gin.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Simplify the binman config and fdt nodes by using the "@..-SEQ"
substitutions and CONFIG_OF_LIST.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Nowadays, u-boot (when CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR is set) will set
enetaddr to a random value if not set and then pass the randomly
generated MAC address to linux.
This is bad for the following reasons:
(1) it makes it impossible for linux to detect this error
(2) linux won't trigger any fallback mechanism for the case where
it didn't find any valid MAC address
(3) a saveenv will store this randomly generated MAC address in the
environment
Probably, the user will also be unaware that something is wrong. He will
just get different MAC addresses on each reboot, asking himself why this
is the case.
As this board usually have a serial port, the user can just fix this by
setting the MAC address manually in the environment. Also disable the
netconsole just in case, because it cannot be guaranteed that it will
work in any case. After all, this was just a convenience option, because
the bootloader - right now - doesn't have the ability to read the MAC
address, which is stored in the OTP. But it is far more important to
have a clear view of whats wrong with a board and that means we can no
longer use this Kconfig option.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
They are no longer needed, because we now have proper driver support for
the sl28cpld management controller.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board has an internal watchdog which supervises the board startup.
Although, the initial state of the watchdog is configurable, it is
enabled by default. In board_late_init(), which means almost everything
worked as expected, disable the watchdog.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The SoC provides two additional watchdogs integrated in the SoC. Enable
support for these.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable the GPIO and watchdog driver. Don't start the watchdog
automatically, though.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Most of the time it is very useful to have the version of the board
management controller. Now that we have a driver, print it during
startup.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The current console output is:
DRAM: 4 GiB
DDR 4 GiB (DDR3, 32-bit, CL=11, ECC on)
The size is printed twice and we can save one line of console output if
we join both lines. The new output is as follows:
DRAM: 4 GiB (DDR3, 32-bit, CL=11, ECC on)
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The gpio block is part of the sl28cpld sl28cpld management controller.
There are three different flavors: the usual input and output where the
direction is configurable, but also input only and output only variants.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The watchdog timer is part of the sl28cpld management controller. The
watchdog timer usually supervises the bootloader boot-up and if it bites
the failsafe bootloader will be activated. Apart from that it supports
the usual board level reset and one SMARC speciality: driving the
WDT_TIMEOUT# signal.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add a multi-function device driver which will probe its children and
provides methods to access the device.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc3
Documentation:
* add man-page for fatload
* add SMBIOS table page
UEFI:
* partial fix for UEFI secure boot with intermediate certs
* disable watchdog when returning to command line
* reset system after capsule update
UEFI specification requires that 5 minutes watchdog timer is
armed before the firmware's boot manager invokes an EFI boot option.
This watchdog timer is updated as follows, according to the
UEFI specification.
1) The EFI Image may reset or disable the watchdog timer as needed.
2) If control is returned to the firmware's boot manager,
the watchdog timer must be disabled.
3) On successful completion of EFI_BOOT_SERVICES.ExitBootServices()
the watchdog timer is disabled.
1) is up to the EFI image, and 3) is already implemented in U-Boot.
This patch implements 2), the watchdog is disabled when control is
returned to U-Boot.
In addition, current implementation arms the EFI watchdog at only
the first "bootefi" invocation. The EFI watchdog must be armed
in every EFI boot option invocation.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Add a cold reset soon after processing capsule update on disk.
This is required in UEFI specification 2.9 Section 8.5.5
"Delivery of Capsules via file on Mass Storage device" as;
In all cases that a capsule is identified for processing the system is
restarted after capsule processing is completed.
This also reports the result of each capsule update so that the user can
notice that the capsule update has been succeeded or not from console log.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Add expected_reset optional argument to ConsoleBase::ensure_spawned(),
ConsoleBase::restart_uboot() and ConsoleSandbox::restart_uboot_with_flags()
so that it can handle a reset while the 1st boot process after main
boot logo before prompt correctly.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Add wait_for_reboot optional argument to ConsoleBase::run_command()
so that it can handle an expected reset by command execution.
This is useful if a command will reset the sandbox while testing
such commands, e.g. run_command("reset", wait_for_reboot = True)
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Since the efi_update_capsule() represents the UpdateCapsule() runtime
service, it has to handle the capsule flags and update ESRT. However
the capsule-on-disk doesn't need to care about such things.
Thus, the capsule-on-disk should use the efi_capsule_update_firmware()
directly instead of calling efi_update_capsule().
This means the roles of the efi_update_capsule() and capsule-on-disk
are different. We have to keep the efi_update_capsule() for providing
runtime service API at boot time.
Suggested-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The general rule of accepting or rejecting an image is
1. Is the sha256 of the image in dbx
2. Is the image signed with a certificate that's found in db and
not in dbx
3. The image carries a cert which is signed by a cert in db (and
not in dbx) and the image can be verified against the former
4. Is the sha256 of the image in db
For example SHIM is signed by "CN=Microsoft Windows UEFI Driver Publisher",
which is issued by "CN=Microsoft Corporation UEFI CA 2011", which in it's
turn is issued by "CN=Microsoft Corporation Third Party Marketplace Root".
The latter is a self-signed CA certificate and with our current implementation
allows shim to execute if we insert it in db.
However it's the CA cert in the middle of the chain which usually ends up
in the system's db. pkcs7_verify_one() might or might not return the root
certificate for a given chain. But when verifying executables in UEFI, the
trust anchor can be in the middle of the chain, as long as that certificate
is present in db. Currently we only allow this check on self-signed
certificates, so let's remove that check and allow all certs to try a
match an entry in db.
Open questions:
- Does this break any aspect of variable authentication since
efi_signature_verify() is used on those as well?
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
SMBIOS is not x86 specific. So we should have an architecture independent
page describing it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The wrong phy was being enabled, because it worked and the proper
PHY did not. After the Renesas maintainer made some adjustments
to the device tree, Linux was able to use the proper driver, and
when that device tree was ported to Linux, the ethernet stopped
working due to the lack of rgmii-rxid support. Now that
rgmii-rxid is supported, enable the proper driver to restore
ethernet function.
Fixes: 1eaf61c84d ("arm: dts: beacon-rzg2: Resync device trees with Linux 5.16-rc3")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Some boards like the Beacon RZ/G2 SOM use either flags for
tx-internal-delay-ps, rx-internal-delay-ps or rgmii-rxid.
In Linux the APSR_RDM flag is set when either rx-internal-delay-ps
is set or the mode is rgmii-rxid, and the APSR_TDM is set when
tx-internal-delay-ps is found or rgmii-txid is set, and both
are set if rgmii-id is set.
The ravb driver in U-Boot driver was missing rgmii-rxid support,
so add that support in a similar fashion to what is done in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
There is a conflict between the static file
lib/acpi/dsdt.c and the file dsdt.c generated
dynamicaly by scripts/Makefile.lib. When a
mrproper is done, the static file dsdt.c is
removed. If a build with acpi enabled is
launched after, the following error is raised:
CC lib/acpi/acpi_table.o
make[2]: *** No rule to make target 'lib/acpi/dsdt.asl', needed by 'lib/acpi/dsdt.c'. Stop.
scripts/Makefile.build:394: recipe for target 'lib/acpi' failed
To avoid such error, the generated file is named
dsdt_generated.c instead of dstdt.c.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Tested-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
The function clk_lookup can be replaced by a direct call
to uclass_get_device_by_name for UCLASS_CLK.
This patch removes duplicated codes by the generic DM API and avoids
issue in clk_lookup because result of uclass_get_device wasn't tested;
when ret < 0, dev = NULL and dev->name is invalid, the next function
call strcmp(name, dev->name) causes a crash.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220131172131.2.I7bc7762eff1e31ab7ff5b34c416ee03b8fe52200@changeid
Test the number of argument in setfreq command to avoid a crash when
the command setfreq is called without argument:
STM32MP> clk setfreq
data abort
pc : [<ddba3f18>] lr : [<ddba3f89>]
reloc pc : [<c018ff18>] lr : [<c018ff89>]
sp : dbaf45b8 ip : ddb1d859 fp : 00000002
r10: dbb3fd80 r9 : dbb11e90 r8 : ddbf38cc
r7 : ddb39725 r6 : 00000000 r5 : 00000000 r4 : dbb3fd84
r3 : dbb3fd84 r2 : 0000000a r1 : dbaf45bc r0 : 00000011
Flags: nzCv IRQs off FIQs off Mode SVC_32 (T)
Code: 4dd3 1062 85a3 ddbd (7803) 2b30
Resetting CPU ...
Fixes: 7ab418fbe6 ("clk: add support for setting clk rate from cmdline")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220131172131.1.I32a8f213d330dccd922f7aafc60d3d63fcbe8615@changeid
It is safe to check if the uclass id on the device is UCLASS_CLK
before to call the clk_ functions, but today this comparison is
not done on the device used in API: clkp->dev->parent
but on the device himself: clkp->dev.
This patch corrects this behavior and tests if the parent device
is a clock device before to call the clock API, clk_enable or
clk_disable, on this device.
Fixes: 0520be0f67 ("clk: prograte clk enable/disable to parent")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
The optional varients of clk_get_* functions are just simple wrappers.
Reduce code size a bit by inlining them. On platforms where it is not used
(most of them), it will not be compiled in any more. On platforms where
they are used, the inlined branch should not cause any significant growth.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211222171114.3091780-3-seanga2@gmail.com
The driver is currently using sizeof(op->cmd.opcode) in the op_len
calculation. Commit d15de62301 ("spi: spi-mem: allow specifying a
command's extension") changed op->cmd.opcode from one byte to two.
Instead, a new struct member op->cmd.nbytes is supposed to be used.
For regular commands op->cmd.nbytes will be one.
Commit d15de62301 ("spi: spi-mem: allow specifying a command's
extension") did update some drivers that overload the generic mem_ops()
implementation, but forgot to update dw_spi_mem_ops().
Calculating op_len incorrectly causes dw_spi_mem_ops() to misbehave, since
op_len is used to determine how many bytes that should be read/written.
On the canaan k210 board, this causes the probe of the SPI flash to fail.
Fix the op_len calculation in dw_spi_mem_ops(). Doing so results in
working SPI flash on the canaan k210 board.
Fixes: d15de62301 ("spi: spi-mem: allow specifying a command's extension")
Signed-off-by: Niklas Cassel <niklas.cassel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Tested-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@opensource.wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
In the TI am65 device tree files there is no reset defined. Also
the Linux kernel driver uses devm_reset_control_get_optional_exclusive(..)
to get the reset.
Lets do the same as the kernel does and make thr reset optinal.
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
With the Kconfig options being deleted, the references to
OMAP_EHCI_PHY are useless. Remove them from the various
defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
With the omap-ehci driver now using the phy subsystem to enable
and disable reset, the driver no longer needs to know which
GPIO's are used, and they can be removed from Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
There are a few boards that use hard-coded GPIO definitions in
their respective defconfig files. If the GPIO's are listed
in their device trees, the nop-phy can toggle the GPIO's,
so the EHCI driver does not need to know anything about the
GPIO's. Add functions for getting the phys and remove the GPIO
toggles since the phy will now do that.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The USB_EHCI_OMAP driver currently has a series of Kconfig options
which let users specify a GPIO for the reset pin. Some devices
may have only one reset, while others might have more.
Since there is a nop phy driver, let's selct enable the PHY
system, and imply the nop phy driver. The nop phy driver can now
toggle the reset pins when putting the phy in and out of reset.
If the gpio is listed under the phy, it will get toggled and
the hard-coded config options specifying the GPIO numbers can
eventually go away.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The reset function should place the phy into reset, while the
init function should take the phy out of reset. Currently the
reset function takes it out of reset, and the init calls the
reset.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The OMAP3 hierarchy has the ehci node as a sub-node of the
usbhshost. The usbhshost node contains an ohci and an ehci
subnode. The configuration of the ehci belongs in the
EHCI node and not its parent. Move it to the proper probe.
usb start
starting USB...
Bus ehci@48064800: USB EHCI 1.00
Bus usb_otg_hs@480ab000: Port not available.
scanning bus ehci@48064800 for devices... 3 USB Device(s) found
scanning usb for storage devices... 1 Storage Device(s) found
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
omap_ehci_hcd_stop appears to be dead code, and omap_ehci_hcd_init
is only called by the probe function, so it can be static to that
function. Remove both from the header along with some additional
checking for DM_USB.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
On some configs (like stm32mp15_dhcom_basic_defconfig), if configs
SPL_LOAD_FIT_FULL and SPL_FIT_FULL_CHECK are enabled. Then the compilatio
fails with the following error:
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: boot/image-fit.o: in function `fit_check_format':
<PATH>/uboot/u-boot-stm/boot/image-fit.c:1641: undefined reference to `fdt_check_full'
scripts/Makefile.spl:509: recipe for target 'spl/u-boot-spl' failed
This issue happens because the function fdt_check_full is only defined if
"!defined(FDT_ASSUME_MASK) || FDT_ASSUME_MASK != 0xff". But this function
may be called even if this condition are not verified. To avoid this issue,
the function fdt_check_full is always defined.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The port/hub leaf nodes don't contain the phy definitions in some dts
files so check the parents.
Signed-off-by: Angus Ainslie <angus@akkea.ca>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we only support expanding out FDT nodes. Make the operation
into an @operation property, so that others can be supported.
Re-arrange and tidy up the documentation so that it has separate
headings for each topic.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Split subnode and property processing into separate functions to make
the _AddNode() function a little smaller. Tweak a few comments.
This does not change any functionality.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Collecting the data from a list of entries and putting it in a file is
a useful operation that will be needed by other entry types. Put this into
a method in the Entry class.
Add some documentation about how to collect data for an entry type.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a file that has two text sections at different addresses, so we can
test this behaviour in binman, once added.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the 'args' property of the mkimage entry type is a string. This
makes it difficult to include CONFIG options in that property. In
particular, this does not work:
args = "-n CONFIG_SYS_SOC -E"
since the preprocessor does not operate within strings, nor does this:
args = "-n" CONFIG_SYS_SOC" "-E"
since the device tree compiler does not understand string concatenation.
With this new feature, we can do:
args = "-n", CONFIG_SYS_SOC, "-E";
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an entry for OP-TEE Trusted OS 'BL32' payload.
This is required by platforms using Cortex-A cores with TrustZone
technology.
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add missing-blob-help, renumber the test file, update entry-docs:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a function which reads the segments and the entry address.
Also fix a comment nit in the tests while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is helpful to support a string or stringlist containing a list of
space-separated arguments, for example:
args = "-n fred", "-a", "123";
This resolves to the list:
-n fred -a 123
which can be passed to a program as arguments.
Add a helper to do the required processing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This does not work at present, since the current algorithm assumes that
either there are no nodes or all nodes have an offset. If a node is new,
but an old node is still in the tree, then syncing fails due to this
assumption.
Fix it and add a test.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When CONFIG_SPL_FIT is enabled we do not access U-Boot directly in
the image, since it is embedded in a FIT which is parsed at runtime.
Provide a CONFIG option to drop the symbols in this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These symbols are incorrect, meaning that binman cannot find the
associated entry. This leads to errors like:
binman: Section '/binman/simple-bin': Symbol '_binman_spl_prop_size'
in entry '/binman/simple-bin/u-boot-spl/u-boot-spl-nodtb':
Entry 'spl' not found in list (mkimage,u-boot-spl-nodtb,
u-boot-spl-bss-pad,u-boot-spl-dtb,u-boot-spl,u-boot-img,main-section)
Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to be able to search for CONFIG options that match a regex,
such as this, which lists boards which define SPL_FIT_GENERATOR and
anything not starting with ROCKCHIP:
./tools/moveconfig.py -f SPL_FIT_GENERATOR ~ROCKCHIP.*
Add support for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This shows an internal type at present, rather than the algorithm name.
Fix it and update the test to catch this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Binman keeps track of positions of each entry in the final image, but
currently this data is wrong for things included in FIT entries,
especially since a previous patch makes FIT a subclass of Section and
inherit its implementation.
There are three ways to put data into a FIT image. It can be directly
included as a "data" property, or it can be external to the FIT image
represented by an offset-size pair of properties. This external offset
is either "data-position" from the start of the FIT or "data-offset"
from the end of the FIT, and the size is "data-size" for both. However,
binman doesn't use the "data-offset" method while building FIT entries.
According to the Section docstring, its subclasses should calculate and
set the correct offsets and sizes in SetImagePos() method. Do this for
FIT subentries for the three ways mentioned above, and add tests for the
two ways binman can pack them in.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman's FIT entry type can have image subentries with "hash" subnodes
intended to be processed by mkimage, but not binman. However, the Entry
class and any subclass that reuses its implementation tries to process
these unconditionally. This can lead to an error when boards specify
hash algorithms that binman doesn't support, but mkimage supports.
Let entries skip processing these "hash" subnodes based on an instance
variable, and set this instance variable for FIT subsections. Also
re-enable processing of calculated and missing properties of FIT entries
which was disabled to mitigate this issue.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Check interrupt status to see if RSA engine is completed. After completion
of the task, write-clear the status to finish operation.
Add missing register base for completion.
Fixes: 89c36cca0b ("crypto: aspeed: Add AST2600 ACRY support")
Signed-off-by: Neal Liu <neal_liu@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
The default U-Boot environment variables and design are all set up for
the MAIN R5FSS cluster to be in Split-mode. This is the setting used
when the dts nodes were originally added in v2021.01 U-Boot and the
dt nodes are synched with the kernel binding property names in
commit 468ec2f3ef ("remoteproc: k3_r5: Sync to upstreamed kernel DT
property names") merged in v2021.04-rc2.
The modes for the MAIN R5FSS cluster got switched back to LockStep mode
by mistake in commit fa09b12dc5 ("arm: ti: k3: Resync dts files and
bindings with Linux Kernel v5.14") in v2022.01-rc1. This throws the
following warning messages when early-booting the cores using default
env variables,
k3_r5f_rproc r5f@5d00000: Invalid op: Trying to start secondary core 7 in lockstep mode
Load Remote Processor 3 with data@addr=0x82000000 83148 bytes: Failed!
Fix this by switching back both the clusters to the expected Split-mode.
Make this mode change in the u-boot specific dtsi file to avoid such
sync overrides in the future until the kernel dts is also switched to
Split-mode by default.
Fixes: fa09b12dc5 ("arm: ti: k3: Resync dts files and bindings with Linux Kernel v5.14")
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
There are a few memory functions for both the emif4 (AM3517)
and sdrc (OMAP35/DM37) code that can be defined as static,
because those functions are not used externally. Make them
static and clean up some of the corresponding headers.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
With LTO enabled, some functions appear to be optimized in a
way that causes hanging on some OMAP3 boards after some
unrelated patches were applied. The solution appears to make
several functions __used. There also appears be to be some
dead code, so remove it while cleaning this up.
This has been tested on a general purpose OMAP3530, DM3730,
and AM3517.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Correct the min/max voltages of VDD_CPU. As per data sheet the VDD_CPU
minimum voltage is .6V & maximum voltage is .9V.
Correct the same. While at it fix the comment to reflect VDD_CPU
instead of VDD_MPU.
Data Sheet Link: https://www.ti.com/lit/gpn/dra829v
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
For the purpose of this driver (activating bypass mode) t6000-dart
and t8103-dart are fully compatible.
Signed-off-by: Janne Grunau <j@jannau.net>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
U-Boot now supports NVMe storage and on the laptop models, the
SPI keyboard. Since we now disable the debug console by default
provide instructions on how the enable the debug console including
a table listing the appropriate UART base address for each of the
supported SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
The address of the debug UART varies differs between the M1 and
the M1 Pro/Max SoCs. So we have to disable it to make a single
U-Boot binary that works on all SoC generations. Leave the
settings for the base address and clock rate of the M1 in place
to make it easier to re-enable the debug UART when needed.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Choose the memory map based on the compatible property from the
device tree passed to us by m1n1. Since DRAM on the M1 Pro/Max
starts at a different address avoid hardcoding the top of usable
memory. Also make sure that the addresses entered into the memory
map are page aligned such that we don't crash in dcache_enable().
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Tested on: Macbook M1 Max
Tested-by: Janne Grunau <j@jannau.net>
The function wrongly will return the card detection status of the SD card
(USDHC2) for the eMMC (USDHC1). Thus booting from eMMC without an inserted
SD card will fail.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Currently the space between kernel_addr_r and the fdt_addr_r is only 32MB.
To have enought space to load kernel images bigger than 32MB change the
variables to a feasible value.
The new environment variables layout is based on the scheme from
"include/configs/ti_armv7_common.h".
The CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR value is set to 0x42000000. With that we have
the same value as for the kernel_addr_r.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Use the complete 512kb (4 blocks) nand partition reserved for u-boot
environment instead of just the first block, this allows the module to
have a working environment even if 3 blocks are bad.
Signed-off-by: Francesco Dolcini <francesco.dolcini@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
After this change it would be possible to use 'mtd' command to get access
to XEA's SPI-NOR partitions by name (e.g. SPL), not by offsets.
To enable this feature the CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_MTD needs to be defined in the
Kconfig, not in xea.h.
=> mtd list
=> mtd read spl-boot-data1 ${loadaddr} 0x0 4
=> md.l ${loadaddr} 1
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
The GW7902 is based on the i.MX 8M Mini / Nano SoC featuring:
- LPDDR4 DRAM
- eMMC FLASH
- Gateworks System Controller
- LTE CAT M1 modem
- USB 2.0 HUB
- M.2 Socket with USB2.0, PCIe, and dual-SIM
- IMX8M FEC
- PCIe based GbE
- RS232/RS485/RS422 serial transceiver
- GPS
- CAN bus
- WiFi / Bluetooth
- MIPI header (DSI/CSI/GPIO/PWM/I2S)
- PMIC
To add support for the i.MX8M Nano GW7902:
- Add imx8mn-venice dts/defconfig/include
- Add imx8mn-gw7902 dts
- Add imx8mn-2gb lpddr4 dram configs
- Add misc support for IMX8M Nano SoC
- rename imx8mm-venice.c to venice.c as it is no longer imx8mm specific
- update README with differences for IMX8MN vs IMX8MM
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The original code logic can not show the correct card clock, and also
has one risk when the div is 0. Because there is div -=1 before.
So move the operation before div -=1, and also involve ddr_pre_div
to get the correct value.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Now original fsl_esdhc.c are split as fsl_esdhc.c and fsl_esdhc_imx.c.
fsl_esdhc_imx.c only cover i.MX SoC. So ARCH_MXC is redundant.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
With binman generating flash.bin, it's not longer necessary to
specify either the location of ATF nor is it necessary to
specify building flash.bin, so let's update the build instructions
to remove those. While in here, update the revision of ATF and
DDR firmware so both Mini and Nano reference the same revision.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The Linux driver automatically can detect and enable UHS, HS200, HS400
and HS400_ES automatically without extra flags being placed into the
device tree.
Right now, for U-Boot to use UHS, HS200 or HS400, the extra flags are
needed in the device tree. Instead, go through the esdhc_soc_data
flags and enable the host caps where applicable to automatically
enable higher speeds.
Suggested-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Use IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG) to make the code
more readable and fix checkpatch.pl warning
Signed-off-by: Tommaso Merciai <tomm.merciai@gmail.com>
Make O4-iMX6ULL-NANO-based board compatible with Yocto layer meta-out4 and
fix device flashing by UUU (aka MFG Tools).
Signed-off-by: Oleh Kravchenko <oleg@kaa.org.ua>
The interface for NOR/OneNAND is called "EIM" not "EMI". Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
With the fuse values in memory we can use some of the other u-boot shell
conditonal operators to do tests.
Signed-off-by: Angus Ainslie <angus@akkea.ca>
- a37xx: pci: Cleanup and minor fix for root port check (Pali)
- pci: mvebu: Ensure that root port is always on root zero bus (Pali)
- kwbimage: Fix dumping DATA registers for v0 images (Pali)
- kwbimage: Support for parsing extended v0 format (Pali)
- a37xx: Fix code and update DTS files to upstream version (Pali)
- a37xx: Fix and extend building memory map (Pali)
- ddr: marvell: a38x: fix BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT decision (Marek)
- mvebu: Optionally reset board on DDR training failure (Marek)
The state of the current DDR training code for Armada 38x is such that
we cannot be sure it will always train successfully - although after the
last change we were yet unable to find a board that failed DDR training,
from experience in the last 2 years we know that it is possible.
The experience also tells us that in many cases the board fails training
only sometimes, and after a reset the training is successful.
Enable the new option that makes the board reset itself on DDR training
failure immediately. Until now we called hang() in such a case, which
meant that the board was reset by the MCU after 120 seconds.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Some boards may occacionally fail DDR training. Currently we hang() in
this case. Add an option that makes the board do an immediate reset in
such a case, so that a new training is tried as soon as possible,
instead of hanging and possibly waiting for watchdog to reset the board.
(If the DDR training fails while booting the image via UART, we will
still hang - it doesn't make sense to reset in such a case, because
after reset the board will try booting from another medium, and the
UART booting utility does not expect that.)
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
First binary executable header is extracted by '-p 1' argument.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These two commands are currently not processed when generating v0 images.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When pflag is set then kwbimage was invoked by dumpimage and not mkimage.
So do not show mkimage error message in this case.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
dumpimage is now able to successfully parse and dump content of the Dove
bootloader image.
Note that support for generating these extended parts of v0 images is not
included yet.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Extended and binary headers are optional and are part of the image header.
Fixes kwboot to determinate correct length of Dove images.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
They are used by Marvell Dove 88AP510 BootROM.
After the main header is a list of optional extended headers and after that
is a list of optional binary executable headers. Between each two extended
headers is additional 0x20 byte long padding.
Original Kirkwood SoCs support only one extended header and no binary
executable header.
Extension of struct ext_hdr_v0 is backward compatible with the old
definition. Only reserved[] fields are changed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In commit 3fc92a215b ("ddr: marvell: a38x: fix SPLIT_OUT_MIX state
decision") I ported a cleaned up and changed version of patch
mv_ddr: a380: fix SPLIT_OUT_MIX state decision
In the port we removed checking for BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT bit,
because:
- the fix seemed to work without it
- the bit was checked for only at one place out of two, while the second
bit, BYTE_SPLIT_OUT_MIX, was checked for in both cases
- without the removal it didn't work on Allied Telesis' x530 board
We recently had a chance to test on more boards, and it seems that the
change needs to be opposite: instead of removing the check for
BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT from the first if() statement, the check
needs to be added also to the second one - it needs to be at both
places.
With this change all the Turris Omnia boards I have had available to
test seem to work, I didn't encounter not even one failed DDR training.
As last time, I am noting that I do not understand what this code is
actually doing, I haven't studied the DDR training algorithm and
I suspect that no one will be able to explain it to U-Boot contributors,
so we are left with this blind poking in the code with testing whether
it works on several boards and hoping it doesn't break anything for
anyone :-(.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function is named build_mem_map, not a3700_build_mem_map.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
In function build_mem_map() prepare also mapping for CCI-400 and
BootROM windows.
BootROM window is 1 MB long and by default starts at address 0xfff00000.
A53 AP BootROM is 16 kB long and repeats in this BootROM window 64 times.
RVBAR_EL3 register is set to value 0xffff0000, so by default A53 AP BootROM
is accessed via range 0xffff0000-0xffff3fff.
CCI-400 window when new TF-A version is used, starts at address 0xfe000000
and when old TF-A version is used, starts at address 0xd8000000.
Physical addresses are read directly from mvebu registers, so if TF-A
remaps it in future (again) then it would not cause any issue for U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function build_mem_map() modifies global variable mem_map. This variable is
used by the get_page_table_size() function which is called by function
arm_reserve_mmu() (as aliased macro PGTABLE_SIZE). Function
arm_reserve_mmu() is called earlier than enable_caches() which calls
build_mem_map(). So arm_reserve_mmu() does not calculate reserved memory
correctly.
Fix this issue by calling build_mem_map() from a3700_dram_init() which is
called before arm_reserve_mmu().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Writing to the PCI_PRIMARY_BUS register of the root port should not change
bus number on which is root port present.
Same change and exactly same fix as was done in commit for pci-aardvark.c.
Fixes: a7b61ab58d ("pci: pci_mvebu: Properly configure and use PCI Bridge (PCIe Root Port)")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Allow access to config space of PCIe Root Port (which is always present on
the root bus) even when PCIe link is down or no card is connected.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If a PIO request is executed while link-down, the whole controller gets
stuck in a non-functional state, and even after link comes up again, PIO
requests won't work anymore, and a reset of the whole PCIe controller is
needed. Therefore we need to prevent sending PIO requests while the link
is down.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This change updates all Armada 37xx DTS files to version which is used by
Linux kernel v5.18.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Official DT bindings for Espressobin have disabled eMMC node.
As U-Boot requires to have this node enabled by default, do it in
armada-3720-espressobin-u-boot.dtsi DTS file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
U-Boot specific changes should be in armada-3720-espressobin-u-boot.dtsi DTS file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In Linux kernel version of armada-37xx.dtsi file sdhci1 pointer refers to
sdhci@d0000 node and sdhci0 pointer to sdhci@d8000 node.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Armada 3720 DTS files in upstream kernel use ethernet nodes named
'ethernet@30000' and 'ethernet@40000'. U-Boot have them named 'neta@30000'
and 'neta@40000'. To have Turris Mox U-Boot board code independent of
ethernet node names, find ethernet node via alias.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Official DT bindings have only one reg property: watchdog address space.
Convert armada-37xx-wdt.c driver to offical DT bindings and access sel_reg
register via MVEBU_REGISTER() macro, as its value (required by U-Boot
driver) is not in DT yet. In later stage can be driver cleaned to not use
it.
This change would allow U-Boot to use A3720 watchdog DTS structure from
Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Official DT bindings use compatible string marvell,armada-3700-ehci.
Update drivers and DTS files.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In commit d368e10705 ("phy: marvell: a3700: Convert to official DT
bindings in COMPHY driver") was done update to official DT bindings but
compatible string of official DT bindings was not updated.
Fix it now.
Fixes: d368e10705 ("phy: marvell: a3700: Convert to official DT bindings in COMPHY driver")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Compatible string microchip,mcp7940x is used by Turris Mox DTS file in
Linux kernel and U-Boot ds1307.c driver works fine with it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
End of DATA register section is indicated by zero value in both raddr and
rdata.
So do not stop dumping registers with non-zero address and zero value.
And also print end of DATA registers section.
Fixes: 1a8e6b63e2 ("tools: kwbimage: Dump kwbimage config file on '-p -1' option")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reported-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Writing to the PCI_PRIMARY_BUS register of the root port should not change
bus number on which is root port present.
This PCI_PRIMARY_BUS register is used only for correct configuration of
legacy PCI stuff, like forwarding of PCI special cycles between buses.
Aardvark HW does not support PCI special cycles, so it does not have HW
register for PCI_PRIMARY_BUS and therefore it does not matter what is
stored in this register.
So fix this issue and do not use PCI_PRIMARY_BUS register in pci-aardvark.c
driver for moving root bus of the root port.
After this change there is no reason for storing bus number (zero) into
first_busno variable, so remove this variable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: cb056005dc ("arm: a37xx: pci: Add support for accessing PCI Bridge on root bus")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There is only one base address, so use dev_read_addr() instead of dev_read_addr_index().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remove "PCI_" prefix from all macros which are aardvark specific to not
conflict with macros defined in global include file pci.h. Instead add
"ADVK_" prefix for them so it is visible that they are aardvark specific.
After "ADVK_" prefix append keyword which describes register group, so it
would be clear to which register each macro value belongs.
Rename some macros for consistency with other macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI config space of the aardvark PCIe Root Port is available only in
internal aardvark memory space starting at offset 0x0. PCI Express
registers (PCI_EXP_*) start at offset 0xc0. And Advanced Error Reporting
registers (PCI_ERR_*) start at offset 0x100.
Replace custom aardvark register macros by standard PCI macros from
include/pci.h file with fixed offset.
Some DEVCTL and AER macros are not defined in include/pci.h file, so define
them in the same way as in linux uapi header file pci_regs.h.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
A new lpddr4 configuration is introduced for J7 SK with 4266 MTs data
rate. Therefore, update the R5 DTS file to point to the new DDR config
file.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
EMIF tool for J721E SK is now updated to 0.6.1 that includes
* Updated write DQ training pattern to enable user pattern and clock
pattern (from 0x7 to 0x6).
* Updated IO drive strength to 40-80-80 Ohms.
J721E SK uses the lpddr4 configuration of 4266 MTs data rate which is
the same as J721E EVM but facing random failures. As the tool update is
specific to the SK board, add a new lpddr4 config of 4266 MTs.
Signed-off-by: Kevin Scholz <k-scholz@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Now that single defconfig can be used for booting J721E EVM and
SK, default device tree will not work for selecting dtb for
kernel. Update the findfdt env to select right dtb based on
board_name env variable.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
S28HS512T on TI SK has sector size of 256KB, so update OSPI partition
to align on 256KB sector size. Since the sector size for MT35XU512ABA
on EVM is 128KB, partitions will remain aligned for EVM.
Also, now since the sector size is 256KB ospi.env.backup will collide
with ospi.sysfw, so move ospi.env.backup to the padding space (0x7C0000)
before ospi.rootfs partition.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Enable configs for building multiple dtbs into a single fit image
and load the right dtb for next stage. This will help to use same
defconfig for both J721E EVM and SK boards.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
J721E Starter Kit (SK)[1] is a low cost, small form factor board designed
for TI’s J721E SoC. TI’s J721E SoC comprises of dual core A72, high
performance vision accelerators, video codec accelerators, latest C71x
and C66x DSP, high bandwidth real-time IPs for capture and display, GPU,
dedicated safety island and security accelerators. The SoC is power
optimized to provide best in class performance for industrial and
automotive applications.
J721E SK supports the following interfaces:
* 4 GB LPDDR4 RAM
* x1 Gigabit Ethernet interface
* x1 USB 3.0 Type-C port
* x3 USB 3.0 Type-A ports
* x1 PCIe M.2 E Key
* x1 PCIe M.2 M Key
* 512 Mbit OSPI flash
* x2 CSI2 Camera interface (RPi and TI Camera connector)
* 40-pin Raspberry Pi GPIO header
Add A72 specific dts for J721E-SK.
[1] https://www.ti.com/tool/SK-TDA4VM
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Board ID I2C EEPROM will be probed before SYSFW is available.
So drop the power-domains property for wakup_i2c0 on which
board ID EEPROM is connected.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Enable support for selecting DTB from FIT within SPL based on the
board name read from EEPROM. This will help to use single defconfig
for both EVM and SK.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Update the board_fit_config_name_match() to choose the right dtb
based on the board name read from EEPROM.
Also restrict multpile EEPROM reads by verifying if EEPROM is already
read.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
j721e-sk doesn't have any daughter cards, so disable daughter
card probing inside board_late_init() and spl_board_init() for
j721e-sk.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
J721E EVM has EEPROM populated at 0x50. J721E SK has EEPROM populated
at next address 0x51 in order to be compatible with RPi. So start
looking for TI specific EEPROM at 0x50, if not found look for EEPROM at
0x51.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
board_late_init(), setup_board_eeprom_env() and setup_serial() is
called only under CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT, so guard these functions
with the same. Also, reorder these functions to place it under
single #ifdef
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Buck regulator 1, 2 and 3 of TPS6594132 on j721e-sk is in 3 Phase
confguration, in-order to support this, add configuring 3 Phase buck
in tps65941 while driver probing.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Since TPS659412 and TPS659413 are both software compatible,
add a compatible string for the same inside tps65941.c.
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
This function has not been conditionally compiled for some time, so
remove the incorrect guards around the declaration.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There are devices which cause a USB stall when trying to read strings.
Specifically Arduino Mega R3 stalls when trying to read the product
string.
The stall currently remains unhandled, and subsequent retries submit new
transfers on a stopped endpoint which ultimately cause a crash in
abort_td():
WARN halted endpoint, queueing URB anyway.
XHCI control transfer timed out, aborting...
Unexpected XHCI event TRB, skipping... (3affe040 00000000 13000000 02008401)
BUG at drivers/usb/host/xhci-ring.c:505/abort_td()!
BUG!
resetting ...
Linux seems to be able to recover from the stall by issuing a
TRB_RESET_EP command.
Introduce reset_ep() which issues a TRB_RESET_EP followed by setting the
transfer ring dequeue pointer via TRB_SET_DEQ. This allows to properly
recover from a USB stall error and continue communicating with the USB
device.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
The kernel devicetree has definitions for port and hub nodes as subnodes
to the USB devices. These subnodes don't contain all of the data required
to properly configure the dwc3. Check the parent nodes if the data is not
in the port/hub node.
Here's an example from the librem5 kernel dts file
&usb_dwc3_0 {
#address-cells = <1>;
#size-cells = <0>;
dr_mode = "otg";
snps,dis_u3_susphy_quirk;
status = "okay";
port@0 {
reg = <0>;
typec_hs: endpoint {
remote-endpoint = <&usb_con_hs>;
};
};
port@1 {
reg = <1>;
typec_ss: endpoint {
remote-endpoint = <&usb_con_ss>;
};
};
};
&usb_dwc3_1 {
dr_mode = "host";
status = "okay";
#address-cells = <1>;
#size-cells = <0>;
/* Microchip USB2642 */
hub@1 {
compatible = "usb424,2640";
reg = <1>;
#address-cells = <1>;
#size-cells = <0>;
mass-storage@1 {
compatible = "usb424,4041";
reg = <1>;
};
};
};
Signed-off-by: Angus Ainslie <angus@akkea.ca>
The correct mask for getting the source/destination register from ESR in
the case of an unaligned access exception is 0x3E0. With this change, a
dummy unaligned store produces the expected info:
"""
>> swi r5, r0, 0x111
...
Hardware exception at 0x111 address
Unaligned data access exception
Unaligned word access
Unaligned store access
Register R5
Return address from exception 0x7f99dfc
### ERROR ### Please RESET the board ###
"""
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220213080925.1548411-6-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
According to the MicroBlaze reference manual (xilinx2021.2/ug984/page-37):
"""
If an exception is caused by an instruction in a delay slot (that is,
ESR[DS]=1), the exception handler should return execution to
the address stored in BTR instead of the normal exception return
address stored in R17.
"""
Adjust the code to print the proper return address for delay slot
exceptions.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220213080925.1548411-4-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The switch statement in _hw_exception_handler() only covers the
rightmost 5 bits that encode the exception cause:
switch (state & 0x1f)
{
...
}
For this reason, the "0x1000" case will never be reached, because the 13th
bit was zeroed out. To fix this, move delay slot exception handling before
the switch statement (delay slot (DS) bit in Exception Status Register is
independent of the exception cause (EC)).
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220213080925.1548411-3-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Driver should be enabled by CONFIG_POWER_DOMAIN=y and
CONFIG_ZYNQMP_POWER_DOMAIN=y. Power domain driver doesn't have own DT node
but it uses zynqmp firmware DT node that's why there is a need to bind
driver when firmware node is found.
Driver itself is simple. It is sending pmufw config object overlay for
enabling access to device which is done in ...domain_request().
In ...domain_on() capabilities are passed and node is requested.
This should be bare minimum of required to get power domain driver working.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/f4b9433b91c0b18c375b061c7a4e29d428f70547.1644226055.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
The changes introduced with commit 6337d53fdf ("arm: dts: sync am33xx
with Linux 5.9-rc7") prevent the PDU001 from operating correctly.
This patch fixes the configuration of the pin multiplexer and uart3.
Signed-off-by: Felix Brack <fb@ltec.ch>
After replacing of include/config/auto.conf sourcing with
extraction of CONFIG_LOCALVERSION, resulting version string
contains quotes around localversion part which are always
present in auto.conf (even if localversion is empty).
This patch fixes this script to remove quotes.
Signed-off-by: Nikita Maslov <wkernelteam@gmail.com>
Cc: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@theobroma-systems.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The pstore command tries to create a reserved-memory node but fails if
it is already present with:
Add 'reserved-memory' node failed: FDT_ERR_EXISTS
This patch creates the node only if it does not exist and adapts the reg
values sizes depending on already present #address-cells and #size-cells
values.
Signed-off-by: Detlev Casanova <detlev.casanova@collabora.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc2-4
Documentation:
* mkeficapsule man-page
UEFI changes:
* add support for signing images to mkeficapsule
* add support for user define capsule GUID
* adjust unit tests for capsules
* fix UEFI image signature validation in case of multiple signatures
The previous patch is changing U-Boot's behavior wrt certificate based
binary authentication. Specifically an image who's digest of a
certificate is found in dbx is now rejected. Fix the test accordingly
and add another one testing signatures in reverse order
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The EFI spec allows for images to carry multiple signatures. Currently
we don't adhere to the verification process for such images.
The spec says:
"Multiple signatures are allowed to exist in the binary's certificate
table (as per PE/COFF Section "Attribute Certificate Table"). Only one
hash or signature is required to be present in db in order to pass
validation, so long as neither the SHA-256 hash of the binary nor any
present signature is reflected in dbx."
With our current implementation signing the image with two certificates
and inserting both of them in db and one of them dbx doesn't always reject
the image. The rejection depends on the order that the image was signed
and the order the certificates are read (and checked) in db.
While at it move the sha256 hash verification outside the signature
checking loop, since it only needs to run once per image and get simplify
the logic for authenticating an unsigned imahe using sha256 hashes.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Before the capsule authentication is supported, this test script works
correctly, but with the feature enabled, most tests will fail due to
unsigned capsules.
So check the results depending on CAPSULE_AUTHENTICATE or not.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This test scenario tests a new feature of mkeficapsule, "--guid" option,
which allows us to specify FMP driver's guid explicitly at the command
line.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Since the syntax of mkeficapsule was changed in the previous commit,
we need to modify command line arguments in a pytest script.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The existing options, "--fit" and "--raw," are only used to put a proper
GUID in a capsule header, where GUID identifies a particular FMP (Firmware
Management Protocol) driver which then would handle the firmware binary in
a capsule. In fact, mkeficapsule does the exact same job in creating
a capsule file whatever the firmware binary type is.
To prepare for the future extension, the command syntax will be a bit
modified to allow users to specify arbitrary GUID for their own FMP driver.
OLD:
[--fit <image> | --raw <image>] <capsule file>
NEW:
[--fit | --raw | --guid <guid-string>] <image> <capsule file>
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a couple of test cases against capsule image authentication
for capsule-on-disk, where only a signed capsule file with the verified
signature will be applied to the system.
Due to the difficulty of embedding a public key (esl file) in U-Boot
binary during pytest setup time, all the keys/certificates are pre-created.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Now we can use mkeficapsule command instead of EDK-II's script
to create a signed capsule file. So update the instruction for
capsule authentication.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
With this enhancement, mkeficapsule will be able to sign a capsule
file when it is created. A signature added will be used later
in the verification at FMP's SetImage() call.
To do that, we need specify additional command parameters:
-monotonic-cout <count> : monotonic count
-private-key <private key file> : private key file
-certificate <certificate file> : certificate file
Only when all of those parameters are given, a signature will be added
to a capsule file.
Users are expected to maintain and increment the monotonic count at
every time of the update for each firmware image.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add CONFIG_TOOLS_MKEFICAPSULE. Then we want to always build mkeficapsule
if tools-only_defconfig is used.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We need to install libgnutls-devel package to build the host tool,
mkeficapsule, and as of now, there seems to be a depencency conflict
in the current msys2 installer;
:: installing libp11-kit (0.24.1-1) breaks dependency \
'libp11-kit=0.23.22' required by p11-kit
To resolve this conflict, however, the initial "pacman -Syyuu" in
'tools_only_windows' job is not enough. Another "pacman -Su" will
enforce all the out-of-date packages being upgraded.
(Probably the first "-Syyuu" can be changed to "-Syu".)
See the installation steps in
https://www.msys2.org/
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
A partial list:
- fw_env updates, a new testcase for mkimage -o ..., nop-phy reset-gpios
support, DFU updates, kaslr-seed support in extlinux.conf, modern
"partitions" support in mtd device tree
The output size for snprint() should not only be respected for whole fields
but also with fields. Add more tests.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Some usb-nop-xceiv devices use a gpio take them out
of reset. Add a reset function to put them into that
state. This is similar to how Linux handles the
usb-nop-xceiv driver.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Environment variables can be stored in two formats:
1. Single entry with header containing CRC32
2. Two entries with extra flags field in each entry header
For that reason fw_env_open() has two main code paths and there are
pointers for CRC32/flags/data.
Previous implementation was a bit hard to follow:
1. It was checking for used format twice (in reversed order each time)
2. It was setting "environment" global struct fields to some temporary
values that required extra comments explaining it
This change simplifies that code:
1. It introduces two clear code paths
2. It sets "environment" global struct fields values only once it really
knows them
To be fair there are *two* crc32() calls now and an extra pointer
variable but that should be cheap enough and worth it.
Signed-off-by: Rafał Miłecki <rafal@milecki.pl>
It's usually easier to understand code & follow it if all arguments are
passed explicitly. Many coding styles also discourage using global
variables.
Behaviour of flash_io() was a bit unintuitive as it was writing to a
buffer referenced in a global struct. That required developers to
remember how it works and sometimes required hacking "environment"
global struct variable to read data into a proper buffer.
Signed-off-by: Rafał Miłecki <rafal@milecki.pl>
Since dfu is not only used for USB, and some platform only
supports DFU_OVER_TFTP or EFI capsule update, dfu_alt_info
is defined on such platforms too.
For such platform, 'dfu list' command is useful to check
how the current dfu_alt_info setting is parsed.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Fix some typo and wrong information about dfu_alt_info.
- Add the parameter format, decimal only or hexadecimal.
- Use same parameter name for the same kind of parameters.
(e.g. dev -> dev_id)
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
When parsing the dfu_alt_info, check the number of arguments
and argument string strictly. If there is any garbage data
(which is not able to be parsed correctly) in dfu_alt_info,
that means something wrong and user may make a typo or mis-
understanding about the syntax. Since the dfu_alt_info is
used for updating the firmware, this mistake may lead to
brick the hardware.
Thus it should be checked strictly for making sure there
is no mistake.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
If dfu_alt_info has repeated spaces or tab (for indentation or
readability), the dfu fails to parse it. For example, if
dfu_alt_info="mtd nor1=image raw 100000 200000" (double spaces
after "raw"), the image entity start address is '0' and the size
'0x100000'. This is because the repeated space is not skipped.
Use space and tab as a separater and apply skip_spaces() to
skip redundant spaces and tabs.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Use strlcpy() instead of strcpy() to prevent copying the
entity name over the name buffer size.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Addresses the feedback provided on 5902a397d0 ("mkimage: Allow to
specify the signature algorithm on the command line") which raced with
the merge.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
echo -n does not give the intended effect when invoked in macOS through
/bin/sh, which is the shell make uses by default, see
"https://stackoverflow.com/questions/11675070/makefile-echo-n-not-working"
for a detailed explanation. In this case, it resulted in "-n" being
written to env.txt and env.in even though they should be empty, which
caused compilation to fail with "Your board uses a text-file
environment, so must not define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS".
This patch prevents the error by replacing echo -n's with touch, as they
are used to create empty files in these cases.
strlen() returns size_t. So we should use %zu to print it.
This avoids incorrect output on 32bit systems.
Fixes: 2fc62f2991 ("stackprot: Make our test a bit more complex")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Stress the '-o algo_name' argument of mkimage by expanding the vboot
test.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Update scripts/pylint.base]
Replace %zx by %lx and cast size_t to ulong.
U-Boot currently prints garbage debug output:
size=x, ptr=18, limit=18: 4002a000
With this change it prints correct debug data:
size=18, ptr=18, limit=2000: 4002a000
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Listing MTD partitions directly in the flash mode has been deprecated
for a while for kernel Device Trees. Look for a node "partitions" in the
found flash nodes and use it instead of the flash node itself for the
partition list when it exists, so Device Trees following the current
best practices can be fixed up.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the Linux implementation of adc-keys
(drivers/input/keyboard/adc-keys.c), `press-threshold-microvolt` is not
really interpreted as a threshold, but rather as the "nominal voltage"
of the button. When the voltage read from the ADC is closest to a
button's `press-threshold-microvolt`, the button is considered pressed.
This patch reconciles the behavior of button-adc with Linux's adc-keys
such that device trees can be synchronized with minimal modifications.
Signed-off-by: Peter Cai <peter@typeblog.net>
this will add kaslrseed keyword to sysboot lable,
when it set, it will request to genarate random number
from hwrng as kaslr-seed.
with this patch exlinux.conf label looks like
label l0
menu testing
linux /boot/vmlinuz-5.15.16-arm
initrd /boot/initramfs-5.15.16-arm.img
fdtdir /boot/dtbs/5.15.16-arm/
kaslrseed
append root=UUID=92ae1e50-eeeb-4c5b-8939-7e1cd6cfb059 ro
Tested on Khadas VIM with kernel 5.16.0-rc5-arm64, Debian 11.
Signed-off-by: Zhang Ning <zhangn1985@qq.com>
The ci_req->hw_buf can be NULL, test whether it is and if so,
avoid accessing it. Else, the system may crash.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peter Chen <peter.chen@nxp.com>
Cc: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Using the XHCI driver, the function `usb_kbd_poll_for_event` takes
30-40ms to run. The exact time is dependent on the polling interval the
keyboard requests in its descriptor, and likely cannot be significantly
reduced without major rework to the XHCI driver.
The U-Boot EFI console service sets a timer to poll the keyboard every 5
microseconds, and this timer is checked every time a block is read off
disk. The net effect is that, on my system, loading a ~40MiB kernel and
initrd takes about 62 seconds with a slower keyboard and 53 seconds
with a faster one, with the vast majority of the time spent polling the
keyboard.
To solve this problem, this patch adds a 20ms delay between consecutive
calls to `usb_kbd_poll_for_event`. This is sufficient to reduce the
total loading time to under half a second for both keyboards, and does
not impact the perceived keystroke latency.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Watson <twatson52@icloud.com>
The imx8mm and imx8mn appear compatible with imx7d-usb
flags in the OTG driver. If the dr_mode is defined as
host or peripheral, the device appears to operate correctly,
however the auto host/peripheral detection results in an error.
The solution isn't just adding checks for imx8mm and imx8mn to
the check for imx7, because the USB clock needs to be running
to read from the USBNC_PHY_STATUS_OFFSET register or it will hang.
Marek requested that I not enable the clocks in ehci_usb_of_to_plat,
so I modified that function to return an unknown state if the
device tree does not explicitly state whether it is a host
or a peripheral.
When the driver probes, it looks to see if it's in the unknown
state, and only then will it read the register to auto-detect.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
EMIF tool for AM64 SK is now updated to 0.8.0 that includes
* disabled Write DQ training
* improve CA ODT to 60 ohms
The lpddr4 enabled with periodic WDQ training is causing periodic 26us
stall. This makes the SoC stall without doing anything which leads to
R5 interrupt latency in TCM memory. Due to this periodic training there
are some outstanding CPU transactions waiting for the lpddr4 to complete.
Hence, disable the periodic write DQ training during the
non-initialization stage of lpddr4 which results in an approximate 1us
stall. Also, update the lpddr4 config to improve CA ODT by 60 ohms
The rationales are as follows:
- PI_WDQLVL_EN: 2 Bits register field to support write DQ leveling,
disable bit 1 that supports Write DQ during non-initialization to
avoid ~26us stall during code execution.
- MR11_DATA_F1/F2_x register fields value changed to 0x66 that changes
the CA ODT from 48ohm to 60ohm to improve the eye margin on CA bus by
increasing the signal swing.
Signed-off-by: James Doublesin <doublesin@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Sinthu Raja <sinthu.raja@ti.com>
There are no boards that define CONFIG_SYS_RESET_ADDR, so drop the
remaining comments referencing it and also the config_whitelist.txt entry.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Acked-by: thomas@wytron.com.tw
There are no boards that define CONFIG_SYS_RESET_ADDRESS, so drop the
associated mpc8xx code that checks for it.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Acked-by: Christophe Leroy <christophe.leroy@csgroup.eu>
This driver adds support for the keyboard on Apple Silicon laptops.
The controller for this keyboard sits on an SPI bus and uses an
Apple-specific HID over SPI protocol. The packets sent by this
controller for key presses and key releases are fairly simple and
are decoded directly by the code in this driver and converted into
standard Linux keycodes. The same controller handles the touchpad
found on these laptops. Packets for touchpad events are simply
ignored.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a driver for the SPI controller integrated on Apple SoCs.
This is necessary to support the keyboard on Apple Silicon laopts
since their keyboard uses an Apple-specific HID over SPI protocol.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a driver for the NVMe storage controller integrated on
Apple SoCs. This NVMe controller isn't PCI based and deviates
from the NVMe standard in its implementation of the command
submission queue and the integration of an NVMMU that needs
to be managed. This commit tweaks the core NVMe code to
support the linear command submission queue implemented by
this controller. But setting up the submission queue and
managing the NVMMU controller is handled by implementing
the driver ops that were added in an earlier commit.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Tested-on: firefly-rk3399
Tested-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The power management controller found on Apple SoCs als provides
a way to reset all devices within a power domain. This is needed
to cleanly shutdown the NVMe controller before we hand over
control to the OS.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add a function to disable the NVMe controller. This will be used
to let the driver for the NVMe storage integrated on Apple SoCs
shutdown the NVMe controller such we can shutdown the NVMe
IOP controller in a clean way afterwards before handing control
to the OS.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The NVMe storage controller integrated on Apple SoCs deviates
from the NVMe standard in two aspects. It uses a "linear"
submission queue and it integrates an NVMMU that needs to be
programmed for each NVMe command. Introduce driver ops such
that we can set up the linear submission queue and program the
NVMMU in the driver for this strange beast.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Most Apple IOPs run a firmware that is based on what Apple calls
RTKit. RTKit implements a common mailbox protocol. This code
provides an implementation of the AP side of this protocol,
providing a function to initialize RTKit-based firmwares as well
as a function to do a clean shutdown of this firmware.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-Boot is expected to support multiple generations of Apple SoCs
in a single binary with a single defconfig. Therefore it makes
more sense to set SYS_SOC to "apple".
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This mailbox driver provides a communication channel with the
Apple IOP controllers found on Apple SoCs. These IOP controllers
are used to implement various functions such as the System
Manegement Controller (SMC) and NVMe storage. It allows sending
and receiving a 96-bit message over a single channel.
The header file with the struct used for mailbox messages is taken
straight from Linux.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Signed-off-by: Sven Peter <sven@svenpeter.dev>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Apple SoCs have an integrated NVMe controller that isn't connected
over a PCIe bus. In preparation for adding support for this NVMe
controller, split out the PCI support into its own file. This file
is selected through a new CONFIG_NVME_PCI Kconfig option, so do
a wholesale replacement of CONFIG_NVME with CONFIG_NVME_PCI.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on: Macbook Air M1
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
patman snake-case conversion
binman fit improvements
ACPI fixes and making MCFG available to ARM
[trini: Update scripts/pylint.base]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The Pogoplug E02 board has the network chip Marvell 88E1116R. Convert
to Driver Model and use uclass mvgbe and the compatible driver M88E1118R
to bring up Ethernet.
- Add board_eth_init(), CONFIG_DM_ETH, and CONFIG_PHY_MARVELL
to bring up Ethernet.
- Currently, CONFIG_RESET_PHY_R symbol is used in
arch/arm/mach-kirkwood/include/mach/config.h for all Kirkwood
boards with mv8831116 PHY, with each board defines the function
reset_phy(). Undefine it for this board.
- As the result of the migration to Driver Model, this u-boot image has
grown substantially (about 100K, give or take). The old envs location
at 0x60000 (384k) is no longer possible. Move it to 0xC0000 (768K).
- Miscellaneous changes: Move constants to .c file and remove header file
board/cloudengines/pogo_e02/pogo_e02.h, use CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD to
keep u-boot image under 512K, use BIT macro, and cleanup comments.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently it is possible to call "kwboot -b -t /dev/ttyUSB0" but not to
call "kwboot -b /dev/ttyUSB0".
Fix it by not trying to process the last argv[], which is non-getopt()
option (tty path) as the image path for -b.
Fixes: c513fe47dc ("tools: kwboot: Allow to use option -b without image path")
Reported-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel@ziswiler.com>
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel@ziswiler.com>
Tested-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel@ziswiler.com>
The Dockstar board has the network chip Marvell 88E1116R. Convert to
Ethernet driver model, and use uclass mvgbe and the compatible driver
M88E1118R to bring up Ethernet.
- Add CONFIG_DM_ETH and associated configs.
- Add board_eth_init() to use uclass mvgbe to bring up the network.
And remove ad-hoc code.
- Add CONFIG_PHY_MARVELL to properly configure the network.
- Currently, CONFIG_RESET_PHY_R symbol is used in
arch/arm/mach-kirkwood/include/mach/config.h for all Kirkwood
boards with mv8831116 PHY, with each board defines the function
reset_phy(). Undefine it for this board.
- Miscellaneous changes: Move constants to .c file and remove
header file board/Seagate/dockstar/dockstar.h, use
CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD to keep u-boot image
under 512K, add CONFIG_HUSH_PARSER, use BIT macro, and cleanup comments.
- Note: This patch is a RESEND for a previous patch:
https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/20210812051854.1340-2-mibodhi@gmail.com/
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Quit esc sequence may be also in the middle of the read buffer.
Fix the detection for that case.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Currently, CONFIG_RESET_PHY_R symbol is used in
arch/arm/mach-kirkwood/include/mach/config.h for all Kirkwood
boards with mv8831116 PHY, with each board defines the function
reset_phy(). Undefine it for this board.
- Add board_eth_init(), CONFIG_DM_ETH, and CONFIG_PHY_MARVELL
to bring up Ethernet.
- Miscellaneous changes: Move constants to .c file and remove header file
board/iomega/iconnect/iconnect.h. Add CONFIG_HUSH_PARSER, use BIT macro,
and cleanup comments.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The Globalscale Technologies Dreamplug board has the network chip
Marvell 88E1116R. Use uclass mvgbe and the compatible driver M88E1310
driver to bring up Ethernet.
- Currently, CONFIG_RESET_PHY_R symbol is used in
arch/arm/mach-kirkwood/include/mach/config.h for all Kirkwood
boards with mv8831116 PHY, with each board defines the function
reset_phy(). Undefine it for this board.
- Add board_eth_init() to use uclass mvgbe to bring up both network
port 0 and 1. And remove ad-hoc code.
- Enable CONFIG_PHY_MARVELL to properly configure the network.
- Add myself as maintainer (this board seems to be orphaned,
could not contact Jason Cooper using current email).
- Miscellaneous changes: Move constants to .c file and remove header file
board/Marvell/dreamplug/dreamplug.h, cleanup comments.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
We can now use same U-Boot images on both QEMU virt machine and QEMU
spike machine so let's update the QEMU RISC-V documentation.
Signed-off-by: Anup Patel <apatel@ventanamicro.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Currently, if MTD NOR is enabled then U-Boot tries to issue flash
commands even when CFI flash DT node is not present. This causes
access fault on RISC-V emulators or ISS which do not emulate CFI
flash. To handle this issue, we implement is_flash_available() for
qemu-riscv board which will return 1 only if CFI flash DT node is
present.
Fixes: d248627f9d ("riscv: qemu: Enable MTD NOR flash support")
Signed-off-by: Anup Patel <apatel@ventanamicro.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Quite a few RISC-V emulators and ISS (including Spike) have host
transfer interface (HTIF) based console. This patch adds HTIF
based console driver for RISC-V platforms which depends totally
on DT node for HTIF register base address.
Signed-off-by: Anup Patel <apatel@ventanamicro.com>
Reviewed-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@vrull.eu>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The binman FIT entry type shares some code with the Section entry type.
This shared code is bound to grow, since FIT entries are conceptually a
variation of Section entries.
Make FIT entry type a subclass of Section entry type, simplifying it a
bit and providing us the features that Section implements. Also fix the
subentry alignment test which now attempts to write symbols to a
nonexistent SPL ELF test file by creating it first.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Avoid AddMissingProperties() and SetCalculatedProperties() with FIT:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman can check for missing binary tools and prints warnings if
anything required for an image is missing. The implementation of this
for the Section entry only checks the subentries, presumably because
Section does not use any binary tools itself. However, this means the
check is also skipped for subclasses of Section which might need binary
tools.
Make sure missing binary tools are checked for subclasses of the Section
entry type as well, by calling the parent class' implementation in
the relevant Section method.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman keeps track of binary tools each entry wants to use. The
implementation of this for the FIT entry only adds "mkimage", but not
the tools that would be used by its subentries.
Register the binary tools that FIT subentries will use in addition to
the one FIT itself uses, and check their existence by copying the
appropriate method from Section entry type. Also add tests that check if
these subentries can use and warn about binary tools.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman tries to expand some entries into parts that make it up, e.g.
'u-boot' into a 'u-boot-expanded' section that contains 'u-boot-nodtb'
and 'u-boot-dtb'. Entries with child entries must call ExpandEntries()
on them to build a correct image, as it's possible that unexpanded child
entries have no data of their own. The FIT entry type doesn't currently
do this, which means putting a "u-boot" entry inside it doesn't work as
expected.
Implement ExpandEntries() for FIT and add a copy of a simple FIT image
test that checks subentry expansion in FIT entries.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
MCFG tables are used on multiple arches. Move to common ACPI lib.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Moritz Fischer <moritzf@google.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use sizeof(*mcfg) instead of sizeof(*header)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit d953137526 ("x86: Move SSDT table to a writer function")
introduced a bug where the actual MCFG entries are no longer generated.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: d953137526 ("x86: Move SSDT table to a writer function")
Signed-off-by: Moritz Fischer <moritzf@google.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
if CONFIG_DM_STDIO is defined but SERIAL_PRESENT not,
gcc drops warnings for serial_stub_* functions
that they are defined but not used.
Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
nulldev_serial_input is static and not used in this file,
so remove it.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This method has the same name as its class which is confusing. It is also
annoying when searching the code.
It builds a string with a colour, so rename it to build().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rename this function so that when we convert it to snake case it will not
conflict with the built-in print() function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use parenthesis for the device_get_ops macro argument. This prevents
errors when using an expression for the parameter.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
sdl.c is compiled against the SDL library.
Trying to redefine wchar_t with -fshort-wchar is not necessary
and leads to build failures when compiling against musl.
Cc: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When building for a custom board, it is quite common to maintain a
private branch which include some defconfig and .dts files. But to
hook up those .dts files requires modifying a file "belonging" to
upstream U-Boot, the arch/*/dts/Makefile. Forward-porting that branch
to a newer upstream then often results in a conflict which, while it
is trivial to resolve by hand, makes it harder to have a CI do "try to
build our board against latest upstream".
The .config usually includes information on precisely what .dtb(s) are
needed, so to avoid having to modify the Makefile, simply add the
files in (SPL_)OF_LIST to dtb-y.
A technicality is that (SPL_)OF_LIST is not always defined, so rework
the Kconfig symbols so that (SPL_)OF_LIST is always defined (when
(SPL_)OF_CONTROL), but only prompted for in the cases which used to be
their "depends on".
nios2 and microblaze already have something like this in their
dts/Makefile, and the rationale in commit 41f59f6853 is similar to
the above. So this simply generalizes existing practice. Followup
patches could remove the logic in those two makefiles, just as there's
potential for moving some common boilerplate from all the
arch/*/dts/Makefile files to the new scripts/Makefile.dts.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Assorted general code cleanups to make sure we use the right macros
and use them correctly and buildman updates around kconfig.h itself.
- Convert some IDE and SCSI symbols to Kconfig.
- Convert CONFIG_REMAKE_ELF
- Introduce conversion deadline for DM_SCSI.
Very few boards remain to be migrated:
am57xx_hs_evm_usb
controlcenterdc
highbank
ls1021atsn_qspi
ls1021atsn_sdcard
ls1021atwr_sdcard_ifc_SECURE_BOOT
ls1046ardb_sdcard_SECURE_BOOT
ls1088ardb_sdcard_qspi_SECURE_BOOT
omap5_uevm
pg_wcom_expu1
pg_wcom_seli8
sandbox
sandbox64
sandbox_flattree
sandbox_noinst
sandbox_spl
tools-only
Addd a migration deadline for a year out.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SCSI_AHCI_PLAT
CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID
CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN
CONFIG_SYS_SATA_MAX_DEVICE
Drop CONFIG_SCSI for everything except the sandbox build. We only need
one build for tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This is defined based on two other CONFIGs for all boards except sandbox
and durian.
For sandbox the value does not matter. For durian the value seems
excessive.
Drop the option completely, to simplify configuration and reduce the
number of things we need to convert to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
At present all ahci drivers depend on AHCI except for DWC_AHCI. But no
boards enable that without also enabling AHCI:
/tools/moveconfig.py -f ~AHCI DWC_AHCI
0 matches
Group them together and sort them in order by Kconfig name (except for
AHCI_MVEBU which uses a different naming convention).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
No boards use this driver without CONFIG_BLK, so clean up the dead code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move the SATA options inside an 'if SATA' part, so they are grouped.
Fix the 'Complient' typo while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
No boards currently use SATA without BLK:
./tools/moveconfig.py -f SATA ~BLK
0 matches
Make SATA depend on BLK to avoid any future confusion. Drop the dead code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This is not used in U-Boot and has not been converted to driver model.
Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_IDE_MAXBUS
CONFIG_SYS_IDE_MAXDEVICE
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_BASE_ADDR
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_STRIDE
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_DATA_OFFSET
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_REG_OFFSET
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_ALT_OFFSET
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_IDE0_OFFSET
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_IDE1_OFFSET
CONFIG_ATAPI
CONFIG_IDE_RESET
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add a -a option to specify changes to the config before the build
commences. For example
buildman -a ~CONFIG_CMDLINE
disables CONFIG_CMDLINE before doing the build.
This makes it easier to try things out as well as to write tests without
creating a new board or manually manging the .config file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If a thread crashes it is helpful to try the operation again with
threading disabled. Add a hint about that.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the only straightforward way to write tests that need a
slightly different configuration is to create a new board with its own
configuration. This is cumbersome.
It would be useful if buildman could adjust the configuration of a build
on the fly. In preparation for this, add a utility library which can
modify a .config file according to various parameters passed to it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the full horror of the Python traceback is shown by default. It
is normally only useful for debugging. Turn it off by default and add a
--debug flag to enable it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function does not run the doctests. Allow the caller to
pass these modules in as strings.
Update patman to use this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new IF_ENABLED_INT() feature to avoid needing our own inline
function to handle this case. Tidy up the logic to ensure that the value
is only used when present. Update the 'expected' comment also.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if an optional Kconfig value needs to be used it must be
bracketed by #ifdef. For example, with this Kconfig setup:
config WIBBLE
bool "Support wibbles, the world needs more wibbles"
config WIBBLE_ADDR
hex "Address of the wibble"
depends on WIBBLE
then the following code must be used:
#ifdef CONFIG_WIBBLE
static void handle_wibble(void)
{
int val = CONFIG_WIBBLE_ADDR;
...
}
#endif
static void init_machine()
{
...
#ifdef CONFIG_WIBBLE
handle_wibble();
#endif
}
Add a new IF_ENABLED_INT() to help with this. So now it is possible to
write, without #ifdefs:
static void handle_wibble(void)
{
int val = IF_ENABLED_INT(CONFIG_WIBBLE, CONFIG_WIBBLE_ADDR);
...
}
static void init_machine()
{
...
if (IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_WIBBLE))
handle_wibble();
}
The value will be CONFIG_WIBBLE_ADDR if CONFIG_WIBBLE is defined and will
produce a build error if not.. This allows us to reduce the use of #ifdef
in the code, ensuring that the compiler still checks the code even if it
is not ultimately used for a particular build.
Add a CONFIG_IF_ENABLED_INT() version as well.
If an attempt is made to use a value that does not exist (i.e. when the
conditional is not enabled), an error about a non-existing function is
generated, e.g.:
common/bloblist.c:447: undefined reference to `invalid_use_of_IF_ENABLED_INT'
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The config_enabled() macro currently uses 0 as the default value. Update
it to allow any value, so we can pass it something else, such as a
non-existent function, to produce a build error if it is not defined.
Also tidy up the code style for IS_ENABLED() and drop the unnecessary
brackets (the value is a simple 0 or 1).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the IS_ENABLED() macro has extra brackets, making it possible
to write:
if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_XXX)
but it is a bit confusing. Add the missing brackets.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
This is supposed to be a build-system flag. Move it there so we can
define it before linux/kconfig.h is included.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Seems that we need the waterlevel setting not only for PIO mode as
without this at least the i.MX 8M Mini won't boot anymore when being
written by such a U-Boot. Corruption has also been observed both on
the i.MX 6 as well as i.MX 8M Mini when using ums on the eMMC. Fix
this by setting the watermark level again regardless of whether in
DMA or PIO mode.
Fixes: 41c6a22fc2 ("mmc: fsl_esdhc_imx: simplify esdhc_setup_data()")
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
In case the eMMC contains any GP partitions or user sets up new GP
partitions, the size of these GP partitions reduce the size of the
USER partition. Subtract the size of those GP partitions from the
calculated size of USER partition when using `user enh start -`.
The following test used to fail before:
```
u-boot=> mmc hwpartition gp1 524288 enh user enh 0 - wrrel on check
Partition configuration:
User Enhanced Start: 0 Bytes
User Enhanced Size: 1.8 GiB
User partition write reliability: on
GP1 Capacity: 256 MiB ENH
No GP2 partition
No GP3 partition
No GP4 partition
Total enhanced size exceeds maximum (261 > 229)
Failed!
```
The test now passes:
```
u-boot=> mmc hwpartition gp1 524288 enh user enh 0 - wrrel on check
Partition configuration:
User Enhanced Start: 0 Bytes
User Enhanced Size: 1.5 GiB
User partition write reliability: on
GP1 Capacity: 256 MiB ENH
No GP2 partition
No GP3 partition
No GP4 partition
```
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
In some cases, a single SerDes instance can be shared between two different
processors, each using a separate link. In these cases, the SerDes
configuration is done in an earlier boot stage. Therefore, add support to
skip reconfiguring, if it is was already configured beforehand.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add support for multilink configuration of Sierra PHY. Currently,
maximum two links are supported.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add single link PCIe register configurations for no SSC and internal
SSC. Also, add missing PMA lane registers for external SSC.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
PIPE phy status is used to communicate the completion of several PHY
functions. Check if PHY is ready for operation while configured for
PIPE mode during startup.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Check if PMA cmn_ready is set indicating the startup process is complete.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add PHY PCS common register configuration sequences for single link.
Update single link PCIe register sequence accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
No functional change. Rename some regmap variables as mentioned in Sierra
register description documentation.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Sierra driver currently supports single link configurations only. Prepare
driver to support multilink multiprotocol configurations along with
different SSC modes.
Signed-off-by: Swapnil Jakhade <sjakhade@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The PLL_CMNLC clocks are modelled as a child clock device of seirra. In the
function device_probe, the corresponding clocks are probed before calling
the device's probe. The PLL_CMNLC mux clock can only be created after the
device's probe. Therefore, move assigned-clocks and assigned-clock-parents
to the link nodes in U-Boot device tree file.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Sierra has two PLLs, PLL_CMNLC and PLL_CMNLC1 and each of these PLLs has
two inputs, plllc_refclk (input from pll0_refclk) and refrcv (input from
pll1_refclk). Model PLL_CMNLC and PLL_CMNLC1 as a clock so that it's
possible to select one of these two inputs from device tree.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add missing clk_disable_unprepare() in cdns_sierra_phy_remove().
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Instead of having separate structure members for each input clock, add
an array for the input clocks within "struct cdns_sierra_phy". This is
in preparation for adding more input clocks required for supporting
additional clock combination.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
No functional change. Group devm_reset_control_get() and
devm_reset_control_get_optional() to a separate function.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
No functional change. Group all devm_clk_get_optional() to a
separate function.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Cadence Sierra PHY driver registers PHY using devm_phy_create()
for all sub-nodes of Sierra device tree node. However Sierra device
tree node can have sub-nodes for the various clocks in addtion to the
PHY. Use devm_phy_create() only for nodes with name "phy" (or "link"
for old device tree) which represent the actual PHY.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Commit 39b823381d ("phy: cadence: Add driver for Sierra PHY")
de-asserts PHY_RESET even before the configurations are loaded in
phy_init(). However PHY_RESET should be de-asserted only after
all the configurations has been initialized, instead of de-asserting
in probe. Fix it here.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The driver enables IPU support. Basically enables the clocks,
timers, watchdog timers and bare minimal MMU and supports
loading the firmware from mmc.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
[Amjad: fix compile warnings]
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
Add remoteproc resource handling helpers. These functions
are primarily to parse the resource table and to handle
different types of resources. Carveout, devmem, trace &
vring resources are handled.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
[Amjad: fix redefinition of "struct resource_table" and compile warnings ]
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
Add find_next_zero_area to fetch the next zero area in the map.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
First check the presence of the ipu firmware in the boot partition.
If present enable the ipu and the related clocks & then move
on to load the firmware and eventually start remoteproc IPU1/IPU2.
do_enable_clocks by default puts the clock domains into auto
which does not work well with reset. Hence adding do_enable_ipu_clocks
function.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
[Amjad: fix IPU1_LOAD_ADDR and compile warnings]
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
Add a reset driver to bring IPs out of reset.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
[Amjad: reset_ops structure member "free" has been renamed to "rfree",
use the latter instead]
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
There is a 4 bit VARIANT number inside the JTAGID register that TI
increments any time a new variant for a chip is produced. Each
family of TI's SoCs uses a different versioning scheme based off
that VARIANT number.
CC: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Bryan Brattlof <bb@ti.com>
J721S2 can support two instances for DDR. Therefore, add the device support
for the same and use 4266MT/s as DDR frequency.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The EVM architecture for J721S2 is similar to that of J721E and J7200. It
is as follows,
+------------------------------------------------------+
| +-------------------------------------------+ |
| | | |
| | Add-on Card 1 Options | |
| | | |
| +-------------------------------------------+ |
| |
| |
| +-------------------+ |
| | | |
| | SOM | |
| +--------------+ | | |
| | | | | |
| | Add-on | +-------------------+ |
| | Card 2 | | Power Supply
| | Options | | |
| | | | |
| +--------------+ | <---
+------------------------------------------------------+
Common Processor Board
Common Processor board is the baseboard that contains most of the actual
connectors, power supply etc. The System on Module (SoM) is plugged on to
the common processor baord. Therefore, add support for peripherals brought
out in the common processor board.
Link to Common Processor Board: https://www.ti.com/lit/zip/sprr439
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
A System on Module (SoM) contains the SoC, PMIC, DDR and basic high speed
components necessary for functionality. Therefore, add support for the
components present on the SoM.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The J721S2 SoC belongs to the K3 Multicore SoC architecture platform,
providing advanced system integration in automotive ADAS applications and
industrial applications requiring AI at the network edge. This SoC extends
the Jacinto 7 family of SoCs with focus on lowering system costs and power
while providing interfaces, memory architecture and compute performance for
single and multi-sensor applications.
Some highlights of this SoC are:
* Dual Cortex-A72s in a single cluster, three clusters of lockstep capable
dual Cortex-R5F MCUs, Deep-learning Matrix Multiply Accelerator(MMA), C7x
floating point Vector DSP.
* 3D GPU: Automotive grade IMG BXS-4-64
* Vision Processing Accelerator (VPAC) with image signal processor and
Depth and Motion Processing Accelerator (DMPAC)
* Two CSI2.0 4L RX plus one eDP/DP, two DSI Tx, and one DPI interface.
* Two Ethernet ports with RGMII support.
* Single 4 lane PCIe-GEN3 controllers, USB3.0 Dual-role device subsystems,
* Up to 20 MCANs, 5 McASP, eMMC and SD, OSPI/HyperBus memory controller,
QSPI, I3C and I2C, eCAP/eQEP, eHRPWM, MLB among other peripherals.
* Hardware accelerator blocks containing AES/DES/SHA/MD5 called SA2UL
management.
See J721S2 Technical Reference Manual (SPRUJ28 – NOVEMBER 2021)
for further details: http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruj28
Introduce basic support for the J721S2 SoC.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Add pinctrl macros for J721S2 SoC. These macro definitions are
similar to that of J721E, but adding new definitions to avoid
any naming confusions in the soc dts files.
checkpatch insists the following error exists:
ERROR: Macros with complex values should be enclosed in parentheses
However, we do not need parentheses enclosing the values for this
macro as we do intend it to generate two separate values as has been
done for other similar platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
There are 4 lanes in the single instance of J721S2 SERDES. Each SERDES
lane mux can select upto 4 different IPs. Define all the possible
functions.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
In Multi DDR subystems with interleaving support, the following needs to
configured,
- interleaving granular size and region
- EMIFs to be enabled
- EMIFs with ecc to be enabled
- EMIF separated or interleaved
- number of cycles of unsuccessful EMIF arbitration to wait before
arbitrating for a different EMIF port, by default set to 3
Add support for configuring all the above by using a MSMC device
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The current driver only supports single instance of DRR subsystem. Add
support for probing multiple instances of DDR subsystem.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add a pointer to ddr instance int the lpddr4_privatedata_s structure for
supporting mutliple instances of DDR in the drivers.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
This adds initial support for the Toradex Verdin iMX8M Plus Quad 4GB WB
IT V1.0B module. They are strapped to boot from eFuses which are factory
fused to properly boot from their on-module eMMC. U-Boot supports
booting from the on-module eMMC only, SDP support is disabled for now
due to missing i.MX 8M Plus USB support.
Functionality wise the following is known to be working:
- eMMC, 8-bit and 4-bit MMC/SD card slots
- Ethernet both on-module eQoS and FEC (requires PHY on carrier board)
- GPIOs
- I2C
Boot sequence is:
SPL ---> ATF (TF-A) ---> U-boot proper
ATF, U-boot proper and u-boot.dtb images are packed into a FIT image,
loaded by SPL.
Boot:
U-Boot SPL 2022.04-rc1-00164-g21a0312611-dirty (Feb 07 2022 - 11:34:04 +0100)
Quad die, dual rank failed, attempting dual die, single rank configuration.
Normal Boot
WDT: Started watchdog@30280000 with servicing (60s timeout)
Trying to boot from BOOTROM
Find img info 0x&48025a00, size 872
Need continue download 1024
Download 779264, Total size 780424
NOTICE: BL31: v2.2(release):rel_imx_5.4.70_2.3.2_rc1-5-g835a8f67b
NOTICE: BL31: Built : 16:52:37, Aug 26 2021
U-Boot 2022.04-rc1-00164-g21a0312611-dirty (Feb 07 2022 - 11:34:04 +0100)
CPU: Freescale i.MX8MP[8] rev1.1 at 1200 MHz
Reset cause: POR
DRAM: 8 GiB
Core: 78 devices, 18 uclasses, devicetree: separate
WDT: Started watchdog@30280000 with servicing (60s timeout)
MMC: FSL_SDHC: 1, FSL_SDHC: 2
Loading Environment from MMC... OK
In: serial
Out: serial
Err: serial
Model: Toradex Verdin iMX8M Plus Quad 4GB Wi-Fi / BT IT V1.0B, Serial# 06817281
Carrier: Toradex Verdin Development Board V1.1A, Serial# 10807609
Setting variant to wifi
Net: Hard-coding pdata->enetaddr
eth1: ethernet@30be0000, eth0: ethernet@30bf0000 [PRIME]
Hit any key to stop autoboot: 0
Verdin iMX8MP #
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc2-2
UEFI
* add unit test for RISCV_EFI_BOOT_PROTOCOL
* disable UEFI for Colibri VF610
* add handle for UART
* fix printing of Unicode strings
* simplify enumeration of block devices
malloc() functions are declared via stdlib.h. Including malloc.h can lead
to build errors e.g. on OS-X.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
When we have the block descriptor we can simply access the device. Drop
the unnecessary function call.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Use this function rather than following the pointers, since it is there
for this purpose.
Add the uclass name to the debug call at the end of dp_fill() since it is
quite useful.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The operation of this function can be confusing. Add some debugging so
we can see what it is doing and when it is called.
Also drop the preprocessor usage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When loading an EFI binary via the UART we assign a UART device path to it.
But we lack a handle with that device path.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The UEFI specification concerning Uart() device path nodes has been
clarified:
Parity and stop bits can either both use keywords or both use
numbers but numbers and keywords should not be mixed.
Let's go for keywords as this is what EDK II does. For illegal
values fall back to numbers.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The printing of a file path node must properly handle:
* odd length of the device path node
* UTF-16 character only partially contained in device path node
* buffer overflow due to very long file path
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Check that snprintf() returns the correct required buffer length and prints
the correct string for UTF-16 strings.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The test for the RISCV_EFI_BOOT_PROTOCOL retrieves the boot hart id via the
protocol and compares it to the value of the boot hart id in the device
tree. The boot hart id is already retrieved from the device tree in the FDT
test.
Merge the two tests to avoid code duplication.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The size of the board file is limited to 520192 bytes. This conflicts with
the size requirement for the UEFI code.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Acked-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Update to the 5.16 imx8mq dts files and dt bindings
Changes since v1:
Dropped rfkill.h that is not in linux mainline yet.
Signed-off-by: Angus Ainslie <angus@akkea.ca>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The previous code wrote the contents of the fuse as is in the
REFTOP_VBGADJ[2:0], but this was wrong if you consider the contents of
the table in the code comment. This table is also different from the
table in the commit description. But then, which of the two is correct?
If it is assumed that an unprogrammed fuse has a value of 0 then for
backward compatibility of the code REFTOP_VBGADJ[2:0] must be set to
6 (b'110). Therefore, the table in the code comment can be considered
correct as well as this patch.
Fixes: 97c16dc8bf ("imx: mx6ull: update the REFTOP_VBGADJ setting")
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dario.binacchi@amarulasolutions.com>
The function to return the default MMC device for the environment
already has a __weak instance doing exactly the same thing. Remove
the superfluous one.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The function to return the default MMC device for the environment
already has a __weak instance doing exactly the same thing. Remove
the superfluous one.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The Linux Kernel Image size for arm64 is still growing.
A Kernel with 54 MB at load address 0x80280000 overlaps
with fdt_addr at 0x83000000. So let's increase it to 0x84000000
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
The i.MX8M Nano can boot over USB using the boot ROM instead of
adding extra code to SPL to support USB drivers, etc. However,
when booting from USB, the environment doesnt' know where to load
and causes a hang. Fix this hang by supporting CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE=y.
It only falls back to this condition when booting from USB, so it
does not impact MMC booting.
Suggested-by: Michael Nazzareno Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Fix address of the pad control register
(IOMUXC_SW_PAD_CTL_PAD_SD1_DATA0) for SD1_DATA0_GPIO2_IO2. This seems
to be a typo but it leads to an exception when pinctrl is applied due to
wrong memory address access.
Signed-off-by: Oliver Stäbler <oliver.staebler@bytesatwork.ch>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Rob Herring <robh@kernel.org>
Fixes: c1c9d41319c3 ("dt-bindings: imx: Add pinctrl binding doc for imx8mm")
Fixes: 748f908cc882 ("arm64: add basic DTS for i.MX8MQ")
Signed-off-by: Shawn Guo <shawnguo@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de> # Picked from Linux 5cfad4f45806f ("arm64: dts: imx8mm/q: Fix pad control of SD1_DATA0")
Add PLL 1.4 GHz, 1.5 GHz, 1.6 GHz, 1.8 GHz options for iMX8M SoCs
in case they should be operated faster, e.g. to improve boot time.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Linux uses slightly different divider settings for the 1.2 GHz PLL
configuration, adjust the coefficients to match Linux.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
When regulator consumer attempts to set enabled DVS regulator voltage,
the driver aborts with "Only DVS bucks can be changed when enabled".
In case the regulator is already set to specified voltage, do nothing
instead of failing outright.
When regulator consumer attempts to set enables regulator which cannot
be controlled because it is already always enabled, the driver aborts
with -EINVAL. Again, do nothing in such case and return 0, because the
request is really fulfilled, the regulator is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Matti Vaittinen <matti.vaittinen@fi.rohmeurope.com>
According to TRM for i.MX8M Nano and Plus, GPR10 register contains lock
bit for TZASC_ID_SWAP_BYPASS bit. This bit is required to be set in
order to avoid AXI bus errors when GPU is enabled on the platform.
TZASC_ID_SWAP_BYPASS bit is alread set for all imx8m applicable
derivatives, but is missing a lock settings to be applied.
Set the TZASC_ID_SWAP_BYPASS_LOCK bit for those derivatives which have
it implemented.
Since we're here, provide also names to bits from TRM instead of using
BIT() macro in the code.
Fixes: deca6cfbf5 ("imx8mn: set BYPASS ID SWAP to avoid AXI bus errors")
Fixes: a07c718129 ("imx8mp: set BYPASS ID SWAP to avoid AXI bus errors")
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
With the updated device tree's having USB support, enable in
U-Boot. This also requires the addition of the imx8m power
domain, since the USB is gated by the power domain controller.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Resync the SOM and baseboar files with the device trees that will
be included in 5.17-RC1 when it's cut. This will improve pinmuxing
for USDHC1 and add USB functionality.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Sync with the latest DDR initialization from Phytec, which
uses version 1.2 of NXP's i.MX7D DRAM Register Programming Aid
spreadsheet.
This updated DDR initialization fixes occasional system freeze.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
As suggested in commit 028abfd9b1 ("imx8mm-evk: Generate a single
bootable flash.bin again") for imx8mm_evk, it is possible to produce
single bootable image via binman. This restores the original behavior in
distros, where only one boot container is used to create target image.
Perform similar adaptions in order to provide single bootable image for
imx8mn-ddr4-evk derivate.
Update documentation to drop additional step of copying u-boot.itb
Fixes: 353dfe4b43 ("imx8mn-ddr4-evk: switch to use binman")
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Commit 72d81360aa ("global: Convert CONFIG_LOADADDR to
CONFIG_SYS_LOADADDR") dropped the usage of LOADADDR and replaced it with
SYS_LOADADDR.
Use the correct macro in environment by replacing CONFIG_LOADADDR with
CONFIG_SYS_LOADADDR.
Fixes: d75ebf3482 ("imx: ventana: fix splash logo drawing")
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Acked-By: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Add fdt_addr_r fdtfile which used by distro boot, and cleanup legacy
environment variables.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Rather than using odd implicit blob-ext naming, explicitly specify the
type to be of blob-ext and therefore also simplify the node naming.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Some of the nodes were named using a underscore, so rectify this and
consistenly use dashes.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi passes the ATF load address via the
'entry' and 'load' properties.
Remove the step that performs the ATF_LOAD_ADDR export, which is
now unneeded.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi passes the ATF load address via the
'entry' and 'load' properties.
Remove the step that performs the ATF_LOAD_ADDR export, which is
now unneeded.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi passes the ATF load address via the
'entry' and 'load' properties.
Remove the step that performs the ATF_LOAD_ADDR export, which is
now unneeded.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
When using a board variant that selects the lvds specific dtb the
*.u-boot.dtsi file will not be included. To have a lvds dtb specific
u-boot.dtsi file move this part to a common board u-boot.dtsi file and
include this in the board base u-boot.dtsi and create an additional one
for the lvds variant.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Without this patch the bcb struct could be located at an odd address
which resulted in data not being copied to the buffer.
Here was the repro steps (from Mattijs):
=> mmc dev 1
=> bcb load 1 misc
=> bcb dump command
00000000: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
00000010: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
=> part start mmc 1 misc misc_start
=> mmc read ${loadaddr} ${misc_start} 4
=> bcb load 1 misc
=> bcb dump command
00000000: 62 6f 6f 74 6f 6e 63 65 2d 62 6f 6f 74 6c 6f 61
00000010: 64 65 72 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
This behavior was observed on an Amlogic A311D (ARM64) platform with a
recent GCC toolchain (11.2.0) but is most likely affecting other
platforms.
To avoid issues the structure is aligned on DMA minimum alignment value
as it is passed directly to the read function.
Signed-off-by: Gary Bisson <gary.bisson@boundarydevices.com>
Tested-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com> # on khadas vim3
We changed to single flash.bin now. So dfu_alt_info should be modified
to reflect this change.
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Add support of secondary boot address for imx8mn. The secondary
boot address is hardcoded in the fuse. The value is calculated
from there according to the following description:
The fuse IMG_CNTN_SET1_OFFSET (0x490[22:19]) is defined as follows:
- Secondary boot is disabled if fuse value is bigger than 10, n = fuse
value bigger than 10.
- n == 0: Offset = 4MB
- n == 2: Offset = 1MB
- Others & n <= 10 : Offset = 1MB*2^n
- For FlexSPI boot, the valid values are: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7.
Signed-off-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Similar to what has been done before with c5437e5b for u-boot proper, we
enable the SMP bit for SPL as well. This is necessary when SDP booting
straight into Linux, i.e. falcon boot. When SDP boot mode is active, the
ROM code does not set this bit which makes the caches not work once
activated in Linux.
On an i.MX6ULL (528MHz), this reduces a minimal kernel's boot time into
an initramfs shell from ~6.1s down to ~1.2s.
Signed-off-by: Sven Schwermer <sven@svenschwermer.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Skip running arch/arm/mach-imx flash.bin generation in case BINMAN is
enabled, otherwise the target in arch/arm/mach-imx/Makefile regenerates
the flash.bin again and produces corrupted result.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@oss.nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Synchronize DH DHCOM DTs with Linux commit 25960cafa06e ("Linux 5.15.12").
There is no functional change to the resulting DTs. The imx6qdl-dhcom-pdk2.dtsi
had to be adjusted with additional headers, gpio.h, pwm.h, input.h, else
the DT cannot be compiled, the same change is likely necessary in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Add labels to remaining anatop regulators, so their supplies can be
assigned in board DTs. This is similar to Linux kernel commit
93385546ba369 ("ARM: dts: imx6qdl-sabresd: Assign corresponding power supply for LDOs")
except it does not contain the unrelated sabresd changes.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The new configs/imx28_xea_sb_defconfig is introduced to facilitate
building the single binary u-boot.sb fox XEA board.
The biggest distinction from "normal" XEA imx28_xea_sb_defconfig is
support for USB mass storage devices (pen drives).
To achieve that, the CONFIG_DM_USB is enabled and supported.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Now the dts information corresponds to the one available in the kernel.
With this patch applied the 'mtd list' shows proper names and
offsets for MTD partitions.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
This change provides the possibility to build XEA (imx287 based) board
U-Boot as a single binary (without support for CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK).
The generated u-boot.sb can be used in the factory environment to for
example perform initial setup or HW testing.
It can be used with 'uuu' utility
(SDPS: boot -f /srv/tftp/xea/u-boot.sb)
In the configs/imx28_xea_defconfig one needs to disable following configs:
# CONFIG_SPL_BLK is not set
# CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK is not set
The board_init_ll() is used in arch/arm/cpu/arm926ejs/mxs/start.S, which
is utilized when CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK is disabled.
However, when it is enabled - the arch/arm/cpu/arm926ejs/start.S is used,
which requires the lowlevel_init() function.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
With the current configuration provided in mxsimage{-spl}.mx28.cfg the
size of SPL binary has been constrained to 32 KiB, due to "LOAD IVT"
command with 0x8000 offset.
The problem was that, the imx28 ROM takes the u-boot.sb and then
extracts from it the IVT header and places it on the 0x8000 OCRAM offset
overwriting any valid (i.e. loaded from eMMC or SPI-NOR) SPL code. This
bug was unnoticed as the overwrite size was just 32 bytes, so the
probability that some important code is altered was low.
However, in the XEA board (where the SPL size is ~39KiB), the overwritten
data was `(struct dm_spi_ops *) 0x800c <mxs_spi_ops>`, which is used
during the boot process.
As a result the SPL execution code hanged with "undefined instruction"
abort as callbacks (with wrong addresses) from it were called.
The fix is to change the OCRAM's offset where IVT is loaded to 0xE000,
so the SPL can grow up to ~57KiB (the maximal size of OCRAM memory
available is 0xE3FC).
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
According to the i.MX6ULL Reference Manual, pad CSI_DATA07 may
have the ESAI_TX0 functionality, not ESAI_T0.
Also, NXP's i.MX Config Tools 10.0 generates dtsi with the
MX6ULL_PAD_CSI_DATA07__ESAI_TX0 naming, so fix it accordingly.
There are no devicetree users in mainline that use the old name,
so just remove the old entry.
Fixes: f8ca22b8de ("arm: dts: imx6ull: add pinctrl defines")
Reported-by: George Makarov <georgemakarov1@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Use imx6_src_get_boot_mode() instead of manually reading SBMR1. The
existing function has proper handling for software overrides of the
bootdevice which can happen, for example, when booting from an alternate
source using `bmode`.
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The PDK2 board is capable of running both 100M and 1G ethernet. However,
the i.MX6 has only one ethernet MAC, so it is possible to configure
either 100M or 1G Ethernet. In case of 100M option, the PHY is on the
SoM and the signals are routed to a RJ45 port. For 1G the PHY is on
the PDK2 board with another RJ45 port. 100M and 1G ethernet use
different signal pins from the i.MX6, but share the MDIO bus.
This SoM board combination is used to demonstrate how to enable 1G
ethernet configuration.
Signed-off-by: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
If `sb_load_cmdfile()` fails to open the configuration file it will jump
to error handling where the code will try to `fclose()` the FILE pointer
which is NULL causing `mkimage` to segfault.
This patch removes the label for error handling and instead returns
immediately which skips the `fclose()` and prevents the segfault. The
errno is also described in the error message to guide users.
Signed-off-by: Mattias Hansson <hansson.mattias@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
The FXL6408 GPIO expander manages critical devices,
including on-module USB hub. Configure the expander to
switch the USB hub into bypass mode, allowing to use
on-carrier-board USB hub.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <cryosay@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Previously these two options are called CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
and CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT. During the transition they are
removed by accident. Thus adding them back.
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Extension boards can be added to Compulab's iot-gate-imx8mm.
We implement extension board manager for detecting the extension
boards.
Signed-off-by: Uri Mashiach <uri.mashiach@compulab.co.il>
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
After acking the requested frequency, should wait the ack bit clear
by DDR controller and check the DFS interrupt for next request polling.
Otherwise, the next polling of request bit will get previous value
that DDR controller have not cleared it, so a wrong request frequency
is used.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
On i.MX8ULP, The dram config timing need to be saved into sram for
ddr retention when APD enter PD mode, so add this support on i.MX8ULP.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The DDRLOCKED bit in CGC2 DDRCLK will auto lock up and down by HW
according to DDR DIV updating or DDR CLK halt status change. So DDR
PCC disable/enable will trigger the lock up/down flow. We
need wait until unlock to ensure clock is ready.
And before configuring the DDRCLK DIV, we need polling the DDRLOCKED
until it is unlocked. Otherwise writing ti DIV bits will not set.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This patch implements enable_adc1_clk() to enable or disable the ADC1
clock on i.MX8ULP.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Get the MAC address from fuse bank5 word 3 and 4. It has
MSB first at lowest address, so have a reverse order with other
iMX used in mac.c
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When LPAV is allocated to RTD, the LPAV won't be reset. So we have to
reset DCNano and MIPI DSI in u-boot before enabling the drivers
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The LPAV is not allocated to APD when dual boot, so LPAV won't
reset when APD is reset. We have to explicitly reset the DDR,
otherwise its initialization will fail.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
8ULP ROM should read the LPOSC trim BIAS fuse to fill the CGC0
LPOSCCTRL[7:0], but it writes a fixed value on A0.1 revision.
A0.2 will fix the issue in ROM. But A0.1 we have to workaround
it in SPL by setting LPOSCCTRL BIASCURRENT again.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Remove the freescale vendor name from CPU revision print to align
with other i.MX platforms
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The setting does not have effect because we should set it after
power on the PS16 for NIC AV.
So move it after upower_init which has powered on all PS
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
To avoid DCNANO underrun issue on high loading test, set its
read Qos on NIC_LPAV to highest
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The board use IO9 of PCA6416 on LPI2C0 and TPM0 for MIPI DSI MUX and
backlight. However the LPI2C0 and TPM0 are M33 resources, in this
patch we simply access them, but this is a temporary solution.
We will modify it when M33 FW changes to set MIPI DSI panel as default
path and enable backlight after reset.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add the DSI clock enable and disable with PCC reset used.
Add the LCD pixel clock calculation and configuration for DCNano
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Assign the PXP/HIFI4/EPDC to APD domain, otherwise APD not
able to receive interrupts from the modules.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When single boot, assign AP domain as the master domain of the LPAV.
Allocates LPAV master and slave resources like GPU, DCNano, MIPI-DSI
eDMA channel and eDMA request to APD
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
S400 enables RDC only when the DBD_EN is fused. Otherwise, the RDC
is allowed by all masters.
Current S400 has issue if the XRDC has released to A35, then A35 reset
will fail in ROM due to S400 fails to get XRDC.
So temp work around is checking the DBD_EN, if it is not fused, we
don't need to call release XRDC or TRDC.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Change boot device logic to also allow environment stored in fat and in
ext4 when booting from SD or from eMMC.
As the boot device check for SD and for eMMC was depending on
ENV_IS_IN_MMC being defined, change the ifdef blocks at env_get_location
to use IS_ENABLED instead for all modes, returning NOWHERE when no valid
mode is found.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Correct printf format for unsigned long long is %llx and not %llxx.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The imx28 uses following voltage supplies hierarchy:
VDD_5V (VDD_BAT) -> VDDIO -> VDDA -> VDDMEM
\-----> VDDD
One shall first enable DCDC on the parent source (VDDIO) and then
follow with its children.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Return the root clock values for MXC_CSPI_CLK, MXC_I2C_CLK,
MXC_UART_CLK and MXC_QSPI_CLK.
At least for the I2C clock the missing support leads to a wrong
configured I2C frequency. The expected value is 100kHz but the resulting
value is about 1MHz.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Use the complete 512kb (4 blocks) nand partition reserved for u-boot
environment instead of just the first block, this allows the module
to have a working environment even if 3 blocks are bad.
Signed-off-by: Francesco Dolcini <francesco.dolcini@toradex.com>
This is the promised second part of the sunxi PR for 2022.04, albeit
technially outside of the merge window. We were working on this full
steam since the beginning of the year, and it deserves to be merged,
I think.
The main attraction is support for the F1C100s SoC, which sports a
venerable ARM926 core. Support for this SoC and the LicheePi Nano board
has been in Linux for years, and U-Boot patches were posted mid last
year already.
The new SoC using ARMv5 also means that the bulk of the new code should
not touch any existing boards, although we did some refactorings first,
of course, which actually cleans up some existing sunxi code.
Compile tested for all 160 sunxi boards, and briefly tested on BananaPi M1,
OrangePi Zero, Pine64 and Pine-H64. Tested by others on their boards,
including F1C100s and F1C200s devices.
Add device tree files for suniv and
Lichee Pi Nano it is a board based on F1C100s.
dt-bindings/dts are synced with 5.16.0
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <Mr.Bossman075@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Add support for the suniv architecture, which is newer ARM9 SoCs by
Allwinner. The design of it seems to be a mixture of sun3i, sun4i and
sun6i.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <Mr.Bossman075@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The ARMv7 start code has support for saving some boot params at the
entry point, which is used by some SoCs to return to BROM.
Port this to ARM926EJ-S start code.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <Mr.Bossman075@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Remove some pointless #ifdefs from this file, as there are quite too
many of them already.
Some definitions don't really hurt to have in any case, so remove the
pointless CONFIG_MMC guard around CONFIG_MMC_SUNXI_SLOT.
The BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT applies regardless of ARM64 or not (now), so remove
that guard as well. The maximum number of MMC devices does not depend on
CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC, so move that out to simplify the file.
Last but not least CONFIG_SPL_BOARD_LOAD_IMAGE serves no real purpose
anymore: it's unconditionally defined for all sunxi boards, and protects
nothing applicable outside of sunxi code anymore. Just remove it.
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When we added Allwinner SoC support to ARMv8, we needed to pull in an
implementation of lowlevel_init() calling the C function s_init(), as
sunxi required it as this time.
The last few patches got rid of this bogus requirement, and as sunxi was
still the only user, we can now remove this lowlevel_init.S from ARMv8
altogether.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently we do some magic "SRAM setup" MMIO writes in s_init(), copied
from the original BSP U-Boot. The comment speaks of this being required
before DRAM access gets enabled, but there is no indication that this
would actually be required that early.
Move this out of s_init(), into board_init_f(). Since this actually only
affects a very few older SoCs, the actual code goes into the cpu/armv7
directory, to move it out of the way for all other SoCs.
This also uses the opportunity to convert some #ifdefs over to the fancy
IS_ENABLED() macros used in actual C code.
We keep the s_init() stub around for now, since armv8's lowlevel_init
still relies on it.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
According to their TRMs, Cortex ARMv7 CPUs with SMP support require the
ACTLR.SMPEN bit to be set as early as possible, before any cache or TLB
maintenance operations are done. As we do those things still in start.S,
we need to move the SMPEN bit setting there, too.
This introduces a new ARMv7 wide symbol and code to set bit 6 in ACTLR
very early in start.S, and moves sunxi boards over to use that instead
of the custom code we had in our board.c file (where it was called
technically too late).
In practice we got away with this so far, because at this point all the
other cores were still in reset, so any broadcasting would have been
ignored anyway. But it is architecturally cleaner to do it early, and
we move a core specific piece of code out of board.c.
This also gets rid of the ARM_CORTEX_CPU_IS_UP kludge I introduced a few
years back, and moves the respective logic into the new Kconfig entry.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far all Allwinner based boards were doing some not-so-lowlevel-setup
in lowlevel's s_init() routine.
This includes the initial clock, timer and pinmux setup, among other
things. This is clearly out of the "absolute bare minimum to get started"
scope that lowlevel_init.S suggests for this function.
Since we have an SPL, which is called right after s_init(), move those
calls to our board_init_f() function. As we overwrite this only for
the SPL, this has the added benefit of not doing this setup *again*
shortly afterwards, when running U-Boot proper.
This makes gpio_init() to be called from the SPL only, so pull this code
into a CONFIG_SPL_BUILD protected part to avoid build warnings.
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
At present we use wide characters for Unicode but this is not necessary.
Change the code to use the 'u' literal instead. This helps to fix build
warnings for sandbox on the Raspberry Pi.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At present we use wide characters for unicode but this is not necessary.
Change the code to use the 'u' literal instead. This helps to fix build
warnings for sandbox on rpi.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This resyncs us with the version found in v5.16 of the Linux kernel with
the following exceptions:
- Keep our u-boot specific tests / code area.
- Change the location of checkpatch.rst
- Drop the "use strscpy" test as we don't have that, but do have strlcpy
and want that used now.
- Keep debug/printf in the list for $logFunctions
This also syncs the spdxcheck.py tool and all the associated
documentation.
S
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is some code that tries to "reset" the SCTLR_ELx register early in
the boot process. The idea seems to be to guarantee some sane settings
that U-Boot actually relies on, for instance running in little-endian
mode, with the MMU off initially.
However the current code has multiple problems:
- For a start, no platform or config defines the symbol that would
enable that code.
- The code itself really only works if the bits that it tries to clear
are already cleared:
- If we run in big-endian mode initially, any previous loads would have
been wrong already. That applies to the (optional) relocation code,
but more prominently to the mask that it uses to clear those bits:
"ldr x1, =0xfdfffffa" looks innocent, but actually involves a memory
access to the literal pool, using the current endianness.
- If we run with the MMU enabled, we are probably doomed already. We
*could* hope that we are running with an identity mapping, but would
need to do some cache maintenance to avoid losing dirty cache lines.
- The idea of doing a read-modify-write of SCTLR is somewhat
questionable to begin with, because as the owner of the current
exception level we should initialise all bits of this register with a
certain fixed value.
- The code is unnecessarily complicated, and the function name is
misspelled.
While those problems *could* admittedly be fixed, the point that is does
not seem to be used at all at the moment tells me we should just remove
this code, and be it to not give a bad example.
If people care, I could introduce some proper SCTLR initialisation code.
We are about to work this out for the boot-wrapper[1] as we speak, but
apparently we got away without doing this in U-Boot ever since, so it
might not be worth the potential trouble.
[1] https://lore.kernel.org/linux-arm-kernel/20220114105653.3003399-7-mark.rutland@arm.com/
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Since commit 93b1965322 ("Makefile: Only build dtc if needed"),
the sub directory scripts/dtc is never cleaned.
Adds the directory dtc to subdir to always clean it.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In case fastboot over Ethernet, am65_cpsw_stop() is not called unless
DM_FLAG_OS_PREPARE is set. Without call to am65_cpsw_stop(), DMA
resources are not released thus leading to failures in kernel.
Fix this by adding DM_FLAG_OS_PREPARE flag to am65_cpsw_nuss_port
driver.
Reported-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add the PDU001 board specific DT files to MAINTAINERS. This should
help for better tracking of changes to these files.
Signed-off-by: Felix Brack <fb@ltec.ch>
Setting LINUX_KERNEL_IMAGE_HEADER=y attempts to include an ARM64 Linux
kernel image header at the start of both U-Boot proper and SPL binaries.
However, some definitions that the image header uses are not included by
the SPL linker script, resulting in a build error. Include them the way
they are included in U-Boot proper's linker script to fix the error.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
ymodem_read_fit() driver will end copying up to BUF_SIZE boundary even
when requested size of copy operation is less than that.
For example, if offset = 0, size = 1440B, ymodem_read_fit() ends up
copying 2KB from offset = 0, to destination buffer addr
This causes data corruption when malloc'd buffer is passed during UART
boot since commit 03f1f78a9b ("spl: fit: Prefer a malloc()'d buffer
for loading images")
With this, UART boot works again on K3 (AM654, J7, AM64) family of
devices.
Fixes: 03f1f78a9b ("spl: fit: Prefer a malloc()'d buffer for loading images")
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
For adding signing feature for capsule authentication to the host tool,
mkeficapsule, we will link gnutls library for crypto operation.
Since we need this command to complete the capsule authentication test
on sandbox in CI loop, necessary packages must be installed on the host.
See my patch, "tools: mkeficapsule: add firmware image signing."
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
If we just use fdtdec_get_addr_size_fixed to get "reg" it will use
64bit address cell to get the base address.
soc {
#address-cells = <1>;
#size-cells = <1>;
compatible ="SiFive,FU500-soc", "fu500-soc", "sifive-soc", "simple-bus";
ranges;
L28: axidma@30010000 {
#dma-cells = <1>;
compatible = "xlnx,axi-dma-1.00.a";
axistream-connected = <&L27>;
axistream-control-connected = <&L27>;
clocks = <&L1>;
interrupt-parent = <&L6>;
interrupts = <32 33>;
reg = <0x30010000 0x4000>;
fdtdec_get_addr_size_fixed: reg: addr=3001000000004000
We should get the base address through its parent's address-cells and
size-cells settings. So we should use fdtdec_get_addr_size_auto_parent()
to get correct base address.
After applying this patch, we can get the correct base address of dma by
replacing fdtdec_get_addr_size_fixed() with
fdtdec_get_addr_size_auto_parent().
fdtdec_get_addr_size_auto_parent:
na=1, ns=1, fdtdec_get_addr_size_fixed: reg: addr=30010000
Signed-off-by: Greentime Hu <greentime.hu@sifive.com>
Signed-off-by: Andy Chiu <andy.chiu@sifive.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220120084128.1892101-1-andy.chiu@sifive.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The available ram can be limited by ram_top as that depends on the
reserved memory nodes provided by the device-tree (via
board_get_usable_ram_top), so make sure to respect ram_top when setting
up bootm_size to avoid overlapping reserved memory regions (e.g. memory
used by OP-TEE).
The same logic is available in env_get_bootm_size when bootm_size is
not defined by the default environment.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220120191730.2009270-1-ricardo@foundries.io
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Populate mtd->dev with flash_info->dev which allows to get
full mtd information using the "mtd list" command.
Before, "mtd list" command returns :
List of MTD devices:
* nor0
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x40000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000004000000 : "nor0"
After this patch we get for example:
List of MTD devices:
* nor0
- device: flash@0
- parent: spi@40430000
- driver: cfi_flash
- path: /soc/spi@40430000/flash@0
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x40000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000004000000 : "nor0"
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit 045ecf8992 ("configs: enable DM_ETH support for LS1046ARDB")
resulted in the PCI bus no longer being implicitly enumerated.
However, this is necessary for the fdt pcie fixups to work.
Therefore, similar to commit 8b6558bd41 ("board: ls1088ardb:
transition to DM_ETH"), pci_init() is now called in the board_init()
routine when CONFIG_DM_ETH is active.
Signed-off-by: Martin Schiller <ms@dev.tdt.de>
CC: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
IFC-NOR and QSPI are muxed on SoC.
So disable IFC node in dts if QSPI is enabled or disable QSPI node in dts
in case QSPI is not enabled.
"ifc/nor" will be changed to "memory-controller/nor" in linux. So need to
modify "ifc/nor" to "memory-controller/nor" in fdt_path_offset().
Signed-off-by: Jianpeng Bu <jianpeng.bu@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The initial patch had typos that caused four defconfigs to miss the
symbol transition to Kconfig. CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR and
CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR are currently initialized to 0 by default
on these builds, which prevents the firmware from loading.
Add the correct symbols to these defconfigs.
Fixes: a97a071d10 ("configs: fsl: migrate FMAN/QE specific defines to Kconfig")
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The commit in the Fixes: tag below broke traffic through switch ports
where the SERDES protocol requires in-band autoneg and this requirement
isn't described in the device tree: SGMII, QSGMII, USXGMII (with
2500Base-X, in-band autoneg isn't supported).
The LS1028A-QDS boards are not yet ready for syncing their device trees
with Linux, since Ethernet is missing there (but has been submitted):
https://lore.kernel.org/lkml/20211112223457.10599-11-leoyang.li@nxp.com/
When agreement is reached for the Ethernet support in Linux, there will
be a sync for these boards as well. For now, just enable in-band autoneg
to fix the breakage.
Fixes: e3789a7262 ("net: dsa: felix: configure the in-band autoneg property based on OF node info")
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Allow device trees to be reused between Linux and U-Boot.
The source for these device trees is linux-next as of commit
bd8a9cd624c6 ("arm64: dts: ls1028a-rdb: update copyright"), which was
chosen because some changes needed to be done to the Linux DTs too,
before they could be shared:
https://lore.kernel.org/linux-arm-kernel/20211202141528.2450169-5-vladimir.oltean@nxp.com/T/#m6f63c92e75fa79a01144b2c2c6dc4776e7971395
There are two more commits on the RDB device tree which haven't been
picked up yet, because they have dependencies on the SoC device tree:
dd3d936a1b17 ("arm64: dts: ls1028a: add ftm_alarm1 node to be used as wakeup source")
b2e2d3e02fb6 ("arm64: dts: ls1028a-rdb: enable pwm0")
These will be picked up on the next resync.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reuse the scheme implemented by the Kontron SL28 boards in
commit d08011d7f9
("arm: dts: ls1028a: disable the PCIe controller by default")
and move the 'status = "okay"' lines for the PCIe controllers
inside a separate U-Boot dtsi for the LS1028A-RDB board. This way, the
existing Linux device tree can simply be dropped in.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is no I2C peripheral on these buses on the reference design board,
and the Linux device tree does not enable them either.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is no SPI peripheral on the LS1028A-RDB, therefore no reason to
enable these nodes in the U-Boot device tree (and Linux does not enable
them either).
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In a bit of a blunder, the blamed commit in the Fixes: tag below made
the mscc_felix switch driver look at the 'managed = "in-band-status"'
device tree property, forgetting that the U-Boot device tree had not
been updated to include that property, whereas the Linux one does.
The switch is therefore described in the device tree as not requiring
in-band autoneg, but the PHY driver for VSC8514 (drivers/net/phy/mscc.c)
still enables that feature. This results in a mismatch => no traffic.
This patch is a copy-paste of the Ethernet device tree nodes from Linux,
which resolves that issue. The device tree update also renames the
Ethernet PHY labels.
Fixes: e3789a7262 ("net: dsa: felix: configure the in-band autoneg property based on OF node info")
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The nodes in the NXP LS1028A-RDB device tree are out of order, regroup
them alphabetically to have a simple delta when the Linux device tree is
brought in.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Now that all in-tree boards have been converted to the compatible
strings from Linux, delete the support for the ad-hoc "pcf2127-rtc" one.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
During the LS1028A-RDB sync with Linux device trees, it was observed
that the same RTC is present on the two boards, and the wrong compatible
string is used in both places. This change updates the RTC from the
LX2160A-RDB to use the compatible string that was established in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
During this board's sync with Linux device trees, it was observed that
it doesn't use the same compatible string for the RTC node as in U-Boot.
This change makes the RTC compatible strings match, for a smoother sync.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The LS1028A-QDS board won't be synced with the Linux device trees right
now, since those are currently still in progress (Ethernet is missing).
However, while we're at converting the RDB, it can be observed that the
same RTC is present on the two boards, and the wrong compatible string
is used in both places. This change updates the RTC from the QDS to use
the compatible string that was established in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
During the LS1028A-RDB sync with Linux device trees, it was observed
that the same RTC is present on the two boards, and the wrong compatible
string is used in both places. This change updates the RTC from the
LX2160A-QDS to use the compatible string that was established in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
During the LS1028A-RDB sync with Linux device trees, it was observed
that the same RTC is present on the two boards, and the wrong compatible
string is used in both places. This change updates the RTC from the
LS1088A-RDB to use the compatible string that was established in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
During the LS1028A-RDB sync with Linux device trees, it was observed
that the same RTC is present on the two boards, and the wrong compatible
string is used in both places. This change updates the RTC from the
LS1088A-QDS to use the compatible string that was established in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Allow this driver to be used by boards which inherit their device trees
from Linux. Compatibility is temporarily retained with the old
compatible string which is U-Boot specific, and will be removed after a
few changes.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This seems to be very similar to the already existing PCA9547, save for
the fact that it supports 0.8V and doesn't support 5V. In fact, it is so
similar to the PCA9547 that the NXP LS1028A-RDB board has been driving
this chip using a "nxp,pca9547" compatible string.
Create a new compatible for the PCA9847 (which is the same as in Linux)
and define the same operating parameters for it as for PCA9547.
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
The current fixup of LX2160A PCIe nodes is based on non-production
rev1 silicon, and in Linux the nodes have been updated for rev2
silicon, so update the searching compatible string to match the
kernel changes. And for compatibility with the rev1 nodes, move
forward the board specific fixup.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Commit eb1986804d ("configs: enable DM_ETH support for LS1043ARDB")
resulted in the PCI bus no longer being implicitly enumerated.
However, this is necessary for the fdt pcie fixups to work.
Therefore, similar to commit 8b6558bd41 ("board: ls1088ardb:
transition to DM_ETH"), pci_init() is now called in the board_init()
routine when CONFIG_DM_ETH is active.
Signed-off-by: Martin Schiller <ms@dev.tdt.de>
CC: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
CC: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The SCRATCHRW4 is only used in secure boot scenario that is unsupported by
our design, so this address can be stolen for storing POST status.
The SCRATCHRW4 is initialized to zero at core rest.
Using a DDR address was unfortunate choice, the DDR at boot time has a
random contend and it happens that sometimes is matching POST magic number.
This behavior can lead to undefined POST behavior and u-boot ending in
failbootcmd command.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Make it in a same way as on the other FOXMC products, this also helps to
avoid unwanted stop caused by some terminal servers that are sending junk
on the serial line.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Even not used by u-boot, this has to be inline with the hw and kernel dts.
U-boot partition table is defined by MTDPARTS_DEFAULT Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch adds default defconfig for u-boot update version, the u-boot
update defconfig is a copy of the default (factory) defconfig with:
- adapted text base and environment addresses
- explicit flag that this is a field updated u-boot version
At the time of implementation this version is only used to verify the
update procedure, in future depend on the needs this defconfig can be
extended with additional options.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Field fail-safe u-boot update for pg-wcom-ls102x designs is introduced
with patch: 81fb05e.
This patch enables already added support by:
- Defining default u-boot build as bootpackage (factory) image.
- Defining u-boot update image location according to the EXPU1 NOR layout.
- Extending mtd partitions according defined EXPU1 NOR layout.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This was probably broken when mainlining, CONFIG_FSL_DEVICE_DISABLE is
not Kconfig but whitelisted.
It's fine to be without flag as this is always enabled for abec1020
(pg-wcom-ls102xa.h)
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch adds default defconfig for u-boot update version, the u-boot
update defconfig is a copy of the default (factory) defconfig with:
- adapted text base and environment addresses
- explicit flag that this is a field updated u-boot version
At the time of implementation this version is only used to verify the
update procedure, in future depend on the needs this defconfig can be
extended with additional options.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Field fail-safe u-boot update for pg-wcom-ls102x designs is introduced
with patch 81fb05e.
This patch enables already added support by:
- Defining default u-boot build as bootpackage (factory) image.
- Defining u-boot update image location according to the SELI8 NOR layout.
- Extending mtd partitions according defined SELI8 NOR layout.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Field fail-safe u-boot update procedure for pg-wcom boards is defined and
implemented by patch: 59b3403.
This patch invokes the update procedure for pg-wcom-ls102x designs during
early misc_init_f execution.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch provides possibility for field fail-safe u-boot updates.
The implementation can be used on all pg-wcom boards that are booting from
parallel NOR flash.
When used in a board design, provided check_for_uboot_update function will
start new u-boot at defined location if updateduboot envvar is set to yes.
With this implementation it is expected that factory programmed u-boot
will always stay as it is, and optionally new u-boot can be safely
programmed by embedded software when the unit is rolled out on the field.
It is expected check_for_uboot_update to be called early in execution
before relocation (*_f) once SoC is basically initialized and environment
can be read, with this possibilities to not be able to fix a u-boot bug by
a u-boot update are reduced to minimum.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The EBOOTCNT is a reserved persistent static memory area in QRIO,
and similar to BOOTCNT is intended to be used as boot counter location.
Comparable to BOOTCNT that is reserved for u-boot main bootcount
infrastructure, EBOOTCNT is intended to be used for pg-wcom board
specific purposes (e.g implementing early boot counter for fail-safe
u-boot update).
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The PHY for the debug interface was placed on the board for the
pg_wcom_ls102x. Hence only when a piggy is plugged, a RJ45 jack
including magnetics is connected to the MDI of the PHY. Without a
piggy the MDI lines are left floating and it does not make sense to
have an active debug PHY.
In case of expu1 an active PHY without a piggy even led to increased
jitter for syncE.
This patch only deactivates the prst line of the debug PHY when a piggy
is detected persent.
Signed-off-by: Rainer Boschung <rainer.boschung@hitachienergy.com>
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is a request from HW designers to use this QRIO pin for detecting
DIC26_SELFTEST status instead of a GPIO pin.
This pin is typically used during production for executing POST tests and
starting test ESW bank.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Beside that mounted rgmii debug phy is 1000Mbps capable, the debug link
between the piggy board and the phy is 100Mbps only.
This leads to longer link establishment time when working in debug mode,
as phy tries to autoneg 1000Mbps.
This patch fixes the speed to 100Mbps and allows smother link establishment
time for the debug interface.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachienergy.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The Ten64 is a networking-oriented MiniITX board
using the NXP LS1088A SoC.
This patch provides the bare minimum to support
Ten64 boards under U-Boot for distroboot.
Some related drivers have not yet been submitted
and this basic support lacks some of the
opinionated defaults provided by our firmware
distribution.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Traverse Technologies Ten64 family boards use a microcontroller
to control low level board functions like startup and reset,
as well as holding details such as the board MAC address.
Communication between the CPU and microcontroller is via
I2C.
To keep the driver structure clean between the Ten64 board
file, DM_I2C, and a future utility command, this driver
has been implemented as a misc uclass device.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
mkimage segfaults due to the ASLR mechanism on MacOS arm64
It is required to use _dyld_get_image_vmaddr_slide()
to prevent segfault on MacOS arm64
This patch is based on the discussion
3b142045e8
Thanks to Jessica Clarke, Ronny Kotzschmar and ptpt52 github user
Reviewed-by: Jessica Clarke <jrtc27@jrtc27.com>
Signed-off-by: Sergey V. Lobanov <sergey@lobanov.in>
The current Makefile rule requires there to be a 'Module' line in the
pylint output, like this:
************* Module binman.fip_util
This line only appears if pylint has some comments about the module. We
cannot rely on it for naming.
Update the code to instead use the filename as the identifier for each
score, so rather than:
multiplexed_log 7.49
we output:
test_multiplexed_log.py 7.20
It is still easy to see which file the score relates to. In fact the new
naming is nicer since the full subdirectories are shown.
The avoids the problem where a module name is not produced, and the output
gets out of sync.
Regenerate pylint.base so we can start from the current baseline.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- kirkwood: Add Pogoplug-V4 support (Tony)
- kirkwood: GoFlex Home : Use Marvell PHY driver (Tony)
- Another set of kwboot improvements (Pali)
- Minor misc stuff
The GoFlex Home board has the network chip Marvell 88E1116R.
Use uclass mvgbe and the compatible driver M88E1118R to bring up Ethernet.
- Currently, CONFIG_RESET_PHY_R symbol is used in
arch/arm/mach-kirkwood/include/mach/config.h for all Kirkwood
boards with mv8831116 PHY, with each board defines the function
reset_phy(). Undefine it for this board.
- Add board_eth_init() to use uclass mvgbe to bring up the network.
And remove ad-hoc code.
- Enable CONFIG_PHY_MARVELL to properly configure the network.
- Miscellaneous changes: use CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD to keep u-boot image
under 512K, use BIT macro, and cleanup comments.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This should enable BootROM output on UART.
(At least on A385 BootROM this is broken, BootROM ignores this debug
flag and does not enable its output on UART if some valid image is
available in SPI-NOR.)
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When -D is specified then both bootmsg and debugmsg are not set, but
imgpath is set. Fix this check for valid and required parameters.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The select() and read() syscalls may be interrupted. Handle EINTR and
retry them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The write() syscall may be interrupted. Handle EINTR and retry it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This delay is not needed anymore since kwboot already handles retrying
logic for incomplete xmodem packets and also forces BootROM to flush its
input queue. Removing it decreases total transfer time.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Force the BootROM to flush its input queue after sending boot pattern.
This ensures that after function kwboot_bootmsg() finishes, BootROM is
able to start receiving xmodem packets without any specific delay or
setup.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Allow option -b without image path parameter, to send boot pattern and
wait for response but not send any image. This allows to use kwboot just
for processing boot pattern and user can use any other xmodem tool for
transferring the image itself (e.g. sx). Useful for debugging purposes.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When kwboot is unable to resend current xmodem packet, show an 'E' in the
progress output instead of a '+'. This allows to distinguish between the
state when kwboot is retrying sending the packet and when retry is not
possible.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Unfortunately during some stages of xmodem transfer, A385 BootROM is not
able to handle repeated xmodem packets. So if an error occurs during that
stage, stop the transfer and return failure.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Marvell BootROM expects retransmission of previous xmodem packet only in
the case when it sends NAK response to the host.
Do not change non-xmodem response (possibly UART transfer error) to NAK
in kwboot_xm_recv_reply() function. Allow caller to receive original
response from device.
Change argument 'nak_on_non_xm' to 'stop_on_non_xm'. Instead of changing
non-xmodem character to NAK, stop processing on invalid character and
return it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
It is unknown why handling of CAN byte was added into kwboot tool as
Marvell BootROM does not support CAN byte. It never sends CAN byte to host
and if host sends CAN byte BootROM handles it as an unknown byte.
Remove code for handling and sending CAN bytes from the kwboot tool.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Sometimes if the first byte of xmodem packet (SOH) is incorrectly
transmitted, BootROM sends NAK for every non-SOH received byte, which
makes BootROM and the host kwboot tool out of sync. BootROM automatically
re-synchronizes after 2s pause by dropping its input queue. So when
attempting retransmit for 9th time or later, ignore NAK reply from BootROM
and either wait for valid ACK or let kwboot timeout, which implies
re-synchronization.
This fixes retransmission of xmodem packets and allows kwboot to work also
without "Waiting ... and flushing tty" code which is at the beginning of
kwboot xmodem transfer.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use the blk_rsp_timeo variable when sleeping before flushing tty.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fix xmodem retry mechanism if some bytes from xmodem packet were lost and
BootROM is still waiting for completing previous xmodem packet.
It is required to wait at least 1.312s on A385, otherwise BootROM does not
accept next xmodem packet if previous one was not completely transferred.
2s should be enough timeout cause that BootROM will drop incomplete xmodem
packet and expects new packet.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use versioned URLs for line numbers as branches are moving in the time and
use master branch for mv-ddr-marvell where is up-to-date code.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We can and should run the node generator only when creating a new image.
When we read it back, there is no need to generate nodes - they already
exits, and binman does not dive that deep into the image - and there is
no way to provide the required fdt-list. So store the mode in the image
object so that Entry_fit can simply skip generator nodes when reading
them from an fdtmap.
This unbreaks all read-backs of images that contain generator nodes in
their fdtmap. To confirm this, add a corresponding test case.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add SPDX to dts file:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 37f815cad0 ("moveconfig: Use a function to read files") adds a
helper function that can read a file as lines, but strips the newline
characters. This change broke parts of moveconfig code that relied on
their existence, resulting in a few issues:
Configs that are defined as empty aren't removed from header files (e.g.
"#define CONFIG_REMAKE_ELF"). Make regex patterns use '\b' to match word
boundaries instead of '\W' (which matched the newlines) so these lines
still match and get removed.
All changes in defconfig are considered removed by savedefconfig even
if they weren't, and line continuations in the headers aren't recognized
and removed properly, because their checks explicitly look for a newline
character. Remove the character from both comparisons.
The printed diff of header files is wrongly formatted and raises an
IndexError if a blank line was removed. Let print() print the new lines,
and use size-independent ways to check strings to fix the diff output.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
a bit delayed, the first batch of the sunxi pull request for this cycle.
This is mostly collecting some patches that were lying around for a
while, plus some recent fixes. Nothing too exciting at this point, but
of course they should be merged nevertheless.
There is the much bigger F1C100s SoC support coming up, which I hope to
be able to send in the next few days, along with the removal of sunxi's
lowlevel_init usage.
Compile tested for all 159 sunxi boards, plus briefly tested on BananaPi
M1, OrangePi Zero, Pine64 and Pine-H64.
Due to a bug in the H3 SoC, where the CPU 0 hotplug flag cannot be
written, resuming CPU 0 requires using the "Super Standby" code path in
the BROM instead of the hotplug path. This path requires jumping to an
eGON image in SRAM.
This resume image, whose single purpose is to jump back to the secure
monitor, only needs to contain a single instruction. Padding the image
to 8 KiB would be wasteful of SRAM. Hook up the -B (block size) option
so users can set the block/padding size.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Although it isn't known what bit 0 in PHY reg 8 does, it's obvious that
it has to be set before read calibration and cleared afterwards. This is
already done for first rank, but not for second (copy & paste error.)
Fix it.
Fixes: f4317dbd06 ("sunxi: Add H616 DRAM support")
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Kconfig symbol is missing CONFIG_ prefix, so compiler will always
skip ODT configuration.
Fix symbol name.
Fixes: f4317dbd06 ("sunxi: Add H616 DRAM support")
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
For sunxi boards with the AXP209, AXP221, AXP809, and AXP818 PMICs
(plus possibly others, I only confirmed the datasheets for these),
it is sometimes desirable to not boot whenever the device is
plugged in. An example would be when using the NTC CHIP inside a
PocketCHIP.
This provides a configurable option to check if bit 0 of
register 0 of the PMIC says it was powered because of a power button
press (0) or a plug-in event (1). If the value is 1 and this option
is selected, the device shuts down shortly after printing a message
to console stating the reason why it's shutting down. Powering up the
board with the power button is not affected.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
[Andre: reword to speak of boot, remove #ifdefs]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Most AXP PMICs feature a "startup source" register, which keeps
information about how the PMIC started operation. Bit 0 in there means
it has been started by "plugging in the power cable".
Define a symbol in each PMIC's header file to be able to use that
register and bit later on.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The calls for flipping bits in the Allwinner pin controller registers
were using unnecessarily complex pointer arithmetic.
Improve readability by simplifying the expression.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Now that the sunxi_gpio driver handles pull-up/down via the driver
model, pin configuration does not need a platform-specific function.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This, along with gpio_flags_xlate(), allows the GPIO driver to handle
pull-up/down flags provided by consumer drivers or in the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The GPIO and pinctrl drivers need these setters for pin configuration.
Since they are DM drivers, they should not be using hardcoded base
addresses. Factor out variants of the setter functions which take a
pointer to the GPIO bank's MMIO registers.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The return values of these functions are always zero, and they are
never checked. Since they are not needed, remove them.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This adds a compatible string for the Allwinner Sun4i-A10 I2C
controller. Without this, boards based on the R8 and A13 (at a
minimum) fail to boot.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Acked-by: Akash Gajjar <gajjar04akash@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Sometimes some ethernet aliases do not exist in U-Boot DT but they
exist in the DT used to boot the system (for example, modified via DT
overlays). In this situation setup_environment is called again in
ft_board_setup() to generate macaddr environment variable for them.
However now the call to fdt_fixup_ethernet() is moved before the call
of ft_board_setup().
Call fdt_fixup_ethernet() again to add MAC addresses for the extra
ethernet aliases.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
[updated commit message]
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The driver for SPI0 on Allwinner H6 SoCs did not use the correct define
SUN50I_GPC_SPI0 for the pin function, but one for a different Allwinner
SoC series.
Fix the conditionals to use the correct define for H6 SoCs. This matches
the conditional logic in the SPL spi driver.
Tested by probing the spi-flash on a pine64_h64-model-b board with
adapted device-tree (disable mmc2, enable spi0).
Signed-off-by: Daniel Wagenknecht <dwagenk@mailbox.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc1-3
Documentation:
* update Nokia RX-51 documentation and move it to rst
* describe boot switch settings for HiFive Unmatched board
UEFI:
* fix the checking of images hashes and signatures
* provide the RISCV_EFI_BOOT_PROTOCOL
- Extend the pci command to support a few more features.
- Add support for custom SPL boot device names (so it's easier for users
to understand)
- Updates for am64x to address some review comments.
- Migration deadline notice for DM_SERIAL
- coreboot payload test
- Support rsa3072 signatures.
- DFU should skip writing empty UBI pages, bootcount printf format char
correction.
A mix of signatures and hashes in db doesn't always work as intended.
Currently if the digest algorithm is not explicitly set to sha256 we
stop walking the security database and reject the image.
That's problematic in case we find and try to check a signature before
inspecting the sha256 hash. If the image is unsigned we will reject it
even if the digest matches.
Since we no longer reject the image on unknown algorithms add an explicit
check and reject the image if any other hash algorithm apart from sha256
is detected on dbx.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
On RISC-V a new UEFI protocol has been introduced. Support printing
its GUID using %pUs.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Abstract common routines to make the code easily understandable.
No functional change.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
unmatched.rst describes booting from SD card or from SPI. But only for
booting from SPI the boot selection settings are described.
Add the missing information.
Fix a typo 'uSD'.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This change contains update for doc/README.nokia_rx51 documentation file
with information how to load U-Boot image to device RAM without need to
flash it and also how to flash it into OneNAND via 0xFFFF flasher.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Since commit 25c5b65178 ("Nokia RX-51: Do not try calling both ext2load
and ext4load") command ext4load is used for all ext2/3/4 fs variants.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This probably should have been done a while back since it is a core
system. Very few boards remain to be migrated.
Addd a migration deadline for a year out.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Coreboot supports U-Boot as a payload and this recently got a bit of a
facelist. Add a test for this.
For now this uses a binary build of coreboot (v4.15). Future work could
potentially build it from source, but we need to figure out the
toolchain problems first, since coreboot uses its own toolchain. It
turns out that this is tricky, because coreboot fails to build with a
vanilla gcc.
This needs some changes to the hooks scripts as well. An example build
is at https://source.denx.de/u-boot/custodians/u-boot-dm/-/jobs/359687
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With Ethboot support in SPL, network stack requires more BSS area, so
increase BSS max size to 16K
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
ROM supports cpsw_port2 for Ethernet boot and SPL stages continue to
download images on the same port, therefore there is no need to enable
cpsw_port1. Disable the same.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Add to support rsa 3072 bits algorithm in tools
for image sign at host side and adds rsa 3072 bits
verification in the image binary.
Add test case in vboot for sha384 with rsa3072 algorithm testing.
Signed-off-by: Jamin Lin <jamin_lin@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For printing phys_addr_t we should use %pa to avoid warning like:
drivers/bootcount/bootcount_syscon.c:110:17: note: in expansion of macro ‘dev_err’
110 | dev_err(dev, "%s: Unsupported register size: %d\n", __func__,
| ^~~~~~~
seen for sandbox_defconfig with CONFIG_PHYS_64BIT=y.
Cf. commit 1eebd14b79 ("vsprintf: Add modifier for phys_addr_t")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Align the DFU MTD backend for the UBI partitions with the mtd command write
behavior when the option .dontskipff is not used: don't write the empty
pages (full of 0xFF); it is not required for UBI, see [1] for details.
This patch avoids the "free space fixup" procedure in the kernel [2]
and allows to program a UBIFS volume generated by mkfs.ubifs without the
option -F, --space-fixup.
The MTD DFU backend implements this behavior introduced on DFU NAND
backend by the commit 13cb7cc9e8 ("dfu: Add option to skip empty pages
when flashing UBI images to NAND") and also supported by the command nand
by CONFIG_CMD_NAND_TRIMFFS and by commit c9494866df ("cmd_nand: add nand
write.trimffs command").
[1] http://www.linux-mtd.infradead.org/doc/ubi.html#L_flasher_algo
[2] http://www.linux-mtd.infradead.org/faq/ubifs.html#L_free_space_fixup
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Allow to call 'pci' and 'pci regions' commands with bus option '*' which
cause pci to process all buses.
PCIe is point-to-point HW and so on each bus is maximally one physical
device. Therefore for PCIe it is common to have multiple buses.
This change allows to easily print all available PCIe devices in system.
Make '*' as default option when no bus argument is specified.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently pci command ignores invalid cmdline arguments and do something.
Add checks that all passed arguments were processed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
'pci regions' currently prints only region information from bus 0 which
belongs to controller 0. Parser for 'pci regions' cmdline currently ignores
any additional arguments and so U-Boot always uses bus 0.
Regions are stored in controller (not on the bus) and therefore to retrieve
controller from the bus, it is needed to call pci_get_controller() which
returns root bus. Because bus 0 is root bus, current code worked fine for
controller 0.
Extend cmdline parser for 'pci regions' to allows specifying bus number,
extend pci_show_regions() code to accept also non-zero bus number and
print bus ranges for which is regions configuration assigned.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Initially it is set to dev_seq but update to the last bus number is
missing. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently the names MMC1, MMC2 and MMC2_2 are output in the SPL. To
achieve more userbility here the name of the boot source can be returned.
E.g. for "MMC1" -> "eMMC" or "MMC2" -> "SD card".
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Having U-Boot look up the passed partition name even though an alias
exists is unexpected, leading to warning messages (when the alias name
doesn't exist as a real partition name) or the use of the wrong
partition.
Change part_get_info_by_name_or_alias() to consider real partitions
names only if no alias of the same name exists, allowing to use aliases
to override the configuration for existing partition names.
Also change one use of strcpy() to strlcpy().
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
In DFU v1.1 specification [1] the DFU_UPLOAD (Short Frame)
is handled only in dfuUPLOADIDLE state:
- Figure A.1 Interface state transition diagram
- the state description in chapter A.2
A.2.3 State 2 dfuIDLE
on Receipt of the DFU_UPLOAD request,and bitCanUpload = 1
the Next State is dfuUPLOADIDLE
A.2.10 State 9 dfuUPLOAD-IDLE
When the length of the data transferred by the device in response
to a DFU_UPLOAD request is less than wLength. (Short frame)
the Next State is dfuIDLE
In current code, when an UPLOAD is completely performed after the first
request (for example with wLength=200 and data read = 9), the DFU state
stay at dfuUPLOADIDLE until receiving a DFU_UPLOAD or a DFU_ABORT request
even it is unnecessary as the previous DFU_UPLOAD request already reached
the EOF.
This patch proposes to finish the DFU uploading (don't go to dfuUPLOADIDLE)
and completes the control-read operation (go to DFU_STATE_dfuIDLE) when
the first UPLOAD response has a short frame as an end of file (EOF)
indicator even if it is not explicitly allowed in the DFU specification
but this seems logical.
[1] https://www.usb.org/sites/default/files/DFU_1.1.pdf
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In case CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV == 0, compile-time condition
is not met and fastboot_set_reboot_flag() fails.
Fixes: a362ce214f ("fastboot: Implement generic fastboot_set_reboot_flag")
Signed-off-by: Roman Stratiienko <r.stratiienko@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
acpi refactoring to allow non-x86 use
binman support for bintools (binary tools)
minor tools improvements in preparation for FDT signing
various minor fixes and improvements
Add support for CDC ACM using the new UDC and gadget API. This protocol
can be used for serial over USB data transfer and is widely supported
by various OS (GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, OSX...). The usual purpose of
such link is to access device debug console and can be useful for
products not exposing regular UART to the user.
A default stdio device named 'usbacm' is created, and can be used
to redirect console to USB link over CDC ACM:
> setenv stdin usbacm; setenv stdout usbacm
Signed-off-by: Loic Poulain <loic.poulain@linaro.org>
It is currenly only used from usbtty driver but make it properly
selectable via Kconfig symbol, for future usage.
Signed-off-by: Loic Poulain <loic.poulain@linaro.org>
This commit converts i.MX28's EHCI USB host driver to driver model
(DM_USB). It is a straightforward conversion (to reuse as much code
as possible), based on ehci-mx5.c code.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Those functions will be re-used when the ehci MXS driver (for imx28)
will be converted to also support CONFIG_DM_USB.
No functional changes introduced - only cosmetic changes (u32 type)
and alignment to pass checkpatch.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
This function is going to be reused with the CONFIG_DM_USB enabled in
the imx28 mxs USB ehci driver.
No functional changes introduced.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
At present mkimage displays the node information but it is not clear what
signing action was taken. Add a message that shows it. For now it only
supports showing a single signing action, since that is the common case.
Sample:
Signature written to 'sha1-basic/test.fit',
node '/configurations/conf-1/signature'
Public key written to 'sha1-basic/sandbox-u-boot.dtb',
node '/signature/key-dev'
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the two functions that call add_verify_data() so that the caller
can see the node that was written to.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we rely on the key blob being in the global_data fdt_blob
pointer. This is true in U-Boot but not with tools. For clarity, pass the
parameter around.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Put the parent node first in the parameters as this is more natural. Also
add a comment to explain what is going on.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We should be consistent in using the term 'signature' to describe a value
added to sign something and 'key' to describe the key that can be used to
verify the signature.
Tidy up the code to stick to this.
Add some comments to fit_config_verify_key() and its callers while we are
here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The copyfile() implementation has strange behaviour if the destination
file already exists. Update it to ensure that any existing data in the
destination file is dropped.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add some more debugging to make it easier to see what is being tried and
what fails. Fix a few comment styles while here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The definition of struct udphdr in include netinet/udp.h in the
musl library differs from the definition in the glibc library.
To use the same definition with musl the symbol _GNU_SOURCE has
to be defined.
Reported-by: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tested-by: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
When building sandbox_defconfig with CONFIG_DM_VIDEO=n a link time error
occurs:
in function `sandbox_serial_pending':
drivers/serial/sandbox.c:101: undefined reference to `video_sync_all'
video_sync_all() is only defined if we have CONFIG_DM_VIDEO=y.
Calling this function in a serial driver looks quite hackish
but at least let's add the missing build constraint.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Each bintool has some documentation which can be useful for the user.
Add a new command that collects this and writes it into a .rst file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Drop the unused gzip code, update comments and add a test for an
invalid algorithm. The temporary file is not needed now, so drop that
also.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Bintools can be missing, in which case binman continues operation but
reports an invalid image. Plumb in support for this and add tests for
entry types which use bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the code to use this bintool, instead of running lzma_alone
directly. This simplifies the code and provides more consistency.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to compress and decompress data.
It supports the features needed by binman as well as installing via the
lzma-alone package.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the code to use this bintool, instead of running lz4 directly. This
simplifies the code and provides more consistency.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to compress and decompress data.
It supports the features needed by binman as well as installing via the
lz4 package.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The compression functions are not actually used by patman, so we don't
need then in the tools module. Also we want to change them to use
bintools, which patman will not support.
Move these into a new comp_util module, within binman.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the fit and mkimage entry types to use this bintool, instead of
running mkimage directly. This simplifies the code and provides more
consistency as well as supporting missing bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the ifwi entry type to use this bintool, instead of running
ifwitool directly. This simplifies the code and provides more
consistency as well as supporting missing bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the GBB and vblock entry types to use this bintool, instead of
running futility directly. This simplifies the code and provides more
consistency as well as supporting missing bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the FIP tests to use this bintool, instead of running fiptool
directly. This simplifies the code and provides more consistency as well
as supporting missing bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CBFS tests to use this bintool, instead of running cbfstool
directly. This simplifies the overall code and provides more consistency,
as well as supporting missing bintools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The tests rely on having at least 5 bintool implementions. Now that we
have this, enable them. Add tests for the binman 'tool' subcommand.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to build images for use by U-Boot.
It supports the features needed by binman as well as installing via the
u-boot-tools packages. Although this is built in the U-Boot tree, it is
still useful to install a binary on the system.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to build Intel IFWI images. It
supports the features needed by the tests as well as downloading a binary
from Google Drive. Although this is built in the U-Boot tree, it is not
currently included with u-boot-tools, so it may be useful to install a
binary on the system.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to sign Chrome OS images and
build the Google Binary Block (GBB). It supports the features needed by
binman as well as fetching a binary from Google Drive. Building it from
source is possible but is left for another time, as it requires at least
one other library.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to run FIP tests. It supports
the features needed by the tests as well as building a binary from
the git tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a Bintool for this, which is used to run CBFS tests. It supports
the features needed by the tests as well as fetching a binary from
Google Drive. Building it from source is very slow since it is not
separately supported by the coreboot build system and it builds an
entire gcc toolchain before starting.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Support collecting the available bintools needed by an image, by
scanning the entries in the image.
Also add a command-line interface to access the basic bintool features,
such as listing the bintools and fetching them if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman requires various tools to actually work, such as 'lz4' to compress
data and 'futility' to sign Chrome OS firmware. At present these are
handled in an ad-hoc manner and there is no easy way to find out what
tools are needd to build an image, nor where to obtain them.
Add an implementation of 'bintool', a base class which implements this
functionality. When a bintool is required, it can be requested from this
module, then executed. When the tool is missing, it can provide a way to
obtain it.
Note that this uses Command directly, not the tools.Run() function. This
allows proper handling of missing tools and avoids needing to catch and
re-raise exceptions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since this is a list of blobs, each blob should have the ability to be
faked, as with blob-ext. Update the Entry base class to set allow_fake
and use the base class in the section code also, so that this propagagtes
to blob-ext-list, which is not a section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Run() function automatically uses the PATH variable to locate a tool
when running it. Add a function that does this manually, so we don't have
to run a tool to find out if it is present.
This is needed by the new Bintool class, which wants to check which tools
are present.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reverse the order of the return tuple, so that the filename is first.
This seems more obvious than putting the temporary directory first.
Correct a bug that leaves a space on the final line.
Allow the caller to control the name of the temporary directory.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new function which returns the entire result from running a tool,
not just stdout. Update Run() to use this and to return stdout on error,
if stderr is empty, since some unfortunate tools write their error
output to stdout rather than stderr.
Move building of the PATH to a separate function.
Make the exception catching more specific, to catch just ValueError, since
broad exceptions are a pain to debug.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this does not check that the external data is in the expected
place. Use a non-zero offset for the external data and check it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is a debug message at present, which is not very helpful. Print out
the error so that action can be taken.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some newer toolchains do not create a symbol for the .ucode section that
this test relies on. Update the test to use the symbol that is explicitly
created, instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This behaviour is necessary with boards where the binman description
requires processing external blobs, since these may be missing.
Enable it by default, so that CI is happy. Warnings indicate that a valid
image is not produced, as with the --allow-missing option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When OF_LIVE flag is enabled on a 64 bits platform, there is an
issue when dev_read_addr() is called and need to perform an address
translation using __of_translate_address().
In case of error, __of_translate_address() return's value is OF_BAD_ADDR
(wich is defined in include/dm/of.h to ((u64)-1) = 0xffffffffffffffff).
The return value of dev_read_addr() is often compared to FDT_ADDR_T_NONE
which is defined as (-1U) = 0xffffffff.
In this case the comparison is always false.
To fix this issue, define FDT_ADDR_T_NONE to (ulong)(-1) in case of
AARCH64. Update accordingly related tests.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The build system already automatically looks for and includes an
in-tree *-u-boot.dtsi when building the control .dtb. However, there
are some things that are awkward to maintain in such an in-tree file,
most notably the metadata associated to public keys used for verified
boot.
The only "official" API to get that metadata into the .dtb is via
mkimage, as a side effect of building an actual signed image. But
there are multiple problems with that. First of all, the final U-Boot
(be it U-Boot proper or an SPL) image is built based on a binary
image, the .dtb, and possibly some other binary artifacts. So
modifying the .dtb after the build requires the meta-buildsystem
(Yocto, buildroot, whatnot) to know about and repeat some of the steps
that are already known to and handled by U-Boot's build system,
resulting in needless duplication of code. It's also somewhat annoying
and inconsistent to have a .dtb file in the build folder which is not
generated by the command listed in the corresponding .cmd file (that
of course applies to any generated file).
So the contents of the /signature node really needs to be baked into
the .dtb file when it is first created, which means providing the
relevant data in the form of a .dtsi file. One could in theory put
that data into the *-u-boot.dtsi file, but it's more convenient to be
able to provide it externally: For example, when developing for a
customer, it's common to use a set of dummy keys for development,
while the consultants do not (and should not) have access to the
actual keys used in production. For such a setup, it's easier if the
keys used are chosen via the meta-buildsystem and the path(s) patched
in during the configure step. And of course, nothing prevents anybody
from having DEVICE_TREE_INCLUDES point at files maintained in git, or
for that matter from including the public key metadata in the
*-u-boot.dtsi directly and ignore this feature.
There are other uses for this, e.g. in combination with ENV_IMPORT_FDT
it can be used for providing the contents of the /config/environment
node, so I don't want to tie this exclusively to use for verified
boot.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Fix doc formatting error (make htmldocs)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For whatever reason, usb_setup_ehci_gadget removes and probes USB device
0. However, not all systems have a device 0. Use the first device
instead.
The device probed should probably have something to do with the
controller (as specified by e.g. ums <controller> or fastboot
<controller>). In fact, I find it odd that we probe the USB device in
the first place, because this is just to set up the gadget itself.
Presumably, the controller should be probed by usb_gadget_initialize
somehow.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add some tables needed for ARM devices, including more MADT subtables,
a CSRT descriptor, GTDT and PPTT.
WIP: This needs comments added.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this list is used to collect items within the DSDT and SSDT
tables. It is useful for it to collect the whole tables as well, so there
is a list of what was created and which write created each one.
Refactor the code accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this over to use a writer file, moving the code from the x86
implementation.
There is no need to store a separate variable since we can simply access
the ACPI context.
With this, the original monolithic x86 function for writing ACPI tables
is gone.
Note that QEMU has its own implementation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this function to the newer style, so we can avoid passing and
returning an address through this function.
Also move this function out of the x86 code so it can be used by other
archs.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Each board has its own way of creating this table. Rather than calling the
acpi_create_fadt() function for each one from a common acpi_write_fadt()
function, just move the writer into the board-specific code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Move this table over to use a writer function, moving the code from the
x86 implementation.
Add a pointer to the DSDT in struct acpi_ctx so we can reference it later.
Disable this table for sandbox since we don't actually compile real ASL
code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this table over to use a writer function, moving the code from the
x86 implementation.
Add a pointer to the DSDT in struct acpi_ctx so we can reference it later.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new ACPI writer to write the base tables at the start of the area,
moving this code from the x86 implementation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new ACPI writer to write the ACPI tables. At present this is all
done in one monolithic function. Future work will split this out.
Unfortunately the QFW write_acpi_tables() function conflicts with the
'writer' version, so disable that for sandbox.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present acpi_setup_base_tables() both sets up the ACPI context and
writes out the base tables.
We want to use an ACPI writer to write the base tables, so split this
function into two, with acpi_setup_ctx() doing the context set, and
acpi_setup_base_tables() just doing the base tables.
Disable the writer's write_acpi_tables() function for now, to avoid
build errors. It is enabled in a following patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we call lots of functions to generate the required ACPI tables.
It would be better to standardise these functions and allow them to be
automatically collected and used when needed.
Add a linker list to handle this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to record the start of an ACPI table so that offsets from
that point can be easily calculated.
Add this to the context and set it before calling the writer method.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some .asl files include others using the iasl 'include' directive. This
needs to be able to find the files referenced.
For an out-of-tree build the source directory is not the current
directory. Moreover, U-Boot preprocesses the input file and puts the
result in the output directory. So iasl does not know where the real
source file came from.
Add a -I option to produce the correct behaviour. We could add an option
to not preprocess the .asl source, but for now that seems unnecessary.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than keying everything off ACPIGEN, use the main
GENERATE_ACPI_TABLE option to determine whether the core ACPI code
is included. Make sure these option are not enabled in SPL/TPL since we
never generate tables there.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current EFI implementation confuses pointers and addresses. Normally
we can get away with this but in the case of sandbox it causes failures.
Despite the fact that efi_allocate_pages() returns a u64, it is actually
a pointer, not an address. Add special handling to avoid a crash when
running 'bootefi hello'.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this option is missing a header file, a function prototype and
the qfw driver needs a header included.
Fix these problems so we can enable this option on sandbox. This will
increase the build coverage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is enabled for quite a few boards which don't create ACPI tables.
Tidy this up by dropping the option for some boards.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some ARM boards are using ACPI now. It seems that U-Boot should support
this method. Add ARM to the list of archs which can generate ACPI tables.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Allow this to be used on any arch. Also convert to using macros so that
we can check the CONFIG option in C code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These have sadly found their way to ARM now. Allow any arch to support
generating ACPI tables.
Disable this for the tools build.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- A number of cleanups to Python code based on running pylint
- Integrate changes so that we can run "make pylint" and compare the
results to a current baseline. Keep this as a manual check for now.
- Improve functionality of moveconfig.py
- pci: iproc: Set all 24 bits of PCI class code
There are over 200 errors in this file. Fix some of them, starting at the
beginning of the file. Future work can continue this effort.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there is quite a bit of ad-hoc code reading from files. The
most common case is to read the file as lines. Put it in a function and
set the unicode encoding correctly.
Avoid writing back to a file when there are obviously no changes as this
speeds things up slightly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there is quite a bit of ad-hoc code writing to files. The
treatment of newlines is different in some of them. Put it in a function
and set the unicode encoding correctly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Python 2 is not supported anymore and Python 3 has had subprocess.DEVNULL
since version 3.3 which was released in 2012. Drop the unnecessary check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This is a newer library and is now preferred for Python scripts. Update
the code to use it instead of optparse
Use 'args' instead of 'options' throughout, since this is the term used
in that module. Also it helps to avoid confusion with CONFIG options, a
term that is used in this file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Quite a few places use double quotes. Fix this to be consistent with
other Python code in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
It is useful to be able to find out which boards define a particular
option, or combination of options. This is not as easy as grepping the
defconfig files since many options are implied by others.
Add a -f option to the moveconfig tool to permit this. Update the
documentation to cover this, including a better title for the doc page.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This doesn't work anymore, since the Kconfig update. The script has no
tests so we did not notice. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
* assert does not need parentheses
* add module docstring
* fix misspelled constant True
* limit lines to 100 characters
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present the Python code in U-Boot is somewhat inconsistent, with some
files passing pylint quite cleanly and others not.
Add a way to track progress on this clean-up, by checking that no module
has got any worse as a result of changes.
This can be used with 'make pylint'.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Re-generate pylint.base]
Add some empty __init__ files for binman, buildman and dtoc so that
pylint is able to recognise these as Python modules and produce more
useful pylint output.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Register 0x43c in its low 24 bits contains PCI class code.
Update code to set all 24 bits of PCI class code and not only upper 16 bits
of PCI class code.
Use standard U-Boot macro (PCI_CLASS_BRIDGE_PCI << 8) for constructing all
24-bits of PCI class for PCI bridge Normal decode.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Roman Bacik <roman.bacik@broadcom.com>
- Assorted dumpimage/mkimage fixes, allow setting the signature
algorithm on the command line with mkimage
- Bugfix to the misc uclass, CONFIG_MP / CMD_MP Kconfig logic improved,
updated Xen platform MAINTAINERS entry and fixed vexpress_aemv8a_semi
booting.
Add Kconfig option(CONFIG_CMD_MP) to enable or disable multiprocessor
commands. Compile cmd/mp.c based on CONFIG_CMD_MP.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The component st_size of struct stat is of type off_t. Depending on the
system printing it using %ld leads to a warning:
tools/mkimage.c:438:54: warning: format '%ld' expects argument of type
'long int', but argument 5 has type
'off_t' {aka 'long long int'} [-Wformat=]
438 | "%s: Bad size: \"%s\" is not valid image: size %ld < %u\n",
| ~~^
| |
| long int
| %lld
When comparing an off_t value to a 32bit integer we should not convert to
uint32_t but to off_t which may be wider.
Reported-by: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
Fixes: 331f0800f1 ("mkimage: allow -l to work on block devices on Linux")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
This permits to prepare FIT image description that do not hard-code the
final choice of the signature algorithm, possibly requiring the user to
patch the sources.
When -o <algo> is specified, this information is used in favor of the
'algo' property in the signature node. Furthermore, that property is set
accordingly when writing the image.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
The actual opt string is inlined - and different. Seems this was a
left-over from older versions of 603e26f763.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The write operation in misc_ops already takes a "const void *" buffer,
but misc_write() takes a mutable "void *". There's no reason for this,
so make misc_write() consistent with the standard write() prototype.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
fit_verify_header fails if it detects unit addresses "@". However, this
will break tools like dumpimage on fit images which worked with previous
versions of the tool (e.g. 2020.04 vs 2021.07). As an example the output
of:
dumpimage -l <fit image>
is:
FIT description: U-Boot fitImage for Linux Distribution
Created: Thu Jan 1 01:00:00 1970
Image 0 (kernel@1)
Description: Linux kernel
Created: Thu Jan 1 01:00:00 1970
Type: Kernel Image
Compression: gzip compressed
Data Size: 6442456 Bytes = 6291.46 KiB = 6.14 MiB
Architecture: AArch64
OS: Linux
Load Address: 0x80080000
Entry Point: 0x80080000
Hash algo: sha256
Hash value: ...
Image 1 (fdt@freescale_fsl-s32g274a-evb.dtb)
Description: Flattened Device Tree blob
Created: Thu Jan 1 01:00:00 1970
Type: Flat Device Tree
Compression: uncompressed
Data Size: 39661 Bytes = 38.73 KiB = 0.04 MiB
Architecture: AArch64
Hash algo: sha256
Hash value: ...
Default Configuration: 'conf@freescale_fsl-s32g274a-evb.dtb'
Configuration 0 (conf@freescale_fsl-s32g274a-evb.dtb)
Description: 1 Linux kernel, FDT blob
Kernel: kernel@1
FDT: fdt@freescale_fsl-s32g274a-evb.dtb
Hash algo: sha256
Hash value: unavailable
But with newer version it shows:
dumpimage -l <fit image>
GP Header: Size d00dfeed LoadAddr 62f0a4
This commit will output a warning that unit addresses were detected but
will not fail:
dumpimage -l <fit image>
Image contains unit addresses @, this will break signing
...
Signed-off-by: Stefan Eichenberger <eichest@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
fit_extract_contents does a fit_check_format even thought it was already
checked during imagetool_verify_print_header.
Therefore, this check is not necessary. This commit removes the
redundancy.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Eichenberger <eichest@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 270f8710f9 ("crc32: Add crc32 implementation using
__builtin_aarch64_crc32b") enabled the usage of ARMv8 CRC instructions
by default, for all arm64 builds. And indeed all Arm Ltd. v8 Cortex-A
cores support the instructions, and they are mandatory starting with
architecture revision v8.1, so realistically every known hardware
implementation should support them.
The Arm Fastmodel however defaults to the bare minimum ARMv8 feature set
by default, which means v8.0 without the CRC instructions, so U-Boot
hangs very early at the moment, without any output (the boot-wrapper or
TF-A printing the last visible lines).
Support for those instructions can be enabled on the model command line
by either:
-C cluster0.cpu0.enable_crc32=1 (for each core)
or by using a higher architecture revision by default:
-C cluster0.has_arm_v8-1=1 (for each cluster)
Of course any arch revision higher than v8.1 would work as well.
But for the sake of a smooth out-of-the-box experience, let's just
disable the usage of those instructions in the defconfig, to avoid
random hangs without any clues.
Reported-by: Ross Burton <ross.burton@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Since commit 9855034397 ("fdt: Don't call board_fdt_blob_setup()
without OF_BOARD") board_fdt_blob_setup() is no more called on
STM32MP platforms in trusted boot which hangs during boot process.
Enable OF_BOARD flag to fix this issue.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add the partition name and remove the line number in error messages
of treat_partition_list() to provide correct information to user of
STM32CubeProgrammer.
The "line number" value was confusing because it is incorrect here;
the index in part_array[] is not aligned with the line number in
the parsed Layout file, because the empty lines and the lines beginning
by '#' are skipped during the first parsing in parse_flash_layout().
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Solve compilation issue on undefined CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV when
CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC is deactivated on STMicroelectronics boards
defconfig
Fixes: 9f97193616 ("board: stm32mp1: use CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV when available")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Synchronize DH DHCOM DTs with Linux commit 25960cafa06e ("Linux 5.15.12").
There is no functional change to the resulting DTs. The eeprom0 alias and
PHY reset GPIO are now reinstated in SoM u-boot dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Synchronize DH DHCOR DTs with Linux commit 25960cafa06e ("Linux 5.15.12").
There is no functional change to the resulting DTs. The eeprom0 alias is
now reinstated in SoM u-boot dtsi, the PHY reset GPIO is reinstated in AV96
u-boot dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Device tree alignment with Linux kernel v5.16-rc5
- ARM: dts: stm32: set otg-rev on stm32mp151
- ARM: dts: stm32: use usbphyc ck_usbo_48m as USBH OHCI clock on stm32mp151
- ARM: dts: stm32: fix AV96 board SAI2 pin muxing on stm32mp15
- ARM: dts: stm32: fix SAI sub nodes register range
- ARM: dts: stm32: fix STUSB1600 Type-C irq level on stm32mp15xx-dkx
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Default value for CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_SINGLEWORD and
CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR are only needed when
CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_GENERIC is used.
This patch avoids to define these configs when an other bootcount backend
is activated, for example for CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Today the bootcount is not managed by the Linux kernel for STM32MP15 as
we don't have driver to update the used backup register in TAMP and the
recovery command still executes the normal bootcmd with
'altbootcmd=run bootcmd'.
So the bootcount feature is never used, the config CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
and the associated environment variable 'altbootcmd' can be removed to
reduce the U-Boot size.
Each boards can re-enable this feature later in their defconfig, if it is
needed, with the expected backend, for example CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_GENERIC
or CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV.
CC: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This patch configures U-Boot SPL for DHCOR SoM to permit DFU upload of
SPL and subsequent u-boot.itb for recovery or commissioning purposes.
To start U-Boot on DHCOR based board, e.g. Avenger96, proceed as follows:
- Install dfu-util on the host PC (in debian this is package 'dfu-util')
- Power off the Avenger96 board.
- Connect both USB-serial console and USB-OTG microB ports to host PC.
- Switch Avenger96 to USB boot mode -- BOOT0..2 switches all set to 0.
- Power on the Avenger96 board.
- Verify using '$ dmesg' that a new device has been detected as follows:
New USB device found, idVendor=0483, idProduct=df11, bcdDevice= 2.00
New USB device strings: Mfr=1, Product=2, SerialNumber=3
Product: DFU in HS Mode @Device ID /0x500, @Revision ID /0x0000
Manufacturer: STMicroelectronics
- Upload U-Boot SPL:
$ dfu-util -a 1 -D u-boot-spl.stm32
- Upload U-Boot proper:
$ dfu-util -a 0 -D u-boot.itb
- At this point, SPL will wait for user to press "Ctrl-C" on serial
console. When ready to interact with U-Boot, press Ctrl-C to start
the bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
In case the SoC reports the boot device type is USB, it means the SPL was
loaded via BootROM DFU mode. Currently the spl_boot_device() returns boot
device as USB host, change it to DFU instead, so the SPL can continue the
DFU boot and load U-Boot via DFU.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
When booting from QSPI, the boot ROM appears to mux the QSPI
pins, but it's not guaranteed to be setup when booting from
eMMC. Fix this by explicitly configuring the pinmux.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc1-2
Documentation:
* describe printf() format codes
UEFI
* enable more algorithms for UEFI image verification, e.g. SHA256-RSA2048
General
* simplify printing short texts for GUIDs
* provide a unit test for printing GUIDs
Use moveconfig.py script to convert define CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS
and CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT to Kconfig and move these entries
to defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
[trini: Re-switch to IS_ENABLED check in spi-nor-core.c, re-run migration]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Prepare migration to Kconfig.
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT becomes boolean and
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS define the MAX size, also used
for detection when CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT=y
(CFI_MAX_FLASH_BANKS = CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS).
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS become mandatory when
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT is activated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Replace CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS by CFI_FLASH_BANKS to prepare
Kconfig migration and avoid to redefine CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS
in cfi_flash.h.
After this patch CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS should be never used in
the cfi code: use CFI_MAX_FLASH_BANKS for struct size or CFI_FLASH_BANKS
for number of CFI banks which can be dynamic.
This patch modify all the files which include mtd/cfi_flash.h.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tidy up the warnings reported by checkpatch.pl to prepare next patches
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Falcon mode is very useful in improving boot speed. A question that
Falcon mode asks is "Where do I look for the kernel". With MMC boot
media, the correct answer is CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR.
The scope of this patch is to move this to Kconfig.
It is possible for a system to support Falcon mode from NOR but not
MMC. In that case, mmc_load_image_raw_os() would not be used. To
address this, conditionally compile mmc_load_image_raw_os() when
SPL_FALCON_BOOT_MMCSD, instead of SPL_OS_BOOT.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Move spl_start_uboot to its own guard in spl_mmc.c, rerun migration]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Use IS_ENABLED() instead, to reduce the number of build paths.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
- fdt_support: Add fdt_for_each_node_by_compatible() helper macro
(Marek)
- turris_omnia: Fixup SATA or PCIe nodes at runtime in DT blob (Pali)
- pci_mvebu: Add support for Kirkwood PCIe controllers (Pali)
- SPL: More verifications for kwbimage in SPL (Pali)
- mvebu: Remove comphy_update_map() (Pali)
- Minor misc stuff
- Disable CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR for android configs
- meson64_android: define raw parts for bootloader to permit flashing with fastboot
- vim3: configure serial# from ethaddr to permit using fastboot like sei510/610
After next branch was merged to v2022.01 release, U-Boot on A3720 started
printing "<debug_uart>" line on UART during booting. There is no need to
print this debug line by default, so disable it via config option
CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_ANNOUNCE in all config files for Armada 3720 boards.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This weak function is not used anymore, so completely remove it.
Private struct comphy_map is not used by any board code anymore, so move it
into private driver header file comphy_core.h.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Code in board_fix_fdt() already detects connected MOX modules so there is
no need to have custom comphy_update_map() function for setting serdes
speeds.
This change sets phy-mode for MOX SFP module (when present) to sgmii.
Comphy driver then sets sgmii serdes speed for this module to 1.25G.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Placing Unicode control codes <U+0080><U+0093> in the middle of a comment
does not make much sense. Let's get rid of all Unicode in
drivers/ram/octeon/octeon3_lmc.c.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use the preferred
if (IS_ENABLED(X))
instead of
#ifdef X
where possible.
There are still places where this is not possible or is more complicated
to convert in this file. Leave those be for now.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Checkpatch warns about using uint32/16/8_t instead of u32/16/8.
Use the preferred types.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Print the wrong srcaddr (spl_image->offset) in error message also for
SATA case.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Last 4 bytes of kwbimage boot image is checksum. Verify it via the new
spl_check_board_image() function which is called by U-Boot SPL after
loading kwbimage.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit 9baab60b80 ("SPL: Add support for parsing board / BootROM specific
image types") added support for loading board specific image types.
This commit adds support for a new weak function spl_parse_board_header()
which is called after loading boot image. Board may implement this function
for checking if loaded board specific image is valid.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Each boot mode has its own kwbimage specified by blockid. So check that
kwbimage is valid by blockid.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add parameter spl_boot_device to spl_parse_board_header(), which allows
the implementations to see from which device we are booting and do
boot-device-specific checks of the image header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are certain restrictions for kwbimage offset and blocksize.
Validate them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Kirkwood uses macros KW_DEFADR_PCI_MEM and KW_DEFADR_PCI_IO for base
address of PCIe mappings. Size of PCIe windows is not defined in any macro
yet, so export them in new KW_DEFADR_PCI_MEM_SIZE and KW_DEFADR_PCI_IO_SIZE
macros.
Kirkwood arch code already maps mbus windows for io and mem, so avoid
calling mvebu_mbus_add_window_by_id() function which would try to do
duplicate window mapping.
Kirkwood PCIe controllers already use "marvell,kirkwood-pcie" DT compatible
string, so mark pci_mvebu.c driver as compatible for it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
On of the MiniPCIe ports on Turris Omnia is also a mSATA port. Whether
it works in SATA or PCIe mode is determined by a strapping pin, which
value is read from the MCU.
We already determine which type of card is connected when configuring
SerDeses.
But until now we left both SATA and PCIe port 0 nodes in device tree
enabled, and so the SATA driver is probed in U-Boot / Linux even if we
know there is no mSATA card, and similarly PCIe driver tries to link on
port 0 even if we know there is mSATA card, not a PCIe card.
Fixup device tree blob to disable SATA node if mSATA card is not
present, and to disable PCIe port 0 node if mSATA card is present.
Do this for U-Boot's DT blob before relocation and also for kernel DT
blob before booting.
This ensures that software does not try to use SATA or PCIe HW when
corresponding PHY is not configured.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored and fixed some issues ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add macro fdt_for_each_node_by_compatible() to allow iterating over
fdt nodes by compatible string.
Convert various usages of
off = fdt_node_offset_by_compatible(fdt, start, compat);
while (off > 0) {
code();
off = fdt_node_offset_by_compatible(fdt, off, compat);
}
and similar, to
fdt_for_each_node_by_compatible(off, fdt, start, compat)
code();
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Khadas vim3 and vim3l defconfigs introduced with:
* f89b90d2d9 ("configs: add khadas-vim3{l}_android for AOSP support")
* 425f06f86e ("configs: prepare khadas-vim3{l}_ab_android for AOSP support")
were based on an outdated defconfig prior to the ede1f4f297 ("configs:
amlogic: Disable CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR when unnecessary") cleanup.
Disable CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR for the android configs as well to
stay consistent.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20220112084023.2858375-1-mkorpershoek@baylibre.com
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Xilinx changes for v2022.04-rc1
gpio:
- Add modepin driver
net:
- Save random mac addresses to eth variable
zynqmp gem:
- Add support for mdio bus DT description
- Add support for reset and SGMII phy configuration
- Reduce timeout for MDIO accesses
zynqmp clk:
- Fix clock handling for gem and usb
phy:
- Add zynqmp phy/serdes driver
serial:
- Add one missing compatible string
microblaze:
- Symbol alignement
- SPL fixups
- Code cleanups
zynqmp:
- Various dt changes, DP pre-reloc, gem resets, gem clocks
- Switch SOM to shared psu configuration
- Move dcache handling to firmware driver
- Workaround gmii2rgmii DT description issue
- Enable broadcasts again
- Change firmware enablement logic
- Small adjustement in firmware driver
versal:
- Support new mmc@ DT nodes
- Fix run time variable handling
- Add missing I2C_PMC ID for power domain
Right now the code explicitly limits us to sha1,256 hashes with RSA2048
encryption. But the limitation is artificial since U-Boot supports
a wider range of algorithms.
The internal image_get_[checksum|crypto]_algo() functions expect an
argument in the format of <checksum>,<crypto>. So let's remove the size
checking and create the needed string on the fly in order to support
more hash/signing combinations.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The ESRT test may try to print a GUID if an error occurs.
Implement the %pU print code.
Correct the ESRT test to use %pU instead of %pUl to avoid the output
of character 'l'.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
For printing GUIDs with macro EFI_ENTRY use %pUs instead of %pUl to provide
readable debug output.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Add a unit test for the %pUs printf code.
Use ut_asserteq_str() for checking string results.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
CONFIG_PARTITION_TYPE_GUID=y is needed for testing some GPT related
functionality.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Use printf code %pUs to print the text representation of the partition type
GUID.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
In different places text representations are used for GUIDs, e.g.
* command efidebug
* command part list for GPT partitions
To allow reducing code duplication introduce a new printf code %pUs.
It will call uuid_guid_get_str() to get a text representation. If none is
found it will fallback to %pUl and print a hexadecimal representation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Currently uuid_guid_get_str() is only built if
CONFIG_PARTITION_TYPE_GUID=y.
To make it usable for other GUIDs compile it if CONFIG_LIB_UUID=y.
The linker will take care of removing it if it is unused.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Power domain driver sends PM fragment to PMUFW. It is sent for every node
which is listed in DT. But some nodes could be already enabled but driver
is not capable to find it out. That's why it blinly sents request for every
listed IP. When PMUFW response by XST_PM_ALREADY_CONFIGURED error code
there is no need to show any error message because node is already enabled.
That's why cover this case with message when DEBUG is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/8c15ef0b68cf191f693d3d010f70ac24cfd8171f.1642163135.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
Function prototypes must not be guarded with ifdef tests. Doing so
prevents us from doing:
if (CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(FOO))
func();
as that results in a warning when CONFIG_FOO is not enabled.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The clock delay of the RMII/RGMII interface is controlled by SCU340~35C.
These values are obtained by measurement and experiments so we simply
use macro to define them.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
There are 4 MDIO bus controllers in AST2600 SOC. Each of them can
connect to one or more PHY chips and is flexible to work with the 4 MAC
devices in AST2600. On AST2600 EVB, MDIO 0,1,2,3 connect to the PHY
chips used by MAC 0,1,2,3 respectively.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add support of the MAC controller of Aspeed AST2600 SOC. The MAC
controller is the same with AST2500, except it has stand-alone MDIO
hardware block.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add support for DM_MDIO to connect to PHY. For the systems that have a
stand-alone MDIO hardware block, enable CONFIG_DM_MDIO to use driver
model for MDIO devices.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This patch adds node for mmc/sd controller found on Action Semi OWL
S700 SoC.
Since, upstream Linux binding has not been merged for S700 MMC/SD
controller, Changes are put in u-boot specific dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com>
This Synchronizes the Actions Semi S700 SoC DT changes from
commit "g58e1100fdc59" ("Linux v5.16-rc3").
Signed-off-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com>
This commit adds SD/MMC clocks, and provides .set/get_rate callbacks
for SD/MMC device present on Actions OWL S700 SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com>
This commit introduces get/set_rate callbacks, these are dummy at
the moment, and can be used to get/set clock for various devices
based on the clk id.
Signed-off-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Changes to the am33xx device (33e9021a) trees have been merged in from
the upstream linux kernel which now means the device tree uses the new
pins format (as of 5.10) where the confinguration can be stores as a
separate configuration value and pin mux mode which are then OR'd
together.
This patch adds support for the new format to u-boot so that
pinctrl-cells is now respected when reading in pinctrl-single,pins
Signed-off-by: Anthony Bagwell <anthony.bagwell@hivehome.com>
[BUG]
When passing a btrfs with NO_HOLE feature to U-boot, and if one file
contains holes, then the hash of the file is not correct in U-boot:
# mkfs.btrfs -f test.img # Since v5.15, mkfs defaults to NO_HOLES
# mount test.img /mnt/btrfs
# xfs_io -f -c "pwrite 0 4k" -c "pwrite 8k 4k" /mnt/btrfs/file
# md5sum /mnt/btrfs/file
277f3840b275c74d01e979ea9d75ac19 /mnt/btrfs/file
# umount /mnt/btrfs
# ./u-boot
=> host bind 0 /home/adam/test.img
=> ls host 0
< > 12288 Mon Dec 27 05:35:23 2021 file
=> load host 0 0x1000000 file
12288 bytes read in 0 ms
=> md5sum 0x1000000 0x3000
md5 for 01000000 ... 01002fff ==> 855ffdbe4d0ccc5acab92e1b5330e4c1
The md5sum doesn't match at all.
[CAUSE]
In U-boot btrfs implementation, the function btrfs_read_file() has the
following iteration for file extent iteration:
/* Read the aligned part */
while (cur < aligned_end) {
ret = lookup_data_extent(root, &path, ino, cur, &next_offset);
if (ret < 0)
goto out;
if (ret > 0) {
/* No next, direct exit */
if (!next_offset) {
ret = 0;
goto out;
}
}
/* Read file extent */
But for NO_HOLES features, hole extents will not have any extent item
for it.
Thus if @cur is at a hole, lookup_data_extent() will just return >0, and
update @next_offset.
But we still believe there is some data to read for @cur for ret > 0
case, causing we read extent data from the next file extent.
This means, what we do for above NO_HOLES btrfs is:
- Read 4K data from disk to file offset [0, 4K)
So far the data is still correct
- Read 4K data from disk to file offset [4K, 8K)
We didn't skip the 4K hole, but read the data at file offset [8K, 12K)
into file offset [4K, 8K).
This causes the checksum mismatch.
[FIX]
Add extra check to skip to the next non-hole range after
lookup_data_extent().
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
The code is cross-ported from BLAKE2 reference implementation
(https://github.com/BLAKE2/BLAKE2).
With minimal change to remove unused macros/features.
Currently there is only one user inside U-boot (btrfs), and since it
only utilize BLAKE2B, all other favors are all removed.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
[trini: Rename ROUND to R to avoid clash with <linux/bitops.h>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Drop the remaining ifdefs around header includes, to fix an old TODO.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Not all architectures define <asm/gpio.h> and even on those that do, the
header cannot be included for all boards without causing various build
failures.
Since common/board_r.c only needs gpio_hog_probe_all() declaration, include
<asm-generic/gpio.h> and drop the associated ifdef.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
asm/mmu.h include is currently guarded by CONFIG_ADDR_MAP ifdef because
the header is only present on arm and powerpc. In order to remove the
dependency on this header and the associated ifdef, move init_addr_map()
declaration to init.h, since it is only called during the common init
sequence.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Add a return value to init_addr_map and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Reviewed-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Add a return value to kgdb_init and use it directly in the post-relocation
init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub. Also, move the "KGDB"
print message inside kgdb_init().
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Commit 98f705c9ce ("powerpc: remove 4xx support") removed (in 2017) the
last code that made use of bedbug debugger support. Since there aren't
any boards left that define either CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG or a real
bedbug_init(), drop this feature from u-boot.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Factor out armv7m fragment to spl_perform_fixups(), which is an arch/board
specific function designed for this purpose.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Fix fastboot flash bug.
If the downloading file size is equal to the partition size, "fastboot
flash" can't work, at least in sunxi platform, because used an
uninitalized point: ep->desc.
This patch also fixed 'data abort' bug in am335x platform.
Reproduce: fastboot flash loader1 spl/sunxi-spl.bin.
Signed-off-by: qianfan Zhao <qianfanguijin@163.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Currently the pxa3xx driver does not set the udevice in the mtd_info
struct and this prevents the mtd from parsing the partitions via DTS
like for SPI-NOR.
So simply set the mtd->dev to the driver udevice.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Let am335x_evm use the CPSW or PRUSS ethernet.
- Implement timer_get_boot_us in the omap timer driver
- gpmc bitflip, QSPI clock calculation on am437x, da8xx_gpio bugfixes
- Assorted K3 updates
Second set of u-boot-at91 features for the 2022.04 cycle:
This small feature set includes few changes for sama7g5 and sama7g5ek:
turn blue led on at boot, changes required for the Rev4 of the board,
better sync with the Linux DT with regards to the new DT nodes.
CONFIG_PHANDLE_CHECK_SEQ will allow different sequence number for nodes
that have the same name, but they are different.
In sama7g5ek case, there are multiple 'i2c@600' nodes which are child
nodes of different parent 'flexcom' nodes.
These are different i2c busses even if the node is the same, and have to be
differentiated.
Without this config, the sequence number 0 is reused for two i2c busses, and
this is something that we have to avoid:
Looking for 'i2c' at 4704, name i2c@600
- serial0, /ahb/apb/serial@e1824200
- i2c0, /ahb/apb/flexcom@e181c000/i2c@600
Found seq 0
i2c_post_bind: i2c@600, seq=0
Looking for 'i2c' at 6236, name i2c@600
- serial0, /ahb/apb/serial@e1824200
- i2c0, /ahb/apb/flexcom@e181c000/i2c@600
Found seq 0
i2c_post_bind: i2c@600, seq=0
After this patch:
Looking for 'i2c' at 4704, name i2c@600
- serial0, /ahb/apb/serial@e1824200
- i2c0, /ahb/apb/flexcom@e181c000/i2c@600
- i2c1, /ahb/apb/flexcom@e2818000/i2c@600
Found seq 1
Before the patch:
=> i2c bus
Bus 0: i2c@600
Bus 0: i2c@600 (active 0)
52: eeprom@52, offset len 1, flags 0
53: eeprom@53, offset len 1, flags 0
=>
After the patch:
=> i2c bus
Bus 0: i2c@600
Bus 1: i2c@600 (active 1)
52: eeprom@52, offset len 1, flags 0
53: eeprom@53, offset len 1, flags 0
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The rev4 of the board sama7g5ek has the eeproms on flexcom8 instead of
flexcom1.
Initialize flexcom8 with required pincontrol and move the eeproms accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add Flexcom8 node with required referenced nodes as phandles.
Since Flexcom8 is present in Linux, take the node exactly as-is from Linux.
Some nodes are referenced in Linux as phandles, the dma and the gic.
Add them as well to the file, even if they are unused by Uboot.
This is a step towards having the U-boot DT equivalent with the DT in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
For configurations with gmii2rgmii and external phy the DT nodes link
should be gem->gmii2rgmii->phy. But due to limitation in Linux driver
the DT is mentioned as gem->phy and gmii2rgmii->phy as shown in below DT.
ethernet@ff0c0000 {
compatible = "cdns,zynqmp-gem\0cdns,gem";
status = "okay";
interrupt-parent = <0x04>;
interrupts = <0x00 0x3b 0x04 0x00 0x3b 0x04>;
reg = <0x00 0xff0c0000 0x00 0x1000>;
clock-names = "pclk\0hclk\0tx_clk\0rx_clk\0tsu_clk";
#address-cells = <0x01>;
#size-cells = <0x00>;
#stream-id-cells = <0x01>;
iommus = <0x0d 0x875>;
power-domains = <0x0c 0x1e>;
clocks = <0x03 0x1f 0x03 0x69 0x03 0x2e 0x03 0x32 0x03 0x2c>;
phy-handle = <0x0e>;
phy-mode = "gmii";
xlnx,ptp-enet-clock = <0x00>;
local-mac-address = [ff ff ff ff ff ff];
phandle = <0x4d>;
mdio {
#address-cells = <0x01>;
#size-cells = <0x00>;
phandle = <0x4e>;
ethernet-phy@1 {
reg = <0x01>;
rxc-skew-ps = <0x708>;
txc-skew-ps = <0x708>;
phandle = <0x0e>;
};
gmii_to_rgmii_0@8 {
compatible = "xlnx,gmii-to-rgmii-1.0";
phy-handle = <0x0e>;
reg = <0x08>;
phandle = <0x4f>;
};
};
};
Since same DT is used in Linux and U-Boot we need to workaround this
issue by using the gmii2rgmii node which points to phy and we should
ignore the gem pointing to phy directly.
Do this workaround by updating priv->phydev->node value with
priv->phy_of_node only if it is not valid node.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/641eb13425ffe80e0743f60cf90d0f940577b9e9.1642162085.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
This driver supports power domains for the power management
controller found on Apple SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These are necessary to make sure the power domains needed for the
serial console are availble in the pre-relocation phase.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This synchronizes the device trees with those that are in the
process of being upstreamed into Linux. This is mostly the
current state of the device trees on the asahilinux branch
with a few extra bits used by OpenBSD. This includes device
trees for machines that were still missing.
There are still some differences that will hopefully be resolved
soon.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The am335x-ice-v2 board's Ethernet ports can be configured
in 'MII' or 'RMII' mode to be connected to 'PRUSS' or 'CPSW'
Ethernet subsystems.
This patch sets the environment variable 'ice_mii' to
'mii' or 'rmii' accordingly. Based on that we choose the
appropriate board devicetree i.e. 'am335x-ice-v2.dtb' or
'am335x-ice-v2-prueth.dtb'.
Since there are 2 Ethernet ports with 2 modes, there can be 4
configurations but for now we consider both ports in different modes
to be an invalid configuration and prevent boot in that case.
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@ti.com>
[Amjad: use overlay instead of using new am335x-ice-v2-prueth.dtb]
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
[trini: Make prueth_is_mii be marked __maybe_unused]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In the case of an erased (sub)page both the data and ECC are all 0xFF
bytes. This fails the normal ECC verification, as the computed ECC of
all-0xFF is not also 0xFF. The GPMC NAND driver attempted to detect
erased pages by checking that the ECC bytes are all-0xFF, but this had
two problems:
1) bitflips in the data were not corrected, so the data looked not-erased
2) bitflips in the ECC bytes were reported as uncorrectable ECC errors
The equivalent Linux driver [1] correctly handles this by counting the
number of 0-bits in the combination of data and ECC bytes. If the number
of 0-bits is less than the amount of bits correctable by the selected
ECC algorithm, then it is treated as an erased page with correctable
bitflips.
Implement similar, though simplified, logic in omap_correct_data_bch().
[1] see omap_elm_correct_data() in omap2.c
Signed-off-by: David Rivshin <drivshin@allworx.com>
On AM4372 the SPI_GCLK input gets its clock from the PRCM module which
divides the PER_CLKOUTM2 frequency (192MHz) by a fixed factor of 4.
See AM437x Reference Manual in section 27 QSPI >> 27.2 Integration.
The QSPI_FCLK therefore needs to take this factor into account and
becomes (192000000 / 4).
Signed-off-by: Stefan Mätje <stefan.maetje@esd.eu>
To make the OMAP DM timer driver useful for the timing of
bootstages, we need to implement timer_get_boot_us(..).
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
The GPIO bank numbers do not appear in the device tree,
so make the gpio name based on the address
(ie gpio@42110000_25 vs 25)
Signed-off-by: chao zeng <chao.zeng@siemens.com>
The fastboot protocol uses per default the UDP port 5554. In some cases
it might be needed to change the used port. The fastboot utility provides
a way to specifiy an other port number to use already.
fastboot -s udp:192.168.1.76:1234 boot fastboot.img
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
NXP's mEMAC reference manual, Chapter 6.5.5 "MDIO Ethernet Management
Interface usage", specifies to poll the BSY (0) bit in the CFG/STAT
register to wait until a transaction has finished, not bit 31 in the
data register.
In the Linux kernel, this has already been fixed in commit 26eee0210ad7
("net/fsl: fix a bug in xgmac_mdio").
This patch changes the register in the fman_mdio and fsl_ls_mdio
drivers.
As the MDIO_DATA_BSY define is no longer in use, this patch also removes
its definition from the fsl_memac header.
Signed-off-by: Markus Koch <markus@notsyncing.net>
Reviewed-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reduce the missing phy-handle log message to debug message. It is
possible for ethernet DT node to have no phy-handle e.g. in case
of a fixed-link connection. Furthermore, drop the FEC: prefix,
which is a copy-paste error and rather print the ethernet device
name.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This driver is based on an older downstream TI kernel, with
changes and cleanups to work with mainline device-tree bindings.
Signed-off-by: Dominic Rath <rath@ibv-augsburg.net>
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The sja1105_check_device_id() function contains logic to work without
changing the device tree on reworked boards, one of which I have (the
NXP LS1021A-TSN normally has a SJA1105T, but I have a version with a
resoldered SJA1105Q which is pin compatible). This logic is taken from
the Linux driver.
However this logic gets shortcircuited in U-Boot by an earlier check for
the exact device ID specified in the device tree. So the reworked board
does not probe the SJA1105Q switch. Remove this duplicated logic and let
the automatic device ID detection do its job.
Fixes: f24b666b22 ("net: dsa: add driver for NXP SJA1105 L2 switch")
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If the DSA API is going to allow drivers to do things such as:
- phy_config in dsa_ops :: port_probe
- phy_startup in dsa_ops :: port_enable
then it would actually be good if the ->port_probe() method would
actually be called in all cases before the ->port_enable() is.
Currently this is true for user ports, but not true for the CPU port,
because the CPU port does not have a udevice registered for it (this is
all part of DSA's design). So the current issue is that after
phy_startup has finished for the CPU port, its phydev->speed is an
uninitialized value, because phy_config() was never called for the
priv->cpu_port_fixed_phy, and it is precisely phy_config() who copies
the speed into the phydev in the case of the fixed PHY driver.
So we need to simulate a probing event for the CPU port by manually
calling the driver's ->port_probe() method for the CPU port.
Fixes: 8a2982574854 ("net: dsa: introduce a .port_probe() method in struct dsa_ops")
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This will allow consumers to choose a pxe label at runtime instead of
having to prompt the user. One good use-case for this, is choosing
whether or not to apply a dtbo depending on the hardware configuration.
e.g: for TI's AM335x EVM, it would be convenient to apply a particular
dtbo only when the J9 jumper is on PRUSS mode. To achieve this, the
pxe menu should have 2 labels, one with the dtbo and the other without,
then the "pxe_label_override" env variable should point to the label with
the dtbo at runtime only when the jumper is on PRUSS mode.
This change can be used for different use-cases and bring more
flexibilty to consumers who use sysboot/pxe_utils.
if "pxe_label_override" is set but does not exist in the pxe menu,
the code should fallback to the default label if given, and no failure
is returned but rather a warning message.
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Call dram_init_banksize() from spl_board_init() otherwise TFTP download
fails due to lmb_get_free_size() not able to find unreserved region due
to lack of DRAM size info. Required to support Ethernet boot on AM64x.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
On certain TI SoC, like AM64x there is a CPSW3G which supports 2
external independent MAC ports for single CPSW instance.
It is not possible for Ethernet driver to register more than one port
for given instance.
This patch modifies top level CPSW NUSS as UCLASS_MISC and binds
UCLASS_ETH to individual ports so as to support bring up more than one
Ethernet interface in U-Boot.
Note that there is no isolation in the since, CPSW NUSS is in promisc
mode and forwards all packets to host.
Since top level driver is now UCLASS_MISC, board files would need to
instantiate this driver explicitly.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Probe toplevel AM65 CPSW NUSS driver from misc_init_r() when driver
is enabled. Since driver is modeled as UCLASS_MISC, we need to
explicitly probe the driver. Use common misc_init_r() that entire
K3 family of SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Driver has a bug in that it uses rflow_in_use bitmap when setting up free rflow range
from TISCI but use rflow_map for reservation in __udma_reserve_rflow()
Fix this by dropping rflow_in_use bitmap array and use rflow_map for
PKTDMA. BCDMA does not need rflow_in_use either.
This fixes CPSW3g not able to get DMA channels at R5 SPL on AM64x
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
In case of xSPI bootmode OSPI flash is in DDR mode and needs to be accessed
in multiple of 16bit accesses Hence we cannot parse sysfw.itb FIT image
directly on OSPI flash via MMIO window. So, copy the image to internal
on-chip RAM before parsing the image.
Moreover, board cfg data maybe modified by ROM/TIFS in case of HS platform
and thus cannot reside in OSPI/xSPI and needs to be copied over to
internal OCRAM.
This unblocks OSPI/xSPI boot on HS platforms
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Tested-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Currently only the PADCFG registers of the main domain are unlocked.
Also unlock PADCFG registers of MCU domain, so MCU pin muxing can be configured by u-boot or Linux.
Signed-off-by: Michael Liebert <liebert@ibv-augsburg.de>
Tested-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-04-rc1
Documentation:
* Fix building HTML documentation of readthedocs.io
* Add ARM Juno board documentation
* Build requirements for Alpine Linux
* Include DM headers in API documentation
UEFI:
* Fix section alignment of EFI binaries
* Fix header length of RISC-V EFI binaries allowing to run them on EDK II
* Remove kaslr-seed from device tree if the EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL is provided
Other:
* Let 'part list' show all 128 GPT partitions
- A number of fixes in various subsystems. This includes having the phy
uclass track power-on and init counts as this should resolve some
tricky functional problems on a number of platforms.
Document the return value in efi_init(). Fix up @sizep in efi_info_get().
Use Return: instead of @return
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present some 32-bit settings are used with the 64-bit app. Fix this by
separating out the two cases.
Be careful not to break the 64-bit payload, which needs to build a 64-bit
EFI stub with a 32-bit U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Christian Melki <christian.melki@t2data.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
That script is not intended for use with EFI, so update the logic to avoid
using it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Christian Melki <christian.melki@t2data.com>
Add an empty CPU init function to avoid fiddling with low-level CPU
features in the app. Set up the C runtime correctly for 64-bit use
and avoid clearing BSS, since this is done by EFI when U-Boot is loaded.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the 'efi' command only works in the EFI payload. Update it to
work in the app too, so the memory map can be examined.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present this function requires a pointer to struct efi_entry_memmap
but the only field used in there is the desc_size. We want to be able
to use it from the app, so update it to use desc_size directly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this code is inline in the app and stub. But they do the same
thing. The difference is that the stub does it immediately and the app
doesn't want to do it until the end (when it boots a kernel) or not at
all, if returning to UEFI.
Move it into a function so it can be called as needed.
Add a comment showing how to store the memory map so that it can be
accessed within the app if needed, for debugging purposes only. The map
can change without notice.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If variable dfu_alt_info is not defined duplicate messages are displayed.
=> efidebug boot dump
Scanning disk mmc2.blk...
Scanning disk mmc1.blk...
Scanning disk mmc0.blk...
Found 3 disks
No EFI system partition
"dfu_alt_info" env variable not defined!
Probably dfu_alt_info not defined
"dfu_alt_info" env variable not defined!
Probably dfu_alt_info not defined
Remove the 'Probably dfu_alt_info not defined' message.
Instead write a warning if the variable contains no entities.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
U-Boot, in some occasions, injects a 'kaslr-seed' property on the /chosen
node. That would be problematic in case we want to measure the DTB we
install in the configuration table, since it would change across reboots.
The Linux kernel EFI-stub completely ignores it and only relies on
EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL for it's own randomness needs (i.e the randomization
of the physical placement of the kernel). In fact it (blindly) overwrites
the existing seed if the protocol is installed. However it still uses it
for randomizing it's virtual placement.
So let's get rid of it in the presence of the RNG protocol.
It's worth noting that TPMs also provide an RNG. So if we tweak our
EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL slightly and install the protocol when a TPM device
is present the 'kaslr-seed' property will always be removed, allowing
us to reliably measure our DTB.
Acked-by: Ard Biesheuvel <ardb@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
A GPT partition table typically has 128 entries. If a partition table
contains a partition 128 'part list' should be able to list it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
For GPT partition tables the 'part list' command stops at the first invalid
partition number. But Ubuntu has images with partitions number
1, 12, 13, 14, 15
In this case only partition 1 was listed by 'part list'.
Fixes: 38a3021edc ("disk: part_efi: remove indent level from loop")
Reported-by: Alexandre Ghiti <alexandre.ghiti@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tested-by: Alexandre Ghiti <alexandre.ghiti@canonical.com>
The alignment of sections in the EFI binaries generated by U-Boot is
incorrect.
According to the PE-COFF specification [1] the minimum value for
FileAlignment is 512. If the value of SectionAlignment is
less then the page size, it must equal FileAlignment.
Let's set both values to 512 for the ARM and RISC-V architectures.
[1] https://docs.microsoft.com/en-us/windows/win32/debug/pe-format
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
EDK II refuses to load the EFI binaries created by U-Boot.
The reason is an incorrect PE-COFF header. The number of
data directories does not match NumberOfRvaAndSizes.
This leads to a failed consistency check in
PeCoffLoaderGetPeHeader():
SizeOfOptionalHeader - HeaderWithoutDataDir) !=
NumberOfRvaAndSizes * sizeof(DATA_DIRECTORY))
Fixes: 9afaeec6ef ("riscv: Complete efi header for RV32/64")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/fdtaddr.h
and add the devfdt API to the HTML documentation;
these functions are NOT compatible with live tree.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/ofnode.h
and add the device tree node API to the HTML documentation;
the ofnode functions are compatible with Live tree or with flat
device tree.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/read.h
and add the device read from device tree API to the HTML
documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/devres.h
and add the driver model device resource API, devres_*(),
to the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/device.h
and add the driver model device API to the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/devres.h
and add the associated driver model API to the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/dm/uclass.h
and add the driver model UCLASS API to the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The Juno Arm development board is an open, vendor-neutral, Armv8-A
development platform.
Add documentation that briefly outlines the hardware, and describes
building and installation of U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_PHANDLE_CHECK_SEQ is outside of the menu 'Library routines'
thus it's invisible in menuconfig and cannot be selected.
Fix this by moving the 'endmenu' after the PHANDLE_CHECK_SEQ definition
Fixes: c589132a1d ("fdt: Use phandle to distinguish DT nodes with same name")
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add some new line feeds at the end of print messages to make things
easier to read on the console. The other env options do this so
this is just an omission for FAT env.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
On boards using the RK3399 SoC, the USB OHCI and EHCI controllers share
the same PHY device instance. While these controllers are being stopped
they both attempt to power-off and deinitialize it, but trying to
power-off the deinitialized PHY device results in a hang. This usually
happens just before booting an OS, and can be explicitly triggered by
running "usb start; usb stop" in the U-Boot shell.
Implement a uclass-wide counting mechanism for PHY initialization and
power state change requests, so that we don't power-off/deinitialize a
PHY instance until all of its users want it done. The Allwinner A10 USB
PHY driver does this counting in-driver, remove those parts in favour of
this in-uclass implementation.
The sandbox PHY operations test needs some changes since the uclass will
no longer call into the drivers for actions matching its tracked state
(e.g. powering-off a powered-off PHY). Update that test, and add a new
one which simulates multiple users of a single PHY.
The major complication here is that PHY handles aren't deduplicated per
instance, so the obvious idea of putting the counts in the PHY handles
don't immediately work. It seems possible to bind a child udevice per
PHY instance to the PHY provider and deduplicate the handles in each
child's uclass-private areas, like in the CLK framework. An alternative
approach could be to use those bound child udevices themselves as the
PHY handles. Instead, to avoid the architectural changes those would
require, this patch solves things by dynamically allocating a list of
structs (one per instance) in the provider's uclass-private area.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com> - Rock960
BOOT_TARGET_DEVICES should only be added if the corresponding u-boot
command is enabled otherwise the build will fail.
Signed-off-by: Piotr Kubik <piotr_kubik@vp.pl>
Apple's ARMv8 cores don't implement EL3 and therefore don't
provide a PSCI implementation. So don't attempt to use
PSCI to reset on machines using Apple SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Previously, a subpage with an uncorrectable error followed by a subpage
with a correctable error would return an erroneous correctable status.
Signed-off-by: Joel Peshkin <joel.peshkin@broadcom.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reporting the return value should always be done on error conditions,
this way the developer can start debugging issues with more knowledge
in-hand.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Dionne-Riel <samuel@dionne-riel.com>
The function was missing from exports, even though it loooks like the
intent of the implementation in sscanf.c was to have it exported.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Dionne-Riel <samuel@dionne-riel.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Calling 'nvme scan' followed by 'nvme detail' crashes U-Boot on Turris
Omnia with the following error:
undefined instruction
pc : [<0a000000>] lr : [<7ff80bfc>]
reloc pc : [<8a8c0000>] lr : [<00840bfc>]
sp : 7fb2b908 ip : 0000002a fp : 02000000
r10: 04000000 r9 : 7fb2fed0 r8 : e1000000
r7 : 0c000000 r6 : 03000000 r5 : 06000000 r4 : 01000000
r3 : 7fb30928 r2 : 7fb30928 r1 : 00000000 r0 : 00000000
Flags: nZCv IRQs off FIQs off Mode SVC_32
Code: 0f0fb4f0 0f0fb4f0 0f0fb4f0 0f0fb4f0 (f0f04b0f)
Resetting CPU ...
This happens when nvme_print_info() tries to return to the caller. It
looks like this error is caused by trying to allocate 8 KiB of memory
on the stack by the two uses of ALLOC_CACHE_ALIGN_BUFFER().
Use malloc_cache_aligned() to allocate this memory dynamically instead.
This fixes 'nvme detail' on Turris Omnia.
Note that similar change was applied to file drivers/nvme/nvme.c in past by
commit 2f83481dff ("nvme: use page-aligned buffer for identify command").
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This test checks for output specific to the sandbox blk device
"sandbox_host_blk", mark it as sandbox specific.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Attempt to handle cases with a downstream port of a PCIe switch where
link training never completes and the link continues switching between
speeds indefinitely with the data link layer never reaching the active
state.
It has been observed with a downstream port of the ASMedia ASM2824 Gen 3
switch wired to the upstream port of the Pericom PI7C9X2G304 Gen 2
switch, using a Delock Riser Card PCI Express x1 > 2 x PCIe x1 device,
P/N 41433, wired to a SiFive HiFive Unmatched board. In this setup the
switches are supposed to negotiate the link speed of preferably 5.0GT/s,
falling back to 2.5GT/s.
However the link continues oscillating between the two speeds, at the
rate of 34-35 times per second, with link training reported repeatedly
active ~84% of the time, e.g.:
02:03.0 PCI bridge [0604]: ASMedia Technology Inc. ASM2824 PCIe Gen3 Packet Switch [1b21:2824] (rev 01) (prog-if 00 [Normal decode])
[...]
Bus: primary=02, secondary=05, subordinate=05, sec-latency=0
[...]
Capabilities: [80] Express (v2) Downstream Port (Slot+), MSI 00
[...]
LnkSta: Speed 5GT/s (downgraded), Width x1 (ok)
TrErr- Train+ SlotClk+ DLActive- BWMgmt+ ABWMgmt-
[...]
LnkCtl2: Target Link Speed: 8GT/s, EnterCompliance- SpeedDis+, Selectable De-emphasis: -3.5dB
Transmit Margin: Normal Operating Range, EnterModifiedCompliance- ComplianceSOS-
Compliance De-emphasis: -6dB
[...]
Forcibly limiting the target link speed to 2.5GT/s with the upstream
ASM2824 device makes the two switches communicate correctly however:
02:03.0 PCI bridge [0604]: ASMedia Technology Inc. ASM2824 PCIe Gen3 Packet Switch [1b21:2824] (rev 01) (prog-if 00 [Normal decode])
[...]
Bus: primary=02, secondary=05, subordinate=09, sec-latency=0
[...]
Capabilities: [80] Express (v2) Downstream Port (Slot+), MSI 00
[...]
LnkSta: Speed 2.5GT/s (downgraded), Width x1 (ok)
TrErr- Train- SlotClk+ DLActive+ BWMgmt- ABWMgmt-
[...]
LnkCtl2: Target Link Speed: 2.5GT/s, EnterCompliance- SpeedDis+, Selectable De-emphasis: -3.5dB
Transmit Margin: Normal Operating Range, EnterModifiedCompliance- ComplianceSOS-
Compliance De-emphasis: -6dB
[...]
and then:
05:00.0 PCI bridge [0604]: Pericom Semiconductor PI7C9X2G304 EL/SL PCIe2 3-Port/4-Lane Packet Switch [12d8:2304] (rev 05) (prog-if 00 [Normal decode])
[...]
Bus: primary=05, secondary=06, subordinate=09, sec-latency=0
[...]
Capabilities: [c0] Express (v2) Upstream Port, MSI 00
[...]
LnkSta: Speed 2.5GT/s (downgraded), Width x1 (downgraded)
TrErr- Train- SlotClk+ DLActive- BWMgmt- ABWMgmt-
[...]
LnkCtl2: Target Link Speed: 5GT/s, EnterCompliance- SpeedDis-
Transmit Margin: Normal Operating Range, EnterModifiedCompliance- ComplianceSOS-
Compliance De-emphasis: -6dB
[...]
Make use of this observation then and attempt to detect the inability to
negotiate the link speed automatically, and then handle it by hand. Use
the Data Link Layer Link Active status flag as the primary indicator of
successful link speed negotiation, but given that the flag is optional
by hardware to implement (the ASM2824 does have it though), resort to
checking for the mandatory Link Bandwidth Management Status flag showing
that the link speed or width has been changed in an attempt to correct
unreliable link operation (the ASM2824 does set it too).
If these checks indicate that link may not operate correctly, then poll
the Data Link Layer Link Active status flag along with the Link Training
flag for the duration of 200ms to see if the link has stabilised, that
is either that the Data Link Layer Link Active status flag has been set
or that Link Training has been inactive during at least the second half
of the interval.
If that has indicated failure, restrict the target speed to 2.5GT/s,
request a link retrain and check again if the link has stabilised. If
that does not work either, then restore the original speed setting and
claim defeat, otherwise we are done.
NB interestingly enough with the ASM2824 vs PI7C9X2G304 configuration
referred above asking the ASM2824 to retrain with a higher target link
speed once the 2.5GT/s speed has been negotiated makes the two devices
successfully negotiate 5.0GT/s. Lifting the 2.5GT/s speed restriction
would however prevent our workaround from working with an OS that issues
a reset and that is unaware of the problem. This is because the devices
would then try to negotiate a higher link speed from scratch and fail,
while the sticky property of the Target Link Speed setting will keep the
2.5GT/s speed restriction across a reset.
Keep the 2.5GT/s speed restriction then, conservatively, if functional
once applied.
Signed-off-by: Maciej W. Rozycki <macro@orcam.me.uk>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
CHUNK_TYPE_RAW buffer is not aligned, and flash sparse images by
fastboot will report "Misaligned operation" if DCACHE is enabled.
Flashing Sparse Image
CACHE: Misaligned operation at range [84000028, 84001028]
CACHE: Misaligned operation at range [84001034, 84002034]
CACHE: Misaligned operation at range [8401104c, 8401304c]
Fix it
Signed-off-by: qianfan Zhao <qianfanguijin@163.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
These hardcoded values were calculated from CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE macro. Now
this macro is configurable via Kconfig, so calculate values 0x0030/0x4030
at compile time via CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE option. Values 0x0030/0x4030
represents offset of CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE from address 0x40000000.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Memory layout in the comment is from Armada XP platform which uses load
address 0x40004030. DB-88f6720 is Armada 375 platform which uses same load
address as Armada 38x which is 0x40000030.
Currently SPL support for Armada 375 is unfinished and does not work. There
is missing Serdes initialization and DDR3 training code. So nobody noticed
that CONFIG_SPL_* options are not correct.
Fix at least CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE constant and remove incorrect comments
about memory layout. So it is not misleading.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Do not check for kwbimage configuration file when just showing information
about existing kwbimage file.
The check for kwbimage configuration file is required only when creating
kwbimage, not when showing information about image or when extracting data
from image.
With this change, it is possible to call mkimage -l and dumpimage -l also
for existing kwbimage file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When there is no -p argument for dumpimage tool specified, extract the main
data image from kwbimage file. This makes dumpimage consistent with other
image formats.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Despite the official specification, BootROM does not look at the lowest bit
of ext field but rather checks if ext field is non-zero.
Moreover original Marvell doimage tool puts into the mhdr->ext field the
number of extended headers, so basically it sets ext filed to non-zero
value if some extended header is present.
Fix U-Boot dumpimage and kwboot tools to parse correctly also kwbimage
files created by Marvell doimage tool, in the same way as the BootROM is
doing it when booting these images.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
To regenerate kwbimage from existing image, it is needed to have kwbimage
config file. Add a new option to generate kwbimage config file from
existing kwbimage when '-p 1' option is given.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For debugging purposes it is good to know where the binary image would be
loaded and also it is needed to know if printed size is image size or the
size of header together with image.
Make it unambiguous by showing that printed size is not the size of the
whole header, but only the size of executable code, and print also the
executable offset of this binary image. Load/execute address is the offset
relative to the base address (either 0x40004000 or 0x40000000).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Data delay is stored as 8-bit number in kwbimage structure. Ensure the
given value is at most 255.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
BootROMs on pre-A38x SoCs enabled its output on UART by default, but A38x'
BootROM has its output on UART disabled by default.
To enable BootROM output on A38x SoC, it is required to set DEBUG flag
(which only enables BootROM output and nothing more) in kwbimage. For UART
images this DEBUG flag is ignored by BootROM.
Enable kwbimage DEBUG flag for all A38x boards.
With this change BootROM prints the following (success) information on UART
before booting U-Boot kwbimage:
BootROM - 1.73
Booting from SPI flash
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This alignment is required only for platforms based on Sheeva CPU core
which are A370 and AXP. Now when U-Boot build system correctly propagates
LOAD_ADDRESS there is no need to have enabled 128-bit boundary alignment on
platforms which do not need it. Previously it was required because load
address was implicitly rounded to 128-bit boundary and U-Boot build system
expected it and misused it. Now with explicit setting of LOAD_ADDRESS there
is no guessing for load address anymore.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
U-Boot SPL for mvebu platform is not compiled as position independent.
Therefore it is required to instruct BootROM to load U-Boot SPL at the
correct address. Loading of kwbimage binary code at specific address can be
now achieved by the new LOAD_ADDRESS token as part of BINARY command in
kwbimage config file.
Update mvebu Makefile to put value of $(CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE) into
LOAD_ADDRESS token when generating kwbimage.cfg from kwbimage.cfg.in.
It is required to update regex for sed to find replacement tokens at any
position on a line in kwbimage config file and not only at the beginning of
the line. This is because LOAD_ADDRESS is specified at the end of line
containing the BINARY command.
It looks like all Armada boards set CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE to value
0x40004030 or 0x40000030. Why this value? It is because main kwbimage
header is at address 0x40004030 or 0x40000000 and it is 32 bytes long.
After the main header there is the binary header, which consist of 1 byte
for type, 3 bytes for size, 1 byte for number of arguments, 3 reserved
bytes and then 4 bytes for each argument. After these arguments comes the
executable code.
So arguments start at address 0x40004028 or 0x40000028. Before commit
e6571f38c9 ("arm: mvebu: Remove dummy BIN header arguments for SPL
binary") there were two (dummy) arguments, which resulted in load address
of 0x40004030 or 0x40000030, always. After that commit (which removed dummy
arguments), load address stayed same due to the 128-bit alignment done by
mkimage.
This patch now reflects the dependency between $(CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE),
load address and dummy kwbimage arguments, and allows the user to adjust
$(CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE) config option to some other value.
For unsupported values, when mkimage/kwbimage cannot set chosen load address
as specified by $(CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE), the build process now fails,
instead of silently generating non-working kwbimage.
Removal of this alignment between $(CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE) and LOAD_ADDRESS
can only be done by compiling U-Boot SPL as position independent. But this
currently is not possible for 32-bit ARM version of U-Boot SPL.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
BootROM loads kwbimage header to L2-SRAM and BootROM reserve only 192 kB for it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function image_headersz_v1() may return zero on fatal errors.
In this case the function already printed an error message.
Check the return value of image_headersz_v1() in kwbimage_generate(),
and exit on zero value with EXIT_FAILURE.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
ARM executable code included in kwbimage binary header, which is not
position independent, needs to be loaded and executed by BootROM at the
correct fixed address.
Armada BootROMs load kwbimage header (in which the executable code is also
stored) at fixed address 0x40004000 or 0x40000000 which is mapped to
L2-SRAM (L2 Cache as SRAM). Address 0x40004000 is used on Armada platforms
with Sheeva CPU core (A370 and AXP) where BootROM uses MMU with 0x4000
bytes for MMU translation table. Address 0x40000000 is used on all other
platforms.
Thus the only way to specify load and execute address of this executable
code in binary kwbimage header is by filling dummy arguments into the
binary header, using the same mechanism we already have for achieving
128-bit boundary alignment on A370 and AXP SoCs.
Extend kwbimage config file parser to allow to specify load address as
part of BINARY command with syntax:
BINARY path_to_binary arg1 arg2 ... argN LOAD_ADDRESS address
If the specified load address is invalid or cannot be used, mkimage will
throw fatal error and exit. This will prevent generating kwbimage with
invalid load address for non-position independent binary code.
If no load address is specified, kwbimage will not fill any the dummy
arguments, thus it will behave the same as before this change.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For other changes it is required to know if CPU core is Sheeva or not.
Therefore add a new command CPU for specifying CPU.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Usage of $(call cmd,...) is standard way to call other commands which
generate things.
It also has the advantage of printing build information in the form
KWBCFG arch/arm/mach-mvebu/kwbimage.cfg
if verbosity is disabled, and printing the build command otherwise.
Note that the '#' character needs to be escaped in Makefile when used as
value for make variable assignment.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Preserve the order of BINARY, DATA and DATA_DELAY commands as they appear
in the input file. They may depend on each other.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Register set header consists of sequence of DATA commands followed by
exactly one DATA_DELAY command. Thus if we are generating image with
multiple DATA_DELAY commands, we need to create more register set headers.
Fix calculation of image size with multiple DATA_DELAY commands and
correctly set pointer to struct register_set_hdr_v1 when initializing new
register set header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Deduplicate code that finishes OPT_HDR_V1_REGISTER_TYPE header by
extracing it into separate function.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This is a cleaned up and fixed version of a patch
mv_ddr: a380: fix SPLIT_OUT_MIX state decision
in each pattern cycle the bus state can be changed
in order to avoide it, need to back to the same bus state on each
pattern cycle
by
Moti Boskula <motib@marvell.com>
The original patch is not in Marvell's mv-ddr-marvell repository. It was
gives to us by Marvell to fix an issues with DDR training on some
boards, but it cannot be applied as is to mv-ddr-marvell, because it is
a very dirty draft patch that would certainly break other things, mainly
DDR4 training code in mv-ddr-marvell, since it changes common functions.
I have cleaned up the patch and removed stuff that seemed unnecessary
(when removed, it still fixed things). Note that I don't understand
completely what the code does exactly, since I haven't studied the DDR
training code extensively (and I suspect that no one besides some few
people in Marvell understand the code completely).
Anyway after the cleanup the patch still fixes isssues with DDR training
on the failing boards.
There was also a problem with the original patch on some of the Allied
Telesis' x530 boards, reported by Chris Packham. I have asked Chris to
send me some logs, and managed to fix it:
- if you look at the change, you'll notice that it introduces
subtraction of cur_start_win[] and cur_end_win[] members, depending on
a bit set in the current_byte_status variable
- the original patch subtracted cur_start_win[] if either
BYTE_SPLIT_OUT_MIX or BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT bits were set, but
subtracted cur_end_win[] only if the first one (BYTE_SPLIT_OUT_MIX)
was set
- from Chris Packham logs I discovered that the x530 board where the
original patch introduced DDR training failure, only the
BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT bit was set, and on our boards where the
patch is needed only the BYTE_SPLIT_OUT_MIX is set in the
current_byte_status variable
- this led me to the hypothesis that both cur_start_win[] and
cur_end_win[] should be subtracted only if BYTE_SPLIT_OUT_MIX bit is
set, the BYTE_HOMOGENEOUS_SPLIT_OUT bit shouldn't be considered at all
- this hypothesis also gains credibility when considering the commit
title ("fix SPLIT_OUT_MIX state decision")
Hopefully this will fix things without breaking anything else.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
I got an
<dirk.eibach@gdsys.cc>: host mxlb.ispgateway.de[80.67.18.126] said:
554 Sorry, no mailbox here by that name. (in reply to RCPT TO command)
when sending e-mail to dirk.eibach@gdsys.cc.
Drop Dirk Eibach from MAINTAINERS of board/gdsys/a38x and
board/gdsys/mpc8308. The latter would be left maintainerless, add
Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc> (he is also maintainer of the former
board).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Before commit 4c289425752f ("mv_ddr: a38x: add support for ddr async
mode"), Asynchornous Mode was only used when the CPU Subsystem Clock
Options[4:0] field in the SAR1 register was set to value 0x13: CPU at
2 GHz and DDR at 933 MHz.
Then commit 4c289425752f ("mv_ddr: a38x: add support for ddr async
mode") added support for Asynchornous Modes with frequencies other than
933 MHz (but at least 467 MHz), but the code it added to check for
whether Asynchornous Mode should be used is wrong: it checks whether the
frequency setting in board DDR topology map is set to value other than
MV_DDR_FREQ_SAR.
Thus boards which define a specific value, greater than 400 MHz, for DDR
frequency in their board topology (e.g. Turris Omnia defines
MV_DDR_FREQ_800), are incorrectly put into Asynchornous Mode after that
commit.
The A38x Functional Specification, section 10.12 DRAM Clocking, says:
In Synchornous mode, the DRAM and CPU clocks are edge aligned and run
in 1:2 or 1:3 CPU to DRAM frequency ratios.
Change the check for whether Asynchornous Mode should be used according
to this explanation in Functional Specification.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Add MVEBU PCIe configs
- Also add SYS_THUMB_BUILD to keep u-boot image size within 512K
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The DT properties for the "enable-arbiter" and "keep-config" config
knobs were previously named inconsistently:
- The u-boot driver used "nand-enable-arbiter" and "nand-keep-config"
names, without Marvell prefixes.
- The Linux driver uses "marvell,nand-keep-config" ("enable-arbiter"
does not exist anymore in recent kernels, but it also used to be
"marvell,nand-enable-arbiter").
- The device trees almost all use "marvell," prefixed names, except for
one single instance of "nand-enable-arbiter" without vendor prefix.
This commit standardizes on the vendor prefixed version, making the
u-boot driver read from DT props "marvell,nand-enable-arbiter" and
"marvell,nand-keep-config". The one device tree using the unprefixed
version is also changed to use the new naming.
This has the side effect of making the previously no-op "marvell,"
config knobs already present in some DTs actually do something. This was
likely the original intention of the DT authors, but note that this
commit was not tested on every single impacted board.
Signed-off-by: Pierre Bourdon <delroth@gmail.com>
As explained in commit 3bedbcc3aa ("arm: mvebu: a38x: serdes: Don't
overwrite read-only SAR PCIe registers") it is required to set Maximum Link
Width bits of PCIe Root Port Link Capabilities Register depending of number
of used serdes lanes. As this register is part of PCIe address space and
not serdes address space, move it into pci_mvebu.c driver.
Read number of PCIe lanes from DT property "num-lanes" which is used also
by other PCIe controller drivers in Linux kernel. If this property is
absent then it defaults to 1. This property needs to be set to 4 for every
mvebu board which use PEX_ROOT_COMPLEX_X4 or PEX_BUS_MODE_X4.
Enabling of PCIe port needs to be done afer all registers in PCIe address
space are properly configure. For this purpose use new mvebu-reset driver
(part of system-controller) and remove this code from serdes code.
Because some PCIe ports cannot be enabled individually, it is required to
first setup all PCIe ports and then enable them.
This change contains also all required "num-lanes" and "resets" DTS
properties, to make pci_mvebu.c driver work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Enabling and disabling PCIe ports is done via address space of system
controller. All 32-bit Armada SoCs use low 4 bits in SoC Control 1 Register
for enabling and disabling some or more PCIe ports. Correct mapping needs
to be set in particular DTS files.
DT API for mvebu-reset is prepared for implementing resets also for other
HW blocks, but currently only PCIe is implemented via index 0.
Currently this driver is not used as PCIe ports are automatically enabled
by SerDes code executed by U-Boot SPL. But this will change in followup
patches.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
After function mvebu_pcie_probe() returns U-Boot DM expects that PCIe link
is already up. In followup patches link initialization will be moved from
SPL to proper and therefore explicitly link up delay is required.
Delay mvebu_pcie_probe() for 100ms to ensure that PCIe link is up after
function finish. In the case when no card is connected to the PCIe slot,
this will delay probe time by 100ms, which should not be problematic.
This change fixes detection and initialization of some QCA98xx cards on
the first serdes when configured in x1 mode. Default configuration of
the first serdes on A385 is x4 mode, so it looks as if some delay is
required when x4 is changed to x1 and card correctly links with A385.
Other PCIe serdes ports on A385 are x1-only, and so they don't have this
problem.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
In first phase just parse DT properties and fill struct mvebu_pcie. In
second phase setup all PCIe links (without enabling them). And in the last
third phase enable all PCIe links and create UCLASS_PCI device for each
one.
Because parsing of DT is done before UCLASS_PCI is created, we cannot use
DM for this action anymore. So remove .of_to_plat callback and replace it
by ad-hoc function for parsing DT properties and filling struct mvebu_pcie.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
SoC specific macro SOC_REGS_PHY_BASE is used for two things:
* calculation of base PCIe port address
* filling PCIe register with address of internal registers
For calculating base PCIe port address use function
ofnode_translate_address() which translates DT "assigned-addresses" to
final PCIe port address.
And for calculating address of internal registers use untranslated and
translated DT "assigned-addresses".
Basically this change reads SOC_REGS_PHY_BASE address indirectly from DT.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Function mvebu_pcie_port_parse_dt() is called only from
mvebu_pcie_of_to_plat() function. Both these function parse DT properties
required to setup mvebu pcie. So inline mvebu_pcie_port_parse_dt() function
into mvebu_pcie_of_to_plat() to have all code related to parsing DT
properties at one place.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Do not call pci_set_region() for resources which were not properly mapped.
This prevents U-Boot to access unmapped memory space.
Update MBUS_PCI_MEM_SIZE and MBUS_PCI_IO_SIZE macros to cover all PCIe MEM
and IO ranges. Previously these macros covered only address ranges for the
first PCIe port. Between MBUS_PCI_IO_BASE and MBUS_PCI_MEM_BASE there is
space for six 128 MB long address ranges. So set MBUS_PCI_MEM_SIZE to value
of 6*128 MB. Similarly set MBUS_PCI_IO_SIZE to 6*64 KB.
Function resource_size() returns zero when start address is 0 and end
address is -1. So set invalid resources to these values to indicate that
resource has no mapping.
Split global PCIe MEM and IO resources (defined by MBUS_PCI_*_* macros)
into PCIe ports in mvebu_pcie_bind() function which allocates per-port
based struct mvebu_pcie, instead of using global state variables
mvebu_pcie_membase and mvebu_pcie_iobase. This makes pci_mvebu.c driver
independent of global static variables (which store the state of
allocation) and allows to bind and unbind the driver more times.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
A385 controlcenterdc board does not use PCI DM properly and touches some
PCIe devices directly in its board code.
This controlcenterdc spl_board_init() function expects that PCIe link is
already initialized. Link itself is initialized in a38x serdes code but
this will change in future and link initialization will be postponed from
U-Boot SPL to proper U-Boot.
So explicitly enable PCIe link 2 in spl_board_init() function via
SoC Control Register 1 to not break this code by future changes. This board
has PCIe link 2 just x1, so no additional initialization (except enabling
PCIe port) is needed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
The only user of board_pex_config() weak function is A385 controlcenterdc
board. It looks like that code in its board_pex_config() function needs to
be executed after PCIe link is up. Therefore put this code into
spl_board_init() function which is called after a38x serdes initialization,
and therefore it is after the serdes hws_pex_config() function finishes
(which is the state before this change).
With this change completely remove board_pex_config() function as it is not
used anymore.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
This implementation is intended to be copied to other projects and
modified, to as to foster a standard means of communcating runtime
information between firmware projects.
The GPL-2 license is too restrictive for some projects, e.g. those
intended as reference implementations rather than designed for
collaborative open-source development.
Update the license to make this easier to share.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
FIx up various minor errors and add the API documentation to the bloblist
docs, since it is quite useful to see it in the same place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we do support allocating the bloblist but the Kconfig is a bit
strange, since we still have to specify an address in that case. Partly
this is because it is a pain to have CONFIG options that disappears when
its dependency is enabled. It means that we must have #ifdefs in the code,
either in the C code or header file.
Make use of IF_ENABLED_INT() and its friend to solve that problem, so we
can separate out the location of bloblist into a choice. Put the address
and size into variables so we can log the result.
Add the options for SPL as well, so we can use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We typically refer to the different U-Boot builds that a board runs
through as phases. This avoids confusion with the word 'stage' which is
used with bootstage, for example. Fix up some bloblist Kconfig help
which uses the wrong term.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if someone adds a tag in the middle of the list it works well
enough within a U-Boot build. But if these tags are used in another
project, or with an older version of SPL, the numbers make become
inconsistent.
Use explicit tag numbers that never change, to resolve this problem.
Allocate areas for existing U-Boot tags and set up an area for use by
projects and vendors, as well as for private use. Keep tags above
0x10000 unallocated for now.
Update bloblist_tag_name() and the tests to work with this new setup.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The EC event log tag is no-longer used. The vboot handoff is now handled
by the vboot context instead.
Drop these unused tags.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It seems best to put the magic number right at the start of the bloblist
header, so it is easier to check. This is how devicetree works.
Make this change now, before other projects make use of bloblist. Other
changes may be needed / discussed, but that is TBD.
Add a checker function as well.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some bright sparks have decided that a cast on a constant cannot be a
constant, so offsetof() produces this warning on clang-10:
include/intel_gnvs.h:113:1: error: static_assert expression is not an
integral constant expression
check_member(acpi_global_nvs, unused2, GNVS_CHROMEOS_ACPI_OFFSET);
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/linux/kernel.h:284:2: note: expanded from macro 'check_member'
offsetof(struct structure, member) == (offset), \
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/linux/stddef.h:20:32: note: expanded from macro 'offsetof'
^
include/intel_gnvs.h:113:1: note: cast that performs the conversions of
a reinterpret_cast is ot allowed in a constant expression
include/linux/stddef.h:20:33: note: expanded from macro 'offsetof'
Fix it by using the compiler built-in version, if available. This syncs
the function to the same implementation as Linux v5.16 in this header
file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When genboardscfg.py is run on machines with 255 or more cores, the
process will consume more than 1024 file descriptors, which is a common
standard ulimit for user processes. As a consequence it will fail with a
lenghty Python trace, with the almost hidden message:
OSError: [Errno 24] Too many open files
It's somewhat questionable whether that level of parallelity is actually
useful for genboardscfg, so we limit the *default* number of jobs to the
safe number of 240, to avoid the problem.
If a user persists, she can still force a higher number via the -j
parameter - hopefully having raised the ulimit accordingly beforehand.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-Boot define loff_t as long long. But the header
/usr/include/linux/types.h may not define it.
This has lead to a build error on Alpine Linux.
So let's use long long instead of loff_t for
the size parameter of function os_get_filesize().
Reported-by: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tested-by: Milan P. Stanić <mps@arvanta.net>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Python doesn't naturally support tilde (~) as a user-home marker in
paths, but git-config does. So we need to resolve it before continuing.
We also shouldn't blindly join the top-level tree with the aliasesfile
path, because it might be an absolute path.
This resolves warnings like the following:
Warning: Cannot find alias file '/path/to/source/tree/~/.git-email'
Seen when git-config is like:
$ git config sendemail.aliasesfile
~/.git-email
Signed-off-by: Brian Norris <briannorris@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Otavio Salvador <otavio@ossystems.com.br>
The commit 3ad3077848 ("dm: core: device: enable power domain in probe")
introduced enabling power domain when device is probed.
By checking this sequence in Linux kernel was found that power domain is
handled first followed by pinctrl setting.
This patch is switching this order to follow Linux kernel that power
domains are handled first follow by pinctrl setting.
The issue was found on Xilinx Kria SOM where firmware is blocking setting
up pin configuration/muxes without enabling power domain for the specific
IP first.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Somewhere along the way, someone misspelt "invalid" and it got copied
everywhere. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Alexander Dahl <ada@thorsis.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Fix binman fake blob support to write outside source directory
- Azure now has stages in the pipeline
- Update to latest focal tag for containers in CI.
- Finish dropping LynxOS
- Add migration message for timer code
Add compatible and data platform struct for sam9x60 SoC.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Rely on the new watchdog timer driver and the sysreset uclass to
reset the system. This gets rid of hard-coded addresses and
should work on systems based on the new M1 Pro and M1 Max SoCs
as well.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-on: Apple M1 Macbook
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a node for the watchdog timer based on the proposed Linux
device tree bindings.
Remove the old reboot node which was a watchdog timert node in
disguise using a preliminary device tree binding.
Signed-off-by: Sven Peter <sven@svenpeter.dev>
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-on: Apple M1 Macbook
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This driver supports the watchdog timer found on Apple's M1 SoC.
On systems that use these SoC, the watchdog timer is the primary
way to reboot the system.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Sven Peter <sven@svenpeter.dev>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-on: Apple M1 Macbook
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Model names are SM-A{3,5,7}20, just SM-{3,5,7}20 could also refer to
SM-J{3,5,7}20 or SM-T{3,5,7}20.
Fixes: 3e2095e960 ("board: samsung: add support for Galaxy A series
of 2017 (a5y17lte)")
Signed-off-by: Henrik Grimler <henrik@grimler.se>
Reviewed-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
a7y17lte is called SM-A720F, and a3y17lte SM-A320F. a3y17lte also
should select PINCTRL_EXYNOS78x0, not the (non-existent)
PINCTRL_EXYNOS7880, and it has an Exynos 7870 SoC and not 7880.
Fixes: 3e2095e960 ("board: samsung: add support for Galaxy A series
of 2017 (a5y17lte)")
Signed-off-by: Henrik Grimler <henrik@grimler.se>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Some boards still use the old timer mechanism. Set a deadline for them to
update to driver model. Point to some examples as well.
This needs a bit of a strange rule to avoid an error on some boards.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
LynxOS needed the do_bootm_lynxkdi() function that got removed in
7e713067ee ("Remove LYNX KDI remainders") - and that function needed
a lynxkdi_boot() function, where the last implementation had been
removed in 98f705c9ce ("powerpc: remove 4xx support") already. Looks
like this OS is definitely not supported anymore, so remove it from
the corresponding lists.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
At present binman writes fake blobs to the current directory. This is not
very helpful, since the files serve no useful purpose once binman has
finished. They clutter up the source directory and affect future runs,
since the files in the current directory are often used in preference to
those in the board directory.
To avoid these problems, write them to the output directory instead.
Move the file-creation code to the Entry base class, so it can be used by
any entry type that needs it. This is required since some entry types,
such as Entry_blob_ext_list, are not subclasses of Entry_blob.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use a unique number instead of the current 203, which is used by 203_fip
as well. Reformat the code to avoid a long line.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Follow what we do in GitLab CI where we break the jobs up in to stages
such that if earlier and often quicker sanity tests fail we don't run
everything else.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When building for i.mx8m boards with binman, a few more additional
files are created which should be removed when running 'make clean'
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
sh7751 platform uses standard format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
Commit 72c2f4acd7 ("pci: sh7751: Convert to DM and DT probing") which did
conversion of PCI sh7751 driver to DM, broke access to config space as that
commit somehow swapped device and function bits in config address.
Fix all these issues by using new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS() which
calculates Config Address correctly.
Also remove nonsense function sh7751_pci_addr_valid() which was introduced
in commit 72c2f4acd7 ("pci: sh7751: Convert to DM and DT probing")
probably due to workarounded issues with mixing/swapping device and
function bits of config address which probably resulted in non-working
access to some devices. With correct composing of config address there
should not be such issue anymore.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 72c2f4acd7 ("pci: sh7751: Convert to DM and DT probing")
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
mcf5445x platform uses standard format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1. So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
x86 platform uses standard format of Config Address for PCI Configuration
Mechanism #1. So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI sh7780 driver uses standard format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI mediatek driver uses extended format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1 but with cleared Enable bit.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS() with clearing
PCI_CONF1_ENABLE bit and remove old custom driver address macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI fsl driver uses extended format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI tegra driver uses extended format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1 but with cleared Enable bit.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS() with clearing
PCI_CONF1_ENABLE bit and remove old custom driver address function.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI mvebu driver uses extended format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS() and remove old custom
driver address macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI msc01 driver uses standard format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1 but with cleared Enable bit.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS() with clearing PCI_CONF1_ENABLE
bit and remove old custom driver address macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI mpc85xx driver uses extended format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PCI gt64120 driver uses standard format of Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1.
So use new U-Boot macro PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS() and remove old custom driver
address macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Lot of PCI and PCIe controllers are using standard Config Address for PCI
Configuration Mechanism #1 or its extended version.
So add PCI_CONF1_ADDRESS() and PCI_CONF1_EXT_ADDRESS() macros into U-Boot's
pci.h header file which can be suitable for most PCI and PCIe controller
drivers. Drivers do not have to invent their own macros and can use these
new U-Boot macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is common to set all base address bits to one and all limit address bits
to zero for disabling address forwarding. Forwarding is disabled when base
address is higher than limit address, so this change should not have any
effect.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If U-Boot does not have any I/O resource for assignment then disable I/O
forwarding in PCI bridge autoconfiguration code. Default initial state of
PCI bridge IO registers is unspecified, therefore they can be in enabled if
U-Boot does not touch them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function dm_pciauto_prescan_setup_bridge() configures base address
registers, therefore it should read type of IO from base address registers
(and not from limit address registers).
Note that base and limit address registers should have same type, so this
change is just usage correction and has no functional change on correctly
working hardware.
Fixes: 8e85f36a8f ("pci: Fix configuring io/memory base and limit registers of PCI bridges")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Macro XR3PCI_ECAM_OFFSET is unused and in case it would be needed in future
it can be replaced by standard PCIE_ECAM_OFFSET macro from pci.h file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
We want to replace '#ifdef' by 'if (IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_...))' in our code.
Therefore functions should be defined unconditionally even if they are not
implemented.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
When failing to send a command because the hardware is busy, return
EBUSY to indicate the cause instead of just -1.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit 263ddfc345 ]
The initial clock setting should be through sysctl register only,
while the mmc_set_clock() will call mmc_set_ios() introduce other
configurations like bus width, mode, and so on.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
This builds on the previous patch by converting yet more preprocessor
macros to C ifs. This is split off so that the changes adapted from
Micheal's patch may be clearly distinguished from the ones I have
authored myself.
MMC_SUPPORTS_TUNING should really get a Kconfig conversion. And DM_GPIO
needs some -ENOSYS stubs when it isn't defined.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit 52faec3182 ]
Make the code cleaner and drop the old-style #ifdef constructs where it is
possible.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit 7e48a028a4 ]
First, we need the waterlevel setting for PIO mode only. Secondy, both DMA
setup code is identical for both directions, except for the data pointer.
Thus, unify them.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit b1ba1460a4 ]
Use the dma_{map,unmap}_single() calls. These will take care of the
flushing and invalidation of caches.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit da86e8cfcb ]
SDMA can only do DMA with 32 bit addresses. This is true for all
architectures (just doesn't apply to 32 bit ones). Simplify the code and
remove unnecessary CONFIG_FSL_LAYERSCAPE.
Also make the error message more concise.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit commit 08197cb8df ]
Drop redundant code for non-removable feature. "non-removable" property
has been read in mmc_of_parse().
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
[ set MMC_CAP_NONREMOVABLE in plat->cfg.host_caps ]
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit 07bae1de38 ]
This patch is to clean up bus width setting code.
- For DM_MMC, remove getting "bus-width" from device tree.
This has been done in mmc_of_parse().
- For non-DM_MMC, move bus width configuration from fsl_esdhc_init()
to fsl_esdhc_initialize() which is non-DM_MMC specific.
And fix up bus width configuration to support only 1-bit, 4-bit,
or 8-bit. Keep using 8-bit if it's not set because many platforms
use driver without providing max bus width.
- Remove bus_width member from fsl_esdhc_priv structure.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
[ converted if statement to switch ]
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[ fsl_esdhc commit 5b05fc0310 ]
Voltage validation should be done by CMD8. Current comparison between
mmc_cfg voltages and host voltage capabilities is meaningless.
So drop current comparison and let voltage validation is through CMD8.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
U-boot prefers DM_MMC + BLK for MMC. Now eSDHC driver has already
support it, so let's force to use it.
- Drop non-BLK support for DM_MMC introduced by below patch.
66fa035 mmc: fsl_esdhc: fix probe issue without CONFIG_BLK enabled
- Support only DM_MMC + BLK (assuming BLK is always enabled for DM_MMC).
- Use DM_MMC instead of BLK for conditional compile.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The return type of EVP_PKEY_get0_RSA() is const struct rsa_st *.
Our code drops the const qualifier leading to
In file included from tools/lib/rsa/rsa-sign.c:1:
./tools/../lib/rsa/rsa-sign.c: In function ‘rsa_add_verify_data’:
./tools/../lib/rsa/rsa-sign.c:631:13: warning:
assignment discards ‘const’ qualifier from pointer target type
[-Wdiscarded-qualifiers]
631 | rsa = EVP_PKEY_get0_RSA(pkey);
| ^
Add a type conversion.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
- disable CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR when unnecessary on amlogic based configs
- meson64_android: add board specific env settings, in order to support VIM3/L for android
- add changes to support VIM3/L android boot by using meson64_android.h config
All i.MX8MQ boards have been converted to binman, which makes it
necessary to flash both flash.bin and u-boot.itb to get a bootable
system. Prior to the conversion, only flash.bin was needed.
Such new requirement breaks existing distro mechanisms to generate the
final binary because the extra u-boot.itb is now required.
Generate a final flash.bin that can be used again as a single bootable
binary to keep the original behavior.
After this change the SPL binary is called spl.bin, which is a more
descriptive name for its purpose, and can still be used standalone (for
example, for secure boot purposes).
Also update imx8mq_evk.rst to remove the u-boot.itb copy step.
This is a cherry-pick of 028abfd9b1 ("imx8mm-evk: Generate a single
bootable flash.bin again") adjusted to apply to i.MX8MQ.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Since commit f7ac30b042, the pin muxing for mmc was removed from the
board file to be managed by DM_MMC which requires PINCTRL to work. It
made the change for sabrelite but nitrogen configs were forgotten.
Signed-off-by: Gary Bisson <gary.bisson@boundarydevices.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Troy Kisky <troy.kisky@boundarydevices.com>
Fastboot support has been broken on platforms using dwc2 controller
since the gadget gets its max packet size from it.
This patch is the equivalent of 723fd5668f which fixed the same issue
but for the chipidea controller.
Fixes: 27c9141b11 ("usb: gadget: fastboot: use correct max packet size")
Signed-off-by: Gary Bisson <gary.bisson@boundarydevices.com>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
CMD_DM is useful for showing the whole DM tree.
Enable it via "imply CMD_DM".
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Increase CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET to avoid the environment region to
overlap with U-Boot proper.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
After the conversion to DM the SD card shows up as 'mmc 2'
device.
Adjust the 'mmcdev' and the distro command 'func' accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Currently, imx6q udoo board fails to boot like this:
U-Boot SPL 2022.01-rc3-00061-g95ca715adad3 (Dec 18 2021 - 18:04:40 -0300)
Trying to boot from MMC1
The reason is that the eSDHC controller is not initialized in SPL.
Initialize the eSDHC controller in SPL via C code as DM is not
used in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
- A large number of updates for i.MX8 platforms. We update buildman /
binman to be able to fake binaries if needed, for CI, and tell the user
the binary won't work. Update platforms to build again with these
changes.
The binman node is part of the imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi file which
is duplicated in imx8mm-kontron-n801x-s-u-boot.dtsi and causes
a build error. Remove the duplicate.
Fixes: 3cbb31f0e848 ("arm64: dts: imx8mm: use common binman configuration")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The binman node is part of the imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi file which
is duplicated in phycore-imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi and causes a build
error. Remove the duplicate.
Fixes: 3cbb31f0e848 ("arm64: dts: imx8mm: use common binman configuration")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Use binman to pack images.
Note that imx8mm_venice supports several boards via multiple DTB's thus
in the fit node we must use:
- fit,fdt-list = "of-list"
- fdt-SEQ
- config-SEQ
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Rather than using odd implicit blob-ext naming, explicitly specify the
type to be of blob-ext and therefore also simplify the node naming.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
With the move to using binman to generate SPL aka u-boot-spl-ddr.bin and
U-Boot proper aka u-boot.itb every board now covers such configuration
in its own U-Boot specific device tree include. Move the comon part of
that configuration to the common imx8mm-u-boot.dtsi include file.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
After all these board switch to binman, we could use common imximage.cfg
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
The standard 1GB Nano was converted to binman, but the 2G version
was neglected. Convert it to binman as well.
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Somewhere along the line, the board stopped being able to boot.
Rather than just fixing the issue, let's fix the issue and migrate
to binman to eliminate a warning when using custom imx tools for
generating the binary.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
To eliminate a warning when using custom imx tools for generating
a binary, use binman to generate flash.bin.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
While converting to binman for an imx8mq board, it has been found that
building in the u-boot CI fails. This is because an imx8mq requires an
external binary (signed_hdmi_imx8m.bin). If this file cannot be found
mkimage fails.
To be able to build this board in the u-boot CI a binman option
(--fake-ext-blobs) is introduced that can be switched on via the u-boot
makefile option BINMAN_FAKE_EXT_BLOBS. With that the needed dummy files are
created.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Revert a clk change, to enable some platforms to work again
- Updates to the udoo NEO family of boards to work correctly
- Fix SiFive Unleashes/Unmatched boards booting
- Update rockchip maintainer entry
This reverts commit 92f1e9a4b3.
The aforementioned patch causes massive breakage on all platforms which
have 'assigned-clock' DT property in their DT which references any clock
that are not supported by the platform clock driver. That can easily
happen either in SPL, or because the clock driver is reduced. Currently
it seems all iMX8M are affected and fail to boot altogether.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@oss.nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
By default the Model information from DT is printed:
CPU: Freescale i.MX6SX rev1.2 996 MHz (running at 792 MHz)
CPU: Extended Commercial temperature grade (-20C to 105C) at 63C
Reset cause: POR
Model: UDOO Neo Basic
Board: UDOO Neo FULL
I2C: ready
As the udoo basic DT is used, such output may be confusing.
Improve it by only printing the Board model instead, which is
read from the board identification GPIOs.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Tommaso Merciai <tomm.merciai@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Tommaso Merciai <tomm.merciai@gmail.com>
Currently, the board model is not printed correctly:
Board: UDOO Neo UNDEFINED
Read the model type in SPL and store it the internal OCRAM, so that
U-Boot proper can retrieve it correctly.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable support for USB and USB storage on the UDOO Neo.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The ethernet has a RMII not RGMII, also needs DM_MDIO and finally
initialise it later in the process as it's not needed that early on
and not everything is ready so it locks up the device.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
This fixes booting from the mSD card from both SPL and when
using it for the OS booting. It also cleans up a few mmc
booting bits that are no longer needed.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
When using QEMU to have a quick test of booting U-Boot S-mode payload
directly without the needs of preparing the SPI flash or SD card images
for SiFive Unleashed board, as per the instructions [1], it currently
does not boot any more.
This was caused by the OF_PRIOR_STAGE removal, as gd->fdt_blob no longer
points to a valid DTB. OF_BOARD is supposed to replace OF_PRIOR_STAGE,
hence we need to add the OF_BOARD logic in board_fdt_blob_setup().
[1] https://qemu.readthedocs.io/en/latest/system/riscv/sifive_u.html#running-u-boot
Fixes: 2e8d2f8843 ("riscv: Remove OF_PRIOR_STAGE from RISC-V boards")
Fixes: d6f8ab30a2 ("treewide: Remove OF_PRIOR_STAGE")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In AOSP, both VIM3 and VIM3L have 2 bootloader flavors,
depending on A/B enablement.
For example, for vim3l, the naming is:
- u-boot_kvim3l_noab.bin : legacy support
- u-boot_kvim3l_ab.bin : A/B support
Prepare a defconfig to support u-boot_kvim3_ab.bin and
u-boot_kvim3l_ab.bin.
This is identical to khadas-vim3{l}_ab_android but will be updated in
the next commit.
Also update partitioning tables for A/B support.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211122152207.219023-4-mkorpershoek@baylibre.com
On Meson GXL, GXM, AXG, G12A, G12B & SM1 SoCs, we can generate an unique
MAC address if none valid found in the eFuses storage.
Only the GXBB based boards doesn't have a fallback way to generate an
unique MAC address, so we rely on CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR to have
a valid one.
An exception is the Radxa Zero board who doesn't have Ethernet on board
so depends on an (or multiple) eventual USB adapters, so leaving the
CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR configs seems safer.
Suggested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211122110710.1038893-1-narmstrong@baylibre.com
Recent changes caused fields in the image main header to be modified
after the header checksum had already been computed. Move the checksum
computation to once again be the last operation performed on the header.
Fixes: 2b0980c240 ("tools: kwbimage: Fill the real header size into the main header")
Signed-off-by: Pierre Bourdon <delroth@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Perform reset before core initialization.
Standard flow which close to 99% users are using getting all IPs out of
reset that there is no need to reset IP again. This is because of all low
level initialization is done in previous bootloader stage.
In SOM case these IPs are not touched by previous bootloader stage that's
why reset needs to be called before IP is accessed to make sure that it is
in correct state.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/5ae1c85b282d632bb62030f1f24a0065661b9153.1638804318.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
Xilinx DTS files are using two way how to describe ethernet phy.
The first (already supported) has phy as subnode of gem node.
eth {
phy-handle = <&phy0>;
phy0: ethernet-phy@21 {
...
};
};
The second has mdio subnode (with mdio name) which has phy subnode. This
structure allow hadling MDIO reset signal (based on Linux mdio.yaml)
eth {
phy-handle = <&phy0>;
mdio {
phy0: ethernet-phy@21 {
...
};
};
};
This patch adds support for the second case where mdio subnode
is found driver will look at its parent to find out which gem is handling
MDIO bus.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/6748007f0b6db9554d7a4b52352dce23ca403f9d.1638798796.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
Current code assumes that the vector base address is always at 0x0.
However, this value is configurable for MicroBlaze, so update the
__setup_exceptions routine to work with any vector base address.
The r4 register is reserved for the vector base address inside
__setup_exceptions and the function prologe/epilogue are also updated to
save and restore r4.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211130163358.2531677-9-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Microblaze is one the last two users of the CONFIG_SYS_RESET_ADDRESS
macro (the other is arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/cpu.c, but the macro is not
defined anywhere in powerpc code, so it should be removed there too).
Replace CONFIG_SYS_RESET_ADDRESS usage in start.S with
CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE. If the reset address should really be
user-configurable, a new Kconfig option could be added.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211130163358.2531677-6-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT and SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT if CONFIG_SPL=y, in
order to fix the following link failures:
common/spl/spl.o: in function `board_init_r':
common/spl/spl.c:755: undefined reference to `puts'
...
common/spl/spl.o: in function `board_init_r':
common/spl/spl.c:756: undefined reference to `hang'
common/spl/spl.c:740: undefined reference to `memset'
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211130163358.2531677-4-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
board_fdt_blob_setup() uses the _end symbol to find the dtb in the non-spl
case. In order to allow microblaze builds to compile successfully with
CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE, the _end symbol must be defined. Align microblaze with
the other architectures and use _end symbol rather than __end to mark the
end of the u-boot binary.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211130163358.2531677-2-ovidiu.panait@windriver.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
DTBs are explicitly listed in the image source file for this board, and
this list already became outdated.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
The memory layout is taken from the device tree passed to us by
m1n1, so there is no need to define this.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The SMSC driver is using the old driver model.
Init the virtio system in vexpress64.c so that the network device is
discovered.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Capture x0 in lowlevel_init.S as potential fdt address. Modify
board_fdt_blob_setup to use fdt address from either vexpress_aemv8.h
or lowlevel_init.S.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Move env var address values to #defines so they can be reused elsewhere.
Rename env var names to those recommended in the README and modify
addresses to allow more space for the kernel.
Fix issue where fdt is called with invalid arguments when booting
without a ramdisk.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Rename from vexpress_aemv8a.h -> vepxress_aemv8.h as new FVPs may not be
v8-A. No change in behavior.
This is towards future work to enable support for the FVP_BaseR.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Create a new documentation section for Arm Ltd boards with a sub-page
for the VExpress64 boards (FVP-A and Juno).
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When using a recent kernel with a bunch of compiled-in
stuff the kernel image easily becomes bigger than 8 MB
yielding this error:
Loading Kernel Image
Image too large: increase CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN
Must RESET board to recover
Fix this by bumping to SZ_64MB.
Cc: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Signed-off-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Since EFI does not relocate and uses the same global_data pointer
throughout the board-init process, drop this unnecessary setup, to avoid
a hang.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Show the revision of this table as it can be important.
Also update the 'efi table' entry to show the actual address of the EFI
table rather than our table that points to it. This saves a step and the
intermediate table has nothing else in it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This provides access to EFI tables after U-Boot has exited boot services.
It is not needed in the app since boot services remain alive and we can
just call them whenever needed.
Add a comment to explain this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The stub checks for failure with efi_init(). Add this for the app as well.
It is unlikely that anything can be done, but we may as well stop.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present each of these has its own static variable and helper functions.
Move them into a shared file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This should return false when the EFI app is running, since UEFI has done
the required low-level init. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present only 4KB of spare space is left in the DTB when building the
EFI app. Increase this to 32KB so there is plenty of space to insert the
binman definition. This cannot be expanded later (as with OF_SEPARATE)
because the ELF image has already been built.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviwed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
If the 'bootm' command is not enabled then this code is not available and
this causes a link error. Fix it.
Note that for the EFI app, there is no indication of missing code. It just
hangs!
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
At present this is disabled, but it should work so long as the kernel does
not need EFI services. Enable it and add a note about remaining work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present only the backspace key is supported in U-Boot, when running as
an EFI app. Add support for arrows, home and end as well, to make the CLI
more friendly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
When starting the app, locate all block devices and make them available
to U-Boot. This allows listing partitions and accessing files in
filesystems.
EFI also has the concept of 'disks', meaning boot media. For now, this
is not obviously useful in U-Boot, but add code to at least locate these.
This can be expanded later as needed.
We cannot use printf() in the early stub or app since it is not compiled
in
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Add some long overdue instructions for building and installing U-Boot on
Allwinner SoC based boards.
This describes the building process, including TF-A and crust, plus
installation to SD card, eMMC and SPI flash, both from Linux and U-Boot
itself. Also describe FEL booting.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Currently we allow and explicitly check a single shared page with
StandAloneMM. This is dictated by OP-TEE which runs the application.
However there's no way for us dynamically discover the number of pages we
are allowed to use. Since writing big EFI signature list variable
requires more than a page, OP-TEE has bumped the number of shared pages to
four.
Let's remove our explicit check and allow the request to reach OP-TEE even
if it's bigger than what it supports. There's no need to sanitize the
number of pages internally. OP-TEE will fail if we try to write more
than it's allowed. The error will just trigger later on, during the
StMM access.
While at it add an error message to help users figure out what failed.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <apalos@gmail.com>
- various fixes to the sandbox display support
- support for showing a logo without splash screen config
- support for BMP drawing to depths other than 16bpp
- tests for the different types of supported BMP images
- support showing a logo when running coreboot via qemu
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc4-4
UEFI:
* allow for more than 16 KiB UEFI variable size when using StMM
Others:
* make watchdog sysreset compatible with separate poweroff driver
* avoid OpenSSL deprecation warnings
- Merge a large number of CONFIG migration patches. Most of these are
taking existing migrations and re-running them. A few of these needed
additional minor conversions done first, so that more complex
dependencies could be expressed. In the end we now have CI jobs to
ensure that no migrated symbols are used in board config header files.
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_JFFS2_DEV
CONFIG_JFFS2_LZO
CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND
CONFIG_JFFS2_PART_OFFSET
CONFIG_JFFS2_PART_SIZE
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_88F5182
CONFIG_BOARD_IS_OPENRD_BASE
CONFIG_BOARD_IS_OPENRD_CLIENT
CONFIG_BOARD_IS_OPENRD_ULTIMATE
CONFIG_D2NET_V2
CONFIG_FEROCEON
CONFIG_FEROCEON_88FR131
CONFIG_INETSPACE_V2
CONFIG_KW88F6192
CONFIG_KW88F6281
CONFIG_KW88F6702
CONFIG_NET2BIG_V2
CONFIG_NETSPACE_LITE_V2
CONFIG_NETSPACE_MAX_V2
CONFIG_NETSPACE_MINI_V2
CONFIG_NETSPACE_V2
CONFIG_SHEEVA_88SV131
At this point mv-plug-common.h is now only an include of mv-common.h so
remove that indirection.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There are a number of symbols that are never defined, only referenced in
code imported from the Linux kernel or similar. Drop them from the list.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The only place we use CONFIG_CPU_ARMV8 was in the arm_dcc serial driver.
Switch this to CONFIG_ARM64 today, and if in the future we need finer
granularity tuning here, a new CONFIG_SERIAL option needs to be
introduced.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Now that all symbols that exist in Kconfig no longer also have boards
setting them in the board config.h file, add a CI test to catch new
instances of this, and fail.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In order to finish moving this symbol to Kconfig for all platforms, we
need to do a few more things. First, for all platforms that define this
to a function, introduce CONFIG_DYNAMIC_SYS_CLK_FREQ, similar to
CONFIG_DYNAMIC_DDR_CLK_FREQ and populate clock_legacy.h. This entails
also switching all users from CONFIG_SYS_CLK_FREQ to get_board_sys_clk()
and updating a few preprocessor tests.
With that done, all platforms that define a value here can be converted
to Kconfig, and a fall-back of zero is sufficiently safe to use (and
what is used today in cases where code may or may not have this
available). Make sure that code which calls this function includes
<clock_legacy.h> to get the prototype.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This CONFIG option is used in one of two ways. The first way is that it
is defined to a static value, of an unsigned long size. The second way
is that it is defined to something, typically a function, to determine
this value at run time.
However, in a few cases that function returns a static value. Change
that to using the static value directly.
In the case of using something at run time, convert everything to using
a function of the same name and prototype. This will allow for further
cleanups.
Finally, we have a few cases where the function is just not used, so
drop it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When we have CONFIG_DYNAMIC_DDR_CLK_FREQ set is the only time we should
have this function, so guard it so that we can include <clock_legacy.h>
in this file later on.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When we have CONFIG_DYNAMIC_DDR_CLK_FREQ set is the only time we should
have this function, so guard it so that we can include <clock_legacy.h>
in this file later on.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The values CONFIG_SYS_CLK_FREQ_C100 and CONFIG_SYS_CLK_FREQ_C110 are
only used in one place and not changed by the board config file. Move
these out of the CONFIG namespace and in to the CFG namespace.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In order to finish this conversion we need to add a symbols for
SPL_SYS_NAND_SELF_INIT and TPL_SYS_NAND_SELF_INIT as there are cases
there where we need to, or need to not, use that framework as things
stand.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CLK
We move the exiting option to common/Kconfig near the other options to
control the contents of board_init_f() and note that this is a legacy
option. We further restrict this to where the call is going to be
non-empty, for the SoCs that had only been using this for some
MMC-related clocks.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In the case of CONFIG_SYS_FDT_ADDR this was being used to modify the
default value of fdt_addr / fdt_addr_r, which is not something to expose
in this manner and is not otherwise done. The case of SYS_ENV_ADDR is
similar but only done on the pic32mzdask platform, for scriptaddr.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_VID
CONFIG_VOL_MONITOR_INA220
CONFIG_VOL_MONITOR_IR36021_READ
CONFIG_VOL_MONITOR_IR36021_SET
CONFIG_VOL_MONITOR_LTC3882_READ
CONFIG_VOL_MONITOR_LTC3882_SET
To finish this migration, we first need to introduce CONFIG_SPL_VID as
some platforms only use this code in full U-Boot while others use it in
SPL as well. To make the Kconfig logic clearer, guard all of the
sub-options with a if VID || SPL_VID check. Finally, add Kconfig
options for the remaining related options that did not previously have
one.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_IMMR
We do this by consolidating the SYS_IMMR options we have and providing
defaults.
We also, in the few places where M68K was also sharing code with these
platforms, define it within the file to CONFIG_SYS_MBAR to match usage.
This should be cleaned up longer term.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START
CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END
This is removing unused defines and correcting the default value to be
0x0 as we are a hex symbol.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Because of how these symbols work, and the remaining board config.h file
uses, we need to do these at the same time. In some cases we just get
to move rather directly to the defconfigs. A few cases require manual
intervention.
For the case of the eb_cpu5282 we need to select HW_WATCHDOG for the
target, given how it's implemented.
For the cases of m53menlo, dh_imx6, display5, and display5_factory we
disable SPL watchdog support as the particular combination of options
they want would require either more symbols or enabling SPL_DM.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_DRIVER_ECC_LAYOUT
In order to do this conversion, expose this option to the user and
use "save" not "safe" in the text.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
This fixes a few platforms where the option was not taking effect as
intended.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This option is used as part of configuring the default environment for a
number of platforms. However, it is always set to 1 and the only time
it is part of Kconfig, it is used in a hard-coded manner. Hard-code the
value in the environment instead.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_FSL_IFC
This is done via select statements to match previous logic.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_ENV_SPI_BUS
CONFIG_ENV_SPI_CS
CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ
CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE
As part of this, we use Kconfig to provide the defaults now that were
done in include/spi_flash.h. We also in some cases change from using
CONFIG_ENV_SPI_FOO to CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_FOO as those were the values in
use anyhow as ENV was not enabled.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This is a "hex" prompt but the default value was given as an int.
Switch the default to hex (0x0) and remove the defconfigs that were
using the default, but as hex before.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
If clk_get_by_name() returns 0 it means it executed successfully while now
we consider it as an error. So let's check if return value is negative to
be an error. Otherwise this prevents "axi" and "disp_axi" to be enabled.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
It is useful to boot coreboot (with U-Boot as a payload) from qemu. Add
a sample script to show how to do this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable this for boards with a display, unless they are using the SPLASH
feature.
This shows a U-Boot logo on boards with a display, which seems like a
useful thing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Show the U-Boot logo by default. This is only 7KB in size so seems like
a useful default for boards that enable a display.
If SPLASH_SCREEN is enabled, it is not enabled by default, so as not to
conflict with that feature.
Also disable it for tests, since we don't want to complicate the output.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This driver is obsolete and only used by nokia_rx51. It should be deleted.
For now, drop the VIDEO_LOGO code to avoid confusion with the new
implementation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
Note that this option depends on CONFIG_DM_VIDEO now, since cfb_console is
deprecated. The only relevant code is now in splash.c
Drop the check for DM_VIDEO in that file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this uses RGB555 format for blitting to a display. Sandbox uses
565 and that seems to be more normal for BMP as well. Update the code
accordingly and add a test.
Note that this likely breaks the theadorable board so we may need to
discuss supporting both formats.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this code to use write_pix8() rather than writing the pixels only
for a single supported display depth. This allows us to support any
depth.
Add some more tests too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the code that writes to a pixel is quite convoluted. It uses a
colour map which is in the uclass and the same code is repeated in
different places within video_bmp_display().
As a first step, create a function which can write a pixel from the
bitmap, no matter what the display depth. Use any provided palette
directly, rather than using the uclass version.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This does not work with sandbox at present. Fix it up to use map_sysmem()
to convert an address to a pointer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a few more tests for BMP rendering. Use a back door into the sandbox
SDL driver to adjust the resolution at runtime.
The truetype code does not support 8bpp. Add this so that the display is
not blank when running in this mode.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The intention is for the copy base to start halfway through the
frame-buffer area. At present is it actually below the frame buffer,
which could have anything in it (probably it is malloc space). Fix
this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If U-Boot starts with the frame buffer set to 16bpp but then runs a test
that uses 32bpp, there is not enough space. Update the driver to use the
maximum possible frame-buffer size, to avoid this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The video driver uses this for debugging, but if used before relocation it
crashes at present. Avoid trying to output debugging before the console is
ready.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When unit tests are run they currently create a new window. Update the
code so that the old one is removed first. This avoids the confusion as to
which one is active.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present sandbox only supports 16 and 32bpp depths, since those are the
easy ones with SDL.
We can support other depths by manually converting the pixel formats. Add
support for this, to enable an 8ppp (monochrome) format.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Our Gitlab CI buildsystem is set up to treat warnings as errors.
With OpenSSL 3.0 a lot of deprecation warnings occur.
With the patch compatibility with OpenSSL 1.1.1 is declared.
In the long run we should upgrade our code to use the current API.
A -Wdiscarded-qualifiers warning is muted by casting.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The watchdog system reset driver can reboot the device but it cannot power
it off. If power off is requested, the driver should not reset the system
but leave powering off to one of the other system reset drivers.
As power cycling is typically not a feature of a watchdog driver the reset
types SYSRESET_POWER and SYSRESET_POWER_OFF shall both be excluded.
Fixes: 17a0c14164 ("dm: sysreset: add watchdog-reboot driver")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently we allow and explicitly check a single shared page with
StandAloneMM. This is dictated by OP-TEE which runs the application.
However there's no way for us dynamically discover the number of pages we
are allowed to use. Since writing big EFI signature list variable
requires more than a page, OP-TEE has bumped the number of shared pages to
four.
Let's remove our explicit check and allow the request to reach OP-TEE even
if it's bigger than what it supports. There's no need to sanitize the
number of pages internally. OP-TEE will fail if we try to write more
than it's allowed. The error will just trigger later on, during the
StMM access.
While at it add an error message to help users figure out what failed.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <apalos@gmail.com>
Merge v8 of Simon's series to make CONFIG_OF_BOARD a boolean option.
Quoting him:
With Ilias' efforts we have dropped OF_PRIOR_STAGE and OF_HOSTFILE so
there are only three ways to obtain a devicetree:
- OF_SEPARATE - the normal way, where the devicetree is built and
appended to U-Boot
- OF_EMBED - for development purposes, the devicetree is embedded in
the ELF file (also used for EFI)
- OF_BOARD - the board figures it out on its own
The last one is currently set up so that no devicetree is needed at all
in the U-Boot tree. Most boards do provide one, but some don't. Some
don't even provide instructions on how to boot on the board.
The problems with this approach were covered in another patch[1], since
removed from this series.
In practice, OF_BOARD is not really distinct from OF_SEPARATE. Any board
can obtain its devicetree at runtime, even it is has a devicetree built
in U-Boot. This is because U-Boot may be a second-stage bootloader and its
caller may have a better idea about the hardware available in the machine.
This is the case with a few QEMU boards, for example.
So it makes no sense to have OF_BOARD as a 'choice'. It should be an
option, available with either OF_SEPARATE or OF_EMBED. This would allow
rpi3, for example, to run with the devicetree provided by the prior
bootloader.
This series makes this change, adding various missing devicetree files
(and placeholders) to make the build work.
To make the 'prior stage' side of things more deterministic, a new
OF_HAS_PRIOR_STAGE is added, which cannot be disabled by updated a board's
defconfig. This should help to prevent mistakes.
It also adds a run-time message showing where the devicetree came from,
as well as warnings if the board's expected flow is not being used. This
comes originally from the 'standard passage' series, which depends on
this series.
It also provides a few qemu clean-ups discovered along the way. The
qemu-riscv64_spl problem is fixed.
Please see [2] for discussion on the v6 series.
I put Heinrich's Tested-by tag[3] for the series onto the three devicetree
patches (ARM and RISC-V) that I think it most affects. It isn't possible
to apply a tag to a whole series at present and in any case there are
changes in v7.
This series is available at u-boot-dm/ofb-working
[1] https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/20211207001209.3467163-2-sjg@chromium.org/
[2] https://lore.kernel.org/u-boot/20211205133207.GW1220664@bill-the-cat/T/#mcd8c0258827fbc1bb3000b7ff9ba0929df1ddcb2
[3] https://lore.kernel.org/u-boot/93913911-4d20-d28f-ee04-739985184c5e@canonical.com/raw
Rockchip BootRom supports new idb header v2 instead of legacy version.
Add support for it so that we can generate image for new SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Yi Liu <liuyi@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Enable efuse support for reading the cpuid#, serial# and generate a
board unique mac address
Signed-off-by: Sjoerd Simons <sjoerd@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The USB controller index must be separated from the type argument,
otherwise the preboot command fails with the error:
Error: Wrong USB controller index format
Add the missing space to fix fastboot mode here.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
PX30.Core is an EDIMM SOM based on Rockchip PX30 from Engicam.
C.TOUCH 2.0 is a general purpose carrier board with capacitive
touch interface support.
10.1" OF is a capacitive touch 10.1" Open Frame panel solutions.
PX30.Core needs to mount on top of C.TOUCH 2.0 carrier with pluged
10.1" OF for creating complete PX30.Core C.TOUCH 2.0 10.1" Open Frame.
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Sync the px30 devicetree files from linux-next tree.
commit <14ce8069f48b> ("lib/stackdepot: allow optional init and
stack_table allocation by kvmalloc() - fixup3")
Note, this path even sync rk3326 files as it depends on px30.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
dmc node is specific to U-Boot, it is always better practice
to maintain U-Boot specific nodes into -u-boot.dtsi files
in order to maintain Linux dts file sync compatibility.
Move the dmc into px30-u-boot.dtsi, also add dmc node
explicitly in rk3326-odroid-go2-u-boot.dtsi since it is
using px30.dts.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Long gone is the time a custom TF-A was needed for Puma, upstream TF-A
works just fine now.
The flashing instructions are updated to match how newer rkdeveloptool
and rkbin work.
Finally, rkbin provides a way to flash SPI via USB OTG interface so
let's document that.
Cc: Quentin Schulz <foss+u-boot@0leil.net>
Signed-off-by: Quentin Schulz <quentin.schulz@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The Odroid Go Advance has a hardware random number generator present.
The device does not have an upstream Linux driver, but does have a
U-Boot driver. Add the appropriate node so that the hardware RNG can be
used in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Allow the kaslr-seed value in the chosen node to be set from a hardware
rng source.
Tested on a Rockchip PX30 (Odroid Go Advance), you must have loaded
the devicetree first and prepared it for editing. On my device the
workflow goes as follows:
setenv dtb_loadaddr "0x01f00000"
load mmc 0:1 ${dtb_loadaddr} rk3326-odroid-go2.dtb
fdt addr ${dtb_loadaddr}
fdt resize
kaslrseed
and the output can be seen here:
fdt print /chosen
chosen {
kaslr-seed = <0x6f61df74 0x6f7b996c>;
stdout-path = "serial2:115200n8";
};
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When running, if the devicetree failed to come from the expected source,
show a warning, e.g:
U-Boot ...
DRAM: 128 MiB
Core: 42 devices, 11 uclasses, devicetree: separate
Warning: Unexpected devicetree source (not from a prior stage)
Warning: U-Boot may not function properly
Flash: 64 MiB
...
These warnings should only appear if the board config has been changed, or
the prior stage is broken.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-Boot always needs some sort of a device tree in the build. Some boards
never actually use this, at least in production systems, since a prior
firmware stage sets one up and passes it to U-Boot. At present the only
mechanism to do that is with custom function (OF_BOARD), but future work
will include a standard way of doing this ('standard passage').
It can be confusing to see a device tree emitted from the U-Boot build in
this situation. Add an option to drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Boards which define OF_HAS_PRIOR_STAGE must define OF_BOARD at present,
since a custom function is the only way to obtain the devicetree at
runtime.
Add a build error when this requirement is not met, to avoid accepting
any patches which break this requirement.
Add an allowlist for boards which use it, currently none. This allowlist
can be updated for local development, if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: change of_whitelist to of_allowlist]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Use this new Kconfig instead of OF_BOARD, so we know for sure which boards
obtain their devicetree from a prior stage. Leave sandbox alone since it
does not. Also don't touch xilinx_versal_virt since it does not have a
specific TARGET Kconfig.
This option implies OF_BOARD for now, but with future work standard
passage may be used instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Add rpi_4_32b and rpi_arm64 to the list of boards converted]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When U-Boot is started from another firmware program, not just a prior
phase of U-Boot, special behaviour is typically used. In particular, the
device tree may come from that prior stage.
At present this is sort-of indicated by OF_BOARD, although the
correlation is not 1:1, since that option simply means that the board has
a custom mechanism for obtaining the device tree. For example, sandbox
defines OF_BOARD. Also the board_fdt_blob_setup() function can in fact
make use of the devicetree in U-Boot if it wishes, as used by
dragonboard410c until very recently.
Add an explicit Kconfig for this situation. Update the OF_BOARD option to
more-accurately reflect what it is doing, e.g. for sandbox.
Drop the docs in the README as it is out of date.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It can be confusing to figure out where the devicetree came from. It seems
important enough to warrant a message during boot. Add information about
the number of devices and uclasses too since it is helpful to have some
idea what is going on with driver model.
Report the devicetree source in bdinfo too.
This looks something like this, with > marking the new line.
U-Boot 2021.10-00190 (Oct 30 2021 - 09:01:29 -0600)
DRAM: 128 MiB
> Core: 42 devices, 11 uclasses, devicetree: passage
Flash: 64 MiB
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this override function is called even when OF_BOARD is not
enabled. This makes it impossible to disable this feature and in fact
makes the OF_BOARD option useless.
Reinstate its intended purpose, so that it is possible to switch between
the appended devicetree and one provided by the board's custom function.
A follower patch adds warnings for this scenario, but for now we don't
have a Kconfig that definitively tells us that OF_BOARD should be used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function should only be called when OF_CONTROL is enabled. It
fails in fdtdec_prepare_fdt() anyway, since gd->fdt_blob stays as NULL
if OF_CONTROL is not enabled.
Drop this useless check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This logic is a bit convoluted for one function. Move the mulit-FIT part
into its own function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
At present one must hack the Makefile to see what is going on with these
files. Also it doesn't quite work correctly.
Fix this by using an environment variable for debugging. Update the docs
also.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This was added as a hack to work around not having an in-tree devicetree.
Now that this is fixed it is not needed.
Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This should not be a separate option from OF_SEPARATE. It is a run-time
option to override the devicetree, even if present.
Move the option out of the choice.
Disable BINMAN_FDT for a few boards which don't actually use it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an empty version of this file, so that we can at least build this
board when devicetrees are required.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This uses QEMU virt which creates its own devicetree.
Add an empty version of this file, so that we can at least build this
board when devicetrees are required.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an empty devicetree file for these boards. It seems to be possible to
obtain a real one from another bootloader called 'bolt' but I will leave
this to the maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an empty file to prevent build errors when building with
CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE enabled.
Unfortunately there are no build instructions in the U-Boot tree to enable
a real file to be created.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an empty version of this file, so that we can at least build this
board when devicetrees are required.
The real devicetree is created by the Xen project on-the-fly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sync these file, obtained from Linux v5.15.
Add a note for the maintainer, and SPDX lines where they are missing.
The added lines are:
SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0 OR BSD-3-Clause
Note, this matches the text in those files, but is not the same as the
GPL-2.0 of some files.
[1] https://releases.linaro.org/android/reference-lcr/juno/7.1-17.05/
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Sync these files, obtained from Linux v5.15.
This adds a devicetree file for rpi_4 which was not there before.
Testing shows no change so far as I can see:
- boots to U-Boot prompt on rpi0, rpi2
- boots to distro on rpi3
- boots to distro on rpi4
I am assuming that syncing with Linux is safe, but the maintainer should
know for sure.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This uses QEMU virt which creates its own devicetree.
Copy the existing empty version of this file, so splitting the existing
qemu-virt into two, since anyone actually trying to use this will need a
different devicetree for 32- and 64-bit machines.
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canaonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This uses QEMU virt which creates its own devicetree.
Add an empty version of this file, so that we can at least build this
board when devicetrees are required.
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canaonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This uses QEMU virt which creates its own devicetree.
Add an empty version of this file, so that we can at least build this
board when devicetrees are required.
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canaonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
QEMU currently generates a devicetree for use with U-Boot. Explain how to
obtain it.
Also explain how to merge it to produce a devicetree with the U-Boot
features included.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Without this option QEMU appears to hang. Add it to avoid confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
doc/usage/index.rst in branch origin/next includes usage/environment twice.
Remove the duplicate entry.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The global data pointer is not used in this driver, remove it's
declaration.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use more appropriate resource_size() function when working with data in
struct resource.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function mvebu_pcie_setup_wins() sets up all other BARs, so move setup of
BAR[0] to this function to have common code at one place.
In the past, commit 193a1e9f19 ("pci: pci_mvebu: set BAR0 after memory
space is set") moved setup of BAR[0] to another location, due to ath10k
not working in kernel, but the reason why was unknown, but it seems to
work now, and we think the issue then was cause by the PCIe Root Port
presenting itself as a Memory Controller and therefore U-Boot's code
have overwritten the BAR. Since the driver now ignores any write
operations to PCIe Root Port BARs, this should not be an issue anymore.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit "fw_setenv: lock the flash only if it was locked before"
checks for Locked status with uninitialized erase data.
Address by moving the test for MEMISLOCKED.
Fixes: 8a726b852502 ("fw_setenv: lock the flash only if it was locked before")
Signed-off-by: Joakim Tjernlund <joakim.tjernlund@infinera.com>
Testing on Armada XP with an EEPROM using register address with size
of 2 has shown, that the register address bytes are sent to the I2C
EEPROM in the incorrect order. This patch swabs the address bytes so
that the correct address is transferred to the I2C device.
BTW: This worked without any issues before migrating Armada XP to
DM I2C.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Cc: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
There is no point to hide/disable fatal errors via debug() macro.
Print fatal errors loudly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Include file debug_uart.h already contains documentation how to use it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There is no maintainer entry for serial_mvebu_a3700.c. Add entry with Pali
and Stefan as maintainers.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There is no maintainer entry for pci-aardvark.c. Add entry for
pci-aardvark.c and pci_mvebu.c with Pali and Stefan as maintainers.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This is a backport from Marvell U-Boot:
https://github.com/MarvellEmbeddedProcessors/u-boot-marvell
commit 381d029e7a ("fix: serdes: a38x, a39x: Improve USB3 electrical
configuration")
Improves electrical USB3 receiver jitter tolerance test:
- De-Emphasize force, in functional mode the transmitter should always
have 3.5db de-emphasize, so we are forcing it.
- After forcing De-Emphasize, choose 3.5db (After forcing, default is
6dB so need to change it to 3.5dB).
- Align90 set to 0x58 - this is the sample point in the receiver, after
the clock is recovered this sampler samples at the chosen value, usually
it is supposed to be 0x60(which is the center of the eye), but sometimes
after adding jitter and ISI the center of the eye can move slightly and
the sample point is not necessarily the exact center, and after
optimization (searching the middle of the eye manually) it was seen that
the center of the eye is actually 0x58 and not 0x60.
- FFE Res and FFE Cap set to 0xE & 0xF respectively: improves this
settings is adequate according to how the USB3 spec defines the
interconnect, thus improves USB3 jitter tolerance settings.
- Change the resolution of the DFE to 0x3 which is 6mV(highest
resolution) , this avoids the DFE to saturate and cease to work.
- HPF set to 0x3 which is 5Khz high pass filter, the function of the HPF
is to filter the low frequency patterns(below 5Khz) to make sure that
the signal is not a noise, the setting before was 0x1(205Khz), and the
change came since the USB3 CP0 pattern, that is used in the USB3 jitter
tolerance testing, is similar to PRBS15, which has 2^15=32768bits which
is 32768*200ps (200ps is one Unit interval in USB3(5Gbps)) = 6.5us,
which is in frequency terms: 152Khz. since the PRBS15 is a random
pattern and can theoretically have once in a while a pattern that will
be at frequency of 152Khz, hence the previous setting (205khz HPF) can
possibly filter this pattern which can cause to an error in the
receiver, thus this change to avoid such scenarios.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Eichenberger <eichest@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: René Straub <rene.straub@netmodule.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The electrical serdes configuration for USB3 expects an array as data
argument. For USB3 the second value is used (see data_arr_idx = USB3 =
1). However, because only one value is inside the array mv_seq_exec is
accessing an invalid element and the serdes is configured wrongly.
This wrong initialization is leading to an unreliable detection
mechanism for some USB3 devices. We were able to reproduce the issue
regularly with an LTE modem from Sierra Wireless (SM7455) where it was
not detected as USB3 device in 1/3 of all tests.
This commit fixes the issue by setting data_arr_idx to 0. This is the
same value as the original U-Boot from Marvell is using. There it is
called FIRST_CELL which is a define for 0.
See: https://github.com/MarvellEmbeddedProcessors/u-boot-marvell
commit 56f963ce4c ("fix: serdes: a38x, a39x: Fix USB3 serdes DB
initialization")
Signed-off-by: Stefan Eichenberger <eichest@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: René Straub <rene.straub@netmodule.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move Turris MOX specific remove_disabled_nodes() to fdt_support with
name fdt_delete_disabled_nodes(), so that others can potentially use it.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The pre-relocation board topology reading in board_fix_fdt() is
unstable: sometimes wrong data are read from the SPI bus.
This is due to wrong order of SPI bus configuration instructions: we
first need to set the pins to SPI mode, and only after that configure
the bus.
Also add a 1ms delay before enabling chip-select, so that the clock pin
is high for some time before reading the bus.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable eth1 node in U-Boot's device-tree if a network module (SFP, Topaz
or Peridot) is detected.
This is required for proper detection of eth1 comphy in a3700 comphy
driver by the following patches.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
It is better to find DT nodes by compatible strings or aliases instead
of path.
There were issues with Linux some DTBs having different names of some
nodes, e.g.
internal-regs
instead of
internal-regs@d0000000
This should be a generic fix for such issues.
Also since fdt_support now contains needed functions, we can drop our
own implementations.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add functions
fdt_node_offset_by_pathf(),
fdt_create_phandle_by_pathf(),
fdt_set_status_by_pathf()
to get node offset, get/create node phandle and set status for node
given by path/alias formatted with sprintf.
Add functions
fdt_create_phandle_by_compatible(),
fdt_set_status_by_compatible()
to get/create node phandle and set status for first node given by
compatible.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This function does not necessarily create a new phandle. If a phandle
exists, no new phandle is created.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The macro __constant_cpu_to_be32() uses ___constant_swab32(), which for
some reason is not defined and causes the following error during
compilation:
include/linux/byteorder/little_endian.h:28:52: warning:
implicit declaration of function ‘___constant_swab32’;
did you mean ‘__builtin_bswap32’? [-Wimplicit-function-declaration]
#define __constant_cpu_to_be32(x) ((__force __be32)___constant_swab32((x)))
Declare all ___constant_swabXX() macros.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
No functional change intended. This patch switches from the legacy I2C
API to the DM I2C API, so that this code can be used with DM I2C
enabled.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After all Armada XP boards have been switched over from legacy I2C
support to DM I2C, let's now also convert this serdes code to use
the DM I2C API.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
No functional change intended. This patch switches from the legacy I2C
API to the DM I2C API, so that this code can be used with DM I2C
enabled.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move to the DM I2C version, so that this board will not get dropped from
mainline.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc4-3
Documentation:
* add Calxeda Highbank/Midway board documentation
Bug fixes:
* call part_init() in blk_get_device_by_str() only for MMC
* fix an 'undefined' error in some driver model macros
Due to a non-existing parameter name in macro's, use of those macro's will
cause a compiler error of "undefined reference".
Unfortunately, dm test doesn't fail because a wrong name ("&dev", hence it
is accidentally a valid name in the context of a caller site) is passed on.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Fixes: f262d4ca4b ("dm: core: Add a way to read platdata for all
child devices")
Fixes: 903e83ee84 ("dm: core: Add a way to iterate through children,
probing each")
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In blk_get_device_by_str(), the comment says: "Updates the partition table
for the specified hw partition."
Since hw partition is supported only on MMC, it makes no sense to do so
for other devices.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Calxeda servers are using U-Boot as the primary bootloader, which
was shipped as part of a firmware upgrade package.
Even though the machines are considered legacy at this point, the port
still works, so deserves some documentation.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In strange cases it is possible for fdtgrep to find nothing to output.
Typically this means that the resulting SPL device tree is not going to
allow anything to boot, but at present the tree is actually invalid,
since it only has an END tag in the struct region.
The FDT spec requires at least a root node. So add a special case to
include at least this, if the FDT_REG_SUPERNODES flag is set.
This ensures that grepping an empty tree still produces a valid tree.
Also add comments to the enum since it is not completely obvious from
the names now.
The typical symptom of this problem is a message from binman:
pylibfdt error -11: FDT_ERR_BADSTRUCTURE
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When outputting a devicetree we should not align the struct section to a
16-byte boundary. The normal position is fine, which is 8-byte aligned.
This avoids leaving adding 8 extra zero bytes in the output tree in the
case where the reserved section is empty (i.e has 16 zero bytes).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the 'missing-msg' for blobs for more detailed output on missing system
firmware and SEBoot blobs.
Signed-off-by: Ivan Mikhaylov <ivan.mikhaylov@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix minor typos:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Instead of joining hard coded '..' to the run-time path of the executable,
take just a dirname out of it. Besides that, use $(srctree) where it makes
sense.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Importing libraries in Python caches the bytecode by default.
Since we run scripts in source tree it ignores the current directory
settings, which is $(srctree), and creates cache just in the middle
of the source tree. Move cache to the current directory.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
This format is used in firmware binaries so we may as well supported it.
With this patch binman supports creating, listing and updating FIPs, as
well as extracting files from one, provided that an FDTMAP is also present
somewhere in the image.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for this format which is used by ARM Trusted Firmware to find
firmware binaries to load.
FIP is like a simpler version of FMAP but uses a UUID instead of a name,
for each entry.
It supports reading a FIP, writing a FIP and parsing the ATF source code
to get a list of supported UUIDs.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
First set of u-boot-at91 features for the 2022.04 cycle:
This feature set includes : support for the new QSPI hardware on
sama7g5, small fixes on sam9x60 and sama7g5, some additions of commands
and PIO controller on sam9x60/sam9x60ek.
Double peripheral RBF configuration are needed on some devices or boards
to stabilize the IO configuration system.
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Sin Hui Kho <sin.hui.kho@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
This patch triggers warm reset to recover the MPFE NoC from corruption
due to high frequency transient clock output from HPS EMIF IOPLL at
VCO startup after peripheral RBF is programmed.
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Sin Hui Kho <sin.hui.kho@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
The romcode_initswstate register need to be set with FSBL_IMAGE_IS_VALID
value if the current FSBL image is found valid, otherwise BootROM will
look for next subsequent valid FSBL image when warm reset is triggered.
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Sin Hui Kho <sin.hui.kho@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
New SoC's of AT91 family with ARM-9 core includes a regular timer and a 64-bit
timer.This patch adds a compile time option to the Makefile such that the old
timer driver is chosen and compiled as default if none of timer configuration
options are explicitly defined in the board configs.
Signed-off-by: Hari Prasath <Hari.PrasathGE@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY to allow filtering with log command
for generic clock and CCF clocks.
This patch also change existing printf, debug and pr_ macro
to log_ or dev_ macro.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reorder include files in the U-Boot expected order:
the common.h header should always be first,
followed by other headers in order,
then headers with directories,
then local files.
It is a preliminary step for next patch.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Improve clk_get_rate() @return documentation that otherwise is a bit
ambiguous. At the moment I expect to return 0 as error since the return
type is 'ulong', instead the function really returns negative value in
case the corresponding function pointer is null and returns 0 if the clock
is invalid.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
PCI Bridge which represents aardvark PCIe Root Port has Expansion ROM Base
Address register at offset 0x30 but its meaning is different than PCI's
Expansion ROM BAR register. Only address format of register is same.
In reality, this device does not have any configurable PCI BARs. So ensure
that write operation into BARs (including Expansion ROM BAR) is noop and
registers always contain zero address which indicates that bars are
unsupported.
Fixes: cb056005dc ("arm: a37xx: pci: Add support for accessing PCI Bridge on root bus")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The PCI Bridge which represents mvebu PCIe Root Port has Expansion ROM
Base Address register at offset 0x30 but its meaning is different that
of PCI's Expansion ROM BAR register, although the address format of
the register is the same.
In reality, this device does not have any configurable PCI BARs. So
ensure that write operation into BARs (including Expansion ROM BAR) is a
noop and registers always contain zero address which indicates that BARs
are unsupported.
Fixes: a7b61ab58d ("pci: pci_mvebu: Properly configure and use PCI Bridge (PCIe Root Port)")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Since u32 takes up 4 bytes, we need to divide the number of u32s by 4
for cfgcache.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The ethernet PHY must be reset on AV96, however DWMAC currently does
not support the MDIO-bus PHY GPIO reset bindings and the ethernet MAC
PHY reset property is going away on next DT sync. Add PHY specific
reset bindings to trigger the PHY reset and fix sporadic ethernet
malfunctions, until the next DT sync.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add script to read U-Boot from SD card and write it to matching
locations in the SPI NOR, thus making the SPI NOR bootable. The
script erases the entire SPI NOR, including U-Boot environment,
to make sure the installation is clean. To retain environment
from current running U-Boot, run 'saveenv' after running the
'update_sf' script.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The USB hub on STM32MP1 DHCOM boards needs to wait a bit longer until
the USB Vbus is stable. Increase the USB power-good delay to 1 s.
This adds default-undefined STM32MP_BOARD_EXTRA_ENV variable into
stm32mp15_common.h to reduce duplication in board-specific config
files adding custom environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The alternate function of PD20 is 4 as per the datasheet of
sama7g5 and not 5 as defined earlier.
Fixes: 558378a4cd ("ARM: mach-at91: add support for new SoC sama7g5")
Signed-off-by: Hari Prasath <Hari.PrasathGE@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The resync of the device trees from Linux 5.16-rc3 caused aliases
to appear on the MMC devices which changed the numbering.
This changed the default boot device and caused boot failure.
Update the mmcdev variable to reflect the new aliases.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The resync of the device trees from Linux 5.16-rc3 caused aliases
to appear on the MMC devices which changed the numbering.
This broke the reading/writing of the environmental variables,
so update the defconfig accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The rzg2_beacon_defconfig creates an image for RZ/G2[MNH] and
as such creates three different device trees and each of them
have a corresponding -u-boot.dtsi file which are basically
copies of each other. Create a common include file to be
referenced by each of the respective board-u-boot.dtsi files
to reduce duplicate code and simplify support going forward.
This also restores some lost functionality from the device
tree re-sync and updates the MAINTAINER file to include all
beacon-renesom device tree files.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The device trees for the Beacon RZ/G2[MNH] boards have undergone
some changes over time, so resync them now.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The RZ/G2 series uses an external clock as a reference to the AVB.
If this clock is controlled by an external programmable clock,
it must be requested by the consumer or it will not turn on.
In order to do this, update the driver to use bulk enable and
disable functions to enable clocks for boards with multiple clocks.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Pull request efi-2022-01-rc4-2
UEFI:
* correctly handle missing TPM device
* prepare for block devices for U-Boot as EFI app
# gpg: Signature made Fri 10 Dec 2021 04:29:20 AM EST
# gpg: using RSA key 6DC4F9C71F29A6FA06B76D33C481DBBC2C051AC4
# gpg: Good signature from "Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>" [unknown]
# gpg: aka "[jpeg image of size 1389]" [unknown]
# gpg: WARNING: This key is not certified with a trusted signature!
# gpg: There is no indication that the signature belongs to the owner.
# Primary key fingerprint: 6DC4 F9C7 1F29 A6FA 06B7 6D33 C481 DBBC 2C05 1AC4
Add a block driver which handles read/write for EFI block devices. This
driver actually already exists ('efi_block') but is not really suitable
for use as a real U-Boot driver:
- The operations do not provide a udevice
- The code is designed for running as part of EFI loader, so uses
EFI_PRINT() and EFI_CALL().
- The bind method probes the device, which is not permitted
- It uses 'EFI' as its parent device
The new driver is more 'normal', just requiring its platform data be set
up in advance.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
UCLASS_EFI_LOADER is used for devices created by applications and
drivers loaded by U-Boots UEFI implementation.
This patch provides a new uclass (UCLASS_EFI_MEDIA) to be used for devices
that provided by a UEFI firmware calling U-Boot as an EFI application.
If the two uclasses can be unified, is left to future redesign.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
These names are better used for access to devices provided by an EFI
layer. Use EFI_LOADER instead here, since these are only available in
U-Boot's EFI_LOADER layer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
When the TCG2 protocol is installed in efi_tcg2_register(),
TPM2 device must be present.
tcg2_measure_pe_image() expects that TCP2 protocol is installed
and TPM device is available. If TCG2 Protocol is installed but
TPM device is not found, tcg2_measure_pe_image() returns
EFI_SECURITY_VIOLATION and efi_load_image() ends with failure.
The same error handling is applied to
efi_tcg2_measure_efi_app_invocation().
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
There are functions that calls tcg2_agile_log_append() outside
of the TCG protocol invocation (e.g tcg2_measure_pe_image).
These functions must to check that TCG2 protocol is installed.
If not, measurement shall be skipped.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This commit modify efi_tcg2_register() to return the
appropriate error.
With this fix, sandbox will not boot because efi_tcg2_register()
fails due to some missing feature in GetCapabilities.
So disable sandbox if EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL is enabled.
UEFI secure boot variable measurement is not directly related
to TCG2 protocol installation, tcg2_measure_secure_boot_variable()
is moved to the separate function.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Literally adhering to the docs gave this wrong output:
U-Boot> setenv fdtaddr 0x87f00000
U-Boot> fdtaddr $fdtaddr
Unknown command 'fdtaddr' - try 'help'
Fixes: d80162cfc5 ("doc: Document how to apply fdt overlays")
Signed-off-by: Alexander Dahl <ada@thorsis.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This fixes two regressions: eMMC operation on boards with WiFi (so using
three MMC devices), and a repeated wrong error message in USB gadget
mode (fastboot, ums).
The sunxi MUSB glue driver has some code to check for external VBUS
presence when it's going to use the MUSB host mode, and it warns if
there is VBUS provided through the cable (in sunxi_musb_enable()).
This code was apparently copied to the USB gadget detection code
(g_dnl_board_usb_cable_connected()), but here we actually *expect*
external VBUS power, so a warning is wrong and confusing.
So far this message rarely triggered, but a recent patch (6fa41cdd19)
changed this:
===========================
=> ums 0 mmc 2
UMS: LUN 0, dev mmc 2, hwpart 0, sector 0x0, count 0xe90000
A charger is plugged into the OTG
/A charger is plugged into the OTG
\A charger is plugged into the OTG
|A charger is plugged into the OTG
-A charger is plugged into the OTG
....
===========================
Remove the message for the gadget cable detection call, and just return
the status of the VBUS detection, as this is what the callers are after.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Commit 03510bf621 ("sunxi: only include alias for eMMC when mmc2
used") protected the eMMC alias in U-Boot's DT stub the with the
associated Kconfig symbol, but was actually using the wrong name.
Fix the name of the symbol to match what's defined in Kconfig and what
the defconfig files actually use.
Fixes: 03510bf621 ("sunxi: only include alias for eMMC when mmc2 used")
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reported-by: 5kft@5kft.org
Reviewed-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
QSPI0 has a MX66LM1G45G SPI NOR flash connected.
Enable the controller and describe the flash.
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
sama7g5 embedds an OSPI and a QSPI controller:
1/ OSPI0 Supporting Up to 200 MHz DDR. Octal, TwinQuad, Hyperflash
and OctaFlash Protocols Supported.
2/ QSPI1 Supporting Up to 90 MHz DDR/133 MHz SDR.
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
sama7g5 QSPI has:
1/ One Octal Serial Peripheral Interfaces (QSPI0) Supporting Up to
200 MHz DDR. Octal, TwinQuad, Hyperflash and OctaFlash Protocols Supported
2/ One Quad Serial Peripheral Interfaces (QSPI1) Supporting Up to
90 MHz DDR/133 MHz SDR
The QSPI controller of SAMA7G5 uses different clock domains, hence extra
synchronization operations must be performed before accessing some
registers. Differentiate between the versions of the IP using has_gclk.
Differentiate between QSPI0 and QSPI1 with has_octal.
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
binman refactoring to improve section handling
bloblist - allow it to be allocated
sandbox config-header cleanup
# gpg: Signature made Sun 05 Dec 2021 10:14:24 PM EST
# gpg: using RSA key B25C0022AF86A7CC1655B6277F173A3E9008ADE6
# gpg: issuer "sjg@chromium.org"
# gpg: Good signature from "Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>" [unknown]
# gpg: WARNING: This key is not certified with a trusted signature!
# gpg: There is no indication that the signature belongs to the owner.
# Primary key fingerprint: B25C 0022 AF86 A7CC 1655 B627 7F17 3A3E 9008 ADE6
This is not needed anymore. Drop it to simplify the code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CONFIG_SYS_ATA_PORT_ADDR is not used in the code anymore. Drop it and use
ATA_PORT_ADDR() locally instead.
Drop CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE and CONFIG_IDE_SWAP_IO which are also
unused.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is not used by sandbox since it uses driver model for the timer.
Drop it.
Also update the tools_only build to avoid build errors, since it does
actually build U-Boot too. Enable DM so we can use CONFIG_TIMER,
disable EFI_LOADER to avoid an error about board_quiesce_devices() and
disable NET to avoid having to define CONFIG_AVB_BUF_ADDR
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This can go in the related header file. Drop the CONFIG option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At present there are Kconfig options for tracing, but sandbox uses
plain #defines to set them. Correct this and make the tracing command
default to enabled so that this is not needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sometimes it is useful to have a list of related external blobs in a
single entry. An example is the DDR binaries used by meson. There are
9 files in total. Add support for this, so we don't have to have a
separate entry for each.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In some cases entries encapsulate other data and it is useful to access
the data within. An example is the fdtmap which consists of a 16-byte
header, followed by a devicetree.
Provide an option to specify an alternative format when extracting files.
In the case of fdtmap, this is 'fdt', which produces an FDT file which can
be viewed with fdtdump.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If an older version of binman is used to list images created by a newer
one, it is possible that it will contain entry types that are not
supported. At present this produces an error.
Adjust binman to use a plain 'blob' entry type to cope with this, so the
image can at least be listed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present it is necessary to symlink files containing external blobs into
the U-Boot tree in order for binman to find them. This is not very
convenient.
Add two new environment/Makefile variables to help with this. Add
documentation as well, fixing a related nit.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Typically the bloblist is positioned at a fixed address in memory until
relocation. This is convenient when it is set up in SPL or before
relocation.
But for EFI we want to set it up only when U-Boot proper is running. Add
a way to allocate it using malloc() and update the documentation to cover
this aspect of bloblist.
Note there are no tests of this feature at present, nor any direct testing
of bloblist_init().
This can be added, e.g. by making this option controllable at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the constructor to work in the recommended way, where the node
properties are read in a separate function. This makes it more similar to
entry_Section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This currently uses _cbfs_entries[] to store entries. Since the entries
are in fact valid etypes, we may as well use the same name as
entry_Section uses, which is _entries. This allows reusing more of the
code there (in a future patch).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is easier to understand this file if reading the entries comes before
obtaining the contents, since that is the order in which Binman proceeds.
Move the function down a bit.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Expand this to explain subclassing better and also to tidy up formatting
for rST.
Fix a few pylint warnings to avoid dropping the score.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The ObtainContents() and GetEntryContents() methods in this file read
every single entry in the section. This is the common case.
However when one of the entries has had its data updated (e.g. with
'binman replace') we don't want to read it again from the file. Allow
the entry to be skipped, for this purpose. This is currently done in the
CBFS implementation, so adding it here will allow that to use more of
the entry_Section code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This method is currently marked private. However it is useful to be able
to subclass it, since much of the entry_Section code can be reused. Rename
it.
Also document one confusing part of this code, so people can understand
how to add a test for this case.
Fix up a few pylint warnings to avoid regressing the score.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a -V option which shows the version number of binman. For now this
just uses a local 'version' file. Once the tool is packaged in some way
we can figure out an approach that suits.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this file to improve the pylint score a little. The remaining item
is:
Function name "ParseArgs" doesn't conform to snake_case naming style
which needs some binman-wide renaming.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the same technique as with binman to load this module from the U-Boot
tree if available. This allows running tests without having to specify
the PYTHONPATH variable.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When compiled with -Og for better debugability u-boot ends up in a stack
overflow using
gcc (Ubuntu 11.2.0-7ubuntu2) 11.2.0
GNU Binutils for Ubuntu 2.37
putchar(ch) is defined as a macro which ends up calling U-Boot's putc()
implementation instead of the glibc one, which calls os_putc() ...
Let's use fputc(ch, stdout) instead as fputc() does not exist in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
* fixes the bug in function bind_drivers_pass that for
CONFIG_CC_OPTIMIZE_FOR_SIZE=n and no entries in the driver_info list,
i.e. n_ents == 0, the processor steps into the first loop iteration
despite the loop condition being false.
* the Xilinx Zynq-7000 device would eventually hang due to an attempted
access to an invalid memory address
* the bug is fixed by changing the type of idx from uint to int
Board: zynq-zybo
Target: ARM
Compiler: arm-none-eabi-gcc 9.2.1
Signed-off-by: Alexander Preissner <fpga-garage@preissner-muc.de>
Acked-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable saving environment to SPI flash memory on SiFive
Unmatched.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Skibo <thomas-git@skibo.net>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Configure SPI flash devices into SPL. Add SPI boot option to spl.c.
Document how to format flash for booting.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Skibo <thomas-git@skibo.net>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This patch updates Microchip MPFS Icicle Kit support. For now,
add Microchip I2C driver, set environment variables for
mac addresses and default build for SBI_V02.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The device tree split into .dtsi and .dts files, common
device node for eMMC/SD, enable I2C1, UART1 for console
instead of UART0, enable the DDR 2GB memory and in
that 288MB memory is reserved for fabric buffer.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Add I2C driver code for the Microchip PolarFire SoC.
This driver supports I2C data transfer and probe for I2C
slave addresses.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Remove the microchip compatible string and default compatible "cdns,macb"
support both 32-bit and 64-bit DMA access.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Add boot command "bootcmd_ram" to support autoboot from RAM.
This feature could be useful at the very initial state of chip design
when there is only a minimal set of peripheral. (e.g. without mmc and mac ..etc)
The kernel image is default to be loaded at 0x2000000 via debug port,
and the following script serves as an example:
spl()
{
cmd="riscv64-linux-gdb -q \
-ex \"target remote $host:$port\" \
-ex \"load\" \
-ex \"thread apply all set \\\$pc=&_start\" \
-ex \"thread apply all set \\\$a0=\\\$mhartid\" \
-ex \"thread apply all set \\\$a1=<dtb address>\" \
-ex \"restore u-boot.itb binary 0x200000\" \
-ex \"restore Image binary 0x2000000\" \
-ex \"c\" \
spl/u-boot-spl
"
echo $cmd
eval $cmd
}
The address where the kernel is loaded can be altered by
changing the value of KERNEL_IMAGE_ADDR.
Signed-off-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The gpio_request_by_name() returns zero in case of success, however the
conditional return value check in gpio_request_by_name() checks only for
(ret != -ENOENT) and if the condition is true, returns ret outright.
This leads to a situation where successful gpio_request_by_name() return
leads to immediate successful eth_phy_of_to_plat() return as well, and
to skipped parsing of "reset-assert-us" and "reset-deassert-us", so the
PHY driver operates with valid reset GPIO, but with assert/deassert times
set to default, which is 0, instead of the values from DT. This breaks
PHY reset.
Fix this by checking if return value is non-zero and then for this one
single allowed non-zero return value, -ENOENT.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
It turns out that in custom designs if the system is reset
multiple times in conjunction with a slight increase in external
temperature, the felix switch starts to behave in a strange way:
packets are no longer received on the ENECT interface connected
to the L2switch internal port (the TX side of internal port stops working
or the packets do not reach there. It is not very clear where
the packets remain blocked. None of the counters points to a disruption
in the L2switch)
The issue is not reproducible on NXP reference designs.
It was observed that by adding the switch core reset, the problem
goes aways, even if intensive testing in temperature chambers
is applied.
The current patch performs soft reset on the switch core to ensure proper
operation of the L2switch.
Signed-off-by: Radu Bulie <radu-andrei.bulie@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
socat is a very powerful tool to work with socets (and not only)
in UNIX systems. Let's add support for it in netconsole.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Tested-by: Ferry Toth <fntoth@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This symbol is not used anywhere in the code. Just enable in couple of
defconfigs but it does nothing that's why remove it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Wait for the read/write transfer finish bit get actually cleared,
this does not happen immediately on at least SoCFPGA Gen5.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Vignesh R <vigneshr@ti.com>
Cc: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
When, for various reasons, a bad FIT image is used where a loadable
image is marked as 0 length, attempt is made for a 0 length allocation and
read of 0 byte read operation.
Instead provide warning in log and skip attempting to do such a load.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add a message on probe in driver model core when the default
pinctrl selection failed.
This message is displayed only when the pinctrl API is
implemented, i.e. when result is not ENOSYS.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the return value ENOSYS for unsupported API
- pinctrl_generic_set_state
- pinctrl_select_state
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The helper macro CONFIG_IS_ENABLED and CONFIG_VAL are not real
configurations and they are no more present in u-boot.cfg so they can
be removed in config_whitelist.txt.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The two helpers macros CONFIG_IS_ENABLED and CONFIG_VAL are defined in
include/linux/kconfig.h but they are not real configurations; they can
be safely removed in the generated configuration file "u-boot.cfg".
This patch simplifies the comparison of this U-Boot configuration file.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Finish converting CONFIG_USE_BOOTCOMMAND, CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND,
CONFIG_RAMBOOTCOMMAND, CONFIG_NFSBOOTCOMMAND, all of
CONFIG_SYS_[BO]R[0-7]_PRELIM, CONFIG_FSL_DDR_BIST and
CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE.
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR4_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR4_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR5_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR5_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR6_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR6_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_BR7_PRELIM
CONFIG_SYS_OR7_PRELIM
This also introduces CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM_BOOL as not all platforms
that can set these values do so. Add the relevant SYS_BRx_PRELIM_BOOL
to platforms that had not been previously migrated.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_USE_BOOTCOMMAND
CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
CONFIG_RAMBOOTCOMMAND
CONFIG_NFSBOOTCOMMAND
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- add nor1 device support for DFU command
- remove CONFIG_STM32_IPCC from stm32mp15 defconfigs
- enable simple framebuffer node for splashscreen for stm32mp1
- use lower-case hex for address for stm32 MCU and MPU's device tree
- define LOG_CATEGORY for stmfx pinctrl driver
- add support for probing bus voltage level translator
- add custom PHY reset bindings on AV96
- enable KSZ90x1 PHY driver on DHCOR
- stm32mp1 DDR update:
- add DDR read data eye training
- remove DDR calibration result
- remove DDR tuning support
- compute DDR size from DDRCTL registers
- DHSOM boards:
- increase USB power-good delay
- add update_sf script to install U-Boot into SF
- increase PHY auto-negotiation timeout to 20 seconds
- fix SoM and board coding strap GPIO handling
- auto-detect uSD level translator
Add support of mtd backend for nor1 when this device is present on the
board, on STM32MP157C-EV1 for example, as the support of several MTD
spi-nor instance are now supported with commit b7f060565e ("mtd:
spi-nor: allow registering multiple MTDs when DM is enabled").
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Since the commit f42045b2e7 ("stm32mp15: replace CONFIG_TFABOOT when
it is possible") the function stm32mp1_ddr_setup is always called so the
__maybe_unused can be removed.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Compute the DDR size from DDR controller register (mstr and addrmap)
in U-Boot proper as the DDR information are useful only for SPL
but not for U-Boot proper, for example with TFABOOT.
This patch simplify U-Boot DT when several DDR size are supported
and support of next SOC in STM32MP family.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The IPCC mailbox is only used for communication with M4 firmware but
it is not used in the stm32 remoteproc driver; it was planed but the
support of this mailbox in remoteproc for STM32MP15x is dropped.
So the associated drivers and config CONFIG_STM32_IPCC can be
deactivated to reduce the U-Boot size; the CONFIG_DM_MAILBOX can be
also deactivated as the mailbox UCLASS is no more used.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Enable an existing simple framebuffer node in the Linux kernel device
tree and the add the associated reserved memory node to preserved the
resources (clock, memory) used by the stm32 video driver to display
the splashscreen = background in exlinux.conf file.
These resources will be released by the Linux driver only when the
associated driver is ready to avoid transition issues during the Linux
kernel initialization between U-Boot splash screen and the final display.
See Linux documentation for details:
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/display/simple-framebuffer.yaml
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Align the framebuffer size on MMU_SECTION_SIZE in kernel, = max 2MB for
LPAE for armV7, to avoid issue with the simple frame buffer activation,
when U-Boot add a reserved memory in the kernel device tree to preserve
the splash screen until Linux driver initialization.
See Linux documentation for details:
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/display/simple-framebuffer.yaml
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add a new function to activate an existing simple frame buffer node
and add the associated reserved memory, with no-map properties.
This device tree update is only done when the video device is active
and the video buffer is used.
This patch uses '#if CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_VIDEO)' because
gd->video_bottom and gd->video_top are only defined when CONFIG_DM_VIDEO
is activated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add the helper function video_is_active() to test if one video device
is active.
This function can be used in board code to execute operation
only when the display is probed / really used.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Rename the function named lcd_dt_simplefb* to fdt_simplefb* to be aligned
with the associated file name fdt_simplefb.h/fdt_simplefb.c
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Rename the file lcd_simplefb.c to fdt_simplefb.c to be aligned
with the configuration name and with the associated include file
./include/fdt_simplefb.h
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_LCD_DT_SIMPLEFB
This patch also renames this config to CONFIG_FDT_SIMPLEFB as the code in
common/lcd_simplefb.c support CONFIG_LCD and CONFIG_VIDEO.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Remove the DDR interactive command tuning, as the support of a predefined
DDR PHY tuning is removed for STM32MP1 driver in SPL and in TF-A
and the result of this tuning will be never used.
Moreover this SW tuning procedure can failed on some hardware
configuration (to many BIST errors and no convergence); it will be no
more supported in the next delivery of the DDR utilities included in
the CubeMX tool of STMicroelectronics.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The support of a predefined DDR PHY tuning result is removed for
STM32MP1 driver because it is not needed at the supported frequency
when built-in calibration is executed.
The calibration parameters were provided in the device tree by the
optional node "st,phy-cal", activated in ddr helper file by the
compilation flag DDR_PHY_CAL_SKIP and filled with values generated
by the CubeMX DDR utilities.
This patch
- updates the binding file to remove "st,phy-cal" support
- updates the device trees and remove the associated defines
- simplifies the STM32MP1 DDR driver and remove the support of
the optional parameter "st,phy-cal"
After this patch, the built-in calibration is always executed
and the calibration registers are moved in the phy dynamic part;
that allows manual tests.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add the read data eye training = training for optimal read valid placement
(RVTRN) when the built-in calibration is executed for LPDDR2 and LPDDR3.
This training is supported on the PUBL integrated in the STM32MP15x
DDR subsystem and it is not required for DDR3.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The uSD level translator on DHSOM and Avenger96 are optional, however it
is possible to auto-detect it. This is done by setting SD CMD line high,
and then testing whether signal level on CK line matches the signal level
on CKIN line. If so, the uSD level translator is present, otherwise it is
not populated.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add support for testing whether bus voltage level translator is present
and operational. This is useful on systems where the bus voltage level
translator is optional, as the translator can be auto-detected by the
driver and the feedback clock functionality can be disabled if it is
not present.
The translator test sets CMD high to avoid interfering with a card, and
then verifies whether signal set on CK is detected on CKIN. If the signal
is detected, translator is present, otherwise the CKIN feedback clock are
disabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Yann Gautier <yann.gautier@foss.st.com>
The ethernet PHY must be reset on AV96, however DWMAC currently does
not support the MDIO-bus PHY GPIO reset bindings and the ethernet MAC
PHY reset property is going away on next DT sync. Add PHY specific
reset bindings to trigger the PHY reset and fix sporadic ethernet
malfunctions, until the next DT sync.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add script to read U-Boot from SD card and write it to matching
locations in the SPI NOR, thus making the SPI NOR bootable. The
script erases the entire SPI NOR, including U-Boot environment,
to make sure the installation is clean. To retain environment
from current running U-Boot, run 'saveenv' after running the
'update_sf' script.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The USB hub on STM32MP1 DHCOM boards needs to wait a bit longer until
the USB Vbus is stable. Increase the USB power-good delay to 1 s.
This adds default-undefined STM32MP_BOARD_EXTRA_ENV variable into
stm32mp15_common.h to reduce duplication in board-specific config
files adding custom environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Using mmc.dtbo from rpi-firmware to switch the controller for the SD
card slot from sdhci to sdhost causes the numbering to change; the
SD card is then not recognized at boot. Add to the range checked.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The Raspberry Pi Foundation released the new Zero 2 W which we
want to detect, so we can detect the correct device tree file name.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The Raspberry Pi Foundation has updated their documentation so update
the URL to the latest place to find the HW device revision codes.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc4
Documentation:
* describe how to enable Virtio RNG on QEMU ARM
UEFI:
* enable testing the TCG2 protocol
* support TPM event log passed from firmware
tpm_tis_remove() leads to calling tpm_tis_ready() with the IO region
unmapped and chip->locality == -1 (locality released). This leads to a
crash in mmio_write_bytes().
The patch implements these changes:
tpm_tis_remove(): Unmap the IO region after calling tpm_tis_cleanup().
tpm_tis_cleanup(): Request locality before IO output and releasing
locality.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Firmwares before U-Boot may be capable of doing tpm measurements
and passing them to U-Boot in the form of eventlog. However there
may be scenarios where the firmwares don't have TPM driver and
are not capable of extending the measurements in the PCRs.
Based on TCG spec, if previous firnware has extended PCR's, PCR0
would not be 0. So, read the PCR0 to determine if the PCR's need
to be extended as eventlog is parsed or not.
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The current tpm2_pcr_read is hardcoded using SHA256. Make the
actual command to TPM configurable to use wider range of algorithms.
The current command line is kept as is i.e limited to SHA-256 only.
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Platforms may have support to measure their initial firmware components
and pass the event log to u-boot. The event log address can be passed
in property tpm_event_log_addr and tpm_event_log_size of the tpm node.
Platforms may choose their own specific mechanism to do so. A weak
function is added to check if even log has been passed to u-boot
from earlier firmware components. If available, the eventlog is parsed
to check for its correctness and further event logs are appended to the
passed log.
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
With TPM emulation enabled in u-boot-test-hooks we should also provide the
tpm2 command used for the test/py/tests/test_tpm2.py test.
One of the Python TPMv2 tests expects sandbox specific values. So disable
it on other platforms.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Sometimes UART stops transmitting characters after UART clock is changed
back to XTAL. In this state UART fifo is always full. Kernel during early
boot wants to print output on UART and is waiting for non-empty UART fifo.
Which leads to CPU hangup without any (debug) output on UART.
Marvell Armada 3700 Functional Specifications says that for programming
fractional divisor registers it is required to disable UART, enable
loopback mode, reset fifos, program registers, disable loopback mode,
release reset of fifos and enable UART.
But these steps do not fix above mentioned issue that UART hangup. Also
gating UART clock does not help. And even resetting UART state machines do
not help.
Experiments showed that UART fifo is unblocked after board is being reset
(during board reset UART HW transmit UART fifo even CPU is not executing
kernel/bootloader anymore).
And another experiments showed that same workaround can be achieved also
by external reset of UART HW (without need to reset board).
So do not implement any of "Marvell recommended" steps from Functional
Specifications as they do not work. And rather prior changing parent clock
back to XTAL, do external reset of UART HW. This operation also resets all
UART registers, so basically it also sets UART clock to default, which is
XTAL. It is unknown why UART hangups and enters such broken state.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit aeb0ca64db ("arm: mvebu: turris_omnia: disable MCU watchdog in
SPL when booting over UART") disabled MCU watchdog when booting over
UART to ensure that watchdog does not reboot the board before UART
transfer finishes.
But if UART transfer fails for some reason, or if U-Boot binary crashes,
then board hangs forever as there is no watchdog running which could
reset it.
To fix this issue, enable A385 watchdog with very high timeout before
disabling MCU watchdog to ensure that even slow transfer can finish
successfully before watchdog timer expires and also to ensure that if
board hangs for some reason, watchdog will reset it.
Omnia's MCU watchdog has fixed 120 seconds timer and it cannot be
changed (without updating MCU firmware). A385 watchdog by default uses
25 MHz input clock and so the largest timeout value (2^32-1) can be
just 171 seconds. But A385 watchdog can be switched to use NBCLK (L2) as
input clock (on Turris Omnia it is 800 MHz clock) and in this case final
watchdog clock frequency is calculated as:
freq = NBCLK / 2 / (2 ^ R)
So A385 watchdog on Turris Omnia can be configured to at most 1374
seconds (about 22 minutes). We set it to 10 minutes, which should be
enough even for bigger U-Boot binaries or slower UART transfers.
Both U-Boot and Linux kernel, when initializing A385 watchdog, switch
watchdog timer to 25 MHz input clock, so usage of NBCLK input clock in
U-Boot SPL does not cause any issues.
Fixes: aeb0ca64db ("arm: mvebu: turris_omnia: disable MCU watchdog in SPL when booting over UART")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The common emulation Makefile has a dependency on a non-existent
qemu_capsule.o when building with support for capsule update enabled
(CONFIG_EFI_RUNTIME_UPDATE_CAPSULE=y).
The code which was in qemu_capsule.c has been completely moved to
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c by commit 7a6fb28c8e ("efi_loader: capsule:
add back efi_get_public_key_data()").
Remove the false dependency.
This fixes the following build error:
make[1]: *** No rule to make target 'board/emulation/common/qemu_capsule.o', needed by 'board/emulation/common/built-in.o'. Stop.
Fixes: commit 47a25e81d3 ("Revert "efi_capsule: Move signature from DTB to .rodata"")
Signed-off-by: Vincent Stehlé <vincent.stehle@arm.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an entry in maintainers for fastboot. It is starting off orphaned, but
hopefully someone can pick it up.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Lukasz has not been very responsive in reviewing clock patches. Add
myself as a maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
At present an Exception is raised if a command fails. This is a very broad
class and makes it difficult for callers to catch the error without also
catching other things, like programming bugs.
Change it to ValueError to make this easier.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the collection function used by pytest is quite strict on the
naming of the functions it detects. In particular it requires the name of
the test to be repeated in the function name.
This is not enforced anywhere else, but instead the tests are silently
omitted from the pytest run. This affects a few dozen tests.
The rule does not seem to have any particular purpose. Relax it, so that
all tests that use the UNIT_TEST() macro will run, regardless of the name
of the test function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the hexdump tests are disabled in sandbox_flattree. This is
good, because they do not pass. Enable the required Kconfig so that they
will, when enabled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a function that returns the number of devices in a uclass. This can be
helpful in sizing an array that needs to hold a list of them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In some cases it is useful to search just by a partial name, such as
when looking for a sibling device that has a common name substring. Add
helper functions to handle these requirements.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we support reading a string list a string at a time. Apart
from being inefficient, this makes it impossible to separate reading of
the devicetree into the of_to_plat() method where it belongs, since any
code which needs access to the string must read it from the devicetree.
Add a function which returns the string property as an array of pointers
to the strings, which is easily used by clients.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The details for of_property_read_string_helper() and
ofnode_read_string_index() are a little inaccurate. Fix up the comments to
avoid confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This method is currently called after the platform data has been freed.
But the pre_unbind() method may wish to access this, e.g. to free some
data structures stored there.
Split the unbinding of devices into two pieces, as is done with removal.
This corrects the problem.
Also tidy a code-style issue in device_remove() while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These functions currently lack tests so add some. The error handling
differs betwee livetree and flattree at present, so only check the error
codes with livetree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Before relocation there is generally not as much available memory and not
that much console output. At present the console-output buffer is the same
side before and after relocation. Add a separate Kconfig option to remove
this limitation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When ext is NULL we cannot dereference it. Update the code flow to avoid
this, so that layout_mbr_partitions() can be used with partition tables
that do not include an extended partition.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this command considers the partitions to be identical if the
start and size are smaller than expected. It should check that they are
the same. Fix this and tidy up the code style a little.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
At present the MMC uclass assumes that the only child it can have is a
block device. Update this so we can add a bootmethod too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide a way for sandbox MMC to present data from a backing file. This
allows a filesystem to be created on the host and easily served via an
emulated mmc device.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When running a program on the host, allow input to be passed in as stdin.
This is needed for running sfdisk, for example.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Otherwise the updated image will end up in the temporary folder that is
purged after completion.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This command is fairly complicated so documentation is useful.
Unfortunately I an not sure how the MTD side of things works and cannot
find information about that.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This text should never change during execution, so it makes sense to
use a const char * so that it can be declared as const in the code.
Update struct cmd_tbl with a const char * pointer for 'help'.
We cannot make usage const because of the bmode command, used on mx53ppd
for example.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
GNU has a very useful third argument to match() but this is not supported
in the POSIX awk.
Update the code to cope, so that the script is POSIX-compliant.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Mark Kettenis <mark.kettenis@xs4all.nl>
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc3-2
Test:
* fix pylint warnings
UEFI:
* disable interrupts before removing devices in ExitBootServices()
* implement poweroff in efi_system_reset() on sandbox
* allow booting via EFI even if some block device fails
* there is no os.path.unlink() method
* don't inherit from object
* add module docstring
* move imports to the top
* avoid unused variable
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
* don't inherit from object
* imports should be on the top level
* avoid unused variable names
* avoid unnecessary else after raise
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
UEFI code is always little-endian. Remove a superfluous test.
Remove a superfluous type conversion.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
If we call efi_clear_os_indications() before initializing the memory store
for UEFI variables a NULL pointer dereference occurs.
The error was observed on the sandbox with:
usb start
host bind 0 sandbox.img
load host 0:1 $kernel_addr_r helloworld.efi
bootefi $kernel_addr_r
Here efi_resister_disk() failed due to an error in the BTRFS implementation.
Move the logic to clear EFI_OS_INDICATIONS_FILE_CAPSULE_DELIVERY_SUPPORTED
to the rest of the capsule code.
If CONFIG_EFI_IGNORE_OSINDICATIONS=y, we should still clear the flag.
If OsIndications does not exist, we should not create it as it is owned by
the operating system.
Fixes: 149108a3eb ("efi_loader: clear OsIndications")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Our algorithm for creating USB device paths may lead to duplicate device
paths which result in efi_disk_register() failing. Instead we should just
skip devices that cannot be registered as EFI block devices.
Fix a memory leak in efi_disk_add_dev() caused by the duplicate device
path.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
If we look at the path that bootm/booti take when preparing to boot the
OS, we see that as part of (or prior to calling do_bootm_states,
explicitly) the process, bootm_disable_interrupts() is called prior to
announce_and_cleanup() which is where udc_disconnect() /
board_quiesce_devices() / dm_remove_devices_flags() are called from. In
the EFI path, these are called afterwards. In efi_exit_boot_services()
however we have been calling bootm_disable_interrupts() after the above
functions, as part of ensuring that we disable interrupts as required
by the spec. However, bootm_disable_interrupts() is also where we go
and call usb_stop(). While this has been fine before, on the TI J721E
platform this leads us to an exception. This exception seems likely to
be the case that we're trying to stop devices that we have already
disabled clocks for. The most direct way to handle this particular
problem is to make EFI behave like the do_bootm_states() process and
ensure we call bootm_disable_interrupts() prior to ending up in
usb_stop().
Cc: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This change implements an SCMI transport for agent interfacing the
OP-TEE SCMI service. OP-TEE provides an SCMI PTA (Pseudo-TA) for
non-secure world to send SCMI messages over an identified channel.
The driver implemented here uses a SMT shared memory for passing
messages between client and server.
The implementation opens and releases channel resources for each
passed SCMI message so that resources allocated (sessions) or
registered (shared memory areas) in OP-TEE firmware are released for
example before relocation as the driver will likely allocate/register
them back when probed after relocation.
The integration of the driver using dedicated config switch
CONFIG_SCMI_AGENT_OPTEE is designed on the model posted to the
U-Boot ML by Patrick Delaunay [1].
Link: [1] https://lore.kernel.org/all/20211028191222.v3.4.Ib2e58ee67f4d023823d8b5404332dc4d7e847277@changeid/
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Cc: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Introduce compatible "linaro,scmi-optee" for SCMI transport channel
based on an OP-TEE service invocation.
Define "linaro,optee-channel-id" property to identify the OP-TEE SCMI
channel used by the protocol(s). OP-TEE SCMI transport can either use
shared memory or a static shared memory buffer identified by the DT.
These bindings were posted to the Linux kernel DT bindings mailing list
and acked by maintainer [1].
Link: [1] https://lore.kernel.org/linux-arm-kernel/20211029102118.GG6526@e120937-lin/T/
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Add two configs CONFIG_SCMI_AGENT_MAILBOX and CONFIG_SCMI_AGENT_SMCCC
to select the supported agents as all the agents are not supported.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Some boards need to change the tx/rx delay config in order for
gigabit Ethernet to work.
In Linux commit bbc4d71d6354 ("net: phy: realtek: fix rtl8211e rx/tx
delay config"), Realtek documented the bits for overriding the delays
from the hardware straps.
Copy the logic from linux, so the delay config is set from the PHY's
interface type (the phy-mode property in the device tree).
This removes the need for a one-off workaround for the Pine A64+ board.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
priv->promisc is used as the parameter of the set_promisc() call
which accepts a bool type instead of char.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
set_promisc() call accepts the parameter of a bool type. Make it
clear by using true instead of 1.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If using OF_CONTROL, fdtcontroladdr is set to the fdt used to configure
U-Boot. When using PXE, if no fdt is defined in the menu file, and
there is no fdt at fdt_addr, add fall back on fdtcontroladdr too.
We are developing board support for the Armv8r64 FVP using
config_distro_bootcmd. We are also using OF_BOARD and would like the
PXE boot option to default to the fdt provided by board_fdt_blob_setup.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The VCI string sent during bootp of U-Boot-SPL is corrupt. This is
because the byte counter is not adjusted within the bootp_extended()
function when the VCI string is added. We fix this.
Signed-off-by: Walter Stoll <walter.stoll@duagon.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The sja1105 is a 5-port switch that uses a DM_DSA driver. Its 5th (CPU)
port is connected internally to the eth2 port of the LS1021A SoC.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The eth aliases are for correct probing order, so that each Ethernet
port will get a predictable MAC address from the environment.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The list of ports which support SGMII depending on switch generation is
available here:
https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/networking/dsa/sja1105.html#port-compatibility-matrix
SGMII can either be used to connect to an external PHY or to the host
port. In the first case, the use of in-band autoneg is expected, in the
last, in-band autoneg is expected to be turned off (fixed-link). So the
driver supports both cases.
SGMII support means configuring the PCS and PMA. The PCS is a Synopsys
Designware XPCS, in Linux this has a separate driver but here it is
embedded within the sja1105 driver. If needed it can be taken out later,
although we would need a UCLASS_PCS for it, which we don't have atm.
Nonetheless, I did go all the way to export an internal MDIO bus for PCS
access, because it is nice to be able to debug the PCS through commands
such as:
=> mdio read ethernet-switch@1-pcs 4 1f.0
Reading from bus ethernet-switch@1-pcs
PHY at address 4:
31.0 - 0x1140
The internal MDIO bus is not registered with DM because there is no
udevice on it, as mentioned. But the XPCS code can still be ripped out,
as needed.
I did not add support for 2500base-x because I do not expect this
interface type to be used as a boot source for anybody, it would just
add unnecessary bloat.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The SJA1105 driver is largely reused from Linux. Its programming model
is that it is blank out of reset, and it waits for a static
configuration stream over SPI, which contains all runtime parameters (it
has no notion of "default values").
Keeping a binary array for the configuration stream would have meant
that aspects such as the CPU port and the MAC speeds could have not been
configured easily, and would have been static and board-dependent.
Live-patching the binary array means recalculating the static config
table CRCs, which is not a fun process.
So we create an abstraction over the static config tables, using the
packing API, same as in Linux. The tables are kept as C structures, and
the binary configuration stream is constructed on-the-go, with CRC and
all.
All static config tables instantiated in this driver are mandatory.
The hardware reference manual can be found at:
https://www.nxp.com/docs/en/user-guide/UM10944.pdf
For tagging, a simplified version of tag_8021q from Linux is used. The
VLAN EtherType is the same (0xdadb) but since we don't want switching in
U-Boot, there is no reason to have a TX VLAN and an RX VLAN for each
port. We just need the RX VLANs to act as the unique pvid of each
front-panel port, to decode the switch port number. The RX VLAN is used
for both RX and TX.
The device tree bindings are the same as in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Instead of trying to guess which operating modes need in-band
negotiation to be active and which ones don't, parse the available
information from the device tree. That will be correct in the cases we
can already guess, and more.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Certain serial SERDES protocols like 1000base-x, 2500base-x, SGMII,
USXGMII can operate either in a mode where the PHY (be it on-board or
inside an SFP module) passes the link parameters (speed, duplex, pause)
to the MAC through in-band through control words standardized by IEEE
802.3 clause 37, or in a mode where the MAC must configure (force) its
link parameters based on information obtained out-of-band (MDIO reads,
guesswork etc).
In Linux, the OF node property named "managed" is parsed by the phylink
framework, and the convention is that if a driver uses phylink, then the
presence of this property means that in-band autoneg should be enabled,
otherwise it shouldn't.
To be compatible with the OF node bindings of drivers that use phylink
in Linux, introduce parsing support for this property in U-Boot too.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
In the current DSA switch driver API, only the udevice of the switch
(belonging to UCLASS_DSA) is exposed, as well as an "int port" argument.
So drivers do not have access to the udevice of individual ports
(belonging to UCLASS_ETH), one of the reasons being that not all ports
have an associated UCLASS_ETH udevice.
However, all DSA ports have an OF node, and in some cases the driver
needs a handle to it, for all ports including the CPU port. Example: the
following Linux per-port device tree property:
managed = "in-band-status";
states whether a port should operate with clause 37 in-band autoneg
enabled or not.
This patch exposes a function which can be called by individual drivers
as needed.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The Freescale TSEC can be a DSA master, and the ports of the attached
DSA switch can have different MAC addresses compared to the TSEC.
Nonetheless, the TSEC must receive the packets on behalf of those switch
ports. Therefore, implement the promiscuous mode method to allow DSA to
set this.
Note that the init_registers() function called from eth_ops :: start
overwrites this setting. There is no reason why the RCTRL register
should be zero-initialized, so just stop clearing it so that the setting
we applied in eth_ops :: set_promisc sticks.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The VSC8502 is a Microchip (formerly Microsemi, formerly Vitesse)
dual port, gigabit Ethernet copper PHY which supports the MII, GMII and
RGMII MAC-side interfaces.
Of these, I could only test RGMII, and my board needed RGMII delays to
be applied by software, so I am able to confirm that this patch handles
that properly.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
It was wrongly set to "MR", fix it.
Fixes: 52e2565bfb ("spi: atmel-quadspi: Add verbose debug facilities to monitor register accesses")
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Add dm command for driver model low level access and
gpio command for query and control gpio pins.
Signed-off-by: Mihai Sain <mihai.sain@microchip.com>
Scripts:
* Update spelling.txt
LMB:
* remove extern keyword in lmb.h
* drop unused lmb_size_bytes()
Test:
* test truncation in snprintf()
Documentation:
* add include/lmb.h to HTML documentation
UEFI:
* reduce non-debug logging output for measured boot
* fix use after free in measured boot
* startup the tpm device when installing the protocol
* implement EFI_EVENT_GROUP_BEFORE_EXIT_BOOT_SERVICES
* record capsule result only if capsule is read
Due to U-Boot's lazy binding mentality the TPM is probed but not properly
initialized. The user can startup the device from the command line
e.g 'tpm2 startup TPM2_SU_CLEAR'. However we can initialize the TPM during
the TCG protocol installation, which is easier to use overall.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
As described in the TCG spec [1] in sections 7.1.1 and 7.1.2 the FinalEvent
table should include events after GetEventLog has been called. This
currently works for us as long as the kernel is the only EFI application
calling that. Specifically we only implement what's described in 7.1.1.
So refactor the code a bit and support EFI application(s) calling
GetEventLog. Events will now be logged in both the EventLog and FinalEvent
table as long as ExitBootServices haven't been invoked.
[1] https://trustedcomputinggroup.org/wp-content/uploads/EFI-Protocol-Specification-rev13-160330final.pdf
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
We have implemented all what is new in UEFI specification 2.9 and relevant
for U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Implement the EFI_EVENT_GROUP_BEFORE_EXIT_BOOT_SERVICES event group
handling.
Add the definition of EFI_EVENT_GROUP_AFTER_READY_TO_BOOT.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Record capsule update result only if the capsule file is
successfully read, because the capsule GUID is not sure when
the file can not be read or the file is not a capsule.
Without this fix, if user puts a dummy (non-capsule) file
under (ESP)EFI/UpdateCapsule, U-Boot causes a synchronous
abort.
This also fixes use-after-free bug of the 'capsule' variable.
Fixes: c74cd8bd08 ("efi_loader: capsule: add capsule_on_disk support")
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
log_info() is used for the debug level logging statement
which should use log_debug() instead. Convert it to reduce the
log output.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This commit adds the comment for efi_system_table and
efi_configuration_table structure.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This list is used by checkpatch.pl. The Linux v5.15 version has several
words that where mispelled in U-Boot too.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The extern keyword is not needed in include/lmb.h to declare functions.
Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Correct Sphinx style comments in include/lmb.h
Add the logical memory block API to the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Defining static functions in includes should be avoided.
Function lmb_is_nomap() is only used in the unit test.
So move it to the unit test.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
If bootloader was updated without running oem format, reboot will cause
boot loop because the SYSTEM stage fails.
Add a final PANIC stage running fastboot to permit recovery.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
This can lead to GPT and BCB errors even if fastboot was selected early
by usb rom boot and the eMMC is blank/invalid.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
This should use the provided U_BOOT_DRIVER() macro so that the driver gets
added to the appropriate linker list. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: 7c9dcfed50 ("pinctrl: meson: rework gx pmx function")
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com> on libretech-cc
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
- An assortment of fixes related to GD, GD_FLG_SKIP_RELOC, and the lmb
- Environment fix on synquacer developmentbox
- Fix for get_info is not valid in partition code
In case U-Boot enters relocation with GD_FLG_SKIP_RELOC, skip the
relocation. The code still has to set up new_gd pointer and new
stack pointer.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In case U-Boot starts with GD_FLG_SKIP_RELOC, the U-Boot code is
not relocated, however the stack and heap is at the end of DRAM
after relocation. Reserve a LMB area for the non-relocated U-Boot
code so it won't be overwritten.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Even if U-Boot has relocation disabled via GD_FLG_SKIP_RELOC , the
relocated stage of U-Boot still picks GD from new_gd location. The
U-Boot itself is not relocated, but GD might be, so copy the GD to
new GD location even if relocation is disabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@oss.nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In some case, get_info() interface can be NULL, add this check to stop
from crash.
Signed-off-by: schspa <schspa@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Without default setting of gd->env_addr, U-Boot will cause
a synchronous abort if the env-variables on the SPI flash is
broken or not saved corectly. Set gd->env_addr correctly.
This reverts commit 535870f3b0.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
- NVMe updates
- TI AM64x related USB updates
- Update PCIe CAM support macros, add PCI CAM support as well
- AST2600, Apple (ARM64) pinctrl drivers
- ARM-specific DEBUG uart inconsistencies fixed
- MediaTek MMC improvement
- aspeed: Support secure boot chain with FIT image verification
Add and Enable USB SuperSpeed Host Port in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Consulting to "NVM Express® Base Specification, revision 2.0".
If more PRP List pages are required, then the last entry of
the PRP List contains the Page Base Address of the next PRP
List page. The next PRP List page shall be memory page aligned.
Signed-off-by: Jon Lin <jon.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Shawn Lin <shawn.lin@rock-chips.com>
Most NVME devcies maintain data in internal cache for an uncertain
times, and u-boot has no method to force NVME to flush cache.
So this patch adds FUA to avoid data loss caused by power off after data
programming.
Signed-off-by: Jon Lin <jon.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
When booting U-Boot in crosvm, the virtual machine emulates a PCI cam
device, not the PCI-E 'ecam' device normally seen on e.g. QEMU. This
PCI device can be supported with only trivial changes to the ecam
driver.
Instead of adding a completely new driver which is identical besides the
initialization step, add support for the PCI version to the existing
driver.
Signed-off-by: Alistair Delva <adelva@google.com>
Cc: Tuomas Tynkkynen <tuomas.tynkkynen@iki.fi>
Cc: Ram Muthiah <rammuthiah@google.com>
AST2600 leverages the FIT hash/signature verification to fulfill
secure boot trust chain. To improve the performance and save SW
code size for those crypto operations, the two HW crypto engine,
HACE and ACRY, are enabled.
However, both of the engines can only access to data stored in
DRAM space. Therefore, we need to move the FIT image into DRAM
before the booting.
This patch update the CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND to execute the pre-defined
ENV variable which consists of FIT image copy to memory and booting.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Enable SPL FIT image load and verification support.
The HW accelerated SHA is also available with the
newly added support of the HACE HW hash engine.
The SPL thumb build is also enabled to keep the binary
less than 64KB to fit into the Aspeed secure boot design.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Return CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR pointing to DRAM space for
spl_get_load_buffer() to allow generic SPL image loading
code (e.g. FIT and Ymodem) to store data in DRAM.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Hash and Crypto Engine (HACE) is designed to accelerate the
throughput of hash data digest, and symmetric-key encryption.
Signed-off-by: Johnny Huang <johnny_huang@aspeedtech.com>
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add YCLK enable for HACE, the HW hash engine of
ASPEED AST2600 SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
The AST2600 SRAM has been extended to 88KB since A1
chip revision. This patch updates the SRAM size to
offer more space for early stack/heap use.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Fix inconsistent function parameter name of the hash algorithm.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Fixes: 92055e138f ("image: Drop if/elseif hash selection in calculate_hash()")
Reviewed-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the recent changes on mmc driver, we saw that the boot is ~5 secs
longer compared to v2021.07 on mediatek platforms.
This regression is seen during mmc_init and caused by the following
patch [1].
Indeed since we did not support poll dat0, we fulfilled the condition
of [1] and a delay of 500 ms was added for every __mmc_switch call.
By adding the support of wait_dat0(), we now don't need to mdelay
during mmc_init anymore.
[1]: https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/1629192034-64056-1-git-send-email-ye.li@nxp.com/
Signed-off-by: Julien Masson <jmasson@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Some boards do not enable SPL_SERIAL so cannot use the debug UART. Add
this condition to the code and drop use of the preprocessor while we are
here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@vrull.eu>
Enable this to permit early debugging. Due to the way qmeu works, the
input clock can be zero and things still work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we don't init the debug UART in the generic ARM code, but
instead leave it to individual machines to handle. This is not the
way it is supposed to work.
Add the required init to the crt files. This ensures that the UART
is available as early as possible and that the announcement appears
when it should, if enabled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A few boards enable CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_BOARD_INIT but do not define the
required init function. Fix this by disabling the debug UART.
With snow the debug UART is enabled but the driver CONFIG is not. Fix this
too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Lot of PCIe controllers are using ECAM addressing. So add common ECAM
macros into U-Boot's pci.h header file which can be suitable for most
PCI controller drivers.
Replace custom ECAM address macros in every PCI controller driver by new
ECAM macros from U-Boot's pci.h header file.
Similar macros are defined also in Linux kernel. There is a small
difference between Linux and these new U-Boot macros.
U-Boot's PCIE_ECAM_OFFSET() takes device and function numbers in separate
arguments. Linux's PCIE_ECAM_OFFSET() takes device and function numbers
encoded in one argument. The reason is that U-Boot's PCI_DEVFN() macro is
different than Linux's PCI_SLOT() macro. So having device and function
numbers in separate arguments makes code more straightforward.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This driver supports both pin muxing and GPIO support for the
pin control logic found on Apple SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Without get_desc, the tpm command will not provide a
description of the device in 'tpm device' or 'tpm info'.
Due to the characteristics of the Atmel TPM it isn't
possible to determine certain attributes (e.g open/close
status) without using the TPM stack (compare Infineon
and ST TPM drivers), so just print out the chip model
and udevice name as the identifier.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This driver was broken due to an empty offset byte being prepended
at the start of every transmission.
The hardware does not mimic an EEPROM device with registers so
an offset byte is not required.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This command is not compiled by default and has not been updated alongside
changes to the tpmv1 API, such as passing the TPM udevice to the relevant
functions.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
To quote Simon:
One barrier to completing the 7-year-long Kconfig migration is that
the default environment is implemented using ad-hoc CONFIG options.
At present U-Boot environment variables, and thus scripts, are defined
by CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS.
It is not really feasible to move the environment to Kconfig as it is
hundreds of lines of text in some cases.
Even considering the current situation, it is painful to add large
amounts of text to the config-header file and dealing with quoting and
newlines is harder than it should be. It would be better if we could just
type the script into a text file and have it included by U-Boot.
This is already supported by the CONFIG_USE_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE feature. But
that does not support use of CONFIG options or comments, so is best suited
for use by other build systems wanting to define the U-Boot environment.
Add a feature that brings in a .env file associated with the board
config, if present. To use it, create a file board/<vendor>/<board>.env or
use CONFIG_ENV_SOURCE_FILE to set a filename.
The environment variables should be of the form "var=value". Values can
extend to multiple lines. This series converts the existing environment
documentation to rST and updates it to explain how to use this.
This has different semantics in different places. Go with the bootm method
and put it in a common function so that the behaviour is consistent in
U-Boot. Update the docs.
To be clear, this changes the way that 'bootelf' and standalone boot
work. Before, if autostart was set to "fred" or "YES", for example, they
would consider that a "yes". This may change behaviour for some boards,
but the only in-tree boards which mention autostart use "no" to disable
it, which will still work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
These conflict with real-word addresses. Use locally administered
MAC addresses and a suitable IPv4 address from 192.0.2.0/24
(TEST-NET-1).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Alexander Dahl <ada@thorsis.com>
Make various other updates suggested during review of the rST conversion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Make various updates suggested during review of the rST conversion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Suggested-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Use a text file for the environment instead of the #define settings.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
At present U-Boot environment variables, and thus scripts, are defined
by CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS. It is painful to add large amounts of text
to this file and dealing with quoting and newlines is harder than it
should be. It would be better if we could just type the script into a
text file and have it included by U-Boot.
Add a feature that brings in a .env file associated with the board
config, if present. To use it, create a file in a board/<vendor>
directory, typically called <board>.env and controlled by the
CONFIG_ENV_SOURCE_FILE option.
The environment variables should be of the form "var=value". Values can
extend to multiple lines. See the README under 'Environment Variables:'
for more information and an example.
In many cases environment variables need access to the U-Boot CONFIG
variables to select different options. Enable this so that the environment
scripts can be as useful as the ones currently in the board config files.
This uses the C preprocessor, means that comments can be included in the
environment using /* ... */
Also support += to allow variables to be appended to. This is needed when
using the preprocessor.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Move this from the README to rST format.
Drop i2cfast since it is obviously obsolete and breaks the formatting.
Other changes and improvements are in a following patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This is a complicated set of #defines and it is painful to convert to a
text file. We can (once pending patches are applied) provide the same
functionality with bootmethod. Drop this for sandbox to allow conversion
to a text-file environment.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Xilinx changes for v2022.01-rc3
sdhci:
- Fix emmc mini case with missing firmware interface
zynqmp:
- Restore JTAG interface if required
- Allow overriding board name
- Add support for DLC21
- Fix one fallthrought statement description
- Use config macro instead of name duplication
- Save multiboot to variable
firmware:
- Handle ipi_req errors better
- Use local buffer in case user doesn't need it instead of NULL/0 location
spi:
- gqsi: Fix write issue at low frequencies
net:
- gem: Disable broadcasts
Compiler is not happy:
common/image-board.c: In function ‘boot_get_kbd’:
common/image-board.c:902:17: warning: implicit declaration of function ‘do_bdinfo’ [-Wimplicit-function-declaration]
902 | do_bdinfo(NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
| ^~~~~~~~~
Move the forward declaration to a header.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove the extra (empty) argument passed to str8w, causing the following
error:
<instantiation>:40:47: error: too many positional arguments
str8w r0, r3, r4, r5, r6, r7, r8, r9, ip, , abort=19f
^
u-boot/arch/arm/lib/memcpy.S:240:5: note: while in macro instantiation
17: forward_copy_shift pull=16 push=16
^
Note: no functional change intended.
Fixes: d8834a1323 ("arm: Use optimized memcpy and memset from linux")
Signed-off-by: Pierre-Clément Tosi <ptosi@google.com>
Fix dfu_alt_info to use nor1 instead of the device name.
This reverts a part of commit 59bd18d4c4 ("configs: synquacer:
Remove mtdparts settings and update DFU setting") because the
commit a4f2d83414 ("mtd: spi: nor: force mtd name to "nor%d"")
changed the mtd device naming scheme to nor%d.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The subdivision name "TQ Components" hasn't been in use for a long time.
Rename the vendor directory to "tq", which also matches our Device Tree
vendor prefix.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Cap end of relocations by the binary size.
Linkers like to insert some auxiliary sections between .rela.dyn and
.bss_start. These sections don't make their way to the final binary, but
reloc_rela still tries to relocate them, resulting in attempted read
past the end of file.
When linking U-Boot with ld.lld, the STATIC_RELA feature (enabled by
default on arm64) breaks the build. After this patch, U-Boot can be
linked successfully with and without CONFIG_STATIC_RELA.
Originally-from: Elena Petrova <lenaptr@google.com>
Signed-off-by: Alistair Delva <adelva@google.com>
Cc: David Brazdil <dbrazdil@google.com>
Cc: Scott Wood <scottwood@freescale.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This ensures the USB_MUSB_PIO_ONLY config is set to an apppropriate
value from the changes enabling USB_MUSB_GADGET does.
Namely, USB_MUSB_PIO_ONLY default to =y on USB_MUSB_SUNXI being y.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Dionne-Riel <samuel@dionne-riel.com>
For testing the TPM drivers and the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL we need the tool
swtpm.
Once we move to Ubuntu Impish we can take libtpms from package libtpms-dev.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Both U-Boot proper and SPL entries were using the same description.
Fixes: b55881dd ("bootstage: Add SPL support")
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With CONFIG_SYSRESET_WATCHDOG=y the sandbox can use a watchdog based system
reset.
To make this work calling sandbox_wdt_expire_now() must lead to a reset.
With this change we can test the development suggested in
[PATCH 0/4] Improved sysreset/watchdog uclass integration
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-August/458656.html
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For successful execution of the watchdog test we need both the GPIO as well
as the SANDBOX watchdog.
Avoid a build failure for CONFIG_WDT_GPIO=n.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Correct an error in the tpl-dtb parameter to binman. At present the TPL
rule follows SPL but this is not correct, if TPL uses of-platdata, for
example.
Fixes: f99cbe4e86 ("fdt: Update Makefile rules with the new OF_REAL Kconfig")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Instead of pretending that we don't have environment to force searching
default environment in env_get_default(), get the data from the
default_environment[] buffer directly.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The env_get_f() function returns -1 on failure. Returning 0 means that
the variable exists, and is empty string.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Do not set GD_FLG_ENV_READY nor GD_FLG_ENV_DEFAULT if failed importing
in env_set_default().
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
WIth EFI we must embed the devicetree in an ELF image so that it is loaded
as part of the executable file. We want it to include the binman
definition in there also, which in some cases cannot be created until the
ELF (u-boot) is built. Add an option to binman to support writing the
updated dtb to the ELF file u-boot.out
This is useful with the EFI app, which is always packaged as an ELF file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Binman needs to be able to update the contents of an ELF file after it has
been build. To support this, add a function to locate the position of a
symbol's contents within the file.
Fix the comments on bss_data.c and Symbol while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present any error from the 'make' command is silently swallowed by the
test system. Fix this by showing it when detected.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Exception base class is a very vague and could be confusing to the
test system. Use the more specific ValueError exception instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This symbol has been functionally dead for a long time. Remove the last
and recent re-introductions of setting it, and update the whitelist so
it will not be re-introduced again.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_TRACE
CONFIG_TRACE_BUFFER_SIZE
CONFIG_TRACE_EARLY
CONFIG_TRACE_EARLY_ADDR
CONFIG_TRACE_EARLY_SIZE
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH
CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET
CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE
CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE
CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV
CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- A number of pxe related cleanups and related re-organization.
- A few related pxe/sysboot/extlinux improvements
- Remove some dead code.
- Update Azure to use a newer Windows build environment
- Add a .get_maintainer.conf file
- A few minor TI SoC platform updates
The driver supports the ds1339 as well, which was probably intended by
the author but prevented by a typo. Fix the typo.
Signed-off-by: Clemens Gruber <clemens.gruber@pqgruber.com>
We need to filter out NET_ETH_START errors because we have to enable
networking in order to propagate the MAC addresses to the DT while there
is no network driver for the prueth in U-Boot yet.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
This got lost while fixing up the condition in
board/siemens/iot2050/board.c
Fixes: b55881dd ("bootstage: Add SPL support")
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 4b2be78ab6 ("time: Fix get_ticks being non-monotonic") has
broken boot on chiliboard platform, as it requires '/chosen/tick-timer'
in device-tree. This resulted in following panic message:
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Provide missing chosen property in device-tree to fix chiliboard
support.
Signed-off-by: Marcin Niestroj <m.niestroj@grinn-global.com>
Since commit e57c7c5c42 ("get_maintainer.pl: update from Linux kernel
v5.13-rc6") only the top level MAINTAINERS file is used. This is because
this commit (accidentally) disabled the search of MAINTAINERS files
(find_maintainer_files is set to 0 again). Before that, commit
b79372ae94 ("scripts/get_maintainer.pl: enable find_maintainer_files")
explicitly enabled that feature. Nowadays, we also have to set
maintainer_path to a directory.
To fix it and enable recursive search of MAINTAINERS, create a
configuration file to set these two variables.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
The last board that used to set CONFIG_LYNXKDI has been removed in
commit 242836a893 ("powerpc: ppc4xx: remove pcs440ep support"),
doc/README.lynxkdi only talks about a MPC8260 board being supported,
and the mpc8260 support has been removed four years ago in commit
2eb48ff7a2 ("powerpc, 8260: remove support for mpc8260") already,
and common/lynxkdi.c only consists of an "#error" statement these
days, so it seems like the LYNX KDI code is dead code nowadays.
Let's remove it now.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Refactor this code so that we can call the 'pxe get' command without going
through the command-line interpreter. This makes it easier to get the
information we need, without going through environment variables.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The only difference between the three helpers is the filesystem type.
Factor this out and call the filesystem functions directly, instead of
through the command-line interpreter. This allows the file size to be
obtained directly, instead of via an environment variable.
We cannot do the same thing with PXE's tftpboot since there is no API
at present to obtain information about the file that was read. So there
is no point in changing pxe_getfile_func to use a ulong for the address,
for example.
This is as far as the refactoring can go for the present.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
It is pretty strange that the pxe code uses the 'filesize' environment
variable find the size of a file it has just read.
Partly this is because it uses the command-line interpreter to parse its
request to load the file.
As a first step towards unwinding this, return it directly from the
getfile() function. This makes the code a bit longer, for now, but will be
cleaned up in future patches.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This function no longer makes sense, since it is pretty easy to prepend
the boot directory to the filename. Drop it and update its only caller.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The 'bootfile' environment variable is read in the bowels of pxe_util to
provide a directory to which all loaded files are relative.
This is not obvious from the API to PXE and it is strange to make the
caller set an environment variable rather than pass this as a parameter.
The code is also convoluted, which this feature implemented by
get_bootfile_path().
Update the API to improve this. Unfortunately this means that
pxe_setup_ctx() can fail, so add error checking.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Both the syslinux and pxe commands use essentially the same code to parse
and run extlinux.conf files. Move this into a common function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
There are a few more blank lines than makes sense for readability. Also
free() handles a NULL pointer so drop the pointless checks.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Move the header file into the main include/ directory so we can use it
from the bootmethod code. Move the C file into boot/ since it relates to
booting.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Move this into the context to avoid a global variable. Also rename it
since the current name does not explain what it actually affects.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
At present the PXE functions pass around a pointer to command-table entry
which is very strange. It is only needed in a few places and it is odd to
pass around a data structure from another module in this way.
For bootmethod we will need to provide some context information when
reading files.
Create a PXE context struct to hold the command-table-entry pointer and
pass that around instead. We can then add more things to the context as
needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Put the function comments in the header file so that the full API can we
examined in one place.
Expand the comments to cover parameters and return values.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Quite a lot of the code in common/relates to booting and images. Before
adding more it seems like a good time to move the code into its own
directory.
Most files with 'boot' or 'image' in them are moved, except:
- autoboot.c which relates to U-Boot automatically running a script
- bootstage.c which relates to U-Boot timing
Drop the removal of boot* files from the output directory, since this
interfers with the symlinks created by tools and there does not appear
to be any such file from my brief testing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Artem Lapkin <email2tema@gmail.com>
- device-tree sync-up with Linux for ls1028a
- fixes/update in fsl-ddr driver, fsl-validate, lx2162a, fsl-mc,
spintable code, configs, qspi node, pci
- enable EFI_SET_TIME support in sl28
- powerpc: Drop -mstring
TPM drivers have currently no maintainers. Add myself since I contributed
the TIS implementation.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
A previous patch added support for an mmio based TPM.
Add an example in QEMU on it's usage
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
A previous commit is adding an MMIO TPMv2 driver. Include in the default
qemu arm configs, since we plan on using them on EFI testing
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add support for devices that expose a TPMv2 though MMIO.
Apart from those devices, we can use the driver in our QEMU setups and
test TPM related code which is difficult to achieve using the sandbox
driver (e.g test the EFI TCG2 protocol).
It's worth noting that a previous patch added TPMv2 TIS core functions,
which the current driver is consuming.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
There's a lot of code duplication in U-Boot right now. All the TPM TIS
compatible drivers we have at the moment have their own copy of a TIS
implementation.
So let's create a common layer which implements the core TIS functions.
Any driver added from now own, which is compatible with the TIS spec, will
only have to provide the underlying bus communication mechanisms.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
With the upcoming TPM2 API, some of the functions name are part of the new
header file. So switch conflicting internal function names and defines.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canaonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
With the upcoming TPM2 API, some of the functions name are part of the new
header file. So switch conflicting internal function names and defines.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
UEFI specification does not require that BootOrder is defined.
In current implementation, boot variable measurement fails and
returns EFI_NOT_FOUND if BootOrder is not defined.
This commit correcly handles this case, skip the boot variable
measurement if BootOrder is not defined.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
- DHSOM update:
- Remove nWP GPIO hog
- Increase SF bus frequency to 50Mhz and enable SFDP
- Disable video output for DHSOM
- Disable EFI
- Enable DFU_MTD support
- Create include file for STM32 gpio driver private data
- Split board and SOC STM32MP15 configuration
- Device tree alignement with v5.15-rc6 for STM32MP15
- Add binman support for STM32MP15x
- Normalise newlines for stm32prog
- Update OTP shadow registers in SPL
We should avoid #ifdef in C modules and the unused functions
are eliminated by the linker.
Use the more readable IS_ENABLE() instead.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In some part of STM32MP15 support the CONFIG_TFABOOT can be replaced
by other config: CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI and CONFIG_ARM_SMCCC.
This patch also simplifies the code in cpu.c, stm32mp1_ram.c and
clk_stml32mp1.c as execution of U-Boot in sysram (boot without SPL and
without TFA) is not supported: the associated initialization code is
present only in SPL.
This cleanup patch is a preliminary step to support SPL load of OP-TEE
in secure world, with SPL in secure world and U-Boot in no-secure world.
Reported-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove the dependency on CONFIG_TFABOOT in stm32mp Kconfig
- always activate the ARCH config: CONFIG_ARCH_SUPPORT_PSCI
and CONFIG_CPU_V7_HAS_NONSEC
- CONFIG_ARMV7_NONSEC is deactivated in trusted defconfig
- the correct sysreset driver is activated in each defconfig:
CONFIG_SYSRESET_PSCI or SYSRESET_SYSCON
Reported-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Currently the upper OTP (after 57) are shadowed in U-Boot proper,
when TFABOOT is not used.
This choice cause an issue when U-Boot is not executed after SPL,
so this BSEC initialization is moved in SPL and no more executed in U-Boot,
so it is still executed only one time.
After this patch this BSEC initialization is done in FSBL: SPL or TF-A.
To force this initialization in all the case, the probe of the BSEC
driver is forced in SPL in the arch st32mp function: spl_board_init().
Even if today BSEC driver is already probed in STM32MP15x clock driver
clk_stm32mp1.c because get_cpu_type() is called in
stm32mp1_get_max_opp_freq() function.
Reported-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The nWP GPIO hog was used to unlock the SPI NOR write protect when U-Boot
used to operate the SPI NOR in 1-1-1 mode. Now that the SPI NOR is operated
in 1-1-4 mode, the hog has adverse effects and causes transfer corruption,
since the hogged pin is also the IO2 pin. Remove the hogs.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The stm32 gpio driver private data are not needed in arch include files,
they are not used by code except for stm32 gpio and pincontrol drivers,
using the same IP; the defines for this IP is moved in a new file
"stm32_gpio_priv.h" in driver/gpio.
This patch avoids to have duplicated file gpio.h for each SOC
in MPU directory mach-stm32mp and in each MCU directory arch-stm32*
and allows to remove CONFIG_GPIO_EXTRA_HEADER for all STM32.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add a configuration file "stm32mp15_st_common.h" to handle the
STMicroelectronics boards configuration and rename stm32mp1.h to
"stm32mp15_common.h" to handle the generic STM32MP15x series configuration.
The configuration file "dh_stm32mp1.h" is also renamed to
"stm32mp15_dh_dhcom" for the configuration of board based on the
dhelectronics STM32MP15x SOM.
In the STMicroelectronics board configuration the default bootcmd
"bootcmd_stm32mp" is updated to only select the extlinux file found on
SD-Card on STM32MP15x EV1 for boot from NOR device.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Device tree alignment with Linux kernel v5.15-rc6
- Set {bitclock,frame}-master phandles on ST DKx
- Add coprocessor detach mbox on stm32mp15x-dkx boards
- Add coprocessor detach mbox on stm32mp157c-ed1 board
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Use binman to add the stm32image header on SPL binary for basic boot
or on U-Boot binary when it is required, i.e. for TF-A boot without FIP
support, when CONFIG_STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE is activated.
The "binman" tool is the recommended tool for specific image generation.
This patch allows to suppress the config.mk file and it is a preliminary
step to manage FIT generation with binman.
The init_r parsing of U-Boot device tree to search the binman
information is not required for STM32MP15, so the binman library
can be removed in U-Boot (CONFIG_BINMAN_FDT is deactivated).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The missing trailing newline could confuse check-config.sh if the
definition of an option was on the first line of the next file that
find(1) happened to return.
Signed-off-by: William Grant <wgrant@ubuntu.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Field srcaddr in kwbimage v0 needs to be adjusted similarly like in v1.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Kwbimage v0 has similar alignment requirements as v1.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fill the real header size without padding into the main header
This allows to reduce final image when converting image to another format
which does not need additional padding.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently kwbimage header is always aligned to 4096 bytes. But it does not
have to be aligned to such a high value.
The header needs to be just 4-byte aligned, while some image types have
additional alignment restrictions.
This change reduces size of kwbimage binaries by removing extra padding
between header and data part.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This change allows to convert image from one format to another without need
to include unnecessary padding (e.g. when target image format has smaller
alignment requirement as source image format).
Do it by storing real image data size without padding to the kwbimage
header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
xmodem block size is 128 bytes, therefore it is possible to transfer only
images with size multiple of 128 bytes. kwboot automatically pads image
with zero bytes at the end to align it to 128 bytes boundary.
Do this padding when generating image to allow uploading with other xmodem
tools or older kwboot versions.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are more unused enums and function prototypes. Remove them. The
function kwbimage_check_params() does not return enum kwbimage_cmd_types,
but a boolean value returned as int.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
kwbimage v0 sldo has 32-bit data checksum at the end like kwbimage v1.
Use same data checksum validation for both v0 and v1 image types.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
kwbimage must have valid blockid member instead of zero value. Thus if
config file does not contain BOOT_FROM command, use by default the value
for SPI booting (which is probably the most common).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For documentation purposes update struct main_hdr_v0 to include information
where version of the image must be stored. For kwbimage v0 it obviously
must be 0. By default all image header memory is initialized to zero,
therefore this change has no functional effect.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These two commands allow to specify custom setting of UART port used for
printing BootROM messages.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Header file mach/cpu.h already defines MBUS_PCI_MEM_SIZE macro which
defines size of MBUS_PCI_MEM_BASE window. So use global MBUS_PCI_MEM_SIZE
macro instead of locally defined PCIE_MEM_SIZE macro. Both macros have same
definition.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
It is useful to see kwboot version in the boot log output for debugging
purposes.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Properly calculate and align image header size to xmodem block size.
Kirkwood v0 images do not have stored total size of header in header
structure itself like it is for v1 images. So kwbheader_size() calculates
size by traversing image structure itself. Aligning is done in kwboot by
putting zero padding bytes between the header and data part.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The Sunxi boards only support a 16 second watchdog timeout. This is too
short to boot Linux. The UEFI specification requires 300 seconds as
default timeout.
Change the default for CONFIG_WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART for ARCH_SUNXI.
Fixes: b147bd3607 ("sunxi: Enable watchdog timer support by default")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tested-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CONFIG_FSL_ENETC is not explicitly enabled in the NXP LS1028A config
files, instead it is selected by CONFIG_MSCC_FELIX_SWITCH, a state of
matters which is fragile.
CONFIG_MSCC_FELIX_SWITCH depends on CONFIG_DM_DSA, which depends on
CONFIG_PHY_FIXED.
Not all LS1028A boards did enable CONFIG_PHY_FIXED, which resulted in
all of Ethernet being compiled out.
This patch makes sure that CONFIG_PHY_FIXED is enabled for all LS1028A
boards, and CONFIG_FSL_ENETC as well - don't rely on that fragile
selection done by the Felix switch config.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In the current code, it doesn't reset the cursors of LUT entry and
StreamID at the beginning of the fixup, so it can result in LUT entry
setup and msi-map mismatch and LUT entries and StreamID leaking
when reload and fixup the DTB.
This patch move the initialization of LUT entry and StreamID cursors
to the beginning of the fixup to resolve the issues.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Use moveconfig.py script to convert CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR,
CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR and CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH to Kconfig and
move these entries to defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Rajesh Bhagat <rajesh.bhagat@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS1046A-QDS board requires updation in few environment configs in TFA
defconfigs of the board.
Following are the changes:
- Update CONFIG_ENV_ADDR
- Update CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE
- Enable CONFIG_SYS_RELOC_GD_ENV_ADDR
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS1046A-QDS has CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SST, CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_EON and
CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_STMICRO defines present in header. Move these entries
from header to defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
I'd like to keep informed about ls1028a.dtsi changes. For now, there is
no top-level entry for any layerscape specific files. Instead, add the
file entry to my board MAINTAINERS file.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Don't use efi_allocate_pages(). The allocated memory isn't carved out of
the lmb allocations. The memory might then be allocated twice.
Particulary, this might happened with the fdt_high/initrd_high feature
which will relocate the fdt/ramdisk. This might then overlap with the
spin table.
Instead use memalign() which allocates on memory on the heap which is
correctly carved out by lmb.
Please note, that the memory is later reserved in the device tree as
well as in the EFI memory map in ft_fixup_cpu() (in
arch/arm/cpu/armv8/fsl-layerscape/fdt.c).
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable support to update the board via the DFU protocol and make it
possible to export the block devices via USB mass storage protocol.
This will not work out of the box, yet. You have to change the dr_mode
of the usb0 controller to peripheral manually to make it work. True, OTG
support will hopefully coming soon.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Now that the DWC3 USB driver has support for the layerscape platform,
use it. This will have the benefit that peripheral mode will work.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add support for the proper dwc3 device tree binding support as specified
in the offical device tree spec.
Initially, add support for the LS1028A support. Other SoCs should be
easy to add by just adding the corresponding compatible string.
Unfortunately, the device trees of all other layerscape SoCs are not
converted and uses a wrong compatible string only known in u-boot.
To maintain backwards compatibility with current u-boot device trees,
add the generic "fsl,layerscape-dwc3" compatible string.
OTG mode is not supported yet. The dr_mode in the devicetree will either
have to be set to peripheral or host.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
[backport from linux commit d9612c2f0449e24983a8b689603210486a930c90]
Enable the undefined length INCR burst type and set INCRx.
Different platform may has the different burst size type.
In order to get best performance, we need to tune the burst
size to one special value, instead of the default value.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
[backport from linux commit db2be4e9e30c6e43e48c5749d3fc74cee0a6bbb3]
Add adjust_frame_length_quirk for writing to fladj register
which adjusts (micro)frame length to value provided by
"snps,quirk-frame-length-adjustment" property thus avoiding
USB 2.0 devices to time-out over a longer run
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Both dr_mode and maximum-speed properties are usually optional. Drivers
will still try to fetch the properties nonetheless, which leads to error
messages, although they are no errors. Change pr_err() to pr_debug().
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Instead of looking at all USB (host) devices, just search all DWC3
device tree nodes. This will (1) fix a panic if of_match is zero and (2)
also apply the fixup if the controller is in peripheral mode. Both
happen when the DWC3 USB controller driver is used.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Check that all matching nodes have the correct compatible and that there
is at least one match.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add a helper to iterate over all nodes with a given compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Now that everything is prepared, copy the fsl-ls1028a.dtsi from the
linux kernel v5.14.12.
Notable changes:
- second watchdog added
- the number of chip selects of the SPI controller is now correct and
reflects what the hardware offers
- the LPUARTs have the correct clock parent
- USB controllers are enabled by default, which was already the case
before this sync because all board enabled all the USB controller
nodes. A linux patch to fix this is pending.
- the eSDHC controller changes from big-endian to little-endian, but
that property seems to be not used at all.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Disable the PCIe controllers by default, just like in the linux device
tree. But there is one catch, for linux they are enabled in-place by the
bootloader. Obviously, this doesn't work for the bootloader. Thus we
explicitly enable the controllers in the -u-boot.dtsi files.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
To make the synchronization of the u-boot device tree with the one from
linux easier, move the I/O window to the one which is specified in the
linux device tree. The actual value shouldn't matter as long as it
mapped to the corresponding memory window of the PCIe controller which
is a 32GiB window at 80_0000_0000h (first controller) or 88_0000_0000h
(second controller).
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This property is unused in the layerscape PCIe controller driver and not
present in the linux device tree. Remove it to be similarly.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The official bindind of the PCIe controller of the ls1028a has the
following compatible string:
compatible = "fsl,ls1028a-pcie";
Additionally, the resource names and count are different. Update the
driver to support this binding and change the entry in the ls1028a
device tree.
Cc: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The official ls1028a binding of the driver uses the following as
compatibles:
compatible = "fsl,ls1028a-dwc3", "snps,dwc3";
Change the ls1028a device tree and add this new compatible to the fsl
specific xhci driver, otherwise the generic dwc3 driver will be used
with the compatibles above.
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The driver will look for a named resource "ecc-addr", but this isn't the
official binding. In fact, the official device tree binding
documentation doesn't mention any resource names at all. But it is safe
to assume that it's the linux ones we have to use if we want to be
compatible with the linux device tree. Thus rename "ecc-addr" to
"sata-ecc" and convert all the users in u-boot.
While at it, also rename "sata-base" to "ahci" although its not used at
all.
This change doesn't affect the SATA controller on the ZynqMP.
Cc: Michal Simek <monstr@monstr.eu>
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The official ls1028a binding of the driver uses the following as
compatibles:
compatible = "fsl,ls1028a-lpuart";
Add the missing compatible to the driver and update the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The official ls1028a binding of the driver uses the following as
compatibles:
compatible = "fsl,ls1028a-dspi", "fsl,ls1021a-v1.0-dspi";
Add the missing compatible to the driver and update the device tree.
We can use the fallback "fsl,ls1021a-v1.0-dspi", because the endianness
is determined by the little-endian property and not by the compatible
string itself. Further, we won't need and specific details on the DMA
configuration (which is different on the LS1021A). If it's ever needed,
we can later add the more specific "fsl,ls1028a-dspi" compatible to the
driver.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
According to the linux device tree specification the compatible string
is:
compatible = "arm,sp805", "arm,primecell";
Fix all users in u-boot.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
While at it fix the indentation.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting it into the new location, keep it sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
While at it fix the indentation.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting it into the new location, keep it sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
While inserting them into the new location, keep them sorted by the
register base offset just like in the linux kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
To keep the device tree similar to the linux kernel one, we need to move
all CCSR related devices into the /soc node. To keep the patches easy to
review, we initially add an empty /soc node and populate it piece by
piece.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Nowadays, both boards boot using the TF-A BL1/BL2 and SPL isn't used at
all. The property is not needed, remove it.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This node is some hodgepodge between the ddr controller node at SoC
offset 0x1080000 and some static memory size of 2GiB. Remove this bogus
node because it doesn't seem to be used at all.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is no "fsl,ls1028a-gpu" compatible string. It is solely for the
proprietary driver which will never be open source. Lately, linux gained
support for the open source etnaviv driver for the GPU (although there
is still support for the DisplayPort PHY missing to get actual graphics
output). Thus, instead of supporting some proprietary driver, switch
over to the open source one, which also have an official device tree
binding.
Cc: Andy Tang <andy.tang@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Adds check for memory clock variable before calculating caslat_actual.
Set mclk_ps to slowest DIMM supported if mclk_ps is found zero.
Signed-off-by: Maninder Singh <maninder.singh_1@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This has not been supported by toolchains for some time and has been
putting out a warning. Drop this.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Remove "num-cs" property from device-tree as it is no longer used by
qspi driver anymore.
Also, specify status as "disabled" and enable qspi support in respective
board dts files. This will also help in aligning node properties with
other board properties.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Document the update image and how to use the EFI UpdateCapsule.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In order to add other Kontron boards to the docs alongside the existing sl28 board,
we need to reduce the levels of the sections and change the title.
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Acked-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable support for update over EFI UpdateCapsule mechanism. This board
doesn't support setting EFI variables after ExitBootservices().
Therefore, we are also enabling EFI_IGNORE_OSINDICATIONS.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Generate a FIT update image during build. The image will be called
"u-boot.update" and can be used to build an EFI UpdateCapsule or during
DFU mode. Although, the latter isn't supported because there is no USB
OTG driver yet.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Allow EFI to actually set the time before ExitBootServices().
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Increase fdt blob size for lx2160 and lx2162 series
to fix below errors/warnings during device tree fixup.
Unable to update property /soc/spi@2100000:status, err=FDT_ERR_NOSPACE
Unable to update property /soc/spi@2110000:status, err=FDT_ERR_NOSPACE
Unable to update property /soc/spi@2120000:status, err=FDT_ERR_NOSPACE
WARNING: could not set reg FDT_ERR_NOSPACE.
WARNING unable to set iommus: FDT_ERR_NOSPACE
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Disabling PCIE support currently lead to a crash because the code for
erratum A010315 is still run. Add a conditional to only select
CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A010315 when CONFIG_PCIE_LAYERSCAPE is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Alban Bedel <alban.bedel@aerq.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fix Bad Shift operator issue in step_to_string function
by adding an if check
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Singh <priyanka.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fix possible divide by zero issue in fsl_ddr_set_memctl_regs
by adding an if check
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Singh <priyanka.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fix possible divide by zero issue in get_memory_clk_period_ps
by adding a check
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Singh <priyanka.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
to fix following checkpatch warnings.
Use 'if (IS_ENABLED(CONFIG...))' instead of '#if or #ifdef' where
possible
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Cc: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
At present the counter never hits the comparitor in this case. Add a
special case.
This ensures that the snow backlight works when at full brightness.
Fixes: 76c2ff3e5f video: backlight: fix pwm's duty cycle calculation
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
According to ./include/linux/kconfig.h,
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OF_BOARD) expands to 0
when CONFIG_SPL_BUILD is defined because
there is no CONFIG_SPL_OF_BOARD.
Use #if defined instead.
Fixes: 2e8d2f8843 ("riscv: Remove OF_PRIOR_STAGE from RISC-V boards")
Signed-off-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This patch adds memcpy_fromio and memcpy_toio definitions for some device
drivers which have these definitions, like cadence_qspi_apb.c
Signed-off-by: Wei Fu <wefu@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc2
Documentation:
* improve description of mmc rescan
* remove obsolete PPC documenation
UEFI
* Provide unit test for the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL
* Implement add EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL.SubmitCommand
* Start the implementation of a 64 bit EFI app
* Reduce rcar3_salvator-x image size
Currently output of dfu commands ends on a line with leading hash signs
('#'). The succeeding output should be placed on a new line.
After writing updates via dfu print a new line.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
rcar3_salvator-x u-boot.img is very close to the 0x100000 size limit.
Disable support for Unicode capitalization.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This commit adds the missing EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL selftest
and Measured Boot selftest in lib/efi_selftest.
This selftest includes PE/COFF image measurement test, some PCR values are
different in each architecture. With that, this commit also adds pre-built
versions of lib/efi_selftest/efi_miniapp_file_image_exit.c for PE/COFF
image measurement test for 32-bit arm, arm64, ia32, x86_64, riscv32 and
riscv64. Prebuilding avoids the problem of reproducible builds.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Make the test 'onrequest'.
Add code comments to the includes with the binaries.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The current EFI video driver only works when running in the stub. In that
case the stub calls boot services (before jumping to U-Boot proper) and
copies the graphics info over to the efi table. This is necessary because
the stub exits boot services before jumping to U-Boot.
The app maintains access to boot services throughout its life, so does not
need to do this. Update the driver to support calling boot services
directly.
Enable video output for the app. Note that this uses the
EFI_GRAPHICS_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL protocol, even though it mentions vesa.
A sample qemu command-line for this case is:
qemu-system-x86_64 -bios /usr/share/edk2.git/ovmf-ia32/OVMF-pure-efi.fd
-drive id=disk,file=try.img,if=none,format=raw -nic none
-device ahci,id=ahci -device ide-hd,drive=disk,bus=ahci.0
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add a function to return this information along with a stub for the
efi_info_get() function, since calling it otherwise hangs U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This variable is already defined by the EFI code. Drop the duplicate
definition when building a 64-bit EFI app.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Most modern platforms use 64-bit EFI so it is useful to have a U-Boot app
that runs under that. Add a (non-functional) build for this.
Note that --whole-archive causes the gcc 9.2 linker to crash, so disable
this for now. Once this is resolved, things should work.
For now, avoid mentioning the documentation for the 64-bit app, since it
does not work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Most EFI implementations use 64-bit but U-Boot only supports running as
a 32-bit app at present. While efi-x86_payload64 does boot from 64-bit
UEFI it immediately changes back to 32-bit before starting U-Boot.
In order to support a 64-bit U-Boot app, update the Kconfig to add an
option for 32/64 bit. Update the prompt for the existing option so it is
clear it relates to the stub. Move both up to just under the choice that
controls them, since this looks better and the menu.
Use CONFIG_EFI_APP in the Makefile instead of CONFIG_TARGET_EFI_APP,
since the latter is specific to a single target and we will have two.
Memory size is set to 32MB for now so that it can run on qemu without
increasing the default memory size. We may need to increase the default
later.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
For the EFI app, we must embed the devicetree in the ELF file since that
is the only thing that is run by UEFI. Drop the warning to avoid
confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
There is no need to avoid driver model for networking. Drop this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
It is quite complicated to run U-Boot on QEMU since we have four
different builds and they must use different versions of qemu and the
UEFI binaries.
Add a script to help. It requires U-Boot itself to be built. Once that
is done you can use this script to build an image for use with qemu and
optionally run it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit adds the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL.SubmitCommand
required in the TCG PC Client PFP spec.
SubmitCommand enables to send the raw command to the TPM device.
To implement this api, tpm2_submit_command() is added
into tpm-v2.c.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
As we discussed in ML, currently a device tree is the only place
to store public keys for capsule authentication. So __weak is not
necessary for now.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide human readable descriptions of the speed nodes instead of the name
of constants from the code.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The related boards have been removed four years ago already, in
commit 98f705c9ce ("powerpc: remove 4xx support"), so this README
file is not required anymore.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The PPC440 support has been removed in commit 98f705c9ce
("powerpc: remove 4xx support"). This patch removes this obsolete
file as well.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F
CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT
CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When building a system that has both TPL and SPL_OS_BOOT, code which
tests for CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT will be built and enabled in TPL, which is
not correct. While there is no CONFIG_TPL_OS_BOOT symbol at this time
(and likely will not ever be) we can use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OS_BOOT) in
these common paths to ensure we only compile these parts in the SPL
case.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
For the symbols which are both hard-coded as enabled and used, move to
Kconfig. The rest of the CONFIG_YAFFS namespace is unselected anywhere,
so we leave it as is.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Instead of hardcoding the watchdog for reset, and the PMIC for poweroff,
use the sysreset framework to manage the available poweroff/reset
backends. This allows (as examples) using the PMIC to do a cold reset,
and using a GPIO to power off H3/H5 boards lacking a PMIC. Furthermore,
it removes the need to hardcode watchdog MMIO addresses, since the
sysreset backends can be discovered using the device tree.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The sysreset uclass unconditionally provides a definition of the
reset_cpu() function. So does the sunxi board code. Fix the build with
SYSRESET enabled by omitting the function from the board code in that
case. The code still needs to be kept around for use in SPL.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add an option to automatically register watchdog devices with the
wdt_reboot driver for use with sysreset. This allows sysreset to be a
drop-in replacement for platform-specific watchdog reset code, without
needing any device tree changes.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently, the wdt_reboot driver always gets its watchdog device
reference from an OF node. This prevents selecting a watchdog at
runtime. Move the watchdog device reference to the plat data, so
the driver can be bound with the reference pre-provided. The
reference will still be acquired from the OF node if it is not
already provided.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These driver probe functions are not (and should not be) called from
outside the respective driver source files. Therefore, the functions
should be marked static.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
None of the sysreset drivers do anything beyond providing sysreset
uclass ops. They should depend on the sysreset uclass.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- pci_mvebu: Fix access to config space and PCIe Root Port (Pali)
- a37xx: pci: Program the data strobe for config read requests (Pali)
- kwboot: Misc improvements and fixes (Pali)
When allocate the GPD ring, and tell its address to the controller, then
the driver starts or resumes the QMU, the controller will try to access
the first GPD, so need flush the first one to avoid wrong GPD status.
Reported-by: Xin Lin <Xin.Lin@mediatek.com>
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
According to the Armada 3720 Functional Specification Data Strobe applies
for both read and write config requests.
Data strobe bits configure which bytes from the start address should be
returned for read request. Set value 0xf (all 4 bits) into Data Strobe
register to read all four bytes from specified 32-bit config space
register. Same value for Data Strobe register is programmed by Linux
pci-aardvark.c driver for config read requests.
Without this patch pci-aardvark driver sets data strobe register only
during config write operations. So any followup config read operations
could result with just partial datai returned (if previous write operation
was not 32-bit wide). This patch fixes it and ensures that config read
operations always read all bytes from requested register.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After successful transfer of whole image only two things can happen:
- BootROM starts execution of data block, which changes UART baudrate
back to 115200 Bd,
- board crashes and causes CPU reset
In both cases UART baudrate is reset to the default speed. So there is
no need to send special magic sequence to inform kwboot that baudrate is
going to be reset and kwboot does not need to wait for this event and
can do it immediately after BootROM acknowledges end of xmodem transfer.
Move ARM code for sending magic sequence from main baudrate change
section to binhdr_pre section which is executed only before changing
baudrate from the default value of 115200 Bd to some new value. Remove
kwboot code waiting for magic sequence after successful xmodem transfer.
Rationale: sometimes when using very high UART speeds, magic sequence is
damaged and kwboot fails at this last stage. Removal of this magic
sequence makes booting more stable.
Data transfer protocol (xmodem) is using checksums and retransmit, so it
already deals with possible errors on transfer line.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The ARM code we inject into the image to change baudrate back to the
default value of 115200 Baud, which is run after successful UART transfer
of the whole image, cannot use stack as at this stage stack pointer is not
initialized yet.
Stack can only be used when BootROM is executing binary header, to
preserve state of registers, since BootROM expects that.
Change the ARM baudrate code to not use stack at all and put binary
header specific pre + post code (which stores and restores registers) into
separate arrays.
The baudrate change code now jumps at it's end and expects that there is
either code which returns to the BootROM or jumps to the original exec
address.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Older Armada SoCs have custom ARMv5te compatible core which does not
support movt instruction. So replace mov + movt instruction pair used for
immediate move construction by mov + orr instructions which are supported
also by ARMv5te.
After this change kwboot ARM code should be compatible with any 32-bit ARM
core compatible by ARMv2 or new. At least GNU AS does not throw any error
or warning.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Increase loop cycles from 600000 to 2998272, which should increase delay
from 1ms to about 5ms on 1200 MHz CPU.
The Number 2998272 was chosen as the nearest value around 3000000 which can
be encoded into one ARM mov instruction. It avoids usage of movt instruction
which is not supported by ARMv5te cores.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Kwboot puts each xmodem packet to kernel queue, then waits until all bytes
of that packet are transmitted over UART and then waits for xmodem reply
until it is received into kernel queue.
If some reply is received during the time we are waiting until all bytes
are transmitted, then kernel puts them into the queue and returns it to
kwboot in next read() call.
So there is no need to wait (with tcdrain() function) until all bytes from
xmodem packet are transmitted over UART, since any reply received either
during that time or after is returned to kwboot with the next read().
Therefore do not call tcdrain() after each xmodem packet sent. Instead
directly wait for any reply after putting xmodem packet into write kernel
queue.
This change could speed up xmodem transfer in case tcdrain() function waits
for a longer time.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After the trasfer of last header packet, it is possible that baudrate
change pattern is received, and also that NAK byte is received so that
the packet should be sent again.
Thus we should not clear the baudrate change state when sending retry
of that packet.
Move code for initializing state variables from kwboot_xm_recv_reply()
to kwboot_xm_sendblock().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently when kwboot receive some garbage reply which does not understand,
it waits 1s before it tries to resend packet again.
The most common error on UART is that receiver sees some bit flipped which
results in invalid reply.
This behavior slows down xmodem transfer over UART as basically on every
error kwboot is waiting one second.
To fix this, try to resend xmodem packet for first 3 attempts immediately
without any delay. If broken reply is received also after the 3 attempts,
continue retrying with 1s delay like it was before.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch does not change behavior of the code, just allows to implement
new changes more easily.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Size of the header stored in kwbimage may be larger than real used size in
the kwbimage header. If there is unused space in kwbimage header then use
it for growing it. So update code to calculate used space of kwbimage
header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This ensures that kwboot_img_grow_hdr() function still sees valid kwbimage
header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Expression (hdrsz % KWBOOT_XM_BLKSZ) is non-zero therefore expression
(KWBOOT_XM_BLKSZ - hdrsz % KWBOOT_XM_BLKSZ) is always less than value
KWBOOT_XM_BLKSZ. So there is no need to add another modulo. Also rename
variable `offset` to `grow` which better describes what is stored in
this variable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
It is hard to debug why kwboot is failing when the last message is
'Finishing transfer' and no additional output. So show verbose message when
kwboot finished transfer and is waiting for baudrate change magic sequence.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For kwbimage v1, tell BootROM to send BootROM messages to UART port number
0 (used also for UART booting) with default baudrate (which should be
115200) and do not touch UART MPP configuration.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If data part of image is modified, update 4-byte data checksum.
It looks like A385 BootROM does not verify this checksum for image
loaded via UART, but we do not know if other BootROMs are also ignoring
it. It is always better to provide correct checksum.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Some vendor U-Boot kwbimage binaries (e.g. those for A375) have load
address set to zero. Therefore it is not possible to inject code which
changes baudrate back to 115200 Bd before the data part.
So instead inject it after the data part and change kwbimage execution
address to that offset. Also store original execution address into
baudrate change code, so after it changes baudrate back to 115200 Bd, it
can jump to orignal address.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Data part of the image contains 4-byte checksum. Validate it when
processing the image.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
SPI image header and data parts do not have to be aligned to 128 byte
xmodem block size. So reserve additional memory for aligning header part
and additional memory for aligning data part.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Explicitly disable 2 stop bits by clearing CSTOPB flag, disable modem
control flow by clearing CRTSCTS flag and do not send hangup after closing
device by clearing HUPCL flag.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Explicitly zero out the rfds fd_set with FD_ZERO() before using it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Root Complex should be the default mode, let's set it explicitly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Now that PCI Bridge is working, U-Boot's CONFIG_PCI_PNP code automatically
enables memory access and bus mastering when it is needed. So do not
prematurely enable memory access and bus mastering.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI Bridge is always accessible also when link is down. So move detection
of link up from mvebu_pcie_of_to_plat() function to mvebu_pcie_valid_addr()
function which is used when accessing PCI config space.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Functions mvebu_pcie_get_local_bus_nr() and mvebu_pcie_get_local_dev_nr()
are not used, so remove them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The mysterious "Memory controller" PCI device which is present in PCI
config space is improperly configured and crippled PCI Bridge which acts
as PCIe Root Port for endpoint PCIe card.
This PCI Bridge reports in PCI config space incorrect Class Code (Memory
Controller) and incorrect Header Type (Type 0). It looks like HW bug in
mvebu PCIe controller but apparently it can be changed via mvebu registers
to correct values.
The worst thing is that this PCI Bridge is crippled and its PCI config
registers in range 0x10-0x34 alias access to internal mvebu registers which
have different functionality as PCI Bridge registers. Moreover,
configuration of PCI primary and secondary bus numbers (registers 0x18
and 0x19) is done via totally different mvebu registers via totally strange
method and cannot be done via PCI Bridge config space.
Due to above fact about PCI config range 0x10-0x34, allocate a private
cfgcache[] buffer in the driver, to which PCI config access requests to
the 0x10-0x34 space will be redirected in mvebu_pcie_read_config() and
mvebu_pcie_write_config() functions. Function mvebu_pcie_write_config()
will also catch writes to PCI_PRIMARY_BUS (0x18) and PCI_SECONDARY_BUS
(0x19) registers and set PCI Bridge primary and secondary bus numbers via
mvebu's own method.
Also, Expansion ROM Base Address register (0x38) is available, but at
different offset 0x30. So recalculate register offset before accessing PCI
config space.
After these steps U-Boot sees working PCI Bridge and CONFIG_PCI_PNP code
can finally start enumerating all PCIe devices correctly, even with more
complicated PCI topology. So update also mvebu_pcie_valid_addr() function
to reflect state of the real device topology.
Each PCIe port is de-facto isolated and every PCI Bridge which is part of
PCIe Root Complex is also isolated, so put them on separate PCI buses as
(local) device 0.
U-Boot already supports enumerating separate PCI buses, real (HW) bus
number can be retrieved by "PCI_BUS(bdf) - dev_seq(bus)" code, so update
config read/write functions to properly handle more complicated tree
topologies (e.g. when a PCIe switch with multiple PCI buses is connected
to the PCIe port).
Local bus number and local device number on mvebu are used for determining
which config request type is used (Type 0 vs Type 1). On normal non-broken
PCIe hardware it is done by primary and secondary bus numbers. So correctly
translate settings between these numbers to ensure that correct config
requests are sent over the PCIe bus.
As bus numbers are correctly re-configured, it does not make sense to print
some initial bogus configuration during probe, so remove this debug code.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When reading 8 or 16 bits from config space, use appropriate readb() or
readw() calls. This ensures that PCIe controller does not read more bits
from endpoint card as asked by read_config() function.
Technically there should not be an issue with reading data from config
space which are not later used as there are no clear-by-read registers.
But it is better to use correct read operation based on requested size.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Current implementation of write_config() is broken for PCI_SIZE_8 or
PCI_SIZE_16 as it always uses writel(), which means that write operation
is always 32-bit, so upper 24 bits for PCI_SIZE_8 and upper 16 bits for
PCI_SIZE_16 are cleared.
Fix this by using writeb() and writew(), respectively.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Fixes for x86 build with Clang/LLVM compiler
- Tangier ACPI changes
- Edison SD card detect pin fix
- EFI on x86 doc update with latest instructions
- PXE utility fixes to align with latest x86 zboot implementation
There are two PCB designs in the wild which use the opposite
signaling for SD card detection. This makes U-Boot working
in one case and failing in the other. Quirk this out by
disconnecting SD card detection pin from the PCB by switching
it to mode 3. In the disconnected state the read value is always
the same and inverted to what we are expecting in the code.
BugLink: https://github.com/edison-fw/meta-intel-edison/issues/136
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
We would need to quirk out the Card Detect case and for that we allow
configuring the SD/SDIO family of pins.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When building U-Boot with clang, it notices that the i8254.h include
guard does not work correctly due to a typo. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Alistair Delva <adelva@google.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: fixed the other same typo at the end of the same file]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There is no point to use Method() for the constant.
Replace it with Name() defined object. For the _STA
case it saves 3 bytes per each entry.
Before: 2881
After: 2833
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
bootm and zboot accept different arguments:
> bootm [addr [arg ...]]
> - boot application image stored in memory
> passing arguments 'arg ...'; when booting a Linux kernel,
> 'arg' can be the address of an initrd image
> zboot [addr] [size] [initrd addr] [initrd size] [setup] [cmdline]
> addr - The optional starting address of the bzimage.
> If not set it defaults to the environment
> variable "fileaddr".
> size - The optional size of the bzimage. Defaults to
> zero.
> initrd addr - The address of the initrd image to use, if any.
> initrd size - The size of the initrd image to use, if any.
In the zboot flow, the current code will reuse the bootm args and attempt
to pass the initrd arg (argv[2]) as the kernel size (should be argv[3]).
zboot also expects the initrd address and size to be separate arguments.
Let's untangle them and have separate argv/argc locals.
Signed-off-by: Zhaofeng Li <hello@zhaofeng.li>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The existing intructions in the U-Boot on EFI doc do not work with
the latest QEMU. Update the doc with the correct instructions, as
well as using the new OVMF URL link.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Environment tidy-ups
patman 'postfix' support
fix binman test race condition causing a timeout error
# gpg: Signature made Sun 31 Oct 2021 03:36:55 PM EDT
# gpg: using RSA key B25C0022AF86A7CC1655B6277F173A3E9008ADE6
# gpg: issuer "sjg@chromium.org"
# gpg: Good signature from "Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>" [unknown]
# gpg: WARNING: This key is not certified with a trusted signature!
# gpg: There is no indication that the signature belongs to the owner.
# Primary key fingerprint: B25C 0022 AF86 A7CC 1655 B627 7F17 3A3E 9008 ADE6
Check sizeof(default_environment) against ENV_SIZE in a static_assert()
instead of runtime.
Only check if !USE_HOSTCC (for in fw_env tool ENV_SIZE expands to a
variable, and cannot be checked statically) nad
!DEFAULT_ENV_INSTANCE_EMBEDDED, for in that case the default_environment
variable is not set.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sometimes we use uchar and sometimes char for the default environment
array. By always using char, we can get rid of some explicit casts.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Various freescale boards set gd->env_addr to default_environment in
board_init(), conditional on CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE, but this is
redundant, since it is done by env_init() before board_init() is called.
Let the env subsystem handle this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Mian Yousaf Kaukab <ykaukab@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This board sets gd->env_addr to default_environment in board_init(), but
the board has environment in SPI flash according to defconfig. Let the
env API handle environment automatically.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
env_flash_init() (both implementations) assigns default environment if
ENV_INVALID, but this is done in the generic env_init() function, which
calls this initializer, so drop it from here.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use spaces instead of tabs in assignments, since there are no lines to
align assignment values to.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
env_nowhere_init() assigns default environment if ENV_INVALID, but this
is done in the generic env_init() function, which calls this
initializer, so drop it from here.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
env_nvram_init() assigns default environment if ENV_INVALID, but this is
done in the generic env_init() function, which calls this initializer,
so drop it from here.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
env_nand_init() says the environment is valid even if it is assigning
default environment due to not being able to access nand pre-reloaction
(determined by macro values). Change this to ENV_INVALID and let the
generic env_init() function, which calls this initializer, assign the
default environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
env_sf_init_addr() says the environment is valid even if it is assigning
default environment due to CRC failure. Change this to ENV_INVALID and
let the generic env_init() function, which calls this initializer,
assign the default environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The function env_sf_init_addr() assigns number literals (1) instead of
ENV_VALID to gd->env_valid. Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the if clause we use tabs and in the else clause spaces. Let's use
spaces in the if clause too.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When linking the final u-boot binary with LLD, the following link errors
are seen:
ld.lld: error: can't create dynamic relocation R_386_32 against local
symbol in readonly segment; recompile object files with
-fPIC or pass '-Wl,-z,notext' to allow text relocations
in the output
>>> defined in arch/x86/cpu/start.o
>>> referenced by arch/x86/cpu/start.o:(.text.start+0x32)
[...]
>>> defined in arch/x86/cpu/start16.o
>>> referenced by arch/x86/cpu/start16.o:(.start16+0x1C)
According to Nick Desaulniers:
"This is a known difference between GNU and LLVM linkers; the GNU
linkers permit relocations in readonly segments (making them not read
only), LLVM does not (by default)."
Since U-Boot apparently seems to use relocations in readonly segments,
change the global linker flags to permit them when linking with LLD by
specifying '-z notext'.
Signed-off-by: Alistair Delva <adelva@google.com>
Cc: Nick Desaulniers <ndesaulniers@google.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present testThreadTimeout() assumes that the expected timeout happens
first when building the section, but it can just as easily happen at the
top-level image. Update the test to cope with both.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The data blob apparently does not need to be modified through the fit
field of the image_sign_info struct so make it point to const to avoid
the need to cast away constness in functions that assign a pointer to
const data to the field.
fit_image_setup_verify already had to cast away constness as it assigned
a const void * argument to the field. The cast can now be removed.
Signed-off-by: Hannu Lounento <hannu.lounento@vaisala.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Revert GIC LPI changes that need to be reworked.
- mvebu SATA booting bugfix
- Samsung Galaxy S9/S9+(SM-G96x0), Samsung Galaxy A and Apple M1
platform support.
Samsung Galaxy A3, A5, A7 (2017) - middle class Samsung smartphones.
U-boot can be used as chain-loaded bootloader to gain control
on booting vanilla linux(and possibly others) kernels
Signed-off-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Cc: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Samsung S9 SM-G9600 - Snapdragon SDM845 version of the phone,
for China \ Hong Kong markets.
Has unlockable bootloader, unlike SM-G960U (American market version),
which allows running u-boot as a chain-loaded bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Hi-end qualcomm chip, introduced in late 2017.
Mostly used in flagship phones and tablets of 2018.
Features:
- arm64 arch
- total of 8 Kryo 385 Gold / Silver cores
- Hexagon 685 DSP
- Adreno 630 GPU
Tested only as second-stage bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Allows to change clock frequency of debug uart,
thus supporting wide range of baudrates.
Enable / disable functionality is not implemented yet.
In most use cases of SDM845 (i.e. mobile phones and tablets)
it's not needed, because qualcomm first stage bootloader leaves it
initialized, and on the other hand there's no possibility to
replace signed first stage bootloader with u-boot.
Signed-off-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Generic Interface (GENI) Serial Engine (SE) based uart
can be found on newer qualcomm SOCs, starting from SDM845.
Tested on Samsung SM-G9600(starqltechn)
by chain-loading u-boot with stock bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Dzmitry Sankouski <dsankouski@gmail.com>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Provide preliminary instructions on how to get U-Boot to run on
Apple Silicon Macs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add preliminary device trees for the Apple M1 mini (2020) and
Apple M1 Macbook Pro 13" (2020). Device tree bindings for
the Apple M1 SoC are still being formalized and these device
trees will be synchronized with the Linux kernel as needed.
The device trees in this commit are based on the initial Apple
M1 device trees from Linux 5.13, nodes for dart, pcie, pinctrl,
pmgr, usb based on bindings on track for inclusion in Linux
5.15 and 5.16 and nodes for i2c, mailbox, nvme, pmu, spmi and
watchdog that don't have a proposed binding yet.
These device trees are provided as a reference only as U-Boot
uses the device tree passed by the m1n1 bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The DART is an IOMMU that is used on Apple's M1 SoC. This driver
configures the DART such that it operates in bypass mode which is
enough to support DMA for the USB3 ports integrated on the SoC.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Apple M1 SoCs include an S5L UART which is a variant of the S5P
UART. Add support for this variant and enable it by default
on Apple SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for Apple's M1 SoC that is used in "Apple Silicon"
Macs. This builds a basic U-Boot that can be used as a payload
for the m1n1 boot loader being developed by the Asahi Linux
project.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Add MAINTAINERS entry]
This uclass is intended to manage IOMMUs on systems where the
IOMMUs are not in bypass mode by default. In that case U-Boot
cannot ignore the IOMMUs if it wants to use devices that need
to do DMA and sit behind such an IOMMU.
This initial IOMMU uclass implementation does not implement and
device ops and is intended for IOMMUs that have a bypass mode
that does not require address translation. Support for IOMMUs
that do require address translation is planned and device ops
will be defined when support for such IOMMUs will be added.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use proper SATA macro for boot_device switch in spl_boot_device() function.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 2226ca1734 ("arm: mvebu: Load U-Boot proper binary in SPL code based on kwbimage header")
Stop using the device tree as a source for ad-hoc information.
This reverts commit 2ae7adc659.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
[trini: Also make board/broadcom/bcmns3/ns3.c fail clearly now]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Ad-hoc bindings that are not part of the upstream device tree / bindings
are not allowed in-tree. Only bindings that are in-progress with
upstream and then re-synced once agreed upon are.
This reverts commit af288cb291.
Cc: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reported-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Marc Zyngier <maz@kernel.org>
This allows specifying partitions using more extended syntax. This is
particularly useful to access eMMC hardware partitions. For example,
this allows something like
ums 0 mmc 0.0,0.1,0.2,0.3
to expose four LUNs for each of the four default eMMC hardware
partitions. Note that the comma syntax was already present, and this
syntax is already documented.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
dev_err seems to be moved to different header file. Include
dm/device_compat.h file to compile properly.
Fixes: 69dae8902b ("linux/compat.h: Remove redefinition of dev_xxx macros")
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Now that the three M/N/H variants can be built from one config,
rename the defconfig file to be more generic since it supports multiple
RZ/G2.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Both Ethernet and USB drivers get their reference clocks from
the versaclock. Enable that driver and the common clock driver
by default.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Now that TARGET_BEACON_RZG2M can handle all the work that
was done with TARGET_BEACON_RZG2N and TARGET_BEACON_RZG2H,
remove them since they just create more duplicate code.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The three different boards share the same board file and only differ
in terms of which SoC is being used. By enabling FIT on
TARGET_BEACON_RZG2M, it can support all three boards and elimate
duplicate code.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
There are three boards from Beacon, RZ/G2 M/N/H which all
use the same board file, but different device trees.
Add code to automatically select the proper device tree
based on the CPU type.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
JetHome has own MAC OUI. Add jethub-j100 board file. Update config.
Signed-off-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This adds support for amlogic efuse write and provides two subcommands
of "sm" command: "efuseread" and "efusewrite" to read/write bytes between
memory and efuse.
Signed-off-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
[narmstrong: fixed indent at end of patch]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
There are 4 registers (PERIPHID{0-3}) that contain the ID of MCI.
For MMCs' with peripheral id 0x02041180 and 0x03041180, H/W flow control
needs to be enabled for multi block writes (MMC CMD 18).
Signed-off-by: Usama Arif <usama.arif@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
It doesn't need to follow more sequence to do the hwparititioning,
because SD doesn't support hwpartitioning feature.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add option to extend the hardware partition to the maximum size by
using the '-' dash sign instead of $cnt parameter. This is useful
in case we want to switch the entire eMMC user area into pSLC mode,
especially in case the device may be populated with different size
eMMCs. With this change, we do not have to calculate the number of
blocks of the user area manually.
To switch the pSLC mode for user area, use e.g. the following.
WARNING: This is a one-time irreversible change.
=> mmc hwpartition user enh 0 - wrrel on complete
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Adds an implementation of the wait_dat0 MMC operation for the DM SDHCI
driver, allowing the driver to continue when the card is ready rather
than waiting for the worst case time on each MMC switch operation.
Signed-off-by: Stephen Carlson <stcarlso@linux.microsoft.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Adds an implementation of the wait_dat0 MMC operation for the Freescale
eSHDC driver, allowing the driver to continue when the card is ready
rather than waiting for the worst case time on each MMC switch operation.
Signed-off-by: Stephen Carlson <stcarlso@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
- mvebu: Fix usage of BIN header arguments (Pali)
- mvebu: turris_omnia: Fix MTD partitions order for Linux (Pali)
- mvebu: nandpagesize support for kwbimage v1 (Pali)
kwbimage v1 has also nandpagesize field. So set it to zero for both image
versions when image is not signed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The NAND_PAGE_SIZE command is already supported by mkimage for v0 images,
but not for v1 images.
A38x and A39x BootROM supports reading NAND flash page size from v1 image
in the same way as Kirkwood BootROM from v0 image. It it documented in A38x
and A39x Functional Specification.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Linux enumerates MTD partitions in DTB order, while the fdt_add_subnode()
function puts a new subnode at the beginning.
To fix this, put MTD partitions into DTB in reverse order.
Fixes: 92f36c8e74 ("arm: mvebu: turris_omnia: fixup MTD partitions in Linux' DTB")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
U-Boot SPL binary does not read BIN header arguments, so passing some dummy
values 0000005b and 00000068 has no effect for U-Boot SPL code.
Probably these two values comes from old Marvell DDR training code which
was separated from U-Boot and used it for some configuration.
Seems that two 32-bit values were specified here to ensure SPL code
alignment to 128-bit boundary as it is required e.g. for A370 or AXP
processors. Main kwbimage header is 64-byte long which is aligned to
128-bit boundary. Optional kwbheader is 32-bit long, number of BIN header
arguments is stored in 32-bit number. So for alignment to 128-bit boundary
is needed 64-bit padding which exactly these two 32-bit dummy arguments
provided.
Now when mkimage correctly aligns start of executable code in BIN header to
128-bit boundary, there is no requirement to put dummy argument values into
kwbimage. So remove them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Important detail is availability of kwbimage BIN header arguments passed
via r0 and r1 registers by BootROM.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
ARM executable code inside the BIN header on some mvebu platforms
(e.g. A370, AXP) must always be aligned with the 128-bit boundary. This
requirement can be met by inserting dummy arguments into BIN header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
ARM executable code inside the BIN header on some mvebu platforms
(e.g. A370, AXP) must always be aligned with the 128-bit boundary. This
requirement can be met by inserting dummy arguments into BIN header.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
OF_HOSTFILE is used on sandbox configs only. Although it's pretty
unique and not causing any confusions, we are better of having simpler
config options for the DTB.
So let's replace that with the existing OF_BOARD. U-Boot would then
have only three config options for the DTB origin.
- OF_SEPARATE, build separately from U-Boot
- OF_BOARD, board specific way of providing the DTB
- OF_EMBED embedded in the u-boot binary(should not be used in production
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit adds the DeployedMode and AuditMode variable
measurement required in TCG PC Client Platform Firmware
Profile Specification.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
This commit adds the UEFI GPT disk partition topology
measurement required in TCG PC Client Platform Firmware
Profile Specification
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Free() checks if its argument in NULL. There is no need for the caller to
do the same.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Correct the test on RNG device presence,when ret is equal to 0,
before to call dm_rng_read function.
Without this patch the RNG device is not used when present (when ret == 0)
or a data abort occurs in dm_rng_read when CONFIG_DM_RNG is activated but
the RNG device is not present in device tree (ret != 0 and devp = NULL).
Fixes: 92fdad28cf ("lib: uuid: use RNG device if present")
CC: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
CC: Torsten Duwe <duwe@suse.de>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The padding pss is only supported on u-boot and tools since
commit 2bbed3ff8c ("image: Use Kconfig to enable FIT_RSASSA_PSS on host")
This commit adds the config SPL_FIT_RSASSA_PSS to support
the padding pss in the SPL.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit adds a check on the padding in the function rsa_verify_key
to avoid using a NULL pointer.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
First two fields are reversed compared to what is expected by the SCMI
specification.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
Fixes: 6038884483 ("clk: add clock driver for SCMI agents")
TCG PC Client Platform Firmware Profile Specification
requires to measure the SMBIOS table that contains static
configuration information (e.g. Platform Manufacturer
Enterprise Number assigned by IANA, platform model number,
Vendor and Device IDs for each SMBIOS table).
The device- and environment-dependent information such as
serial number is cleared to zero or space character for
the measurement.
Existing smbios_string() function returns pointer to the string
with const qualifier, but exisintg use case is updating version
string and const qualifier must be removed.
This commit removes const qualifier from smbios_string()
return value and reuses to clear the strings for the measurement.
This commit also fixes the following compiler warning:
lib/smbios-parser.c:59:39: warning: cast to pointer from integer of
different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
const struct smbios_header *header = (struct smbios_header *)entry->struct_table_address;
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Not all SPI flashes and controllers can do continuous transfer longer
than 16 MiB, so perform the DFU read in 16 MiB chunks.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Make sure to (if applicable) flush the D-cache, invalidate I-cache,
and disable MMU and caches before jumping to OPTEE.
This fixes the SDP->SPL->OPTEE boot flow on iMX6Q and most likely on
some other ARM SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Co-developed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
In multiple places we need the default GUID matching a variable name.
The patch provides a library function. For secure boot related variables
like 'PK', 'KEK', 'db' a lookup table is used. For all other variable
names EFI_GLOBAL_VARIABLE is returned.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
UEFI variable names are typically constants and hence should be defined as
const. Unfortunately some of our API functions do not define the parameters
for UEFI variable names as const. This requires unnecessary conversions.
Adjust parameters of several internal functions to tre UEFI variable names
as const.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The commit 47a25e81d3 ("Revert "efi_capsule: Move signature from DTB to
.rodata"") failed to revert the removal of efi_get_public_key_data().
Add back this function and move it under lib/efi_loader so that other
platforms can utilize it. It is now declared as a weak function so that
it can be replaced with a platform-specific implementation.
Fixes: 47a25e81d3 ("Revert "efi_capsule: Move signature from DTB to
.rodata"")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This reverts commit a7e4f905d2.
The description originally written by Sughosh is still valid
even after the commit 47a25e81d3 ("Revert "efi_capsule: Move signature
from DTB to .rodata"") was applied.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
This reverts commit d428e81266.
We have agreed with removing dtb-related stuff from mkeficapsule
command even if the commit 47a25e81d3 ("Revert "efi_capsule: Move
signature from DTB to .rodata"") was applied.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This commit fixes the following compilation warning
of boottime->install_configuration_table() function.
lib/efi_selftest/efi_selftest_tcg2.c:475:46:
warning: passing argument 1 of ‘boottime->install_configuration_table’
discards ‘const’ qualifier from pointer target type [-Wdiscarded-qualifiers]
ret = boottime->install_configuration_table(&smbios_guid, dmi);
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Support for the PPC74xx processors has been removed in commit
d928664f41 ("powerpc: 74xx_7xx: remove 74xx_7xx cpu support")
more than 6 years ago already. So the corresponding README file
can now be removed, too.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Support for PPC4XX processors has been removed. So we should not mention it
in the documentation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Currently the MMC environment driver supports storing redundant environment
only in one eMMC partition at different offsets. This is sub-optimal, since
if this one boot partition is erased, both copies of environment are lost.
Since the eMMC has two boot partitions, add support for storing one copy of
environment in each of the two boot partitions.
To enable this functionality, select CONFIG_SYS_REDUNDAND_ENVIRONMENT to
indicate redundant environment should be used. Set CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART
to 1 to indicate environment should be stored in eMMC boot partition. Set
CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET equal to CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND, and both to the offset
from start of eMMC boot partition where the environment should be located.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
The loads srec loading may overwrite piece of U-Boot accidentally.
Prevent that by using LMB to detect whether upcoming write would
overwrite piece of reserved U-Boot code, and if that is the case,
abort the srec loading.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the environment is stored in eMMC hardware boot partition, the environment
driver first stores the currently selected eMMC boot partition, then does the
requested operation, and then restores the original boot partition settings.
In case the environment operation fails, the boot partition settings are also
restored.
The 'env erase' implementation in the MMC environment driver lacks the path
which restores the boot partition. This could lead to various failure modes,
like the system boots the wrong copy of bootloader etc. Fix this by filling
in the missing restoration path.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
- Add and enable watchdog driver
- Prepare for SYSRESET driven AXP poweroff
- Prepare for SoCs without MMC2
- Some fixes for extending SPL (SPL-DM for RISC-V)
- Some preparations for proper VBUS management
- Fix secure monitor move
Allwinner R329 has no MMC2.
Only include the code of MMC2 if the base address of it is defined.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@sipeed.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Some Allwinner SoCs (e.g. R329) doesn't have a MMC2 controller at all,
and on boards that we do not utilize MMC2, the alias for it is just
useless.
Only include the alias when we specify CONFIG_MMC_SUNXI_EXTRA_SLOT to 2.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@sipeed.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
For some reason, the watchdog was disabled in the H616 device tree. Most
likely this is a copy-paste from the H6 device tree: the H6 watchdog is
disabled because it is broken in some chips. However, there is no
evidence of issues with the H616 watchdog.
Enable the watchdog node so it can be used by the driver.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
A watchdog helps recover from hangs or failure to boot an OS. It can
also be used by the sysreset framework to intentionally reset the
system. Now that a driver is available, let's enable this functionality
on sunxi boards.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This driver supports the sun4i/sun6i/sun20i watchdog timers.
They have a maximum timeout of 16 seconds.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The sunxi clock driver exposes a reset controller, so it selects the
reset controller framework. Ensure that dependency is also satisfied
when building the driver for the SPL.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The more recent Allwinner SoCs BootROMs can actually load SPL images
larger than 32KB. We use this on the H616 to fit the extra code needed
for the PMIC into the image, and have provisions in board.c to respect
that larger SPL size when booting from MMC.
However the sunxi SPL SPI loader has a hardcoded load offset of 32KB,
which will fail on the H616.
To fix this, use the same algorithm we use for MMC: if the SPL size is
smaller than 32KB, we use 32KB, otherwise we expect the U-Boot payload
directly after the SPL code.
This prepares for SPI booting with larger SPLs like on the H616.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The AXP PMICs have the ability to power off the system. The existing
code for this is duplicated for each PMIC variant, and uses the legacy
non-DM "pmic_bus" interface. When SYSRESET is enabled, this can all be
replaced with a sysreset device using the DM_PMIC interface.
Since the trigger bit is the same on all PMIC variants, use the register
definitions from the oldest supported PMIC.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The sysreset uclass has an option to provide the do_poweroff() function.
When that option is enabled, the AXP power drivers should not provide
their own definition.
For the AXP305, which is paired with 64-bit systems where TF-A provides
PSCI, there is another possible conflict with the PSCI firmware driver.
This driver can be enabled even if CONFIG_PSCI_RESET is disabled, so
make sure to use the right symbol in the condition.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
A single DM-based driver should be able to support some feature for
several PMIC variants where the interface is the same. For example,
all PMIC variants use the same register bit to trigger poweroff.
However, currently only definitions for a single PMIC are available at
a time. This requires drivers to use #ifdefs and different indentifiers
for each variant they support.
Let's simplify this by making register definitions for all variants
available from the header. Then no preprocessor conditions are needed;
the driver can use the register definition from any variant that
supports the relevant feature.
An exception is the GPIO-related definitions, which do not use unique
identifiers. So for now, keep them like before. They will be cleaned up
along with the GPIO driver.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This header attempted to avoid multiple inclusion using a header guard.
But the preprocessor symbol was never defined, so the guard had no
effect. Fix this by defining the symbol.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When adding eGON support to mkimage, the struct boot_file_head
definition was moved to its own header. This is the only thing
mksunxiboot needed out of asm/arch/spl.h. Clean up the relative
include by switching to new header.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
commit 1ebfc0c631 ("sunxi: A23/A33/H3: Move sun8i secure monitor to
SRAM A2") attempted to move the secure monitor to SRAM A2. But not all
sun8i SoCs have SRAM A2, so a check was put in for SUNXI_SRAM_A2_SIZE to
avoid breaking the other SoCs.
However, because the header providing SUNXI_SRAM_A2_SIZE was not
included, this unintentionally skipped the new definitions on all SoCs.
Fix this by including the right header.
Fixes: 1ebfc0c631 ("sunxi: A23/A33/H3: Move sun8i secure monitor to SRAM A2")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The device tree binding provides for getting VBUS state from a device
referenced by phandle, as an optional alternative to using a GPIO. In
U-Boot, where there is no power supply class, this VBUS detection will
be implemented using a regulator device and its get_enable method.
Let's hook this up to the PHY driver.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The Linux driver checks the VBUS detection GPIO first; then VBUS power
supply; then finally assumes VBUS is present. When adding VBUS power
supply support, we want to match that order, so we get the same behavior
in case both a GPIO and a power supply are provided in the device tree.
So refactor the function a bit to remove the early return, and use the
same "assume VBUS is present" final fallback.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Both of these messages log the GPIO number of the ID detection GPIO,
which is not terribly useful, especially in the VBUS detection function.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
sunxi-common.h defines CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR to put SPL's BSS in
DRAM. Due to this, we must select SPL_SEPARATE_BSS, or else SPL will
attempt to load its DTB from the wrong address (after BSS in DRAM).
This change fixes booting with SPL_OF_CONTROL=y.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Errata ERR050568 description says that "Flash access by FlexSPI AHB
command may not work with platform frequency equal to 300 MHz" on
LS1028A.
By default, smaller length reads(equal to RX FIFO size) are done by IP
bus and larger length reads using AHB bus. For adding errata workaround,
use IP bus to read entire flash contents and disable AHB path when
platform frequency is 300Mhz.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Add support for disabling AHB bus and read entire flash contents via IP
bus only. Please note, this enables IP bus read using a quirk which can
be enabled directly in device-type data or in existence of an errata
where AHB bus may need to be disabled.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The mt25qu512a supports 4K or 64K sectors, so adding
SECT_4K to enable 4K sector usage.
Tested on Intel n5x hardware with QSPI carrier card
Signed-off-by: Kris Chaplin <kris.chaplin@linux.intel.com>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
[jagan: droped Tested-by of patch author and datasheet link]
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The original purpose of mtd_erase_callback() in Linux at the time it was
imported to U-Boot, was to inform the caller that erasing is done (since
it was an asynchronous operation).
All supplied callback methods in U-Boot do nothing, but the
mtd_erase_callback() function was (until previous patch) grossly abused
in U-Boot's mtdpart implementation for completely different purpose.
Since we got rid of the abusement, remove the mtd_erase_callback()
function and the .callback member from struct erase_info entirely, in
order to avoid such problems in the future.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The _erase() method of the mtdpart driver, part_erase(), currently
implements offset shifting (for given mtdpart partition) in a weird way:
1. part_erase() adds partition offset to block address
2. parent driver's _erase() method is called
3. parent driver's _erase() method calls mtd_erase_callback()
4. mtd_erase_callback() subtracts partition offset from block address
so that the callback function is given correct address
The problem here is that if the parent's driver does not call
mtd_erase_callback() in some scenario (this was recently a case for
spi_nor_erase(), which did not call mtd_erase_callback() at all), the
offset is not shifted back.
Moreover the code would be more readable if part_erase() not only added
partition offset before calling parent's _erase(), but also subtracted
it back afterwards. Currently the mtd_erase_callback() is expected to do
this subtracting since it does have to do it anyway.
Add the more steps to this procedure:
5. mtd_erase_callback() adds partition offset to block address so that
it returns the the erase_info structure members as it received them
6. part_erase() subtracts partition offset from block address
This makes the code more logical and also prevents errors in case
parent's driver does not call mtd_erase_callback() for some reason.
(BTW, the purpose of mtd_erase_callback() in Linux is to inform the
caller that it is done, since in Linux erasing is done asynchronously.
We are abusing the purpose of mtd_erase_callback() in U-Boot for
completely different purpose. The callback function itself has empty
implementation in all cases in U-Boot.)
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
The spi_nor_erase() function does not call mtd_erase_callback() as it
should.
The mtdpart code currently implements the subtraction of partition
offset in mtd_erase_callback().
This results in partition offset being added prior calling
spi_nor_erase(), but not subtracted back on return. The result is that
the `mtd erase` command does not erase the whole partition, only some of
it's blocks:
=> mtd erase "Rescue system"
Erasing 0x00000000 ... 0x006fffff (1792 eraseblock(s))
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x100000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x201000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x302000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x403000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x504000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x605000, len 4096
jedec_spi_nor spi-nor@0: at 0x706000, len 4096
This is obviously wrong.
Add proper calling of mtd_erase_callback() into the spi_nor_erase()
function.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
This check is already done in all callers: mtdcore's mtd_write() /
mtd_erase(), legacy spi_nor_write() / spi_flash_erase(). No reason to do
this here as well.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Check for zero length in the legacy spi_flash_read() /
spi_flash_write() / spi_flash_erase() functions.
On zero length, return 0 immediately, don't call the underlying method.
Rationale:
- these legacy functions call the _read(), _write() and _erase() methods
of struct mtd
- the DM callers of these methods already check for zero length
- making all callers of these methods check for zero length makes it
possible to remove the check from implementations of these _read(),
_write() and _erase() methods
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The cleanup code of spi_nor_erase() function calls write_disable(), but
does not return it's return value even in case of failure. Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
The cleanup code of the spi_nor_erase() function overwrites the ret
variable with return value of clean_bar(), even if the ret variable is
already set. Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
The S25FL256L is a part of the S25FL-L family and has the same feature set
as S25FL128L except the density.
The datasheet can be found in the following link.
https://www.cypress.com/file/316171/download
The S25FL256L is 32MB NOR Flash that does not support Bank Address
Register. This fixup is activated if CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR is enabled and
returns ENOTSUPP in setup() hook to avoid further ops.
Tested on Xilinx Zynq-7000 FPGA board.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Pull request for efi-2022-01-rc1
Documentation:
Use Sphinx 3.43.
Move system reset documentation to HTML
UEFI:
Fix linking EFI apps with LLVM
Fix alignment of loaded image
Correct simple network protocol test
Code cleanup
Refactoring of env_get_char() etc.
Update buildman to use gcc-11.1.0
Use in-container toolchain for nokia_rx51 CI test
# gpg: Signature made Thu 21 Oct 2021 09:34:07 PM EDT
# gpg: using RSA key B25C0022AF86A7CC1655B6277F173A3E9008ADE6
# gpg: issuer "sjg@chromium.org"
# gpg: Good signature from "Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>" [unknown]
# gpg: WARNING: This key is not certified with a trusted signature!
# gpg: There is no indication that the signature belongs to the owner.
# Primary key fingerprint: B25C 0022 AF86 A7CC 1655 B627 7F17 3A3E 9008 ADE6
Move the following functions from cmd/nvedit.c to env/common.c:
env_set_ulong()
env_set_hex()
env_get_hex()
eth_env_get_enetaddr()
eth_env_set_enetaddr()
env_get()
from_env()
env_get_f()
env_get_ulong()
since these functions are not specific for U-Boot's CLI.
We leave env_set() in cmd/nvedit.c, since it calls _do_env_set(), which
is a static function in that file.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the past the env_match() function was used to match envs with
- name, i.e. string "name"
- variable assignment, i.e. string "name=other_value"
The latter is not the case anymore, since the env_match() function is
now used only in env_get_f(), and so we can simplify the function into
a simple strncmp() with an additional comparison to '='.
Let's do this, and since the resulting function is quite simple, let's
also inline its code into env_get_f().
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Copy the value of the found variable into given buffer with memcpy()
instead of ad-hoc code.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently the env_get_f() function's return value behaves weirdly: it
returns the number of bytes written into `buf`, but whether this is
excluding the terminating NULL-byte or including it depends on whether
there was enough space in `buf`.
Change the function to always return the actual length of the value of
the environment variable (excluding the terminating NULL-byte) on
success. This makes it behave like sprintf().
All users of this function in U-Boot are compatible with this change.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The `nxt` variable actually points to the terminating null-byte of the
current env var, and the next env var is at `nxt + 1`, not `nxt`. So a
better name for this variable is `end`.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since we no longer use env_get_char() to access n-th character of
linearized environment data, but rather access the arrays themselves, we
can convert the iteration to use string pointers instead of position
indexes.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is a relic from the past when environment was read from
underlying device one character at a time.
It is used only in the case when getting an environemnt variable prior
relocation, and the function is simple enough to be inlined there.
Since env_get_char() is being changed to simple access to an array, we
can drop the failing cases and simplify the code (this could have been
done before, since env_get_char() did not fail even before).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function was used by other parts of U-Boot in the past when
environment was read from underlying device one character at a time.
This is not the case anymore.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This comment is not true since commit 6215bd4c1f ("api: Use hashtable
function for API_env_enum").
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit b2cdef4861 ("env: restore old env_get_char() behaviour")
dropped the .get_char() method from struct env_driver, but left the two
existing implementations (eeprom and nvram) in case someone would use
them by overwriting weak function env_get_char_spec().
Since this was never done in the 3.5 years, let's drop these methods and
simplify the code.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function actually returns:
- the number of bytes written into @buf excluding the terminating
NULL-byte, if there was enough space in @buf
- the number of bytes written into @buf including the terminating
NULL-byte, if there wasn't enough space in @buf
- -1 if the variable is not found
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix up the header's include guard to contain the definition of
dm_priv_to_rw(), which was erroneously added outside of it, by moving
its #endif to the end of the file (i.e. where it belongs). This removes
the risk of compilation errors resulting from the redefinition of that
function where the header might have been (indirectly) included more
than once.
Fixes: cfb9c9b77c ("dm: core: Use separate priv/plat data region")
Signed-off-by: Pierre-Clément Tosi <ptosi@google.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
While CI has been using gcc-11.1.0 for a long time, we have not updated
buildman to match. Correct this omission.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Instead of fetching an arm toolchain to use, run the test with the one
that's already in the container image.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On the iMX7ULP uCOM board, OP-TEE uses the memory region defined by the
maximum DRAM address minus CONFIG_OPTEE_TZDRAM_SIZE, so subtract
CONFIG_OPTEE_TZDRAM_SIZE from the available DRAM size to avoid
conflicts.
Note the OPTEE boot process itself subtracts the DRAM region it
lives in from the memory map passed to Linux.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable the EQoS i.MX driver in defconfig, also enable the PHYLIB
to facilitate the case that only has FEC enabled.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Since we uses the DTS and PHY reset gpio in EQoS driver to do the
reset, remove the duplicated codes from board file.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
i.MX8MP EVK has two ethernet ports. Add relevant nodes and properties
for EQoS port to the EVK DTS file.
In -u-boot.dtsi, change the u-boot eqos compatible string, add PHY
reset gpio and remove assigned clocks as not supported in CCF.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
i.MX8MP has two ENET controllers, have to update the function to
enable loading two MAC addresses.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
When boot.bin is configured for secure boot the CSU will disable the
JTAG interface on all cases.
Some boards might rely on this interface for flashing to QSPI in which
case those systems might end up bricked during development.
This commit will restore the interface under CSU control
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20211013134800.19452-1-jorge@foundries.io
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
As stated in comment above the code, CRS response can be returned to OS
only for 4-byte PCI_VENDOR_ID config read request. So fix the code.
Fixes: 1d7ad68559 ("arm: a37xx: pci: Handle propagation of CRSSVE bit from PCIe Root Port")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We can only select SPL_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT if SPL is enabled, otherwise
we get a warning about unmet dependencies on platforms that don't use
SPL.
Fixes: cf47a8cf8f ("arm: mvebu: Select SPL_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT on ARMADA_32BIT")
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI Bridge which represents Aardvark PCIe Root Port does not have
configurable bars.
So ensure that write operation to bars registers on PCI Bridge is noop and
bars registers always contain zero address which indicates that bars are
unsupported.
After this change U-Boot 'pci bar 0.0.0' command does not show any
allocated bars for PCI Bridge device.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: cb056005dc ("arm: a37xx: pci: Add support for accessing PCI Bridge on root bus")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Instead of declaring CONFIG_SPL_DRIVERS_MISC in board config header,
select it in Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Instead of declaring CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE dependant on
CONFIG_SPL_BUILD in board config header, select
CONFIG_SPL_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE in Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We are printing board information in checkboard() function, which is
called from the default weak implementation of show_board_info().
Rename checkboard() to show_board_info(). This throws away the weak
implementation of show_board_info().
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently we always overwrite ethaddrs with those from EEPROM.
In order to allow user to use a cloned MAC address in U-Boot, change the
code so that it sets ethaddr variables only if they aren't set or are
invalid.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently we overwrite ethaddr and eth1addr only if these variables
don't exist.
Better overwrite them even if the env variable exists, but is invalid -
eth_env_get_enetaddr_by_index() checks for validity.
Refactor the code to use a for cycle.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Handle reset button even if we can't configure modules.
This happens if we fail retrieving reset GPIO with which we can reset
the modules.
(Note that this GPIO is different from reset button GPIO.)
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We are printing board information in last_stage_init(), but U-Boot has
dedicated function, show_board_info(), for this.
Move code which prints board information (board version, serial number,
module topology, ...) to show_board_info().
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reorder the definitions in Turris MOX' board config header, drop the
comment relics from when this file was copied, fix indentation.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move the config option CONFIG_I2C_MV to a Kconfig option
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MV and move the default definition from config header
files into defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move config options CONFIG_LAST_STAGE_INIT and
CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE to turris_mox_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are two Linux ioctls which implements tcsendbreak() functionality:
TCSBRK and TCSBRKP
TCSBRK with non-zero parameter implements tcdrain() and with zero parameter
implements tcsendbreak() for duration of 0.25s.
TCSBRKP with zero parameter is same as TCSBRK and with non-zero parameter
implements tcsendbreak() for duration in deciseconds specified by
parameter. TCSBRKP does not have to be provided by older toolchain
versions.
So tcsendbreak() has to either use TCSBRK with zero parameter or TCSBRKP
with any parameter.
Fix code to use TCSBRKP and fallback to TCSBRK with 0.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The function show_eeprom is missing int i if debug is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Sven Auhagen <sven.auhagen@voleatech.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When compiling U-Boot with ld.lld as the linker, the helloworld EFI app
example fails to link:
LD lib/efi_loader/helloworld_efi.so
ld.lld: error: section: .dynamic is not contiguous with other relro
sections
LLD will always create RELRO program header regardless of target
emulation, whereas BFD may automatically disable it for unsupported
targets. Add -znorelro to disable it explicitly in all cases.
Signed-off-by: Alistair Delva <adelva@google.com>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Nick Desaulniers <ndesaulniers@google.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The 'efidebug boot dump' command should not display the VenMedia() device
path node preceding the device path of the initial ram disk.
By letting efi_dp_from_lo() skip the VenMedia() device path node we can
simplify the coding.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Parameter size is never used in function efi_dp_from_lo(). Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Instead of copying a GUID and then using a pointer to the copy for calling
guidcmp(), just pass the pointer to the orginal GUID.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We are ignoring the alignment communicated via the PE/COFF header.
Starting 5.10 the Linux kernel will loudly complain about it. For more
details look at [1] (in linux kernel).
So add a function that can allocate aligned EFI memory and use it for our
relocated loaded image.
[1] c32ac11da3f83 ("efi/libstub: arm64: Double check image alignment at entry")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Vincent Stehlé <vincent.stehle@arm.com>
Acked-by: Ard Biesheuvel <ardb@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When using a file to store UEFI variables we must make sure that secure
boot related variables are not loaded from this file. With commit
9ef82e2947 ("efi_loader: don't load signature database from file")
this has already been implemented for variables defined in the UEFI
specification. As most Linux distributions use Shim we should do the same
for Shim's MOK database.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
It is useful to see some basic EFI info with the command as it forms part
of the information about a board.
Add a hook for this and show the table address as a start.
While here, fix an invalid cast in setup_efi_info(). Note that this
function is using a data structure defined by Linux so we cannot change
it. Also note that ulong is used since this is the standard in U-Boot
(>6k uses), despite there being quite a bit of the more verbose uintptr_t
(930 uses).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The setup routines are called from zimage but don't really belong in the
zimage header. Add a new EFI header to house these. Add comments so it is
clear what the functions do.
Note that these functions are x86-specific. The zimage business is not
used on other architectures.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At present this information is stripped when linking. It is useful to keep
it around. Strip it from the .efi files instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Separate this out slightly from the payload, with a new entry.
We might consider renaming EFI PAYLOAD to EFI LOADER, but that would
require quite a lot of file changes.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This code should never have been added as it builds a new feature on top
of legacy code. This has already been improved with the dependency on BLK.
Add a dependency on DM_ETH also, to avoid needing to deal with this old
code.
Boards which want EFI_LOADER should migrate to driver model first.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Repeatedly receive the packets until the receive buffer is empty.
If the buffer is empty, EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL::Receive()
returns EFI_NOT_READY. We don't need to use the wait_for_event()
every time.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Do not check EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_RECEIVE_INTERRUPT in packet
receiving loop. This depends on the implementation and not
related to whether the packet can be received or not.
Whether the received packets are available or not is ensured
by wait_for_packet, and that is already done in the loop.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
According to the UEF specification v2.9, the main purpose of the
EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_PROTOCOL::GetStatus() is for checking the link
status via EFI_SIMPLE_NETWORK_MODE::MediaPresent.
So this uses net->get_status() for checking the link status before
running network test.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
mkeficapsule is used to create capsules for UEFI firmware update.
To ease inclusion into U-Boot tools packages of Linux distributions we
should add it to the tools-only_defconfig.
Provide dummy values for CONFIG_AVB_BUF_ADDR, CONFIG_AVB_BUF_SIZE to
satisfy Kconfig.
Suggested-by: Vagrant Cascadian <vagrant@debian.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The PPC 440 support has been removed in commit 98f705c9ce
("powerpc: remove 4xx support") already, so this file is
certainly not required anymore.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Huth <thuth@redhat.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Complete the Sphinx documentation in include/sysreset.h
Add the include to the generated HTML documentation of the U-Boot API.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
For enums documented according to the requirements in chapter
"Structure, union, and enumeration documentation" of
https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/doc-guide/kernel-doc.html
errors occur with Sphinx 2.4.4 which disappear with Sphinx 3.4.3,
e.g.
/builds/u-boot/custodians/u-boot-efi/doc/api/sysreset:6:
./include/sysreset.h:60:Unknown interpreted text role "enum".
Sphinx 3.4.3 is the version used by Debian in the current release.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add code to build the eMMC variant of the Colibri iMX6ULL, i.e. the
'Colibri iMX6ULL 1GB' which has a eMMC instead of the raw NAND used
on other SKUs.
Related-to: ELB-4056, ELB-4057
Signed-off-by: Max Krummenacher <max.krummenacher@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Integrate new Toradex SKU 0062 Colibri iMX6ULL 1GB IT. This commit
basically adjusts three parameters of the RAM settings:
Increase density from 4Gb to 8Gb
Increase ROW address from 15 to 16
Increase tRFC (refresh command time) from 260 to 350
This timing is valid for all Toradex Colibri iMX6ULL SKUs
Related-to: ELB-4055, ELB-4057
Signed-off-by: Philippe Schenker <philippe.schenker@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Add new i.MX 6ULL and 8M Plus SKUs to ConfigBlock handling:
0062: Colibri iMX6ULL 1GB IT (eMMC)
0063: Verdin iMX8M Plus Quad 4GB IT
0064: Verdin iMX8M Plus Quad 2GB Wi-Fi / BT IT
0065: Verdin iMX8M Plus QuadLite 1GB IT
0066: Verdin iMX8M Plus Quad 8GB Wi-Fi / BT
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Restore "Is the module an IT version? [y/N]" for "cfgblock create"
interactive mode command, which was leading to invalid detection
of 0051 Colibri iMX8DX 1GB WB module;
Fixes: a5b5ad4d85 ("toradex: tdx-cfg-clock: add new i.mx 8m mini/plus skus")
Related-to: ELB-3482
Signed-off-by: Denys Drozdov <denys.drozdov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Also take over maintainership of remaining Toradex SoMs as Oleksandr
has left our company.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
CC: Oleksandr Suvorov <cryosay@gmail.com>
After the conversion to binman in commit 8996e6b7c6 ("imx8mm_evk: switch
to use binman to pack images"), it is necessary to flash both flash.bin and
u-boot.itb to get a bootable system. Prior to this commit, only flash.bin
was needed.
Such new requirement breaks existing distro mechanisms to generate the
final binary because the extra u-boot.itb is now required.
Generate a final flash.bin that can be used again as a single
bootable binary to keep the original behavior.
After this change the SPL binary is called spl.bin, which is a more
descriptive name for its purpose, and can still be used standalone
(for example, for secure boot purposes).
Also update imx8mm_evk.rst to remove the u-boot.itb copy step.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
NXP used to setup the gpmi clock root from gpmi_clk in early versions
in their downstream BSP. [1]
However on mainline the gpmi clock root was always setup from enfc
since the beginning of the i.MX 6 series SoCs, which is still the same
today. [2]
NXP followed the mainline approach at some point and changed
setup_gpmi_io_clk to setup gpmi clock root from enfc which left faulty
code behind in our board file. [3]
This commit follows the change of NXP as it improves the performance of
the NAND from ~1.2 MiB/s to ~12 MiB/s. [3]
This change was verified to work in recovery-mode and u-boot loaded
from NAND on all four Colibri iMX6ULL SKUs from Toradex.
The frequency used to read the NAND, measured on RE# (Read Enable):
before this patch: 1.4 MHz
after this patch: 22 MHz
in Linux Kernel: 50 MHz
[1] https://source.codeaurora.org/external/imx/uboot-imx/tree/arch/arm/cpu/armv7/mx6/clock.c?h=nxp/imx_v2016.03_4.1.15_2.0.0_ga#n62
[2] commit 23608e23fd ("i.mx: add the initial support for freescale i.MX6Q processor")
[3] https://source.codeaurora.org/external/imx/uboot-imx/commit/?id=7a82a19ceabfb04bbc1591a67c99751748781c7d
Signed-off-by: Philippe Schenker <philippe.schenker@toradex.com>
Finally, found the root cause of the issue already once mentioned back
here [2] which caused the following error message during boot:
imx_wdt watchdog@30280000:
pinctrl_select_state_full: uclass_get_device_by_phandle_id: err=-19
Turns out while the watchdog node itself was already u-boot,dm-spl its
pinctrl node was not which caused it to be unavailable at that early
stage. Note that any and all other boards I checked also seem to be
missing this. However, I can't judge whether or not they might indeed
need a similar fix or not.
[2] https://marc.info/?l=u-boot&m=161786572422973
Fixes: commit d304e7ace3
("ARM: imx8m: Fix reset in SPL on Toradex iMX8MM Verdin")
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable and set preboot var with fdtfile evaluation.
It will be checked and run immediately before starting the
CONFIG_BOOTDELAY countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
entering interactive mode.
This provides possibility to use different boot cmds in interactive mode
without manual setting fdtfile value, as it it's already evaluated
before entering interactive mode.
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Variable "kernel_image" is used in boot.scr script only, that sets its
own default value to the constant string @@KERNEL_IMAGETYPE@@ in case
"kernel_image" is not set.
The default name of the kernel image shipped with BSP 5.x is "Image.gz".
Setting kernel_image="Image" as a pre-defined u-boot variable
breaks booting systems with modern versions of boot.scr, whereas
renaming it fixes booting with modern scripts and does not break working
of earlier versions of boot.scr.
While at it also update the copyright period, rather than hard-coding
fdtfile default fdt_board to dev for the Verdin iMX8M Mini and fix its
closing #endif comment.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Prepare for DEK blob encapsulation support through "dek_blob" command.
On ARMv8, u-boot runs in non-secure, thus cannot encapsulate a DEK blob
for encrypted boot.
The DEK blob is encapsulated by OP-TEE through a trusted application
call. U-boot sends and receives the DEK and the DEK blob binaries
through OP-TEE dynamic shared memory.
To enable the DEK blob encapsulation, add to the defconfig:
CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT=y
CONFIG_FAT_WRITE=y
CONFIG_CMD_DEKBLOB=y
Taken from NXP's commit 56d2050f40 ("imx8m: Add DEK blob encapsulation
for imx8m").
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Turns out Microship (formerly Micrel) meanwhile integrated proper
support for the DLL setup on their KSZ9131. Unfortunately, this
conflicts with our previous board code doing that.
Fix this by getting rid of our board code and just relying on the
generic implementation relying on rgmii-id being used as phy-mode.
Fixes: commit c6df0e2ffd
("net: phy: micrel: add support for DLL setup on ksz9131")
Fixes: commit af2d3c91d8
("ARM: dts: imx8mm-verdin: Set PHY mode to RGMII-ID")
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Due to missing configs, CI goes in deadlock until an OOM is tracked. Add
CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR and replace CONFIG_SYS_EXTRA_OPTIONS with
CONFIG_IMX_CONFIG.
Signed-off-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
CC: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu)" <paul.liu@linaro.org>
CC: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Even if board can be successfuly built, CI goes in deadlock (see thread
on https://www.mail-archive.com/u-boot@lists.denx.de/msg419663.html).
This is caused by SYS_CONFIG set in header file and because defconfig
for the board is out of sync with Kconfig. As result, buildman goes on
to read from stdin until an OOM is reached.
Signed-off-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
CC: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Hex and int Kconfig options are supposed to have defaults. This is so we
can configure U-Boot without having to enter particular values for the
items that don't have specific values in the board's defconfig file.
If this rule is not followed, then introducing a new Kconfig can produce
a loop like this:
Break things (BREAK_ME) [] (NEW)
Error in reading or end of file.
Break things (BREAK_ME) [] (NEW)
Error in reading or end of file.
The continues forever since buildman passes /dev/null to 'conf', and
the build system just tries again. Eventually there is so much output that
buildman runs out of memory.
We can detect this situation by looking for a symbol (like 'BREAK_ME')
which has no default (the '[]' above) and is marked as new. If this
appears multiple times in the output, we know something is wrong.
Add a filter function for the output which detects this situation. Allow
it to return True to terminate the process. Implement this termination in
cros_subprocess.
With this we get a nice message:
buildman --board sandbox -T0
Building current source for 1 boards (0 threads, 32 jobs per thread)
sandbox: w+ sandbox
+.config:66:warning: symbol value '' invalid for BREAK_ME
+
+Error in reading or end of file.
+make[3]: *** [scripts/kconfig/Makefile:75: syncconfig] Terminated
+make[2]: *** [Makefile:569: syncconfig] Terminated
+make: *** [Makefile:177: sub-make] Terminated
+(** did you define an int/hex Kconfig with no default? **)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present buildman does not write any output (to the 'out' and 'err)
files if the build terminates with a fatal error. This is to avoid adding
lots of spam to the logs.
However there are times when this is actually useful, such as when the
build fails for an obscure reason such as a Kconfig loop.
Update the logic to always write the output, so that the user gets a clue
as to what is happening.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
io read/write may cause wrong result because they may read/write data
from/to register instead of memory. Add 'volatile' to avoid it.
Signed-off-by: Nick Hu <nick.hu@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The following warning is seen in unleashed.c in a 32-bit build:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Cast with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The following warning is seen in sifive_ddr.c in a 32-bit build:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Change to use dev_read_addr_index_ptr().
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The following warning is seen in macb.c in a 32-bit build:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Change to use dev_read_addr_index_ptr(), or cast with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
At present there is only devfdt_get_addr_ptr() which only returns
the first <addr, size> pair in the 'reg' property. Add a new API
devfdt_get_addr_index_ptr() to return the indexed pointer.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The following warning is seen in ocores_i2c.c in a 32-bit build:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Change to use dev_read_addr_ptr().
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
dev_read_addr() returns a value of type fdt_addr_t which is a 64-bit
address and plat->base is a pointer. In a 32-bit build, this causes the
following warning seen when building sifive-gpio.c:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Change to use dev_read_addr_ptr().
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
dev_read_addr() returns a value of type fdt_addr_t which is a 64-bit
address and pd->va is a pointer. In a 32-bit build, this causes the
following warning seen when building sifive-prci.c:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Change to use dev_read_addr_ptr().
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The following warning is seen in cache-sifive-ccache.c in a 32-bit build:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Fix by casting it with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Commit 47d73ba4f4 ("board: sifive: overwrite board_fdt_blob_setup in u-boot proper")
added a board-specific implementation of board_fdt_blob_setup() which
takes a pointer as the return value, but it does not return anything
if CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE is not enabled. This will cause a build warning
seen when testing booting S-mode U-Boot directly from QEMU, per the
instructions in [1]:
board/sifive/unleashed/unleashed.c: In function ‘board_fdt_blob_setup’:
board/sifive/unleashed/unleashed.c:125:1: warning: control reaches end of non-void function [-Wreturn-type]
Return &_end as the default case.
[1] https://qemu.readthedocs.io/en/latest/system/riscv/sifive_u.html#running-u-boot
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
commit 6bf6d81c11 ("clk: fixed_rate: add dummy enable() function")
implemented .enable, so fixed rate clocks can be used where drivers
might call clk_enable(). Implement the .disable op for the same reason;
some drivers, e.g. USB PHYs, may attempt to disable clocks at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
While we intentionally set -std=gnu11 for building host tools, and have
for quite some time, we never dropped -std=gnu99 from tools/Makefile.
This resulted in passing -std=gnu11 ... -std=gnu99 when building, and
gnu99 would win. This in turn would result now in warnings such as:
tools/mkeficapsule.c:25:15: warning: redefinition of typedef 'u32' is a C11 feature [-Wtypedef-redefinition]
typedef __u32 u32;
^
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This enables the clock controller driver support on TI's SoCs. This will
fix this GPIO issue at boot time:
request_and_set_gpio: Unable to request GPIO_PR1_MII_CTRL
request_and_set_gpio: Unable to request GPIO_MUX_MII_CTRL
request_and_set_gpio: Unable to request GPIO_FET_SWITCH_CTRL
request_and_set_gpio: Unable to request GPIO_PHY_RESET
This issue comes from the fact that the clock controller is not probed.
Enable the TI's clock controller driver support to solve this.
Signed-off-by: Amjad Ouled-Ameur <aouledameur@baylibre.com>
At present U-Boot always builds dtc if CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is defined, even
when DTC is provided. The built dtc is not actually used, so this is a
waste of time.
Update the Makefile logic to build dtc only if one is not provided to the
build with the DTC variable. Add documentation to explain this.
This saves about 3.5 seconds of elapsed time on a clean build of
sandbox_spl for me.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We need this to make building dtc optional. It makes no sense to build our
own dtc if the system one works correctly.
This reverts commit ddb87a0b40.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Bulletproof the default boot command with reset statements in case
any command in the chain would fail. In case a failure were to happen,
the board will reset, increment boot counter and retry the procedure.
In case the failures persist and the boot counter reaches the bootlimit,
U-Boot starts altbootcmd instead of the default bootcmd boot command.
The altbootcmd swaps the default boot partition for the other boot
partition, which is an identical copy or an older copy, and tries
booting from that one instead.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Build U-Boot in Thumb2 mode for M53Menlo board, this makes better
use of the CPU since the instruction density is higher.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
The board can do primary/secondary boot switching, enable the bmode command.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Move setting CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND to the mx7ulp_com_defconfig file.
It also allows replacing the default CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND without
code modification.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Add redundant environment support as it is required
by SWUpdate.
While at it, place the CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET at 0x100000 to allow
more headroom.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
The previous patches removed OF_PRIOR_STAGE from the last consumers of the
Kconfig option. Cleanup any references to it in documentation, code and
configuration options.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At some point back in 2018 prior_stage_fdt_address and OF_PRIOR_STAGE got
introduced, in order to support a DTB handed over by an earlier stage boo
loader. However we have another option in the Kconfig (OF_BOARD) which has
identical semantics.
So let's remove the option in an effort to simplify U-Boot's config and DTB
management, and use OF_BOARD instead.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At some point back in 2018 prior_stage_fdt_address and OF_PRIOR_STAGE got
introduced, in order to support a DTB handed over by an earlier stage boo
loader. However we have another option in the Kconfig (OF_BOARD) which has
identical semantics.
On RISC-V some of the boards pick up the DTB from a1 and copy it in their
private gd_t. Apart from that they copy it to prior_stage_fdt_address, if
the Kconfig option is selected, which is unnecessary.
So let's switch the config option for those boards to OF_BOARD and define
the required board_fdt_blob_setup() for them.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
On mvebu this is defined if and only if !ARM64.
Otherwise it is defined for boards with ARCH_MX23, ARCH_TEGRA and
ARCH_ZYNQ, and also for SOC_AR934X (tplink_wdr4300).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This option is only used for
mx23evk_defconfig
mx23_olinuxino_defconfig
which are the only i.MX23 boards.
Add depend on ARCH_MX23 and default to y.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
In preparation for moving this option to Kconfig, rename it to be
consistent with other USB EHCI Kconfig options.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The default configuration of rk3399 EMMC PHY does not enable the
strobe line, and EMMC controller will got data transmission error
at HS400 mode.
Signed-off-by: Yifeng Zhao <yifeng.zhao@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
fix up ppll init freq.
support tclk_emmc.
add freq (26M) for mmc device.
fix up the sfc clk rate unit error.
Change in V2:
remove change id.
Signed-off-by: Elaine Zhang <zhangqing@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The devicetree submitted and approved for the mainline linux kernel is
slightly different than the one present here. This syncs both
devicetrees (for the Rockchip SFC node at least) present on the PX30
and the Odroid Go Advance. Changes include renaming the flash node,
reordering the values in the SFC node for the rk3326-odroid-go2,
changing the name of the cs pinctrl node to cs0, and updating the
u-boot specific tree to utilize the new flash node value.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Brand names are supposed to be written with a capital,
so change them all.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In the list of mainline U-boot supported Rockchip boards
rk3188 is placed below under the name rv3188. Give back it's
original name and sort the list in alphabetical order.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The 64 bit rk33xx chips don't have the ROCKCHIP_USB2_PHY IP so
drop the configs as they were likely copied over from other
boards during enablement.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Starting with commit 92f1e9a4b3 ("clk: Detect failure to set
defaults") the clk driver for the PX30 would fail to probe for the
Odroid Go Advance. This patch is to remove the clock for the GPU from
the U-Boot specific devicetree, as that clock is not supported by the
U-Boot clk_px30 driver.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Starting with commit 92f1e9a4b3 ("clk: Detect failure to set
defaults") the clk driver for the PX30 for the Odroid Go Advance would
no longer probe correctly, because setting the cpll and gpu clocks are
not supported with the clk_px30 U-Boot driver. This adds support for
setting the cpll clock to the clk_px30 driver. Another patch will
update the U-Boot specific device-tree to remove the GPU clock which is
not used by U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Remove the latest reference of CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_AMD_CHECK_DQ7 in code
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This define was left over from a previous revision, and was never used.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove some config finishing by _ badly added by
scripts/build-whitelist.sh when joker is used in comments.
for example:
doc/uImage.FIT/command_syntax_extensions.txt:
... #ifdef CONFIG_OF_* | ...
cmd/nvedit.c:# error Define one of CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_{EEPROM| \
FLASH|MMC|FAT|EXT4|\
Remove also configs only used in comments:
- CONFIG_BOOGER in include/linux/kconfig.h
- CONFIG_COMMANDS
- CONFIG_INIT_IGNORE_ERROR
- CONFIG_REG_*
- CONFIG_HOTPLUG : drivers/watchdog/omap_wdt.c:18
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When a test hands on a real board there is no way on the console to obtain
any information about why it hung.
With sandbox we can actually find out that it died and get a signal or
exit code. Add this to make it easier to figure out what happened.
So instead of:
test/py/u_boot_spawn.py:171: in expect
c = os.read(self.fd, 1024).decode(errors='replace')
E OSError: [Errno 5] Input/output error
We get:
test/py/u_boot_spawn.py:171: in expect
c = os.read(self.fd, 1024).decode(errors='replace')
E ValueError: U-Boot exited with signal 11 (Signals.SIGSEGV)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Header type is 7-bit number so use all 7 bits when detecting header type
and not only 2 bits.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Header type is 7-bit number so properly clear upper 8th bit which
indicates multifunction device.
And do not try to show bars for unsupported header types.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function dm_pci_hose_probe_bus() expects that bus is valid PCI device with
Bridge header type (0x01). So add check before touching PCI config space to
prevent misconfiguring some non-standard device.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI Rom Address is currently supported only for Normal (0x00) and
Bridge (0x01) header types. Fix code accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This produces a lot of code output which is not very helpful and is quite
annoying to wade through. Use the short format by default.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If multiple entries are present in the memory-region property, this new
memory-region-names property can be used to specify names for each of
them so that they can be more easily distinguished.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Rather than duplicate the Ethernet MAC address and carveout updating
code for each board, move it to a common location and make it more
reusable.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
The EMC frequency tables are created from a training sequence performed
during early boot and passed in via a reserved memory region by nvtboot.
Copy this table to the kernel DTB so that the kernel can use it to scale
the EMC frequency at runtime.
Note that early bootloaders store the EMC table at an address that
currently intersects with the load address of the initial ramdisk. In
order to avoid copying the table to a different address, simply change
the load address for the initial ramdisk in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Support multiple reserved memory regions per device to support platforms
that use both a framebuffer and color conversion lookup table for early
boot display splash.
While at it, also pass along the name, compatible strings and flags of
the carveouts.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Reserved memory nodes can have additional flags. Support reading and
writing these flags to ensure that reserved memory nodes can be properly
parsed and emitted.
This converts support for the existing "no-map" flag to avoid extending
the argument list for fdtdec_add_reserved_memory() to excessive length.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
The fdtdec_set_carveout() function's parameters are inconsistent with
the parameters passed to fdtdec_add_reserved_memory(). Fix up the order
to make it more consistent.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Reserved memory nodes can have a compatible string list to identify the
type of reserved memory that they represent. Support specifying an
optional compatible string list when creating these nodes.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
When retrieving a given carveout for a device, allow callers to query
the name. This helps differentiating between carveouts when there are
more than one.
This is also useful when copying carveouts to help assign a meaningful
name that cannot always be guessed.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
In order make it possible to use fdtdec_get_carveout() in loops, return
FDT_ERR_NOTFOUND when the passed-in index exceeds the number of phandles
present in the given property.
Signed-off-by: Thierry Reding <treding@nvidia.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
The current code invalidates the range after the read buffer since the
buffer pointer gets incremented in the read loop. Use a temporary
pointer to make sure we have a pristine pointer to invalidate the
correct memory range after read.
Fixes: 704e040a51 ("nvme: Apply cache operations on the DMA buffers")
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
The DS1307 driver was originally based on the DS1337 driver. However,
the functionality of the clock set/get functions has diverged. In the
original DS1337 driver, the set/get functions did the following:
1) Setting the clock ensured the oscillator was enabled.
2) Getting the clock checked and reset the oscillator-stop flag.
The DS1307 does not have an oscillator-stop flag, but the driver tried
(incorrectly) to emulate this by ensuring the oscillator was running. It
really makes no sense to start a stopped clock without setting it.
This patch makes the DS1307 driver behave like the original DS1337
driver again. For the DS1307 itself, this is just a removal of code,
since there is no oscillator-fail bit to check or reset, and the clock
is started when it is set. Since the DS1307 driver can now also be used
for the DS1337 and DS1340 which do have this bit, add code to handle the
oscillator-stop bit in the same was the original DS1337 driver did --
i.e. report that the oscillator had stopped and clear the flag.
This means that setting the date using the date command (which does both
a get and a set) will now clear the oscillator-stop flag in addition to
setting and starting the clock.
The old-style (non-DM) code has not been updated and will be removed in
a future patch. Note that this older code does not support the DS1337,
as there is a separate driver for this. Also note that the original (DM)
code used the wrong control-register address for the DS1337.
Signed-off-by: Mark Tomlinson <mark.tomlinson@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
This patch optimizes the commit mentioned below by avoiding running
a set of commands which are useless in the case when
size < mydata->sect_size and sect_count would be 0.
Fixes: 5b3ddb17ba ("fs/fat/fat.c: Do not perform zero block reads if there are no blocks left")
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Co-developed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Add a driver for Macronix raw NAND controller.
This patch referred from linux mxic_nand.c. The difference from the
linux version is described here.
1. In order to adapt to the uboot nand framework, add function
binding (cmdfunc, read_byte, read_buf, write_buf).
2. Added parsing command format to use hardware correctly.
3. Remove the incompatible functions of Uboot.
Signed-off-by: Zhengxun Li <zhengxunli@mxic.com.tw>
strlcat() need to be passed the full buffer length. The incorrect call
caused truncation of partition names for fastboot_raw_partition_... and
fastboot_partition_alias_... env lookup to much less than PART_NAME_LEN.
Fixes: 69a7529831 ("fastboot: Fix possible buffer overrun")
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
- Disable ATAGS for STM32 MCU and MPU boards
- Disable bi_boot_params for STM32 MCU and MPU boards
- Update stm32-usbphyc node management
- Convert CONFIG_STM32_FLASH to Kconfig for STM32 MCU boards
- Convert some USB config flags to Kconfig for various boards
- Convert CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND flag to Kconfig for STM32 F429 board
- Remove specific CONFIG_STV0991 flags
- Remove unused CONFIG_USER_LOWLEVEL_INIT flag
- Add ofdata_to_platdata() callback for stm32_spi driver
- Update for stm32f7_i2c driver
- Remove gpio_hog_probe_all() from STM32 MP1 board
- Fix bind command
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Second set of u-boot-at91 features for the 2022.01 cycle:
This small feature set adds the support for PWM driver for the sama5d2
SoC. It also adds a node in the DT for this SoC.
The bulk of it is Samuel's DM_I2C rework, which removes the nasty I2C
deprecation warnings for most 32-bit boards. It also includes some
smaller refactorings that pave the way for more changes, mostly driven
by needing to support the Allwinner RISC-V SoC later on.
Board wise we gain support for the FriendlyARM NanoPi R1S H5 router
board and official Pinetab support.
Build-tested for all 160 sunxi boards, and boot tested on a A64, A20,
H3, H6, and H616 board. USB, SD card, eMMC, and Ethernet all work there
(where applicable).
Add usb_gadget_handle_interrupts(), usb_gadget_register_driver()
and usb_gadget_unregister_driver() to be able to test
binding usb gadget.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Herbert Poetzl <herbert@13thfloor.at>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix a regression brings by commit 84f8e36f03 ("cmd: bind: allow to
bind driver with driver data")
As example, the following bind command doesn't work:
bind /soc/usb-otg@49000000 usb_ether
As usb_ether driver has no compatible string, it can't be find by
lists_bind_fdt(). In bind_by_node_path(), which called lists_bind_fdt(),
the driver entry is known, pass it to lists_bind_fdt() to force the driver
entry selection.
For this, add a new parameter struct *driver to lists_bind_fdt().
Fix also all lists_bind_fdt() callers.
Fixes: 84f8e36f03 ("cmd: bind: allow to bind driver with driver data")
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reported-by: Herbert Poetzl <herbert@13thfloor.at>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Herbert Poetzl <herbert@13thfloor.at>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andy.shevchenko@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that the last users of legacy I2C (outside of SPL) have been
resolved, we can enable DM_I2C at the sunxi architecture level.
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Two displays supported by the sunxi display driver (each one used by a
single board) require initialization over I2C. Both previously used
i2c_soft; replace this with the i2c-gpio instance that already exists in
those boards' device trees (sun5i-a13-utoo-p66 and sun6i-a31-colombus).
Since the i2c-gpio nodes are not referenced by any other node in the
device trees (the device trees have no panel node), the I2C bus is
selected by its node name.
This panel initialization code was the only i2c_soft user, so the
i2c_soft GPIO setup code can be removed now as well.
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The pmic_bus functions are used in both SPL (for regulator setup) and
U-Boot proper (for regulator setup, SID access, GPIO, and poweroff).
Currently, pmic_bus conflicts with DM_I2C because it uses the legacy I2C
interface. This commit makes pmic_bus dual-compatible with either the
legacy I2C functions or the newly-added PMIC_AXP driver (which uses
DM_I2C). In turn, this allows platforms to start transitioning to DM_I2C
in U-Boot proper, without breaking boards that still depend on the
legacy I2C interface for other reasons.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Instead of using the SoC symbols to decide the bus type, use whichever
bus driver is actually enabled. This allows collapsing all of the AXP2xx
and AXP8xx variants into one "else" case. It also has the advantage of
falling back to I2C when the other bus drivers are disabled; this works
because all of the PMICs support I2C in addition to other interfaces.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This bus controller is used to communicate with an X-Powers AXP PMIC.
Currently, various drivers access PMIC registers through a platform-
specific non-DM "pmic_bus" interface, which depends on the legacy I2C
framework. In order to convert those drivers to use DM_PMIC, this bus
needs a DM_I2C driver.
Refactor the rsb functions to take the base address as a parameter,
and implement both the existing interface (which is still needed in
SPL) and the DM_I2C interface on top of them.
The register for switching between I2C/P2WI/RSB mode is the same across
all PMIC variants, so move that to the common header.
There are only a couple of pairs of hardware/runtime addresses used
across all PMIC variants. So far the code expected only the "primary"
pair, but some PMICs like the AXP305 and AXP805 use the secondary pair,
so add support for that to the DM driver as well.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This bus controller is used to communicate with an X-Powers AXP PMIC.
Currently, various drivers access PMIC registers through a platform-
specific non-DM "pmic_bus" interface, which depends on the legacy I2C
framework. In order to convert those drivers to use DM_PMIC, this bus
needs a DM_I2C driver.
Refactor the p2wi functions to take the base address as a parameter,
and implement both the existing interface (which is still needed in
SPL) and the DM_I2C interface on top of them.
The register for switching between I2C/P2WI/RSB mode is the same across
all PMIC variants. Move that to the common header, so it can be used by
both interface implementations.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
AXP_PMIC_BUS enables communication with a specific AXP PMIC at a
PMIC-dependent I2C/P2WI/RSB bus address. It is automatically selected
as a dependency of the PMIC driver. It should not be selectable by the
user when no PMIC is chosen.
AXP_GPIO uses the pmic_bus functions, and also depends on a specific
PMIC header to pick up register definitions.
Both of these changes have no impact on any existing configs, since
the code does not compile if the dependencies are not met.
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
SUN8I_RSB should not be selected by MACH_SUN8I, because the hardware
is not present in half of those SoCs (H3/H5, R40, and V3s). Move the
selection to the SoCs where the hardware actually exists.
As it currently stands, selecting that option also requires using it in
some way, which is not the case for one A80 board. Since we have only
three A80 boards in total, we select it their via their defconfigs.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
[Andre: fixing up Sunchip_CX-A99 build]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CONFIG_SPL_I2C is the wrong symbol to use here. It is the top-level
Kconfig symbol (not specific to either legacy or DM I2C), whereas the
i2c_init() function is specific to legacy I2C. This change fixes a
build failure when enabling SPL_I2C but not SPL_SYS_I2C_LEGACY.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
These PMICs provide some combination of battery charger, fuel gauge,
GPIOs, regulators, and VBUS routing. These functions are represented
as child nodes in the device tree. Add the minimal driver needed to
probe these child devices and provide the DM_PMIC ops.
Enable the driver by default for SoCs that normally pair with a PMIC.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Now that there is a separate symbol to enable DM_PMIC in SPL, update the
the SPL-specific driver symbols to depend on this new option.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Kconfig symbols for two PMIC drivers (PMIC_AS3722 and DM_PMIC_MC34708)
were missing a dependency on DM_PMIC. To fix this inconsistency, and to
keep it from happening again, wrap the driver section with "if DM_PMIC"
instead of using a "depends on DM_PMIC" clause for each driver.
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This fixes the usage of the USB 3.0-capable port under U-Boot as USB
2.0-only port.
Original patch by Chao Zeng.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Account for the changes done between merge proposal and the final merge.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The macro called MUX_VAL generates a writel instruction with
semicolon at the end. This table was written to use semicolons,
however one was missed:
MUX_VAL(CP(SYS_BOOT2), (IEN | PTD | DIS | M4)) /* GPIO_4 */
Since the extra semicolon is unnecessary with the use of the macro,
remove all of them, and cleanup whitespace.
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Suggested-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The patch enables spread spectrum clocking (SSC) for MPU and LCD PLLs.
As reported by the TI spruh73x/spruhl7x RM, SSC is only supported for
the DISP/LCD and MPU PLLs on am33xx/am43xx. SSC is not supported for
DDR, PER, and CORE PLLs.
Calculating the required values and setting the registers accordingly
was taken from the set_mpu_spreadspectrum routine contained in the
arch/arm/mach-omap2/am33xx/clock_am33xx.c file of the u-boot project.
In locked condition, DPLL output clock = CLKINP *[M/N]. In case of
SSC enabled, the reference manual explains that there is a restriction
of range of M values. Since the clk_ti_am3_dpll_round_rate() attempts
to select the minimum possible N, the value of M obtained is not
guaranteed to be within the range required. With the new "ti,min-div"
parameter it is possible to increase N and consequently M to satisfy the
constraint imposed by SSC.
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210606202253.31649-6-dariobin@libero.it
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Registers for adjusting the spread spectrum clocking (SSC) have been
added. As reported by the TI spruhl7x RM, SSC is supported only for LCD
and MPU PLLs, but the PRCM_CM_SSC_DELTAMSTEP_DPLL_XXX and
PRCM_CM_SSC_MODFREQDIV_DPLL_XXX registers, as well as the enable field
in the PRCM_CM_CLKMODE_DPLL_XXX registers are mapped for all PLLs (CORE,
MPU, DDR, PER, DISP, EXTDEV).
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210606202253.31649-5-dariobin@libero.it
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Registers for adjusting the spread spectrum clocking (SSC) have been
added. As reported by the TI spruh73x RM, SSC is supported only for LCD
and MPU PLLs, but the CM_SSC_DELTAMSTEP_DPLL_XXX and
CM_SSC_MODFREQDIV_DPLL_XXX registers, as well as the enable field in the
CM_CLKMODE_DPLL_XXX registers are mapped for all PLLs (CORE, MPU, DDR,
PER, DISP).
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210606202253.31649-4-dariobin@libero.it
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
There are five omap3 based boards from LogicPD. Two of them
have added LTO support. Add the remaining three to use LTO.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
This adds support for the NanoPi R1S H5 board.
Allwinner H5 SoC
512MB DDR3 RAM
10/100/1000M Ethernet x 2
RTL8189ETV WiFi 802.11b/g/n
USB 2.0 host port (A)
MicroSD Slot
Reset button
Serial Debug Port
WAN - LAN - SYS LED
The dts file is taken from Linux 5.14 tag.
Signed-off-by: Chukun Pan <amadeus@jmu.edu.cn>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Add a driver so the clocks/resets for these peripherals (especially I2C,
RSB, and UART) can be enabled using the normal uclass methods.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Currently, the I2C clocks are configured in the sunxi board code. Add
the I2C clocks to the DM clock driver so they can be enabled from the
DM I2C driver using the normal uclass methods.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Since the beginning, all banks have had space for 32 pins, even when
not all pins were implemented. Let's use a single constant for the GPIO
bank size here, like the GPIO driver is already doing.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This clarifies which callers must be updated to complete the DM_GPIO
conversion.
The only remaining caller of name_to_gpio in generic code is inside the
!DM_GPIO block in cmd/gpio.c. DM_GPIO is always selected on sunxi, so
that code cannot be reached. And after this commit, there are only two
remaining implementations of name_to_gpio.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
As part of migrating to DM_GPIO and DM_PINCTRL, eventually we will
remove the asm/arch/gpio.h header. In preparation, clean up the various
files that include it.
Some files did not contain any GPIO code at all, so this header was
completely unused.
A few files contained only legacy platform-specific GPIO code for
setting up pin muxes. They were left unchanged, as that code will be
completely removed by the DM_PINCTRL migration.
The remaining files contain some combination of DM_GPIO and legacy GPIO
code. For those, switch to including asm/gpio.h (if it wasn't included
already). Right now, this header provides both sets of functions,
because ARCH_SUNXI selects GPIO_EXTRA_HEADER. This will still be the
right header to include once the DM_GPIO migration is complete and
GPIO_EXTRA_HEADER is no longer needed.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
For some systems, such as the PinePhone, there is no way for the end
user to make sure the system is indeed booting before the boot script is
executed, which takes several seconds. Therefore, it can be useful to
provide early visual feedback as soon as possible.
In order achieve this goal, this patch initializes the status LED (if
configured) in the SPL.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Ferraris <arnaud.ferraris@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The only caller of this function was the MMC pinmux code, which used it
to parse a string given from a Kconfig symbol. As the Kconfig symbol has
been converted to a Boolean, this function is no longer needed.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Only one board, Yones Toptech BD1078, actually uses a non-default MMC
pinmux. All other uses of these symbols select the default value or an
invalid value. To simplify things, remove support for the unused pinmux
options, and convert the remaining option to a Boolean.
This allows the pinmux to be chosen by the preprocessor, instead of
having the code parse a string at runtime (for a build-time option!).
Not only does this reduce code size, but it also allows this Kconfig
option to be used in a table-driven DM pinctrl driver.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The CCU header is only used by the DM drivers, not any platform code.
Its current location adds an artificial dependency on CONFIG_ARM and
ARCH_SUNXI, which will be problematic when adding the CCU driver for
a RISC-V sunxi platform.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The PineTab device-tree is already in u-boot, this commit adds the
corresponding defconfig, based on pinephone_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Ferraris <arnaud.ferraris@collabora.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Move CONFIG_VIDEO_MXS from board headers to Kconfig
and drop it from obsolete cfb_console driver.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
After DM_VIDEO conversion the 'vidconsole' is the correct name
for the frame buffer console. 'video' will not work, so update
the description of the config option.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
At present U-Boot has a header file called lz4.h for its own use. If the
host has its own lz4 header file installed (e.g. from the 'liblz4-dev'
package) then host builds will use that instead.
Move the U-Boot file into its own directory, as is done with various
other headers with the same problem.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Convert pixel values when necessary like we do for 16bpp
framebuffers.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add support for 30bpp mode where pixels are picked in 32-bit
integers but use 10 bits instead of 8 bits for each component.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
This function is far too long. Before trying to remove #ifdefs, split out
the code that deals with selecting the FDT into a separate function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use boolean variables to deal with the strange #ifdef logic of this
function, so we can remove the #ifdefs.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is far too long. Before trying to remove #ifdefs, split out
the code that deals with selecting the ramdisk into a separate function.
Leave the code indented as it was for easier review. The next patch cleans
this up along with checkpatch violations.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This file has a lot of conditional code and much of it is unnecessary.
Clean this up to reduce the number of build combinations.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is only used in one place and does not need to use the
preprocessor. Move it to the C file and convert it to a normal function.
Drop fit_unsupported() since it is not used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present EFI_SECURE BOOT selects RSA but does not necessarily enable
FIT_SIGNATURE. Mostly this is fine, but a few boards do not enable it,
so U-Boot tries to do RSA verification when loading FIT images, but it
is not enabled.
This worked because the condition for checking the RSA signature is
wrong in the fit_image_verify_with_data() function. In order to fix it
we need to fix this dependency. Make sure that FIT_SIGNATURE is enabled
so that RSA can be used.
It might be better to avoid using 'select' in this situation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We can use the new host_build() function for this, so drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
This is not needed with Kconfig, since we can use IS_ENABLED() easily
enough. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
This is not needed with Kconfig, since we can use IS_ENABLED() easily
enough. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
This is not needed with Kconfig, since we can use IS_ENABLED() easily
enough and the board code is now in a separate file. Update the only place
where this is used and drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add a host Kconfig for CRC32. With this we can use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CRC32)
directly in the host build, so drop the unnecessary indirection.
Add a few more conditions to SPL_CRC32 to avoid build failures as well as
TPL_CRC32. Also update hash.c to make crc32 optional and to actually take
notice of SPL_CRC32.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add a host Kconfig for FIT_RSASSA_PSS. With this we can use
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(FIT_RSASSA_PSS) directly in the host build, so drop the
forcing of this in the image.h header.
Drop the #ifdef around padding_pss_verify() too since it is not needed.
Use the compiler to check the config where possible, instead of the
preprocessor.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add a host Kconfig for FIT_VERBOSE. With this we can use
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(FIT_VERBOSE) directly in the tools build, so drop the
forcing of this in the image.h header.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add a host Kconfig for OF_LIBFDT. With this we can use
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OF_LIBFDT) directly in the tools build, so drop the
unnecessary indirection.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Make use of the host Kconfig for FIT. With this we can use
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(FIT) directly in the host build, so drop the unnecessary
indirection.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
We can use the __maybe_unused attribute to avoid some of the #ifdefs in
this file. Update the functions accordingly.
Note: The actual hashing interface is still a mess, with four separate
combinations and lots of #ifdefs. This should really use a driver
approach, e.g. as is done with partition drivers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
At present when building host tools, we force CONFIG_SHAxxx to be enabled
regardless of the board Kconfig setting. This is done in the image.h
header file.
For SPL we currently just assume the algorithm is desired if U-Boot proper
enables it.
Clean this up by adding new Kconfig options to enable hashing on the host,
relying on CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() to deal with the different builds.
Add new SPL Kconfigs for hardware-accelerated hashing, to maintain the
current settings.
This allows us to drop the image.h code and the I_WANT_MD5 hack.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Unfortunately these were removed by mistake. This means that adding hash
support to SPL brings in all software algorithms, with a substantial
increase in code size.
The origin of the problem was renaming them to SPL_FIT_xxx and then these
were removed altogether in a later commit.
Add them back. This aligns with CONFIG_MD5, for example, which has an SPL
variant.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: f5bc9c25f3 ("image: Rename SPL_SHAxxx_SUPPORT to SPL_FIT_SHAxxx")
Fixes: eb5171ddec ("common: Remove unused CONFIG_FIT_SHAxxx selectors")
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
In preparation for enabling CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() on the host build, add
some options to enable the various FIT options expected in these tools.
This will ensure that the code builds correctly when CONFIG_TOOLS_xxx
is distinct from CONFIG_xxx.
Drop some #ifdefs which are immediately unnecessary (many more are in
later patches).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
At present we must separately test for the host build for many options,
since we force them to be enabled. For example, CONFIG_FIT is always
enabled in the host tools, even if CONFIG_FIT is not enabled by the
board itself.
It would be more convenient if we could use, for example,
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(FIT) and get CONFIG_HOST_FIT, when building for the
host. Add support for this.
With this and the tools_build() function, we should be able to remove all
the #ifdefs currently needed in code that is build by tools and targets.
This will be even nicer when we move to using CONFIG(xxx) everywhere,
since all the #ifdef and IS_ENABLED/CONFIG_IS_ENABLED stuff will go away.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk> # b4f73886
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
With the new TOOLS_LIBCRYPTO and some other changes, it seems that we are
heading towards calling this a tools build rather than a host build,
although of course it does happen on the host.
I cannot think of anything built by the host which cannot be described as
a tool, so rename this function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add a macro to handle manually relocating a pointer. Update the iamge code
to use this to avoid needing #ifdefs.
This also fixes a bug where the 'done' flag was not set.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than adding an #ifdef and open-coding this calculation, add a
helper function to handle it. Use this in the image code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To avoid having #ifdefs in a few functions which are completely different
in the board and host code, create a new image-host.c file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To avoid a large #ifdef in the image.c file, move the affected code into
a separate file.
Avoid any style fix-ups for easier review. Those are in the next patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Adjust this function so that preprocessor macros are not needed. With
this, the host build uses more of the same header files as the target
build.
Rather than definining CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN, add a CONSERVE_MEMORY
define, since that is the purpose of the value.
This appears to have no impact on code size from a spot check of a few
boards (snow, firefly-rk3288, boston32r2el, m53menlo).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The gzip API uses the u64 type in it, which is not available in the host
build. This makes it impossible to include the header file.
We could make this type available, but it seems unnecessary. Limiting the
compression size to that of the 'unsigned long' type seems good enough. On
32-bit machines the limit then becomes 4GB, which likely exceeds available
RAM anyway, therefore it should be sufficient. On 64-bit machines this is
effectively u64 anyway.
Update the header file and implementation to use 'ulong' instead of 'u64'.
Add a definition of u32 for the cases that seem to need exactly that
length. This should be safe enough.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The zstd implementation prints the error in image_decomp() which is
incorrect and does not match other algorithms. Drop this and let the
caller report the error.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function is full of preprocessor macros. Adjust it to
check for an unsupported algorithm after the switch(). This will allow
us to drop the macros.
Fix up the return-value path and an extra blank line while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The existing zstd API requires the same sequence of calls to perform its
task. Create a helper for U-Boot, to avoid code duplication, as is done
with other compression algorithms. Make use of of this from the image
code.
Note that the zstd code lacks a test in test/compression.c and this should
be added by the maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When passing a data buffer back from a function, it is not always clear
who owns the buffer, i.e. who is responsible for freeing the memory used.
An example of this is where multiple files are decompressed from the
firmware image, using a temporary buffer for reading (since the
compressed data has to live somewhere) and producing a temporary or
permanent buffer with the resuilts.
Where the firmware image can be memory-mapped, as on x86, the compressed
data does not need to be buffered, but the complexity of having a buffer
which is either allocated or not, makes the code hard to understand.
Introduce a new 'abuf' which supports simple buffer operations:
- encapsulating a buffer and its size
- either allocated with malloc() or not
- able to be reliably freed if necessary
- able to be converted to an allocated buffer if needed
This simple API makes it easier to deal with allocated and memory-mapped
buffers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
According to datasheet, the upper four bits are reserved or used for
reflecting the ECC status of the accumulated pages. The error bits
number for the worst segment of the current page is encoded on lower
four bits. Fix it by masking the upper bits.
This same issue has been already fixed in the linux kernel by:
"mtd: spinand: macronix: Fix ECC Status Read"
(sha1: f4cb4d7b46f6409382fd981eec9556e1f3c1dc5d)
Apply the same fix in the U-Boot driver.
Signed-off-by: Haolin Li <li.haolin@qq.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
DM_GPIO_HOG flag has been replaced by GPIO_HOG flag since a while in
commit 49b10cb492 ("gpio: fixes for gpio-hog support").
And furthermore, gpio_hog_probe_all() is already called in board_r.c.
So gpio_hog_probe() can be removed from stm32mp1.c.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
DM_GPIO_HOG flag has been replaced by GPIO_HOG flag since a while in
commit 49b10cb492 ("gpio: fixes for gpio-hog support").
And furthermore, gpio_hog_probe_all() is already called in board_r.c.
So gpio_hog_probe() can be removed from stm32mp1.c.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The digital filter related computation are present in the driver
however the programming of the filter within the IP is missing.
The maximum value for the DNF is wrong and should be 15 instead of 16.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Today all the I2C instance point on the same global
variable stm32_i2c_setup according the compatible: i2c_priv->setup =
pointer to the same driver data.
This patch changes this driver data (stm32f7_setup and stm32mp15_setup)
to a const struct and move the timing struct 'setup' as element of i2c
privdata, initialized in stm32_ofdata_to_platdata() with the driver
configuration data.
This patch solves issues when several I2C instance have not the same
clock source or not the same configuration: each timing setup is saved
is the I2C privdata.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Commit ca1a4c8632 ("mvebu: select boot device at SoC level") made it
unnecessary for the A385 boards to have their own kwbimage.cfg but as
the x530 was in flight at the time it was added with it's own
kwbimage.cfg. Remove the custom kwbimage.cfg as the SoC level file is
suitable.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Since the CP1 pinctrl is not properly set in the DTS, there is no
need for setting the pinctrl by writing hardcoded values to the MPP
registers.
So, drop the code relating to that.
Fixes: 87c220d0 ("arm: mvebu: mvebu_armada-8k: Add support for initializing iEi Puzzle-M801 networking")
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Current CP1 pinctrl that is set on the Puzzle M801 is incorrect.
CP1 pins are only used for the SMI bus and the MSS I2C, all other
pins are just GPIO-s.
Due to this being set completely wrong, the pinctrl was actually
ended up being hardcoded in the board_early_init_f() step so that
SMI would work.
That is obviously not the right thing to do, so convert the register
hex values that were being written to individual pin modes and set it
in the DTS.
Add the SMI pins to the CP1 MDIO node as otherwise CP1 pinctrl does
not get probed without an consumer.
Fixes: 2ae2b8a2 ("arm: mvebu: Initial iEi Puzzle-M801 support")
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Select SPL_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT on 32bit Armada platforms via Kconfig,
as this was removed from mach/config.h in a2ac2b96 ("Convert
CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT et al to Kconfig").
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fixes: a2ac2b96 ("Convert CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT et al to Kconfig")
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Marek Behún <kabel@kernel.org>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
There were several changes for this structure but the documentation was
not changed at the time. Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Now that PCI Bridge (PCIe Root Port) for Aardvark is emulated in U-Boot,
add support for handling and propagation of CRSSVE bit.
When CRSSVE bit is unset (default), driver has to reissue config
read/write request on CRS response.
CRSSVE bit is supported only when CRSVIS bit is provided in read-only
Root Capabilities register. So manually inject this CRSVIS bit into read
response for that register.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Now that PCI Bridge is working for the PCIe Root Port, U-Boot's PCI_PNP
code automatically enables memory access and bus mastering when needed.
We do not need to enable it when setting the HW up.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Aardvark does not have a real PCIe Root Port device on the root bus.
Instead it has PCIe registers of PCIe Root Port device mapped in
internal Aardvark memory space starting at offset 0xc0.
The PCIe Root Port itself is normally available as a PCI Bridge device
on the root bus with bus number zero. Aardvark instead has the
configuration registers of this PCI Bridge at offset 0x00 of Aardvark's
memory space, but the class code of this device is Mass Storage
Controller (0x010400), instead of PCI Bridge (0x600400), which causes
U-Boot to fail to recognize it as a P2P Bridge
Add a hook into the pcie_advk_read_config() / pcie_advk_write_config()
functions to redirect access for root bus from PIO transfer to this
internal Aardvark memory space. This will allow U-Boot to access
configuration space of this PCI Bridge which represents PCIe Root Port.
Redirect access to PCI Bridge registers in range 0x10 - 0x34 to driver's
internal buffer (cfgcache[]). This is because at those addresses
Aardvark has different registers, incompatible with config space of a
PCI Bridge.
Redirect access to PCI Bridge register PCI_ROM_ADDRESS1 (0x38) to
Aardvark internal address for that register (0x30).
When reading PCI Bridge register PCI_HEADER_TYPE, set it explicitly to
value Type 1 (PCI_HEADER_TYPE_BRIDGE) as PCI Bridge must be of Type 1.
When writing to PCI_PRIMARY_BUS or PCI_SECONDARY_BUS registers on this
PCI Bridge, correctly update driver's first_busno and sec_busno
variables, so that pcie_advk_addr_valid() function can check if address
of any device behind the root bus is valid and that PIO transfers are
started with correct config type (1 vs 0), which is required for
accessing devices behind some PCI bridge after the root bus.
U-Boot's PCI_PNP code sets primary and secondary bus numbers as relative
to the configured bus number of the root bus. This is done so that
U-Boot can support multiple PCIe host bridges or multiple root port
buses, when internal bus numbers are different.
Now that root bus is available, update code in pcie_advk_read_config()
and pcie_advk_write_config() functions to correctly calculate real
Aardvark bus number of the target device from U-Boot's bus number as:
busno = PCI_BUS(bdf) - dev_seq(bus)
Stefan: Small fix of header masking as suggested by Pali.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Aardvark reports Disabled and Hot Reset LTSSM states as values >= 0x20.
Link is not up in these states, so fix pcie_advk_link_up() function.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These are part of SOC_CONTROL_REG1 register, not PEX_CAPABILITIES_REG.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remove unused PCIe functions from SerDes code. They are unused and are
duplicated either from generic PCIe code or from pci_mvebu.c.
Remove also unused PCIe macros from SerDes code. They are just obfuscated
variants of standards macros in include/pci.h or in pci_mvebu.c.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This code is trying to parse PCIe config space of PCIe card connected on
the other end of link and then is trying to force 5.0 GT/s speed via Target
Link Speed bits in PCIe Root Port Link Control 2 Register on the local part
of link if it sees that card supports 5.0 GT/s via Max Link Speed bits in
Link Capabilities Register.
The code is incorrect for more reasons:
- Accessing config space of an endpoint card cannot be done immediately.
If the PCIe link is not up, reading vendor/device ID registers will
return all ones.
- Parsing is incomplete, so it can cause issues even for working cards.
Moreover there is no need to force speed to 5.0 GT/s via Target Link Speed
bits on PCIe Root Port Link Control 2 Register. Hardware changes speed from
2.5 GT/s to 5.0 GT/s autonomously when it is supported.
Most importantly, this code does not change link speed at all, since
because after updating Target Link Speed bits on PCIe Root Port Link
Control 2 Register, it is required to retrain the link, and the code for
that is completely missing.
The code was probably needed for making buggy endpoint cards work. Such a
workaround, though, should be implemented via PCIe subsystem (via quirks,
for example), as buggy cards could also affect other PCIe controllers.
Note that this code is fully unrelated to a38x SerDes code and really
should not have been included in SerDes initialization. Usage of magic
constants without names and comments made this SerDes code hard to read and
understand.
Remove this PCIe application code from low level SerDes code. As this code
is configuring only 5.0 GT/s part, in the worst case, it could leave buggy
cards at the initial speed of 2.5 GT/s (if somehow before this change they
could have been "upgraded" to 5.0 GT/s speed even with missing link
retraining). Compliant cards which just need longer initialization should
work better after this change.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI device ID is part of the PCIe controller SoC / revision. For Root
Complex mode (which is the default and the only mode supported currently
by U-Boot and Linux kernel), it is PCI device ID of PCIe Root Port device.
If there is some issue with this device ID, it should be set / updated by
PCIe controller driver (pci_mvebu.c), as this register resides in address
space of the controller. It shouldn't be done in SerDes initialization
code.
In the worst case (a specific board for example) it could be done via
U-Boot's weak function board_pex_config().
But it should not be overwritten globally for all A38x devices.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enabling Common Clock Configuration bit in PCIe Root Port Link Control
Register should not be done unconditionally. It is enabled by operating
system as part of ASPM. Also after enabling Common Clock Configuration it
is required to do more work, like retraining link. Some cards may be broken
due to this incomplete Common Clock Configuration and some cards are broken
and do not support ASPM at all.
Remove this incomplete code for Common Clock Configuration. It really
should not be done in SerDes code as it is not related to SerDes, but to
PCIe subsystem.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Device/Port Type bits of PCIe Root Port PCI Express Capabilities Register
are read-only SAR registers and are initialized according to current mode
configured by PCIe controller. Changing PCIe controller mode (from Root
Complex mode to Endpoint mode or the other way) is possible via PCI
Express Control Register (offset 0x41A00), bit 1 (ConfRoot Complex). This
has to be done in PCIe controller driver (in our case pci_mvebu.c). Note
that default mode is Root Complex.
Maximum Link Speed bits of PCIe Root Port Link Capabilities Register are
platform specific and overwriting them does not make sense. They are set by
PCIe controller according to current SerDes configuration. For A38x it is
5.0 GT/s if SerDes supports appropriate speed.
Maximum Link Width bits of PCIe Root Port Link Capabilities Register are
read-only SAR registers, but unfortunately if this is not set correctly
here, then access PCI config space of the endpoint card behind this Root
Port does not work.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add comments to understand what this magic code is doing.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
SoC Control 1 Register (offset 0x18204) is already defined by macro
SOC_CONTROL_REG1.
Use macro SOC_CONTROL_REG1 instead of macro SOC_CTRL_REG in ctrl_pex.c
code and remove the other definition.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Replace magic register offsets by macros to make code more readable.
Add comments about what this code is doing.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Subroutines in comphy_usb2_power_up() and comphy_sgmii_power_up() functions
may fail. In this case, do not continue execution of current function and
instead jump to the end. Return value in 'ret' variable is already set.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit 079b35a261 ("arm: a37xx: pci: Increase PCIe MEM size from 16 MiB
to 127 MiB") increased size of PCIe MEM to 127 MiB, which is the maximal
possible size for allocated 128 MiB PCIe window. PCIe IO size in that
commit was unchanged.
Armada 3720 PCIe controller supports 32-bit IO space mapping so it is
possible to assign more than 64 KiB if address space for IO.
Currently controller has assigned 127 MiB + 64 KiB memory and therefore
there is 960 KiB of unused memory. So assign it to IO space by increasing
IO window from 64 KiB to 1 MiB.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 079b35a261 ("arm: a37xx: pci: Increase PCIe MEM size from 16 MiB to 127 MiB")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remove the following STV0991 specific configs:
- CONFIG_STV0991 (never used, only defined in CONFIG_SYS_EXTRA_OPTIONS)
- CONFIG_STV0991_HZ (replaced by generic CONFIG_SYS_HZ)
- CONFIG_STV0991_HZ_CLOCK (replaced by generic CONFIG_SYS_HZ_CLOCK)
This patch allows to reduce the file config_whitelist.txt.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Using the tools moveconfig.py to move the following config in the
defconfig files:
CONFIG_USB_HOST_ETHER
CONFIG_USB_ETHER_ASIX
CONFIG_USB_ETHER_MCS7830
CONFIG_USB_ETHER_SMSC95XX
These option are already migrated since the commit f58ad98a62 ("usb: net:
migrate USB Ethernet adapters to Kconfig") and the commit ae3584498b
("usb: net: migrate CONFIG_USB_HOST_ETHER to Kconfig").
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This reverts commit d5d726d3cc,
which breaks boards which ship with multiple SD/eMMC sockets.
This stm32mp1.h config is not used only by the ST reference
boards, but all the other STM32MP1 based boards in U-Boot, so
changes to this stm32mp1.h cannot break the other boards.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add protection on presence and order of the phy node sub node
by using the mandatory reg information.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The vbus-supply is an optional property of sub-node connector node.
and no more in the usb phyc node (in first proposed binding).
This regulator for USB VBUS may be needed for host mode.
See the latest kernel binding for details in
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/phy/phy-stm32-usbphyc.yaml.
usbphyc_port0: usb-phy@0 {
reg = <0>;
phy-supply = <&vdd_usb>;
#phy-cells = <0>;
connector {
compatible = "usb-a-connector";
vbus-supply = <&vbus_sw>;
};
};
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Import HS400 support for iMX7ULP B0 from the Linux kernel:
2eaf5a533afd ("mmc: sdhci-esdhc-imx: Add HS400 support for iMX7ULP")
According to IC suggest, need to clear the STROBE_DLL_CTRL_RESET
before any setting of STROBE_DLL_CTRL register.
USDHC has register bits(bit[27~20] of register STROBE_DLL_CTRL)
for slave sel value. If this register bits value is 0, it needs
256 ref_clk cycles to update slave sel value. IC suggest to set
bit[27~20] to 0x4, it only need 4 ref_clk cycle to update slave
sel value. This will short the lock time of slave.
i.MX7ULP B0 will need more time to lock the REF and SLV, so change
to add 5us delay.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Use the common imx8mm-venice-u-boot.dtsi (dtb for the
'DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE) so that it inherits things like binman.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Use the common imx8mm-venice-u-boot.dtsi (dtb for the
'DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE) so that it inherits things like binman.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Use the common imx8mm-venice-u-boot.dtsi (dtb for the
'DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE) so that it inherits things like binman.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
When using SWUpdate, it is necessary to toggle between partitions.
Use the 'mmcpart' environment variable to accomplish that.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
After switch to use binman, no need to use the bash script
to check file exsiting or not. And there is bug that
the script will be executed everytime Makefile is used which is
confusing people.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
When creating flash.bin, the hdmi firmware might not be
copied to U-Boot source tree. Then mkimage will fail.
However we are switching to binman, binman will show the
message if the file not there, and create empty file per
i.MX8MQ binman node. So we not fail mkimage here othersize
CI will fail if hdmi firmware not copied here.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The Kontron SoM-Line i.MX8MM (N801x) by Kontron Electronics GmbH is a SoM
module with an i.MX8M-Mini SoC, 1/2/4 GB LPDDR4 RAM, SPI NOR, eMMC and PMIC.
The matching evaluation boards (Board-Line) have 2 Ethernets, USB 2.0, HDMI/LVDS,
SD card, CAN, RS485 and much more.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Tested-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Remove board_ehci_hcd_init function that is not used with DM_USB
and replace its functionality with device-tree configuraton that treats
USB HUB RST# as a gpio enable for the usbh1 vbus regulator.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Enable LVDS display detection and panel-specific configuration
Make I2C based LVDS detection and configuration model specific:
- not all boards support LVDS connectors; fail detection that do not
support LVDS to avoid misdetecting an I2C device as a display
- GPIO configuration is panel specific; use panel name where needed
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
We configure network phy configuration for internal delay, LED config,
and clock config. If we leave the phy reset gpio defined in dt the
kernel may issue a reset to the phy and break these configs. While some
may be handled by a kernel phy driver, others may not (typically LED
config).
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
This adds support for i.MX6UL/ULL-based evaluation kits with SoMs by
Kontron Electronics GmbH.
Currently there are the following SoM flavors (SoM-Line):
* N6310: SOM with i.MX6UL-2, 256MB RAM, 256MB SPI NAND
* N6311: SOM with i.MX6UL-2, 512MB RAM, 512MB SPI NAND
* N6411: SOM with i.MX6ULL, 512MB RAM, 512MB SPI NAND
And the according evaluation boards (Board-Line):
* N6310-S: Baseboard with SOM N6310, eMMC, display (optional), ...
* N6311-S: Baseboard with SOM N6311, eMMC, display (optional), ...
* N6411-S: Baseboard with SOM N6411, eMMC, display (optional), ...
Currently U-Boot describes i.MX6UL and i.MX6ULL through separate config
options at compile-time. Though the differences are so minor, that for
the scope of these SoMs we just use a single defconfig that is compatible
with both SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
The CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE definition did not account for all areas that
are used by the boot ROM according to the manual, causing boot failures
due to truncated SPL images when actually hitting this limit.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Synchronize the u-boot and kernel imx device trees, using tuned
script from commit c0157bdcafa1 ("ARM: dts: imx: use generic name bus")
Per devicetree specification, generic names are recommended to be
used, such as bus.
i.MX AIPS is an AHB - IP bridge bus, so we could use bus as node
name.
Script:
sed -i "s/\<aips@/bus@/" arch/arm/dts/imx*.dtsi
sed -i "s/\<aips@/bus@/" arch/arm/dts/vf*.dtsi
sed -i "s/\<aips-bus@/bus@/" arch/arm/dts/imx*.dtsi
sed -i "s/\<aips-bus@/bus@/" arch/arm/dts/vf*.dtsi
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Update the mx7ulp wdog disable sequence to avoid potential reset
issue in unlock or refresh sequence. Both sequence need two words
write to wdog CNT register in 16 bus clocks window, if miss the
window, the write will cause violation in wdog and reset the chip.
Current u-boot code is using writel() function which has a DMB
barrier to order the memory access. The DMB between two words write
may introduce some delay in certain circumstance, causing the wdog
reset due to 16 bus clock window requirement.
Also, WDOG1 might have been enabled already depending on FUSE hence
we need to be as close as possible to its reconfiguration timing
requirement of 128 bus clock limit.
This patch replaces writel() function by __raw_writel() to avoid such
issue, and improve to check if watchdog is already disabled or
unlocked.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Co-developed-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Co-developed-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
The RX8803 and RX8900 register layouts are compatible with the one of
the RV8803. So add these to the compatibles.
The same compatible strings are used and approved in linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Add u-boot.dtsi specific to imx6-apalis with a watchdog enabled.
If OP-TEE is loaded by SPL, it may use a watchdog to handle fails of
u-boot running. Enable the watchdog in SPL to use it by OP-TEE.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since c6df0e2ffd ("net: phy: micrel: add support for DLL setup on ksz9131")
the Micrel PHY driver correctly configures the delay register. The Verdin PHY
is RGMII-ID, so reflect that in DT, otherwise the ethernet no longer works.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Cc: Max Krummenacher <max.krummenacher@toradex.com>
Cc: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
The BSP platform LmP supports the board NXP iMX8QM MEK. The
kernel size in LmP exceeds 32Mb. Increase the maximum size
of an uncompressed kernel to fix the following error:
Uncompressing Kernel Image
Error: inflate() returned -5
Image too large: increase CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN
Must RESET board to recover
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
The BSP platform LmP supports the board NXP iMX8M Plus EVK. The
kernel size in LmP exceeds 32Mb. Increase the maximum size
of an uncompressed kernel to fix the following error:
Uncompressing Kernel Image
Error: inflate() returned -5
Image too large: increase CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN
Must RESET board to recover
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
The BSP platform LmP supports the board NXP iMX8M Mini EVK. The
kernel size in LmP exceeds 32Mb. Increase the maximum size
of an uncompressed kernel to fix the following error:
Uncompressing Kernel Image
Error: inflate() returned -5
Image too large: increase CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN
Must RESET board to recover
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
The CAAM on IMX7ULP doesn't support public key hardware acceleration
(PKHA), as in other NXP parts. Disable RSA_FREESCALE_EXP for IMX7ULP
too.
Fixed: f4e9ff7135 ("Kconfig: Don't use RSA_FREESCALE_EXP on IMX")
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
binman conversion made flashing flash.bin
and u-boot.itb necessary. Update binman config
to create a single flash.bin image again.
This updates imx8mp_evk and phyCORE-i.MX8MP as they share the
same binman config.
Updated also imx8mp_evk documentation.
Tested on phyCORE-i.MX8MP.
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
When purchasing imx8mm-cl-iot-gate it is able to customize the
memory size. It could be 1GB, 2GB and 4GB. We implement
board_phys_sdram_size() to detect the memory size for usage.
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paulliu@debian.org>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Cc: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Since derivatives are moving to binman from usage of the FIT generator
script, and considering the warning introduced in f4a43d2925
("Makefile: Warn against using CONFIG_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR"), usage of FIT
generator is discouraged.
Current FIT generator also generates broken output, since commit
3f04db891a ("image: Check for unit addresses in FITs") prohibits using
'@' for unit addresses but the generator script still emits the old
sematics.
Remove the generator script and corresponding call in Makefile, all
derivatives should be migrated to binman in order to provide binary
images.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Currently imx8mm-cl-iot-gate_defconfig fails to produce a working boot
binary due to the lack of fip.bin:
" BINMAN all
Image 'main-section' is missing external blobs and is non-functional: blob-ext
Some images are invalid"
To make the build process more consistent with the other i.MX8M targets,
split the defconfig in two:
- imx8mm-cl-iot-gate_defconfig: standard defconfig that only
requires ATF / DDR firmware.
- imx8mm-cl-iot-gate-optee_defconfig: "more advanced" defconfig that
requires ATF / Optee / mbedtls / DDR firmware.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Tested-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Display hwmon values by default when using the 'gsc' command.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
After the enforcement of DM_MMC the microSD card is not detected. Fix by
correctly configuring the card detect in the devicetree.
Signed-off-by: Andrej Rosano <andrej.rosano@f-secure.com>
Since the mxs_nand_spl has implemented adjust read offset in
nand_spl_load_image, so we don't need to check the bad block in
nand_spl_adjust_offset. Directly return the offset to continue
read by nand_spl_load_image.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
According to 8MM/MN/MP reference manual, their pad registers only have
4 valid DSE values. And DSE2 and DSE4 are different with current
definitions in iomux-v3.h. Fix the issue to align with manual.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The SD clock disable is wrapped by MMC_SUPPORTS_TUNING. So it
only works when UHS is enabled. However, in SD initialization the
power cycle does not depends on UHS. But the power cycle needs
disable the SD clock before power down.
So this causes a problem when UHS is not enabled. Some cards can't
become ready (ACMD14 timeout) due to the clock is enabled during
power cycle.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
cherry-picked from NXP code:
719d665a87c6: ("MLK-20467 imx8m: Fix issue for booting signed image through uuu")
which fixes secure boot on imx8m based boards. Problem was
that FIT header and so IVT header too, was loaded to
memallocated address. So the ivt header address coded
in IVT itself does not fit with the real position.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Tested-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
read the address where the IVT header must sit
from IVT image header, loaded from SPL into
an malloced buffer and copy the IVT header
to this address
May make this dependend on SoC ?
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
add hook function spl_load_simple_fit_fix_load()
which is called after fit image header is loaded.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Add new SoC ID for S905Y2 found in Radxa Zero
- pcie_dw_meson: fix usb fail when pci link fails to go up
- Sync Amlogic DT from Linux 5.14
- dwc3-meson-gxl: add AXG compatible
- dts: keep back HW order for MMC devices since change in Upstream Linux
- Cleanup local AXG DT USB nodes now everything is upstream
- distro_bootcmd: run pci enum for scsi_boot just like it is done for nvme_boot
- New Boards:
- Odroid-HC4: a variant of Odroid-C4 with 2 SATA ports (via PCIe-SATA bridge)
- Beelink GS-King X: A variant of the other Beelink board with 2 SATA ports (via USB3-SATA bridge)
- Banana Pi M5: another credit card SBC
- JetHub D1/H1: home automation controllers
- Radxa Zero: another RPi Zero sized SBC
Add documentation bits for the Radxa Zero
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
[narmstrong: updated u200 MAINTAINERS]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add a defconfig for the Radxa Zero SBC, using an Amlogic S905Y2 chip.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
[narmstrong: updated u200 MAINTAINERS & add missing CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR from defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add support for new home automation devices.
JetHome Jethub D1 (http://jethome.ru/jethub-d1) is a home automation controller with the following features:
- DIN Rail Mounting case
- Amlogic A113X (ARM Cortex-A53) quad-core up to 1.5GHz
- no video out
- 512Mb/1GB DDR3
- 8/16GB eMMC flash
- 1 x USB 2.0
- 1 x 10/100Mbps ethernet
- WiFi / Bluetooth AMPAK AP6255 (Broadcom BCM43455) IEEE 802.11a/b/g/n/ac, Bluetooth 4.2.
- TI CC2538 + CC2592 Zigbee Wireless Module with up to 20dBm output power and Zigbee 3.0 support.
- 2 x gpio LEDS
- GPIO user Button
- 1 x 1-Wire
- 2 x RS-485
- 4 x dry contact digital GPIO inputs
- 3 x relay GPIO outputs
- DC source with a voltage of 9 to 56 V / Passive POE
JetHome Jethub H1 (http://jethome.ru/jethub-h1) is a home automation controller with the following features:
- Square plastic case
- Amlogic S905W (ARM Cortex-A53) quad-core up to 1.5GHz
- no video out
- 1GB DDR3
- 8/16GB eMMC flash
- 2 x USB 2.0
- 1 x 10/100Mbps ethernet
- WiFi / Bluetooth RTL8822CS IEEE 802.11a/b/g/n/ac, Bluetooth 5.0.
- TI CC2538 + CC2592 Zigbee Wireless Module with up to 20dBm output power and Zigbee 3.0 support.
- MicroSD 2.x/3.x/4.x DS/HS cards.
- 1 x gpio LED
- ADC user Button
- DC source 5V microUSB with serial console
Patches from:
- JetHub H1
https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210915085715.1134940-4-adeep@lexina.inhttps://git.kernel.org/amlogic/c/abfaae24ecf3e7f00508b60fa05e2b6789b8f607
- JetHub D1
https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210915085715.1134940-5-adeep@lexina.inhttps://git.kernel.org/amlogic/c/8e279fb2903990cc6296ec56b3b80b2f854b6c79
Signed-off-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
[narmstrong: removed unused variable value]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
JetHub devices uses its own boot sequence with "rescue" button
Signed-off-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The Beelink GS-King X is a variant of the GS King boards but with an internal
USB to SATA bridge and advanced audio features.
[narmstrong: add missing CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR from defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The Odroid-HC4 is a variant of the Odroid-C4 board but with a PCIe-SATA bridge
instead of the USB3 ports.
[narmstrong: add missing CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR from defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The SCSI device can be a PCIe adapter, so run pcie enum if enabled.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add SCSI target to be able to boot from the SATA disks on the Odroid HC4 using
an on-board AHCI PCIe controller.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Since Linux commmit [1], the order is fixed with aliases, in order to keep the
MMC device order, set it back to HW order in U-Boot dtsi files.
[1] ab547c4fb39f ("arm64: dts: amlogic: Assign a fixed index to mmc devices")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Upstream Linux uses the "amlogic,meson-axg-usb-ctrl" for AXG SoCs.
This adds it to the compatible list for this driver.
Reported-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Vyacheslav Bocharov <adeep@lexina.in>
Import Amlogic DT changes from Linux commit 7d2a07b76933 ("Linux 5.14"),
dt-bindings clock changes and new meson-g12b-gsking-x.dts,
meson-sm1-bananapi-m5 & odroid-hc4 boards.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
On Amlogic A311D, when the PCIe link fails disabling the related clocks
makes USB fail. For an unknown reason, this doesn happen on the S905D3 SoC.
Mimic the Linux behavior by not considering a link failure a probe failure,
and continue even if the PCIe link is down.
Reported-by: Art Nikpal <email2tema@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add the SOC ID for the S905Y2 to board info, see below for before/after
tested with a Radxa Zero board:
SoC: Amlogic Meson G12A (Unknown) Revision 28:b (30:2)
SoC: Amlogic Meson G12A (S905Y2) Revision 28:b (30:2)
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
If Coherence Manager were not set in the beginning,
u-boot-spl would sometimes fail to boot to u-boot proper.
Enable CM and I/D cache at the same time in harts_early_init
Signed-off-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
There should be a platform compiled with the new driver.
Enable CONFIG_SYSRESET_SBI for all QEMU boards using SBI.
If you want to test the SBI sysreset driver, disable
CONFIG_SYSRESET_SYSCON.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
bootm_low is used as a base address is used to allocate space for the
FDT blob, initrd, cmdline, etc. when booting Linux. Set the default
value for RISC-V to the start of the first DRAM bank, so platforms can
get their DRAM layout from the device tree, and do not need to define
CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The no-map property is wrongly skipped if a no-map reserved memory
node follows one without that property. Fix this by not remembering
the absence of a no-map property across loop iterations.
Fixes: d4ea649f17 ("riscv: Provide a mechanism to fix DT for reserved memory")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Atish Patra <atish.patra@wdc.com>
The RISC-V SBI interface v0.1 provides a function for printing a
character to the console. Even though SBI v0.1 functions are deprecated,
the SBI console is quite useful for early debugging, because it works
without any dcache, memory, or MMIO access in S mode.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
In some cases, the best config cannot be used because the VCO would be
out-of-spec. In these cases, we may need to try a worse combination of r/od
in order to find the best representable config. This also adds a few test
cases to catch this and other (possible) unlikely errors.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Having to copy-paste the same 3 lines makes adding new test cases
error-prone. Use a macro.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Everything here sits in a while (true) loop. However, this introduces a
couple of layers of indentation. We can simplify the code by introducing a
single goto instead of using continue/break. This will also make adding
loops in the next patch easier.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The PLL functions take ulong arguments for rate, but still check if that
rate is negative (which is never true). The correct way to handle this is
to use IS_ERR_VALUE (like is already done in k210_clk_set_rate). While
we're at it, we can move the error checking up into the caller of the pll
set/get rate functions. This also protects our other calculations from
using bogus values for rate.
Fixes: 609bd60b94 ("clk: k210: Rewrite to remove CCF")
Reported-by: Coverity Scan <scan-admin@coverity.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The values of CONFIG_NAND_OMAP_ECCSCHEME map to the enum in
include/linux/mtd/omap_gpmc.h for valid ECC schemes. Make which one we
will use be a choice statement, enumerating the ones which we have
implemented.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_NAND_FSL_ELBC
CONFIG_NAND_FSL_IFC
Note that a number of PowerPC platforms had previously enabled
CONFIG_NAND_FSL_ELBC without CONFIG_MTD_RAW_NAND, and now they no longer
enable the option, reducing the size of a few functions.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
We only include <linux/mtd/rawnand.h> in <nand.h> for the forward
declaration of struct nand_chip, so do that directly. Then, include
<linux/mtd/rawnand.h> where required directly.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS
In order to do this, introduce a choice for HAS_LARGE/SMALL_BADBLOCK_POS
as those are the only valid values. Use LARGE as the default as no
in-tree boards use SMALL, but it is possible.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SPL_NAND_LOAD
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Typically platforms will define CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT based on
CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE / CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE. Switch to this
in preparation for migrating CONFIG_SYS_NAND namespace to Kconfig.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Olaf Mandel <o.mandel@menlosystems.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
OEM_REVISION is 32-bit unsigned number. It should be increased only when
changing software version. Therefore it should not depend on build time.
Change calculation to use U-Boot version numbers and set this revision
to date number.
Prior this change OEM_REVISION was calculated from build date and stored in
the same format.
After this change macro U_BOOT_BUILD_DATE is not used in other files so
remove it from global autogenerated files and also from Makefile.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use dev_ function to read the sides and colour to support a live tree.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use dev_ function to read the name and boolean to support a live tree.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These tests currently run in a particular sequence, with some of them
depending on the actions of earlier tests.
Add a check for sandbox and reset to a known state at the start of each
test, so that all tests can run in parallel.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The -z tests don't really need to be part of the main set. Separate them
out so we can drop the test setup/cleans functions and thus run all tests
in parallel.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the tests to use separate working directories, so we can run them
in parallel. It also makes it possible to see the individual output files
after the tests have completed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Target code and mkimage share the same hashing infrastructure. If one
is wrong, it's very likely that both are wrong in the same way. Thus
testing won't catch hash regressions. This already happened in
commit 92055e138f ("image: Drop if/elseif hash selection in
calculate_hash()"). None of the tests caught that CRC32 was broken.
Instead of testing hash_calculate() against itself, create a FIT with
containing a kernel with pre-calculated hashes. Then check the hashes
produced against the known good hashes.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The generic GPIO flags binding is shared across many drivers, some of
which need their own xlate function. Factor out the flag translation
code from gpio_xlate_offs_flags so it does not need to be duplicated.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Translation of an OF GPIO specifier should fail if the pin offset is
larger than the number of pins in the GPIO bank.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Translation of a pin name to a device+offset should fail if the offset
is larger than the number of pins in the GPIO bank.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This config is only used by three boards with this SOC. Most other
platforms derive this information from devicetree, and are unlikely
to ever need this config.
Moreover, it is confusing when Kconfig asks for this value under
"Support OPTEE images", but does not do anything with the value.
Move it to imx7 for those boards who still make use of it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
This value is not used by u-boot, and it should not. The load address
of an OPTEE image is defined by said image. Either a uImage or a FIT
will have a defined load address and entry point. Those values are the
correct ones, not CONFIG_OPTEE_LOAD_ADDR.
Commit f25006b96e ("optee: Add CONFIG_OPTEE_LOAD_ADDR") justifies
this config by requiring its presence in u-boot's .config for other
images as part of a larger build, claiming it is "the best way".
This argument is not persuasive. U-boot's configuration is driven by
platform requirements, not the other way around. It seems more likely
that the argument is conflating tooling issues with Kconfig. Yocto and
buildroot have excellent mechanisms for defining values across the
board (pun intended). u-boot's Kconfig is the wrong place to do it.
Furthermore, it is not "best" for u-boot because it hardcodes a value
which is then not used. In fact the load address that u-boot uses is
the one derived from the OPTEE image.
Confused yet? I sure was. To prevent future confusion, remove
CONFIG_OPTEE_LOAD_ADDR.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
It is no longer used in u-boot. Information about the TZDRAM location
is usually available in the devicetree as "/reserved-memory/" nodes.
Because this isn't used, remove it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The configs TZDRAM_BASE and TZDRAM_SIZE are expected to describe the
memory allocated to the OPTEE region. according to according to commit
c5a6e8bd00 ("optee: Add optee_verify_bootm_image()"). The TZDRAM is
with some limitations, described by "/reserved-memory" nodes in the
devicetree.
Consequently TZDRAM_BASE and TZDRAM_SIZE can point to imaginary
regions which have nothing to do with actual DRAM. They are not used
to configure the hardware or set up the Trust Zone Controller (TZC)
for OP-TEE -- the devicetree values are used instead.
When a valid OP-TEE image does not fall within the region described by
these configs, u-boot will refuse to load it. In fact, it mostly
serves to cause "bootm" to reject perfectly good OP-TEE images.
Ironically, someone has to correctly configure the devicetree for
TZDRAM, then go back and enter the same information in Kconfig for
"bootm". To remedy this, do not use TZDRAM_BASE and TZDRAM_SIZE in the
verification of OPTEE images.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Add stub for tee_find_device function when CONFIG_TEE is not activated
to simplify the caller code.
This patch allows to remove the CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OPTEE) tests
for stm32 platform.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@inaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Jens Wiklander <jens.wiklander@linaro.org>
The configuration CONFIG_OPTEE is defined 2 times:
1- in lib/optee/Kconfig for support of OPTEE images loaded by bootm command
2- in drivers/tee/optee/Kconfig for support of OP-TEE driver.
It is abnormal to have the same CONFIG define for 2 purpose;
and it is difficult to managed correctly their dependencies.
Moreover CONFIG_SPL_OPTEE is defined in common/spl/Kconfig
to manage OPTEE image load in SPL.
This definition causes an issue with the macro CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OPTEE)
to test the availability of the OP-TEE driver.
This patch cleans the configuration dependency with:
- CONFIG_OPTEE_IMAGE (renamed) => support of OP-TEE image in U-Boot
- CONFIG_SPL_OPTEE_IMAGE (renamed) => support of OP-TEE image in SPL
- CONFIG_OPTEE (same) => support of OP-TEE driver in U-Boot
- CONFIG_OPTEE_LIB (new) => support of OP-TEE library
After this patch, the macro have the correct behavior:
- CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OPTEE_IMAGE) => Load of OP-TEE image is supported
- CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(OPTEE) => OP-TEE driver is supported
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Both dummy.nbytes and dummy.buswidth may be zero. By not checking
the later, it is possible to trigger division by zero and a crash.
This does happen with tiny SPI NOR framework in SPL. Fix this by
adding the check and returning zero dummy bytes in such a case.
Fixes: 38b0852b0e ("spi: cadence-qspi: Add support for octal DTR flashes")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Vignesh R <vigneshr@ti.com>
Cc: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
[trini: Drop Pratyush's RB as his requested changes weren't made as
Marek disagreed]
This allows to use the watchdog in custom scripts but does not enforce
that the OS has to support it as well.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
To avoid the need of extra boot scripting on AM65x for loading a
watchdog firmware, add the required rproc init and loading logic for the
first R5F core to the watchdog start handler. In case the R5F cluster is
in lock-step mode, also initialize the second core. The firmware itself
is embedded into U-Boot binary to ease access to it and ensure it is
properly hashed in case of secure boot.
One possible firmware source is https://github.com/siemens/k3-rti-wdt.
The board is responsible for providing the firmware as additional
loadable via the U-Boot fit image. The driver will pick up its location
from /fit-images/k3-rti-wdt-firmware then.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
This adds support for the IOT2050 Basic and Advanced devices. The Basic
used the dual-core AM6528 GP processor, the Advanced one the AM6548 HS
quad-core version.
Both variants are booted via a Siemens-provided FSBL that runs on the R5
cores. Consequently, U-Boot support is targeting the A53 cores. U-Boot
SPL, ATF and TEE have to reside in SPI flash.
Full integration into a bootable image can be found on
https://github.com/siemens/meta-iot2050
Based on original board support by Le Jin, Gao Nian and Chao Zeng.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Prepares for the addition of the IOT2050 board which is based on the TI
AM65x. The board comes in four variants, Basic and Advanced, each as
product generation 1 (SR1.0) and 2 (SR2.x), so there are separate dts
files needed. Furthermore, the SPL has its own device tree.
Based on original board support by Le Jin, Gao Nian and Chao Zeng.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The function prototype for ft_pci_setup is inside fdt_support.h, we need
to include that header.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid W=1 build warnings, declare this function as static, since it
is not used outside of this translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To avoid a build warning with W=1, provide a function prototype for
dm_pciauto_prescan_setup_bridge, which is a non-static function whose
definition is inside pci_auto.c.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The weak definition of pci_skip_dev from drivers/pci/pci_common.c is not
under CONFIG_DM_PCI_COMPAT, and that definition needs a previous
function prototype declaration to avoid W=1 build warnings.
That prototype is not available due to it being under CONFIG_DM_PCI_COMPAT,
so move it outside of that preprocessor block.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Writing of individual registers was not functioning
correctly as a 0 'offset' byte under DM-managed
I2C was being appended in front of register we
wanted to access.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
The RX8025/RX8035 does not like having it's time registers
set byte-by-byte in separate I2C transactions.
From the note at the top of the file, it appears
target-dependent workarounds have been used in the
past for this.
Resolve this by setting the time registers in a single
I2C transaction.
As part of this, also ensure the '24/12' flag in the RTC
is reset before writing the date (instead of after), otherwise
the RX8035 will clear the seconds and minutes registers.
Tested on Traverse Ten64 (NXP LS1088A) with RX8035.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
The RX8035 is a newer model from EPSON which is
very similar in operation to the RX8025.
The changes mirror similar ones that will be
in Linux 5.15:
https://lore.kernel.org/all/20210709044518.28769-2-matt@traverse.com.au/
The UBOOT_DRIVER ID has also been corrected, previously
it declared itself as rx8010sj_rtc which is a different driver.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
A search of the tree showed there is only one user
of this driver (soon to be two) - board/socrates
The second user will be the Traverse Ten64 board.
Both these boards have DM_RTC.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
The WDT devices described in the general .dtsi file
should be marked as "disabled" by default.
A WDT should be then enabled in the board specific
.dts file on demands.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
This resyncs the dts files for all of the currently in-tree K3
platforms, along with relevant bindings, with the v5.14 Linux Kernel
release. Of note are that the main-navss/mcu-navss nodes were renamed
to main_navss / mcu_navss and so the u-boot.dtsi files needed to be
updated to match.
Tested on j721e_evm and am65x_evm.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Remove the last non-CONFIG_DM boards, and their related unused code.
- Finish a few partial migrations to Kconfig, and remove some redundant
serial related code.
We enforce that DM_SERIAL will have SYS_MALLOC_F enabled and so
SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN will have a value. Remove the build-time check.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
A number of platforms are still defining CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE to
the fallback default of "{ 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 }", but
with varying whitespace, or were introduced after the default fallback
was added. Use the default table here.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is the last ARCH_MX25 platform, remove those
references as well.
Cc: Matthias Weisser <weisserm@arcor.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is the last armada100 platform, remove that support
as well.
Cc: Prafulla Wadaskar <prafulla@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is the last mx35 platform, remove that support as
well.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Add Pali and Marek as another authors of the kwboot utility.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Change kwboot_img_patch() to avoid code repetition of setting errno to
EINVAL.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The kwboot utility does not handle EAGAIN / EBUSY errors, it expects
blocking mode on tty - it uses select() to check if data is available.
Disable non-blocking mode by clearing O_NDELAY flag which was set by
open().
We can't just take O_NDELAY from open(), because it is required there
until the CLOCAL flag is set on the tty.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Function kwboot_tty_recv() has its own handling of read timeout, we
don't need to do set it in tty settings.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Retrieve current terminal settings via tcgetattr(), set to raw mode with
cfmakeraw(), enable receiver via CREAD and ignore modem control lines
via CLOCAL.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The tcsetattr() function can return 0 even if baudrate was not changed.
Check whether baudrate was changed to requested value, and in case of
arbitrary baudrate, check whether the set value is within 3% tolerance.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The A38x platform supports more baudrates than just those defined by the
Bn constants, and some of them are higher than the highest Bn baudrate
(the highest is 4 MBd while A38x support 5.15 MBd).
On Linux, add support for arbitrary baudrates. (Since there is no
standard POSIX API to specify arbitrary baudrate for a tty device, this
change is Linux-specific.)
We need to use raw TCGETS2/TCSETS2 or TCGETS/TCSETS ioctls with the
BOTHER flag in struct termios2/termios, defined in Linux headers
<asm/ioctls.h> (included by <sys/ioctl.h>) and <asm/termbits.h>. Since
these headers conflict with glibc's header file <termios.h>, it is not
possible to use libc's termios functions and we need to reimplement them
via ioctl() calls.
Note that the Bnnn constants from <termios.h> need not be compatible
with Bnnn constants from <asm/termbits.h>.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ termios macros rewritten to static inline functions (for type control)
and moved to tools/termios_linux.h ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add support for uploading the boot image (the data part only) at higher
baudrate than the standard one.
The kwboot utility already has -B option, but choosing other baudrate
than the standard one (115200 Bd) can only work for debug mode, not for
booting the device. The BootROM for kwboot supported platforms (Orion,
Kirkwood, Dove, Discovery, AXP, A37x, A38x, A39x) cannot change the
baudrate when uploading boot image via the Xmodem protocol, nor can it
be configured via strapping pins.
So instead we add this support by injecting baudrate changing code into
the kwbimage v1 header as a new optional binary extension. This code is
executed by BootROM after it receives the whole header. The code sends
the magic string "$baudratechange\0" just before changing the baudrate
to let kwboot know that it should also change it. This is because the
injected code is run as the last binary extension, and we do not want
to loose possible output from other possible binary extensions that
came before it (in most cases this is U-Boot SPL).
We also inject the code before the payload (the data part of the image),
to change the baudrate back to the standard value, in case the payload
does not reset UART.
This change improves boot time via UART significantly (depending on the
chosen baudrate), which is very useful when debugging.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ major refactor ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Explicitly check the image size against size of struct main_hdr_v1.
This way the check is more readable, since the `hdrsz` variable
may semantically contain another value.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The beginning of image data must be sent in a separate xmodem block;
the block must not contain end of header with the beginning of data.
Therefore we need to ensure that the image header size is a multiple of
xmodem block size (which is 128 B).
Read the file into a malloc()ed buffer of enough size instead of
mmap()ing it. (If we are going to move the data, most of the pages will
be dirty anyway.) Then move the payload if header size needs to be
increased.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These structures are relevant for several other platforms, mention them
all.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add functions kwbheader_size() and kwbheader_size_for_csum().
Refactor code determining header size to use these functions.
Refactor header checksum determining function.
Remove stuff that is not needed anymore.
This simplifies the code a little and fixes one instance of validating
header size meant for checksum instead of whole header size.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Rename this function to kwbimage_version() and don't cast argument if
not needed.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
SPI/NOR kwbimage may have destination address set to 0xFFFFFFFF, which
means that the image is not downloaded to DDR but rather it is executed
directly from SPI/NOR. In this case execution address is set to SPI/NOR
area.
When patching image to UART type, change destination and execution
addresses from SPI/NOR XIP area to DDR area 0x00800000 (which is default
for A38x).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Some image types have source address in non-bytes unit; for example for
SATA images, it is in 512 B units.
We need to multiply by unit size when patching image type to UART.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
It is not possible to modify image with secure header due to
cryptographic signature.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Create macro
for_each_opt_hdr_v1
and functions
opt_hdr_v1_size(),
opt_hdr_v1_valid_size(),
opt_hdr_v1_ext(),
opt_hdr_v1_first() and
opt_hdr_v1_next()
to simplify iteration over version 1 optional headers.
This prevents ugly code repetition and makes it nicer to read.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The kwboot_img_patch_hdr() function already decides if header patching
is needed. Always call this function and deprecate the unneeded command
line option `-p`.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After kwboot sends EOT, BootROM sends back ACK. Add code for handling
this and retry sending EOT on error.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently if BootROM fails to respond with ACK/NAK to a xmodem block, we
will be waiting indefinitely for such response.
Make sure that we only wait at most 1 second (blk_rsp_timeo) for ACK/NAK
for each block in case non-xmodem text output is not being expected.
Interpret this timeout expiration as NAK, to try to send the block
again.
On the other hand, if timeout expires without ACK while some non-xmodem
output was already received (DDR training output, for example), we know
that the block was received, since the code is being executed, so in
this case exit with ETIMEDOUT.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When executing header code (which contains U-Boot SPL in most cases),
wait 10s after every non-xmodem character received (i.e. printed by
U-Boot SPL) before timing out.
Sometimes DDR training, which runs in SPL, may be slow.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There is no separation between output from the code from binary header
(U-Boot SPL in most cases) and subsequent kwboot output.
Print '\n' to make distinguishing these two easier.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When sending image header / image data, BootROM does not send any
non-xmodem text output. We should therefore interpret unknown bytes in
the xmodem protocol as errors and resend current packet. This should
improve the transfer in case there are errors on the UART line.
Text output from BootROM may only happen after whole image header is
sent and before ACK for the last packet of image header is received.
In this case BootROM may execute code from the image, which may interact
with UART (U-Boot SPL, for example, prints stuff on UART).
Print received non-xmodem output from BootROM only in this case.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored & simplified ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This is a non-functional change that should make the code more readable.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This change is required to implement other features in kwboot.
Split sending header and data parts of the image into two stages.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[ refactored ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When progress was not completed, current terminal position is in progress
bar. So print newline before printing error message to make error message
more readable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Ensure that `pos` is still in range up to the `width` so printing 100%
works also for bigger images. After printing 100% progress reset it to
zero, so that next progressbar can be started.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The compiler complains that we are comparing int with size_t when
compiled with -W.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function kwboot_xm_makeblock() always returns length of xmodem block. It
is always non-negative and calculated from variable with size_t type. Set
return type of this function to size_t and remove dead code which checks
for negative value.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When kwboot_tty_recv() fails or times out, it does not set the `c`
variable to NAK. The variable is then compared, while it holds either
an undefined value or a value from previous iteration. Set `c` to NAK so
that the other side will try to resend current block, and remove the
now unnecessary break.
In other failure cases return immediately.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Print kwboot's (U-Boot's) version when printing usage.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are 3 instances in kwboot.c where we need to write() a given
buffer whole (iteratively writing until all data are written), and 2 of
those instances are wrong, for they do not increment the buffer pointer.
Refactor the code into a new function kwboot_write() where it is fixed.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The `in` variable is set to -1 in kwboot_terminal() if stdin is not a
tty. In this case we should not look whether -1 is set in fd_set, for it
can lead to a buffer overflow, which can be reproduced with
echo "xyz" | ./tools/kwboot -t /dev/ttyUSB0
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
On 32-bit ARM the compiler complains:
tools/kwbimage.c:547: warning: format ‘%lu’ expects argument of type
‘long unsigned int’, but argument 4 has
type ‘unsigned int’
Fix this by using %zu instead of %lu format specifier.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Rebuild our current docker image so that ca-certificates will be updated
and Let's Encrypt issued certificates will work again.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Rebuild our current docker image so that ca-certificates will be updated
and Let's Encrypt issued certificates will work again.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Xilinx changes for v2022.01-rc1
zynq:
- Enable capsule update for qspi and mmc
- Update zed DT qspi compatible string
zynqmp:
- Add missing modeboot for EMMC
- Add missing nand DT properties
- List all eeproms for SC on vck190
- Add vck190 SC psu_init
clk:
- Handle only GATE type clock for Versal
watchdog:
- Update versal driver to handle system reset
Existing driver uses generic watchdog mode which generates a signal to
PLM firmware, but the signal cannot be used to reset the system.
Change driver to use window watchdog basic mode. This window watchdog mode
generates a signal to PLM firmware which decides what action to take upon
expiry of watchdog.
Timeout value for xlnx_wwdt_start will come in milli seconds from wdt
framework. Make changes to load count value accordingly.
Add checks before loading the timer for min and max possible values.
Fix authour email id of Ashok Reddy Soma to long email id.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/1632808919-8600-2-git-send-email-ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Generate dfu_alt_info setup at runtime for capsule update.
Enabling this feature will help with upgrading boards without remembering
what is where.
The similar change was done for ZynqMP by commit b86f43de0b ("xilinx:
zynqmp: Add support for runtime dfu_alt_info setup").
Code needs to be enabled by CONFIG_SET_DFU_ALT_INFO.
And also enable capsule on disk for RAW firmware images with efidebug
command.
Two indexes are supported for SPL flow. Images can be generated like:
./tools/mkeficapsule --raw spl/boot.bin --index 1 capsule1.bin
./tools/mkeficapsule --raw u-boot.img --index 2 capsule2.bin
Then place them to SD card and load them:
load mmc 0 10000000 capsule1.bin && efidebug capsule update -v 10000000
load mmc 0 10000000 capsule2.bin && efidebug capsule update -v 10000000
FSBL flow will also work where only index 1 capsule is used. There
should be enough space for using boot.bin with bitstream too.
Zynq also support multiple boot locations in SPI or MMC but it is not wired
by this patch.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/bea5fc75a87a5971f118b46bab4aa7ca39a629c6.1630061610.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
XHCI firmware upload must be performed only once after initializing the
PCI bridge. This fixes USB stack initialization after calling "usb stop;
usb start" on Raspberry Pi 4B.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenz@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The @suse.de address doesn't exist anymore. Update it to something not
dependent on my workplace.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenz@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
During the migration to a single DTSI for the CP110-s specific pinctrl
compatibles were moved to the SoC DTSI as CP0 and CP1 have some specifics.
Namely, CP0 eMMC/SDIO support depends on the mvebu-pinctrl driver setting
the BIT(0) in eMMC PHY IO Control 0 Register to 0 in order for the connect
the eMMC/SDIO PHY to the controller and not use it as a MPP pin multiplexor.
So, the mvebu-pinctrl driver check specifically for the
"marvell,armada-8k-cpm-pinctrl" compatible to clear the that bit.
Issue is that compatibles in the 8040 DTSI were set to "marvell,8k-cpm-pinctrl"
for CP0 and "marvell,8k-cps-pinctrl" for the CP1.
This is obviously incorrect as the pinctrl driver does not know about these.
So fix the regression by applying correct compatibles to the DTSI.
Regression found and tested on the Puzzle M801 board.
Fixes: a0ba97e5 ("arm: armada: dts: Use a single dtsi for cp110 die description")
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
i2c changes for 20210928-for-next
- i2c: rcar_i2c: Enable configuring SCL rise and fall times
- i2c: mvtwsi: Add support for DM clocks and resets
- mtd: nand: raw: convert nand_dt_init() to ofnode_xx() interface
- Reintroduce creating internally the "nor%d" style names, in order to
fix some use U-Boot use-cases involving the "mtd" command.
- Fix a regression over the default SPI bus mode shown by having the
compiled default actually start being used. The correct default here
is 0.
- Fix ethernet on imx7d-sdb
- Fix a regression with MTD NAND devices when OF_LIVE is enabled
Commit 0d52bab46 (mx7dsabre: Enable DM_ETH) changed these flags from 0
(aka GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH) to GPIO_ACTIVE_LOW. It claimed to "Also sync
device tree with v5.5-rc1", but in the linux tree, these gpios have
always been GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH ever since this node was introduced
around v4.13 (linux commit 184f39b5).
I'm guessing that the reason for the GPIO_ACTIVE_LOW was to work
around the behaviour of the soft-spi driver back then, which
effectively defaulted to spi-mode 3 and not 0. That was arguably a bug
in the soft-spi driver, which then got fixed in 0e146993bb (spi: add
support for all spi modes with soft spi), but that commit then broke
ethernet on this board.
Fix it by setting the gpios as active high, which as a bonus actually
brings us in sync with the .dts in the linux source tree.
Without this, one gets
Net: Could not get PHY for FEC0: addr 0
No ethernet found.
With this, ethernet (at least ping and tftp) works as expected from
the U-Boot shell.
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Joris Offouga <offougajoris@gmail.com>
Cc: "Christian Bräuner Sørensen" <yocto@bsorensen.net>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
nand_dt_init() is still using fdtdec_xx() interface.
If OF_LIVE flag is enabled, dt property can't be get anymore.
Updating all fdtdec_xx() interface to ofnode_xx() to solve this issue.
For doing this, node parameter type must be ofnode.
First idea was to convert "node" parameter to ofnode type inside
nand_dt_init() using offset_to_ofnode(node). But offset_to_ofnode()
is not bijective, in case OF_LIVE flag is enabled, it performs an assert().
So, this leads to update nand_chip struct flash_node field from int to
ofnode and to update all nand_dt_init() callers.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Force the mtd name of spi-nor to "nor" + the driver sequence number:
"nor0", "nor1"... beginning after the existing nor devices.
This patch is coherent with existing "nand" and "spi-nand"
mtd device names.
When CFI MTD NOR device are supported, the spi-nor index is chosen after
the last CFI device defined by CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS.
When CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT is activated, this config
is replaced by to cfi_flash_num_flash_banks in the include file
mtd/cfi_flash.h.
This generic name "nor%d" can be use to identify the mtd spi-nor device
without knowing the real device name or the DT path of the device,
used with API get_mtd_device_nm() and is used in mtdparts command.
This patch also avoids issue when the same NOR device is present 2 times,
for example on STM32MP15F-EV1:
STM32MP> mtd list
SF: Detected mx66l51235l with page size 256 Bytes, erase size 64 KiB, \
total 64 MiB
List of MTD devices:
* nand0
- type: NAND flash
- block size: 0x40000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1000 bytes
- OOB size: 224 bytes
- OOB available: 118 bytes
- ECC strength: 8 bits
- ECC step size: 512 bytes
- bitflip threshold: 6 bits
- 0x000000000000-0x000040000000 : "nand0"
* mx66l51235l
- device: mx66l51235l@0
- parent: spi@58003000
- driver: jedec_spi_nor
- path: /soc/spi@58003000/mx66l51235l@0
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x10000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000004000000 : "mx66l51235l"
* mx66l51235l
- device: mx66l51235l@1
- parent: spi@58003000
- driver: jedec_spi_nor
- path: /soc/spi@58003000/mx66l51235l@1
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x10000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000004000000 : "mx66l51235l"
The same mtd name "mx66l51235l" identify the 2 instances
mx66l51235l@0 and mx66l51235l@1.
This patch fixes a ST32CubeProgrammer / stm32prog command issue
with nor0 target on STM32MP157C-EV1 board introduced by
commit b7f060565e ("mtd: spi-nor: allow registering multiple MTDs when
DM is enabled").
Fixes: b7f060565e ("mtd: spi-nor: allow registering multiple MTDs when DM is enabled")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
[trini: Add <dm/device.h> to <mtd.h> for DM_MAX_SEQ_STR]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When mdio_register fails, mdio_free should be called on the mdiodev that
was previously allocated with mdio_alloc.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
If mdio_register fails, it is nice to not leave behind dangling
allocated memory.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass DSA_PORT_NAME_LENGTH - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
These functions can return errors, it's best to catch them and trigger
the driver unwind code path.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
dm_mdio_post_probe used to be vulnerable after truncation, but has been
patched by commit 398e7512d8 ("net: Fix Covarity Defect 244093").
Nonetheless, we can use strlcpy like the rest of the code base now,
which yields the same result.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
strncpy() simply bails out when copying a source string whose size
exceeds the destination string size, potentially leaving the destination
string unterminated.
One possible way to address is to pass MDIO_NAME_LEN - 1 and a
previously zero-initialized destination string, but this is more
difficult to maintain.
The chosen alternative is to use strlcpy(), which properly limits the
copy len in the (srclen >= size) case to "size - 1", and which is also
more efficient than the strncpy() byte-by-byte implementation by using
memcpy. The destination string returned by strlcpy() is always NULL
terminated.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Currently the init_phy function may overwrite the priv->interface
property, since it calls tsec_get_interface which tries to determine it
dynamically based on default register values in ECNTRL.
Let's do that only if phy-connection-type happens to not be defined in
the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The felix driver runs only on NXP LS1028A, which most definitely does
not support the parallel 10G interface, just USXGMII, and that only up
to 2.5Gbps (toned down from 10 Gbps via symbol replication).
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The enetc driver runs only on NXP LS1028A, which most definitely does
not support the parallel 10G interface, just USXGMII, and that only up
to 2.5Gbps (toned down from 10 Gbps via symbol replication).
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
After the discussion here:
https://lore.kernel.org/netdev/20210603143453.if7hgifupx5k433b@pali/
which resulted in this patch:
https://patchwork.kernel.org/project/netdevbpf/patch/20210704134325.24842-1-pali@kernel.org/
and many other discussions before it, notably:
https://patchwork.kernel.org/project/linux-arm-kernel/patch/1512016235-15909-1-git-send-email-Bhaskar.Upadhaya@nxp.com/
it became apparent that nobody really knows what "SGMII 2500" is.
Certainly, Freescale/NXP hardware engineers name this protocol
"SGMII 2500" in the reference manuals, but the PCS devices do not
support any "SGMII" specific features when operating at the speed of
2500 Mbps, no in-band autoneg and no speed change via symbol replication
. So that leaves a fixed speed of 2500 Mbps using a coding of 8b/10b
with a SERDES lane frequency of 3.125 GHz. In fact, "SGMII 2500 without
in-band autoneg and at a fixed speed" is indistinguishable from
"2500base-x without in-band autoneg", which is precisely what these NXP
devices support.
So it just appears that "SGMII 2500" is an unclear name with no clear
definition that stuck.
As such, in the Linux kernel, the drivers which use this SERDES protocol
use the 2500base-x phy-mode.
This patch converts U-Boot to use 2500base-x too, or at least, as much
as it can.
Note that I would have really liked to delete PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_SGMII_2500
completely, but the mvpp2 driver seems to even distinguish between SGMII
2500 and 2500base-X. Namely, it enables in-band autoneg for one but not
the other, and forces flow control for one but not the other. This goes
back to the idea that maybe 2500base-X is a fiber protocol and SGMII-2500
is an MII protocol (connects a MAC to a PHY such as Aquantia), but the
two are practically indistinguishable through everything except use case.
NXP devices can support both use cases through an identical configuration,
for example RX flow control can be unconditionally enabled in order to
support rate adaptation performed by an Aquantia PHY. At least I can
find no indication in online documents published by Cisco which would
point towards "SGMII-2500" being an actual standard with an actual
definition, so I cannot say "yes, NXP devices support it".
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
To avoid a warning with W=1 about this function not having a previous
prototype, declare it as static, because it is not used outside of this
translation module.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
"dev" and "dsa_pdata" are unused inside dsa_port_of_to_pdata.
"dsa_priv" is unused inside dsa_port_probe.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
While adding the logic for DSA to register a fixed-link PHY for the CPU
port, I forgot to pass it to the .port_disable method too, just
.port_enable.
Bug had no impact for felix_switch.c, due to the phy argument not being
used, but ksz9477.c does use it => NULL pointer dereference.
Fixes: fc054d563b ("net: Introduce DSA class for Ethernet switches")
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
NXP Legal insists that the following are not fine:
- Saying "NXP Semiconductors" instead of "NXP", since the company's
registered name is "NXP"
- Putting a "(c)" sign in the copyright string
- Putting a comma in the copyright string
The only accepted copyright string format is "Copyright <year-range> NXP".
This patch changes the copyright headers in the networking files that
were sent by me, or derived from code sent by me.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Make sure that the link status returned by phy_startup() is propagated
to the .start() method of struct eth_ops.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
It is an unfortunate reality that some PHY settings done by U-Boot
persist even after the PHY is reset and taken over by Linux, and even
more unfortunate that Linux has come to depend on things being set in a
certain way.
For example, on the NXP LS1028A-RDB, the felix switch ports are
connected to a VSC8514 QSGMII PHY. Between the switch port PCS and the
PHY, the U-Boot drivers enable in-band auto-negotiation which makes the
copper-side negotiated speed and duplex be transmitted from the PHY to
the MAC automatically.
The PHY driver portion that does this is in vsc8514_config():
/* Enable Serdes Auto-negotiation */
phy_write(phydev, MDIO_DEVAD_NONE, PHY_EXT_PAGE_ACCESS,
PHY_EXT_PAGE_ACCESS_EXTENDED3);
val = phy_read(phydev, MDIO_DEVAD_NONE, MIIM_VSC8514_MAC_SERDES_CON);
val = val | MIIM_VSC8574_MAC_SERDES_ANEG;
phy_write(phydev, MDIO_DEVAD_NONE, MIIM_VSC8514_MAC_SERDES_CON, val);
The point is that in-band autoneg should be turned on in both the PHY
and the MAC, or off in both the PHY and the MAC, otherwise the QSGMII
link will be broken.
And because phy_config() is currently called at .port_enable() time, the
result is that ports on which traffic has been sent in U-Boot will have
in-band autoneg enabled, and the rest won't.
It can be argued that the Linux kernel should not assume one way or
another and just reinitialize everything according to what it expects,
and that is completely fair. In fact, I've already started an attempt to
remove this dependency, although admittedly I am making slow progress at
it:
https://patchwork.kernel.org/project/netdevbpf/cover/20210212172341.3489046-1-olteanv@gmail.com/
Nonetheless, the sad reality is that NXP also has, apart from kernel
drivers, some user space networking (DPDK), and for some reason, the
expectation there is that somebody else initializes the PHYs. The kernel
can't do it because the device ownership doesn't belong to the kernel,
so what remains is for the bootloader to do it (especially since other
drivers generally call phy_config() at probe time). This is a really
weak guarantee that might break at any time, but apparently that is
enough for some.
Since initializing the ports and PHYs at probe time does not break
anything, we can just do that.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Some drivers might want to execute code for each port at probe time, as
opposed to executing code just-in-time for the port selected for
networking.
To cater to that use case, introduce a .port_probe() callback method
into the DSA switch operations which is called for each available port,
at the end of dsa_port_probe().
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
This snippet of code has a bothering "if (...) return 0" in it which
assumes it is the last piece of code running in dsa_port_probe().
This makes it difficult to add further code at the end of dsa_port_probe()
which does not depend on MAC address stuff.
So move the code to a dedicated function which returns void and let the
code flow through.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Non DM builds fail with the following error:
drivers/net/tsec.c:641:24: error: 'tsec_get_interface' defined but not used [-Werror=unused-function]
641 | static phy_interface_t tsec_get_interface(struct tsec_private *priv)
Fix that.
Signed-off-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
In commit b24bb99d cp110 configuration initially done in u-boot
was removed and delegated to atf firmware as smc call.
That commit didn't account for later introduced in d13b740c SATA invert polarity support.
This patch adds support of passing SATA invert polarity flags to atf
firmware during the smc call.
Signed-off-by: Denis Odintsov <shiva@mail.ru>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Cc: Rabeeh Khoury <rabeeh@solid-run.com>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After getting MTD device via get_mtd_device_nm(), we need to put it with
put_mtd_device(), otherwise we get
Removing MTD device #0 (mx25l6405d) with use count 1
before booting kernel.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
TCG EFI Protocol Specification defines the number_of_algorithms
field in spec ID event to be equal to the number of active
algorithms supported by the TPM device. In current implementation,
this field is populated with the count of all algorithms supported
by the TPM which leads to incorrect spec ID event creation.
Similarly, the algorithm array in spec ID event should be a variable
length array with length being equal to the number_of_algorithms field.
In current implementation this is defined as a fixed length array
which has been fixed.
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@linaro.org>
CC: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The devicetree binding files are in their own directory and use a simple
text format. Add a link for the binding for the /config node, since it
is otherwise hard to find.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Since Albert Aribaud is not maintaining anymore the LaCie Ethernet Disk
mini V2 board, then I am taking over.
Signed-off-by: Simon Guinot <simon.guinot@sequanux.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remove the driver st_smic.c used in SPEAr products and the associated
config CONFIG_ST_SMI; this driver is no more used in U-Boot after the
commit 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr
support").
Fixes: 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
I am taking over responsibility for the GE board from Sebastian Reichel.
Updating the MAINTAINERS files to reflect this.
Signed-off-by: Martyn Welch <martyn.welch@collabora.com>
Acked-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
As the lastest spear directories are removed, delete the associated entry
in the MAINTAINERS file:
- arch/arm/cpu/arm926ejs/spear/
- arch/arm/include/asm/arch-spear/
Fixes: 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Output like the following is quite irritating:
=> bootefi hello
Scanning disk mmc2.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Scanning disk mmc1.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Scanning disk mmc0.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Albeit a whole disk may be formatted with a filesystem in most cases
a partition table is used and the whole disk (partition number 0) doesn't
contain a filesytem. Some partitions may only contain a blob. Not seeing a
filesytem on the whole disk or on any partition is only worth a debug
message.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Our mailmapper script required Python 2 which is no longer maintained.
A main difference when converting to Python 3 is that byte strings are not
character strings. So add conversion and skip over conversion errors.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tpm test cases relies on tpm device setup. Provide an environment
variable "env__tpm_device_test_skip = True" to skip the test case
if tpm device is not present.
Only needed will have to add variable to the py-test framework.
Test runs successfully even this variable is absent.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The KBUILD_BASENAME contains just the name of the compiled module,
in this case 'sequencer', rather than a full path to the compiled
file. Use it to prevent pulling the full path into the U-Boot binary,
which is useless and annoying.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
The SPI NOR bus mode is 0 on this system, update it accordingly.
Increase frequency to 40 MHz and enable SFDP parsing, since the
flashes on this system support that and it is a huge performance
improvement.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
This adds support for the DWC_sub31 controllers such as those
found on Apple's M1 SoC. This version of the controller
seems to work fine with the existing driver.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Allow using different PHY interfaces for multiple USB controllers. When no
value is set in DT, we fall back to CONFIG_MXC_USB_PORTSC for now to stay
compatible with current board configurations.
This also adds support for the HSIC mode of the i.MX7.
Signed-off-by: Markus Niebel <Markus.Niebel@ew.tq-group.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
The MXC_EHCI_MODE_ definitions are redundant. Replace MXC_EHCI_MODE_SERIAL
with the equivalent PORT_PTS_SERIAL.
Only the zmx25 platform is affected.
Signed-off-by: Markus Niebel <Markus.Niebel@ew.tq-group.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Pine H64 and Orange Pi 3 both provide a USB3 type A port.
Enable it in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Some platforms, like the Allwinner H6, do not have a separate glue layer
around the dwc3. Instead, they rely on the clocks/resets/phys referenced
from the dwc3 DT node itself. Add support for enabling the clocks/resets
referenced from the dwc3 DT node.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Resetting an XHCI controller inside xhci_register undoes any register
setup performed by the platform driver. And at least on the Allwinner
H6, resetting the XHCI controller also resets the PHY, which prevents
the controller from working. That means the controller must be taken out
of reset before initializing the PHY, which must be done before calling
xhci_register.
The logic in the XHCI core was added to support the Raspberry Pi 4
(although this was not mentioned in the commit log!), which uses the
xhci-pci platform driver. Move the reset logic to the platform driver,
where it belongs, and where it cannot interfere with other platform
drivers.
This also fixes a failure to call reset_free if xhci_register failed.
Fixes: 0b80371b35 ("usb: xhci: Add reset controller support")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This driver is needed for XHCI to work on the Allwinner H6 SoC. The
driver is copied from Linux v5.10.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT is activated,
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS is replaced by cfi_flash_num_flash_banks,
but this variable is defined in drivers/mtd/cfi_flash.c, which is
compiled only when CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER is activated, in U-Boot
or in SPL when CONFIG_SPL_MTD_SUPPORT is activated.
This patch deactivates this feature CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT
when flash cfi driver is not activated to avoid compilation issue in
the next patch, when CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS is used in spi_nor_scan().
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
nand_dt_init() is still using fdtdec_xx() interface.
If OF_LIVE flag is enabled, dt property can't be get anymore.
Updating all fdtdec_xx() interface to ofnode_xx() to solve this issue.
For doing this, node parameter type must be ofnode.
First idea was to convert "node" parameter to ofnode type inside
nand_dt_init() using offset_to_ofnode(node). But offset_to_ofnode()
is not bijective, in case OF_LIVE flag is enabled, it performs an assert().
So, this leads to update nand_chip struct flash_node field from int to
ofnode and to update all nand_dt_init() callers.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The controller may need to have clocks/resets enabled for it to work.
Add support for this. Since the clocks/resets are optional on some
platforms (per the device tree binding), do not prevent probing the
controller if they are missing.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
The Linux i2c driver supports i2c-scl-rising-time-ns,
and i2c-scl-falling-time-ns, but U-Boot uses hard-coded values
for these values.
Update the calculation by fetching them from the device tree if
present and use the previous values as the default if they are
missing.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
We have individual SOC symbols for each keystone 2 platform. Use the
existing CONFIG_ARCH_KEYSTONE rather than CONFIG_SOC_KEYSTONE to
encompass all of the keystone families.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_OMAP_EHCI_PHY1_RESET_GPIO
CONFIG_OMAP_EHCI_PHY2_RESET_GPIO
CONFIG_OMAP_EHCI_PHY3_RESET_GPIO
To do this, we also introduce CONFIG_HAS_CONFIG_OMAP_EHCI_PHYn_RESET_GPIO
options to get setting the GPIO number.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
We have one places that uses this symbol and CONFIG_TARGET_OMAPL138_LCDK
works equally well, switch to that.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Move the main option for handling drivers/dma/keystone_nav* to Kconfig,
and enable it by default. All of the sub-symbols are not configurable,
so remove them from the CONFIG namespace.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The COFNIG_KEYSTONE_RBL_NAND option is always enabled for the driver on
keystone platforms, but not older davinci platforms. Use def_bool for
the symbol. For CONFIG_KEYSTONE_NAND_MAX_RBL_PAGE, it's only used within
the driver and derived from another symbol, so remove CONFIG from the
name. Finally, CONFIG_KEYSTONE_NAND_MAX_RBL_SIZE is a bit more fixed.
For now, use the value directly. Long term, as part of DM'ifying NAND,
this should come from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Since cm_t35 was removed, CONFIG_CM_T3X does not exist. This lets us
simplify the code in board/compulab/common/eeprom.c a bit.
Cc: Igor Grinberg <grinberg@compulab.co.il>
Cc: Nikita Kiryanov <nikita@compulab.co.il>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At this point in time, all platforms that had previously used
drivers/usb/phy/omap_usb_phy.c have been migrated to DM and related
options. Remove this now unused code and some related unused defines.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This is only used in the aemif driver that is otherwise currently
keystone2 centric. Moving forward, if this is applicable to some other
platform then such base addresses should be able to be obtained via the
device tree. Use KS2_AEMIF_CNTRL_BASE directly now rather than
indirectly.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- At this point there are a large number of Beaglebone boards, refer to
them as a family rather than a growing list.
- Reword customization as we're largely Kconfig-oriented now.
- Remove the NOR section as the relevant defconfigs have long been
removed and the general support was not updated.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In commit b24bb99d cp110 configuration initially done in u-boot
was removed and delegated to atf firmware as smc call.
That commit didn't account for later introduced in d13b740c SATA invert polarity support.
This patch adds support of passing SATA invert polarity flags to atf
firmware during the smc call.
Signed-off-by: Denis Odintsov <shiva@mail.ru>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Cc: Rabeeh Khoury <rabeeh@solid-run.com>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After getting MTD device via get_mtd_device_nm(), we need to put it with
put_mtd_device(), otherwise we get
Removing MTD device #0 (mx25l6405d) with use count 1
before booting kernel.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are two duplicated declarations for ft_cpu_setup() and
ft_pci_setup().
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Some PCIe controller's read_config() method support indicating error
directly via return value, but some cannot distinguish all-ones (or
all-zeros) read response from an error.
The current code in pci_bind_bus_devices() interprets all-ones /
all-zeros in PCI_VENDOR_ID register as "nothing connected", and
continues the cycle, but an error returned via return value breaks the
cycle.
This is wrong for the PCIe controllers which return this error via
return value.
Handle all errors when reading PCI_VENDOR_ID the same way.
This fixes enumeration of PCI devices for example when there is a PCI
bridge connected behind another PCI bridge and not all ports are
connected to a device, and the controller (for example Aardvark)
translates the UR error (Unsupported Request) as -EOPNOTSUPP.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The cpu nodes in arch/sandbox/dts/test.dts should conform to the devicetree
specification:
* property device_type must be set to "cpu"
* the reg property must be provided
* the cpu nodes must have an address
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for accessing GPIOs using of-plata. This uses the same
mechanism as for clocks, but allows use of the xlate() method so that
the driver can interpret the parameters.
Update the condition for GPIO_HOG so that it is not built into SPL,
since it needs SPL_OF_REAL which is not enabled in sandbox_spl.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is available but not exported. More generally it does not
really work as intended.
Reimplement it and add a sandbox test too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is actually a misnomer now, since the phandle info may contain
a driver_info index or a udevice index. Rename it to use the word
'phandle', which seems more accurate. Add a comment while we are here.
Also add a test for this function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Convert some of these occurences to C code, where it is easy to do. This
should help encourage this approach to be used in new code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that we have a 'positive' Kconfig option, use this instead of the
negative one, which is harder to understand.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The condition to indicate whether there is a runtime devicetree available
is OF_CONTROL && !OF_PLATDATA. This is a bit unweidly and is repeated in
a lot of places.
Add a new OF_REAL Kconfig which provides this information directly.
Note: This is similar in effect to LIBFDT. We might consider dropping
LIBFDT and using this instead, but this is left for now as we also have
OF_LIBFDT_OVERLAY which it would not make sense to change.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current API is outdated as it requires a devicetree pointer.
Move these functions to use the ofnode API and update this globally. Add
some tests while we are here.
Correct the call in exynos_dsim_config_parse_dt() which is obviously
wrong.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
TCG EFI Protocol Specification defines the number_of_algorithms
field in spec ID event to be equal to the number of active
algorithms supported by the TPM device. In current implementation,
this field is populated with the count of all algorithms supported
by the TPM which leads to incorrect spec ID event creation.
Similarly, the algorithm array in spec ID event should be a variable
length array with length being equal to the number_of_algorithms field.
In current implementation this is defined as a fixed length array
which has been fixed.
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@linaro.org>
CC: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The devicetree binding files are in their own directory and use a simple
text format. Add a link for the binding for the /config node, since it
is otherwise hard to find.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When printing full help output from a tool, we should be able to handle
a PAGER variable which includes arguments, e.g. PAGER='less -F'.
Signed-off-by: Paul Barker <paul.barker@sancloud.com>
Collect the code for printing the full help message of patman, buildman
and binman into a single function in patman.tools.
Signed-off-by: Paul Barker <paul.barker@sancloud.com>
vexpress_ca9x4 is seemingly the only board except for qemu_arm which
is able to run U-Boot correctly, using the `-M vexpress-a9` option to
QEMU. Building for qemu_arm and running qemu-system-arm with the `-M
virt` argument has a number of downsides, most importantly that it
only supports virtio storage drivers. This significantly reduces its
usefulness in testing memory card and Flash solutions, especially when
the tested images are from a third party source.
So therefore we reintroduce the vexpress_ca9x4 board in this commit,
with the explicit goal of using it with QEMU.
A number of differences to note from the original:
* Since the board was apparently unmaintained, I have now set myself
as the maintainer.
* The board has been converted to use the driver model, which was the
reason it was removed in the first place.
* The vexpress_ca15_tc2 and vexpress_ca5x2 boards, which were removed
in the same commit, are not necessary for the QEMU use case, and
have been omitted.
* An `mmc0` alias was introduced in the dts file. The mmc is not
detected correctly without this, now that it's based on the device
tree instead of the board's init function.
* A couple of other nodes were removed because they were problematic
when trying to run the UEFI bootmgr. Once again, the primary use
case here is QEMU, and these nodes are not needed for that to work.
* Unnecessary board init code has been removed, thanks to driver model
and device tree.
* `CONFIG_OF_EMBED` has been enabled. I know this goes against
recommended practice, but there doesn't seem to be any other way to
pass the dtb to U-Boot in the QEMU scenario. Using the -dtb argument
does not work, I suppose because U-Boot doesn't use the same
mechanics as the kernel when it's booting.
* Load addresses have been changed to fit QEMU use case.
People wanting to get a more detailed, yet somewhat isolated, diff
between this and the original, can run this command:
git diff c6c26a05b89f25a06e7562f8c2071b60fd0c9eac~1 -- \
$( git diff-tree --diff-filter=A -r --name-only HEAD~1 HEAD)
(Make sure to either check out this commit first, or replace HEAD with
the commit ID of this commit)
Signed-off-by: Kristian Amlie <kristian.amlie@northern.tech>
Simplify the bootm and the spl code by using the new config
CONFIG_SUPPORT_PASSING_ATAGS.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Since Albert Aribaud is not maintaining anymore the LaCie Ethernet Disk
mini V2 board, then I am taking over.
Signed-off-by: Simon Guinot <simon.guinot@sequanux.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remove the driver st_smic.c used in SPEAr products and the associated
config CONFIG_ST_SMI; this driver is no more used in U-Boot after the
commit 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr
support").
Fixes: 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
I am taking over responsibility for the GE board from Sebastian Reichel.
Updating the MAINTAINERS files to reflect this.
Signed-off-by: Martyn Welch <martyn.welch@collabora.com>
Acked-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
As the lastest spear directories are removed, delete the associated entry
in the MAINTAINERS file:
- arch/arm/cpu/arm926ejs/spear/
- arch/arm/include/asm/arch-spear/
Fixes: 570c3dcfc1 ("arm: Remove spear600 boards and the rest of SPEAr support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Output like the following is quite irritating:
=> bootefi hello
Scanning disk mmc2.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Scanning disk mmc1.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Scanning disk mmc0.blk...
No valid Btrfs found
Bad magic number for SquashFS image.
** Unrecognized filesystem type **
Albeit a whole disk may be formatted with a filesystem in most cases
a partition table is used and the whole disk (partition number 0) doesn't
contain a filesytem. Some partitions may only contain a blob. Not seeing a
filesytem on the whole disk or on any partition is only worth a debug
message.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Our mailmapper script required Python 2 which is no longer maintained.
A main difference when converting to Python 3 is that byte strings are not
character strings. So add conversion and skip over conversion errors.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Tpm test cases relies on tpm device setup. Provide an environment
variable "env__tpm_device_test_skip = True" to skip the test case
if tpm device is not present.
Only needed will have to add variable to the py-test framework.
Test runs successfully even this variable is absent.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This patch enables the use of the optimized memset(), memmove() &
memcpy() versions recently added on ARM64.
Please note that these optimized functions are now only enabled for
recent GCC versions (>= 9.4), as earlier GCC versions throw these
errors:
aarch64-linux-ar: warning: arch/arm/lib/memset-arm64.o: unsupported GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE (5) type: 0xc0000000
...
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
[trini: Make this default to off as it causes problems on some platforms still]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The optimized memset uses the dc opcode, which causes problems when the
cache is disabled. This patch adds a check if the cache is disabled and
uses a very simple memset implementation in this case. Otherwise the
optimized version is used.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Ported from https://github.com/ARM-software/optimized-routines
These files are included from this repository, including the latest
git commit ID:
string/aarch64/memcpy.S: afd6244a1f8d
string/aarch64/memset.S: e823e3abf5f8
string/asmdefs.h: e823e3abf5f8
Note that memmove is also handled by the memcpy function.
Please note that when adding these optimized functions as default memset
memcpy functions in U-Boot, U-Boot fails to boot on the LX2160ARDB.
After the initial ATF output, no U-Boot output is shown on the serial
console. Some exception is triggered here in the very early boot process
as some of the assembler opcodes need the caches to be enabled.
Because of this, a follow-up patch will add a check to use a simple
non-optimized memset for the "cache disabled" case.
Note:
I also integrated and tested with the Linux versions of these optimized
functions. They are similar to the ones now integrated but these ARM
versions are still a small bit faster.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Rework lmb reservation so we have common code for all arches to use
- armv8 cache.S cleanups, crc32 speedup
- ENV_IS_NOWHWERE, pci io/memory base configuration fixes
Lower 4 bits of PCI_MEMORY_BASE and PCI_MEMORY_LIMIT registers are reserved
and should be zero. So do not set them to non-zero value.
Lower 4 bits of PCI_PREF_MEMORY_BASE and PCI_PREF_MEMORY_LIMIT registers
contain information if 64-bit memory addressing is supported. So preserve
this information when overwriting these registers.
Lower 4 bits of PCI_IO_BASE and PCI_IO_LIMIT register contain information
if 32-bit io addressing is supported. So preserve this information and do
not try to configure 32-bit io addressing (via PCI_IO_BASE_UPPER16 and
PCI_IO_LIMIT_UPPER16 registers) when it is unsupported.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
On MediaTek boards we cannot override the SYS_BOARD / SYS_CONFIG_NAME
variables from defconfig.
This is because in board/mediatek/mtXXXX/Kconfig this value was override
by default due to the if CONFIG_TARGET_MTXXXX condition.
Merge all the Kconfigs to the mach-medatek/Kconfig.
This way:
- we only define SYS_{SOC,VENDOR} once
- all board definitions are in a single place, simplifying the build logic.
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <glaroque@baylibre.com>
The arc/arm/m68k/microblaze/mips/ppc arch_lmb_reserve() implementations
are all mostly the same, except for a couple of details. Implement a
generic arch_lmb_reserve_generic() function which can be parametrized
enough to cater for those differences between architectures. This can
also be parametrized enough so it can handle cases where U-Boot is not
relocated to the end of DRAM e.g. because there is some other reserved
memory past U-Boot (e.g. unmovable firmware for coprocessor), it is not
relocated at all, and other such use cases.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Alexey Brodkin <alexey.brodkin@synopsys.com>
Cc: Angelo Dureghello <angelo@sysam.it>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Cc: Eugeniy Paltsev <Eugeniy.Paltsev@synopsys.com>
Cc: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Cc: Michal Simek <monstr@monstr.eu>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The arch_lmb_reserve() is called by lib/lmb.c lmb_reserve_common() even
if CMD_BOOTM is not enabled. However, the arc variant of arch_lmb_reserve()
is only compiled in if CMD_BOOTM is enabled.
This currently does not trigger build error, because there is an empty
weak implementation of arch_lmb_reserve(), however that is not the
function that should be used on arc.
Fix this by moving the arch_lmb_reserve() implementation into common
code and always compile it in.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The arch_lmb_reserve() is called by lib/lmb.c lmb_reserve_common() even
if CMD_BOOT{I,M,Z} is not enabled. However, the arm32/arm64 variant of
arch_lmb_reserve() is only compiled in if CMD_BOOT{I,M,Z} is enabled.
This currently does not trigger build error, because there is an empty
weak implementation of arch_lmb_reserve(), however that is not the
function that should be used on arm32/arm64.
Fix this by moving the arch_lmb_reserve() implementation into common
code and always compile it in.
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
ARMv8.0 has optional crc32 instruction for crc32 calculation. The
instruction is mandatory since ARMv8.1. The crc32 calculation is
faster using the dedicated instruction, e.g. 1.4 GHz iMX8MN gives:
=> time crc32 0x50000000 0x2000000
time: 0.126 seconds # crc32 instruction
time: 0.213 seconds # software crc32
Add implementation using the compiler builtin wrapper for the crc32
instruction and enable it by default, since we don't support any
platforms which do not implement this instruction.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Make crc32_table guarded by CONFIG_ARM64_CRC32]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Replace the current 2-instruction 2-step tripling code by a
corresponding single instruction leveraging ARMv8-A's "flexible second
operand as a register with optional shift". This has the added benefit
(albeit arguably negligible) of reducing the final code size.
Fix the comment as the tripled cache level is placed in x12, not x0.
Signed-off-by: Pierre-Clément Tosi <ptosi@google.com>
Improve the file's readability and conciseness by using the appropriate
Aarch64 instruction: ubfx (unsigned bitfield extract). This makes the
code easier to follow as it directly manipulates the offsets and widths
of the fields read from system registers, as they are expressed in the
Standard (ARM ARM). This has the added benefit (albeit arguably
negligible) of reducing the final code size.
Signed-off-by: Pierre-Clément Tosi <ptosi@google.com>
Avoid applying the "fix" introduced by commit 5557eec01c ("env: Fix
invalid env handling in env_init()") to the environment "nowhere".
This is necessary as that commit, by setting the return value of
env_init() to -ENOENT if gd->env_valid is ENV_INVALID, forces that
function to reset gd->env_valid to ENV_VALID. By doing so, it breaks the
assumption (required by ENV_IS_NOWHERE) that gd->env_valid must be
ENV_INVALID.
This, in turn, results in env_relocate() calling env_load() (it should
not), which itself, calls U_BOOT_ENV_LOCATION(nowhere).load() i.e.
env_nowhere_load(). That function, being implemented under the
assumption mentioned above, calls env_set_default(), which in turn,
seeing that gd->env_valid is ENV_VALID (it should not), tries to
dereference whatever lies in gd->env_addr (most likely garbage), leading
to a faulty memory access.
Note that other env_locations might be concerned by this bug but that
this commit only intends to fix it for when ENV_IS_NOWHERE.
Fixes: 5557eec01c ("env: Fix invalid env handling in env_init()")
Signed-off-by: Pierre-Clément Tosi <ptosi@google.com>
First set of u-boot-at91 features for the 2022.01 cycle:
This feature set includes : the support for CPU driver for arm926
(sam9x60 device); changes required for OP-TEE boot for sama5d2_xplained
and sama5d27_som1_ek boards; QSPI boot configuration for sama5d2_icp;
starting to remove old Kconfig unused symbols from config_whitelist.txt
(work will take more time); also small fixes and updates in mach, DT,
configs, etc.
The KBUILD_BASENAME contains just the name of the compiled module,
in this case 'sequencer', rather than a full path to the compiled
file. Use it to prevent pulling the full path into the U-Boot binary,
which is useless and annoying.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
The SPI NOR bus mode is 0 on this system, update it accordingly.
Increase frequency to 40 MHz and enable SFDP parsing, since the
flashes on this system support that and it is a huge performance
improvement.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
This adds support for the DWC_sub31 controllers such as those
found on Apple's M1 SoC. This version of the controller
seems to work fine with the existing driver.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Allow using different PHY interfaces for multiple USB controllers. When no
value is set in DT, we fall back to CONFIG_MXC_USB_PORTSC for now to stay
compatible with current board configurations.
This also adds support for the HSIC mode of the i.MX7.
Signed-off-by: Markus Niebel <Markus.Niebel@ew.tq-group.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
The MXC_EHCI_MODE_ definitions are redundant. Replace MXC_EHCI_MODE_SERIAL
with the equivalent PORT_PTS_SERIAL.
Only the zmx25 platform is affected.
Signed-off-by: Markus Niebel <Markus.Niebel@ew.tq-group.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
Pine H64 and Orange Pi 3 both provide a USB3 type A port.
Enable it in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Some platforms, like the Allwinner H6, do not have a separate glue layer
around the dwc3. Instead, they rely on the clocks/resets/phys referenced
from the dwc3 DT node itself. Add support for enabling the clocks/resets
referenced from the dwc3 DT node.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Resetting an XHCI controller inside xhci_register undoes any register
setup performed by the platform driver. And at least on the Allwinner
H6, resetting the XHCI controller also resets the PHY, which prevents
the controller from working. That means the controller must be taken out
of reset before initializing the PHY, which must be done before calling
xhci_register.
The logic in the XHCI core was added to support the Raspberry Pi 4
(although this was not mentioned in the commit log!), which uses the
xhci-pci platform driver. Move the reset logic to the platform driver,
where it belongs, and where it cannot interfere with other platform
drivers.
This also fixes a failure to call reset_free if xhci_register failed.
Fixes: 0b80371b35 ("usb: xhci: Add reset controller support")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This driver is needed for XHCI to work on the Allwinner H6 SoC. The
driver is copied from Linux v5.10.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Continue to use the "ssbl" name for GPT partition of secondary boot
stage = U-Boot for basic boot with SPL to avoid to disturb existing user.
The "fip" partition name is only used for TFA_BOOT with FIP, it is a TF-A
BL2 requirement; it the default configuration for STMicroelectronics
boards.
Fixes: b73e8bf453 ("arm: stm32mp: add defconfig for trusted boot with FIP")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Replace the number in the flexcom-mode property with the define from the
include file.
This corresponds to the approach in Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add dt-bindings include file for Atmel Flexcom hardware block.
This file is copied from Linux kernel.
It is used in devicetrees from Linux.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The AT91 RM9200DK board was removed long time ago.
Remove existing references that were not cleaned up.
Fixes: 1c85752258 ("ARM: remove broken "at91rm9200dk" board")
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
CONFIG_SYS_AT91_CPU_NAME looks to be unused.
Remove it and remove it from config_whitelist.txt
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Rewrite the CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND only if it's not previously configured from
defconfig file.
This allows the user to select from defconfig/menuconfig the desired
boot command.
Adjust the current board defconfigs to reflect the default booting command
for the specific ENV configuration.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add new config for storing environment from QSPI1.
Signed-off-by: Mihai Sain <mihai.sain@microchip.com>
[eugen.hristev@microchip.com: cleanup and add MAINTAINERS entry]
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Fixed the following DTC build warning (reproducible with W=1)
arch/arm/dts/at91-sama5d2_icp.dtb: Warning (unit_address_format): /ahb/ohci@00400000: unit name should not have leading 0s
arch/arm/dts/at91-sama5d2_icp.dtb: Warning (unit_address_format): /ahb/ehci@00500000: unit name should not have leading 0s
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Alexander Dahl <ada@thorsis.com>
Reorder the nodes following the kernel rules: nodes in a range are sorted
by ascending bus address, and when referenced by phandle, are ordered
alphabetically.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add support for sst26vf064b 64Mbit qspi-flash that is
present on sama5d2_icp board.
Signed-off-by: Mihai Sain <mihai.sain@microchip.com>
[eugen.hristev@microchip.com: move u-boot properties to sama5d2_icp-u-boot.dtsi]
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
When using OP-TEE, address range [0x20000000 - 0x22000000] is reserved.
This modification allows to have a system which always work even when
OP-TEE is present.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
In order to make it more flexible and allow modifying the base address
of DRAM without recompiling U-Boot, use memory node from device tree
with fdtdec functions.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
sama5d2_xplained DRAM detection code will be modified to use device tree
instead of hardcoded addresses. In order to prepare that, add the memory
node to at91-sama5d2_xplained.dts.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
When using OP-TEE, address range [0x20000000 - 0x22000000] is reserved.
This modification allows to have a system which always work even when
OP-TEE is present.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
In order to make it more flexible and allow modifying the base address
of DRAM without recompiling U-Boot, use memory node from device tree
with fdtdec functions.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
When SYSRESET is enabled, cpu_reset function is also defined in
sysreset-uclass.c which lead to multiple definitions of this function
since reset.c is build unconditionally. Add a check in Makefile to build
this file only if SYSRESET isn't enabled.
SYSRESET can be enabled when building SYSRESET_PSCI for instance on this
platform.
Signed-off-by: Clément Léger <clement.leger@bootlin.com>
This commit updates the default config with the values that will be used
soon on the Atmel / Microchip AT91SAM9G25 based GARDENA smart gateway.
Signed-off-by: Reto Schneider <reto.schneider@husqvarnagroup.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add bindings for CPU. This will allow displaying correctly the crystal,
CPU and master clock.
Reported-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Fixes: a64862284f ("clk: at91: sam9x60: add support compatible with
CCF")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
The crystal, CPU and master clock were not displayed correctly on SAM9X60
after adding CCF clock support. Add compatible for ARM926EJ-S to fix
this.
Reported-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Fixes: a64862284f ("clk: at91: sam9x60: add support compatible with CCF")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Split master clock in 2 controlling block: one for prescaler one for
divider. This will allow referencing correctly the CPU clock and
master clock in device trees.
Reported-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Fixes: a64862284f ("clk: at91: sam9x60: add support compatible with
CCF")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
reset_*_bulk expects a real pointer.
Fixes: 4f7abafe1c ("driver: watchdog: reset watchdog in designware_wdt_stop() function")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This was unfortunately applied despite much discussion about it beiong
the wrong way to implement this feature.
Revert it before too many other things are built on top of it.
This reverts commit ddf67daac3.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With Device Manager firmware in an elf file form, we cannot load the FIT
image to the exact same address as any of the executable sections of the
elf file itself is located.
However, the device tree descriptions for the ARMV8 bootloader/OS
includes DDR regions only the final sections in DDR where the Device
Manager firmware is actually executing out of.
As the R5 uC is usually operating at a slower rate than an ARMv8 MPU,
by starting the Armv8 ahead of parsing the elf and copying the correct
sections to the required memories creates a race condition where the
ARMv8 could overwrite the elf image loaded from the FIT image prior to
the R5 completing parsing and putting the correct sections of elf in
the required memory locations. OR create rather obscure debug conditions
where data in the section is being modified by ARMV8 OS while the elf
copy is in progress.
To prevent all these conditions, lets make sure that the elf parse and
copy operations are completed ahead of ARMv8 being released to execute.
We will pay a penalty of elf copy time, but that is a valid tradeoff in
comparison to debug of alternate scenarios.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
NB0 is bridge to SRAM and NB1 is bridge to DDR.
To ensure that SRAM transfers are not stalled due to delays during DDR
refreshes, SRAM traffic should be higher priority (threadmap=2) than
DDR traffic (threadmap=0).
This fixup is critical to provide deterministic access latency to
MSMC from ICSSG, it applies to all AM65 silicon revisions and is due
to incorrect reset values (has no erratum id) and statically setting
things up should be done independent of usecases and board.
This specific style of Northbridge configuration is specific only to
AM65x devices, follow-on K3 devices have different data prioritization
schemes (ASEL and the like) and hence the fixup applies purely to
AM65x.
Without this fix, ICSSG TX lock-ups due to delays in MSMC transfers in
case of SR1 devices, on SR2 devices, lockups were not observed so far
but high retry rates of ICSSG Ethernet (icssg-eth) and, thus, lower
throughput.
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@ti.com>
Acked-by: Andrew F. Davis <afd@ti.com>
Acked-by: Tomi Valkeinen <tomi.valkeinen@ti.com>
Acked-by: Benoit Parrot <bparrot@ti.com>
[Jan: rebased, dropped used define, extended commit log]
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
[Nishanth: Provide relevant context in the commit message]
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon<nm@ti.com>
The K3 SoCs have some PLL output clocks (POSTDIV clocks) which in
turn serve as inputs to other HSDIV output clocks. These clocks use
the actual value to compute the divider clock rate, and need to be
registered with the CLK_DIVIDER_ONE_BASED flags. The current k3-clk
driver and data lacks the infrastructure to pass in divider flags.
Update the driver and data to account for these divider flags.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
There are three different divider values in the DIV_CTRL register
controlled by the k3-pll driver. Currently the ti_pll_clk_set_rate
function writes the entire register when programming plld, even though
plld only resides in the lower 6 bits.
Change the plld programming to read-modify-write to only affect the
relevant bits for plld and to preserve the other two divider values
present in the upper 16 bits, otherwise they will always get set to zero
when programming plld.
Fixes: 0aa2930ca1 ("clk: add support for TI K3 SoC PLL")
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Add a note to the automatically generated clk-data and dev-data files
for j721e and j7200 to indicate that they are in fact auto-generated and
should not be hand edited.
Also adjust TI URL to use https instead of http and also add an empty
line before first header inclusion.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The TI K3 Fractional PLLs use two programmable POSTDIV1 and POSTDIV2
divisors to generate the final FOUTPOSTDIV clock. These are in sequence
with POSTDIV2 following the POSTDIV1 clock. The current J7200 clock data
has the POSTDIV2 clock as the parent for the POSTDIV1 clock, which is
opposite of the actual implementation. Fix the data by simply adjusting
the register bit-shifts.
The Main PLL1 POSTDIV clocks were also defined incorrectly using Main PLL0
register values, fix these as well.
Fixes: 277729eaf3 ("arm: mach-k3: Add platform data for j721e and j7200")
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The TI K3 Fractional PLLs use two programmable POSTDIV1 and POSTDIV2
divisors to generate the final FOUTPOSTDIV clock. These are in sequence
with POSTDIV2 following the POSTDIV1 clock. The current J721E clock data
has the POSTDIV2 clock as the parent for the POSTDIV1 clock, which is
opposite of the actual implementation. Fix the data by simply adjusting
the register bit-shifts.
The Main PLL1 POSTDIV clocks were also defined incorrectly using Main PLL0
register values, fix these as well.
Fixes: 277729eaf3 ("arm: mach-k3: Add platform data for j721e and j7200")
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Add a weak release_resources_for_core_shutdown() stub implementation
that can be overridden by actual implementation if a SoC supports that
function.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
The common TI SCI header file uses some macros from err.h and these
get exercised when CONFIG_TI_SCI_PROTOCOL is not defined. Include
the linux/err.h header file in this header file directly rather
than relying on source files to include it to eliminate any
potential build errors.
While at this, reorder the existing header file include to the
beginning of the file.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Header file version.h does not use anything from timestamp.h. Including of
timestamp.h has side effect which cause recompiling object file at every
make run because timestamp.h changes at every run.
So remove timestamp.h from version.h and include timestamp.h in files
which needs it.
This change reduce recompilation time of final U-Boot binary when U-Boot
source files were not changed as less source files needs to be recompiled.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
[trini: Add in lib/acpi/acpi_table.c and test/dm/acpi.c, rework a few others]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Version string is available in global variable char version_string[].
Macro U_BOOT_VERSION_STRING is not used by any other file, so remove it
completely from version.h. Other files were already converted to use
variable version_string[].
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
U_BOOT_DATE and U_BOOT_TIME are updated on every run of make command.
Therefore mrc.c file is recompiled every time when running make which means
that whole U-Boot binary is recompiled on every run of make command.
Simplify it and do not recompile U-Boot binary on every run of make command
by not depending on macros U_BOOT_DATE and U_BOOT_TIME.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There is no platform which needs to overload version_string[] variable, so
remove weak symbol mark.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As explained by Wolfgang, historically PowerPC would do a number of
things to hand-optimize placement of the binary on NOR flash in order to
maximize utilization of very scarce resources. These days, we simply
aren't optimizing our binary layout for NOR flash placement and it's
quite likely this wasn't working as intended. Furthermore, this level
of optimization makes it difficult to have version_string be a global,
instead of a weak and overridden value, and so make more progress on
reproducible builds, which is a current concern.
Move to having PowerPC no longer store version_string in the early part
of text so that it might be part of the first page of NOR and instead
use the same declaration everyone else does.
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/96716.1629798400@gemini.denx.de/
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There is no need to overload version_string at the end of start.S files.
Common implementation of version_string should be fine.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[trini: Keep the align, it's important for the rest of linkage]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
More C files do not use compile time timestamp macros and do not have to be
recompiled every time when SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH changes.
This patch moves version_string[] from version.h to version_string.h and
updates other C files which only needs version_string[] string to include
version_string.h instead of version.h. After applying this patch these
files are not recompiled every time when SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH changes.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Macro U_BOOT_VERSION_STRING is already stored in variable version_string.
So use directly this variable instead of storing U_BOOT_VERSION_STRING into
temporary variable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
[trini: This area was reworked since posted, what is here is now really
inspired by the previous version, so drop Ilias' Acked-by]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Currently, there is no ENTRY() entry in the m68k linker script.
However, since they currently contain a version_string symbol, which
then overrides the default weak version_string symbol, the linker
decides we must keep start.o in the resulting link. Add an ENTRY() line
so that the linker will know to keep this, even when version_string is
no longer provided in start.S
Cc: Huan Wang <alison.wang@nxp.com>
Cc: Angelo Dureghello <angelo@sysam.it>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Some tests produce a lot of output that does not need to be individually
checked by an assertion. Add a macro to handle this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to map a file into memory so that it can be accessed using
simple pointers. Add a function to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a function to return the size of a file. This is useful in situations
where we need to allocate memory for it before reading it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This message comes up a lot when scanning filesystems. It suggests to the
user that there is some sort of error, but in fact there is no reason to
expect that a particular partition has a sqfs filesystem. Other
filesystems don't print this error.
Turn it into a debug message.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
This message comes up a lot when scanning filesystems. It suggests to the
user that there is some sort of error, but in fact there is no reason to
expect that a particular partition has a btrfs filesystem. Other
filesystems don't print this error.
Turn it into a debug message.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
CONFIG_SPIFLASH is manually re-added as it is not a new symbol, but now
only exists in CONFIG_SYS_EXTRA_OPTIONS.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With legacy PCI code removed and thus DM_PCI also removed, a few places
did not get correctly updated with the merge to next and thus broke.
Remove now extraneous dependencies on DM_PCI.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Ivan's patch fixes a kernel warning when booting RPi2, as the firmware
already
provides a frambebuffer node.
Marek's patch fixes random crashes on 32 bit RPi4 with newer firmware.
My SMBIOS patchesfixes an issue that show up with
e4f8e543f1 ("smbios: Drop the unused Kconfig options").
Basically the SMBIOS table broke and wasn't readable anymore.
It appears that RPi firmware has already added framebuffer
node under /chosen, at least on RPi 2 versions. So check
for this and don't add duplicate node.
Signed-off-by: Ivan T. Ivanov <iivanov@suse.de>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Move the XHCI PCI device base up in the virtual address space. This fixes
initialization failure observed with newer Raspberry Pi firmware, later
than 63b1922311 ("firmware: arm_loader: Update armstubs with those from
PR 117). It looks that chosing 0xff800000 as the XHCI PCI device base
conflicts with the updated ARM/VideoCore firmware.
This also requires to reduce the size of the mapped PCI device region
from 8MiB to 4MiB to fit into 32bit address space. This is still enough
for the XHCI PCI device.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenz@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Enable this driver to allow U-Boot to get SMBIOS table information from
a device tree node.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Acked-by: Fabian Vogt <fvogt@suse.com>
At present SMBIOS tables are empty, which breaks some use-cases that
rely on that. Add some minimal information to fulfill this.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The hash algorithm selection was streamlined in commit 92055e138f
("image: Drop if/elseif hash selection in calculate_hash()"). Said
commit kept the call to cpu_to_uimage() to convert the CRC to big
endian format.
This would have been correct when calling crc32_wd(). However, the
->hash_func_ws member of crc32 points to crc32_wd_buf(), which already
converts the CRC to big endian. On a little endian host, doing both
conversions results in a little-endian CRC. This is incorrect.
To remedy this, simply drop the call to cpu_to_uimage(), thus only
doing the byte-order conversion once.
Fixes: 92055e138f ("image: Drop if/elseif hash selection in
calculate_hash()")
Tested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
We are not guaranteed to have the padding_pkcs_15_verify symbol since
commit 92c960bc1d ("lib: rsa: Remove #ifdefs from rsa.h"), and
commit 61416fe9df ("Kconfig: FIT_SIGNATURE should not select RSA_VERIFY")
The padding_algos only make sense with RSA verification, which can now
be disabled in lieu of ECDSA. In fact this will lead to build failures
because of the missing symbol mentioned earlier.
To resolve this, move the padding_algos to a linker list, with
declarations moved to rsa_verify.c. This is consistent with commit
6909edb4ce ("image: rsa: Move verification algorithm to a linker list")
One could argue that the added #ifdef USE_HOSTCC is ugly, and should
be hidden within the U_BOOT_PADDING_ALGO() macro. However, this would
be inconsistent with the "cryptos" list. This logic for was not
previously explored:
Without knowledge of the U_BOOT_PADDING_ALGO() macro, its use is
similar to something being declared. However, should #ifndef
USE_HOSTCC be part of the macro, it would not be obvious that it
behaves differently on host code and target code. Having the #ifndef
outside the macro makes this obvious.
Also, the #ifdef is not always necessary. For example ecda-verify
makes use of U_BOOT_CRYPTO_ALGO() without any accompanying #ifdefs.
The fundamental issue is a lack of separation of host and target code
in rsa_verify. Therefore, the declaration of a padding algo with the
external #ifdef is more readable and consistent.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
There are trivial typos in the Kconfig file. Fixed them.
Also, fixed grammar in the descriptions with typos.
Fixes: d56b4b1974 ("configs: Migrate RBTREE, LZO, CMD_MTDPARTS, CMD_UBI and CMD_UBIFS")
Fixes: 7264f2928b ("spl: fit: Eanble GZIP support for image decompression")
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If keydir is not provided but name is we want to use name as key_id.
But with the current coding name is only used on its own if it is NULL
and keydir is provided which never occurs.
Fixes: 824ee745fb ("lib/rsa: Use the 'keyfile' argument from mkimage")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some SoCs (as seen on A20) seem to misreport the MMC FIFO level if the
FIFO is completely full: the level size reads as zero, but the FIFO_FULL
bit is set. We won't do a single iteration of the read loop in this
case, so will be stuck forever.
Check for this situation and use a safe minimal FIFO size instead when
we hit this case.
This fixes MMC boot on A20 devices after the MMC FIFO optimisation
(9faae5457f).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
We don't need this check anymore since when PCI is enabled, driver model
is always used.
Sadly this doesn't work with nds32 for some reason to do with the
toolchain. Add a work-around for that.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline.
Remove it.
Note that we have to add CONFIG_SPIFLASH to scripts/config_whitelist.txt
because it's not really migrated at this point.
Acked-by: Michael Durrant <mdurrant@arcturusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Zhadan <oleks@arcturusnetworks.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Zhadan and Michael Durrant <arcsupport@arcturusnetworks.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Handle CONFIG_SPIFLASH differently and delete Kconfig file]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Support using mmc command for enumerating mmc card in a given mode
Fix device_remove in mmc
Fix switch issue with send_status disabled
Drop 1ms delay in fsl_esdhc command sending
Revert "mmc: sdhci: set to INT_DATA_END when there are data"
Since the beginning of this driver which was initially for the MPC8379
and MPC8536 SoCs, there is this spurious 1ms delay. According to the
comment it should actually be only 8 clock cycles. Esp. during EFI block
transfers, this 1ms add up to a significant delay and slows down EFI
boot.
I couldn't find any mention in the MPC8536 that there should be a delay
of 8 clock cycles between commands. The SD card specification mentions that
the clock has to be left enabled for 8 cycles after a command or
response. But I don't see how this delay will help with this.
Go ahead and just remove it. If there will ever be any regression we can
introduce a compile time flag, but for now I'd like to keep it simple.
In the split off imx driver this delay was also removed in commit
9098682200 ("mmc: fsl_esdhc_imx: remove the 1ms delay before sending
command").
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
This adds CI tests for SiFive Unleashed board.
QEMU supports booting exact the same images as used on the real
hardware out of the box, that U-Boot SPL loads U-Boot proper
from either an SD card or the SPI NOR flash, hence we can easily
set up CI to cover these 2 boot flows of SiFive Unleashed board.
With this, now we can have regression testing of mmc-spi-slot and
sifive spi drivers, as well as mmc and spi-nor subsystems.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This adds genimage [1] config files for generating SD card and spi-nor
images, which can be programmed to an SD card or SPI flash and boot
from there.
The same images will be used for U-Boot CI testing for this board.
[1] https://github.com/pengutronix/genimage
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
genimage [1] is a tool to create flash/disk images. This is required
by some targets, e.g.: sifive_unleashed, to generate sdcard or spi-nor
images for real hardware, as well as U-Boot CI testing.
[1] https://github.com/pengutronix/genimage
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At present U-Boot CI testing is still using QEMU 4.2.0 which is
pretty old. Let's bump up to QEMU 6.1.0.
ninja-build is added as the prerequisite required by QEMU 6.1.0.
Note there is a bug in QEMU 6.1.0 Xilinx Zynq UART emulation codes.
A quick fix [1] was posted on QEMU mailing list but it it too late
for 6.1.0 release. Let's manually apply the bug fix on top of the
v6.1.0 release tag at the time being.
[1] http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/qemu-devel/patch/20210823020813.25192-2-bmeng.cn@gmail.com/
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reduce the code size by avoiding using the external UEFI API and using our
internal functions instead.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
There is two unneeded EFI_CALL references in tcg2_measure_pe_image().
The first one in efi_search_protocol() and the second on in the device path
calculation. The second isn't even a function we should be calling, but a
pointer assignment, which happens to work with the existing macro.
While at it switch the malloc call to a calloc, remove the unnecessary cast
and get rid of an unneeded if statement before copying the device path
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The move to driver model should by now be completed. To be able to remove
pre-driver model code from our block IO code require CONFIG_BLK=y for UEFI
support.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Sort these and add a type so it is clear how to set the value. Add a note
about usage to the top. Correct the 'no-keyboard' binding which is missing
a prefix.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On J721e R5 SPL, dfu buffer for loading sysfw.itb image gets allocated
before DRAM gets initialized. So, the buffer gets allocated in MCU L3
RAM. The current buffer size to be allocated is 256KB and the available
total heap memory is 0x70000 (448KB). This leads to NOMEM errors during
allocation.
In other cases when constraints such as above are not present fix the size
of buffers to the sector size in OSPI for proper functioning.
Also, if CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE is defined and
CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE is not defined then the max file size for dfu
transfer is defined as CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE.
Fix these by setting appropriate buffer sizes in their respective defconfig
files and defining the max file size as 8 MB which is the default dfu
buffer size.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The size of u-boot.img is above 1MB and that of tispl.bin is close to 1MB,
in case of j721e. Therefore, increase the sizes allocated for tispl.bin and
u-boot.img to 2 MB and 4 MB respectively, in dfu_alt_info_ram environment
variable.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
In the cdns3 usb driver, the clock name looked for is ref. Therefore, fix
the clock-names property in usb0 instance for proper initialization of
cdns3 usb gadget driver.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The DM binary runs on the MCU R5F Core0 after R5 SPL on J721E and J7200
SoCs. The binary is built alongside the TFA, OPTEE and A72 SPL binaries
and included in the tispl.bin FIT image. The R5 SPL loads the DM binary
at 0xA0000000 address, based on the value used in the FIT image build
script. The DM binary though is an ELF image and not a regular binary
file, and so is processed further to load the actual program segments
using the U-Boot's standard ELF loader library.
The DM binary does leverage a certain portion of DDR for its program
segments, and typically reserves 16 MB of DDR at 0xA0000000 with the
1st MB used for IPC between Linux and the remote processor, and
remaining memory for firmware segments. This can cause an incomplete
loading of the program segments if the DM binary is larger than 1 MB,
due to overlap of the initial loaded binary and the actual program
segments.
Fix this by using the address 0x89000000, which matches the current
"addr_mcur5f0_0load" env variable used by R5 SPL before the DM firmware
inclusion into the tispl.bin.
Fixes: df5363a67f ("tools: k3_fit_atf: add DM binary to the FIT image")
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Add u-boot,dm-spl tag in the pinmux device tree node, required for MMCSD1
subsystem.
Fixes: b6059ddc45 ("arm: dts: k3-am642: Add r5 specific dt support")
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add env variables for booting to kernel from USB MSC device. The second
partition in the USB MSC device needs to formatted as ext4 file system with
kernel and dtb images, present in the /boot folder.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Make finduuid generic by making it dependent on the boot variable. For
example, this can now be used for finding the uuid of partitions in usb
device too.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Fix the dr_mode in the U-Boot device tree blob, by reading the mode field
from the USB Boot Configuration fields. The dr_mode will only be fixed when
booting from USB.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
This commit uses the existing DEFAULT_MMC_TI_ARGS and
DEFAULT_FIT_TI_ARGS defintions to replace the 'mmc*' environment
variables in the configuration. The check for the 'boot_fit' is handled
like the 'am335x_*' boards with 'CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND'.
Signed-off-by: Derald D. Woods <woods.technical@gmail.com>
Both am335x_boneblack_vboot and am335x_evm_spiboot require
SPL_OF_CONTROL to function but are currently missing this option. Add
it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
HS400_ES is missed when down grade to HS mode during
device_remove the mmc device
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
When send_status is false or wait_dat0 is not supported, the switch
function should not send CMD13 but directly return.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add documentation on the usage of "mmc dev" and "mmc rescan" commands to
set user defined speed modes.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add support for enumerating MMC card in a given mode using mmc rescan and
mmc dev commands. The speed mode is provided as the last argument in these
commands and is indicated using the index from enum bus_mode in
include/mmc.h. A speed mode can be set only if it has already been enabled
in the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Tested-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
This reverts commit 17ea3c8628.
In eMMC specification, for the response-with-busy(R1b, R5b)
command, the DAT0 will driven to LOW as BUSY status, and in
sdhci specification, the transfer complete bit should be wait
for BUSY status de-assert.
All response-with-busy commands don't contain data, the data
judgement is no need.
Signed-off-by: Yuezhang.Mo <Yuezhang.Mo@sony.com>
Reviewed-by: Andy Wu <Andy.Wu@sony.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Use dev_dbg() instead of dev_err() in pcie_advk_check_pio_status().
For example CRS is not an error status, it just says that the request
should be retried.
Without this, U-Boot spams the terminal with
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x100000
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x108000
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x110000
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x120000
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x128000
pcie_advk pcie@d0070000: Non-posted PIO Response Status: UR, 0xc80 @ 0x130000
...
when a device is not connected to a PCIe switch (Unsupported Request
from the switch).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
While a board could have multiple SATA ports, some of the ports might
not have a disk attached to them. So while probing for disks,
sata_mv_probe() should continue probing all ports, and skip one with
no disk attached.
Tests with:
- Seagate Goflex Net (Marvell Kirkwood 88F6281) out-of-tree u-boot.
- Zyxel NSA325 (Marvell Kirkwood 88F6282 out-of-tree u-boot.
Observation:
If a board has 2 or more SATA ports, and there is only one disk
attached to one of the ports, sata_mv_probe() does not return
a successful probe status. And if only one disk is attached to the
2nd port (i.e. port 1), it is not probed at all.
Patch Description:
Let sata_mv_probe() continues probing all ports, even if there
is error in probing a given port, and then return a successful
status if there is at least one port was probed successfully.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fix baudrate value 5150000 which was added in commit ead4864fa6 ("arm:
mvebu: a38x: Define supported UART baudrates").
Exact value for divisor 3 with 250 MHz TCLK is 5208333 baudrate. In above
commit I incorrectly rounded it to 5150000 value due to testing with
USB-UART hw which incorrectly reported exact value and divisor configured
on other other end of UART link.
Fix this value to 520000 baudrate which is more close to the exact hardware
value and also has less fraction parts.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: ead4864fa6 ("arm: mvebu: a38x: Define supported UART baudrates")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
According to PCIe base specification, if CRS Software Visibility is not
enabled, the Root Complex must re-issue the Configuration Request as a new
Request.
Normally this part of Root Complex is implemented in hardware but aardvark
is somehow special and does not implement it in hardware and expect that
handling of config requests are fully implemented in software.
This re-issuing functionality is required also because U-Boot does not
support CRS Software Visibility feature and therefore expects that Root
Complex re-issues requests as is specified in PCIe base specification.
Retry / re-issue config request up to the PIO_MAX_RETRIES, to prevent
infinite loop. After retry count exceed PIO_MAX_RETRIES, returns failure.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There was mistake in commit 4cd61c43fd ("arm: a37xx: pci: Fix handling
PIO config error responses"). U-Boot does not support handling of CRS
return value for PCI_VENDOR_ID config read request and also does not set
CRSSVE bit.
Therefore disable returning CRS response for now.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 4cd61c43fd ("arm: a37xx: pci: Fix handling PIO config error responses")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Since mvpp2 is using the new mdio driver and the cp110 has been
synced with the linux upstream, the mdio has to enabled in the
device tree file.
This is missing for some device tree files and therefore the
network cards do not come online.
Signed-off-by: Sven Auhagen <sven.auhagen@voleatech.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Change maintainer to me. Prafulla is no longer active in U-Boot community.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When dropping SHA512_ALGO in general, we didn't catch some cases where
an option was selecting both SHA512 and SHA512_ALGO and caused them to
select SHA512 twice. Kconfig doesn't complain, but this is still wrong
and should be corrected.
Fixes: e60e449931 ("lib: Drop SHA512_ALGO in lieu of SHA512")
Reported-by: Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Merge some fixes to how we enable hash algorithms for FIT images in
SPL. This fixes a few cases where we should have had some options
enabled, but did not. This also removes otherwise unused options in a
few other cases.
calculate_hash() would try to select the appropriate hashing function
by a if/elseif contruct. But that is exactly why hash_lookup_algo()
exists, so use it instead.
This does mean that we now have to 'select HASH' to make sure we get
the hash_lookup_algo() symbol. However, the change makes sense because
even basic FITs will have to deal with "hash" nodes.
My only concern is that the 'select SPL_HASH' might cause some
platform to grow above its SPL size allowance
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
[trini: Make FSL_CAAM be implied only on ARM && SPL]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
MD5 is being called directly in some places, but it is not available
via hash_lookup_algo("md5"). This is inconsistent with other hasing
routines. To resolve this, add an "md5" entry to hash_algos[].
The #ifdef clause looks funnier than those for other entries. This is
because both MD5 and SPL_MD5 configs exist, whereas the other hashes
do not have "SPL_" entries. The long term plan is to get rid of the
ifdefs, so those should not be expected to survive much longer.
The md5 entry does not have .hash_init/update/finish members. That's
okay because hash_progressive_lookup_algo() will catch that, and
return -EPROTONOSUPPORT, while hash_lookup_algo() will return the
correct pointer.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
[trini: Use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED not IS_ENABLED for MD5 check]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
All of these configs exist. Stick to using CONFIG_[ST]PL_HASH, and drop all
references to CONFIG_[ST]PL_HASH_SUPPORT. This means we need for
CHAIN_OF_TRUST to select SPL_HASH now.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
[trini: Add TPL case, fix CHAIN_OF_TRUST, other tweaks]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
SHA512_ALGO was used as a "either SHA512 or SHA384", although the
implementations of these two algorithms share a majority of code.
From a Kconfig interface perspective, it makes sense to present two
distinct options. This requires #ifdefing out the SHA512
implementation from sha512.c. The latter doesn't make any sense.
It's reasonable to say in Kconfig that SHA384 depends on SHA512, and
seems to be the more polite way to handle the selection.
Thus, automatically select SHA512 when SHA384 is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Originally CONFIG_FIT_SHAxxx enabled specific SHA algos for and only
for hash_calculate() in common/image-fit.c. However, since commit
14f061dcb1 ("image: Drop IMAGE_ENABLE_SHAxxx"),
the correct selector was changed to CONFIG_SHAxxx.
The extra "_FIT_" variants are neither used, nor needed. Remove them.
One defconfig disables FIT_SHA256, which is now changed to 'SHA256'.
CMD_MVEBU_BUBT needs to select select SHA256 to avoid undefined
references to "sha256_*()". bubt.c needs sha256, so this selection is
correct. It is not clear why this problem did not manifest before.
Note that SHA selection in SPL is broken for this exact reason. There
is no corresponding SPL_SHAxxx. Fixing this is is beyond the scope of
this change.
Also note that we make CONFIG_FIT now imply SHA256, to make up for
FIT_SHA256 previously being a default y option.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
[trini: Add imply SHA256 to FIT]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Merge ATAGs and MACH_ID options to Kconfig, and then disable them for
nearly all platforms. A small number of platforms actively require
this support still, and have it still enabled. Otherwise, it's migrated
and disabled.
As this is only useful when booting with ATAGs, which are now largely
disabled, remove this value for the remaining platforms. We have a few
places in the code that had been testing for MACH_TYPE as a sort of
internal logic. Update those to use different but still correct CONFIG
symbols.
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With the exceptions of ds109, ds414, icnova-a20-swac, nokia_rx51 and
stemmy, disable ATAG support. A large number of platforms had enabled
support but never supported a kernel so old as to require it. Further,
some platforms are old enough to support both, but are well supported by
devicetree booting, and have been for a number of years. This is
because some of the ATAGs related functions have been re-used to provide
the same kind of information, but for devicetree or just generally to
inform the user. When needed still, rename these functions to
get_board_revision() instead, to avoid conflicts. In other cases, these
functions were simply unused, so drop them.
Cc: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Stefan Bosch <stefan_b@posteo.net>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
No iMX platforms have supported ATAG-based booting. They have however
re-used the CONFIG_SERIAL_TAG option as a way to enable support of
reading the OTP fuses and setting the serial# environment variable in
some cases. Change the warp7 support to use this symbol, use this for
updating the rest of the imx7 code, and update the imx8 conditionals.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: NXP i.MX U-Boot Team <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The enable_caches is a generic hook for architecture-implemented, we
define this function to enable composable cache of sifive platforms.
In sifive_cache, it invokes the generic cache_enable interface of cache
uclass to execute the relative implementation in SiFive ccache driver.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The enable_caches is a generic hook for architecture-implemented, we
leverage this function to enable caches for RISC-V
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
This driver is currently responsible for enabling all ccache ways.
Composable cache could be configure as RAM or cache, we will use it as
RAM at the beginning to put the u-boot SPL there. In u-boot proper
phrase, we will use the composable cache as cache, and try to enable the
cache ways.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The ocores_i2c.c driver is missing a sentinel at the end of
the compatible strings list. This causes the "dm compat" command
to spew garbage.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Skibo <thomas-git@skibo.net>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
To make analyzing exceptions easier output the code that leads to it.
We already do the same on the ARM platform.
Here is an example:
=> exception ebreak
Unhandled exception: Breakpoint
EPC: 000000008ff5d50e RA: 000000008ff5d62c TVAL: 0000000000000000
EPC: 000000008020b50e RA: 000000008020b62c reloc adjusted
Code: 2785 0693 07a0 dce3 fef6 47a5 d563 00e7 (9002)
To disassemble the code we can use the decodecode script:
$ echo 'Code: 2785 0693 07a0 dce3 fef6 47a5 d563 00e7 (9002)' | \
CROSS_COMPILE=riscv64-linux-gnu- scripts/decodecode
Code: 2785 0693 07a0 dce3 fef6 47a5 d563 00e7 (9002)
All code
========
0: 2785 addiw a5,a5,1
2: 07a00693 li a3,122
6: fef6dce3 bge a3,a5,0xfffffffffffffffe
a: 47a5 li a5,9
c: 00e7d563 bge a5,a4,0x16
10:* 9002 ebreak <-- trapping instruction
...
Code starting with the faulting instruction
===========================================
0: 9002 ebreak
...
As it is not always clear if the first 16 bits are at the start or in the
middle of a 32bit instruction it may become necessary to strip the first
u16 from the output before calling decodecode to get the correct
disassembled code.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Both for 64bit and 32bit at least on one board we should compile the sbi
command. Enabling it on QEMU will allow to write a test for it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When booting in EFI, lib/efi_loader/efi_memory.c calls
board_get_usable_ram_top(0) which returns by default
gd->ram_base + gd->ram_size which is the top of DDR.
In case of OPTEE boot, the top of DDR is currently reserved by OPTEE,
board_get_usable_ram_top(0) must return an address outside OPTEE
reserved memory.
gd->ram_top matches this constraint as it has already been initialized
by substracting all DT reserved-memory (included OPTEE memory area).
Fixes: 92b611e8b0 ("stm32mp: correctly handle board_get_usable_ram_top(0)")
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc4
Documentation:
Remove invalid reference to configuration variable in UEFI doc
UEFI:
Parameter checks for the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL
Improve support of preseeding UEFI variables.
Correct the calculation of the size of loaded images.
Allow for UEFI images with zero VirtualSize
- Further Makefile/Kconfig namespace cleanups from Simon. This migrates
a number of symbols to Kconfig and replaces some inconsistencies
between CONFIG_FOO and CONFIG_SPL_FOO_SUPPORT/CONFIG_TPL_FOO_SUPPORT.
The code under drivers/net is related to ethernet networking drivers, in
some fashion or another. Drop these from the top-level Makefile and
also move the phy rule into drivers/net/Makefile which is where it
belongs. Make the new rule for drivers/net check for the build-stage
relevant ETH symbol.
Fix up some Kconfig dependencies while we're here to mirror how the
Makefile logic now works.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Introduce ETH, Kconfig dependency changes, am43xx fix]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Move the power/ rules into drivers/power to avoid clutter in the Makefile
and drivers/Makefile files.
We must select SPL_POWER if SPL_POWER_DOMAIN is used, since the two are
currently independent and boards do not necessarily enable SPL_POWER.
Add a TPL_POWER as well, as that is used by one board.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
At present we have SPL_POWER but not piain POWER. This works because
there is a special build rule in Makefile that always includes the
drivers/power directory.
It is better to have all driver directories included by drivers/Makefile
and there is already a rule in there for this purpose. It just needs a
Kconfig for U-Boot proper, so add one.
Update the pmic.h header file so that it defines the old pmic struct
always, when driver model is not in use. That will avoid build errors
for boards which enable POWER but not DM_PMIC.
Enable this option always. That seems strange at first sight, but it
actually but mimics the current Makefile behaviour. Once we can drop the
old PMICs it should be easy enough to rename DM_PMIC to POWWER, or
something similar.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_POWER_I2C
CONFIG_POWER_LEGACY
They are handled at the same time due to a dependency between them.
Update the Makefile rule to use legacy power only in U-Boot proper.
Unfortunately a separate rule is needed in SPL to be able to build
legacy power. Add SPL related symbols for both, to allow for SPL-only
usage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[trini: More SPL related cleanups, reword commit message]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This option is used in pre-driver model code and much of it has never
been converted to driver model.
We want to add a new option to enable power support, so we can use a
simple rule in the Makefile. Rename this one, which is really about
a particular implementation of power.
Also update the pmic.h header file so it either includes the legacy
API or the driver model one.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add a proper Kconfig option for SPL so we can remove the hack in some of
the board config files.
This involves adding CONFIG_SPL_DM_PMIC to some of the configs as well
as updateing the Makefile rule for PMIC_RK8XX to exclude SPL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[trini: Add SPL_PMIC_RK8XX, enable when needed, handle undef of
CONFIG_DM_PMIC_PFUZE100 as well]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At present we have SPL_GPIO and TPL_GPIO but not piain GPIO. This
works because there is a special build rule in Makefile that always
includes the drivers/gpio directory.
It is better to have all driver directories included by drivers/Makefile
and there is already a rule in there for this purpose. It just needs a
Kconfig for U-Boot proper, so add one.
Enable the option always for now, since this mimics current behaviour.
This can be updated once DM_GPIO is used everywhere.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is not a good idea to use things called CONFIG_xxx in the source code
since this prefix is reserved for use by Kconfig. Rename these variables.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We cannot use the existing DMA config for the MCD driver because it is
not migrated to driver model. In order to move it to drivers/Makefile
we need some sort of option for it. Add a new DMA_LEGACY option, which
also acts as a signal that it should be migrated.
Enable this for devkit3250 which uses CONFIG_DMA_LPC32XX which is not
converted to Kconfig.
For now this is not used in the Makefile. That update happens in a
following patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rename this option so that CONFIG_IS_ENABLED can be used with it.
Oddly there is already an SPL_CACHE option. Drop it in favour of this one.
Drop the special SPL Makefile rule which is now superfluous.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we have SPL_SERIAL and TPL_SERIAL but not piain SERIAL. This
works because there is a special build rule in Makefile that always
includes the drivers/serial directory.
It is better to have all driver directories included by drivers/Makefile
and there is already a rule in there for this purpose. It just needs a
Kconfig for U-Boot proper, so add one.
It is always enabled, for now, since that mimics the current behaviour.
It should be possible to drop the strange 'SERIAL_PRESENT' option at some
point and use SERIAL instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rename these options so that CONFIG_IS_ENABLED can be used with them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
[trini: Fixup some incorrect renames]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
TCG EFI Protocol Specification defines that PCRIndex parameter
passed from caller must be 0 to 23.
TPM2_MAX_PCRS is currently used to check the range of PCRIndex,
but TPM2_MAX_PCRS is tpm2 device dependent and may have larger value.
This commit newly adds EFI_TCG2_MAX_PCR_INDEX macro, it is used to
check the range of PCRIndex parameter.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
TCG EFI Protocol Specification requires to the input
ProtocolCapability.Size < size of the EFI_TCG2_BOOT_SERVICE_CAPABILITY
up to and including the vendor ID field.
Current implementation does different calculation, let's fix it.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
TCG EFI Protocol Specification defines the required parameter
checking and return value for each API.
This commit adds the missing parameter check and
fixes the wrong return value to comply the specification.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
When U-Boot is started we have to use the existing variables to determine
in which secure boot state we are.
* If a platform key PK is present and DeployedMode=1, we are in deployed
mode.
* If no platform key PK is present and AuditMode=1, we are in audit mode.
* Otherwise if a platform key is present, we are in user mode.
* Otherwise if no platform key is present, we are in setup mode.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Writing variables AuditMode and DeployedMode serves to switch between
Secure Boot modes. Provide a separate value for these in efi_auth_var_type.
With this patch the variables will not be read from from file even if they
are marked as non-volatile by mistake.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
The UEFI specification requires that the signature database may only be
stored in tamper-resistant storage. So these variable may not be read
from an unsigned file.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
We should not first allocate memory and then report a rounded up value as
image size. Instead first round up according to section allocation and then
allocate the memory.
Fixes: 82786754b9 ("efi_loader: ImageSize must be multiple of SectionAlignment")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
In a section header VirtualSize may be zero. This is for instance seen in
the .sbat section of shim. In this case use SizeOfRawData as section size.
Fixes: 9d30a941cc ("efi_loader: don't load beyond VirtualSize")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
This Kconfig symbol was never added to U-Boot but it was mentioned in the
origin commit c35df7c9e4 ("qemu: arm64: Add documentation for capsule
update"). That's why remove it from documentation to be accurate.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently it is possible to cancel loadx and loady commands by pressing
CTRL+X (CAN character) at least 3 times quickly.
All other U-Boot commands, including loadb and loads can be cancelled by
CTRL+C. So allow it also in xyz-modem code used by loadx and loady
commands. Implement it by handling CTRL+C (ETX character) in the same way
as CTRL+X (CAN character).
Due to how x/y-modem protocol works, it is required to press
CTRL+C or CTRL+X at least 3 times quickly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Transfer termination tries to instruct sender that transfer was terminated.
Print error message and indicates aborted transfer in return value.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In x-modem protocol EOF is not an error state at the end of file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Variable xyz.len is set to -1 on error. At the end xyzModem_stream_read()
function calls memcpy() with length from variable xyz.len. If this variable
is set to -1 then value passed to memcpy is casted to unsigned value, which
means to copy whole address space. Which then cause U-Boot crash. E.g. on
arm64 it cause CPU crash: "Synchronous Abort" handler, esr 0x96000006
Fix this issue by checking that value stored in xyz.len is valid prior
trying to use it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Per a request from Andre Przywara and agreed with by Peter Hoyes, the
vexpress aemv8r support wasn't quite ready to be merged, but the
discussion had moved off list. We should keep the first patch in the
series for now, but revert the rest. This reverts the following
commits:
e0bd6f31ce doc: Add documentation for the Arm vexpress board configs
30e5a449e8 arm: Use armv8_switch_to_el1 env to switch to EL1
b53bbca63b vexpress64: Add BASER_FVP vexpress board variant
2f5b7b7490 armv8: Add ARMv8 MPU configuration logic
37a757e227 armv8: Ensure EL1&0 VMSA is enabled
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
DMA is aligned to ARCH_DMA_MINALIGN(64 bytes), but as per spec, alignment
required is 4bytes only. Change DMA alignment from ARCH_DMA_MINALIGN to
GQSPI_DMA_ALIGN. Remove alignment of data length in non-exponential case.
Some minor improvements in the initialization to initialize gen_fifo
threshold and disable qspi controller while setting config register.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Tested-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Current implementation uses auto mode for starting generic FIFO.
The recommendation from IP designers is to use manual mode, hence
change to manual start mode.
In fill genfifo first write to genfio and then trigger manual start.
Also enable and check for genfifo empty interrupt status in place of
genfifo not full interrupt.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Tested-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This Kconfig symbol was never added to U-Boot but it was mentioned in the
origin commit c35df7c9e4 ("qemu: arm64: Add documentation for capsule
update"). That's why remove it from documentation to be accurate.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Add position independent execution support for ARMv7
- Snapdragon, synquacer, vexpress64 fixes / improvements
- Prevent NEON register use on ARMv8
- Other assorted fixes
On some cases, the actual number of bytes read can be shorter
than what was requested. This can be handled gracefully by
taking this difference into account instead of exiting.
Signed-off-by: Thibault Ferrante <thibault.ferrante@gmail.com>
The prototype of psci_features() duplicated. Remove extra declaration.
Fixed: e21e3ffdd1 ("psci: Fix warnings when compiling with W=1")
Reported-by: Michael Scott <mike@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@foundries.io>
For ARMv8-A, NEON is standard, so the compiler can use it even when no
special target flags are provided. For example, it can use stores from
NEON registers to zero-initialize large structures. GCC 11 decides to
do this inside the DRAM init code for the Allwinner H6.
However, GCC 11 has a bug where it generates misaligned NEON register
stores even with -mstrict-align. Since the MMU is not enabled this early
in SPL, the misaligned store causes an exception and breaks booting.
Work around this issue by restricting the compiler to using GPRs only,
not vector registers. This prevents any future surprises relating to
NEON use as well.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Create a new documentation section for Arm Ltd boards with a sub-page
for the vexpress board (FVP-A, FVP-R and Juno).
Document how the armv8_switch_to_el1 environment variable can be used
to switch between booting from S-EL2/S-EL1 at runtime on the BASER_FVP.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
Use the environment variable armv8_switch_to_el1 to determine whether
to switch to EL1 at runtime. This is an alternative to the
CONFIG_ARMV8_SWITCH_TO_EL1 compile-time option.
The environment variable will be ineffective if the ARMV8_MULTIENTRY
config is used.
This is required by the Armv8r64 architecture, which must be able to
boot at S-EL1 for Linux but may need to boot at other ELs for other
systems.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
The BASER_FVP board variant is implemented on top of the BASE_FVP board
config (which, in turn, is based on the Juno Versatile Express board
config). They all share a similar memory map - for BASER_FVP the map is
inverted from the BASE_FVP
(https://developer.arm.com/documentation/100964/1114/Base-Platform/Base---memory/BaseR-Platform-memory-map)
* Create new TARGET_VEXPRESS64_BASER_FVP target, which uses the same
board config as BASE_FVP and JUNO
* Adapt vexpress_aemv8a.h header file to support BASER_FVP (and rename
to vexpress_aemv8.h)
* Enable config to switch to EL1 for the BASER_FVP
* Create vexpress_aemv8r defconfig
* Provide an MPU memory map for the BASER_FVP
For now, only single core boot is supported.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
[trini: Add MAINTAINERS, move BOOTCOMMAND to defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Armv8r64 is the first Armv8 platform that only has a PMSA at the
current exception level. The architecture supplement for Armv8r64
describes new fields in ID_AA64MMFR0_EL1 which can be used to detect
whether a VMSA or PMSA is present. These fields are RES0 on Armv8a.
Add logic to read these fields and, for the protection of the memory
used by U-Boot, initialize the MPU instead of the MMU during init, then
clear the MPU regions before transition to the next stage.
Provide a default (blank) MPU memory map, which can be overridden by
board configurations.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
On Armv8-R, the EL1&0 memory system architecture is configurable as a
VMSA or PMSA, and resets to an "architecturally unknown" value.
Add code to armv8_switch_to_el1_m which detects whether the MSA at
EL1&0 is configurable using the id_aa64mmfr0_el1 register MSA fields.
If it is we must ensure the VMSA is enabled so that a rich OS can boot.
The MSA and MSA_FRAC fields are described in the Armv8-R architecture
profile supplement (section G1.3.7):
https://developer.arm.com/documentation/ddi0600/latest/
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
The use of ARMv8.3 pointer authentication (PAuth) is governed by fields
in HCR_EL2, which trigger a 'trap to EL2' if not enabled. The reset
value of these fields is 'architecturally unknown' so we must ensure
that the fields are enabled (to disable the traps) if we are entering
the kernel at EL1.
The APK field disables PAuth instruction traps and the API field
disables PAuth register traps
Add code to disable the traps in armv8_switch_to_el1_m. Prior to doing
so, it checks fields in the ID_AA64ISAR1_EL1 register to ensure pointer
authentication is supported by the hardware.
The runtime checks require a second temporary register, so add this to
the EL1 transition macro signature and update 2 call sites.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
This reverts commit f7e16bb0c5, since
the U-Boot doesn't boot if it is booted directly from SPI-NOR with
CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT=y. Unless fixing this issue, it is better
to revert this change.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
CONFIG_MMC_SPI_CRC_ON needs the crc16 functions, but it was not included
in an SPL build. For non-SPL builds, crc16.o is already added
unconditionally. This also removes CONFIG_SPL_YMODEM_SUPPORT from the
sifive board configs, which is only relevant for some ARM boards and was
only set for its side effect of adding crc16.o.
When running 'part list' for an ISO partition the numbers are not under the
labels.
Correct the alignment of the ISO partition list. With the patch the
output looks like:
Part Start Sect x Size Type
1 3720 5024 512 U-Boot
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The logic in msm_generate_mac_addr() was originally taken from the LK
bootloader where the serial number is a string and must be parsed first.
However, in U-Boot msm_board_serial() returns an u32 and
msm_generate_mac_addr() has quite complicated code that will first
print it as a hex string and then immediately parse it again.
What this function actually does at the end is to put the serial number
encoded as big endian (the order used for the hex string) into the u8 *mac.
Use put_unaligned_be32() to do that with bit shifts instead of going
through the string format.
This should be slightly more efficient and cleaner but does not result
in any functional difference.
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
At the moment U-Boot produces an empty MAC address (02:00:00:00:00:00)
if the eMMC is not used by anything in U-Boot (e.g. with
CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE=y instead of having the environment on eMMC).
This happens because then there is nothing that actually initializes
the eMMC and reads the "cid" that is later accessed.
To fix this, call mmc_init() to ensure the eMMC is initialized.
There is no functional difference if the eMMC is already initialized
since then mmc_init() will just return without doing anything.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
A U-Boot image could be loaded and executed at a different
location than it was linked at.
For example, Aspeed takes a stable release version of U-Boot image
as the golden one for recovery purposes. When the primary storage
such as flash is corrupted, the golden image would be loaded to any
SRAM/DRAM address on demands through ethernet/UART/etc and run for
rescue.
To deal with this condition, the PIE is needed as there is only one
signed, golden image, which could be however executed at different
places.
This patch adds the PIE support for ARMv7 platform.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
This new option allows to disable ahci-pci driver in SPL. Disabling it is
needed when SPL_PCI is not enabled as ahci-pci depends on PCI.
This change fixes following compile error when CONFIG_SPL_SATA_SUPPORT is
enabled and SPL_PCI is disabled.
LD spl/u-boot-spl
arm-linux-gnueabihf-ld.bfd: drivers/ata/ahci.o: in function `ahci_probe_scsi_pci':
drivers/ata/ahci.c:1205: undefined reference to `dm_pci_map_bar'
arm-linux-gnueabihf-ld.bfd: drivers/ata/ahci.c:1215: undefined reference to `dm_pci_read_config16'
arm-linux-gnueabihf-ld.bfd: drivers/ata/ahci.c:1216: undefined reference to `dm_pci_read_config16'
arm-linux-gnueabihf-ld.bfd: drivers/ata/ahci.c:1220: undefined reference to `dm_pci_map_bar'
make[1]: *** [scripts/Makefile.spl:512: spl/u-boot-spl] Error 1
make: *** [Makefile:1977: spl/u-boot-spl] Error 2
LD spl/u-boot-spl
arm-linux-gnueabihf-ld.bfd: drivers/ata/ahci-pci.o: in function `ahci_pci_probe':
drivers/ata/ahci-pci.c:21: undefined reference to `ahci_probe_scsi_pci'
make[1]: *** [scripts/Makefile.spl:512: spl/u-boot-spl] Error 1
make: *** [Makefile:1977: spl/u-boot-spl] Error 2
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
File drivers/ata/ahci-pci.c calls function ahci_probe_scsi_pci() which is
compiled only when DM_PCI is enabled. So add missing dependency into
Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The ds1307 driver also supports the DS1339 and DS1340.
However, in ds1307_rtc_reset the register writes assume that the chip
is a DS1307. This is evident in the writing of bits SQWE, RS1, RS0 to
the control register. While this applies correctly to the DS1307, on a
DS1340 the control register doesn't contain those bits (instead, the
register is used for clock calibration). By writing these bits the
clock calibration will be changed and the chip can become
non-functional after a reset call.
Signed-off-by: Callum Sinclair <callum.sinclair@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
Enabling CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD produces a significantly smaller
U-Boot binary (250 KiB vs 320 KiB) that still seems to be fully
functional. Make use of that by default but keep it as "imply" so it
can be disabled for testing in case this causes trouble for someone.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Over the time, the "stemmy" U-Boot board was tested on several other
Samsung smartphones based on ST-Ericsson NovaThor Ux500. Convert the
documentation to reStructuredText at doc/board/ste/stemmy.rst and
make the device list complete. Also note that the board now boots
into USB Fastboot instead of just ending up at the U-Boot prompt.
The device table is mostly taken from the postmarketOS wiki article
(https://wiki.postmarketos.org/wiki/ST-Ericsson_NovaThor_U8500).
All the newly added devices were tested by Linus Walleij.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Make use of the new drivers for ARM U8500 introduced in the U-Boot
2021.10 merge window by adding basic support for USB Fastboot with
the "stemmy" board. As a first step this will always boot directly
into USB Fastboot for now with the console displayed on the screen
to make that obvious.
Samsung uses quite strange GPT partition labels on these boards,
so also add a bunch of fastboot_partition_alias_* to make this more
easy to use.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
So far there is no need for a clock driver in U-Boot because the
previous boot stage leaves all the necessary clocks on. However,
some drivers in U-Boot (e.g. arm_pl180_mmci) depend on having a clock
driver to obtain the clock frequency.
Setting up the clock drivers properly is a bit tricky on U8500,
so for now add a simple fixed-clock for the eMMC that allows obtaining
the clock frequency. This should be replaced eventually if some board
actually requires enabling some of the clocks.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Imply the options for new drivers added for ARM U8500 during the
U-Boot 2021.10 merge window. Adding these as "imply" in the Kconfig
avoids having to add them to all the board defconfigs but still allows
disabling them if wanted.
Also select DM_USB_GADGET if DM_USB is selected because otherwise
the Ux500 MUSB glue driver does not show up in the configuration.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Update MAINTAINERS with various drivers for ARM U8500 that were
added during the U-Boot 2021.10 merge window.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
When k_recv() returns zero it indicates that kermit transfer was aborted.
Function do_load_serial_bin() (caller of load_serial_bin()) interprets
value ~0 as aborted transfer, so properly propagates information about
aborted transfer from k_recv() to do_load_serial_bin().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
This resyncs us with the version found in v5.13 of the Linux kernel with
the following exceptions:
- Keep our u-boot specific tests / code area.
- Change the location of checkpatch.rst (which we now import)
- Drop the "use strscpy" test as we don't have that, but do have strlcpy
and want that used now.
- Keep debug/printf in the list for $logFunctions
And note that we now also include the spdxcheck.py tool that
checkpatch.pl supports calling out to, and include upstream's
checkpatch.rst in our develop section of the documentation.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Currently, an empty imput file causes `mmap()` to fail, and you get an
error like "mkimage: Can't read file.img: Invalid argument", which is
extremely unintuitive and hard to diagnose if you don't know what to
look for. Add an explicit check for an empty file and provide a clear
error message instead.
We already bounds check the image size when listing and re-signing
existing images, so we only need this check here, when opening data
files going into a image.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Hebb <tommyhebb@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With glibc 2.33 (Ubuntu package glibc6 2.33-0ubuntu9) building
sifive_unmatched_defconfig results in:
In file included from /usr/include/stdio.h:866,
from ././include/compiler.h:26,
from <command-line>:
In function ‘snprintf’,
inlined from ‘rsa_engine_get_priv_key’ at ./tools/../^:273:4:
/usr/include/riscv64-linux-gnu/bits/stdio2.h:71:10: warning:
‘%s’ directive argument is null [-Wformat-truncation=]
71 | return __builtin___snprintf_chk (__s, __n,
__USE_FORTIFY_LEVEL - 1,
|
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
72 | __glibc_objsize (__s), __fmt,
| ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
73 | __va_arg_pack ());
| ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Avoid passing a NULL string.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Calculate hash using DM driver if supported.
For backward compatibility, the call to legacy
hash functions is reserved.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Add purely software-implmented drivers to support multiple
hash operations including CRC, MD5, and SHA family.
This driver is based on the new hash uclass.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Add UCLASS_HASH for hash driver development. Thus the
hash drivers (SW or HW-accelerated) can be developed
in the DM-based fashion.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Older OpenSSL and libressl versions have a slightly different API.
This require #ifdefs to support. However, we still can't support it
because the ECDSA path does not compile with these older versions.
These #ifdefs are truly a vestigial appendage.
Alternatively, the ECDSA path could be updated for older libraries,
but this requires significant extra code, and #ifdefs. Those libraries
are over three years old, and there concerns whether it makes sense to
build modern software for real world use against such old libraries.
Thusly, remove #ifdefs and code for old OpenSSL and LibreSSL support.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
BTRFS volume consists of a number of subvolumes which can be mounted separately
from each other. The top-level subvolume always exists even if no subvolumes
were created manually. A subvolume can be denoted as the default subvolume i.e.
the subvolume which is mounted by default.
The default "default subvolume" is the top-level one, but this is far from the
common practices used in the wild. For instance, openSUSE provides an OS
snapshot/rollback feature based on BTRFS. To achieve this, the actual OS root
filesystem is located into a separate subvolume which is "default" but not
"top-level". That means that the /boot/dtb/ directory is also located inside
this default subvolume instead of top-level one.
However, the existing btrfs u-boot driver always uses the top-level subvolume
as the filesystem root. This behaviour 1) is inconsistent with
mount /dev/sda1 /target
command, which mount the default subvolume 2) leads to the issues when
/boot/dtb cannot be found properly (see the reference).
This patch uses the default subvolume as the filesystem root to overcome
mentioned issues.
Reference: https://bugzilla.suse.com/show_bug.cgi?id=1185656
Signed-off-by: Matwey V. Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Fixes: f06bfcf54d ("fs: btrfs: Crossport open_ctree_fs_info() from btrfs-progs")
Reviewed-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Support for register headers in v1 images was implemented in commit
02ba70ad68 ("tools: kwbimage: Add support for DATA command also for v1
images"). So remove old comment.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 02ba70ad68 ("tools: kwbimage: Add support for DATA command also for v1 images")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
image_get_csk_index() may return -1 in case of an error. Don't use this
value as index.
This resolves Coverity CID 338488
Memory - illegal accesses (NEGATIVE_RETURNS)
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Always check the return value of fopen().
This resolves Coverity CID 338491:
Null pointer dereferences (NULL_RETURNS)
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Disable MCU watchdog in board_late_init() instead of board_init(), so
that it is disabled after U-Boot enables SOC watchdog instead of before.
This way there is no window when the board is vulnerable.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When booting over UART, sending U-Boot proper may take too much time and
MCU watchdog will reset the board before U-Boot proper is loaded.
Better disable MCU watchdog in SPL when booting over UART.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We do not need to guard code in board_init() and board_late_init()
functions with the CONFIG_SPL_BUILD macro, since these functions are not
called in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move the function get_boot_device() from spl.c to cpu.c.
Make it visible, so that it may be used from other files.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Armada 37xx serial driver does not use CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_SHIFT.
So do not define any bogus value for CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_SHIFT option in any
Armada 37xx defconfig file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCIe-based NVMe SSD disks in M.2 2230/2242/2260 form-factor can be
connected to Turris Omnia mPCIe slot via passive M.2 <--> mPCIe adapter.
So enable PCIe NVMe drivers.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
SATA disks could be connected via mPCIe add-in card with PCIe-SATA
controller into Mox-B or Mox-G module.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Espressobin has one on-board SATA port which is connected directly to CPU.
More SATA disks can be connected via mPCIe add-in card with PCIe-SATA
controller.
So enable required SATA AHCI PCIe drivers in defconfig file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
File mach/soc.h is included also in 64-bit mvebu processors, so define
Armada XP related macros only when compiling for Armada XP.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There are already IBR_HDR_* constants for these numbers, so use them.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Part of image data is 4 byte checksum, so every image must contain at least
4 bytes. Verify it to prevent memory corruptions.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Only image versions 0 and 1 are supported. Verify it in
kwbimage_verify_header() function.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Define all standard baudrates plus 3 non-standard high speed:
3125000 4000000 5150000
3125000 matches divisor 5 with 250 MHz TCLK and divisor 4 with 200 MHz TCLK.
4000000 is the rounded value for divisor 4 with 250 MHz TCLK (3906250) and
divisor 3 with 200 MHz TCLK (4166666).
5150000 is the rounded value (5208333) for divisor 3 with 250 MHz TCLK.
Testing showed that rounded value is more stable then exactly calculated.
And it is the highest possible baudrate which is stable on A38x platform.
Any other baudrate values above 2500000 are unstable, which is reason why
e.g. standard value 3000000 is not defined, and it is needed to use
non-standard value 3125000.
Tested all defined UART baudrates on Turris Omnia (A38x with 250 MHz TCLK).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Further CONFIG to Kconfig migrations
- Some DDR related symbols
- CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR moved, loadaddr always set in environment now.
- Finish MX7D, convert IMX_CONFIG
- Some RAMBOOT related options
- L1 cache size converted and named consistently for all arches. A
further follow-up to rename things for even better clarity is welcome.
- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT, CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
default n/no doesn't need to be specified. It is default option anyway.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
[trini: Rework FSP_USE_UPD portion]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT_ONLY
In order to do this, we need to introduce SPL and TPL variants of these
options so that we can clearly disable these options only in SPL in some
cases, and both instances in other cases.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Based on include/configs/ls1046ardb.h it seems that CONFIG_RAMBOOT_PBL
should have been enabled, but was not. Enable and migrate the values to
Kconfig.
Cc: Mingkai Hu <mingkai.hu@nxp.com>
Cc: Rajesh Bhagat <rajesh.bhagat@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Rather than using CONFIG_SABRELITE to set FDTFILE for only that
platform, switch to always setting this based on
CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE as this should always match the kernel
device tree name anyhow.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Troy Kisky <troy.kisky@boundarydevices.com>
Move the CONFIG_DDR_MB symbol to Kconfig. A later clean-up would be to
make dynamic memory size detection work based on how this is done on
other i.MX6 platforms.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Troy Kisky <troy.kisky@boundarydevices.com>
- Provide a default Kconfig value of the default script
- Largely continue to define this via the board Kconfig file
- For the boards that select a script based on defconfig rather than
TARGET, keep this within the defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Currently, there is no over-arching symbol for access to
arch/arm/mach-imx nor the CONFIG symbols that are common over all of
these related platforms. This new CONFIG symbol will allow us to start
down this path.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Now that we have consistent usage, migrate this symbol to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
- In most of the codebase, we reference CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR and not
CONFIG_LOADADDR.
- Generally, CONFIG_SYS_LOADADDR is set to CONFIG_LOADADDR and then as
noted, we use CONFIG_SYS_LOADADDR.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
All platforms define CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR, but only some define
CONFIG_LOADADDR. Very very rarely are these not the same address, and
qemu-ppce500 is one such case. However, based on reading the history of
the code, this mismatched value was simply a copy-paste from other
PowerPC platforms where it is this unused currently. Switch the code to
use CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR and update the documentation.
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
- Guard most of the options in drivers/ddr/fsl/Kconfig with
SYS_FSL_DDR || SYS_FSL_MMDC.
- Migrate FSL_DMA, DDR_ECC, DDR_ECC_CMD, and ECC_INIT_VIA_DDRCONTROLLER
to Kconfig.
- Clean up the logic for including the DDR_ECC_CMD code.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As this symbol can either be a fixed value or the function
get_board_ddr_clk, migration is tricky. Introduce a choice of DYNAMIC
or STATIC_DDR_CLK_FREQ. If DYNAMIC, we continue to use the board
defined get_board_ddr_clk function. If STATIC, set CONFIG_DDR_CLK_FREQ
to that value and now include/clock_legacy.h contains the function
prototype or defines get_board_ddr_clk() to that static value. Update
callers to test for DYNAMIC or STATIC.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Move the symbol that controls building some JEDEC SPD support functions
to Kconfig. This is required on the TI keystone 2 platforms and very
frequently (but not always) used on large number of Freescale/NXP
platforms, so use imply there.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
We have a number of CONFIG symbols to express the fixed size of system
memory. For now, rename CONFIG_DDR_FIXED_SIZE to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_SIZE
and adjust usage to match that CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_SIZE expects the entire
size rather than MiB.
Cc: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Move CONFIG_DDR_32BIT/64BIT to Kconfig as a choice for Armada XP
platforms. Make 64bit the default as this mirrors the current code.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Check that the watchdog_reset() implementation in wdt-uclass behaves
as expected:
- resets all activated watchdog devices
- leaves unactivated/stopped devices alone
- that the rate-limiting works, with a per-device threshold
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
It seems that no other test has claimed gpio_a:7 yet, so use that.
The only small wrinkle is modifying the existing wdt test to use
uclass_get_device_by_driver() since we now have two UCLASS_WDT
instances in play, so it's a little more robust to fetch the device by
driver and not merely uclass+index.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
A rather common kind of external watchdog circuit is one that is kept
alive by toggling a gpio. Add a driver for handling such a watchdog.
The corresponding linux driver apparently has support for some
watchdog circuits which can be disabled by tri-stating the gpio, but I
have never actually encountered such a chip in the wild; the whole
point of adding an external watchdog is usually that it is not in any
way under software control. For forward-compatibility, and to make DT
describe the hardware, the current driver only supports devices that
have the always-running property. I went a little back and forth on
whether I should fail ->probe or only ->start, and ended up deciding
->start was the right place.
The compatible string is probably a little odd as it has nothing to do
with linux per se - however, I chose that to make .dts snippets
reusable between device trees used with U-Boot and linux, and this is
the (only) compatible string that linux' corresponding driver and DT
binding accepts. I have asked whether one should/could add "wdt-gpio"
to that binding, but the answer was no:
https://lore.kernel.org/lkml/CAL_JsqKEGaFpiFV_oAtE+S_bnHkg4qry+bhx2EDs=NSbVf_giA@mail.gmail.com/
If someone feels strongly about this, I can certainly remove the
"linux," part from the string - it probably wouldn't the only place where
one can't reuse a DT snippet as-is between linux and U-Boot.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
A board can have and make use of more than one watchdog device, say
one built into the SOC and an external gpio-petted one. Having
wdt-uclass only handle the first is both a little arbitrary and
unexpected.
So change initr_watchdog() so we visit (probe) all DM watchdog
devices, and call the init_watchdog_dev helper for each.
Similarly let watchdog_reset() loop over the whole uclass - each
having their own ratelimiting metadata, and a separate "is this device
running" flag.
This gets rid of the watchdog_dev member of struct global_data. We
do, however, still need the GD_FLG_WDT_READY set in
initr_watchdog(). This is because watchdog_reset() can get called
before DM is ready, and I don't think we can call uclass_get() that
early.
The current code just returns 0 if "getting" the first device fails -
that can of course happen because there are no devices, but it could
also happen if its ->probe call failed. In keeping with that, continue
with the handling of the remaining devices even if one fails to
probe. This is also why we cannot use uclass_probe_all().
If desired, it's possible to later add a per-device "u-boot,autostart"
boolean property, so that one can do CONFIG_WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART
per-device.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Since the gd->watchdog_dev member is going away, switch to using the
new wdt_stop_all() helper.
While here, clean up the preprocessor conditional: The ->watchdog_dev
member is actually guarded by CONFIG_WDT [disabling that in
x530_defconfig while keeping CONFIG_WATCHDOG breaks the build], and in
the new world order so is the existence of the wdt_stop_all()
function.
Actually, existence of wdt_stop_all() depends on CONFIG_${SPL_}WDT, so
really spell the condition using CONFIG_IS_ENABLED, and make it a C
rather than cpp if.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Since the watchdog_dev member of struct global_data is going away in
favor of the wdt-uclass handling all watchdog devices, prepare for
that by adding a helper to call wdt_stop() on all known devices.
If an error is encountered, still do wdt_stop() on remaining devices,
but remember and return the first error seen.
Initially, this will only be used in one single
place (board/alliedtelesis/x530/x530.c).
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
For the unit tests, it is more convenient if the tests are in charge
of when the watchdog devices are started and stopped, so prevent
wdt-uclass from doing it automatically.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
As a step towards handling all DM watchdogs in watchdog_reset(), use a
per-device flag to keep track of whether the device has been started
instead of a bit in gd->flags.
We will still need that bit to know whether we are past
initr_watchdog() and hence have populated gd->watchdog_dev -
incidentally, that is how it was used prior to commit 9c44ff1c5f.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
In preparation for handling all DM watchdogs in watchdog_reset(), pull
out the code which handles starting (or not) the gd->watchdog_dev
device.
Include the device name in various printfs.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
The addition of .pre_probe and .per_device_auto made this look
bad. Fix it.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
As preparation for having the wdt-uclass provided watchdog_reset()
function handle all DM watchdog devices, and not just the first such,
introduce a uclass-owned struct to hold the reset_period and
next_reset, so these become per-device instead of being static
variables.
No functional change intended.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
wdt_start() does the "no ->start? return -ENOSYS" check, don't
open-code that in wdt_expire_now().
Also, wdt_start() maintains some global (and later some per-device)
state, which would get out of sync with this direct method call - not
that it matters much here since the board is supposed to reset very
soon.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
These symbols are now either unused or were only used within the config
file to determine other logic, which could be done in a way that doesn't
further pollute the CONFIG namespace.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Begin merging some Kconfig migration, and CONFIG namespace cleanup
series in. This gives us:
- A number of I2C symbols migrated over
- DWC2, i8042, altera_spi and a few other areas updated to use CFG not
CONFIG for the concept of "configuration space" defines.
- Rename CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_BOARD_SETTINGS to EXTRA_ENV_BOARD_SETTINGS
- Some dead code removal.
- Rename a number of CONFIG symbols that were only referenced within
the config header to not use CONFIG as a prefix.
While the Kconfig language seems to accept either form of whitespace, we
use a space throughout the project, except in these spots.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Rather than using CONFIG namespace for logic internal to
include/configs/astro_mcf5373l.h to select ASTRO_ID (and populate the
default environment), strip CONFIG from the various options used and
set.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Update the comment here to refer to PCI_CONFIG_ADDRESS rather than
CONFIG_ADDRESS.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The value CONFIG_ALTERA_SPI_IDLE_VAL is never re-defined by a board.
Rename this to ALTERA_SPI_IDLE_VAL.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This driver uses the CONFIG namespace to set the chips internal CONFIG
namespace related bits. However, CONFIG is reserved for the top-level
Kconfig based configuration system. Use CFG as the namespace here
instead to avoid pollution.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There are an assortment of hard-coded CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND options in some
board headers. Rework these so that they do not add to the CONFIG
namespace.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Migrate CONFIG_GICV2 and CONFIG_GICV3 to Kconfig. We still have the GIC
related registers that need to be handled more cleanly but start by
moving this symbol to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This driver uses the CONFIG namespace to set the chips internal CONFIG
namespace related bits. However, CONFIG is reserved for the top-level
Kconfig based configuration system. Use CFG as the namespace here
instead to avoid pollution.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
- As there are no boards that use different values for speed / slave on
different buses, use a single option.
- Switch to using the common SYS_I2C_SPEED / SYS_I2C_SLAVE options.
- Introduce _HAS_ options for additional buses as only the first one is
common to all users.
- Convert all remaining symbols to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Migrate SYS_I2C_SH and related defines to Kconfig
- Remove currently unused SYS_I2C_SH related defines
- Cleanup related README section.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C1
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C2
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C3
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C4
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The omap24xx I2C driver uses its own CONFIG namespace for common I2C
variables. Rather than convert more of them to Kconfig, rename these to
the common I2C ones and remove the entirely unused functionality. As
part of this, we make the am335x_shc platforms consistent with their
intended speed values.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There are no users of more than 1 i2c bus in the non-DM case currently.
Remove the additional defines for this.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Convert SYS_I2C_EARLY_INIT to Kconfig, and make it depend on
SPL_SYS_I2C_LEGACY. Remove the weak implementation as it's either
something that needs to exist for real, or shouldn't be called.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
First, we convert CONFIG_SYS_I2C_LEGACY to Kconfig. Next, as you cannot
have SYS_I2C_LEGACY and DM_I2C at the same time, introduce
CONFIG_SPL_SYS_I2C_LEGACY so that we can enable the legacy option only
in SPL. Finally, for some PowerPC cases we also need
CONFIG_TPL_SYS_I2C_LEGACY support. Convert all of the existing users to
one or more symbols.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Currently the legacy software i2c support is only used for a single bus.
Remove all of the extra and unused support. Also update the README to
not reference that, and finish removing some already badly auto-edited
related text.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This converts the following to Kconfig:
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Rename usages of CONFIG_SYS_DEF_EEPROM_ADDR to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR
based on current usage.
- Convert CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN,
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_BUS, CONFIG_CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE
CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS and CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS
to Kconfig. We move these symbols around a bit and add appropriate
dependencies to them. In some cases, we now add a correct default value
as well.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At this point in time, there's no systems with "U-Boot environment
exists on an EEPROM which is accessed over the I2C bus" that sets this
option. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This platform defines everything needed to be able to use the
eeprom command. In addition, board/compulab/common/eeprom.c is required
by the platform, and does not use CONFIG_ID_EEPROM to enable/disable
builing of it. In order to migrate CONFIG symbols to Kconfig and to not
have to add complex logic to handle this case, enable CMD_EEPROM on this
board.
Cc: Uri Mashiach <uri.mashiach@compulab.co.il>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Finish moving this driver to Kconfig.
- Update the dependency logic for Exynos5 too
- Remove the unused CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0_SPEED variable
- Drop CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0_SLAVE as it's always set to 0.
- Move the internal SYS_I2C_S3C24X0_SLAVE define closer to the only user.
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The instances of CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR on these platforms doesn't
match up with the rest of the EERPOM related defines in U-Boot. Move
these out of the CONFIG namespace rather than make complex Kconfig
logic.
Cc: Samuel Egli <samuel.egli@siemens.com>
Cc: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
The shc platforms do not make use of the rest of the EEPROM
infrastructure. Rather than make more elaborate Kconfig logic, remove
this setting from the CONFIG namespace.
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Looking over the current boards, there are no users of
CONFIG_MAC_ADDR_IN_EEPROM. Further, omapl138_lcdk uses
CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR. Drop various unused code paths.
Cc: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Cc: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This platform does not use any of the standard EEPROM functionality and
instead provides its own. Use a local namespace for the I2C related
defines to access the EEPROM.
Cc: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Rework the default environment a bit to not use non-standard
CONFIG_ENV_... names and similar one-off CONFIG names.
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Rename CONFIG_ENV_KS2_BOARD_SETTINGS to ENV_KS2_BOARD_SETTINGS so that
it better fits with the rest of the environment addition macros.
Cc: Vitaly Andrianov <vitalya@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Rename CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_BOARD_SETTINGS to EXTRA_ENV_BOARD_SETTINGS in
order to not further add to the CONFIG namespace.
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
There are a number of DWC2 configuration options that are set in dwc2.h
and referenced in dwc2.c only. Move these out of the CONFIG_DWC2
namespace and in to the DWC2 namespace. Note that hikey was defining an
option that was already always enabled, so we can remove that hunk.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Xilinx changes for v2021.10-rc3
xilinx:
- Disable CONFIG_ARCH_FIXUP_FDT_MEMORY
- Print information about cpu via soc drivers and enable DISPLAY_CPUINFO
- Wire infrastructure for DTB_RESELECT and MULTI_DTB_FIT
zynq:
- Wire single QSPI
- Use power-source instead of io-standard properties
- Enable nor on zc770-xm012
zynqmp:
- Change handling around multi_boot()
- Setup offset for u-boot.itb in spi
- Generate run time dfu_alt_info for capsule update
- Use explicit values for enums (zynqmp_firmware.h)
- Enable RTC/SHA1/BUTTON/BUTTON_GPIO command
- Disable WDT driver by default
- Bind usb/scsi via preboot because of EFI
- DT updates/fixes
- Add soc driver
- Fix SPL SPI boot mode
versal:
- Add soc driver
sdhci:
- Update tap delay programming for zynq_sdhci driver
cmd:
- Fix RTC uclass handling in date command
- Update pwm help message
- Update reset help message
watchdog:
- Fix wwdt compilation
rtc:
- Deal with seq alias in rtc uclass
- Add zynqmp RTC driver
fdt:
- Add kernel-doc for fdt_fixup_memory_banks()
There is no space in OCM for SPL stack because the space in OCM is occupied
by TF-A. That's why move relocate stack to DDR to 0x18000000 address
and also enable SPL_SIZE_LIMIT not to be more then 0xfffea000 which is
default address for TFA.
It is good to summarize current DDR usage in SPL flow.
0-0x80000 is used for BSS
(CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR, CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE)
0x100000 is used for DTB passing address
(CONFIG_XILINX_OF_BOARD_DTB_ADDR)
0x17fffe70 - CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR - is used for GD
0x18000000 is used for SPL stack
(CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR)
0x20000000-0x21000000 is used for SPL malloc area
(CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START, CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE)
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Use TF-A instead of ATF in description. And update generic description with
removing ATF because also configurations without it are supported.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
U-Boot support board detection at run time and based on it change DT.
This feature is implemented for SOM Kria platforms which contain two
eeproms which contain information about SOM module and CC (Carrier card).
Full U-Boot starts with minimal DT file defined by
CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE which is available in multi DTB fit image.
It is using default setup of board_name variable initializaed to
DEVICE_TREE which corresponds to CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE option.
When DTB_RESELECT is enabled board_detection() is called. Keep it your mind
that this code is called before relocation. board_detection() is calling
xilinx_read_eeprom() which fills board_info (xilinx_board_description)
structure which are parsed in board_name_decode().
Based on DT configuration and amount of nvmemX aliases name of the board is
composed by concatenating CONFIG_SYS_BOARD "-" <board_name> "-rev"
<board_revision> "-" <cc_name> "-rev" <cc_revision>.
If CC is not present or more are available it keeps going.
When board name is composed and returned from board_name_decode() it is
assigned to board_name variable which is used by
board_fit_config_name_match() which is called via fdtdec_setup() when it
goes over config options in multi dtb FIT image.
From practical point of view multi DTB image is key point here which has to
contain configs for detected combinations. Unfortunately as of now they
have to be full DTBs and DTBOs are not supported.
That's why configuration like:
config_X {
description = "zynqmp-board-cc";
fdt = "board", "cc";
};
needs to be squashed together with:
fdtoverlay -o zynqmp-board-cc -i arch/arm/dts/zynqmp-board.dtb \
arch/arm/dts/zynqmp-cc.dtbo
and only one dtb is in fit:
config_X {
description = "zynqmp-board-cc";
fdt = "board-cc";
};
For creating multi DTBs fit image use mkimage -E, e.g.:
mkimage -E -f all.its all.dtb
When DTB_RESELECT is enabled xilinx_read_eeprom() is called before
relocation and it uses calloc for getting a buffer. Because this is dynamic
memory it is not relocated that's why xilinx_read_eeprom() is called again
as the part of board_init(). This second read with calloc buffer placed in
proper position board_late_init_xilinx() can setup u-boot variables as
before.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
When MULTI_DTB_FIT is enabled fit-dtb.blob fit image is created which
contain all DTBs listed by CONFIG_OF_LIST. And with DTB_RELESELECT there is
a need to handle it as one file with DTBs in it not as separate DTBs in
u-boot.its/itb.
That's why extend mkimage_fit_atf.sh to generate u-boot.itb correctly.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Start of DTB should be 64bit aligned that's why also make sure that end is
also 64bit aligned. It is not required but it is nice thing to do.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enabling MULTI_DTB_FIT and DTB_RESELECT can end up with multi DTBs in FIT
image placed and aligned only by 32bits (4bytes). Based on device tree
specification:
"Specifically, the memory reservation block shall be aligned to an 8-byte boundary
and the structure block to a 4-byte boundary."
is 64bit (8bytes) alignment required. That's why make sure that
fit-dtb.blob and u-boot.itb as our primary target images for Xilinx ZynqMP
are all 64bit aligned.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
DT needs to be 64bit aligned. If it is not fdt64_to_cpu will fail when try
to read information about reserved memory. The system ends in exception
without any clue what's going it. That's why detect not aligned DT and
panic to show where the issue is coming from.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add support for changing DT at run time. It is done via board_detection()
which returns platform_id and platform_version which can be used via
board_name_decode() to compose board_local_name string which corresponds
with DT which is should be used.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Origin code was allocating only pointers to struct xilinx_board_description
and there was separate allocation for structure self and freeing in case of
failure.
The code is directly allocating space for all structures by one calloc to
simlify logic.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Use variable which points to DEVICE_TREE by default. The reason for this
change is to enable DTB_RESELECT and MULTI_DTB_FIT where board detection
can be used for change DTB at run time. That's why there must be reference
in board_fit_config_name_match() via variable instead of hardcoding it
which is sufficient for that use case.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
FRU spec expected \0 for unused symbols but unfortunately a lot of boards
are using spaces instead of \0. That's why after saving it to desc->name
name is checked again and all spaces are converted to \0. This will ensure
that names can be used for string manipulations like concatenation.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
dev_dbg, dev_err and dev_warn seems to be moved to different header file.
Include dm/device_compat.h file to compile properly.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The commit 573a3811ed ("sysreset: psci: support system reset in a generic
way with PSCI") has added support for warm reset via PSCI but this hasn't
been reflected in usage message and user has to look at the code how to run
it. That's why update usage text to make this clear.
Here is full help with updated usage:
ZynqMP> help reset
reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
Usage:
reset - cold boot without level specifier
reset -w - warm reset if implemented
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
The first name is taken from command name that's why shouldn't be listed in
help. And commands shouldn't be listed with <> which means value but value
itself is command name.
Also add description for commands to make it clear what it does.
Before
pwm pwm <invert> <pwm_dev_num> <channel> <polarity>
pwm <config> <pwm_dev_num> <channel> <period_ns> <duty_ns>
...
After:
pwm invert <pwm_dev_num> <channel> <polarity> - invert polarity
pwm config <pwm_dev_num> <channel> <period_ns> <duty_ns> - config PWM
pwm enable <pwm_dev_num> <channel> - enable PWM output
pwm disable <pwm_dev_num> <channel> - disable PWM output
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
soc_xilinx_versal driver allows identification of family & revision
of versal SoC. This driver is selected by CONFIG_SOC_XILINX_VERSAL.
Probe this driver using platdata U_BOOT_DEVICE structure which is
defined at mach-versal/cpu.c.
Add this config to xilinx_versal_virt_defconfig &
xilinx_versal_mini_ospi_defconfig file to select this driver.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
soc_xilinx_zynqmp driver allows identification of family & revision
of zynqmp SoC. This driver is selected by CONFIG_SOC_XILINX_ZYNQMP.
Add this config to xilinx_zynqmp_virt_defconfig file.
Probe this driver using platdata U_BOOT_DEVICE structure which is
specified in mach-zynqmp/cpu.c.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add kernel-doc description for fdt_fixup_memory_banks() because it is
implemented in one specific way and this information should be available
for others to decide if their SoC conforms to it.
If you don't want U-Boot to update your memory DT layout please disable
CONFIG_ARCH_FIXUP_FDT_MEMORY.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Based on DT spec you can have one memory node which multiple ranges or
multiple nodes.
fdt_fixup_memory_banks() is not implemented in a correct way when multiple
memory nodes are present because all ranges are put it to the first memory
node found. And next memory nodes are kept in DT which ends up in the same
range specification in the same DT.
Here is what it is happening.
Origin DT.
memory@0 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x0 0x0 0x0 0x80000000>;
};
memory@800000000 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x8 0x00000000 0x0 0x80000000>;
};
After fdt_fixup_memory_banks()
memory@0 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x0 0x0 0x0 0x80000000>, <0x8 0x00000000 0x0 0x80000000>;
};
memory@800000000 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x8 0x00000000 0x0 0x80000000>;
};
As is visible memory@0 node got second range but there is still
memory@800000000 node present and 2G range is listed twice.
The solution can't be that second node is removed because it can be
referenced already that's why it is better for us to disable this option
for now.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Replace 'io-standard' property with 'power-source' property in all
zynq dts files to be in sync with Zynq Pinctrl driver.
Signed-off-by: Sai Krishna Potthuri <lakshmi.sai.krishna.potthuri@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Based on thread
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-June/451828.html
especially
"Overall we have a deficiency in the UEFI implementation in that we
cannot deal with block devices added or removed after initialization."
there is a need to deal with removable media as usb/scsi/sata.
That's why bridge this gap in EFI implementation by resetting usb and
scsi resets to get all disks before efi_init_obj_list() is called.
In our standard boot flow, where we use distro boot, order is fixed as
"jtag mmc0 mmc1 qspi0 nand0 usb0 usb1 scsi0 pxe dhcp" with prioritizing
boot device added by commit 2882b39d56 ("arm64: zynqmp: Setup the first
boot_target at run time").
When device has ESP partition all devices should be detected because then
efi_disk_register() in efi_init_obj_list() is called only once.
The first such a device is sd/emmc(mmc0/mmc1) and then disks on usb/sata
are not handled at all.
The commit 6bb577dbb3 ("arm64: zynqmp: Disable
EFI_CAPSULE_ON_DISK_EARLY") also pointed out on this issue but detection of
removable media wasn't solved that's why do it now via preboot command.
I have tested cases without usb and scsi and there is no problem with
calling resets without devices itself.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Do not enable watchdog driver in default zynqmp configuration. The reason
is that not all distributions are handling watchdog properly and then
expires and system resets. If someone needs watchdog in their design please
enable it by hand.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
As per SD spec when SD host controller is reset, it takes 1000msec
to detect the card state. In case, if we enable the sd bus voltage &
card detect state is not stable, then host controller will disable
the sd bus voltage.
In case of warm/subsystem reboot, due to unstable card detect state
host controller is disabling the sd bus voltage to sd card causing
sd card timeout error. So we wait for a maximum of 1000msec to get
the card detect state stable before we enable the sd bus voltage.
This current fix is workaround for now, this needs to be analysed
further. Zynqmp platform should behave the same as Versal, but we
did not encounter this issue as of now. So we are fixing it for
Versal only.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Move tapdelay function calls to zynq_sdhci.c and make them static
inline. zynqmp_tap_delay.h has function prototypes for the functions
defined in tap_delays.c, which will not be needed anymore.
Remove tap_delays.c and zynqmp_tap_delay.h files.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Currently xilinx sdhci driver is using zynqmp_mmio_write() to set
tapdelay values and DLL resets. Continue to use this for SPL and mini
U-Boot where U-Boot will be executed at EL3 level.
Use firmware call xilinx_pm_request() using appropriate arguments to
set input/output tapdelays and also for DLL resets in regular flow(EL2).
Host driver should explicitly request DLL reset before ITAP (assert DLL)
and after OTAP (release DLL) to avoid issues in some cases. Also handle
error return where possible.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The DDR subsystem in Diamond Mesa is consisted of controller, PHY,
memory reset manager and memory clock manager.
Configuration settings of controller, PHY and memory reset manager
is come from DDR handoff data in bitstream, which contain the register
base addresses and user settings from tool.
Configuration settings of memory clock manager is come from the HPS
handoff data in bitstream, however the register base address is defined
in device tree.
The calibration is fully done in HPS, which requires IMEM and DMEM
binaries loading to PHY SRAM for running this calibration, both
IMEM and DMEM binaries are also part of bitstream, this bitstream
would be loaded to OCRAM by SDM, and configured by DDR driver.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Minimum 1GB memory size is required in current memory test, so this patch
improves the memory test for processing memory size less than 1GB, and
the size in power of two.
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Move cm_get_mpu_clk_hz function declaration from individual device's
clock manager header file to common clock_manager.h.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
There is a QSPI NOR flash part on the board. Because this chip isn't
yet supported in Linux, but it is supported in U-Boot, and the
face that the RPC_SPI compatible names are different in U-Boot and
Linux, the device tree updates are confined to -u-boot.dtsi files.
In order to use the QSPI, TF-A must leave RPC unlocked by compiling
TF-A with RZG_RPC_HYPERFLASH_LOCKED=0.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Bas <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
N5X support both HPS handoff data and DDR handoff data.
Existing HPS handoff functions are restructured to support both existing
devices and N5X device.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Rename to common file name to used by all SOC64 devices and change
"_S10_" to "_SOC64_" in base_addr_soc64.h.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Move 'linux_qspi_enable' from bootcommand to board_prep_linux function when
OS booted from FIT image for Stratix 10 and Agilex. This flow is common for
all Intel SOC64 devices.
U-Boot will update 'fdt_addr' environment value based on FIT image in
board_prep_linux function, and 'linux_qspi_enable' will refer to 'fdt_addr'
environment value to retrieve the device tree node.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc3
Documentation:
* Rename Freescale to NXP
* Document structures used for the UEFI TCG2 protocol
UEFI:
* Device paths must use EfiBootServicesData
fsl-qoriq: Fixes related to env, spi, usb, crypto, configs, distro-boot
for Layerscape Boards like lx2, sl28, ls2088ardb.
powerpc: Fixes for t208xrdb revd board and cortina related configs
update for T208xRDB, T4240RDB.
i2c changes for for-v2021.10-rc3
new driver:
- Introduce mcp230xx support
from Sebastian Reichel
new feature:
- i2c-gpio: add support for "sda-gpios" + "scl-gpios" i2c-gpio bindings.
from Samuel Holland
- bootcount: add a new driver with syscon as backend
from Nandor Han
The driver will use a syscon regmap as backend and supports both
16 and 32 size value. The value will be stored in the CPU's endianness.
Signed-off-by: Nandor Han <nandor.han@vaisala.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To avoid confusion about the order of the GPIOs, the i2c-gpio binding
was updated to use a separate property for each GPIO instead of an
array. However, the driver only supports the old binding. Add support
for the new binding as well, so the driver continues to work as device
trees are updated.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Introduce driver for I2C based MCP230xx GPIO chips, which are
quite common and already well supported by the Linux kernel.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add function to apply a bitmask to an i2c register, so
that specific bits can be cleared and/or set.
Suggested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
tiny-printf variant doesn't know how to handle %llu format string, but both
tiny-printf and print_size can meet in SPL when TFTP is used to obtain main
u-boot image. This is known to lead to critical boot issue at AM335x platform
when printf is catched in infinite loop.
To avoid such issues and make print_size function tiny-printf friendly, use %u
instead of %luu. Note, that the size value is guaranteed to be less than 1024
in this conditional branch, so the cast to unsigned int is safe.
Signed-off-by: Matwey V. Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
%pM format string is used to print MAC-address and this is required while SPL
network boot.
This patch fixes the SPL boot issues like the following:
Trying to boot from USB eth
## Error: flags type check failure for "ethaddr" <= "40309614M" (type: m)
## Error inserting "ethaddr" variable, errno=1
eth0: eth_cpsw## Error: flags type check failure for "eth1addr" <=
"81f01114M" (type: m)
## Error inserting "eth1addr" variable, errno=1
, eth1: usb_ether
eth_cpsw Waiting for PHY auto negotiation to complete......... TIMEOUT !
Problem booting with BOOTP
SPL: failed to boot from all boot devices
### ERROR ### Please RESET the board ###
Signed-off-by: Matwey V. Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current U-Boot version has the next matches for boot partitions:
> mmc0boot0 to EMMC_BOOT1
> mmc0boot1 to EMMC_BOOT1 (should be EMMC_BOOT2)
This patch fixes a typo for the boot partition number.
Signed-off-by: Oleh Kravchenko <oleg@kaa.org.ua>
Cc: Pantelis Antoniou <panto@antoniou-consulting.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Update boot-commands to load device-tree from
boot-device at 'fdt_addr_r' address in DDR
during distro-boot.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
One of the "dma_addr_t" instances was left out when
converting to "caam_dma_addr_t".
Fixes: 2ff17d2f74 ("crypto: fsl: refactor for 32 bit version CAAM support on ARM64")
Signed-off-by: Horia Geantă <horia.geanta@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
T4240RDB supports booting from 2 nor banks(default and altbank). The
corresponding defconfig can only have one entry defined and therefore,
extend cs4340_get_fw_addr() function to overwrite firmware address which
will be later used in cortina firmware.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
T2080RDB supports booting from 2 nor banks(default and altbank). The
corresponding defconfig can only have one entry defined and therefore,
extend cs4340_get_fw_addr() function to overwrite firmware address which
will be later used in cortina firmware.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS2088A-RDB supports TFA boot source and has 2 nor banks(default and
altbank) and QSPI as boot source. The corresponding defconfig can only
have one entry defined and therefore, extend cs4340_get_fw_addr()
function to overwrite firmware address which will be later used in
cortina firmware.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add support for boards supporting TFA boot separately in cortina
firmware. Please note, a weak function is defined to retrieve firmware
address values as CONFIG_CORTINA_FW_ADDR is now defined in defconfig and
can only have one possible value defined. This weak function will help
in overwrting the values to get proper addresses as per boot source.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Use moveconfig.py script to convert below defines to Kconfig and move
these entries to defconfigs.
CONFIG_CORTINA_FW_ADDR
CONFIG_CORTINA_FW_LENGTH
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add PHY_CORTINA as default option in SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV Kconfig entry as
PHY_CORTINA require SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV value similar to FMAN_ENET or QE.
This helps in resolving compilation failure.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
NXP platforms expect custom bootcmd and mcinitcmd to be
updated as per boot source with default environment.
Check env variable fsl_bootcmd_mcinitcmd_set to prepare
bootcmd and mcinitcmd
Fixes: cbf77d2018 (armv8: fsl-layerscape: Fix automatic
setting of bootmcd with TF-A)
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Free dynamically allocated memory before every return statement
in calc_img_key_hash() and calc_esbchdr_esbc_hash() function.
Verified the secure boot changes using ls1046afrwy board.
Signed-off-by: Kshitiz Varshney <kshitiz.varshney@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Starting with board revision D, the MISCCSR CPLD register needs to be
configured to enable Power-on Reset for software reset commands.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LX2160A-RDB/QDS has micron mt35xu512aba flash which requires flag
CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_MT35XU on to probe flash successfully.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board doesn't use the MTD subsystem in u-boot, thus there is no
need to specify the partitions. They are outdated anyway. Just drop
them.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Import linux commit 007773e16a6f ("spi: nxp-fspi: Ensure width is
respected in spi-mem operations") to fix SPI access on boards which
don't have all SPI I/O lines connected to the flash.
Since commit 71025f013c ("mtd: spi-nor-core: Rework hwcaps selection")
u-boot figures out the capabilities by looking at spi_mem_supports_op().
The FlexSPI driver doesn't take the board layout into account. Fix that.
Fixes: 383fded70c ("spi: nxp_fspi: new driver for the FlexSPI controller")
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Memory allocated in the implementation of the
EFI_DEVICE_PATH_TO_TEXT_PROTOCOL must be of type EfiBootServicesData.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
dp_alloc() was using a constant from the wrong enum resulting in creating
device paths in EfiReservedMemory.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
Use enum efi_memory_type and enum_allocate_type in the definitions of the
efi_allocate_pages(), efi_allocate_pool().
In the external UEFI API leave the type as int as the UEFI specification
explicitely requires that enums use a 32bit type.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
This commit adds the comment of the TCG Specification
efi_tcg2.h file refers, and comment for the structure.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
'make htmldocs' does not use file doc/board/st/st.rst because the name
matches the directory name. Let's rename it to st-dt.rst.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Having "i.MX7D/i.MX8MM SRC_GPR10 PERSIST_SECONDARY_BOOT for bootloader A/B
switching" at the top level of the documentation tree does not make sense.
Move it to board specific information.
Fixes: 59e3d1bd49 ("doc: imx: psb: Document usage of SRC_GPR10 PERSIST_SECONDARY_BOOT for A/B switching")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add board_fdt_blob_setup to return the device tree location which is
passed by prior stage in u-boot proper. The generic board_fdt_blob_setup
always returns _end, it mignt be ok because u-boot SPL would currently
put the dtb there, but it would be broken if we put the dtb to another
place and assigned the location into a1 register for u-boot proper. Use
the location passed by prior stage would make more sence, because we
actually pass the location to u-boot proper and want to use that one,
rather than the dtb which in _end.
We can't use CONFIG_OF_PRIOR_STAGE because it doens't distinguish the
implementation of u-boot SPL and u-boot proper, so u-boot SPL need to
reply on the prior stage to pass device tree location as well, but we
don't pass the DT from boot rom now. In addition, when
CONFIG_OF_PRIOR_STAGE is enabled, the u-boot-spl.bin and u-boot.itb won't
include the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
As (3581811dc2 "riscv: sifive/fu540: Move SPL related functions to spl.c"),
we put the SPL stuff in spl.c, we don't need to compile unleashed.c and
unmatched.c in SPL build.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Commit 37304aaf60 ("Convert CONFIG_USE_PREBOOT and CONFIG_PREBOOT to
Kconfig") removed preboot commands in RISC-V targets and broke
extlinux support as reported by Fu Wei <wefu@redhat.com>.
The patch finishes migration of CONFIG_USE_PREBOOT and CONFIG_REBOOT
to Kconfig.
Fixes: 37304aaf60 ("Convert CONFIG_USE_PREBOOT and CONFIG_PREBOOT to Kconfig")
Reported-By: Fu Wei <wefu@redhat.com>
Signed-off-by: David Abdurachmanov <david.abdurachmanov@sifive.com>
Signed-off-by: Dimitri John Ledkov <dimitri.ledkov@canonical.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The USB recovery mode is used by Toradex to load the Toradex Easy
Installer image which supports further system images installation.
Prepare for loading and launching the Toradex Easy Installer if the
USB Recovery mode is activated.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Highlights:
- Handle TF-A boot with FIP for STM32MP1
- Fix board_get_usable_ram_top(0) for STM32MP1
- DT alignement with kernel v5.14 for STM32MP1
- SPI-NOR DT update for DHSOM
- Add UCLASS API for ECDSA singnature and implement it for STM32MP1
This test verifies that ECDSA_UCLASS is implemented, and that
ecdsa_verify() works as expected. The definition of "expected" is
"does not find a device, and returns -ENODEV".
The lack of a hardware-independent ECDSA implementation prevents us
from having one in the sandbox, for now.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
FIT signatures can now be implemented with ECDSA. The assumption that
all FIT images are signed with RSA is no longer valid. Thus, instead
of 'select'ing RSA, only 'imply' it. This doesn't change the defaults,
but allows one to explicitly disable RSA support.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The STM32MP ROM provides several service. One of them is the ability
to verify ecdsa256 signatures. Hook the ROM API into the ECDSA uclass.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Implement the crypto_algo .verify() function for ecdsa256. Because
it backends on UCLASS_ECDSA, this change is focused on parsing the
keys from devicetree and passing this information to the specific
UCLASS driver.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Define a UCLASS API for verifying ECDSA signatures. Unlike
UCLASS_MOD_EXP, which focuses strictly on modular exponentiation,
the ECDSA class focuses on verification. This is done so that it
better aligns with mach-specific implementations, such as stm32mp.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The SPI NOR is a bit further away from the SoC on DHCOR than on DHCOM,
which causes additional signal delay. At 108 MHz, this delay triggers
a sporadic issue where the first bit of RX data is not received by the
QSPI controller.
There are two options of addressing this problem, either by using the
DLYB block to compensate the extra delay, or by reducing the QSPI bus
clock frequency. The former requires calibration and that is overly
complex for SPL, so opt for the second option. This incurs 20ms delay
during boot, when SPL loads U-Boot to DRAM.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Device tree alignment with Linux kernel v5.14-rc3
- ARM: dts: stm32: move stmmac axi config in ethernet node on stm32mp15
- ARM: dts: stm32: Configure qspi's mdma transfer to block for stm32mp151
- ARM: dts: stm32: add a new DCMI pins group on stm32mp15
- ARM: dts: stm32: fix ltdc pinctrl on microdev2.0-of7
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The function board_get_usable_ram_top can be called after relocation
with total_size = 0 to get the uppermost pointer that is valid to access
in U-Boot.
When total_size = 0, the reserved memory should be not take in account
with lmb library and 'gd->ram_base + gd->ram_size' can be used.
It is the case today in lib/efi_loader/efi_memory.c:efi_add_known_memory()
and this patch avoids that the reserved memory for OP-TEE is not part of
the EFI available memory regions.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The MTD tee partitions used to save the OP-TEE binary are needed when
TF-A doesn't use the FIP container to load binaries.
This patch puts under CONFIG_STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE flag the associated
code in U-Boot binary and prepare the code cleanup when
CONFIG_STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE support will be removed after TF-A migration
to FIP support.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
TF-A for STM32MP15 now supports the FIP: it is a packaging format which
includes the secure monitor, u-boot-nodtb.bin and u-boot.dtb
This FIP file is loaded by FSBL = TF-A BL2.
This patch updates the board documentation to use this FIP file and no
more u-boot.stm32 (with STM32 image header) which is no more generated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add TF-A FIP support for trusted boot on STM32MP15x,
when STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE is not activated.
With FIP support the SSBL partition is named "fip" and its size is 4MB,
so the ENV partition name in device tree (for SD card or eMMC)
or offset in defconfig (CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET / CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND)
need to be modified.
With FIP the TEE MTD partitions are removed because the OP-TEE binray are
included in the FIP containers.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
With FIP support in TF-A (when CONFIG_STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE
is not activated), the DT nodes needed by OP-TEE are added by OP-TEE
firmware in U-Boot device tree, present in FIP.
These nodes are only required in trusted boot, when TF-A load the file
u-boot.stm32, including the U-Boot device tree with STM32IMAGE header,
in this case OP-TEE can't update the U-Boot device tree.
Moreover in trusted boot mode with FIP, as the OP-TEE nodes are present
in U-Boot device tree only when needed the function
stm32_fdt_disable_optee can be removed.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
By default for trusted boot with TF-A, U-Boot (u-boot-nodtb)
is located in FIP container with its device tree and with
the secure monitor (provided by TF-A or OP-TEE).
The FIP file is loaded by TF-A BL2 and each components is
extracted at the final location.
This patch add CONFIG_STM32MP15x_STM32IMAGE to request the
STM32 image generation for SOC STM32MP15x
when FIP container is not used (u-boot.stm32 is loaded by TF-A
as done previously to keep the backward compatibility).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add the support of the BSEC clock used by the STM32MP misc driver
since the commit 622c956cad ("stm32mp: bsec: manage clock when present
in device tree") even if this clock is not yet defined in kernel device
tree stm32mp151.dtsi.
This patch avoids issue for basic boot when this secure clock are not
provided by secure world with SCMI.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc2-2
Documentation:
* Require Sphinx >= 2.4.4 for 'make htmldocs'
* Move devicetree documentation to restructured text and update it
* Document stm32mp1 devicetree bindings
UEFI
* Extend measurement to UEFI variables and ExitBootServices()
* Support Uri() node in devicetree to text protocol
* Add Linux magic token to RISC-V EFI test binaries
Refactor efi_append_scrtm_version() to use common
function for adding eventlog and extending PCR.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
TCG PC Client PFP spec requires to measure
"Exit Boot Services Invocation" if ExitBootServices() is invoked.
Depending upon the return code from the ExitBootServices() call,
"Exit Boot Services Returned with Success" or "Exit Boot Services
Returned with Failure" is also measured.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Swap two ifs in efi_exit_boot_services().
efi_tcg2_notify_exit_boot_services must have EFIAPI signature.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
TCG PC Client PFP spec requires to measure "Boot####"
and "BootOrder" variables, EV_SEPARATOR event prior
to the Ready to Boot invocation.
Since u-boot does not implement Ready to Boot event,
these measurements are performed when efi_start_image() is called.
TCG spec also requires to measure "Calling EFI Application from
Boot Option" for each boot attempt, and "Returning from EFI
Application from Boot Option" if a boot device returns control
back to the Boot Manager.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
TCG PC Client PFP spec requires to measure the secure
boot policy before validating the UEFI image.
This commit adds the secure boot variable measurement
of "SecureBoot", "PK", "KEK", "db", "dbx", "dbt", and "dbr".
Note that this implementation assumes that secure boot
variables are pre-configured and not be set/updated in runtime.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Add the Linux magic to the EFI file header to allow running our test
programs with GRUB's linux command.
MajorImageVersion = 1 indicates a kernel that can consume the
EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL. This allows to dump the GRUB provided intird with
our initrddump.efi tool.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
iPXE used Uri() device path nodes. So we should support them in the
device path to text protocol.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
With device tree binding migration to yaml it is difficult to synchronize
the binding from Linux kernel to U-Boot.
Instead of maintaining the same dt bindings, this patch adds in the U-Boot
documentation the path to the device tree bindings in Linux kernel for
STMicroelectronics devices, when they are used without modification.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add links for referenced text files.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This question comes up every now and then with people coming from Linux.
Add some notes about it so we can point to it in the mailing list.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This file is about 10 years old and the updates have not covered
everything that has changed, particularly in the last few years. Update
the information and add mention of the u-boot.dtsi files.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix typos.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Move this to rST format, largely unchanged to start with. Add an index
for this topic, as well as an empty intro.
Note this patch does not include updates! Is it just a conversion to the
new format. See the next patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchart <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Adjust the Latex formatting to match Linux v5.13.1:
* add Latex margins
* reformat the code in doc/conf.py to match Linux
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Now that the spi-nor fix has been made in u-boot/master via:
commit 87e7219f9c ("mtd: spi-nor: Respect flash's hwcaps in spi_nor_adjust_hwcaps()")
enable CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SMART_HWCAPS on Intel Crown Bay again.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update SeaBIOS build instructions using exact command that involves
"make olddefconfig", and mention SeaBIOS release 1.14.0 has been
used for testing.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable SeaBIOS support for any kernel that requires legacy BIOS
services.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Odroid Go Advance uses a Rockchip Serial Flash Controller with an
XT25F128B SPI NOR flash chip. This adds support for both. Note that
while both the controller and chip support quad mode, only two lines
are connected to the chip. Changing the pinctrl to bus2 and setting tx
and rx lines to 2 for this reason.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jon Lin <jon.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Adds support for XT25F128B used on Odroid Go Advance. Unfortunately
this chip uses a continuation code which I cannot seem to parse, so
there are possibly going to be collisions with chips that use the same
manufacturer/ID.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jon Lin <jon.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
This patch adds support for the Rockchip serial flash controller
found on the PX30 SoC. It should work for versions 3-5 of the SFC
IP, however I am only able to test it on v3.
This is adapted from the WIP SPI-MEM driver for the SFC on mainline
Linux. Note that the main difference between this and earlier versions
of the driver is that this one does not support DMA. In testing
the performance difference (performing a dual mode read on a 128Mb
chip) is negligible. DMA, if used, must also be disabled in SPL
mode when using A-TF anyway.
Signed-off-by: Chris Morgan <macromorgan@hotmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jon Lin <jon.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Currently there are a few arm32 rockchip board configs that don't
generate u-boot-rockchip.bin when running make because CONFIG_BINMAN
is not enabled. This patch changes CONFIG_ARCH_ROCKCHIP to also select
CONFIG_BINMAN if CONFIG_SPL and !CONFIG_ARM64.
Example builds that don't generate u-boot-rockchip.bin without this
patch:
export ARCH=arm
export CROSS_COMPILE=/usr/bin/arm-linux-gnueabihf-
make kylin-rk3036_defconfig
make
export ARCH=arm
export CROSS_COMPILE=/usr/bin/arm-linux-gnueabihf-
make rock_defconfig
make
export ARCH=arm
export CROSS_COMPILE=/usr/bin/arm-linux-gnueabihf-
make tinker-rk3288_defconfig
make
Signed-off-by: Johan Gunnarsson <johan.gunnarsson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Sync the rk3399 DTs and associated bits from 5.14-rc1.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
(Remove the conflict content for vmarc-som)
Signed-off-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
- Convert GoFlex Home Ethernet and SATA to Driver Model (Tony)
- mvebu: Automatically detect CONFIG_SYS_TCLK (Pavel)
- mvebu: sata_mv: Fix HDD identication during cold start (Tony)
- a37xx: pci: Fix handling PIO config error responses (Pavel)
- Other minor misc changes and board maintainer updates
- odroid-n2: fix fdtfile suffix for n2-plus
- sei610 & meson64_android cleanups to prepare android 11 boot support
- use Android BCB mechanism for reboot reason instead of HW reboot flag
- Switch meson64_android boot flow to use abootimg for A/B, AVB and DTBO support
Remove the recommended MAC address from the network card.
NanoPi R4S has a EEPROM attached to the 2nd I2C bus (U92), which stores the MAC address.
Signed-off-by: Xiaobo Tian <peterwillcn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The host-index-min property is invalid,
so it inherits from the sdmmc definition in dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Xiaobo Tian <peterwillcn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Correct the LEDS label name and remove the board type prefix,
which is actually unnecessary here, removes the redefined system status LED pin.
Signed-off-by: Xiaobo Tian <peterwillcn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Add clock, phy and other configuration, it is convenient to support
new controller. Here a short summary of the changes:
- Add mmc_of_parse to parse dts config.
- Remove OF_PLATDATA related code.
- Reorder header inclusion.
- Add phy ops.
- add ops set_ios_post to modify the parameters of phy when the
clock changes.
- Add execute tuning api for hs200 tuning.
Signed-off-by: Yifeng Zhao <yifeng.zhao@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In the Linux DT the file rk3xxx.dtsi is shared between
rk3066 and rk3188. Both rk3xxx.dtsi and rk3188.dtsi have recently
had some updates.
For a future rk3066 support in U-boot this file must also update.
Move U-boot specific things in a rk3188-radxarock-u-boot.dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In the Linux DT the file rk3xxx.dtsi is shared between
rk3066 and rk3188. Both rk3xxx.dtsi and rk3188.dtsi have recently
had some updates.
For a future rk3066 support in U-boot this file must also update.
Move U-boot specific things in a rk3188-u-boot.dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In order to update the DT for rk3188
sync the power domain dt-binding header.
This is the state as of v5.12 in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In the Linux DT the file rk3xxx.dtsi is shared between
rk3066 and rk3188. This file has recently had some updates.
For a future rk3066 support in U-boot this file must also update.
Move U-boot specific things in a rk3xxx-u-boot.dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In order to update the DT for rk3066 and rk3188
sync the clock dt-binding header.
This is the state as of v5.12 in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Johan Jonker <jbx6244@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko@sntech.de>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Problem: board_spl_was_booted_from return wrong boot_devices[3] value
/spi@ff1d0000 and same-as-spl dont work properly for SPINOR flash
because arch/arm/mach-rockchip/spl-boot-order.c spl_node_to_boot_device
need parse SPINOR flash node as UCLASS_SPI_FLASH
spl-boot-order: same-as-spl > *** BOOT_SOURCE_ID 3 (2:emmc 3:spi 5:sd ...
/spi@ff1d0000 > board_boot_order: could not map node @618 to a boot-device
/sdhci@fe330000 > /mmc@fe320000
Solution: just change it to /spi@ff1d0000/flash@0
spl-boot-order: same-as-spl > *** BOOT_SOURCE_ID 3 (2:emmc 3:spi 5:sd ...
/spi@ff1d0000/flash@0 > /sdhci@fe330000 > /mmc@fe320000
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Basically all, i.e. rk3036.dtsi, rk3128.dtsi, rk3xxx.dtsi, rk322x.dtsi,
rk3288.dtsi, rk3308-u-boot.dtsi, rk3328-u-boot.dtsi, rk3399-u-boot.dtsi
and px30-u-boot.dtsi Rockchip SoC devicetrees which have mmc indexes
are defining eMMC as mmc0 and sdmmc as mmc1.
This means that the rule to try to boot from the SD card first is ignored,
which as per comment is what we want and is important for distros, which
rely on that.
Fix this by setting the correct mmc index, i.e. first from mmc1 (SD card),
second from mmc0 (eMMC).
Signed-off-by: Alex Bee <knaerzche@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Enable support to the 2 NOR flashes on the QEMU RISC-V virt machine.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Those embers wrapped with CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI in struct flash_info_t
are unconditionally used in the cfi_flash.c driver.
Drop the #ifdefs in the definition of flash_info_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The DM version CFI flash driver is in driver/mtd/cfi_flash.c, which
only gets built when FLASH_CFI_DRIVER is on. If CFI_FLASH is on but
FLASH_CFI_DRIVER is not, nothing is enabled at all.
Fix this dependency by selecting FLASH_CFI_DRIVER when CFI_FLASH is
enabled.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Change maintainer to me. Suriyan no longer has this board and wishes
to see someone maintaining it actively.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Change maintainer to me. Eric no longer has this board and wishes
to see someone maintaining it actively.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If ddr3_init() fails then DDR was not initialized and we cannot load and
execute U-Boot. We cannot continue, we cannot do anything in this case, so
hang.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Returning fabricated CRS value (0xFFFF0001) by PCIe Root Complex to OS is
allowed only for 4-byte PCI_VENDOR_ID config read request and only when
CRSSVE bit in Root Port PCIe device is enabled. In all other error PCIe
Root Complex must return all-ones.
So implement this logic in pci-aardvark.c driver properly.
aardvark HW does not have Root Port PCIe device and U-Boot does not
implement emulation of this device. So expect that CRSSVE bit is set as
U-Boot can already handle CRS value for PCI_VENDOR_ID config read request.
More callers of pci_bus_read_config() function in U-Boot do not check for
return value, but check readback value. Therefore always fill readback
value in pcie_advk_read_config() function. On error fill all-ones of
correct size as it is required for PCIe Root Complex.
And also correctly propagates error from failed config write request to
return value of pcie_advk_write_config() function. Most U-Boot callers
ignores this return value, but it is a good idea to return correct value
from function.
These issues about return value of failed config read requests, including
special handling of CRS were reported by Lorenzo and Bjorn for Linux kernel
driver pci-aardvark together with quotes from PCIe r4.0 spec, see details:
https://lore.kernel.org/linux-pci/20210624213345.3617-1-pali@kernel.org/t/#u
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
During cold start, with some HDDs, mv_sata_identify() does not populate
the ID words on the 1st ATA ID command. In fact, the first ATA ID
command will only power up the drive, and then the ATA ID command
processing is lost in the process.
Tests with:
- Seagate ST9250320AS 250GB HDD and Seagate ST4000DM004-2CV104 4TB HDD.
- Zyxel NSA310S (Kirkwood 88F6702), Marvell Dreamplug (Kirkwood 88F6281),
Seagate GoFlex Home (Kirkwood 88F6281), Pogoplug V4 (Kirkwood 88F6192).
Observation:
- The Seagate ST9250320AS 250GB took about 3 seconds to spin up.
- The Seagate ST4000DM004-2CV104 4TB took about 8 seconds to spin up.
- mv_sata_identify() did not populate the ID words after the call to
mv_ata_exec_ata_cmd_nondma().
- Attempt to insert a long delay of 30 seconds, ie. mdelay(30_000), after
the call to ata_wait_register() inside mv_ata_exec_ata_cmd_nondma() did
not help with the 4TB drive. The ID words were still empty after that 30s
delay.
Patch Description:
- Added a second ATA ID command in mv_sata_identify(), which will be
executed if the 1st ATA ID command did not return with valid ID words.
- Use the HDD drive capacity in the ID words as a successful indicator of
ATA ID command.
- In the scenario where a box is rebooted, the 1st ATA ID command is always
successful, so there is no extra time wasted.
- In the scenario where a box is cold started, the 1st ATA command is the
power up command. The 2nd ATA ID command alleviates the uncertainty of
how long we have to wait for the ID words to be populated by the SATA
controller.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Config option CONFIG_SYS_TCLK is set by kw88f6281.h and kw88f6192.h files
to correct SOC/platform value. So do not overwrite it in board config
include files.
Kirkwood 88F6180 and 88F6192 uses 166 MHz TCLK and Kirkwood 88F6281 uses
200 MHz TCLK.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This mvebu axp platform always uses fixed 250 MHz TCLK. So specify this
CONFIG_SYS_TCLK option in msys section of global file soc.h file instead of
manual configuration in every board file.
Now every #if-#else case of soc.h file defines CONFIG_SYS_TCLK, so remove
useless default CONFIG_SYS_TCLK value from the end of soc.h file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This mvebu msys platform always uses fixed 200 MHz TCLK. So specify this
CONFIG_SYS_TCLK option in msys section of global file soc.h file instead of
manual configuration in every board file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Bit 20 in SAR register specifies if TCLK is running at 200 MHz or 166 MHz.
Use this information instead of manual configuration in every board file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Bit 15 in SAR register specifies if TCLK is running at 200 MHz or 250 MHz.
Use this information instead of manual configuration in every board file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In DM Ethernet, the old "egiga0" name is no longer valid,
so replace these with Ethernet PHY names from device tree. Also, read
Ethernet PHY address from device tree.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add DM_ETH, SATA_MV and associated configs to goflexhome_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Activate the following Kconfig options:
* AVB for Android Verified Boot support
* ADTIMG for merging DTBOs
* ABOOTIMG for extracting Android boot image
Also rework the partitioning tables:
- add a misc partition to handle BCB messages
- add a dtbo partition to store various DTBOs
- add a vbmeta partition for AVB hashes
- Merge vendor and system into the "super" partition
Note: avb support is disables by default. To activate it:
=> setenv force_avb 1;
=> saveenv;
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <glaroque@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
doc/README.gpt states:
> The fields 'uuid' and 'uuid_disk' are optional if CONFIG_RANDOM_UUID is
> enabled. A random uuid will be used if omitted or they point to an empty/
> non-existent environment variable. The environment variable will be
> set to the generated UUID. The 'gpt guid' command reads the current
> value of the uuid_disk from the GPT.
Since we have CONFIG_RANDOM_UUID=y, remove the hard-coded uuids
and use meaningful variable names instead.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
There is a mix of spaces and tabs at the leading \. This makes updating
theses lines harder.
Add a single space before each \ for some consistency.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
AVB (Android Verified Boot) is well supported in U-Boot already.
Add support for it in meson64_android.
This is controlled by the "force_avb" environment variable and the
CONFIG_CMD_AVB option.
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <glaroque@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
To prepare for AVB support, increase SYS_MALLOC_LEN to 128M.
This value has been found by testing the following on khadas vim3l:
=> avb init
=> avb verify
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Permit redefining SYS_MALLOC_LEN for board specific configs.
This is especially useful for Android with AVB, which requires a malloc
length of 128M.
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <glaroque@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The N2+ dtb is meson-g12b-odroid-n2-plus.dtb, not n2_plus, so
correct the suffix provided in the board file. Also align the
board ident string shown during boot to match.
Fixes: 8bc780106c ("board: amlogic: odroid: add runtime detection of the N2/N2+/C4/HC4 variants")
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add i.MX8ULP EVK basic support, support SD/I2C/ENET/LPUART
Log as below: I would keep some debug info for now, and after we move
to be stable and production launch, we could drop that.
U-Boot SPL 2021.07-rc4-00164-gb800e19a6b (Jun 29 2021 - 10:23:30 +0800)
Normal Boot
upower_init: soc_id=48
upower_init: version:11.11.6
upower_init: start uPower RAM service
user_upwr_rdy_callb: soc=b
user_upwr_rdy_callb: RAM version:12.6
Turn on switches ok
Turn on memories ok
Clear DDR retention ok
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F1 frequency.
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F0 frequency.
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F1 frequency.
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F2 frequency.
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F1 frequency.
Poll for freq_chg_req on SIM register and change to F2 frequency.
complete
De-Skew PLL is locked and ready
WDT: Not found!
Trying to boot from BOOTROM
image offset 0x8000, pagesize 0x200, ivt offset 0x0
Load image from 0x3a800 by ROM_API
NOTICE: BL31: v2.4(release):imx_5.10.35_2.0.0_imx8ulp_er-10-gf37e59b94
NOTICE: BL31: Built : 01:56:58, Jun 29 2021
NOTICE: upower_init: start uPower RAM service
NOTICE: user_upwr_rdy_callb: soc=b
NOTICE: user_upwr_rdy_callb: RAM version:12.6
U-Boot 2021.07-rc4-00164-gb800e19a6b (Jun 29 2021 - 10:23:30 +0800)
CPU: Freescale i.MX8ULP rev1.0 at 744 MHz
Reset cause: POR
Boot mode: Single boot
Model: FSL i.MX8ULP EVK
DRAM: 2 GiB
MMC: FSL_SDHC: 0, FSL_SDHC: 2
Loading Environment from MMC... ***
Warning - bad CRC, using default environment
In: serial@293a0000
Out: serial@293a0000
Err: serial@293a0000
Net:
Warning: ethernet@29950000 (eth0) using random MAC address -
96:35:88:62:e0:44
eth0: ethernet@29950000
Hit any key to stop autoboot: 0
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add iMX8ULP DDR initialization driver which loads the DDR timing
parameters and executes the training procedure.
When enabling IMX8ULP_DRAM_PHY_PLL_BYPASS, using PHY PLL bypass mode
to do DDR init
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
When booting from boot part1/2, the image offset should be 0, but
ROM has a bug to return 0x8000. Has to workaround the issue before
ROM fix it.
Use a ROM function to know boot from emmc boot part or user part
So we can set the image offset accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Since CMC1 MR0 only reflects high 16 bits boot cfg used for AP domian,
it does not connect to low 16 bits for RTD. So we can't get the correct
boot mode.
Change to use DGO_GP5 of SEC_SIM which is set by ROM.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
The CMC1 SRS reflects the current reset cause, not SSRS.
Then you could get "Reset cause: WARM-WDG" when issue reset in U-Boot.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This driver uses FSB to read some fuses, but not support program fuse.
It only works in SPL (secure mode), u-boot needs traps to ATF to
read them.
Some fuses can read from S400 API and others are from FSB.
Also support program some fuses via S400 API
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Need probe the S400 MU device in arch_cpu_init_dm, so we can use
S400 API in u-boot
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Rlease LPAV from RTD to APD
Release gpu2D/3D to APD
Set TRDC MBC2 MEM1 for iomuxc0 access
Since upower depends AP/M33 SW to configure IOMUX for its PMIC i2c
and MODE pins. we have to open iomuxc0 access for A35 core (domain 7)
in single boot.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
There is xrdc inside i.MX8ULP, we need to configure permission to make
sure AP non-secure world could access the resources.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since S400 will set the memory of SPL image to R/X. We can't write
to any data in SPL image.
1. Set the parameters save/restore only for u-boot, not for SPL. to
avoid write data.
2. Not use MU DM driver but directly call MU API to send release XRDC
to S400 at early phase.
3. Configure the SPL image memory of SRAM2 to writable (R/W/X)
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
According to latest S400 API doc, the the success indicate value is
changed to 0xd6. So update the driver codes.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Because we have set reset vector to ATF in SPL, have to set it back
to ROM for any reset in u-boot
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
SRAM2 is half L2 cache and default to SRAM after system boot.
To enable the full l2 cache (512KB), it needs to reset A35 to make
the change happen.
So re-implement the jump entry function in SPL:
1. configure the core0 reset vector to entry (ATF)
2. enable the L2 full cache
3. reset A35
So when core0 up, it runs into ATF. And we have 512KB L2 cache working.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
i.MX8ULP support using ROM API to load container image,
it use same ROM API as i.MX8MN/MP, and use same container format
as i.MX8QM/QXP.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since the container is shared among i.MX platforms, move its header file
to mach-imx
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add basic i.MX8ULP support
For the MMU part, Using a simple way the calculate the MMU size to avoid
default heavy calcaulation. And align address and size in the table
settings to 2MB or 4GB as much as possible. So we can reduce the 4K page
allocations in MMU table which will spends much time in create the
page table
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add the specific board model from EEPROM config to the device-tree to
make it easier to access from Linux userspace.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
remove unused SPL features to shink the size of the SPL which
otherwise would no longer fit into IMX8M Mini OCRAM.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Make the conversion to driver model as it is mandatory.
Successfully tested booting Linux from the SD card.
Dropped support for networking and splash screen as these need
to be properly converted to DM and tested.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Add PCIe reset gpio to the Bx50v3 devicetree and get get rid of
CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Select CONFIG_IMX_HAB so that the "hab_status" command
becomes available, which is useful for checking if the
chip has been correctly setup to run in secure boot mode.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The GW7902 is based on the i.MX 8M Mini / Nano SoC featuring:
- LPDDR4 DRAM
- eMMC FLASH
- Gateworks System Controller
- LTE CAT M1 modem
- USB 2.0 HUB
- M.2 Socket with USB2.0, PCIe, and dual-SIM
- IMX8M FEC
- PCIe based GbE
- RS232/RS485/RS422 serial transceiver
- GPS
- CAN bus
- WiFi / Bluetooth
- MIPI header (DSI/CSI/GPIO/PWM/I2S)
- PMIC
Do the following to add support for it:
- add dts
- add PMIC config
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Add board model/serial# strings to env. Move the creation of the strings
to gsc_read() and the display of the info into gsc_info() so they are
available to U-Boot proper.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
replace looking up i2c bus name by bus number and define bus numbers and
eeprom address with #defines.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Replace the deprecated 'tx-fifo-depth' and 'rx-fifo-depth' properties
not supported by U-Boot drivers/net/phy/dp83867.c with the proper
'ti,fifo-depth' property.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The GW71xx has a USB Type-C connector with USB 2.0 signaling. GPIO1_12
is the power-enable to the TPS25821 Source controller and power switch
responsible for monitoring the CC pins and enabling VBUS. Therefore
GPIO1_12 must always be enabled and the vbus output enable from the
IMX8MM can be ignored.
To fix USB OTG VBUS enable a pull-up on GPIO1_12 to always power the
TPS25821 and change the regulator output to GPIO1_10 which is
unconnected.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The intention of commit d714a75fd4 ("imx: replace CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT
with CONFIG_IMX_HAB") was to convert from CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT to
CONFIG_IMX_HAB, but it replaced with an extra "_" character.
Fix it by using the correct CONFIG_IMX_HAB symbol.
Fixes: d714a75fd4 ("imx: replace CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT with CONFIG_IMX_HAB")
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The GW54xx-G revision has the foolowing changes:
- replaces the EOL GbE PHY with an updated part (requires an enable pin)
- replaces the EOL analog video decoder with an updated part
(requires dt prop)
- add power control to miniPCIe socket
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The GW53xx-G revision has the foolowing changes:
- replaces the EOL GbE PHY with an updated part (requires an enable pin)
- replaces the EOL analog video decoder with an updated part
(requires dt prop)
- add power control to miniPCIe socket
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The GW5913 is a Single Board Computer based on the NXP i.MX6Q/DL SoC
with the following features:
- DDR3 DRAM
- NAND FLASH (256MiB or 2048MiB)
- Gateworks System Periperhal Controller
- front panel LED's
- front panel pushbutton
- Digital I/O connector (I2C/GPIO/UART)
- u-blox Zoe-M8Q GPS
- 1x RJ45 GbE
- 1x MiniPCIe socket with PCIe USB 2.0 and nanoSIM socket
- Passive PoE and wide-range DC power supply
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The GW5912 is a Single Board Computer based on the NXP i.MX6Q/DL SoC
with the following features:
- DDR3 DRAM
- NAND FLASH (256MiB or 2048MiB)
- microSD socket
- Gateworks System Periperhal Controller
- front panel LED's
- front panel pushbutton
- RS232 connector (2x UARTs)
- CAN/RS485 connector
- Digital I/O connector (I2C/GPIO)
- SPI connector
- u-blox Zoe-M8Q GPS
- LIS2DE12 Accellerometer
- 1x FEC GbE RJ45 with 802.3at Active PoE
- 1x PCI GbE RJ45 with Passive PoE
- 5x MiniPCIe socket with PCIe/USB 2.0
- 1x MiniPCIe socket with PCIe/USB 2.0 and SIM socket
- Aux power input with wide-range DC power supply
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The GW5910 is a Single Board Computer based on the NXP i.MX6Q/DL SoC
with the following features:
- DDR3 DRAM
- NAND FLASH (256MiB or 2048MiB)
- microSD socket
- Gateworks System Periperhal Controller
- front panel LED's
- front panel pushbutton
- RS232 connector (2x UARTs)
- Digital I/O connector (I2C/GPIO)
- SPI connector
- u-blox Zoe-M8Q GPS
- LIS2DE12 Accellerometer
- TI CC1352 ARM Cortex-M4 multiprotocol sub-1GHz / 2.4GHz wireless MCU
- On-board brcmfmac WiFi and BT module
- RGMII RJ45 GbE
- 1x MiniPCIe socket with PCIe/USB 2.0
- 1x MiniPCIe socket with USB 2.0 and nanoSIM socket
- Passive PoE and wide-range DC power supply
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The Gateworks Ventana boards have always had usb0=usbh1 and usb1=usbotg
because OTG is often subloaded on these boards and a bit in the EEPROM
which flagging that OTG is subloaded is used to remove the dt node via the
alias.
U-Boot DM_USB UMS requires the usb0 alias be assigned to the usbotg
so fix the usb0 alias in order for UMS to work.
Fixes 72c46327f0: ("imx: ventana: enable dm support for USB")
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Move board/revision specific dt fixups for WDOG and UHS-I features
so that we can call them early for U-Boot control dt as well.
Additionally drop a deprected non-mainline dt-prop fixup regarding
HDMI input format.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
EEPROM bits no longer indicate support for NAND so instead use
hard-coded value from board config struct.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Update the documentation on how to build the u-boot image for
Colibri iMX8QXP, adding support of V1.0D revision of the module.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
If config block support is enabled, USB gadget modes unconditionally
use Toradex Product ID as USB PID. Some applications might prefer a
different and/or static USB PID. Add a Kconfig configuration option
to descide whether to use USB PID from config block or the fallback
config option CONFIG_G_DNL_PRODUCT_NUM.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan.agner@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
In case USB serial downloader has been used to load U-Boot start the
serial download protocol (SDP) emulation. This allows to download
complete images such as Toradex Easy Installer over USB SDP as well.
This code uses the boot ROM provided boot information to reliably
detect USB serial downloader.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan.agner@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Do not pass the console baudrate to the 'console' variable
to avoid the baudrate being passed twice when extlinux.conf
contains the standard: console=${console},${baudrate} format.
cat /proc/cmdline
root=PARTUUID=00000000-01 rootwait rw console=ttymxc0,115200,115200
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
In some cases 'patman status' leaves a blank line between the sign-off
and the tags it collects from patchwork. Fix this and add a test.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present it is possible to call uclass_get() before driver model is
inited. In fact this happens on x86 boards which use Intel FSPv1, since
mrccache_get_region() tries to get the SPI flash device very early
during init.
This has always been undefined behaviour. Previously it generally worked,
i.e. returned an error code without crashing, because gd->uclass_root_s
is zeroed and the uclass can be added despite driver model not being
ready, due to the way lists are implemented. With the change to use a
gd->uclass_root pointer, this no-longer works. For example, it causes a
hang on minnowmax.
Fix this by adding a check that driver model is ready when uclass_get() is
called. This function is called in the process of locating any device, so
it is a good place to add the check.
This fixes booting on minnowmax.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: 8a715530bb ("dm: core: Allow the uclass list to move")
Migrate the dm_warn function to log macro with
LOGC_DM category and LOGL_WARNING level.
This macro allows filtering with log command and allows
output on all log backend.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This reverts commit 2359fa7a87.
While the goal is valid and there is surely unused memory in that area,
we also have a lot of crucial things still located at the top-of-memory
while running lmb_alloc_base. Such things are the page table (tlb_addr),
relocated U-Boot and the active stack. Possibly more. So this patch was
premature, we will need relocations of those things first if we want to
use the range.
Fixes booting on the IOT2050, but likely also on other boards. It got
stuck on relocating the FDT - over the relocated U-Boot code.
Signed-off-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Since R-Car Gen3 already enables position independent build, also set
CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE=0x0 to finalize the switch. This is possible since
534f0fbd65 ("arm64: Fix relocation of env_addr if POSITION_INDEPENDENT=y")
fixed current env_get_char() crash with CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE=0x0 .
This change permits us to start U-Boot from any location in DRAM instead
of specific TEXT_BASE.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Turn on PIE, so that the U-Boot binary can be started from any arbitrary
location in DRAM instead of a predefined fixed one. Note that this patch
is not setting SYS_TEXT_BASE=0x0 yet, since that triggers relocation bugs
in env code that are yet to be fixed.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Cc: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
The bootargs in all those boards are a copy of initial example
bootargs, just remove those as they make little sense in most
configurations.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Now that driver model is always used, check for PCI.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Update logic, reword]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
We don't need this check anymore since when PCI is enabled, driver model
is always used.
Use CONFIG_PCI instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Correct macro usage)
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Import the imx28-evk devicetree files from Linux kernel
version 5.11-rc7.
This is in preparation for converting the mx28evk_defconfig
target to driver model.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
set_delay() has return type as void. If there are any errors while
setting tapdelay's it won't be able to return them.
Change the prototype of set_delay() in sdhci_ops structure and return
the errors from wherever it is called.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Change return type of arasan_sdhci_set_tapdelay() to int, to facilitate
returning errors. Get return values from input and output set clock phase
functions inside arasan_sdhci_set_tapdelay() and return those errors.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add firmware based reset controller for Xilinx ZynqMP SoC to let other
drivers to call reset functions. Driver is only tested on Xilinx ZynqMP but
support for Xilinx Versal can be simply added. That's why reset_id and
nr_reset are assigned in probe folder.
Driver is inpired by driver from Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable RTC command to be able to check available.
And also enable ZynqMP RTC driver to be possible to use by default.
Here is the list when both drivers are enabled:
ZynqMP> rtc list
RTC #0 - rtc_emul
RTC #1 - rtc@ffa60000
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The whole driver logic is taken from Linux kernel but only set/get/reset
functions are implemented. When device is power off RTC is power out of
battery.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
RTCs are using sequence number defined in aliases node. Date command with
DM_RTC enabled is looking for the first RTC with index 0. But when
RTC_EMULATION is enabled it gets likely most of the time index 0 even when
system has rtc0 device via aliases node and gets sequence number 0.
That's why extend the code to look for sequence 0 number first. If this
fails continue to use existing device with index 0.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
RTCs are using aliases for sequences. That's why enable
DM_UC_FLAG_SEQ_ALIAS for exact RTC indentification.
The same flag is used by a lot of other uclasses like mmc, pci, serial,
spi, timer, tpm, etc.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The main reason for this to be implemented is capsule update.
Two memories are supported and tested which is MMC FAT based and QSPI
based.
For creating capsule these commands are used:
./tools/mkeficapsule --raw spl/boot.bin --index 1 capsule1.bin
./tools/mkeficapsule --raw u-boot.itb --index 2 capsule2.bin
Then transfer to SD card where these commands run:
load mmc 0 10000000 capsule1.bin
efidebug capsule update -v 10000000
load mmc 0 10000000 capsule2.bin
efidebug capsule update -v 10000000
Depends on the boot device used are binaries loaded to qspi or mmc fat
partition.
Also multiboot register is handled to make sure that the same location(id)
is used as image which is upgraded.
Two locations are used by purpose for SPL flow. If only boot.bin is used
create only one capsule.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This variable is pointing to offset is qspi where u-boot image is placed.
In our case it is location of u-boot.itb file. Offset is the same as is
used by Xilinx Zynq SoC.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
When U-Boot runs in EL2 there is no access to csu_base registers that's why
this has to be done via firmware interface to find out multi boot register
value. Till now this function is called only from SPL in EL3.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Change multi_boot() to return multiboot value and move print out of this
function and let this function to be used by other functions without
duplicating message.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
When env_set() is called there is no need to allocate memory for variable
which is already saved that's why free it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Now that DM_PCI is always enabled, check on CONFIG_PCI instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Update for non-PCI users of this code, reword]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This prevents use of IS_ENABLED() in other files. Functions should be
visible in headers even if they are not available at link time.
Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Modified the help text of 'chpart' command ,mentioning that it is
for MTD devices.
Signed-off-by: Adarsh Babu Kalepalli <opensource.kab@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
HELP description is provided for ‘configure’ sub-command
of ‘blkcache’.
Signed-off-by: Adarsh Babu Kalepalli <opensource.kab@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Symbol CONFIG_SYS_ID_EEPROM is defined in include/configs/MPC8548CDS.h
but never used. Remove it here and from the whitelist.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Start out by documenting general expectations on when CI is run, how
anyone can run Azure pipelines, and how GitLab CI pipelines can be run.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In SquashFS, the contents of a directory is stored by
squashfs_directory_entry structures which contain the file's name, inode
and position within the filesystem.
The inode number is not stored directly; instead each directory has one
or more headers which set a base inode number, and files store the
offset from that to the file's inode number.
In mksquashfs, each inode is allocated a number in the same order as
they are written to the directory table; thus the offset from the
header's base inode number to the file's inode number is usually
positive.
Hardlinks are simply stored with two directory entries referencing the
same file. This means the second entry will thus have an inode number
much lower than the surrounding files. Since the header's base inode
number comes from the first entry that uses the header, this delta will
usually be negative.
Previously, U-Boot's squashfs_directory_entry.inode_offset field was
declared as an unsigned value. Thus when a negative value was found, it
would either resolve to an invalid inode number or to that of an
unrelated file.
A squashfs image to test this can be created like so:
echo hi > sqfs_test_files/001-root-file
mkdir sqfs_test_files/002-subdir
touch sqfs_test_files/002-subdir/003-file
ln sqfs_test_files/{001-root-file,002-subdir/004-link}
mksquashfs sqfs_test_files/ test.sqfs -noappend
Note that squashfs sorts the files ASCIIbetacally, so we can use the
names to control the order they appear in. The ordering is important -
the first reference to the file must have a lower inode number than the
directory in which the second reference resides, and the second
reference cannot be the first file in the directory.
Listing this sample image in U-Boot results in:
=> sqfsls virtio 2 002-subdir
0 003-file
Inode not found.
0 004-link
Signed-off-by: Campbell Suter <campbell@snapit.group>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
The "-E" option to mkimage generates a FIT with external data using the
data-size and data-offset properties which must both be ignored when
verifying a signature.
Add "data-offset" to the list of excluded properties for signature
verification; since the line is now too long, re-format the list to
one-per-line and make it static since the data is constant.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current stable release of LLVM is 12, update to that. While at it,
fix that we had not correctly upgraded to LLVM 11 previously.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The DT bindings of "jedec,spi-nor" [1] defines "m25p,fast-read" property
to indicate that "fast read" opcode can be used to read data from the
chip instead of the usual "read" opcode.
If this property is not present in DT, mask out fast read in
spi_nor_init_params(). This change mirrors the same logic in
spi_nor_info_init_params() in drivers/mtd/spi-nor/core.c in
the Linux kernel v5.14-rc3.
[1] Documentation/devicetree/bindings/mtd/jedec,spi-nor.yaml in the kernel tree
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The smart spi_nor_adjust_hwcaps() does not respect the SPI flash's
hwcaps, and only looks to the controller on what can be supported.
The flash's hwcaps needs to be AND'ed before checking.
Fixes: 71025f013c ("mtd: spi-nor-core: Rework hwcaps selection")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When slave drivers don't set the max_read_size, the spi-mem should
directly use data.nbytes and not limit to any size. But current
logic will limit to the max_write_size.
This commit mirrors the same changes in the dm version done in
commit 535b1fdb8e ("spi: spi-mem: Fix read data size issue").
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
- Fixed broken ICH SPI driver in software sequencer mode
- Added "m25p,fast-read" to SPI flash node for x86 boards
- Drop ROM_NEEDS_BLOBS and BUILD_ROM for x86 ROM builds
- Define a default TSC timer frequency for all x86 boards
- x86 MTRR MSR programming codes bug fixes
- x86 "hob" command bug fixes
- Don't program MTRR for DRAM for FSP1
- Move INIT_PHASE_END_FIRMWARE to FSP2
- Use external graphics card by default on Intel Crown Bay
- tangier: Fix DMA controller IRQ polarity in CSRT
U-Boot mostly uses hex for value input, largely because addresses are much
easier to understand in hex.
But in some cases a decimal value is requested, such as where the value is
small or hex does not make sense in the context. In these cases it is
sometimes useful to be able to provide a hex value in any case, if only to
resolve any ambiguity.
Add this functionality, for increased flexibility.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The code to convert a character into a digit is repeated twice in this
file. Factor it out into a separate function. This also makes the code a
little easier to read.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add some tests that check the behaviour of this function. These are the
same as for simple_strtoul() but with a few longer values.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If we see 0x then we can assume this is the start of a hex value. It
does not seem necessary to check for a hex digit after that since it will
happen when parsing the value anyway.
Drop this check to simplify the code and reduce size. Add a few more test
cases for when a 0x prefix is used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This parameter is not documented properly since it does not cover the
meaning when the base is 0. Update this in both functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is a pain to have to specify the value 10 in each call. Add a new
dectoul() function and update the code to use it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is a pain to have to specify the value 16 in each call. Add a new
hextoul() function and update the code to use it.
Add a proper comment to simple_strtoul() while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function seems to assume that the chr[] variable contains zeros at
the start, which is not always true. Use strlcpy() to be safe.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The board routes the Integrated Graphics Device (IGD) to an LVDS
panel, which is less popular than a PCIe based graphics card.
Disable the IGD so that it does not show up in the PCI configuration
space as a VGA display controller, so we can use an external PCIe
graphics card with whatever cable we have.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Initialize 'igd' and 'sdvo' to NULL so that we just need to test
them against NULL later, to be compatible with that case that IGD
and SDVO devices were already in disabled state.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For FSP1, there is no such INIT_PHASE_END_FIRMWARE.
Move board_final_cleanup() to fsp2 directory.
Fixes: 7c73cea442 ("x86: Notify the FSP of the 'end firmware' event")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are several outstanding issues as to why this does not apply
to FSP1:
* For FSP1, the system memory and reserved memory used by FSP are
already programmed in the MTRR by FSP.
* The 'mtrr_top' mistakenly includes TSEG memory range that has the
same RES_MEM_RESERVED resource type. Its address is programmed
and reported by FSP to be near the top of 4 GiB space, which is
not what we want for SDRAM.
* The call to mtrr_add_request() is not guaranteed to have its size
to be exactly the power of 2. This causes reserved bits of the
IA32_MTRR_PHYSMASK register to be written which generates #GP.
For FSP2, it seems this is necessary as without this, U-Boot boot
process on Chromebook Coral goes very slowly.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The resource type for system memory is currently displayed as
"unknown", which is wrong.
Fixes: 51af144eb7 ("x86: Allow showing details about a HOB entry")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the hob command usage and help messages are messed up
in a single line. They should be separated.
This was a regression introduced when [seq] and [-v] were added
to the command.
Fixes: d11544dfa9 ("x86: hob: Add way to show a single hob entry")
Fixes: 51af144eb7 ("x86: Allow showing details about a HOB entry")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The size parameter of mtrr_add_request() and mtrr_set_next_var()
shall be power of 2, otherwise the logic creates a mask that does
not meet the requirement of IA32_MTRR_PHYSMASK register.
Programming such a mask value to IA32_MTRR_PHYSMASK generates #GP.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present mtrr_commit() programs the MTRR MSRs starting from
index 0, which may overwrite MSRs that were already programmed
by previous boot stage or FSP.
Switch to call mtrr_set_next_var() instead.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Current mtrr_commit() logic assumes that MTRR MSRs are programmed
consecutively from index 0 to its maximum number, and whenever it
detects an unused one, it clears all other MTRRs starting from that
one. However this may not always be the case.
In fact, the clear is not much helpful because these MTRRs come out
of reset as disabled already. Drop the clear codes.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested on chromebook_coral, chromebook_samus, chromebook_link, minnowmax
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If for some reason, TSC timer frequency cannot be determined from
hardware, nor is it specified in the device tree, U-Boot will panic
resulting in endless reset during boot.
Let's define a default TSC timer frequency using the Kconfig value
CONFIG_X86_TSC_TIMER_FREQ (note: #include must be used instead of
/include/ otherwise the macro is not pre-processed).
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently there are two places to specify the x86 TSC timer frequency
with one in Kconfig used for early timer and the other one in device
tree used when the frequency cannot be determined from hardware.
This may potentially create an inconsistent config where the 2 values
do not match. Let's use the one specified in Kconfig in the device
tree as well.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These 2 options are no longer needed as now binman is used to build
u-boot.rom.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
binman complains when binary blobs are present:
Node '/binman/rom/intel-vga': Offset 0xfff90000 (4294508544) overlaps
with previous entry '/binman/rom/u-boot-dtb-with-ucode' ending at
0xfff9204c (4294516812)
Adjust VGA rom address to 0xfffa0000 so that u-boot.rom image can be
successfully built again.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
IRQ polarity in CSRT has the same definition as by ACPI specification
chapter 19.6.64 "Interrupt (Interrupt Resource Descriptor Macro)", i.e.
ActiveHigh is 0, and ActiveLow is 1. On Intel Tangier the DMA controller
IRQ polarity is ActiveHigh.
Note, in DSDT (see southcluster.asl) it's described correctly.
Fixes: 5e99fde34a ("x86: tangier: Populate CSRT for shared DMA controller")
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Except ICH7 SPI, all SPI flashes connected to ICH9 / Fast SPI should
have "m25p,fast-read" property present in their DT nodes.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since commit 71025f013c ("mtd: spi-nor-core: Rework hwcaps selection")
SPI flash on Intel Crown Bay board does not work anymore.
Disable CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SMART_HWCAPS until a proper fix is made to
the spi-nor core.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since commit 43c145b8b3 ("spi: ich: Correct max-size bug in ich_spi_adjust_size()")
(in v2020.04-rc1), SPI flash read no longer works with ICH SPI controller
in software sequencer mode.
ICH controller can only transfer a small number of bytes at once.
Before commit 43c145b8b3, the logic happens to make sure data.nbytes
is limited to slave->max_write_size but after commit 43c145b8b3
data.nbytes is no longer limited because slave->max_read_size is not
initialized with a valid number.
Fixes: 43c145b8b3 ("spi: ich: Correct max-size bug in ich_spi_adjust_size()")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Parameter -W for sphinx-build turns build warnings into errors. This helps
us to avoid bad patches passing Gitlab CI.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The Hitachi tx18d42vm LCD panel driver is really just initialising the
device, using bitbanged SPI, during operation there is nothing to do.
This makes the driver self contained, so drop the bogus dependency on
the legacy CONFIG_VIDEO.
This avoids the warning when building Chuwi_V7_CW0825_defconfig, since
we switched to DM_VIDEO recently.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The U-Boot port for ST-Ericsson Ux500 is currently only used on the
"stemmy" board, where U-Boot runs after firmware that already sets up
a boot splash screen. This means that the display is already on
and we can just continue using it for U-Boot.
Add a simple driver that simplifies this by reading the display
configuration (e.g. screen size, bpp) from the hardware registers.
It also checks the configured "source synchronization" - for some
displays (usually DSI command mode displays) we need to explicitly
trigger a software sync. This is done through the video_sync()
callback that triggers the sync and wait for completion.
Cc: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
sandbox TPM-emulator improvements
rST documentation and fixes for moveconfig
handle empty 'ranges' property in dtoc
patman warning for invalid tag
clean-ups to 'fdt add' command
At present if we see 'ranges' property (with no value) we assume it is a
boolean, as per the devicetree spec.
But another node may define 'ranges' with a value, forcing us to widen it
to an int array. At present this is not supported and causes an error.
Fix this and add some test cases.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
An int array can hold a single int so we should not need to do anything
in the widening operation. However due to a quirk in the code, an int[3]
widened with an int produced an int[4]. Fix this and add a test.
Fix a comment typo while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The current name is confusing because the logic is actually backwards from
what you might expect. Rename it to needs_widening() and update the
comments.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The autoboot tests are a recent addition to U-Boot, providing much-needed
coverage in this area.
A side effect of the keyed autoboot test is that this feature is enabled
in sandbox always. This changes the autoboot prompt and confuses the
pytests. Some tests become slower, for example the vboot tests take about
27s now instead of 3s.
We don't actually need this feature enabled to be able to run the tests.
Add a switch to allow sandbox to turn it on and off as needed. Use this
in the one test that needs it.
Add a command-line flag in case this is desired in normal use.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: 25c8b9f298 ("test: add first autoboot unit tests")
Reviewed-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Some of the more advanced features of this tool don't work anymore since
kconfiglib was update. Update the code accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The examples here are a bit messed up since the command does not match
the documentation. Use a different example instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This tool has nothing to do with testing. It is for refactoring code
automatically using a 'semantic patch' tool.
Create a new section for 'refactoring' and move it into there. It is
likely that other topics may fall under the same heading, such as
using moveconfig and search/replace tools.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this information is hidden away. Make it more visible by
putting it first, in an intro section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add a error in patman tool when the commit message contents an invalid
tag "Serie-.*" instead of "Series-.*".
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It seems useful to show whether the address of the Control or Working
devicetree is being shown. Add support for this. Drop the confusing 0x
prefix since the command itself only accepts hex.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is fairly easy to handle this case and it makes the emulator more
useful, since PCRs are commonly extended several times.
Add support for this, using U-Boot's sha256 support.
For now sandbox only supports a single PCR, but that is enough for the
tests that currently exist.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is the number of PCRs, so the current check is off by one. Also the
map itself should not be checked, just the resulting pcr_index, to avoid
confusing people who read the code.
Fix these problems.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the tpm2 emulator does not support storing the device state.
Add this so we can handle the normal vboot flow through the sandbox
executables (VPL->SPL etc.) with the TPM contents staying in place.
Note: sandbox has not yet been converted to use livetree for the state
information, since livetree does not yet support writing to the tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add checking as to whether the current TPM state is valid, so we can
implement reading/writing the state.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function current handles the kernel case incorrectly. Fix it, and
use the shorter TPM_HDR_LEN while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for this command, moving away from the previous approach of
hard-coding the initial data in the driver, now that the kernel-space data
has to be set up by the higher-level vboot code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this code assumes that the TPM data has been read but this may
not be the case. Refactor the code to use a separate pointer so we know
the current state of the data.
Add error checking for the data size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We want to support nvdata in TPM2 as well. To avoid code duplicating the
associated code, move it into a common file.
Drop the special-case logic for the kernel space. This can be handled by
the higher-level code now, i.e. in vboot itself.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We should not use /dev/sda and /dev/sdb in our examples. Users might
inadvertently mess up their workstation. Use /dev/sdX instead.
Remove console output like '# ' and '> ' which makes copying hard.
Set example language to bash for correct syntax-highlighting.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
iewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
CONFIG_HEXDUMP is needed to display UEFI variables using 'printenv -e'.
Enabling CONFIG_SPL_HEXDUMP only makes sense for debugging purposes.
Hence CONFIG_SPL_HEXDUMP should not be enabled by default.
The following boards currently have CONFIG_SPL_HEXDUMP=y. This includes
boards that don't use SPL at all.
axm_defconfig
imx8mm-cl-iot-gate_defconfig
imx8mm_venice_defconfig
imxrt1020-evk_defconfig
imxrt1050-evk_defconfig
kontron_sl28_defconfig
kp_imx53_defconfig
lx2160ardb_tfa_stmm_defconfig
mt7622_rfb_defconfig
octeon_ebb7304_defconfig
octeon_nic23_defconfig
qemu_arm64_defconfig
qemu_arm_defconfig
qemu-riscv32_defconfig
qemu-riscv32_smode_defconfig
qemu-riscv64_defconfig
qemu-riscv64_smode_defconfig
qemu-x86_64_defconfig
qemu-x86_defconfig
sandbox64_defconfig
sandbox_defconfig
stm32mp15_basic_defconfig
stm32mp15_trusted_defconfig
synquacer_developerbox_defconfig
taurus_defconfig
xilinx_versal_virt_defconfig
The patch only keeps it enabled on
sandbox_spl_defconfig
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When scrolling the TrueType console a buffer overrun occurs.
Fixes: a29b012037 ("video: Add a console driver that uses TrueType fonts")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Move the PSCI runtime code for H3/A23/A33 into SRAM
- Pick the environment from the actual MMC boot device (SD card vs.
eMMC)
- Plus a small improvement from Icenowy, just for good measure.
There are more Allwinner SoCs that do not have a SCP now.
When there's no SCP_ADDR macro defined, we can assume there's no SCP
available.
Drop the scp part of FIT description when SCP_ADDR does not exist.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@sipeed.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far for the H3, A23, and A33 SoCs, we use DRAM to hold the secure
monitor code (providing PSCI runtime services). And while those SoCs do
not have the secure SRAM B like older SoCs, there is enough (secure)
SRAM A2 to put the monitor code and data in there instead.
Follow the design of 64-bit SoCs and use the first part for the monitor,
and the last 16 KiB for the SCP firmware. With this change, the monitor
no longer needs to reserve a region in DRAM.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
[Andre: amend commit message, fix R40 and V3s build]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Currently, the environment is always stored in eMMC if eMMC is enabled
in the config. This means images written to SD and eMMC will cross-
contaminate their environments unless the configuration is changed.
By dropping the device number from the environment location string and
implementing mmc_get_env_dev, we will always use the environment from
the boot device when booting from SD/eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Static inline function _debug_uart_init() should avoid calling external
(non-inline) functions. Therefore do not call get_ref_clk() in
_debug_uart_init() and reimplement its functionality without external
function calls.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
CONFIG_BAUDRATE should be used for setting the baudrate for the early debug
UART. This replaces current hardcoded 115200 value.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behun <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Enable DM SATA, removed IDE driver, and add SATA MV driver.
- Use ethernet PHY names from device tree in default boot command
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In DM Ethernet, the old "egiga0" and 'egiga1" names are no longer valid,
so replace these with Ethernet PHY names from device tree. Also, read
Ethernet PHY address for each port from device tree.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The PWM pins on North Bridge on Armada 37xx can be configured into PWM
or GPIO functions. When in PWM function, each pin can also be configured
to drive low on 0 and tri-state on 1 (LED mode).
The current definitions handle this by declaring two pin groups for each
pin:
- group "pwmN" with functions "pwm" and "gpio"
- group "ledN_od" ("od" for open drain) with functions "led" and "gpio"
This is semantically incorrect. The correct definition for each pin
should be one group with three functions: "pwm", "led" and "gpio".
Change the "pwmN" groups to support "led" function.
Remove "ledN_od" groups. This cannot break backwards compatibility with
older device trees: no device tree uses it since there is no PWM driver
for this SOC yet. Also "ledN_od" groups are not even documented.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Extracting is now supported by dumpimage, so mention it in help instead
of `kwbimage -x`.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The kwbimage library does not support extracting subimages. Implement it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The gdsys a38x config file (controlcenterdc_defconfig) uses BootROM to
load U-Boot proper.
Since it is now possible to do this via U-Boot SPL framework, we do not
need to provide custom spl_board_init() which calls return_to_bootrom().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This padding depends on board config file and therefore it makes the
mkimage binary tool board specific, which is not correct. One cannot use
mkimage tool built as a result for board A to generate images for board
B, even if both A and B are on the same platform.
This CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS padding was needed when kwbimage v1 contained
SPL code which loaded U-Boot proper based on CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS,
instead of reading correct offset from kwbimage header.
Now that SPL code parses kwbimage header and deterinate correct offset,
there is no need for this CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS padding anymore.
By removing it we also reduce the size of SPL code and therefore also
decrease the final size of v1 kwbimage. This means there is more space
for U-Boot proper binary.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The SPL code now already parses kwbimage v1 headers where all necessary
information about how to load and execute U-Boot proper is present. The
legacy 64-byte U-Boot header is not used anymore.
Remove this 64-byte header by putting u-boot.bin binary (instead of
u-boot.img) into kwbimage v1 and let SPL code or BootROM to load U-Boot
directly at its execution address.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Now that proper load and execution addresses are set in v1 kwbimage we
can use it for loading and booting U-Boot proper.
Use the new spl_parse_board_header() function to implement parsing the
kwbimage v1 header. Use information from this header to locate offset and
size of the U-Boot proper binary, instead of using the legacy U-Boot
header which is prepended to the U-Boot proper binary stored at fixed
offset. This has the advantage that we do not need to relay on legacy
U-Boot header anymore and therefore U-Boot proper binary can be stored at
any offset, as is the case when loading & booting U-Boot proper by
BootROM. The CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS option is therefore not used by SPL
code anymore.
Also allow to compile U-Boot SPL without CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT,
CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT or CONFIG_SPL_SATA_SUPPORT set. In this case
BootROM is used for loading and executing U-Boot proper. This reduces the
size of U-Boot's SPL image. By default these config options are enabled
and so BootROM loading is not used. In some cases BootROM reads from SPI
NOR at lower speed than U-Boot SPL. So people can decide whether they
want to have smaller SPL binary at the cost of slower boot.
Therefore dependency on CONFIG_SPL_DM_SPI, CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT,
CONFIG_SPL_SPI_LOAD, CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT, CONFIG_SPL_DM_GPIO,
CONFIG_SPL_DM_MMC, CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT, CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT,
CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT, CONFIG_SPL_SATA_SUPPORT and
CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT is changed from strict to related "imply"
(which can be selectivelly turned off and causes booting via BootROM).
Options CONFIG_SYS_SPI_U_BOOT_OFFS,
CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR and
CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_DATA_PART_OFFSET have to to be set to
zero as they define the location where kwbimage header starts. It is the
location where BootROM expects start of the kwbimage from which it reads,
parses and executes SPL part. The same applies to option
CONFIG_SPL_SATA_RAW_U_BOOT_SECTOR, which has to be set to one.
Update all config files to set correct values of these options and set
CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS to the correct value - the offset where U-Boot
proper starts.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Platform specific BootROM may use its own image type for loading SPL or
U-Boot proper. In some cases it makes sense to not use BootROM supplied
code for booting U-Boot proper but rather to use U-Boot SPL for this,
e.g. when U-Boot SPL can load U-Boot proper faster than BootROM. In this
case it is required for platform board code to parse and load U-Boot in
BootROM specific image type.
This change adds support for parsing platform / board / BootROM specific
image types via weak function spl_parse_board_header() which is called
before marking boot image as a raw.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Some image types (e.g. kwbimage v1) store the offset to SPL binary and
offset to U-Boot proper binary in their headers. To avoid reading SPL
binary when loading U-Boot proper, add support for specifying offset in
struct spl_image_info, which defines the offset from the beginning of
the header and the beginning of the executable data.
Initial support is added only for SPI, MMC and SATA code. We can extend
it later if needed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Current code uses hack in board_init_f() which calls return_to_bootrom()
to skip U-Boot SPL code and return back to BootROM to load U-Boot via
UART or from NAND.
This change migrates that hack from the board_init_f() function and
changes it to return BOOT_DEVICE_BOOTROM instead of returning to BootROM
directly, so that U-Boot's SPL framework is used for returning to
BootROM.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
U-Boot's SPL framework already has an API for loading U-Boot via
BootROM.
Implement the function board_return_to_bootrom() for mvebu SPL code.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Register r0 should be set to return value 0x0 - NO_ERR.
Set r0 with return value after all registers are restored from the
stack, so that the return value is always correct.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 944c7a3176 ("arm: mvebu: Add option to use UART xmodem protocol via kwboot")
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Function image_version() returns unsigned value, so it can never be
negative. Explicitly check for two supported image versions: v0 and v1.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Call tcsetattr() only if the file descriptor is valid. It may be
invalidated by previous lines (if it is not a tty descriptor).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The 'buf' variable is a pointer and '_buf' is the array itself.
Therefore we should pass sizeof(_buf) instead of sizeof(buf) to read().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
There is no code for extracting data from kwbimage, so show an error
message when user tries this via e.g. dumpimage call:
./tools/dumpimage -T kwbimage -o /tmp/out u-boot-spl.kwb
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Trying to call the following command causes NULL pointer dereference in
strlen():
./tools/dumpimage -T kwbimage -o /tmp/out u-boot-spl.kwb
Fix it by checking whether params->imagename is non-NULL before calling
strlen().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
These structures must have specific size without padding, so mark them as
packed via the de-facto standard macro __packed. Also replace PACKED
macro.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The mkimage host tool can be used to generate kwbimage v1 image with
secure header on host system for A38x plaform also when U-Boot is being
compiled for different platform. So there is no reason to not allow
compiling of mkimage/kwbimage with secure header support for e.g. x86-64
host.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
This command is supported only by v1 images and specifies a milliseconds
delay after executing some set of DATA commands. The special string value
SDRAM_SETUP instructs BootROM to setup SDRAM controller instead of
executing delay. SDRAM_SETUP may be specified only once and after the
last DATA command.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The DATA command is already supported by mkimage for v0 images, but not
for v1 images.
BootROM code which executes v1 images also supports DATA command via an
optional extended v1 header OPT_HDR_V1_REGISTER_TYPE.
Implement support for DATA command for v1 images.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The PAYLOAD keyword does nothing. No code is using it and both mkimage
and kwbimage completely ignore it. It looks like a relict from the past.
The payload image itself can be specified only via -d parameter to
mkimage.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Binary header consist of:
* 1 byte for header type
* 3 bytes for header size
* 1 byte for number of arguments
* 3 reserved bytes
* N*4 bytes for arguments
* M bytes (aligned to 4 bytes) for executable data
* 1 byte for information about next header
* 3 reserved bytes
The first four bytes are specified as
sizeof(struct opt_hdr_v1)
and the remaining bytes as
ALIGN(s.st_size, 4) + (binarye->binary.nargs + 2) * sizeof(uint32_t)
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The number is stored in one byte, so the maximum should be 255.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The data part of v1 kwbimage currently contains U-Boot binary prepended
by 64 bytes long Legacy U-Boot image header. This means that the load
address is currently substracted by 64 bytes to ensure that U-Boot's
entry point is at specified execution address.
As mkimage has already separate arguments for load (-a) and execution
(-e) address, there is no need to derive fixed load address from
execution address.
Therefore remove this load address hack from the kwbimage tool and
support generating v1 kwbimage with arbitrary addresses for load and
execution.
Finally, calculate correct load address by caller for mkimage tool in
Makefile. File u-boot-spl.kwb is always a v1 kwbimage and it is the only
v1 kwbimage which U-Boot's build system generates.
Remove also useless overwriting of destaddr for /binary.0 to the value
which is already set on previous lines.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The binary header in kwbimage contains executable SPL code.
Print information about this binary header and not only information
about it's data part.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Extended header checksum for v0 image is present only in the case when
extended header is present. Skip checksum validation if extended header
is not present.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
In the case when the file name is specified relative to the current
working directory, it does not contain '/' character and strrchr()
returns NULL.
The following strcmp() function then crashes on NULL pointer
dereference.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
SATA and SDIO images must be aligned to sector size (which in most cases
is 512 bytes) and Source Address in main header is stored in number of
sectors from the beginning of the drive. SATA image must be stored at
sector 1 and SDIO image at sector 0. Source Address for PCIe image is
not used and must be set to 0xFFFFFFFF.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Writing into SPI NOR and NAND memory can be done only in 256 bytes long
blocks. Align final image size so that when it is burned into SPI NOR or
NAND memory via U-Boot's commands (sf or mtd), we can use the $filesize
variable directly as the length argument.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The return value of kwbimage_generate() is used for aligning the data
part of kwbimage. Use it for calculating proper 4 byte alignment as is
required by BootROM and also use it for allocating additional 4 bytes
for the 32-bit data checksum.
This simplifies the alignment code to be only at one place (in function
kwbimage_generate) and also simplifies setting checksum as it can be
directly updated in memory.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
The CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS option may be defined as empty string.
In this case it causes compilation error:
tools/kwbimage.c: In function ‘image_headersz_v1’:
tools/kwbimage.c:1002:39: error: expected expression before ‘)’ token
if (headersz > CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS) {
^
tools/kwbimage.c:1006:41: error: expected expression before ‘)’ token
(int)headersz, CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS);
^
tools/kwbimage.c:1011:35: error: expected expression before ‘;’ token
headersz = CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS;
^
make[1]: *** [scripts/Makefile.host:112: tools/kwbimage.o] Error 1
make: *** [Makefile:1822: tools] Error 2
Check whether the value of CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_OFFS is really set.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
With the introduction of a generic reboot flag implemented in commit
a362ce214f ("fastboot: Implement generic fastboot_set_reboot_flag"), we
no longer need the custom PSCI implementation to handle the reboot reason.
This reverts commit 9a34dedfae.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Whenever we test for boot-fastboot in the BCB, it means that Android
wants us to boot into recovery with a special mode (fastbootd).
Force reboot into recovery in that case.
Note: we don't erase the bcb on purpose here: recoveryOS needs to read
the BCB as well to know if it boots into regular recovery mode or
fastbootd mode.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Right now meson64_android does not know how to boot into Android
Recovery: it simply falls back to "fastboot" mode in the bootloader.
Implement the boot to recovery.
While at it, use the standard BCB way instead of a sm for consistency.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
As of today, we use a "vendor specific" secure monitor call for the
reboot reason (sm).
We should not need this. Android uses the BCB (Bootloader Control Block)
to communicate with the bootloader.
Implement "reboot into bootloader" using the standard BCB way instead of
using sm calls.
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
For the eMMC on ST-Ericsson Ux500v2 we need slightly different
configuration values. Use the existing switch statement to match
the peripheral ID of Ux500v2 (0x10480180) and override the necessary
values to make the eMMC work on devices with ST-Ericsson Ux500.
Cc: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com> on stm32f769-disco
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Simplify the code a bit by using the common mmc_of_parse() function
instead of duplicating the device tree parsing code. We can still get
a default value for cfg->f_max by assigning it before calling
mmc_of_parse().
Another advantage of this refactoring is that we parse more properties
now, e.g. "non-removable" can be used to disable CD entirely.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com> on stm32f769-disco
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The arm,primecell compatible is used for lots of different types
of devices, e.g. I2C, SPI, coresight, ... We really should not bind
the MMC driver to all of them.
Looking through the device trees in U-Boot there seems to be always
a second compatible string for the pl180 device, either arm,pl180
(already listed) or arm,pl18x. Add the "arm,pl18x" compatible to the
list but remove the generic "arm,primecell".
Note that on Linux these compatibles cannot be found in drivers
because AMBA/primecell devices are matched based on their peripheral ID
instead of the compatible.
This fixes the following error messages when booting the ST-Ericsson
U8500 "stemmy" board with the arm_pl180_mmci driver enabled:
MMC: ptm@801ae000 - probe failed: -38
ptm@801af000 - probe failed: -38
funnel@801a6000 - probe failed: -38
tpiu@80190000 - probe failed: -38
etb@801a4000 - probe failed: -38
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Fixes: 6f41d1a17e ("mmc: arm_pl180_mmci: Sync compatible with kernel")
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com> on stm32f769-disco
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Fix mmc_rpmb_route_frames() implementation to comply with most MMC
drivers that expect some alignment of MMC data frames in memory.
When called from drivers/tee/optee/rpmb.c, the address passed is not
aligned properly. OP-TEE OS inserts a 6-byte header before a raw RPMB
frame which makes RPMB data buffer not 32bit aligned. To prevent breaking
ABI with OPTEE-OS RPC memrefs, allocate a temporary buffer to copy the
data into an aligned memory.
Many RPMB drivers implicitly expect 32bit alignment of the eMMC frame
including arm_pl180_mmci.c, sandbox_mmc.c and stm32_sdmmc2.c
Signed-off-by: Timothée Cercueil <timothee.cercueil@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Timothée Cercueil <litchi.pi@protonmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
To display the bootup logo, we read the gpt and assume that the
partition with index "2" will be the "logo" partition.
This might not always be the case, and it's very error-prone.
Load the logo partition by label instead of by index.
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
To boot Android, we read the gpt and assume that the partition with
index "1" will be the "boot" partition.
This might not always be the case, as there are no requirements from
Android on the partition order.
However, Android does seem to use the "boot" label quite a lot on their
public documentation [1]
Load the boot partition by label instead of by index
[1] https://source.android.com/devices/bootloader/partitions
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The PADCONFIG_202 register (0x02621328) is affected by the locking
of the RSTMUX8 register (0x02620328), and so cannot be configured
in kernel. This has been confirmed as a hardware bug and affects
all K2G SoCs.
Setup the pinmux for this pin before locking the RSTMUX8 register
to allow the ICSS1 PRU1 Ethernet PHY port to work properly. The
workaround was added only for the K2G-ICE board to configure the
pins needed for the PRUSS Ethernet usecase.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726232248.24395-1-s-anna@ti.com
This patch adds the possibility to pass the PIN the OpenSSL Engine
used during signing via the environment variable MKIMAGE_SIGN_PIN.
This follows the approach used during kernel module
signing ("KBUILD_SIGN_PIN") or UBIFS image
signing ("MKIMAGE_SIGN_PIN").
Signed-off-by: Marc Kleine-Budde <mkl@pengutronix.de>
Some builds of squashfs-tools append version string with "-git" or
similar. The float() conversion will fail in this case.
Improve the code to only convert to float() the string before the '-'
character.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
With LTO activated, the buildman tools failed with an error on my
configuration (Ubuntu 20.04, stm32mp15_trusted_defconfig) with the error:
../arm-linux-gnueabi/bin/nm:
scripts/gen_ll_addressable_symbols.sh: file format not recognized
It seems the shell variable initialization NM=$(NM) is not correctly
interpreted when shell is started in the Makefile, but I have not this
issue when I compile the same target without buildman.
I don't found the root reason of the problem but I solve it by
providing $(NM) as script parameter instead using a shell variable.
The command executed is identical:
cmd_keep-syms-lto.c := NM=arm-none-linux-gnueabihf-gcc-nm \
u-boot/scripts/gen_ll_addressable_symbols.sh arch/arm/cpu/built-in.o \
.... net/built-in.o >keep-syms-lto.c
cmd_keep-syms-lto.c := u-boot/scripts/gen_ll_addressable_symbols.sh \
arm-none-linux-gnueabihf-gcc-nm arch/arm/cpu/built-in.o \
... net/built-in.o > keep-syms-lto.c
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
*sig_size isn't set until later so use the correct variables.
Signed-off-by: Donald Chan <hoiho@lab126.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At early U-Boot stage, before relocation, MMU is not yet configured
and disabled. DDR may not be configured with the correct memory
attributes (can be configured in MT_DEVICE instead of MT_MEMORY).
In this case, usage of memcpy_{from, to}io() may leads to synchronous
abort in AARCH64 in case the normal memory address is not 64Bits aligned.
To avoid such situation, forbid usage of normal memory cast to (u64 *) in
case MMU is not enabled.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Cc: mark.kettenis@xs4all.nl
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Align reset_cpu function with the next prototypes in
sysreset.h or in cpu_func.h to solve compilation issue:
void reset_cpu(void);
This patch solves the prototype conflict when cpu_func.h is
included.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
These are out of date. Update them and point to the existing build
instructions to avoid duplication. Add a few that are missing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this driver assumes that ulong is 64-bits long. On 32-bit
machines it is not. Use the 64-bit code only on 64-bit machines.
This makes things work correctly on 32-bit machines.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This rule should not be in the top-level Makefile. Now that we have a
consistent set of I2C Kconfigs for U-Boot proper, SPL and TPL, we can move
it.
Make use of the existing SPL/TPL rule in drivers/Makefile instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rename these options so that CONFIG_IS_ENABLED can be used with them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
At present we have CONFIG_SPL_I2C but not CONFIG_I2C. The reason
CONFIG_I2C is not strictly necessary is that:
a) We have CONFIG_SYS_I2C_LEGACY and CONFIG_DM_I2C for the two possible
i2c stacks
b) In U-Boot proper, we always build drivers/i2c/ regardless of the
options
Still, it is better to have CONFIG_I2C - it makes U-Boot proper similar to
SPL/TPL, so we can (in a future commit) simplify the Makefile rules.
Enable it by default, since as above, we have separate options
(SYS_I2C_LEGACY and DM_I2C) to control whether it is 'really' enabled.
Once we have migrated I2C to driver model, we can drop SYS_I2C_LEGACY and
make DM_I2C become I2C. For now, this lets us simplify the Makefile rules.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This actually does nothing but is defined by a few dozen boards. Drop it,
so we can define a real one.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
While there is a CONFIG_I2C it does not really mean anything and is
defined by only a few dozen boards. This should key off
CONFIG_SYS_I2C_LEGACY instead.
Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
It is quite confusing that CONFIG_SYS_I2C selects the legacy I2C and
CONFIG_DM_I2C selects the current I2C. The deadline to migrate I2C is less
than a year away.
Also we want to have a CONFIG_I2C for U-Boot proper just like we have
CONFIG_SPL_I2C for SPL, so we can simplify the Makefile rules.
Rename this symbol so it is clear it is going away.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Rename this option so that CONFIG_IS_ENABLED can be used with it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
These don't belong in the drivers Makefile so move them down into
the correct place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Fixup some missing dependencies this exposed]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Adjust the subdirectories included in this file so that they are in
alphabetical order. This makes it easier to follow.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than looking at two KConfig options in the Makefile, create a new
Kconfig option for compiling lib/charset.c
Enable it for UFS also, which needs this support.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
It is bad practice to put function declarations behind an #ifdef since
it makes it impossible to use IS_ENABLED() in the C code. The main reason
for doing this is when an empty static inline function is desired when
the feature is disabled.
To this end, this header provides two different versions of various
functions and macros. Collect them together in one place for clarity.
Allow all the rest of the header to be included, regardless of the
setting of EFI_LOADER.
With the inclusion of blk.h the 'struct blk_desc' declaration is
unnecessary. Drop it while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since the ACPI-generation code makes use of UUIDs we typically need to
enabled UUID support for it to build. Add a new Kconfig condition.
Use it for BTRFS also.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This file does not correctly handle the various cases, sometimes
producing warnings about partition_basic_data_guid being defined but not
used. Fix it.
There was some discussion about adjusting Kconfig or making
HAVE_BLOCK_DEVICE a prerequisite for PARTITIONS, but apparently this is
not feasible. Such changes can be undertaken separate from the goal of
this series.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present when using 'make mrproper' on an out-of-tree build, a warning
is shown about include/asm being a directory. With old versions of U-Boot
it is a file, but more recently it has become a directory.
Remove this directory first, since that covers both cases.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The aarch64 catch-all job is starting to get close to or exceed the time
limit for jobs. Move the i.MX8 boards to their own job to fix this.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Add usage for the setexpr command. It has been added to describe
mainly the new setexpr format string operation.
Signed-off-by: Roland Gaudig <roland.gaudig@weidmueller.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add format string handling operator to the setexpr command.
It allows to use C or Bash like format string expressions to be
evaluated with the result being stored inside the environment variable
name.
setexpr <name> fmt <format> [value]...
The following example
setexpr foo fmt "%d, 0x%x" 0x100 ff
will result in $foo being set to "256, 0xff".
Signed-off-by: Roland Gaudig <roland.gaudig@weidmueller.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Import the following helper functions from Busybox-1.33.1 which are
required by printf.c:
process_escape_sequence from libbb/process_escape_sequence.c,
skip_whitespace from libbb/skip_whitespace.c,
overlapping_strcpy from libbb/safe_strncpy.c
src-url: https://git.busybox.net/busybox/
commit bcc5b0e6caca6c7602a6a41f "Bump version to 1.33.1"
version: 1.33.1
Signed-off-by: Roland Gaudig <roland.gaudig@weidmueller.com>
Import printf.c from the Busybox project, which provides Bash like
format string handling.
src-url: https://git.busybox.net/busybox/
commit bcc5b0e6caca6c7602a6a41f "Bump version to 1.33.1"
version: 1.33.1
Signed-off-by: Roland Gaudig <roland.gaudig@weidmueller.com>
Add simple_strtoll function for converting a string containing digits
into a long long int value.
Signed-off-by: Roland Gaudig <roland.gaudig@weidmueller.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Add SMBIOS info for Khadas VIM boards
- Fix meson-axg-mipi PHY build
- Fix VIM3 board phy-names property setup
- Return correct value for non emmc boot sources on VIM3
- add kernel compression vars
- FIP Enable OP-TEE and TZC support in SPL for STM32MP15 SoC
- Add stm32mp15 missing SPI clock support
- Manage pull-up on gpio button STM32MP15 boards
- Correct STM32MP15 boot when TAMPER registers are invalid
- Fix EMMC pinmux on STM32MP15 Avenger96 board
Khadas vim series: Use devicetree for SMBIOS settings
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
With commit 84a42ae366 ("dm: core: Rename device node to indicate it
is private") and commit f10643cf8a ("dm: core: Access device ofnode
through functions") accesses to the "node" member were replaced with
dev_ofnode(). Also apply that replacement here.
Fixes: 4547551aa0 ("phy: Add Amlogic AXG MIPI PCIe Analog PHY driver")
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
With commit 41575d8e4c ("dm: treewide: Rename auto_alloc_size members
to be shorter") "priv_auto_alloc_size" was renamed to "priv_auto". Apply
the rename to these two drivers as well.
Fixes: 4547551aa0 ("phy: Add Amlogic AXG MIPI PCIe Analog PHY driver")
Fixes: 7ef19503ba ("phy: Add Amlogic AXG MIPI D-PHY driver")
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
need return -1 if boot source is not EMMC or SD ( for example it will be
useful if we have multy env sources configuration and device was booted
from SPI flash and env need read from SPI not from mmc )
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
make possible to load simple compressed linux kernel for meson64
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add the "/reserved-memory/optee" node to the SPL devicetree. The
purpose is to allow configuring TZC regions when booting OP-TEE.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
OP-TEE is very particular about how the TZC should be configured.
When booting an OP-TEE payload, an incorrect TZC configuration will
result in a panic.
Most information can be derived from the SPL devicetree. The only
information we don't have is the split between TZDRAM and shared
memory. This has to be hardcoded. The rest of the configuration is
fairly easy, and only requires 3 TZC regions. Configure them.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The purpose of this change is to allow configuring TrustZone (TZC)
memory permissions. For example, OP-TEE expects TZC regions to be
configured in a very particular way. The API presented here is
intended to allow exactly that.
UCLASS support is not implemented, because it would not be too useful.
Changing TZC permissions needs to be done with care, so as not to cut
off access to memory we are currently using. One place where we can
use this is at the end of SPL, right before jumping to OP-TEE.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
OP-TEE requires some particular setup, which is not needed for linux
or other payloads. Add a hook for platform-specific code to perform
any OP-TEE related configuration and initialization.
A weak function is used because it is symmetrical to other
spl_board_prepare_for_*() implementations. A solution to avoid the use
of weak functions would trivially apply to all these implementations.
However, re-designing this is beyond the scope of this patch.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In general, Falcon mode means we're booting a linux kernel directly.
With FIT images, however, an OP-TEE secure kernel can be booted before
linux. Thus, if the next stage is an IH_OS_TEE, this isn't necessarily
a problem.
Of course, a general solution would involve mmc_load_image_raw_os()
only loading the binary, and leaving the decision of suitability to
someone else. However, a rework of the boot flow is beyond the scope
of this patch. Accept IH_OS_TEE as a valid OS value.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Commit 500327e2ea ("ARM: dts: stm32mp1: DT alignment with Linux kernel v5.8-rc1")
renamed sdmmc2_d47_pins_b phandle to sdmmc2_d47_pins_c, but without updating
the AV96 DT which uses that phandle. Linux missed similar update as well and
it was only added in commit 1ad6e36ec266 ("ARM: dts: stm32: Fix sdmmc2 pins
on AV96") .
Update the AV96 DT pinmux phandle, otherwise eMMC 8bit mode does not work
and access to eMMC takes a very long time to fall back to 4bit mode.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add the missing SPI clock even if these instances are not available
on STMicroelectronics boards: SPI2_K, SPI3_K, SPI4_K, SPI6_K.
With this patch, the SPI2 / SPI3 / SPI4 / SPI6 instances can be used on
customer design without the clock driver error:
stm32mp1_clk_get_id: clk id 131 not found
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
When a push-button is released and PA13/PA14 are defined as input (high-Z)
the LED should not be active as the circuit is open but a small current
leak through PCB or push-button close the circuit and allows a small LED
bias giving erroneous level voltage.
So it is recommended to activate an internal pull-up in order to clearly
fix the voltage at PA13/PA14 when button is released and to wait
a short delay before to read the GPIO value only when the pull-up is
correctly configured.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
When the TAMP register 20 have an invalid value (0x0 for example after
TAMPER error) the "boot_device" U-Boot env variable have no value and
no error is displayed in U-Boot log.
The STM32MP boot command bootcmd_stm32mp failed with strange trace:
"Boot over !"
and the next command in bootcmd_stm32mp failed with few indication:
if test ${boot_device} = serial || test ${boot_device} = usb;
then stm32prog ${boot_device} ${boot_instance};
As it is difficult to investigate, the current patch avoids this issue:
- change the debug message to error: "unexpected boot mode" is displayed
- display trace "Boot over invalid!" in bootcmd_stm32mp
- execute "run distro_bootcmd" to try all the possible target
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The J721E R5 SPL will no longer support booting of the Main R5FSS Core0
after the R5 SPL re-architecture for System Firmware split. The MCU R5F
branch-only boot does not use the K3 R5F remoteproc driver, and relies
only on the filesystem (FS) support for now. The K3 R5F remoteproc driver
is therefore no longer needed in R5 SPL, so drop it from the J721E R5
defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726211311.5977-6-s-anna@ti.com
The MAIN R5FSS0 cluster and corresponding nodes are no longer required
to be enabled in R5 SPL after removing the support for booting any core
from this cluster on R5 SPL. So, remove these from the relevant dts
files.
This is essentially a revert of the additions done in commit 2984b82b3b
("arm: dts: k3-j721e-r5: Enable r5fss0 cluster in SPL").
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726211311.5977-5-s-anna@ti.com
The mach-k3 common code defined a weak start_non_linux_remote_cores()
function so that the proper implementation can be plugged in the
SoC-specific source files. This won't be needed anymore, so remove the
the common code.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726211311.5977-4-s-anna@ti.com
The common J7 specific start_non_linux_remote_cores() override function
implements the logic to load and boot the Main R5FSS Core0 from R5 SPL.
This won't be supported any more for either J721E or J7200 after the R5
SPL rearchitecture for the System Firmware split into TI Foundation
Security (TIFS) and Device Management (DM) firmwares. So, cleanup the
corresponding code and the related SPL env variables.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726211311.5977-3-s-anna@ti.com
The Main R5FSS Core0 on J721E SoCs is originally booted from R5 SPL
itself to achieve certain product-level early-boot metrics. This is
no longer supported after the R5 SPL re-architecture (support merged
for v2021.10-rc1). Move the booting of this core altogether from R5
SPL to A72 U-Boot.
The env variables are left as is for now, and will be cleaned up
in a subsequent patch.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726211311.5977-2-s-anna@ti.com
The default U-Boot environment variables and design are all set up to
have the MCU R5FSS cluster to be in Split-mode. This is the setting
in v2021.01 U-Boot and the dt nodes are synched with the kernel binding
property names in commit 468ec2f3ef ("remoteproc: k3_r5: Sync to
upstreamed kernel DT property names") merged in v2021.04-rc2.
The mode for the cluster got switched back to LockStep mode by mistake
in commit e497876343 ("arm: dts: k3-am65: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts
into U-Boot") also in v2021.04-rc2. This throws the following warning
messages when early-booting the cores using default env variables,
k3_r5f_rproc r5f@41400000: Invalid op: Trying to start secondary core 2 in lockstep mode
Load Remote Processor 1 with data@addr=0x82000000 65268 bytes: Failed!
Fix this by switching back the cluster to the expected Split-mode.
Make this mode change in the u-boot specific dtsi file to avoid such
sync overrides in the future until the kernel dts is also switched to
Split-mode by default.
Fixes: e497876343 ("arm: dts: k3-am65: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726162213.28719-1-s-anna@ti.com
Kconfig symbols for SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV and SYS_MMC_ENV_PART have been added by
commit 7d08077334. Therefore, move the
definitions of configs to corresponding board defconfig files and enable
configs to save env in eMMC.
Also enable config for FAT write in U-Boot.
Fixes: 33b7258947 ("board: ti: am64x: Add board support for am64x evm")
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726152807.22991-5-a-govindraju@ti.com
A Wilink wireless device is connected to MMCSD0 subsystem and is not
supported in U-Boot. Therefore, disable main_sdhci0 device tree node in
U-Boot.
If main_sdhci0 device tree node is disabled then the the index of
main_sdhci1 node becomes 0 which leads to break in boot flow. Therefore,
add an alias to fix the index to 1.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726152807.22991-3-a-govindraju@ti.com
CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE was set to 0x70000000 in the commit,
"26f32c32b250 configs: am64x_evm_*_defconfig: Rearrange the components in
SRAM to satisfy the limitations for USB DFU boot mode". This change seems
to have been dropped during a merge commit.
Therefore, fix this by setting CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE to 0x70000000.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210726145840.18977-1-a-govindraju@ti.com
MAIN CPSW0 requires the PHY to be powered on and reset for QSGMII
operation. Add a env variable to configure driving "0" on ENET_EXP_PWRDN
controlled by GPIO EXPANDER2 (I2C Addr: 0x22), PIN: 17 and driving "1"
on ENET_EXP_RESETZ controlled by GPIO EXPANDER2 (I2C Addr: 0x22),
PIN: 18.
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210721155849.20994-18-kishon@ti.com
Configure the parent clock of wiz3_pll0_refclk to the internal clock
required for USB3 to be functional and also remove "ti,usb2-only"
property as it now supports USB3 mode. This has properties specific to
u-boot on top of DT present in v5.13 of Linux Kernel.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210721155849.20994-12-kishon@ti.com
Add support for WIZ module present in TI's J721E SoC. WIZ is a SERDES
wrapper used to configure some of the input signals to the SERDES. It is
used with both Sierra(16G) and Torrent(10G) SERDES. This driver configures
three clock selects (pll0, pll1, dig) and supports resets for each of the
lanes.
This is an adaptation of the linux driver.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210721155849.20994-10-kishon@ti.com
Add a Sierra PHY driver with PCIe and USB support.
This driver is a port from the mainline linux driver.
The PHY has multiple lanes, which can be configured into
groups, and a generic PHY device is created for each group.
There are two resets controlling the overall PHY block, one
to enable the APB interface for programming registers, and
another to enable the PHY itself. Additionally there are
resets for each PHY lane.
The PHY can be configured in hardware to read register
settings from ROM, or they can be written by the driver.
The sequence of operation on startup is to enable the APB
bus, write the PHY registers (if required) for each lane
group, and then enable the PHY. Each group of lanes
can then be individually controlled using the power_on()/
power_off() function for that generic PHY
One difference with the linux driver is that the PHY is
always reset after it is powered-on. This is because role
switching is not supported in u-boot and the cable
orientation is handled by the PHY reset.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Alan Douglas <adouglas@cadence.com>
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210721155849.20994-8-kishon@ti.com
This device tree is imported from Linux 5.13.1 and enabled via the
am335x board file and the am335x evm defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Paul Barker <paul.barker@sancloud.com>
These device trees are updated to match the versions in Linux 5.13.1.
The tick-timer entry in am335x-bone-common.dtsi is preserved.
Signed-off-by: Paul Barker <paul.barker@sancloud.com>
It is useful to have a board with unit tests enabled, to check that this
does not break.
Let's choose snow, since it is not under active development and it is
glorious.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Add a bus driver for this and use it to configure the bus parameters for
the Ethernet interface. Drop the old pre-driver-model code.
Switch over to use driver model for Ethernet.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Move the PHY properties from DWC3 node to USB node in ZynqMP DTs as here
the USB3 PHY used is PSGTR, which is connected to Xilinx USB core. This
PHY initialization should be handled from Xilinx USB core as the
prerequisite register configurations are done here only.
Signed-off-by: Manish Narani <manish.narani@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add kernel_comp_addr_r, kernel_comp_size env variables for zynqmp and
versal to be able to use the compressed kernel Image(.gz,.bz2,.lzma,.lzo)
using booti command.
Signed-off-by: Raju Kumar Pothuraju <raju.kumar-pothuraju@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
It is default value which had been converted by commit 432e398068
("include/configs: drop default definitions of CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE"). That's
why also remove it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
reset and poweroff are called via hooks in psci driver which is going
around sysreset framework that's why enable sysreset drivers and do reset
and poweroff via this framework. Using this flow will allow us to call
SYSTEM_WARM_RESET based on psci 1.1 spec which can be calles with reset -w
command.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The SPL can also be compiled with sysreset drivers just fine, so
update the condition to cater for that option.
The same change was done by commit efa1a62ad2 ("ARM: imx8m: Do not define
do_reset() if sysreset is enabled").
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
CONFIG_SYSRESET_CMD_POWEROFF defines do_poweroff() in sysreset-uclass.c
that's why don't define it twice when both CONFIG_SYSRESET_CMD_POWEROFF and
CONFIG_CMD_POWEROFF are enabled. CONFIG_SYSRESET_CMD_POWEROFF depends on
CONFIG_CMD_POWEROFF.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add support for xilinx multirate(MRMAC) ethernet driver.
This driver uses multichannel DMA(MCDMA) for data transfers of MRMAC.
Added support for 4 ports of MRMAC for speeds 10G and 25G.
MCDMA supports upto 16 channels but in this driver we have setup only
one channel which is enough.
Tested 10G and 25G on all 4 ports.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add speed macro's for higher ethernet speeds to be used in u-boot
networking drivers. Added Macros for speeds 14G, 20G, 25G, 40G, 50G,
56G, 100G and 200G inline with linux.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
lpd_lsbus is clock which is used by many IPs like dmas, gems, gpio, sdhcis,
spis, ttcs, uarts, watchdog that's why make sense to also enable access to
change this clock. For this clock you already get the rate.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The board zynqmp-zc1751-xm016-dc2 support only USB2.0.
This patch removes USB3.0 DT configuration for DC2 board.
Signed-off-by: Piyush Mehta <piyush.mehta@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The system refuses to boot without any environment, so return ENVL_NOWHERE when
there's nowhere to store the environment instead of ENVL_UNKNOWN.
This fixes that the board won't boot from eMMC when CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FAT is not
defined, for example. Similar for other combinations.
Fixes: 1025bd098a "xilinx: zynqmp: Add support for saving variables"
Signed-off-by: Mike Looijmans <mike.looijmans@topic.nl>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
All these variables/structure are local and should be static.
Issues are reported by sparse:
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:49:11: warning: symbol 'zynqmp_iclk_phases' was not declared. Should it be static?
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:50:11: warning: symbol 'zynqmp_oclk_phases' was not declared. Should it be static?
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:53:11: warning: symbol 'versal_iclk_phases' was not declared. Should it be static?
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:54:11: warning: symbol 'versal_oclk_phases' was not declared. Should it be static?
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:546:24: warning: symbol 'arasan_ops' was not declared. Should it be static?
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Fix these kernel doc warnings:
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:181: warning: contents before sections
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:236: warning: contents before sections
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:291: warning: contents before sections
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:297: warning: Function parameter or member 'degrees' not described in 'sdhci_versal_sdcardclk_set_phase'
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:354: warning: contents before sections
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:360: warning: Function parameter or member 'degrees' not described in 'sdhci_versal_sampleclk_set_phase'
drivers/mmc/zynq_sdhci.c:467: warning: contents before sections
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Split arasan_zynqmp_set_tapdelay() to handle input and output tapdelays
separately. This is required to handle zero values for ITAP and OTAP
values. If we dont split, we will have to remove the if() in the
function, which makes ITAP values to be overwritten when OTAP values are
called to set and vice-versa.
Restrict tap_delay value calculated to max allowed 8 bits for ITAP and 6
bits for OTAP for ZynqMP.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Restrict tap_delay value to the allowed size(8bits for itap and 6 bits
for otap) before writing to the tap delay register.
Clear ITAP and OTAP delay bits before updating with the new tap value
for Versal platform.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Allow configuring ITAP and OTAP values with zero to avoid failures in
some cases (one of them is SD boot mode). Legacy, SDR12 modes require
to program the ITAP and OTAP values as zero, whereas for SDR50 and SDR104
modes ITAP value is zero.
In SD boot mode firmware configures the SD ITAP and OTAP values and
in this case u-boot has to re-configure required tap values(including zero)
based on the operating mode.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
set_phase() functions are not modifying the ret value and returning
the same uninitialized ret, return 0 instead.
Keep the return type as int to return errors when the tapdelay's are
set via xilinx_pm_request() in future.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
commit 03f1f78a9b ("spl: fit: Prefer a malloc()'d buffer for loading
images")' changed the way buffer allocation worked for SPL to a more
flexible method.
For xilinx zynqmp the 1MB buffer is not necessarily enough when dealing
with complex fit images (e.g. containing FPGA/TF-A/OP-TEE/U-Boot
proper), which can easily reach up to 10MB, so increase the default
CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE size to 16MB to cover more advanced
scenarios.
Signed-off-by: Ricardo Salveti <ricardo@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc1-3
Documentation:
provide Makefile documentation
SMBIOS:
generate BIOS release date based on UEFI version
improve error handling in SMBIOS table generation
UEFI:
correct handling of signed capsule if authentication if off
Commit b81406db51 ("arm: serial: Add debug UART capability to the
pl01x driver") add supports to use pl01x as a debug UART. However,
due to CONFIG_IS_ENABLED macro requires CONFIG_SPL_* prefix, the
_debug_uart_init() would not choose TYPE_PL011 in SPL build. This
patch fixes the bug by judging CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_PL011 explicitly.
Signed-off-by: Chen Baozi <chenbaozi@phytium.com.cn>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Change the path from doc/uefi to doc/develop/uefi.
Fixes: commit d1ceeeff6c ("doc: Move UEFI under develop/")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
After the commit c70f44817d ("efi_loader: simplify 'printenv -e'"),
"-all" option is no longer necessary.
Just remove them in the test script.
Fixes: c70f44817d ("efi_loader: simplify 'printenv -e'")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In the commit c982874e93 ("efi_loader: refactor
efi_setup_loaded_image()"), setjmp-related definitions were moved to
efi_loaded_image_obj in efi_loader.h. So setjmp.h is no longer
refererenced in efi_api.h.
This also fixes some error when efi_api.h will be included in
mkeficapsule.c.
Fixes: c982874e93 ("efi_loader: refactor efi_setup_loaded_image()")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If capsule authentication is disabled and yet a capsule file is signed,
its signature must be removed from image data to flush.
Otherwise, the firmware will be corrupted after update.
Fixes: 04be98bd6b ("efi: capsule: Add support for uefi capsule
authentication")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
efi_guid_capsule_root_cert_guid is never used.
Just remove it.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
SMBIOS tables only support 32bit addresses. If we don't have memory here
handle the error gracefully:
* on x86_64 fail to start U-Boot
* during UEFI booting ignore the missing table
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
BIOS Release Date must be in format mm/dd/yyyy and must be release date.
U-Boot currently sets BIOS Release Date from U_BOOT_DMI_DATE macro which is
generated from current build timestamp.
Fix this issue by setting U_BOOT_DMI_DATE macro to U-Boot version which is
better approximation of U-Boot release date than current build timestamp.
Current U-Boot versioning is in format yyyy.mm so as a day choose 01.
Some operating systems are using BIOS Release Date for detecting when was
SMBIOS table filled or if it could support some feature (e.g. BIOS from
1990 cannot support features invented in 2000). So this change also ensures
that recompiling U-Boot from same sources but in different year does not
change behavior of some operating systems.
Macro U_BOOT_DMI_DATE is not used in other file than lib/smbios.c
so remove it from global autogenerated files and also from Makefile.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
* remove duplicate heading to avoid build error with 'make htmldocs'
* length of underlines must match header
* use appropriate header levels
* fix type %s/linux/Linux/
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
U-Boot uses the Linux Kbuild build system. Add the associated
documentation so that people can understand the Makefiles better.
This is taken from Linux v5.12
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
pl01x_putc() might return -EAGAIN if there was no space in FIFO. In that
case, high-level caller should wait until there is space and resend the
character.
Signed-off-by: Chen Baozi <chenbaozi@phytium.com.cn>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
smc and hvc commands take upto 8 user input arguments, the maximum
number of arguments of the U_BOOT_CMD macro should set to 9.
Besides, fix the typo (arg7 -> arg6) in hvc command's help message.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CNTFRQ_EL0 is only writable from the highest supported exception
level on the platform. For Armv8-A, this is typically EL3, but
technically EL2 and EL3 are optional so it may need to be
initialized at EL2 or EL1. For Armv8-R, the highest exception
level is always EL2.
This patch moves the initialization outside of the switch_el
block and uses a new macro branch_if_not_highest_el which
dynamically detects whether it is at the highest supported
exception level.
Linux's docs state that CNTFRQ_EL0 should be initialized by the
bootloader. If not set, the the U-Boot prompt countdown hangs.
Signed-off-by: Peter Hoyes <Peter.Hoyes@arm.com>
For some reason, the DragonBoard 410c aborts autoboot immediately if
U-Boot is started without LK. It looks like it picks up a single broken
character via serial and therefore believes a key was pressed to abort
autoboot.
After some debugging, it seems like adding some delay after pinctrl
setup but before UART initialization fixes the issue. It's also worth
mentioning that unlike when booting from LK, the pinctrl setup is
actually necessary when booting U-Boot without LK since UART is broken
if the pinctrl line is removed.
I suspect that reconfiguring the pins might take some time to stabilize
and if the UART controller is enabled too quickly it will pick up some
random noise. Adding a few milliseconds of delay fixes the issue and
shouldn't have any other negative side effects.
3ms seems to be the minimum delay required in my tests, use 5ms instead
just to be sure.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
At the moment pressing the volume down key does not actually launch
fastboot. This is because setting "bootdelay" to "-1" actually
disables autoboot and drops to the U-Boot console. It does not execute
the "bootcmd".
The correct value for "bootdelay" here would be "-2", which disables
the delay and key checking and would immediately execute the "bootcmd".
However, even better in this case is using "preboot" to trigger Fastboot.
The advantage is that running "fastboot continue" will actually continue
the autoboot process instead of ending up in the U-Boot shell.
Also make sure to unset "preboot" again immediately in case the user
saves the environment after triggering fastboot.
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Fixes: aa043ee91a ("db410c: automatically launch fastboot")
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The DragonBoard 410c has proprietary firmware from Qualcomm that
reserves 8 MiB of memory for tz/smem/hyp/rmtfs/rfsa from 0x86000000
to 0x86800000. I'm not aware of any ATF (ARM Trusted Firmware) port
for DB410c that would reserve 30 MiB of memory at the end of RAM.
I suspect the comment might have been copied from hikey.h which has
a very similar comment (and which actually does have an ATF port).
Reducing the memory size just prevents U-Boot from using the end of
the RAM, not the reserved region inbetween. Therefore we might as well
display the correct DRAM size (1 GiB) instead of strange 986 MiB.
Fixes: 626f048bbc ("board: Add Qualcomm Dragonboard 410C support")
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
At the moment the U-Boot port for the DragonBoard 410c is designed
to be loaded as an Android boot image after Qualcomm's Little Kernel (LK)
bootloader. This is simple to set up but LK is redundant in this case,
since everything done by LK can be also done directly by U-Boot.
Dropping LK entirely has at least the following advantages:
- Easier installation/board code (no need for Android boot images)
- (Slightly) faster boot
- Boot directly in 64-bit without a round trip to 32-bit for LK
So far this was not possible yet because of unsolved problems:
1. Signing tool: The firmware expects a "signed" ELF image with extra
(Qualcomm-specific) ELF headers, usually used for secure boot.
The DragonBoard 410c does not have secure boot by default but the
extra ELF headers are still required.
2. PSCI bug: There seems to be a bug in the PSCI implementation
(part of the TrustZone/tz firmware) that causes all other CPU cores
to be started in 32-bit mode if LK is missing in the boot chain.
This causes Linux to hang early during boot.
There is a solution for both problems now:
1. qtestsign (https://github.com/msm8916-mainline/qtestsign)
can be used as a "signing" tool for U-Boot and other firmware.
2. A workaround for the "PSCI bug" is to execute the TZ syscall when
entering U-Boot. That way PSCI is made aware of the 64-bit switch
and starts all other CPU cores in 64-bit mode as well.
Simplify the dragonboard410c board by removing all the extra code that
is only used to build an Android boot image that can be loaded by LK.
This allows dropping the custom linker script, special image magic,
as well as most of the special build/installation instructions.
CONFIG_REMAKE_ELF is used to build a new ELF image that has both U-Boot
and the appended DTB combined. The resulting u-boot.elf can then be
passed to the "signing" tool (e.g. qtestsign).
The PSCI workaround is placed in the "boot0" hook that is enabled
with CONFIG_ENABLE_ARM_SOC_BOOT0_HOOK. The extra check for EL1 allows
compatibility with custom firmware that enters U-Boot in EL2 or EL3,
e.g. qhypstub (https://github.com/msm8916-mainline/qhypstub).
As a first step these changes apply only to DragonBoard410c.
Similar changes could likely also work for the DragonBoard 820c.
Note that removing LK wouldn't be possible that easily without a lot of
work already done three years ago by Ramon Fried. A lot of missing
initialization, pinctrl etc was already added back then even though
it was not strictly needed yet.
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Since we can not set OsIndications from Runtime Services
SetVariables at this moment, it is better to ignore the
OsIndications if there is any capsule file in the
correct place.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since the recent commit;
commit b891ff18f8 ("efi_loader: Force a single FMP instance per hardware store")
forces a single FMP instances for a storage, we can not
enable both RAW and FIT capsule image support at once.
Since RAW capsule image support is simpler than FIT,
enable RAW capsule image instead of FIT by default.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Enable UEFI secure boot on synquacer. Note that unless user
setup their keys, the secure boot will not work.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since the U-Boot for the SynQuacer DeveloperBox is designed for
compatible with EDK2 boot, we don't need to support Ext2/4 fs
support by default. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since MTD partitions are based on the devicetree name,
remove unneeded mtdparts settings and update DFU setting.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Add partition information to the spi-nor flash.
This is required for accessing NOR flash via mtdparts.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Make the U-Boot binary for SynQuacer position independent so
that the previous bootloader (SCP firmware or BL2) can load
the U-Boot anywhere.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since the SCBM SMMU is not only connected to the NETSEC
but also shared with the F_SDH30 (eMMC controller), that
should be initialized at board level instead of NETSEC.
Move the SMMU initialization code into board support
and call it from board_init().
Without this fix, if the NETSEC is disabled, the Linux
eMMC ADMA cause an error because SMMU is not initialized.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
This adds tests for the crypt-based and plain SHA256-based password hashing
algorithms in the autoboot flow.
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In case crypt-based hashing is enabled this will be the default mechanism
that is used. If a user wants to have support for both, the environment
variable `bootstopusesha256` can be set to `true` to allow plain SHA256
based hashing of the password.
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The key-sequence based unlock mechanisms are sensitive to junk symbols
that could have been sent to stdin and are still waiting to be retrieved.
Enabling this option will read all symbols off stdin before displaying the
autoboot prompt (and starting to read the password from stdin).
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In case a user has to enter a complicated password it is sometimes
desireable to give the user more time than the default timeout.
Enabling this feature will disable the timeout entirely in case the user
presses the <Enter> key before entering any other character.
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
While doing code-review internally this got nitpicked by 2 reviewers, so
I decided to include this here.
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
In order to prevent using the global errno, replace it with a static
version and create a wrapper function which returns the error value.
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Add the basic functionality required to support the standard crypt
format.
The files crypt-sha256.c and crypt-sha512.c originate from libxcrypt and
their formatting is therefor retained.
The integration is done via a crypt_compare() function in crypt.c.
```
libxcrypt $ git describe --long --always --all
tags/v4.4.17-0-g6b110bc
```
Signed-off-by: Steffen Jaeckel <jaeckel-floss@eyet-services.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
RTC devices could provide battery-backed memory that can be used for
storing the reboot mode magic value.
Add a new reboot-mode back-end that uses RTC to store the reboot-mode
magic value. The driver also supports both endianness modes.
Signed-off-by: Nandor Han <nandor.han@vaisala.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A use case for controlling the boot mode is when the user wants
to control the device boot by pushing a button without needing to
go in user-space.
Add a new backed for reboot mode where GPIOs are used to control the
reboot-mode. The driver is able to scan a predefined list of GPIOs
and return the magic value. Having the modes associated with
the magic value generated based on the GPIO values, allows the
reboot mode uclass to select the proper mode.
Signed-off-by: Nandor Han <nandor.han@vaisala.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A new driver uclass is created to handle the reboot mode control.
The new uclass driver is updating an environment variable with the
configured reboot mode. The mode is extracted from a map provided
at initialization time. The map contains a list of modes
and associated ids.
Signed-off-by: Nandor Han <nandor.han@vaisala.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_NET_MULTI has been removed long time ago by commit 795428fc67
("net: remove CONFIG_NET_MULTI") but 4 boards were added later which wasn't
found. The patch is removing this reference from 4 boards.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
The macro should be passed a state, which should be passed
to the actual function. Otherwise using that macro would
yield a build error.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The ARM Juno boards can be used as somewhat decent machines to run
off-the-shelf distributions, with USB, SATA, GBit Ethernet and 8GB of
DRAM.
With stable DTs in the board's NOR flash this would work really nicely,
however the default boot command is to fetch a kernel and an initrd from
the on-board NOR flash, which sounds somewhat embedded.
Include the config_distro_bootcmd.h header and define the available
devices (starting with USB, to catch USB installer sticks) to make
distributions and UEFI work out of the box.
The NOR flash kernel functionality is still preserved as the last
resort, should all other methods fail.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
The generic distro boot sequence iterates over several types of devices,
trying one after another. In doing do, it starts with setting the
"devtype" variable, then uses this later in more generic commands.
Now most (block) device types use a local variable for that, but DHCP
puts the type into the environment, where it shadows any local variables.
As a consequence any boot attempt after bootcmd_dhcp has been run fails:
===========================
VExpress64# run bootcmd_dhcp
...
VExpress64# run bootcmd_sata0
SATA#0:
(3.0 Gbps)
SATA#1:
(No RDY)
Device 0: Model: 16GB SATA Flash Drive ....
... is now current device
Couldn't find partition dhcp 0:1
===========================
This problem typically doesn't show, because DHCP is mostly the last
command to try, but is a problem when this order is different, or when
distro_bootcmd or bootcmd_xxx are run separately or multiple times.
Let bootcmd_dhcp use a local variable, as the other kids do, to make the
order of boot commands irrelevant, and allow repeated calls.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When we build U-Boot with POSITION_INDEPENDENT we must have
SYS_TEXT_BASE be set to zero. Make this the default in that case.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Switch to fit_image_get_data_and_size() for consistency with all other
data loaded from FIT.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As 'part_get_info_by_name' now returns more status codes than just
-1 to indicate failure, we need to update the return value check.
Signed-off-by: Anders Dellien <anders.dellien@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
This patch add support for using NXP's pca8574 I2C IO expander, which
has only 8 IO lines.
After this change the .data member's information from struct udevice_id
are used to either sent one or two bytes.
Moreover, the '_le16' suffix from pcf8575_i2c_{write|read}_le16()
functions have been removed as now we also sent 8 bit data.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Those members are not used anymore as ones from gpio_dev_priv
structure (when DM_GPIO support is enabled) are used instead.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Allow pin name parameter for pimux staus command,
as gpio command to get status of one pin.
The possible usage of the command is:
> pinmux dev pinctrl
> pinmux status
> pinmux status -a
> pinmux status <pin-name>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the result of do_status and always returns a CMD_RET_ value
(-ENOSYS was a possible result of show_pinmux).
This patch also adds pincontrol name in error messages (dev->name)
and treats correctly the status sub command when pin-controller device is
not selected.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This change ensures both U-Boot and OP-TEE see the same content
from shared memory when OP-TEE is invoked prior U-Boot relocation.
This change is required since U-Boot may execute with data cache off
while OP-TEE always enables cache on memory shared with U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Jens Wiklander <jens.wiklander@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
It's possible that LOAD_FIT_FULL will have different values for TPL and
SPL, in which case just checking CONFIG_SPL_LOAD_FIT_FULL causes this to
be compiled in to the TPL even though functions and struct members it
depends on are not.
Use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() to ensure the correct TPL/SPL variant is
checked.
Signed-off-by: John Keeping <john@metanate.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Change the reg variable to not be unsigned so that we not get into an
unsigned compared against 0.
Signed-off-by: Cosmin-Florin Aluchenesei <aluchenesei.cosmin-florin@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add a common empty ops: eqos_null_ops() to remove the duplicated empty
functions and reduce the driver size for stm32 and imx config.
This patch also aligns the prototype of ops 'eqos_stop_clks' with other
eqos ops by adding return value.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Use the generic ethernet phy which already manages the correct binding
for gpio reset, including the assert an deassert delays.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Since the commit commit 6a895d039b ("net: Update eQos driver and FEC
driver to use eth phy interfaces") the field phyaddr of driver private data
struct eqos_priv is no more used in eqos_start() for the phy_connect()
parameter.
Now this variable is only initialized in eqos_probe_resources_stm32()
it can be removed.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Bind any subnode with name beginning by mdio, mdio0 for example,
and not only the "mdio" as namei of subnode.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Replace debug trace and printf to log macros:
- debug() replaced by dev_dbg() when device is available, this macro
indicate the device name since commit ceb70bb870 ("dm: Print device
name in dev_xxx like Linux")
- printf() replaced by log_notice() to allow dispatch to log backends.
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The gpio reset and the assert or deassert delay are defined in generic
binding of the ethernet phy in Linux:
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/ethernet-phy.yaml
reset-gpios:
maxItems: 1
description:
The GPIO phandle and specifier for the PHY reset signal.
reset-assert-us:
description:
Delay after the reset was asserted in microseconds. If this
property is missing the delay will be skipped.
reset-deassert-us:
description:
Delay after the reset was deasserted in microseconds. If
this property is missing the delay will be skipped.
See also U-Boot: doc/device-tree-bindings/net/phy.txt
This patch adds the parsing of this common DT properties in the
u-class "eth_phy_generic", used by default in the associated driver
"eth_phy_generic_drv"
This parsing function eth_phy_of_to_plat can be reused by other
ethernet phy drivers for this uclass UCLASS_ETH_PHY.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Fixed a defect of a null pointer being discovered by Coverity Scan:
CID 331544: Null pointer dereferences (REVERSE_INULL)
Null-checking "size" suggests that it may be null, but it has already been
dereferenced on all paths leading to the check.
Signed-off-by: Chen Guanqiao <chenguanqiao@kuaishou.com>
The sandbox can handle signals. Due to a damaged global data pointer
additional exceptions in the signal handler may occur leading to an endless
loop. In this case leave the handling of the secondary exception to the
operating system.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
One of binman's attributes is that it is extremely fast, at least for a
Python program. Add some simple timing around operations that might take
a while, such as reading an image and compressing it. This should help
to maintain the performance as new features are added.
This is for debugging purposes only.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the process outputs a lot of data on stdout this can be quite slow,
since the bytestring is regenerated each time. Use a bytearray instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The constructor should not read the node information. Move it to the
ReadNode() method instead. This allows this etype to be subclassed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some images may take a while to build, e.g. if they are large and use slow
compression. Support compiling sections in parallel to speed things up.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
(fixed to use a separate test file to fix flakiness)
At present compression uses the same temporary file for all invocations.
With multithreading this causes the data to become corrupted. Use a
different filename each time.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present when function names are logged, the output is a little hard to
read since every function is a different length. Add a way to pad the
names so that the log messages line up vertically. This doesn't work if
the function name is very long, but it makes a big difference in most
cases.
Use 20 characters as a default since this covers the vast majority of
functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to be able to iterate over block devices. Typically there
are fixed and removable devices. For security reasons it is sometimes
useful to ignore removable devices since they are under user control.
Add iterators which support selecting the block-device type.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for reading devicetree flags for MMC devices. With this we
can distinguish between fixed and removable drives. Note that this
information is only available when the device is probed, not when it is
bound, since it is read in the of_to_plat() method. This could be changed
if needed later.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
If SPL fails to boot, try to provide an error code to indicate what is
wrong. For example, if a uclass is missing, this can return -EPFNOSUPPORT
(-96) which provides useful information.
Add a helper for accessing the image-loader name so we can drop the use
of #ifdefs in this code.
Put this feature behind a CONFIG_SHOW_ERRORS option to avoid increasing
the code size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If signature verification is not in use we don't need to worry about
the risk of using @ in node names. Update fit_image_verify() to allow
it if the function is not enabled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is possible to add a blob that ends at the end of the bloblist, but at
present this is not supported. Fix it and add a regression test for this
case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some comments for struct bloblist_hdr are a bit ambiguous. Update them to
clarify the meaning more precisely. Also document bloblist_get_stats()
properly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sometimes a blob needs to expand, e.g. because it needs to hold more log
data. Add support for this. Note that the bloblist must have sufficient
spare space for this to work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than calling directly into the sandbox SDL code, we can use the
normal U-Boot console handling for this feature. Update the code, to make
it more generic.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a function to read this information from the EC. It is useful for
determining whether the battery has enough charge to boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
SDL provides a hinting feature which provides a higher-quality image
with the double-display option (-K). Enable it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the display does not show on some machines, e.g. Ubunutu
20.04 but the reason is unknown. Add a work-around until this can be
determined.
Also include more error checking just in case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The SPL header has a function for obtaining the phase in capital letters,
e.g. 'SPL'. Add one for lower-case also, as used by sandbox.
Use this to generalise the sandbox logic for determining the filename of
the next sandbox executable. This can provide support for VPL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When things go wrong it can be confusing to figure out what to change.
Add a few more details to the documentation.
Fix a 'make htmldocs' warning while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Walter Lozano <walter.lozano@collabora.com>
At present if a driver is missing a uclass or compatible stirng, this
is silently ignored. This makes sense in most cases, particularly for
the compatible string, since it is not required except when the driver
is used with of-platdata.
But it is also not very helpful. When there is some sort of problem
with a driver, the missing compatible string (for example) may be the
cause.
Add a warning in this case, showing it only for drivers which are used
by the build.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Walter Lozano <walter.lozano@collabora.com>
Some rockchip drivers use a suffix on the of_match line which is not
strictly valid. At present this causes the parsing to fail. Fix this
and offer a warning.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This expects a . before the field name (.e.g '.compatible = ...) but
presently accepts anything at all. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Walter Lozano <walter.lozano@collabora.com>
At present we show when a driver is missing but this is not always that
useful. There are various reasons why a driver may appear to be missing,
such as a parse error in the source code or a missing field in the driver
declaration.
Update the implementation to record all warnings for each driver, showing
only those which relate to drivers that are actually used. This avoids
spamming the user with warnings related to a driver for a different board.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Walter Lozano <walter.lozano@collabora.com>
Ensure USB hub, PCIe-USB bridge, and ULPI device to be reset
even if the rebooting is without power-cycling.
Signed-off-by: Vincent Chen <vincent.chen@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Create a new function spl_reset_device_by_gpio to reset the device
whose reset pin is connected to the GPIO. Then, using this function
to initialize GEMGXL.
Signed-off-by: Vincent Chen <vincent.chen@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This patch reverts the following commits:
- 4b4159d0f3 ("riscv: dts: add dts for unmatched rev1")
- ffe9a394df ("board: sifive: support spl multi-dtb on unmatched board")
We won't plan to support unmatched that the revision below 3 in u-boot,
so they can be dropped because they might be useless.
Changed in v2:
- rebase codebase to the latest master branch
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Suggested-by: David Abdurachmanov <david.abdurachmanov@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
If force_reloc flag is not set and booti is called for an address
ouside RAM (i. e. QSPI NOR flash), we should honor that and not try
to force relocation in a bogus fashion.
Signed-off-by: Vitaly Wool <vitaly.wool@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
We wouldn't like to allow user to change the serial number, so remove
the command for changing serial number in EEPROM.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Suggested-by: David Abdurachmanov <david.abdurachmanov@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Filter out dmas dma-names interrupt-parent interrupts interrupts-extended
interrupt-names interrupt-map interrupt-map-mask iommus DT properties on
R-Car Gen3, since they are not used by U-Boot and only take space.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The RPC HF might be locked by ATF, and any access to its register
space would result in complete hang. Disable the RPC HF by default.
The ATF should be patched to set RPC node status = "okay" in the DT
fragment it passes to U-Boot in case the RPC HF access is unlocked,
and that way U-Boot could access the RPC HF safely.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The CPU: print only has one space after it, while the other prints
from U-Boot align the value to offset 7. Align the CPU: print too.
No functional change.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Enable support for sysinfo on supported R-Car Gen3 boards. The sysinfo
is used e.g. to access and decode board-specific information and then
in turn used by board-info to print those information. On R-Car Gen3
the sysinfo rcar3 driver is used to parse the board ID EEPROM, obtain
board type and revision from it, and let board-info print this
information on boot.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Enable support for I2C EEPROM driver on supported Renesas R-Car Gen3 boards.
This is useful for accessing the board ID EEPROM.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Add sysinfo node and phandle to the board ID EEPROM on all boards
where this functionality is described in DT, which is Salvator-X(S),
ULCB and Ebisu. The u-boot,dm-pre-reloc is necessary here, since the
sysinfo must be available early during boot. The V3M and V3H boards
currently do not describe this board ID EEPROM in upstream DT, but
that could be easily added later, once the DTs contain the necessary
nodes.
ULCB and Ebisu needs the full EEPROM node in the u-boot extras DT,
since the EEPROM node is still missing in the upstream DTs. Ebisu
also needs extra compatible string override for the i2c_dvfs.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The Renesas R-Car Gen3 development kits contain board ID EEPROM.
This driver parses out the board ID and revision out of that
EEPROM and exports it e.g. for the board-info print on boot.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Set MC Firmware size in read commands in
env to 2MB.
Update DDR Memory read address for MC firmware to
0x80a00000 and MC DPC address to 0x80e00000.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Set MC Firmware size in read commands in
env to 2MB.
Update DDR Memory read address for MC firmware to
0x80a00000 and MC DPC address to 0x80e00000.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Set MC Firmware size in read commands in
env to 2MB.
Update DDR Memory read address for MC firmware to
0x80a00000 and MC DPC address to 0x80e00000.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Set MC Firmware size in read commands in
env to 2MB.
Update DDR Memory read address for MC firmware to
0x80a00000 and MC DPC address to 0x80e00000.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS1043A-QDS board requires updation in few environment configs in TFA
and QSPI defconfigs.
Following are the changes:
- Define CONFIG_ENV_ADDR
- Unset CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR
- Enable CONFIG_SYS_RELOC_GD_ENV_ADDR
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The optical 10G port is described as fixed-link in the device tree. Enable
the necessary support.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
lx2160ardb Rev-C board has i2c node for thermal monitors
connected to different chip offset.
Add device tree fixup to use lx2160ardb dts and apply
thermal node fixups for lx2160ardb Rev-C board.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
[sp:thernal->thermal]
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The RGMII ports on LS1043ARDB platforms require both RX and TX internal
delays to be enabled. The device tree reports only the TX ID because the
RX ID used to be enabled by default.
With the addition of RX ID support for the Realtek 8211F PHY driver in
commit e32e4d0f58 ("net: phy: realtek: add rx delay support for
RTL8211F"), the RX ID is disabled by the driver if not reported explicitly.
This causes the RX to no longer work.
Change the phy-connection-type for the RGMII ports to "rgmii-id" in order
to enable both RX and TX internal delays.
Fixes: be1d758969 ("ARM: dts: add QorIQ DPAA 1 FMan v3 to LS1043ARDB")
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Updates the board configuration to enable use of the PCA9547 I2C mux.
Signed-off-by: Stephen Carlson <stcarlso@linux.microsoft.com>
[Squashed ls2088a patch to fix compilation]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Refactors similar mux code from multiple NXP boards into a common location,
and allows it to be disabled in config.
New config: CONFIG_FSL_USE_PCA9547_MUX to enable PCA9547 mux functionality.
Signed-off-by: Stephen Carlson <stcarlso@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
- Marvell SheevaPlug: Convert Ethernet and SATA to Driver Model (Tony)
- Zyxel NSA310S NAS: Convert to Driver Model (Tony)
- Turris_omnia: Add `u-boot-env` NOR partition (Marek)
- Turris_omnia: Fixup MTD partitions in Linux' DTB (Marek)
- Espressobin: Enable 'mtd' command and define SPI NOR partitions (Pali)
- Enabled distro boot for all TI platforms.
- Cleanup for AM335x Guardian Board
- PRUSS rproc on AM65 platform.
- Add PMIC support for J7200
- Misc fixes for Nokia RX-51
# Conflicts:
# arch/arm/mach-omap2/am33xx/Kconfig
U-Boot now supports parsing SPI NOR partitions from Device Tree. So enable
'mtd' command support for Espressobin board and define partition layout in
U-Boot Espressobin DTS file. Access to SPI NOR via 'sf' command is old
method and 'mtd' command is now preferred variant.
From include file remove '#define CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS' as this option is
now defined and enabled in defconfig file. This change is required to fix
compile error:
CC arch/arm/lib/asm-offsets.s
In file included from include/config.h:4,
from include/common.h:16,
from lib/asm-offsets.c:14:
include/configs/mvebu_armada-37xx.h:63: warning: "CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS" redefined
#define CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS /* required for UBI partition support */
In file included from ././include/linux/kconfig.h:4,
from <command-line>:
include/generated/autoconf.h:44: note: this is the location of the previous definition
#define CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS 1
After enabling support for mtd command, output from 'mtd list' on
Espressobin board is:
=> mtd list
List of MTD devices:
* w25q32dw
- device: spi-flash@0
- parent: spi@10600
- driver: jedec_spi_nor
- path: /soc/internal-regs/spi@10600/spi-flash@0
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x1000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000000400000 : "w25q32dw"
- 0x000000000000-0x0000003f0000 : "firmware"
- 0x0000003f0000-0x000000400000 : "u-boot-env"
=>
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fixup SPI NOR partition nodes in Linux' device tree prior booting Linux.
Linux' devicetree does not contain "u-boot-env" partition and we do not
want to add it there because the address is different between stock
U-Boot and current upstream U-Boot.
Instead we add code that recreates partition nodes from scratch
according to how U-Boot sees them (which is defined in U-Boot's device
tree).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Specify a separate partition `u-boot-env` for U-Boot's env settings for
the Turris Omnia board.
Do this only in U-Boot's specific DTS. We do not want to do this in
Linux' official DTS, because Omnia's stock U-Boot stores env at a
different address, and there are still boards with stock U-Boot.
In a subsequent patch will add board code that fixes Linux's DTB before
booting Linux.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- In DM Ethernet, the old "egiga0" name is no longer valid, so replace it
with Ethernet PHY name from device tree. Also, Ethernet PHY address
is available so read it from device tree.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
In DM Ethernet, the old "egiga0" name is no longer valid, so replace it
with Ethernet PHY name from device tree. Also, Ethernet PHY address
is available so read it from device tree.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Convert to Driver Model.
- Add DM USB, DM Ethernet, and DM SATA configs to nsa310s_defconfig
- Add CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE to nsa310s_defconfig
- Move CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE from board file to nsa310s_defconfig
- Add CONFIG_IDENT_STRING, and CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR
to nsa310s_defconfig
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add device tree kirkwood-nsa310s.dts for Zyxel NSA310S board to
convert to Driver Model.
Signed-off-by: Tony Dinh <mibodhi@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- With the deadline for DM_USB (host controller support), DM_VIDEO,
DM_SPI_FLASH and DM_PCI now at 2 years past the release where their
migration deadline was given, finish removing platforms and enforcing
the switch.
As the deadline for migration to DM_USB, when using a USB host
controller has now gone two years past the deadline, enforce migration.
This is done by:
- Ensuring that all host controller options (other than the very legacy
old MUSB ones) now select USB_HOST. USB_HOST now enforces DM_USB and
OF_CONTROL.
- Remove other parts of Kconfig logic that had platforms pick DM_USB.
- To keep Kconfig happy, have some select statements test for USB_HOST
as well.
- Re-order some Kconfig entries and menus so that we can cleanly pick
host or gadget roles. For the various HCD options that have platform
glue options, group them together and update dependencies in some
cases.
- As SPL_DM_USB is not required, on platforms that had not yet enabled
it, disable it.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Cc: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Cc: FUKAUMI Naoki <naobsd@gmail.com>
Cc: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As the logic here is only used when we have a USB host controller, test
on CONFIG_USB_HOST rather than CONFIG_USB in general. This lets us move
towards using CONFIG_USB only as a menu symbol to say that we have some
form of USB, and then USB_HOST or USB_GADGET depending on the role that
USB plays within the build.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reuse the common logic to allow for BOOT_TARGET_DEVICES to list USB as a
possibility if we're building for a platform that will have USB but not
if we don't, so that we don't hit the link-time check for trying to have
USB boot on a non-USB system.
Acked-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is also the last in family remove the related
support as well.
Cc: Angelo Durgehello <angelo.dureghello@timesys.com>
Cc: TsiChung Liew <Tsi-Chung.Liew@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is also the last in family remove the related
support as well.
Cc: Angelo Durgehello <angelo.dureghello@timesys.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As almost all peripherals are connected via PCI dependent on the
used core card, PCI setup is always required. Thus run pci_init()
including PCI scanning and probing and core card specific setups
in board_early_init_r().
Also prepare support for dynamically managing the status of the
different PCI DT nodes dependent on used core card via option
CONFIG_OF_BOARD_FIXUP. Before this feature can be enabled,
the call order of the fix_fdt() init hook in board_init_f
needs to be changed. Otherwise rw_fdt_blob points to a read-only
NOR flash address. Thus this options needs to stay disabled
until the board_init_f problem could be solved. This breaks
running the default U-Boot image on real HW using the FPGA core
card but Qemu emulation still works. Currently Qemu is more
important as MIPS CI tests depend on Malta and the deadline
for PCI DM conversion will be enforced soon.
Signed-off-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Add DT binding for GT64120 and MSC01 PCI controllers. Only
GT64120 is enabled by default to support Qemu. The MSC01 node
will be dynamically enabled by Malta board code dependent
on the plugged core card.
Signed-off-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
On MIPS the DRAM start address respectively CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE
is still used as a virtual, CPU-mapped address instead of being used
as physical address. Converting all MIPS boards and generic MIPS code
to fix that is not trivial. Due to the approaching deadline for
PCI DM conversion, this workaround is required for MIPS boards with
PCI support until the CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE issue could be solved.
Add a compile-time option to let the PCI uclass core optionally map
the DRAM address to a physical address when adding the PCI region
of type PCI_REGION_SYS_MEMORY.
Signed-off-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This commit updates the default config with the values that will
be used soon on the MediaTek MT7688 based GARDENA smart gateway.
CONFIG_SPL_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN had to be increased due to the more
demanding new configuration.
Signed-off-by: Reto Schneider <reto.schneider@husqvarnagroup.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc1-2
* Correct device path nodes for GUID partitions
* Embed keys to check update capsules instead of providing then in DTB
* Increase event log buffer size for measured boot.
Since we removed embeddingg the capsule key into a .dtb and fixed
authenticated capsule updates for all boards, move the relevant
documentation in the efi file and update it accordingly
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
commit 322c813f4b ("mkeficapsule: Add support for embedding public key in a dtb")
added a bunch of options enabling the addition of the capsule public key
in a dtb. Since now we embedded the key in U-Boot's .rodata we don't this
this functionality anymore
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The capsule signature is now part of our DTB. This is problematic when a
user is allowed to change/fixup that DTB from U-Boots command line since he
can overwrite the signature as well.
So Instead of adding the key on the DTB, embed it in the u-boot binary it
self as part of it's .rodata. This assumes that the U-Boot binary we load
is authenticated by a previous boot stage loader.
Reviewed-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
TCG PC Client PFP spec says "The Log Area Minimum Length
for the TCG event log MUST be at least 64KB." in ACPI chapter.
This commit increase the buffer size to 64KB.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Use %pD to log device-path instead of using efi_dp_str() and
efi_free_pool() locally in find_boot_device().
This is a cleanup patch, no feature update nor fix.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Previously, the GPT device GUID was being used instead of the partition,
which was incorrect.
Signed-off-by: Alfonso Sánchez-Beato <alfonso.sanchez-beato@canonical.com>
Let EFI_LOADER select CONFIG_PARTITION_UUIDS.
Use log_warning() instead of printf() for warning.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <heinrich.schuchardt@canonical.com>
According to i.MX7ULP Reference Manual we should wait for WDOG unlock
and reconfiguration to complete.
Section "59.5.3 Configure Watchdog" provides the following example:
DisableInterrupts; //disable global interrupt
WDOG_CNT = 0xD928C520; //unlock watchdog
while(WDOG_CS[ULK]==0); //wait until registers are unlocked
WDOG_TOVAL = 256; //set timeout value
WDOG_CS = WDOG_CS_EN(1) | WDOG_CS_CLK(1) | WDOG_CS_INT(1) |
WDOG_CS_WIN(0) | WDOG_CS_UPDATE(1);
while(WDOG_CS[RCS]==0); //wait until new configuration takes effect
EnableInterrupts; //enable global interrupt
Update U-Boot WDOG driver to align with i.MX7ULP reference manual.
Use 32 bits accessing to CS register. According to RM, the bits in
this register only can write once after unlock. So using 8 bits access
will cause problem.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
According to i.MX7ULP Reference Manual the second word write for both
UNLOCK and REFRESH operations must occur in maximum 16 bus clock.
The current code is using writel() function which has a DMB barrier to
order the memory access. The DMB between two words write may introduce
some delay in certain circumstance, causing a WDOG timeout due to 16 bus
clock window requirement.
Replace writel() function by __raw_writel() to achieve a faster memory
access and avoid such issue.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Setup USB clock in board codes, and enable the DWC3 XHCI and
PHY drivers to make USB3.0 host port working on i.MX8MQ EVK.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Add clock function to setup relevant clocks for USB3.0 controllers and
PHYs on i.MX8MQ
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Tested-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Add the USB PHY driver for i.MX8MQ to work with DWC3 USB controller.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Tested-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Host tool features, such as mkimage's ability to sign FIT images were
enabled or disabled based on the target configuration. However, this
misses the point of a target-agnostic host tool.
A target's ability to verify FIT signatures is independent of
mkimage's ability to create those signatures. In fact, u-boot's build
system doesn't sign images. The target code can be successfully built
without relying on any ability to sign such code.
Conversely, mkimage's ability to sign images does not require that
those images will only work on targets which support FIT verification.
Linking mkimage cryptographic features to target support for FIT
verification is misguided.
Without loss of generality, we can say that host features are and
should be independent of target features.
While we prefer that a host tool always supports the same feature set,
we recognize the following
- some users prefer to build u-boot without a dependency on OpenSSL.
- some distros prefer to ship mkimage without linking to OpenSSL
To allow these use cases, introduce a host-only Kconfig which is used
to select or deselect libcrypto support. Some mkimage features or some
host tools might not be available, but this shouldn't affect the
u-boot build.
I also considered setting the default of this config based on
FIT_SIGNATURE. While it would preserve the old behaviour it's also
contrary to the goals of this change. I decided to enable it by
default, so that the default build yields the most feature-complete
mkimage.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Function pointers from crypto_algos array are relocated, when
NEEDS_MANUAL_RELOC is set. This relocation doesn't happen if the algo
is placed in a linker list. Implement this relocation.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This macro is no longer needed for code flow or #ifdefs. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This macro is no longer needed for code flow or #ifdefs. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is no longer necessary to implement rsa_() functions as no-ops
depending on config options. It is merely sufficient to provide the
prototypes, as the rsa code is no longer linked when unused.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is no longer necessary to implement ecdsa_() functions as no-ops
depending on config options. It is merely sufficient to provide the
prototypes, as the ecdsa code is no longer linked when unused.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Crytographic algorithms (currently RSA), are stored in linker lists.
The crypto_algos array is unused, so remove it, and any logic
associated with it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move the RSA verification crytpo_algo structure out of the
crypto_algos array, and into a linker list.
Although it appears we are adding an #ifdef to rsa-verify.c, the gains
outweigh this small inconvenience. This is because rsa_verify() is
defined differently based on #ifdefs. This change allows us to have
a single definition of rsa_verify().
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The purpose of this change is to enable crypto algorithms to be placed
in linker lists, rather than be declared as a static array. The goal
is to remove the crypto_algos array in a subsequent patch.
Create a new linker list named "cryptos", and search it when
image_get_crypto_algo() is invoked.
NOTE that adding support for manual relocation of crypto_algos within
linker lists is beyond the scope of this patch.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove any ifdefs in image-sig.c that were previously used to
differentiate from the host code. Note that all code dedicated to
relocating ->sign() and ->add_verify_data)_ can be safely removed,
as signing is not supported target-side.
NOTE that although it appears we are removing ecdsa256 support, this
is intentional. ecdsa_verify() is a no-op on the target, and is
currently only used by host code.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
image-sig.c is used to map a hash or crypto algorithm name to a
handler of that algorithm. There is some similarity between the host
and target variants, with the differences worked out by #ifdefs. The
purpose of this change is to remove those ifdefs.
First, copy the file to a host-only version, and remove target
specific code. Although it looks like we are duplicating code,
subsequent patches will change the way target algorithms are searched.
Besides we are only duplicating three string to struct mapping
functions. This isn't something to fuss about.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is not needed with Kconfig, since we can use IS_ENABLED() easily
enough. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
We already have a host Kconfig for these SHA options. Use
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(SHAxxx) directly in the code shared with the host build,
so we can drop the unnecessary indirections.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
We already have a host Kconfig for SHA1. Use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(SHA1)
directly in the code shared with the host build, so we can drop the
unnecessary indirection.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Drop the _SUPPORT suffix so we can use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() with this
option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Drop the _SUPPORT suffix so we can use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() with this
option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
These option are named inconsistently with other SPL options, thus making
them incompatible with the CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() macro. Rename them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The ENABLE part of this name is redundant, since all boolean Kconfig
options serve to enable something. The SUPPORT part is also redundant
since Kconfigs can be assumed to enable support for something. Together
they just serve to make these options overly long and inconsistent
with other options.
Rename FIT_ENABLE_SHAxxx_SUPPORT to FIT_SHAxxx
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
There is no separate SPL/TPL config for WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART.
So use IS_ENABLED instead of CONFIG_IS_ENABLED to make watchdog
working in SPL again.
Fixes: 830d29ac37 ("watchdog: Allow to use CONFIG_WDT without starting watchdog")
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In uboot command line environment, watchdog is not able to be
stopped with below commands:
SOCFPGA_STRATIX10 # wdt dev watchdog@ffd00200
SOCFPGA_STRATIX10 # wdt stop
Refer to watchdog driver in linux kernel, it is also need to reset
watchdog after disable it so that the disable action takes effect.
Signed-off-by: Meng Li <Meng.Li@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Remove the mmc alias no more required as the sequence number
of mmc device is used for boot_instance.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Use the device sequence number in boot_instance variable
and no more the SDMMC instance provided by ROM code/TF-A.
After this patch we don't need to define the mmc alias in
device tree, for example:
mmc0 = &sdmmc1;
mmc1 = &sdmmc2;
mmc2 = &sdmmc3;
to have a correct mapping between the ROM code boot device =
"${boot_device}${boot_instance}" and the MMC device in U-Boot.
With this patch the 'mmc0' device (used in mmc commands) is
always used when only one instance sdmmc is activated in device
tree, even if it is only the sdmmc2 or sdmmc3.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Use the existing defines PMIC_SIZE and OTP_SIZE and a new define
CMD_SIZE for virtual partition size.
This patch corrects the size for OTP partition in alternate name
(1024 instead of 512) and avoids other alignment issues.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Enable the clocks during syscon probe when they are present in device tree.
This patch avoids a freeze when the SYSCFG clock is not enabled by
TF-A / OP-TEE.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add the support of SYSCFG clock used by syscon driver
to prepare the clock management of STM32MP_SYSCON_SYSCFG.
This clock is already defined in kernel device tree,
stm32mp151.dtsi but not yet supported in the syscon driver:
syscfg: syscon@50020000 {
compatible = "st,stm32mp157-syscfg", "syscon";
reg = <0x50020000 0x400>;
clocks = <&rcc SYSCFG>;
};
It is safe to support this clock in U-Boot driver with
RCC_MC_APB3ENSETR, Bit 11 SYSCFGEN: SYSCFG peripheral clocks
enable.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The expected sequence to close the device
1/ Load key in DDR with any supported load command
2/ Update OTP with key: STM32MP> stm32key read <addr>
At this point the device is able to perform image authentication but
non-authenticated images can still be used and executed.
So it is the last moment to test boot with signed binary and
check that the ROM code accepts them.
3/ Close the device: only signed binary will be accepted !!
STM32MP> stm32key close
Warning: Programming these OTP is an irreversible operation!
This may brick your system if the HASH of key is invalid
This command should be deactivated by default in real product.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Allow to read the OTP value and lock status with the command
$> stm32key read.
This patch also protects the stm32key fuse command.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Lock the OTP value of key's hash after the command
$> stm32key fuse <address>
This operation forbids a second update of these OTP as they are
ECC protected in BSEC: any update of these OTP with a different value
causes a BSEC disturb error and the closed chip will be bricked.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This command is used to evaluate the secure boot on stm32mp SOC,
it is deactivated by default in real products.
We activate this command only in STMicroelectronics defconfig
used with the evaluation boards.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reduce the content of short help message for stm32prog command and
removed the carriage return to fix the display of 'help' command when
this command is activated.
Fixes: 954bd1a923 ("stm32mp: add the command stm32prog")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add the variable used by PXE command for fdtoverlays support
since the commit 69076dff22 ("cmd: pxe: add support for FDT overlays").
Reused the unused "splashimage" address as CONFIG_SPLASH_SOURCE and
CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO are not activated and U-Boot display the "BACKGROUND"
image found in extlinux.conf to manage splashscreen on stm32mp1 boards.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Fix wrong register use when set/reset ST bit.
ST bit is in register M41T62_REG_SEC not in M41T62_REG_ALARM_HOUR.
I have not actually tested this. But this seemed buggy from inspection.
Fixes: 9bbe210512 ("rtc: m41t62: add oscillator fail bit reset support")
Signed-off-by: Max Yang <max.yang@deltaww.com>
At the moment android_image_get_kcomp() can automatically detect
LZ4 compressed kernels and the compression specified in uImages.
However, especially on ARM64 Linux is often compressed with GZIP.
Attempting to boot an Android image with a GZIP compressed kernel
image currently results in a very strange crash, e.g.
Starting kernel ...
"Synchronous Abort" handler, esr 0x02000000
...
Code: 5555d555 55555d55 555f5555 5d555d55 (00088b1f)
Note the 1f8b, which are the "magic" bytes for GZIP images.
U-Boot already has the image_decomp_type() function that checks for
the magic bytes of bzip2, gzip, lzma and lzo. It's easy to make use
of it here to increase the chance that we do the right thing and the
user does not become confused with strange crashes.
This allows booting Android boot images that contain GZIP-compressed
kernel images.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
The current fitImage DTO implementation expects each fitImage image
subnode containing DTO to have 'load' property, pointing somewhere
into memory where the DTO will be loaded. The address in the 'load'
property must be different then the base DT load address and there
must be sufficient amount of space between those two addresses.
Selecting and using such hard-coded addresses is fragile, error
prone and difficult to port even across devices with the same SoC
and different DRAM sizes.
The DTO cannot be applied in-place because fdt_overlay_apply_verbose()
modifies the DTO when applying it onto the base DT, so if the DTO was
used in place within the fitImage, call to fdt_overlay_apply_verbose()
would corrupt the fitImage.
Instead of copying the DTO to a specific hard-coded load address,
allocate a buffer, copy the DTO into that buffer, apply the DTO onto
the base DT, and free the buffer.
The upside of this approach is that it is no longer necessary to
select and hard-code specific DTO load address into the DTO. The
slight downside is the new malloc()/free() overhead for each DTO,
but that is negligible (*).
(*) on iMX8MM/MN and STM32MP1
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Pantelis Antoniou <pantelis.antoniou@konsulko.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[trini: Add <linux/sizes.h>]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There's currently no user of %p[iI]6, so including ip6_addr_string()
in the image is a waste of bytes. It's easy enough to have the
compiler elide it without removing the code completely.
The closest I can find to anybody "handling" ipv6 in U-Boot currently
is in efi_net.c which does
if (ipv6) {
ret = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
As indicated in the comment, it can easily be put back, but preferably
under a config knob.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
U-Boot doesn't support %pS/%pF or any other kind of kallsyms-like
lookups. Remove the comment.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
This saves some code, both in terms of #LOC and .text size, and it is
also the normal convention that foo(...) is implemented in terms of
vfoo().
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
When the default clocks cannot be set, the clock is silently probed and
the error is ignored. This is incorrect, since having the clocks at the
correct speed may be important for operation of the system.
Fix it by checking the return code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In this case the value seems save to pass to os_free(). Add a comment.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 165109)
In tpm_sendrecv_command() the command buffer is passed in. If a mistake is
somehow made in setting this up, the size could be out of range. Add a
sanity check for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 331152)
The width is set up in single_of_to_plat() and can only have three values,
all of which result in a non-zero divisor. Add a comment.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 331154)
At present the return value of ofnode_get_property() is not checked, which
causes a coverity warning. While we are here, use logging for the errors.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 331157)
Update dm_dump_drivers() to use the return value from uclass_get() to
check the validity of uc. This is equivalent and should be more attractive
to Coverity.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 316601)
The devres_alloc() function is intended to avoid the need for freeing
memory, although in practice it may not be enabled, thus leading to a true
leak.
Nevertheless this is intended. Add a comment.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312951)
The devres_alloc() function is intended to avoid the need for freeing
memory, although in practice it may not be enabled, thus leading to a true
leak.
Nevertheless this is intended. Add a comment to explain this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312952)
This value is either 0 for success or -1 for error. Coverity reports that
"ret" is passed to a parameter that cannot be negative, pointing to the
condition 'if (ret < 0)'.
Adjust it to just check for non-zero and avoid showing -1 in the error
message, which is pointless. Perhaps these changes will molify Coverity.
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312956)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This cannot actually fail, but check the value anyway to keep coverity
happy.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 316351)
At present if ifname is exactly IFNAMSIZ characters then it will result
in an unterminated string. Fix this by using strlcpy() instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 316358)
Acked-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Unfortunately for testing is required qflasher which works only in 32-bit
x86 mode. Apparently 64-bit x86 Azure CI has no problems as it has
preinstalled 32-bit libraries and can execute also 32-bit x86 executables.
This change just show human readable output why nokia_rx51_test.sh test
script fails.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210618133108.32497-1-pali@kernel.org
By default bootmenu is loaded only from eMMC. After this change U-Boot
first tries to load bootmenu from uSD card and if it fails then fallback to
eMMC. People want to boot alternative OS from removable uSD without need to
modify eMMC content. So this backward compatible change allows it.
Part of this change is also optimization of trymmc* macros so they can be
used in preboot macro for loading bootmenu.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210618132704.32066-2-pali@kernel.org
Enable U-Boot bootz command and update env scripts to try loading also
zImage file and to try booting via bootz command.
Update also lowlevel_init.S code for checking validity of zImage magic to
correctly relocate kernel in zImage format.
This change allows U-Boot to directly boot Linux kernel without need for
converting kernel image into U-Boot uImage format.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210618132704.32066-1-pali@kernel.org
Remove the environment support for various legacy boot methods. With
this, we will now default to booting any distribution that follows the
generic distro boot framework and no longer attempt to boot various
legacy (to this SoC) scripts/etc. Note that if we do not find anything
here we will continue to try and Android methods and will start by
trying fastboot.
Cc: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210701132612.7559-3-trini@konsulko.com
Remove the environment support for various legacy boot methods. With
this, we will now default to booting any distribution that follows the
generic distro boot framework and no longer attempt to boot various
legacy (to this SoC) scripts/etc.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210701132612.7559-1-trini@konsulko.com
try_unlock_memory() is only used in one file, so make it static
in that file,remove it from the sys_proto header file, and relocate
it into the #ifdef section that call it. This will make it only built
under the conditions when it is called, and it may help with some
further optimization in the future.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210625192308.277136-2-aford173@gmail.com
Add the DT nodes for the ICSSG0, ICSSG1 and ICSSG2 processor subsystems
that are present on the K3 AM65x SoCs. The three ICSSGs are identical
to each other for the most part, with the ICSSG2 supporting slightly
enhanced features for supporting SGMII PRU Ethernet. Each ICSSG instance
is represented by a PRUSS subsystem node. These nodes are enabled by
default.
DT nodes are fetch from Linux 5.13 Kernel.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210622063431.3151-5-lokeshvutla@ti.com
So far all the u-boot specific properties for both r5 and a53 are
placed in k3-am654-base-board-u-boot.dtsi. But there are few a53
nodes that should be updated but doesn't belong to r5. So create a
separate r5 specific u-boot dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210622063431.3151-4-lokeshvutla@ti.com
The K3 AM65x family of SoCs have the next generation of the PRU-ICSS
processor subsystem, commonly referred to as ICSSG. Each ICSSG processor
subsystem on AM65x SR1.0 contains two primary PRU cores and two new
auxiliary PRU cores called RTUs. The AM65x SR2.0 SoCs have a revised
ICSSG IP that is based off the subsequent IP revision used on J721E
SoCs. This IP instance has two new custom auxiliary PRU cores called
Transmit PRUs (Tx_PRUs) in addition to the existing PRUs and RTUs.
Each RTU and Tx_PRU cores have their own dedicated IRAM (smaller than
a PRU), Control and debug feature sets, but is different in terms of
sub-modules integrated around it and does not have the full capabilities
associated with a PRU core. The RTU core is typically used to aid a
PRU core in accelerating data transfers, while the Tx_PRU cores is
normally used to control the TX L2 FIFO if enabled in Ethernet
applications. Both can also be used to run independent applications.
The RTU and Tx_PRU cores though share the same Data RAMs as the PRU
cores, so the memories have to be partitioned carefully between different
applications. The new cores also support a new sub-module called Task
Manager to support two different context thread executions.
The driver currently supports the AM65xx SoC
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Murali Karicheri <m-karicheri2@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210622063431.3151-3-lokeshvutla@ti.com
The Programmable Real-Time Unit - Industrial Communication
Subsystem (PRU-ICSS) is present of various TI SoCs such as
AM335x or AM437x or the AM654x family. Each SoC can have
one or more PRUSS instances that may or may not be identical.
The PRUSS consists of dual 32-bit RISC cores called the
Programmable Real-Time Units (PRUs), some shared, data and
instruction memories, some internal peripheral modules, and
an interrupt controller. The programmable nature of the PRUs
provide flexibility to implement custom peripheral interfaces,
fast real-time responses, or specialized data handling.
Add support for pruss driver. Currently am654x family
is supported.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210622063431.3151-2-lokeshvutla@ti.com
Earlier, the region 0x701c0000 to 0x701dffff was firewalled off because of
a bug in SYSFW. In the v2021.05 release of SYSFW this bug has been fixed
and this region can now be used for other allocations.
Therefore, move TF-A's load address to 0x701c0000 and update its location
in the device tree node. Also, increase the size allocated for TF-A to
account for future expansions.
Fixes: defd62ca13 ("arm: dts: k3-am64-main: Update the location of ATF in SRAM and increase its max size")
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210616163821.20457-2-a-govindraju@ti.com
This is a revert of a recent logic change in setup_zimage(). We do
actually need to install this information always. Change it to install
from the Coreboot tables if available, else the normal source.
Fixes: e7bae8283f ("x86: Allow installing an e820 when booting from coreboot")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
With the new 2021.04 we have a new version of Chromium OS boot, which
supports sandbox, coral and coral-on-coreboot. Add documentation for
this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
With of-platdata-inst we want to set up a reference to each devices'
parent device, if there is one. If we find that the device has a parent
(i.e. is not a root node) but it is not in the list of devices being
written, then we cannot create the reference.
Report an error in this case, since it indicates that the parent node
is either missing a compatible string, is disabled, or perhaps does not
have any properties because it was not tagged for SPL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
All the x86 devicetree files are built at once, whichever board is
actually being built. If coreboot is the target build, CONFIG_ROM_SIZE
is not defined and samus cannot build Chromium OS verified boot. Add
this condition to avoid errors about CONFIG_ROM_SIZE being missing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add information about memory usage when U-Boot is started from coreboot.
This is useful when debugging. Also, since coreboot takes a chunk of
memory in the middle of SDRAM for use by PCI devices, it can help avoid
overwriting this with a loaded kernel by accident.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Use VENDOR_COREBOOT instead of TARGET_COREBOOT so we can have multiple
coreboot boards, sharing options. Only SYS_CONFIG_NAME needs to be
defined TARGET_COREBOOT.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a function comment for get_coreboot_info() and a declaration for
cb_get_sysinfo(), since this may be called from elsewhere.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Set up coral so that it can boot from coreboot, even though it is a
bare-metal build. This helps with testing since the same image can be used
in both cases.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The BIOS version may not be present, e.g. on a Chrome OS build. Add the
BIOS date as well, so we get some sort of indication of coreboot's
vintage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
A recent change to disable cache setup when booting from coreboot
assumed that this has been done by SPL. The result is that for the
coreboot board, the cache is disabled (in start.S) and never
re-enabled.
If the cache was turned off, as it is on boards without SPL, we should
turn it back on. Add this new condition.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
These constants conflict with error codes returned by the MP
implementation when something is wrong. In particular, mp_first_cpu()
returns MP_SELECT_BSP when running without multiprocessing enabled.
Since this is -2, it is interpreted as an error by callers, which
expect a positive CPU number for the first CPU.
Correct this by using a different range for the pre-defined CPU
numbers, above zero and out of the range of possible CPU values. For
now it is safe to assume there are no more than 64K CPUs.
This fixes the 'mtrr' command when CONFIG_SMP is not enabled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When starting U-Boot from a previous-stage bootloader we presumably don't
need to set up the variable MTRRs. In fact this could be harmful if the
existing settings are not what U-Boot uses.
Skip that step in this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
These headers are not actually used. Drop them so that this driver can
be used by other boards, e.g. coreboot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When booting from coreboot we may not have a PCH driver available. The
SPI driver can operate without the PCH but currently complains in this
case. Update it to continue to work normally. The only missing feature
is memory-mapping of SPI-flash contents, which is not essential.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
At present only bridge devices are bound before relocation, to save space
in pre-relocation memory. In some cases we do actually want to bind a
device, e.g. because it provides the console UART. Add a devicetree
binding to support this.
Use the PCI_VENDEV() macro to encode the cell value. This is present in
U-Boot but not used, so move it to the binding header-file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
These functions don't modify the device-ID struct that is passed in, so
mark the argument as const, so the data structure can be declared that
way. This allows it to be placed in the rodata section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a new 'quiet' argument to mmc_get_op_cond() function which avoids
printing error message when SD/eMMC card is not detected.
Espressobin and mx6cuboxi boards use this function for detecting presence
of eMMC and therefore it is expected and normal that eMMC does not have to
be connected. So error message "Card did not respond to voltage select!"
should be skipped in this case as it is not an error.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Acked-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Use function mmc_get_op_cond() instead of mmc_init() for detecting presence
of eMMC. Documentation for this function says that it could be used to
detect the presence of SD/eMMC when no card detect logic is available.
This function is also used by mx6cuboxi board for detecting presence of eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Ensure that 'env default -a' always set correct value to $fdtfile, even
when custom user variable is already stored in non-volatile env storage
(means that env_get("fdtfile") call returns non-NULL value).
As default value is now correctly set like if specified at compile time in
CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS, there is no need to set $fdtfile explicitly via
env_set("fdtfile", ...) call.
So remove wrong skip based on env_get("fdtfile") and then also unneeded
env_set("fdtfile", ...) call.
Fixes: c4df0f6f31 ("arm: mvebu: Espressobin: Set default value for $fdtfile env variable")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The config option CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_CLOCK is not used by Armada 3720's
serial driver (it wasn't even before the recent update of that driver).
Even if it was used, the value was incorrect (the frequency of the clock
is 25 MHz, not 25.8048 MHz).
Remove it from config files and set the default value to 0.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Now that the MTD subsystem properly supports OF partitions of a SPI NOR,
we can enable the MTD command and start using it instead of the
deprecated sf command.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Commit e2e95e5e25 ("spi: Update speed/mode on change") changed the
boot time on Turris Omnia from ~2.3s to over 8s, due to SPL loading main
U-Boot from SPI NOR at 1 MHz instead of 40 MHz.
This is because the SPL code passes the CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED option
to spi_flash_probe(), and with the above commit spi_flash_probe() starts
prefering this parameter instead of the one specified in device-tree.
The proper solution here would probably be to fix the SF subsystem to
prefer the frequency specified in the device-tree, if it is present, but
I am not sure what else will be affected on other boards with such a
change. So until then we need a more simple fix.
Since the CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED option is used by the code, put the
correct value there for Turris Omnia. Also put the correct value to
CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE and use 40 MHz when reading environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
If fixup offset is zero then there is nothing to fix. All calculation in
this case just increase addresses by value zero which results in identity.
So in this case skip whole fixup re-calculation as it is not needed.
This is just an optimization for special case when fix_offset is zero which
skips code path which does only identity operations (meaning nothing). No
functional changes.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Remapped address of PCIe outbound window may have set only bits from the
mask. Add additional check that remapped address which is calculated from
PCIe bus address specified in DTS file is valid.
Remove also useless clearing of low 16 bits in win_mask. As win_size is
power of two and is at least 0x10000 it means that it always has zero low
16 bits.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This script was broken by the change to default archives for linking.
This is due to objcopy specifically disallowing copying of thin
archives. To fix this and re-support external users of this script,
switch to using the same logic the u-boot-initial-env make target uses
to dump the section from the object file.
Reported-by: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@web.de>
Fixes: 958f2e57ef ("build: use thin archives instead of incremental linking")
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When building the envtools target with CONFIG_USE_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE=y,
the tools require generated/defaultenv_autogenerated.h.
In file included from tools/env/fw_env.c:126:
include/env_default.h:115:10: fatal error: generated/defaultenv_autogenerated.h: No such file or directory
115 | #include "generated/defaultenv_autogenerated.h"
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Align Kconfig and Kbuild logic to Linux 4.20 release with minimal impact
on files outside of this scope.
Our previous Kconfig sync was done by commit 587e4a4296 ("kconfig /
kbuild: Re-sync with Linux 4.19").
As part of this re-sync, a few related changes from previous Linux
releases were found to have been missed and merged in, and are not in
the following list.
The imported Linux commits are:
[From prior to v4.19]
b1e0d8b70fa3 kbuild: Fix gcc -x syntax
a4353898980c kconfig: add CC_IS_GCC and GCC_VERSION
469cb7376c06 kconfig: add CC_IS_CLANG and CLANG_VERSION
[From v4.19 to v4.20]
487c7c7702ab kbuild: prefix Makefile.dtbinst path with $(srctree) unconditionally
0d91bf584fe5 kbuild: remove old check for CFLAGS use
25815cf5ffec kbuild: hide most of targets when running config or mixed targets
00d78ab2ba75 kbuild: remove dead code in cmd_files calculation in top Makefile
23066c3f4e21 Compiler Attributes: enable -Wstringop-truncation on W=1 (gcc >= 8)
37c8a5fafa3b kbuild: consolidate Devicetree dtb build rules
80463f1b7bf9 kbuild: add --include-dir flag only for out-of-tree build
77ec0c20c7e0 kbuild: remove VERSION and PATCHLEVEL from $(objtree)/Makefile
74bc0c09b2da kbuild: remove user ID check in scripts/mkmakefile
4fd61277f662 kbuild: do not pass $(objtree) to scripts/mkmakefile
80d0dda3a4e5 kbuild: simplify command line creation in scripts/mkmakefile
fb073a4b473e kbuild: add -Wno-pointer-sign flag unconditionally
9df3e7a7d7d6 kbuild: add -Wno-unused-but-set-variable flag unconditionally
69ea912fda74 kbuild: remove unneeded link_multi_deps
7d0ea2524202 kbuild: use 'else ifeq' for checksrc to improve readability
04c459d20448 kconfig: remove oldnoconfig target
0085b4191f3e kconfig: remove silentoldconfig target
3f80babd9ca4 kbuild: remove unused cc-fullversion variable
2cd3faf87d2d merge_config.sh: Allow to define config prefix
076f421da5d4 kbuild: replace cc-name test with CONFIG_CC_IS_CLANG
6bbe4385d035 kconfig: merge_config: avoid false positive matches from comment lines
[From post v4.20]
885480b08469 Makefile: Move -Wno-unused-but-set-variable out of GCC only block
There are a number of changes related to additional warnings as well as
being able to drop cc-name entirely that have been omitted for now as
additional work is required first.
Cc: Masahiro Yamada <masahiroy@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Update U-Boot's version of scripts/get_maintainer.pl to sync it up with the
latest changes to the Linux kernel's version of the same script.
The last sync was with Linux kernel version v4.16. The commits to the kernel's
get_maintainer.pl since then (starting with the most recent) are:
6343f6b71f83 get_maintainer: exclude MAINTAINERS file(s) from --git-fallback
cdfe2d220476 get_maintainer: add test for file in VCS
e33c9fe8b80c get_maintainer: fix unexpected behavior for path/to//file (double slashes)
0c78c0137621 get_maintainer: add email addresses from .yaml files
0ef82fcefb99 scripts/get_maintainer.pl: deprioritize old Fixes: addresses
ef0c08192ac0 get_maintainer: remove uses of P: for maintainer name
2f5bd343694e scripts/get_maintainer.pl: add signatures from Fixes: <badcommit> lines in commit message
49662503e8e4 get_maintainer: add ability to skip moderated mailing lists
0fbd75fd7fee get_maintainer: allow option --mpath <directory> to read all files in <directory>
5f0baf95b1ed get_maintainer.pl: add -mpath=<path or file> for MAINTAINERS file location
31bb82c9caa9 get_maintainer: allow usage outside of kernel tree
0455c74788fd get_maintainer: improve patch recognition
882ea1d64eb3 scripts: use SPDX tag in get_maintainer and checkpatch
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Function rtc_to_tm() is needed for FAT file system support even if we don't
have a real time clock. So move it from drivers/ to lib/.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The return value '-ENOSPC' of fit_set_timestamp function does not match
the caller fit_image_write_sig's expection which is '-FDT_ERR_NOSPACE'.
Fix it by not calling fit_set_timestamp, but call fdt_setprop instead.
This fixes a following mkimage error:
| Can't write signature for 'signature@1' signature node in
| 'conf@imx6ull-colibri-wifi-eval-v3.dtb' conf node: <unknown error>
| mkimage Can't add hashes to FIT blob: -1
Signed-off-by: Ming Liu <liu.ming50@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
I removed CONFIG_IS_BUILTIN and CONFIG_IS_MODULE in commit
7d78a4547d ("linux/kconfig.h: remove unused helper macros"), but
fixdep.c still looks for those. It's harmless, but also pointless and
possibly confusing to a future reader.
Fixes: 7d78a4547d ("linux/kconfig.h: remove unused helper macros")
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
When "mkimage -l" was run on a block device it would fail with
erroneous message, because fstat reports a size of zero for those:
mkimage: Bad size: "/dev/sdb4" is not valid image
This patch identifies the "is a block device" case and reports it as
such, and if it knows how to determine the size of a block device on
the current OS, proceeds.
As shown in
http://www.mit.edu/afs.new/sipb/user/tytso/e2fsprogs/lib/blkid/getsize.c
this is no portable task, and I only handled the case of a modern
Linux kernel, which is what I can test.
Signed-off-by: Yann Dirson <yann@blade-group.com>
The ST-Ericsson DB8500 SoC contains a MUSB OTG controller which
supports both host and gadget mode. For some reason there is
nothing special about it - add a simple glue driver for Ux500
that literally just sets up MUSB together with a generic PHY.
There are no SoC-specific registers etc needed to make USB work.
The new Ux500 glue driver is only tested to work with DM_USB
and DM_USB_GADGET. Both host and gadget mode work fine on
the u8500 "stemmy" board that is already present in U-Boot.
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
The AB8500 PMIC contains an USB PHY that needs to be set up in
device or host mode to make USB work properly. Add a simple driver
for the generic PHY uclass that allows enabling it.
The if (CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(USB_MUSB_HOST)) might be a bit strange.
The USB PHY must be configured in either host or device mode and
somehow the USB PHY driver must be made aware of the mode.
Actually, the MUSB driver used together with this PHY does not
support dynamic selection of host/device mode in U-Boot at the moment.
Therefore, one very simple approach that works fine is to select
the mode to configure at compile time. When the MUSB driver is
configured in host mode the PHY is configured in host mode, and
similarly when the MUSB driver is configured in device/gadget mode.
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
All devices based on ST-Ericsson Ux500 use a PMIC similar to AB8500
(Analog Baseband). There is AB8500, AB8505, AB9540 and AB8540
although in practice only AB8500 and AB8505 are relevant since the
platforms with AB9540 and AB8540 were cancelled and never used in
production.
In general, the AB8500 PMIC uses I2C as control interface, where the
different register banks are represented as separate I2C devices.
However, in practice AB8500 is always connected to a special I2C bus
on the DB8500 SoC that is controlled by the power/reset/clock
management unit (PRCMU) firmware.
Add a simple driver that allows reading/writing registers of the
AB8500 PMIC. The driver directly accesses registers from the PRCMU
parent device (represented by syscon in U-Boot). Abstracting it
further (e.g. with the i2c uclass) would not provide any advantage
because the PRCMU I2C bus is always just connected to AB8500 and
vice-versa.
The ab8500.h header is mostly taken as-is from Linux (with some
minor adjustments) to allow using similar code in both Linux and
U-Boot.
Cc: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Acked-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The U-Boot "stemmy" board is mainly intended to simplify booting
mainline Linux on various smartphones from Samsung based on ST-Ericsson
Ux500. While the mainline kernel is working great, there are still some
features missing there. In particular, it is currently not possible to
charge the battery when using the mainline kernel.
This means that it is still necessary to boot the downstream/vendor
kernel from Samsung sometimes to charge the device. That kernel is
ancient, still uses board files + ATAGS instead of device trees and
relies on a strange very long kernel command line hardcoded in the
Samsung bootloader.
Actually, since mainline is booted with device trees there is a very
simple way to make the old downstream kernel work as well: We can
simply take most of the ATAGS passed to U-Boot from the Samsung
bootloader and copy them as-is when booting a kernel without device
tree. That way the long command line and other needed ATAGS are copied
as-is without having to bother with them.
The only exception is the ATAG_INITRD - since the initrd is loaded
by U-Boot, the atag for that should be generated in U-Boot so it points
to the correct address. All other ATAGS are copied as-is and not
generated in U-Boot.
Also use the chance and provide a serial# for U-Boot by parsing the
ATAG_SERIAL that is also passed by the Samsung bootloader.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
At the moment the "stemmy" board attempts to detect the RAM size with
a simple memory test (get_ram_size()). Unfortunately, this does not work
correctly for devices with 768 MiB RAM (e.g. Samsung Galaxy Ace 2
(GT-I8160), "codina"). Reading/writing memory after the 768 MiB RAM
succeeds but actually overwrites some earlier parts of the memory.
For U-Boot this does not result in any major problems, but on Linux
this will eventually lead to strange crashes because of the memory
corruption.
Since the "stemmy" U-Boot port is designed to be chainloaded from
the original Samsung bootloader, the most reliable way to get the
available amount of RAM is to look at the ATAGS passed by the Samsung
bootloader. Fortunately, the header used to generate ATAGS in U-Boot
(asm/setup.h) can also be easily used to parse them.
Also clarify and simplify stemmy.h a bit to make it more clear where
some of the magic values in there are actually coming from.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Add PCIe driver for UniPhier SoCs. This PCIe controller is based on
Synopsys DesignWare Core IP.
This version doesn't apply common DW functions because supported
controller doesn't have unroll version of iATU.
Signed-off-by: Kunihiko Hayashi <hayashi.kunihiko@socionext.com>
I'm no longer work in Intel, change Intel SoCFPGA co-maintainer to
Tien Fong Chee.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <lftan.linux@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
According to arch/arm/lib/crt0_64.S, the BSS section is "UNAVAILABLE"
and uninitialized before relocation. Also, it overlaps with the
appended DTB before relocation, so writing data into a variable
in the BSS section might corrupt the appended DTB.
Unfortunately, pinctrl-apq8016.c and pinctrl-apq8096.c do place the
"pin_name" variable in the BSS section (since it's uninitialized).
It's also used before relocation, when setting up the pinctrl for
the serial driver.
On DB410c this causes "GPIO_5" to be written into some part of an
appended DTB, e.g.:
80111820: edfe0dd0 9f100000 38000000 c00e0000 ...........8....
80111830: 28000000 11000000 10000000 00000000 ...(............
80111840: 4f495047 8800355f 00000000 00000000 GPIO_5..........
80111850: 00000000 00000000 01000000 00000000 ................
80111860: 03000000 04000000 00000000 02000000 ................
80111870: 03000000 04000000 0f000000 02000000 ................
80111880: 03000000 2d000000 1b000000 6c617551 .......-....Qual
80111890: 6d6d6f63 63655420 6c6f6e68 6569676f comm Technologie
Depending on the part of the DTB that is corrupted this might not
cause any problems, but it can also result in strange reboots
without any serial output.
Fortunately, in practice this does not cause issues on DB410c yet
because board_fdt_blob_setup() in dragonboard410c.c currently
overrides the appended DTB with the one passed by the previous
bootloader (LK) (which does not get corrupted).
DB820c does not have board_fdt_blob_setup() so I would expect it to
be affected by this problem. Perhaps everyone was just fortunate to
not compile an U-Boot configuration where the pin_name corrupts an
important part of the DTB.
Make sure "pin_name" is explicitly placed in the .data section
instead of .bss to fix this.
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The sysinfo_get_str() implementation checks whether the sysinfo was even
detected. In U-Boot proper, sysinfo_detect() is not called anywhere but
on one specific board. Call sysinfo_detect() before sysinfo_get_str() to
make sure the sysinfo is detected and sysinfo_get_str() returns valid
value instead of -EPERM.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Replace uclass_first_device_err(UCLASS_SYSINFO, &dev) with sysinfo_get(&dev).
The board_info code may use sysinfo to print board information, so use the
sysinfo functions consistently. The sysinfo_get() is internally implemented
as return uclass_first_device_err(UCLASS_SYSINFO, &dev) anyway, so there is
no functional change.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Linux kernel binding is using atmel,24c01 compatible string. On the
other hand there is atmel,24c01a which is not listed in the kernel.
Add compatible string without "a" suffix to be compatible with Linux
kernel binding.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Simplify the code a bit by using dev_read_addr_ptr() instead of
dev_read_addr(). This avoids having to cast explicitly to the
struct nomadik_mtu_regs.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Nomadik GPIO is a fairly simple GPIO module used in the ST-Ericsson
Ux500 SoCs (and some older Nomadik SoCs). It uses registers where
each GPIO is represented as a single bit, plus "set" and "clear"
registers that allow updating the state without having to read the
existing state.
The driver implements support for it for use together with DM_GPIO
and the existing ste-dbx5x0.dtsi device tree.
Cc: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
The original U-Boot port for the ST-Ericsson U8500 SoC was dropped
in commit 68282f55b8 ("arm: Remove unused ST-Ericsson u8500 arch").
Most of the drivers related to the old port were removed, but the
db8500_gpio.c driver was forgotten for some reason. There is no way
to select it and it does not compile anymore because of missing
headers, so let's just remove it.
The new port for U8500 introduced in commit 689088f9da
("arm: Add support for ST-Ericsson U8500 SoC") fully embraces the
new Driver Model and device trees where possible, so this is
preparation to add a new, simplified GPIO driver based on DM_GPIO.
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Pull request for efi-2021-10-rc1
Documentation
* fix typo in signature.txt
UEFI
* provide file attributes in EFI_FILE_PROTOCOL.Read()
* various capsule update fixes
Fix find_boot_device() to set bootdev_root if it finds the
bootdev from BootNext. Currently it sets the bootdev_root only
when it finds bootdev from BootOrder.
Fixes: c74cd8bd08 ("efi_loader: capsule: add capsule_on_disk support")
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Accked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If multiple capsules are applied, the FMP drivers for the individual
capsules can expect the value of CapsuleLast to be accurate. Hence
CapsuleLast must be updated after each capsule.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
* Use log category LOGC_EFI. This allows to remove 'EFI:' prefixes in
messages.
* Rephrase some of the messages.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When reading a directory using EFI_FILE_PROTOCOL.Read() provide file
attributes and timestamps.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When reading a directory in the UEFI file system we have to return file
attributes and timestamps. Copy this data to the directory entry structure.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The default implementation of checkboard() calls the
nxp_board_rev_string() function
to retrieve a character representing the revision number of the board.
However, this
attempt to retrieve the revision number may fail in certain situations or be
otherwise undesirable.
There is already a configuration option to avoid retrieving the
revision number of
the board: CONFIG_NXP_BOARD_REVISION. In fact, if this option is enabled, the
nxp_board_rev_string() function's definition will be omitted entirely,
meaning that the previous implementation of checkboard() would result
in a linker error.
This changeset makes the default implementation of checkboard() respect the
CONFIG_NXP_BOARD_REVISION configuration option, only attempting to retrieve
the board revision number if that option is defined.
Signed-off-by: Cody Gray <cody@codygray.com>
In case the iMX8M boot from eMMC boot partition and the primary image
is corrupted, the BootROM is capable of starting a secondary image in
the other eMMC boot partition as a fallback.
However, the BootROM leaves the eMMC BOOT_PARTITION_ENABLE setting as
it was, i.e. pointing to the boot partition containing the corrupted
image, and the BootROM does not provide any indication that this sort
of fallback occured.
According to AN12853 i.MX ROMs Log Events, Rev. 0, May 2020, it is
possible to determine whether fallback event occurred by parsing the
ROM event log. In case ROM event ID 0x51 is present, fallback event
did occur.
This patch implements ROM event log parsing and search for event ID
0x51 for all iMX8M SoCs, and based on that corrects the eMMC boot
partition selection. This way, the SPL loads the remaining boot
components from the same eMMC boot partition from which it was
started, even in case of the fallback.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Cc: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Cc: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
The Gateworks System Controller thermal protection feature will disable
the board primary power supply if the on-board temperature sensor
reaches 86C. In many cases this could occur before the temperature
critical components such as CPU, DRAM, eMMC, and power supplies have
reached their max temperature.
Remove the forced re-enable of thermal protection so that users can
knowingly disable it.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The imx8mm-venice-gw7901 board has an I2C connected KSZ9897S GbE switch
with an IMX8MM FEC MAC master connected via RGMII_ID.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Fix the dsa switch config:
- remove the unnecessary phy-mode from the switch itself
- added the necessary fixed-link node to the non-cpu ports required
for U-Boot DSA
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The Microchip KSZ9477/KSZ9897/KSZ9567 7-Port Gigabit Ethernet Switches
support SGMII/RGMII/MII/RMII with register access via SPI, I2C, or MDIO.
This driver currently supports I2C register access but SPI or MDIO register
access can be easily added at a later time.
Tagging is not implemented and instead the active port is tracked to
avoid needing a tag to store port information.
This was tested with the imx8mm-venice-gw7901 board which has a
KSZ9897S switch with an IMX8MM FEC MAC master connected via RGMII_ID.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If ports have their own unique MAC addrs and master has a set_promisc
function, call it so that packets will be received for ports.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Enabling promiscuous mode is necessary if FEC is the master of a DSA
switch driver where each port has their own MAC address.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Enabling promiscuous mode can be useful for DSA switches where each port
has its own MAC address.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If the FEC is connected to a fixed-link (upstream switch port for
example) the phy_of_node should be set to the fixed-link node
so that speed and other properties can be found properly.
In addition fix a typo in the debug string.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
When using uclass_get_device* to get the FEC device we need to use
device sequence instead of index into UCLASS_ETH. In systems where for
example a I2C based DSA switch exists it will probe before the FEC
master and its ports will be registered first and have the first
indexes yet the FEC's sequence comes from the device-tree alias.
Take for example the imx8mm-venice-gw7901 board which has an i2c based
DSA switch:
u-boot=> net list
eth1 : lan1 00:0d:8d:aa:00:2f
eth2 : lan2 00:0d:8d:aa:00:30
eth3 : lan3 00:0d:8d:aa:00:31
eth4 : lan4 00:0d:8d:aa:00:32
eth0 : ethernet@30be0000 00:0d:8d:aa:00:2e active
Thus in this case uclass_get_device(UCLASS_ETH, 0, &dev) returns lan1
which is wrong but uclass_get_device_seq(UCLASS_ETH, 0, &dev) returns
ethernet@30be000 which is correct.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The Gateworks GW7901 is an ARM based single board computer (SBC)
featuring:
- i.MX8M Mini SoC
- LPDDR4 DRAM
- eMMC FLASH
- SPI FRAM
- Gateworks System Controller (GSC)
- Atmel ATECC Crypto Authentication
- USB 2.0
- Microchip GbE Switch
- Multiple multi-protocol RS232/RS485/RS422 Serial ports
- onboard 802.11ac WiFi / BT
- microSD socket
- miniPCIe socket with PCIe, USB 2.0 and dual SIM sockets
- Wide range DC power input
- 802.3at PoE
To add support for this board:
- add dts from Linux (accepted for v5.14)
- add SPL PMIC config
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The driver depends on DM_SPI and if it's not available (e. g. in SPL),
then we should not try to build it as this will fail.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Make macros actually use passed parameter instead of local variables
that happen
to be named the same as symbols in macro expansion.
Signed-off-by: Kacper Kubkowski <kkubkowski@fluence.pl>
Increase VDD_ARM to prevent timing issues as VDD_SOC is
used in OD mode. Also increase GIC clock.
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable support for the fec ethernet on phyCORE-i.MX8MP.
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
With the first redesign the debug UART had changed from
UART2 to UART1.
As the first hardware revision is considered as alpha and
will not be supported in future. The old setup will not
be preserved.
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This update includes eqos support and some minor changes.
Synced with kernel commit
412627f6ffe3 ("arm64: dts: imx8mp-phyboard-pollux-rdk: Add missing pinctrl entry")
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Factor out the common node settings for dm-spl and dm-pre-reloc
and move them to imx8mp-u-boot.dtsi
Signed-off-by: Teresa Remmet <t.remmet@phytec.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
If reset-gpio is defined by device-tree use that if
CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO is not defined.
Note that after this the following boards which define
CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO in their board header file as well as their
device-tree should be able to remove CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO without
consequence:
- mx6sabresd
- mx6sxsabresd
- novena
- tbs2910
- vining_2000
Note that the ge_bx50v3 board uses CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO and does
not have reset-gpios defined it it's pcie node in the dt thus removing
CONFIG_PCIE_IMX_PERST_GPIO globally can't be done until that board adds
reset-gpios.
Cc: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com> (maintainer:GE BX50V3 BOARD)
Cc: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com> (maintainer:GE BX50V3 BOARD)
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com> (maintainer:MX6SABRESD BOARD)
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de> (maintainer:NOVENA BOARD)
Cc: Soeren Moch <smoch@web.de> (maintainer:TBS2910 BOARD)
Cc: Silvio Fricke <open-source@softing.de> (maintainer:VINING_2000 BOARD)
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Select the CMD_UNZIP option so that the 'gzwrite' command
can be used to flash .gz image into the eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
On the Yocto image there is a single partition and the kernel
and dtb are present in the 'boot' directory.
Change it accordingly so that the board can boot the Yocto
image by default.
Use the generic 'load' command instead, which is able to
read from an ext4 partition.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Add LVDS support for DLC0700XDP21LF 7in 1024x600 display
(equivalent to the DLC-700JMGT4 with new touch controller)
Signed-off-by: Robert Jones <rjones@gateworks.com>
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
In the default pulse-skipping mode regulators that are very lightly
loaded can fail to regulate properly. Switching them to always use
continuous mode causes only around 10mW of overall system power
difference in a lightly loaded system that isn't already operating
them in continuous mode.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
In the default 'auto' mode regulators that are very lightly loaded
can be put in PFM mode and fail to regulator properly. Switching them
to always use continuous PWM mode has a neglibable affect on system
power and garuntees proper regulation under lightly loaded circumstances.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Substitutions in EOL parts changes the VDD_2P5 voltage rail such that
the previously unused VGEN6 LDO is needed in place of the lower power
VGEN5 for the GW54xx-G.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
For some time now having USB_KEYBOARD support has caused usb to be
initialized on boot. To allow for a quicker bootup we don't want this
for Ventana and don't really need USB keyboard support so remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Some IPs have their accessible address space restricted by the
interconnect. Let's make sure U-Boot only ever uses the space below
the 4G address boundary (which is 3GiB big), even when the effective
available memory is bigger.
We implement board_get_usable_ram_top() for all i.MX8M SoCs, as the
whole family is affected by this.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
The MX25V8035F is a 8Mb SPI NOR flash and the MX25R1635F is very
similar, but has twice the size (16Mb) and supports a wider supply
voltage range.
They were tested on the Kontron Electronics i.MX6UL and i.MX8MM SoMs.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Aside from the usual fixes and updates one visible change is the
MMC update, which fixes some lingering bugs and gives a decent speed
increase on some boards (9->19 MB/s on H6, 21->43 MB/s on A64 eMMC).
I am keeping an watchful eye on bug reports here, to spot any correctness
regressions.
Another change is finally the enablement of the first USB host port on
many boards without micro-USB (data) sockets, like the Pine64 family.
That doubles the number of usable USB ports from 1 to 2 on those boards.
Some smaller fixes, 4GB DRAM support (on the H616) and a new board (ZeroPi)
conclude this first round of changes.
Compile-tested for all 157 sunxi boards, boot-tested on Pine H64,
Pine64-LTS, OrangePi Zero 2 and BananaPi M2 Berry.
Summary:
- DT update for H3/H5/H6
- Enable first USB port on boards without micro-USB
- ZeroPi board support
- 4GB DRAM support for H616 boards
- MMC fixes and speed improvement
- some fixes
At the moment the Allwinner MMC driver parses the bus-width and
non-removable DT properties itself, in the probe() routine.
There is actually a generic function provided by the MMC framework doing
this job, also it parses more generic properties like broken-cd and
advanced transfer modes.
Drop our own code and call mmc_of_parse() instead, to get all new
features for free.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
To avoid the complexity of DMA operations (with chained descriptors), we
use repeated MMIO reads and writes to the SD_FIFO_REG, which allows us
to drain or fill the MMC data buffer FIFO very easily.
However those MMIO accesses are somewhat costly, so this limits our MMC
performance, to between 17 and 22 MB/s, but down to 9.5 MB/s on the H6
(partly due to the lower AHB1 frequency).
As it turns out we read the FIFO status register after *every* word we
read or write, which effectively doubles the number of MMIO accesses,
thus effectively more than halving our performance.
To avoid this overhead, we can make use of the FIFO level bits, which are
in the very same FIFO status registers.
So for a read request, we now can collect as many words as the FIFO
level originally indicated, and only then need to update the status
register.
We don't know for sure the size of the FIFO (and it seems to differ
across SoCs anyway), so writing is more fragile, which is why we still
use the old method for that. If we find a minimum FIFO size available on
all SoCs, we could use that, in a later optimisation.
This patch increases the eMMC read speed on a Pine64-LTS from about
22MB/s to 44 MB/s. SD card reads don't gain that much, but with 23 MB/s
we now reach the practical limit for 3.3V SD cards.
On the H6 we double our transfer speed, from 9.5 MB/s to 19.7 MB/s.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Newer SoCs have a self calibration feature, which avoids us writing hard
coded phase delay values into the controller.
Consolidate the code by avoiding unnecessary #ifdefs, and also enabling
the feature for all those newer SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
All SoCs since the Allwinner A64 (H5, H6, R40, H616) feature the so
called "new timing mode", so enable this in Kconfig for those SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Among the SoCs using the "new timing mode", only the A83T needs to
explicitly switch to that mode.
By just defining the symbol for that one odd A83T bit to 0 for any other
SoCs, we can always OR that in, and save the confusing nested #ifdefs.
Clean up the also confusing new_mode setting on the way.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Most Allwinner SoCs which use the so called "new timing mode" in their
MMC controllers actually use the double-rate PLL6/PERIPH0 clock as their
parent input clock. This is interestingly enough compensated by a hidden
"by 2" post-divider in the mod clock, so the divider and actual output
rate stay the same.
Even though for the H6 and H616 (but only for them!) we use the doubled
input clock for the divider computation, we never accounted for the
implicit post-divider, so the clock was only half the speed on those SoCs.
This didn't really matter so far, as our slow MMIO routine limits the
transfer speed anyway, but we will fix this soon.
Clean up the code around that selection, to always use the normal PLL6
(PERIPH0(1x)) clock as an input. As the rate and divider are the same,
that makes no difference.
Explain the hardware differences in a comment.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When enabling PHYS_64BIT on 32-bit platforms, we get two warnings about
pointer casts in sunxi_mmc.c. Those are related to MMIO addresses, which
are always below 1GB on all Allwinner SoCs, so there is no problem with
anything having more than 32 bits.
Add the proper casts to make it compile cleanly.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The delay and bus-width setup are slightly different across the
Allwinner SoC generations, and we covered this so far with some
preprocessor conditionals.
Use the more readable IS_ENABLE() instead.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The H616 is our first supported Allwinner SoC which goes beyond the 4GB
address space "barrier", by having more than 32 address bits.
Lift the preliminary 3GB DRAM limit for the H616, and update the page
table setup on the way, to actually map that last GB as well.
As not all devices are actually capable of dealing with more than 32
bits (the DMA in the EMAC for instance), we also limit U-Boot's own
DRAM usage to 4GB on the way.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
We hardcode the pinctrl setting for the MMC controllers in boards.c,
since we need them also in the SPL, where there is no DT yet.
Add the respective setting for the H616 SoC, to enable eMMC on boards
with this SoC as well.
Also to make diagnosing this problem easier, print a warning if a board
tries to setup MMC2 pins without a respective SoC setting being defined.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan at amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec at siol.net>
ZeroPi is a new board of high performance with low cost
designed by FriendlyElec., using the Allwinner H3 SOC.
ZeroPi features
- Allwinner H3, Quad-core Cortex-A7@1.2GHz
- 256MB/512MB DDR3 RAM
- microsd slot
- 10/100/1000Mbps Ethernet
- Debug Serial Port
- DC 5V/2A power-supply
Signed-off-by: Yu-Tung Chang <mtwget@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
OrangePi PC2 board has DRAM with ODT, so enable it.
H5 SoC is also connected to voltage regulator. It's default value is
reasonable at reset, but might be too low when rebooting with a lower
voltage programmed. In order to avoid instability, enable driver for it
and set it to appropriate voltage.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
[Andre: remove original ZQ value change, adjust commit message]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Most clock factors and dividers in the H6 PLLs use a "+1 encoding",
which we were missing on two occasions.
This fixes the MMC clock setup on the H6, which could be slightly off due
to the wrong parent frequency:
mmc 2 set mod-clk req 52000000 parent 1176000000 n 2 m 12 rate 49000000
Also the CPU frequency (PLL1) was a tad too high before.
For PLL5 (DRAM) we already accounted for this +1, but in the DRAM code
itself, not in the bit field macro. Move this there to be aligned with
what the other SoCs and other PLLs do.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Recent Allwinner platforms (starting with the H3) only use the MUSB
controller for peripheral mode and use HCI for host mode. As a result,
extra steps need to be taken to properly route USB signals to one or
the other. More precisely, the following is required:
* Routing the pins to either HCI/MUSB (controlled by PHY);
* Enabling USB PHY passby in HCI mode (controlled by PMU).
The current code will enable passby for each PHY and reroute PHY0 to
MUSB, which is inconsistent and results in broken USB peripheral support.
Passby on PHY0 must only be enabled when we want to use HCI. Since
host/device mode detection is not available from the PHY code and
because U-Boot does not support changing the mode dynamically anyway,
we can just mux the controller to MUSB if it is enabled and mux it to
HCI otherwise.
This fixes USB peripheral support for platforms with PHY0 dual-route,
especially H3/H5 and V3s.
Signed-off-by: Paul Kocialkowski <paul.kocialkowski@bootlin.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Update the H3 DT files from the Linux 5.12 release.
The changes update some boards, and don't affect U-Boot, but fix Gigabit
Ethernet when this DT is passed on to the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Update the H5 DT files from the Linux 5.12 release.
The changes don't affect U-Boot at all, but fix Gigabit Ethernet when
this DT is passed on to the Linux kernel. It also introduces DVFS.
This also updates the shared sunxi-h3-h5.dtsi, but that only adds nodes
that are of no concern to U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Update the H6 DT files from the Linux 5.12 release.
The changes are minimal (many LED node renames), but also help to enable
USB port 0 in U-Boot (later), enable the RSB device (not yet used in
U-Boot), and also introduce an MMC frequency limit.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
As seen with clang-12:
warning: __asm_invalidate_l3_dcache changed binding to STB_WEAK
As we indeed use ENTRY and then declare the function weak manually. Use
the WEAK declarative from <linux/linkage.h> instead.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
On arm64, board info is not applicable and kernel command line patched into
the DT, so the LMB reservation here makes no sense anymore. On legacy arm32,
this might still be necessary on systems which do not use DT or use legacy
ATAGS. Disable this LMB reservation on arm64.
This also permits Linux DT to specify reserved memory node at address close
to the end of DRAM bank, i.e. overlaping with U-Boot location. Since after
boot, U-Boot will be no more, this is OK.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Cc: Simon Goldschmidt <simon.k.r.goldschmidt@gmail.com>
Cc: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Fix following compilation issue when SYS_DCACHE_OFF is enable:
drivers/misc/scmi_agent.c:128: undefined reference to `mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour'
when SYS_DCACHE_OFF is enable, mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour() must be
defined.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
On implementations that support VHE, the layout of the CPTR_EL2
register depends on whether HCR_EL2.E2H is set. If the bit is
set, CPTR_EL2 uses the same layout as CPACR_EL1 and can in fact
be accessed through that register. In that case, jump to the
EL1 code to enable access to the FP/SIMD registers. This allows
U-Boot to run on systems that pass control to U-Boot in EL2 with
EL2 Host mode enabled such as machines using Apple's M1 SoC.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Acked-by: Marc Zyngier <maz@kernel.org>
The cavium,bdk node is a non-standard dt node used by the BDK and
therefore it is removed from the dt before booting Linux. Do not
require this node to exist as it won't for standard dt's.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Extend CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE and include all standard baudrates and
also nonstandard up to the 6 MBaud. U-Boot's A3720 UART driver can use
baudrates from 300 Baud to 6 MBaud.
This changes all A3720 boards, since all of them include either
mvebu_armada-37xx.h or turris_mox.h config file.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Unfortunately the UART driver in current Linux for Armada 3700 expects
UART's parent clock to be XTAL and calculats baudrate divisor according
to XTAL clock. Therefore we must switch back to XTAL clock before
booting kernel.
Implement .remove method for this driver with DM_FLAG_OS_PREPARE flag
set.
If current baudrate is unsuitable for XTAL clock then we do not change
anything. This can only happen if the user either configured unsupported
settings or knows what they are doing and has kernel patches which allow
usage of non-XTAL parent clock.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Using TBG clock as parent clock for UART allows us using higher
baudrates than 230400.
Turris MOX with external FT232RL USB-UART works fine up to 3 MBaud
(which is maximum for this USB-UART controller), while EspressoBIN with
integrated pl2303 USB-UART also works fine up to 6 MBaud.
Slower baudrates with TBG as a parent clock can be achieved by
increasing TBG dividers and oversampling divider. When using the slowest
TBG clock, minimal working baudrate is 300.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Setting DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC for Armada 3720 clock drivers (TBG and
peripheral clocks) makes it possible for serial driver to retrieve clock
rates via clk API.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
UART parent clock is by default the platform's xtal clock, which is
25 MHz.
The value defined in the driver, though, is 25.8048 MHz. This is a hack
for the suboptimal divisor calculation
Divisor = UART clock / (16 * baudrate)
which does not use rounding division, resulting in a suboptimal value
for divisor if the correct parent clock rate was used.
Change the code for divisor calculation to round to closest value, i.e.
Divisor = Round(UART clock / (16 * baudrate))
and change the parent clock rate value to that returned by
get_ref_clk().
This makes A3720 UART stable at standard UART baudrates between 1800 and
230400.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
With the spear family of platforms gone, remove references to them from
the build jobs.
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
While this platform has not yet been converted, there is active efforts
to do so. Keep the platform for now.
This reverts commit aa697e6904.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Remove a large number of platforms that did not migrate to DM_PCI or
DM_USB by 2 years past the migration deadline and do not have a
migration imminent.
If MUSB support is disabled, these parts of the code will fail to build.
Cc: Paul Kocialkowski <contact@paulk.fr>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them. As this is
the last of the SPEAr platforms, so remove the rest of the remaining
support as well.
Cc: Vipin Kumar <vipin.kumar@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them. As this is
also the last SPEAR3XX platform, remove that symbol as well.
Cc: Vipin Kumar <vipin.kumar@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Cc: Vipin Kumar <vipin.kumar@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Cc: Vipin Kumar <vipin.kumar@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it
Cc: Ajay Bhargav <contact@8051projects.net>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it.
This is also the last PL010_SERIAL using board, so remove those
references.
Cc: Sergey Kostanbaev <sergey.kostanbaev@fairwaves.ru>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_USB by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Cc: Andreas Bießmann <andreas@biessmann.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As this board does not use CONFIG_OF_CONTROL and the DM_USB migration
deadline has passed, disable USB_GADGET support.
Cc: Eric Nelson <eric@nelint.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Eric Nelson <eric@nelint.com>
As these boards support CONFIG_OF_CONTROL today, perform a basic
CONFIG_DM migration.
Cc: Eric Cooper <ecc@cmu.edu>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As these boards support CONFIG_OF_CONTROL today, perform a basic
CONFIG_DM migration.
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As these boards support CONFIG_OF_CONTROL today, perform a basic
CONFIG_DM migration.
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka@openwrt.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As these boards support CONFIG_OF_CONTROL today, perform a basic
CONFIG_DM migration.
Cc: Dave Purdy <david.c.purdy@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As these boards support CONFIG_OF_CONTROL today, perform a basic
CONFIG_DM migration.
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not converted to DM_USB by the deadline, disable USB
support as they do not enable CONFIG_OF_CONTROL.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it. As this is the last
ARCH_T4160 platform, remove that support as well.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it. As this is the last
ARCH_MPC8315 platform, remove that support as well.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it. This is also the last
of the ARCH_MPC8641/MPC8610 platforms, so remove that support as well.
Cc: Paul Gortmaker <paul.gortmaker@windriver.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them. As this includes
the last ARCH_MPC8572 platform, remove that as well.
Cc: Peter Tyser <ptyser@xes-inc.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Peter Tyser <ptyser@xes-inc.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it. As this is the last
ARCH_MPC8568 platform, remove that support as well.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them. As this is
the only ARCH_T1023 platform left, remove that support as well.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them. As this is the only
ARCH_MPC8555 platform left, remove that support as well.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it. As this is the only
MPC8541 target left, remove that architecture support as well.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and is
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline and are
also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Cc: Paul Gortmaker <paul.gortmaker@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline
and is also missing conversion to CONFIG_DM. Remove them.
Cc: Reinhard Arlt <reinhard.arlt@esd-electronics.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Ilya Yanok <yanok@emcraft.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI, CONFIG_DM_USB or
in some cases CONFIG_DM itself by the deadline. Remove them.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline.
Remove them. As this is the last of the mcf547x_8x family of boards,
remove that support as well.
Cc: TsiChung Liew <Tsi-Chung.Liew@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_PCI by the deadline.
Remove them. As this is all of the CONFIG_M548x platforms as well,
remove that code.
Cc: TsiChung Liew <Tsi-Chung.Liew@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With the ventana boards migrated to DM_PCI and DM_ETH, we can remove
this prototype.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- Move to gcc-11.1.0 builds from kernel.org for supported platforms and
LLVM-11 for those tests.
- As Heinrich has noted, the RISC-V platform specification has a profile
OS-A for running rich operating systems like Linux and BSD. This profile
requires 64bit and UEFI conforming to the EBBR. Only the 'embedded'
profile may use 32bit. Given this, drop grub for 32bit RISC-V as it no
longer compiles with gcc-11.1 and upstream is unlikely to fix it:
https://www.mail-archive.com/grub-devel@gnu.org/msg30736.html
- Update to grub-2.06 release to address other issues of building with
gcc-11.1.
- Update to newer Xtensa (gcc-9.2.0) and ARC (gcc-10.2) toolchains
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
With x86 we can execute an option ROM either natively or using the
x86 emulator (if enabled with CONFIG_BIOSEMU). Both of these share
the _X86EMU_env variable, with the native code using it to hold
register state during interrupt processing.
At present, in 32-bit U-Boot, the variable is declared twice, once
in common code and once in code only compiled with CONFIG_BIOSEMU.
With GCC 11 this causes a 'multiple definitions' error on boards
with CONFIG_BIOSEMU.
Drop the emulator definition when CONFIG_BIOSEMU is used.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When we do not have bootstage enabled, rather than include an empty
dummy function, we just don't reference it. This saves us space in some
tight builds. This also shows a few cases where show_boot_progress was
incorrectly guarded before.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Follow what the Linux Kernel does here and disable the
'zero-length-bounds', 'array-bounds' and 'stringop-overflow' warnings
here.
This brings in commits 5c45de21a2223, 44720996e2d79 and 5a76021c2eff7
from the Linux Kernel.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The board code here references the display_width / display_height
variables set in the video driver, declare these as externs as gcc-11
will notice and lead to a multiple definition error.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In some board cpld.h files the definition of the cpld_data struct
not-quite makes a typedef for cpld_data_t. This problem is caught with
gcc-11 as a multiple definition error. As there are no users of this
non-typedef, fix this by not declaring it one to begin with.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Shengzhou Liu <Shengzhou.Liu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With gcc-11 we see:
drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ddr3_debug.c:672:47: error: argument 2 of type 'u32[5]' {aka 'unsigned int[5]'} with mismatched bound [-Werror=array-parameter=]
672 | int ddr3_tip_read_adll_value(u32 dev_num, u32 pup_values[MAX_INTERFACE_NUM * MAX_BUS_NUM],
| ~~~~^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
In file included from drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ddr3_training_ip_engine.h:10,
from drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ddr3_init.h:17,
from drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ddr3_debug.c:6:
drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ddr3_training_ip_flow.h:116:47: note: previously declared as 'u32[]' {aka 'unsigned int[]'}
And similar warnings. Correct these by updating the prototype. Remove
the prototype for ddr3_tip_read_pup_value as it is unused.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
First set of u-boot-atmel fixes for 2021.10 cycle:
This small fixes set is dedicated to fixing the onewire subsystem for
the at91 boards which was broken since 2020.04.
Previous device tree for OpenPiton emits a warning during compilation.
This commit fixes the previous warning adds dts to the OpenPiton RISC-V
board and added the device tree to MAINTAINER file.
Signed-off-by: Tianrui Wei <tianrui-wei@outlook.com>
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
- mpc8379erdb DM_USB, DM_PCI and DM_ETH support.
- Drop PCI support from the integrator family of boards
- Add synquacer support
- Assorted lpc32xx updates and improvements
- snapdragon (and related) fixes, Broadcom iproc update
At the moment, the U-Boot serial_msm driver does not initialize the
UART_DM_DMEN register with the required value. Usually this does not
cause any problems, because there is Qualcomm's LK bootloader running
before U-Boot which initializes the register with the correct value.
It's important that this register is initialized correctly, because
the U-Boot driver does not make use of the BAM/DMA or single character
mode functionality of the UART controller. A different bootloader
before U-Boot might initialize the register differently.
For example, on DragonBoard 410c U-Boot can also be installed to the
"aboot" partition (replacing LK entirely). In this case U-Boot is
loaded directly by SBL, which seems to use the single-character mode
for some reason. In single character mode there is always just one
char in the FIFO, instead of the 4 characters expected by
msm_serial_fetch(). It also causes issues with "earlycon" later in
the Linux kernel, which tries to output 4 chars at once,
but only the first char will be written.
This causes early UART log in Linux to be corrupted like this:
[ 00ano:ameoi .Q1B[ 00ac _idaM00080oo'ahani-lcle._20). 15NdNii 5 SPMSJ20:U2
[ 00rkoolmsamel
[ 00Fw ]elamletopsioble
[ 00ore
instead of
[ 0.000000] Booting Linux on physical CPU 0x0000000000 [0x410fd030]
[ 0.000000] Machine model: Qualcomm Technologies, Inc. APQ 8016 SBC
[ 0.000000] earlycon: msm_serial_dm0 at MMIO 0x00000000078b0000 (options '')
[ 0.000000] printk: bootconsole [msm_serial_dm0] enabled
Make sure to initialize UART_DM_DMEN correctly to fix this issue
when loading U-Boot directly after SBL (instead of through LK).
There is no functional difference when loading U-Boot through LK
since LK also initializes UART_DM_DMEN to 0x0. [1]
[1]: https://git.linaro.org/landing-teams/working/qualcomm/lk.git/tree/platform/msm_shared/uart_dm.c?h=dragonboard410c-LA.BR.1.2.7-03810-8x16.0-linaro3#n203
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
It looks like SD card detection is broken at the moment for DB410c.
The eMMC is detected correctly, but the SD card is not.
This is probably similar to the issue fixed in commit 8505147403
("mmc: msm_sdhci: Use mmc_of_parse for setting host_caps") for eMMC,
except that the SD card does not have a property like "non-removable"
that skips the card detection.
The SDHCI on DB410c cannot detect itself if a SD card is inserted,
so add the necessary cd-gpios to make SD card detection work again.
While at it, fix the #gpio-cells for the soc_gpios to avoid DTC
warnings - the soc_gpios are actually already used with two cells
for the gpio-leds so this was just wrong all the time.
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stephan Gerhold <stephan@gerhold.net>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The GICC register used by u-boot is 0x0a20c000, which is actually a GICC
for WCNSS, the WLAN processor. U-boot runs on the Application Processor,
therefore it should use APCS GICC instead. Hence, correct it with APCS GICC
register address.
Signed-off-by: Sheep Sun <sunxiaoyang2003@gmail.com>
Enable a DMed i2c driver for the ea-lpc3250devkitv2 board.
Include some sample commands/output for testing.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Convert the CONFIG_SYS_I2C_LPC32XX configuration symbol from an include
directive to a Kconfig value.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the of_match/compatible string to the lpc32xx i2c driver so it works
correctly with device-tree.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
The lpc32xx driver was not obtaining the per-device base address correctly
from the device tree. Fix the FIXME in order to get the correct base address.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Add basic support for running U-Boot on the Embedded Artists LPC3250
Developer's Kit v2 board by launching U-Boot from the board's s1l loader
(which comes pre-installed on the board).
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Import the dtsi, dts, and clock binding files for the lpc32xx ea3250 board
directly and unmodified from the latest Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
There's nothing special or unique to the lpc32xx that requires its own config
parameter for specifying the console uart index. Therefore instead of using
the lpc32xx-specific CONFIG_SYS_LPC32XX_UART include parameter, use the
already-available CONFIG_CONS_INDEX from Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable EFI capsule update support. With the EFI capsule update,
you can update U-Boot, TF-A and OP-TEE. TF-A and OP-TEE are
usually combined as a FIP binary, but if the binary is bigger
than 480KB, you have to modify FIP header, split the OP-TEE
and stores the OP-TEE binary in the different place. This
configuration supports both cases.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since the EDK2 GenerateCapsule script is out of date and it
doesn't generate the supported version capsule file, the document
should refer the mkeficapsule in tools.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Add the DeveloperBox 96boards EE support. This board is also
known as Socionext SynQuacer E-Series. It contians one "SC2A11"
SoC, which has 24-cores of arm Cortex-A53, and 4 DDR3 slots,
3 PCIe slots (1 4x port and 2 1x ports which are expanded via
PCIe bridge chip), 2 USB 3.0 ports and 2 USB 2.0 ports, 2 SATA
ports and 1 GbE, 64MB NOR flash and 8GB eMMC on standard
MicroATX Form Factor.
For more information, see this page;
https://www.96boards.org/product/developerbox/
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Add device trees for 96boards EE DeveloperBox and basement SynQuacer
SoC dtsi. These files are imported from EDK2
commit 83d38b0b4c0f240d4488c600bbe87cea391f3922
as-is (except for the changes #include path and some macros).
And add U-Boot specific changes in synquacer-sc2a11-developerbox-u-boot.dtsi
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
This is a driver for the HSSPI SPI controller on SynQuacer SoC.
The HSSPI has command sequence mode (memory mapped) and
direct mode (FIFO access). The driver will operate it under
the direct mode. And before booting OS, it switch back to the
command sequence mode since that is compatible with default
EDK2 behavior.
Signed-off-by: Jassi Brar <jaswinder.singh@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Add ECAM based SynQuacer PCIe RC driver. This driver configures the
PCIe RC and filter out a ghost pcie config.
Since the Linux kernel expects "socionext,synquacer-pcie-ecam" device
is configured by firmware (EDK2), it doesn't re-configure in the kernel.
So as same as EDK2, U-Boot needs to configure it before boot the kernel.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Since some SoCs and boards do not hae extra asm/arch/gpio.h,
introduce CONFIG_GPIO_EXTRA_HEADER instead of adding
!define(CONFIG_ARCH_XXXX) in asm/gpio.h.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Without this fix, scsi-scan will cause a synchronous abort
when accessing ops->scan.
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for 1.3GHz, 1.35GHz and 1.4GHz parts. This is based on
equivalent code in Broadcom's LDK 5.0.6.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
We didn't convert the Integrator to use DM for PCI in
time, and we don't use it either so let's just drop
PCI support from the Integrator.
Signed-off-by: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In commit 1e4687aa47 ("binman: Use target-specific tools when
cross-compiling"), a utility function was implemented to get preferred
compilation tools using environment variables like CC and CROSS_COMPILE.
Although it intended to provide custom default tools (same as those in
the global Makefile) when no relevant variables were set (for example
using "gcc" for "cc"), it is only doing so when CROSS_COMPILE is set and
returning the literal name of the tool otherwise.
Remove the check for an empty CROSS_COMPILE, which makes the function
use it as an empty prefix to the custom defaults and return the intended
executables.
Fixes: 1e4687aa47 ("binman: Use target-specific tools when cross-compiling")
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
This patch adds a limited pulse-width modulator to sandbox's Chromium OS
Embedded Controller emulation. The emulated PWM device supports multiple
channels but can only set a duty cycle for each, as the actual EC
doesn't expose any functionality or information other than that. Though
the EC supports specifying the PWM channel by its type (e.g. display
backlight, keyboard backlight), this is not implemented in the emulation
as nothing in U-Boot uses this type specification.
This emulated PWM device is then used to test the Chromium OS PWM driver
in sandbox. Adding the required device node to the sandbox test
device-tree unfortunately makes it the first PWM device, so this also
touches some other tests to make sure they still use the sandbox PWM.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Each _device_ belonging to a given uclass of course has its own ->ops,
of a type determined by and known to the uclass.
However, no instance of a uclass_driver seems to populate ->ops, and
the only reference to it in code is this relocation.
Moreover, it's not really clear what could sensibly be assigned; it
would have to be some "struct uclass_ops *" providing a set of methods
for the core to call on that particular uclass, but should the need
for that ever arise, it would be better to have a member of that
particular type instead of void*.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
GCC provides a symbol _init in crti.o on x86_64 and aarch64 but not on
RISC-V. The following lines leads to a build error for sandbox_defconfig on
RISC-V due to the missing symbol:
common/board_f.c:269:
#elif defined(CONFIG_SANDBOX) || defined(CONFIG_EFI_APP)
gd->mon_len = (ulong)&_end - (ulong)_init;
The sandbox code is not copied into the memory allocated using mmap().
Hence we can safely use gd->mon_len = 0 to avoid the reference to _init.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
state_uninit() and dm_uninit() are mutually exclusive:
state_uninit() prints via drivers. So it cannot be executed after
dm_uninit().
dm_uninit() requires memory. So it cannot be executed after state_uninit()
which releases all memory.
Just skip dm_uninit() when resetting the sandbox. We will wake up in a new
process and allocate new memory. So this cleanup is not required. We don't
do it in sandbox_exit() either.
This avoids a segmentation error when efi_reset_system_boottime() is
invoked by a UEFI application.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Addresses in state->ram_buf must be in the low 4 GiB of the address space.
Otherwise we cannot correctly fill SMBIOS tables. This shows up in warnings
like:
WARNING: SMBIOS table_address overflow 7f752735e020
Ensure that state->ram_buf is initialized by the first invocation of
os_malloc().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Define LOG_CATEGORY for all uclass to allow filtering with
log command.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if sandbox crashes it prints a message and tries to exit. But
with the recently introduced signal handler, it often seems to get stuck
in a loop until the stack overflows:
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
Segmentation violation
...
The signal handler is only useful for a few tests, as I understand it.
Make it optional.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are two revisions of unmatched board with different DDR timing,
we'd like to support multi-dtb mechanism in SPL, then it selects the
right DTB at runtime according to PCB revision in I2C EEPROM.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The difference between unmatched rev3 and rev1 is DDR timing, the rev3
uses 1866 MT/s for 16GiB, and rev1 uses 2133 MT/s for 8GiB.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
There are different DDR parameter settings for different board
revisions. Add a new interface to get the PCB revision to determine
which DT should be selected at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Enable SPL_I2C_SUPPORT for fu740, and add 'u-boot,dm-spl' property in
i2c node.
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Add initial support for the PCB description EEPROM for SiFive HiFive
Unmatched boards.
This implementation is refactored based on Paul Walmsley's porting and
adopt the suggestions from David Abdurachmanov.
Signed-off-by: Paul Walmsley <paul.walmsley@sifive.com>
Signed-off-by: David Abdurachmanov <david.abdurachmanov@sifive.com>
Signed-off-by: Zong Li <zong.li@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The GPIO polarity for onewire must be GPIO_ACTIVE_HIGH.
On previous versions this used to work as it looks like the right flag values
are being passed since :
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2020-April/407195.html
And that series broke the old functionality for onewire nodes.
Some boards had the correct value for the polarity, but it wasn't clear
so I replaced it with the right macro for the flag, instead of an empty value.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
gpio_request_by_name should be called with proper flags.
The 0 value flag is invalid, and causes bad initialization of the gpio.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
This commit adds support to piton_mmc driver for OpenPiton-riscv64
This driver has many things set as preconfigured because the hardware
automatically configures most of the settings during startup.
Signed-off-by: Tianrui Wei <tianrui-wei@outlook.com>
Signed-off-by: Jonathan Balkind <jbalkind@ucsb.edu>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
This patch adds openpiton-riscv64 SOC support. In particular, this
board supports a standard bootflow through zsbl->u-boot SPL->
opensbi->u-boot proper->Linux. There are separate defconfigs for
building u-boot SPL and u-boot proper
Signed-off-by: Tianrui Wei <tianrui-wei@outlook.com>
Signed-off-by: Jonathan Balkind <jbalkind@ucsb.edu>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Replace 'pciaux' with 'pcieaux', including name string and function
prefix. The old name string, 'pciaux', might cause an error if PCIe
driver is changed to use clk_get_by_name() with 'pcieaux' to get
clock.
Signed-off-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Now that u-boot gained DSA support, and it is already enabled for the
kontron_sl28 board, add the last missing piece and enable the
corresponding devices it in the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Make sure that errors in the PHY driver .startup() method, such as no
link, are propagated and not ignored.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The RGMII spec supports optional in-band status reporting for the speed
and duplex negotiated on the copper side, and the ENETC driver enables
this feature by default.
However, this does not work when the PHY does not implement the in-band
reporting, or when there is a MAC-to-MAC connection described using a
fixed-link. In that case, it would be better to disable the feature in
the ENETC MAC and always force the speed and duplex to the values that
were negotiated and retrieved over MDIO once the autoneg is finished.
Since this works always, we just do it unconditionally and drop the
in-band code.
Note that because we need to wait for the autoneg to complete, we need
to move enetc_setup_mac_iface() after phy_startup() returns, and then
pass the phydev pointer all the way to enetc_init_rgmii().
The same considerations have led to a similar Linux driver patch as well:
https://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/netdev/net-next.git/commit/?id=c76a97218dcbb2cb7cec1404ace43ef96c87d874
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Given that even a fixed-link has an associated phy_device, there is no
reason to operate in a mode when dm_eth_phy_connect fails.
Remove the driver checks for a NULL priv->phy and just return -ENODEV
when that happens.
Copyright updated according to corporate requirements.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The enetc-2 port is used as DSA master (connected back-to-back to
mscc_felix_port4). Since the convention is to not enable ports in the
common SoC dtsi unless they are used on the board, then enable enetc-2
only when mscc_felix_port4 itself is enabled.
All existing device trees appear to adhere to this rule, so disable
enetc-2 in the SoC dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
To comply with the device tree bindings expectations for an Ethernet
controller, as well as to simplify the driver code, declare fixed-link
nodes for the internal ENETC ports (attached to the mscc_felix switch).
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
There are no PCB trace delays on this board, so the PHY needs to enable
its internal ones in order to have a proper electrical connection to the
enetc MAC.
Fixes: b32e9a7578 ("arm: dts: ls1028a updates for network interfaces")
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Due to an upstream change, the ls1028a.dtsi bindings for the mscc_felix
switch got accepted with all ports disabled by default and with no link
to the DSA master - this needs to be done on a per board basis.
Note that enetc-2 is not currently disabled in the ls1028a.dtsi, but
presumably at some point it might become. Explicitly enable it in the
QDS device trees anyway, to proactively avoid issues when that happens.
Fixes: a7fdac7e2a ("arm: dts: ls1028a: define QDS networking protocol combinations")
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The SMC911x Ethernet MACs can be integrated using a 16 or 32-bit bus.
The driver needs to know about this choice, which is the reason for us
having a Kconfig symbol for that.
Now this bus width is already described using a devicetree property, and
since the driver is DM compliant and is using the DT now, we should query
this at runtime. We leave the Kconfig choice around, in case the DT is
missing this property.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The SMC911x Ethernet driver needs to know which accessor functions it
can use to access the MMIO registers. For that reason we have a Kconfig
choice between 16 and 32-bit bus width.
Since it's only those two options that we (and the Linux kernel)
support, and there does not seem to be any evidence of another bus
width anywhere, limit the Kconfig construct to a simple symbol.
This simplifies the code and allows a later rework to be much easier.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
In a system with multiple network controllers it can be difficult
to know the names of the various devices available. This is especially
true for USB ether devices as they do not display device names upon
detection.
This is being added as a net sub-system in case other commands may
want to be added or moved here.
Note that this is only enabled for DM_ETH
Example:
U-Boot > net
net - NET sub-system
Usage:
net list - list available devices
U-Boot > net list
eth0 : ethernet@2188000 00:d0:12:98:f5:47 active
eth1 : e1000#0 00:d0:12:98:f5:48
eth2 : asix_eth 8c:ae:4c:f5:84:9d
eth3 : asix_eth 8c:ae:4c:f9:41:e3
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
- General test.py improvements
- Rewrite the squashfs tests
- Update our CI container to Ubuntu 20.04 "focal" base.
- Make some changes to the Azure yaml so that we can have more tests run
there.
Move us up to being based on Ubuntu 20.04 "focal" and the latest tag
from Ubuntu for this release. For this, we make sure that "python" is
now python3 but still include python2.7 for the rx51 qemu build as that
is very old and does not support python3.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Add more details to test cases by comparing each expected line with the
command's output. Add new test cases:
- sqfsls at an empty directory
- sqfsls at a sub-directory
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org> [on sandbox]
Signed-off-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
The previous strategy to know if a file was correctly loaded was to
check for how many bytes were read and compare it against the file's
original size. Since this is not a good solution, replace it by
comparing the checksum of the loaded bytes against the original file's
checksum. Add more test cases: files at a sub-directory and non-existent
file.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org> [on sandbox]
Signed-off-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Remove the previous OOP approach, which was confusing and incomplete.
Add more test cases by making SquashFS images with various options,
concerning file fragmentation and its compression. Add comments to
properly document the code.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org> [on sandbox]
Signed-off-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
The filesystem test setup needs to prepare disk images for its tests,
with either guestmount or loop mounts. The former requires access to the
host fuse device (added in a previous patch), the latter requires access
to host loop devices. Both mounts also need additional privileges since
docker's default configuration prevents the containers from mounting
filesystems (for host security).
Add any available loop devices to the container and try to add as few
privileges as possible to run these tests, which narrow down to adding
SYS_ADMIN capability and disabling apparmor confinement. However, this
much still seems to be insecure enough to let malicious container
processes escape as root on the host system [1].
[1] https://blog.trailofbits.com/2019/07/19/understanding-docker-container-escapes/
Since the mentioned tests are marked to run only on the sandbox board,
add these additional devices and privileges only when testing with that.
An alternative to using mounts is modifying the filesystem tests to use
virt-make-fs (like some EFI tests do), but it fails to generate a
partitionless FAT filesystem image on Debian systems. Other more
feasible alternatives are using guestfish or directly using libguestfs
Python bindings to create and populate the images, but switching the
test setups to these is nontrivial and is left as future work.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
The EFI secure boot and capsule test setups need to prepare disk images
for their tests using virt-make-fs, which requires access to the host
fuse device. This is not exposed to the docker container by default and
has to be added explicitly. Add it.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
The filesystem and EFI (capsule and secure boot) test setups try to use
guestmount and virt-make-fs respectively to prepare disk images to run
tests on. However, these libguestfs tools need a kernel image and fail
with the following message (revealed in debug/trace mode) if it can't
find one:
supermin: failed to find a suitable kernel (host_cpu=x86_64).
I looked for kernels in /boot and modules in /lib/modules.
If this is a Xen guest, and you only have Xen domU kernels
installed, try installing a fullvirt kernel (only for
supermin use, you shouldn't boot the Xen guest with it).
This failure then causes these tests to be skipped in CIs. Install a
kernel package in the Docker containers so the CIs can run these
tests with libguestfs tools again (assuming the container is run with
necessary host devices and privileges). As this kernel would be only
used for virtualization, we can use the kernel package specialized for
that. On Ubuntu systems kernel images are not readable by non-root
users, so explicitly add read permissions with chmod as well.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Some filesystem tests are failing when their image is prepared with
guestmount, but succeeding if loop mounts are used instead. The reason
seems to be a race condition the guestmount(1) manual page explains:
When guestunmount(1)/fusermount(1) exits, guestmount may still be
running and cleaning up the mountpoint. The disk image will not be
fully finalized.
This means that scripts like the following have a nasty race condition:
guestmount -a disk.img -i /mnt
# copy things into /mnt
guestunmount /mnt
# immediately try to use 'disk.img' ** UNSAFE **
The solution is to use the --pid-file option to write the guestmount
PID to a file, then after guestunmount spin waiting for this PID to
exit.
The Python standard library has an os.waitpid() function for waiting a
child to terminate, but it cannot wait on non-child processes. Implement
a utility function that can do this by polling the process repeatedly
for a given duration, optionally killing the process if it won't
terminate on its own. Apply the suggested solution with this utility
function, which makes the failing tests succeed again.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If guestmount isn't available on the system, filesystem test setup falls
back to using loop mounts to prepare its disk images. If guestmount is
available but fails to work, the tests are immediately skipped. Instead
of giving up on a guestmount failure, try using loop mounts as an
attempt to keep tests running.
Also stop checking if guestmount is in PATH, as trying to run a missing
guestmount can now follow the same failure codepath and fall back to
loop mounts anyway.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Probably, a pointer to a variable in an inner block should not
be exposed to an outer block.
Fixes: c70f44817d ("efi_loader: simplify 'printenv -e'")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
[trini: Don't make guid const now]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Kconfig defaults to mode 3 if CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE is not set.
It becomes an issue since meson_spifc does not support SPI_CPHA.
Needed after commit e2e95e5e25 ("spi: Update speed/mode on change").
Fixes: e2e95e5e25 ("spi: Update speed/mode on change")
Signed-off-by:Da Xue <da@libre.computer>
[narmstrong: reformated commit reference & added Fixes tag]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Although U-Boot supports capsule update on-disk, it's lack of support for
SetVariable at runtime prevents applications like fwupd from using it.
In order to perform the capsule update on-disk the spec says that the OS
must copy the capsule to the \EFI\UpdateCapsule directory and set a bit in
the OsIndications variable. The firmware then checks for the
EFI_OS_INDICATIONS_FILE_CAPSULE_DELIVERY_SUPPORTED bit in OsIndications
variable, which is set by the submitter to trigger processing of the
capsule on the next reboot.
Let's add a config option which ignores the bit and just relies on the
capsule being present. Since U-Boot deletes the capsule while processing
it, we won't end up applying it multiple times.
Note that this is allowed for all capsules. In the future, once
authenticated capsules are fully supported, we can limit the functionality
to those only.
Signed-off-by: apalos <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reword Kconfig description.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
After each reboot we must clear flag
EFI_OS_INDICATIONS_FILE_CAPSULE_DELIVERY_SUPPORTED in variable
OsIndications.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Improve efi_query_variable_info() to check the parameter settings and
return correct error code according to the UEFI Specification 2.9,
and the Self Certification Test (SCT) II Case Specification, June
2017, chapter 4.1.4 QueryVariableInfo().
Reported-by: Kazuhiko Sakamoto <sakamoto.kazuhiko@socionext.com>
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
After if we should use parentheses to keep the code readable.
Fixes: a95f4c8859 ("efi_loader: NULL dereference in EFI console")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We only install FMPs if a CapsuleUpdate is requested. Since we now have an
ESRT table which relies on FMPs to build the required information, it
makes more sense to unconditionally install them. This will allow userspace
applications (e.g fwupd) to make use of the ERST and provide us with files
we can use to run CapsuleUpdate on-disk
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Chapter 23 of the EFI spec (rev 2.9) says:
"A specific updatable hardware firmware store must be represented by
exactly one FMP instance".
This is not the case for us, since both of our FMP protocols can be
installed at the same time because they are controlled by a single
'dfu_alt_info' env variable.
So make the config options depend on each other and allow the user to
install one of them at any given time. If we fix the meta-data provided
by the 'dfu_alt_info' in the future, to hint about the capsule type
(fit or raw) we can revise this and enable both FMPs to be installed, as
long as they target different firmware hardware stores
Note that we are not using a Kconfig 'choice' on purpose, since we
want to allow both of those to be installed and tested in sandbox
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When running the efidebug capsule disk-update command, the efi_fmp_raw
protocol installation fails with 2 (EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER) as below.
This is because the code passes efi_root instead of the handle local var.
=> efidebug capsule disk-update
EFI: Call: efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces( &handle, &efi_guid_firmware_management_protocol, &efi_fmp_fit, NULL)
EFI: Entry efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces(00000000fbaf5988)
EFI: Call: efi_install_protocol_interface( handle, protocol, EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE, protocol_interface)
EFI: Entry efi_install_protocol_interface(00000000fbaf5988, 86c77a67-0b97-4633-a187-49104d0685c7, 0, 00000000fbfa6ee8)
EFI: new handle 00000000fbb37520
EFI: Exit: efi_install_protocol_interface: 0
EFI: 0 returned by efi_install_protocol_interface( handle, protocol, EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE, protocol_interface)
EFI: Exit: efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces: 0
EFI: 0 returned by efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces( &handle, &efi_guid_firmware_management_protocol, &efi_fmp_fit, NULL)
EFI: Call: efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces( &efi_root, &efi_guid_firmware_management_protocol, &efi_fmp_raw, NULL)
EFI: Entry efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces(00000000fbfec648)
EFI: Call: efi_install_protocol_interface( handle, protocol, EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE, protocol_interface)
EFI: Entry efi_install_protocol_interface(00000000fbfec648, 86c77a67-0b97-4633-a187-49104d0685c7, 0, 00000000fbfa6f18)
EFI: handle 00000000fbaf8520
EFI: Exit: efi_install_protocol_interface: 2
EFI: 2 returned by efi_install_protocol_interface( handle, protocol, EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE, protocol_interface)
EFI: Exit: efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces: 2
EFI: 2 returned by efi_install_multiple_protocol_interfaces( &efi_root, &efi_guid_firmware_management_protocol, &efi_fmp_raw, NULL)
Command failed, result=1
To fix this issue, pass the handle local var which is set NULL right
before installing efi_fmp_raw as same as the installing efi_fmp_fit.
(In both cases, the local reference to the handle will be just discarded)
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Merge build-time sanity checks to ensure the size of gd doesn't
change. This can happen during cleanups due to not all symbols being
implemented in Kconfig.
The layout and contents of struct global_data depends on a lot of
CONFIG_* preprocessor macros, not all of which are entirely converted
to Kconfig - not to mention weird games played here and there. This
can result in one translation unit using one definition of struct
global_data while the actual layout is another.
That can be very hard to debug. But we already have a mechanism that
can help catch such bugs at build time, namely the asm-offsets
machinery which is necessary anyway to provide assembly code with the
necessary constants. So make sure that every C translation unit that
include global_data.h actually sees the same size of struct
global_data as that which was seen by the asm-offsets.c TU.
It is likely that this patch will break the build of some boards. For
example, without the patch from Matt Merhar
(https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-May/450135.html) or some
other fix, this breaks P2041RDB_defconfig:
CC arch/powerpc/lib/traps.o
AS arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc85xx/start.o
In file included from include/asm-generic/global_data.h:26,
from ./arch/powerpc/include/asm/global_data.h:109,
from include/init.h:21,
from arch/powerpc/lib/traps.c:7:
include/linux/build_bug.h:99:41: error: static assertion failed: "sizeof(struct global_data) == GD_SIZE"
99 | #define __static_assert(expr, msg, ...) _Static_assert(expr, msg)
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/linux/build_bug.h:98:34: note: in expansion of macro ‘__static_assert’
98 | #define static_assert(expr, ...) __static_assert(expr, ##__VA_ARGS__, #expr)
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/asm-generic/global_data.h:470:1: note: in expansion of macro ‘static_assert’
470 | static_assert(sizeof(struct global_data) == GD_SIZE);
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~
make[1]: *** [scripts/Makefile.build:266: arch/powerpc/lib/traps.o] Error 1
make: *** [Makefile:1753: arch/powerpc/lib] Error 2
make: *** Waiting for unfinished jobs....
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[Linux commit 6bab69c65013bed5fce9f101a64a84d0385b3946]
BUILD_BUG_ON() is a little annoying, since it cannot be used outside
function scope. So one cannot put assertions about the sizeof() a
struct next to the struct definition, but has to hide that in some more
or less arbitrary function.
Since gcc 4.6 (which is now also the required minimum), there is support
for the C11 _Static_assert in all C modes, including gnu89. So add a
simple wrapper for that.
_Static_assert() requires a message argument, which is usually quite
redundant (and I believe that bug got fixed at least in newer C++
standards), but we can easily work around that with a little macro
magic, making it optional.
For example, adding
static_assert(sizeof(struct printf_spec) == 8);
in vsprintf.c and modifying that struct to violate it, one gets
./include/linux/build_bug.h:78:41: error: static assertion failed: "sizeof(struct printf_spec) == 8"
#define __static_assert(expr, msg, ...) _Static_assert(expr, "" msg "")
godbolt.org suggests that _Static_assert() has been support by clang
since at least 3.0.0.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Xilinx changes for v2021.10
clk:
- Add driver for Xilinx Clocking Wizard IP
fdt:
- Also record architecture in /fit-images
net:
- Fix plat/priv data handling in axi emac
- Add support for 10G/25G speeds
pca953x:
- Add missing dependency on i2c
serial:
- Fix dependencies for DEBUG uart for pl010/pl011
- Add setconfig option for cadence serial driver
watchdog:
- Add cadence wdt expire now function
zynq:
- Update DT bindings to reflect the latest state and descriptions
zynqmp:
- Update DT bindings to reflect the latest state and descriptions
- SPL: Add support for ECC DRAM initialization
- Fix R5 core 1 handling logic
- Enable firmware driver for mini configurations
- Enable secure boot, regulators, wdt
- Add support xck devices and 67dr
- Add psu init for sm/smk-k26 SOMs
- Add handling for MMC seq number via mmc_get_env_dev()
- Handle reserved memory locations
- Add support for u-boot.itb generation for secure OS
- Handle BL32 handoffs for secure OS
- Add support for 64bit addresses for u-boot.its generation
- Change eeprom handling via nvmem aliases
It is working in a way that only minimal timeout is setup to reach
expiration just right after it is setup.
Please make sure that PMUFW is compiled with ENABLE_EM flag.
On U-Boot prompt you can test it like:
ZynqMP> wdt dev watchdog@fd4d0000
ZynqMP> wdt list
watchdog@fd4d0000 (cdns_wdt)
ZynqMP> wdt dev
dev: watchdog@fd4d0000
ZynqMP> wdt expire
(And reset should happen here)
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The spi_get_bus_and_cs() may be called on the same bus and chipselect
with different frequency or mode. This is valid usecase, but the code
fails to notify the controller of such a configuration change. Call
spi_set_speed_mode() in case bus frequency or bus mode changed to let
the controller update the configuration.
The problem can easily be triggered using the sspi command:
=> sspi 0:0@1000
=> sspi 0:0@2000
Without this patch, both transfers happen at 1000 Hz. With this patch,
the later transfer happens correctly at 2000 Hz.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-07-rc5-2
Documentation:
* man-page for askenv
bug fixes
* correct display of BootOrder in efidebug command
* do not allow TPL_HIGH_LEVEL for CreateEvent(Ex)
* correct handling of unknown properties in SMBIOS tables
The nor->ready() and spansion_sr_ready() introduced earlier in this
series are used for multi-die package parts.
The nor->quad_enable() sets the volatile QE bit on each die.
The nor->erase() is hooked if the device is not configured to uniform
sectors, assuming it has 32 x 4KB sectors overlaid on bottom address.
Other configurations, top and split, are not supported at this point.
Will submit additional patches to support it as needed.
The post_bfpt/sfdp() fixes the params wrongly advertised in SFDP.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cypress chips support SPINOR_OP_EN4B(B7h) to enable 4-byte addressing mode.
Cypress chips support B8h to disable 4-byte addressing mode instead of
SPINOR_OP_EX4B(E9h).
This patch defines new opcode and updates set_4byte() to support
enable/disable 4-byte addressing mode for Cypress chips.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The spansion_sr_ready() reads status register 1 by Read Any Register
commnad. This function is called from Flash specific hook with die address
and dummy cycles to support multi-die package parts from Spansion/Cypress.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
For dual/quad die package devices from Spansion/Cypress, the device's
status needs to be checked by reading status registers in all dies, by
using Read Any Register command. To support this, a Flash specific hook
that can overwrite the legacy status check is needed.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Some of Spansion/Cypress chips support volatile version of configuration
registers and it is recommended to update volatile registers in the field
application due to a risk of the non-volatile registers corruption by
power interrupt. This patch adds a function to set Quad Enable bit in CFR1
volatile.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Some of Spansion/Cypress chips support Read/Write Any Register commands.
These commands are mainly used to write volatile registers and access to
the registers in second and subsequent die for multi-die package parts.
The Read Any Register instruction (65h) is followed by register address
and dummy cycles, then the selected register byte is returned.
The Write Any Register instruction (71h) is followed by register address
and register byte to write.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If both POSITION_INDEPENDENT and SYS_RELOC_GD_ENV_ADDR are enabled,
wherever original env is placed anywhere, it should be relocated to
the right address.
Relocation offset gd->reloc_off is calculated with SYS_TEXT_BASE in
setup_reloc() and env address gd->env_addr is relocated by the offset in
initr_reloc_global_data().
gd->env_addr
= (orig env) + gd->reloc_off
= (orig env) + (gd->relocaddr - SYS_TEXT_BASE)
However, SYS_TEXT_BASE isn't always runtime base address when
POSITION_INDEPENDENT is enabled. So the relocated env_addr might point to
wrong address. For example, if SYS_TEXT_BASE is zero, gd->env_addr is
out of memory location and memory exception will occur.
There is a difference between linked address such as SYS_TEXT_BASE and
runtime base address. In _main, the difference is calculated as
"run-vs-link" offset. The env_addr should also be added to the offset
to fix the address.
gd->env_addr
= (orig env) + ("run-vs-link" offset) + gd->reloc_off
= (orig env) + (SYS_TEXT_BASE - _start) + (gd->relocaddr - SYS_TEXT_BASE)
= (orig env) + (gd->relocaddr - _start)
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Kunihiko Hayashi <hayashi.kunihiko@socionext.com>
Acked-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Tested-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Commit e4f8e543f1a9("smbios: Drop the unused Kconfig options")
break SMBIOS tables. The reason is that the patch drops the Kconfig
options *after* removing the code using them, but that changes the semantics
of the code completely. Prior to the change a non NULL value was used in
the 'product' and 'manufacturer ' fields.
Chapter 6.2 of the DMTF spec requires Manufacturer and Product Name to be
non-null on some of the tables. So let's add sane defaults for Type1/2/3.
* Before the patchset:
<snip>
Handle 0x0002, DMI type 2, 14 bytes
Base Board Information
Manufacturer: Not Specified
Product Name: Not Specified
Version: Not Specified
Serial Number: Not Specified
Asset Tag: Not Specified
Features:
Board is a hosting board
Location In Chassis: Not Specified
Chassis Handle: 0x0000
Type: Motherboard
Invalid entry length (0). DMI table is broken! Stop.
* After the patchset:
<snip>
Handle 0x0005, DMI type 32, 11 bytes
System Boot Information
Status: No errors detected
Handle 0x0006, DMI type 127, 4 bytes
End Of Table
Fixes: e4f8e543f1 ("smbios: Drop the unused Kconfig options")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
We currently define the EFI support of an SMBIOS table as the third bit of
"BIOS Characteristics Extension Byte 1". The latest DMTF spec defines it
on "BIOS Characteristics Extension Byte 2".
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Remove superfluous assignment.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
help file for using askenv cmd is created.
It provides description on the command purpose,
description of arguments,
couple of examples (illustrating command usage),
configuration parameter and
possible return values.
Signed-off-by: Adarsh Babu Kalepalli <opensource.kab@gmail.com>
Add missing entry in doc/usage/index.rst.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Display the number of the boot option and not its index.
Fixes: 2ecee31017 ("efi_loader: use efi_create_indexed_name()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
According to chapter 7.1 "Event, Timer, and Task Priority Services"
TPL_HIGH_LEVEL should not be exposed to applications and drivers.
According to the discussion with EDK II contributors this implies that
CreateEvent() shall not allow to create events with TPL_HIGH_LEVEL.
Cc: Samer El-Haj-Mahmoud <Samer.El-Haj-Mahmoud@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Samer El-Haj-Mahmoud <Samer.El-Haj-Mahmoud@arm.com>
This patch adds psgtr clocks and phy entry for USB0, USB1 and SATA node for
zc1751-xm017-dc3 board.
Signed-off-by: Piyush Mehta <piyush.mehta@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There are lot of accesses to priv data in of_to_plat(), which is incorrect.
Create a platform data structure and use it in of_to_plat(), then copy all
platform data to priv data in probe.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This adds serial parameters that include stop bit mode, parity mode,
and character length. Mark parity and space parity modes are not
supported.
At the moment, the only path to call setconfig directly is DM testing,
however, this affects the size of SPL for DM testing, so it doesn't
apply to SPL.
Signed-off-by: Kunihiko Hayashi <hayashi.kunihiko@socionext.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Both of these drivers are implemented with and without DM that's why more
symbols should be handled.
The most problematic one is enabling DEBUG_UART_PL011 based on
PL01X_SERIAL(DM based) because debug console has type selection based on
it.
enum pl01x_type type = CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DEBUG_UART_PL011) ?
TYPE_PL011 : TYPE_PL010;
Without it pl01x_generic_setbrg() is configuring different registers.
Fixes: 4cc24aeaf4 ("serial: Add missing Kconfig dependencies for debug consoles")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since this flash doesn't have a Profile 1.0 table, the Octal DTR
capabilities are enabled in the post SFDP fixup, along with the 8D-8D-8D
fast read settings.
Enable Octal DTR mode with 20 dummy cycles to allow running at the
maximum supported frequency of 200Mhz.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The Cypress Semper flash is an xSPI compliant octal DTR flash. Add
support for using it in octal DTR mode.
The flash by default boots in a hybrid sector mode. Switch to uniform
sector mode on boot. Use the default 20 dummy cycles for a read fast
command.
The SFDP programming on some older versions of the flash was incorrect.
Fixes for that are included in the fixup hooks.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Some of Spansion/Cypress chips have overlaid 4KB sectors at top and/or
bottom, depending on the device configuration, while U-Boot supports
uniform sector layout only.
The spansion_erase_non_uniform() erases overlaid 4KB sectors,
non-overlaid portion of normal sector, and remaining normal sectors, by
selecting correct erase command and size based on the address to erase
and size of overlaid portion in parameters. Since different Spansion
flashes can use different opcode for erasing the 4K sectors, the opcode
must be passed in as a parameter based on the flash being used.
Signed-off-by: Takahiro Kuwano <Takahiro.Kuwano@infineon.com>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
[p.yadav@ti.com: Refactor the function to be compatible with nor->erase,
make 4K opcode customizable, call spi_nor_setup_op() before executing
the op.]
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
On devices with non-uniform sector sizes like Spansion S25 or S28 family
of flashes the sector under erase does not necessarily have to be
mtd->erasesize bytes long. For example, on S28 flashes the first 128 KiB
region is composed of 32 4 KiB sectors, then a 128 KiB sector, and then
256 KiB sectors till the end.
Let the flash-specific erase functions erase less than the requested
length in case of the 4 or 128 KiB sectors and report the number of
bytes erased back to the calling function.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When the flash is handed to us in a stateful mode like 8D-8D-8D, it is
difficult to detect the mode the flash is in. One option is to read SFDP
in all modes and see which one gives the correct "SFDP" signature, but
not all flashes support SFDP in 8D-8D-8D mode.
Further, even if you detect the mode of the flash via SFDP, you still
have the problem of actually reading the ID. The Read ID command is not
standardized across flash vendors. Flashes can have different dummy
cycles needed for reading the ID. Some flashes even expect a 4-byte
dummy address with the Read ID command. All this information cannot be
obtained from the SFDP table.
So, perform a Software Reset sequence before reading the ID and
initializing the flash. A Soft Reset will bring back the flash in its
default protocol mode assuming no non-volatile configuration was set.
This will let us detect the flash even if ROM hands it to us in Octal
DTR mode.
To accommodate cases where there is more than one flash on a board, and
only one of them needs a soft reset, failure to reset is not made fatal,
and we still try to read ID if possible.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
On probe, the SPI NOR core will put a flash in 8D-8D-8D mode if it
supports it. But Linux as of now expects to get the flash in 1S-1S-1S
mode. Handing the flash to Linux in Octal DTR mode means the kernel will
fail to detect the flash.
So, we need to reset to Power-on-Reset (POR) state before handing off
the flash. A Software Reset command can be used to do this.
One limitation of the soft reset is that it will restore state from
non-volatile registers in some flashes. This means that if the flash was
set to 8D mode in a non-volatile configuration, a soft reset won't help.
This commit assumes that we don't set any non-volatile bits anywhere,
and the flash doesn't have any non-volatile Octal DTR mode
configuration.
Since spi-nor-tiny doesn't (and likely shouldn't) have
spi_nor_soft_reset(), add a dummy spi_nor_remove() for it that does
nothing.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
A Soft Reset sequence will return the flash to Power-on-Reset (POR)
state. It consists of two commands: Soft Reset Enable and Soft Reset.
Find out if the sequence is supported from BFPT DWORD 16.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The Micron MT35XU512ABA flash does not support the quad enable bit. But
instead of programming the Quad Enable Require field to 000b ("Device
does not have a QE bit"), it is programmed to 111b ("Reserved").
While this is technically incorrect, it is not reason enough to abort
BFPT parsing. Instead, continue BFPT parsing assuming there is no quad
enable bit present.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Allow flashes to specify a hook to enable octal DTR mode. Use this hook
whenever possible to get optimal transfer speeds.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The xSPI Profile 1.0 table specifies how many dummy cycles and address
bytes are needed for the Read Status Register command in Octal DTR mode.
Use that information to send the correct Read SR command.
Some controllers might have trouble reading just 1 byte in DTR mode. So,
when we are in DTR mode read 2 bytes and discard the second. This shows
no side effects with the two flashes I tested: Micron mt35xu512aba and
Cypress s28hs512t.
Update Read FSR to mimic Read SR because they share the same
characteristics.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This table is indication that the flash is xSPI compliant and hence
supports octal DTR mode. Extract information like the fast read opcode,
the number of dummy cycles needed for a Read Status Register command,
and the number of address bytes needed for a Read Status Register
command.
The default dummy cycles for a fast octal DTR read are set to 20. Since
there is no simple way of determining the dummy cycles needed for the
fast read command, flashes that use a different value should update it
in their flash-specific hooks.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Some devices in DTR mode expect an extra command byte called the
extension. The extension can either be same as the opcode, bitwise
inverse of the opcode, or another additional byte forming a 16-byte
opcode. Get the extension type from the BFPT. For now, only flashes with
"repeat" and "inverse" extensions are supported.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
JESD216 rev D makes BFPT 20 DWORDs. Update the BFPT size define to
reflect that.
The check for rev A or later compared the BFPT header length with the
maximum BFPT length, BFPT_DWORD_MAX. Since BFPT_DWORD_MAX was 16, and so
was the BFPT length for both rev A and B, this check worked fine. But
now, since BFPT_DWORD_MAX is 20, it means this check will also stop BFPT
parsing for rev A or B, since their length is 16.
So, instead check for BFPT_DWORD_MAX_JESD216 to stop BFPT parsing for
the first JESD216 version, and check for BFPT_DWORD_MAX_JESD216B for the
next two versions.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Double Transfer Rate (DTR) is SPI protocol in which data is transferred
on each clock edge as opposed to on each clock cycle. Make
framework-level changes to allow supporting flashes in DTR mode.
Right now, mixed DTR modes are not supported. So, for example a mode
like 4S-4D-4D will not work. All phases need to be either DTR or STR.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Even when spi_nor_write_reg() has no data to write, like when executing
a write enable operation, it sets the data direction to
SPI_MEM_DATA_OUT. This trips up spi_mem_check_buswidth() because it
expects a data phase when there is none. Make sure the data direction is
set to SPI_MEM_NO_DATA when there is no data to write.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The spi-mem layer provides a spi_mem_supports_op() function to check
whether a specific operation is supported by the controller or not.
This is much more accurate than the hwcaps selection logic based on
SPI_{RX,TX}_ flags.
Rework the hwcaps selection logic to use spi_mem_supports_op().
To make sure the build doesn't break for boards not using CONFIG_DM_SPI,
add a simple SPI_{RX,TX}_ based hwcaps selection logic in spi-mem-nodm
similar to spi_mem_default_supports_op(). This change is only
compile-tested.
To avoid SPL size problems on the x530 board, the old hwcaps selection
is still kept around. Leaving the code in-place was getting difficult to
read and understand, so the code is restructured to have it all in one
isolated function. As a result of this, the parameter hwcaps to
spi_nor_setup() is no longer needed. Remove it.
Based on the Linux commit c76f5089796a (mtd: spi-nor: Rework hwcaps
selection for the spi-mem case, 2019-08-06)
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Sometimes the information in a flash's SFDP tables is wrong. Sometimes
some information just can't be expressed in the SFDP table. So,
introduce the fixup hooks to allow tailoring settings for a specific
flash.
Three hooks are added: default_init, post_sfdp, and post_bfpt. These
allow tweaking the flash settings at different point in the probe
sequence. Since the hooks reside in nor->info, set that value just
before the call to spi_nor_init_params().
The hooks and at what points they are executed mimics Linux's spi-nor
framework. One major difference is that Linux puts the struct
spi_nor_fixups in nor->info. This is not possible in U-Boot because the
spi-nor-ids list is shared between spi-nor-core.c and spi-nor-tiny.c.
Since spi-nor-tiny shouldn't have those fixup hooks populated, add a
separate function that lets flashes populate their fixup hooks.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
These structures will be used in a later commit inside another structure
definition. Also take the declarations out of the ifdef since they won't
affect the final binary anyway and will be used in a later commit.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
nor->setup() can be used by flashes to configure settings in case they
have any peculiarities that can't be easily expressed by the generic
spi-nor framework. This includes things like different opcodes, dummy
cycles, page size, uniform/non-uniform sector sizes, etc.
Move related declarations to avoid forward declarations.
Inspired by the Linux kernel's setup() hook.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If a flash chip has more than 16MB capacity but its BFPT reports
BFPT_DWORD1_ADDRESS_BYTES_3_OR_4, the spi-nor framework defaults to 3.
The check in spi_nor_scan() doesn't catch it because addr_width did get
set. This fixes that check.
Ported from Kernel commit 324f78dfb442b82365548b657ec4e6974c677502.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Set up opcode extension and enable/disable DTR mode based on whether the
command is DTR or not.
xSPI flashes can have a 4-byte dummy address associated with some
commands like the Read Status Register command in octal DTR mode. Since
the flash does not support sending the dummy address, we can not use
automatic write completion polling in DTR mode. Further, no write
completion polling makes it impossible to use DAC mode for DTR writes.
In that mode, the controller does not know beforehand how long a write
will be and so it can de-assert Chip Select (CS#) at any time. Once CS#
is de-assert, the flash will go into burning phase. But since the
controller does not do write completion polling, it does not know when
the flash is busy and might send in writes while the flash is not ready.
So, disable write completion polling and make writes go through indirect
mode for DTR writes and let spi-mem take care of polling the SR.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Once the start bit is toggled it takes a small amount of time before it
is internally synchronized. This means we can't start writing during
that part. So add a small delay to allow the bit to be synchronized.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If the device tree provides a read delay value, use that directly and do
not perform the calibration procedure.
This allows the device tree to over-ride the read delay value in cases
where the read delay value obtained via calibration is incorrect. One
such example is the Cypress Semper flash. It needs a read delay of 4 in
octal DTR mode. But since the calibration procedure is run before the
flash is switched in octal DTR mode, it yields a read delay of 2. A
value of 4 works for both octal DTR and legacy modes.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
spi_mem_default_supports_op() rejects DTR ops by default to ensure that
the controller drivers that haven't been updated with DTR support
continue to reject them. It also makes sure that controllers that don't
support DTR mode at all (which is most of them at the moment) also
reject them.
This means that controller drivers that want to support DTR mode can't
use spi_mem_default_supports_op(). Driver authors have to roll their own
supports_op() function and mimic the buswidth checks. Or even worse,
driver authors might skip it completely or get it wrong.
Add spi_mem_dtr_supports_op(). It provides a basic sanity check for DTR
ops and performs the buswidth requirement check. Move the logic for
checking buswidth in spi_mem_default_supports_op() to a separate
function so the logic is not repeated twice.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Controllers can use this function to perform basic sanity checking on
the spi-mem op.
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
In xSPI mode, flashes expect 2-byte opcodes. The second byte is called
the "command extension". There can be 3 types of extensions in xSPI:
repeat, invert, and hex. When the extension type is "repeat", the same
opcode is sent twice. When it is "invert", the second byte is the
inverse of the opcode. When it is "hex" an additional opcode byte based
is sent with the command whose value can be anything.
So, make opcode a 16-bit value and add a 'nbytes', similar to how
multiple address widths are handled.
All usages of sizeof(op->cmd.opcode) also need to be changed to be
op->cmd.nbytes because that is the actual indicator of opcode size.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Each phase is given a separate 'dtr' field so mixed protocols like
4S-4D-4D can be supported.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Add a driver for Macronix SPI controller IP.
This patch referred from linux spi-mxic.c. The difference from the
linux version is described here.
1. To adapt uboot spi framework, modify some functions naming.
2. Remove the incompatible functions of Uboot.
3. Add dummy byte recalculattion function to support dummy buswidth
not align data buswidth operation.(ex: 1-1-4, 1-1-8)
4. Add Octal mode support.
Signed-off-by: Zhengxun <zhengxunli.mxic@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
[jagan: fixed file permission, comment line, kconfig]
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Unlike imx6, on imx7 the USB PHY is described as:
usbphynop1: usbphynop1 {
compatible = "usb-nop-xceiv";
clocks = <&clks IMX7D_USB_PHY1_CLK>;
clock-names = "main_clk";
#phy-cells = <0>;
};
which does not have the 'reg' property.
Do not return an error when the 'reg' property is not found
for the USB PHY.
This fixes USB gadget regression on a imx7s-warp board.
Successfully tested the "ums 0 mmc 0" command on two boards:
imx7s-warp and imx6dl-pico-pi.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
On a imx7s-warp board the fdtdec_get_alias_seq() function
always fails.
As priv->portnr is only used on i.MX6, move fdtdec_get_alias_seq()
inside the CONFIG_MX6 block.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
The board detection is incorrectly stating it's an rcar3 variant
instead of an RZ/G2 variant on all the r8a774*1_beacon boards.
Set the flag to correctly display as RZ/G2[M/N/H]
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Add board code for the R8A779A0 V3U Falcon board.
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
--
Marek: - various small rebase fixes and clean ups
The R-Car V3U does support RPC interface, however the support for it is
missing in upstream Linux DTs as of commit 9f4ad9e425a1 ("Linux 5.12"),
add the node into u-boot.dtsi to let U-Boot access the SPI NOR or HF.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Import R8A779A0 V3U PFC tables from Linux 5.12, commit 9f4ad9e425a1
("Linux 5.12") . Add parts of PFC table integration from
pinctrl: renesas: Add R8A779A0 V3U PFC tables
by Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>" .
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The R8A779A0 V3U GPIO block has additional "General Input Enable" INEN
register. Add new R8A779A0 compatible string with a new quirk and also
a handler for this quirk which toggles the INEN register in the right
place. INEN register handling is based on "gpio: renesas: Add R8A779A0
V3U support" by Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Add clock tables for R8A779A0 V3U SoC from Linux 5.12,
commit 9f4ad9e425a1 ("Linux 5.12")
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
--
Marek: - Add .reset_modemr_offset
- Sync tables from Linux 5.12
- Rebase on latest u-boot
On R8A779A0 V3U SoC, PLL1 and PLL5 use a divider value
from cpg_pll_configs table while PLL{20,21,30,31,4} use
different control offset. Introduce new types to handle
this and handle those types in the Gen3 clock code.
Based on "clk: renesas: Add support for R8A779A0 V3U PLLn"
by Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The get_mtd_device_nm() function (code imported from Linux) simply
iterates all registered MTD devices and compares the given name with
all MTDs' names.
With SPI_FLASH_MTD enabled U-Boot registers a SPI-NOR as a MTD device
with name identical to the SPI flash chip name (from SPI ID table). Thus
for a board with multiple same SPI-NORs it registers multiple MTDs, but
all with the same name (such as "s25fl164k"). We do not want to change
this behaviour, since such a change could break existing boot scripts,
which can rely on a hardcoded name.
In order to allow somehow to uniqely select a MTD device, change
get_mtd_device_nm() function as such:
- if first character of name is '/', try interpreting it as OF path
- otherwise compare the name with MTDs name and MTDs device name.
In the following example a board has two "s25fl164k" SPI-NORs. They both
have name "s25fl164k", thus cannot be uniquely selected via this name.
With this change, the user can select the second SPI-NOR either with
"spi-nor@1" or "/soc/spi@10600/spi-nor@1".
Example:
=> mtd list
List of MTD devices:
* s25fl164k
- device: spi-nor@0
- parent: spi@10600
- driver: jedec_spi_nor
- path: /soc/spi@10600/spi-nor@0
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x1000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000000800000 : "s25fl164k"
* s25fl164k
- device: spi-nor@1
- parent: spi@10600
- driver: jedec_spi_nor
- path: /soc/spi@10600/spi-nor@1
- type: NOR flash
- block size: 0x1000 bytes
- min I/O: 0x1 bytes
- 0x000000000000-0x000000800000 : "s25fl164k"
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Currently when the SPI_FLASH_MTD config option is enabled, only one SPI
can be registered as MTD at any time - it is the last one probed (since
with old non-DM model only one SPI NOR could be probed at any time).
When DM is enabled, allow for registering multiple SPI NORs as MTDs by
utilizing the nor->mtd structure, which is filled in by spi_nor_scan
anyway, instead of filling a separate struct mtd_info.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add support for parsing partitions defined in device-trees via the
`partitions` node with `fixed-partitions` compatible.
The `mtdparts`/`mtdids` mechanism takes precedence. If some partitions
are defined for a MTD device via this mechanism, the code won't register
partitions for that MTD device from OF, even if they are defined.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add functions ofnode_get_addr_size_index_notrans(), which is a
non-translating version of ofnode_get_addr_size_index().
Some addresses are not meant to be translated, for example those of MTD
fixed-partitions.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Tested-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
- x86: Discard .note.gnu.property sections
- nvme: Skip block device creation for inactive namespaces
- nvme: Convert NVMe doc to reST, and various minor fixes
On some distributions the mkfs is under /sbin and /sbin is not set
for mere users. Include /sbin to the PATH when creating file system,
so that users won't get a scary traceback from Python.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Update to me as co-maintainer with Peng.
Additionally, update the mmc alias in git-mailrc.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
All symbols that are defined in Kconfig will always be defined (or not)
prior to preprocessing due to the -include directive while building.
However, symbols which are not yet migrated will only be defined (or
not) once the board config.h is included, via <config.h>. While the end
goal must be to migrate all symbols, today we have cases where the size
of gd will get mismatched within the build, based on include order.
Mitigate this by making sure that any <asm/global_data.h> that uses
symbols not in Kconfig does start with <config.h>. Remove this when not
needed.
Cc: Alexey Brodkin <alexey.brodkin@synopsys.com>
Cc: Eugeniy Paltsev <Eugeniy.Paltsev@synopsys.com>
Cc: Huan Wang <alison.wang@nxp.com>
Cc: Angelo Dureghello <angelo@sysam.it>
Cc: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Based on the comment in socfpga_soc64_common.h, the intention is for
CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE to be unused. However, in the code we do:
...
and that will evaluate to true. This leads to unwanted code being
compiled. Further, as CONFIG_SYS_MEM_RESERVE_SECURE has not been
migrated to Kconfig, this leads to a mismatch in the size of gd
depending on if we have or have not also had <configs/BOARD.h> also
included yet.
Remove the define as it's not needed.
Cc: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Cc: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Cc: Dalon Westergreen <dalon.westergreen@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With the changes in commit 588efcdd72fc ("powerpc: Don't use relative
include for config.h in global_data.h") fixing the root of the problem,
we no longer need this re-inclusion.
This reverts commit f6c0d365d3.
Cc: Matt Merhar <mattmerhar@protonmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
As there is an arch/powerpc/include/asm/config.h file using "" to get
config.h here can lead to using that rather than include/config.h. This
in turn can lead to a mismatch in the size of gd.
Cc: Matt Merhar <mattmerhar@protonmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Matt Merhar <mattmerhar@protonmail.com>
The original code is in the public domain. Licenses/README states that the
general license for U-Boot is GPL 2.0+. So we can mark the malloc code as
GPL 2.0+ too.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This was missed when NVMe support was initially brought to U-Boot
back in 2017. Add an entry for it and list myself as the maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
A udevice's priv space is cleared in alloc_priv() in the DM core.
Don't do it again in its probe() routine.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present there is an offset of one added during the creation of
block device. This can be very confusing as we wanted to encode the
namespace id in the block device name but namespae id cannot be zero.
This changes to use the namespace id directly in the block device
name, eliminating the offset of one effectively.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present for each namespace there is a block device created for it.
There is no issue if the number of supported namespaces reported from
the NVMe device is only 1.
Since QEMU commit 7f0f1acedf15 ("hw/block/nvme: support multiple namespaces"),
the number of supported namespaces reported has been changed from 1
to 256, but not all of them are active namespaces. The actual active
one depends on the QEMU command line parameters. A common case is
that namespace 1 being active and all other 255 being inactive.
If a namespace is inactive, the namespace identify command returns a
zero filled data structure. We can use field NSZE (namespace size) to
decide whether a block device should be created for it.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the block device creation happens in the NVMe uclass
driver post_probe() phase. In preparation to support multiple
namespaces, we should issue namespace identify before creating
block devices but that touches the underlying hardware hence it
is not appropriate to do such in the uclass driver post_probe().
Let's move it to driver probe() phase instead.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
AQA (Admin Queue Attributes) register is a dword size with
lower word of ASQS, and higher word of ACQS.
The code set the variable aqa twice, but it is redundant.
Signed-off-by: Wesley Sheng <wesleyshenggit@sina.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Each prp is 8 bytes, calculate the number of prps
per page should just divide page size by 8
there is no need to minus 1
Signed-off-by: Wesley Sheng <wesleyshenggit@sina.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
writel() and co. already include the endian swap; doing the swap twice
is, er, unhelpful.
Tested on a P4080DS, which boots perfectly fine off NVMe with this.
Signed-off-by: David Lamparter <equinox@diac24.net>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When switching to kernel.org x86_64 gcc 11.1.0 toolchain, u-boot.rom
built from qemu-x86_defconfig no longer boots anymore. Investigation
shows that U-Boot fails at a very early stage during the boot process,
in fdtdec_prepare_fdt() where fdt_check_header() complains that there
is not a valid device tree found at gd->fdt_blob which points to _end.
Now _end points to an allocated section .note.gnu.property which of
course is wrong.
This issue is however not seen when using the default Ubuntu 20.04 gnu
toolchain (gcc 9.3.0 with binutils 2.34). Further investigation shows
that it is caused by a behavior change of binutils v2.36 which is part
of the kernel.org gcc 11.1.0 toolchain, via the following commit:
939b95c77bf2 ("Linux/x86: Configure gas with --enable-x86-used-note by default")
In fact, there was already a regression bug report [1] for binutils two
months ago, but the binutils folks did not think it is a bug :(
To resolve this, there are several options:
* pass -Wa,-mx86-used-note=no to gas
* pass -R .note.gnu.property to objcopy
* discard the section in the linker script
Linux kernel uses the discard way [2], so let's do the same for U-Boot.
[1] https://sourceware.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=27753
[2] commit 4caffe6a28d3 ("x86/vdso: Discard .note.gnu.property sections in vDSO")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
On ARM64 secure OS can run as 64bit or 32bit that's why it is necessary to
record information about architecture that other code can read it and
properly pass it to TF-A and start in 64bit or 32bit mode.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
DT files have been added this year but forgot to update it that's why do it
in separate patch now.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
It is not recommended to have aliases for gpio. In past it was used in
Linux for assigning numbers via sysfs which is deprecated and libgpiod
should be used instead.
In U-Boot this number is used for seq number but gpio offset are not
counted from this number. That's why having these aliases only for seq
number is not needed. As is done in Linux it is the best to use full gpio
name instead of sequence number which depends on sequence in binding.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Align USB nodes with the latest dt-bindings. It is adding resets, new
interrupt and also some quirks.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
dtc supports new sugar syntax which is easier compare to previous one
that's why also covert overlays for SOM to it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
kv260-revB is different compare to revA (usbhub is wired via i2c) that's
why remove revA compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The Clocking Wizard IP supports clock circuits customized
to your clocking requirements. The wizard support for
dynamically reconfiguring the clocking primitives for
Multiply, Divide, Phase Shift/Offset, or Duty Cycle.
Limited by U-Boot clk uclass without set_phase API, this
patch only provides set_rate to modify the frequency.
Signed-off-by: Zhengxun <zhengxunli.mxic@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Xilinx ZynqMP supports also addresses above 4GB (32bit) that's why also
generate u-boot.its with 64bit load/entry addresses to also support
different configurations.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
psgtr node should be below pinctrl for easier comparion among dts files.
That's why move that nodes to different location.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Clock setting is not static anymore that's why it depends on firmware setup
that's why remove this comment.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Networking subsystem is not using aliases that's why remove them for CAN
devices. There is also no any other Xilinx ZynqMP DT file with them.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
As per the design specification
"The 16-bit Seconds Calibration Value represents the number of
Oscillator Ticks that are required to measure the largest time
period that is less than or equal to 1 second.
For an oscillator that is 32.768 KHz, this value will be 0x7FFF."
Signed-off-by: Srinivas Neeli <srinivas.neeli@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
psgtr node should be below pinctrl for easier comparion among dts files.
That's why move that nodes to different location.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Historically dpdma and dpsub are placed at the end of files. Move nodes
there for easier comparison among dts files.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
dwc3 can be used only for higher speeds than super-speed that's why
explicitly set it up.
This is also aligned with other ZynqMP dts files.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Uarts already have u-boot,dm-pre-reloc via zynqmp.dtsi that's why there is
no need to have them in platform DT files too.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is need to pass entry about secure OS when bl32_entry is defined.
Currently only 64bit support is added but /fit-images node have been
extended to also record if this is 32bit or 64bit secure OS. When this is
tested the code will be update to support this configuration too.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The first change is to trying to find out TF-A load address based on
reading elf file. Expectation is that bl31.bin is in the same folder as
bl31.elf. It brings new flexibility to place TF-A to any address (DDR
included).
And also enable TEE generation also with TEE configuration.
Expecation is the same as above that tee.bin and tee.elf are in the same
folder.
User has to just define link to BL31/BL32 binary files and the rest should
be handled by the script.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
TF-A and SecureOS can allocate the part of DDR for self but U-Boot is not
handling this configuration that the part of memory is reserved and
shouldn't be used by U-Boot. That's why read all reserved memory locations
and don't use it.
The code was taken from commit 4a1b975dac ("board: stm32mp1: reserve
memory for OP-TEE in device tree") and commit 1419e5b516 ("stm32mp:
update MMU config before the relocation") which is used by stm32 and does
the job properly.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The SMMU is disabled in device tree so this change has no impact.
The benefit is that this way it is in sync with xen.dtsi. Xen enables
the SMMU and makes use of it.
Signed-off-by: Stefano Stabellini <stefano.stabellini@xilinx.com>
There is no reason to have CCI no enabled by default. Enable it when your
system configuration requires it. In Xilinx configuration flow this is
work for Device Tree Generator which reads information from HW Design
configuration.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
K26 has EMMC and SD and default 0 is not working when system is booting out
of SD which is controller 1. Add controller autodetection via
mmc_get_env_dev(). The same code is used for distro_boot selection done in
board_late_init(). bootseq variable can't be reused because this is called
so late.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Rename amba to AXI. Based on Xilinx Zynq TRM (Chapter 5) chip is "AXI
point-to-point channels for communicating addresses, data, and response
transactions between master and slave clients. This ARM AMBA 3.0..."
Issues are reported as:
.. amba: $nodename:0: 'amba' does not match
'^([a-z][a-z0-9\\-]+-bus|bus|soc|axi|ahb|apb)(@[0-9a-f]+)?$'
>From schema:
../github.com/devicetree-org/dt-schema/dtschema/schemas/simple-bus.yaml
Similar change has been done for Xilinx ZynqMP SoC.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/8a4bc80debfbb79c296e76fc1e4c173e62657286.1606397101.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
SVDs are using different name which can't be handled via zynqmp_devices
structure. That's why introduce zynqmp_detect_svd_name() which checks ID
code for these devices and show proper name for them.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enabling EFI secure boot which is required for EBBR specification.
Enabling this will fix
"RT.SetVariable - Create one Time Base Auth Variable, the expect return
status should be EFI_SUCCESS"
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
From U-Boot, loading application on RPU core 0 is fine but loading on
core 1 is not handled properly. Lock-step mode needs both the R5 cores
to be initialized and it is working fine. Whereas in SPLIT mode individual
R5 cores needs to be initialized as they need to execute differenet
applications. Handle both these lock-step and split modes by propagating
mode and RPU core number(4 for RPU0 and 5 for RPU1) for various functions
and by adding conditions in those functions.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The Linux commit f69629919942 ("dt-bindings: sram: Convert SRAM bindings to
json-schema") converted binding to yaml and some missing required
properties started to be reported. Align binding based on it.
The patch is fixing these warnings:
.../zynq-zc702.dt.yaml: sram@fffc0000: '#address-cells' is a required property
.../zynq-zc702.dt.yaml: sram@fffc0000: '#size-cells' is a required property
.../zynq-zc702.dt.yaml: sram@fffc0000: 'ranges' is a required property
>From schema: .../Documentation/devicetree/bindings/sram/sram.yaml
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/87c02786ccd8d7827827a9d95a8737bb300caeb0.1606397101.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
The Linux commit f8f79fa6bb25 ("dt-bindings: at25: convert the binding
document to yaml") converted binding to yaml and 3 deprecated properties
pop up.
The patch is fixing these warnings:
.../zynq-zc770-xm013.dt.yaml: eeprom@2: 'pagesize' is a required property
.../zynq-zc770-xm013.dt.yaml: eeprom@2: 'size' is a required property
.../zynq-zc770-xm013.dt.yaml: eeprom@2: 'address-width' is a required property
>From schema: .../Documentation/devicetree/bindings/eeprom/at25.yaml
by converting them to new binding.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/be2c1125d98386033e182012eb08986924707a76.1606397101.git.michal.simek@xilinx.com
Use the ZDMA channel 0 to initialize the DRAM banks. This avoid
spurious ECC errors that can occur when accessing unitialized memory.
The feature is enabled by setting the option
CONFIG_SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_ECC_INIT and providing the following data:
SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_BANK1_BASE: start of memory to initialize
SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_BANK1_LEN : len of memory to initialize (hex)
SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_BANK2_BASE: start of memory to initialize
SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_BANK2_LEN : len of memory to initialize (hex)
Setting SPL_ZYNQMP_DRAM_BANK_LEN to 0 takes no action.
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
pca953x also depends on i2c that's why add dependency to Kconfig.
Where GPIO is enabled but I2C compilation error pops up.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Replace typo CONFIG_USE_AUTOBOOT_MENUKEY with
CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_USE_MENUKEY as when they were introduced initially there
was some mismatch in which name was used where.
Fixes: 8fc31e23aa ("autoboot: Rename CONFIG_MENUKEY to CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_MENUKEY")
Signed-off-by: Da Xue <da@libre.computer>
This function is passed *dev not *dev_desc, so pass the right name to
part_init().
Fixes: f14c5ee5ab ("disk: part_dos: update partition table entries after write")
Signed-off-by: Christian Melki <christian.melki@t2data.com>
MSYS2 Windows build started to fail since yesterday (Jun 21):
checking keyring...
checking package integrity...
error: gcc-libs: signature from "David Macek <david.macek.0@gmail.com>" is unknown trust
:: File /var/cache/pacman/pkg/gcc-libs-10.2.0-1-x86_64.pkg.tar.zst is corrupted (invalid or corrupted package (PGP signature)).
error: gcc: signature from "David Macek <david.macek.0@gmail.com>" is unknown trust
:: File /var/cache/pacman/pkg/gcc-10.2.0-1-x86_64.pkg.tar.zst is corrupted (invalid or corrupted package (PGP signature)).
error: failed to commit transaction (invalid or corrupted package)
Errors occurred, no packages were upgraded.
Switching to the latest installer (version 20210604) seems to fix it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This reverts commit 63756575b4.
Since this commit a imx6qdl-pico board boots extremely slowly
in both SPL as well as U-Boot proper.
Fix this regression by reverting the offending commit for now.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Tested-by: Pierre-Jean Texier <texier.pj2@gmail.com>
This patch allows uboot scripts make choices about where to boot from based
on the active mmc boot partition. This allows having two copies of kernel,
filesystems etc, and choosing which to boot from based off of the active
bootloader partition.
Signed-off-by: Reuben Dowle <reuben.dowle@4rf.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The data read is not working when using FIFO mode.
From DesignWare databook, when a Data_Transfer_Over (DTO) interrupt is
received, the software should read the remaining data from FIFO.
Add DTO interrupt checking on data read path and clear interrupts before
start reading from FIFO. So, it doesn't clear the next pending
interrupts unintentionally after read from FIFO.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
With a 48MHz input clock, the lowest bus frequency can be as low as
48000000 / (4 * 4095) = 2930Hz. Such an extremely low frequency will cause
the mmc framework take seconds to finish the initialization.
Limiting the minimum bus frequency to a slightly higher value can solve the
issue without any side effects.
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
imx8mm ekv has been switched to use distro boot commands, but had no
correct options enabled to support sysboot.
According to the README.distro, sysboot is consindered to be a
recommended way of using distro boot commands, it required default distro
features to be enabled instead of only those that are relevant to the boot
script.
Replace the boot script specific options in the config to a default distro
option.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fixes: 2df8930bf9 ("imx8mm: configs: add support for distro boot commands")
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
imx8mp ekv has been switched to use distro boot commands, but had no
correct options enabled to support sysboot.
According to the README.distro, sysboot is consindered to be a
recommended way of using distro boot commands, it required default distro
features to be enabled instead of only those that are relevant to the boot
script.
Replace the boot script specific options in the config to a default distro
option.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fixes: 9b162b1d1f ("imx8mp: configs: add support for distro boot commands")
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Remove the LED unit addresses and reg properties to
fix the following dtc build warnings:
arch/arm/dts/o4-imx-nano.dtb: Warning (reg_format): /leds/led@0:reg: property has invalid length (4 bytes) (#address-cells == 2, #size-cells == 1)
...
arch/arm/dts/o4-imx-nano.dtb: Warning (avoid_default_addr_size): /leds/led@0: Relying on default #address-cells value
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Oleh Kravchenko <oleg@kaa.org.ua>
- stm32mp157c-odyssey-som DT fixes
- stm32_qspi: Fix short data write operation
- dfu: set max_buf_size to erasesize also for NOR devices
- Fixes ethernet clock property name for STM32MP1 board
- STM32CubeProgrammer: various fixes
- clk: cosmetic update for clk-uclass
If the environment does not have "soc" or "board" set, and fdtdir
option is specified in extlinux.conf, the bootloader will crash whilst
dereferencing a null pointer. Add a guard against null soc or
board. Fixes a crash of qemu-riscv64_smode configuration, which does
not have CONFIG_SYS_SOC defined.
Signed-off-by: Dimitri John Ledkov <xnox@ubuntu.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Linux uses the prefix "ethernet" whereas u-boot uses "eth". This is from
the linux tree:
$ grep "eth[0-9].*=.*&" arch/**/*dts{,i}|wc -l
0
$ grep "ethernet[0-9].*=.*&" arch/**/*dts{,i}|wc -l
633
In u-boot device trees both prefixes are used. Until recently the only
user of the ethernet alias was the sandbox test device tree. This
changed with commit fc054d563b ("net: Introduce DSA class for Ethernet
switches"). There, the MAC addresses are inherited based on the devices
sequence IDs which is in turn given by the device tree.
Before there are more users in u-boot and both worlds will differ even
more, rename the alias prefix to "ethernet" to match the linux ones.
Also adapt the test cases and rename any old aliases in the u-boot
device trees.
Cc: David Wu <david.wu@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the environment variable "ethact" is not set, the first device in the
uclass is returned. This depends on the probing order of the ethernet
devices. Moreover it is not not configurable at all.
Try to return the ethernet device with sequence id 0 first which then
can be configured by the aliases in a device tree. Fall back to the old
mechanism in case of an error.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Commit 4f0278dac5 ("net: sun8i-emac: Lower MDIO frequency") leads to
network failure on the OrangePi PC.
=> dhcp
sun8i_emac_eth_start: Timeout
According to the commit message the change of the MDIO frequency is only
required for external PHYs.
Fixes: 4f0278dac5 ("net: sun8i-emac: Lower MDIO frequency")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add SynQuacer's NETSEC GbE controller driver.
Since this driver will load the firmware from SPI NOR flash,
this depends on CONFIG_SYNQUACER_SPI=y.
Signed-off-by: Jassi Brar <jaswinder.singh@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Disabling clk_ck clock leads to link up status loss in phy, which
leads to auto-negotiation restart before each network command
execution.
This issue is especially big for PXE boot protocol because of
auto-negotiation restarts before each configuration filename trial.
To avoid this issue don't disable clk_ck clock after it was enabled.
Signed-off-by: Daniil Stas <daniil.stas@posteo.net>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
commit f1bcad22dd ("net: e1000: add support for writing to EEPROM")
adds support for storing hwaddr in EEPROM however i210 devices do not
support this and thus results in errors such as:
Warning: e1000#0 failed to set MAC address'
Check if a flash device is present and if not return -ENOSYS indicating
this is not supported.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Move the message "Invalid or missing layout file."
to debug level as it is a normal behavior and not an error
and add the missing '\n'.
This patch avoids the strange trace :
Boot over usb0!
Invalid or missing layout file.DFU alt info setting: done
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Use get_cpu_dev() in uart getID command and remove the defines
DEVICE_ID_BYTE1 and 2 defines.
This patch prepare the support for new SOC family.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Handle the second USB enumeration only when the flashlayout is received
and when phase is PHASE_FLASHLAYOUT. This patch removes the call of
stm32prog_next_phase as it is already done in stm32prog_dfu_init().
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
When CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is activated, CONFIG_LEGACY_IMAGE_FORMAT
is deactivated and the define IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY don't exist with
include/image.h:
#if defined(CONFIG_LEGACY_IMAGE_FORMAT)
#define IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY 0x01 /* legacy image_header based format */
#endif
This patch adds the needed check on compilation flag
CONFIG_LEGACY_IMAGE_FORMAT to avoid the compilation error
for command stm32prog:
cmd_stm32prog.c:81:8: error: ‘IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY’ undeclared
(first use in this function); did you mean ‘IMAGE_FORMAT_FIT’?
81 | if (IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY ==
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
| IMAGE_FORMAT_FIT
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add the support in command stm32prog of kernel load and start
with initrd file, identify by the partition Type "Binary" in
the flashlayout.tsv, for example:
- 0x01 fsbl Binary none 0x0 tfa.stm32
- 0x03 fip Binary none 0x0 fip.bin
P 0x10 kernel System ram0 0xC2000000 uImage.bin
P 0x11 dtb FileSystem ram0 0xC4000000 board.dtb
P 0x12 initrd Binary ram0 0xC4400000 <initrd>
The <initrd> file can be a legacy image "uInitrd", generated
with mkimage, or a RAW initrd image "initrd.gz".
After a DFU detach the bootm command with be executed
with the associated address, for example:
$> bootm 0xC2000000 0xC4400000:<size> 0xC4000000
When the "Binary" partition type is absent, the 'bootm'
command starts the kernel without ramdisk, for example:
$> bootm 0xC2000000 - 0xC4000000
With this paths, it is no more mandatory to generate FIT
including the kernel, DT and initrd:
- 0x01 fsbl Binary none 0x0 tfa.stm32
- 0x03 fip Binary none 0x0 fip.bin
P 0x10 fit System ram0 0xC2000000 fit.bin
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Handle timeout in stm32prog_serial_get_buffer to sent NACK
to STM32CubeProgrammer when the buffer is not fully received.
This patch avoids to reach the STM32CubeProgrammer timeout and
the associated unrecoverable error.
Timeout error occurred while waiting for acknowledgment.
Error: Write Operation fails at packet number 4165 at address 0x1044FF
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This patch removes the header check for UART download;
the check of checksum is not mandatory with even parity and chuck
checksum for each 256 received bytes and it is only done for
STM32 image (FSBL = TF-A BL2), not for FIT image.
This patch solve issue of duplicated 0x100 byte written with FIP header.
Fixes: 4fb7b3e108 ("stm32mp: stm32prog: add FIP header support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Use the correct name for STMicroelectronics phys config properties,
replace '_' by '-':
"st,eth_clk_sel" => "st,eth-clk-sel"
"st,eth-ref-clk-sel" => st,eth-clk-sel"
These property name are aligned with the upstreamed Linux kernel binding:
linux/Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/stm32-dwmac.yaml
See Linux kernel commit "dt-bindings: net: stmmac: add phys config
properties" merged in v5.1-rc1.
This patch allow to reuse the kernel device tree directly in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
For NOR devices the logical DFU buffer size is the sector_size,
as it is done in dfu_sf.c or in spi/sf_mtd.c
(sf_mtd_info.erasesize = flash->sector_size)
For NAND the DFU size was already limited to erasesize as
has_pages = true.
So the mtd dfu backend can use this erasesize for all the MTD devices,
NOR and NAND with dfu->max_buf_size = mtd->erasesize
This difference was initially copied from MTD command, where
data is fully available in RAM without size limitation.
This patch avoids to have many sector write in dfu_mtd.c at the end
of the DFU transfer and avoids issues with USB timeout or WATCHDOG.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This driver supports Rockchip NFC (NAND Flash Controller) found on
RK3308, RK2928, RKPX30, RV1108 and other SOCs. The driver has been
tested using 8-bit NAND interface on the ARM based RK3308 platform.
Support Rockchip SoCs and NFC versions:
- PX30 and RK3326(NFCv900).
ECC: 16/40/60/70 bits/1KB.
CLOCK: ahb and nfc.
- RK3308 and RV1108(NFCv800).
ECC: 16 bits/1KB.
CLOCK: ahb and nfc.
- RK3036 and RK3128(NFCv622).
ECC: 16/24/40/60 bits/1KB.
CLOCK: ahb and nfc.
- RK3066, RK3188 and RK2928(NFCv600).
ECC: 16/24/40/60 bits/1KB.
CLOCK: ahb.
Supported features:
- Read full page data by DMA.
- Support HW ECC(one step is 1KB).
- Support 2 - 32K page size.
- Support 8 CS(depend on SoCs)
Limitations:
- No support for the ecc step size is 512.
- Untested on some SoCs.
- No support for subpages.
- No support for the builtin randomizer.
- The original bad block mask is not supported. It is recommended to
use the BBT(bad block table).
Signed-off-by: Yifeng Zhao <yifeng.zhao@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Use the generic error number instead of specific error number.
Changes fix the below error.
drivers/pci/pcie_dw_rockchip.c: In function 'rk_pcie_read':
drivers/pci/pcie_dw_rockchip.c:70:10: error: 'PCIBIOS_UNSUPPORTED'
undeclared (first use in this function)
70 | return PCIBIOS_UNSUPPORTED;
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
drivers/pci/pcie_dw_rockchip.c: In function 'rk_pcie_write':
drivers/pci/pcie_dw_rockchip.c:90:10: error: 'PCIBIOS_UNSUPPORTED'
undeclared (first use in this function)
90 | return PCIBIOS_UNSUPPORTED;
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Cc: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Cc: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Cc: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Anand Moon <linux.amoon@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
RK3568 is a high-performance and low power quad-core application
processor designed for personal mobile internet device and AIoT
equipments.
Signed-off-by: Joseph Chen <chenjh@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
fdtoverlay (pxe_utils) require define fdtoverlay_addr_r env variable
for example sunxi-common.h meson64.h already have it.
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The SDMMC2 interface hosts an eMMC. Replace the interface properties
that would only apply to SD cards—“broken-cd” and “disable-wp”—with
relevant ones: “non-removable”, “no-sd” and “no-sdio”.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Szymaszek <gszymaszek@short.pl>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
First set of u-boot-atmel features for the 2021.10 cycle:
This feature set converts the boards pm9261 and pm9263 Ethernet support
to DM; enables hash command for all SAM boards; fixes the NAND pmecc
bit-flips correction; adds Falcon boot for sama5d3_xplained board; and
other minor adjustments.
Add Priyanka Jain as MAINTAINER for
T2080RDB_revD_defconfig,
T2080RDB_revD_NAND_defconfig,
T2080RDB_revD_SDCARD_defconfig and
T2080RDB_revD_SPIFLASH_defconfig
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Change the USB erratum number A-050106 to A-050204 as A-050106 is
a duplicate and never be published.
Fixes 0cfa00cdb9 (“armv8: Add workaround for USB erratum A-050106”)
Signed-off-by: Ran Wang <ran.wang_1@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Under DM, we rely on u-boot's device tree to provide the correct PHY
addresses. The board_fix_fdt callback is intended to be used for
device tree fixups before relocation. Unfortunately, this isn't an
option when booting from flash since the device tree isn't writable
before relocation.
This patch introduces the CONFIG_T2080RDB_REV_D option to signal that a
board revision D or up is the target. The config option is used to set
the correct Aquantia PHY address in the board's u-boot device tree.
Defconfig files with the option enable explicitly are added for
convenience.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The T2080RDB boards revisions D and up have updated 10G Aquantia PHYs
connected to MAC1 and MAC2. The second Aquantia PHY is located at a
different address on the MDIO bus compared to rev C (0x8 instead of 0x1).
Fix-up the Linux device tree to update the PHY address for the second
Aquantia PHY on boards revisions D and up. Also rename the PHY node to
reflect the changes.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Detect and print the board revision version based on the CPLD registers.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Both DM_ETH and DM_PCI are enabled for the T2080RDB board. Remove the
board_eth_init() callback and the non-DM_ETH code paths since they are not
needed anymore.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
A system clock of 66MHz was chosen for the pg-wcom-ls102xa.
Compared to the Evalboard, this corresponds to a reduction of 1/3.
The system counter clock should have been reduced accordingly,
but that was not the case, so we had a system time that was
1/3 behind the real time.
This patch corrects the system counter clock to
8.333MHz = 66.667MHz / 8.
Signed-off-by: Rainer Boschung <rainer.boschung@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In order to improve power consumption ls102x allows to disable peripherals
that are not in use.
This patch follows SELI8 HW design description and disables peripherals
that are not in use in our designs, the same configuration is applicable
and for EXPU1.
This patch uses available hwconfig option for updating ls102x device
disable configuration.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The default behavior in the latest u-boot revisions is to rotate the
active net device to the next available if the requested link is not
established.
For our ls102x based devices this would mean that if active debug net
device is not available, u-boot will rotate and set the next net device
that is one of the estar adapters.
To return from this situation manual action to set correct ethact
adapter will be needed and this can be annoying when working in
debug mode.
Setting ethrotate=no will disable net adapter rotation and will make sure
that the primary adapter is always used.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This is most probably a typo, and in older u-uboot versions is same as
'saveenv', in the newer uboot versions there is a separate 'save' command
that is different from 'saveenv'.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In our designs we reserve PRAM area at the end of the RAM, and in order
this area to be visible and taken into account by the u-boot memory mgmt
CONFIG_PRAM has to be defined.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
From production view this is standard test executed during production on
all linux based foxmc cards.
On CENT2 HW defined memory region is zero means that some DDR accesses are
done by memory_post_dataline and memory_post_addrline but pattern tests
are skipped that's why mem_regions is fast there.
On ls102x for the complete DDR region of 1GiB memory_regions_post_test
takes approx. 4min and this is too much for production, so this patch
defines only 1MiB region as compromise.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The EXPU1 design is a new 40G capable ethernet service unit card for
Hitachi-Powergrids wired-com product lines.
The base SoC is same as for already added SELI8 card, consequently the
already added u-boot support for SELI8 is reused.
Signed-off-by: Rainer Boschung <rainer.boschung@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
[Fixed new line error at EOF]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Address and size cells on SOC are set to 1. But gpio nodes are specified
with 2 cells. This fixes the gpio nodes to correct cells.
Signed-off-by: Lasse Klok Mikkelsen <lkmi@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Current tsec adapter sets adapter gigabit capabilities by default, and in
reality this must not always be the case.
It is possible that tsec adapter is used for 100Mbps connection, and in
this case setting 1000Mbps capabilities can lead to some side effects such
longer autoneg process.
In our ls102x designs this problem leads to long autoneg times (> 4 sec)
in case board rgmii link is 100Mbps capable only.
Limiting the rgmii link capabilities provides faster and smoother
link establishment.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Commit df86d32 breaks linux kernel and product application boot.
Linux kernel and our product application scripts are expecting 0x prefix
for hexadecimal values, while env_set_hex writes them without a prefix.
This patch partially revert env_set_hex usage for affected env variables.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
During the mainlining of the board this was by mistake set to sector size.
Our user space env scripts are expecting envsize of 0x4000, and setting
this differently will break our cross-platform compatibility.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Drop CONFIG_SYS_FSL_MMC_HAS_CAPBLT_VS33. CONFIG_FSL_ESDHC_VS33_NOT_SUPPORT
is used instead.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc> [for kontron-sl28]
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
For eSDHC, power supply is through peripheral circuit.
Some eSDHC versions have value 0 of the bit but that
does not reflect the truth. 3.3V is common for SD/MMC,
and is supported for all boards with eSDHC in current
u-boot. So, make 3.3V is supported in default in code.
CONFIG_FSL_ESDHC_VS33_NOT_SUPPORT can be enabled if
future board does not support 3.3V.
This is also a fix-up for one previous patch, which converted
to use IS_ENABLED() for CONFIG_SYS_FSL_MMC_HAS_CAPBLT_VS33
that is not a Kconfig option.
Fixes: 52faec3182 ("mmc: fsl_esdhc: replace most #ifdefs by IS_ENABLED()")
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
These boards, according to the schematic and per the board I own, use an
M24256-BWDW6TP I2C EEPROM which requires two address bytes.
This fixes the 'mac' command which is used to program, among other
things, the MAC addresses for the ethernet interfaces on the board.
Signed-off-by: Matt Merhar <mattmerhar@protonmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
IFC NOR flash base address of ls2088a is 0x580000000,
and offset of env crc is 0x500000, so fix the macro
CONFIG_ENV_ADDR to fix synchronous exception(access illegal address)
Fixes: 59071804c1 ("configs: ls2080a: Correct ENV_ADDR value")
Signed-off-by: Biwen Li <biwen.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Stop to initialize the PCIe controller if it's disabled by RCW.
Fixes: 118e58e26e ("pci: layerscape: Split the EP and RC driver")
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Read Linux PPFE firmware from flash partition and pass it to Linux through
FDT entry. So that we can avoid placing PPFE firmware in Linux rootfs.
(FDT may increase at max by 64KB)
Signed-off-by: Chaitanya Sakinam <chaitanya.sakinam@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Anji J <anji.jagarlmudi@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Biwen Li <biwen.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
For cpu release command, check whether PSCI is supported firstly,
if supported, use PSCI to kick off secondary cores, otherwise still
use spin table.
Signed-off-by: Jiafei Pan <Jiafei.Pan@nxp.com>
[Fixed checkpatch alignment CHECKs]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This adds the unit test for the K210 PLL to the sandbox defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that the k210 clock driver does not depend on CCF, we should no longer
imply it (and probably should not have in the first place). We can also
reduce the pre-relocation malloc arena back to something sensible.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Linux has had some stability issues when using AISRAM with a different
frequency from SRAM. Mirror their change here now that we relocate into
AISRAM.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Now that we have only one clock driver, we don't need to have our own
subdirectory. Move the driver back with the rest of the clock drivers.
The MAINTAINERS for kendryte pinctrl is also fixed since it has always been
wrong.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This driver no longer serves a purpose now that we have moved away from
CCF. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This speeds up boot by preventing multiple reconfigurations of the PLLs.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This adds support for setting clock rates, which was left out of the
initial CCF expunging. There are several tricky bits here, mostly related
to the PLLS:
* The PLL's bypass is broken. If the PLL is reconfigured, any child clocks
will be stopped.
* PLL0 is the parent of ACLK which is the CPU and SRAM's clock. To prevent
stopping the CPU while we configure PLL0's rate, ACLK is reparented
to IN0 while PLL0 is disabled.
* PLL1 is the parent of the AISRAM clock. This clock cannot be reparented,
so we instead just disallow changing PLL1's rate after relocation (when
we are using the AISRAM).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Since we are no longer using CCF we cannot use the default soc_clk_dump.
Instead, implement our own.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Now that there no separate PLL driver, we can no longer make the PLL
functions static. By moving the PLL driver in with the rest of the clock
code, we can make these functions static again. We still keep the pll
header for unit testing, but it is pretty reduced.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
This is effectively a complete rewrite to remove all dependency on CCF.
The code is now smaller, and so is the binary. It also takes up less memory
at runtime (since we don't have to create 40 udevices). In general, I am
much happier with this driver as much of the complexity and late binding
has been removed.
The k210_*_params structs which were previously used to initialize CCF
clocks are now used as the complete configuration. Since we can write our
own division logic, we can now do away with several "half" clocks which
only existed to provide constant factors of two.
The clock IDs have been renumbered to remove unused clocks. This may not be
the last time they are renumbered, since we have diverged with Linux. There
are also still a few clocks left out which may need to be added back in.
In general, I have tried to leave out behavioral changes. However, there is
a small bugfix regarding ACLK. According to the technical reference manual,
its mux comes *after* its divider (which is present only for PLL0). This
would have required yet another intermediate clock to fix with CCF, but
with the new driver it is just 2 lines of code :)
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Since 291da96b8e ("clk: Allow clock defaults to be set during re-reloc
state for SPL only") it has been impossible to set clock defaults before
relocation. This is annoying on boards without SPL, since there is no way
to set clock defaults before U-Boot proper. In particular, the aisram rate
must be changed before relocation on the K210, since U-Boot will hang if we
try and change the rate while we are using aisram.
To get around this, extend the stage parameter to allow force setting
defaults, even if they would be otherwise postponed for later. A device
tree property was decided against because of the concerns in the original
commit thread about the overhead of repeatedly parsing the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Current logic in riscv_get_ipi() for Andes PLICSW does not look
correct. The mask to test IPI pending bits for a hart should be
left shifted by (8 * gd->arch.boot_hart), just the same as what
is done in riscv_send_ipi().
Fixes: 8b3e97badf ("riscv: add functions for reading the IPI status")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Tested-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The doc says CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT is in ax25-ae350.h, while
actually it is not. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
At present the AE350 SPL defconfig is using OF_PRIOR_STAGE. The
intention was to use gdb to load device tree before running U-Boot
SPL/proper from RAM. When we switch to OF_SEPARATE we will have to
use our own DT but without "u-boot,dm-spl" in several essential
nodes, SPL does not boot.
Let's add all the required "u-boot,dm-spl" for SPL config.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
All the device nodes that refer to plic0 as their interrupt parent
have 2 cells encoded in their interrupts property, but plic0 only
provides 1 cell in #interrupt-cells which is incorrect.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
When using bootefi to boot a EFI binary, u-boot is supposed to
provide networking service for EFI application. Currently, 'pfe stop'
command is called from bootcmd before running bootefi. As a result
network stops working for EFI applications and console is flooded with
"Rx pkt not on expected port" messages.
Implement board_quiesce_devices() for ls1012a boards and call
pfe_command_stop() from it instead of calling 'pfe stop' from
*_bootcmd and bootcmd.
Tested-by: Anji Jagarlmudi <anji.jagarlmudi@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Mian Yousaf Kaukab <ykaukab@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
[Fixed checkpatch space error]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
It was noticed that the clock isn't continuously enabled when there is
no link. This is because the 125MHz clock is derived from the internal
PLL which seems to go into some kind of power-down mode every once in a
while. The LS1028A expects a contiuous clock. Thus enable the PLL all
the time.
Also, the RGMII pad voltage is wrong, it was configured to 2.5V (that is
the VDDH regulator). The correct voltage is 1.8V, i.e. the VDDIO
regulator.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
One of the points of putting the rescue boot command into default
environment is that user can invoke it without physical access to the
board (without having to press the factory reset button), by running
run bootcmd_rescue
in U-Boot's console.
Therefore we have to ensure that bootcmd_rescue is always set to default
value, regardless of whether the factory reset button was pressed.
Otherwise the variable will be empty for example after upgrade from
previous U-Boot.
Fixes: ec3784d626 ("arm: mvebu: turris_mox: add support for board rescue mode")
Fixes: 176c3e7760 ("arm: mvebu: turris_omnia: support invoking rescue boot from console")
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This supports Falcon boot support for Microchip SAMA5D3 Xplained,
tested on raw MMC, and on raw NAND.
spl_start_uboot() is has the simplest possible implementation.
It doesn't test the environment because enabling environment support
currently causes the SPL to exceed its maximum size (64 KiB).
It doesn't check the serial for incoming characters either because
this functionality currently doesn't seem to work from the SPL
on this board.
Settings for Falcon boot from at FAT partition are also added to
avoid compile failures when CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT is enabled, but this
particular case is currently not functional as adding FAT and
partition support cause the SPL to be too big again.
Signed-off-by: Michael Opdenacker <michael.opdenacker@bootlin.com>
In absence of Device Manager (DM) services such as at R5 SPL stage,
driver will have to natively setup TCHAN/RCHAN/RFLOW cfg registers.
Add support for the same.
Note that we still need to send chan/flow cfg message to TIFS via TISCI
client driver in order to open up firewalls around chan/flow but setting
up of cfg registers is handled locally.
U-Boot specific code is in a separate file included in main driver so
as to maintain similarity with kernel driver in order to ease porting of
code in future.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210607141753.28796-8-vigneshr@ti.com
In absence of Device Manager (DM) services such as at R5 SPL stage,
driver will have to natively setup Ring Cfg registers. Add support for
the same.
Note that we still need to send RING_CFG message to TIFS via TISCI
client driver in order to open up firewalls around Rings.
U-Boot specific code is in a separate file included in main driver so
as to maintain similarity with kernel driver in order to ease porting of
code in future.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210607141753.28796-7-vigneshr@ti.com
R5 SPL needs access to cfg space of Rings and UDMAP, therefore add RING
CFG, TCHAN CFG and RCHAN CFG address ranges.
Note that these registers are present within respective IPs but are
not populated in Linux DT nodes (as they are configured via TISCI APIs)
and hence are added to -u-boot.dtsi for now.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210607141753.28796-6-vigneshr@ti.com
On J721e and J7200, MCU R5 core (boot master) itself would run Device
Manager (DM) Firmware and interact with TI Foundational Security (TIFS)
firmware to enable DMA and such other Resource Management (RM) services.
So, during R5 SPL stage there is no such RM service available and ti_sci
driver will have to directly interact with TIFS using DM to DMSC
channels to request RM resources.
Therefore add DT binding and driver for the same. This driver will
handle Resource Management services at R5 SPL stage.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210607141753.28796-4-vigneshr@ti.com
MCU timer1 is used as the tick timer for MCU R5 SPL, and the
clock-frequency defined in DT appears to be incorrect at the moment.
Actual clock source for the timer is MCU_SYSCLK0 / 4 which is 250MHz.
Earlier setup of 25MHz went unnoticed, as there was a separate issue
with omap-timer, which caused an error to the clock by a factor of 8
with j7 devices. This problem surfaced once the omap-timer was fixed.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Update build instructions and image formats based on HSM rearch. A new
DM image is added into the build, which gets executed right after R5
SPL finishes its job.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Sysfw is not going to provide access to power management features in the
new architecture, so SPL must implement these itself. Enable all the raw
register access based clock + power domain drivers.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Sysfw is not going to provide access to power management features in the
new architecture, so SPL must implement these itself. Enable all the raw
register access based clock + power domain drivers.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Force the clk-k3 driver to probe early during R5 SPL boot to ensure the
default system clock configuration is completed. Many other drivers
assume a default state of the clock tree and it is currently possible
for them to probe before clk-k3 depending on the exact system
configuration.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Reported-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Tested-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Copy the contents of the board config loaded from sysfw.itb into an
EXTBOOT shared memory buffer that gets passed to sciserver. This only
needs to be done if EXTBOOT area has not been populated by ROM code yet.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Only start-up the non-linux remote cores if we are running in legacy
boot mode. HSM rearch is not yet supporting this.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
If the raw PM support is built in, we are operating in the split
firmware approach mode where PM support is not available. In this
case, skip the board config for this.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add callback routines for parsing the firmware info from FIT image, and
use the data to boot up ATF and the MCU R5 firmware.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add platform clock and powerdomain data for J721e and J7200. This data
is used by the corresponding drivers to register all the required device
clocks and powerdomains.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add DM (device manager) firmware image to the fit image that is loaded by
R5 SPL. This is needed with the HSM rearch where the firmware allocation
has been changed slightly.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add support command for debugging K3 power domains. This is useful with
the HSM rearch setup, where power domains are directly controlled by SPL
instead of going through the TI SCI layer. The debugging support is only
available in the u-boot codebase though, so the raw register access
power domain layer must be enabled on u-boot side for this to work. By
default, u-boot side uses the TI SCI layer, and R5 SPL only uses the
direct access methods.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Normally, power domains are handled via TI-SCI in K3 SoCs. However,
SPL is not going to have access to sysfw resources, so it must control
them directly. Add driver for supporting this.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add driver to support TI K3 generation SoC clocks. This driver registers
the clocks provided via platform data, and adds support for controlling
the clocks via DT handles.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add support for TI K3 SoC PLLs. This clock type supports
enabling/disabling/setting and querying the clock rate for the PLL. The
euclidean library routine is used to calculate divider/multiplier rates
for the PLLs.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Clock rates are cached within the individual clock nodes, and right now
if one changes a clock rate somewhere in the middle of the tree, none
of its child clocks notice the change. To fix this, clear up all the
cached rates for us and our child clocks.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
If a clock provider is not ready for assigning default rates/parents
during its probe, it may return -EPROBE_DEFER directly from xlate.
Handle this special case properly by skipping the entry and adjusting the
return value to pass. The defaults will be handled properly in post probe
phase then.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Set rate should return the new clock rate on success, and negative error
value on failure. Fix this, as currently set_rate returns 0 on success.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Add new clk subcommand "clk setfreq", for setting up a clock rate
directly from u-boot cmdline. This is handy for any debugging purposes
towards clocks.
Acked-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Bail out early if device returned for the parent clock is null.
This avoids warning prints like this when doing clk dump:
dev_get_uclass_priv: null device
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Some clocks are not associated to a DM node, so just parsing the DM is not
enough. This is especially true for root clocks, which typically don't have
any parents. Instead, fetch every registered UCLASS_CLK instance, and dump
these out.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Current driver only supports registering fixed rate clocks from DT. Add
new API which makes it possible to register fixed rate clocks directly
from e.g. platform specific clock drivers.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
board_fit_image_post_process() passes only start and size of the image,
but type of the image is not passed. So pass fit and node_offset, to
derive information about image to be processed.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
With the sysfw rearch, sysfw PM calls are no longer available from SPL
level. To properly support this, remove the is_on checks and the reset
assertion from the R5 remoteproc driver as these are not supported.
Attempting to access unavailable services will cause the device to hang.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
On J7 family of SoCs (J721E and J7200), sysfw is being split to be run
under two cores, TIFS portion on DMSC core, and DM firmware under MCU
R5. As MCU R5 is also used to run one phase of the bootloader, we must
prevent access from here towards sysfw services. To support this, add
new config option which can be used to detect presence of RM/PM sysfw
services.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Copy the best rational approximation calculation routines from Linux.
Typical usecase for these routines is to calculate the M/N divider
values for PLLs to reach a specific clock rate.
This is based on linux kernel commit:
"lib/math/rational.c: fix possible incorrect result from rational
fractions helper"
(sha1: 323dd2c3ed0641f49e89b4e420f9eef5d3d5a881)
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <t-kristo@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
Sata/scsi and usb based devices are not started at this stage that's why
disks are not found and early update can't happen.
It is because of deficiency in the UEFI implementation which is not able to
deal with block devices which are added or removed after initialization.
EFI capsule on disk early feature needs to be fixed first to be able to
enable this feature properly.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable manual start in zynqmp_qspi_fill_gen_fifo().
Also enable GQSPI_IXR_GFNFULL_MASK and check for it instead of
GQSPI_IXR_GFEMTY_MASK.
Add dummy write to genfifo register in chipselect.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
The default register configuration after powerup for PSSYSMON_ANALOG_BUS
register is incorrect. Hence, fix this in SPL by writing correct fixed
value. It follows UG1085 chapter 'PS SYSMON Analog_Bus' and reflects commit
sw_apps:zynq ("056ca65d44549ce27f716d423e8dfdefeee7440c")
in Xilinx:embeddedsw[1].
[1] https://github.com/Xilinx/embeddedsw
Signed-off-by: Adrian Fiergolski <adrian.fiergolski@fastree3d.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
0x04000000- 0x06000000 is reserved memory. We cannot load to anything here.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable configuration options to support Turris network boot. This
includes FIT support and some crypto commands.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add nodes for SPI NOR partitions to the device tree of Turris MOX, as
are in Linux' device tree.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add default fdtfile environment variable with value
marvell/armada-3720-turris-mox.dtb.
This can be useful for some boot scenarios.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Configure blinking on ethernet PHY LEDs on the MOX A board when entering
rescue mode via reset button.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add necessary config options and board code to support board factory
reset / rescue mode on Turris MOX.
In order to also support invoking rescue mode from U-Boot console,
without having to press the factory reset button, put the rescue command
into `bootcmd_rescue` default environment variable. When factory reset
button is pressed, invoke rescue mode via distroboot by setting
`boot_targets` to `rescue`.
Rescue boot from console can be invoked by running
run bootcmd_rescue
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add nodes for indicator LED and reset button so that board code can
implement board factory reset mechanism.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The fragmented files were not correctly read because of two issues:
- The squashfs_file_info struct has a field named 'comp', which tells if
the file's fragment is compressed or not. This field was always set to
'true' in sqfs_get_regfile_info and sqfs_get_lregfile_info. It should
actually take sqfs_frag_lookup's return value. This patch addresses
these two assignments.
- In sqfs_read, the fragments (compressed or not) were copied to the
output buffer through a for loop which was reading data at the wrong
offset. Replace these loops by equivalent calls to memcpy, with the
right parameters.
I tested this patch by comparing the MD5 checksum of a few fragmented
files with the respective md5sum output in sandbox, considering both
compressed and uncompressed fragments.
Signed-off-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Update the driver to support the device tree and the driver model.
The read / write helpers in rtc_ops allow access to scratch registers
only. The offset parameter is added to the address of the scratch0
register.
Support for non-DM has been removed as there were no users.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210602203805.11494-8-dariobin@libero.it
To write correct data to the TC registers, the STATUS register must be
read until the BUSY bit is equal to zero. Once the BUSY flag is zero,
there is a 15 μs access period in which the TC registers can be
programmed.
The rtc_wait_not_busy() has been inspired by the Kernel.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210602203805.11494-5-dariobin@libero.it
For USB DFU boot mode there is a limitation on the load address of boot
images that they have to be less than 0x70001000. Therefore, move the
SPL_TEXT_BASE address to 0x70000000.
Currently ATF is being loaded at 0x70000000, if the SPL is being loaded at
0x70000000 then ATF would overwrite SPL image when loaded. Therefore, move
the location of ATF to a latter location in SRAM, past the SPL image. Also
rearrange the EEPROM and BSS data on top of ATF.
Given below is the placement of various data sections in SRAM
┌──────────────────────────────────────┐0x70000000
│ │
│ │
│ │
│ SPL IMAGE (Max size 1.5 MB) │
│ │
│ │
│ │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x7017FFFF
│ │
│ SPL STACK │
│ │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x70192727
│ GLOBAL DATA(216 B) │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x701927FF
│ │
│ INITIAL HEAP (32 KB) │
│ │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x7019A7FF
│ │
│ BSS (20 KB) │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x7019F7FF
│ EEPROM DATA (2 KB) │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x7019FFFF
│ │
│ │
│ ATF (123 KB) │
│ │
│ │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x701BEBFB
│ BOOT PARAMETER INDEX TABLE (5124 B)│
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x701BFFFF
│ │
│SYSFW FIREWALLED DUE TO A BUG (128 KB)│
│ │
├──────────────────────────────────────┤0x701DFFFF
│ │
│ DMSC CODE AREA (128 KB) │
│ │
└──────────────────────────────────────┘0x701FFFFF
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210604163043.12811-9-a-govindraju@ti.com
AM64 EVM board has a micro USB 2.0 AB connector and the USB0_VBUS is
connected with a resistor divider in between. USB0_DRVVBUS pin is muxed
between USB0_DRVVBUS and GPIO1_79 signals.
Add the corresponding properties and set the pinmux mode for USB subsystem
in the evm dts file.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210604163043.12811-7-a-govindraju@ti.com
U-Boot either supports USB host or device mode for a node at a time in the
device tree nodes. To support both host and dfu bootmodes, dr_mode is set
to "peripheral" by default and then fixed based on the mode selected by
the boot mode config dip switches on the board.
This needs to happen before the cdns3 generic layer binds the usb device
to a host or a device driver. Therefore, use fdtdec_setup_board()
implementation to fixup the device tree property.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20210604163043.12811-4-a-govindraju@ti.com
Pull request for efi-2021-07-rc5
Documentation:
* pinmux and ums man-page
Bug fixes:
* Consider that partition numbers as hexadecimal.
* Avoid a possible NULL dereference in efi_capsule_delete_file().
Add support for Storopack's SMEGW01 board, which is an
IoT gateway based on the i.MX7D SoC.
Based on the original U-Boot work done by Phytec.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@denx.de>
Supported boot device types in iMX8MN: MMC, DHCP.
Add DISTRO_DEFAULTS config option and include the distro boot command
header file to enable full support of distro boot on i.MX8M Nano EVK (both
DDR and LPDDR derivatives).
Drop previous environment, which was targeting customized boot commands and
boot order.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Frequency requested by ddrphy_init_set_dfi_clk from fracpll uses MHZ()
macro, which expands the value provided to the Hz range without taking into
account the precise Hz setting. This causes the frequency of 266 MHz not ot
be found in the imx8mm_fracpll_tbl, since it is entered there with a
precise Hz value. This in turn causes the boot hang in SPL, as proper DDR
fracpll frequency cannot be determined.
Correct the value in imx8mm_fracpll_tbl to match the one expanded by
MHZ(266) macro, rounding it down to MHz range only.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: "NXP i.MX U-Boot Team" <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Fixes: 825ab6b406 ("driver: ddr: Refine the ddr init driver on imx8m")
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable driver model support for FEC ethernet which allows us to remove
the iomux and board_eth_init function. Replace the toggling of the ethernet
phy reset with dt configuration.
Enable driver model support for PCI which allows us to remove the
eth1000_initialize() call. Additionally enable PCI_INIT_R to scan for
PCI devices on init such as the e1000 that is present on the GW552x.
Convert board_pci_fixup to use dm callback and remove pcidisable env
variable which is not supported for DM_PCI and thus leave PCI always
enabled during init.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Clock initialization functionality has ambitious debug messages, which are
printed out when failures are triggered during execution:
- Separate frequency table lookup functions have the the same output that
makes it impossible to understand which function failed and produced the
output
- PLL decoding routine has a generic debug statement printed, which does
not state the actual value failed to be found
Extend the output for both cases with prefixing table lookup functions
output with function name, and report the failed value in PLL decoding
routine.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: "NXP i.MX U-Boot Team" <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
A simple prototyping board with one microSD port, one Ethernet port,
2 USB ports, I2C, SPI, GPIO, and UART interfaces.
Signed-off-by: Oleh Kravchenko <oleg@kaa.org.ua>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Board designed for quick prototyping and has one microSD port,
2 Ethernet ports, 2 USB ports, I2C, SPI, CAN, RS-485, GPIO,
UART interfaces, and 2 RGB LEDs.
Signed-off-by: Oleh Kravchenko <oleg@kaa.org.ua>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Usb needs IMXRT1050_CLK_USBOH3 clock to be enabled, so let's add it to
clock driver.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
We need those macros to instruct drivers on how to behave for SoC specific
quirks, so let's add it as done for other i.MX SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
At the moment a lot of u-boot,dm-spl properties are present in board .dts
file but this is not correct since u-boot,dm-spl property is u-boot
specific and must be listed into the separate imrt1020-evk-u-boot.dtsi
file. So let's move every u-boot,dm-spl property present in
imxrt1020-evk.dts to imxrt1020-evk-u-boot.dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
At the moment a lot of u-boot,dm-spl properties are present in board .dts
file but this is not correct since u-boot,dm-spl property is u-boot
specific and must be listed into the separate imrt1050-evk-u-boot.dtsi
file. So let's move every u-boot,dm-spl property present in
imxrt1050-evk.dts to imxrt1050-evk-u-boot.dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Lcdif needs both "pix" and "axi" clocks to be enabled so let's add them to
lcdif node.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Since we assume pll5 is the default lcdif clock source let's move
assigned-clocks(-parents) properties to .dtsi file.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Lcd peripheral needs 2 different gates to be enable to work, so let's
introduce the missing one(LCDIF_PIX) and rename the existing one
(LCDIF_APB).
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Some SoC needs "disp_axi" clock to be enabled, so let's try to retrieve it
and enabling. If it fails it gives only a debug(), but this clock as well
as "axi" clock is not mandatory.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
On some SoC mxsfb needs more than one clock gate(actual "per" clock). So
let's introduce "axi" clock that can be provided but it's not mandatory.
This is inspired from linux mxsfb driver. Also let's rename "per" clock to
"pix" clock for compatibility with already existing .dts lcdif nodes
implementation.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Now device_type = "memory" is mandatory to allow u-boot to read memory
node, so let's add it to memory node.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Now device_type = "memory" is mandatory to allow u-boot to read memory
node, so let's add it to memory node.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
This timer driver uses GPT Timer (General Purpose Timer) available on
a lot of i.MX SoCs family. This driver deals with both 24Mhz oscillator
as well as peripheral clock.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
[Giulio: added the driver's stub and handled peripheral clock prescaler
setting making driver to work correctly]
Signed-off-by: Jesse Taube <mr.bossman075@gmail.com>
[Jesse: added init, setting prescaler for 24Mhz support and enabling
timer]
This mpu handling works for every i.MXRT SoC that we have, so let's
generalize imxrt1050_region_config to imxrt_region_config.
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Brackets '[' need to be escaped to avoid a build warning
lib/efi_loader/efi_image_loader.c:223:
WARNING: Inline strong start-string without end-string.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
When `usb start` is called on the terminal, the dwc2 driver will try
to start every USB device as host first, even if it is explicitly
configured as peripheral in the device tree (dr_mode = "peripheral").
So to avoid an unwanted 15 seconds delay when initializing the usb
(one second per channel = 1s x 15), this patch adds a check to the
initialization, and will skip host initialization of the device is
explicitly set as peripheral. The checking is already done similarly
in the `drivers/usb/gadget/dwc2_udc_otg.c` driver.
Signed-off-by: João Loureiro <joaofl@gmail.com>
Currently the config options CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE and
CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE are being set in include/configs/<board>.h
files and also in <board_name>_defconfig files without a Kconfig option. It
is easier for users to set these configs in defconfig files than in config
header files as they are a part of the source code.
Add Kconfig symbols, and update the defconfigs by using tools/moveconfig.py
script.
Suggested-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Acked-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Acked-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
TFTP transfer size can be used to re-size the TFTP progress bar on
single line based on the server reported file size. The support for
this has been around from 2019, but it was never converted to proper
Kconfig.
While adding this new Kconfig, enable it by default for OMAP2+ and K3
devices also.
Signed-off-by: Tero Kristo <kristo@kernel.org>
If we want to address partition 15 of virtio block device 11, we have to
write:
virtio b:f
When calling sprintf() we must use %x for the device and partition numbers.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add the missing dependency for the command ums:
- CONFIG_BLK: call of blk_* functions in usb_mass_storage.c
- CONFIG_USB_GADGET: required to select CONFIG_USB_FUNCTION_MASS_STORAGE
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reorder alphabetically the command in the index of usage
in U-Boot documentation.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
To quote Simon, first for the display changes:
At present we have two ways of showing a hex dump. Once has been in
U-Boot since the dawn of time and the other was recently added from
Linux.
They both have their own unique features.
This series makes a few changes to bring them closer together. It also
adds support for logging a buffer, which is useful since it can put it
through the same log drivers as other logging output.
Also it adds tests, so we can check the behaviour.
And then the logging changes:
At present when logging is not enabled, all log() calls become nops.
This does not seem right, since if the log level is high enough then
there should be some sort of message. So in that case, this series
updates it to print the message if the log level is above LOGL_INFO.
This mimics the behaviour for the log_...() macros like log_debug() and
log_info(), so we can drop the special case for these.
Also the current implementation does not support multiple log calls on
the same line nicely. The tags are repeated so the line is very hard to
read. This series adds that as a new feature.
Kernel device tree got updated to use clock name as "ref" instead of
"usb2_refclk". Fix cdns3-ti.c to use the correct name.
Fixes: 70e167495a ("arm: dts: k3-j721e: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Fixes: 6239cc8c4e ("arm: dts: k3-j7200: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Signed-off-by: Kishon Vijay Abraham I <kishon@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
At present if logging not enabled, log_info() becomes a nop. But we want
log output at the 'info' level to be akin to printf(). Update the macro to
pass the output straight to printf() in this case.
This mimics the behaviour for the log_...() macros like log_debug() and
log_info(), so we can drop the special case for these.
Add new tests to cover this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The pr_cont_test.c test requires CONFIG_LOG since it directly accesses
fields in global_data that require it. Move the test into the CONFIG_LOG
condition to avoid build errors.
Enable CONFIG_LOG on sandbox (not sandbox_spl, etc.) so that we still run
this test. This requires resyncing of the configs.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present print_buffer() outputs a hex dump but it is not possible to
place this dump in a string. Refactor it into a top-level function which
does the printing and a utility function that dumps a line into a string.
This makes the code more generally useful.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present print_hex_dump() only supports either 16- or 32-byte lines.
With U-Boot we want to support any line length up to a maximum of 64.
Update the function to support this, with 0 defaulting to 16, as with
print_buffer().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current implementation outputs an address as a pointer. Update the
code to use an address instead, respecting the 32/64 nature of the CPU.
Add some initial tests copied from print_test_display_buffer(), just the
ones that can pass with the current implementation.
Note that for this case print_hex_dump() and print_bufffer() produce the
same result. For now the tests are duplicated sine we have separate
functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move the comments to the header file so people can find the function info
without digging in the implementation. Fix up the code style and add an
enum for the first arg.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present with print_buffer() U-Boot shows four spaces between the hex
and ASCII data. Two seems enough and matches print_hex_dump(). Change it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a test for this function, to cover the various features. Expand the
expect_str length to take acount of the ~300-bytes lines generated in one
case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This test predates the test framework in U-Boot. It uses #define DEBUG and
assert() to check the result. Update it to use the framework so it can
report failure constitent with other tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If a line of more than 256 bytes is generated, the test will fail but the
reason is not clear. Add a check for this condition and print a helpful
message.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the console output buffer is exhausted, characters are silently dropped
from the end. Detect this condition and report an error when reading back
the characters.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To quote the series author, Patrick Delaunay:
On STM32MP15x platform we can use OP-TEE, loaded in DDR in a region
protected by a firewall. This region is reserved in the device with
the "no-map" property as defined in the binding file
doc/device-tree-bindings/reserved-memory/reserved-memory.txt.
Sometime the platform boot failed in U-Boot on a Cortex A7 access to
this region (depending of the binary and the issue can change with compiler
version or with code alignment), then the firewall raise an error,
for example:
E/TC:0 tzc_it_handler:19 TZC permission failure
E/TC:0 dump_fail_filter:420 Permission violation on filter 0
E/TC:0 dump_fail_filter:425 Violation @0xde5c6bf0, non-secure privileged read,
AXI ID 5c0
E/TC:0 Panic
After investigation, the forbidden access is a speculative request performed
by the Cortex A7 because all the DDR is mapped as MEMORY with CACHEABLE
property.
The issue is solved only when the region reserved by OP-TEE is no more
mapped in U-Boot as it is already done in Linux kernel.
Tested on DK2 board with OP-TEE 3.12 / TF-A 2.4:
With hard-coded address for OP-TEE reserved memory,
the error doesn't occur.
void dram_bank_mmu_setup(int bank)
{
....
for (i = start >> MMU_SECTION_SHIFT;
i < (start >> MMU_SECTION_SHIFT) + (size >> MMU_SECTION_SHIFT);
i++) {
option = DCACHE_DEFAULT_OPTION;
if (i >= 0xde0)
option = INVALID_ENTRY;
set_section_dcache(i, option);
}
}
Just by modifying the test on 0xde0 to 0xdf0, the OP-TEE memory protected
by firewall is mapped cacheable and the error occurs.
I think that it can be a general issue for ARM architecture: the "no-map" tag
of reserved memory in device should be respected by U-Boot if firewall
is configured before U-Boot execution.
But I don't propose a generic solution in
arm/lib/cache-cp15.c:dram_bank_mmu_setup()
because the device tree parsing done in lmb_init_and_reserve() takes a
long time when it is executed without data cache.
Synchronize R-Car Gen2/Gen3 pinctrl tables with Linux 5.12,
commit 9f4ad9e425a1 ("Linux 5.12") . This is a rather large
commit, since the macros in sh-pfc.h also got updated, so
all the PFC tables must be updated in lockstep.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
No more map the reserved region with "no-map" property by marking
the corresponding TLB entries with invalid entry (=0) to avoid
speculative access.
The device tree parsing done in lmb_init_and_reserve() takes a
long time when it is executed without data cache, so it is called in
enable_caches() before to disable it.
This patch fixes an issue where predictive read access on secure DDR
OP-TEE reserved area are caught by firewall.
Series-cc: marex
Series-cc: pch
Series-cc: marek.bykowski@gmail.com
Series-cc: Ard Biesheuvel <ardb@kernel.org>
Series-cc: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add 8M for the U-Boot reserved memory (display, fdt, gd, ...)
mapped cacheable before relocation.
Without this patch the device tree, located before the MALLOC area
is not tagged cacheable just after relocation, before mmu reconfiguration.
This patch reduces the duration for device tree parsing in
lmb_init_and_reserve.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Save the 'no-map' information present in 'reserved-memory' node to allow
correct handling when the MMU is configured in board to avoid
speculative access.
This binding is defined in
doc/device-tree-bindings/reserved-memory/reserved-memory.txt
Additional properties:
...
no-map (optional) - empty property
- Indicates the operating system must not create a virtual mapping
of the region as part of its standard mapping of system memory,
nor permit speculative access to it under any circumstances other
than under the control of the device driver using the region.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add a new function lmb_is_reserved_flags to check if
an address is reserved with a specific flags.
This function can be used to check if an address was
reserved with no-map flags with:
lmb_is_reserved_flags(lmb, addr, LMB_NOMAP);
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add "flags" in lmb_property to save the "no-map" property of
reserved region and a new function lmb_reserve_flags() to check
this flag.
The default allocation use flags = LMB_NONE.
The adjacent reserved memory region are merged only when they have
the same flags value.
This patch is partially based on flags support done in Linux kernel
mm/memblock .c (previously lmb.c); it is why LMB_NOMAP = 0x4, it is
aligned with MEMBLOCK_NOMAP value.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable NAND on mmc defconfig for greater flexibility and for consistency
reasons. All our other boards that have a NAND flash integrated, enable
NAND regardless of the type of the defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Not correcting anything in case of empty ECC data area
is not an appropriate strategy, because an uncorrected bit-flip
in an empty sector may cause upper layers (namely UBI) fail to work
properly. Therefore the approach chosen in Linux kernel and other
u-boot mtd drivers has been adopted, where a heuristic implemented
by nand_check_erased_ecc_chunk() is used in order to detect and
correct empty sectors.
Tested with sama5d3_xplained and sam9x60-ek.
Signed-off-by: Kai Stuhlemmer (ebee Engineering) <kai.stuhlemmer@ebee.de>
Tested-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
[ta: reorder if conditions, change commit subject, s/uint8_t/u8.]
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Add a test of dev_read_resource with translation or without translation
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Removed call of ofnode_translate_address() after ofnode_read_resource
in luton_switch.c:luton_probe(); it is unnecessary since
the commit feb7ac457c ("dm: core: Add address translation in
fdt_get_resource").
Fixes: feb7ac457c ("dm: core: Add address translation in fdt_get_resource")
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Horatiu Vultur <horatiu.vultur@microchip.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
With commit 41575d8e4c ("dm: treewide: Rename auto_alloc_size members
to be shorter") "priv_auto_alloc_size" was renamed to "priv_auto". This
driver was sent to the mailing list before that change, merged after it,
and still has the old form. Apply the rename here as well.
Fixes: 1b9ee2882e ("pwm: Add a driver for Chrome OS EC PWM")
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
os_find_text_base() assumes that first line of /proc/self/maps holds
information about the text. Hence we must call the function before calling
os_malloc() which calls mmap(0x10000000,).
Failure to do so has led to incorrect values for pc_reloc when an
exception was reported
=> exception undefined
Illegal instruction
pc = 0x5628d82e9d3c, pc_reloc = 0x5628c82e9d3c
as well as incorrect output of the bdinfo command
=> bdinfo
relocaddr = 0x0000000007858000
reloc off = 0x0000000010000000
Fixes: b308d9fd18 ("sandbox: Avoid using malloc() for system state")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In of_get_address(), there is:
dev_count_cells(dev, &na, &ns);
followed by:
bus->count_cells(dev, &na, &ns);
but no codes in between use na/ns, hence the first call is useless.
By dropping the first call, dev_count_cells() is now useless too.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
'dma-ranges' frequently exists without parent nodes having 'dma-ranges'.
While this is an error for 'ranges', this is fine because DMA capable
devices always have a translatable DMA address. Also, with no
'dma-ranges' at all, the assumption is that DMA addresses are 1:1 with
no restrictions unless perhaps the device itself has implicit
restrictions.
This keeps in sync with Linux kernel commit:
81db12ee15cb: of/address: Translate 'dma-ranges' for parent nodes missing 'dma-ranges'
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These boards were not converted to DM_VIDEO before deadline,
so disable video support for now.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Richard Hu <richard.hu@technexion.com>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The board was not converted to DM_VIDEO before deadline, so disable
video support for now.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Hannes Schmelzer <hannes.schmelzer@br-automation.com>
The board was not converted to DM_VIDEO before deadline, so disable
video support for now.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Make it possible to invoke rescue boot from U-Boot console, without
having to press the factory reset button. This is needed when accessing
the device remotely, for example.
Achieve this by putting rescue command into `bootcmd_rescue` default
environment variable and setting some distroboot environment variables
to their default values when the factory button is pressed.
Rescue boot from console can be invoked by running
run bootcmd_rescue
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Update rescue mode boot command on Turris Omnia. We are compressing the
image with lzma now.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The `ranges` DT property of the PCIe node is currently ignored by
Aardvark driver - all entries are used as transparent PCIe MEM, despite
some of them being defined for IO in DT.
This is because the driver does not setup PCIe outbound windows and thus
a default configuration is used.
This can cause an external abort on CPU when a device driver tries to
access non-MEM space.
Setup the PCIe windows according to the `ranges` property for all
non-MEM resources (currently only IO) and also non-transparent MEM
resources.
Because Linux expects that bootloader does not setup Aardvark PCIe
windows, disable them before booting Linux.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For some configurations with more PCIe cards and PCIe bridges, 16 MiB of
PCIe MEM space may not be enough. Since TF-A already allocates a 128 MiB
CPU window for PCIe, and since IO port space is only 64 KiB in total,
use all the remaining space (64 + 32 + 16 + 8 + 4 + 2 + 1 = 127 MiB) for
PCIe MEM.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Current version of this function uses a lot of incorrect assumptions about
the `ranges` DT property:
* parent(#address-cells) == 2
* #size-cells == 2
* number of entries == 2
* address size of first entry == 0x1000000
* second child address entry == base + 0x1000000
Trying to increase PCIe MEM space to more than 16 MiB leads to an overlap
with PCIe IO space, and trying to define additional MEM space (as a third
entry in the `ranges` DT property) causes U-Boot to crash when booting the
kernel.
## Flattened Device Tree blob at 04f00000
Booting using the fdt blob at 0x4f00000
Loading Device Tree to 000000001fb01000, end 000000001fb08f12 ... OK
ERROR: board-specific fdt fixup failed: <unknown error>
- must RESET the board to recover.
Fix a3700_fdt_fix_pcie_regions() to properly parse and update all addresses
in the `ranges` property according to
https://elinux.org/Device_Tree_Usage#PCI_Address_Translation
Now it is possible to increase PCIe MEM space from 16 MiB to maximal value
of 127 MiB.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Fixes: cb2ddb291e ("arm64: mvebu: a37xx: add device-tree fixer for PCIe regions")
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Find PCIe DT node by compatible string instead of retrieving it by using
hardcoded DT path.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Change DT compatible string for A3700 PCIe from 'marvell,armada-37xx-pcie'
to 'marvell,armada-3700-pcie' to make U-Boot A3700 PCIe DT node compatible
with Linux' DT node.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Disable Root Bridge I/O space, memory space and bus mastering in Aardvark's
remove method, which is called before booting Linux kernel.
This ensures that PCIe device which was initialized and used by U-Boot
cannot do new DMA transfers until Linux initializes PCI subsystem and loads
appropriate drivers for the device.
During initialization of PCI subsystem Linux in fact disables this bus
mastering on Root Bridge (and later enables it when driver is loaded and
configured), but there is a possibility of a small window after U-Boot
boots Linux when bus mastering is enabled, which is not correct.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
During our debugging of the Aardvark driver in Linux we have discovered
that the PCIE_CORE_LINK_CTRL_STAT_REG register in fact controls standard
PCIe Link Control Register for PCIe Root Bridge. This led us to discover
that the name of the PCIE_CORE_LINK_TRAINING macro and the corresponding
comment by this macro's usage is misleading; this bit in fact controls
Retrain Link, which, according to PCIe base spec is defined as:
A write of 1b to this bit initiates Link retraining by directing the
Physical Layer LTSSM to the Recovery state. If the LTSSM is already in
Recovery or Configuration, re-entering Recovery is permitted but not
required.
Entering Recovery state is normally done from LTSSM L0, L0s and L1 states.
But since the pci-aardvark.c driver enables Link Training just a few lines
above, the controller is not in L0 ready state yet. So setting aardvark bit
PCIE_CORE_LINK_TRAINING does not actually enter Recovery state at this
place.
Moreover, trying to enter LTSSM Recovery state without other configuration
is causing issues for some cards (e.g. Atheros AR9xxx and QCA9xxx). Since
Recovery state is not entered, these issues are not triggered.
Remove code which tries to enter LTSSM Recovery state completely.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add default bootarguments with booting from mmc0 for this configuration.
This will allow a default Linux boot for this board.
Suggested-by: Jarvis Chen <jarvis.chen@microchip.com>
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
If a chunk was larger than 4GiB, then chunk_data_sz would overflow and
blkcnt would not be calculated correctly. Upgrade it to a u64 and cast
its multiplicands as well. Also fix bytes_written while we're at it.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This contains the fix to bring back the SD card as MMC0. In the long run
we are looking into a more robust solution, but for now we need to fix
this, as this breaks the user experience left, right, and centre.
Also add the one MAINTAINERS path addition from Samuel.
Fix compilation error when Werror is turned on. The warning could
possible break some CI builds.
Signed-off-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Add dts support for fu740. The HiFive Unmatched support is based on
fu740 cpu and drivers in following patch set.
Signed-off-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
[greentime.hu: set fu740 speed to 1.2GHz]
Signed-off-by: Greentime Hu <greentime.hu@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Add pcie driver for SiFive fu740, the driver depends on
fu740 gpio, clk and reset driver to do init. Force running at Gen1
for better capatible enumeration.
Several devices are tested:
a) M.2 NVMe SSD
b) USB-to-PCI adapter
c) Ethernet adapter (E1000 compatible)
Signed-off-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
These drivers are sunxi platform-specific, and so are of interest to the
sunxi maintainers.
In fact, as there is no PHY driver maintainer, drivers/phy/allwinner had
no maintainer at all.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Commit 2243d19e56 ("mmc: mmc-uclass: Use dev_seq() to read aliases
node's index") now actually enforces U-Boot's device enumeration policy,
where explicitly named devices come first, then any other non-named
devices follow, without filling gaps.
For quite a while we have had an "mmc1 = &mmc2;" alias in our
sunxi-u-boot.dtsi, which now leads to the problem that the SD card
(which was always mmc device 0) now gets to be number 2.
This breaks quite some boot scripts, including our own distro boot
commands, and some other features looking at $mmc_bootdev, also
fastboot.
Just add an explicit mmc0 alias in the very same file to fix this and
restore the old behaviour.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reported-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Tested-by: Simon Baatz <gmbnomis@gmail.com>
"TCG PC Client Platform Firmware Profile Specification"
requires to measure every attempt to load and execute
a OS Loader(a UEFI application) into PCR[4].
This commit adds the PE/COFF image measurement, extends PCR,
and appends measurement into Event Log.
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Replace CONFIG_HASH_CALCULATE by CONFIG_HASH
Fix conversions between pointers and u64.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The hash_calculate() symbol is provided by hash-checksum.c. It depends
on hash_progressive_lookup_algo(), provided when CONFIG_HASH=y.
The issue is that hash_calculate() is used by the efi_loader,
irregardless of CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE. As pointed out in
commit 87316da05f ("lib: introduce HASH_CALCULATE option"),
enabling hash_calculate() based on CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is incorrect.
To resolve this, use CONFIG_HASH as the compile switch for
hash-checksum.c. This ensures that all dependencies are compiled, and
is the most natural Kconfig to use.
There is the issue of having to 'select HASH' in a couple of places
that already 'select SHA256'. This is a deeper problem with how hashes
are organized, and fixing it is beyonf the scope of this change.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
When we think of Kconfig, we usually think of features that we like
to enable or not. Ideally, we wouldn't use Kconfig to fix a build
issue, although sometimes it might make sense. With Kconfig it's hard
to guarantee that the fix is universal. We can only say that it works
for the set of tested configurations. In the majority of cases, it's
preferable to let the linker figure things out for us.
The reverted commit attempted to fix a build issue by adding an
invisible Kconfig option. This is wrong in several ways:
It invents a new Kconfig variable when CONFIG_HASH already
exists for the same purpose.
Second, hash-checksum.c makes use of the hash_progressive_lookup_algo()
symbol, which is only provided with CONFIG_HASH, but this dependency
was not expressed in the reverted patch.
It feels like Kconfig is turning into a listing of all available
source files, and a buffet to 'select' which ones to compile. The
purpose of this revert is to enable the next change to make use of
CONFIG_HASH instead of adding to Kconfig.
This reverts commit 87316da05f.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Coverity reported 3 warnings on the current code.
CID 331856, 331855, 331854 on the latest scan.
Fix the rest of the warnings by initializing the variables before
passing them to tpm2_get_pcr_info().
In order to avoid future warnings and errors initialize them to 0 within
the function as well, since the values are always OR'ed after querying the
hardware.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Enable the true random number generator. It can be used, for example, to
generate partition UUIDs when partitioning with the gpt command. The
generator is already enabled in the device trees of several other
STM32MP1‐based boards, like DKx or DHCOM.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Szymaszek <gszymaszek@short.pl>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The CMD_UNZIP provides the 'gzwrite' command, which is convenient
for writing e.g. gz-compressed images to eMMC from U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Currently the code sets eth1addr only if /ethernet1 alias exists in DT,
the node pointed to by the alias has "micrel,ks8851-mll" compatible
string, and the KSZ8851 CCR register read indicates programmed EEPROM
is not connected.
This is not sufficient to detect cases where the DT still contains the
KSZ8851 nodes, but the chip itself is not present. Extend the detection
to handle these cases.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
BITS_PER_LONG is used to represent register's size which is 32.
But when compiled on arch64, BITS_PER_LONG is then equal to 64.
Fix bank and offset computation to make it work on arch32 and
arch64 and ensure that register's size is always equal to 32.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Pankaj Dev <pankaj.dev@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Fix the result of DFU_OP_WRITE operation in mtd_block_op function
when mtd_lock is not supported (-EOPNOTSUPP) to avoid DFU stack
error on the DFU manifestation of the MTD device, when
dfu_flush_medium_mtd is called.
Without this patch, dfu-util failed on dfuERROR state at the end
of the write operation on the alternate even if MTD write
opeartion is correctly performed.
$> dfu-util -a 3 -D test.bin
....
DFU mode device DFU version 0110
Device returned transfer size 4096
Copying data from PC to DFU device
....
Download [=========================] 100% 225469 bytes
Download done.
state(10) = dfuERROR, status(14) = Something went wrong,
but the device does not know what it was Done!
Fixes: 65f3fc18fc ("dfu_mtd: Add provision to unlock mtd device")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
The AM64x SoC uses a central Device Management and Security Controller
(DMSC) processor that manages all the low-level device controls
including the system-wide SoC reset. The system-wide reset is managed
through the system reset driver.
Add a sysreset controller node as a child of the dmsc node to enable
the "reset" command from U-Boot prompt for the K3 AM642 SK.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
The AM64x SoC uses a central Device Management and Security Controller
(DMSC) processor that manages all the low-level device controls
including the system-wide SoC reset. The system-wide reset is managed
through the system reset driver.
Add a sysreset controller node as a child of the dmsc node to enable
the "reset" command from U-Boot prompt for the K3 AM642 EVM.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
The ti_sci_msg_req_reboot message payload has been extended to include a
domain field, but for the purposes of u-boot this should be zero to
reset the entire SoC as it did before. Include domain for completeness
and set to zero to ensure proper operation.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
The default U-Boot environment variables and design are all set up for
both the MAIN R5FSS clusters to be in Split-mode. This is the setting
in v2021.01 U-Boot and the dt nodes are synched with the kernel binding
property names in commit 468ec2f3ef ("remoteproc: k3_r5: Sync to
upstreamed kernel DT property names") merged in v2021.04-rc2.
The modes for both the clusters got switched back to LockStep mode by
mistake in commit 70e167495a ("arm: dts: k3-j721e: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6
dts into U-Boot") also in v2021.04-rc2. This throws the following warning
messages when early-booting the cores using default env variables,
k3_r5f_rproc r5f at 5d00000: Invalid op: Trying to start secondary core 7 in lockstep mode
Load Remote Processor 3 with data at addr=0x82000000 98484 bytes: Failed!
k3_r5f_rproc r5f at 5f00000: Invalid op: Trying to start secondary core 9 in lockstep mode
Load Remote Processor 5 with data at addr=0x82000000 98484 bytes: Failed!
Fix this by switching back both the clusters to the expected Split-mode.
Make this mode change in the u-boot specific dtsi file to avoid such
sync overrides in the future until the kernel dts is also switched to
Split-mode by default.
Fixes: 70e167495a ("arm: dts: k3-j721e: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Reported-by: Minas Hambardzumyan <minas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
AM64x GP and SK EVM have DP83867 PHY connected to CPSW external port0.
Enable the driver in order to use ethernet at U-Boot prompt.
CONFIG_PHY_TI is selected by CONFIG_PHY_TI_DP83867 and thus can be dropped.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
ut_asserteq_strn is defined twice. Remove one definition.
Fixes: 33d7edfd5f ("test: Add a way to check part of a console line or skip it")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Commit 712cc962b7 ("GitLab: Remove "tags" stanzas") removed the 'all'
tag from all the jobs. The sandbox_noinst_test.py test was added in
between the author date and commit date (commit 6c914e4232
("azure/gitlab: Add tests for sandbox_noinst")) which is probably why it
still contains the tags. This commit fixes that so all jobs now don't
require tags on the GitLab runners.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Commit 1ba21bb06b ("test: Don't unmount not (yet) mounted system")
fixes an issue in the filesystem tests where the test setup may fail
to mount an image and still attempt to unmount it. However, the commit
unintentionally breaks the test setups in two ways.
The newly created unmounted filesystem images are being immediately
deleted due to some cleanup steps being misplaced into finally blocks,
which makes them always run instead of only on failures. The mount calls
always fail since the images never exist, causing the tests to be always
skipped. This patch moves these cleanup calls into the except blocks to
fix this and makes the tests run again.
There are also unmount calls misplaced into finally blocks, making them
run after the tests instead of before the tests. These unmount calls
make the filesystem image file consistent with the changes made to it as
part of the test setup, and this misplacement is making a number of
tests fail unexpectedly.
The unmount calls must be run before the tests use the image, meaning
before the yield call and not in the finally block. They must also be
run as a cleanup step when the filesystem setup fails, so they can't be
placed as the final call in the try blocks since they would be skipped
on such failures. For these reasons, this patch places the unmount calls
both in the except blocks and the else blocks of the final setup step.
This makes the unexpectedly failing tests to succeed again.
Furthermore, this isolates the mount calls to their own try-except
statement to avoid reintroducing the original issue of unmounting a
not-mounted image while fixing the unmount misplacement.
After these fixes, running "make tests" with guestmount available results
in two test failures not related to the mentioned commit. If the
guestmount executables are unavailable, the mounts fallback to using
sudo and result in no failures.
Fixes: 1ba21bb06b ("test: Don't unmount not (yet) mounted system")
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
A lot of entries were using spaces instead of tab for alignment that's why
it is good to fix it to use the same style everywhere.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The superblock buffer must be cache aligned, since it might be used
in DMA context, allocate it using ALLOC_CACHE_ALIGN_BUFFER() just
like it was done in btrfs_read_superblock() and read_tree_node().
This fixes this output on boot and non-working btrfs on iMX53:
CACHE: Misaligned operation at range [ced299d0, ced2a9d0]
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
When reading directories the UEFI sub-system must supply file attributes
and timestamps. These fields will have to be added to struct fs_dirent.
SquashFS should not fill these fields with random data. Ensure that they
are zeroed out.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
The assembly output of the arch_initr_trap() function differed by a
single byte after common.h was removed from traps.c:
fff49a18 <arch_initr_trap>:
fff49a18: 94 21 ff f0 stwu r1,-16(r1)
fff49a1c: 7c 08 02 a6 mflr r0
fff49a20: 90 01 00 14 stw r0,20(r1)
-fff49a24: 80 62 00 44 lwz r3,68(r2)
+fff49a24: 80 62 00 38 lwz r3,56(r2)
fff49a28: 4b ff 76 19 bl fff41040 <trap_init>
fff49a2c: 80 01 00 14 lwz r0,20(r1)
fff49a30: 38 60 00 00 li r3,0
fff49a34: 38 21 00 10 addi r1,r1,16
fff49a38: 7c 08 03 a6 mtlr r0
This was causing a consistent hard lockup during the MMC read / loading
of the QoriQ FMan firmware on a P2041RDB board.
Re-adding the header causes identical assembly to be emitted and allows
the firmware loading and subsequent boot to succeed.
Fixes: 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header")
Signed-off-by: Matt Merhar <mattmerhar@protonmail.com>
Some callers (e.g. cmd/fs.c) of fs_set_blk_dev may use a NULL dev_part_str.
While blk_get_device_part_str handles this fine,
part_get_info_by_dev_and_name does not. This fixes commands crashing when
implicitly using bootdevice.
The unit test has also been updated to set bootdevice to a known value and
to restore it after we are done.
Fixes: 7194527b6a ("cmd: fs: Use part_get_info_by_dev_and_name_or_num to parse partitions")
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If reg property of pinctrl-single node requires address translation then
probe fails with following message:
single-pinctrl pinctrl@4301c000: failed to get base register size
This is because driver uses dev_read_addr_size() to get size which also
tries to fetch untranslated addr and fails.
Fix this by using dev_read_addr_size_index() which takes care of address
translation and also makes following dev_read_addr() call redundant.
This fixes Ethernet failures on TI's AM654 based EVMs due to lack of
pinmux configuration.
Fixes: 9fd8a430f3 ("pinctrl: single: get register area size by device API")
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Remove qemu_mips boards because DM migration doesn't make sense.
The board support for qemu_mips is already marked as deprecated
in Qemu in favour of the Malta board. Also qemu_mips support
has been removed from Linux a long time ago.
The official replacement is the Malta board. The same Malta U-Boot
image can be used with Qemu and on physical hardware.
All combinations of Big Endian and Little Endian as well as 32 bit
and 64 bit are supported.
Signed-off-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Compiling with -Wextra produces a number of (harmless) warnings for the EFI
TCG2 protocol. Let's fix those in case we ever enable the flag on the EFI
subsystem
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Use efi_get_variable_int() instead of EFI_CALL(RT->get_variable()).
Use efi_set_variable_int() instead of EFI_CALL(efi_set_variable()).
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Tested-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Simplify the creation of indexed variable names like 'Boot0000' by using
function efi_create_indexed_name().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
To print a UTF-16 string use %ls instead of converting string to UTF-8.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
To print a UTF-16 string use %ls instead of converting string to UTF-8.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Before this patch efi_dp_from_name() only accommodated a maximum file path
length of 31 characters. This leads to boot failures due to file name
truncation.
Allow arbitrary path lengths.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This is preparation for PE/COFF measurement support.
PE/COFF image hash calculation is same in both
UEFI Secure Boot image verification and measurement in
measured boot. PE/COFF image parsing functions are
gathered into efi_image_loader.c, and exposed even if
UEFI Secure Boot is not enabled.
This commit also adds the EFI_SIGNATURE_SUPPORT option
to decide if efi_signature.c shall be compiled.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Configuring a system with CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_AUTHENTICATE=y but without a
method to retrieve the public key data is a misconfiguration. We should get
a build failure for it. Therefore remove the weak efi_get_public_key_data()
implementation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Add LTO (link time optimization) support to the build system and
enable it on a few boards. This is an alternative to using
-ffunction-sections/-fdata-sections and --gc-sections at link time to
remove unused code. This can result in notable savings, but needs
testing on each platform before use as it can expose problems by
optimizing away various functionally necessary calls.
With better compiler optimizations available, a compiler may see we do
nothing with our buffer after calling memset and omit the call, thus
causing us to not smash the stack. Add a comment to explain why we now
also have a printf call, so that the test will pass as the memset will
not be omitted.
Reported-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When using LTO, we can throw away the --gc-sections flag, but only if
using private libgcc.
When using system's libgcc, --gc-sections is still needed, otherwise
linking will fail due to undefined references to libc's symbols.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When building with LTO, using -ffunction-sections/-fdata-sections is not
useful anymore.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When building highbank_defconfig with LTO, the compiler complains about
type mismatch of function ahci_link_up().
The third parameter of this function is of type u8 in
drivers/ata/ahci.c, but of type int in board/highbank/ahci.c.
There is no reason in using u8, and the code using this function
actually passes an int variable into the function (so it is implicitly
converted to u8).
Change the type of this parameter to int in drivers/ata/ahci.c.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
For some reason when building SPL for ARMv8 with LTO, the relocation
information is not discarded.
Discard it explicitly in the linker script.
This fixes LTO build for imx8mm_venice_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Adam Ford says that DM3730 needs board.c compiled without LTO flags.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
When building with LTO, the compiler complains about type mismatch of
function usb_gadget_handle_interrupts(). This function is defined
without parameters in files
arch/arm/mach-rockchip/board.c
board/samsung/common/exynos5-dt.c
but it should have one parameter, int index.
Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
When seaboard_defconfig is compiled with LTO, the compiler complains
about some instructions not being supported in ARM mode.
This is caused by arch/arm/mach-tegra/tegra20/warmboot_avp.c having
different CFLAGS declared in Makefile. This file needs to be compiled
without LTO.
Fix this by removing -flto for this file.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When building imx8mp_evk_defconfig with LTO, the compiler complains
about type mismatch of function imx_eqos_txclk_set_rate() in file
drivers/net/dwc_eth_qos.c:845:12
which contains a weak definition of this function, vs file
arch/arm/mach-imx/imx8m/clock_imx8mm.c
which contains an implementation.
Change the type of this function in the implementation to fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When building with LTO, the compiler complains about type mismatch of
function clk_bsc_enable() in file:
arch/arm/cpu/armv7/kona-common/clk-stubs.c
vs other files that define or use this function:
warning: type of ‘clk_bsc_enable’ does not match original declaration.
Change the type of this function to that of the other usages.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When building keystone with LTO the compiler complains:
Error: selected processor does not support `smc #0' in Thumb mode
Fix this by removing -flto for the file implementing these SMC calls.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
When apf27_defconfig is built with LTO, linking complains about
undefined reference to `nand_boot`. This is because it is referenced
from inline assembly. Make it visible.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
When imx28_xea_defconfig is built with LTO, the compiler complains about
the two different declarations of _start:
include/asm-generic/sections.h as extern void _start(void);
arch/arm/cpu/arm926ejs/mxs/mxs.c as extern uint32_t _start;
Fix this.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Fix LTO build for some thumb-interwork usecases (such as for
da850evm_defconfig), where inline assmebly such as
mrc p15,0,r2,c1,c0,0
causes the compiler to fail during LTO linking with
Error: selected processor does not support `mrc p15,0,r2,c1,c0,0'
in Thumb mode
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On ARM, the gd pointer is stored in registers r9 / x18. For this the
-ffixed-r9 / -ffixed-x18 flag is used when compiling, but using global
register variables causes errors when building with LTO, and these
errors are very difficult to overcome.
Richard Biener says [1]:
Note that global register vars shouldn't be used with LTO and if they
are restricted to just a few compilation units the recommended fix is
to build those CUs without -flto.
We cannot do this for U-Boot since all CUs use -ffixed-reg flag.
It seems that with LTO we could in fact store the gd pointer differently
and gain performance or size benefit by allowing the compiler to use
r9 / x18. But this would need more work.
So for now, when building with LTO, go the clang way, and instead of
declaring gd a global register variable, we make it a function call via
macro.
[1] https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=68384
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Thumb instruction `ldr` is able to move high registers only from
armv7. For armv5 and armv6 we have to use `mov`.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In style of linked lists, instead of declaring symbols for boundaries
of getopt options array in the linker script, declare corresponding
sections and retrieve the boundaries via static inline functions.
Without this clang's LTO produces binary without any getopt options,
because for some reason it thinks that array is empty (start and end
symbols are at the same address).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When building with LTO, the system libc's `errno` variable used in
arch/sandbox/cpu/os.c conflicts with U-Boot's `errno` (defined in
lib/errno.c) with the following error:
.../ld: errno@@GLIBC_PRIVATE: TLS definition in /lib64/libc.so.6
section .tbss mismatches non-TLS reference in
/tmp/u-boot.EQlEXz.ltrans0.ltrans.o
To avoid this conflict use different asm label for this variable when
CONFIG_SANDBOX is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some toolchains are compiled so that they pass a --build-id=something
parameter to the linker implicitly.
This causes U-Boot LTO linking to fail with something like:
ld: section .note.gnu.build-id LMA ... overlaps section .text LMA ...
because U-Boot's link scripts do not currently handle .note.gnu.build-id
section.
Fix this by explicitly disabling build-id.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add plumbing for building U-Boot with Link Time Optimizations.
When building with LTO, $(PLATFORM_LIBS) has to be in --whole-archive /
--no-whole-archive group, otherwise some functions declared in assembly
may not be resolved and linking may fail.
Note: clang may throw away linker list symbols it thinks are unused when
compiling with LTO. To force these symbols to be included, we refer to
them via the __ADDRESSABLE macro in a C file generated from compiled
built-in.o files before linking.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently we use incremental linking (ld -r) to link several object
files from one directory into one built-in.o object file containing the
linked code from that directory (and its subdirectories).
Linux has, some time ago, moved to thin archives instead.
Thin archives are archives (.a) that do not really contain the object
files, only references to them.
Using thin archives instead of incremental linking
- saves disk space
- apparently works better with dead code elimination
- makes things easier for LTO
The third point is the important one for us. With incremental linking
there are several options how to do LTO, and that would unnecessarily
complicate things.
We have to use the --whole-archive/--no-whole-archive linking option
instead of --start-group/--end-group, otherwise linking may fail because
of unresolved symbols, or the resulting binary will be unusable.
We also need to use the P flag for ar, otherwise final linking may fail.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Indent the linking commands so that they look cosmetically better.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When compiling with LTO, the compiler fails with an error saying that
`crc_table` causes a section type conflict with `efi_var_buf`.
This is because both are declared to be in the same section (via macro
`__efi_runtime_data`), but one is const while the other is not.
Put this variable into the section .rodata.efi_runtime, instead of
.data.efi_runtime, via macro __efi_runtime_rodata.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.gpk@gmx.de>
Add $(CFLAGS_EFI) and remove $(CFLAGS_NON_EFI) for
efi_selftest_miniapp_exception.o.
The removal is needed when compiling with LTO - this object file needs
to be compiled without -flto.
The adding is for consistency with other miniapps.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add macro __efi_runtime_rodata, for const variables with similar purpose
as those using __efi_runtime_data.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Document the macros __efi_runtime and __efi_runtime_data in Sphinx
style.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When linking with LTO, the compiler complains about type mismatch of
variables `__efi_runtime_start`, `__efi_runtime_stop`,
`__efi_runtime_rel_start` and `__efi_runtime_rel_stop`:
include/efi_loader.h:218:21: warning: type of ‘__efi_runtime_start’
does not match original
declaration [-Wlto-type-mismatch]
218 | extern unsigned int __efi_runtime_start, __efi_runtime_stop;
| ^
arch/sandbox/lib/sections.c:7:6: note: ‘__efi_runtime_start’ was
previously declared here
7 | char __efi_runtime_start[0] __attribute__((section(".__efi_run
| ^
Change the type to char[] in include/efi_loader.h.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It seems that sometimes (happening on ARM64, for example with
turris_mox_defconfig) GCC, when linking with LTO, changes the symbol
names of some functions, for example lib/string.c's memcpy() function to
memcpy.isra.0.
This is a problem however when GCC for a code such as this:
struct some_struct *info = get_some_struct();
struct some struct tmpinfo;
tmpinfo = *info;
emits a call to memcpy() by builtin behaviour, to copy *info to tmpinfo.
This then results in the following linking error:
.../lz4.c:93: undefined reference to `memcpy'
.../uuid.c:206: more undefined references to `memcpy' follow
GCC's documentation says this about -nodefaultlibs option:
The compiler may generate calls to "memcmp", "memset", "memcpy" and
"memmove". These entries are usually resolved by entries in libc.
These entry points should be supplied through some other mechanism
when this option is specified.
Make these functions visible by using the __used macro to avoid this
error.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Improve the regular expression that matches unittest symbols in
u-boot.sym.
Currently we do not enforce no prefix in symbol string, but with the
soon to come change in linker lists declaring lists and entries with the
__ADDRESSABLE macro (because of LTO), the symbol file will contain for
every symbol of the form
_u_boot_list_2_ut_X_2_Y
also symbol
__UNIQUE_ID___addressable__u_boot_list_2_ut_X_2_YN,
(where N at the end is some number).
In order to avoid matching these additional symbols, ensure that the
character before "_u_boot_list_2_ut" is not a symbol name character.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit does the same thing as Linux commit 33def8498fdd.
Use a more generic form for __section that requires quotes to avoid
complications with clang and gcc differences.
Remove the quote operator # from compiler_attributes.h __section macro.
Convert all unquoted __section(foo) uses to quoted __section("foo").
Also convert __attribute__((section("foo"))) uses to __section("foo")
even if the __attribute__ has multiple list entry forms.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is how Linux does this now, see Linux commit 339f29d91acf.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is a serious bug in regmap_read() and regmap_write() functions
where an uint pointer is cast to (void *) which is then cast to (u8 *),
(u16 *), (u32 *) or (u64 *), depending on register width of the map.
For example given a regmap with 16-bit register width the code
int val = 0x12340000;
regmap_read(map, 0, &val);
only changes the lower 16 bits of val on little-endian machines.
The upper 16 bits will remain 0x1234.
Nobody noticed this probably because this bug can be triggered with
regmap_write() only on big-endian architectures (which are not used by
many people anymore), and on little endian this bug has consequences
only if register width is 8 or 16 bits and also the memory place to
which regmap_read() should store it's result has non-zero upper bits,
which it seems doesn't happen anywhere in U-Boot normally. CI managed to
trigger this bug in unit test of dm_test_devm_regmap_field when compiled
for sandbox_defconfig using LTO.
Fix this by utilizing an union { u8; u16; u32; u64; } and reading data
into this union / writing data from this union.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
There is no good reason to use a sequence from rand() here. We may as well
invent our own sequence.
This should molify Coverity which does not use rand() being used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312949)
Clang has -Wself-assign enabled by default under -Wall and so when
building with -Werror we would get an error here. Inspired by Linux
kernel git commit a21151b9d81a ("tools/build: tweak unused value
workaround") make use of the fact that both Clang and GCC support
casting to `void` as the method to note that something is intentionally
unused.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Increase the BOOTM_LEN to 32M . This would allow a bigger kernel image to be
booted, for example the multi_v7_defconfig.
Loading Kernel Image
Image too large: increase CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN
Must RESET board to recover
resetting ...
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The V3U SoC has several unlock registers, one per register group. They
reside at offset zero in each 0x200 bytes-sized block.
To avoid adding yet another table to the PFC implementation, this
patch adds the option to specify an address mask instead of the fixed
address in sh_pfc_soc_info::unlock_reg.
This is a direct port of Linux 5.12 commit e127ef2ed0a6
("pinctrl: renesas: Implement unlock register masks") by
Ulrich Hecht <uli+renesas@fpond.eu>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The help text for Gen2 entries had a copy paste error, still containing
the Gen3 string, while the description was correctly listing Gen2. Fix
the help text.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The help text in the Kconfig file was always a copy of the same thing.
Move single copy into the common PFC driver entry instead. Also fix a
copy-paste error in the PFC help text, which identified PFC as clock.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Pass struct udevice to rcar_gpio_set_direction() in preparation of
quirk handling in rcar_gpio_set_direction(). No functional change.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Most of the PLLx, MAIN, FIXED clock handlers are calling very similar
code, which determines parent rate and then applies multiplication and
division. The only difference is whether multiplication is fixed factor
or coming from CRx register. Deduplicate the code into a single function.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Base on Linux v5.10-rc2, commit 8b652aa8a1fb by Yoshihiro Shimoda
To support other register layouts in the future, add register pointers
of {control,status,reset,reset_clear}_regs into struct cpg_mssr_info
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
From Linux v5.10-rc2, commit ffbf9cf3f946 by Yoshihiro Shimoda
Introduce enum clk_reg_layout to support multiple register layout variants
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
CPG IP in some specific Renesas SoCs (i.e. new R8A779A0 V3U SoC)
requires a different setting procedure. Make struct cpg_mssr_info
accessible to handle the clock setting in that case.
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The MODEMR register offset changed on R8A779A0, make the MODEMR offset
configurable. Fill the offset in on all clock drivers. No functional
change.
Based off "clk: renesas: Make CPG Reset MODEMR offset accessible from
struct cpg_mssr_info" by Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
This supports RPCD2 clock handling. While at it, add the check point
for RPC-IF clock RPCD2 Frequency Division Ratio, since it must be odd
number
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
This patch fixes Realtime Module Stop Control Register (RMSTPCR) offsets
based on R-Car Gen3, H2/M2/M2N/E2/E2X hardware user's manual.
The r8a73a4 only has RMSTPCR0 - RMSTPCR5 so this calculation change
doesn't affect it.
Signed-off-by: Hai Pham <hai.pham.ud@renesas.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Reinstate RPC clock on D3/E3 after Linux 5.12 synchronization.
The D3 and E3 clock drivers do not contain RPC clock entries
mainline Linux yet.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
With commit 8678776df6 (arm: mvebu: armada-3720-uDPU: fix PHY mode
definition to sgmii-2500) the PHY mode was switch to "sgmii-2500", even
when this is functionally incorrect since "2500base-x" was not supported
in U-Boot at that time. As this mode is now supported (at least present
in the headers), this patch moves back to the orinal version.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Jakov Petrina <jakov.petrina@sartura.hr>
Cc: Vladimir Vid <vladimir.vid@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Until now the mvpp2 driver used an extra 'phy-speed'
DT property in order to differentiate between the
SGMII and SGMII @2.5GHz. As there is a dedicated
PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_SGMII_2500 flag to mark the latter
start using it and drop the custom flag.
Signed-off-by: Marcin Wojtas <mw@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Chulski <stefanc@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Nadav Haklai <nadavh@marvell.com>
Tested-by: Nadav Haklai <nadavh@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Currently, there are 2 valid cases for interface, PHY
and mdio relation:
- If an interface has PHY handler, it'll call
mdio_mii_bus_get_from_phy(), which will register
MDIO bus.
- If we want to use fixed-link for an interface,
PHY handle is not defined in the DTS, and no
MDIO is registered.
There is a third case, for some boards (with switch),
the MDIO is used for switch configuration, but the interface
itself uses fixed link. This patch allows this option by
checking if fixed-link subnode is defined, in this case,
MDIO bus is registers, but the PHY address is set to
PHY_MAX_ADDR for this interface, so this interface will
not try to access the PHY later on.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Chulski <stefanc@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Because the mvpp2 driver now relies on the PHYLIB and
the external MDIO driver, configuring low level
SMI bus settings is redundant.
Signed-off-by: Marcin Wojtas <mw@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Chulski <stefanc@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
1. Differ between Port1 RGMII and SFI modes in Netcomplex config.
2. Remove XPCS config from SFI mode.
Port1 doesn't XPCS domain, XPCS config should be removed.
Access to Port1 XPCS can cause stall.
3. Add Port1 MPCS configurations.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Chulski <stefanc@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Xilinx changes for v2021.07-rc3
ZynqMP:
- Syncup DT with Linux kernel
- Fix mmc mini configurations via DT
- Add pinctrl/psgtr description to DTs
- Add DTs for Kria boards
- Enable RTC and Time commands
Versal:
- Fix early BSS section location
It will need larger heap size for u-boot-spl to load u-boot.itb which
be generated from binman than USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR.
Signed-off-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Now that we have switched to binman to generate u-boot.itb for all
RISC-V boards, USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR is no longer needed and can
be dropped.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new BINMAN_STANDALONE_FDT option for AE350 based SPL defconfigs,
so that binman is now used to generate u-boot.itb.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
By utilizing the newly introduced BINMAN_STANDALONE_FDT option, along
with a new dedicated device tree source file for the QEMU virt target
used for binman only, we can now use binman to generate u-boot.itb.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sort the RISC-V DTS build targets by their Kconfig target names in
alphabetical order.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For scenarios like OF_BOARD or OF_PRIOR_STAGE, no device tree blob is
provided in the U-Boot build phase hence the binman node information
is not available. In order to support such use case, a new Kconfig
option BINMAN_STANDALONE_FDT is introduced, to tell the build system
that a device tree blob containing binman node is explicitly required
when using binman to package U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Generally speaking BINMAN_FDT makes sense for OF_SEPARATE or OF_EMBED.
For the other OF_CONTROL methods, it's quite possible binman node is
not available as binman is invoked during the build phase instead of
runtime. Let's only turn it on for OF_SEPARATE or OF_EMBED by default.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present SiFive Unleashed board uses the Makefile to create the FIT,
using USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR, which is deprecated as per the Makefile
warning. Update to use binman instead.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently there are 2 binman test cases using the same 172 number.
It seems that 172_fit_fdt.dts was originally named as 170_, but
commit c0f1ebe9c1 ("binman: Allow selecting default FIT configuration")
changed its name to 172_ for no reason. Let's change it back.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Right now U-Boot is not aware about date/time that's why enable it by
default also with EFI runtime service for setting time.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
U-Boot expects to be linked to a specific hard-coded address and to
be loaded to and run from that address. CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT
config lifts that restriction & allowing the code to be loaded to
and executed from almost any address.
As we enabled CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT, CONFIG_INIT_SP_RELATIVE
is enabled by default, where it will set the early stack pointer at
runtime by adding an offset value to &_bss_start. The offset value
is taken from SYS_INIT_SP_BSS_OFFSET.
SYS_INIT_SP_BSS_OFFSET offset should be large enough so that the
early malloc region, global data (gd), and early stack should fit.
With commit d8fabcc424 ("arm64: versal: Increase SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN")
SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN is increased from 32KB to 1MB, so we need to
accommodate this space with SYS_INIT_SP_BSS_OFFSET. Hence increasing
SYS_INIT_SP_BSS_OFFSET to 1.5MB.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Acked-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The patch contains several DT files for SOM platform.
Carrier card is sck-kv (KV260) revA/B. SMK-K26 is description for starter
kit which doesn't have EMMC populated. And SM-K26 is full som with EMMC.
Files are divided in this way to make sure that SOM can be plugged to
different carrier card and all peripherals on SOM (or defined by a spec) can
be used by U-Boot. Full DT for SOM+CC can be merged together as overlays.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Mainline kernel has psgtr driver that's why it is good to add description
to DT files. Some boards are just missing description for USB3 and sata.
zc1751-dc1 and p-a2197 are also missing clock descriptions for input
clocks.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
ZynqMP pinctrl Linux driver has been merged to 5.13-rc1 kernel. Based on it
DT files can be extended by pinctrl configurations.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Probe zynqmp firmware driver by adding zynqmp firmware, power &
ipi mailbox device tree nodes for mini emmc.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Add missing xlnx,mio-bank property to sdhci node. Also add properties with
0 value to have it listed in case that files are copied to different
projects where default case doesn't need to be handled in the same way.
That's why explicitly list them too.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
I2C muxes that have the slave devices with same address are
falling into the below problem.
VCK190 system controller (SC) - zynqmp-e-a2197-00-revA.dts
I2C1 (0xff030000) -> Mux1 (@0x74) -> Channel 3 -> 0x50
I2C1 (0xff030000) -> Mux2 (@0x75) -> Channel 0 -> 0x50
1. SC accesses I2C1 - Mux1 (0x74) - Channel 3 and then
2. SC accesses I2C1 - Mux2 (0x75) - Channel 0.
Now it results in 2 slave devices with same address (0x50)
on the I2C bus, making the communication un-reliable.
When ' i2c-mux-idle-disconnect' is in DT, after '1', the Mux
channel output is disconnected, making none of the channels
available to the I2C1. So, there is no question of having the
same addressed slave (0x50) present on the bus when we are doing '2'.
Same pattern is seen in below two boards also.
ZCU208 - zynqmp-zcu208-revA.dts
ZCU216 - zynqmp-zcu216-revA.dts
Signed-off-by: Raviteja Narayanam <raviteja.narayanam@xilinx.com>
Add label to GPIO lines so the user-level applications can find any line
without knowing its physical path on System Controller on VCK190/VMK180.
These labels are describing EMIO gpio connection which depends on PL which
we normally don't describe but that's only way to go for now. Lately this
should be done out of this source code.
Signed-off-by: Saeed Nowshadi <saeed.nowshadi@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The 'silabs,skip-recall' property prevents interruption in operation of
the clock while the driver is being probed. Without this property, the
DDR DIMM clk can cause a failure during Versal's boot.
Signed-off-by: Saeed Nowshadi <saeed.nowshadi@xilinx.com>
All si570 which are used for ps reference clock generation should contain
silabs,skip-recall property not to cause break on ps clock.
On Versal boards this will cause hang on Versal cpu when it is booted at
the same time with SC.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-07-rc3
Documentation:
* add a man-page for the size command
* add man-page for extension command to index
Bug fixes:
* avoid build failure due to missing SHA512 hardware acceleration
* correct error handling in TCG2 protocol
* don't let user disable capsule authentication
* correct reading directories via UEFI API
Build error occurs when CONFIG_EFI_SECURE_BOOT or
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_AUTHENTICATE is enabled,
because hash-checksum.c is not compiled.
Since hash_calculate() implemented in hash-checksum.c can be
commonly used aside from FIT image signature verification,
this commit itroduces HASH_CALCULATE option to decide
if hash-checksum.c shall be compiled.
Signed-off-by: Masahisa Kojima <masahisa.kojima@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
EFI_TCG2 depends not only on TPMv2 but also on the underlying algorithms.
So select the missing SHA1, SHA256, SHA384 and SHA512 we currently support
Reported-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add 'default y'.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now we are stopping the EFI subsystem if a TPMv2 exists but the
protocol fails to install. Now that we've switched the config to 'default
y' the sandbox TPM fails, since it doesn't support all the required
capabilities of the protocol.
Not installing the protocol is not catastrophic. If the protocol fails
to install the PCRs will never be extended to the expected values, so
some other entity later in the boot flow will eventually figure it out
and take the necessary actions.
While at it fix a corner case were the user can see an invalid error
message when the protocol failed to install. We do have a tcg2_uninit()
which we call when the protocol installation fails. There are cases though
that this might be called before the configuration table is installed (e.g
probing the TPM for capabilities failed). In that case the user will see
"Failed to delete final events config table". So stop printing it since it's
not an actual failure , simply because the config table was never installed
in the first place.
In order to stop printing it make efi_init_event_log() and create_final_event()
cleanup themselves and only call tcg2_uninit() when the protocol installation
fails.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Instead of just failing, clean up the installed config table and
EventLog memory if logging an s-crtm event fails during the protocol
installation
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Eliminate label 'out:' by using return.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
efi_init_event_log() calls tcg2_uninit() in case of failure.
We can skip that since the function is called on efi_tcg2_register()
which also cleans up if an error occurs
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This is same issue as https://bugzilla.redhat.com/show_bug.cgi?id=1733817,
but that fix was wrongly partial reverted.
When reading a directory, EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL should be returned when
the supplied buffer is too small, so a use-case is to call
EFI_FILE_PROTOCOL.Read() with *buffer_size=0 and buffer=NULL to
obtain the needed size before doing the actual read.
So remove the check only for directory reading, file reading already
do the check by itself.
Fixes: db12f518edb0("efi_loader: implement non-blocking file services")
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefan Sørensen <stefan.sorensen@spectralink.com>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The current capsule authentication code checks if the environment
variable capsule_authentication_enabled is set, for authenticating the
capsule. This is in addition to the check for the config symbol
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_AUTHENTICATE. Remove the check for the environment
variable. The capsule will now be authenticated if the config symbol
is set.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviwed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Commit a479f103dc ("hash: Allow for SHA512 hardware implementations")
defined function definitions for hardware accelerated SHA384 and SHA512.
If CONFIG_SHA_HW_ACCEL=y, these functions are used.
We already have boards using CONFIG_SHA_HW_ACCEL=y but none implements the
new functions hw_sha384() and hw_sha512().
For implementing the EFI TCG2 protocol we need SHA384 and SHA512. The
missing hardware acceleration functions lead to build errors on boards like
peach-pi_defconfig.
Introduce a new Kconfig symbol CONFIG_SHA512_HW_ACCEL to control if the
functions hw_sha384() and hw_sha512() shall be used to implement the SHA384
and SHA512 algorithms.
Fixes: a479f103dc ("hash: Allow for SHA512 hardware implementations")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Building 32bit boards with the TCG2 protocol enabled leads to a build
warning due to a missing conversion.
lib/efi_loader/efi_tcg2.c:774:27:
error: cast to pointer from integer of different size
[-Werror=int-to-pointer-cast]
774 | ret = tcg2_create_digest((u8 *)data_to_hash, data_to_hash_len,
| ^
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
'make htmldocs' results in a build warning
checking consistency... doc/usage/extension.rst:
WARNING: document isn't included in any toctree
Add the document to the index.
Fixes: 2f84e9cf06 ("cmd: add support for a new "extension" command")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Versions of U-Boot before 2014.01 created a symlink from include/asm to
the architecture-specific header directory.
If an ARM board is build with that old version, then sandbox is built on
a more recent version (both with in-tree builds), the include/asm symlink
confuses the build system. It picks up the ARM headers when it should be
using the sandbox ones.
Since 2014 U-Boot has only created a symlink inside the include/asm/
directory and only for out-of-tree builds. So for in-tree builds it does
not expect to see an include/asm symlink. It is not removed by
'make mrproper'. It does show up with 'git status' but is easy enough to
miss.
Add include/asm to the files to remove with 'make mkproper'. For recent
U-Boot builds this has no effect, since include/asm is a directory, not a
file. If the include/asm symlink is there, it will be removed.
Reported-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
s/psci_features/request_psci_features/g for the case when both
ARCH_SUPPORT_PSCI=y and ARM_PSCI_FW=y, that leads to these
compilation issues:
drivers/firmware/psci.c:69:12: error: conflicting types for 'psci_features'
69 | static int psci_features(u32 psci_func_id)
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~
In file included from drivers/firmware/psci.c:23:
./arch/arm/include/asm/system.h:548:5: note: previous declaration of 'psci_features' was here
548 | s32 psci_features(u32 function_id, u32 psci_fid);
| ^~~~~~~~~~~~~
Tested-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Fixes: b7135b034f ("psci: add features/reset2 support")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Python3 taken from the PATH causes build issues when pylibfdt bindings are
generated with Yocto SDK.
Python3 provided as a part of SDK is not compatible with host Python3,
therefore binding build breaks with following errors:
scripts/dtc/pylibfdt/libfdt_wrap.c:154:11: fatal error: Python.h: No such file or directory
154 | # include <Python.h>
| ^~~~~~~~~~
Do not enforce the python3 from the PATH and make it conditionally-assigned
so it can be overridden from outside of build system. Keep the default
assignment to point to version that is taken from the PATH.
Similar fix has been introduced in b48bfc74ee ("tools: allow to override
python"), where conditional assignment is used for python executable to
address similar build errors.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: e91610da7c ("kconfig: re-sync with Linux 4.17-rc4")
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Add base support for Marvell OcteonTX2 CN9130 DB (mostly done
by Kostya)
- Sync Armada 8k MMU setup with Marvell version (misc Marvell
authors)
- spi: kirkwood: Some fixes especially for baudrate generation
(misc Marvell authors)
- mvebu: x530: Reduce SPL image size (Stefan)
- Rename "rx_training" to "mvebu_comphy_rx_training" (Stefan)
Currently all assembly optimized implementation of memory routines
show up at the top level of the RISC-V architecture Kconfig menu.
Let's group them together into a submenu.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present U-Boot SPL fails to boot on SiFive Unleashed board, due
to a load address misaligned exception happens when loading the FIT
image in spl_load_simple_fit(). The exception happens in memmove()
which is called by fdt_splice_().
Commit 8f0dc4cfd1 introduces an assembly version of memmove but
it does take misalignment into account (it checks if length is a
multiple of machine word size but pointers need also be aligned).
As a result it will generate misaligned load/store for the majority
of cases and causes significant performance regression on hardware
that traps misaligned load/store and emulate them using firmware.
The current behaviour of memcpy is that it checks if both src and
dest pointers are co-aligned (aka congruent modular SZ_REG). If
aligned, it will copy data word-by-word after first aligning
pointers to word boundary. If src and dst are not co-aligned,
however, byte-wise copy will be performed.
This patch was taken from the Linux kernel patch [1], which has not
been applied at the time being. It fixes the memmove and optimises
memcpy for misaligned cases. It will first align destination pointer
to word-boundary regardless whether src and dest are co-aligned or
not. If they indeed are, then wordwise copy is performed. If they
are not co-aligned, then it will load two adjacent words from src
and use shifts to assemble a full machine word. Some additional
assembly level micro-optimisation is also performed to ensure more
instructions can be compressed (e.g. prefer a0 to t6).
With this patch, U-Boot boots again on SiFive Unleashed board.
[1] https://patchwork.kernel.org/project/linux-riscv/patch/20210216225555.4976-1-gary@garyguo.net/
Fixes: 8f0dc4cfd1 ("riscv: assembler versions of memcpy, memmove, memset")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If /chosen was missing, chosen_offset would never get updated with the new
/chosen node. This would cause fdt_setprop_u32 to fail. This patch fixes
this by setting chosen_offset. In addition, log any errors from setting
boot-hartid as well.
Fixes: 5370478d1c ("riscv: Add boot hartid to device tree")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Atish Patra <atish.patra@wdc.com>
At present there is only one Kconfig option CONFIG_SIFIVE_CLINT to
control the enabling of SiFive CLINT support in both SPL (M-mode)
and U-Boot proper (S-mode). So for a typical SPL config that the
SiFive CLINT driver is enabled in both SPL and U-Boot proper, that
means the S-mode U-Boot tries to access the memory-mapped CLINT
registers directly, instead of the normal 'rdtime' instruction.
This was not a problem before, as the hardware does not forbid the
access from S-mode. However this becomes an issue now with OpenSBI
commit 8b569803475e ("lib: utils/sys: Add CLINT memregion in the root domain")
that the SiFive CLINT register space is protected by PMP for M-mode
access only. U-Boot proper does not boot any more with the latest
OpenSBI, that access exceptions are fired forever from U-Boot when
trying to read the timer value via the SiFive CLINT driver in U-Boot.
To solve this, we need to split current SiFive CLINT support between
SPL and U-Boot proper, using 2 separate Kconfig options.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This fixes two minor format issues of the ax25-ae350 reST file.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Even if only USB gadget is defined, dwc3 generic driver enables
a definition and probe/remove functions for host driver.
This enables the definition if USB_HOST is enabled only.
Signed-off-by: Kunihiko Hayashi <hayashi.kunihiko@socionext.com>
All newer Allwinner SoCs (since about 2013) miss the CONFIGDATA register
in their MUSB implementation, so they need a quirk to hardcode this.
Currently this quirk depends on listing the SoCs affected in musb_reg.h,
which means that this list needs to grow with every new chip.
Move the quirk feature into Kconfig, next to PIO_ONLY, and change the
default to y (for Allwinner builds), while listing the early
implementations as exceptions.
This fixes USB peripheral operation on some newer SoCs, which were not
explicitly listed before.
Tested on H6, H616, R40 (which were broken before), and also on the H5
and A20, for regressions.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This patch adds the base support for the Marvell Octeon TX2 CN913x DB.
Only one defconfig is added with this patch. Other board variants are
available (NAND, MMC booting) and images for these boards can be
generated by following the documentation added in the included README.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the dtsi/dts files needed to support the Marvell
Octeon TX2 CN913x DB. This is only the base port with not all
interfaces supported fully.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Rename the misleading cmd "rx_training" to "mvebu_comphy_rx_training" to
avoid confusion and mixup with DDR3/4 training. This makes it clear,
that this command is platform specific and handles the COMPHY RX
training.
Also depend this cmd on ARMADA_8K and not TARGET_MVEBU_ARMADA_8K to make
is available for OcteonTX2 CN913x.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Cc: Marek Behun <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Cc: Nadav Haklai <nadavh@marvell.com>
Acked-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Acked-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
The pcie_dw_mvebu configure ATU regions for memory, configuration
and IO space types. However the latter is not obligatory
and when not specified in the device tree, causes wrong
ATU configuration. Fix that by adding a dependency on the
detected PCIE regions count.
Signed-off-by: Marcin Wojtas <mw@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-on: https://sj1git1.cavium.com/18136
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Tested-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Some of the setups including cn9130 opens mmio window starting from
0xc0000000, reflect it in the u-boot code.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
There is region left by ATF, which needs to remain in memory to provide RT
services. To prevent overwriting it by u-boot, do not provide any mapping
for this memory region, so any attempt to access it will trigger
synchronous exception.
Update sr 2021-04-12:
Don't update armada3700/cpu.c mmu table, as this has specific changes
included in mainline.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After commit 1fe929ed497bcc8975be8d37383ebafd22b99dd2
("spi: kirkwood: prevent configuring speed exceeding max controller freq")
the spi frequency could be set to 0 on platform where spi-max-frequency
is not defined (e.g. on armada-388-gp). Prevent limiting speed in
mentioned cases.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Tested-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Marcin Wojtas <marcin@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds a limitation in the kirkwood_spi driver
set_speed hook, which prevents setting too high transfer
speed.
Signed-off-by: Marcin Wojtas <mw@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Tested-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The Armada SoC family implementation of this SPI hardware module has
extended the configuration register to allow for a wider range of SPI
clock rates. Specifically the Serial Baud Rate Pre-selection bits in the
SPI Interface Configuration Register now also use bits 6 and 7 as well.
Modify the baud rate calculation to handle these differences for the
Armada case. Potentially a baud rate can be setup using a number of
different pre-scalar and scalar combinations. This code tries all
possible pre-scalar divisors (8 in total) to try and find the most
accurate set.
Signed-off-by: Ken Ma <make@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Currently, building U-Boot for x530 fails since the SPL image is too
big. This patch reduces the SPL size by changing the following Kconfig
options:
Enable CONFIG_SPL_TINY_MEMSET
Disable CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR
By disabling CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR, the tiny SPI NOR framework can be
used.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
Cc: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
When the PHY interface is set as TXID & RXID, the delays should be taken from DT,
but first they should not be hardcoded since the PHY driver will set them.
Fixes: 798424e857 ("net: designware: add Amlogic Meson8b & later glue driver")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If the PHY isn't specified in the DT, -ENODATA means it should be skipped,
handle it like -ENOENT.
With that, devices without USB3 supported can have USB working (Odroid-HC4).
Fixes: adb049abf7 ("usb: dwc3: Add Meson G12A USB Glue")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This lacks the right u-boot specific DT include to make HDMI work.
Reported-by: B1oHazard <ty3uk@mail.ua>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This reverts commit bc8bbb77f7.
This commit breaks U-Boot booting on SiFive Unleashed board, as
there is no such CSR on U54 core.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
The pwm_sifive_set_config() and pwm_sifive_set_enable() cannot work
properly due to the wrong implementations. It will cause the u-boot
PWM command to not work as expected. The bugs will be resolved in this
patch.
Signed-off-by: Vincent Chen <vincent.chen@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Testing showed that disabling AI while leaving PLL1 enabled disabled the
aisram. This suggests that AI is a more appropriate clock for that ram
bank.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This is more consistent with the naming of other ram banks, and matches
what Linux is doing.
Reported-by: Damien Le Moal <Damien.LeMoal@wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
We just need to initialize all the clocks pre-reloc. The clock driver
creates a bunch of devices, so we need to increase the pre-reloc malloc
arena.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
These devices are necessary for the clock driver, which is required by the
sram driver, to run pre-relocation.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Variables which had previously been stored in .bss are moved to .data. In
addition, probed needs to be reset when the clock driver is re-bound
post-relocation.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
No other (real) clocks have the cpu clock as their parent; instead they are
children of aclk. Move the clint clock under aclk to match them.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This simplifies the PLL creation process, since we don't have to pass all
the parameters individually.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This conditional always evaluated as false, regardless of the value of reg.
Fix it so that it properly tests the bits in the PLL register. Also test
PLL_EN, now that we set it.
Reported-by: Damien Le Moal <Damien.LeMoal@wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
After starting or setting the rate of a PLL, the enable bit must be set.
This fixes a bug where the AI ram would not be accessible, because it
requires PLL1 to be running.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Damien Le Moal <damien.lemoal@wdc.com>
If the user/dev explicitly requests a clock be assigned a certain rate,
then we should warn them if we can't do it. This makes it clear if the
clock is running at the default rate.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Update the Kconfig and the board file to make the am335x board compatible
with cape detection.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
The am335x from BeagleBone use i2c EEPROM to detect capes.
The memory is wired to i2c bus 2 therefore it need to be enabled.
Add i2c2 clock, pinmux description and pinmux enable function.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Add the extension_board_scan specific function to scan the information
of the EEPROM on one-wire and fill the extension struct.
Add the Kconfig symbol to enable the needs to detect DIPs.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Maxime Ripard <maxime@cerno.tech>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This patch changes the functioning of the detection of w1 devices.
The old way was a comparison between detected w1 and the ones described in
the device tree. Now it will just look for the driver matching the family
id of the w1 detected.
The patch is inspired from Maxime Ripard code.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Maxime Ripard <maxime@cerno.tech>
The BeagleBone platforms all use a common mechanism to discover and
identify extension boards (called "capes"): each extension board has an
I2C-connected EEPROM describing itself.
This patch implements a generic extension_scan_board() feature that can
be used by all BeagleBone platforms to read those I2C EEPROMs and fill
in the list of "extension" structures.
Following commits will enable this common logic on two BeagleBone
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
This commit extends the sandbox to implement a dummy
extension_board_scan() function and enables the extension command in
the sandbox configuration. It then adds a test that checks the proper
functionality of the extension command by applying two Device Tree
overlays to the sandbox Device Tree.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
[trini: Limit to running on sandbox]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This patch adds a new "extension" command, which aims at detecting
extension boards connected to the hardware platform, and apply the
Device Tree overlays that describe the hardware present on those
extension boards.
In order to enable this mechanism, board-specific code must implement
the extension_board_scan() function that fills in a linked list of
"struct extension", each describing one extension board. In addition,
the board-specific code must select the SUPPORT_EXTENSION_SCAN Kconfig
boolean.
Based on this:
- "extension scan" makes the generic code call the board-specific
extension_board_scan() function to retrieve the list of detected
extension boards.
- "extension list" allows to list the detected extension boards.
- "extension apply <number>|all" allows to apply the Device Tree
overlay(s) corresponding to one, or all, extension boards
The latter requires two environment variables to exist and set one variable
to run:
- extension_overlay_addr: the RAM address where to load the Device
Tree overlays
- extension_overlay_cmd: the U-Boot command to load one overlay.
Indeed, the location and mechanism to load DT overlays is very setup
specific.
- extension_overlay_name: set by the command: the name of the DT which
will be load during the execution.
When calling the command described in the extension_overlay_cmd
variable, the variable extension_overlay_name will be defined. So a
typical extension_overlay_cmd will look like this:
extension_overlay_cmd=load mmc 0:1 $extension_overlay_addr /boot/$extension_overlay_name
Here is an example on how to use it:
=> run loadfdt
=> fdt addr $fdtaddr
=> setenv extension_overlay_addr 0x1000
=> setenv extension_overlay_cmd 'load mmc 0:1 ${extension_overlay_addr} /boot/${extension_overlay_name}'
=> extension scan
Found 1 extension board(s).
=> extension apply 0
519 bytes read in 3 ms (168.9 KiB/s)
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Maxime Ripard <maxime@cerno.tech>
Move the fdt_valid function to fdt_support.
This changes allow to be able to test the validity of a devicetree in
other c files.
Update code syntax.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Maxime Ripard <maxime@cerno.tech>
Enable CONFIG_DM_ETH in configs/pm9263_defconfig
Drop legacy initialization in board/ronetix/pm9263.c
Remove network related setting from include/configs/pm9263.h
Signed-off-by: Ilko Iliev <iliev@ronetix.at>
Scrub duplicate /memory@* node entries here. Some R-Car DTs might
contain multiple /memory@* nodes, however fdt_fixup_memory_banks()
either generates single /memory node or updates the first /memory
node. Any remaining memory nodes are thus potential duplicates.
However, it is not possible to delete all the memory nodes right
away, since some of those might not be DRAM memory nodes, but some
sort of other memory. Thus, delete only the memory nodes which are
in the R-Car3 DBSC ranges.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
The rcar-common/common.c contains various common board functions shared
by all R-Car and RZG boards. This board is not compiling the file in, so
add it. This way, part of the board code can be de-duplicated too.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Add CPSW related nodes for AM642 SK. There are two CPSW ports on the
board but U-Boot supports only the first port.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
AM64 as CPSW3G IP with 2 external ports. Add DT entries for the same
(based on kernel DT).
Disable second port as its by default set to ICSS usage on EVM.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Currently driver may end up caching disabled port ID as active
interface. Fix this by bailing out earlier in case port is marked
disabled in the DT.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
CPSW NUSS IP on K3 SoCs can have more than one external port (upto 8)
Therefore increase AM65_CPSW_CPSWNU_MAX_PORTS to 9 (8 ext + 1 Root port)
as preparation to allow any one of the 8 ports to be used as ethernet
interface in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
ICSSG Ethernet driver uses two src threads per port (one per slice).
Similarly CPSW uses one src thread.
Drop PSIL EP static data for other src threads in order to reduce
R5 SPL footprint. This makes AM65x board bootable again.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
With AM64x supporting only K3_NAV_RINGACC_RING_MODE_RING or the exposed
ring mode, all other K3 SoCs have also been moved to this common
baseline. Therefore drop other modes such as
K3_NAV_RINGACC_RING_MODE_MESSAGE (and proxy) to save on SPL footprint.
There is a saving of ~800 bytes with this change for am65x_evm_r5_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com>
AM64 dual mode rings are modeled as pair of Rings objects which has common
configuration and memory buffer, but separate real-time control register
sets for each direction mem2dev (forward) and dev2mem (reverse).
AM64 rings must be requested only using k3_ringacc_request_rings_pair(),
and forward ring must always be initialized/configured. After this any
other Ringacc APIs can be used without any callers changes.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Update struct ti_sci_msg_rm_udmap_tx_ch_cfg_req to latest ABI to support
AM64x BCDMA Block copy channels.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Parse MAC addresses from EEPROM and set them in the env. This is needed
to get MAC address for additional ethernet ports on the EVM.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Enable all relevant configs for building multiple dtbs into a single fit
image and load the right dtb for next stage.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Enable relevant configs that checks for the size of image and stack:
BSS: 4KB
Initial MALLOC: 512KB
Initial Stack: 8K
SPL Image size can be: ~960KB
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
AM642 StarterKit (SK) board is a low cost, small form factor board
designed for TI’s AM642 SoC. It supports the following interfaces:
* 2 GB LPDDR4 RAM
* x2 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces capable of working in switch and MAC mode
* x1 USB 3.0 Type-A port
* x1 UHS-1 capable µSD card slot
* 2.4/5 GHz WLAN + Bluetooth 4.2 through WL1837
* 512 Mbit OSPI flash
* x2 UART through UART-USB bridge
* XDS110 for onboard JTAG debug using USB
* Temperature sensors, user push buttons and LEDs
* 40-pin Raspberry Pi compatible GPIO header
* 24-pin header for peripherals in MCU island (I2C, UART, SPI, IO)
* 54-pin header for Programmable Realtime Unit (PRU) IO pins
* Interface for remote automation. Includes:
* power measurement and reset control
* boot mode change
Add basic support for AM642 SK.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Now that single defconfig can be used for booting AM64 EVM and SK,
default device tree will not work for selecting dtb for kernel.
Update the env to select right dtb based on eeprom.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Current BSS allocation of SPL is as below:
size spl/u-boot-spl
text data bss dec hex filename
144572 5484 1752 151808 25100 spl/u-boot-spl
But 20KB is allocated currently for BSS. Reduce it to 4KB and
save some space for stack.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Enable support for selecting DTB within SPL based on EEPROM.
This will help to use single defconfig for both EVM and SK
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
I2C EEPROM data contains the board name and its revision.
Add support for:
- Reading EEPROM data and store a copy at end of SRAM
- Updating env variable with relevant board info
- Printing board info during boot.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
In SPL, DDR should be made available by the end of board_init_f()
so that apis in board_init_r() can use ddr. Adding support for
triggering DDR initialization from board_init_f().
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Introduce ddr node for am642 needed for all ddr configurations.
Also, introduce the 1600MTs DDR4 configuration that is supported on the
am642-evm.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Attempt to get and enable a vtt regulator if one is provided from the
dts. If we do not find one, continue as not all platforms have this.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Introduce support for the AM64 DDRSS controller which uses the 16bit
variation of the controller. This controller shares much functionality
with the existing J721e support, so this patch introduces only the new
code needed for am64 specific support from "_16bit_" files with headers
under "16bit/" include path/.
Also add a CONFIG_K3_AM64_DDRSS option to the choice required for use
with CONFIG_K3_DDRSS to allow selecting AM64 support.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Introduce a new version of the ddr driver which has the ability to
support different variations of the controller. Also introduce support
for the 32bit variation of the controller which is what was already
supported by the previous version used for J721e and J7200.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Create a new CONFIG_K3_DDRSS option to select the common parts of the
k3-ddrss driver. Also introduce a choice that depends on the top level
option to select CONFIG_K3_J721E_DDRSS for j721e support, and update
corresponding Kconfig as required.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Rename the k3-j721e folder under drivers/ram to k3-ddrss in preparation
of introducing additional support for other platforms to the same
driver.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Fix the indentation for certain macros to be consistent with the other
macros in the file, as the existing indentation does not make sense in
many places.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The AM642 EValuation Module (EVM) is a board that provides access to
various peripherals available on the AM642 SoC, such as PCIe, USB 2.0,
CPSW Ethernet, ADC, and more.
Add basic support.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The AM642 SoC belongs to the K3 Multicore SoC architecture platform,
providing advanced system integration to enable applications such as
Motor Drives, PLC, Remote IO and IoT Gateways.
Some highlights of this SoC are:
* Dual Cortex-A53s in a single cluster, two clusters of dual Cortex-R5F
MCUs, and a single Cortex-M4F.
* Two Gigabit Industrial Communication Subsystems (ICSSG).
* Integrated Ethernet switch supporting up to a total of two external
ports.
* PCIe-GEN2x1L, USB3/USB2, 2xCAN-FD, eMMC and SD, UFS, OSPI memory
controller, QSPI, I2C, eCAP/eQEP, ePWM, ADC, among other
peripherals.
* Centralized System Controller for Security, Power, and Resource
Management (DMSC).
See AM64X Technical Reference Manual (SPRUIM2, Nov 2020)
for further details: https://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruim2
Introduce basic support for the AM642 SoC to enable SD/MMC boot.
Introduce a limited set of MAIN domain peripherals under cbass_main and
a set of MCU domain peripherals under cbass_mcu.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Add pinctrl macros for AM64 SoC. These macro definitions are similar to
that of previous platforms, but adding new definitions to avoid any
naming confusions in the soc dts files.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
AM64x uses a different thread mapping that existing K3 SoCs, so update
the valid thread ID list to include those used for AM64x.
Also remove the comment identifying the purpose of each thread ID. The
purpose of the thread ID is specified when describing the threads in the
device tree and the same ID can mean different things on different SoCs,
so the comment is not useful.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Add support for the controller present on the AM642 SoC.
There are instances:
sdhci0: 8bit bus width, max 400 MBps
sdhci1: 4bit bus width, max 100 MBps
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Change the memory attributes for the DDR regions used by the remote
processors on AM65x so that the cores can see and execute the proper code.
A separate table based on the previous K3 SoCs is introduced since the
number of remote processors and their DDR usage is different between the
SoC families.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The AM642 SoCs use the Main R5FSS0 as a boot processor, and runs
the R5 SPL that performs the initialization of the System Controller
processor and starting the Arm Trusted Firmware (ATF) on the Arm
Cortex A53 cluster. The Core0 serves as this boot processor and is
parked in WFE after all the initialization. Core1 does not directly
participate in the boot flow, and is simply parked in a WFI.
Power down these R5 cores (and the associated RTI timer resources
that were indirectly powered up) after starting up ATF on A53 by
using the appropriate SYSFW API in release_resources_for_core_shutdown().
This allows these Main R5F cores to be further controlled from the
A53 to run regular applications.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Use the System Firmware (SYSFW) loader framework to load and start
the SYSFW as part of the AM642 early initialization sequence. Also
make use of existing logic to detect if ROM has already loaded sysfw
and avoided attempting to reload and instead just prepare to use already
running firmware.
While at it also initialize the MAIN_UART1 pinmux as it is used by SYSFW
to print diagnostic messages.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
For AM642, ROM supports loading system firmware directly
from boot image. ROM passes information about the number of
images that are loaded to bootloader at a specific address
that is temporary. Add support for storing this information
somewhere permanent before it gets corrupted.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
To access various control MMR functionality the registers need to
be unlocked. Do that for all control MMR regions in the MAIN domain.
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
AM642 allows for booting from primary or backup boot media.
Both media can be chosen individually based on switch settings.
ROM looks for a valid image in primary boot media, if not found
then looks in backup boot media. In order to pass this boot media
information to boot loader, ROM stores a value at a particular
address. Add support for reading this information and determining
the boot media correctly.
Signed-off-by: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
The AM642 SoC belongs to the K3 Multicore SoC architecture platform,
providing advanced system integration to enable applications such as
Motor Drives, PLC, Remote IO and IoT Gateways.
Some highlights of this SoC are:
* Dual Cortex-A53s in a single cluster, two clusters of dual Cortex-R5F
MCUs, and a single Cortex-M4F.
* Two Gigabit Industrial Communication Subsystems (ICSSG).
* Integrated Ethernet switch supporting up to a total of two external
ports.
* PCIe-GEN2x1L, USB3/USB2, 2xCAN-FD, eMMC and SD, UFS, OSPI memory
controller, QSPI, I2C, eCAP/eQEP, ePWM, ADC, among other
peripherals.
* Centralized System Controller for Security, Power, and Resource
Management (DMSC).
See AM64X Technical Reference Manual (SPRUIM2, Nov 2020)
for further details: https://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spruim2
Signed-off-by: Dave Gerlach <d-gerlach@ti.com>
Using the custom TI functions required not only replacing common memory
access functions but also rewriting the routines used to set bypass and
lock states. As for readl() and writel(), they also required the address
of the register to be accessed, a parameter that is hidden by the TI clk
module.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Replaces the common memory access functions used by the driver with the
ones exported from the TI clk module.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The clock access functions exported by the clk header use the
struct clk_ti_reg parameter to get the address of the register. This
must also apply to clk_ti_latch(). Changes to TI's clk-mux and
clk-divider drivers prevented the patch from generating compile errors.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
As it has been now two years past the migration deadline, it is required
to have migrated. Remove the check from the Makefile and rework some of
the Kconfig logic slightly to get the functional dependencies of DM_MMC
/ BLK right in both the SPL and non-SPL case.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The migration deadline for having LIBATA mean that AHCI is also enabled
was v2019.07. As that has long since passed, adjust the Kconfig
dependencies.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There are a number of platforms that depend on a SATA driver that has
been converted to require AHCI but the platforms themselves are behind
on other migrations that would make it trivial to enable AHCI. Disable
SATA in these cases.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These specific configs are missing a number of migrations. In addition,
they are blocking completion of the now-expired DM_MMC migration as it
requires enabling BLK.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Cc: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
Cc: Sumit Garg <sumit.garg@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This was missed when VirtIO support was initially brought to U-Boot
back in 2018. Add an entry for it and list myself as the maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This commit updates the default config with the values that are actually
used "in the wild" and which are close to what is used on the MediaTek
MT7688 based, 2nd generation of the GARDENA smart gateway:
- Reduce startup time by setting bootdelay to 0 (still allows accessing
the shell, one just has to send a key press quicker)
- Adjusting U-Boot environment volume names and MTD partitions to
the actual layout
Signed-off-by: Reto Schneider <reto.schneider@husqvarnagroup.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Allow for boards to update bootargs before booting the OS (helpful in
some forms of secure boot).
- Enhance GPT write support.
- gpio-sysinfo updates
- Allow env to be appended from dtb
Adding timeout mechanism to avoid spi driver from stucking
in the while loop in __atcspi200_spi_xfer().
Signed-off-by: Dylan Jhong <dylan@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Add a callback harts_early_init() to start.S to allow different riscv
hart perform setup code for each hart as early as possible. Since all
the harts enter the callback, they must be able to run the same
setup.
Signed-off-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
By declaring board-specific board_fdt_chosen_bootargs() the kernel
command line arguments can be adjusted before injecting to flat dt
chosen node.
Signed-off-by: Niko Mauno <niko.mauno@vaisala.com>
This change would enhance the existing 'gpt read' command to allow
(optionally) writing of the read GPT partitions to an environment
variable in the UBOOT partitions layout format. This would allow users
to easily change the overall partition settings by editing said variable
and then using the variable in the 'gpt write' and 'gpt verify' commands.
Signed-off-by: Farhan Ali <farhan.ali@broadcom.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Corneliu Doban <cdoban@broadcom.com>
Cc: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
Cc: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Check that a variable defined in /config/environment is found in the
run-time environment, and that clearing fdt_env_path from within that
node works.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Acked-by: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
[trini: Conditionalize the test being linked in]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
It can be useful to use the same U-Boot binary for multiple purposes,
say the normal one, one for developers that allow breaking into the
U-Boot shell, and one for use during bootstrapping which runs a
special-purpose bootcmd. Or one can have several board variants that
can share almost all boot logic, but just needs a few tweaks in the
variables used by the boot script.
To that end, allow the control dtb to contain a /config/enviroment
node (or whatever one puts in fdt_env_path variable), whose
property/value pairs are used to update the run-time environment after
it has been loaded from its persistent location.
The indirection via fdt_env_path is for maximum flexibility - for
example, should the user wish (or board logic dictate) that the values
in the DTB should no longer be applied, one simply needs to delete the
fdt_env_path variable; that can even be done automatically by
including a
fdt_env_path = "";
property in the DTB node.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Acked-by: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
This uses the newly-added dm_gpio_get_values_as_int_base3 function to
implement a sysinfo device. The revision map is stored in the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This has the uclass enforce calling detect() before other methods. This
allows drivers to cache information in detect() and perform (cheaper)
retrieval in the other accessors. This also modifies the only instance
where this sequencing was not followed.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since 07c9e683a4 ("smbios: Allow a few values to come from sysinfo")
there are common global sysinfo IDs. This patch moved existing IDs above
SYSINFO_ID_USER.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
of_parse_phandle_with_args (called by dev_read_phandle_with_args) does not
support getting the length of a phandle list by using the index -1.
Instead, use dev_count_phandle_with_args which supports exactly this
use-case.
Fixes: 8558217153 ("gpio: Convert to use APIs which support live DT")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Supported peripherals: Ethernet, eMMC, Serial.
U-Boot SPL 2021.04-00911-g5fa1e2ffeb-dirty (Apr 23 2021 - 09:11:14
+0200)
Normal Boot
Trying to boot from MMC2
U-Boot 2021.04-00911-g5fa1e2ffeb-dirty (Apr 23 2021 - 09:11:14 +0200)
CPU: Freescale i.MX8MQ rev2.1 at 1000 MHz
Reset cause: POR
Model: Ronetix iMX8M-CM SoM
DRAM: 1 GiB
WDT: Started with servicing (60s timeout)
MMC: FSL_SDHC: 0, FSL_SDHC: 1
Loading Environment from MMC... OK
In: serial
Out: serial
Err: serial
Net:
Warning: ethernet@30be0000 (eth0) using random MAC address -
42:0d:e7:78:da:53
eth0: ethernet@30be0000
Hit any key to stop autoboot: 0
u-boot=>
Signed-off-by: Ilko Iliev <iliev@ronetix.at>
commit 6ecbe13756 ("drivers: pci: imx: add imx_pcie_remove function")
attempted to resolve an issue caused by MX6QDL not having a proper
intneral PCIe core reset and thus hanging during kernel init if the
bootloader had enabled PCI.
The issue exists for IMX6Q, IMX6D, IXM6S, and IMX6DL. Fix the case for
IMX6S and IMX6DL getting missed.
This fixes IMX6S and IMX6DL with PCI enabled in U-Boot booting for
Linux v4.11+.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
instead using ls and awk to determine file size use stat instead.
This fixes an invalid size reporting for user or group names that have
spaces in them.
This adds a dependency on the stat application which is part of
the coreutils package which also includes ls.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Current setup instructions for i.MX8QM MEK board include somewhat
conflicting instructions, so here's an attempt to fix it.
After trying both sets of firmwares, I can conclude that both of
them fail to work:
- no boot at all with imx-sc-firmware-0.7 / firmware-imx-7.6
- partial success with imx-sc-firmware-1.1 / firmware-imx-8.0:
U-Boot 2021.04-rc3-00135-ge0669a43c8 (Mar 08 2021 - 16:49:08 +0200)
CPU: NXP i.MX8QM RevB A53 at 1200 MHz
Model: Freescale i.MX8QM MEK
Board: iMX8QM MEK
mu_hal_receivemsg timeout
Build: SCFW 65afe5f6, SECO-FW 65afe5f6, ATF a-20190
mu_hal_receivemsg timeout
sc_misc_get_boot_dev: res:16
Boot: SD0
DRAM: mu_hal_sendmsg timeout
sc_rm_is_memreg_owned: mr:0 res:21
...
Signed-off-by: Priit Laes <priit.laes@paf.com>
If we fail to probe for whatever reason, we cannot unregister/free the
MII bus unless we registered it with fec_get_miibus. This fixes FECs
sharing an MDIO bus from destroying it, preventing the other FEC from
using it.
Fixes: 6a895d039b ("net: Update eQos driver and FEC driver to use eth phy interfaces")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
If a phy is disabled, don't use it. This matches Linux's behavior.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Update the highest subordinate bus number after probing the devices
under the bus for setting up the bridge correctly.
The commit 42f3663a3f ("pci: Update to use new sequence numbers")
removed this but it is required if a PCIe bridge is under the bus.
Fixes: 42f3663a3f ("pci: Update to use new sequence numbers")
Signed-off-by: Masami Hiramatsu <masami.hiramatsu@linaro.org>
Remove the invalid 'regulator-always-on' property to resolve:
starting USB...
Bus usb@2184000: Error enabling VBUS supply (ret=-13)
probe failed, error -13
Bus usb@2184200: USB EHCI 1.00
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Engicam C.TOUCH 2.0 is an EDIMM compliant general purpose Carrier
board.
Genaral features:
- Ethernet 10/100
- Wifi/BT
- USB Type A/OTG
- Audio Out
- CAN
- LVDS panel connector
i.Core MX8M Mini is an EDIMM SoM based on NXP i.MX8M Mini from Engicam.
i.Core MX8M Mini needs to mount on top of this Carrier board for
creating complete i.Core MX8M Mini C.TOUCH 2.0 board.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <a142252061ff> ("arm64: dts: imx8mm: Add Engicam i.Core MX8M Mini
C.TOUCH 2.0")
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Engicam EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit is an EDIMM 2.2 Form Factor Capacitive
Evaluation Board.
Genaral features:
- LCD 7" C.Touch
- microSD slot
- Ethernet 1Gb
- Wifi/BT
- 2x LVDS Full HD interfaces
- 3x USB 2.0
- 1x USB 3.0
- HDMI Out
- Mini PCIe
- MIPI CSI
- 2x CAN
- Audio Out
i.Core MX8M Mini is an EDIMM SoM based on NXP i.MX8M Mini from Engicam.
i.Core MX8M Mini needs to mount on top of this Evaluation board for
creating complete i.Core MX8M Mini EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <051c08eea682> ("arm64: dts: imx8mm: Add Engicam i.Core MX8M Mini
EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit")
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
i.Core MX8M Mini is an EDIMM SoM based on NXP i.MX8M Mini
from Engicam.
General features:
- NXP i.MX8M Mini
- Up to 2GB LDDR4
- 8/16GB eMMC
- Gigabit Ethernet
- USB 2.0 Host/OTG
- PCIe Gen2 interface
- I2S
- MIPI DSI to LVDS
- rest of i.MX8M Mini features
i.Core MX8M Mini needs to mount on top of Engicam baseboards
for creating complete platform solutions.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <470d6dad5ddd> ("arm64: dts: imx8mm: Add Engicam i.Core MX8M Mini
SoM")
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Matteo Lisi <matteo.lisi@engicam.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Minor cosmetic changes to unify `CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS'
indentation between Bx50v3 and PPD to make comparison and
review easier and simplify the default boot command.
Signed-off-by: Ian Ray Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Increase watchdog period, in order to accomodate recent kernel size
and configuration changes.
Signed-off-by: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Add PHY's reset GPIO, so that U-Boot does a PHY hard reset.
This is needed, since the PHY might become unresponsive if
watchdog reboots the system while a transaction is ongoing.
The reset GPIO is added to the U-Boot specific DT files, since
the kernel does not setup the reserved registers correctly after
resetting the PHY and thus must not reset it.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
The DA9063 enables the CRYSTAL bit by default, but there is no
crystal populated on the BA16 system on module. Without explicitly
clearing the CRYSTAL bit the system runs unstable and sometimes
reboots unexpectedly.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
In case binman is enabled, the u-boot.itb is generated using this tool
and there is no direct u-boot.itb target, but instead the binman tool
must be invoked. Add support for this case.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
- Add base support for Marvell OcteonTX2 CN9130 CRB (mostly done
by Kostya)
- Sync Armada 3k/7k/8k SERDES code with Marvell version (misc Marvell
authors)
- pci-aardvark: Fix processing PIO transfers (Pali)
Add a reference for the TPM event types and provide missing constants.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add test item for getting address and size functions
Test the following function:
- ofnode_get_addr()
- ofnode_get_size()
Signed-off-by: Chen Guanqiao <chenguanqiao@kuaishou.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add functions to add size of addresses in the device tree using ofnode
references.
If the size is not set, return FDT_SIZE_T_NONE.
Signed-off-by: Chen Guanqiao <chenguanqiao@kuaishou.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we sometimes see problems in gitlab where the environment has
0x80 characters or sequences which are not valid UTF-8.
Avoid this by using bytes for the environment, both internal to buildman
and when writing out the 'env' file. Add a test to make sure this works
as expected.
Reported-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Fixes: e5fc79ea71 ("buildman: Write the environment out to an 'env' file")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There have been at least a few cases where an exception has occurred in a
thread and resulted in buildman hanging: running out of disk space and
getting a unicode error.
Handle these by collecting a list of exceptions, printing them out and
reporting failure if any are found. Add a test for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If there are no nodes or if all nodes are disabled, this function would
return err without setting it first. Fix this by initializing err to
zero.
Fixes: 94f7afdf7e ("dm: core: Ignore disabled devices when binding")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Today of_address_to_resource() is called only in
ofnode_read_resource() for livetree support and
fdt_get_resource() is called when livetree is not supported.
The fdt_get_resource() doesn't do the address translation
so when it is required, but the address translation is done
by ofnode_read_resource() caller, for example in
drivers/firmware/scmi/smt.c::scmi_dt_get_smt_buffer() {
...
ret = ofnode_read_resource(args.node, 0, &resource);
if (ret)
return ret;
faddr = cpu_to_fdt32(resource.start);
paddr = ofnode_translate_address(args.node, &faddr);
...
The both behavior should be aligned and the address translation
must be called in fdt_get_resource() and removed for each caller.
Fixes: a44810123f ("dm: core: Add dev_read_resource() to read device resources")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
When used with hierarchical images, use the Chromium OS convention of
adding a section before all the subentries it contains.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use an interator in two of the fmap tests so it is easier to add new
items. Also check the name first since that is the first indication
that something is wrong. Use a variable for the expected size of the
fmap to avoid repeating the code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Parse each empty-line-delimited message separately. This saves having to
deal with all the different line content styles, we only care about the
header ERROR | WARNING | NOTE...
Also make checkpatch print line information for a uboot specific
warning.
Signed-off-by: Evan Benn <evanbenn@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Given that we have tests that require pygit2 and it can be installed
like any other python module, fail much more loudly if it is missing.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Given that test/py/requirements.txt has all required test modules, make
use of that rather than a manual pip install list before running our
assorted tool testsuites.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is easier to read the positive conditional.
While at it, convert hard coded length of "_test_" to strlen("_test_")
which will be converted to a constant bu optimizing compiler.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When run `ut dm [test name]` allow to use simple pattern to run all tests
started with given prefix. For example, to run all ACPI test cases:
ut dm acpi*
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present each invocation of run_steps() updates OUTPUT_FILES_COMMON,
since it does not make a copy of the dict. This is fine for a single
invocation, but for tests, run_steps() is invoked many times.
As a result it may include unwanted items from the previous run, if it
happens that a test runs twice on the same CPU. The problem has not been
noticied previously, as there are few enough tests and enough CPUs that
is is rare for the 'wrong' combination of tests to run together.
Fix this by making a copy of the dict, before updating it. Update the
tests to suit, taking account of the files that are no-longer generated.
With this fix, we no-longer generate files which are not needed for a
particular state of OF_PLATDATA_INST, so the check_instantiate() function
is not needed anymore. It has become dead code and so fails the
code-coverage test (dtoc -T). Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These two tests require an ELF image so that symbol information can be
written into the SPL/TPL binary. At present they rely on other tests
having set it up first, but every test must run independently. This can
cause occasional errors in CI.
Fix this by setting up the required files, as other tests do.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The commit 6c993815bb ("net: phy: xilinx: Be compatible with live OF
tree") change driver behavior to while loop which wasn't correct because
the driver was looping over again and again. The reason was that
ofnode_valid() is taking 0 as correct value.
Fix it by changing while loop to ofnode_for_each_subnode() which is only
loop over available nodes.
Fixes: 6c993815bb ("net: phy: xilinx: Be compatible with live OF tree")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Trying to clear PIO_START register when it is non-zero (which indicates
that previous PIO transfer has not finished yet) causes an External
Abort with SError 0xbf000002.
This bug is currently worked around in TF-A by handling External Aborts
in EL3 and ignoring this particular SError.
This workaround was also discussed at:
https://git.trustedfirmware.org/TF-A/trusted-firmware-a.git/commit/?id=3c7dcdac5c50https://lore.kernel.org/linux-pci/20190316161243.29517-1-repk@triplefau.lt/https://lore.kernel.org/linux-pci/971be151d24312cc533989a64bd454b4@www.loen.fr/https://review.trustedfirmware.org/c/TF-A/trusted-firmware-a/+/1541
Implement a proper fix to prevent this External Abort. As it is not
possible to cancel a pending PIO transfer, simply do not start a new one
if previous has not finished yet. In this case return an error to the
caller.
In most cases this SError happens when there is no PCIe card connected
or when PCIe link is down. The reason is that in these cases a PIO
transfer takes about 1.44 seconds. For this reason we also increase the
wait timeout in pcie_advk_wait_pio() to 1.5 seconds.
If PIO read transfer for PCI_VENDOR_ID register times out, or if it
isn't possible to read it yet because previous transfer is not finished,
return Completion Retry Status value instead of failing, to give the
caller a chance to send a new read request.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Add additional step which enables the Impedance and PLL calibration.
- Enable old squelch detector instead of the new analog squelch detector
circuit and update host disconnect threshold value.
- Update LS TX driver strength coarse and fine adjustment values.
Change-Id: Ifa0a585bfb5ecab0bfa033eed6874ff98b16a7df
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
In CP115, comphy4 can be configured into SFI port1
(in addition to SFI0). This patch adds the option
described above.
In addition, rename all existing SFI/XFI references:
COMPHY_TYPE_SFI --> COMPHY_TYPE_SFI0
No functional change for exsiting configuration.
Change-Id: If9176222e0080424ba67347fe4d320215b1ba0c0
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
According to Design Reference Specification the PHY PLL and Calibration
register from PHY0 are shared for multi-port PHY. PLL control registers
inside other PHY channels are not used.
This commit reworks utmi device tree nodes in a way that common PHY PLL
registers are moved to main utmi node. Accordingly both child nodes
utmi-unit range is reduced and register offsets in utmi_phy.h are updated
to this change.
This fixes issues in scenarios when only utmi port1 was in use, which
resulted with lack of correct pll initialization.
Change-Id: Icc520dfa719f43a09493ab31f671efbe88872097
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
New products can contain up to 6 usb ports, therefore allow to initialize
all relevant UTMI PHYs.
Change-Id: I28c36e59fa0e3e338bb3ee0cee2240b923f39785
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <Kostya.Porotchkin@cavium.com>
It helps ATF to determine who called power off
function (U-boot/Linux) and act accordingly
Change-Id: Icfc5cbfdba64754496812154272b28c0ff639f0f
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
- the default value of comphy pipe selector is set to PCIe (x4)
in case of unconnected comphy the default value remains 0x4
which may lead to several issues with comphy initialization.
- this patch adds SMC call that powers off the comphy lane in case of
unconnected comphy.
Change-Id: I196b2916518dd8df3b159ffa85e2989b8e483087
Signed-off-by: Christine Gharzuzi <chrisg@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Currently, we don't pass id for SGMII 0/1.
A bug in comphy selector configuration was found (in comphy
firmware), after fixing it, SGMII0/1 have different configuration,
so we need to pass the ID the firmware.
Change-Id: Idcff4029cc9cf018278e493221b64b33574e0d38
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Change-Id: I358792a96c13b54e700c05227cc7a8f6bd584694
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Now the comphy configuration is handled in atf, therefore there is no
need to configure phy or pipe selector in u-boot, it is configured by
atf for each particular pair: lane and mode.
Change-Id: I0bebf8d5ff66dbeb6bf9ef90876195938a8eb705
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Replace the XFI training with appropriate SMC call, so the firmware will
perform exact initialization.
Update Stefan 2021-03-23:
Move comphy_smc() function to an earlier place - necessary for the
mainline merge.
Change-Id: I789b130b05529dc80dadcf66aef407d93595b762
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Replace the comphy initialization for USB with appropriate SMC call,
so the firmware will execute required serdes configuration.
Change-Id: I7f773c0dfac70db9dd2653de2cdcfac577e78c4e
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Replace the comphy initialization for RXAUI with appropriate SMC call,
so the firmware will execute required serdes configuration.
Change-Id: Iedae0285fb283e05bb263a8b4ce46e8e7451a309
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Even if comphy types of SATA2/SATA3/SGMII3 and comphy speeds of
1.5G/3G/6.25G were referenced in the driver non configuration (dts)
was using it.
This patch removes unused definitions.
Change-Id: I53ed6f9d3a82b9d18cb4e488bc14d3cf687f9488
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
This patch adds support for running RX training using new command called
"rx_training"
Usage:
rx_training - rx_training <cp id> <comphy id>
RX training allows to improve link quality (for SFI mode)
by running training sequence between us and the link partner,
this allows to reach better link quality then using static configuration.
Change-Id: I818fe67ccaf19a87af50d4c34a9db7d6802049a5
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Marcin Wojtas <mw@semihalf.com>
This allows the lower level driver access to comphy map data
(required for RX training support, which is introduced
in the following patches).
Change-Id: Ib7ffdc4b32076c01c3a5d33f59552c9dfc6b12fa
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
If fdtdec_get_int can't find speed, set COMPHY_SPEED_INVALID
If fdtdec_get_int can't find type, set COMPHY_TYPE_INVALID
Move the error print if phy-type is invalid
Add continue to the probe loop (in a case of invalid phy)
Cosmetic changes
Change-Id: I0c61b40bfe685437426fe907942ed338b7845378
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Add UTMI analog parameters initialization values according to
latest ETP.
Change-Id: I5bcca205a3995202a18ff126f371a81f69e205c8
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
UTMI should be initialized only for enabled device tree nodes.
This fix overrides current internal configuration array
entry with the next DT entry data if error is detected
during the current DT entry parsing or the current port
is disabled.
This way the internal configuration structure will only
contain valid ports information obtained from the DT.
Change-Id: I9c43c6a5d234e15ae9005d1c9bc983fc1f3544b8
Signed-off-by: Omri Itach <omrii@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Ken Ma <make@marvell.com>
In get_speed_string() we have an array (speed_strings[])
which includes all possible speed strings.
This array size and content must be aligned to the speed
defines in comphy_data.h.
This patch adds missing 5.125G speed, aligns speed_strings[]
and fixes incorrect printing when speed > 5.0G.
Change-Id: I9900d23595094be321be0c62fcaa88036324568e
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Currently, all comphy definitions are PHY_TYPE_XX and PHY_SPEEED_XX.
Those definition might be confused with MDIO PHY definitions.
This patch does the following changes:
- PHY_TYPE_XX --> COMPHY_TYPE_XX
- PHY_SPEED_XX --> COMPHY_SPEED_XX
This improves readability, no functional change.
Change-Id: I2bd1d9289ebbc5c16fa80f9870f797ea1bcaf5fa
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
- For some Marvell SoCs, like armada-3700, there are both
USB host and device controller, but on PHY level the
configuration is the same.
- The new type supports both USB device and USB host
- This patch is cherry-picked from u-boot-2015 as-is.
Change-Id: I01262027edd8ec23391cff6fb409b3009aedfbb9
Signed-off-by: jinghua <jinghua@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Ken Ma <make@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Because of the incorrectly supported SGMII_2500 mode, this patch
disables eth2 for now until this issue will be fixed in mainline.
Also fix an incorrect comment.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Cc: Stefan Chulski <stefanc@marvell.com>
Cc: Nadav Haklai <nadavh@marvell.com>
Cc: Marek Behun <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch adds the base support for the Marvell Octeon TX2 CN9130 CRB.
Not all interfaces are supported fully yet.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the dtsi/dts files needed to support the Marvell
Octeon TX2 CN9130 CRB. This is only the base port with not all
interfaces supported fully.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Move the default environment location to the end of 4MB flash
region. This change allows to accomodate larger flash boot
images making space for forthcoming code changes.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add support for SoCs based on AP807 die.
Remove unused include file for Armada-8020 SoC.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Use a single dtsi file for CP110 die instead of master/slave.
Moving to single file will allow miltiple DTSI inclusions with
re-defined CP index and name.
This change will also allow support for SoCs containing more than
two CP110 dies on board.
Move pin control definitions from CP110 DTS to board DTS files
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- fix the dependency for MMC boot (add XENON to MVEBU_MMC)
- fix the bubt destination assignment (missing # in "else" case)
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add support for regulator-force-boot-off DT property.
This property can be used by the board/device drivers for
turning off regulators on early init stages as pre-requisite
for the other components initialization.
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The dw_eth_pdata is not accessible from the mdio device, it gets the mdio bus plat
leading to random sleeps (-10174464 on Odroid-HC4).
This moves the dw_mdio_reset function to a common one taking the ethernet
device as parameter and use it from the dw_mdio_reset and dm_mdio variant functions.
Fixes: 5160b4567c ("net: designware: add DM_MDIO support")
Reported-by: Mark Kettenis <mark.kettenis@xs4all.nl>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
According to S26KL512S datasheet [1] and S29GL01GS datasheet [2],
the procedure to read out PPB lock bits is to send the PPB Entry,
PPB Read, Reset/ASO Exit. Currently, the code does send incorrect
PPB Entry, PPB Read and Reset/ASO Exit is completely missing.
The PPB Entry sent is implemented by sending flash_unlock_seq()
and flash_write_cmd(..., FLASH_CMD_READ_ID). This translates to
sequence 0x555:0xaa, 0x2aa:0x55, 0x555:0x90=FLASH_CMD_READ_ID.
However, both [1] and [2] specify the last byte of PPB Entry as
0xc0=AMD_CMD_SET_PPB_ENTRY instead of 0x90=FLASH_CMD_READ_ID,
that is 0x555:0xaa, 0x2aa:0x55, 0x555:0xc0=AMD_CMD_SET_PPB_ENTRY.
Since this does make sense, this patch fixes it and thus also
aligns the code in flash_get_size() with flash_real_protect().
The PPB Read returns 00h in case of Protected state and 01h in case
of Unprotected state, according to [1] Note 83 and [2] Note 17, so
invert the result. Moreover, align the arguments with similar code
in flash_real_protect().
Finally, Reset/ASO Exit command should be executed to exit the PPB
mode, so add the missing reset.
[1] https://www.cypress.com/file/213346/download
Document Number: 001-99198 Rev. *M
Table 40. Command Definitions, Nonvolatile Sector Protection
Command Set Definitions
[2] https://www.cypress.com/file/177976/download
Document Number: 001-98285 Rev. *R
Table 7.1 Command Definitions, Nonvolatile Sector Protection
Command Set Definitions
Fixes: 03deff433e ("cfi_flash: Read PPB sector protection from device for AMD/Spansion chips")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This fixes an issue getting resets index 1 and 3+, the spurius "> 0"
made it return the index 0 or 1, whatever index was passed.
The dm_test_reset_base() did not catch it, but the dm_test_reset_base() extension
catches it and this fixes the regression.
This also fixes a reggression on Amlogic G12A/G12B SoCs, where HDMI output was disable
even when Linux was booting.
Fixes: ea9dc35aab ("reset: Get the RESET by index without device")
Reported-by: B1oHazard <ty3uk@mail.ua>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
With this extended test, we get the following failure :
=> ut dm reset_base
Test: dm_test_reset_base: reset.c
test/dm/reset.c:52, dm_test_reset_base(): reset_method3.id == reset_method3_1.id: Expected 0x14 (20), got 0x2 (2)
Test: dm_test_reset_base: reset.c (flat tree)
test/dm/reset.c:52, dm_test_reset_base(): reset_method3.id == reset_method3_1.id: Expected 0x14 (20), got 0x2 (2)
Failures: 2
A fix is needed in reset_get_by_index_nodev() when introduced in [1].
[1] ea9dc35aab ("reset: Get the RESET by index without device")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
As reported by Coverity Scan for Das U-Boot, the 'less-than-zero'
comparison of an unsigned value is never true.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
When CONFIG_USE_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE=y and the file
CONFIG_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE is empty (or at least doesn't contain any
non-comment, non-empty lines), we end up feeding nothing into xxd,
which in turn then outputs nothing. Then blindly appending ", 0x00"
means that we end up trying to compile (roughly)
const char defaultenv[] = { , 0x00 }
which is of course broken.
To fix that, change the frobbing of the text file so that we always
end up printing an extra empty line (which gets turned into that extra
nul byte we need) - that corresponds better to the binary format
consisting of a series of key=val nul terminated strings, terminated
by an empty string.
Reported-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
There are some cases where decompressed sectors can have padding zeros.
In kernel code, we have lines to address such situation:
/*
* btrfs_getblock is doing a zero on the tail of the page too,
* but this will cover anything missing from the decompressed
* data.
*/
if (bytes < destlen)
memset(kaddr+bytes, 0, destlen-bytes);
kunmap_local(kaddr);
But not in U-boot code, thus we have some reports of U-boot failed to
read compressed files in btrfs.
Fix it by doing the same thing of the kernel, for both inline and
regular compressed extents.
Reported-by: Matwey Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Link: https://bugzilla.suse.com/show_bug.cgi?id=1183717
Fixes: a26a6bedaf ("fs: btrfs: Introduce btrfs_read_extent_inline() and btrfs_read_extent_reg()")
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
When zImage support was added to SPL, the messages were hidden to reduce
code size. However, the wrong config symbol was used. Since this file is
only built when CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK=y, the messages were always hidden.
Use the correct symbol so the messages are printed in U-Boot proper.
Also use IS_ENABLED to drop the #ifdef.
Fixes: 431889d6ad ("spl: zImage support in Falcon mode")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
When flush_cache() is called during boot on our ~7M kernel image, the
hundreds of thousands of WATCHDOG_RESET calls end up adding
significantly to boottime. Flushing a single cache line doesn't take
many microseconds, so doing these calls for every cache line is
complete overkill.
The generic watchdog_reset() provided by wdt-uclass.c actually
contains some rate-limiting logic that should in theory mitigate this,
but alas, that rate-limiting must be disabled on powerpc because of
its get_timer() implementation - get_timer() works just fine until
interrupts are disabled, but it just so happens that the "big"
flush_cache() call happens in the part of bootm where interrupts are
indeed disabled. [1] [2] [3]
I have checked with objdump that the generated code doesn't change
when this option is left at its default value of 0: gcc is smart
enough to see that the ">=" comparison is tautologically true, hence
all assignments to "flushed" are eliminated as dead stores.
On our board, setting the option to something like 65536 ends up
reducing total boottime by about 0.8 seconds.
[1] https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/20200605111657.28773-1-rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk/
[2] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-April/446906.html
[3] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-April/447280.html
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
CONFIG_5xx hasn't existed since commit 5025897774 (powerpc, 5xx:
remove support for 5xx). Remove this last mention of it.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Having WATCHDOG_RESET() called automatically from the timer interrupt
runs counter to the idea of a watchdog device - if the board runs into
an infinite loops with interrupts still enabled, the watchdog will
never fire.
When using CONFIG_(SPL_)WDT, the watchdog_reset function is a lot more
complicated than just poking a few SOC-specific registers - it
involves accessing all kinds of global data, and if the interrupt
happens at the wrong time (say, in the middle of an WATCHDOG_RESET()
call from ordinary code), that can end up corrupting said global data.
Allow the board to opt out of calling WATCHDOG_RESET() from the timer
interrupt handler by setting CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ to 0 - as that
setting is currently nonsensical (it would be compile-time
divide-by-zero), it cannot affect any existing boards.
Add documentation for both the existing and extended meaning of
CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
The code, which is likely copied from arch/powerpc/lib/interrupts.c,
lacks a fallback definition of CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ and refers to
a non-existing timestamp variable - obviously priv->timestamp is
meant.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Some boards don't work with the rate-limiting done in the generic
watchdog_reset() provided by wdt-uclass.
For example, on powerpc, get_timer() ceases working during bootm since
interrupts are disabled before the kernel image gets decompressed, and
when the decompression takes longer than the watchdog device
allows (or enough of the budget that the kernel doesn't get far enough
to assume responsibility for petting the watchdog), the result is a
non-booting board.
As a somewhat hacky workaround (because DT is supposed to describe
hardware), allow specifying hw_margin_ms=0 in device tree to
effectively disable the ratelimiting and actually ping the watchdog
every time watchdog_reset() is called. For that to work, the "has
enough time passed" check just needs to be tweaked a little to allow
the now==next_reset case as well.
Suggested-by: Christophe Leroy <christophe.leroy@csgroup.eu>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION on Salvator-X(S), ULCB, Ebisu,
which means the Spansion HF PPB protection bits can be operated
using the 'protect' U-Boot command.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
The clock driver used a heavy-handed approach where it turned off
all available clocks, while also possibly setting bits which are not
documented in the R-Car datasheet. Update the tables so that only
the bits which are documented are set or cleared when tearing down
the clock driver.
Note that the only clock left running before booting Linux are now
MFIC, INTC-AP, INTC-EX and SCIF2 / SCIF0 on V3x.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Import updated devicetree files from the Linux v5.12 release.
Besides some node and audio port renames this changes the PHY modes to
either rgmii-id or rgmii-txid. From the board files the Pinephone sees
a lot of updates.
This also adds the long missing USB PHY property for controller 0, which
allows the U-Boot PHY driver to eventually use port 0 in host mode
(pending another U-Boot patch).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Update R40 .dts{,i} and dt-binding headers to current version from kernel.
Files taken from Linux 5.12-rc1 release
(commit fe07bfda2fb9cdef8a4d4008a409bb02f35f1bd8)
Signed-off-by: Ivan Uvarov <i.uvarov@cognitivepilot.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Commit eb5a2b6710 ("net: sun8i-emac: Determine pinmux based on SoC,
not EMAC type") switched the pinmux setup over to look at
CONFIG_MACH_SUN* symbols, to find the appropriate mux value.
Unfortunately this patch missed to check for the H5, which is
pin-compatible to the H3, but uses a different Kconfig symbol (because
it has ARMv8 vs. ARMv7 cores).
Replace the pure SUN8I_H3 symbol with the joint SUNXI_H3_H5 one, which is
there to cover the peripherals common to both SoCs.
Also explicitly list each supported SoC, and have an error message in the
fallback case, to avoid those problems in the future.
This fixes Ethernet support on all H5 boards.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org> # Orange Pi PC2
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
This patch adds support for the following I2C devices connected to
I2C bus 0 on the Octeon EBB7304:
- Dallas DS1337 RTC
- TLV EEPROM
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
We already have a clock driver for MIPS Octeon. This patch changes the
Octeon DT nodes to supply the clock property via the clock driver
instead of using an hard-coded value, which is not correct in all cases.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Otherwise the output will look like this on MIPS Octeon NIC23:
Device 0: (0:0) Vendor: ATA Prod.: aSDnsi klUrt aII Rev: 4X11
Type: Hard Disk
Capacity: 457862.8 MB = 447.1 GB (937703088 x 512)
instead of this version:
Device 0: (0:0) Vendor: TA Prod.: SanDisk Ultra II Rev: X411
Type: Hard Disk
Capacity: 457862.8 MB = 447.1 GB (937703088 x 512)
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds a few missing virt_to_phys() to use the correct physical
address for DMA operations in the common AHCI code. This is done to
support the big-endian MIPS Octeon platform.
Additionally the code a cleaned up a bit (remove some empty lines) and
made a bit better readable.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch enables the usage of the MVEBU AHCI/SATA driver. The only
changes necessary to support MIPS Octeon via DT based probing are, to
add the compatible DT property and the use of dev_remap_addr() so that
the correct mapped address is used in the Octeon case (phys != virt).
Please note that this driver supports the usage of the "scsi" command
and not the "sata" command, since it does not provide an own "scan"
function, which is needed for the "sata" cmd support.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
For easy AHCI/ SATA integration, this patch adds board_ahci_enable()
for the MVEBU AHCI driver, which will be used by this platform. This
platform specific "enable" function will setup the proper endian
swapping in the AHCI controller so that it can be used by the common
AHCI code.
Additionally the endian swizzle entry for AHCI in
octeon_should_swizzle_table[] is removed, as this enabled the original
lowlevel code function, e.g. octeon_configure_qlm(), for the QLM setup
to work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the necessary platform infrastructure code, so that the
MIPS Octeon drivers "serial_octeon_pcie_console" & "serial_bootcmd" can
be used. This is e.g. the bootmem initialization in a compatible way to
the Marvell 2013 U-Boot, so that the exisiting PC remote tools like
"oct-remote-console" & "oct-remote-load" can be used. This is be done in
the newly introduced arch_misc_init(), which calls the necessary init
functions when enabled.
These patches are in preparation for the MIPS Octeon NIC23 board
support, which is a desktop PCIe target board enabling these features.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the PCI bootcmd feature for MIPS Octeon, which will be
used by the upcoming Octeon III NIC23 board support. It enables the use
of the "oct-remote-load" and "oct-remote-bootcmd" on host PC's to
communicate with the PCIe target and load images into the onboard
memory and issue commands.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the PCI remote console feature for MIPS Octeon, which
will be used by the upcoming Octeon III NIC23 board support. It enables
the use of the "oct-remote-console" tool on host PC's to communicate
with the PCIe target.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
As DEBUG is no Kconfig symbol, we can't use the IS_ENABLED() macros.
This patch switches to the unfortunately necessary #ifdef usage again
to make it work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
While porting from the Marvell source, I introduced a bug by misplacing
the parenthesis. This patch fixes this issue.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch changes the MIPS Octeon defconfig to enable some features
for PCIe enablement. This includes CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT to call the
board specific serdes init code.
With these features enabled, the serdes and PCIe driver including the
Intel E1000 driver can be tested on the Octeon EBB7304.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the PCIe host controller driver for MIPS Octeon II/III.
The driver mainly consist of the PCI config functions, as all of the
complex serdes related port / lane setup, is done in the serdes / pcie
code available in the "arch/mips/mach-octeon" directory.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the board specific QLM/DLM init code to the Octeon 3
EBB7304 board. The configuration of each port is read from the
environment exactly as done in the 2013 U-Boot version to keep the
board and it's configuration compatible.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the newly added C files to the Makefile to enable
compilation. This is done in a separate step, to not introduce build
breakage while adding the single files with potentially missing
externals.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import octeon_qlm.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import octeon_fdt.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-qlm.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcie.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-util.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-jtag.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-fdt.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-cfg.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
To match all other cvmx-* header, this patch moves the already existing
cvmx-lmcx-defs.h header one directory up.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
With the newly added headers and their restructuring (which macro is
defined where), some changes in the already existing Octeon files are
necessary. This patch makes the necessary changes.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import misc remaining header files from 2013 U-Boot. These will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Import cvmx-sso-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sriox-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sriomaintx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-smix-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sli-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sata-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-rst-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pow-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pko-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pki-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pip-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pepx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pemx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcsx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pciercx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcieepx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-npi-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-mio-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-l2c-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-ipd-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-gserx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-gmxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-fpa-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dtx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dpi-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dbg-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-ciu-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-bgxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-asxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-agl-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import misc cvmx-helper header files from 2013 U-Boot. They will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This will be used by the upcoming Serdes and driver code ported from
the original 2013 U-Boot code to mainline.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This fixes an issue getting resets index 1 and 3+, the spurius "> 0"
made it return the index 0 or 1, whatever index was passed.
The dm_test_reset_base() did not catch it, but the dm_test_reset_base() extension
catches it and this fixes the regression.
This also fixes a reggression on Amlogic G12A/G12B SoCs, where HDMI output was disable
even when Linux was booting.
Fixes: ea9dc35aab ("reset: Get the RESET by index without device")
Reported-by: B1oHazard <ty3uk@mail.ua>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
With this extended test, we get the following failure :
=> ut dm reset_base
Test: dm_test_reset_base: reset.c
test/dm/reset.c:52, dm_test_reset_base(): reset_method3.id == reset_method3_1.id: Expected 0x14 (20), got 0x2 (2)
Test: dm_test_reset_base: reset.c (flat tree)
test/dm/reset.c:52, dm_test_reset_base(): reset_method3.id == reset_method3_1.id: Expected 0x14 (20), got 0x2 (2)
Failures: 2
A fix is needed in reset_get_by_index_nodev() when introduced in [1].
[1] ea9dc35aab ("reset: Get the RESET by index without device")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
As reported by Coverity Scan for Das U-Boot, the 'less-than-zero'
comparison of an unsigned value is never true.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
When CONFIG_USE_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE=y and the file
CONFIG_DEFAULT_ENV_FILE is empty (or at least doesn't contain any
non-comment, non-empty lines), we end up feeding nothing into xxd,
which in turn then outputs nothing. Then blindly appending ", 0x00"
means that we end up trying to compile (roughly)
const char defaultenv[] = { , 0x00 }
which is of course broken.
To fix that, change the frobbing of the text file so that we always
end up printing an extra empty line (which gets turned into that extra
nul byte we need) - that corresponds better to the binary format
consisting of a series of key=val nul terminated strings, terminated
by an empty string.
Reported-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
There are some cases where decompressed sectors can have padding zeros.
In kernel code, we have lines to address such situation:
/*
* btrfs_getblock is doing a zero on the tail of the page too,
* but this will cover anything missing from the decompressed
* data.
*/
if (bytes < destlen)
memset(kaddr+bytes, 0, destlen-bytes);
kunmap_local(kaddr);
But not in U-boot code, thus we have some reports of U-boot failed to
read compressed files in btrfs.
Fix it by doing the same thing of the kernel, for both inline and
regular compressed extents.
Reported-by: Matwey Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Link: https://bugzilla.suse.com/show_bug.cgi?id=1183717
Fixes: a26a6bedaf ("fs: btrfs: Introduce btrfs_read_extent_inline() and btrfs_read_extent_reg()")
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
When zImage support was added to SPL, the messages were hidden to reduce
code size. However, the wrong config symbol was used. Since this file is
only built when CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK=y, the messages were always hidden.
Use the correct symbol so the messages are printed in U-Boot proper.
Also use IS_ENABLED to drop the #ifdef.
Fixes: 431889d6ad ("spl: zImage support in Falcon mode")
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
When flush_cache() is called during boot on our ~7M kernel image, the
hundreds of thousands of WATCHDOG_RESET calls end up adding
significantly to boottime. Flushing a single cache line doesn't take
many microseconds, so doing these calls for every cache line is
complete overkill.
The generic watchdog_reset() provided by wdt-uclass.c actually
contains some rate-limiting logic that should in theory mitigate this,
but alas, that rate-limiting must be disabled on powerpc because of
its get_timer() implementation - get_timer() works just fine until
interrupts are disabled, but it just so happens that the "big"
flush_cache() call happens in the part of bootm where interrupts are
indeed disabled. [1] [2] [3]
I have checked with objdump that the generated code doesn't change
when this option is left at its default value of 0: gcc is smart
enough to see that the ">=" comparison is tautologically true, hence
all assignments to "flushed" are eliminated as dead stores.
On our board, setting the option to something like 65536 ends up
reducing total boottime by about 0.8 seconds.
[1] https://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/20200605111657.28773-1-rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk/
[2] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-April/446906.html
[3] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-April/447280.html
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
CONFIG_5xx hasn't existed since commit 5025897774 (powerpc, 5xx:
remove support for 5xx). Remove this last mention of it.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Having WATCHDOG_RESET() called automatically from the timer interrupt
runs counter to the idea of a watchdog device - if the board runs into
an infinite loops with interrupts still enabled, the watchdog will
never fire.
When using CONFIG_(SPL_)WDT, the watchdog_reset function is a lot more
complicated than just poking a few SOC-specific registers - it
involves accessing all kinds of global data, and if the interrupt
happens at the wrong time (say, in the middle of an WATCHDOG_RESET()
call from ordinary code), that can end up corrupting said global data.
Allow the board to opt out of calling WATCHDOG_RESET() from the timer
interrupt handler by setting CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ to 0 - as that
setting is currently nonsensical (it would be compile-time
divide-by-zero), it cannot affect any existing boards.
Add documentation for both the existing and extended meaning of
CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
The code, which is likely copied from arch/powerpc/lib/interrupts.c,
lacks a fallback definition of CONFIG_SYS_WATCHDOG_FREQ and refers to
a non-existing timestamp variable - obviously priv->timestamp is
meant.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Some boards don't work with the rate-limiting done in the generic
watchdog_reset() provided by wdt-uclass.
For example, on powerpc, get_timer() ceases working during bootm since
interrupts are disabled before the kernel image gets decompressed, and
when the decompression takes longer than the watchdog device
allows (or enough of the budget that the kernel doesn't get far enough
to assume responsibility for petting the watchdog), the result is a
non-booting board.
As a somewhat hacky workaround (because DT is supposed to describe
hardware), allow specifying hw_margin_ms=0 in device tree to
effectively disable the ratelimiting and actually ping the watchdog
every time watchdog_reset() is called. For that to work, the "has
enough time passed" check just needs to be tweaked a little to allow
the now==next_reset case as well.
Suggested-by: Christophe Leroy <christophe.leroy@csgroup.eu>
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable EFI capsule update features to be enabled by default also with all
dfu valid options for ZynqMP.
This feature was tested on Xilinx ZynqMP zcu104 board with defining
dfu_alt_info="mmc 0:1=boot.bin fat 0 1;u-boot.itb fat 0 1"
and
dfu_alt_info="sf 0:0=boot.bin raw 0 0x50000;u-boot.itb raw 0x80000
0x500000".
There is a need to increase malloc size for getting dfu mmc to work.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
CC: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Import updated devicetree files from the Linux v5.12 release.
Besides some node and audio port renames this changes the PHY modes to
either rgmii-id or rgmii-txid. From the board files the Pinephone sees
a lot of updates.
This also adds the long missing USB PHY property for controller 0, which
allows the U-Boot PHY driver to eventually use port 0 in host mode
(pending another U-Boot patch).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Update R40 .dts{,i} and dt-binding headers to current version from kernel.
Files taken from Linux 5.12-rc1 release
(commit fe07bfda2fb9cdef8a4d4008a409bb02f35f1bd8)
Signed-off-by: Ivan Uvarov <i.uvarov@cognitivepilot.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Commit eb5a2b6710 ("net: sun8i-emac: Determine pinmux based on SoC,
not EMAC type") switched the pinmux setup over to look at
CONFIG_MACH_SUN* symbols, to find the appropriate mux value.
Unfortunately this patch missed to check for the H5, which is
pin-compatible to the H3, but uses a different Kconfig symbol (because
it has ARMv8 vs. ARMv7 cores).
Replace the pure SUN8I_H3 symbol with the joint SUNXI_H3_H5 one, which is
there to cover the peripherals common to both SoCs.
Also explicitly list each supported SoC, and have an error message in the
fallback case, to avoid those problems in the future.
This fixes Ethernet support on all H5 boards.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org> # Orange Pi PC2
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Enable CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION on Salvator-X(S), ULCB, Ebisu,
which means the Spansion HF PPB protection bits can be operated
using the 'protect' U-Boot command.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
The clock driver used a heavy-handed approach where it turned off
all available clocks, while also possibly setting bits which are not
documented in the R-Car datasheet. Update the tables so that only
the bits which are documented are set or cleared when tearing down
the clock driver.
Note that the only clock left running before booting Linux are now
MFIC, INTC-AP, INTC-EX and SCIF2 / SCIF0 on V3x.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- MIPS: octeon: fix minor bugs of initial merge
- MIPS: octeon: add support for QLM and PCI-E controller
- MIPS: octeon: add support for AHCI and SATA
- MIPS: octeon: add E1000 ethernet support
- MIPS: octeon: add Octeon III NIC23 board
- ata/scsi: add support for Big Endian platforms
Bump our py version to 1.10.0 to address CVE-2020-29651.
Reported-by: GitHub dependabot
Reported-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
- search for additional detailed timings in the EDID extension block
- rework sunxi DE2 driver and accompanying DW-HDMI platform driver
to drop redundant device specific code, and later use the DT as a
source of information
Currently DE2 driver uses functions which are defined in internal
headers. They are not meant to be used outside of uclass framework.
Switch DE2 driver to public ones. This has additional benefit that
device_probe doesn't need to be called manually.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
There is no real need to read source_id at probe time. It also doesn't
make sense to store it in driver private data since it's already stored
in class platform data. While this looks like cleanup (and it is), it's
also important for DE2 driver rework because this info will be filled
later (after probe is already executed).
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
It turns out that there are two ways how hot plug detection can be done.
One is standard way for DW HDMI controller - checking bit 2 in 0x3004
register. Another way is applicable only to Allwinner custom PHY - by
checking bit 19 in register 0x10038. Both methods are equally good as
far as we know.
Use standard method in order to reduce amount of custom code.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
One of my monitors have only 4k@60 timing in base EDID block which is
out of range for devices with HDMI 1.4. It turns out that it has
additional detailed timings in CTA-861 Extension Block and two of them
are appropriate for HDMI 1.4.
Add additional search for valid detailed timing in extension block.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Code which searches for valid detailed timing entry will be used in more
places. Extract it.
No functional change is made. However, descriptors are casted to
edid_detailed_timing instead of edid_monitor_descriptor. Descriptor can
be of either type, but since we're interested only in DTD, it is more
fitting to cast to edid_detailed_timing.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
When searching for detailed timing in EDID, check for digital display
earlier. There is no point parsing other parameters if this flag is not
present.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Currently driver accepts all resolution which won't work on 4k screens.
Add validation callback which limits acceptable resolutions to 297 MHz.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
commit cbea241e935e("efidebug: add multiple device path instances on Boot####")
slightly tweaked the efidebug syntax adding -b, -i and -s for the boot
image, initrd and optional data.
The pytests using this command were adapted as well. However I completely
missed the last "" argument, which at the time indicated the optional data
and needed conversion as well. This patch is adding the missing -s flag
and the tests are back to normal.
Fixes: cbea241e935e("efidebug: add multiple device path instances on Boot####")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviwed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In case of failure at efi_get_variable_int("BootOrder"), we should
skip examining boot option variables and return an appropriate error
code which is the one the function returned.
Fixes: CID 331153 Code maintainability issues (UNUSED_VALUE)
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Indicated by Coverity Scan CID 331147
The ESRT was being refreshed in situations where the UpdateCapsule
procedure failed. In that scenario:
1) the ESRT refresh was superfluous.
2) a failed ESRT refresh return code overwrites the UpdateCapsule error
return code.
This commit ensures that the ESRT is only refreshed when the
UpdateCapsule performs successfully.
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CC: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
CC: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
CC: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CC: nd@arm.com
Signed-off-by: Jose Marinho <jose.marinho@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Bumping the digest list count, for all supported algorithms, can be
calculated outside of the individual switch statements. So let's do that
for every loop iteration instead and simplify the code a bit.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
To avoid diverging function definitions we need to include efi_loader.h.
Fixes: fe179d7fb5 ("efi_loader: Add size checks to efi_create_indexed_name()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide a man-page for the fatinfo command.
The .rst file was lost in patch 15d9694600 ("doc: fatinfo man-page").
Fixes: 15d9694600 ("doc: fatinfo man-page")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This patch adds support for the following I2C devices connected to
I2C bus 0 on the Octeon EBB7304:
- Dallas DS1337 RTC
- TLV EEPROM
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
We already have a clock driver for MIPS Octeon. This patch changes the
Octeon DT nodes to supply the clock property via the clock driver
instead of using an hard-coded value, which is not correct in all cases.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Otherwise the output will look like this on MIPS Octeon NIC23:
Device 0: (0:0) Vendor: ATA Prod.: aSDnsi klUrt aII Rev: 4X11
Type: Hard Disk
Capacity: 457862.8 MB = 447.1 GB (937703088 x 512)
instead of this version:
Device 0: (0:0) Vendor: TA Prod.: SanDisk Ultra II Rev: X411
Type: Hard Disk
Capacity: 457862.8 MB = 447.1 GB (937703088 x 512)
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds a few missing virt_to_phys() to use the correct physical
address for DMA operations in the common AHCI code. This is done to
support the big-endian MIPS Octeon platform.
Additionally the code a cleaned up a bit (remove some empty lines) and
made a bit better readable.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch enables the usage of the MVEBU AHCI/SATA driver. The only
changes necessary to support MIPS Octeon via DT based probing are, to
add the compatible DT property and the use of dev_remap_addr() so that
the correct mapped address is used in the Octeon case (phys != virt).
Please note that this driver supports the usage of the "scsi" command
and not the "sata" command, since it does not provide an own "scan"
function, which is needed for the "sata" cmd support.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
For easy AHCI/ SATA integration, this patch adds board_ahci_enable()
for the MVEBU AHCI driver, which will be used by this platform. This
platform specific "enable" function will setup the proper endian
swapping in the AHCI controller so that it can be used by the common
AHCI code.
Additionally the endian swizzle entry for AHCI in
octeon_should_swizzle_table[] is removed, as this enabled the original
lowlevel code function, e.g. octeon_configure_qlm(), for the QLM setup
to work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the necessary platform infrastructure code, so that the
MIPS Octeon drivers "serial_octeon_pcie_console" & "serial_bootcmd" can
be used. This is e.g. the bootmem initialization in a compatible way to
the Marvell 2013 U-Boot, so that the exisiting PC remote tools like
"oct-remote-console" & "oct-remote-load" can be used. This is be done in
the newly introduced arch_misc_init(), which calls the necessary init
functions when enabled.
These patches are in preparation for the MIPS Octeon NIC23 board
support, which is a desktop PCIe target board enabling these features.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the PCI bootcmd feature for MIPS Octeon, which will be
used by the upcoming Octeon III NIC23 board support. It enables the use
of the "oct-remote-load" and "oct-remote-bootcmd" on host PC's to
communicate with the PCIe target and load images into the onboard
memory and issue commands.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the PCI remote console feature for MIPS Octeon, which
will be used by the upcoming Octeon III NIC23 board support. It enables
the use of the "oct-remote-console" tool on host PC's to communicate
with the PCIe target.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
As DEBUG is no Kconfig symbol, we can't use the IS_ENABLED() macros.
This patch switches to the unfortunately necessary #ifdef usage again
to make it work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
While porting from the Marvell source, I introduced a bug by misplacing
the parenthesis. This patch fixes this issue.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch changes the MIPS Octeon defconfig to enable some features
for PCIe enablement. This includes CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT to call the
board specific serdes init code.
With these features enabled, the serdes and PCIe driver including the
Intel E1000 driver can be tested on the Octeon EBB7304.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the PCIe host controller driver for MIPS Octeon II/III.
The driver mainly consist of the PCI config functions, as all of the
complex serdes related port / lane setup, is done in the serdes / pcie
code available in the "arch/mips/mach-octeon" directory.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This patch adds the board specific QLM/DLM init code to the Octeon 3
EBB7304 board. The configuration of each port is read from the
environment exactly as done in the 2013 U-Boot version to keep the
board and it's configuration compatible.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the newly added C files to the Makefile to enable
compilation. This is done in a separate step, to not introduce build
breakage while adding the single files with potentially missing
externals.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import octeon_qlm.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import octeon_fdt.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-qlm.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcie.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-util.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-jtag.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-fdt.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-helper-cfg.c from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used by the later
added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS Octeon II / III
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
To match all other cvmx-* header, this patch moves the already existing
cvmx-lmcx-defs.h header one directory up.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
With the newly added headers and their restructuring (which macro is
defined where), some changes in the already existing Octeon files are
necessary. This patch makes the necessary changes.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import misc remaining header files from 2013 U-Boot. These will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Import cvmx-sso-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sriox-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sriomaintx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-smix-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sli-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-sata-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-rst-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pow-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pko-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pki-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pip-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pepx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pemx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcsx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pciercx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-pcieepx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-npi-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-mio-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-l2c-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-ipd-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-gserx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-gmxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-fpa-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dtx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dpi-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-dbg-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-ciu-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-bgxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-asxx-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import cvmx-agl-defs.h header file from 2013 U-Boot. It will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import misc cvmx-helper header files from 2013 U-Boot. They will be used
by the later added drivers to support PCIe and networking on the MIPS
Octeon II / III platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This will be used by the upcoming Serdes and driver code ported from
the original 2013 U-Boot code to mainline.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For work with EFI it is good to have GUID partitions enabled and also
option to work with UEFI variables. That's why enable both.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Currently u-boot supports addresses upto 39-bits only. If anybody
wants to use addresses of more than 39-bits in Linux they will have
a separate memory node in DT. In such cases they will have multiple
memory nodes.
Currently u-boot selects and runs on lower memory bank region.
But bootscript is being loaded on dram bank 0, where dram bank 0 will
point to 1st memory node in DT. If first memory node is mentioned as
higher ddr(>39-bits address) then u-boot cannot load the bootscript.
So fix this issue by setting bootscript address within the lower memory
bank region.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add support for usb dfu & thor to distro boot on zynq platform.
Add 60s timeout of dfu-utils to start transaction. Remove
DFU_ALT_INFO_RAM as we use bootcmd_usb_dfu instead of dfu_ram.
Remove DFU_ALT_INFO_MMC as part of distro boot cleanup.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Change "dfu_usb" to "usb_dfu" for better representation and change
required macros. Add 60s timeout of dfu-utils to start transaction.
Add support for usb thor to distro boot. Remove DFU_ALT_INFO_RAM
as we use bootcmd_usb_dfu instead of dfu_ram.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The dfu ram info is wired in connection to Linux kernel and certain setup.
We should change this to be more generic as others command. That's why
using boot via script is the way to go.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
In usb boot mode distro boot should select usb device as primary boot
device instead of usb host. So make usb dfu as primary boot device. But do
not list it in boot_targets as fallback option because it is not classic
mode for booting. Using 60s timeout by default should be enough time for
dfu-utils to start transaction. In case none needs this please change
timeout value in the command or disable CONFIG_DFU_TIMEOUT.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
On systems without usb gadget dfu core fails which was reported by error
but command itself returns pass which breaks any usage in a script.
That's why propagate error from run_usb_dnl_gadget().
Fixes: 16297cfb2a ("usb: new board-specific USB init interface")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable this feature by default to be able to work with env import/export
commands which are done in this slightly changed variable format (There is
addtional flag fields in variable file which is changing CRC calculation).
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable saving variables to MMC(FAT) and SPI based on primary
bootmode. If bootmode is JTAG, dont save env anywhere(NOWHERE).
Enable ENV_FAT_DEVICE_AND_PART="0:auto" for Versal platforms as well.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable saving variables to MMC(FAT), NAND, SPI based on primary
bootmode. If bootmode is JTAG, dont save env anywhere(NOWHERE).
Since most of the flashes on zynq evaluation boards are 16MB in size,
set default ENV_OFFSET to 15MB(0xE00000).
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This variable is used for pointing to location where redundant variables
are located. There is no default value. And it doesn't need to be specified
which is showing as warning when savedefconfig is called.
make xilinx_zynqmp_virt_defconfig
#
# configuration written to .config
#
make savedefconfig
scripts/kconfig/conf --savedefconfig=defconfig Kconfig
.config:199:warning: symbol value '' invalid for ENV_OFFSET_REDUND
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
According to EHCI spec, software needs to do handshake with HC for
safely removing QH from async list. This handshake is implemented by
setting IAAD (Interrupt on Async Advance Doorbell) bit in USB_USBCMD
register and poll the IAA (Interrupt on Async Advance bit) in the
USB_USBSTS to ensure the HC has released all on-chip state that may
potentially reference one of the data structures just removed.
Current codes only check active status of the last QTD, but this can't
ensure the QH is released from HC. We can meet unrecoverable
"EHCI timed out on TD" errors when running UEFI SCT tests on USB disk.
The USB_ASYNCLISTADDR register is changed to a invalid address when the
issue happens. It is fixed after adding the IAA handshake.
Steps to reproduce the issue:
1. Build the UEFI SCT from https://github.com/tianocore/edk2-test
2. Build the EDK2 UEFI Shell from https://github.com/tianocore/edk2
3. Copy SCT files and Shell.efi to USB disk FAT partition
4. Load the Shell.efi from USB FAT, and run bootefi to execute it
5. After booting into Shell, enter the SCT directory and run "sct -a"
to execute all tests.
6. Tests run about 1 hour and stop with many EHCI timeout errors like
EHCI timed out on TD - token=0x801f8c80
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
For the latest kernel device tree the max number of reserved regions
in lmb library is reached: 8 with 5 reserved regions in device tree.
When a new region is added, the lmb allocation for the device tree
relocation failed and boot with ramdisk failed.
This patch avoids this issue by increasing the max number of
supported reserved memory in lmb library to 16.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add 2 configs CONFIG_LMB_MEMORY_REGIONS and CONFIG_LMB_RESERVED_REGIONS
to change independently the max number of the regions in lmb
library.
When CONFIG_LMB_USE_MAX_REGIONS=y, move the lmb property arrays to
struct lmb and manage the array size with the element 'max' of struct
lmb_region; their are still allocated in stack.
When CONFIG_LMB_USE_MAX_REGIONS=n, keep the current location in
struct lmb_region to allow compiler optimization.
Increase CONFIG_LMB_RESERVED_REGIONS is useful to avoid lmb errors in
bootm when the number of reserved regions (not adjacent) is reached:
+ 1 region for relocated U-Boot
+ 1 region for initrd
+ 1 region for relocated linux device tree
+ reserved memory regions present in Linux device tree.
The current limit of 8 regions is reached with only 5 reserved regions
in DT.
see Linux kernel commit bf23c51f1f49 ("memblock: Move memblock arrays
to static storage in memblock.c and make their size a variable")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
As in lmb_region, cnt < max and in the lmb library
use region[i] only with i in 0...cnt, this region array size
can be reduced by 1 element without overflow.
This patch allows to reduce the struct lmb size.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add a max parameter in lmb_region struct to handle test
in lmb_add_region without using the MAX_LMB_REGIONS
define.
This patch allows to modify these size independently for
memory of reserved regions in the next patches.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove the unused field size of struct lmb_region as it is initialized to 0
and never used after in lmb library.
See Linux kernel commit 4734b594c6ca ("memblock: Remove memblock_type.size
and add memblock.memory_size instead")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
There are no system calls in U-Boot, but ENOSYS is still allowed (and
preferred since 42a2668743 ("dm: core: Document the common error codes")).
Silence this warning.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is technically a library function, but we use MMCs for testing, so
it is easier to do it with DM. At the moment, the only block devices in
sandbox are MMCs (AFAIK) so we just test with those.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
blk_get_device_by_str returns the device number on success. So we must
check if the return was negative to determine an error.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Recently, tests have been added primarily to the end of the dm Makefile.
This results in merge conflicts when two people add new tests at the
same time. To reduce these conflicts, alphabetize the makefile.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
This patch enables USB storage support with the necessary partition
support on the MIPS Octeon EBB7304.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Until now, the Octeontx MMC driver did only support the ARM Octeon
TX/Tx2 platforms. This patch adds support for the MIPS Octeon platform
to this driver. Here a short summary of the changes:
- Enable driver compilation for MIPS Octeon, including the MMC related
header file
- Reorder header inclusion
- Switch to using the clk framework to get the input clock
- Remove some functions for MIPS Octeon, as some registers don't
exist here
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
The MT7688KN is a multi-chip package with 8MiB DDR1 KGD. So the DDR type
from bootstrap register must be ignored, and always be assumed as DDR1.
This patch fixes the displayed DDR type of mt7628.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The MT7688KN is a multi-chip package with 8MiB DDR1 KGD. So the DDR type
from bootstrap register must be ignored, and always be assumed as DDR1.
This patch fixes an issue that mt7628_ddr_pad_ldo_config() may be passed
with a wrong ddr_type in MT7688KN.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Sometimes no traffic was getting out on the ports, the root cause was
a wrong configuration of the Serdes6G, which is used on jr2 pcb111.
This patch fixes this issue by applying the correct configuration.
Fixes: 5e1d417bec ("net: Add MSCC Jaguar2 network driver.")
Signed-off-by: Horatiu Vultur <horatiu.vultur@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add support for stack protector for UBOOT, SPL, and TPL
as well as new pytest for stackprotector
Signed-off-by: Joel Peshkin <joel.peshkin@broadcom.com>
Adjust UEFI build flags.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The current usage of the variable CFLAGS_NON_EFI on the x86 architecture
deviates from other architectures.
Variable CFLAGS_NON_EFI is the list of compiler flags to be removed when
building UEFI applications. It is not a list of flags to be added anywhere.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
regmap_read() only fills the first two bytes of val. The last two bytes are
random data from the stack. This means the test will fail randomly.
For low endian systems we could simply initialize val to 0 and get correct
results. But tests should not depend on endianness. So let's use a pointer
conversion instead.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-boot might display wrong module revision information
for modules with an assembly version 'K'. "cfgblock create"
does not takes into account all revision digits from PID8.
This fix takes into account all digits of PID8
to store module revision.
Signed-off-by: Denys Drozdov <denys.drozdov@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Use psci driver exported functions for reset/poweroff, instead of
invoking directly invoke_psci_fn.
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Adds support for:
* PSCI_FEATURES, which was introduced in PSCI 1.0. This provides API
that allows discovering whether a specific PSCI function is implemented
and its features.
* SYSTEM_RESET2, which was introduced in PSCI 1.1, which extends existing
SYSTEM_RESET. It provides support for vendor-specific resets, providing
reset_type as an additional param.
For additional details visit [1].
Implementations of some functions were borrowed from Linux PSCI driver
code [2].
[1] https://developer.arm.com/documentation/den0022/latest/
[2] drivers/firmware/psci/psci.c
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Rob does not have access to any Calxeda systems anymore, also has
expressed a lack of interest in those systems in the past.
I have multiple working Midway nodes under my desk in the office, so
am happy to take over maintainership.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far U-Boot was hard coding a (surely sufficient) memory size of 512
MB, even though all machines out there have at least 4GB of DRAM.
Since U-Boot uses its memory knowledge to populate the EFI memory map,
we are missing out here, at best losing everything beyond 4GB on Midway
boxes (which typically come with 8GB of DRAM).
Since the management processor populated the DT memory node already with
the detected DRAM size and configuration, we use that to populate
U-Boot's memory bank information, which is the base for the UEFI memory
map.
This finally allows us to get rid of the NR_DRAM_BANKS=0 hack, that we
had in place to avoid U-Boot messing up the DT memory node before
loading the kernel.
Also, to cover the whole of memory, we need to enable PHYS_64BIT.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far we were defining a somewhat confusing PHYS_SDRAM_1_SIZE variable,
which originally was only used for setting the memtest boundaries. This
definition in highbank.h has been removed about a year ago (moved to
Kconfig), so we also don't need the hard-coded size definition any longer.
Get rid of the misleading memory size definition, which was actually wrong
anyway (it's 4088 MB for those machines with just 4GB of DRAM).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
To squash that nasty warning message and make better use of the newly
gained OF_CONTROL feature, let's convert the calxedagmac driver to the
"new" driver model.
The conversion is pretty straight forward, mostly just adjusting the
use of the involved data structures.
The only actual change is the required split of the receive routine into
a receive and free_pkt part.
Also this allows us to get rid of the hardcoded platform information and
explicit init calls.
This also uses the opportunity to wrap the code decoding the MMIO
register base address, to make it safe for using PHYS_64BIT later.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
All Calxeda machines are actually a poster book example of device tree
usage: the DT is loaded from flash by the management processor into
DRAM, the memory node is populated with the detected DRAM size and this
DT is then handed over to the kernel.
So it's a shame that U-Boot didn't participate in this chain, but
fortunately this is easy to fix:
Define CONFIG_OF_CONTROL and CONFIG_OF_BOARD, and provide a trivial
function to tell U-Boot about the (fixed) location of the DTB in DRAM.
Then enable DM_SERIAL, to let the PL011 driver pick up the UART platform
data from the DT. Also define AHCI, to bring this driver into the driver
model world as well.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far on Highbank/Midway machines U-Boot only ever uses 512MB of DRAM,
even though the machines have typically 4GB and 8GB, respectively.
That means that so far we didn't need an extra limit for placing the DTB
and initrd, as the 512MB are lower than the kernel's limit ("lowmem",
typically 768MB).
With U-Boot now needing to learn about the actual memory size (to
correctly populate the EFI memory map), it might relocate fdt and initrd
to the end of DRAM, which is out of reach of the kernel.
So add limiting values to the fdt_high and initrd_high environment
variables, to prevent U-Boot from using too high addresses.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Anatop is an integrated regulator inside i.MX6 SoC.
There are 3 digital regulators which controls PU, CORE (ARM), and SOC.
And 3 analog regulators which controls 1P1, 2P5, 3P0 (USB).
This patch adds the Anatop regulator driver.
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <fabio.estevam@nxp.com>
Cc: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Trying to compile with CONFIG_CMD_MMC=y and CONFIG_MMC=n leads to errors:
riscv64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: cmd/built-in.o: in function `do_mmcops':
cmd/mmc.c:984: undefined reference to `get_mmc_num'
riscv64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: cmd/built-in.o: in function `do_mmc_setdsr':
cmd/mmc.c:873: undefined reference to `find_mmc_device'
Add missing dependency.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The fdt node offset is apparently not set properly when probed
causing no MDIO busses to be found. Fix this by obtaining the
offset.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
After check for maximum between max id and available ports, also check
if available port count is less than max id and update.
In the case of the CN8030 OcteonTX SoC max_id needs to be reduced to
the number of ports found otherwise the following occurs on a scan:
GW6404-B> scsi scan
scanning bus for devices...
Target spinup took 0 ms.
AHCI 0001.0300 32 slots 1 ports 6 Gbps 0x1 impl SATA mode
flags: 64bit ncq ilck stag pm led clo only pmp fbss pio slum part ccc
apst
Device 0: (0:0) Vendor: ATA Prod.: SanDisk SD8SFAT0 Rev: Z233
Type: Hard Disk
Capacity: 61057.3 MB = 59.6 GB (125045424 x 512)
"Synchronous Abort" handler, esr 0x96000006
elr: 000000000052f824 lr : 000000000052fa10 (reloc)
elr: 000000007fee9824 lr : 000000007fee9a10
x0 : 0000000000000001 x1 : 0000000000000001
x2 : 000000007bea3528 x3 : 000000007bea3580
x4 : 0000000000000200 x5 : 0000000000000000
x6 : 0000000000000002 x7 : 000000007bea3540
x8 : 00000000fffffff8 x9 : 0000000000000008
x10: 00000000000186a0 x11: 000000000000000d
x12: 0000000000000006 x13: 000000000001869f
x14: 0000000000000007 x15: 00000000ffffffff
x16: 000000007ff439a5 x17: 000000007ff5730c
x18: 000000007bea9de0 x19: 000000007ff7a580
x20: 000000007bec79f8 x21: 0000000000000000
x22: 000000007bea3580 x23: 0000000000000000
x24: 0000000000000000 x25: 000000007bec7a00
x26: 00000000ffffffc0 x27: 000000007bec79d0
x28: 000000007beb51c0 x29: 000000007bea3480
Code: 91246800 940130c2 12800000 1400004f (b9402ae0)
Resetting CPU ...
Signed-off-by: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Revert a change that occured between the Marvell SDK-10.1.1.0
and SDK-10.3.1.1 which broke QSMII phy support.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Move CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD out of the octeontx_common header
and into the defconfig files.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fixes IDE issues found on the Malta board under Qemu:
1) DMA implied commands were sent to the controller in stead of the PIO
variants. The rest of the code is DMA free and written for PIO operation.
2) direct pointer access was used to read and write the registers instead
of the inb/inw/outb/outw functions/macros. Registers don't have to be
memory mapped and ATA_CURR_BASE() does not have to return an offset from
address zero.
3) Endian isues in ide_ident() and reading/writing data in general. Names
were corrupted and sizes misreported.
Tested malta_defconfig and maltael_defconfig to work again in Qemu.
Signed-off-by: Reinoud Zandijk <reinoud@NetBSD.org>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
UCLASS_IRQ driver is not Intel specific. Make CONFIG_IRQ
selectable for all platforms.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The GICv3 RM requires "The first 1KB of memory for the LPI Pending tables
must contain only zeros on initial allocation, and this must be visible
to the Redistributors, or else the effect is UNPREDICTABLE".
And as the following statement, we here clear the whole Pending tables
instead of the first 1KB.
"An LPI Pending table that contains only zeros, including in the first 1KB,
indicates that there are no pending LPIs.
The first 1KB of the LPI Pending table is IMPLEMENTATION DEFINED. However,
if the first 1KB of the LPI Pending table and the rest of the table contain
only zeros, this must indicate that there are no pending LPIs."
And there isn't any pending LPI under U-Boot, so it's unnecessary to
load the contents of the Pending table during the enablement, then set
the GICR_PENDBASER.PTZ flag.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com> # NXP LS1028A
Reviewed-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Now we have PCIe, let's also enable NVMe to access an eventual NVMe SSDs
connected on the M.2 slot.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Enable PCIe by default in u-boot, this should eventually be made dynamic
in the runtime board config depending on the MCU configuration.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The sync of the device tree and dt-bindings from Linux v5.6-rc2
11a48a5a18c6 ("Linux 5.6-rc2") causes Ethernet to break on some
ODROID-C2. The PHY seems to need proper reset timing to be functional
in U-Boot and Linux afterwards. Readd the old PHY reset bindings for
dwmac until we support the new bindings in the PHY node.
Fixes: dd5f2351e9 ("arm64: dts: meson: sync dt and bindings from v5.6-rc2")
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Second set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.07 cycle:
This small feature set include support for 5th PIO bank on pio4 pinctrl
driver and a fix for the SPL on sama5d3.
This reverts commit 38d6b7ebda.
struct global_data contains a pointer to the bd_info structure. This
pointer was populated spl_set_bd() to a pre-allocated bd_info in the
".data" section. The referenced commit replaced this mechanism to one
that uses malloc(). That new mechanism is only used if SPL_ALLOC_BD=y.
which very few boards do.
The result is that (struct global_data)->bd is NULL in SPL on most
platforms. This breaks falcon mode, since arch_fixup_fdt() tries to
access (struct global_data)->bd and set the "/memory" node in the
devicetree. The result is that the "/memory" node contains garbage
values, causing linux to panic() as it sets up the page table.
Instead of trying to fix the mess, potentially causing other issues,
revert to the code that worked, while this change is reworked.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Now we have PCIe, let's also enable NVMe to access an eventual NVMe SSDs
connected on the M.2 slot.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Enable PCIe by default in u-boot, this should eventually be made dynamic
in the runtime board config depending on the MCU configuration.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The sync of the device tree and dt-bindings from Linux v5.6-rc2
11a48a5a18c6 ("Linux 5.6-rc2") causes Ethernet to break on some
ODROID-C2. The PHY seems to need proper reset timing to be functional
in U-Boot and Linux afterwards. Readd the old PHY reset bindings for
dwmac until we support the new bindings in the PHY node.
Fixes: dd5f2351e9 ("arm64: dts: meson: sync dt and bindings from v5.6-rc2")
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add support for sama7g5 pinctrl variant, with 5 banks with a degraded
8 line only 5th bank.
Based on Linux Kernel implementation.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
This is a patchset which makes away with the .bind() controller indexing
workaround which was broken since before v2021.04, and then adds PHY
support and MX8M support on top of that. Better add it into the release
early to get as much testing as possible done, because this really does
a lot of changes to the ehci-mx6 driver.
Fix cast from pointer to integer of different size by casting the
pointer to uintptr_t instead of uint32_t, the former has correct
size on both 32bit and 64bit architectures.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
There is now multiple copies of CONFIG_MXC_USB_PORTSC in configs set to
PORT_PTS_UTMI | PORT_PTS_PTW, which is in fact the default register value
for MX6, MX7 and MX7ULP. Define the default value of CONFIG_MXC_USB_PORTSC
in the driver and use it in case CONFIG_MXC_USB_PORTSC is not defined in
config, to reduce the duplication.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
In case the platform uses DM, determine port number, which is
used as offset in USBMISC registers, from PHY node DT aliases,
just like Linux does.
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Instead of passing ad-hoc sequence number to usb_oc_config(), pass in
the USB MISC address itself. The USB MISC address comes from DT in DM
case, and from the old method using controller index in non-DM case.
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Split usb_power_config() per SoC and pass in USB PHY, USBNC and ANATOP
addresses instead of ad-hoc sequence numbers. This is only applicable
on legacy systems which do not implement proper PHY support. Once PHY
support is available, parts of this can be removed altogether and moved
to the PHY driver, similar to Linux phy-mxs-usb.c .
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Instead of passing ad-hoc index to USB PHY handling functions and then
try and figure out the PHY address, pass in the PHY address itself. For
DM case, this address comes easily from DT. For non-DM case, the previous
method is still present, however the non-DM case will soon be removed.
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
In order to pass component addresses around easily instead of passing
ad-hoc sequence numbers, it is necessary to split ehci_mx6_common_init().
Make it so and call the separate functions instead.
Since board_ehci_hcd_init() makes no sense in DM case, do not call it
in DM case.
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
In case DM and OF controler is enabled, but PHY support is disabled,
parse USB PHY and MISC component addresses from DT manually. Those
component addresses will be used in subsequent patches to access the
ANATOP, PHY and MISC registers matching the controller and thus get
rid of the ad-hoc controller sequence number mapping.
Fixes: 4de51cc25b ("usb: ehci-mx6: Drop assignment of sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
The fsl,usbphy DT property is deprecated, replace it with phys DT
property and specify #phy-cells, so that the generic PHY framework
can parse the PHY bindings without any extra hacking.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
The fsl,usbphy DT property is deprecated, replace it with phys DT
property and specify #phy-cells, so that the generic PHY framework
can parse the PHY bindings without any extra hacking.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
If realloc() fails, we should free the old buffer.
Fixes: c74cd8bd08: ("efi_loader: capsule: add capsule_on_disk support")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Remove function invocations using the EFI_CALL macro for those
functions that do not have an EFI_ENTRY call in their definition. Such
functions can use u-boot api's which rely on u-boot global data(gd)
pointer. The Arm and RiscV architectures maintain a separate gd
pointer, one for u-boot, and a separate gd for the efi application.
Calling a function through the EFI_CALL macro changes the gd pointer
to that used for the efi application, with u-boot gd being
unavailable. Any function then trying to dereference u-boot's gd will
result in an abort.
Fix this issue by removing the EFI_CALL macro for all of such
functions which do not begin by an EFI_ENTRY function call.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Two external references cannot have the same name:
doc/chromium/overview.rst:5:
WARNING: Duplicate explicit target name: "youtube"
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In reStructured text footnotes are referenced like [1]_.
Add missing underscores.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
As the the SPI flash is probed and is released in each ENV sf function
the env_flash no more need to be static.
This patch move this device handle as local variable of each function and
simplify the associated code (env_flash is never == NULL when
setup_flash_device is called).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Free the SPI resources by calling spi_flash_free() in each env sf
function to avoid issue for other SPI users.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add support of opts erase for env in SPI flash;
this opts is used by command 'env erase'.
This command only fills the env offset by 0x0 (bit flip to 0) and
the saved environment becomes invalid (with bad CRC).
It doesn't erase the sector here to avoid issue when the sector
is larger than the env (i.e. embedded when
CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE > CONFIG_ENV_SIZE).
The needed sector erase will be managed in the next "env save" command,
using the opt ".save", before to update the environment in SPI flash.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add ENV_ERASE_PTR macro to handle erase opts and remove the associated
ifdef.
This patch is a extension of previous commit 82b2f41357 ("env_internal.h:
add alternative ENV_SAVE_PTR macro").
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
This fixes the case where there are multiple environment drivers, one of
them is the default environment one, and it is followed by an environment
driver which does not implement .init() callback. The default environment
driver sets gd->env_valid to ENV_INVALID and returns 0 from its .init()
callback implementation, which is valid behavior for default environment.
Since the subsequent environment driver does not implement .init(), it
also does not modify the $ret variable in the loop. Therefore, the loop
is exited with gd->env_valid=ENV_INVALID and ret=0, which means that the
code further down in env_init() will not reset the environment to the
default one, which is incorrect.
This patch sets the $ret variable back to -ENOENT in case the env_valid
is set to ENV_INVALID by an environment driver, so that the environment
would be correctly reset back to default one, unless a subsequent driver
loads a valid environment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Tested-By: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Since commit 0f036bf4b8 ("env: Warn on force access if ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE set")
a warning message is displayed when setenv -f is used WITHOUT
CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE, but the variable is set anyway, resulting
in lots of log pollution.
env_flags_validate() returns 0 if the access is accepted, or non zero
if it is refused.
So the original code
#ifndef CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
if (flag & H_FORCE)
return 0;
#endif
was correct, it returns 0 (accepts the modification) if forced UNLESS
IGNORE_FORCE is set (in which case access checks in the following code
are applied). The broken patch just added a printf to the force accepted
case.
To obtain the intent of the patch we need this:
if (flag & H_FORCE) {
#ifdef CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
printf("## Error: Can't force access to \"%s\"\n", name);
#else
return 0;
#endif
}
Fixes: 0f036bf4b8 ("env: Warn on force access if ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE set")
Signed-off-by: Martin Fuzzey <martin.fuzzey@flowbird.group>
If one of the reads fails when importing redundant environments (a
single read failure), the env_flags wouldn't get initialized in
env_import_redund(). If a user then calls saveenv, the new environment
will have the wrong flags value. So on the next load the new environment
will be ignored.
While debugging this, I also noticed that env/sf.c was not correctly
handling a single read failure, as it would not check the crc before
assigning it to gd->env_addr.
Having a special error path for when there is a single read failure
seems unnecessary and may lead to future bugs. Instead collapse the
'single read failure' error to be the same as a 'single crc failure'.
That way env_check_redund() either passes or fails, and if it passes we
are guaranteed to have checked the CRC.
Signed-off-by: Brandon Maier <brandon.maier@rockwellcollins.com>
CC: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
CC: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This is roughly the U-Boot side equivalent to commit
e282c422e0 (tools: fw_env: use erasesize from MEMGETINFO ioctl). The
motivation is the case where one has a board with several revisions,
where the SPI flashes have different erase sizes.
In our case, we have an 8K environment, and the flashes have erase
sizes of 4K (newer boards) and 64K (older boards). Currently, we must
set CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE to 64K to make the code work on the older
boards, but for the newer ones, that ends up wasting quite a bit of
time reading/erasing/restoring the last 56K.
At first, I wanted to allow setting CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE to 0 to mean
"use the erase size the chip reports", but that config
option is used in a number of preprocessor conditionals, and shared
between ENV_IS_IN_FLASH and ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH.
So instead, introduce a new boolean config option, which for now can
only be used with ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH. If left off, there's no change
in behaviour.
The only slightly annoying detail is that, when selected, the compiler
is apparently not smart enough to see that the the saved_size and
saved_offset variables are only used under the same "if (sect_size >
CONFIG_ENV_SIZE)" condition as where they are computed, so we need to
initialize them to 0 to avoid "may be used uninitialized" warnings.
On our newer boards with the 4K erase size, saving the environment now
takes 0.080 seconds instead of 0.53 seconds, which directly translates
to that much faster boot time since our logic always causes the
environment to be written during boot.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
As preparation for the next patch, use a local variable to represent
the sector size. No functional change.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
According to latest errata of J721e [1], HS400 mode is not supported
in MMCSD0 subsystem (i2024) and SDR104 mode is not supported in MMCSD1/2
subsystems (i2090). Therefore, replace mmc-hs400-1_8v with mmc-hs200-1_8v
in MMCSD0 subsystem and add a sdhci mask to disable SDR104 speed mode.
Also, update the itap delay values for all the MMCSD subsystems according
the latest J721e data sheet[2]
[1] - https://www.ti.com/lit/er/sprz455/sprz455.pdf
[2] - https://www.ti.com/lit/ds/symlink/tda4vm.pdf
Fixes: 70e167495a ("arm: dts: k3-j721e: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
This adds support for devices with R40 dual rank DRAM, and asymmetric
A64 DRAM devices like the Pinephone/3GB.
Also we enable automatic gzipped kernel support, and allow scripted
DT overlay support. The rest of the patches are cleanups, but also
some sunxi-specific preparatory patches for USB3.0 and improved HDMI
support. The bulk of those changes will go through other trees, though.
Build-tested for all 156 sunxi boards, and boot tested on a A64, A20, R40,
H5, H6 and H616 board. USB, SD card, eMMC, HDMI and Ethernet all work
there (where applicable), with the exception of Ethernet on the H5. Since
this is already broken in v2021.04, I will send a separate fix.
Currently sunxi Makefile manually specifies full path to dw-hdmi common
code. However, that is not needed because it can be selected in Kconfig
instead.
Select proper symbol in Kconfig and drop path from Makefile.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The "booti" command to load arm64 Linux kernels supports automatic
decompression of zipped kernel images, but relies on some environment
variables to point to usable buffer RAM.
Add those variables and let them point to some default values, that
should cover most use-cases.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The FIT description has access to the configuration variables. Use the
appropriate variable instead of hardcoding the address.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
binman can fill in the default FIT configuration index as selected by
the "default-dt" argument, which is set to CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE.
Let's respect the user's configuration by taking advantage of this
feature, instead of always defaulting to the first device tree in
CONFIG_OF_LIST.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The 32kHz clock ("LOSC") on sunxi SoCs is provided by the RTC. It is
used, among other things, by the XHCI controller in the H6. To be able
to call clk_get_bulk() on the XHCI controller, some device needs to
provide all referenced clocks.
Since LOSC is a fixed-rate always-on clock, implementation is trivial.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Previously we do not have proper dual rank memory detection on R40
(because we omitted PIR_QSGATE, which does not work on R40 with our
configuration), and dual rank memory is just simply disabled as early
R40 boards available (Banana Pi M2 Ultra and Berry) have single rank
memory.
As a board with dual rank memory (Forlinx OKA40i-C) is now known to us,
we need to have a way to do memory rank detection to support that board.
Add some routine to detect memory rank by trying to access the memory
in rank 1 and check for error status of the memory controller, and then
enable dual rank memory on R40.
Similar routine can be used to detect half DQ width (which is also
detected by PIR_QSGATE on other SoCs), but it's left unimplemented
because there's no known R40 board with half DQ width now.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
[Andre: Move R40 detect code call into sunxi_dram_init()]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Previously we have known that R40 has a configuration register for its
rank 1, which allows different configuration than rank 0. Reverse
engineering of newest libdram of A64 from Allwinner shows that A64 has
this register too. It's bit 0 (which enables dual rank in rank 0
configuration register) means a dedicated rank size setup is used for
rank 1.
Now, Pine64 scheduled to use a 3GiB LPDDR3 DRAM chip (which has 2GiB
rank 0 and 1GiB rank 1) on PinePhone, that makes asymmetric dual rank
DRAM support necessary.
Add this support. The code could support both A64 and R40, but because
dual rank detection is broken on R40 now, we cannot really use it on R40
currently.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Commit 69076dff22 ("cmd: pxe: add support for FDT overlays") added
support for loading DT overlay files to PXE boot. However, it needs
additional environment variable which points to memory location which
can be used to temporary store overlay data.
Add it and in the process unify alignment using spaces and fix comment.
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
update ls1028aqds networking protocol, config in ls1021atwr, env in ls1012a
Add seli3 board support, booke watchdog, update eTSEC support in ppc-qemu
Add DM_SERIAL and lpuart in sl28, add DM_ETH support for some of powerpc platforms
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
- Minor fix to Apollo Lake devicetree bindings for FSP
- Refactor Designware PCIe drivers to core and SoC parts
- Add Amlogic Meson Designware PCIe controller driver
Add the FMan v3 nodes for the T1042D4RDB. The nodes are copied over with
little modification from the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add the QorIQ DPAA 1 FMan v3 device tree nodes for the T1042 SoC.
The device tree nodes are copied over with little modification
from the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
When two FMan's are present on a board, the MDIO nodes are found at the
same offsets inside each FMan. This causes "non unique device name"
errors when registering the MDIO nodes under the second FMan. Fix this
by updating the offsets of the MDIO nodes to include the parent FMan's
offset.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add the FMan v3 nodes for the T4240RDB. The nodes are copied over with
little modification from the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add the QorIQ DPAA 1 FMan v3 device tree nodes for the T4240 SoC.
The device tree nodes are copied over with little modification
from the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Disable the FMan mEMAC 5 and 6 nodes from the fdt since they are not
available under the supported RCW. Also disable the associated
"fsl,dpa-ethernet" nodes that reference them.
This is a simplified version of the fdt_fixup_fman_ethernet call for
use under DM_ETH.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add the FMan v3 nodes for the T2080RDB. The nodes are copied over with
little modification from the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add the QorIQ DPAA 1 FMan v3 device tree nodes for the T2080 SoC.
The device tree nodes are copied over with little modification from
the Linux kernel source code.
Signed-off-by: Camelia Groza <camelia.groza@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
scan_dev_for_efi is supposed to be called from scan_dev_for_boot.
However, this call is missing for ls1012a boards. As a result EFI
boot doesn’t work. Fix this issue by removing custom definition of
scan_dev_for_boot and use the default definition instead.
Signed-off-by: Mian Yousaf Kaukab <ykaukab@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Sometimes it is desireable to have the console output on the first
serial line. Introduce a configuration option for it (in the board
scope).
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
With all preparations in place, switch over to DM_SERIAL.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Move the CONFIG_DM_* from the defconfig to the TARGET_SL28 config.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
DM_SERIAL needs both the device tree as well as an early heap. Thus, we
have to call spl_early_init() to initialize the memory allocator and the
setup the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
To use the debug UART we have to call debug_uart_init() in the SPL. Do
so as soon as possible.
As an example, here is how you can use it on a LS1028A SoC:
CONFIG_DEBUG_UART=y
CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_BASE=0x21c0500
CONFIG_DEBUG_UART_CLOCK=200000000
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
It is not recommended to use CONFIG_xxx defines for things which are not
Kconfig options. Rename this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
QEMU ppce500 target can dynamically instantiate an eTSEC device
if "-device eTSEC" is given to QEMU. This commit enables eTSEC
driver and the required fixed PHY driver to create a usable
network configuration using eTSEC.
Unlike a real world 85xx board that usually stores the eTSEC MAC
address in an EEPROM, CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR is required for
QEMU otherwise U-Boot ethernet initialization complains no valid
ethernet address is set.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
QEMU ppce500 target can dynamically instantiate an eTSEC device on
a platform bus if "-device eTSEC" is given to QEMU. It is presented
as a "simple-bus" in the device tree, with an additional compatible
string "qemu,platform".
Let's create a virtual memory mapping for it in misc_init_r(), in
preparation to adding eTSEC support.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This adds a test case to verify reading <ranges> of a simple-bus is
working as expected.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present we decode simple bus <ranges> using the following assumption:
- parent #address-cells 1
- child #address-cells 1
- child #size-cells 1
However this might not always be the case.
Update to use fdt_addr_t and fdt_size_t in 'struct simple_bus_plat', and
use fdt_read_ranges() to correctly decode it according to the actual
parent and child #address-cells / #size-cells under a Kconfig option
CONFIG_SIMPLE_BUS_CORRECT_RANGE which can be turned on for any board
that needs it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present the tsec driver uses a non-standard DT bindings to get
its <reg> base / size. The upstream Linux kernel seems to require
the <reg> base / size to be put under a subnode of the eTSEC node
with a name prefix "queue-group". This is not documented in the
kernel DT bindings, but it looks every dtsi file that contains the
eTSEC node was written like this.
This commit updates the tsec driver to handle this case.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present the Freescale TSEC node DT bindings doc requires a <reg>
property in the TSEC node. But this might not always be the case.
In the upstream Linux kernel, there is no DT bindings doc for it
but the kernel driver tests a subnode of a name prefixed with
"queue-group", as we can see from gfar_of_init():
for_each_available_child_of_node(np, child) {
if (!of_node_name_eq(child, "queue-group"))
...
in drivers/net/ethernet/freescale/gianfar.c
Update our DT bindings to describe this alternate description.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
dev_remap_addr() eventually calls dev_read_addr_index(), while
pdata->iobase holds the return value of dev_read_addr() that calls
dev_read_addr_index() too. Such duplication can be avoided by using
map_physmem() directly.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The DSA sandbox driver is used for unit testing the DSA class code.
It implements a simple 2 port switch plus 1 CPU port, and uses a
very simple tag to identify the ports.
The DSA sandbox device is connected via CPU port to a regular Ethernet
sandbox device, called 'dsa-test-eth, managed by the existing eth
sandbox driver. The 'dsa-test-eth' is not intended for testing the
eth class code however, but it is used to emulate traffic through the
'lan0' and 'lan1' front pannel switch ports. To achieve this the dsa
sandbox driver registers a tx handler for the 'dsa-test-eth' device.
The switch ports, labeled as 'lan0' and 'lan1', are also registered
as eth devices by the dsa class code this time. So pinging through
these switch ports is as easy as:
=> setenv ethact lan0
=> ping 1.2.3.5
Unit tests for the dsa class code were also added. The 'dsa_probe'
test exercises most API functions from dsa.h. The 'dsa' unit test
simply exercises ARP/ICMP traffic through the two switch ports,
including tag injection and extraction, with the help of the dsa
sandbox driver.
I took care to minimize the impact on the existing eth unit tests,
though some adjustments needed to be made with the addition of
extra eth interfaces used by the dsa unit tests. The additional eth
interfaces also require MAC addresses, these have been added to the
sandbox default environment.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Message-Id: <20210216224804.3355044-5-olteanv@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Simplify the logic of phy_connect_fixed() by using the new API
ofnode_phy_is_fixed_link(), which brings additional bonus of
supporting the old DT bindings.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present phy_connect_gmii2rgmii() is implemented using a DM API
dev_of_offset() hence it cannot support a non-DM configuration.
Remove the non-DM version prototype of phy_connect_gmii2rgmii()
and make the driver depend on CONFIG_DM_ETH.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Following the same updates that were done to the fixed phy driver,
use ofnode_ APIs instead of fdt_ APIs so that the Xilinx PHY driver
can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In drivers/net/phy/Kconfig, CONFIG_PHY_FIXED already depends on
CONFIG_DM_ETH, so the function prototype definition when
CONFIG_DM_ETH=n does nothing, so it can be dropped. It is also
never reachable, since the whole function is already under #ifdef
CONFIG_PHY_FIXED (which again, as I said, depends on CONFIG_DM_ETH=y).
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Message-Id: <20210216224804.3355044-3-olteanv@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
On systems that use CONFIG_OF_LIVE, the "ofnode" type is defined
as const struct device_node *np, while on the flat DT systems it
is defined as a long of_offset into gd->fdt_blob.
It is desirable that the fixed PHY driver uses the higher-level
ofnode abstraction instead of parsing gd->fdt_blob directly,
because that enables it to work on live OF systems.
The fixed PHY driver has used a nasty hack since its introduction in
commit db40c1aa1c ("drivers/net/phy: add fixed-phy /
fixed-link support"),
which is to pass the long gd->fdt_blob offset inside int phydev->addr
(a value that normally holds the MDIO bus address at which the PHY
responds). Even ignoring the fact that the types were already
mismatched leading to a potential truncation (flat OF offset was
supposed to be a long and not an int), we really cannot extend this
hack any longer, because there's no way an int will hold the other
representation of ofnode, the struct device_node *np.
So we unfortunately need to do the right thing, which is to use the
framework introduced by Grygorii Strashko in
commit eef0b8a930 ("net: phy: add ofnode node to struct phy_device").
This will populate phydev->node for the fixed PHY.
Note that phydev->node will not be valid in the probe function, since
that is called synchronously from phy_device_create and we really have
no way of passing the ofnode directly through the phy_device_create API.
So we do what other drivers do too: we move the OF parsing logic from
the .probe to the .config method of the PHY driver. The new function
will be called at phy_config() time.
I do believe I've converted all the possible call paths for creating
a PHY with PHY_FIXED_ID, so there is really no reason to maintain
compatibility with the old logic of retrieving a flat OF tree offset
from phydev->addr. We just pass 0 to phydev->addr now.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Message-Id: <20210216224804.3355044-2-olteanv@gmail.com>
[bmeng: keep fixedphy_probe(); update mdio-uclass.c to handle fixed phy]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Introduce a helper API ofnode_phy_is_fixed_link() to detect whether
the ethernet controller connects to a fixed-link pseudo-PHY device.
Note there are two ways to describe a fixed PHY attached to an
Ethernet device:
- the new DT binding, where 'fixed-link' is a sub-node of the
Ethernet device
- the old DT binding, where 'fixed-link' is a property with 5
cells encoding various information about the fixed PHY
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Per the upstream Linux kernel doc:
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/net/ethernet-controller.yaml
There are two ways to describe a fixed PHY attached to an Ethernet
device. This updates our dt-bindings doc to add the old DT bindings.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add a driver for the PowerPC Book E watchdog driver that is present on a
number of Freescale/NXP SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The SELI8 design is a new tdm service unit card for Hitachi-Powergrids
XMC and FOX product lines.
It is based on NXP LS1021 SoC and it provides following interfaces:
- IFC interface for NOR, NAND and external FPGA's
- 1 x RGMII ETH for debug purposes
- 2 x SGMII ETH for management communication via back-plane
- 1 x uQE HDLC for management communication via back-plane
- 1 x I2C for peripheral devices
- 1 x SPI for peripheral devices
- 1 x UART for debug logging
It is foreseen that the design will be later re-used for another XMC and
FOX service cards with similar SoC requirements.
Signed-off-by: Rainer Boschung <rainer.boschung@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Signed-off-by: Matteo Ghidoni <matteo.ghidoni@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Includes DT definition for the following serdes protocols using various
PHY cards: 85xx, 13xx, 65xx, 9999, 7777.
Note that the default device tree for QDS now uses 85xx.
Enabling any of the others requires patching the fsl-ls1028a-qds.dtsi
file (the includes at the bottom of the file).
The phy-handle is specified as a path rather than a label because it is
possible to use the #include multiple times (meaning that more than one
PHY riser card of one type is inserted), and therefore, there would be
duplicate labels with the same name.
LBRW means that the board needs lane B rework before using this dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add support for the DW PCIe controller found in the Amlogic Meson AXG and
G12 (G12A, G12B, SM1) SoCs.
This uses the common DW PCIe helpers introducted previously.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
With the introduction of pcie_dw_rockchip, and need to support the DW PCIe in the
Amlogic AXG & G12 SoCs, most of the DW PCIe helpers would be duplicated.
This introduce a "common" DW PCIe helpers file with common code merged from the
dw_ti and dw_rockchip drivers and adapted to fit with the upcoming dw_meson.
The following changes will switch the dw_ti and dw_rockchip to use these helpers.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Green Wan <green.wan@sifive.com>
[bmeng: remove the blank line at EOF of drivers/pci/pcie_dw_common.c]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
An entry is missing in the FSP-S devicetree bindings, and as a result
the description for the next few following entries is off by one line.
Signed-off-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Most modern OpenSSL engines have methods overridden at the EVP level rather
than at RSA level, to make these engines work properly with mkimage, the RSA
signing code needs to switch to using EVP_* APIs as much as possible.
Signed-off-by: Donald Chan <hoiho@lab126.com>
[trini: Rebase on top of keyfile changes]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
OP-TEE images are normally packaged with
type = "tee;
os = "tee";
However, fit_image_load() thinks that is somehow invalid. However if
they were declared as type = "kernel", os = "linux", fit_image_load()
would happily accept them and allow the boot to continue. There is no
technical limitation to excluding "tee".
Allowing "tee" images is useful in a boot flow where OP-TEE is
executed before linux.
In fact, I think it's unintuitive for a "load"ing function to also do
parsing and contain a bunch ad-hoc heuristics that only its caller
might know. But I don't make the rules, I just write fixes. In more
polite terms: refactoring the fit_image API is beyond the scope of
this change.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Consider the following FIT:
images {
whipple {};
};
configurations {
conf-1 {
firmware = "whipple";
};
};
Getting the 'firmware' image with fit_image_load() is not possible, as
it doesn't understand 'firmware =' properties. Although one could pass
IH_TYPE_FIRMWARE for 'image_type', this needs to be converted to a
"firmware" string for FDT lookup -- exactly what this change does.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The 'firmware' property of a config node takes precedence over the
'kernel' property. 'standalone' is deprecated. However, give users a
couple of releases where 'standalone' still works, but warns loudly.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
U-Boot expects the FDT to be located right after the _end
linker symbol (see fdtdec.c: board_fdt_blob_setup())
The "basic" LOAD_FIT path is aware of this limitation, and relocates
the FDT at the expected location. Guessing the expected location
probably only works reliably on 32-bit arm, and it feels like a hack.
One proposal would be to pass the FDT address to u-boot
(e.g. using 'r2' on arm platforms).
The variable is named "fdt_hack" to remind future contributors that,
"hey! we should fix the underlying problem". However, that is beyond
the scope of this patch.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The information on the OS should be contained in the FIT, as the
self-explanatory "os" property of a node under /images. Hard-coding
this to U_BOOT might send us down the wrong path later in the boot
process.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The correct FDT to use is described by the "fdt" property of the
configuration node. When the fit_unamep argument to fit_image_load()
is "fdt", we get the "/images/fdt" node. This is incorrect, as it
ignores the "fdt" property of the config node, and in most cases,
the "/images/fdt" node doesn't exist.
Use NULL for the 'fit_unamep' argument. With NULL, fit_image_load()
uses the IH_TYPE_FLATDT value to read the config property "fdt",
which points to the correct FDT node(s).
fit_image_load() should probably be split into a function that reads
an image by name, and one that reads an image by config reference. I
don't make those decisions, I just point out the craziness.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Several architectures had a default board_fit_config_name_match already;
this provides a generic weak version. We default to rejecting all configs.
This will use the FIT's default config, instead of the first config. This
may result in boot failures if there are multiple configurations and the
first config is *not* the default.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
The new correct way to load an FPGA image is to declare it in the list
of "loadables". multi-with-fpga.its used the now deprecated "fpga"
property. Since this example most likely intended to use u-boot's
generic FPGA loading code, compatible = "u-boot,fpga-legacy" is also
appropriate here.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The "simple" SPL_LOAD_FIT path is the most compliant with the format
documented in doc/uImage.FIT/source_file_format.txt. The other two
paths to load a FIT are SPL_LOAD_FIT_FULL and the "bootm" command.
Since the Kconfig menu is the most likely place for a new user to see
these options, it seems like the most logical candidate to document
the limitations. This documents the _known_ issues, and is not
intended to be a complete list of all follies.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 4afc4f37c7 ("doc: FIT image: Clarify format and simplify
syntax") and delegated FPGA images to be added via the list of
"loadables" in lieu of the "fpga" property. Now actually implement
this in code.
Note that the "compatible" property is ignored for the time being, as
implementing "compatible" loading is beyond the scope of this change.
However, "u-boot,fpga-legacy" is accepted without warning.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Commit 4afc4f37c7 ("doc: FIT image: Clarify format and simplify
syntax") requires that FPGA images be referenced through the
"loadables" in the config node. This means that "fpga" properties in
config nodes are deprecated.
Given that there are likely FIT images which use "fpga", let's not
break those right away. Print a warning message that such use is
deprecated, and give users a couple of releases to update their
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The FPGA loading code in spl_simple_fit_read() can easily be separated
from the rest of the logic. It is split into two functions instead of
one because spl_fit_upload_fpga() is used in a subsequent patch.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 4afc4f37c7 ("doc: FIT image: Clarify format and simplify
syntax") introduced a "compatible" property for loadable images.
It did not define its contents. Use "u-boot,fpga-legacy" compatible
string to specify that fpga_load() should be used to load the image.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
spl_load_fit_image() will try to load an image at the address given
in the "load" property. Absent such property, it uses
image_info->load_addr
Correct use of this is demonstrated in spl_fit_append_fdt(), which
resets the 'load_addr' before each spl_load_fit_image() call.
On the other hand loading "loadables" loop in spl_load_simple_fit()
completely ignores this. It re-uses the same structure, but doesn't
reset load_addr. If loadable [i] does not have a "load" property, its
load address defaults to load_addr, which still contains the address
of loadable [i - 1].
A simple solution is to treat NULL as an invalid load address. The
caller can set load_addr = 0 to request an abort if the "load"
property is absent.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Originally, the ECDSA code path used 'keydir' as the key filename.
mkimage has since been updated to include a new 'keyfile' argument.
Use the new argument for passing in the key.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Keys can be derived from keydir, and the "key-name-hint" property of
the FIT. They can also be specified ad-literam via 'keyfile'. Update
the ECDSA signing path to use the appropriate one.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Keys can be derived from keydir, and the "key-name-hint" property of
the FIT. They can also be specified ad-literam via 'keyfile'. Update
the RSA signing path to use the appropriate one.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It's not always desirable to use 'keydir' and some ad-hoc heuristics
to get the filename of the signing key. More often, just passing the
filename is the simpler, easier, and logical thing to do.
Since mkimage doesn't use long options, we're slowly running out of
letters. I've chosen '-G' because it was available.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
After lots of debating, this documents how we'd like mkimage to treat
'keydir' and 'keyfile' arguments. The rest is in the docs.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a test to make sure that the ECDSA signatures generated by
mkimage can be verified successfully. pyCryptodomex was chosen as the
crypto library because it integrates much better with python code.
Using openssl would have been unnecessarily painful.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We wish to use pycryptodomex to verify code paths involving ECDSA
signatures. Add it to requirements.txt so that they get picked up
automatically .gitlab and .azure tasks
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
mkimage supports rsa2048, and rsa4096 signatures. With newer silicon
now supporting hardware-accelerated ECDSA, it makes sense to expand
signing support to elliptic curves.
Implement host-side ECDSA signing and verification with libcrypto.
Device-side implementation of signature verification is beyond the
scope of this patch.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
fdt_add_bignum() is useful for algorithms other than just RSA. To
allow its use for ECDSA, move it to a common file under lib/.
The new file is suffixed with '-libcrypto' because it has a direct
dependency on openssl. This is due to the use of the "BIGNUM *" type.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
rsa-checksum.c sontains the hash_calculate() implementations. Despite
the "rsa-" file prefix, this function is useful for other algorithms.
To prevent confusion, move this file to lib/, and rename it to
hash-checksum.c, to give it a more "generic" feel.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In case exit is called in a script without parameter, the command
returns -2 ; in case exit is called with a numerical parameter,
the command returns -2 and lower. This leads to the following problem:
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit 1' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
0
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit 0' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
0
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit -2' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
0
That is, no matter what the 'exit' command argument is, the return
value is always 0 and so it is not possible to use script return
value in subsequent tests.
Fix this and simplify the exit command such that if exit is called with
no argument, the command returns 0, just like 'true' in cmd/test.c. In
case the command is called with any argument that is positive integer,
the argument is set as return value.
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit 1' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
1
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit 0' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
0
=> setenv foo 'echo bar ; exit -2' ; run foo ; echo $?
bar
0
Note that this does change ABI established in 2004 , although it is
unclear whether that ABI was originally OK or not.
Fixes: c26e454dfc
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Pantelis Antoniou <pantelis.antoniou@konsulko.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Call the translation function on the ofnode_read_resource result only
when the livetree is not activated.
Today of_address_to_resource() calls ofnode_read_resource() for livetree
support and fdt_get_resource() when livetree is not supported.
The fdt_get_resource() doesn't do the address translation
so when it is required when livetree is activated but this address
translation is already done by ofnode_read_resource().
Fixes: 240720e905 ("firmware: scmi: mailbox/smt agent device")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
This is the only driver that uses this function. Update it to use the
alternative which is dm_gpio_clrset_flags().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
Select CMD_QFW and QFW_MMIO in the qemu-arm board (covers arm and
arm64).
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add MMIO driver for QFW.
Note that there is no consumer as of this patch.
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
A sandbox driver and test are added for the qfw uclass, and a test in
QEMU added for qfw functionality to confirm it doesn't break in real
world use.
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
We move qfw into its own uclass and split the PIO functions into a
specific driver for that uclass. The PIO driver is selected in the
qemu-x86 board config (this covers x86 and x86_64).
include/qfw.h is cleaned up and documentation added.
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Align the MMU area for SCMI shared buffer on section size;
use the ALIGN macro in mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour call.
Since commit d877f8fd0f ("arm: provide a function for boards init
code to modify MMU virtual-physical map") the parameter of
mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour need to be MMU_SECTION_SIZE
aligned.
Fixes: 240720e905 ("firmware: scmi: mailbox/smt agent device")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Skip the processing of *.aml and *.dat files while iterating through the
source in order to process header files.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
strn(cat|cpy) has a bad habit of not nul-terminating the destination,
resulting in constructions like
strncpy(foo, bar, sizeof(foo) - 1);
foo[sizeof(foo) - 1] = '\0';
However, it is very easy to forget about this behavior and accidentally
leave a string unterminated. This has shown up in some recent coverity
scans [1, 2] (including code recently touched by yours truly).
Fortunately, the guys at OpenBSD came up with strl(cat|cpy), which always
nul-terminate strings. These functions are already in U-Boot, so we should
encourage new code to use them instead of strn(cat|cpy).
[1] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-March/442888.html
[2] https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2021-January/438073.html
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This fixes several uses of strn(cpy|cat) which did not terminate their
destinations properly.
Fixes de1728ce4c ("fastboot: Allow u-boot-style partitions")
Reported-by: Coverity Scan
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This test is adapted from glibc, which is very concerned about alignment.
It also tests strlcpy by dependency.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This introduces strlcat, which provides a safer interface than strncat. It
never copies more than its size bytes, including the terminating nul. In
addition, it never reads past dest[size - 1], even if dest is not
nul-terminated.
This also removes the stub for dwc3 now that we have a proper
implementation.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
strlcpy should always return the number of bytes copied. We were
accidentally missing the nul-terminator. We also always used to return a
non-zero value, even if we did not actually copy anything.
Fixes: 23cd138503 ("Integrate USB gadget layer and USB CDC driver layer")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Right now the error messages when optee has a version mismatch or shared
memory is not configured are done with a debug().
That's not very convenient since you have to enable debugging to figure
out what's going on, although this is an actual error.
So let's switch the debug() -> dev_err() and report those explicitly.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
serial_reinit_all() is only available if CONFIG_SERIAL is defined (i.e.
!CONFIG_DM_SERIAL).
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
stdio_dev methods have taken a pointer to themselves since 709ea543
(nearly 7 years ago).
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for rtc3028 rtc from microcrystal.
based on linux dirver:
commit a38fd8748464: ("Linux 5.12-rc2")
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add local variables agent0/agent1 to refer to SCMI sandbox context
agent and ease readability of the test.
For consistency, rename regul_dev to regul0_dev and remove sandbox_voltd
in dm_test_scmi_voltage_domains().
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix inline comments and empty line in scmi driver and test files.
Remove test on IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_*_SCMI) in test/dm/scmi.c since these
configuration are expected enabled when CONFIG_FIRMWARE_SCMI is enabled
in sandbox configuration.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Implement voltage regulators interfaced by the SCMI voltage domain
protocol. The DT bindings are defined in the Linux kernel since
SCMI voltage domain and regulators patches [1] and [2] integration
in v5.11-rc7.
Link: [1] 0f80fcec08
Link: [2] 2add5cacff
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The gpt command require the GPT backup header at the standard location
at the end of the device. Check the alternate LBA value before reading
the GPT backup header from the last usable LBA of the device.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Herbrechtsmeier <stefan.herbrechtsmeier@weidmueller.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If there were no variable substitutions in a command, then initial
assignments would be misinterpreted as commands, instead of being skipped
over. This is demonstrated by the following example:
=> foo=bar echo baz
Unknown command 'foo=bar' - try 'help'
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
For all other erase failures, the fail_addr is updated with the
failing address. Only in the case of erase failure due to bad block
detection, the fail_addr is not updated. This change simply updates
the fail_addr for this specific scenario so that it is consistent with
the rest of the code.
Signed-off-by: Farhan Ali <farhan.ali@broadcom.com>
On ARMv8 systems
load mmc 0:1 $loadaddr vmlinuz-5.10.0-3-arm64
booti
leads to a hanging system requiring to physically reset the system:
FDT and ATAGS support not compiled in - hanging
### ERROR ### Please RESET the board ###
For systems where physical access is difficult hanging is a poor choice.
It is preferable to reset the system when U-Boot reaches a state that is
not recoverable.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Similar to support for SHA1 and SHA256, allow the use of hardware hashing
engine by enabling the algorithm and setting CONFIG_SHA_HW_ACCEL /
CONFIG_SHA_PROG_HW_ACCEL.
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
Checkpatch complains about:
ERROR: "foo * bar" should be "foo *bar"
and
CHECK: Alignment should match open parenthesis
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
The optee_copy_fdt_nodes is only used to copy op-tee nodes
of U-Boot device tree (from gd->fdt_blob when OF_LIVE is not activated)
to external device tree but it is not compatible with OF_LIVE.
This patch migrates all used function fdt_ functions to read node on
old_blob to ofnode functions, compatible with OF_LIVE and remove this
parameter "old_blob".
The generated "device tree" is checked on stm32mp platform with OF_LIVE
activated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add power_max77696_init() function.
Since warp doesn't support DM, the keeping its code in board file is
better than maintainig the file of driver.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The test adds two pinmux nodes to the device tree, one to test when a
register changes only one pin's mux (pinctrl-single,pins), and the other
to test when more than one pin's mux is changed (pinctrl-single,bits).
This required replacing the controller's register access functions when
the driver is used on sandbox.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It allows to display the muxing of a given pin. Inspired by more recent
versions of the Linux driver, in addition to the address and the value
of the configuration register I added the pin function retrieved from
the DT. In doing so, the information displayed does not depend on the
platform, being a generic type driver, and it can be useful for debug
purposes.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The configuration of pinmux registers was implemented with duplicate
code which can be removed by adding two functions for read/write access.
Access to 8-bit registers has also been added.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The patch is inspired by more recent versions of the Linux driver.
Replacing the default value 0xffffffff of the function mask with 0 is
certainly more conservative in case the "pinctrl-single,function-mask"
DT property is missing.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In more recent versions of the Linux kernel the driver's probe function
returns an error if the "pinctrl-single,register-width" DT property is
missing. The lack of this information, in fact, does not allow to know
whether to access the registers of the controller at 8, 16, ... bits.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use dev_read_addr_size to get size of the controller's register area.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The dev_dbg(dev, " reg/val 0x%pa/0x%08x\n", ®, val); prints the 'reg'
address preceded by the prefix 0x0x instead of 0x. This because the
printf '%pa' format specifier already prepends the prefix '0x' to the
address displayed.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The pinmux configuration DT node of a peripheral does not define a
physical address but an offset. Only by adding it to the base address of
the controller it is possible to calculate the physical address of the
register to be configured. Printing an offset also requires a different
formatting option than a physical address.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The 'n' variable is used as a loop counter, not as a physical address,
and is used in a comparison with an int. So it makes sense to change
its type from phys_addr_t to int.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
A previous patch had removed the GPIO nodes from being built
into the SPL Device tree, but CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT remained
which makes the MMC card detect fail and the board does not boot.
Fix this by disabling CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT.
Fixes: 6f1efe81aa ("configs: omap3/35_logic and omap3/35_logic_somlv: Reduce SPL size")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
- rk3399 eDP support
- pwm backlight without a known period_ns
- add Chrome OS EC PWM driver
- Kconfig SIMPLE_PANEL DM_GPIO dependency
- remove mb862xx driver remnants
- fix KiB format in reserve_video() debug trace
- fix tegra124 sor CSTM LVDS_EN_ENABLE/DISABLE config
- fix line padding calculation for 16 and 24 BPP bitmaps
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Each row in the pixel array in the bitmap file is padded
if necessary so the row size is always a multiple of 4 bytes.
In current code the complement of row size to a multiple of
4 bytes is further unnecessarily multiplied by the pixel size.
This results in incorrect displaying of bitmaps having row size
that is not a multiple of 4 bytes. Fix this by removing
the unnecessary multiplication.
Tested with 24BPP bitmap and XRGB32 display.
Signed-off-by: Sylwester Nawrocki <s.nawrocki@samsung.com>
Tested-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Bitwise OR has a higher operator precedence than the ternary conditional.
Add the missing parentheses.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Update the debug trace for the reserved video memory to KB as indicated
in the message with "%luk"; before the patch the computed size
gd->relocaddr - addr is in bytes.
This patch aligns the debug trace in reserve_video() with others
functions, for example on stm32mp157c-dk2:
- Reserving 3080192k for video at: dfd00000
+ Reserving 3008k for video at: dfd00000
Reserving 873k for U-Boot at: dfc25000
Reserving 32776k for malloc() at: ddc23000
Reserving 72 Bytes for Board Info at: ddc22fb0
Reserving 280 Bytes for Global Data at: ddc22e90
Reserving 119072 Bytes for FDT at: ddc05d70
Reserving 0x278 Bytes for bootstage at: ddc05af0
Fixes: 5630d2fbc5 ("board: Show memory for frame buffers")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
drivers/video/mb862xx.c was removed in commit
9c1e098fb9 from December 2020, however, this
last little remnant in drivers/video/cfb_console.c remained.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
SIMPLE_PANEL currently only depends on PANEL && BACKLIGHT, but the code
makes references to dm_gpio_set_value and gpio_request_by_name. These
are defined in drivers/gpio/gpio-uclass.c, so a dependency on DM_GPIO
corrects these link errors:
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: drivers/built-in.o: in function `simple_panel_set_backlight':
/home/kameliya/u-boot/drivers/video/simple_panel.c:42: undefined reference to `dm_gpio_set_value'
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: drivers/built-in.o: in function `simple_panel_enable_backlight':
/home/kameliya/u-boot/drivers/video/simple_panel.c:27: undefined reference to `dm_gpio_set_value'
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: drivers/built-in.o: in function `simple_panel_of_to_plat':
/home/kameliya/u-boot/drivers/video/simple_panel.c:72: undefined reference to `gpio_request_by_name'
This issue is only exposed if you have a board which enables
CONFIG_DM_VIDEO without CONFIG_DM_GPIO; so far, none do, but soon a QEMU
board may.
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
This PWM is used in rk3399-gru-bob and rk3399-gru-kevin to control
the display brightness. We can only change the duty cycle, so on
set_config() we just try to match the duty cycle that dividing duty_ns
by period_ns gives us. To disable, we set the duty cycle to zero while
keeping the old value for when we want to re-enable it.
The cros_ec_set_pwm_duty() function is taken from Depthcharge's
cros_ec_set_bl_pwm_duty() but modified to use the generic pwm type.
The driver itself is very loosely based on rk_pwm.c for the general pwm
driver structure.
The devicetree binding file is from Linux, before it was converted to
YAML at 5df5a577a6b4 ("dt-bindings: pwm: Convert google,cros-ec-pwm.txt
to YAML format") in their repo.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The PWM device provided by Chrome OS EC doesn't really support anything
other than setting a relative duty cycle. To support it as a backlight,
this patch makes the PWM period optional in the device tree and pretends
the valid brightness range is its period_ns.
Also adds a sandbox test for a PWM channel that has a fixed period,
checking that the resulting duty_cycle matches on a set_config() even if
the requested period_ns can't be set.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove them. As the P5020 is the last ARCH_P5020 platform, remove that
support as well.
Cc: Andy Fleming <afleming@gmail.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC, along with other
DM conversions, by the deadline. Remove them.
Cc: Dirk Eibach <dirk.eibach@gdsys.cc>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC, along with other
DM conversions, by the deadline. Remove them.
Cc: Dirk Eibach <dirk.eibach@gdsys.cc>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Ilya Yanok <yanok@emcraft.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it. It is also the only ARCH_T2081 board so remove that support
as well.
Cc: Shengzhou Liu <Shengzhou.Liu@nxp.com>
Cc: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Otavio Salvador <otavio@ossystems.com.br>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Jason Liu <jason.hui.liu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove them.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Paul Kocialkowski <contact@paulk.fr>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Thomas Weber <weber@corscience.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
These boards have not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline.
Remove them.
Cc: Steve Rae <steve.rae@raedomain.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Erik van Luijk <evanluijk@interact.nl>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Jon Mason <jon.mason@broadcom.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Eddy Petrișor <eddy.petrisor@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Linus Walleij <linus.walleij@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The mvsata_ide driver was due for DM conversion by v2019.07. As that
has long passed, remove the driver and disable it in the boards which
had enabled it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. In order to
convert to using the DWC SATA driver under DM further migrations are
required.
Cc: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Cc: Akshay Bhat <akshaybhat@timesys.com>
Cc: Ken Lin <Ken.Lin@advantech.com.tw>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The dwc ahsata driver is written such that CONFIG_BLK must be enabled,
add this as a dependency in Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Enable the AHCI and BLK features to complete migration of various
drivers.
Cc: Andrew F. Davis <afd@ti.com>
Cc: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Although ptr arithmetics are allowed with extensions in gcc, they
are not allowed by the C spec. So switch to (void *)(uintptr_t) instead
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Show short arguments along with long arguments in online help:
$ tools/mkeficapsule -h
Usage: mkeficapsule [options] <output file>
Options:
-f, --fit <fit image> new FIT image file
-r, --raw <raw image> new raw image file
-i, --index <index> update image index
-I, --instance <instance> update hardware instance
-K, --public-key <key file> public key esl file
-D, --dtb <dtb file> dtb file
-O, --overlay the dtb file is an overlay
-h, --help print a help message
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Fix the build warning when building for 32 bit systems by using the
length modifier for size_t.
lib/efi_loader/efi_esrt.c: In function ‘efi_esrt_populate’:
include/efi_loader.h:126:8: warning: format ‘%ld’ expects argument of type ‘long int’, but argument 8 has type ‘size_t’ {aka ‘unsigned int’} [-Wformat=]
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Enable building of the crypto helper functions used during capsule
authentication by selecting IMAGE_SIGN_INFO.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
* UEFI spec 2.9 introduced a new memory type EFI_UNACCEPTED_MEMORY_TYPE.
Add it to enum EFI_MEMORY_TYPE.
* Add missing EFI_MEMORY_CPU_CRYPTO constant
* Improve description of EFI_PERSISTENT_MEMORY_TYPE
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Replace static function efi_get_device_handle_info() by a simplified
function efi_get_device_path_text() avoiding EFI_CALL().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Since that invlolves external projects and not only U-Boot, add guidance
for supported platforms
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Avoid 'make htmldocs' build warnings:
./include/linker_lists.h:224: warning:
Function parameter or member '_type' not described in 'll_entry_ref'
./include/linker_lists.h:224: warning:
Function parameter or member '_name' not described in 'll_entry_ref'
./include/linker_lists.h:224: warning:
Function parameter or member '_list' not described in 'll_entry_ref'
Fixes: 851144350b ("linker_lists: Allow use in data structures")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
* Avoid a warning: "Incorrect use of kernel-doc format".
* Remove duplicate text.
* Clarify usage of EFI_SETTING_VIRTUAL_ADDRESS_MAP.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now file_fat_detectfs() did not detect some interface types like
EFI, HOST, VIRTIO.
Avoid duplicate code by calling blk_get_if_type_name().
The interface type now will be shown in lower case to match all other use
cases.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
get_var() is defined statically in efi_bootmgr.c and doesn't properly
check a buffer allocation. Remove it completely and use the exported
function from efi_var_common.c that does the same thing
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Document the command line options for efidebug and initrd loading
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Rewiewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In order to ensure that the VOP registers are in correct state,
add missing support for the VOP reset lines found in the device-tree
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
In order to ensure that the eDP registers are in correct state,
add missing support for the eDP reset lines found in the device-tree.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
The debug string printing the device name, framebuffer address and of node
is using %lu as format for the framebuffer address, which is not so nice.
Change it to %lx.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
In the code, the default polarity is set to positive/positive,
which is neither normal polarity or inverted polarity. It's
only the hardware default. This leads to booting linux with
wrong polarity setting.
Update the code to use PWM_DUTY_POSTIVE | PWM_INACTIVE_NEGATIVE
by default instead.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
- uboot rockchip edp code is looking for a rockchip,panel property
for the edp dts node, so add it.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
When booting with EFI and graphics, the memory used for framebuffer
has to be reserved, otherwise it may leads to kernel memory
overwrite.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
The linux code is setting polarity configuration to 3 but
uboot code is setting it to 1. Change the configuration to match the
linux configuration
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
According to linux commit "drm/rockchip: analogix_dp: add rk3399 eDP
support" (82872e42bb1501dd9e60ca430f4bae45a469aa64), rk3288 and rk3399
eDP IPs are nearly the same, the difference is in the grf register
(SOC_CON6 versus SOC_CON20). So, change the code to use the right
register on each IP.
The clocks don't seem to be the same, the eDP clock is not at index 1
on rk3399, so don't try changing the clock at index 1 to rate 0 on
rk3399.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
The current code is using an hard coded enum and the of node reg value of
endpoint to find out if the endpoint is mipi/hdmi/lvds/edp/dp. The order
is different between rk3288, rk3399 vop little, rk3399 vop big.
A possible solution would be to make sure that the rk3288.dtsi and
rk3399.dtsi files have "expected" reg value or an other solution is
to find the kind of endpoint by comparing the endpoint compatible value.
This patch is implementing the more flexible second solution.
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Patard <arnaud.patard@rtp-net.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Add rt-thread art-pi board support based on STM32H750 SoC
Add Engicam i.Core STM32MP1 SoM
Add FIP header support for STM32programmer
Update uart number when no serial device found for STM32MP1
Remove board_check_usb_power function when ADC flag is not set
Update SPL size limitation for STM32MP1
Set soc_type, soc_pkg, soc_rev env variables for STM32MP1
Split up get_soc_name(), clean the decoding up a bit, and set up
environment variables which contain the SoC type, package, revision.
This is useful on SoMs, where multiple SoC options are populated.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
A now removed comment promises to "limit SYSRAM usage to first 128 KB".
This would imply that only SYSRAM from 0x2ffc0000 - 0x2ffe0000 would be
used. This is not what happens at all.
First, SPL_MAX_SIZE is referenced from SPL_TEXT_BASE, which on all
existing configs is set to 0x2ffc2500, not SYSRAM_BASE (0x2ffc0000).
Some of it is in the first 128 KiB and some of it is in the second
128 KiB chunk of SYSRAM.
Second, SPL_MAX_SIZE, does not restrict the BSS size. While a valiant
attempt is made via SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE, the value of 0x00100000 is much
larger than SYSRAM, and doesn't account for the non-BSS sections.
Because we're putting the .text and .bss in the same boat, the correct
way to limit them together is via SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT. With the current
SPL_TEXT_BASE, we couldn't limit even a very basic SPL to the first
128 KiB, and there is no technical reason to do so. Because of this,
simply allow the SPL to use all SYSRAM.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR is only used on a few mach- linker scripts.
stm32mp1 uses the generic script under arch/arm/cpu/u-boot-spl.lds,
which does not make use of this definition.
The SPL BSS starts in SRAM, right after .text, .rodata, .data, and
.u_boot_list. A very short version of the STM32MP1 memory map is:
* SYSRAM: 2ffc0000 - 30000000 <- all of SPL is here
* DRAM: c0000000+
0xC0200000 is a DRAM address, and has nothing to do with SPL. It is
just very misleading to have it next to CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE, or to
have it at all.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Since commit 03f1f78a9b ("spl: fit: Prefer a malloc()'d buffer for
loading images"), FIT images must be malloc()'d before being loaded.
The old size of 1 MiB is suitable for FIT images with u-boot and an
FDT, but something containing a linux kernel is almost sure to fail.
It's safe to extend malloc all the way to 0xc2000000, but no further.
Linux likes to be loaded at 0xc2000000, so we use that as our cutoff
point. This gives us 29 MiB of malloc() space, which suited for more
complex FIT images including several DTBs, kernel, and OP-TEE images.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Simplify the code of the function board_check_usb_power
based in CONFIG_ADC and adc_measurement; the function is removed by the
linker when the CONFIG_ADC is not activated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Replace the remaining printf in setup_boot_mode() by log macro
to handle filtering for log features.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Align the uart number in the trace of setup_boot_mode() with the name of
the uart/usart device (start at 1) and not with the instance value
(start at 0), i.e. the serial device sequence number and the index in
serial_addr[].
Fixes: f49eb16c17 ("stm32mp: stm32prog: replace alias by serial
device sequence number")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add support of TF-A FIP header in command stm32prog for all the boot
partition and not only the STM32IMAGE.
This patch is a preliminary patch to support FIP as second boot stage
after TF-A BL2 when CONFIG_TFABOOT is activated for trusted boot chain.
The FIP is archive binary loaded by TF-A BL2, which contains the secure OS
= OP-TEE and the non secure firmware and device tree = U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
7" OF is a capacitive touch 7" Open Frame panel solutions with
- 7" AUO B101AW03 LVDS panel
- EDT, FT5526 Touch
MicroGEA STM32MP1 is a STM32MP157A based Micro SoM.
MicroDev 2.0 is a general purpose miniature carrier board with CAN,
LTE and LVDS panel interfaces.
MicroGEA STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of MicroDev 2.0 board with
pluged 7" OF for creating complete MicroGEA STM32MP1 MicroDev 2.0
7" Open Frame Solution board.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <1d278204cbaa> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam MicroGEA STM32MP1
MicroDev 2.0 7" OF")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
MicroDev 2.0 is a general purpose miniature carrier board with CAN,
LTE and LVDS panel interfaces.
Genaral features:
- Ethernet 10/100
- USB Type A
- Audio Out
- microSD
- LVDS panel connector
- Wifi/BT (option)
- UMTS LTE with sim connector (option)
MicroGEA STM32MP1 is a STM32MP157A based Micro SoM.
MicroGEA STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of this MicroDev 2.0 board
for creating complete MicroGEA STM32MP1 MicroDev 2.0 Carrier board.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <f838dae7afd0> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam MicroGEA STM32MP1
MicroDev 2.0 board")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
MicroGEA STM32MP1 is a STM32MP157A based Micro SoM.
General features:
- STM32MP157AAC
- Up to 1GB DDR3L-800
- 512MB Nand flash
- I2S
MicroGEA STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of Engicam MicroDev carrier
boards for creating complete platform solutions.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <0be81dfaeaf8> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam MicroGEA STM32MP1
SoM")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Engicam C.TOUCH 2.0 is an EDIMM compliant general purpose Carrier
board.
Genaral features:
- Ethernet 10/100
- Wifi/BT
- USB Type A/OTG
- Audio Out
- CAN
- LVDS panel connector
i.Core STM32MP1 is an EDIMM SoM based on STM32MP157A from Engicam.
i.Core STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of this Carrier board for
creating complete i.Core STM32MP1 C.TOUCH 2.0 board.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <6ca2898df59f> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam i.Core STM32MP1
C.TOUCH 2.0")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Engicam EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit is an EDIMM 2.2 Form Factor Capacitive
Evaluation Board.
Genaral features:
- LCD 7" C.Touch
- microSD slot
- Ethernet 1Gb
- Wifi/BT
- 2x LVDS Full HD interfaces
- 3x USB 2.0
- 1x USB 3.0
- HDMI Out
- Mini PCIe
- MIPI CSI
- 2x CAN
- Audio Out
i.Core STM32MP1 is an EDIMM SoM based on STM32MP157A from Engicam.
i.Core STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of this Evaluation board for
creating complete i.Core STM32MP1 EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit.
Linux dts commit details:
commit <adc0496104b6> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam i.Core STM32MP1
EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
i.Core STM32MP1 is an EDIMM SoM based on STM32MP157A from Engicam.
General features:
- STM32MP157A
- Up to 1GB DDR3L
- 4GB eMMC
- 10/100 Ethernet
- USB 2.0 Host/OTG
- I2S
- MIPI DSI to LVDS
- rest of STM32MP157A features
i.Core STM32MP1 needs to mount on top of Engicam baseboards
for creating complete platform solutions.
Linux commit details:
commit <30f9a9da4ee1> ("ARM: dts: stm32: Add Engicam i.Core STM32MP1
SoM")
Add support for it.
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
strsep will change data from original memory address,
in case the memory is in non-sdram/sram place, will
run into a bug(hang at SDRAM: )
just add a temporary array to store bank_name[] to fix this
bug.
Signed-off-by: dillon min <dillon.minfei@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This patchset has following changes:
- introduce stm32h750.dtsi to support stm32h750 value line
- add pin groups for usart3/uart4/spi1/sdmmc2
- add stm32h750i-art-pi.dtb (arch/arm/boot/dts/Makefile)
- add stm32h750i-art-pi.dts to support art-pi board
- add stm32h750i-art-pi-u-boot.dtsi to support art-pi board (u-boot)
art-pi board component:
- 8MiB qspi flash
- 16MiB spi flash
- 32MiB sdram
- ap6212 wifi&bt&fm
the detail board information can be found at:
https://art-pi.gitee.io/website/
Signed-off-by: dillon min <dillon.minfei@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Some instances are missing in current support of stm32h743 MCU. This commit
adds usart3/uart4 and sdmmc2 support.
Signed-off-by: dillon min <dillon.minfei@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This patch is intend to add support stm32h750 value line,
just add stm32h7-pinctrl.dtsi for extending, with following changes:
- rename stm32h743-pinctrl.dtsi to stm32h7-pinctrl.dtsi
- move 'pin-controller' from stm32h7-pinctrl.dtsi to stm32h743.dtsi
- update stm32h743i-{disco, eval}.dts to include stm32h7-pinctrl.dtsi
Signed-off-by: dillon min <dillon.minfei@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
As different boards has their own sdram hw connection, mount different
sdram modules, so move sdram timing parameter and pin configuration
to their board device tree.
Signed-off-by: dillon min <dillon.minfei@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This reverts the arch/arm/mach-imx/imx_bootaux.c changes of commit
805b3cac1e. The loader function name was changed so that it does
not clash with the generically available function in lib/elf.c.
imx-bootaux loads an elf file linked for an auxilary core. Thus the
loader function requires address translation from the auxilary core's
address space to where those are mapped into U-Boot's address space.
So the elf loader is specific and must not be replaced with a generic
loader which doesn't provide the address translation functionality.
Fixes commit 805b3cac1e ("lib: elf: Move the generic elf
loading/validating functions to lib")
Signed-off-by: Max Krummenacher <max.krummenacher@toradex.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Pass "pfuze3000@8" in pmic_get() so that the PMIC node can
be found in the devicetree.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Some board like imx8mm-evkb, IO voltage switch from 3.3v to 1.8v need
around 18ms, common code only delay 10ms, so need to delay extra 8ms.
Otherwise voltage switch will timeout when wait for data0 line.
This IO voltage switch time depends on board design, depend on the
PMIC and capacitance. imx8mm-evkb board use PCA9450(PMIC) and 10uF
capacitance.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Common code already handle the voltage switch sequence based on spec,
so remove the redundant voltage switch code.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
sel_input value for the following uart5 pins is
different between i.MX6UL and i.MX6ULL:
MX6_PAD_UART5_TX_DATA__UART5_DTE_RX
MX6_PAD_UART5_RX_DATA__UART5_DCE_RX
MX6_PAD_ENET1_RX_EN__UART5_DCE_RTS
MX6_PAD_ENET1_TX_DATA0__UART5_DTE_RTS
MX6_PAD_CSI_DATA02__UART5_DCE_RTS
As sel_input value for the second one is fixed by
the previous commit, fix the rest.
Signed-off-by: Yuichiro Goto <goto@k-tech.co.jp>
Document SRC_GPR10 PERSIST_SECONDARY_BOOT functionality. This is useful for
reliable bootloader A/B updates, as it permits switching between two copies
of bootloader at different offsets of the same storage. The switch happens
in case one copy is corrupted OR can be enforced by user. This functionality
is present at least since i.MX53, however is poorly documented in all known
SoC datasheets, hence this document aims to clarify the usage, currently on
i.MX7D and i.MX8MM.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de> # Original MX7D work, this document
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io> # All the MX8M work
Cc: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Cc: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Cc: Jan Kiszka <jan.kiszka@siemens.com>
Cc: Ludwig Zenz <lzenz@dh-electronics.com>
Cc: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Enabled "fsl,legacy-bch-geometry" in U-Boot device tree overlay
to match the legacy BCH geometry layout, which mainline Linux
applies when "fsl,use-minimum-ecc" is not specified in the device
tree.
Reinstated SYS_NAND_ONFI_DETECTION, which when disabled, masked
the mismatch on SOMs with Winbond NAND flash chips.
Signed-off-by: Niel Fourie <lusus@denx.de>
Convert the Olimex Olinuxino board's support for MMC to driver model following
Fabio Estevam's excellent example from:
commit: 23013aa961:
mx23evk: Convert to driver model
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
Add the dts file for the Olimex Olinuxino from the linux kernel, and enable
its use in this machine's defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Trevor Woerner <twoerner@gmail.com>
For FSL_USDHC, it do not implement VENDORSPEC_CKEN/PEREN/HCKEN/IPGEN, these
are reserved bits. Instead, use VENDORSPEC_FRC_SDCLK_ON to gate on/off the
card clock output.
After commit b5874b552f ("mmc: fsl_esdhc_imx: add wait_dat0() support"),
we meet SD3.0 card can't work at UHS mode, mmc_switch_voltage() fail because
the second mmc_wait_dat0 return -ETIMEDOUT. According to SD spec, during
voltage switch, need to gate off/on the card clock. If not set the FRC_SDCLK_ON,
after CMD11, hardware will gate off the card clock automatically, so card do
not detect the clock off/on behavior, so will draw the data0 line low until
next command.
Fixes: b5874b552f ("mmc: fsl_esdhc_imx: add wait_dat0() support")
Tested-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Enable DM block, DM MMC and DM SATA support on iMX6 Udoo
convert board code to match the DM support.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <fabio.estevam@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
It doesn't make much sense to have two separate configs for
the riotboard so let's merge the SPL config into the main one
for less duplication.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Cc: "Eric Bénard" <eric@eukrea.com>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <fabio.estevam@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
While initializing dram in spl_dram_init(), mdelay() is called that in
order calls get_ticks() that verifies if timer exists, if doesn't, it
throws a panic(), but since preloader_console_init() has still not been
called those panic()s will fail. This doesn't help debugging, so let's
setup console before calling spl_dram_init() by moving it after
spl_dram_init().
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
While initializing dram in spl_dram_init(), mdelay() is called that in
order calls get_ticks() that verifies if timer exists, if doesn't, it
throws a panic(), but since preloader_console_init() has still not been
called those panic()s will fail. This doesn't help debugging, so let's
setup console before calling spl_dram_init() by moving it after
spl_dram_init().
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
While initializing dram in spl_dram_init(), mdelay() is called that in
order calls get_ticks() that verifies if timer exists, if doesn't, it
throws a panic(), but since preloader_console_init() has still not been
called those panic()s will fail. This doesn't help debugging, so let's
setup console before calling spl_dram_init() by moving it after
spl_dram_init().
Signed-off-by: Giulio Benetti <giulio.benetti@benettiengineering.com>
Fix an URL for downloading the SCFW binary for an Apalis iMX8X
and improve u-boot image build instructions.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Since Toradex provides the full set of overlays for Linux kernel
for display interfaces for both Apalis iMX6Q and Colibri iMX6DL
modules, the video= settings are obsolete. Remove them.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
All the other boards have tdxargs specified for setting manual kernel
command-line arguments. Add them also to NAND-based boards.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Schenker <philippe.schenker@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
commit 03f1f78a9b ("spl: fit: Prefer a malloc()'d buffer for loading images")'
changed the way buffer allocation worked for SPL to a more flexible
method.
For venice this caused breakage that is resolved by increasing the size
of CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE as the current FIT slighly exceeds 512KiB.
Additionally remove the unnecessary comment on CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
and CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE as the size is obvious from the define.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
use dm_i2c_probe instead of i2c_get_chip which appears to be more
reliable.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Enable driver model for MTD and NAND support allowing us to remove
the iomux, init, and most of the static configuration.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Enable driver model support for MMC and SATA.
Note that DM_MMC requires aliases for your mmc devices so
they are added to the dts. Linux does not support enumerating mmc
devices by alias so these are not present in the Linux dts.
Note that we still need board_mmc_init() and board_mmc_getcd() for
not DM SPL to support MMC.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Enable dm support for USB (which also requires dm support for fixed
regulators used for vbus enable) and remove usb iomux which is no
longer needed.
We can remove the handling of otgpwr_en gpio as this is defined in
dt as usbotg vbus-supply but we need to keep the handling of
USB_HUB_RST# for boards that have a USB HUB as that isn't defined in
the dt's currently.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Once the IMX6 pinctrl driver is added UART is fully using driver mode
so we no longer need to config and initialize it.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
In preparation for dm conversion convert to OF_CONTROL by adding FIT image
support and multi dtb.
Add a board_fit_config_name_match to match the dtb based off of EEPROM
model.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The fsl-usb dt bindings in Linux default dr_mode to 'host' for
backward compatibility however U-Boot prints an error if
this property does not exist. Declare it in the Gateworks
Ventana device-trees to avoid the error.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Add a weak nand_get_mtd function for nand drivers to provide mtd info
and use this to set pagesize such that reading of non page-aligned
elements can succeed.
The spl_load_simple_fit already handles block block access so all we
need to do is provide the nand writesize as the block length.
Further cleanup of the drivers which use nand_spl_loaders.c such as
am335x_spl_bch.c, atmel_nand.c, and nand_spl_simple.c could be done
using info from mtd_info instead of statically defined details.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
commit 9f6a14c47f ("spl: fit: nand: fix fit loading in case of bad blocks")
added support for adjusting the image offset to account for bad blocks.
However this requires nand_spl_adjust_offset() which requires fully defined
specifics of the NAND chip being used may not be avialable.
Allow skipping this support for drivers or configs which don't specify
the NAND chip details statically with defines.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The OCRAM_S is regular memory, just like the OCRAM, add it to the MMU
tables so it can be used and cached.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Previous patch "MLK-18044-4: crypto: caam: Fix pointer size to 32bit
for i.MX8M" breaks the 64 bits CAAM.
Since i.MX CAAM are all 32 bits no matter the ARM arch (32 or 64),
to adapt and not break 64 bits CAAM support, add a new config
CONFIG_CAAM_64BIT and new relevant type "caam_dma_addr_t".
This config is default enabled when CONFIG_PHYS_64BIT is set except
for iMX8M.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Horia Geantă <horia.geanta@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The signature is generated using manufacturing protection private key.
Fix typo in fsl_mfgprot.c.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add DEK encapsulation support for imx8. The DEK blob is generated by the
SECO through the SCFW API.
Signed-off-by: Clement Faure <clement.faure@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add DEK blob encapsulation support for IMX8M through "dek_blob" command.
On ARMv8, u-boot runs in non-secure, thus cannot encapsulate a DEK blob
for encrypted boot.
The DEK blob is encapsulated by OP-TEE through a trusted application call.
U-boot sends and receives the DEK and the DEK blob binaries through OP-TEE
dynamic shared memory.
To enable the DEK blob encapsulation, add to the defconfig:
CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT=y
CONFIG_FAT_WRITE=y
CONFIG_CMD_DEKBLOB=y
Signed-off-by: Clement Faure <clement.faure@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
It is highly recommended to set the PRIBLOB bitfield to 0x3 once your
encrypted boot image has booted up, this prevents the generation of new
blobs that can be used to decrypt an encrypted boot image. The PRIBLOB is
a sticky type bit and cannot be changed until the next power on reset.
Add the set_priblob_bitfield U-Boot command to prevent the generation of
new blobs.
Signed-off-by: Clement Le Marquis <clement.lemarquis@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Ye Li <Ye.Li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
- Add Armada 38x RTC driver (Marek)
- turris_omnia: Misc updates (enable RTC and other cmds) (Marek)
- ds414: Misc updates (enable XHCI_PCI USB support etc) (Phil)
- Convert MVEBU MMC driver to DM (Harm)
- kirkwood: Misc updates and cleanups to some boards (Harm)
Add signature with crc32 value for all images in binman node for FIT
image in device tree. And, enable FIT signature checking for Stratix10
and Agilex ATF and VAB sdmmc boot.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Changed to store QSPI reference clock in kHz instead of Hz in
boot scratch cold0 register for Stratix10 and Agilex.
This patch is in preparation for Intel N5X SDRAM driver
support. Reserved 4 bits for Intel N5X SDRAM driver,
and there will be 28 bits to store QSPI reference clock.
Due to limited bits, QSPI reference clock frequency is
converted to kHz from Hz.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Tien Fong Chee <tien.fong.chee@intel.com>
Restructure Stratix10 and Agilex handoff code to used by
all SOC64 devices, in preparation to support handoff for
Diamond Mesa.
Remove wrap_pinmux_config_s10.c. Add wrap_handoff_soc64.c
which contains the generic function to parse the handoff
data.
Update system_manager_soc64.c to use generic handoff
function in wrap_handoff_soc64.c.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Rearrange sequence of macros in handoff_soc64.h without any functionality
change. In preparation for Stratix10 and Agilex handoff function
restructuring.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Move Stratix10 and Agilex SPL common code to spl_soc64.c.
We are in preparation for new n5x device support.
No functional change in this patch.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
The uart nodes already provide <clocks> property for the driver to
dynamically calculate the correct clock frequency. There is no need
to keep the hard-coded <clock-frequency> property.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Tested-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
The RISC-V architecture default value of CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
(0x1000) would not provide enough memory for devices like mpfs
clock and ns16550 serial to bind well before relocation.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Tested-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Linux kernel commit a2770b57d083 ("dt-bindings: timer: Add CLINT bindings")
adds the official DT bindings for CLINT, which uses "sifive,clint0"
as the compatible string. "riscv,clint0" is now legacy and has to
be kept for backward compatibility of legacy systems.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Provide optimized versions of memcpy(), memmove(), memset() copied from
the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Provide a unit test for the longjmp() library function
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
The value returned by setjmp must be nonzero. If zero is passed as
parameter it must be replaced by 1.
This patch reduces the code size a bit.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
In preparation to add SiFive Unmatched board support, let's rename
the existing fu540 board to unleashed.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Yu-Chi Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
* enable storing the environment in the SPI flash
* enable EXT4 and FAT file system
* enable hush shell
* run k210_bootcmd as default boot command
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This adds the necessary bindings. Most of them are already there.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The clock subsystem requires that clk_free be called on clocks obtained via
clk_get_*.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is preferred over #if because the compiler can check syntax even if
the feature is disabled. This cannot be used for CONFIG_CLK because
CONFIG_DW_WDT_CLOCK_KHZ is not defined on all platforms.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
log_2_n_round_up is only found in arm. fls performs the same job and is
generic.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In i.MX8M platforms the secure memory block has a newer version
than those used in i.MX6/7 platforms, this patch update the driver
to use the correct registers offsets.
Signed-off-by: Aymen Sghaier <aymen.sghaier@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The CAAM block used in i.MX8M is 32 bits address size but when the flag
PHYS_64BIT is enabled for armv8, the CAAM driver will try to use a
wrong pointer size.
This patch fixes this issue.
Signed-off-by: Aymen Sghaier <aymen.sghaier@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Enabling CAAM driver for i.MX8M platforms, a 64 bits architecture,
lead to casting warnings: from/to pointer to/from integer with
different size. This patch fix these warnings
Signed-off-by: Aymen Sghaier <aymen.sghaier@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
U-Boot can instantiate CAAM RNG if needed by crypto operations.
Call sec_init() prior running a blob operation to ensure
RNG is correctly instantiated.
Make sure CAAM clock is enabled and check if a job ring is
available for that operation.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
In order to build CMD_BLOB on i.MX CAAM supported devices it's
necessary to select IMX_HAB. Add IMX_HAB and CAAM supported
SoCs as dependency.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since commit 8891410c729b ("MLK-19848 mx6dq: Fix chip version issue for
rev1.3") it's not possible to call the HAB API functions on i.MX6DQ
SoC Rev 1.3:
Authenticate image from DDR location 0x12000000...
undefined instruction
pc : [<412c00dc>] lr : [<8ff560bc>]
reloc pc : [<c8b6d0dc>] lr : [<178030bc>]
sp : 8ef444a8 ip : 126e8068 fp : 8ff59aa8
r10: 8ffd51e4 r9 : 8ef50eb0 r8 : 006e8000
r7 : 00000000 r6 : 126ea01f r5 : 0000002b r4 : 126e8000
r3 : 412c00dd r2 : 00000001 r1 : 00000001 r0 : 00000063
Flags: nzCv IRQs off FIQs off Mode SVC_32
Resetting CPU ...
resetting ...
The hab.h code is defining the HAB API base address according to the
old SoC revision number, thus failing when calling the HAB API
authenticate_image() function.
Fix this issue by using mx6dq rev 1.3 instead of mx6dq rev 1.5.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since cmd_dek is using CAAM JR, so enable the CMD_DEK only when
HAS_CAAM is set
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add some SOC level codes and build configurations to use HAB lib for
CONFIG_IMX_HAB (secure boot), like adding the SEC_CONFIG fuse, enable
fuse driver, CAAM clock function, and add CAAM secure RAM to MMU table.
The FSL_CAAM is temporally not enabled for iMX8M when CONFIG_IMX_HAB is set,
because we don't need the CAAM driver for SPL.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The blob command is not working on i.MX7D, i.MX8MQ and i.MX8MM
devices.
Due to different cache management it's necessary to flush dcache
range for destination address so data can be available in memory.
Add necessary operations in blob_encap() and blob_decap() functions.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The imx8mm has changed the address of rvt_hab, use new address for imx8mm.
The authentication procedure is same as imx8mq. In u-boot, the authentication
uses SIP call to trap ATF to run HAB authenticate.
Users need to add CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT=y to defconfig to enable the feature.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When building 32-bit targets with CONFIG_SECURE_BOOT and DEBUG enabled
the following warnings are displayed:
arch/arm/mach-imx/hab.c:840:41: warning: format '%lx' expects argument \
of type 'long unsigned int', but argument 3 has type 'uint32_t \
{aka unsigned int}' [-Wformat=]
printf("HAB check target 0x%08x-0x%08lx fail\n",
~~~~^
%08x
ddr_start, ddr_start + bytes);
arch/arm/mach-imx/hab.c:845:45: warning: format '%x' expects argument \
of type 'unsigned int', but argument 3 has type 'ulong \
{aka long unsigned int}' [-Wformat=]
printf("\nivt_offset = 0x%x, ivt addr = 0x%x\n", ivt_offset, ivt_addr);
~^
%lx
Fix warnings by providing the correct data type.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When booting in low power or dual boot modes the M4 binary is
authenticated by the M4 ROM code.
Add an option in hab_status command so users can retrieve M4 HAB
failure and warning events.
=> hab_status m4
Secure boot disabled
HAB Configuration: 0xf0, HAB State: 0x66
No HAB Events Found!
Add command documentation in mx6_mx7_secure_boot.txt guide.
As HAB M4 API cannot be called from A7 core the code is parsing
the M4 HAB persistent memory region. The HAB persistent memory
stores HAB events, public keys and others HAB related information.
The HAB persistent memory region addresses and sizes can be found
in AN12263 "HABv4 RVT Guidelines and Recommendations".
Reviewed-by: Utkarsh Gupta <utkarsh.gupta@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The HABv4 implementation in ROM checks if HAB major version
in IVT header is 4.x.
The current implementation in hab.c code is only validating
HAB v4.0 and HAB v4.1 and may be incompatible with newer
HABv4 versions.
Modify verify_ivt_header() function to align with HABv4
implementation in ROM code.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add ability for hab_status command to show All HAB events and not just
HAB failure events
Signed-off-by: Utkarsh Gupta <utkarsh.gupta@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Currently it's not possible to authenticate additional boot images in HAB
open configuration.
The hab.c code is checking if the SEC_CONFIG[1] fuse is programmed prior
to calling the hab_authenticate_image() API function. Users cannot check
if their additional boot images has been correctly signed prior to closing
their device.
Enable hab.c to authenticate additional boot images in open mode so HAB
events can be retrieved through get_hab_status() function.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Modify to use hab_rvt_failsafe function for failsafe ROM API, not
directly call its ROM address. This function will wrap the sip call for iMX8M
platforms.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Calling csf_is_valid() with an un-signed image may lead to data abort
as the CSF pointer could be pointing to a garbage address when accessed
in HAB_HDR_LEN(*(const struct hab_hdr *)(ulong)ivt_initial->csf).
Authenticate image from DDR location 0x80800000...
Check CSF for Write Data command before authenticating image
data abort
pc : [<fff5494c>] lr : [<fff54910>]
reloc pc : [<8780294c>] lr : [<87802910>]
sp : fdf45dc8 ip : 00000214 fp : 00000000
r10: fffb6170 r9 : fdf4fec0 r8 : 00722020
r7 : 80f20000 r6 : 80800000 r5 : 80800000 r4 : 00720000
r3 : 17a5aca3 r2 : 00000000 r1 : 80f2201f r0 : 00000019
Flags: NzcV IRQs off FIQs off Mode SVC_32
Resetting CPU ...
resetting ...
To avoid such errors during authentication process, validate IVT structure
by calling validate_ivt function which checks the following values in an IVT:
IVT_HEADER = 0x4X2000D1
ENTRY != 0x0
RES1 = 0x0
DCD = 0x0 /* Recommended */
SELF != 0x0 /* Absoulute address of IVT */
CSF != 0x0
RES2 = 0x0
This commit also checks if Image's start address is 4 byte aligned.
commit "0088d127 MLK-14945 HAB: Check if IVT valid before authenticating image"
removed as this patch addresses the issue.
Signed-off-by: Utkarsh Gupta <utkarsh.gupta@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
There are some changes to support ARM64 i.MX8M platform in this patches:
1. The hab_rvt base and function vectors are different as i.MX6/7
2. Need to bypass an workaround for i.MX6 to fix problem in MMU.
3. The x18 register needed save & restore before calling any HAB API. According
to ARM procedure call spec, the x18 is caller saved when it is used as
temporary register. So calling HAB API may scratch this register, and
cause crash once accessing the gd pointer.
On ARMv7, the r9 is callee saved when it is used as variable register. So
no need to save & restore it.
4. Add SEC_CONFIG fuse for iMX8M
When current EL is not EL3, the direct calling to HAB will fail because
CAAM/SNVS can't initialize at non-secure mode. In this case, we use
SIP call to run the HAB in ATF.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When loading kernel image, the image size is parsed from header, so it
does not include the CSF and IVT.
Add back the authenticate_image function to wrap the imx_hab_authenticate_image
with calculating IVT offset and full image size.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Prior instantiating RNG we have to ensure if the CAAM job rings are
available. Avoid hardcoded job ring max size and use the definition at
fsl_sec.h
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Prior calling sec_in32() we have to ensure CAAM clock is enabled, the
function sec_in32() is reading CAAM registers and if CAAM clock is disabled
the system will hang.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The CAAM output ring size register offset is currently defined in fsl_sec.h
as FSL_CAAM_ORSR_JRa_OFFSET, use this definition to avoid hardcoded value in
i.MX common code.
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This code was originally developed by Raul Cardenas <raul.casas@nxp.com>
and modified to be applied in U-Boot imx_v2017.03.
More information about the initial submission can be seen
in the link below:
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2016-February/245273.html
i.MX7D has an a protection feature for Manufacturing process.
This feature uses asymmetric encryption to sign and verify
authenticated software handled between parties. This command
enables the use of such feature.
The private key is unique and generated once per device.
And it is stored in secure memory and only accessible by CAAM.
Therefore, the public key generation and signature functions
are the only functions available for the user.
The manufacturing-protection authentication process can be used to
authenticate the chip to the OEM's server.
Command usage:
Print the public key for the device.
- mfgprot pubk
Generates Signature over given data.
- mfgprot sign <data_address> <data_size>
Signed-off-by: Raul Ulises Cardenas <raul.casas@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Breno Lima <breno.lima@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <fabio.estevam@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Both i.MX8MQ B1 and B2 should use default LPDDR4 script, while B0
has another dedicated script.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
i.MX8MQ B2 also has fixed value in OCOTP_READ_FUSE_DATA register,
so it does not support "fuse sense" command like B1.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
i.MX8MQ B2 is using same value in OCOTP_READ_FUSE_DATA like B1, so
we have to check the ROM verision to distinguish the revision.
As we have checked the B1 rev for sticky bits work around in
secure boot. So it won't apply on B2.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The value of Unique ID in uboot and kernel is different for iMX8MP:
serial#=02e1444a0002aaff
root@imx8mpevk:/sys/devices/soc0# cat soc_uid
D699300002E1444A
The reason is that Fuse Addresses of Unique ID of iMX8MP are 0x420 and
0x430.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Users reported LPDDR4 MR12 value is set to 0 during PHY training,
not the value from FSP timing structure, which cause compliance test failed.
The root cause is the CATrainOpt[0] is set to 1 in 2D FSP timing
but not set in 1D. According to PHY training application node,
to enable the feature both 1D and 2D need set this field to 1,
otherwise the training result will be incorrect.
The PHY training doc also recommends to set CATrainOpt[0] to 0 to use
MR12 value from message block (FSP structure). So update the LPDDR4
scripts of all mscale to clear CATrainOpt[0].
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
For dual core and single core iMX8M parts, the thermal node and PMU node
in kernel DTB also needs update to remove the refers to deleted core nodes.
Otherwise both driver will fail to work.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
There are 3 part numbers for 11x11 i.MX8MNano with different core number
configuration: UltraLite Quad/Dual/Solo
Comparing with i.MX8MN Lite parts, they have MIPI DSI disabled. So
checking the MIPI DSI disable fuse to recognize these parts.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add dedicated defconfigs for iMX8MN low drive mode which set the VDD_SOC
and VDD_DRAM to 0.8v, DDR at 1600MTS (800Mhz clock) and GPU at 200Mhz.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add support for iMX8MN LPDDR4 EVK board which uses 2GB LPDDR4 and
PCA9450B PMIC.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Currently PCA9450 might have address 0x25 or 0x35, so let user
choose the address.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
On i.MX8MN, we can only support DLL-ON mode only, so update the timing
to support 2400mts & 1066mts setpoint.
Signed-off-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
There is a frequency/timing limitation for SOC and ARM, if SOC is OD
voltage/OD freq, then ARM can't run at ND voltage/1.2Ghz, it may have
timing risk from SOC to ARM.
Current VDD_SOC is set to 0.95v OD voltage in SPL, and kernel will
increase bus clocks to OD frequency before it increases ARM voltage.
So to conform to the limitation, we'd better increases VDD_ARM to OD
voltage in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
VDD SOC normal run changed to 0.85V
LPDDR4 freq0 change from 4000MTS to 2400MTS
Signed-off-by: haidong.zheng <haidong.zheng@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Use more safer refresh time value for 6GB LPDDR4 on this EVK board.
Update the parameters for every frequency point.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
After switching to new LPDDR4 firmware 202006 version, have to
update the LPDDR4 timing accordingly from RPA tool.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Sherry Sun <sherry.sun@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jacky Bai <ping.bai@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add inline ECC support for lpddr4 on imx8mp-evk. And add a config which
can enable/disable inline ECC feature for lpddr4 on imx8mp-evk board.
Signed-off-by: Sherry Sun <sherry.sun@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix the warning by set the variable zero to uint64_t
"warning: ‘write’ reading 5 bytes from a region of size 4"
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The non-dm MMC driver has been converted to the driver model. The
sheevaplug was using the non-dm driver and this commit enables the new
driver.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
CC: Prafulla Wadaskar <prafulla@marvell.com>
CC: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Unfortunately this board has no DM support at all. We are also way past
the deadline for driver model support for various devices on this board.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
CC: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Call 'run update_uboot' to fetch u-boot-spl.kwb via TFTP and write it
into the correct SPI flash location. The latter's size is defined in
DS414's DTB file, so hard-coding it should be acceptable here.
Take care to not append garbage from RAM to the written image and to
stay within assigned flash boundaries even if an oversized image was
fetched.
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Define a misc_init_r() which calls "syno populate_env" if the
environment seems incomplete (or default), indicated by missing
"ethaddr" variable. With this in place, no random MAC address fallback
is needed anymore.
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Move the relevant bits from ds109.{c,h} into common/ and adjust the code
to fit both DS109 and DS414. Moreover:
* Introduce syno_board_id() which translates CONFIG_MACH_TYPE into the
expected board ID tag value.
* Properly initialize isusbhost, mac and mtu fields from env variables.
* Set the right bootargs/bootcmd to correctly boot legacy kernel out of
the (DS414) box. Getting the ramdisk location right is a bit tedious.
Cc: Walter Schweizer <swwa@users.sourceforge.net>
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
With the recent fixes in pci_mvebu and xhci-pci drivers, the two rear
USB3 ports are finally usable and accessing them no longer hangs the
system.
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Version 0.9 of OpenSBI provides the system reset extension which allows us
to reset and power off boards without board specific code.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The latest versions of pygit2 are not available in practically any
distribution at this time. Furthermore, we don't need the latest in
order to run all of our testsuites. Reduce this version requirement to
something older that meets our needs while still supporting running our
tests on older hosts (and so, test labs).
Reported-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Given the structure of our current GitLab tests, we don't make real use
of the tags. Furthermore, these tags prevent the automatic usage of the
default GitLab runners. Remove these tags.
Reported-by: Roger Meier <r.meier@siemens.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Now that there is a single SuperH platform, rework the Azure job
slightly. Azure build time limits mean that we need to split the world
build up still. Make a single build job for the single Renesas SuperH
platform as well as all of the ARM platforms from Renesas.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The function jffs2_1pass_read_inode() was discarding the summary
inodes and dirent because the value in datacrc flag wasn't
initialized in function jffs2_sum_process_sum_data().
This fix initializes the status of all summary records to indicate
that the CRC needs to be verified when they are loaded.
Before this fix, the behaviors produced by the undefined value of
datacrc was:
- Summary's registries were discarded when 'b->datacrc' is equal
as 'CRC_BAD'.
- Summary's registries were not checked when b->datacrc differs of
'CRC_BAD' and 'CRC_UNKNOWN'
So, almost all of the time the crc just isn't checked, and in some
cases the registries are discarded.
Signed-off-by: Wagner Popov dos Santos <wpopov@gmail.com>
Fixes address violation in functions read_nand_cached() and
read_onenand_cached(). This happens because these functions
try to read a fixed amount
of data even when the offset+length
is above the nand's limit.
Signed-off-by: Wagner Popov dos Santos <wpopov@gmail.com>
Update hwpartition usage
Check bootbus's arguments
workaround for erratum A-011334 for fsl_esdhc driver
add pulse width detection workaround for fsl_esdhc driver
Use alias num before checking mmc index when creating device
This change makes debugging a bit easier as the output is better
readable with the added space. The explicit le16_to_cpu() is not
needed in the output. Also this patch moves the strings into one line
to make the patch checkpatch clean.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Accessing the xHCI controller registers should be done via the
xhci_readl/writel functions. This patch adds this to a few missing
places.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Add missing endianness conversions to usb_get_port_status(). This
(amongst others) is necessary to enable the use of USB 3 hubs on
big-endian platforms like MIPS Octeon.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Use dev_seq() to read aliases node's index and pass it as device number
for creating bulk device.
Suggested-by: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
First check if there is an alias for the device tree node defined with the
given num before checking against device index.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
HS400 mode on the LS1028A SoC isn't reliable. The linux driver has a
workaroung for the pulse width detection. Apply this workaround in
u-boot, too.
This will make HS400 mode work reliably on the LS1028A SoC.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
LS1028A SoCs are restricted in what divider values are allowed for HS400
mode. This is basically a port from the corresponding linux driver.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
According to Specification, each bit have valid value.
But it doesn't check whether arguments is valid or not.
It has potential bug with arguments passed by wrong value.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Modified more readable about hwpartition usage.
Because it's difficult to understand how to use its command.
The arguments didn't optional.
mmc hwpartition needs to pass <USER> <GP> <MODE> as arguments.
Description about each arguments what is required is the below:
USER - <user> <enh> <start> <cnt> <wrrel> <{on|off}>
GP - <{gp1|gp2|gp3|gp4}> <cnt> <enh> <wrrel> <{on|off}>
MODE - <{check|set|complete}>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The static ethernet link type config code is no more needed because now handled by
the meson8b glue driver, delete it.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The ethernet memory power domain is handled by the meson-ee-pwrc driver,
delete the static code.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This adds a proper glue driver for the Designware DWMAC ethernet MAC IP
found in the Amlogic Meson8, GXBB, GXL, GXM, G12A, G12B & SM1 SoCs.
This is aimed to replace the static ethernet link setup found on the board
init code for the Amlogic SoC based boards.
Tested on a libretech-cc (S905x Internal RMII 10/100 PHY) and Khadas VIM3 (A113d
with external 10/100/1000 RGMII PHY) to cover the most extreme setups.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The Amlogic G12A & compatible SoCs embeds a mux to either communicate with
the external PHY or the internal 10/100 PHY.
This adds support for this mux as a MDIO MUX device.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add support for DM_MDIO to connect to PHY and expose a MDIO device for the
internal MDIO bus in order to dynamically connect to MDIO PHYs with DT
with eventual MDIO muxes in between.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add support for MMIO register MDIO muxes based on the Linux mdio-mux-mmioreg driver.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Espressobin had disabled watchdog support (CONFIG_WDT) because older stable
Linux kernel versions (which are used by current stable OpenWRT and Debian
versions) do not have support for Armada 3700 watchdog driver. Therefore
they are not able to periodically kick watchdog so Espressobin enter into
boot loop.
This change enable CONFIG_WDT, CONFIG_WDT_ARMADA_37XX and CONFIG_CMD_WDT
options which add support for U-Boot 'wdt' command. And unset new
CONFIG_WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART option which cause that watchdog is not
automatically started by U-Boot during init phase, like when CONFIG_WDT
option is not set at all.
So with this change, U-Boot on Espressobin would have working 'wdt' command
which can be used from boot scripts (e.g. for enabling watchdog prior new
Linux booting kernel). But default behavior of watchdog status stays
unchanged, U-Boot does not start watchdog on Espressobin during its init
phase.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
In some cases it is useful to compile support for U-Boot command 'wdt'
without starting HW watchdog in early U-Boot phase. For example when the
user want to start the watchdog only on demand by some boot script.
This change adds a new compile option WATCHDOG_AUTOSTART to control whether
U-Boot should automatically start the watchdog during init phase or not.
This option is enabled by default as it was the default behavior prior
introducing this new change. When compiling U-Boot users can decide to turn
this option off.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Function wdt_start() may fail. So in initr_watchdog() function check return
value of wdt_start() call and print error message when watchdog starting
failed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Watchdog is ready after successful call of ops->start() callback in
wdt_start() function. And is stopped after successful call of ops->stop()
callback in wdt_stop function.
So move setting of GD_FLG_WDT_READY flag from initr_watchdog() function to
wdt_start() and ensure that GD_FLG_WDT_READY flag is unset in wdt_stop()
function.
This change ensures that GD_FLG_WDT_READY flag is set only when watchdog is
running. And ensures that flag is also also when watchdog was started not
only by initr_watchdog() call (e.g. by U-Boot 'wdt' command).
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
We had a problem detecting 8/16bit flash devices connected only via
8bits to the SoC for quite a while. Commit 239cb9d9
[mtd: cfi_flash: Fix CFI flash driver for 8-bit bus support] finally
fixed this 8-bit bus support. But also broke some other boards using
this cfi driver. So this patch had to be reverted.
I spotted a different, simpler approach for this 8-bit bus support
on the barebox mailing list posted by
Oleksij Rempel <bug-track@fisher-privat.net>:
http://www.spinics.net/lists/u-boot-v2/msg14687.html
Here the commit text:
"
Many cfi chips support 16 and 8 bit modes. Most important
difference is use of so called "Q15/A-1" pin. In 16bit mode this
pin is used for data IO. In 8bit mode, it is an address input
which add one more least significant bit (LSB). In this case
we should shift all adresses by one:
For example 0xaa << 1 = 0x154
"
This patch now is a port of this barebox patch to U-Boot.
Along with the change w.r.t from barebox,
Some flash chips can support multiple bus widths, override the
interface width and limit it to the port width.
Tested on 16-bit Spansion flash on sequoia.
Tested 8-bit flashes like 256M29EW, 512M29EW.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki <jaganna@xilinx.com>
Cc: Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki <jaganna@xilinx.com>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Cc: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Cc: York Sun <york.sun@nxp.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Due to a recent change, tests are limited to running on sandbox only.
Correct this so that any architecture can run them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Fixes: c79705ea93 ("test: Move dm_test_init() into test-main.c")
Tested-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Avoid 'make htmldocs' build warnings:
./include/os.h:139: warning:
Function parameter or member 'ptr' not described in 'os_realloc'
./include/os.h:139: warning:
Function parameter or member 'length' not described in 'os_realloc'
Fixes: 14e46dfb17 ("sandbox: Add os_realloc()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present debug() statements can cause debuf output to appear when LOG is
enabled but DEBUG is not. This is not intended and it seems that the
condition is wrong.
Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This existing code assumes that a reg property is larger than one cell,
but this is not always the case. Fix this assumption.
Also if a node's parent is missing the #address-cells and #size-cells
properties we use 2 as a default for each. But this should not happen in
practice. More likely the properties were removed for SPL due to there
being no 'u-boot,dm-pre-reloc' property, or similar. Add a warning for
this as the failure can be very confusing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present an empty size is considered to be a 64-bit value. This does not
seem useful and wastes space. Limit the 64-bit detection to where one or
both of the addr/size is two cells or more.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present warnings are shown as soon as they are discovered in the
source scannner. But the function that detects them may be called multiple
times.
Collect all the warnings and show them at the end.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The environment may contain some unicode characters. At least that is what
seemed to happen on one commit:
Building current source for 1 boards (0 threads, 64 jobs per thread)
0 0 0 /1 -1 (starting)
Traceback (most recent call last):
File ".../tools/buildman/buildman", line 64, in <module>
ret_code = control.DoBuildman(options, args)
File "tools/buildman/control.py", line 372, in DoBuildman
options.keep_outputs, options.verbose)
File ".../tools/buildman/builder.py", line 1704, in BuildBoards
results = self._single_builder.RunJob(job)
File ".../tools/buildman/builderthread.py", line 526, in RunJob
self._WriteResult(result, job.keep_outputs, job.work_in_output)
File ".../tools//buildman/builderthread.py", line 349, in _WriteResult
print('%s="%s"' % (var, env[var]), file=fd)
UnicodeEncodeError: 'ascii' codec can't encode characters in position
311-312: ordinal not in range(128)
The problem defies repetition with any change at all to buildman. But
let's set an encoding in any case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the code to use -ENOSYS, which is the correct error code for an
unimplemented system call in U-Boot.
Also we should not check for a missing operations array as this is not
permitted. For now this can be covered by an assert().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We don't need to check -ENOTSUPP since this is not used for this purpose
in U-Boot. Update the code accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Update clk_composite_set_parent() to use -ENOSYS, which is the correct
error code for U-Boot. Also rearrange the code so that the error condition
is clearly indicated and the function runs to the end in the normal case,
since this is the common style in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
At present some drivers use -ENOSUPP to indicate that an unknown or
unsupported clock is used. Most use -EINVAL, indicating an invalid value,
so convert everything to that.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Driver model uses quite strong conventions on error codes, but these are
currently not clearly documented. Add a description of the commonly used
errors.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
While we cannot know which commit the warning relates to, this should not
be fatal. Print the warning and carry on.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some versions of make complain about using a grouped target without a
recipe:
.../pylibfdt/Makefile:36: *** grouped targets must provide a recipe. Stop.
Fix this by adding a dummy recipe.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently it is not possible to boot Linux from the SD card
by default.
Make the necessary adjustments to allow it.
Reported-by: Peter Bergin <peter@berginkonsult.se>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.z@gmail.com> # imx8mn_ddr4_evk
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
In newer docutils writers/latex2e/docutils.sty has a unicode character
in the comments which can in turn cause Python 3.6 at least to fail.
Pin to the previous docutils release for now.
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The usb command cannot be compiled with CONFIG_USB=n:
ld.bfd: cmd/usb.c:660: undefined reference to `usb_stop'
ld.bfd: cmd/usb.c:663: undefined reference to `usb_started'
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This bash code is currently showing up in the build unless 'make -s' is
used. We don't normally show these sorts of things as they are confusing.
Also this code was not shown before the recent refactoring of how these
messages are displayed.
Add an '@' to silence it.
Suggested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Fixes: 1373252851 ("Makefile: Add common code to report deprecation")
When test suite tries to create a file for a new filesystem test case and fails,
the clean up of the exception tries to unmount the image, that has not yet been
mounted. When it happens, the fuse_mounted global variable is set to False and
inconveniently the test case tries to use sudo, so without this change the
admin of the machine gets an (annoying) email:
Subject: *** SECURITY information for example.com ***
example.com : Feb 5 19:43:47 : ... COMMAND=/bin/umount .../build-sandbox/persistent-data/mnt
and second run of the test cases on uncleaned build folder will ask for sudo
which is not what expected.
Besides that there is a double unmount calls during successfully run test case.
All of these due to over engineered Python try-except clause and people didn't
get it properly at all. The rule of thumb is that don't use more keywords than
try-except in the exception handling code. Nevertheless, here we adjust code
to be less intrusive to the initial logic behind that complex and unclear
constructions in the test case, although it adds a lot of lines of the code,
i.e. splits one exception handler to three, so on each step we know what
cleanup shall perform.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Loading Trusted-Firmware's BL31 at 16KB into DRAM was originally a hack
to allow sharing more code with the other SoCs (which use this offset
in SRAM). However there is no longer a reason for that, as the
problematic macros have been properly separated there.
The latest (and hopefully final) TF-A code drop now changes the load
address to the beginning of DRAM, which is also more easily protected
by the Trustzone memory controller (code to be done).
Adjust the load address of BL31 now, to avoid any issues with
incompatible versions later on (the TF-A patches are about to be merged).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
In the devicepath node to text conversion for Uart nodes a break statement
is missing.
Indicated by Coverity Scan CID 330038
Fixes: 62df6e9c99 ("efi_loader: Uart device path")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
First set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.07 cycle:
This small feature set includes the implementation of the slew rate for
the PIO4 pin controller device, and a fix for arm926ejs-based
microprocessors that avoids a crash.
There are several changes which happen in mainline kernel which should get
also to U-Boot. Here is the list of patches from the kernel:
- ARM: zynq: Fix leds subnode name for zc702/zybo-z7
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Fix leds subnode name for zcu100/ultra96 v1
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Fix u48 si5382 chip on zcu111
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Wire up the DisplayPort subsystem
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Add DisplayPort subsystem
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Add DPDMA node
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Enable phy driver for Sata on zcu102/zcu104/zcu106
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Enable si5341 driver for zcu102/106/111
- arm64: dts: zynqmp: Add DT description for si5328 for zcu102/zcu106
- arm64: dts: zynqmp-zcu100-revC: correct interrupt flags
- arm64: dts: xilinx: align GPIO hog names with dtschema
- arm64: zynqmp: Add Xilinx AES node
- dt: bindings: dma: xilinx: dpdma: DT bindings for Xilinx DPDMA
but also some other changes have been done.
- Using only one compatible string for adxl345 on zturn
- Remove Xilinx internal DP bindings
- Remove USB3.0 serdes configurations
- Remove SATA serdes configuration for zc1232
- Resort nvmem_firmware
- Update nand compatible string
- Aling power-domains property for sd0/1
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
With "clk dump" command, few clocks are showing up incorrect values
and some clocks are displayed as "unknown".
Add missing clocks to zynqmp clock driver to display proper
clocks rates.
Implement a simple way to get clock source, instead of calling
functions. Change existing functions to this simple mechanism.
Fix gem clock name "gem_rx" to "gem_tx" which was incorrect.
Change dbf_fpd & dbf_lpd clk names to dbg_fpd & dbg_lpd.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
In zynqmp.dtsi file renamed "clk_sys" clock to "controller" and
"clk_flash" clock to "bus" as per upstreamed Arasan NAND driver.
This fixes NAND driver probe failure.
Signed-off-by: Amit Kumar Mahapatra <amit.kumar-mahapatra@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Update the following device tree properties for nand flash
- Set software ecc mode.
- Set bch as ecc algo.
- Set read block to 0.
Signed-off-by: Amit Kumar Mahapatra <amit.kumar-mahapatra@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
EMMC will have bus-width 8 and it is non-removable in general. These
are missing from dt node. Add bus-width and non-removable parameters
to emmc node.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
size of malloc() pool for use before relocation is not sufficient
for ZynqMP mini u-boot with emmc configuration. Increase it to 4K.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add initial support for NanoPi M4B, a minor revision of
the original NanoPi M4.
Commit details of rk3399-nanopi-m4b.dts sync from Linux 5.12-rc4:
"arm64: dts: rockchip: Add NanoPi M4B board"
(sha1: c7b03115003f7f337ab165542cee37148cf30a8a)
Signed-off-by: Alexandre Vicenzi <alexandre.vicenzi@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-cihps.com>
NanoPi R4s is SBC base on Rockchip RK3399 hexa-core processor with
dual-Core Cortex-A72 and Mali-T864 GPU with 4GiB(LPDDR4) of RAM, SD card support,
including 2 gigabit ethernet(RTL8211E 1Gbps - RTL8111H 1Gbps) and 2 USB 3.0 port.
port.It also has two GPIO headers which allows further peripherals to be used.
The devicetree file is taken of the rk3399 nanopi4 Linux kernel [1].
[1] e7a0959082
Signed-off-by: xiaobo <peterwillcn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The path in the Linux kernel dts directory is
rockchip/rk3326-odroid-go2.dtb.
That also seems to match the FDT path set on other boards (ie:
rock64-rk3328 for example).
Signed-off-by: Roger Pau Monne <royger@FreeBSD.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Remove the unset of the EFI loader, it's possible for U-Boot to
provide a EFI environment on this board, and it's also required by
the FreeBSD loader which mandated EFI on Aarch64.
Signed-off-by: Roger Pau Monné <royger@FreeBSD.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
On Puma we have the environment at an offset of 16 kiB.
On the eMMC this gives us 16 kiB for the environment before the SPL starts.
On the SPI NOR we also have 16 kiB until end of flash.
So let's increase the environment size from 8 kiB to its maximum
of 16 kiB for both MMC and SPI NOR.
Signed-off-by: Christoph Muellner <christoph.muellner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
A commit from last year re-imported the DTS files form the upstream kernel.
By doing so the VDD_LOG regulator in the board's DTS was dropped.
Let's restore this, but move it into the u-boot overlay to prevent this
issue in the future.
Fixes: 167efc2c7a ("arm64: dts: rk3399: Sync v5.7-rc1 from Linux")
Signed-off-by: Christoph Muellner <christoph.muellner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The Rock960 doesn't have SPI flash on-board, but the bits
get enabled by default which means when booting we get
some errors. Explicitly disable it to stop the errors.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Drop a irrelevent comment now the related configs have moved
to the various config files.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
This is the state as of v5.10 + the recently added timer0 phandle
targetted at the 5.12 merge window.
With this the non-mainline nodes like the dmc move to a separate
rk3368-u-boot.dtsi that is included from the board-specific
-u-boot.dtsi files, similar to how rk3399 does this.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
With the STACK_R_ADDR at 0x600000 (6MB) we're competing with
with the loading address of either u-boot or atf parts, so move
that away to 0x4000000 (64MB) similar to rk3399.
Only lion currently sets that at all but not sheep the second
rk3368 board, so just move that to the Kconfig for rk3368 similar
to rk3399 as well.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Mimicing for example the rk3399, set the SYS_BOOTM_LEN to 64MB so
that regular kernel images can get loaded without problems.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR currently is at 0x00280000 which is only 512KB
behind the area where we load u-boot to, which depending on u-boot size
may overlap at some point.
So for safety just pick the same value rk3399 has and set
CONFIG_SYS_LOAD_ADDR to 0x00800800 on rk3368 as well.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Using a non-default SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR setting makes the
resulting u-boot-rockchip.bin unbootable, as it gets stuck after SPL.
Removing the setting from the defconfig allows U-Boot to load
successfully.
Signed-off-by: Roger Pau Monné <royger@FreeBSD.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The code was trying to disable PCS auto-negotiation when a fixed-link node
is present and enable it otherwise. However, the PCS registers were being
written before the PCSSEL bit was set in the network configuration
register, and it appears that in this state, PCS register writes are
ignored. The result is that the intended change only took effect on the
second network operation that was performed, since at that time PCSSEL is
already enabled.
Fix the order of register writes so that PCS registers are only written to
after the PCS is enabled.
Fixes: 26e62cc971 ("net: gem: Disable PCS autonegotiation in case of fixed-link")
Signed-off-by: Robert Hancock <robert.hancock@calian.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
On Arm-based Macs, -no_pie is ignored and gives a linker warning.
Moreover, the build falls over with:
ld: Absolute addressing not allowed in arm64 code but used in '_image_type_ptr_aisimage' referencing '_image_type_aisimage'
for dumpimage and mkimage, since we put data structs in text sections
not data sections and so cannot have dynamic relocations. Instead, move
the sections to __DATA and drop disabling PIE.
Signed-off-by: Jessica Clarke <jrtc27@jrtc27.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
We need this header for U_BOOT_CMD, which is always present even without
EFI.
Fixes: 82c468a049 ("dm: test: Update Makefile conditions")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When including this file on a board other than sandbox (e.g by enabling
UNIT_TEST and CMD_SETEXPR) an results. Fix it by declaring struct udevice
first.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Rework the deprecation warnings to be consistently phrased.
- Add in a warning for DM_I2C, for a year from next release.
- Fix Azure builds of Windows host tools.
We now see an error such as:
warning: database file for 'ucrt64' does not exist (use '-Sy' to download)
error: failed to prepare transaction (could not find database)
So use -Sy as suggested.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This probably should have been done a while back since it is a core
system. Add a migration deadline of later this year, to catch the
stragglers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_DM_ETH check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with snow
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_ETH (Driver Model
for Ethernet drivers). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_ETH before the v2020.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_ETH (Driver Model
for Ethernet drivers). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_ETH before the v2020.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_WDT check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with kmcent2
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_WDT (DM watchdog support).
Please update the board to use CONFIG_WDT before the
v2019.10 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_WDT (Driver Model
for DM watchdog). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_WDT before the v2019.10 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_DM_SPI_FLASH check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with vinco
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_SPI_FLASH. Please update
the board to use CONFIG_SPI_FLASH before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_SPI_FLASH (Driver Model
for SPI flash). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_SPI_FLASH before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_DM_VIDEO check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with pxm2
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO (Driver Model
for video). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_VIDEO before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
==================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_DM_PCI check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with MPC8349ITX
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_PCI Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_PCI before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_PCI (Driver Model
for PCI). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_PCI before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_LIBATA check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with MPC8349ITX
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does use CONFIG_LIBATA but has CONFIG_AHCI not
enabled. Please update the storage controller driver to use
CONFIG_AHCI before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_AHCI (Driver Model
for AHCI). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_AHCI before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the CONFIG_MVSATA_IDE check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with nas220
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does use CONFIG_MVSATA_IDE which is not
ported to driver-model (DM) yet. Please update the storage
controller driver to use CONFIG_AHCI before the v2019.07
release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_AHCI (Driver Model
for AHCI instead of CONFIG_MVSATA_IDE). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_AHCI before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the USB check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with xpress
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_USB. Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_USB before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_USB (Driver Model
for USB). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_USB before the v2019.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the MMC check to use the 'deprecated' function.
Tested with zc5202
Old message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_MMC. Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_MMC before the v2019.04 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
New message:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_MMC (Driver Model
for MMC). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_MMC before the v2019.04 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a function which can be called to report a migration problem. This
will make it easier to add new migration checks, since the logic and
strings are not spread out over 8 lines of code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the driver model migration messages are mixed with the others.
Collect them together before starting to refactor them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On RISC-V the symbols __dyn_sym_start, dyn_sym_end are referenced in
efi_runtime_relocate().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a few more internal checks to make sure offsets are correct, before
updating the dtb.
To make this easier, update the functions which add a property to return
that property,.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
So far we have only needed to add subnodes to empty notds, so have not
had to deal with ordering. However this feature is needed for binman's
expanded nodes, since there may be another node in the same section.
While libfdt adds new properties after existing properties, it adds new
subnodes before existing subnodes. This means that we must reorder the
nodes in the cached version, so that the ordering remains consistent.
Update the sync implementation to sync existing subnodes first, then
add new ones, then tidy up the ordering in the cached version. Update the
test to cover this behaviour.
Also improve the comment about property syncing while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new test that adds a subnode alongside an existing one, as well as
adding properties to a subnode. This will expand to adding multiple
subnodes in future patches. Put a node after the one we are adding to so
we can check that things sync correctly.
The testAddNode() test should be in the TestNode class since it is a node
test, so move it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Once the tree has been synced, thus potentially moving things around in the
fdt, we set _cached_offsets to False so that a refresh will happen next
time a property is accessed.
This 'lazy' refresh doesn't really save much time, since refresh is a very
fast operation, just a single walk of the tree. Also, having the refresh
happen in the bowels of property access it makes it harder to figure out
what is going on.
Simplify the code by always doing a refresh before and after a sync. Set
_cached_offsets to True immediately after this, in the Refresh() function,
since this makes more sense than doing it in the caller.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If a property does not yet have an offset, then that means it exists in
the cache'd fdt but has not yet been synced back to the flat tree. Use
the dirty flag for this so we don't need to check the offset too. Improve
the comments for Prop and Node to make it clear what an offset of None
means.
Also clear the dirty flag after the property is synced.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sometimes it is useful to specify the default alignment for all entries
in a section, such as when word-alignment is necessary, for example. It
is tedious and error-prone to specify this individually for each section.
Add a property to control this for a section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Generally the content of sections is not built until the final assembly
of the image. This is partly to avoid wasting time, since the entries
within sections may change multiple times as binman works through its
various stages. This works quite well since sections exist in a strict
hierarchy, so they can be processed in a depth-first manner.
However the 'collection' entry type does not have this luxury. If it
contains a section within its 'content' list, then it must produce the
section contents, if available. That section is typically a sibling
node, i.e. not part oc the collection's hierarchy.
Add a new 'required' argument to section.GetData() to support this. When
required is True, any referenced sections are immediately built. If this
is not possible (because one of the subentries does not have its data yet)
then an error is produced.
The test for this uses a 'collection' entry type, referencing a section as
its first member. This forces a call to _BuildSectionData() with required
set to False, at first, then True later, when the image is assembled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The vblock entry type includes code to collect the data from a number of
other entries (not necessarily subentries) and concatenating it. This is
a useful feature for other entry types.
Make it a base class, so that vblock can use it, along with other entry
types.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there is a command-line flag to disable substitution of expanded
entries. Add an option to the entry node as well, so it can be controlled
at the node level.
Add a test to cover this. Fix up the comment to the checkSymbols() function
it uses, while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide the model information through sysinfo so that it shows up on
boot. For memconfig 4 pins are provided, for 16 combinations. For SKU
ID there are two options:
- two pins provided in a ternary arrangement, for 9 combinations.
- reading from the EC
Add a binding doc and drop the unused #defines as well.
Example:
U-Boot 2021.01-rc5
CPU: Intel(R) Celeron(R) CPU N3450 @ 1.10GHz
DRAM: 3.9 GiB
MMC: sdmmc@1b,0: 1, emmc@1c,0: 2
Video: 1024x768x32 @ b0000000
Model: Google Coral (memconfig 5, SKU 3)
This depends on the GPIO series:
http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/list/?series=228126
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some boards may want to show the SKU ID or other information obtained at
runtime. Allow this to come from sysinfo. The board can then provide a
sysinfo driver to provide it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is not possible to remove the state before driver model is uninited,
since the devices are allocated in the memory buffer. Also it is not
possible to uninit driver model afterwards, since the RAM has been
freed.
Drop the uninit altogether, since it is not actually necessary.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an extra condition here since we cannot put x86 tables in a bloblist
when bloblists are not supported.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The U_BOOT_CMDREP_COMPLETE() macro produces a build error if CONFIG_CMDLINE
is not enabled. Fix this by updating the macro to provide the 'repeatable'
arugment in this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this documentation over to reST. Move the example files into a files/
directory so they are still separate.
Do a few minor updates while we are here:
- Tidy up sandbox build instructions
- Update my github account name
- Add some talks and links
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The _SUPPORT suffix is from an earlier time and interferes with use of
the CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() macro. Rename the option to drop the suffix.
Tidy up the TODO that prompted this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This feature was dropped from U-Boot some time ago:
f12f96cfaf (sf: Drop spl_flash_get_sw_write_prot")
However, we do need a way to see if a flash device is write-protected,
since if it is, it may not be possible to write to do (i.e. failing to
write is expected).
I am not sure of the correct layer to implement this, so this patch is a
stab at it. If spi-flash makes sense then I will add to the 'sf' also.
Re the points mentioned in the removal commit:
1) This kind of requirement can be achieved using existing
flash operations and flash locking API calls instead of
making a separate flash API.
Which uclass is this?
2) Technically there is no real hardware user for this API to
use in the source tree.
I do want coral (at least) to support this.
3) Having a flash operations API for simple register read bits
also make difficult to extend the flash operations.
This new patch only mentions write-protect being on or off, rather than
the actual mechanism.
4) Instead of touching generic code, it is possible to have
this functionality inside spinor operations in the form of
flash hooks or fixups for associated flash chips.
That sounds to me like what drivers are for. But we still need some sort
of API for it to be accessible.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present bootstage silently ignores new records if it runs out of
space. It is sometimes obvious by looking at the report, but the IDs are
not contiguous, so it is easy to miss.
Aad a message so that action can be taken.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We have two separate places that need to figure out the bootstage ID to
use. Put this code in a function so that the logic is in one place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These tests current produce unwanted output on sandbox. Use the correct
functions to controller console output, to avoid this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sandbox is special in that it is used for testing and it does not match
any particular target architecture. Allow it to load an image from any
architecture, so that 'bootm' can be used as needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present when a file is bound to a host device it is always marked as
removeable. Arguably the device is removeable, since it can be unbound at
will. However while it is bound, it is not considered removable by the
user. Also it is useful to be able to model both fixed and removeable
devices for code that distinguishes them.
Add a -r flag to the 'host bind' command and plumb it through to provide
this feature.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove the 'bind' subcommand before processing the arguments. This will
make it easier to add an optional flag.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function has a strange mix of declarations and argument parsing
which is a bit hard to follow and harder to modify. Separate out the
declarations at the start of the function and adjust the ordering of
the code slightly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present sandbox removes its executable after failing to run it,
since there is no other way that it would get cleaned up.
However, this is actually only wanted if the image was created within
sandbox. For the case where the image was generated by the build system,
such as u-boot-spl, we don't want to delete it.
Handle the two code paths accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function only exists if CPU is enabled. Update the code to take
account of this, so that it does not have to be enabled on all sandbox
builds.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
When booting from coreboot there is no need to notify the FSP of anything,
since coreboot has already done it. Nor it is possible, since the FSP
details are not provided by coreboot.
Skip it in this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When booting from coreboot the FSP video information is no-longer
available. Enable the coreboot driver so that we can get some sort of
display in this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the debug UART is only set up in SPL, on the assumption that
the boot flow will always pass through there. When booting from coreboot,
SPL is not used, so the debug UART is not available.
Move the code into a common place so that it can be used in U-Boot proper
also. Add the required init to start_from_spl.S as well.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Allow referencing a CBFS file in the flashmap, so that it is possible to
boot from coreboot, where files are not available from binman.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This driver cannot work when booted from coreboot, since the FSP
information is not available. Disable it in that case, so that the
coreboot video driver can be used instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When booting from coreboot we need this driver for the video to work.
Update the driver to be usable on any board.
The driver disables itself if it sees that is not booted from coreboot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The copy buffer, if enabled, prevents booting from coreboot correctly,
since no memory is allocated for it. Allow it to fall back to disabled
in this situation. This ensures that a console is displayed, even if
it is slow.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This information is interesting to look at and can be important for
debugging and inspection. Add a command to display it in a helpful
format.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this code into a generic location so that it can be used by other x86
boards which want to boot from coreboot. Also ensure that this is called
if booting from coreboot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Quite a few new tag types have been added over the years. Bring these into
U-Boot so that all required tags can be parsed.
Add a proper comment to struct sysinfo_t while we are here, since many of
the meanings are not obvious.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to be able to parse coreboot tables on any x86 build which is
booted from coreboot. Add a new Kconfig option to enable this feature and
move the code so it can be used on any board, if enabled.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add new timestamp codes that are present in coreboot, so that we can decode
these in U-Boot.
At present TS_U_BOOT_START_KERNEL is used twice. It should only be used
just before jumping to Linux, so update the other call site to use
TS_START_KERNEL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This all relates to the sysinfo structure provided by coreboot. Put the
timestamp definitions into the same file as the others. Tidy up a few
comments at the same time.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is possible to boot U-Boot for chromebook_coral either 'bare metal' or
from coreboot. In the latter case we want to provide access to the coreboot
sysinfo tables. Move the definitions into a file available to any x86
board.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CBFS now supports compressed filed. Add support for reading this
information so that the correct decompression can be applied. The
decompression itself is not implemented in CBFS.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In file_cbfs_next_file() there is a lot of complicated code to move to
the next file. Use the ALIGN() macros to simplify this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The file_cbfs_next_file() function is already fairly long. Before
expanding it further, move the core part into a separate function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The file traversal functions currently use a single global CBFS. In some
cases we need to access multiple CBFSs to obtain different files. Add new
functions to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In some cases CBFS does not start with a header but is just a collection
of files. It is possible to support this so long as the size of the CBFS
is provided.
Update the cbfs_init_mem() function to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When U-Boot is booted from coreboot the SMBIOS tables are written by
coreboot, not U-Boot. The existing method of updating the BIOS version
string does not work in that case, since gd->smbios_version is only set
when U-Boot writes the tables.
Add a new function which allows the version to be updated by parsing the
tables and writing the string in the correct place. Since coreboot
provides a pointer to the SMBIOS tables in its sysinfo structure, this
makes it easy to do the update.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CBFS now supports attributes for things that cannot fit in the header as
originally conceived. Add the structures for these.
Also rename attributes_offset to something shorter, to ease code
readability.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The driver currently reads the card-detect but does not register it with
the MMC stack. Update this so that card-detect works as expected.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since the recent bug fix, it doesn't matter which GPIO phandle is used so
long as the GPIO number is right. Still, we may as well use the correct
one to avoid confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
At present the eMMC device does not have an alias so it appears after
the SD card which is device 1. There is no device 0 which is odd.
Make the eMMC device be the first one. Update the boot script to use the
new device.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The Intel GPIO binding allows GPIOs to be globally numbered, so that it
does not matter which GPIO bank is specified in the device tree. This is
convenient and avoid confusion since the banks do not have the same number
of GPIOs and the numbering is not sequential.
The GPIO uclass ensures that the device mentioned in the devicetree
binding is probed. It is fine for the driver to update gpio_desc to point
to a different driver, but this may not have been probed. If it has not
been, then it cannot be claimed since there is no uclass data.
We could handle this in the GPIO uclass but so far it is an unusual
situation so it is probably not worth the extra code. Handle this case in
the GPIO driver by probing the selected device if necessary.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add detailed information on how to build the coral image, since it needs
binary blobs. Provide a way to avoid the memory-training delay. Also show
the console output from a sample run.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
dfu_free_entities() invoking dfu_free_entity_sf() has let to segementation
faults due to double freeing the same device.
spi_flash_free() is not relevant for the driver model but exists only for
compatibility with old drivers.
We must not remove any device here:
* The device may still be referenced.
* We don't want to have to probe again.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Having an rng in the sandbox is useful not only for tests but also for e.g.
UEFI. Therefore, copy the rng node from test.dts to sandbox.dtsi.
In the case of UEFI, it can then be verified with `efidebug dh' that a
"Random Number Generator" protocol is indeed present.
This also fixes the following `bootefi' error:
Missing RNG device for EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL
Signed-off-by: Vincent Stehlé <vincent.stehle@arm.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
dtoc support for of-platdata-inst
driver model support for of-platdata-inst
support of-platdata-inst on x86 / coral
binman support for exapanded entries
binman convert docs to reST
ti-sysc fix for duplicate uclass driver
patman minor improvements
pylibfdt build only if needed
correct obscure CI error with OF_PLATDATA_INST
Many entries start 'Entry containing a'. This looks fine in the source
code but is annoying when viewed in the htmldocs table of contents. Drop
these unnecessary words.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a link to binman's documentation and adjust the files so that it is
accessible. Use the name README.rst so it is easy to discover when binman
is installed without U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These docs are useful for developers, not users. Move them under that
section.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Much of the content here is useful only for development. Move it under
that section.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We don't need to spell out the separate pieces of U-Boot phase binaries
anymore. Revert to using the simple entry and let binman do the expansion
itself as needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To support the use of 'expanded' entries, binman needs to be told whether
SPL and TPL have a devicetree and whether they need BSS padding. Add these
to the Makefile.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When creating an entry, check for an expanded version of that entry, then
use it instead. This allows, for example use of:
u-boot {
};
instead of having to write out in full:
u-boot {
type = "section";
u-boot-nodtb {
};
u-boot-dtb {
};
};
Add an implementaion of this and associated documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for this feature in the control, image and section modules, so
that expanded entries will be selected by default. So far there are no
expanded entry types, so this is a nop.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new command-line option to disable expanded entries. This is needed
for most tests, since it is much easier to 'factor out' this function into
a separate test and keep the existing packing tests simple.
Add the option and select it by default from tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As the first step in supporting expanded entries, add a way for binman to
automatically select an 'expanded' version of an entry type, if requested.
This is controlled by a class method.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present, before any entry expansion is done (such as a 'files' entry
expanding out to individual entries for each file it contains), we check
the binman definition (i.e. '/binman' node) to find out what devicetree
files are used in the images.
This is a pain, since the definition may change during expansion. For
example if there is no u-boot-spl-dtb entry in the definition at the start,
we assume that the SPL devicetree is not used. But if an entry later
expands to include this, then we don't notice.
In fact the flexibility provided by the current approach of checking the
definition is not really useful. We know that we can have SPL and TPL
devicetrees. We know the pathname to each, so we can simply check if the
files are present. If they are present, we can prepare them and update
them regardless of whether they are actually used. If they are not present,
we cannot prepare/update them anyway, i.e. an error will be generated.
Simplify state.Prepare() so it uses a hard-coded list of devicetree files.
Note that state.PrepareFromLoadedData() is left untouched, since in that
case we have a complete definition from the loaded file, but cannot of
course rely on the devicetree files that created it still being present.
So in that case we still check the image defitions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we store an entry as the third field in output_fdt_info[].
This is only used to get the type of the entry. Of course multiple entries
may have this same type. Also the entry type is the key to this dict, so
we can use that instead.
Drop the field and update GetUpdateNodes() to suit. Improve the comment for
output_fdt_info a little while here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we always use the main devicetree for SPL/TPL as well when
setting up the state. But this it not needed if there is a real devicetree
for SPL or TPL. In fact it confuses things since we cannot distinguish
between one being provided and using the fake one.
Update the code to create the fakes only when requested. Put the mapping
in a constant so we can use it elsewhere.
Rename 'other_fname' to 'fname' while we are here since there is nothing
'other' about it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A few tests declare a type when this can be inferred from the node name.
Drop these lines, since it might cause confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This entry holds the padding between the end of of TPL binary and the
end of BSS. This region must be left empty so that the devicetree can be
appended correctly and remain accessible without interfering with BSS.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since this is an execuable we should be able insert symbol values into it.
Add support for this.
Use common code for this test and the original testSymbols. Use hex
consistently for the values and add some more comments.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The documentation for this entry indicates that the SPL binary is included
along with the padding. It is not, so update it to correct the error.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Several entries currently use an underscore in the entry-type name, but in
fact a hyphen is used. Update the docs to fix this as it might be
confusing.
Also simplify the 'filename' comment and fix the 'operation' typo.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Regenerate the entry documentation, which step was missed when the
files-align feature was added.
Fixes: 6eb9932668 ("binman: Support alignment of files")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move the documentation to the base method as it is with other methods.
Also update it a little while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Extracting files to the current directory is not normally a very friendly
thing to do, but it can be warranted, e.g. in a new temporary dir. At
present binman reports an error when such an attempt is made. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With Apollo Lake, SPL is placed in read-only memory. Set this new option
so that OF_PLATDATA_INST can be used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These devices are not actually built in TPL but are currently active in
the TPL devicetree. For of-platdata-inst this means that we will try to
generate devices for them, which fails.
Update them to be active only in U-Boot proper.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We don't normally need this driver in TPL/SPL, so drop it for now. It can
be enabled by individual boards if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With TPL we don't need full PCI support and it adds to code size. Instead,
a simple_bus driver is good enough to be able to read and write the PCI
config and do a little basic setup.
So at present there are two drivers in U-Boot called pci_x86. One is in
UCLASS_PCI, used in SPL and U-Boot proper. The other is in
UCLASS_SIMPLE_BUS and used only in TPL.
Add a tag to tell dtoc about this, so it knows which one to use when
generating the devices and uclasses.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the standard of-platdata we must fix up driver_data manually. With
of-platadata-inst this is not necessary, since it is added to the device
by dtoc.
Update the code to handle this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This enum is needed to generate build-time devices. Tell dtoc where to
find the header, to avoid compile errors in the generated code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The dm.h header should come first. In fact it needs to, since otherwise
the driver model definitions are not available to dt-structs.h
Fix this, since it causes problems with OF_PLATDATA_INST.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Collect this together in one place, so driver model can access set it up
in a new place if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a description of the new features, along with internal technical
documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This doc has a few pieces that are out-of-date. Fix these. Also we have
started to use 'devicetree' instead of 'device tree' or 'device-tree'
since it is easier to see as a single term, so replace all ocurrences
accordingly.
Also move the caveats to the end, since this is a fairly solid part of
U-Boot now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a warning to each of these functions so that people do not attempt to
use them outside driver model.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Make use of the new priv/plat data region if enabled. This is implemented
as a simple offset from the position set up by dtoc to the new position.
So long as all access goes through dm_priv_to_rw() this is safe.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Collect this together in one place, so driver model can access set it up
in a new place if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the device priv/data data allocated by dtoc is stored in the
data section along with other variables. On some platforms it is better
to allocate space for it separately, e.g. if SPL is running from read-only
memory.
Create a new space with the same size as that allocated by dtoc, ready for
use.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When of-platdata-inst is active, use the flags in the new udevice_rt
table, dropping them from the main struct udevice. This ensures that the
latter is not updated at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present when driver model needs to change a device it simply updates
the struct udevice structure. But with of-platdata-inst most of the fields
are not modified at runtime. In fact, typically only the flags need to
change.
For systems running SPL from read-only memory it is convenient to separate
out the runtime information, so that the devices don't need to be copied
before being used.
Create a new udevice_rt table, similar to the existing driver_rt. For now
it just holds the flags, although they are not used in this patch.
Add a new Kconfig for the driver_rt data, since this is not needed when
of-platdata-inst is used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some systems (e.g. x86 APL) run SPL from read-only memory. The device
instances created by dtoc are therefore not writeable. To make things work
we would need to copy the devices to read/write memory.
To avoid this, add an option to use a separate runtime struct for devices,
just as is done for drivers. This can be used to hold information that
changes at runtime, avoiding the need for a copy.
Also add a Kconfig option for read-only SPL, which selects this feature.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add this new board to the test plans. Travis-CI is left out, since it is
being removed soon due to lack of capacity.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move sandbox_spl over to use OF_PLATDATA_INST. Create a new board to
test the case when this is not enabled, since we will be keeping that
code around for several months and want to avoid regressions.
Skip the dm_test_of_plat_dev() test since driver info is not available
for OF_PLATDATA_INST.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With recent changes this can be supported again. Add it back.
This reverts commit d85f2c4f29.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the i2c emulators require access to the devicetree, which is
not possible (by design) with of-platdata.
Add a way for drivers to record the of-platdata index of their emulator,
so that we can still find the emulator.
This allows i2c emulation to work with of-platdata.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The test framework reinits driver model tests before running each test.
Since malloc_simple does not support free(), this eventually runs out of
memory.
Fix it for now by increasing the space to 32KB.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This function finds a device by its driver_info index. With
of-platdata-inst we do not use driver_info, but instead instantiate
udevice records at build-time.
However the semantics of using the function are the same in each case:
the caller provides an index and gets back a device.
So rename the function to device_get_by_ofplat_idx(), so that it can be
used for both situations. The caller does not really need to worry about
the details.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the structs used by these drivers are declared in the C files
and so are not accessible to dtoc. Move them to header files, as required.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function is included in the build but with of-platdata it
only services to produce a confusing link error complaining about a call
to dev_read_u32_default().
Drop it so that any call to uclass_find_device_by_phandle() is flagged as
an error, making it easier to see what is going on.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is now only used in a test. Drop it. Also drop
DM_DRVINFO_GET() which was the only purpose for having the function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Create a version of this driver for sandbox so that it can use the
of-platdata struct.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We need to allow SoCs to create their own drivers for this so that they
can use their own of-platdata structs. To minimise code duplication,
export the driver operations and the ofdata_to_plat() setup function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the structs used by this driver are not accessible outside it,
so cannot be used with OF_PLATDATA_INST. Move them to a header file to
fix this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is not possible to destroy the uclasses when they are created at
build time. Skip this step so that SPL test can complete successfully.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When dt-structs.h is used, include the dt-decl.h header as well, so that
these declarations are available.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Which files we generate depends on the setting of OF_PLATDATA_INST in the
build. This might change between builds, but the build directory may be
reused.
Leaving old files around is confusing and switching the OF_PLATDATA_INST
setting does not necessarily regenerate the files, e.g. if the devicetree
has not changed.
Remove all the files before regenerating new ones.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are actually two generated files but only one is currently mentioned
in the Makefile as a dependency. Put them both in a Makefile variable and
use that instead, to avoid inconsistency.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present all possible files are generated, even if some of them just
have a header and an empty body. It is better to generate only the files
that are needed, so that the two types of build (based on the setting of
OF_PLATDATA_INST) can be mutually exclusive.
This is intended to fix a strange problem sometimes found with CI:
Building current source for 1 boards (1 thread, 40 jobs per thread)
sandbox: + sandbox_spl
+drivers/built-in.o: In function `dm_setup_inst':
+drivers/core/root.c:135: undefined reference to
`_u_boot_list_2_udevice_2_root'
+dts/dt-uclass.o:(.u_boot_list_2_uclass_2_serial+0x10): undefined
reference to `_u_boot_list_2_udevice_2_serial'
...
This likely happens when switching from !OF_PLATDATA_INST to
OF_PLATDATA_INST since running 'make xxx_defconfig" does not currently
cause any change in which files are generated. With !OF_PLATDATA_INST
the dt-device.c file has no declarations and this is assumed to be the
starting state. The error above seems to indicate that, after changing
to OF_PLATDATA_INST, the dt-uclass.c file is regenerated but the
dt-device.c files is not. This does not seem possible from the relevant
Makefile.spl rule:
u-boot-spl-platdata := $(obj)/dts/dt-plat.o $(obj)/dts/dt-uclass.o
$(obj)/dts/dt-device.o
cmd_dtoc = $(DTOC_ARGS) -c $(obj)/dts -C include/generated all
include/generated/dt-structs-gen.h $(u-boot-spl-platdata_c) &: \
$(obj)/$(SPL_BIN).dtb
@[ -d $(obj)/dts ] || mkdir -p $(obj)/dts
$(call if_changed,dtoc)
It seems that this cannot regenerate dt-uclass.c without dt-device.c since
'dtoc all' is used. So here the trail ends for now.
In any case it seems better to generate files that are uses and not bother
with those that serve no purpose. So update dtoc to do this automatically.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When OF_PLATDATA_INST is enabled, we need dt-uclass.c and dt-device.c for
the build to work. When OF_PLATDATA_INST is not enabled, we only need
dt-plat.c
Update the Makefile rules to indicate this.
At present all files are generated and compiled regardless of which are
actually needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since the dst_dir rule always runs, it causes a rebuild of the of-platdata
files even if not needed.
Create the directory inside the rule instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the build rule for pylibfdt depends on _libfdt.so but modern
Python versions add a different suffix to the output file, resulting in
something like _libfdt.cpython-38-x86_64-linux-gnu.so
The result is that pylibfdt is rebuilt every time.
Rename the file the standard name so that the rule works correctly. Also
add libfdt.py to the dependencies, so that file is always created if
missing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Pull request for efi-next
New:
provide EFI ESRT table
initrd via Load_File2_Protocol uses boot options
create an S-CRTM event for measured boot
Bug fixes:
avoid double free of SPI device in dfu_free_entity()
avoid memory leak in TCG2 protocol
We recently added a common function for calculating file size,
instead of copy pasting the code around. Switch one of the
occurences over to the common function
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviwed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Setup will always occur before ExitBootServices(). So eliminate
EFI_SETUP_AFTER_BOOTTIME_EXIT. Put the SetVirtualAddressMap() test into a
separate class so that we can execute it last.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
TCG PC Client Platform Firmware Profile Spec mandates that an S-CRTM
event for the version identifier using the event type EV_S_CRTM_VERSION
must be measured.
So since we are trying to add more conformance into U-Boot, let's add
the event using U_BOOT_VERSION_STRING, extend PCR[0] accordingly and log
it in the EventLog
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Current code doesn't free the efi allocated memory in case the protocol
failed to install
Fixes: c8d0fd5825 ("efi_loader: Introduce eventlog support for TCG2_PROTOCOL")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This commit slightly extends test_efi_capsule_fw3.
In order to run the test the following must be added to
sandbox_defconfig:
+CONFIG_CMD_SF=y
+CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY=y
+CONFIG_CMD_FAT=y
+CONFIG_DFU=y
The ESRT is printed in the u-boot shell by calling efidebug esrt.
The test ensures that, after the capsule is installed, the ESRT
contains entries with the GUIDs:
- EFI_FIRMWARE_IMAGE_TYPE_UBOOT_FIT_GUID;
- EFI_FIRMWARE_IMAGE_TYPE_UBOOT_RAW_GUID;
test invocation:
sudo ./test/py/test.py --bd sandbox -k capsule_fw3 -l --build
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CC: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
CC: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CC: Alexander Graf <agraf@csgraf.de>
CC: nd@arm.com
Signed-off-by: Jose Marinho <jose.marinho@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This commmit exercises the ESRT creation in a EFI selftest.
A fake FMP, with TEST_ESRT_NUM_ENTRIES FW images, is installed in the
system leading to the corresponding ESRT entries being populated.
The ESRT entries are checked against the datastructure used to
initialize the FMP.
Invocation from the sandbox platform:
add to sandbox_defconfig:
+CONFIG_CMD_BOOTEFI_SELFTEST=y
make sandbox_capsule_defconfig all
./u-boot -d arch/sandbox/dts/test.dtb
bootefi selftest
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CC: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
CC: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CC: Alexander Graf <agraf@csgraf.de>
CC: nd@arm.com
Signed-off-by: Jose Marinho <jose.marinho@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The ESRT is initialised during efi_init_objlist after
efi_initialize_system_table().
The ESRT is recreated from scratch at the following events:
- successful UpdateCapsule;
- FMP instance install.
The code ensures that every ESRT entry has a unique fw_class value.
Limitations:
- The ESRT is not updated if an FMP instance is uninstalled;
- the fields image_type and flags are in the current implementation left
undefined. Setting these values will require a per-platform function
that returns the image_type/flags as a function of the image fw_class.
CC: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CC: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
CC: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
CC: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
CC: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CC: Alexander Graf <agraf@csgraf.de>
CC: nd@arm.com
Signed-off-by: Jose Marinho <jose.marinho@arm.com>
Remove two EFI_CALL() indirections.
Move ESRT GUID in efidebug's list of GUIDs.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Multiple DFU entities may share the same SPI device. We must make sure that
the SPI device is only freed once.
When using the driver model it is not necessary to free the SPI device.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
The UEFI spec allows a packed array of UEFI device paths in the
FilePathList[] of an EFI_LOAD_OPTION. The first file path must
describe the loaded image but the rest are OS specific.
Previous patches parse the device path and try to use the second
member of the array as an initrd. So let's modify efidebug slightly
and install the second file described in the command line as the
initrd device path.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Up to now we install EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL to load an initrd
unconditionally. Although we correctly return various EFI exit codes
depending on the file status (i.e EFI_NO_MEDIA, EFI_NOT_FOUND etc), the
kernel loader, only falls back to the cmdline interpreted initrd if the
protocol is not installed.
This creates a problem for EFI installers, since they won't be able to
load their own initrd and continue the installation. It also makes the
feature hard to use, since we can either have a single initrd or we have
to recompile u-boot if the filename changes.
So let's introduce a different logic that will decouple the initrd
path from the config option we currently have.
When defining a UEFI BootXXXX we can use the filepathlist and store
a file path pointing to our initrd. Specifically the EFI spec describes:
"The first element of the array is a device path that describes the device
and location of the Image for this load option. Other device paths may
optionally exist in the FilePathList, but their usage is OSV specific"
When the EFI application is launched through the bootmgr, we'll try to
interpret the extra device path. If that points to a file that exists on
our disk, we'll now install the load_file2 and the efi-stub will be able
to use it.
This opens up another path using U-Boot and defines a new boot flow.
A user will be able to control the kernel/initrd pairs without explicit
cmdline args or GRUB.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
A following patch introduces a different logic for loading initrd's
based on the EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL.
Since similar logic can be applied in the future for other system files
(i.e DTBs), let's add some helper functions which will retrieve and
parse file paths stored in EFI variables.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
On the following patches we allow for an initrd path to be stored in
Boot#### variables. Specifically we encode in the FIlePathList[] of
the EFI_LOAD_OPTIONS for each Boot#### variable.
The FilePathList[] array looks like this:
kernel - 0xff - VenMedia(initrd GUID) - initrd1 - 0x01 initrd2 - 0xff
So let's add the relevant functions to concatenate and retrieve a device
path based on a Vendor GUID.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reformat function descriptions.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When uploading an EFI binary via the UART we have to call
efi_set_bootdev() or we won't be able to execute it.
Put the includes into alphabetic order.
Fixes: 5f59518a7b ("efi_loader: setting boot device")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When uploading an EFI binary via the UART we need to assign a device path.
* Provide devicepath node to text conversion for Uart() node.
* Provide function to create Uart() device path.
* Add UART support to efi_dp_from_name().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Even if CONFIG_DM_VIDEO=y and stdout="vidconsole", a video device may not
be available. Check the return values of the relevant functions.
If no video output device is available, assume that the serial console is
in use.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This occur when building on Raspberry Pi 400 (32-bit ARM). Fix them.
Examples:
cmd/efidebug.c: In function ‘do_efi_capsule_update’:
cmd/efidebug.c:75:49: warning: cast from pointer to integer of different
size [-Wpointer-to-int-cast]
ret = EFI_CALL(RT->update_capsule(&capsule, 1, (u64)NULL));
^
include/efi_loader.h:104:9: note: in definition of macro ‘EFI_CALL’
typeof(exp) _r = exp; \
^~~
cmd/efidebug.c:75:49: warning: cast from pointer to integer of different
size [-Wpointer-to-int-cast]
ret = EFI_CALL(RT->update_capsule(&capsule, 1, (u64)NULL));
^
include/efi_loader.h:104:19: note: in definition of macro ‘EFI_CALL’
typeof(exp) _r = exp; \
^~~
In file included from include/common.h:20,
from lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:9:
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c: In function ‘efi_update_capsule’:
include/efi_loader.h:83:8: warning: format ‘%lu’ expects argument of type
‘long unsigned int’, but argument 10 has type ‘size_t’
{aka ‘unsigned int’} [-Wformat=]
debug("%sEFI: Entry %s(" format ")\n", __efi_nesting_inc(), \
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/linux/printk.h:37:21: note: in definition of macro ‘pr_fmt’
#define pr_fmt(fmt) fmt
^~~
include/log.h:229:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘log’
log(LOG_CATEGORY, LOGL_DEBUG, fmt, ##args); \
^~~
include/log.h:249:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘debug_cond’
debug_cond(_DEBUG, fmt, ##args)
^~~~~~~~~~
include/efi_loader.h:83:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘debug’
debug("%sEFI: Entry %s(" format ")\n", __efi_nesting_inc(), \
^~~~~
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:444:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘EFI_ENTRY’
EFI_ENTRY("%p, %lu, %llu\n", capsule_header_array, capsule_count,
^~~~~~~~~
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:444:19: note: format string is defined here
EFI_ENTRY("%p, %lu, %llu\n", capsule_header_array, capsule_count,
~~^
%u
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Replace (uintptr_t)NULL by 0.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We are redefining how u-boot locates the initrd to load via the kernel
LoadFile2 protocol. This selftest is not relevant any more, so remove
it. A new one will be added later
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The (yet unreleased version of the) devicetree specification clearly
states that:
As with the /reserved-memory node, when booting via UEFI
entries in the Memory Reservation Block must also be listed
in the system memory map obtained via the GetMemoryMap() toi
protect against allocations by UEFI applications. The memory
reservation block entries should be listed with type
EfiReservedMemoryType.
This restores the behaviour that was changed by commit 4cbb2930bd
("efi_loader: consider no-map property of reserved memory").
Fixes: 4cbb2930bd ("efi_loader: consider no-map property of reserved memory")
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
GRUB_ARM32_WORKAROUND can be disabled on ARCH_SUNXI as the Allwinner SoCs
only have a level 2 cache controlled via CP15 and not an architecturally
defined cache. Having the cache available speeds up booting Linux.
On ARCH_BCM283X it is already disabled via rpi_2_defconfig. But let's move
this setting to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Linux commit a75bbe71a27 ("mtd: rawnand: fsl_ifc: fix FSL NAND driver to
read all ONFI parameter pages")
Per ONFI specification (Rev. 4.0), if the CRC of the first parameter page
read is not valid, the host should read redundant parameter page copies.
Fix FSL NAND driver to read the two redundant copies which are mandatory
in the specification.
Signed-off-by: Jane Wan <Jane.Wan@nokia.com>
Signed-off-by: Boris Brezillon <boris.brezillon@bootlin.com>
Signed-off-by: Maxim Kochetkov <fido_max@inbox.ru>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
As on some incipient Layerscape platforms (LS1043A series) there isn't
separate PF control register block, these registers reside in the LUT
register block, so when the driver detected there isn't 'ctrl', it will
assign the 'lut' address to the ls_pcie->ctrl.
The current code allocate memory for the struct ls_pcie with random
contents, this can result in skipping to assign the ls_pcie->ctrl with
the 'lut' address, then further crash with the incorrect address.
Fixes: 118e58e26e ("pci: layerscape: Split the EP and RC driver")
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS1028A-RDB/QDS has Micron "mt35xu02g" nor flash of size 256M with 128K
sector size. Correct CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE value to 128K.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LS1028A-QDS has CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SST and CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_EON defines
present in header. Move these entries from header to defconfigs.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is no Spansion flash on LS1028A-RDB/QDS boards.
Unset CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SPANSION option for both the boards.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
It is now safe to remove Flexspi configs NXP_FSPI_FLASH_SIZE and
NXP_FSPI_FLASH_NUM options from headers as they are no longer used by
driver anymore.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There is no Spansion flash on LX2160A-RDB/QDS boards.
Unset CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_SPANSION option for both the boards.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The User Guide contains handy things like block diagrams and DIP switch
settings and it's even available on the public web. Add a link to it in
the README.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The T2080RDB has a ds1339 on i2c0. Add this to the devicetree and enable
the relevant support in the configs.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
As far as u-boot is concerned the ds1339 is compatible with the other
devices supported by the ds1307 driver. The Linux driver does expose
some additional functionality but as far as u-boot is concerned just
adding the compatible string is enough.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The name of the define must indicate 'Asynchronous', so 'ASYNC' is more
appropriate. AYSNC is probably a typo, and checkpatch script is throwing
a warning if this is set in the board include files.
It is save to change this now as none of the existing designs is using it
so far, but we will use it in our design it help to make IFC settings
more transparent.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Check CONFIG_SOCFPGA_SECURE_VAB_AUTH before perform 'is OS booted from FIT'
checking in board_prep_linux function. And, fix typo of
CONFIG_SOCFPGA_SECURE_VAB_AUTH_ALLOW_NON_FIT_IMAGE.
CONFIG_FIT will be enabled in both ATF and VAB boot flow, thus,
board_prep_linux function will always be called by both ATF and
VAB boot flow.
board_pre_linux function will do 'is OS booted from FIT' checking,
and it will be called before board_fit_image_post_process function.
VAB boot flow expects the OS is always booted from FIT and with VAB
signed cerfiticate because the VAB authentication is implemented in
board_fit_image_post_process function. So, VAB needs the 'is OS booted
from FIT' checking in board_pre_linux function.
However, for ATF boot flow, it is not a requirement that the OS must
always booted from FIT. The OS can be booted from individual Image and
kernel dtb file. Thus, we should not do 'if OS is booted from FIT'
checking in board_prep_linux function.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
The startup code in arm/cpu/arm926ejs preserves the link register across
the call to lowlevel_init by using r4:
mov r4, lr /* perserve link reg across call */
bl lowlevel_init /* go setup pll,mux,memory */
mov lr, r4 /* restore link */
The lowlevel_init function for at91 machines based on the same CPU uses r4
and hence corrupts it causing a data abort when it returns to the startup
code. This patch fixes this by using r6 instead of r4 in the lowlevel_init
function.
Discovered and the fix was tested on a AT91SAM9261 based board.
Signed-off-by: Martin Townsend <martin@rufilla.com>
Reviewed-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Now that dtoc generates some new C files, add these to the build so that
the instantiated devices and uclasses can be used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is no need to ever add new uclasses since these are set up at build
time. Update the code to return an error if this is attempted.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With this we don't need to scan and bind drivers, not even the root
device. We just need to locate the root device that was set up at build
time, then set our root in global_data to point to it.
Update the code to handle this case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When OF_PLATDATA_INST is enabled we don't need to create the uclass list.
Instead we just need to point to the existing list. Update the code
accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With OF_PLATDATA_INST devices are bound at build time. We should not need
binding of devices at runtime in most cases. However it is inflexible to
absolutely prohibit it, so add an option to control this.
Update the driver model core so that it does not bind devices. Update
device_bind() to return an error if called.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add macros which work with instantiated devices and uclasses, as created
at build time by dtoc. Include variants that can be used in data
structures.
These are mostly used by dtoc but it is worth documenting them fully for
the occasional case where they might come up in user code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present linker lists are designed for use in code. They make use of
statements within expressions ({...}), for example.
It is possible to generate a reference to a linker_list entry that can
be used in data structures, where such features are not permitted. It
requires that the reference first be declared as extern. In other
words the existing macro needs to be split into two parts.
Add new macros to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We can use extern instead, so let's drop these macros. It adds one more
thing to learn about and doesn't make the code any clearer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The module defines a duplicate uclass driver for UCLASS_SIMPLE_BUS, but
it is not allowed. This breaks of-platdata and makes the result
non-deterministic.
The driver does not need to be an uclass driver, so lets remove it. I
had turned it into an uclass driver because I thought wrongly it had to
call the dm_scan_fdt_dev routine to work properly, but some tests on the
board have shown otherwise.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for generating a file containing udevice instances. This
avoids the need to create these at run time.
Update a test uclass to include a 'per_device_plat_auto' member, to
increase test coverage.
Add another tab to the driver_info output so it lines up nicely like the
device-instance output.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for generating a file containing uclass instances. This avoids
the need to create these at run time.
Update a test uclass to include a 'priv_auto' member, to increase test
coverage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a summary to the top of the generated code, to make it easier to see
what the file contains.
Also add a tab to .plat so that its value lines up with the others.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For now dtoc only supports a hard-coded list of phandle properties, to
avoid any situation where it makes a mistake in its determination.
Make this into a constant dict, recording both the phandle property name
and the associated #cells property in the target node. This makes it
easier to find and modify.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some of these do not follow the rules. Make sure the driver name matches
the compatible string in all cases.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this property is a phandle but does not have a #xxx-cells
property to match it. Add one so that is works the same as gpio and clock
phandles.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This file is not used when instantiating devices. Update dtoc to skip
generating its contents and just add a comment instead.
Also it is useful to see the driver name and parent for each device.
Update the file to show that information, to avoid updating the same
tests twice.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an option to generate the declaration file, which declares all
drivers and uclasses, so references can be used in the code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add Kconfig options to support build-time device instantiation. When
fully implemented, this will allow dtoc to create U-Boot devices (i.e.
struct udevice records) at build time, thus reducing code space in
SPL.
For now this defaults to off, but will be enabled when the rest of
the implementation is in place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an option to instantiate devices at build time. For now this just
parses the option and sets up a few parameters.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The device for the root node is normally bound by driver model on init.
With devices being instantiated at build time, we must handle the root
device also.
Add support for processing the root node, which may not have a compatible
string.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We only care about uclasses that are actually used. This is determined by
the drivers that use them. Check all the used drivers and build a list of
'valid' uclasses.
Also add references to the uclasses so we can generate C code that uses
them. Attach a uclass to each valid driver.
For the tests, now that we have uclasses we must create an explicit test
for the case where a node does not have one. This should only happen if
the source code does not build, or the source-code scanning fails to find
it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that we have the alias information we can assign a sequence number
to each device in the uclass. Store this in the node associated with each
device.
This requires renaming the sandbox test drivers to have the right name.
Note that test coverage is broken with this patch, but fixed in the next
one.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If a driver declaration is included in a comment, dtoc currently gets
confused. Update the parser to only consider declarations that begin at
the start of a line. Since multi-line comments begin with an asterisk,
this avoids the problem.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Scan the aliases in the device tree to establish the number of devices
within each uclass, and the sequence number of each.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If drivers have the same name then we cannot distinguish them. This only
matters if the driver is actually used by dtoc, but in that case, issue
a warning.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Instead of using a separate step for this processing, handle it while
scanning its associated driver. This allows us to drop the code coverage
exception in this case.
Note that only files containing drivers are scanned by dtoc, so aliases
declared in a file that doesn't hold a driver will not be noticed. It
would be confusing to put them anywhere other than in the driver that they
relate to, but update the documentation to say this explicitly, just in
case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Typically dtoc can detect the header file needed for a driver by looking
for the structs that it uses. For example, if a driver as a .priv_auto
that uses 'struct serial_priv', then dtoc can search header files for the
definition of that struct and use the file.
In some cases, enums are used in drivers, typically with the .data field
of struct udevice_id. Since dtoc does not support searching for these,
add a way to tell dtoc which header to use. This works as a macro included
in the driver definition.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-Boot operates in several phases, typically TPL, SPL and U-Boot proper.
The latter does not use dtoc.
In some rare cases different drivers are used for two phases. For example,
in TPL it may not be necessary to use the full PCI subsystem, so a simple
driver can be used instead.
This works in the build system simply by compiling in one driver or the
other (e.g. PCI driver + uclass for SPL; simple_bus for TPL). But dtoc has
no way of knowing which code is compiled in for which phase, since it does
not inspect Makefiles or dependency graphs.
So to make this work for dtoc, we need to be able to explicitly mark
drivers with their phase. This is done by adding an empty macro to the
driver. Add support for this in dtoc.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add logic to assign property values to nodes as required by dtoc. The
references allow nodes to refer to each other in C code. The macros used
by dtoc are not yet defined in driver model. They will be added along
with the actual driver model implementation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is convenient to attach drivers, etc. to nodes so that we can use the
Node object as the main data structure in this module.
Add a function which adds the new properties, along with documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These have '_test' suffixes which are not present on the drivers in the
source code. Drop the suffixes to avoid a mismatch when scanning.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is confusing to have the test files in the same places as the
implementation. Move them into a separate directory.
Add a helper function for test_dtoc, to avoid repeating the same
path.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Drivers can have private / platform data contained in structs and these
struct definitions are generally kept in header files. In order to
generate build-time devices, dtoc needs to generate code that declares
the data contained in those structs. This generated code must include the
relevant header file, to avoid a build error.
We need a way for dtoc to scan header files for struct definitions. Then,
when it wants to generate code that uses a struct, it can make sure it
includes the correct header file, first.
Add a parser for struct information, similar to drivers. Keep a dict of
the structs that were found.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Uclasses can have per-device private / platform data so dtoc needs to
scan these drivers. This allows it to find out the size of this data so
it can be allocated a build time.
Add a parser for uclass information, similar to drivers. Keep a dict of
the uclasses that were found.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In order to output variables to hold the priv/plat information used by
each device, dtoc needs to know the struct for each. With this, it can
declare this at build time:
u8 xxx_priv [sizeof(struct <name>)];
Collect the various struct names from the drivers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We should ignore anything in the .git directory or any of the
build-sandbox, etc. directories created by 'make check'. These can confuse
dtoc. Update the code to ignore these.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present most of the tests scan the U-Boot source tree as part of their
run. This information does not change across tests, so we can save time
by remembering it.
Add a way to set up this information and use it for each test, taking a
copy first, so as not to mess up the original.
This reduces the run time from about 1.6 seconds to 1.5 seconds on my
machine. For code coverage (which cannot run in parallel), it reduces from
33 seconds to 5.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we simply record the name of a driver parsed from its
implementation file. We also need to get the uclass and a few other
things so we can instantiate devices at build time. Add support for
collecting this information. This requires parsing each driver file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the FAT environment driver to the priority list.
When testing the UEFI sub-system the EFI system partition is formatted with
FAT so it is reasonable to store the environment there.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
goto after return has not effect. Calling of_node_put() in case of some
errors and not for others is inconsistent.
Fixes: 51bdb50904 ("dm: Introduce xxx_get_dma_range()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently keyboard input fails in the GUI window opened by
./u-boot -T -l
Add the missing include to test.dts.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It's convenient to be able to scroll up in `patman -H`.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Boichat <drinkcat@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This files uses the macro U_BOOT_CMD which is defined in command.h,
but command.h is conditionally included. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The PCI MMC driver depends on the generic MMC SDHCI driver,
otherwise it does not compile.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
UEFI test files like helloworld.efi require an architecture specific
PE-COFF header.
Currently this does not work for cross compiling. If $CROSS_COMPILE is set,
use the first part of the architecture triplet from the variable to
choose the PE-COFF header.
Now we can cross-compile the sandbox, e.g.
make sandbox_defconfig NO_SDL=1
CROSS_COMPILE=/opt/bin/aarch64-linux-gnu- NO_SDL=1 MK_ARCH=aarch64 make
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When a tag is used in a patch subject (e.g. "tag: rest of message") and
it cannot be found as an alias, patman currently reports a fatal error,
unless -t is provided, in which case it reports a warning.
Experience suggest that the fatal error is not very useful. Instead,
default to reporting a warning, with -t tell patman to ignore it
altogether.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the subcommands some of the documentation examples are no-longer
correct. Fix all of them, so it is consistent.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there is only one board which uses sandbox SPL. But with
sandbox_noinst being added, this is no longer true. Add a --board flag
so that we just build one board on azure, as is done in gitlab.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This patch adds an option which allows setting the device header offset.
This is useful if this tool is used to generate ATF BL2 image of mt7622 for
SD cards.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch makes use of the decompression mechanism implemented for mt7628
previously to reduce the total image size. Binman will be also removed.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Currently the setbrg logic of serial-mtk is messy, and should be rewritten.
Also an option is added to make it possible to use highspeed-3 mode for all
bauds.
The new logic is:
1. If baud clock > 12MHz
a) If baud <= 115200, highspeed-0 mode will be used (ns16550 compatible)
b) If baud <= 576000, highspeed-2 mode will be used
c) any bauds > 576000, highspeed-3 mode will be used
2. If baud clock <= 12MHz
Forced highspeed-3 mode
a) If baud <= 115200, calculates the divisor using DIV_ROUND_CLOSEST
b) any bauds > 115200, the same as 1. c)
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The EPHY LEDs belongs to the built-in FE switch of MT7629, which is barely
used. These LED pins on reference boards are used as JTAG socket. So it's
a good idea to change the default state to JTAG, and this will make it
convenience for debugging.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
It's better to use the generic timer which is correctly initialized by
the ATF. The generic timer has higher resolution than the mtk_timer.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The EPHY LEDs of mt7629 can be used as JTAG. This patch adds the jtag pin
group to the pinctrl driver.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The mtk pinctrl driver is a combination driver with support for both
pinctrl and gpio. When this driver is used in SPL, gpio support may not be
enabled, and this will result in a compilation error.
To fix this, macros are added to make sure gpio related code will only be
compiled when gpio support is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This is a bug fix for mtk pinctrl common part. Appearently pins should be
used instead of grps in mtk_get_pin_name().
Signed-off-by: Sam Shih <sam.shih@mediatek.com>
More than one pumpkin board has been made with different MediaTek SoCs.
Rename the pumpkin board to follow the naming convention of all
other MediaTek boards and also to not be confusing when other pumpkin
boards will be added in follow-up commits.
Signed-off-by: Fabien Parent <fparent@baylibre.com>
When uploading an EFI binary via the UART we have to call
efi_set_bootdev() or we won't be able to execute it.
Put the includes into alphabetic order.
Fixes: 5f59518a7b ("efi_loader: setting boot device")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When uploading an EFI binary via the UART we need to assign a device path.
* Provide devicepath node to text conversion for Uart() node.
* Provide function to create Uart() device path.
* Add UART support to efi_dp_from_name().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Even if CONFIG_DM_VIDEO=y and stdout="vidconsole", a video device may not
be available. Check the return values of the relevant functions.
If no video output device is available, assume that the serial console is
in use.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At the moment the nvme_get_features() and nvme_set_features() functions
carry a (somewhat misleading) comment about missing cache maintenance.
As it turns out, nvme_get_features() has no caller at all in the tree,
and nvme_set_features' only user doesn't use a DMA buffer.
Mention that in the comment, and leave some breadcrumbs for the future,
should those functions attract more users.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At the moment nvme_read_completion_status() tries to invalidate a single
member of the cqes[] array, which is shady as just a single entry is
not cache line aligned.
The structure is dictated by hardware, and with 16 bytes is smaller than
any cache line we usually deal with. Also multiple entries need to be
consecutive in memory, so we can't pad them to cover a whole cache line.
As a consequence we can only always invalidate all of them - U-Boot just
uses two of them anyway. This is fine, as they are only ever read by the
CPU (apart from the initial zeroing), so they can't become dirty.
Make this obvious by always invalidating the whole array, regardless of
the entry number we are about to read.
Also blow up the allocation size to cover whole cache lines, to avoid
other heap allocations to sneak in.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Tested-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The api_public.h header file undefined macro CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
But api/api_storage.c includes this header before including part.h,
causing the type of lbaint_t and subsequently the type signature of
blk_dread() and blk_dwrite() functions to change from the rest of U-Boot
(if CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA is defined for the board).
This is of course wrong, because the call to blk_dread() / blk_dwrite()
will receive mangled arguments.
Fix this by removing the undef of macro CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA and instead
make the immediate code do what it would do as if the macro was not
defined.
Add a FIXME to whoever is maintaining this code.
CI managed to trigger this bug when compiling for lsxhl_defconfig, which
has CONFIG_API selected. The compiler complained about blk_dwrite() and
blk_dread() not matching original declarations:
include/blk.h:280:15: warning: type of ‘blk_dwrite’ does not match
original declaration
[-Wlto-type-mismatch]
280 | unsigned long blk_dwrite(struct blk_desc *block_dev, lbaint_t st
| ^
drivers/block/blk-uclass.c:456:15: note: type mismatch in parameter 2
456 | unsigned long blk_dwrite(struct blk_desc *block_dev, lbaint_t st
| ^
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The module defines a duplicate uclass driver for UCLASS_SIMPLE_BUS, but
it is not allowed. This breaks of-platdata and makes the result
non-deterministic.
The driver does not need to be an uclass driver, so lets remove it. I
had turned it into an uclass driver because I thought wrongly it had to
call the dm_scan_fdt_dev routine to work properly, but some tests on the
board have shown otherwise.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since commit 8ee802f899 ("mmc: fsl_esdhc: make sure delay chain locked
for HS400") HS400 mode is unreliable on LS1028A SoCs. Some workarounds are
missing for this SoC.
Disable HS400 mode for now.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
building with MTK_AHCI enabled results in implicit declaration and
undefined reference of dev_err followed by a segfault of gcc
drivers/ata/mtk_ahci.c: In function 'mtk_ahci_parse_property':
drivers/ata/mtk_ahci.c:65:4: warning:
implicit declaration of function 'dev_err'
drivers/ata/mtk_ahci.c:65: undefined reference to `dev_err'
in function `mtk_ahci_probe':
drivers/ata/mtk_ahci.c:92: undefined reference to `dev_err'
Segmentation fault
fix this by adding the dm/device_compat.h to includes
Signed-off-by: Frank Wunderlich <frank-w@public-files.de>
- Make tests search /sbin for tools, don't use ENODATA in host tools to
be more portable, avb fix when partition isn't found and a bugfix for
mediatek mmc.
On some distributions the mkfs.ext4 is under /sbin and /sbin is not set
for mere users. Include /sbin to the PATH when creating ext4 disk image,
so that users won't get a scary traceback from Python.
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Unfortunately -ENODATA is not available in OpenBSD. Use -EBADMSG
instead, to indicate a missing timestamp.
Fixes: c5819701a3 image: Adjust the workings of fit_check_format()
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
commit e58e68d9 ("mmc: mtk-sd: assign plat->cfg.f_max with a correct value")
wrongly assumed that plat->cfg.f_max is always unset at the time
mscd_drv_probe() is run. This is not true in case max-frequency being
defined in device tree, as it is then already set by mmc_of_parse()
in msdc_of_to_plat().
Only set plat->cfg.f_max to the default maximum value in case it is
not already set to a sane value.
Fixes: e58e68d93e ("mmc: mtk-sd: assign plat->cfg.f_max with a correct value")
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Signed-off-by: Daniel Golle <daniel@makrotopia.org>
The EK874 development kit from Silicon Linux is made of CAT874 (the main
board) and CAT875 (the sub board that goes on top of CAT874).
This patch adds the required board support to boot Si-Linux EK874 board
based on R8A774C0 SoC.
DTS files apart from r8a774c0-ek874-u-boot.dts and r8a774c0-u-boot.dtsi
have been imported from Linux kernel 5.11 commit f40ddce88593
("Linux 5.11").
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Renesas RZ/G2E (a.k.a. r8a774c0) is pin compatible with R-Car
E3 (a.k.a. r8a77990), however it doesn't have several automotive
specific peripherals.
This patch hooks R8A774C0 SoC with the pfc driver.
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
The HiHope RZ/G2H board from HopeRun consists of main board
(HopeRun HiHope RZ/G2H main board) and sub board(HopeRun
HiHope RZ/G2H sub board). The HiHope RZ/G2H sub board sits
below the HiHope RZ/G2H main board.
This patch adds the required board support to boot HopeRun HiHope
RZ/G2H board.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
The HiHope RZ/G2N board from HopeRun consists of main board
(HopeRun HiHope RZ/G2N main board) and sub board(HopeRun
HiHope RZ/G2N sub board). The HiHope RZ/G2N sub board sits
below the HiHope RZ/G2N main board.
This patch adds the required board support to boot HopeRun HiHope
RZ/G2N board.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
The HiHope RZ/G2M board from HopeRun consists of main board
(HopeRun HiHope RZ/G2M main board) and sub board(HopeRun
HiHope RZ/G2M sub board). The HiHope RZ/G2M sub board sits
below the HiHope RZ/G2M main board.
This patch adds the required board support to boot HopeRun HiHope
RZ/G2M board.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-04-rc5
Bug fixes:
* fix memory type for memory reservation block
* illegal cast to pointer in initrddump
* fix compiler warnings
Documentation:
* move README.dfu to HTML documentation
Move README.dfu to doc/usage/dfu.rst and convert to reStructured text.
In the long run this page should be split into two. One for the overview
and one for the dfu command. UEFI capsule updates and dfutftp should be
integrated into the overview page.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This occur when building on Raspberry Pi 400 (32-bit ARM). Fix them.
Examples:
cmd/efidebug.c: In function ‘do_efi_capsule_update’:
cmd/efidebug.c:75:49: warning: cast from pointer to integer of different
size [-Wpointer-to-int-cast]
ret = EFI_CALL(RT->update_capsule(&capsule, 1, (u64)NULL));
^
include/efi_loader.h:104:9: note: in definition of macro ‘EFI_CALL’
typeof(exp) _r = exp; \
^~~
cmd/efidebug.c:75:49: warning: cast from pointer to integer of different
size [-Wpointer-to-int-cast]
ret = EFI_CALL(RT->update_capsule(&capsule, 1, (u64)NULL));
^
include/efi_loader.h:104:19: note: in definition of macro ‘EFI_CALL’
typeof(exp) _r = exp; \
^~~
In file included from include/common.h:20,
from lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:9:
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c: In function ‘efi_update_capsule’:
include/efi_loader.h:83:8: warning: format ‘%lu’ expects argument of type
‘long unsigned int’, but argument 10 has type ‘size_t’
{aka ‘unsigned int’} [-Wformat=]
debug("%sEFI: Entry %s(" format ")\n", __efi_nesting_inc(), \
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/linux/printk.h:37:21: note: in definition of macro ‘pr_fmt’
#define pr_fmt(fmt) fmt
^~~
include/log.h:229:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘log’
log(LOG_CATEGORY, LOGL_DEBUG, fmt, ##args); \
^~~
include/log.h:249:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘debug_cond’
debug_cond(_DEBUG, fmt, ##args)
^~~~~~~~~~
include/efi_loader.h:83:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘debug’
debug("%sEFI: Entry %s(" format ")\n", __efi_nesting_inc(), \
^~~~~
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:444:2: note: in expansion of macro ‘EFI_ENTRY’
EFI_ENTRY("%p, %lu, %llu\n", capsule_header_array, capsule_count,
^~~~~~~~~
lib/efi_loader/efi_capsule.c:444:19: note: format string is defined here
EFI_ENTRY("%p, %lu, %llu\n", capsule_header_array, capsule_count,
~~^
%u
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Replace (uintptr_t)NULL by 0.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We are redefining how u-boot locates the initrd to load via the kernel
LoadFile2 protocol. This selftest is not relevant any more, so remove
it. A new one will be added later
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Use %z when printing size_t values. This avoids errors on 32-bit
machines.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use a conversion to size_t for printing stat.st_size.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The (yet unreleased version of the) devicetree specification clearly
states that:
As with the /reserved-memory node, when booting via UEFI
entries in the Memory Reservation Block must also be listed
in the system memory map obtained via the GetMemoryMap() toi
protect against allocations by UEFI applications. The memory
reservation block entries should be listed with type
EfiReservedMemoryType.
This restores the behaviour that was changed by commit 4cbb2930bd
("efi_loader: consider no-map property of reserved memory").
Fixes: 4cbb2930bd ("efi_loader: consider no-map property of reserved memory")
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
GRUB_ARM32_WORKAROUND can be disabled on ARCH_SUNXI as the Allwinner SoCs
only have a level 2 cache controlled via CP15 and not an architecturally
defined cache. Having the cache available speeds up booting Linux.
On ARCH_BCM283X it is already disabled via rpi_2_defconfig. But let's move
this setting to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Add WATCHDOG_RESET() in MTD framework and STM32 QSPI driver
- stm32mp1_trusted_defconfig rely on SCMI support
- Remove the nand MTD configuration for NOR boot in stm32mp1 board
- STM32programmer update
- Bsec: manage clock when present in device tree
- stm32mp15: move bootdelay configuration in defconfig
- Update for stm32 dsi and dw_mipi_dsi
- STM32 MCU's cleanup
- Fix compilation issue depending on SYS_DCACHE_OFF and SYS_ICACHE_OFF flags
- Update stm32mp1 doc
Enable relevant configs that checks for the size of image and stack:
BSS: 3KB
Initial MALLOC: ~22KB
Initial Stack: 8K
SPL Image size can be: ~215KB
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Current BSS allocation of SPL is as below:
$ size spl/u-boot-spl
text data bss dec hex filename
132369 7852 1496 141717 22995 spl/u-boot-spl
But 20KB is allocated currently for BSS. Reduce it to 3KB and save some
space for stack.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
In a previous attempt to unify config options and remove items
from the whitelist file, SPL items were moved into a section
enabled with CONFIG_SPL_BUILD. Unfortunately, SPL_PAD_TO
is referenced at the head Makefile and uses this define
to create padding of the output file. When it was moved
to CONFIG_SPL_BUILD, it caused boot errors with devices
that are not booting from NOR. Fix the boot issues by moving
SPL_PAD_TO out so it's always.
Fixes: 7bb33e4684 ("ARM: da850-evm: Unify config options with Kconfig")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
With bd_info dropped from the data section, the Logic PD OMAP3 boards
and AM3517 fail to boot. Enabling CONFIG_SPL_ALLOC_BD restores
them.
Fixes: 38d6b7ebda ("spl: Drop bd_info in the data section")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The Secure Channel Protocol 03 command sends control requests
(enable/provision) to the TEE implementing the protocol between the
processor and the secure element.
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Adds support for a working SCP03 emulation. Input parameters are
validated however the commands (enable, provision) executed by the TEE
are assumed to always succeed.
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable and provision the SCP03 keys on a TEE controlled secured elemt
from the U-Boot shell.
Executing this command will generate and program new SCP03 encryption
keys on the secure element NVM.
Depending on the TEE implementation, the keys would then be stored in
some persistent storage or better derived from some platform secret
(so they can't be lost).
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
This Trusted Application allows enabling SCP03 as well as provisioning
the keys on TEE controlled secure element (ie, NXP SE050).
All the information flowing on buses (ie I2C) between the processor
and the secure element must be encrypted. Secure elements are
pre-provisioned with a set of keys known to the user so that the
secure channel protocol (encryption) can be enforced on the first
boot. This situation is however unsafe since the keys are publically
available.
For example, in the case of the NXP SE050, these keys would be
available in the OP-TEE source tree [2] and of course in the
documentation corresponding to the part.
To address that, users are required to rotate/provision those keys
(ie, generate new keys and write them in the secure element's
persistent memory).
For information on SCP03, check the Global Platform HomePage and
google for that term [1]
[1] globalplatform.org
[2] https://github.com/OP-TEE/optee_os/
check:
core/drivers/crypto/se050/adaptors/utils/scp_config.c
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The 'reset' command now resets sandbox but does not quit it. Fix the
instructions.
Fixes: 329dccc067 ("sandbox: implement reset")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some format strings use the wrong type. Fix them.
Example warnings:
In file included from test/dm/acpi.c:22:
test/dm/acpi.c: In function ‘dm_test_acpi_cmd_list’:
test/dm/acpi.c:362:21: warning: format ‘%lx’ expects argument of type
‘long unsigned int’, but argument 4 has type ‘unsigned int’ [-Wformat=]
ut_assert_nextline("RSDP %08lx %06lx (v02 U-BOOT)", addr,
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
sizeof(struct acpi_rsdp));
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
include/test/ut.h:282:33: note: in definition of macro ‘ut_assert_nextline’
if (ut_check_console_line(uts, fmt, ##args)) { \
^~~
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix the warning:
drivers/tpm/tpm2_tis_sandbox.c: In function ‘sandbox_tpm2_xfer’:
drivers/tpm/tpm2_tis_sandbox.c:288:48: warning: format ‘%ld’ expects
argument of type ‘long int’, but argument 2 has type ‘size_t’
{aka ‘unsigned int’} [-Wformat=]
printf("TPM2: Unmatching length, received: %ld, expected: %d\n",
~~^
%d
send_size, length);
~~~~~~~~~
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We don't need to enable logging to run this command since the output will
still appear. Drop the 'select'.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The existing log_ret() and log_msg_ret() macros consider an error to be
less than zero. But some function may return a positive number to indicate
a different kind of failure. Add macros to check for that also.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When multiple log() calls are used which don't end in newline, the
log prefix is prepended multiple times in the same line. This makes the
output look strange.
Fix this by detecting when the previous log record did not end in newline.
In that case, setting a flag.
Drop the unused BUFFSIZE in the test while we are here.
As an example implementation, update log_console to check the flag and
produce the expected output.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present only a single flag (force_debug) is used in log records. Before
adding more, convert this into a bitfield, so more can be added without
using more space.
To avoid expanding the log_record struct itself (which some drivers may
wish to store in memory) reduce the line-number field to 16 bits. This
provides for up to 64K lines which should be enough for anyone.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a second on writing tests, covering when to use Python and C, where
to put the tests, etc. Add a link to the existing Python test
documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present some of the documentation about running sandbox tests is in the
sandbox docs. It makes more sense to put it in with the other testing
docs, with a link there from sandbox. Update the documentation
accordingly.
Also add a paragraph explaining why sandbox exists and the test philosophy
that it uses.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As an example of an SPL test, add a new test for loading a FIT within
SPL. This runs on sandbox_spl. For this to work, the text base is adjusted
so that there is plenty of space available.
While we are here, document struct spl_load_info properly, since this is
currently ambiguous.
This test only verifies the logic path. It does not actually check that
the image is loaded correctly. It is not possible for sandbox's SPL to
actually run u-boot.img since it currently includes u-boot.bin rather than
u-boot. Further work could expand the test in that direction.
The need for this was noted at:
http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/20201216000944.2832585-3-mr.nuke.me@gmail.com/
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this casts addresses to pointers so cannot work with sandbox.
Update the code to use map_sysmem() instead.
As part of this change, the existing load_ptr is renamed to src_ptr since
it is not a pointer to load_addr. It is confusing to use a similar name
for something that is not actually related. For the alignment code,
ALIGN() is used instead of open-coded alignment. Add a comment to the line
that casts away a const.
Use a (new) load_ptr variable to access memory at address load_addr.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function can only locate the u-boot ELF file. For SPL it
is handy to be able to locate u-boot.img since this is what would normally
be loaded by SPL.
Add another argument to allow this to be selected.
While we are here, update the function to load SPL when running in TPL,
since that is the next stage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present SPL only runs driver model tests. Update it to run all
available tests, i.e. in any test suite.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present each test suite has its own portion of the linker_list section
of the image, but other lists are interspersed. This makes it hard to
enumerate all the available tests without knowing the suites that each one
is in.
Place all tests together in a single contiguous list by giving them
common prefix not used elsewhere in U-Boot. This makes it possible to find
the start and end of all tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we use the linker list directly. This is not very friendly, so
add a helpful macro instead. This will also allow us to change the naming
later without updating this code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current name is the same as the main test runner file. Rename it to
avoid confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add this functionality to ut_run_list() so it can be removed from
dm_test_run().
At this point all tests are run through ut_run_list().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a check to ut_run_list() as to whether a list has driver model tests.
Move the logic for the test devicetree into that function, in an effort
to eventually remove all logic from dm_test_run().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this function to use the return value of ut_run_list() to check for
success/failure, so that they are in sync. Also return a command success
code so that the caller gets what it expects.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use this function instead of implementing it separately for driver model.
Make ut_run_tests() private since it is only used in test-main.c
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we use a global test state for all driver-model tests. Make use
of a local struct like we do with the other tests.
To make this work, add functions to get and set this state. When a test
starts, the state is set (so it can be used in the test). When a test
finishes, the state is unset, so it cannot be used by mistake.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Driver model tests are generally run twice, once with livetree enable and
again with it disabled. Add a function to handle this and call it from the
driver model test runner.
Make ut_run_test() private since it is not used outside test-main.c now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Instead of having a separate function for running driver model tests, use
the common one. Make the pre/post-run functions private since we don't
need these outside of test-main.c
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this function into the common test runner and rename it to
dm_test_post_run() so that its purpose is clear.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this function into test-main so that all the init is in one place.
Rename it so that its purpose is clearer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Driver model is a core part of U-Boot. We don't really need to have a
separate test structure for the driver model tests and it makes it harder
to write a test if you have to think about which type of test it is.
Subsume the fields from struct dm_test_state into struct unit_test_state
and delete the former.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For driver model tests we want to reinit the data structures so that
everything is in a known state before the test runs. This avoids one test
changing something that breaks a subsequent tests.
Move the call for this into test_pre_run().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We already have a function for silencing the console during tests. Use
this from test_pre_run() and drop this code from the driver model tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Ultimately we want to get rid of the special driver model test init and
use test_pre_run() and test_post_run() for all tests. As a first step,
use those function to handle console recording.
For now we need a special case for setting uts->start, but that wil go
away once all init is in one place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Split out the test preparation into a separation function before
expanding it. Add a post-run function as well, currently empty.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new test runner that will eventually be able to run any test. For
now, have it run the 'command' unit tests, so that the functionality in
cmd_ut_category() moves into it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is the main test function for driver model but not for other tests.
Rename the file and the function so this is clear.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This prefix should be for setexpr, not mem. This means that trying to
select just these tests to run does not work. Fix it.
For some reason this provokes an assertion failure due to memory not
being freed. Move the env_set() in setexpr_test_str() to before the
malloc() heap size size is recorded and disable the rest in
setexpr_test_str_oper().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a few notes about the sandbox_spl tests, since they are special.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add details about how to run a sandbox test directly, without using
pytest. This is more convenient for rapid development, since it is faster
and allows easier use of a debugger. Also mention sandbox_flattree as an
example of the different sandbox builds available.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a comment about this option in the documentation. Also mention the
script that runs these combinations.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
With of-platdata we always have a dtv struct that holds the platform data
provided by the driver_info record. However, this struct can be empty if
there are no actual devicetree properties provided.
The upshot of empty platform data is that it will end up as a zero-size
member in the BSS section, which is fine. But if the driver specifies
plat_auto then it expects the correct amount of space to be allocated.
At present this does not happen, since device_bind() assumes that the
platform-data size will always be >0. As a result we end up not
allocating the space and just use the BSS region, overwriting whatever
other contents are present.
Fix this by removing the condition that platform data be non-empty, always
allocating space if requested.
This fixes a strange bug that has been lurking since of-platdata was
implemented. It has likely never been noticed since devices normally have
at least some devicetree properties, BSS is seldom used on SPL, the dtv
structs are normally at the end of bss and the overwriting only happens
if a driver changes its platform data.
It was discovered using sandbox_spl, which exercises more features than
a normal board might, and the critical global_data variable 'gd' happened
to be at the end of BSS.
Fixes: 9fa2819009 ("dm: core: Expand platdata for of-platdata devices")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Some more updates/sync's to A38x DDR3 code (Marek & Pali)
- marvell/ddr/AXP: Some type fixes found in the LTO work (Marek)
- Espressobin: Enable more options (Pali)
- pci-aardvark: Implement workaround for the readback value of
VEND_ID (Paili)
Fix following compilation issue when SYS_DCACHE_OFF and/or SYS_DCACHE_SYS
are enabled :
arch/arm/mach-stm32mp/cpu.c: In function ‘early_enable_caches’:
arch/arm/mach-stm32mp/cpu.c:223:10: error: ‘volatile struct arch_global_data’ has no member named ‘tlb_size’
223 | gd->arch.tlb_size = PGTABLE_SIZE;
| ^
arch/arm/mach-stm32mp/cpu.c:224:10: error: ‘volatile struct arch_global_data’ has no member named ‘tlb_addr’
224 | gd->arch.tlb_addr = (unsigned long)&early_tlb;
| ^
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove board_early_init_f() and board_late_init() callbacks for stm32
boards as the corresponding flags (CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT and
CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R) are now disabled.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
These flags was defined and callbacks linked to these flags are empty
and only returning 0.
Remove BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F and BOARD_LATE_INIT flags for these stm32 boards.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Config option ARMADA_39X is never set so remove all dead code hidden under
ifdef CONFIG_ARMADA_39X blocks.
Also remove useless checks for CONFIG_ARMADA_38X define as this macro is
always defined for a38x code path.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Marvell Armada 3720 Functional Errata, Guidelines, and Restrictions
document describes in erratum 4.1 PCIe value of vendor ID (Ref #: 243):
The readback value of VEND_ID (RD0070000h [15:0]) is 1B4Bh, while it
should read 11ABh.
The firmware can write the correct value, 11ABh, through VEND_ID
(RD0076044h [15:0]).
Implement this workaround in U-Boot PCIe controller driver aardvark for
both PCI vendor id and PCI subsystem vendor id.
This change affects PCI vendor id of PCIe root bridge emulated by Linux
kernel. With this change Linux kernel reports correct vendor id 11AB.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable support for NVMe disks which can be connected to mPCIe slot via M.2
reduction. Enable btrfs and squashfs filesystems which are used by more
Linux distributions. And enable fsuuid and setexpr commands which can be
useful in scripting.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The arrays `pbs_dq_mapping`, `div_ratio1to1` and `div_ratio2to1` have
different bounds declared in header files where these variables are also
defined from the ones declared in source files.
This causes the compiler to complain (when building with LTO):
ddr3_sdram.c:24:12: warning: type of ‘pbs_dq_mapping’ does not match
original declaration
[-Wlto-type-mismatch]
ddr3_patterns_64bit.h:911:5: note: array types have different bounds
ddr3_patterns_64bit.h:911:5: note: ‘pbs_dq_mapping’ was previously
declared here
ddr3_dfs.c:45:11: warning: type of ‘div_ratio1to1’ does not match
original declaration [-Wlto-type-mismatch]
ddr3_axp_vars.h:167:4: note: array types have different bounds
ddr3_axp_vars.h:167:4: note: ‘div_ratio1to1’ was previously declared
here
ddr3_dfs.c:46:11: warning: type of ‘div_ratio2to1’ does not match
original declaration [-Wlto-type-mismatch]
ddr3_axp_vars.h:196:4: note: array types have different bounds
ddr3_axp_vars.h:196:4: note: ‘div_ratio2to1’ was previously declared
here
CI managed to trigger this as an error when compiling with LTO for AXP.
Fix this by using values from the header files, which seem to be the
correct ones.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
In arch/arm/mach-mvebu/dram.c we always include axp's xor.h for common
XOR definitions, regardless whether we compile for axp or a38x.
But the declaration of this function has a different signature in axp's
xor.h from the one used in a38x' implementation - one parameter is u64
instead of u32. This can result in wrong argument's being passed to that
function on a38x with no one the wiser.
I discovered this when building U-Boot for Turris Omnia with LTO. The
compiler complains about the different signatures being thrown into the
same linking process:
axp/xor.h:67:5: warning: type of ‘mv_xor_mem_init’ does not match
original declaration [-Wlto-type-mismatch]
67 | int mv_xor_mem_init(u32 chan, u32 start_ptr, u32 block_size,
| ^
a38x/xor.c:165:5: note: type mismatch in parameter 3
165 | int mv_xor_mem_init(u32 chan, u32 start_ptr, unsigned long long
| ^
a38x/xor.c:165:5: note: type ‘long long unsigned int’ should match
type ‘u32’
Fix this by changing the type of the block_size argument in the axp's
implementation and header file to the one used in a38x (and upstream
mv-ddr-marvell).
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This syncs drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/ with the master branch of repository
https://github.com/MarvellEmbeddedProcessors/mv-ddr-marvell.git up to the
commit 7c351731d196 ("Merge pull request #29 from pali/sync-a38x-uboot").
This patch was created by following steps:
1. Replace all a38x files in U-Boot tree by files from upstream github
Marvell mv-ddr-marvell repository.
2. Run following command to omit portions not relevant for a38x and ddr3:
files=drivers/ddr/marvell/a38x/*
sed 's/#if defined(CONFIG_ARMADA_38X) || defined(CONFIG_ARMADA_39X)/#ifdef TRUE/' -i $files
unifdef -m -UMV_DDR -UMV_DDR_ATF -UCONFIG_DDR4 -UCONFIG_APN806 \
-UCONFIG_MC_STATIC -UCONFIG_MC_STATIC_PRINT -UCONFIG_PHY_STATIC \
-UCONFIG_PHY_STATIC_PRINT -UCONFIG_CUSTOMER_BOARD_SUPPORT \
-UCONFIG_A3700 -UA3900 -UA80X0 -UA70X0 -DTRUE $files
3. Manually omit SPDX-License-Identifier changes from this patch as
upstream license in upstream github repository contains long license
texts and U-Boot is using just SPDX-License-Identifier.
After applying this patch, a38x ddr3 code in upstream Marvell github
repository and in U-Boot would be fully identical. So in future applying
above steps could be used to sync code again.
The only change in this patch is removal of dead code and some fixes with
include files.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
commit 258be123226f8f5cd516b7813fe201fb7d7416e9 upstream.
At this moment, only page 0 of SPD is being read but to support
smbios, we need to read page 1 also which has more info. In order
to do that, we need to allocate more space.
Signed-off-by: Sujeet Baranwal <sujeet.baranwal@cavium.com>
Tested-by: sa_ip-sw-jenkins <sa_ip-sw-jenkins@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Sujeet Kumar Baranwal <Sujeet.Baranwal@cavium.com>
Reviewed-by: Nadav Haklai <nadavh@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Check whether user has explicitly defined the mmc device to use
in mmc_get_env_dev() with CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV.
On STMicroelectronics boards the used mmc device for environment is
the instance of boot device provided by the ROM code; the mmc instance
is configured by alias in device tree. The used partition is defined in
device tree with u-boot,mmc-env-partition = "ssbl".
This patch allows to override this selection for the support of customer
boards without alias; for example when SDMMC1 is not used and ENV in
mmc0=SDMMC2, user can force the value: CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV = 0.
On STMicroelectronics boards, the current behavior is kept with
CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV = -1.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The DSI phy can be turned on from the DSI digital interface in
the dphy_enable() function or from a dedicated DSI phy "wrapper"
in phy_ops->init() function. If the STM32MP1 case, the wrapper
is used then the dphy_enable() "warning" traces are not relevant.
This patch moves these "warning" traces to "debug" traces so
they are still available for DSI phy based on the digital
interface in debug logging mode, but not there in normal mode
for both cases.
Note: The related Linux kernel driver uses a "debug"
message too.
Signed-off-by: Yannick Fertre <yannick.fertre@foss.st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Acked-by: Yannick Fertre <yannick.fertre@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Remove the child device of the STM32 DSI bridge when the driver probe
failed to stop futher probe request on panels used with STMicroelectronics
board (orisetech_otm8009a.c or raydium-rm68200.c driver).
This patch avoid the trace "cannot get reset GPIO" when
STM32MP157 device tree is used on stm32MP151 SOC without DSI support.
In this hw_version value is 0, as DSI bridge is absent and the panel
ofdata_to_platdata is called for each try of panel probe,
the gpio reset pin is requested but after dsi father probe failed).
For the next request, the PANEL ofdata_to_platdata failed as the gpio
is already used.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The STM32MP15 boards have no reason to configure bootdelay in stm32mp1.h
as it is already done with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY (default = 2) and in
include/env_default.h.
This patch allows configuration for customers which reuse stm32mp1.h
and reduce the size of the default environment.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The command "stm32prog serial <dev>" can directly use the device sequence
number of serial uclass as this sequence number is egual to alias when it
exist; this assumption simplify the code and avoid access to gd->fdt_blob
and the device tree parsing.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
When serial instance is not found in device tree, the console
should be enabled and the error should be indicated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Add CONFIG_CMD_STM32PROG_SERIAL and CONFIG_CMD_STM32PROG_USB to
independently select the support of UART or USB communication for
STM32CubeProgrammer.
For serial boot over UART, user can deactivate CONFIG_CMD_STM32PROG_SERIAL
to use U-Boot console of binary loaded by UART (for board bring-up for
example).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Since commit d5d726d3cc ("configs: stm32mp1: only support SD card after
NOR in bootcmd_stm32mp"), the stm32mp1 boards only support SD card after
NOR boot device, so the MTD partitions for nand0 or spi-nand0 are useless
(no need of "UBI" partition in nand0 or spi-nand0).
This patch removes these nand MTD update for nor boot and simplify nand0
and spi-nand0 support (remove the mtd_boot variable).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Enable SCMI clock and reset domain support for stm32mp1 platform
and ARM SMC mailbox driver used as communication channel for
SCMI messages between non-secure world and secure SCMI server.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
This change makes stm32mp1 clock driver to get the root clocks
reference from the device node in the FDT rather than fetching
straight these clocks by their name. Driver now stores the
clock reference and use it to know if a root clock is present,
get its rate or gets its related udevice reference.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Define in the RCC clock provider node which root clocks the driver
depends on. These are root oscillators, which may be present or
not, upon FDT content.
This update binding is introduced in Linux kernel device tree by patch
"ARM: dts: stm32: move clocks/resets to SCMI resources for stm32mp15"
This patch is a preliminary step for SCMI support of stm32mp15
boards with trusted boot chain, based on TF-A or OP-TEE.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
In case of big area read/write on spi nand, watchdog timeout may occurs.
To fix that, add WATCHDOG_RESET() in spinand_mtd_read() and
spinand_mtd_write() to ensure that watchdog is reset.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In case of big area erased on nand, watchdog timeout may occurs.
To fix that, add WATCHDOG_RESET() in nanddev_mtd_erase() to ensure that
watchdog is reset.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In case of reading large area and memory-map mode is misconfigured
(memory-map size declared lower than the real size of the memory chip)
watchdog can be triggered.
Add WATCHDOG_RESET() in _stm32_qspi_read_fifo to fix it.
Issue reproduced with stm32mp157c-ev1 board and memory map size set to
1, with following command:
sf read 0xC0000000 0 0x4000000
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
In case of big area write/erase on spi nor, watchdog timeout may occurs.
Issue reproduced on stm32mp157c-ev1 with following commands:
sf write 0xC0000000 0 0x3000000
or
sf erase 0 0x1000000
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
When flush cache of the current GPD and resume QMU, the controller
will try to access the next GPD after processing the current one,
if not flush the next GPD, the controller may get wrong GPD status.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
At present most of the Intel-specific code is built on all devices, even
those which don't have software support for the features provided there.
This means that any board can enable CONFIG_INTEL_ACPIGEN even if it does
not have the required features.
Add a new INTEL_SOC option to control this access. This must be selected
by SoCs that can support the required features.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: fixed a typo in arch/x86/Kconfig]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This option is better placed in the x86 code since it is not generic
enough to be in the core code. Move it.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: fixed a typo in arch/x86/Kconfig]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When CONFIG_CHROMEOS is not enabled this currently does not build. Fix it.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Building qemu-x86_64_defconfig with GCC 11.0 fails with:
arch/x86/cpu/intel_common/lpc.c:
In function ‘lpc_common_early_init’:
arch/x86/cpu/intel_common/lpc.c:56:40:
error: expression does not compute the number of elements in this array;
element type is ‘struct reg_info’, not ‘u32’ {aka ‘unsigned int’}
[-Werror=sizeof-array-div]
56 | sizeof(values) / sizeof(u32));
| ^
arch/x86/cpu/intel_common/lpc.c:56:40: note: add parentheses around the
second ‘sizeof’ to silence this warning
arch/x86/cpu/intel_common/lpc.c:50:11: note: array ‘values’ declared here
50 | } values[4], *ptr;
| ^~~~~~
Add parentheses to silence warning.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add target to Makefile to generate "u-boot-spl-dtb.hex" for Intel
SOCFPGA SOC64 devices (Stratix 10 and Agilex). "u-boot-spl-dtb.hex"
is hex formatted spl with and offset of CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE. It
combines the spl image and dtb. "u-boot-spl-dtb.hex" is needed to
generate the final configuration bitstream for Intel SOCFPGA SOC64
devices.
Signed-off-by: Dalon Westergreen <dalon.westergreen@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND have been moved to Kconfig.boot. This patch
move the CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND macro from socfpga_soc64_common.h to
*_defconfig file for both Stratix 10 and Agilex.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Support 'vab' command to perform vendor authentication.
Command format: vab addr len
Authorize 'len' bytes starting at 'addr' via vendor public key
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Vendor Authorized Boot is a security feature for authenticating
the images such as U-Boot, ARM trusted Firmware, Linux kernel,
device tree blob and etc loaded from FIT. After those images are
loaded from FIT, the VAB certificate and signature block appended
at the end of each image are sent to Secure Device Manager (SDM)
for authentication. U-Boot will validate the SHA384 of the image
against the SHA384 hash stored in the VAB certificate before
sending the image to SDM for authentication.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Pull request for efi-2021-04-rc3-3
New:
* Provide library functions for converting UTF-8 streams either to code
page 437 or Unicode code points.
Bug fixes:
* Fix the capsule update unit tests.
* Use the terminal size of the video console if it is the primary output.
Up to now the EFI capsule Python tests were always skipped. The reason is
that mkimage fails with:
uboot_bin_env.its:13.21-23.5: Warning (unit_address_vs_reg):
/images/u-boot-bin@100000: node has a unit name, but no reg property
uboot_bin_env.its:24.21-34.5: Warning (unit_address_vs_reg):
/images/u-boot-env@150000: node has a unit name, but no reg property
If a unit in a device-tree has an address, a reg property must be provided.
But adding a reg property is not the solution here.
Since 2017 unit addresses are disallowed for FIT,
cf. common/image-fit.c:1624.
So remove the unit addresses in uboot_bin_env.its.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
utf8_get() should return an error if hitting an illegal UTF-8 sequence and
not silently convert the input to a question mark.
Correct utf_8() and the its unit test.
console_read_unicode() now will ignore illegal UTF-8 sequences.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Carve out a function to translate a Unicode code point to an 8bit codepage.
Provide a unit test for the new function.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If stdout is 'vidconsole', we correctly set the console size.
If stdout is 'vidconsole,serial', the video console is ignored.
We should always evaluate the size of vidconsole if it is the primary
console.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
- Convert qemu-ppce500 to driver model and enable additional driver
support
- bug fixes/updates in net-dsa driver, vid driver, move configs to kconfig
- Update Maintainers of some powerpc, layerscape platforms
Add a reST document to describe how to build and run U-Boot for
the QEMU ppce500 machine.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
board/emulation is the place for other QEMU targets like x86, arm,
riscv. Let's move the qemu-ppce500 board codes there.
List me as a co-maintainer for this board.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This function is not called anywhere. Only fsl_ddr_sdram_size() is
necessary [1] for QEMU. Drop it.
[1] arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc85xx/cpu.c::dram_init()
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Now that we have switched to CONFIG_OF_CONTROL, and we can use the
env variable 'fdtcontroladdr' directly instead of creating one that
is duplicated.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
After U-Boot is relocated to RAM already, the previous temporary FDT
virtual-physical mapping that was used in the pre-relocation phase
is no longer needed. Let's delete the mapping.
get_fdt_virt() might be used before and after relocation, update it
to return different virtual address of FDT.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The QEMU ppce500 target integrates a Freescale I2C controller and
has a Pericom pt7c4338 RTC connected to it. Enable corresponding
DM drivers so that 'date' command is actually useful.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The QEMU ppce500 target provides the power off functionality via
the GPIO pin#0, and we can support this using the sysreset gpio
poweroff driver. Let's enable it.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
sysreset uclass driver provides an implementation of 'reset'
command using the sysreset_ APIs unconditionally. It also
supports the 'poweroff' command using the sysreset_ APIs,
but under a Kconfig option CONFIG_SYSRESET_CMD_POWEROFF.
Let's do the same for the 'reset' command, by introducing a
new Kconfig option CONFIG_SYSRESET_CMD_RESET, and set it to
on by default, to allow a board that don't have a sysreset
reset driver yet, but have a sysreset poweroff driver to
compile without any issue.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
QEMU ppce500 target integrates a GPIO controller that is compatible
with the QorIQ GPIO controller. Enable the DM GPIO driver for it
and the 'gpio' command.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
dev_read_addr_size_index() returns fdt_addr_t which might be a
64-bit physical address. This might be true for some 85xx SoCs
whose CCSBAR is mapped beyond 4 GiB.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Without this, the DM GPIO driver for MPC8xxx does not compile for
MPC85xx SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable VirtIO BLK driver so that we can store a kernel image to
a disk image and boot from there.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The VirtIO BLK driver depends on the blk uclass driver.
Add the dependency in the Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
By default the QEMU ppce500 machine connects a VirtIO NET to the
PCI controller, although it can be replaced to an e1000 NIC via
additional command line options.
Now that we have switched over to DM PCI, VirtIO support becomes
possible. This commit enables the support.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The 'virtio' command calls blk_common_cmd() which is only available
when CONFIG_HAVE_BLOCK_DEVICE is on. Fix the Kconfig dependency.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present the board supports non-DM version PCI and E1000 drivers.
Switch over to use DM ETH and PCI by:
- Rewrite the PCI address map functions using DM APIs
- Enable CONFIG_MISC_INIT_R to do the PCI initialization and
address map
- Drop unnecessary ad-hoc config macros
- Remove board_eth_init() in the board codes
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present the driver only supports 32-bit bus and cpu address.
The controller's outbound registers/fields for extended address
are not programmed. Let's program them to support 64-bit bus and
cpu address.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
devfdt_get_addr_index() returns fdt_addr_t which might be a 64-bit
physical address. Use map_physmem() to return the virtual address
that can be used by a 32-bit machine.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
For the QEMU ppce500 machine, LAW registers are not implemented
hence CONFIG_FSL_LAW is not turned on and all LAW APIs are not
available. We should wrap all LAW registers programming in the
mpc85xx PCI driver with CONFIG_FSL_LAW.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The QEMU ppce500 target integrates 2 NS16550 serial ports. Switch
over to use the DM version of the driver by:
- drop unnecessary ad-hoc config macros
- add get_serial_clock() in the board codes
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present initr_addr_map() is put at a late stage in the
init_sequence_r[] calls. This won't work because lot of
device driver initialization (e.g.: serial port) happens
before it but is lack of the address translation support.
This moves the call to a bit earlier, right after the DM
initialization.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In phys_to_virt() and virt_to_phys(), if CONFIG_ADDR_MAP is defined,
they use addrmap_ translation APIs to do the address translation.
However these APIs only work in post-relocation phase.
Update the code logic to fall back to use the default one when in
pre-relocation phase.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This adds a new command 'addrmap' to display the address map for
non-identity virtual-physical memory mappings.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present address_map[] is static and its type is unknown to external
modules. In preparation to create a command to list its contents, this
patch moves its type definition and declaration to the header file.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present QEMU ppce500 target has not been migrated to driver model
yet. As a start, let's enable driver model and the 'dm' command.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The QEMU ppce500 machine generates a device tree blob and passes
it to U-Boot during boot. Let's enable OF_CONTROL with OF_BOARD
and provide board_fdt_blob_setup() in the board codes.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MAP_END currently points to 0xe8000000, which means
the upper end of the virtual address mapped to PCI bus address ends
at 0xe8000000. But this is wrong as the CCSBAR was already mapped
at 0xe0000000 with a 1 MiB size.
Fixes: fa08d39517 ("PPC 85xx: Add qemu-ppce500 machine")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
When QEMU originally supported the ppce500 machine back in Jan 2014,
it was created with a 1:1 mapping of PCI bus address. Things seemed
to change rapidly that in Nov 2014 with the following QEMU commits:
commit e6b4e5f4795b ("PPC: e500: Move CCSR and MMIO space to upper end of address space")
and
commit cb3778a0455a ("PPC: e500 pci host: Add support for ATMUs")
the PCI memory and IO physical address were moved to beyond 4 GiB,
but PCI bus address remained below 4 GiB, hence a non-identity
mapping was created. Unfortunately corresponding U-Boot updates
were missed along with the QEMU changes and the U-Boot QEMU ppce500
PCI support has been broken since then.
This commit makes the PCI (non-DM version) work again.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
At present fdt_read_prop() can only handle 1 or 2 cells. It is
called by fdt_read_range() which may be used to read PCI address
from <ranges> for a PCI bus node where the number of PCI address
cell is 3. The <ranges> property is an array of:
{ <child address> <parent address> <size in child address space> }
When trying to read <child address> from a PCI bus node using
fdt_read_prop(), as the codes below:
/* Read <child address> */
if (child_addr) {
r = fdt_read_prop(ranges, ranges_len, cell, child_addr,
acells);
if (r)
return r;
}
it will fail, because the PCI child address is made up of 3 cells
but fdt_read_prop() cannot handle it. We advance the cell offset
by 1 so that the <child address> can be correctly read.
This adds the special handling of such case.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Commit e002474158 ("pci: pci-uclass: Dynamically allocate the PCI regions")
changes 'struct pci_controller'.regions from pre-allocated array of
regions to dynamically allocated, which unfortunately broken lots of
boards that still use the non-DM PCI driver.
This patch changes the non-DM fsl_pci_init driver to dynamically
allocate the regions, just like what's done in the pci uclass driver.
Fixes: e002474158 ("pci: pci-uclass: Dynamically allocate the PCI regions")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Because we probe the master ourselves (and fail if there is no master),
it is not possible that we don't have a master device.
There is one catch though: device removal. We don't support that. It
wasn't supported neither before this patch. Because the master device
was only set in .pre_probe(), if a device was removed master_dev was a
dangling pointer and transmitting a frame cause a panic. I don't see a
good solution without having some sort of notify machanism when a
udevice is removed.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc> [DSA unit tests]
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Because the uclass has the "*_auto" properties set, the driver model
will take care of allocating the private structures for us and they
can't be NULL. Drop the checks.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
DSA needs to have the master device probed first for MAC inheritance.
Until now, it only works by chance because the only user (LS1028A SoC)
will probe the master device first. The probe order is given by the PCI
device ordering, thus it works because the master device has a "smaller"
BDF then the switch device.
Explicitly probe the master device in dsa_port_probe().
Fixes: fc054d563b ("net: Introduce DSA class for Ethernet switches")
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
It doesn't make sense to have DSA without a master port. Error out early
if there is no master port.
Fixes: fc054d563b ("net: Introduce DSA class for Ethernet switches")
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Remove MAINTAINERS entries for
P3041DS_NAND_SECURE_BOOT_defconfig
and P5040DS_NAND_SECURE_BOOT_defconfig
as these configs support have been removed.
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch adds support for more PMBus compatible devices to the NXP
drivers for its QorIQ family devices. At runtime, the voltage regulator is
queried over I2C, and the required voltage multiplier determined. This
change supports the DIRECT and LINEAR PMBus voltage reporting modes.
Previously, the driver only supported a few specific devices such as the
IR36021 and LTC3882, so this change allows the QorIQ series to be used
with a much larger variety of core voltage regulator devices.
checkpatch warning "Use if (IS_DEFINED (...))" was ignored to maintain
consistency with the existing code.
Signed-off-by: Stephen Carlson <stcarlso@linux.microsoft.com>
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
There are times where buildman seems to get stuck in this job when in
CI. Forcing single-threaded here allows us to complete and move on.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At present even if only a single thread is in use, buildman still uses
threading.
For some debugging it is helpful to do everything in the main process.
Allow -T0 to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop
asm/global_data.h from common header") broke compilation of squashfs
filesystem when CONFIG_CMD_SQUASHFS=y is enabled.
Compilation is failing on error:
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: u-boot/fs/squashfs/sqfs_inode.c:121: undefined reference to `le32_to_cpu'
Fixes: 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header")
Suggested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
A working device tree node of ns16550 should never be populated
with value zero for the <clock-frequency> property. Unfortunately
this is the case for the QEMU ppce500 target.
Let's try to assign plat->clock to CONFIG_SYS_NS16550_CLK as the
last resort to handle such case.
This commit should be reverted when:
- The following QEMU patch [1] is merged, and
- U-Boot CI has upgraded its QEMU version that contains the fix
[1] http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/qemu-devel/patch/1612362288-22216-2-git-send-email-bmeng.cn@gmail.com/
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently ns16550_serial_assign_base() treats the argument 'base'
with type `ulong`. This is incorrect because the base address was
obtained from device tree with type `fdt_addr_t` that can represent
a physical address larger than 32-bit in a 32-bit system.
Fixes: 9e6ce62190 ("serial: ns16550: Fix ordering of getting base address")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
lib/of_live.c references the following 2 ofnode APIs:
of_alias_scan() and of_get_property().
These APIs get built only when DM is on. Fix the dependency then.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
lib/binman.c references the following 3 ofnode APIs:
ofnode_first_subnode(), ofnode_path() and ofnode_read_bool().
These APIs get built only when DM is on. Fix the dependency then.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Each invocation of the 'host bind' command with a file name argument opens
a file descriptor. The next invocation of the 'host bind' command destroys
the block device but the file descriptor remains open. The same holds true
for the 'unbind blk' command.
Close the file descriptor when unbinding the host block device.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
patman's --limit-cc option parses its argument to an integer and uses
that to trim the list of CC recipients to a particular maximum. but that
only works if the cc variable is a list, which it is not.
Signed-off-by: Bernhard Kirchen <bernhard.kirchen@mbconnectline.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present these three Kconfigs exist even when bootstage is not enabled.
This is not necessary since bootstage.c is only built if BOOTSTAGE is
enabled.
Make them conditional. Also fix up the overflow message to mention TPL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present device_bind() does some unnecessary work if a device fails to
bind in SPL. Add the missing conditions.
Also fix a style nit in the same function while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With of-platdata we always have a dtv struct that holds the platform data
provided by the driver_info record. However, this struct can be empty if
there are no actual devicetree properties provided.
The upshot of empty platform data is that it will end up as a zero-size
member in the BSS section, which is fine. But if the driver specifies
plat_auto then it expects the correct amount of space to be allocated.
At present this does not happen, since device_bind() assumes that the
platform-data size will always be >0. As a result we end up not
allocating the space and just use the BSS region, overwriting whatever
other contents are present.
Fix this by removing the condition that platform data be non-empty, always
allocating space if requested.
This fixes a strange bug that has been lurking since of-platdata was
implemented. It has likely never been noticed since devices normally have
at least some devicetree properties, BSS is seldom used on SPL, the dtv
structs are normally at the end of bss and the overwriting only happens
if a driver changes its platform data.
It was discovered using sandbox_spl, which exercises more features than
a normal board might, and the critical global_data variable 'gd' happened
to be at the end of BSS.
Fixes: 9fa2819009 ("dm: core: Expand platdata for of-platdata devices")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Using the internal vs. external pull resistors it is possible to get
27 different combinations from 3 strapping pins. Add an implementation
of this.
This involves updating the sandbox GPIO driver to model external and
(weaker) internal pull resistors. The get_value() method now takes account
of what is driving a pin:
sandbox: GPIOD_EXT_DRIVEN - in which case GPIO_EXT_HIGH provides the
value
outside source - in which case GPIO_EXT_PULL_UP/DOWN indicates the
external state and we work the final state using those flags and
the internal GPIOD_PULL_UP/DOWN flags
Of course the outside source does not really exist in sandbox. We are just
modelling it for test purpose.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new flag to keep track of whether sandbox is driving the pin, or
whether it is expecting an input signal. If it is driving, then the value
of the pin is the value being driven (0 or 1). If not driving, then we
consider the value 0, since we don't currently handle things like pull-ups
yet.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
We don't need to implement direction_input() and direction_output()
anymore. Drop them and use update_flags() instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this driver to use the common method of putting the driver
operations in an 'ops' variable install of calling gpio_get_ops()
repeatedly. Make it const since operations do not change.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The new update_flags() method is more flexible since it allows the
driver to see the full flags all at once. Use that in preference to these
two functions. Add comments to that effect.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
It is convenient to be able to adjust some of the flags for a GPIO while
leaving others alone. Add a function for this.
Update dm_gpio_set_dir_flags() to make use of this.
Also update dm_gpio_set_value() to use this also, since this allows the
open-drain / open-source features to be implemented directly in the
driver, rather than using the uclass workaround.
Update the sandbox tests accordingly. This involves a lot of changes to
dm_test_gpio_opendrain_opensource() since we no-longer have the direciion
being reported differently depending on the open drain/open source flags.
Also update the STM32 drivers to let the uclass handle the active low/high
logic.
Drop the GPIOD_FLAGS_OUTPUT() macro which is no-longer used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Allow this function to see all flags, including the internal sandbox ones.
This allows the tests to fully control the behaviour of the driver.
To make this work, move the setting of GPIOD_EXT_HIGH -to where the flags
are updated via driver model, rather than the sandbox 'back door'.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
At present we have the concept of a pin's external value. This is what
is used when getting the value of a pin. But we still set the
GPIOD_IS_OUT_ACTIVE flag when changing the value. This is not actually
correct, since if the pin changes from output to input, the external
value need not change. Adjust the logic for this difference.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
At present with the sandbox GPIO driver it is not possible to change the
value of GPIOD_IS_OUT_ACTIVE unless the GPIO is an output. This makes it
hard to test changing the flags since we need to be aware of the internal
workings of the driver.
The feature is designed to aid testing.
Split this feature out into a separate sandbox-specific flag, so that the
flags can change unimpeded. This will make it easier to allow updating the
flags in a future patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Adjust the terminology in this driver to reflect that fact that all flags
are handled, not just direction flags.
Create a new access function to get the full GPIO state, not just the
direction flags. Drop the static invalid_dir_flags since we can rely on a
segfault if something is wrong.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
This function can be used to get any flags, not just direction flags.
Rename it to avoid confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
It is more useful to be able to read all the flags, not just the direction
ones. In fact this is what the STM32 driver does. Update the method name
to reflect this.
Tweak the docs a little and use 'flagsp' as the return argument, as is
common in driver model, to indicate it returns a value.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The current method is a misnomer since it is also used (e.g. by stm32) to
update pull settings and open source/open drain.
Rename it and expand the documentation to cover a few more details.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
These functions use devicetree and cannot work with of-platdata, which has
no runtime devicetree.
If they are used, the current linker error is confusing, since it talks
about missing functions in the bowels of driver model.
Avoid compiling these functions at all with of-platdata, so that a
straightforward link error points to the problem.
Series-changes; 3
- Fix 'wprl' typo
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
DM_VIDEO migration deadline is already expired, but around
80 Allwinner boards are still using video in a legacy way:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO before the v2019.07 release.
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Convert the legacy video driver over to the DM_VIDEO framework. This is
a minimal conversion: it doesn't use the DT for finding its resources,
nor does it use DM clocks or DM devices for the outputs (LCD, HDMI, CVBS).
Tested in Bananapi M1+ Plus 1920x1200 HDMI out. (Jagan)
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
[Andre: rebase and smaller fixes]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now when usbtty serial console is fixed in U-Boot enable CONFIG_USB_TTY for
Nokia RX-51 board by default.
Fix also USB product id as U-Boot ignores CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID macro and
include U-Boot string into USB product name to indicate usage of U-Boot.
CONFIG_CONSOLE_MUX is already used and U-Boot console is available for
all in/out devices. Therefore there is no need to have separate commands
'run sercon', 'run usbcon' and 'run vgacon', so remove them.
As space for U-Boot is limited to 256kB, enable CONFIG_OPTIMIZE_INLINING
and disable some other unused options so CONFIG_USB_TTY can be enabled.
Nokia RX-51 does not have easily accessible UART serial console so the only
option for easy debugging is to use device's keyboard+screen or this usbtty
serial console over USB.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
After removal of MUX configuration there is no need to have extra rx51.h.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
This function is not used and was never called.
This board contains '#define CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT' because X-Loader
set everything up, including MUX configuration.
Also this MUX configuration is incorrect and does not match hardware.
So remove this dead, unused and broken code.
This change will decrease size of U-Boot binary.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Function s_init() is called only from lowlevel_init(). So compile it only
when function lowlevel_init() is compiled.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Function lowlevel_init() is called only from cpu_init_crit() and this
function is wrapped into #if .. #endif section. So compile also
lowlevel_init() function under same #if condition.
Function cpy_clk_code() uses lowlevel_init symbol to get address where
go_to_speed code ends. As this symbol is not available anymore when
compiling with CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT, defines a new label
go_to_speed_end at the place where go_to_speed code ends.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
All debug messages from ep0.c except a few are printed by dbg_ep0() macro.
So for remaining few exceptions use also dbg_ep0() instead of serial_printf().
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
If we do not set FIFO buffer address and size for some endpoint which is in
use then default programmed address 0x0 would be used which is in conflict
with address of FIFO buffer for endpoint 0. Moreover address of FIFO buffer
for endpoint 0 cannot be programmed, it is fixed to 0x0. Sharing address
space between more endpoints cause data loss and unexpected errors.
This patch is fixing transmission of characters over usbtty serial console
and allows using of usbtty for debugging purposes on Nokia N900.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Interrupt for EP0 is indicated in intrtx register via first bit. This bit
is set for both RX and TX despite register has only TX in its name. First
bit in intrrx register is reserved, not used and never set.
So remove calling musb_peri_ep0() function at every iteration of udc_irq()
and musb_peri_rx() and call it only from musb_peri_tx() when correct
interrupt bit in initrtx it set.
Address from SET ADDRESS command must be set to faddr register only after
acknowledging SERV_RXPKTRDY followed by received EP0 interrupt. So prior
calling musb_peri_ep0_set_address() check for EP0 interrupt instead of
(incorrect) MUSB_INTR_SOF interrupt.
This patch fixes issue that host (computer) cannot register U-Boot USB
device and is failing with errors:
usb 1-1: new full-speed USB device number 86 using xhci_hcd
usb 1-1: Device not responding to setup address.
usb 1-1: Device not responding to setup address.
usb 1-1: device not accepting address 86, error -71
U-Boot was writing address to faddr register too early and did not wait for
correct interrupt after which should update address.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
If musb_peri_rx_ep() was called to process received HW buffer but U-Boot
cannot read it yet (e.g. because U-Boot SW buffer is full) then interrupt
was marked as processed also when HW buffer stayed unprocessed.
U-Boot tried to process this buffer again when it received interrupt again,
but it can receive it only when sender (host) sends a new data. As sender
(host) is not going to send a new data until U-Boot process current data
this issue caused a deadlock in case sender (host) is emitting data faster
than U-Boot can process it.
Reading musb intrrx register automatically clears this register and marks
interrupt as processed. So to prevent marking interrupt in U-Boot as
processed, adds a new variable pending_intrrx which would contain
unprocessed bits of intrrx register.
For a second step, every time when musb_peri_rx_ep() is called and there
are waiting data to be processed (signaled by MUSB_RXCSR_RXPKTRDY) either
acknowledge sender (via musb_peri_rx_ack()) that whole HW buffer was
processed or set corresponding bit in pending_intrrx that HW buffer was not
fully processed yet and next iteration is required after U-Boot allocates
space for reading HW buffer.
This patch fixes receiving large usb buffers, e.g. file transfer via Kermit
protocol implemented by 'loadb' U-Boot command over usbtty serial console.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
If udc_endpoint_write() was called with bigger payload which does not fit
into one USB packet it is needed to transmit payload in more USB packets.
First packet is transmitted by udc_endpoint_write() call itself and other
packets are put into waiting queue.
Implement function musb_peri_tx() which checks if endpoints are ready for
transmit and continue transmission of waiting queue.
This patch fixes sending big output from printenv command over usbtty
serial console.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>>
PERI_RXCSR is 16bit register so store its value into 16bit local variable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
This patch fixes configuring FIFOs for one-directional endpoints which have
only one queue (either RX or TX, but noth both).
Size of FIFO buffer is 2^(idx+3) bytes and starting address is 2^(addr+3).
Moreover first 64 bytes are reserved for EP0.
Without this patch if FIFO size specified by caller was zero then idx was
incorrectly calculated (expr. ffs(0)-1) and size overflowed in fifosz
register. This register uses has only 4 bits for FIFO size. Moreover
specifying zero buffer size is not possible (with idx=0 is minimal buffer
size 8 bytes).
So even for one-directional endpoints we need to correctly specify both
(RX and TX) FIFO buffer sizes and its addresses.
This patch is fixing calculation of start address and buffer size to
minimal value and ensures that it would not overlap with buffer reserved
for EP0.
This issue caused loose of packets on USB bus in both directions and
basically usbtty was unusable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Without this patch clearing was done only when U-Boot was compiled with
MUSB Host Controller. But clearing of data toggle bit is needed also for
MUSB Device Controller otherwise Device Controller does not work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
musb udc code depends on usb gadget code provided by CONFIG_USB_DEVICE as
defined in drivers/usb/gadget/Makefile. But this Makefile is not included
into U-Boot build when CONFIG_USB_GADGET is not set. As CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
cannot be enabled together with CONFIG_USB_GADGET it means that dependency
for musb udc code is not compiled during build. Fix it by including
drivers/usb/gadget dependency also when CONFIG_USB_DEVICE is set.
This patch fixes compile errors:
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_ep0_rx':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `ep0_recv_setup'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_ep0_idle':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `ep0_recv_setup'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_ep0_zero_data_request':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_ep0_idle':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `ep0_recv_setup'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_ep0_rx':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_rcv_complete'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `musb_peri_rx_ep':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_rcv_complete'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `udc_endpoint_write':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_tx_complete'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `udc_irq':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o:u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: more undefined references to `usbd_device_event_irq' follow
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `udc_setup_ep':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_alloc_urb'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: drivers/usb/musb/built-in.o: in function `udc_startup_events':
u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
arm-linux-gnueabi-ld.bfd: u-boot/drivers/usb/musb/musb_udc.c: undefined reference to `usbd_device_event_irq'
make: *** [Makefile:1762: u-boot] Error 1
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Function next_urb() selects the last urb data buffer from linked list to
which next data from usbtty's puts function should be appended.
But to check if TX data still exists it is needed to look at the first urb
data buffer from linked list. So check for endpoint->tx_urb (first from the
linked list) instead of current_urb (the last from the linked list).
Successful call to udc_endpoint_write() may invalidate active urb and
allocate new urb in queue which invalidates pointer returned by next_urb()
function.
So call next_urb() prior putting data into urb buffer and call it every
time after using udc_endpoint_write() function to prevent sending data from
usbtty's puts function in incorrect order.
This patch fixes issue that usbtty code does not transmit data when they
are waiting in the tx queue.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
This function has incorrect implementation of prepending CR prior LF.
Without this patch it prepended CR prior whole string which is going to be
written and let LF without leading CR. Fix this issue by inserting CR at
correct place to make output on usbtty serial console more readable.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
With TPM2 we don't actually lock the TPM once verified boot is finished.
Instead we disable the platform hierarchy which serves the same purpose.
Add an implementation of this so we can safely boot into the kernel.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add support for this so that the TPM can be set up for use with
Chromium OS verified boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Update tpm2_clear() and tpm2_pcr_extend() so that the command size
is not repeated twice. Add a small comment to the latter.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Add support for TPMv2 versions of API functions. So far this is not
complete as the standard is quite large, but it implements everything
currently available for TPMv2 in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Take over the plain 'tpm_...' functions for use by the new TPM API. Rename
all the TPMv1 functions so they are called from the API.
Update the TPMv1 functions so that they are called from the API. Change
existing users to use the tpm1_ prefix so they don't need to go through
the API, which might introduce uncertainty.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
There are two different TPM standards. U-Boot supports both but each has
its own set of functions. We really need a single TPM API that can call
one or the other. This is not always possible as there are some
differences between the two standards, but it is mostly possible.
Add an API to handle this. So far it is not plumbed into the build and
only supports TPMv1.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The response is shown but not the request. Update the code to show both
if debugging is enabled.
Use a 'uint' type for size so it matches the register-word size on both
32- and 64-bit machines.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the security chip is not used in these U-Boot phases. Update
the Makefile to exclude it.
Fix a few logging statements while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Sandbox provides a way to write out its emulated memory on exit. This
makes it possible to pass a bloblist from one phase (e.g. SPL) to the
next.
However the bloblist is not closed off, so the checksum is generally
invalid. Fix this by finishing up the bloblist before writing the memory
file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This state is not accessible to the running U-Boot but at present it is
allocated in the emulated SDRAM. This doesn't seem very useful. Adjust
it to allocate from the OS instead.
The RAM buffer is currently not freed, but should be, so add that into
state_uninit(). Update the comment for os_free() to indicate that NULL is
a valid parameter value.
Note that the strdup() in spl_board_load_image() is changed as well, since
strdup() allocates memory in the RAM buffer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We provide os_malloc() and os_free() but not os_realloc(). Add this,
following the usual semantics. Also update os_malloc() to behave correctly
when passed a zero size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This code is still using the old command typedef. It was not noticed since
this file is not currently built. It is using a non-existent option in the
Makefile.
Drop this file since it is not needed for correct operation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Comparing a hex dump on the U-Boot command line with the contents of a
file on the host system is fairly easy and convenient to do manually if
it is small. But the format used hexdump by default differs from that
shown by U-Boot. Add a note about how to make them the same.
(For large dumps, writing the data to the network with tftpput, or to a
USB stick with ext4save is easiest.)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add notes about how to make binman produce verbose logging when building.
Add a comment on how to do this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is printed twice but we only need one message, since there is very
little processing in between them. Drop the second one, since all branches
of the switch() already have output. Update the U-Boot message to include
the phase being jumped to.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The normal memory (other that DCACHE_OFF) should be executable by default,
only the device memory (DCACHE_OFF) used for peripheral access should have
the bit execute never (TTB_SECT_XN_MASK).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Overidde the weak function dram_bank_mmu_setup() to set the DDR
(preloc case) or the SYSRAM (in SPL case) executable before to enable
the MMU and configure DACR.
This weak function is called in dcache_enable/mmu_setup.
This patchs avoids a permission access issue when the DDR is marked
executable (by calling mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour with
DCACHE_DEFAULT_OPTION) after MMU setup and domain access permission
activation with DACR in dcache_enable.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Mark the top of ram, used for relocated U-Boot as a normal memory
(cacheable and executable) to avoid permission access issue when
U-Boot jumps to this relocated code.
When MMU is activated in pre-reloc stage; only the beginning of
DDR is marked executable.
This patch avoids access issue when DACR is correctly managed.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Historically, the reset_cpu() function had an `addr` parameter which was
meant to pass in an address of the reset vector location, where the CPU
should reset to. This feature is no longer used anywhere in U-Boot as
all reset_cpu() implementations now ignore the passed value. Generic
code has been added which always calls reset_cpu() with `0` which means
this feature can no longer be used easily anyway.
Over time, many implementations seem to have "misunderstood" the
existence of this parameter as a way to customize/parameterize the reset
(e.g. COLD vs WARM resets). As this is not properly supported, the
code will almost always not do what it is intended to (because all
call-sites just call reset_cpu() with 0).
To avoid confusion and to clean up the codebase from unused left-overs
of the past, remove the `addr` parameter entirely. Code which intends
to support different kinds of resets should be rewritten as a sysreset
driver instead.
This transformation was done with the following coccinelle patch:
@@
expression argvalue;
@@
- reset_cpu(argvalue)
+ reset_cpu()
@@
identifier argname;
type argtype;
@@
- reset_cpu(argtype argname)
+ reset_cpu(void)
{ ... }
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This reverts commit 576007aec9.
The parameter passed to reset_cpu() no longer holds a meaning as all
call-sites now pass the value 0. Thus, branching on it is essentially
dead code and will just confuse future readers.
Revert soft-reset support and just always perform a hard-reset for now.
This is a preparation for removal of the reset_cpu() parameter across
the entire tree in a later patch.
Fixes: 576007aec9 ("lpc32xx: cpu: add support for soft reset")
Cc: Sylvain Lemieux <slemieux@tycoint.com>
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
The current implementation of reset_cpu() in the ns3 board code does not
archieve what it is supposed to (according to the comments), due to
a number of reasons:
1. The argument to reset_cpu() is _not_ actually passed from the
`reset` command, but is set to 0 in all call-sites (in this
specific case, see arch/arm/lib/reset.c). Thus, performing
different kinds of resets based on its value will not work as
expected.
2. Contrary to its documentation, the passed argument is not
interpreted, but a static `L3_RESET` define is used. The other
comment properly notes that this will always perform a L3 reset,
though.
3. The "parsing" of the static `L3_RESET` value is not even using the
upper and lower nibble as stated in the comment, but uses the last
two decimal digits of the value.
This is currently one of the only implementations left in U-Boot, which
make "use" of the value passed to reset_cpu(). As this is done under
false assumption (the value does not have any meaning anymore), it makes
sense to bring it into line with the rest and start ignoring the
parameter.
This is a preparation for removal of the reset_cpu() parameter across
the entire tree in a later patch.
Fixes: b5a152e7ca ("board: ns3: default reset type to L3")
Cc: Bharat Gooty <bharat.gooty@broadcom.com>
Cc: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
nds32 is one of the only architectures which still have a reset_cpu()
implementation that makes use of the `addr` parameter. The rest of
U-Boot now ignores it and passes 0 everywhere. It turns out that even
here, reset_cpu() is no longer referenced anywhere; reset is either not
implemented (e.g. ae3xx) or realized using a WDT (e.g. ag101).
Remove this left-over implementation in preparation for the removal of
the `addr` parameter in the entire tree.
Cc: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Signed-off-by: Harald Seiler <hws@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
On the RPi4 armv7 build we have the situationt that we use physical
addresses of 64 bit, while the virtual addresses are 32 bit.
Remap the base address in this scenario via map_physmem().
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The EFI Grub workaround isn't needed with Grub version 2.04 or higher.
This version was published over a year ago, so disable the workaround
to reduce boot time.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
SAMA7G5 supports slew rate configuration. Adapt the driver for this.
For switching frequencies lower than 50MHz the slew rate needs to
be enabled. Since most of the pins on SAMA7G5 fall into this category
enabled the slew rate by default.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
The u-boot-with-spl.imx is a concatenation of SPL and u-boot.uim.
The u-boot.uim is u-boot.bin wrapped in uImage. In case OF_SEPARATE
is enabled, the u-boot.bin does not contain control DT for U-Boot,
and so u-boot.uim does not contain the DT, and so u-boot-with-spl.imx
does not contain the DT, and a system where u-boot-with-spl.imx is
written to offset 1024B to the start of storage no longer boots, as
it is missing DT.
In case OF_SEPARATE is enabled, u-boot.img contains both u-boot.bin
and the necessary DTs. Therefore, use u-boot.img instead of u-boot.uim
to generate u-boot-with-spl.imx when OF_SEPARATE is enabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Christoph Niedermaier <cniedermaier@dh-electronics.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
In drivers we use a family of printing functions including pr_err() and
pr_cont(). CONFIG_LOGLEVEL is used to control which of these lead to output
via printf().
Our logging functions allow finer grained control of output. So replace
printf() by the matching logging functions. The usage of CONFIG_LOGLEVEL
remains unchanged.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When the btrfs_read_fs_root() function is searching a ROOT_ITEM with
location key offset other than -1, it currently fails via BUG_ON.
The offset can have other value than -1, though. This can happen for
example if a subvolume is renamed:
$ btrfs subvolume create X && sync
Create subvolume './X'
$ btrfs inspect-internal dump-tree /dev/root | grep -B 2 'name: X$
location key (270 ROOT_ITEM 18446744073709551615) type DIR
transid 283 data_len 0 name_len 1
name: X
$ mv X Y && sync
$ btrfs inspect-internal dump-tree /dev/root | grep -B 2 'name: Y$
location key (270 ROOT_ITEM 0) type DIR
transid 285 data_len 0 name_len 1
name: Y
As can be seen the offset changed from -1ULL to 0.
Do not fail in this case.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: David Sterba <dsterba@suse.com>
Cc: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Instead of hard-coding the offset of DRAM entries in MMU table all over
the code, auto-detect the offset. This removes error-prone code which
would break e.g. in case the MMU table is modified.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Commit 247bbeb74c ("ARM: dts: imx8m: increase off-on delay on the SD Vcc
regulator") caused the imx8mq-evk board to not be able to store the
environment variables in the SD card.
Remove the u-boot,off-on-delay-us property to fix the regression.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Since commit c738adb8db ("tool: Move ALIGN_MASK to header as common MACRO")
the i.MX8MQ EVK board no longer boots.
The reason is that imx8mimage.c used a custom __ALIGN_MASK() macro, so
restore the original macro to fix the boot and rename it accordingly.
Reported-by: Lukas Rusak <lorusak@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Add phy-reset-duration and phy-reset-post-delay to FEC node for PHY
reset, otherwise the PHY does not work correctly.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
There is a second lpddr configuration with 2GB of RAM, but this requires
different RAM timings, so in addition to adding the timing file, a
separate defconfig is necessary.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Update imx-atf and firmware-imx to latest released versions.
Update address of ATF_LOAD_ADDR that has changed to 0x970000 in imx-atf
commit 48733cb4e773a7584ced601de9d717efa3d73815.
Add 'O=' to make and build in separate directory as one issue has been noticed
where it was trouble building directly inside u-boot source dir. Restructure the workflow
and copy binaries after defconfig to ensure that build directory is created.
Signed-off-by: Peter Bergin <peter@berginkonsult.se>
Cc: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
CONFIG_SPL_LEGACY_IMAGE_SUPPORT is necessary for mx6sabresd and
mx6sabreauto, because u-boot is packed as legacy image not FIT.
However, this config is not set when CONFIG_SPL_LOAD_FIT is enabled.
Must enable it explicitly, otherwise will fail to boot like below.
U-Boot SPL 2021.04-rc2 (Feb 20 2021 - 16:43:04 -0800)
Trying to boot from MMC1
mmc_load_image_raw_sector: mmc block read error
SPL: failed to boot from all boot devices
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
On imx6Q/imx6DL, we find if config the DTOCV to 0~3, it will impact
cmd6 behavior, after cmd6 get transfer complete interrupt, the data0
line will keep low over 5 seconds. This should be a IC bug on imx6Q/DL.
For other platforms, do not has this issue.
To fix this issue, fix the DTOCV to 0xE, the max setting, this also align
with Linux configuration.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
I would like to help supporting this board, so add myself
as a maintainer.
Now that the board has been converted to DM, also add
its devicetree in the MAINTAINERS files entry.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Make the conversion to driver model as it is mandatory.
Successfully tested booting Linux from the SD card.
Dropped splash screen support as this needs to be properly
converted to DM and tested.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Import the imx23-evk devicetree files from Linux kernel
version 5.11.
This is in preparation for converting the mx23evk_defconfig
target to driver model.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Make the conversion to driver model as it is mandatory.
Tested booting the Linux kernel from the SD card.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Import the imx51-babbage devicetree files from Linux kernel
version 5.11-rc7.
This is in preparation for converting the mx51evk_defconfig
target to driver model.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Add a compatible for i.MX51 so that i.MX51 can use this driver
via driver model.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The micro SD card slot uses GPIO3_13 as card detect pin, so describe
it in the devicetree.
This was noticed when converting imx53-qsb board to driver model
in U-Boot as the micro SD card was not getting detected.
After this change it is possible to load the dtb and zImage
from the SD card and boot Linux.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Make the conversion to driver model as it is mandatory.
Remove the SATA support for now as the i.MX53 support has not
been added yet.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Import the imx53-qsb devicetree files from Linux kernel
version 5.11-rc7.
This is in preparation for converting the mx53loco_defconfig
target to driver model.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The RGMII link delays can be set on either MAC or PHY side. Set the
rgmii-id PHY mode for FEC and remove FEC_ENET_ENABLE_.XC_DELAY
setting, so that these definitions aren't used anymore throughout
the U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Some compression algorithms currently can be enabled for SPL and
U-Boot proper separately. Therefore take into account USE_HOSTCC
is well as CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() in these cases to prevent compiling these
functions in case of a host tool build.
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Set default critical/alert temperature and enabling monoitoring.
Without calling imx_tmu_enable_msite() monitoring will not be enabled
and read_temperature will return 0. Additionally without setting alert
temperature will cause imx_tmu_get_temp() to spin indefiniately thinking
the system needs to cool.
This resolves the board spinning endlessly when enabling IMX_TMU in the
SPL.
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
The serial number OTP is similar to the imx7 version, except that the
register names are different. This also sets serial# directly, instead of
providing board_get_serial.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Some root filesystem configurations do not have separate /boot partition,
but rather place kernel, DT, scripts into /boot directory. Search the /boot
directory for these boot components in case they are not found in /, which
is the old behavior.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
As Stephen is no longer actively maintaining the uboot-test-hooks
repository, switch to using the instance on our GitLab.
Acked-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@wwwdotorg.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
There is now CONFIG_SPL_DM_SPI{,_FLASH}, however keeping
CONFIG_DM_SPI{,_FLASH} enabled in SPL seems to grow the SPL
by a couple of bytes:
text data bss dec hex filename
- 34069 1568 96 35733 8b95 spl/u-boot-spl
+ 34075 1568 96 35739 8b9b spl/u-boot-spl
In either case, the binary is bootable, so remove the part
in board config.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Andreas Geisreiter <ageisreiter@dh-electronics.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Ludwig Zenz <lzenz@dh-electronics.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Enable DTO support to make it possible to boot fitImage with DTOs
embedded in them.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Pull request for efi-2021-04-rc3-2
Bug fixes:
* debug build for mkeficapsule
* limit output length for VenHw, VenMedia
* ACPI tables must be in EfiACPIReclaimMemory
- Add USB host boot support in stm32mp1 config
- Enable uefi related commands for STMicroelectronics STM32MP15 boards
- Remove duplicate uart nodes in stm32mp15 device tree
VenHw and VenMedia device path nodes may carry vendor defined data of
arbitrary length. When converting a device path node to text ensure that we
do not overrun our internal buffer.
In our implementation of
EFI_DEVICE_PATH_TO_TEXT_PROTOCOL.ConvertDevicePathToText() we could first
determine the output length and then allocate buffers but that would nearly
double the code size. Therefore keep the preallocated buffers and truncate
excessive device paths instead.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Fix a missing comma sign (,) from a printf(), that is only
reachable if DEBUG is defined, in which case the build fails with:
tools/mkeficapsule.c:266:36: error: expected ‘)’ before ‘bin’
266 | printf("\tbin: %s\n\ttype: %pUl\n" bin, guid);
| ^~~~
| )
Signed-off-by: Klaus Heinrich Kiwi <klaus@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The UEFI spec does not allow ACPI tables to be in runtime services memory.
It recommends EfiACPIReclaimMemory.
Remove a superfluous check that the allocated pages are 16 byte aligned.
EFI pages are 4 KiB aligned.
Fixes: 86df34d42b ("efi_loader: Install ACPI configuration tables")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The board can boot with UEFI. With the latest changes in U-Boot's
EFI subsystem we also have support for EFI runtime variables, without
SetVariable support. We can also store the EFI variables in a file on the
ESP partition and preserve them across reboots.
The env and efidebug commands are missing in order to configure
EFI variables and the efibootmgr though. Since U-Boot's default config
enables other EFI related commands (e.g bootefi), let's add the env related
and efidebug commands and allow users to do that
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove duplicated uart nodes introduced with commit 62f95af92a
("ARM: dts: stm32mp1: DT alignment with Linux kernel v5.9-rc4"),
because the uart nodes wasn't correctly ordered in alphabetic order.
Only cosmetic: the generated device tree don't change.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Since commit 8745b9ebcc ("usb: gadget: add super speed support")
ums was no more functional on platform which use dwc2_udc_otg driver.
This was due to a too restrictive test which checked that the gadget
driver speed was either FS or HS.
So all gadget driver with max speed set to speed higher than
HS (SS in case of composite gadget driver in our case) are not
allowed, which is wrong.
Update the speed test in usb_gadget_register_driver() and in
dwc2_gadget_start() to allow all gadget driver speed equal or higher
than FS.
Tested on stm32mp157c-ev1 board.
Fixes: c791c8431c ("usb: dwc2: convert driver to DM_USB_GADGET")
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The OUT endpoint can just be ignored as it is not used, just as the
corresponding Set_Report request for IN-only interfaces. E.g. the
Linux gadget hid keyboard also provides an interrupt endpoint.
Also cleanup confusing debug messages like "found set protocol", which
is printed when a keyboard device is found, while the Set_Protocol request
is issued quite some time later.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Brüns <stefan.bruens@rwth-aachen.de>
add support for the UUU commands ACmd and UCmd.
Enable them through the Kconfig option
CONFIG_FASTBOOT_UUU_SUPPORT
base was commit in NXP kernel
9b149c2a2882: ("MLK-18591-3 android: Add FSL android fastboot support")
and ported it to current mainline. Tested this patch
on imx6ul based board.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Acked-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
This documents the way U-Boot understands partitions specifications.
This also updates the fastboot documentation for the changes in the
previous commit.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This anchor is only for the k210 partition layout, so rename it
appropriately. This keeps it from conflicting with the (to be added)
anchor for U-Boot partitions in general.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds support for partitions of the form "dev.hwpart:part" and
"dev#partname". This allows one to flash to eMMC boot partitions without
having to use CONFIG_FASTBOOT_MMC_BOOT1_SUPPORT. It also allows one to
flash to an entire device without needing CONFIG_FASTBOOT_MMC_USER_NAME.
Lastly, one can also flash MMC devices other than
CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV.
Because devices can be specified explicitly, CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV
is used only when necessary for existing functionality. For those cases,
fastboot_mmc_get_dev has been added as a helper function. This allows
There should be no conflicts with the existing system, but just in case, I
have ordered detection of these names after all existing names.
The fastboot_mmc_part test has been updated for these new names.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This makes the next commit more readable by doing the move now.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The only thing mmcpart was used for was to pass to blk_dselect_hwpart.
This calls blk_dselect_hwpart directly from raw_part_get_info_by_name. The
error handling is dropped, but it is reintroduced in the next commit
(albeit less specificly).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds support for things like "#partname" and "0.1#partname". The block
device parsing is done like in blk_get_device_part_str.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds an option to part_get_info_by_dev_and_name_or_num to allow
callers to specify whether whole-disk partitions are fine.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Several functions in disk/part.c just return -1 on error. This makes them
return different errnos for different failures. This helps callers
differentiate between failures, even if they cannot read stdout.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This test verifies the mapping between fastboot partitions and partitions
as understood by U-Boot. It also tests the creation of GPT partitions,
though that is not the primary goal.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds support writing to the sandbox mmc backed by an in-memory
buffer. The unit test has been updated to test reading, writing, and
erasing. I'm not sure what MMCs erase to; I picked 0, but if it's 0xFF
then that can be easily changed.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- turris_mox: Enhancements, mostlly defconfig changes (Pali)
- pci-aardvark: Set Max Payload Size and Max Read Request Size
to 512 bytes (Pali)
- pci_mvebu: Minor cleanup and refactoring (Marek)
- Upgrade A38x DDR3 training to version 14.0.0 (Marek)
The relevant changes to the already existing GD5F1GQ4UExxG support has
been determined by consulting the GigaDevice product change notice
AN-0392-10, version 1.0 from November 30, 2020.
As the overlaps are huge, variable names have been generalized
accordingly.
Apart form the lowered ECC strength (4 instead of 8 bits per 512 bytes),
the new device ID, and the extra quad IO dummy byte, no changes had to
be taken into account.
New hardware features are not supported, namely:
- Power on reset
- Unique ID
- Double transfer rate (DTR)
- Parameter page
- Random data quad IO
The inverted semantic of the "driver strength" register bits, defaulting
to 100% instead of 50% for the Q5 devices, got ignored as the driver has
never touched them anyway.
The no longer supported "read from cache during block erase"
functionality is not reflected as the current SPI NAND core does not
support it anyway.
Implementation has been tested on MediaTek MT7688 based GARDENA smart
Gateways using both, GigaDevice GD5F1GQ5UEYIG and GD5F1GQ4UBYIG.
Signed-off-by: Reto Schneider <reto.schneider@husqvarnagroup.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The datasheet only lists one dummy byte in the 0xEB operation for the
following chips:
* GD5F1GQ4xExxG
* GD5F1GQ4xFxxG
* GD5F1GQ4UAYIG
* GD5F4GQ4UAYIG
Reto Schneider:
- Linux patch ported to U-Boot
- Checked for compatibility with GD5F1GQ4xBxxG
- Fixed operation code in original commit message (0xEH -> 0xEB)
Signed-off-by: Reto Schneider <reto.schneider@husqvarnagroup.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The sf test command is used to test spi flashes (and spi masters). Printing
the exact error code is very helpful to those debugging the spi stack.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If there is an error while erasing SPI flash, no errno is displayed. This
makes it difficult to determine the cause of the error. This change mirrors
the logic for write errors above.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
On the i.MX8M Mini, ret = clk_set_rate() sets ret to the value of the
rate the clock was able to set. When checking for errors, it only
checks that it is not NULL. Since positive numbers are not errors,
only check for negative numbers when handling errors.
Fixes: 383fded70c ("spi: nxp_fspi: new driver for the FlexSPI controller")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The code was processed with unifdef utility to omit portions not
relevant to A38x and DDR3. This removes usage of many macros, including
A70X0, A80X0 and A3900. It seems that the unifdef utility did not remove
the macros from #else comment.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 56db5d1464b44df10a02b99e615ebd6f6a35c428 upstream.
@pali suggested this change
In commit 6285efb ("mv_ddr: add support for twin-die combined memory
device") was added support for twin-die combined memory device and
default value for explicitly uninitialized structure members is zero, s
also twin_die_combined is initialized to zero. Which means COMBINED
value.
As prior this commit there was no support for twin-die combined memory
device, default value for twin_die_combined should be NOT_COMBINED. This
change change order of enum mv_ddr_twin_die to ensure that NOT_COMBINED
has value zero.
Signed-off-by: heaterC <airyguy@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 2bdd12dd68b1f8e27a03a3443ae49a09a14c18e4 upstream.
The commit mentioned above changes non-DDR3 stuff in upstream, but it
also changes code in ddr3_training.c.
Import this change to remain consistent with upstream.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit c8b301463d508c807a33f7b7eaea98bbda4aa35e upstream.
The funtion returnd cs size in byte instead of MB, that cause
calculation error since the caller was expected to get u32 and when he
got above 4G it refers it as 0.
The fix was to get the cs memory size from function as in MB and then
multiply it by 1MB.
Signed-off-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit d653b305d0b3da9727c49124683f1a6d95d5c9a5 upstream.
The commit mentioned above changes non-DDR3 stuff in upstream, but it
also changes header ddr_topology_def.h.
Import this header change to remain consistent with upstream.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 20c89a28548cdab11f88d2ec8936344af0686a1e upstream.
WL phase correcion stage is failing while using bus_width of 16bit, not
to be fix this stage is un-necessary when working with bus_width of 16
bit.
Signed-off-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 6285efb8a118940877522c4c07bd7c64569b4f5f upstream.
the twin-die combined memory device should be treatened as X8
device and not as X16 one
Signed-off-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
[ - the default value for twin_die_combined is set to NOT_COMBINED for
all boards, as this was default behaviour prior this change ]
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 2d3b9437cf38c06c4330e0de07f29476197f5e04 upstream.
The ODT enable heuristic based on active chip-selects is not always
correct. Some board might use two chip-selects, but have only one ODT
line connected. Allow board specific mv_ddr_topology_map to directly set
the ODT configuration register value.
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Nadav Haklai <Nadav.Haklai@cavium.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <Kostya.Porotchkin@cavium.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 3908e20c6c520339e9bddb566823ae5e065d5218 upstream.
The commit mentioned above changes non-DDR3 stuff in upstream, but it
also changes header ddr_topology_def.h.
Import this header change to remain consistent with upstream.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit ab9240402a70cc02496683971779e75eff410ab4 upstream.
- function mv_ddr_spd_die_capacity_user_get() has a bug,
since it insert a user memory enum to it,
instead of SPD memory enum (which are different)
- fix: remove mv_ddr_spd_die_capacity_user_get() function.
- memory size with 64 and 32 bit already calculated correctly
at mv_ddr_mem_sz_per_cs_get() function
Signed-off-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Chulski <Stefan.Chulski@cavium.com>
Reviewed-by: Alex Leibovich <alexl@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <Kostya.Porotchkin@cavium.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 6c705ebc0d70f67ed7cae83ad1978c3305ef25be upstream.
The commit mentioned above changes non-DDR3 stuff in upstream, but it
also changes header mv_ddr_topology.h.
Import this header change to remain consistent with upstream.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit 61a8910998d7b553e80f600ebe8147a8b98f0945 upstream.
Required changes made for 32bit ddr support.
An update is made to the topology map, according to
bus_act_mask, set in the dram_port.c
Signed-off-by: Alex Leibovich <alexl@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <Kostya.Porotchkin@cavium.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit a165037ec26f301be75e1fabc263643683e85255 upstream.
The commit mentioned above changes non-DDR3 stuff in upstream, but it
also changes header ddr_topology_def.h.
Import this header change to remain consistent with upstream.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
commit ce62bef8fac559e27245259882e45f19cdc293ad upstream.
- fix JIRA A7K8K-5056
- remove TEST_PATTERN write at the load patern stage earlier to WL SUP stage
- the WL SUP stage already writes this pattern to the memory, if the pattern exist at the memory
then the algorithm will fail, since it think that there are no phase to correct
Signed-off-by: Moti Buskila <motib@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Kostya Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Tested-by: Chris Packham <chris.packham@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
The SPI NOR flash node name in main device tree for Turris Omnia is
called `spi-nor@0`.
Rename node spi-flash@0 in Turris Omnia's -u-boot.dtsi file to spi-nor@0
so that U-Boot does not try to probe the same SPI NOR device multiple
times.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Linux displays the real PCIe card connected to a mvebu PCIe slot as
device 0, not 1. This is done by setting local dev number to 1, so that
the local "Marvell Memory controller" device is on address 1.
Let's do it also in U-Boot.
With this commit the pci command in U-Boot prints something like:
=> pci
Scanning PCI devices on bus 0
BusDevFun VendorId DeviceId Device Class Sub-Class
_____________________________________________________________
00.00.00 0x168c 0x003c Network controller 0x80
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Refactor validation of bdf parameter in mvebu_pcie_read/write_config
functions.
We can simplify the code by putting the validation into separate
function.
Also there are always only two devices visible on local bus:
* on slot configured by function mvebu_pcie_set_local_dev_nr()
(by default this register is set to 0) there is a
"Marvell Memory controller", which isn't useful in root complex
mode,
* on all other slots the real PCIe card connected to the PCIe slot.
We can simplify the code even more by simply allowing access only to
the real PCIe card.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Other drivers (aardvark, intel_fpga) print "(addr,size,val)" when
debugging is enabled. Print size for pci_mvebu as well.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCI uclass maps PCI bus numbers to the seq member of struct udevice.
Use dev_seq(dev) as the bus number in mvebu_pcie_probe instead of an
incrementing a static variable.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Cc: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
NVMe drives can be connected to Turris MOX via MOX B and MOX G
extensions.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
USB devices can be connected to Turris MOX also via MOX F extension which
contains VL805 PCIe based USB 3.0 controller.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
PCIe devices do not work in U-Boot without proper initialization and
configuration of PCI config space like the PCI_BASE_ADDRESS_0 register.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Fix usage of VL805 XHCI PCIe controller when it is connected via PCIe to
Armada 3720 SOC. Without this U-Boot crashes when trying to access
enumerated USB devices connected to this XHCI PCIe controller.
This should be done according to the PCIe Link Initialization sequence, as
defined in Marvell Armada 3720 Functional Specification.
Linux has this code too.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The NOR flash w25q128 denoted by JEDEC ID 0xef4018 actually represents
various models. From Winbond's website, I could only find 3 types of
them:
W25Q128JV-IQ/JQ
datasheet:https://www.winbond.com/resource-files/
w25q128jv%20revg%2004082019%20plus.pdf
W25Q128FV (SPI Mode)
datasheet: https://www.winbond.com/resource-files/
w25q128fv%20rev.m%2005132016%20kms.pdf
W25Q128BV
datesheet: https://www.winbond.com/resource-files/
w25q128bv_revh_100313_wo_automotive.pdf
According to the datasheets, all of these 3 types support BP(0,1,2) and
TB bits in the status register (SR), so it could reuse the flash
protection logic for ST Micro.
So it should be safe to add the SPI_NOR_HAS_LOCK and SPI_NOR_HAS_TB
flags to the w25q128 entry of spi_nor_ids table.
Signed-off-by: Su Baocheng <baocheng.su@siemens.com>
[jagan: remove comments in spi-nor-ids.c]
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it. As this is the last ARCH_MPC8569 board, remove that support
as well.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In the cases of T2080RDB_SECURE_BOOT, T2080RDB_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT,
P2041RDB_SECURE_BOOT, P2041RDB_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT, P3041DS_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT
and P4080DS_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT while some forms of the board have been
migrated more fully to current build standards, these have not. Remove
them.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline.
Remove it.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Commit "common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header" added
asm/global_data.h into secure.h. However, secure.h will be included
by psci.S. Adding asm/global_data.h has caused compilation failure in
pcsi.S. Add "ifndef __ASSEMBLY__" in asm/global_data.h.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When copying to a u32 field we should use sizeof(u32) and not
sizeof(*u32) in memcpy.
On 64bit systems like cortina_presidio-asic-emmc_defconfig using
sizeof(*u32) leads to a buffer overrun.
Fixes: febe13b438 ("net: cortina_ni: Add eth support for Cortina Access CAxxxx SoCs")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
ca_do_bch_correction() takes a random value from the stack and starts
counting bitflips from this value. Initialize the counter.
This passed unnoticed as the value is finally ignored in the call
hierarchy.
Fixes: 161df94b3c ("mtd: rawnand: cortina_nand: Add Cortina CAxxxx SoC support")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The values of left_edge[0] and right_edge[0] are overwritten before they
are used. Remove the superfluous assignments.
Fixes: 285b3cb939 ("dm: ddr: socfpga: fix gen5 ddr driver to not use bss")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Include "compiler.h" in sha512.c. This is needed by 'cpu_to_be64' macro
that used in 'sha512_base_do_finalize' function.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In 8a8d24bd Simon dropped data from all the various _platdata calls
but it seems this wasn't caught for the RNG200 driver from when it
was posted to merged. This fixes that issue.
Fixes: 537f0018 (rng: Add iProc RNG200 driver)
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
test/cmd/setexpr.c cannot be linked with CONFIG_CMD_SETEXPR=n:
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `setexpr_test_sub':
test/cmd/setexpr.c:227: undefined reference to `setexpr_regex_sub'
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `setexpr_test_backref':
test/cmd/setexpr.c:267: undefined reference to `setexpr_regex_sub'
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Avoid build warnings observed with gcc 10.2
In file included from lib/rsa/rsa-keyprop.c:16:
include/u-boot/rsa-mod-exp.h:65:24: warning:
‘struct udevice’ declared inside parameter list will not be visible
outside of this definition or declaration
65 | int rsa_mod_exp(struct udevice *dev, const uint8_t *sig,
| uint32_t sig_len,
| ^~~~~~~
include/u-boot/rsa-mod-exp.h:96:24: warning:
‘struct udevice’ declared inside parameter list will not be visible
outside of this definition or declaration
96 | int (*mod_exp)(struct udevice *dev, const uint8_t *sig,
|
by defining struct udevice.
Fixes: 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The EFI Grub workaround on BananaPi R2 slows down the boot process to
the point, that the watchdog will trigger a reboot before the kernel can
reset it. Fix this by disabeling the workaround.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Currently we fail silently if there is an algorithm mismatch. To help
distinguish this failure condition.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
VIRTIO_ID_MAX_NUM is the largest device ID plus 1. Therefore a device id
cannot be greater or equal to VIRTIO_ID_MAX_NUM. Fix the comparison
accordingly.
Fixes: 8fb49b4c7a ("dm: Add a new uclass driver for VirtIO transport devices")
Signed-off-by: Vincent Stehlé <vincent.stehle@laposte.net>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Current sed usage in the DTC command relies on GNU sed specific -i
option which has a slightly different syntax for BSD sed and always
expects an extension to be provided in order to create a backup file.
Instead drop the cat concatenation done before the sed call and use
sed itself to edit and concatenate the files.
No functional change intended.
Signed-off-by: Roger Pau Monné <royger@FreeBSD.org>
Fist use extended regexp in order to drop the '\' around the
parentheses which is not supported by BSD sed in regular mode.
Secondly use [[:blank:]] instead of \s, as the later is a GNU
extension.
No functional change intended.
Signed-off-by: Roger Pau Monné <royger@FreeBSD.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Compiling the sandbox fails on armv7 due to conflicting definitions of
memcpy() and memset() in include/malloc.h and include/linux/string.h.
Use linux/string.h here.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Convert the hikey to use DM_USB and DM_ETH.
Conversion based on rpi as it has a similar DWC config.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
U-boot allows the default device tree to be overridden from
the build environment using the DEVICE_TREE variable.
Make sure that we include it in the SPL FIT mkimage build step.
This also fixes a broken image in case CONFIG_OF_LIST and
CONFIG_OF_OVERLAY_LIST are unset (i.e., expected to be supplied
by the DEVICE_TREE env var).
Signed-off-by: Klaus Heinrich Kiwi <klaus@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
Having the ability to support firmware FIT signatures on the SPL sounds
not so useful if the SPL is not supporting to load a (U-boot) firmware
as a FIT image.
Signed-off-by: Klaus Heinrich Kiwi <klaus@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
Selecting SPL_FIT_SIGNATURE (without selecting U-boot proper
verified boot first) breaks the build due to
CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE_MAX_SIZE being undefined, in addition to Kconfig
warnings on RSA and IMAGE_SIGN_INFO unmet dependencies.
Signed-off-by: Klaus Heinrich Kiwi <klaus@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
Since commit 325dd1f642 ("fs: btrfs: Use btrfs_iter_dir() to ...")
when btrfs is listing a directory, the output is not aligned:
<SYMLINK> 15 Wed Sep 09 13:20:03 2020 boot.scr -> @/boot/boot.scr
<DIR> 0 Tue Feb 02 12:42:09 2021 @
<FILE> 108 Tue Feb 02 12:54:04 2021 1.info
Return back to how it was displayed previously, i.e.:
<SYM> 15 Wed Sep 09 13:20:03 2020 boot.scr -> @/boot/boot.scr
<DIR> 0 Tue Feb 02 12:42:09 2021 @
< > 108 Tue Feb 02 12:54:04 2021 1.info
Instead of '<FILE>', print '< >', as ext4 driver.
If an unknown directory item type is encountered, we will print the type
number left padded with spaces, enclosed by '?', instead of '<' and '>',
i.e.:
? 30? ............................. name
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Fixes: 325dd1f642 ("fs: btrfs: Use btrfs_iter_dir() to replace ...")
Cc: David Sterba <dsterba@suse.com>
Cc: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Sometimes it is useful to boot OS with already fixed-up
device tree. Check for env variable 'skip_board_fixup'
before calling ft_board_setup().
Current behaviour is unchanged, additionally user can
set skip_board_fixup to 1 to skip the fixup.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
sqfs_opendir() called in sqfs_size(), sqfs_read(), sqfs_exists() may fail
leading to sqfs_closedir(NULL) being called. Do not dereference NULL.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently, we check argc in a number of places to make sure that we have
all of the required arguments for each of the pwm sub-commands.
However, there's at least one place where we've got dead code as we'll
never have argc == 0, due to checking that argc was at least 4 earlier
and having only subtracted 3. Rework things so that when we have
determined our subcommand make sure we have the right number of
arguments for it, or error out. This means we can stop checking against
argc again later.
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 316601)
Cc: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@sifive.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Xilinx changes for v2021.04-rc3
qspi:
- Support for dual/quad mode
- Fix speed handling
clk:
- Add clock enable function for zynq/zynqmp/versal
gem:
- Enable clock for Versal
- Fix error path
- Fix mdio deregistration path
fpga:
- Fix buffer alignment for ZynqMP
xilinx:
- Fix reset reason clearing in ZynqMP
- Show silicon version in SPL for Zynq/ZynqMP
- Fix DTB selection for ZynqMP
- Rename zc1275 to zcu1275 to match DT name
If zynqmp_qspi_set_speed() is called multiple times with the same speed,
then on the second call it will skip recalculating the baud_rate_val as
it assumes the speed is already configured correctly. But it will still
write the baud_rate_val to the configuration register and call
zynqmp_gqspi_set_tapdelay(). Because it skipped recalculating the
baud_rate_val, it will use the initial value of 0 . This causes the
driver to run at maximum speed which for many spi flashes is too fast and
causes data corruption.
Instead only write out a new baud_rate_val if we have calculated the
correct baud_rate_val.
This opens up another issue with the "if (speed == 0)", we don't save
off the new plat->speed_hz value when setting the baud rate on the
speed=0 path. Instead mimic what the Linux zynqmp gqspi driver does, and
have speed==0 just use the same calculation as a normal speed. That will
cause the baud_rate_val to use the slowest speed possible, which is the
safest option.
Signed-off-by: Brandon Maier <brandon.maier@rockwellcollins.com>
CC: jagan@amarulasolutions.com
CC: michal.simek@xilinx.com
CC: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashokred@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Folder names corresponds to DT name. These boards have been renamed from
zc1275 to zcu1275 by commit shown below and this should be the part of that
commit.
Fixes: 420d446781 ("arm64: zynqmp: Rename zc1275 to zcu1275")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable rx clock along with tx clock for versal platform. Use compatible
data to enable/disable clocks in the driver.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add clock enable functionality in versal clock driver to enable
clocks from peripheral drivers using clk_ops.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add clock enable functionality in zynqmp clock driver to enable
clocks from peripheral drivers using clk_ops.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
A lot of Xilinx drivers are checking -ENOSYS which means that clock driver
doesn't have enable function. Remove this checking from drivers and create
dummy enable function as was done for clk_fixed_rate driver by
commit 6bf6d81c11 ("clk: fixed_rate: add dummy enable() function").
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no need to clear reset reason register because it is protected by
PMUFW already which is reported when verbose log is enabled as:
pm_core.c@733 APU> No write permission to 0xFF5E0220
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Due to pointer arithmetic, "sizeof(u32) * ARCH_DMA_MINALIGN" is
subtracted. It seems that the original intention was to just subtract
ARCH_DMA_MINALIGN. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Currently support for the Samsung serial port driver is part
of CONFIG_S5P which controls selection of several drivers for
the S5P family. Give it its own config option such that we
can use it on other SoCs as well.
Signed-off-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
Remove pmic_max8997/8 files about no-DM.
There are already existed max8997/8 as driver-model.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
This file contains characters which are not valid in utf-8. This confuses
dtoc which wants to parse it. They don't really serve any purpose anyway,
so drop them.
To: U-Boot Mailing List <u-boot@lists.denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- splash_source warning fix when building with 64-bit toolchains
- lq123p1jx31 and nv101wxmn51 compatible in simple panel driver
- remove not used mb862xx driver
- add Himax HX8238D panel driver
- s/video_uc_platdata/video_uc_plat/
After 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header")
build fails with :
drivers/button/button-uclass.c:13:5: error: conflicting types for 'button_get_by_label'
int button_get_by_label(const char *label, struct udevice **devp)
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Adding struct udevice forward declaration in button.h solves the build error.
Fixes: 401d1c4f5d ("common: Drop asm/global_data.h from common header")
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix the 'devivce' typo in arch/sandbox/include/asm/clk.h.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The commit 6337d53fdf ("arm: dts: sync am33xx with Linux 5.9-rc7")
synchronized the am33xx-clocks.dtsi file with Linux 5.9-rc7 with the
exception of two nodes. I think I was wrong and it is better to keep
the two files similar and possibly make changes to the *-u-boot.dtsi
files.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The previous version printed the same debug message for both the enable
and disable routines without highlighting whether you were enabling or
disabling the module. It is now clear whether you are enabling or
disabling the module.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
When trying to port our mpc8309-based board to DM_ETH, on top of
Heiko's patches, I found that nothing in mdio-uclass.c seems to
support the use of a fixed-link subnode of the ethernet DT node. That
is, the ethernet node looks like
enet0: ethernet@2000 {
device_type = "network";
compatible = "ucc_geth";
...
fixed-link {
reg = <0xffffffff>;
speed = <100>;
full-duplex;
};
but the current code expects there to be phy-handle property. Adding
that, i.e.
phy-handle = <&enet0phy>;
enet0phy: fixed-link {
just makes the code break a few lines later since a fixed-link node
doesn't have a reg property. Ignoring the dtc complaint and adding a
dummy reg property, we of course hit "can't find MDIO bus for node
ethernet@2000" since indeed, the parent node of the phy node does not
represent an MDIO bus. So that's obviously the wrong path.
Now, in linux, it seems that the fixed link case is treated specially;
in the of_phy_get_and_connect() which roughly corresponds to
dm_eth_connect_phy_handle() we have
if (of_phy_is_fixed_link(np)) {
ret = of_phy_register_fixed_link(np);
...
} else {
phy_np = of_parse_phandle(np, "phy-handle", 0);
...
}
phy = of_phy_connect(dev, phy_np, hndlr, 0, iface);
And U-Boot's phy_connect() does have support for fixed-link
subnodes. Calling phy_connect() directly with NULL bus and a dummy
address does seem to make the ethernet work.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Pull request for efi-2021-04-rc3
Bug fixes:
* Let EFI simple file protocol access last block of partition
* Correct conversion of multi-part device paths in
EFI_DEVICE_PATH_TO_TEXT_PROTOCOL.ConvertDevicePathToText()
Documentation:
* booti and qfw man-pages
i2c changes for v2021.04
new feature:
- Allow disabling driver model for I2C in SPL
fixes:
- i2c-gpio: Fix GPIO output
- at91: fix crash when using 'i2c probe'
Our current implementation of
EFI_DEVICE_PATH_TO_TEXT_PROTOCOL.ConvertDevicePathToText() truncates multi
part device paths after the first part. We should convert all parts.
Render device path instance ends as commas. This is not explicitly
described in the UEFI spec but mimics what EDK II does.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Test EFI_DEVICE_PATH_TO_TEXT_PROTOCOL.ConvertDevicePathToText() for a multi
part device path.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
With the last update of conf.py the references to U-Boot where replaced by
references to Linux.
Fix the project references in the generated documentation.
Reported-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Fixes: 98f01cf7a2 ("doc: update Kernel documentation build system")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The last block is of size media->block_size
Signed-off-by: Jesper Schmitz Mouridsen <jesper@schmitz.computer>
Simplify expression.
Apply same change to efi_disk_write_blocks().
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() macro, which provides more convenient
way to check $(SPL)DM_I2C/$(SPL)DM_I2C_GPIO configs
for both SPL and U-Boot proper.
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C) expands to:
- 1 if CONFIG_SPL_BUILD is undefined and CONFIG_DM_I2C is set to 'y',
- 1 if CONFIG_SPL_BUILD is defined and CONFIG_SPL_DM_I2C is set to 'y',
- 0 otherwise.
All occurences were replaced automatically using these bash cmds:
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/ifndef CONFIG_DM_I2C/if !CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C)/g' {} +
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/ifdef CONFIG_DM_I2C/if CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C)/g' {} +
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/defined(CONFIG_DM_I2C)/CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C)/g' {} +
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/ifndef CONFIG_DM_I2C_GPIO/if !CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C_GPIO)/g' {} +
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/ifdef CONFIG_DM_I2C_GPIO/if CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C_GPIO)/g' {} +
$ find . -type f -exec sed -i
's/defined(CONFIG_DM_I2C_GPIO)/CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(DM_I2C_GPIO)/g' {} +
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Drop CONFIG_DM_I2C undefs from board header files, and make them
disabled on these boards in defconfigs instead.
Disabling on Kconfig symbol was done automatically with this script:
cd configs
files=(*ls1046a*)
files2=(*T104*RDB*)
files3=(ls1021atwr_*)
files4=("imx8mp_evk_defconfig phycore-imx8mp_defconfig")
combine=("${files[@]}" "${files2[@]}" "${files3[@]}" "${files4[@]}")
cd ..
for item in ${combine[*]}
do
echo "Adjusting $item"
echo "# CONFIG_SPL_DM_I2C is not set" >> configs/$item
make $item && make savedefconfig && cp defconfig configs/$item
done
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
At present if U-Boot proper uses driver model for I2C, then SPL has to
also. While this is desirable, it places a significant barrier to moving
to driver model in some cases. For example, with a space-constrained SPL
it may be necessary to enable CONFIG_SPL_OF_PLATDATA which involves
adjusting some drivers.
This patch introduces a separate Kconfig symbols for enabling DM_I2C and
DM_I2C_GPIO support in SPL.
This will also help to get away from dirty workarounds to
achieve non-DM I2C support for SPL, which is currently used in some
board header files like:
ifdef CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
undef CONFIG_DM_I2C
endif
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When issuing 'i2c probe', the driver was crashing, because at probe
there is a request with zero length buffer to write to i2c bus.
The xfer_msg function assumes the buffer is always there, and never
checks for the buffer length.
=> i2c dev 0
Setting bus to 0
=> i2c probe
Valid chip addresses:
data abort
pc : [<7ffa97dc>] lr : [<7ffa96f8>]
reloc pc : [<66f277dc>] lr : [<66f276f8>]
sp : 7fb7c110 ip : 7ff87a28 fp : 7ff99938
r10: 00000002 r9 : 7fb7dec0 r8 : 00000000
r7 : e181c600 r6 : 7fb88c20 r5 : 00000000 r4 : 7fb7c128
r3 : 00000000 r2 : 00000001 r1 : 00000000 r0 : 00000009
Flags: nZCv IRQs off FIQs off Mode SVC_32
Code: eb0092f4 e1a00005 e8bd81f0 e594300c (e5d33000)
Resetting CPU ...
Fixes: 8800e0fa20 ("i2c: atmel: add i2c driver")
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The dm_gpio_set_dir_flags function cannot be used to update the
configuration of a GPIO pin because it does a bitwise OR with the
existing flags. Looks like commit 788ea83412 ("gpio: add function
_dm_gpio_set_dir_flags") has introduced this behaviour and the i2c-gpio
driver has been broken since.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
CC: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
R-Car3 can have multiple regions of type memory in DT, enable
CONFIG_PCI_REGION_MULTI_ENTRY to handle those instead of using
just one of the memory regions.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Because the first PCIExAR(n) register is configured with the mapping,
It is the second PCIExAR(n) register that must be written with 0, not
the last one. Update the n from 4 to 1 to select the correct register.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
OF_STDOUT_PATH was meant to hold the devicetree path to the serial
console, to be put into the linux,stdout-path property of the chosen node.
The only user of that was sunxi, and it was actually wrong for years
there: the paths hardcoded in sunxi_common.h were not matching the DTs,
evident by the leading 0's in nodenames, which have been removed years
ago.
On top of that, "linux,stdout-path" is now deprecated for a while (Linux
commit 2a9d832cc9aae from November 2014), and also all modern DTs
(including those included in U-Boot) carry a "stdout-path" property
already.
So remove the stanza from sunxi_common.h, and, since this was the last
user, also remove the associated bits from the rest of U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The A23, A33, H3, H5, A83T, V3 and Sochip S3 sun8i SoCs can mux uart1 on
GPIOs PG6 and PG7. This patch adds support for using uart1 on those pins
as boot console.
Signed-off-by: Tobias Schramm <t.schramm@manjaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
As variables were moved to Kconfig, some of the surrounding ifdefs were
left around, even though they were empty. Clean them up.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
It turns out that there is a magic bit in PRCM region which seemingly
makes PLLs work if it's enabled. Sadly, there is no documentation what
it does exactly, so we'll just mimick BSP boot0 behaviour and enable it
before any clock is set up.
Fixes: b18bd53d6c ("sunxi: introduce support for H616 clocks")
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
CONFIG_VIDEO_MB862xx cannot be selected by any configuration.
So we can eliminate include/mb862xx.h.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The mb862xx driver does not conform to the driver model and is unused.
Eliminate it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add "boe,nv101wxmn51" to the compatible node. This is the panel for
chromebook_bob.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add "sharp,lq123p1jx31" to the compatible node. This is the panel for
chromebook_kevin.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix -Wint-to-pointer-cast warning
common/splash_source.c: In function 'splash_load_raw':
common/splash_source.c:100:12: warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
100 | bmp_hdr = (struct bmp_header *)bmp_load_addr;
| ^
common/splash_source.c: In function 'splash_sf_read_raw':
common/splash_source.c:39:47: warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
39 | return spi_flash_read(sf, offset, read_size, (void *)bmp_load_addr);
| ^
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- mmc_spi improvement
- added mmc-pwrseq to remove duplicated code
- fix response timeout after switch command
- sdhci: skip cache invalidation if DMA is not used
Before time, PWRSEQ is selected since below commit.
commit 262d343633 ("board: amlogic: select PWRSEQ for all amlogic platform")
Select MMC_PWRSEQ config because of introducing CONFIG_MMC_PWRSEQ for
only eMMC module.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
mmc_spi_sendcmd(), mmc_spi_readdata() and mmc_spi_writedata() are
currently undocumented. Add comment blocks to explain the arguments
and the return value.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
After command is sent and before card response shows up on the line,
there is a variable number of clock cycles in between called Ncr.
The spec [1] says the minimum is 1 byte and the maximum is 8 bytes.
Current logic in mmc_spi_sendcmd() has a flaw that it could only work
with certain SD cards with their Ncr being just 1 byte.
When resp_match is false, the codes try to receive only 1 byte from
the SD card. On the other hand when resp_match is true, the logic
happens to be no problem as it loops until timeout to receive as many
bytes as possible to see a match of the expected resp_match_value.
However not every call to mmc_spi_sendcmd() is made with resp_match
being true hence this exposes a potential issue with SD cards that
have a larger Ncr value.
Given no issue was reported as of today, we can reasonably conclude
that all cards being used on the supported boards happen to have a 1
byte Ncr timing requirement. But a broken case can be triggered by
utilizing QEMU to emulate a larger value of Ncr (by default 1 byte
Ncr is used on QEMU). This commit fixes such potential spec violation
to improve the card compatibility.
[1] "Physical Layer Specification Version 8.00"
chapter 7.5.1: Command / Response
chapter 7.5.4: Timing Values
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
After issuing the switch command: Wait until 'current state' of the card
status becomes 'tran'. This prevents from response timeout at the next
command because of 'current state' = 'data'.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Bosch <stefan_b@posteo.net>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
If DMA(SDMA or ADMA) is not used, the cache invalidation
after reading is no need, should be skipped. Otherwise
U-Boot may hang at the cache invalidation.
Found this issue and tested this fix on DragonBoard 410c.
Fixes: commit 4155ad9aac ("mmc: sdhci: fix missing cache invalidation after reading by DMA")
Signed-off-by: Yuezhang.Mo <Yuezhang.Mo@sony.com>
Reviewed-by: Andy Wu <Andy.Wu@sony.com>
It's confusing whether arguments are optional or mandatory.
Update the command's usage to clarify how to use.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The 'brcm,bcm2711-hdmi0' compatible string is used on RPi4 instead of
'brcm,bcm2835-hdmi' since the IP core was upgraded (now called VC6
instead of VC4). This has no functional change as far as u-boot driver
is concerned. So simply add the compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The DM_DMA option is needed in order to translate physical address into
bus addresses on a per-device basis.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
So far we've been content with passing physical addresses when
configuring memory addresses into XHCI controllers, but not all
platforms have buses with transparent mappings. Specifically the
Raspberry Pi 4 might introduce an offset to memory accesses incoming
from its PCIe port.
Introduce xhci_virt_to_bus() and xhci_bus_to_virt() to cater with these
limitations, and make sure we don't break non DM users.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
[mb: fix compilation for 32 bit]
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
fix from nicolas
By reusing DT nodes already available in sandbox's test DT introduce a
test to validate dev_phys_to_bus()/dev_bus_to_phys().
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
These functions, instead of relying on hard-coded platform-specific
address translations, make use of the DMA constraints provided by the DM
core. This allows for per-device translations.
We can't yet get rid of the legacy phys_to_bus()/bus_to_phys()
implementations as some of its users are not integrated into the
device model.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Calculating the DMA offset between a bus address space and CPU's every
time we call phys_to_bus() and bus_to_phys() isn't ideal performance
wise, as it implies traversing the device tree from the device's node up
to the root. Since this information is static and available before the
device's initialization, parse it before the probe call an provide the
DMA offset in 'struct udevice' for the address translation code to use
it.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Introduce some new nodes in sandbox's test device-tree and dm tests in
order to validate dev_get_dma_range().
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Add the following functions to get a specific device's DMA ranges:
- dev_get_dma_range()
- ofnode_get_dma_range()
- of_get_dma_range()
- fdt_get_dma_range()
They are specially useful in oder to be able validate a physical address
space range into a bus's and to convert addresses from and to address
spaces.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
So far we've assumed a fixed configuration for inbound windows as we had
a single user for this controller. But the controller's DMA constraints
were improved starting with BCM2711's B1 revision of the SoC, notably
available in CM4 and Pi400. They allow for wider inbound windows. We can
now cover the whole address space, whereas before we where limited to
the lower 3GB.
This information is passed to us through DT's 'dma-ranges' property and
it's specially important for us to honor it since some interactions with
the board's co-processor assume we're doing so (specifically the XHCI
firmware load operation, which is handled by the co-processor after
u-boot has correctly configured the PCIe controller).
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The Raspberry Pi Foundation released the new Compute Module 4 which we
want to detect, so we can enable Ethernet on it and know the correct
device tree file name.
Note that this sets the Ethernet option to true since the official CM4
IO board has an Ethernet port. But that might not be the case when using
custom ones.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The Raspberry Pi Foundation released the new RPi400 which we want to
detect, so we can enable Ethernet on it and know the correct device tree
file name.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
When RPi4 is booted from USB Mass Storage, the firmware reports 947MiB of
the ARM memory (948 in case of the standard SD-card boot). This value is
not MMU_SECTION_SIZE aligned, so the dram_bank_mmu_setup() skips mapping
of the last 1MiB. This later causes u-boot in ARM 32bit mode to freeze,
because it relocated itself into that unmapped memory and fails to
execute.
Fix this by limiting the size of the first bank to the multiple of
MMU_SECTION_SIZE.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Tested-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Make sure we handover the PCIe controller in a clean state. Some of the
devices hanging from the PCIe bus might need to be properly reset
through #PERST in order for Linux to be able to initialize them.
This is specially important in order to properly initialize Raspberry Pi
4 B and 400's USB chip.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The PCIe bus the controller is connected to might need to be removed
prior the handover. Make sure xhci-pci is also removed so as to avoid
unexpected timeouts or hangs.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
We find the iProc RNG200 in the Raspberry Pi 4. Add it to all it's
config so that it can be used.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
[mb: drop rpi_4_32b_defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Add adc-keys device to the sandbox/test.dts and connect it to the channel
#3 of the sandbox_adc driver. The default values sampled by sandbox_adc
driver determines that button3 and button4 are released and button5 is
pressed.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add support for getting the 'vref-supply' regulator and register it as
ADC's reference voltage regulator, so clients can translate sampled ADC
values to the voltage.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add a simple Analog to Digital Converter device based button driver. This
driver binds to the 'adc-keys' device tree node.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Dump adc-keys bindings documentation from Linux kernel source tree from
commit 698dc0cf9447 ("dt-bindings: input: adc-keys: clarify
description").
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
When a FIT config specifies a devicetree, we should load it, no
questions asked. In the case of the "simple" FIT loading path, a
difficulty arises in selecting the load address of the FDT.
The default FDT location is right after the "kernel" or "firmware"
image. However, if that is an OP-TEE image, then the FDT may end up in
secure DRAM, and not be accessible to normal world kernels.
Although the best solution is to be more careful about the FDT
address, a viable workaround is to only append the FDT after a u-boot
or Linux image. This is identical to the previous logic, except that
FDT loading is extended to IH_OS_LINUX images.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Use the IS_ENABLED() macro to control code flow, instead of the
caveman approach of sprinkling #ifdefs. Code size is not affected, as
the linker garbage-collects unused functions. However, readability is
improved significantly.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There's no point in guarding function prototypes with #ifdefs. If a
function is not defined, the linker will notice. Having the prototype
does not affect code size.
What the #if guard takes away is the ability to use IS_ENABLED:
if (CONFIG_IS ENABLED(FIT_IMAGE_POST_PROCESS))
board_fit_image_post_process(...)
When the prototype is guarded, the above form cannot be used. This
leads to the proliferation of #ifdefs, and unreadable code. The
opportunity cost of the #if guard outweighs any benefits. Remove it.
Since the original version of this patch, an empty definition was
added by commit f14e6eec6c ("image: cleanup pre-processor usage").
The empty definition can cause silent failures, when an implementation
of board_fit_image_post_process() is expected because the linker will
not catch the missing function. Thus this patch removes this empty
inline declaration.
Fixes: f14e6eec6c ("image: cleanup pre-processor usage")
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The configuration node a sub node under "/configurations", which
describes the components to load from "/images". We only need to
locate this node once.
However, for each component, spl_fit_get_image_name() would parse the
FIT image, looking for the correct node. Such work duplication is not
necessary. Instead, once the node is found, cache it, and re-use it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When a desired configuration is not found, conf_node will have a
negative value. Thus the for loop will start at the root "/" node of
the image, print the "/description" property, and stop.
It appears the intent of the loop was to print the names of the
subnodes under "/configurations". We would need the offset to the
"/configurations" node, which is abstracted by fit_find_config_node().
This change agrees that abstracting the node offset is the correct
design, and we shouldn't be parsing the configurations manually. Thus
the loop in spl_fit_get_image_name() is useless. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Several loose arguments describe the FIT image. They are thus related,
and it makes sense to pass them together, in a structure. Examples
include the FIT blob pointer, offset to FDT nodes, and the offset to
external data.
Use a spl_fit_info structure to group these parameters.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The logical steps in spl_load_simple_fit() are difficult to follow.
I think the long comments, ifdefs, and ungodly number of variables
seriously affect the readability. In particular, it violates section 6
of the coding style, paragraphs (3), and (4).
The purpose of this patch is to improve the situation by
- Factoring out initialization and parsing to separate functions
- Reduce the number of variables by using a context structure
This change introduces no functional changes.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The size is derived from the FIT image itself. Any alignment
requirements are machine-specific and known by the board code. Thus
the total length can be derived from the FIT image and knowledge of
the platform. The 'length' argument is redundant. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CC: Matt Porter <mporter@konsulko.com>
Add support for random number generator RNG200.
This is for example found on RPi4.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
[mb: adapt to new struct driver memebers]
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The switch driver for LS1028A Ethernet switch is now compiled in for
the NXP LS1028A reference design boards and for the Kontron SMARC-sAL28.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
The definition follows the DSA binding in kernel and describes the switch,
its ports and PHYs. The switch node has the same structure as in Linux
and this patch enables it (and relevant ports) for the LS1028A RDB board.
ENETC PF6 is the 2nd Eth controller linked to the switch on LS1028A, it is
not used in U-Boot and was disabled. Ethernet port aliases were also
added to better manage the multitude of ports available now.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
This driver is used for the Ethernet switch integrated into LS1028A NXP.
Felix on LS1028A has 4 front panel ports and two internal ports, I/O
to/from the switch is done through an ENETC Ethernet interface.
The 4 front panel ports are available as Ethernet interfaces and can be
used with the typical network commands like tftp.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
DSA stands for Distributed Switch Architecture and it covers switches that
are connected to the CPU through an Ethernet link and generally use frame
tags to pass information about the source/destination ports to/from CPU.
Front panel ports are presented as regular ethernet devices in U-Boot and
they are expected to support the typical networking commands.
DSA switches may be cascaded, DSA class code does not currently support
this.
Signed-off-by: Alex Marginean <alexandru.marginean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
The DSA (Distributed Switch Architecture) implementation has made a
design decision when it got introduced to the Linux kernel in 2008.
That was to hide away from the user the CPU-facing Ethernet MAC, since
it does not make sense to register it as a struct net_device (UCLASS_ETH
udevice for U-Boot), because that would never be beneficial for a user:
they would not be able to use it for traffic, since conceptually, a
packet delivered to the CPU port should loop back into the system.
Nonetheless, DSA has had numerous growing pains due to the lack of a
struct net_device for the CPU port, but so far it has overcome them.
It is unlikely at this stage of maturity that this aspect of it will
change.
We would like U-Boot to present the same information as Linux, to be at
parity in terms of number of interfaces, so that ethNaddr environment
variables could directly be associated between U-Boot and Linux.
Therefore, we would implicitly like U-Boot to hide the CPU port from the
user as well.
But the paradox is that DSA still needs a struct phy_device to inform
the driver of the parameters of the link that it should configure the
CPU port to. The problem is that the phy_device is typically returned
via a call to phy_connect, which needs an udevice to attach the PHY to,
and to search its ofnode for the 'fixed-link' property. But we don't
have an udevice to present for the CPU port.
Since 99% of DSA setups are MAC-to-MAC connections between the switch
and the host Ethernet controller, the struct phy_device is going to be a
fixed PHY. This simplifies things quite a bit. In U-Boot, a fixed PHY
does not need an MDIO bus, and does not need an attached dev either.
Basically, the phy_connect call doesn't do any connection, it just
creates the fixed PHY.
The proposal of this patch is to introduce a new fixed_phy_create
function which will take a single argument: the ofnode that holds this:
port@4 {
reg = <4>;
phy-mode = "internal";
fixed-link {
speed = <2500>;
full-duplex;
};
};
and probe a fixed PHY driver using the information from this ofnode.
DSA will probably be the only user of this function.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Unlike the Linux fixed PHY driver, the one in U-Boot does not attempt to
emulate the clause 22 register set of a gigabit copper PHY driver
through the swphy framework. Therefore, the limitation of being unable
to support speeds higher than gigabit in fixed-link does not apply to
the U-Boot fixed PHY driver. This makes the fixed-link U-Boot
implementation more similar to the one from phylink, which can work with
any valid link speed.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Claudiu Manoil <claudiu.manoil@nxp.com>
Extend existing DM tee tests adding test coverage for reverse RPC calls.
Currently this commit only adds tests for I2C requests from TEE driver
to TEE supplicant, for instance reading/writing data to emulated i2c
eeprom defines in standard sandbox test device tree
(arch/sandbox/dts/test.dtb):
=> i2c bus
Bus 0: i2c@0 (active 0)
2c: eeprom@2c, offset len 1, flags 0
...
Running TEE tests:
=> ut dm tee
Test: dm_test_tee: tee.c
Test: dm_test_tee: tee.c (flat tree)
Failures: 0
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
This adds support for RPC test trusted application emulation, which
permits to test reverse RPC calls to TEE supplicant. Currently it covers
requests to the I2C bus from TEE.
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jens Wiklander <jens.wiklander@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Add pygit2 and pyelftools to the list of packages for virtualenv
needed to run all sets of pytests.This fixes warnings like:
binman.elf_test.TestElf.testDecodeElf (subunit.RemotedTestCase):
Python elftools not available
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit gives the secure world access to the I2C bus so it can
communicate with I2C slaves (typically those would be secure elements
like the NXP SE050).
A similar service implementation has been merged in linux:
c05210ab ("drivers: optee: allow op-tee to access devices on the i2c
bus")
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
In case of IOMUX enabled it assumes that console devices in the list
are available to get them stopped properly via ->stop() callback.
However, the USB keyboard driver violates this assumption and tries
to play tricks so the device get destroyed while being listed as
an active console.
Swap the order of device deregistration and IOMUX update along with
converting to use iomux_replace_device() jelper to avoid the use-after-free.
Fixes: 3cbcb28928 ("usb: Fix usb_kbd_deregister when console-muxing is used")
Fixes: 8a83487030 ("dm: usb: Add a remove() method for USB keyboards")
Reported-by: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Some console devices may appear or disappear at run time. In order to
support such a hotplug mechanism introduce a new iomux_replace_device()
helper to update the list of devices without altering environment.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
It is not only less lines of code, but also better readability
when new macro is being in use. Introduce for_each_console_dev()
helper macro and convert current users to it.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Logical continuation of the change that brought console_devices_set() is
to unify console_setfile() with it and replace in the callers.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
It's possible that NULLDEV can be disabled while it makes leftovers,
move entire device under #if.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Nobody is using stdio_deregister(), remove for good.
Note, even its parameters are not consistent with stdio_register().
So, if anyone want to introduce this again, better with some consistency.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Move gpio controller nodes from am33xx.dtsi to am33xx-l4.dtsi. Now both
files are more similar to those found in Linux 5.9-rc7. To be fully
operational as before it was also necessary to fix the am33xx-clock.dtsi
file. It too is now almost the same as the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Since commit 6239cc8c4e ("arm: dts: k3-j7200: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts
into U-Boot") ranges have been added to CPSW node which results in
U-Boot CPSW driver failing to acquire phy_gmii_sel register range and
thus failing to configure GMII mode correctly.
Fix this by deleting ranges in -u-boot-dtsi just like its done for other
K3 platforms.
Fixes: 6239cc8c4e ("arm: dts: k3-j7200: Sync Linux v5.11-rc6 dts into U-Boot")
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
It is possible to construct a devicetree blob with multiple root nodes.
Update fdt_check_full() to check for this, along with a root node with an
invalid name.
CVE-2021-27097
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bruce Monroe <bruce.monroe@intel.com>
Reported-by: Arie Haenel <arie.haenel@intel.com>
Reported-by: Julien Lenoir <julien.lenoir@intel.com>
Some strange modifications of the FIT can introduce security risks. Add an
option to check it thoroughly, using libfdt's fdt_check_full() function.
Enable this by default if signature verification is enabled.
CVE-2021-27097
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bruce Monroe <bruce.monroe@intel.com>
Reported-by: Arie Haenel <arie.haenel@intel.com>
Reported-by: Julien Lenoir <julien.lenoir@intel.com>
At present this function does not accept a size for the FIT. This means
that it must be read from the FIT itself, introducing potential security
risk. Update the function to include a size parameter, which can be
invalid, in which case fit_check_format() calculates it.
For now no callers pass the size, but this can be updated later.
Also adjust the return value to an error code so that all the different
types of problems can be distinguished by the user.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bruce Monroe <bruce.monroe@intel.com>
Reported-by: Arie Haenel <arie.haenel@intel.com>
Reported-by: Julien Lenoir <julien.lenoir@intel.com>
When searching for a node called 'fred', any unit address appended to the
name is ignored by libfdt, meaning that 'fred' can match 'fred@1'. This
means that we cannot be sure that the node originally intended is the one
that is used.
Disallow use of nodes with unit addresses.
Update the forge test also, since it uses @ addresses.
CVE-2021-27138
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bruce Monroe <bruce.monroe@intel.com>
Reported-by: Arie Haenel <arie.haenel@intel.com>
Reported-by: Julien Lenoir <julien.lenoir@intel.com>
At present fdt_find_regions() assumes that the FIT is a valid devicetree.
If the FIT has two root nodes this is currently not detected in this
function, nor does libfdt's fdt_check_full() notice. Also it is possible
for the root node to have a name even though it should not.
Add checks for these and return -FDT_ERR_BADSTRUCTURE if a problem is
detected.
CVE-2021-27097
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Bruce Monroe <bruce.monroe@intel.com>
Reported-by: Arie Haenel <arie.haenel@intel.com>
Reported-by: Julien Lenoir <julien.lenoir@intel.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
As this is the last SH4A board, remove that support as well.
Cc: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
Patch-cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu.nobuhiro@renesas.com>
Patch-cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM by the deadline of v2020.01
and is missing other conversions which depend on this as well. Remove it.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board relies on using CONFIG_LIBATA but does not enable CONFIG_AHCI. The
deadline for this conversion was the v2019.07 release. The use of CONFIG_AHCI
requires CONFIG_DM. The deadline for this conversion was v2020.01. Remove
this board.
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline of
v2019.04, which is almost two years ago. In addition there are other DM
migrations it is also missing. Remove it.
Cc: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline of
v2019.04, which is almost two years ago. In addition there are other DM
migrations it is also missing. Remove it.
Cc: Prabhakar Kushwaha <prabhakar.kushwaha@nxp.com>
Cc: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This board has not been converted to CONFIG_DM_MMC by the deadline of
v2019.04, which is almost two years ago. In addition there are other DM
migrations it is also missing. Remove it.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc2-2
Bug fixes:
* fix stack smashing in UEFI capsule updates
* correct loading of UEFI binaries where Virtual size is not a
multiple of FileAlignment
* simplify detection of capsule files.
* buildman: use threading.is_alive() instead of removed method IsAlive()
The isAlive() method was deprecated in Python 3.8 and has been removed in
Python 3.9. See https://bugs.python.org/issue37804. Use is_alive() instead.
Since Python 2.6 is_alive() has been a synonym for isAlive(). So there
should be no problems for users using elder Python 3 versions.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
fix get_last_capsule() leads to writes beyond the stack allocated buffer.
This was indicated when enabling the stack protector.
utf16_utf8_strcpy() only stops copying when reaching '\0'. The current
invocation always writes beyond the end of value[].
The output length of utf16_utf8_strcpy() may be longer than the number of
UTF-16 tokens. E.g has "CapsuleКиев" has 11 UTF-16 tokens but 15 UTF-8
tokens. Hence, using utf16_utf8_strcpy() without checking the input may
lead to further writes beyond value[].
The current invocation of strict_strtoul() reads beyond the end of value[].
A non-hexadecimal value after "Capsule" (e.g. "CapsuleZZZZ") must result in
an error. We cat catch this by checking the return value of strict_strtoul().
A value that is too short after "Capsule" (e.g. "Capsule0") must result in
an error. We must check the string length of value[].
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
'.' and '..' are directories. So when looking for capsule files it is
sufficient to check that the attribute EFI_FILE_DIRECTORY is not set. We
don't have to check for these special names.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
PE section table entries' SizeOfRawData must be a multiple of
FileAlignment, and thus may be rounded up and larger than their
VirtualSize.
We should not load beyond the VirtualSize, which is "the total size of
the section when loaded into memory" -- we may clobber real data at the
target in some other section, since we load sections in reverse order
and sections are usually laid out sequentially.
Signed-off-by: Asherah Connor <ashe@kivikakk.ee>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
First set of u-boot-atmel fixes for 2021.04 cycle:
This small PR includes just two fixes but very important: one revert in
the clk subsystem which fixes the boot on many old boards
(sama5d2_xplained, sama5d4_xplained), which currently crash at boot; and
one small fix related to debug serial on sama7g5ek board.
Revert changes in at91 compat.c that cause u-boot to fail booting on
sama5d4_xplained and sama5d2_xplained
Log below:
<debug_uart>
No serial driver found
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Could not initialize timer (err -19)
Fixes: a2703ce10c ("dm: Remove uses of device_bind_offset()")
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the serial tx/rx are floating, it can happen that bogus characters
are detected on the line at boot time. This leads to U-boot accidentally
thinking someone pressed a key to stop autoboot, thus stopping booting process.
This can happen if the serial cable is not connected. There are hardware
pull-ups on the board connected to serial cable VBUS.
To solve this when the cable is not plugged, enable internal pull-ups as well
for the tx/rx lines.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
The Linux kernel v5.7-rc1 introduced the compatible "st,stm32mp15-hsotg".
See Linux kernel commit d49850110434 ("dt-bindings: usb: dwc2: add
support for STM32MP15 SoCs USB OTG HS and FS")
This patch updates the supported compatible in DWC2 driver,
removes the add-on done in U-Boot dtsi and keeps the compatible
defined in SOC dtsi arch/arm/dts/stm32mp151.dtsi:
usbotg_hs: usb-otg@49000000 {
compatible = "st,stm32mp15-hsotg", "snps,dwc2";
reg = <0x49000000 0x10000>;
...
};
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Testing with v2021.01 on MIPS Octeon has shown, that the latest patch
for the "short packet event trb handling" did introduce a bug on
platforms with virtual address != physical address. This patch fixes
this issue by using the correct address types in the compare (both
physical in this case).
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Ran Wang <ran.wang_1@nxp.com>
Cc: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Function dm_pci_map_bar() may fail and returns NULL. Check this to prevent
dereferencing a NULL pointer.
In xhci-pci this may happen when board does not enable CONFIG_PCI_PNP and
PCI_BASE_ADDRESS_0 contains unconfigured zero address.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Add optional properies to disable usb2 or usb3 ports, they are used
when provided ports are not used on some special platforms.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Add support to disable specific ports, it's useful for some
scenarios:
1. usb3 PHY is shared whith PCIe or SATA, the corresponding
usb3 port can be disabled;
2. some usb2 or usb3 ports are not used on special platforms,
they should be disabled to save power.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Both Zynq and ZynqMP can show silicon versions in SPL boot flow. It is
useful to be aware.
The patch is also fixing possition of these bits on ZynqMP.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Fix bug introduced by commit listed below. It is for cases where Versal or
ZynqMP don't have DDR mapped. Later SPL was also excluded by
commit a672b9871b ("xilinx: common: Do not touch
CONFIG_XILINX_OF_BOARD_DTB_ADDR in SPL").
Fixes: 506009fc10 ("xilinx: common: Change macro handling in board_fdt_blob_setup()")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Use the ADC channel 1 to check the hardware revision of the board and
detect the N2 vs. N2+ and the C4 vs. HC4 variants. Each of them use
different dtb file, so adjust fdtfile environment variable to the
detected variant.
The ADC min/max values for each variant are taken from the vendor code,
adjusted to the 12-bit ADC driver operation mode (vendor code use 10-bit
mode).
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The Amlogic AXG MIPI + PCIe Analog PHY provides function for both PCIe and
MIPI DSI at the same time, and provides the Analog part of MIPI DSI transmission
and Analog part of the PCIe lines.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The Amlogic AXG SoCs embeds a MIPI D-PHY used to communicate with DSI
panels.
This D-PHY depends on a separate analog PHY.
Signed-off-by:Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add the PHY configure op callback to the generic PHY uclass to permit
configuring the PHY.
It's useful for MIPI DSI PHYs to setup the link timings.
Signed-off-by:Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The MIPI D-PHY spec defines default values and boundaries for most of the
parameters it defines. Introduce helpers to help drivers get meaningful
values based on their current parameters, and validate the boundaries of
these parameters if needed.
These helpers and header are taken from Linux commit 9123e3a74ec7 ("Linux 5.9-rc1").
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
- Enable the fastboot oem commands in stm32mp15 defconfig
- Fixes pinctrol for stmfx and stm32
- Add support of I2C6_K in stm32mp15 clock driver
- Alignment with Linux kernel device tree v5.11-rc2 for ST boards
Device tree alignment with Linux kernel v5.11-rc2
- fix DCMI DMA features on stm32mp15 family
- Add alternate pinmux for FMC EBI bus
- Harmonize EHCI/OHCI DT nodes name on stm32mp15
- update sdmmc IP version for STM32MP15
- Add LP timer irqs on stm32mp151
- Add LP timer wakeup-source on stm32mp151
- enable HASH by default on stm32mp15
- enable CRC1 by default on stm32mp15
- enable CRYP by default on stm32mp15
- set bus-type in DCMI endpoint for stm32mp157c-ev1 board
- reorder spi4 within stm32mp15-pinctrl
- add STUSB1600 Type-C using I2C4 on stm32mp15xx-dkx
- fix mdma1 clients channel priority level on stm32mp151
- fix dmamux reg property on stm32mp151
- adjust USB OTG gadget fifo sizes in stm32mp151
- update stm32mp151 for remote proc synchronization support
- support child mfd cells for the stm32mp1 TAMP syscon
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The kilohertz unit abbreviation should read 'kHz'.
Note to STM32 team: modified files were generated, it may be worth
to fix STM32CubeMX tool.
Signed-off-by: Fabrice GIRARDOT <fabrice.girardot@flowbird.group>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add support of missing I2C6_K with bit 3 of RCC_MC_APB5ENSETR =
I2C6EN: I2C6 peripheral clocks enable.
This patch allows customer to use I2C6 in SPL or in U-Boot
as other I2C instance, already support in clk driver.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Bind only the enabled GPIO subnode, to avoid to probe the node
"gpio-controller" present in SOC dtsi (disabled by default) but
not enabled in the included pincontrol dtsi file.
For example, in stm32mp15xxac-pinctrl.dtsi 2 gpio bank are absent:
gpioj: gpio@5000b000
gpiok: gpio@5000c000
Then these GPIO are absent in output of command "dm tree" and
"gpio status -a"
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
OTYPE can be used for output or for alternate function to select
PP = push-pull or OP = open-drain mode, according reference manual
(Table 81. Port bit configuration table).
This patch removes this indication for input pins and adds it
for AF and output pins for pinmux command output.
Fixes: b305dbc08b ("pinctrl: stm32: display bias information for all pins")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
pin-controller pin's name must be equal to pin's name used in device
tree with "pins" DT property.
Issue detected on stm32mp157c-ev1 board with goodix touchscreen.
In DT, the goodix's pin is declared in DT with the node:
goodix_pins: goodix {
pins = "gpio14";
bias-pull-down;
};
Whereas in stmfx pin-controller driver, pin's name are equal to
"stmfx_gpioxx" where xx is the pin number.
This lead to not configure stmfx's pins at probe because pins is
identified by its name (see pinctrl_pin_name_to_selector() in
pinctrl-generic.c) and stmfx pin "gpio14" can't be found.
To fix this issue, come back to the original stmfx pin's name.
Revert "pinctrl: stmfx: update pin name"
This reverts commit 38d30cdcd65c73eeefac5efa328ad444a53b77dd.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Tested-by: Patrick DELAUNAY <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Enable the fastboot oem command bootbus, used to configure the eMMC
boot behavior, with same format than 'mmc bootbus'
and with parameter: boot_bus_width reset_boot_bus_width boot_mode
On stm32mp1 boards the expected command is
$> fastboot oem partconf:0 0 0
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Enable the fastboot oem command partconf, used to select the correct
eMMC boot partition, with same format than 'mmc partconf'
with parameter: boot_ack boot_partition
On stm32mp1 family:
- boot_ack = 1 (Boot Acknowledge is needed by ROM code)
- boot_partition = 1 or 2 (Boot partition 1 / 2 enabled for boot)
So on EV1 board the expected commands to select boot partition 1 or 2
$> fastboot oem partconf:1 1
$> fastboot oem partconf:1 2
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
- Espressobin: Set default env values at runtime (Pali)
- Espressobin: Set the maximum slave SPI speed to 40MHz (Pali)
- theadorable: PCIe test code enhancement and early deemphasis
enabling (Stefan)
- pci_mvebu: Disable config access to PCI host bridge ports (Stefan)
- mv_sdhci: parse device-tree entry (Baruch)
Update gpio driver to use same logic for big-endian and little-endian
Signed-off-by: Biwen Li <biwen.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Drop the CONFIG_VIDEO to fix the following build warning.
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO Please update
the board to use CONFIG_DM_VIDEO before the v2019.07 release.
UPD include/generated/dt.h
Failure to update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
UPD include/generated/timestamp_autogenerated.h
====================================================
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Update data type of '1' to '1ull' in below assignment
size = 1ull << sizebit;
to fix incorrect assignment issue.
e.g: when sizebit was 31, 0x80000000 got sign extended to
0xffffffff_80000000
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Reported-by: Dean Saridakis <dean.saridakis@baesystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable the I-Cache to speed up the boot time, especailly for the NOR
boot, currently it takes about 15 seconds from power up to the U-Boot
prompt, and with the I-Cache enabled it only takes around 2.5 seconds.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LX2162A is not like LX2160A which has different PCIe controller
in rev1 and rev2 silicon. It supports only one configuration of
PCIe controller, which is same as LS2088A. So update PCIe
compatible string same as LS2088A.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch moves the SVR definitions to a new svr.h for
Layerscape armv7 and armv8 platforms respectively, so that
the PCIe driver can reuse them.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The LS1088 requires the same QUADSPI_QURIK_BASE_INTERNAL
workaround as the LS208x and also has a 64 byte TX buffer.
With the previous settings SPI-NAND reads over AHB were
corrupted.
Fixes: 91afd36f38 ("spi: Transform the FSL QuadSPI driver to use the SPI MEM API")
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Adapted from kernel commit b0177aca7aea
From: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Make use of a core helper to ensure the desired width is respected
when calling spi-mem operators.
Otherwise only the SPI controller will be matched with the flash chip,
which might lead to wrong widths. Also consider the width specified by
the user in the device tree.
Fixes: 91afd36f38 ("spi: Add a driver for the Freescale/NXP QuadSPI controller")
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/r/20200114154613.8195-1-michael@walle.cc
Signed-off-by: Mark Brown <broonie@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au> [adapt for U-Boot]
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
spi_mem_default_supports_op is used internally by controller
drivers to verify operation semantics are correct.
It is used internally inside spi-mem but has not (in U-Boot)
been declared in spi-mem.h for external use.
Signed-off-by: Mathew McBride <matt@traverse.com.au>
Reviewed-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Replace instances of sprintf()/set_env() for setting hexadecimal
values with set_env_hex().
In set_km_env() the "pram" variable was set to an hexadecimal
value, while initr_mem() expects an unsigned decimal, so use
set_env_ulong() instead.
Signed-off-by: Niel Fourie <lusus@denx.de>
Cc: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Pulled in the kmcent2.dts and all its dependents from Linux 5.10,
commit 2c85ebc57b3e upstream. Replaced the license text with
SPDX License Identifiers.
Signed-off-by: Niel Fourie <lusus@denx.de>
Cc: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Take into account SDRAM_BASE address when calculating pnvramaddr and
varaddr offsets.
Up to now Keymile designs had SDRAM_BASE equal to zero and the offsets
where calculated correctly, this fix is for the upcoming designs that
have SDRAM_BASE different then zero.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This patch is fixing qrio driver compilation for ARM architecture:
- It includes asm/io.h for in_/out_ access
- It use correct names for set/clear_bits as defined in linux/bitops.h
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Multiple LX2(LX2160A/LX2162A SoC) personality variants
exists based on CAN-FD and security bit in SVR.
Currenly SVR_SOC_VER mask only security bit.
Update SVR_SOC_VER to mask CAN_FD and security bit
for LX2 products.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
When A-050382 errata is enabled, ECAM and EDMA have
conflicting stream id 40. This patch fixes the same.
Signed-off-by: Nipun Gupta <nipun.gupta@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Laurentiu Tudor <laurentiu.tudor@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable SATA support. Although not supported by the usual SATA pins on
the SMARC baseboard connector, SATA mode is supported on a PCIe lane.
This way one can use a mSATA card in a Mini PCI slot.
We need to invert the received data because in this mode the polarity of
the SerDes lane is swapped. Provide a fixup in board_early_init_f() for
the SPL. board_early_init_f() is then not common between SPL and u-boot
proper anymore, thus common.c is removed, as it just contained said
function.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Although this variant has two external network ports, they are not (yet)
supported by the bootloader because they are connected via an internal
network switch. Otherwise its the same as the other variants.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
This variant has one network port connected via RGMII and doesn't have
any TSN capabilities out-of-the-box. Instead it has all four SerDes
lanes available for customer use.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The variants differ in their network configuration. Move the first two
network aliases to the proper variant device tree includes. This is in
prepartion for variant 1 and 2 support which has a different network
port mapping. The network aliases for the two internal ports will stay
in the common dtsi because they are present on all board variants.
This might leave a hole if there is no ethernet1 alias. This is
intended.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Current MDIO wait time is too long, which introduce long delay when
PHY negotiation register checking. Reduce it to 10us
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Fugang Duan <Fugang.duan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add COMMON_ENV(kernelheader_addr_r, fdtheader_addr_r,
kernel_addr_r, fdt_addr_r, load_addr)
to fix a bug that failed to boot to ubuntu
Failed log as follows,
## Executing script at 80000000
load - load binary file from a filesystemUsage:
load <interface> [<dev[:part]> [<addr> [<filename> [bytes [pos]]]]]
- Load binary file filename from partition part on device
type interface instance dev to address addr in memory.
bytes gives the size to load in bytes.
If bytes is 0 or omitted, the file is read until the end.
pos gives the file byte position to start reading from.
If pos is 0 or omitted, the file is read from the start.
...
Bad Linux ARM64 Image magic!
SCRIPT FAILED: continuing...
Signed-off-by: Biwen Li <biwen.li@nxp.com>
[Updated description]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
We have encountered circumstances when a board design does not include
pull-up resistors on the external MDIO buses which are not used. This
leads to the MDIO data line not being pulled-up, thus the MDIO controller
will always see the line as busy.
Without a timeout in the MDIO bus driver, the execution is stuck in an
infinite loop when any access is initiated on that external bus.
Add a timeout in the driver so that we are protected in this
circumstance. This is similar to what is being done in the Linux
xgmac_mdio driver.
Signed-off-by: Ioana Ciornei <ioana.ciornei@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Madalin Bucur <madalin.bucur@oss.nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Although the status register is protected by the hardware write
protection, there is a hardware jumper to disable that hardware write
protection. Thus if a user would set this jumper any u-boot start would
disable the write protection altogether.
Circumvent that by not disabling the write protection in the first
place.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Provide an explicit configuration option to disable default "unlock all"
of any flash chip which supports locking. It doesn't make sense to
automatically unprotect the entire flash on each u-boot startup if the
block protection bits are actually used.
Traditionally, the unlock was there to be able to write to flash devices
which powered-up with the block protection bits set. Over time this
feature creeped into all flash devices which support locking.
For a more detailed description and discussion see:
https://lore.kernel.org/linux-mtd/20201203162959.29589-8-michael@walle.cc/
Keep things simple in u-boot and just provide a configration option to
disable this behavior which can be set per board.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Call mmc_of_parse() so that generic DT properties like 'non-removable'
are taken into account.
This fixes boot on Clearfog with eMMC on SOM that requires the
non-removable property.
Reported-by: Thorsten Spille <thorsten_spille@netcor.de>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
While the SPI controller speed is defined by DTS, the maximum
slave speed (connected devices) is limited by the pre-defined
configuration value CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED to 1MHz
This patch increases this maximum SPI slave device speed to 40MHz
Change-Id: I0d1239bd8a2061c66725c2c227c1e1f49c92c29e
Signed-off-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Reviewed-on: http://vgitil04.il.marvell.com:8080/59516
Tested-by: iSoC Platform CI <ykjenk@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
[pali: Set CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED via defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Testing has shown, that the quality of the PCIe signals and also the
stability of correct link establishment on the 2 PCIe ports is better,
when the deemphasis bit is set in the PCIe config register.
This needs to be done very early, even before the SERDES setup code is
run. This way, the first link will already be established with this
setup.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch changes the board specific "pcie" U-Boot command to not only
check for PCIe device existance but also for the correct link speed
and width that has been established. This cmd can be used by U-Boot
scripts for automated testing, if the PCIe setup is correct. Meaning,
that all PCIe devices are correctly detected and the link speed and
width is corrent.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch changes the PCI config routines in the Armada XP / 38x driver
to not allow access to the PCIe root ports.
While updating the Armada XP based theadorable to the latest mainline
and testing it with the DM PCI driver I noticed, that the PCI root
bridge was being configured incorrectly. Resulting in the PCIe Intel
WiFi was not working correctly in Linux. With this patch applied, all
PCIe devices work without any issues in Linux again.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Cc: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
On Espressobin board are MAC addresses stored in U-Boot env area. Therefore
they are not present in default_environment[] array constructed at compile
time.
This change puts permanent MAC addresses into default_environment[] array
at board runtime. Espressobin board has enabled DEFAULT_ENV_IS_RW option
and therefore can modify this array.
This change ensure that 'env default -a' does not delete permanent MAC
addresses from Espressobin env storage area.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
On Espressobin board value for $fdtfile cannot be determined at compile
time and is calculated at board runtime code. This change uses a new option
DEFAULT_ENV_IS_RW to allow modifying default_environment[] array at runtime
and set into it correct value.
This change also ensure that 'env default -a' set correct value to $fdtfile.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
This change allows board code to modify default_environment[] array when
compile option DEFAULT_ENV_IS_RW is specified in board config file.
Some board default variables depend on runtime configuration which is not
known at compile time. Therefore allow to set default_environment[] array
as non-const and allow board code to modify it when it is needed.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
The Beacon EmbeddedWorks kit is based on the R8A774E1 SoC also
known as the RZ/G2H.
The kit consists of a SOM + Baseboard and supports microSD,
eMMC, Ethernet, a couple celular radios, two CAN interfaces,
Bluetooth and WiFi. It shares much of the same design as
the RZ/G2M and RZ/G2N dev kits.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The Beacon EmbeddedWorks kit is based on the R8A774B1 SoC also
known as the RZ/G2N.
The kit consists of a SOM + Baseboard and supports microSD,
eMMC, Ethernet, a couple celular radios, two CAN interfaces,
Bluetooth and WiFi. It shares much of the same design as
the RZ/G2M dev kit.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
The versaclock doesn't have a driver yet, but there are a bunch
of device tree updates for the Beacon RZ/G2 boards that won't
compile without these. A driver is coming, so sync the bindings
for now
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
In case MMC has MBR system and fastboot writes GPT,
MMC is still recognized as MBR.
Invoke part_init() to purge cached data and update
information about partition table type.
Signed-off-by: Roman Stratiienko <r.stratiienko@gmail.com>
Add command oem bootbus which executes the command
``mmc bootbus <id> <arg>`` on the current fastboot mmc device
(<i> = CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV) to set the eMMC boot
configuration on first update, with
<arg> = boot_bus_width reset_boot_bus_width boot_mode
$> fastboot oem bootbus:<boot_bus_width> <reset_boot_bus_width> <boot_mode>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Add fastboot command oem partconf which executes the command
``mmc partconf <id> <arg> 0`` on the current <id> mmc device
to configure the eMMC boot partition with
<arg>: boot_ack boot_partition, so the command is:
$> fastboot oem partconf:<boot_ack> <boot_partition>
The partition_access argument is forced to 0 (userdata)
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
[lukma - Kconfig adjustments after merging this patch]
Update the code and the configs for eMMC boot and userdata
partitions acces
- FASTBOOT_MMC_BOOT_SUPPORT: boot partition 1 and 2 (erase/write)
- FASTBOOT_MMC_BOOT1_NAME: boot partition 1, default name="mmc0boot0"
- FASTBOOT_MMC_BOOT2_NAME: boot partition 2, default name="mmc0boot1"
This patch also removes the unnecessary dependency with
ARCH_MEDIATEK and EFI_PARTITION.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Split userdata and boot partition support for eMMC update
and correct the description (update is supported).
The new configuration CONFIG_FASTBOOT_MMC_USER_SUPPORT
allows to activate support of userdata partition update,
based on target name=CONFIG_FASTBOOT_MMC_USER_NAME
This patch also removes the unnecessary dependency with
ARCH_MEDIATEK and EFI_PARTITION.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
It is possible to implement fastboot_set_reboot_flag in a generic way
if BCB commands are turned on for a target. Using
bcb_set_reboot_reason allows to do this by simply passing string with
correct reboot reason that should be handled during next boot process.
If BCB are turned off, then bcb_set_reboot_reason would simply return
error, so it won't introduce any new behaviour for such targets.
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
This reverts commit 0ebf9842e5.
Current generic implementation of fastboot_set_reboot_flag is somewhat
messy and requires some additional configuration option to be enabled
besides CMD_BCB, so it reverts that implementtion in order to bring a
new cleaner one.
Next commit introduces new generic implementation of
fastboot_set_reboot_flag.
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
- introduces some standard sysinfo options as a source, e.g. to read
strapping pins to determine the board revision
- allows the U-Boot version number to be included
- allows the version number to be provided programmatically, e.g. to
support the build system adding information after U-Boot is built
While static configuration is useful it cannot cover every case. Sometimes
board revisions are encoded in resistor straps and must be read at
runtime.
The easiest way to provide this information is via sysinfo, since the
board can then provide a driver to read whatever is needed.
Add some standard sysinfo options for this, and use them to obtain the
required information.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
These ops are missing at present which is not permitted. Add an empty
operation struct.
Note: If the uclass requires operations then the drivers should provide
them. Otherwise, checking for missing operations must be done in every
uclass operation, so it adds to code size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the struct is not available unless SYSINFO is enabled. This is
annoying since code it is not possible to use compile-time checks like
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(SYSINFO) with this header.
Fix it by moving the #ifdef.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the version string is obtained from PLAIN_VERSION. Some boards
may want to configure this using the device tree, since the build system
can more easily insert things there after U-Boot itself is built. Add this
option to the code.
Also in some cases the version needs to be generated programmatically,
such as when it is stored elsewhere in the ROM and must be read first.
To handle this, keep a pointer around so that it can be updated later.
This works by storing the last string in the context, since it is easier
than passing out a little-used extra parameter.
Provide a function to update the version string.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a new member to the context struct which tracks the end of the string
table. This allows us to avoid recalculating this at the end.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
We can store this in the context and avoid passing it to each function.
This makes it easier to follow and will also allow keeping track of the
end of the string table (in future patches).
Add an 'eos' field to the context and create a function to set it up.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present we pass the ofnode to each function. We also pass the 'eos'
pointer for adding new strings. We don't track the current end of the
string table, so have smbios_string_table_len() to find that.
The code can be made more efficient if it keeps information in a
context struct. This also makes it easier to add more features.
As a first step, switch the ofnode parameter to be a context pointer.
Update smbios_add_prop() at the same time to avoid changing the same
lines of code in consecutive patches.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
We may as well include the U-Boot release information in the type-0 table
since it is designed for that purpose.
U-Boot uses release versions based on the year and month. The year cannot
fit in a byte, so drop the century.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present a few of the structs use u8 instead of char. This is a string,
so char is better. Update them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This type is not used outside the smbios.c file so there is no need for it
to be in the header file. Move it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
For SMBIOS we want to store the numeric version numbers in the tables. It
does not make sense to parse the strings. Instead, add new #defines with
the version and patchlevel.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There are quite a few available version options in U-Boot. Add a list of
the available Makefile variables and #defines, along with examples.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
- Sync DTS from Linux kernel for all K3 platforms
- Add MMC higher speed nodes for AM65x, J721e, J7200
- Convert Nokia RX-51 to use CONFIG_DM_MMC
- Minor fixes for LEGO MINDSTORMS
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc2
Bug fixes:
* do not allow creating of files with filenames on FAT file system
* install UEFI System Partition GUID on ESP handle
* in dtbdump.efi test tool use GUID to find ESP handle
Documentation:
* man-page for load command
* describe end of life of plat_auto
If the exception cannot be raised, the command returns.
Currently the return values are not all the same.
Remove the sub-chapter 'Return value'
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The Load File2 protocol exposes a device path with a VenMedia() node. Hence
our implementation of the device path to text protocol should support this
node.
Cc: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If dtbdump.efi is loaded from memory when calling LoadImage the loaded
image protocol will not indicate the partition from where it was loaded.
In this case use the EFI system partition for the 'load' and 'save'
commands.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On the handle for the UEFI System Partition we must install the System
Partition GUID (with a NULL interface).
Let the efidebug command display the GUID.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In the implementation of the EFI_DT_FIXUP_PROTOCOL:
* Only check the buffer size when EFI_DT_APPLY_FIXUPS is set.
* In this case the field totalsize of the device-tree may not exceed the
buffer size.
* Install device-tree only if EFI_DT_INSTALL_TABLE is set.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Sync all J7200 related v5.11-rc6 Linux kernel dts into U-Boot.
MCU R5F nodes are not yet added in Linux kernel yet but were added
in U-Boot. In order to avoid regressions, r5f nodes are kept intact.
These will be added in kernel in future.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Sync all J721e related v5.11-rc6 Linux kernel dts into U-Boot.
HBMC nodes are not yet added in Linux kernel yet but were added
in U-Boot. In order to avoid any regressions, hbmc nodes are kept
intact. These will be added in kernel in future.
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Add configs for voltage switching and UHS modes for the SD card
and HS200 for the eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
There's an issue with the base board in which the power cycle
circuit takes way longer to power down than expected by mmc core.
code. This prevents the card from enumerating in UHS modes.
Disable UHS modes for this board until a new board revision fixes
the issue.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add the appropriate itapdly and clkbuf-sel values required for
some lower speed modes.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add configs to support UHS modes for the SD card and HS200 for the eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add configs to support UHS modes for the SD card and HS200 for the eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add support for UHS modes by adding the regulators to power cycle
and voltage switch the card. Also add pinmuxes required for each
node
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Add support for regulators to power cycle and switch IO voltage to the
SD card. This enables support for UHS modes.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Because of fundamental interface issues in am65x pg1, only the
initial sdhci1 node at 25 MHz was added in the u-boot.dtsi
from which both the base-board.dts and r5-base-board.dts
inherit the node. Move the node out to k3-am65-main.dtsi
where it belongs and add the board specific properties
in base-board.dts and r5-base-board.dts
This ensures dts compatibility with the kernel dts in the
base-board.dts and enables the SD card interface at 50 MHz
and High Speed mode
While we are here, also fix the main_mmc0_pins_default
property to be included and inherit from the base-board.dts
instead of the u-boot.dtsi
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Use the generic sdhci_set_control_reg() instead of duplicating
in platform driver.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
According to the AM654x Data Manual[1], the setup timing in lower speed
modes can only be met if the controller uses a falling edge data launch.
To ensure this, the HIGH_SPEED_ENA (HOST_CONTROL[2]) bit should be
cleared in default speed, SD high speed, MMC high speed, SDR12 and SDR25
speed modes.
Use the sdhci writeb callback to implement this condition.
[1] http://www.ti.com/lit/gpn/am6546 Section 5.10.5.16.1
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
With the new SW tuning App note[1], a custom tuning algorithm is
required for eMMC HS200, HS400 and SD card UHS modes. The algorithm
involves running through the 32 possible input tap delay values and
sending the appropriate tuning command (CMD19/21) for each of them
to get a fail or pass result for each of the values. Typically, the
range will have a small contiguous failing window. Considering the
tuning range as a circular buffer, the algorithm then sets a final
tuned value directly opposite to the failing window.
[1] https://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spract9
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add support for writing new clock buffer select property for both
the am654x and j721e 4 bit IPs
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
DLL need only be enabled for speed modes and clock frequencies at or
above 50 MHz. For speed modes that don't enable the DLL, we need to
configure a static input delay value. This involves reading an optional
itap-del-sel-* value from the device tree and configuring it for the
appropriate speed mode.
Therefore, move all dll configurations to their own functions and gate it
with 50 MHz speed and a minimum mode. If both these conditions are not
satisfied then configure delay chain modes.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add Support for AM65x PG2.0. Use the SoC bus framework to fixup
the platform data and do DLL calibration if the revision is 1.0
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Not all controllers need calibration for the PHY DLL. Add a DLL_CALIB
flag to indicate the same.
Also move the write of trm_icp and driver strength to the set_clock()
function to match the kernel configuration flow.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
There are some speed modes that work without switching the dll on.
Unconditionally switch off the DLL before setting clock frequency to
support this case. The software will automatically enable DLL for speed
modes that require it. This also means the dll_on priv data member is no
longer required.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Add a set_voltage() function which handles the switch from 3.3V to 1.8V
for SD card UHS modes.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
With commit 38d6b7ebda ("spl: Drop bd_info in the data section") you
need to enable this option to boot from mmc.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The K3 R5F remoteproc driver in U-Boot was upstreamed prior to the
equivalent remoteproc driver in the Linux kernel. Some of the DT
properties used in U-Boot got upstreamed using different names
in Linux kernel.
The modified property names include the R5F cluster mode configuration
property "lockstep-mode"; and three different individual R5F core config
properties - "atcm-enable", "btcm-enable" and "loczrama". The property
names were updated as follows:
lockstep-mode => ti,cluster-mode
atcm-enable => ti,atcm-enable
btcm-enable => ti,btcm-enable
loczrama => ti,loczrama
Update the K3 R5F remoteproc driver, the corresponding binding, and
all the existing usage in AM65x, J721E and J7200 dts files all at
once to use the new properties and to not break any bisectability.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
AM65x SoC has two USB subsystems and their corresponding device tree nodes
have the same name but different path. While allocating sequence numbers
for these device tree nodes using alias, phandles can be used to
distinguish them.
Enable config for phandle check while getting sequence number to
distinguish the USB device tree nodes.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
This disables booting to non-Linux OSes.
This board is uncomfortably close to its 256K size limit, so every
few KB saved helps.
Signed-off-by: David Lechner <david@lechnology.com>
This disables the CONFIG_NET setting for LEGO MINDSTORMS EV3. This board
does not have any built-in networking, so it does not make sense to
enable this feature.
This also fixes the warning:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_ETH (Driver Model
for Ethernet drivers). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_ETH before the v2020.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Signed-off-by: David Lechner <david@lechnology.com>
This drops assigning bi_arch_number on LEGO MINDSTORMS EV3. This board
never had its own unique number and since we are using device tree,
we no longer need to pass an arch number to Linux.
Signed-off-by: David Lechner <david@lechnology.com>
This sets the serial# environmet variable instead of using ATAGs on
LEGO MINDSTORMS EV3.
Also fix some nomenclature while we are touching this code (Bluetooth
address is not the same as MAC address, EEPROM version is not the same
as board version).
Signed-off-by: David Lechner <david@lechnology.com>
Move twl4030_power_mmc_init() from board_mmc_power_init() to misc_init_r()
and disable CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F. Otherwise U-Boot cannot initialize MMC.
Also disable CONFIG_CMD_SLEEP CONFIG_DM_DEVICE_REMOVE CONFIG_MMC_VERBOSE to
free some space.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Add "zboot" command to the list of supported boot in the
label_boot function.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: add component tags in the summary]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Replace all the macro ifdef by IS_ENABLED.
All of these configs are set in the defconfig files and not in the
include board headers files.
Signed-off-by: Kory Maincent <kory.maincent@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: keep the preprocessor case unchanged]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Unfortunately the multi-core boot for QEMU x86 has been broken since
commit 77a5e2d3bc ("x86: mp_init: Set up the CPU numbers at the start").
In order to support QEMU x86 multi-core boot, the /cpus node must be
bound before any actual fix up in qemu_cpu_fixup(). This adds the
uclass_get() call to ensure this, just like what was done before.
Fixes: 77a5e2d3bc ("x86: mp_init: Set up the CPU numbers at the start")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The dm_spi_ops.xfer() API does not support dual and quad SPI modes. It
also doesn't allow the zynqmp_gqspi driver to calculate the correct
number of dummy cycles for some NOR ops (as doing so also requires the
buswidth).
Port the zynqmp_gqspi driver to spi_controller_mem_ops, which gives us
the buswidth values to correctly support all SNOR_PROTO_X_X_X commands
and to properly calculate dummy cycles.
Signed-off-by: Brandon Maier <brandon.maier@rockwellcollins.com>
CC: jagan@amarulasolutions.com
CC: michal.simek@xilinx.com
CC: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashokred@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The FAT32 File System Specification [1] requires leading and trailing
spaces as well as trailing periods of long names to be ignored.
[1]
Microsoft Extensible Firmware Initiative
FAT32 File System Specification
Version 1.03, December 6, 2000
Microsoft Corporation
https://www.win.tue.nl/~aeb/linux/fs/fat/fatgen103.pdf
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
sandbox_scmi_devices_ctx() may return NULL. We should not dereference this
value in sandbox_scmi_devices_remove().
The problem was indicated by 'gcc-11 -fanalyzer'.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
gcc -fanalyzer needs the information that a function does not return to
provide accurate information.
os_abort() does not return. Mark it accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are some calls to bdinfo_print_num_l() with parameters that
could be a 64-bit value on a 32-bit system. Change those calls to
use bdinfo_print_num_ll() instead.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we have bdinfo_print_num() to print unsigned long numbers.
We also have print_phys_addr() which accept numbers that might be
64-bit on a 32-bit platform.
Rename these 2 functions to be clearer:
bdinfo_print_num() => bdinfo_print_num_l()
print_phys_addr() => bdinfo_print_num_ll()
While we are here, make bdinfo_print_num_ll() public so that it can
be used outside cmd/bdinfo.c in the future.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
phys_addr_t and phys_size_t are currently defined as `unsigned long`,
but RV32 supports 34-bit physical address, hence both phys_addr_t and
phys_size_t should be defined to 64-bit using `unsigned long long`.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
At present prior_stage_fdt_address is declared as phys_addr_t. On
a 32-bit platform where phys_addr_t can be 64-bit, assigning its
value to gd->fdt_blob which is a pointer, can cause warnings.
Cast it to uintptr_t before the assignment.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
priv->iobase was declared as phys_addr_t which is now a 64-bit
address. In a 32-bit build, this causes the following warning
seen when building ftmac100.c:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Cast priv->iobase with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
addr was delcared as fdt_addr_t which is now a 64-bit address.
In a 32-bit build, this causes the following warning seen when
building ax25-ae350.c:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Cast addr with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
dev_read_addr() returns fdt_addr_t which is now a 64-bit address.
In a 32-bit build, this causes the following warning seen when
building serial_sifive.c:
warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size [-Wint-to-pointer-cast]
Cast the return value with uintptr_t.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
It's possible to have ram_top above 4 GiB in a 32-bit system, hence
we need to declare ram_top as `phys_addr_t`.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The min() macro used in dram_init_banksize() requires two elements
to compare have the same type. Let's explicitly cast gd->ram_top.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
When testing QEMU RISC-V 'virt' machine with a 2 GiB memory
configuration, it was discovered gd->ram_top is assigned to
value zero in setup_dest_addr().
While gd->ram_top should not be declared as type `unsigned long`,
which will be updated in a future patch, the current logic in
board_get_usable_ram_top() can be updated to cover both 64-bit
and 32-bit RISC-V.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Make mention of this feature in the core documentation so people can
discover it without looking at a header file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add another flag to the DM core which could be assigned to drivers and
which makes those drivers call their remove callbacks last, just before
booting OS and after all the other drivers finished with their remove
callbacks. This is necessary for things like clock drivers, where the
other drivers might depend on the clock driver in their remove callbacks.
Prime example is the mmc subsystem, which can reconfigure a card from HS
mode to slower modes in the remove callback and for that it needs to
reconfigure the controller clock.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if device_remove() decides that the device should not actually
be removed, it still calls the uclass pre_remove() method and powers the
device down.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the uclass pre-remove method is called before the children are
removed. But the children may refused to be removed, in whch case the
uclass is in a tricky situation. At present we handle this by calling
the uclass' post_probe() method. But it seems better to avoid doing
anything with the uclass in this case.
Switch the ordering so that we make sure the children can be removed
before advising the uclass.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This flag has the word 'REMOVE' in it which means it conflicts with
the DM_REMOVE flags. Rename it to DM_FLAG_LEAVE_PD_ON which seems to
indicate its purpose well enough.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This has no useful meaning in U-Boot and will never be returned. We want
to reserve this flag for internal driver model use.
Drop the code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This has no useful meaning in U-Boot. Use -ENOMEM since that appears to
be what has gone wrong in this case. We want to reserve this flag for
internal driver model use.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Directories or files called '.' or '..' cannot be created or written to
in any directory. Move the test to normalize_longname() to check this
early.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This patch involves no functional change. It is just about code
readability.
Both in file_fat_write_at() and fat_mkdir() the incoming file or directory
path are split into two parts: the parent directory and the base name.
In file_fat_write_at() the value of the variable basename is assigned to
the filename parameter and afterwards the variable filename is used instead
of basename. It is more readable to use the variable basename and leave
filename unchanged.
In fat_mkdir() the base name variable is called directory. This is
confusing. Call it basename like in file_fat_write_at(). This allows to
rename parameter new_directory to directory in the implementation of
fat_mkdir() to match the function declaration.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this out of the common header and include it only where needed. In
a number of cases this requires adding "struct udevice;" to avoid adding
another large header or in other cases replacing / adding missing header
files that had been pulled in, very indirectly. Finally, we have a few
cases where we did not need to include <asm/global_data.h> at all, so
remove that include.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Commit dd5c954e91 ("travis/gitlab/azure: Use -W to avoid warnings check")
added -W to avoid warnings check, but it mistakenly dropped -E for
the world build script in the azure pipelines.
This caused builds on the azure pipelines fail to report warnings. Let's
add it back.
Fixes: dd5c954e91 ("travis/gitlab/azure: Use -W to avoid warnings check")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The implementation of pytest_runtest_protocol() must call
pytest_runtest_logstart() and pytest_runtest_logfinish(). This appears to
be necessary even in pytest 5.2.1 judging by the default version of
pytest_runtest_protocol(), but evidently some form of code reorganization
in pytest only made this have a practical effect in the newer version. I'd
previously been under the impression that 100% of the required work of
pytest_runtest_protocol() was handled by the fact it called
runtestprotocol() as its implementation. However, it appears that custom
implementations do need to do a little more than this.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@wwwdotorg.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Config allows to disable printing contents of fitImage to optimize boottime.
Signed-off-by: Ravik Hasija <rahasij@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The load command should not silently return to the console prompt if an
invalid block device is specified and no file is loaded.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
No version information is used in armv8/fwcall.c therefore do not include
version.h header file. This change prevents recompiling fwcall.o when
SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH changes.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Fix CMD_ACPI dependency in Kconfig
- Correct overflow in __udelay() in TSC timer driver
- Add a devicetree node for eMMC for Coral
- Minor improvements on image loading
- Reduce size of Samus image
With the recent addition of ACPI generation, the image size has got beyond
its current limit.
Samus does not actually use this, nor x86 emulation for PCI ROMs, so
disable both features.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Enhance the debugging to show the next stage being booted as well as a
dump of the start of the image.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This should be done even if not using TPL, since BSS may be in use or
boards that only use SPL. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present if the command line is very long it is truncated by the
printf() statement, which works within a limited buffer. Use puts()
instead. Also show better debugging with the command-line setup
fails.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present it is possible to dump an image within the zimage command, but
it is also useful to be able to dump it from elsewhere, for example in a
loader that has special handling for the different zimage stages.
Export this feature as a new function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The Global Non-Volatile Storage struct has some fields with particular
meanings. Rename these to make things easier to follow. Also add a few
more boot flags.
GNVS should not be confused with GNVQ (Going Nowhere Very Quickly).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present BSS is always placed in SDRAM. If a separate BSS is not in use
this means that BSS doesn't work as expected. Make the setting conditional
on the SEPARATE_BSS option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The part of U-Boot that actually ends up in u-boot-nodtb.bin is not built
with any particular alignment. It ends at the start of the BSS section.
The BSS section selects its own alignment, which may larger.
This means that there can be a gap of a few bytes between the image
ending and BSS starting.
Since u-boot.bin is build by joining u-boot-nodtb.bin and u-boot.dtb (with
perhaps some padding for BSS), the expected result is not obtained. U-Boot
uses the end of BSS to find the devicetree, so this means that it cannot
be found.
Add 32-byte alignment of BSS so that the image size is correct and
appending the devicetree will place it at the end of BSS.
Example SPL output without this patch:
Sections:
Idx Name Size VMA LMA File off Algn
0 .text 000142a1 fef40000 fef40000 00001000 2**4
CONTENTS, ALLOC, LOAD, RELOC, READONLY, CODE
1 .u_boot_list 000014a4 fef542a8 fef542a8 000152a8 2**3
CONTENTS, ALLOC, LOAD, RELOC, DATA
2 .rodata 0000599c fef55760 fef55760 00016760 2**5
CONTENTS, ALLOC, LOAD, RELOC, READONLY, DATA
3 .data 00000970 fef5b100 fef5b100 0001c100 2**5
CONTENTS, ALLOC, LOAD, RELOC, DATA
4 .binman_sym_table 00000020 fef5ba70 fef5ba70 0001ca70 2**2
CONTENTS, ALLOC, LOAD, DATA
5 .bss 00000060 fef5baa0 fef5baa0 00000000 2**5
ALLOC
You can see that .bss is aligned to 2**5 (32 bytes). This is because of
the mallinfo struct in dlmalloc.c:
17 .bss.current_mallinfo 00000028 00000000 00000000 000004c0 2**5
ALLOC
In this case the size of u-boot-spl-nodtb.bin is 0x1ba90. This matches up
with the _image_binary_end symbol:
fef5ba90 g .binman_sym_table 00000000 _image_binary_end
But BSS starts 16 bytes later, at 0xfef5baa0, due to the 32-byte
alignment. So we must align _image_binary_end to a 32-byte boundary. This
forces the binary size to be 0x1baa0, i.e. ending at the start of bss, as
expected.
Note that gcc reports __BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT__ of 16 on this build, even
though it generates an object file with a member that requests 32-byte
alignment.
The current_mallinfo struct is 40 bytes in size. Increasing the struct to
68 bytes (i.e. just above a 64-byte boundary) does not cause the alignment
to go above 32 bytes. So it seems that 32 bytes is the maximum alignment
at present.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: add more details in the commit message to help people understand]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Move to log_debug() and make use of the new SPL function to find the
text base.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is useful to know the TEXT_BASE value for the image being loaded in
TPL/SPL. Add a new spl_get_image_text_base() function to handle this.
Make use of this in the x86 SPL handler, instead of having the logic
there.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Use a driver name in line with the compatible string so that of-platdata
can use this driver.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some comments were provided after this patch was applied. Address them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present long delays such as msleep(2000) can cause an overflow in this
function. There is no need for this, since it already uses a 64-bit int.
Add a cast to correct this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Trying to compile qemu-x86_64_defconfig with CONFIG_CMD_ACPI=y and
CONFIG_ACPIGEN=n fails with
ld.bfd: cmd/built-in.o: in function `do_acpi_items':
cmd/acpi.c:162: undefined reference to `acpi_dump_items'
Add the missing configuration dependency.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is useless and misleading to print the ret variable that is not set
by the dev_read_addr routine. Also, move the '\n' character after the
round bracket that contains the error code.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The pinmux choice for the RMII/RGMII pins the EMAC is connected to is
not dependent on the EMAC IP, but on the SoC it is integrated in.
Deriving the pinmux from the DT compatible string (as we do at the
moment) will thus cause problems with certain EMAC IP / SoC combinations.
To avoid this exact issue with the H616, let's use our Kconfig MACH
symbols to choose the correct pinmux setup.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
At the moment we only consider the EPHY register for those SoCs were
we actually have an internal PHY to configure. However even other SoCs
have this register, an expect the EPHY select bit to be cleared for
proper operation with an external PHY.
Rework sun8i_emac_set_syscon_ephy() to be called regardless of the EMAC
model, and clear the H3_EPHY_SELECT bit if no internal PHY is used.
We get away without it so far because SoCs like the A64 clear this bit
on reset, but we need to explicitly clear it on the H616, for instance.
The Linux driver does so as well.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Change to use wMaxPacketSize of current speed EP desc for request
length wrap up.
Reviewed-by: Peter Chen <peter.chen@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
If one of functions is not super speed capable, we need force the udc
to be high speed, this is an equivalent implementation of
usb_gadget_udc_set_speed() in kernel but simple, which set the gadget
max_speed to be high speed, so afterwards when start gadget duc can
set the HW to be USB 2.0 mode.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Chen <peter.chen@nxp.com>
Tested-by: faqiang.zhu <faqiang.zhu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This patch is to add usb gadget super speed support in common
driver, including BOS descriptor and select the super speed
descriptor from function driver.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Chen <peter.chen@nxp.com>
Tested-by: faqiang.zhu <faqiang.zhu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Always use the new added config for os_desc_config to fix cdev->
os_desc_config may miss set in case we restart usb gadget driver.
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The current way to set cdev->os_desc_config is wrong if user restart
fastboot, as the old config is not used anymore and new allocated
usb_configuration will be used, so set the os_desc_config while
usb_add_config.
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peter Chen <peter.chen@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add device interface GUID for Microsoft Extended Properties Feature
Descriptor.
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This is a proting patch from linux kernel: 37a3a533429e
("usb: gadget: OS Feature Descriptors support"), the original commit
log see below:
There is a custom (non-USB IF) extension to the USB standard:
http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/windows/hardware/gg463182
They grant permission to use the specification - there is
"Microsoft OS Descriptor Specification License Agreement"
under the link mentioned above, and its Section 2 "Grant
of License", letter (b) reads:
"Patent license. Microsoft hereby grants to You a nonexclusive,
royalty-free, nontransferable, worldwide license under Microsoft鈥檚
patents embodied solely within the Specification and that are owned
or licensable by Microsoft to make, use, import, offer to sell,
sell and distribute directly or indirectly to Your Licensees Your
Implementation. You may sublicense this patent license to Your
Licensees under the same terms and conditions."
The said extension is maintained by Microsoft for Microsoft.
Yet it is fairly common for various devices to use it, and a
popular proprietary operating system expects devices to provide
"OS descriptors", so Linux-based USB gadgets whishing to be able
to talk to a variety of operating systems should be able to provide
the "OS descriptors".
This patch adds optional support for gadgets whishing to expose
the so called "OS Feature Descriptors", that is "Extended Compatibility ID"
and "Extended Properties".
Hosts which do request "OS descriptors" from gadgets do so during
the enumeration phase and before the configuration is set with
SET_CONFIGURATION. What is more, those hosts never ask for configurations
at indices other than 0. Therefore, gadgets whishing to provide
"OS descriptors" must designate one configuration to be used with
this kind of hosts - this is what os_desc_config is added for in
struct usb_composite_dev. There is an additional advantage to it:
if a gadget provides "OS descriptors" and designates one configuration
to be used with such non-USB-compliant hosts it can invoke
"usb_add_config" in any order because the designated configuration
will be reported to be at index 0 anyway.
This patch also adds handling vendor-specific requests addressed
at device or interface and related to handling "OS descriptors"."
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
As other users may use utf8_to_utf16le() to convert the utf8
to utf16 for usb, so move it to head file.
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This is a porting patch from linux kernel: 19824d5eeece
("usb: gadget: OS String support"), original commit log
see below:
"There is a custom (non-USB IF) extension to the USB standard:
http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/windows/hardware/gg463182
They grant permission to use the specification - there is
"Microsoft OS Descriptor Specification License Agreement"
under the link mentioned above, and its Section 2 "Grant
of License", letter (b) reads:
"Patent license. Microsoft hereby grants to You a nonexclusive,
royalty-free, nontransferable, worldwide license under Microsoft鈥檚
patents embodied solely within the Specification and that are owned
or licensable by Microsoft to make, use, import, offer to sell,
sell and distribute directly or indirectly to Your Licensees Your
Implementation. You may sublicense this patent license to Your
Licensees under the same terms and conditions."
The said extension is maintained by Microsoft for Microsoft.
Yet it is fairly common for various devices to use it, and a
popular proprietary operating system expects devices to provide
"OS descriptors", so Linux-based USB gadgets whishing to be able
to talk to a variety of operating systems should be able to provide
the "OS descriptors".
This patch adds optional support for gadgets whishing to expose
the so called "OS String" under index 0xEE of language 0.
The contents of the string is generated based on the qw_sign
array and b_vendor_code.
Interested gadgets need to set the cdev->use_os_string flag,
fill cdev->qw_sign with appropriate values and fill cdev->b_vendor_code
with a value of their choice.
This patch does not however implement responding to any vendor-specific
USB requests."
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
As the SDP protocol use the predefined ep num for communication, we can't
change its name hence reset its ep num while do ep autoconfig, this is
only apply for SPL.
Signed-off-by: Li Jun <jun.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since some new fields in usb_ep structure been moved to usb_ss_ep.
The CDNS3 gadget driver should replies on this operation to bind the
usb_ss_ep with the endpoint descriptor when function layer uses
usb_ep_autoconfig to add endpoint descriptors to gadget. So that
CDNS3 driver can know the EP information and configure the EP once
the set configuration request is received.
Signed-off-by: Sherry Sun <sherry.sun@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Each array is used only in one file (core.c or ep0.c). Move their content
to correct file, mark them as static and do not export out of current file.
This change allows to decrease size of u-boot.bin as more of those strings
are not used.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reinitialize dfu_env_entities after flashing the 'SCRIPT' entity to
ensure that the potential changes to the 'dfu_alt_info' environment
variable are applied.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reinitialize DFU USB gadget after flashing the 'SCRIPT' entity to ensure
that the potential changes to the 'dfu_alt_info' environment variable are
applied.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
[lukma - I've moved the bool retry to avoid build (CI) errors]
Define a new 'SCRIPT' type for DFU entities. The downloaded data are
treated as simple u-boot's scripts and executed with run_command_list()
function.
Flashing the 'SCRIPT' entity might result in changing the 'dfu_alt_info'
environment variable from the flashed script, so add a global variable
for tracking the potential need to reinitialize the dfu_alt_info related
structures.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Define a new 'SKIP' type for the DFU entities. The flashed data for that
entity is simply ignored without returning any error values.
This allows to have one flashing procedure and images for the different
board types or variants, where each board uses only the images relevant
to it and skips the rest. This is especially usefull for the THOR
protocol, which usually transfers more than one file in a single session.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
[mszyprow: rephrased commit message and docs for easier reading, changed
subject to "dfu: add 'SKIP' entity"]
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Use the default MMC device set in the command line if entity specifies it
as -1. This allows to use the same dfu_alt_info string for different MMC
devices (like embedded eMMC and external SD card if data layout is the
same on both devices).
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Show the interface name (i.e. 'mmc') in the information string to ease
user checking which device is exported via USB Mass Storage protocol.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
In case of usb_add_function() failure the error path has an issue,
i.e the global pointer variable is assigned to garbage
Fix the above mentioned issue by assigning pointer to NULL.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
In case of usb_add_function() failure the error path has two issues:
- the potentially allocated structure isn't getting freed
- the global pointer variable is assigned to garbage
Fix the above mentioned issues by freeing memory and assigning NULL.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
On request/suggestion from Simon Glass back in May 22 2019 [1], the
'strsep' mechanism implemented in bcb_set() was set to work directly
with user-provided argv strings, to avoid duplicating memory and for
the sake of simpler implementation.
However, since we recently exposed bcb_write_reboot_reason() API to be
called by U-Boot fastboot, the idea is to be able to pass const string
literals to this new BCB API, carrying the reboot reason.
Since 'strsep' (just like its older/superseded sibling 'strtok')
modifies the input string passed as parameter, BCB command in its
current state would attempt to perform in-place modifications in a
readonly string, which might lead to unexpected results.
Fix the above with the cost of one dynamic memory allocation ('strdup').
This will also ensure no compiler warnings when passing string literals
to bcb_write_reboot_reason().
[1] http://u-boot.10912.n7.nabble.com/PATCH-v2-0-2-Add-bcb-command-to-read-modify-write-Android-BCB-td369934i20.html#a370456
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Eugeniu Rosca <erosca@de.adit-jv.com>
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
Enriching the functionality of U-Boot 'bcb' may assume using the
existing sub-commands as building blocks for the next ones.
A clean way to achive the above is to expose a number of static
routines, each mapped to an existing user command (e.g. load/set/store),
with a user/caller-friendly prototype (i.e. do not force the caller
to wrap an integer into a string).
This third patch makes '__bcb_store' available for internal needs.
No functional change intended.
Signed-off-by: Eugeniu Rosca <erosca@de.adit-jv.com>
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
Enriching the functionality of U-Boot 'bcb' may assume using the
existing sub-commands as building blocks for the next ones.
A clean way to achive the above is to expose a number of static
routines, each mapped to an existing user command (e.g. load/set/store),
with a user/caller-friendly prototype (i.e. do not force the caller
to wrap an integer into a string).
This second patch makes '__bcb_set' available for internal needs.
No functional change intended.
Signed-off-by: Eugeniu Rosca <erosca@de.adit-jv.com>
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
Enriching the functionality of U-Boot 'bcb' may assume using the
existing sub-commands as building blocks for the next ones.
A clean way to achive the above is to expose a number of static
routines, each mapped to an existing user command (e.g. load/set/store),
with a user/caller-friendly prototype (i.e. do not force the caller
to wrap an integer into a string).
This first patch makes '__bcb_load' available for internal needs.
No functional change, except for a tiny update in error handling.
Signed-off-by: Eugeniu Rosca <erosca@de.adit-jv.com>
Signed-off-by: Roman Kovalivskyi <roman.kovalivskyi@globallogic.com>
Casting 32bit int value directly into 64bit unsigned type causes
wrong value for file size equal or larger than 2GB. Fix the wrong
file size by casting uint32_t first.
Fixes: commit 1fe9ae76b1 ("gadget: f_thor: update to support more than 4GB file as thor 5.0")
Reported-by: Junghoon Kim <jhoon20.kim@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Seung-Woo Kim <sw0312.kim@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
For UBI partitions ("partubi" in dfu_alt_info), dfu_fill_entity_mtd sets
the mtd.ubi flag; however other functions incorrectly check for nand.ubi
instead. Fix this by checking for the correct flag.
Signed-off-by: Guillermo Rodriguez <guille.rodriguez@gmail.com>
Cc: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
The R-Car3 SDHI should set these two bits in DMA_MODE register according
to the specification, to indicate 64bit bus width. No other bus width
options are permitted and the default value is 0, which is incorrect.
Set the bits accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
DTS files apart from r8a774a1-hihope-rzg2m-u-boot.dts and
r8a774a1-u-boot.dtsi have been imported from linux 5.10
commit 2c85ebc57b3e1817 ("Linux 5.10").
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Commands like 'fatinfo' call dev_print() to print device information. If
the block device is created via 'host bind', we should print accurate
information.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide information about host backed block device.
Mark the device created by 'host bind' as removable.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The auto_alloc_size members of struct driver has been renamed auto.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Re-send because of line-wraps.
Without this patch, u-boot just hangs if the fdt pointer is
not initialized. The diagnostic subsystems are not yet initialized,
so all you get is a blind hang.
Signed-off-by: Stanislav.Pinchuk@kaspersky.com
The UEFI Self Certification Test (SCT) checks the SetTime() service with
the following steps:
* set date
* reset
* check date matches
To be compliant the sandbox should keep the offset to the host RTC during
resets. The implementation uses the environment variable
UBOOT_SB_TIME_OFFSET to persist the offset.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Libraries that link with U-Boot typically may expect to be able to include
ctype.h but this file is in a different place in U-Boot. Add a symlink to
make this work.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function uses the old format for reading hashes. Add
support for the current format.
Add a test while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The use of pinctrl in the core of driver model is useful but can provoke
some strange behaviour. Add a comment to aid debugging.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current driver name does not match its compatible string, so
of-platdata does not work correctly. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if these calls are used with of-platdata, a confusing error is
produced, referring to a function not actually called by the code causing
the problem.
Fix this by not inlining, so that the error mentions the dev_read_...()
function and it is more obvious what is going on.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These cannot work with of-platdata since they currently need the
devicetree at runtime. Disable the emulators and the sandbox I2C driver
that needs them. We can enable these later, if needed for testing.
Switch the of_plat_parent test over to use a simple bus instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Update the devicetree so that the TPM and RTC can be used in SPL. Also
enable the pins used for getting the memory configuration settings while
we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current help talks about relocation which doesn't apply to SPL and
TPL. Update it to avoid confusion.
Also make the TPL size default to the same as the SPL size, since this is
more likely to be a useful value than the one used by U-Boot proper, which
may be quite a bit larger.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The EC can store small amounts of data for the benefit of the
verified boot process. Since the EC is seldom reset, this can allow the
AP to store data that survives a reboot or a suspend/resume cycle.
Add support for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On x86 platforms the EC provides a way to read 'switches', which are
on/off values determined by the EC.
Add a new driver method for this and implement it for LPC.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This should not happen in normal operation, but the EC might have a bug,
so add a run-time check just in case.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Allow a longer time for the EC to reboot. Also use a constant for the
hash delay time, so it is clear what it is for.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is used several times in this file. Put it in a function to avoid
code duplication.
Also add a test for this function. There are no cros_ec tests at present,
so it is time to update the code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The offset of an entry needs to be adjusted by its skip-at-start value.
This is currently missing when reading entry data. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When packing files it is sometimes useful to align the start of each file,
e.g. if the flash driver can only access 32-bit-aligned data. Provides a
new property to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if a devicetree blob is included in a vblock it does not deal
with updates. This is because the vblock is created once at the start and
does not have a method to update itself later, after all the entry
contents are finalised.
Fix this by adjusting how the vblock is created.
Also simplify Image.ProcessEntryContents() since it effectively duplicates
the code in Section.ProcessContents().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Normally when an entry is created, any entry arguments it has are required
to be provided, so it can actually generate its contents correctly.
However when an existing image is read, Entry objects are created for each
of the entries in the image. This happens as part of the process of
reading the image into binman.
In this case we don't need the entry arguments, since we do not intend to
regenerate the entries, or at least not unless requested. So there is no
sense in reporting an error for missing entry arguments.
Add a new property for the Image to handle this case. Update the error
reporting to be conditional on this property.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present binman only supports resolving symbols in the same section as
the binary that uses it. This is quite limited because we often need to
group entries into different sections.
Enhance the algorithm to search the entire image for symbols.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present on large files, lz4 uses a larger block size (e.g. 256KB) than
the 64KB supported by the U-Boot decompression implementation. Also it is
optimised for maximum compression speed, producing larger output than we
would like.
Update the parameters to correct these problems.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable this option so that the boot-script substitutions of %U works as
expected. With this, it can boot into Chrome OS.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the TPM description to include the interrupt mechanicm since this
is useful to know. Also add a warning if the TPM cannot be found and a
debug line if it succeeds.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When the Cr50 starts up it doesn't have a valid locality. The driver sets
it to -1 to indicate that. Tracking this allows cr50_i2c_cleanup() to
avoid releasing a locality that was not claimed.
However the helper functions that generate the flags use a u8 type which
cannot support -1, so they return a locality of 0xff.
Fix this by updating the type. With this, 'tpm startup TPM2_SU_CLEAR'
works as expected.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc1-4
Bug fixes:
* re-read the partition table after writing GPT
* fix a problem booting ARMv7 boards with PSCI without UEFI
* make aarch64 UEFI test programs compatible with GRUB linux command
* correct the alignment check in the EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL
* check EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL.Media->LastBlock in unit test
Add the Linux magic to the EFI file header to allow running our test
programs with GRUB's linux command. Now we can dump the fixed-up device
tree with our dtbdump.efi tool.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Some ARMv7 boards using PSCI require to be in secure-mode when booted via
'bootz' or 'bootm'. During distro-boot 'bootefi bootmgr' is called to check
if booting via UEFI is possible.
With the change we change the switch from secure mode to non-secure mode is
moved from the UEFI subsystem setup to just before calling StartImage().
Cc: Jernej Škrabec <jernej.skrabec@gmail.com>
Reported by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If the field Media->IoAlign of the EFI block IO protocol is zero, no
alignment is required. Our code required 4 GiB alignment in this case.
Don't check buffer alignment if Media->IoAlign == 0.
Fixes: f59f0825e8 ("efi_loader: parameter checks BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The field Media->LastBlock of the EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL must be filled
with the index of the last logical block (LBA) for the block device that
our test driver provides.
After calling ConnectController() U-Boot exposes the block IO protocol for
the partition check that the value of Media->LastBlock equals the partition
size minus one.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Excluding ut str in test/cmd_ut.c but compiling test/str_ut.c results in
failure of the Python test invoking the C unit tests as observed on
sipeed_riscv_smode_defconfig:
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_str_upper]
Allow to compile test/str_ut.c on all boards.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Excluding ut bootm in test/cmd_ut.c but compiling test/bootm.c results in
failure of the Python test invoking the C unit tests as observed on
sipeed_riscv_smode_defconfig:
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_nop]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_nospace]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_silent]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_silent_var]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_subst]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_subst_both]
FAILED test/py/tests/test_ut.py::test_ut[ut_bootm_subst_var]
Only compile test/bootm.c on the sandbox.
Fixes: f158ba15ee ("bootm: Add tests for fixup_silent_linux()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As noted in comments, yield_fixture has been deprecated for longer than
our minimum required version of pytest. Newer versions of pytest cause
this to be a louder warning, and as the migration is trivial, perform it
now.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
With Pytest 6.0.2 'make tests' fails:
sandbox: Traceback (most recent call last):
File "./test/py/test.py", line 20, in <module>
sys.exit(load_entry_point('pytest', 'console_scripts', 'pytest')(args))
TypeError: console_main() takes 0 positional arguments but 1 was given
The definition of console_scripts has changed as follows:
Pytest 4.6.1:
[options.entry_points]
console_scripts =
pytest=pytest:main
py.test=pytest:main
Pytest 6.0.2:
[options.entry_points]
console_scripts =
pytest=pytest:console_main
py.test=pytest:console_main
The new function console_main() has a comment:
"This function is not meant for programmable use; use `main()`"
Hence let's call pytest.main() directly.
Move args processing into the __main__ paragraph.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Tested-by: Andy Shevchenko <andy.shevchenko@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Compiling wandboard_defconfig with CONFIG_UT_LOG=y leads to a build error:
test/log/pr_cont_test.c: In function ‘log_test_pr_cont’:
test/log/pr_cont_test.c:28:14: error:
‘gd_t’ {aka ‘volatile struct global_data’} has no member named ‘log_fmt’
log_fmt = gd->log_fmt;
We do not want to let CONFIG_UT_LOG depend on CONFIG_LOG=y because we have
tests for logging functions called with CONFIG_LOG=n.
Fix the build dependency.
Reported-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Since commit 565a4147d1 ("fs: btrfs: Add more checksum algorithms")
btrfs uses the sha256 checksum algorithm. But Kconfig lacks to select
it. This leads to compilation errors:
fs/built-in.o: In function `hash_sha256':
fs/btrfs/crypto/hash.c:25: undefined reference to `sha256_starts'
fs/btrfs/crypto/hash.c:26: undefined reference to `sha256_update'
fs/btrfs/crypto/hash.c:27: undefined reference to `sha256_finish'
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
When copying short name plus extension refer to the encapsulating structure
and not to the short name element.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Re-send because of line-wraps.
This patch fixes the behaviour of the menuconfig's BOOTCOMMAND
setting. Which is just ignored without that patch on
vexpress_aemv8a platform.
Signed-off-by: Stanislav.Pinchuk@kaspersky.com
1. Enable MTK SPI NOR controller driver on mt7622 & mt7629.
2. Enable quad mode for read and single mode for write.
Signed-off-by: SkyLake.Huang <skylake.huang@mediatek.com>
This patch adds support for MTK SPI NOR controller, which you
can see on mt7622 & mt7629.
1. This controller is designed only for SPI NOR. We can't adjust
its bus clock dynamically. Set clock in dts instead.
2. This controller only supports 1-1-1 write mode.
3. Remove mtk_snor_match_read() since upper SPI-MEM layer already
handles command.
4. sf read/write/update commands are tested with this driver.
Signed-off-by: SkyLake.Huang <skylake.huang@mediatek.com>
This is a basic driver for the ultra-low-power Abracon AB x80x series
of RTC chips. It supports in particular, the supersets AB0805 and AB1805.
It allows reading and writing the time, and enables the supercapacitor or
battery charger.
Signed-off-by: Ying-Chun Liu (PaulLiu) <paul.liu@linaro.org>
If both stop key and delay key are empty, the length of these
keys is 0. The subtraction operation will cause the u_int type
variable to overflow, will cause illegal memory access in key
input loop.
This commit fixes this bug by using int type instead of u_init.
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Some images may have multiple copies of the same thing, e.g. two versions
of the read/write U-Boots. It is necessary to read data from one or other
of these under selection of the verified-boot logic. Add a function to
select the subnode to use.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this logic out of the main init function so it is available for
other purpose.
Use a different error when multiple-images is in use but no subnode is
available. This makes it easier to determine what is wrong.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Unfortunately the toolchain often brings in the crc32 table even if the
function is not actually used. For now, exclude it from the TPL build,
which is very sensitive to size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Set this flag so that it is available to those looking at the device. For
non-removable devices there is no need to check for insertion/removable
since the media can never change.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
At present if an eMMC part is in the system, the ACPI table generated
will include information about that, as well as the SD card. We only need
to include the SD card, since it has a card-detect GPIO. Use a different
compatible string for each option, and add code only for the SD card.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
This macro is the length of the string but excludes the terminator. Users
must add 1 when declaring a large-enough string. Add a comment to make
this clear.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this code uses a simple printf() format if running in SPL. But
SPL can use the full printf. Use USE_TINY_PRINTF instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This includes information about sandbox which is not relevant for most
boards. Drop it.
Also add the address to help figure out the problem.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function may be used in SPL where devicetree is not available.
Use the correct macro so that the function does not try to read it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In some cases so much of the framebuffer is updated that it is not worth
copying the changes piece by piece to the copy framebuffer. Add a function
to copy the whole thing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add tag names for recently added types.
Fixes: d2cb7a22da (x86: Allow putting some tables in the bloblist)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Typically in TPL/SPL the bloblist is quite small. But U-Boot proper may
want to add a lot more to it, such as ACPI tables.
Add a way to expand the bloblist by relocating it in U-Boot proper, along
with the other relocation activities.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is useful to be able to figure out which phase we are loading next and
which phase we came from. Add some functions to handle this as well as
returning the name of a phase. This allows messages like "Booting to x"
where x is the next phase.
At present, TPL says 'Jumping to U-Boot' at the end, when in fact it is
jumping to SPL. This is confusing, so use the new functions to correct
this.
Tests for this will come with an upcoming minor SPL test refactor.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the function rsa_verify_hash, if the "main" key doesn't
work, u-boot try others keys. But it searches those keys
in the FIT image instead of the u-boot device tree.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch completely removes CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY from the PCI code as
it is not configured for any board (any more). With this removal, some
PCI related files get cleaned up a bit.
Additional, dm_pciauto_setup_device() is now static, as it's not
referenced from any code outside of this C file.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In fit_config_verify_sig(), when no 'signature*' subnode exists in
the configuration node, the fdt_for_each_subnode() loop is a no-op.
Therefore, no error flags are set, and 'err_,sg' is not populated
with an error string. This is incorrect behavior.
Populate err_msg to indicate that no 'signature' is found, before
entering the loop. The first call to fit_image_verify_sig() will
override clear err_msg, or set it to a more specific message.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed ARM_SMCCC_FAST_CALL value is shifted to 31'st bit. Then, it is expanded
to 64 bit value, which results in 1s in higher 32 bits.
This causes corrupted values in 64-bit SMC IDs and issues in buggy handlers of
32-bit calls.
We need to make ARM_SMCCC_FAST_CALL unsigned long, so it would work properly
on 32 bit architectures.
Signed-off-by: Volodymyr Babchuk <volodymyr_babchuk@epam.com>
Reviewed-by: Jens Wiklander <jens.wiklander@linaro.org>
Macro 'cmd_objcopy_uboot' currently does not work with passed empty command
expanded from 'cmd_static_rela' and therefore dummy command 'true' is set
in 'cmd_static_rela' to workaround this issue.
Eliminate it now by fixing 'cmd_objcopy_uboot' macro to work also with
empty 'cmd_static_rela' macro and remove useless invocation of command
'true'.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Espressobin: Disable slot when emmc is not present (Pali)
- DS414; config header cleanup (Phil)
- PCI: auto-config enhancement (Phil)
- pci_mvebu: Also map IO region (Phil)
- serial: a3720: Implement pending method for output direction (Pali)
- turris_mox: Enable a few commands (Marek)
- helios4 & ClearFog changes (Dennis)
- Plus some minor misc changes
Pull request for documentation tag doc-2021-04-rc1-3
Update the build system for the HTML documentation to allow using
Sphinx 3.
Man-page for exception command.
This adds support for specifying FDT overlays in an extlinux/pxelinux
configuration file.
Without this, there is no simple way to apply overlays when the kernel
and fdt is loaded by the pxe command.
This change adds the 'fdtoverlays' keyword for a label, supporting multiple
overlay files to be applied on top of the fdt specified in the 'fdt' or
'devicetree' keyword.
Example:
label linux
kernel /Image
fdt /soc-board.dtb
fdtoverlays /soc-board-function.dtbo
append console=ttyS0,115200 root=/dev/mmcblk0p2 rootwait
This code makes usage of a new variable called fdtoverlay_addr_r used to load
the overlay files without overwritting anything important.
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Cc: Jernej Škrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Cc: Jonas Karlman <jonas@kwiboo.se>
Tested-by: Jernej Škrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Škrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The phydev structure has a PHY OF node pointer in it, use that OF node
first when looking up PHY OF node properties, since that is likely the
correct PHY OF node pointer. If the pointer is not valid, which is the
case e.g. on legacy DTs, fall back to parsing MAC ethernet-phy subnode.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Cc: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add some missing address translations from virtual address in local DRAM
to physical address, which is needed for the DMA transactions to work
correctly.
This issue was detected while testing the e1000 driver on the MIPS
Octeon III platform, which needs address translation.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Using (dm_)pci_virt_to_mem() is incorrect to translate the virtual
address in local DRAM to a physical address. The correct macro here
is virt_to_phys() so switch to using this macro.
As virt_to_bus() is now not used any more, this patch also removes
both definitions (DM and non-DM).
This issue was detected while testing the e1000 driver on the MIPS
Octeon III platform, which needs address translation.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Enable setexpr command in defconfig for Turris MOX. We have found that
this is sometimes useful in U-Boot scripts and there is enough space in
NOR memory on MOX.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Enable wdt command in defconfig for Turris MOX. This is useful when
doing debugging.
Signed-off-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Value pcie->dev in function pcie_advk_probe() is not initialized yet
so use dev as argument for dev_dbg()/dev_warn().
Function pcie_advk_wait_pio() itself prints error message on failure
so do not print duplicate error message in caller.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
To check if some output characters are waiting either in Transmitter
Holding Register or Transmitter Shift Register we need to look at
TX_EMPTY bit of UART Status Register.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Update the documentation build system according to Linux v5.11-rc1.
Deactive the automarkup.py extension module which on Gitlab CI is
incompatible with Unicode.
With this patch we can build the HTML documentation using either of
Sphinx 2 and Sphinx 3.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Install all requirements according to doc/sphinx/requirements.txt in the
virtual environment used for testing 'make htmldocs'.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Sphinx 3 builds fail due to doc/develop/logging.rst producing duplicate
labels.
Include logging.h only once in the API section and use cross-references for
the enums log_level_t and log_category_t.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Configure an IO region and window for PNP identical to how MEM region is
set up. Linux does this only if the DT defines a pcie-io-aperture
property for the SOC, but since all supported boards do this should not
be needed.
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
On my DS414, some PCI devices return odd values when probing BAR sizes.
An obvious case is all-ones response, the Linux driver
(drivers/pci/probe.c) catches those explicitly and a comment explains
that either bit 0 or bit 1 must be clear (depending on MEM or IO type).
Other BARs return e.g. 0xfff0000f or 0xfff00004 and thus manage to break
size calculation due to the "middle" zeroes. Mitigate that copying more
or less what Linux does and do a "find least bit set".
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A few minor changes:
* Get rid of leftover comments, other commits removed the defines they
referred to.
* CONFIG_SYS_NETA_INTERFACE_TYPE is not used anymore since commit
e3b9c98a23 ("net: mvneta: Convert to driver model").
* Drop CONFIG_USB_MAX_CONTROLLER_COUNT: it is per-HCI type, so XHCI and
EHCI could still both work be used.
* Unconditionally define CONFIG_EHCI_IS_TDI: it has no effect on XHCI so
that conditional doesn't make any sense.
* Define a larger PHY_ANEG_TIMEOUT: In my test bed, the NIC is directly
connected to some RTL8111 and the default 8s timeout was often too
short.
Signed-off-by: Phil Sutter <phil@nwl.cc>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This change extends previous commit 061c6d1b23 ("arm: mvebu: Espressobin:
Detect presence of emmc at runtime") and when emmc is not present then emmc
is removed from U-Boot DM and corresponding slot is disabled. Therefore on
Espressobin board without soldered emmc, state of emmc hw should be same as
if emmc was disabled in DTS.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
SATA and UART ClearFog imaages are not buildable as ENV_SECT_SIZE is not defined
set values for both possible targets
Signed-off-by: Dennis Gilmore <dennis@ausil.us>
Move all aliases defintions into the main dts file
Add u-boot definiton to i2c0 based on clearfog
set spi1 status to okay
Signed-off-by: Dennis Gilmore <dennis@ausil.us>
The Armada driver also works on Nedap's custom Kirkwood board with a
Marvell 88F6180 CPU. The original commit of that driver,
commit 704d9a645e ("gpio: Add DM GPIO driver for Marvell MVEBU"),
also mentions that this driver would be suitable for Kirkwood. This
does not completely replace the Kirkwood specific driver as there
are still boards depending on that driver.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>,
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
H616 is very similar to H6 so most of the infrastructure can be reused.
However, two big differences are that it doesn't have functional SRAM A2
which is usually used for TF-A and it doesn't have ARISC co-processor.
It also needs bigger SPL size - 48 KiB.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far the only difference between the various Allwinner MMC controller
we are concerned about is the mod clock register offset.
This is actually not directly related to the MMC controller IP, but an
integration choice, dependent on the SoC this appears in.
To avoid becoming trapped with some compatible fallback strings, let's
remove the whole struct sunxi_mmc_variant, and replace this with a SoC
based choice, which we can derive from the CONFIG_MACH_SUNx_y symbols.
This will later simplify H616 support.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Allwinner H616 supports many types of DRAM. Most notably it supports
LPDDR4. However, all commercially available boards at this time use
only DDR3, so this commit adds only DDR3 support.
Controller and MBUS are very similar to H6 but PHY is completely
unknown.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Acked-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
H616 has mostly the same clocks as H6 with some small differences. Just
reuse H6 clocks for H616 and handle differences with macros.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
H616 supports and needs bigger SPL than 32 KiB, mostly due to big DRAM
driver and need for PMIC configuration, which pulls several drivers which
are not needed otherwise.
spl_mmc_get_uboot_raw_sector() will now compare pre-configured size with
that, reported in SPL header. If size in header is bigger, it will use
that value instead.
In the process of function rework, also add missing function argument.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
There was no need to have prcm definitions for H6 and similar SoCs till
now. However, support R_I2C will be needed soon in SPL.
Move old definitions to prcm_sun6i.h and add new ones in prcm_sun50i.h.
One of those files will be selected in common prcm.h based on defined
macros.
This commit doesn't do any functional change.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
While currently none of the newer Allwinner SoCs currently has I2C
support implemented in U-Boot, this will change soon. mvtwsi driver is
good as it is for them except one macro. Update it to be ready once I2C
support lands for those SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
It turns out that several SoCs share same mmc configuration as H6. In
order to lower ifdef clutter replace H6 specific macro with common one.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
It turns out that there are at least 2 other SoCs which have basically
the same memory map, similar clocks and other features as H6. It's very
likely that we'll see more such SoCs in the future. In order to ease
porting to new SoCs and lower ifdef clutter, introduce common symbol for
them.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The #ifdef CONFIG_xxxPWR conditionals were not working as expected, as
string Kconfig symbols are always "defined" from the preprocessor's
perspective. This lead to unnecessary calls to the GPIO routines, but
also always added a half a second delay to wait for a SATA disk to power
up. Many thanks to Peter for pointing this out!
Fix this by properly comparing the Kconfig symbols against the empty
string. strcmp() would be nicer for this, but GCC does not optimise this
away, probably due to our standalone compiler switches.
Reported-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org> # Orange Pi WinPlus
Tested-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
dts file is taken from Linux 5.11-rc1 tag.
The Bluetooth controller of this device ships with a default address,
use the new CONFIG_FIXUP_BDADDR option to fix it up.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
[Updated OrangePi 3 DT, rebase and config update]
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This commit adds support for Tanix TX6 TV box, based on H6. It's low end
H6 board, with 3 GiB of RAM, eMMC, fast ethernet, USB, IR and other
peripherals.
DT file is taken from Linux 5.11-rc1 release.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far all GBit users of the sun8i-emac driver were using the "rgmii"
PHY mode, even though this turns out to be wrong. It just worked because
the PHY driver doesn't do the proper setup (yet).
In fact for most boards the "rgmii-id" or "rgmii-txid" PHY modes are the
correct ones.
To allow the DTs to describe the phy-mode correctly, and to stay
compatible with Linux, at least allow those other RGMII modes in the
driver.
This avoids breakage if mainline DTs will be synced with U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Pull request for documentation tag doc-2021-04-rc1 (2)
* Man-pages for sbi, exit, for, echo, loady, true, false, conitrace
* Adjust suppression of newline in echo command.
* Provide unit test for echo command.
Second set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.04 cycle
This feature set includes macb updates for all interfaces and new
sama7g5 variant support; micrel ksz9031 DLL support; a new board from
Giant based on Adafruit feather form factor which contains a SAMA5D27
SoC; several fixes regarding the NAND flash PMECC block; and pincontrol
drive strength support for pio4 controller.
'make htmldocs' creates a warning:
./include/asm-generic/global_data.h:443:
warning: Function parameter or member 'uclass_root_s'
not described in 'global_data'
Correct the member descriptions.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The first argument is the load address and not an offset.
The second argument cannot be entered without the first one.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
By default the echo command emits its arguments followed by a line feed.
If any of the arguments contains the sub-string "\c", the line feed is
suppressed.
This does not match shells used in Linux and BSD where the first argument
has to be -n to suppress the line feed.
The hush shell interferes with the parsing of backslashes. E.g. in the
following command line quadruple backslashes are required for suppressing
the line feed:
for i in 1 2 3; do for j in 4 5; do echo \\\\c ${i}${j}; done; echo; done;
To avoid unexpected behavior the patch changes echo to use -n as first
argument to suppress the line feed.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC flag for reset-mtmips to make sure this driver can
be probed before relocation even if u-boot,dm-pre-reloc is not present
in the dts.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Currently this driver does not set the value of plat->cfg.f_max, which
results in that MMC framework will always run at the lowest frequency.
This patch sets plat->cfg.f_max to the maximum allowed frequency, which
equals to the source clock frequency.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The driver is missing pad control settings (pad delay and pad conf) for
the mt7620 and mt76x8. Although mt76x8 still works well, mt7620 will
encounter CRC error on data transfers.
This patch adds default pad control settings for mt7620_compat.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
It turns out that the sclk cycles used by mt7620/mt7628 is the same as
other chips (20 bits, 1048576), not 65536.
This patch removes sclk_cycle_shift from dev_comp, and uses a macro with
a value 20 instead.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds ethernet driver for MediaTek MT7620 SoC.
The MT7620 SoC has a built-in ethernet (Frame Engine) and a built-in
7-port switch and two xMII interfaces (can be MII/RMII/RGMII).
The port 0-3 of the switch connects to intergrited FE PHYs. Port 4 can be
configured to connect to either the intergrited FE PHY, or the xMII.
Port 5 always connects to the xMII. Port 6 is the CPU port.
This driver supports MT7530 giga switch connects to port 5.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds spi controller support for MediaTek MT7620 SoC.
The SPI controller supports two chip selects. These two chip selects are
implemented as two separate register groups, but they share the same bus
(DI/DO/CLK), only CS pins are dedicated for each register group.
Appearently these two register groups cannot operates simulataneously so
they are implemented as one controller.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds pinctrl support for MediaTek MT7620 SoC.
The MT7620 SoC supports only pinmux.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds a clock driver for MediaTek MT7620 SoC.
This driver provides clock gate control as well as getting clock frequency
for CPU/SYS/XTAL and some peripherals.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds uart support for MediaTek MT7620 and earlier SoCs.
The UART used by MT7620 is incompatible with the ns16550a driver.
All registers of this UART have different addresses. A special 16-bit
register for Divisor Latch is used to set the baudrate instead of the
original two 8-bit registers (DLL and DLM).
The driver supports of-platdata which is useful for tiny SPL.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Since mt7620 is added into Kconfig, the CONFIG_SOC_MT7628=y which is
omitted by default must be added back, otherwise make xxx_defconfig for
these boards will be configured for mt7620 platform.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The mt7620_rfb board supports integrated 10/100M PHYs plus two external
giga PHYs. It also has 8MB SPI-NOR, mini PCI-e x1 slot, SDHC and USB.
The mt7620_mt7530_rfb boards supports an external MT7530 giga switch and a
16MB SPI-NOR flash.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds support for MediaTek MT7620 SoC.
All files are dedicated for u-boot.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch adds support for mtmips SoCs to initialize the SDRAM.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
The sysreset driver has a config CONFIG_SPL_SYSRESET for the spl stage.
Change CONFIG_SYSRESET to CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(SYSRESET) will give spl a
chance to use _machine_restart instead of the sysreset driver.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE points to cached memory, i.e. KSEG0, which is not
suitable for detecting memory size.
Replace CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE with KSEG1, and make dram_init() always do
memory size detection in any stage.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Currently only mt7628 needs the sysreset driver, do not select it for
mt7620.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
This patch is a preparation for add a new soc fot mtmips.
Move all mt7628 related Kconfig (boards and UART selection) into mt7628
subdirectory and make sure the top directory of mtmips contains only
selection for SoCs.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Previous the dts files for gardena-smart-gateway-mt7688 and
linkit-smart-7688 are set to be built when mtmips is selected.
This can lead to a compilation error if another soc is added to this arch
with different dtsi files.
So it's better to build the dtb only if their board is selected.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc1-3
Bug fixes for UEFI sub-system:
* correct value of EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL.Media.LastBlock
* correct GUID when closing of EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL
* error handling in mkeficapsule tool
Bug fixes for FAT file system:
* consistent error handling for flush dir()
Unfortunately we now see a number of now-fatal warnings about duplicate
labels. It is often unclear how best to re-write the document in
question to not duplicate these otherwise logical headings.
This reverts commit 10a1df3cd4.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Convert test/py/README.md to restructured text and add it to the generated
HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move test/README to the 'Develop U-Boot' chapter of the HTML documentation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the help message used for 'make help':
Documentation targets:
Linux kernel internal documentation in different formats from ReST:
=>
U-Boot documentation in different formats from ReST:
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Update the docomentation build system according to Linux v5.11-rc1.
With this patch we can build the HTML documentation using either of
Sphinx 2 and Sphinx 3.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[Fix warning in b4860qds.rst about "Switch Settings"]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Beacon EmbeddedWorks is releasing a devkit based on the i.MX8M
Nano SoC consisting of baseboard + SOM.
The kit is based on the same design as the Beacon dev kit with
the i.MX8M Mini.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The previous macro was off by one bit and so we were getting a ddr
size which was twice the real size. This commit refactors the macro so
it returns the right size in _bytes_ and modifies the printf call so the
size is still printed in MiB.
Signed-off-by: Marc Ferland <ferlandm@amotus.ca>
In case the clock framework is enabled, enable the SPI controller clock
and obtain max frequency from the clock framework.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
The CSPI/ECSPI register bits do not differ between newer SoCs, instead
of having multiple copies of the same thing for each iMX SoC, define
the bits in the driver.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Add ECSPI clock entries to iMX8MN clock driver. Only make those entries
available in case SPI support in U-Boot is enabled at all to conserve
space, esp. in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
In order to support the QSPI chip on the SOM, the Flexspi bus
needs to be configured to talk with the SPI chip.
Resync the som device tree with 5.11-rc4
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
There is a QSPI chip connected to the FSPI. Enable the defconfig
to support it.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Supported boot device types in iMX8MQ: MMC, DHCP.
CONFIG_DISTRO_DEFAULTS is added for enabling the DISTRO_DEFAULTS option.
CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND which is defined in include/configs/imx8mq_evk.h is
deleted because "run distro_bootcmd" is required to be the default boot
mode.
scriptaddr is the location in RAM where boot.scr.uimg/boot.scr will be
loaded to prior to execution.
kernel_addr_r is the location in RAM where the kernel will be loaded to.
Delete unnecessary environment variables because "run distro_bootcmd" is
set to be the default boot mode.
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Move the bootcounter to SVNS_LPGDR to free up OCRAM for usage by the VPU.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Now that header files no longer include common.h it must be included
first.
Otherwise the build fails with errors like
include/asm/arch/clock.h:43:1: error: unknown type name 'u32'
u32 imx_get_uartclk(void);
Fixes: c3dc39a2f8 ("arm: Don't include common.h in header files")
Signed-off-by: Martin Fuzzey <martin.fuzzey@flowbird.group>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch converts the dart6ul ethernet support to DM_ETH and cleans
up the legacy ethernet code. The clean up, more specifically:
* moves the fec2 node and pin definition to the carrier board DTS
since the phy associated with it is on the carrier board and not on
the SoM;
* add the reset pin associated to each phy;
* separate the ethernet, mdio and reset pins of each fec so that they
are easier to reference;
* add clock properties to the phy nodes since they are connected to the
50Mhz ENET[12]_TX_CLK clock of the SoC;
* remove CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F since the function is now empty.
Signed-off-by: Marc Ferland <ferlandm@amotus.ca>
Because SPL can support SD UHS, the fixed regulator needs to be
enabled in SPL to reset the SD card.
Fixes: 1a5d9c84b4 ("imx8mm_beacon: Enable HS400 on MMC controller")
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
This fixes eth0 not initializing properly. Both eth0 and eth1 use the
MDIO interface on eth1 to access their PHYs. However, without
DM_ETH_PHY, eth0 still tries to use its own MDIO interface to access its
phy. Before this patch, a boot log might contain lines like
Net:
Warning: ethernet@20b4000 using MAC address from ROM
eth1: ethernet@20b4000 [PRIME]Could not get PHY for FEC0: addr 2
After this patch they now look like
Net:
Warning: ethernet@20b4000 using MAC address from ROM
eth1: ethernet@20b4000 [PRIME]Get shared mii bus on ethernet@2188000
Warning: ethernet@2188000 using MAC address from ROM
, eth0: ethernet@2188000
As an alternative to DM_ETH_PHY, FEC_MXC_SHARE_MDIO could also have been
used to achieve the same effect.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <sean.anderson@seco.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Distro Boot requires a U-Boot-specific script named boot.scr or
boot.scr.uimg which contains boot commands to boot the system. The
boot.cmd is such a file. Use mkimage to generate boot.scr or
boot.scr.uimg from boot.cmd, and the command is:
mkimage -A arm -O linux -T script -C none -a 0 -e 0 -n "Distro Boot Script" -d boot.cmd boot.scr.uimg
The boot.cmd file is an example script and can be modified based on
needs. bootargs is set in this script and root uses the default value
"/dev/mmcblk1p2 rootwait rw" which can be changed by overriding mmcroot.
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Supported boot device types in iMX8MP: MMC.
CONFIG_CMD_PART is added for command part and CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC is
for command fstype.
scriptaddr is the location in RAM where boot.scr.uimg/boot.scr will be
loaded to prior to execution. kernel_addr_r is the location in RAM where
the kernel will be loaded to. Delete unnecessary environment variables
because "run distro_bootcmd" is set to be the default boot mode.
On the iMX8MP platform I used, "mmc1" represents SD card and "mmc2"
represents eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Distro Boot requires a U-Boot-specific script named boot.scr or
boot.scr.uimg which contains boot commands to boot the system. The
boot.cmd is such a file. Use mkimage to generate boot.scr or
boot.scr.uimg from boot.cmd, and the command is:
mkimage -A arm -O linux -T script -C none -a 0 -e 0 -n "Distro Boot Script" -d boot.cmd boot.scr.uimg
The boot.cmd file is an example script and can be modified based on
needs. bootargs is set in this script and root uses the default value "
/dev/mmcblk1p2 rootwait rw" which can be changed by overriding mmcroot.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Supported boot device types in iMX8MM: MMC, DHCP.
CONFIG_CMD_PART is added for command part and CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC is
for command fstype.
CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND which is defined in include/configs/imx8mm_evk.h is
deleted because "run distro_bootcmd" is required to be the default boot
mode.
scriptaddr is the location in RAM where boot.scr.uimg/boot.scr will be
loaded to prior to execution.
kernel_addr_r is the location in RAM where the kernel will be loaded to.
Delete unnecessary environment variables.
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Alice Guo <alice.guo@nxp.com>
Modify the GPT common platform driver for mx7 which only use 24Mhz
OSC as clock source.
Note: at default, the mx7d will use system counter as timer. The GPT
is disabled.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When boot type could not be detected from rom sw info,
read sbmr1 to detect, here we only use it to detect FLEXSPI
boot, because ROM not update it in rom sw info.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Since we remove SATA device before boot OS, when AHCI is enabled, update
the codes to remove AHCI device.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
iMX8MP has shifted market segment fuse one bit from 0x440 [7:6] to [6:5],
correct it in imx common codes.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add NAND boot support for i.MX8MP by adding i.MX8MP in nandbcb support
list, reading boot_search_count from fuse.
i.MX8MN NAND boot is same as i.MX8MP, fix some issues as well.
Signed-off-by: Han Xu <han.xu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity Issue 9006656. In nandbcb_set_boot_config, an integer overflow
occurs, with the result converted to a wider integer type.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity Issue 9006658. In fill_dbbt_data, an integer overflow occurs,
with the result converted to a wider integer type
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity Issue 9006657. In read_fcb, leak of memory to system
resource "fcb_raw_page". Adjust the sequence to check the mtd bad
block prior than allocation of "fcb_raw_page", also check the NULL
return of allocation.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity Issue 9006655. In write_fcb, leak of memory to resource
"fcb_raw_page". Since we have initialized the "ret" to 0, should return
the value of ret.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity Issue 9006654. In write_fcb, use of an uninitialized
variable "ret".
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When doing DDR scrub, the DDR may enter into self refresh if the
selfref_en is enabled before DDR scrub. This will cause scrub
can't complete that SBRSTAT.scrub_done won't be set.
Since the selfref_en can be programmed during the course of
normal operation, move it after DDR scrub
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
use CONFIG_TARGET_IMX8MN_DDR4_EVK for DDR4 EVK board, we will use
CONFIG_TARGET_IMX8MN_EVK for LPDDR4 EVK board.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The field Media.LastBlock of the EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL.Media was filled
incorrectly both for block devices as well as for partitions.
The field must be filled with the index of the last logical block (LBA):
* block devices: device size minus 1
* partitions: partition size minus 1
Reported-by: Alexander von Gluck IV <kallisti5@unixzen.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The UEFI specification requires event notification levels to be
> TPL_APPLICATION and <= TPL_HIGH_LEVEL.
With the patch the CreateEvent() and CreatedEventEx() services are changed
to check that the notification level is not TPL_APPLICATION.
Reference:
UEFI Specification 2.8 Errata B, table 27 "TPL Restrictions",
"Event Notification Levels"
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Miscellaneous fixes in the mkeficapsule utility -- these include a few
resource leak issues flagged by Coverity along with some additional
code improvements suggested by Heinrich during code review.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Fill reserved members of efi_firmware_management_capsule_image_header
structure with zero's for safety.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Fixes: CID 316354
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CID 316361 says:
> Passing argument "count * 8UL /* sizeof (*files) */" to
> function "dlmalloc" and then casting the return value to "u16 **" is
> suspicious. In this particular case "sizeof (u16 **)" happens to be equal
> to "sizeof (u16 *)", but this is not a portable assumption.
> > 767 tmp_files = malloc(count * sizeof(*files));
The change in this patch fixes the ambiguity.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Fixes: CID 316361
For readability use *tmp_files instead of tmp_files[0]
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CID 316364 says:
> Null pointer dereferences (FORWARD_NULL)
> printf("Result total size: 0x%x\n", result->variable_total_size);
at do_efi_capsule_res().
The code is basically safe because a buffer for "result" is allocated
by malloc() and filled up by the second get_variable(), which fails any way
if the allocation has failed.
But the first (and second) get_variable() possibly returns an error other
than EFI_SUCCESS. We always need to check the return code from
get_variable() before accessing the data in "result".
While this change won't suppress CID 316364, the resulting code is much
safer.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Use the correct GUID when closing the file load protocol.
Remove an unnecessary check (Coverity CID 316363).
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The short name and extension of FAT files are stored in adjacent fields of
the directory entry. For some operations like calculating a checksum or
copying both fields it is preferable to treat both as one structure.
Change the definition of the directory entry structure to include a
structure comprising the name and the extension field.
This resolves Coverity CID 316357, CID 316350, CID 316348.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide function description for flush_dir().
Move all error messages for flush_dir() from the callers to the function.
Move mapping of errors to -EIO to the function.
Always check return value of flush_dir() (Coverity CID 316362).
In fat_unlink() return -EIO if flush_dirty_fat_buffer() fails.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The UBI_IOCVOLUP ioctl can fail if exclusive access to the volume isn't
obtained. If this happens, the flush operation doesn't return error,
leaving the caller without knowledge of missing flush.
Fix this by forwarding the error (-1) from ubi_update_start().
Fixes: 34255b92e6 ("tools: env: Add support for direct read/write UBI volumes")
Signed-off-by: Martin Hundebøll <martin@geanix.com>
These commands were disabled when CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is disabled, but
they do not depend on crypto support so they can be unconditionally
enabled.
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
When CONFIG_FIT_CIPHER=y and CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE=n is there is no
implementation of image_get_host_blob for mkimage/dumpimage:
/usr/bin/ld: tools/common/image-cipher.o: in function `fit_image_decrypt_data':
image-cipher.c:(.text+0x9a): undefined reference to `image_get_host_blob'
Move the implementation to a common file so it can be shaed between
image-cipher.c and image-fit-sig.c.
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
If CONFIG_FIT_CIPHER is enabled without CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE then
mkimage/dumpimage will fail to link:
/usr/bin/ld: tools/common/image-cipher.o: in function `fit_image_decrypt_data':
image-cipher.c:(.text+0x9a): undefined reference to `image_get_host_blob'
/usr/bin/ld: tools/common/image-cipher.o:(.data.rel+0x10): undefined reference to `EVP_aes_128_cbc'
/usr/bin/ld: tools/common/image-cipher.o:(.data.rel+0x40): undefined reference to `EVP_aes_192_cbc'
/usr/bin/ld: tools/common/image-cipher.o:(.data.rel+0x70): undefined reference to `EVP_aes_256_cbc'
/usr/bin/ld: tools/lib/aes/aes-encrypt.o: in function `image_aes_encrypt':
aes-encrypt.c:(.text+0x22): undefined reference to `EVP_CIPHER_CTX_new'
/usr/bin/ld: aes-encrypt.c:(.text+0x6f): undefined reference to `EVP_EncryptInit_ex'
/usr/bin/ld: aes-encrypt.c:(.text+0x8d): undefined reference to `EVP_EncryptUpdate'
/usr/bin/ld: aes-encrypt.c:(.text+0xac): undefined reference to `EVP_CIPHER_CTX_free'
/usr/bin/ld: aes-encrypt.c:(.text+0xf2): undefined reference to `EVP_EncryptFinal_ex'
collect2: error: ld returned 1 exit status
Signed-off-by: Joel Stanley <joel@jms.id.au>
The propoerty sign-images points to images in the configuration
node. But thoses images may references severals "sub-images" (for
example for images loadable). This commit adds the support of
severals sub-images.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
This commit creates a function fit_config_add_hash that will be
used in the next commit to support several 'sub-images'.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
** Introduction
There are currently four ways to load an OS image with u-boot
1. SPL -> u-boot -> bootm
2. SPL blue falcon mode
3. "Basic" FIT image (CONFIG_LOAD_FIT)
4. "Full-featured" FIT image (CONFIG_LOAD_FIT_FULL)
These four code paths were developed independently, and share very
little code. (3) and (4), behave very differently, are littered with
special cases. They even have different DTS syntax and properties.
The cause of this divergence is that the FIT format specification
leaves a number of things open to interpretation. The purpose of this
change is to enable the reduction of code size, duplication, and
complexity by updating and streamlining the FIT format.
We are only marginally concerned with backwards compatibility, because
we don't have inter-compatibility. For example, CONFIG_LOAD_FIT is
able to load images that CONFIG_LOAD_FIT_FULL won't. This is a direct
result of the incompatible syntax between the two implementations.
Ideally, these changes would enable "simple" FIT to be a subset of the
"full" fit implementation, and share most code. These changes should
also eliminate the need for falcon mode (although we are not
advocating for the removal of falcon mode at this time).
** Description of changes
* The "configurations" node is now mandatory
Guessing how to load components based on their "os" and "type" invites
confusion and superfluous heuristics. Instead, require each FIT image
to be explicit on how components should be loaded.
* Eliminate "ramdisk", "setup", "standalone", and "fpga" properties
Having too many special purpose properties requires special-casing
FIT loading code. When a special property can be handled by another
property, it is redundant.
- A "ramdisk" is identical to a loadable. Thus ramdisk images should
be placed under "loadables".
- A "setup" node can be achieved by using a "kernel" or "firmware"
property instead.
- "standalone" is used for u-boot nodes. The correct property to use
in this case is "firmware".
- "fpga" is a loadable
* Prioritize control between "firmware" and "kernel"
"firmware" and "kernel" are special nodes in that control is passed
to the "entry-point" of the image. Both can be present, for example,
an OP-TEE firmware with a linux kernel. When both are present,
control is passed to the "firmware" image.
** Further generalizations (not included herein)
The "firmware" and "kernel" properties could be generalized as a
"next-boot-stage", or similar name. This "next" stage would be special
in that it is both executable, and is the stage that is passed
control. For example, "next-stage" could be an op-tee image, with
linux as a loadable, or a u-boot image.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
The dm root node is needed early in the spl to allow the timer to be
used. This change calls spl_early_init to initialize the dm root node.
Signed-off-by: Greg Gallagher <greg@embeddedgreg.com>
Giant board is a tiny SBC based on the Adafruit Feather form factor,
created by groboards it contains a SAMA5D2 processor (SAMA5D27),
128 MB of RAM and a microSD card for storage.
Signed-off-by: Greg Gallagher <greg@embeddedgreg.com>
Take into account all RGMII interface types. Depending on it
the RGMII PHY's timings are setup.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
clk_set_rate() returns the set rate in case of success and a
negative number in case of failure. Consider failure only the
negative numbers.
Fixes: 3ef64444de ("dm: net: macb: Implement link speed change callback")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Different implementation of USER IO register needs different
mapping for bit fields of this register. Add implementation
for this and, since clken is part of USER IO and it needs to
be activated based on per SoC capabilities, add caps in
macb_config where clken specific information needs to be filled.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Because ATMEL_BASE_ROM is defined to 0x100000, it already points
to the begin of the index table for 512 byte sectors correction.
Thus its offset must be zero and the index of the table for 1024
byte sectors must start at offset 0x8000.
Signed-off-by: Kai Stuhlemmer (ebee Engineering) <kai.stuhlemmer@ebee.de>
[ta: update commit message]
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Offsets are described in the datasheet at section:
"11.4.4.2 NAND Flash Boot: PMECC Error Detection and Correction".
For testing I "injected" bit flips into u-boot NAND memory area,
and then read back. PMECC could not correct the errors. With the
offsets updated everything is fine.
Fixes: 3225f34e5c ("ARM: atmel: add sama5d3xek support")
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
When CONFIG_ATMEL_NAND_HW_PMECC is set, CONFIG_PMECC_CAP defaults
to the value of 2. At the conversion to Kconfig for the PMECC config
values, some boards/defconfigs were wrongly configured.
Update CONFIG_PMECC_CAP to the PMECC_CAP value before the conversion.
Fixes: 49ad40298c ("ARM: at91: Convert SPL_GENERATE_ATMEL_PMECC_HEADER to Kconfig")
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
SPL_GENERATE_ATMEL_PMECC_HEADER selects:
ATMEL_NAND_HWECC [=y] && ATMEL_NAND_HW_PMECC [=y].
With the removal of SPL_GENERATE_ATMEL_PMECC_HEADER,
ATMEL_NAND_HW_PMECC and ATMEL_NAND_HWECC were no longer
selected. Also, when the SPL_GENERATE_ATMEL_PMECC_HEADER was removed,
the configs were not updated using savedefconfig, thus the
'commit d168bcb6fe ("configs: Resync with savedefconfig")'
further removes the CONFIG_PMECC_CAP value.
Update defconfigs and add CONFIG_ATMEL_NAND_HW_PMECC,
which selects ATMEL_NAND_HWECC, in order to restore NAND PMECC
support. Restore CONFIG_PMECC_CAP value.
Fixes: 57f76c2a47 ("configs: at91: remove SPL_GENERATE_ATMEL_PMECC_HEADER from non-nand configs")
Signed-off-by: Tudor Ambarus <tudor.ambarus@microchip.com>
Use dev_read_prop instead of using the fdt_read_property which
reads from the GD struct's fdt.
This way the node is accessed via the device config instead of the
global struct, which makes code more portable and GD independent.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
- New board: rk3328 NanoPi R2S board;
- Fix init voltage for some rk3399 boards;
- enable rng for rk3399 by default;
- set default to SPI bus 1 for SPI-flash for some board;
- add dwc PCIe controller driver on rockchip platform;
Add Rockchip dwc based PCIe controller driver for rk356x platform.
Driver support Gen3 by operating as a Root complex.
Signed-off-by: Shawn Lin <shawn.lin@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
This adds support for the NanoPi R2S from FriendlyArm.
Rockchip RK3328 SoC
1GB DDR4 RAM
Gigabit Ethernet (WAN)
Gigabit Ethernet (USB3) (LAN)
USB 2.0 Host Port
MicroSD slot
Reset button
WAN - LAN - SYS LED
Signed-off-by: David Bauer <mail@david-bauer.net>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The rng is embedded in the SoC so enable it in the device tree
universally, the use of it can be controlled by enabling/disabling
at the device config level.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Cc: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
SPI flash on this machine is located on bus 1, default to using bus 1
for SPI flash and stop aliasing it to bus 0. Formerly the alias spi1
pointed to &spi5, use an alias spi5 for this instead.
Signed-off-by: Hugh Cole-Baker <sigmaris@gmail.com>
Suggested-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
SPI flash on this board is located on bus 1, default to using bus 1 for
SPI flash on both rk3399-roc-pc and -mezzanine, and stop aliasing it to
bus 0.
Signed-off-by: Hugh Cole-Baker <sigmaris@gmail.com>
Suggested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: c4cea2bb ("rockchip: Enable building a SPI ROM image on bob")
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Before 'if (err)' we have to initialize the variable otherwise we use a
random value from the stack.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At the beginning of close_ctree_fs_info() the value 0 is assigned to err
and never changed before testing it.
Let's get rid of the superfluous variable.
Fixes: f06bfcf54d ("fs: btrfs: Crossport open_ctree_fs_info() from btrfs-progs")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
SquashFS supports sprase blocks in files - that is, if a given block is
composed only of zeros, it's not written to the output file to save
space and it's on-disk length field is set to zero to indicate that.
Previously the squashfs driver did not recognise that, and would attempt
to read and decompress a zero-sized block, which obviously failed.
The following command may be used to create a file for testing:
cat <(dd if=/dev/urandom of=/dev/stdout bs=1M count=1) \
<(dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/stdout bs=1M count=1) \
<(dd if=/dev/urandom of=/dev/stdout bs=1k count=200) >test_file
Signed-off-by: Campbell Suter <campbell@snapit.group>
In __btrfs_map_block() we do a int * int and assign it to u64.
This is not safe as the result (int * int) is still evaluated as (int)
thus it can overflow.
Convert one of the multiplier to u64 to prevent such problem.
In real world, this should not cause problem as we have device number
limit thus it won't go beyond 4G for a single stripe.
But it's harder to teach coverity about all these hidden limits, so just
fix the possible overflow.
Reported-by: Coverity CID 312957
Reported-by: Coverity CID 312948
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc1-2
* Provide a test tool for initial RAM disk provided via load file2 protocol.
* Make more items configurable to reduce code size:
* Boot manager
* EFI_DT_FIXUP_PROTOCOL
* EFI_DEVICE_PATH_UTILITIES_PROTOCOL
* Bug fixes
* avoid EFI runtime symbols in global symbol table
CONFIG_SYS_REDUNDAND_ENVIRONMENT is changing in env_internal.h how u-boot
works with variables. struct environment_s has one byte flags property
which also affects ENV_SIZE macro.
I have reached the case where CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE is default setup
but custom scripts can be designed in a way that u-boot is asked to
import/export variables from/to file which can be in certain format.
That's why also for this configuration make sense to enable
CONFIG_SYS_REDUNDAND_ENVIRONMENT because it depends on environment file
format.
The patch is removing dependency on this configuration to support selecting
environment file format without any specific dependency where variables are
stored.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This hook is used in full U-Boot that's why there is no reason to touch
this location from SPL. The hook was introduced for QEMU usage but none is
really running SPL on QEMU that's why it shouldn't break any usecase.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Remove ifdef logic which is handled by preprocessor and move it link time
optimization to get full compile code coverage.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
For systems which has both sdhci controllers enable it is worth to export
bootseq number for variables. Then the variable can be used in custom
scripts to tune logic for OS.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no need to define the same macros in drivers.
All macros have been added by commit 17a42abb40 ("mmc: Define timing
macro's").
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
EFI applications must use CR LF as line endings.
Provide a print() function to reduce code size.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide an UEFI application to save the initial RAM disk provided by U-Boot
via the Load File2 protocol.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
In EFI 1.10 a version of the Unicode collation protocol using ISO 639-2
language codes existed. This protocol is not part of the UEFI specification
any longer. It was however required to run the UEFI Self Certification Test
(SCT) II, version 2.6, 2017. So we implemented it for the sole purpose of
running the SCT.
As the SCT does not need the protocol anymore it is time for removal.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Allow the EFI_DEVICE_PATH_UTILITIES_PROTOCOL to be disabled via
configuration.
On systems that are very tight on U-Boot image size we may want to disable
the protocol. As it is required to run the UEFI Shell enable it by default.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Some boards are very tight on the binary size. Booting via UEFI is possible
without using the boot manager.
Provide a configuration option to make the boot manager available.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This reverts commit 1231184caa.
While the change is fine in theory, a number of tests need to be updated
to match.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Move all load options related functions to a new module. So that they can
be compiled independently.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
dev_read_alias_seq() used uc_drv->name compared to alias
stem string, Ethernet's alias stem uses "ethernet", which
does not match the eth-uclass driver name "eth", can not
get the correct index of ethernet alias namer. So it seems
change uclass driver name to match the alias stem is a more
reasonable way.
Signed-off-by: David Wu <david.wu@rock-chips.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A sporadic condition occurs when the "bad packet" error is triggered
repeatedly, which results in "bad packet" messages scrolling on the
console during transfer. To avoid triggering this, reset the internal
RXFC count on the first occurance of the "bad packet", which forces
the code to re-read the RX packet count from the MAC, and prevents
any additional "bad packet" messages if there are no more packets in
the MAC. Also print better debug information if this condition occurs.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
When calling srand_mac we use a weak seed dependent on the
mac address. If present, use a RNG device instead to incerase entropy.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Torsten Duwe <duwe@suse.de>
When calculating a random UUID we use a weak seed.
Use a RNG device if present to increase entropy.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Torsten Duwe <duwe@suse.de>
Fix typo which would cause a build error.
Fixes: 3eaac6307d ("net: introduce packet capture support")
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
When the tftp server did not send any OACK, the tftp_next_ack variable
was not set to the correct value . As the server was transmitting
blocks we generated a lot of 'Received unexpected block: $n, expected
$n+1' error messages. Depending on the timeout setting the transfer
could still complete though.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
While doing DHCP the interface IP is set to 0.0.0.0. This causes the
check in net.c on dst_ip to be effectively skipped, and all IP datagrams
are accepted up the IP stack. In the case of an ICMP_ECHO_REQUEST for the
matching MAC address (regardless of destination IP), the result is that
an ICMP_ECHO_REPLY is sent. The source address of the ICMP_ECHO_REPLY is
0.0.0.0, which is an illegal source address.
This can happen in common practice with the following sequence:
DHCP (U-Boot or OS) acquires IP address 10.0.0.1
System reboots
U-Boot starts DHCP and send DHCP DISCOVER
DHCP server decides to OFFER 10.0.0.1 again
(perhaps because of existing lease or manual configuration)
DHCP server tries to PING 10.0.0.1 to see if anyone is squatting on it
DHCP server still has our MAC address in its ARP table for 10.0.0.1
U-Boot receives PING, and responds with an illegal source address
This may further result in a the DHCP server seeing the response as
confirmation that someone is squatting on 10.0.0.1, and picking a
new IP address from the pool to try again
Signed-off-by: David Rivshin <drivshin@allworx.com>
Implement programming MAC address to the hardware also for device model
configuration.
Fixes: b565b18a29 ("board: ge: bx50v3: Enable DM for PCI and ethernet")
Signed-off-by: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Running the start() handler twice without a stop() inbetween completely
breaks communication for some ethernet drivers like fec_mxc.
eth_halt() is called before each eth_init(). Due to the switch to
eth_is_active() in commit 68acb51f44 ("net: Only call halt on a driver
that has been init'ed"), this is not sufficient anymore when netconsole
is active: eth_init_state_only()/eth_halt_state_only() manipulate the
state check that is performed by eth_is_active() without actually
calling into the driver.
The issue can be triggered by starting a network operation (e.g. ping or
tftp) while netconsole is active.
Add an additional "running" flag that reflects the actual state of the
driver and use it to ensure that eth_halt() actually stops the device as
it is supposed to.
Fixes: 68acb51f44 ("net: Only call halt on a driver that has been init'ed")
Signed-off-by: Matthias Schiffer <matthias.schiffer@ew.tq-group.com>
The timer being used by this driver may have already been used by first
stage bootloader (e.g. ATF/preloader), and it's settings may differ from
what this driver is going to use.
This may cause issues, such as inaccurate timer frequency due to
incorrect clock divider.
This patch adds the initialization code to avoid them.
Signed-off-by: Weijie Gao <weijie.gao@mediatek.com>
If no GPIO controller is found, the return value should not depend on a
random value on the stack. Initialize variable ret.
The problem was indicated by cppcheck.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
drivers/mtd/mw_eeprom.c contains code that never worked. mw_eeprom_write()
and mw_eeprom_read() have incorrect loop conditions:
while (len <= 2) {
CONFIG_MW_EEPROM is not set anywhere. So let's simply drop the module.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Avoid calling free(addr) twice if the device for ucode is not found.
The problem was indicated by cppcheck.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Freeing a buffer before calling hang() is superfluous. Removing the call
reduces the SPL size.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Update branch and version information of ATF and DDR firmware files to
point to latest releases provided by NXP.
This is especially critical for imx8mp evk, as the ATF support for that
SoC is only available in latest releases.
Align all SoCs from imx8m family to use identical revisions of ATF and
DDR firmware.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Calling calloc() for 0 members does not make any sense.
Setting ch_priv->busy_desc = NULL for ch_priv->desc_cnt > 0 is equally
unreasonable.
The current code will lead to a NULL dereference in bcm6348_iudma_enable().
The assignments for ch_priv->busy_desc are obviously swapped.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add the command "pwm" for controlling the pwm channels. This
command provides pwm invert/config/enable/disable functionalities
via PWM uclass drivers
Signed-off-by: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds basic register access and child regulator binding
for the Monolithic MP5416 Power Management IC which integrates
four DC/DC switching converters and five LDO regulators.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Add low level platform initialization for the AST2600 SoC.
The 2-stage booting with U-Boot SPL are leveraged to support
different booting mode.
However, currently the patch supports only the booting from
memory-mapped SPI flash.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
AST2600 is the 7th generation of Aspeed SoC designated for
Interated Remote Management Processor.
AST2600 has significant performance improvement by integrating
1.2GHz dual-core ARM Cortex A7 (r0p5) CPU with FPU. Most of the
controllers are also improved with more features and better
performance than preceding AST24xx/AST25xx.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
AST2600 has 8 watchdog timers including 8 sets of
32-bit decrement counters, based on 1MHz clock.
A 64-bit reset mask is also supported to specify
which controllers should be reset by the WDT reset.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
AST2600 supports DDR4 SDRAM with maximum speed DDR4-1600.
The DDR4 DRAM types including 128MbX16 (2Gb), 256MbX16 (4Gb),
512MbX16 (8Gb), 1GbX16 (16Gb), and 1GbX8 TwinDie (16Gb) are supported.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
Set environment for Nand flash (U-boot 2020.04):
- add nand flash in the device tree
- add new default configuration file for G3 using parallel Nand
- set nand parameters in presidio_asic.h
Signed-off-by: Kate Liu <kate.liu@cortina-access.com>
Signed-off-by: Alex Nemirovsky <alex.nemirovsky@cortina-access.com>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Our kirkwood device embeds a USB host controller that is now used
on some boards. This enables the support of USB and the corresponding
driver.
Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
CC: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The driver only needs to retrieve the pin for the ACPI info. The driver
itself works without depending on GPIO.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The pci_mmc.c driver can generate ACPI info and therefore includes
asm/acpi_table.h by proxy. This file does not exist for the ARM
architecture and thus code compilation failed when using this
driver on ARM.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
CC: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As no gpio.h is defined for this architecture, to avoid
compilation failure, do not include <asm/arch/gpio.h> for
QEMU.
Signed-off-by: Harm Berntsen <harm.berntsen@nedap.com>
mkimage is only able to package aarch32 binaries. Add support for
AArch64 images.
One can create a ARM64 image using the following command line:
mkimage -T mtk_image -a 0x201000 -e 0x201000 -n "media=emmc;arm64=1"
-d bl2.bin bl2.img
Signed-off-by: Fabien Parent <fparent@baylibre.com>
Enable USB gadget on pumpkin. This requires to also enable
BOARD_LATE_INIT since the init is done in board_late_init function.
Signed-off-by: Fabien Parent <fparent@baylibre.com>
- Update qemu-riscv.rst build instructions.
- Add support for SPI on Kendryte K210.
- Add Microchip PolarFire SoC Icicle Kit support.
- Add support for an early timer.
- Select TIMER_EARLY to avoid infinite recursion for Trace.
Pull request for documentation tag doc-2021-04-rc1
* document man-page base command
* move README.fdt-overlays to HTML documentation
* add synopsis for pstore command
Remove the leading "0x" from rpc node to fix the below dtc warning:
Warning (simple_bus_reg): Node /soc/rpc@0xee200000 simple-bus unit
address format error, expected "ee200000"
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
By default on startup all the pin types are configured to
PINMUX_TYPE_NONE (in sh_pfc_map_pins()), when pin is set as GPIO the
pin type is updated to PINMUX_TYPE_GPIO. But the type is not updated
when the pin is set as a function in sh_pfc_pinctrl_pin_set() or
sh_pfc_pinctrl_group_set() calls (these calls only set the MUX if
the pin type is PINMUX_TYPE_NONE ie unused).
So with the current implementation pin functionality could be overwritten
silently, for example if the same pin is added for SPI and serial.
This patch makes sure of updating pin type after every successful call to
sh_pfc_config_mux() and thus fixing from pin functionality to be
overwritten. Also a warning message is printed if the current pin is being
overwritten before abort.
This also avoids pin re-muxing to same type that is for example from
command line device is asked to re-probe/select (mmc dev x) we return
early with success in this case as the pin is already muxed.
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
This patch adds Microchip MPFS Icicle Kit support. For now, only
NS16550 Serial, Microchip clock, Cadence eMMC and MACB drivers are
enabled. The Microchip MPFS Icicle defconfig by default builds
U-Boot for S-Mode because U-Boot on Microchip PolarFire SoC will run
in S-Mode as payload of HSS + OpenSBI.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Anup Patel <anup.patel@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Add clock driver code for the Microchip PolarFire SoC. This driver
handles reset and clock control of the Microchip PolarFire SoC device.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Anup Patel <anup.patel@wdc.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Enable 32-bit or 64-bit DMA in the macb driver based on the macb
hardware compatibility and it is configured with structure macb_config
in the driver.
The Microchip PolarFire SoC Memory Protection Unit(MPU) gives the 64-bit
DMA access with the GEM, the MPU transactions on the AXI bus is 64-bit
not 32-bit So 64-bit DMA is enabled for the Microchip PolarFire SoC GEM.
Signed-off-by: Padmarao Begari <padmarao.begari@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Anup Patel <anup.patel@wdc.com>
Tested-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Added support for timer_early_get_count() and timer_early_get_rate()
This is mostly useful in tracing.
Signed-off-by: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
When tracing functions is enabled this adds calls to
__cyg_profile_func_enter() and __cyg_profile_func_exit() to the traced
functions.
__cyg_profile_func_enter() and __cyg_profile_func_exit() invoke
timer_get_us() to record the entry and exit time.
initr_dm() will make gd->dm_root = NULL and gd->timer = NULL, so
timer_get_us() -> get_ticks() -> dm_timer_init() will lead to an
indefinite recursion.
So select TIMER_EARLY when tracing got enabled.
Signed-off-by: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@sifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
This enables configs necessary for using SPI. The environment is saved to
the very end of SPI flash. This is unlikely to be overwritten unless the
entire flash is reprogrammed.
This also supplies a default bootcommand. It loads an image and device tree
from the first partition of the MMC. This is a minimal/least effort
bootcmd, so suggestions (especially in the form of patches) are welcome. I
didn't set up distro boot because I think it is unlikely that any
general-purpose linux distros will ever be ported to this board.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Chrstopher Obbard <obbardc@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
fit_print_contents prints similar fit information as printed in bootm stages.
Removing this API reduces redundancy & provides improvement in boottime.
Signed-off-by: Ravik Hasija <rahasij@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Change 2 typo error in CONFIG_LIB_ELF description:
- Supoort => Support
- fir => for
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide a unit test for printing via pr_err() and pr_cont().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With commit d094a0734c ("log: allow for message continuation") we have
defined a special log level and category for message continuation. Let's
have a macro for using these.
If logging is enabled log_cont() will create a continuation log output with
the same logging level and category as the previous message.
If logging is not enabled, log_cont() will print like printf().
Provide macros for logging levels LOG_EMERG, LOG_ALERT, LOG_CRIT.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Change debug_cond() such that it can be used instead of a function like
debug().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The macro BIT_MASK is already defined in include/linux/bitops.h. To avoid
name collisions rename BIT_MASK() in drivers/ram/k3-j721e/lpddr4_private.h
to LPDDR4_BIT_MASK().
Remove superfluous parantheses.
Remove superfluous comparison to 0.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
log.h and dm/devres.h are U-Boot includes. So placing them
behind #ifndef __UBOOT__ does not make any sense.
Fixes: f7ae49fc4f ("common: Drop log.h from common header")
Fixes: 61b29b8268 ("dm: core: Require users of devres to include the header")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Building fails with DEBUG=1:
lib/aes.c: In function ‘debug_print_vector’:
lib/aes.c:622:45: error:
cast from pointer to integer of different size
[-Werror=pointer-to-int-cast]
622 | printf("%s [%d] @0x%08x", name, num_bytes, (u32)data);
Pointers can only be cast to (uintptr_t). But anyway we have
%p for printing pointers.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
obj-$(CONFIG_$(SPL_TPL_)YMODEM_SUPPORT) += xyzModem.o is there,
no need obj-$(CONFIG_SPL_YMODEM_SUPPORT) += xyzModem.o
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Make it more obvious what .dts file was expected by the build system.
When adding support for a new board, I kept getting this error message,
assuming I passed a wrong DEVICE_TREE parameter.
However, what was really the mistake was that the entry in
`arch/arm/dts/Makefile` was missing, and u-boot didn't like not being
able to find the .dtb file that should have been produced.
Simply logging the expected .dtb file name should make it easier to spot
such mistakes.
Signed-off-by: Florian Klink <flokli@flokli.de>
When ESC/CTRL+C is pressed interrupt bootmenu and jump into U-Boot console.
As the last entry in bootmenu is always U-Boot console just choose the last
entry when ESC or CTRL+C is pressed.
ESC key is detected when either no other character appears after '\e'
within 10ms or when non-'[' appears after '\e'.
It is useful when bootmenu is part of boot process and you want to
interrupt boot process by scripts which control U-Boot (serial) console.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A common use of memmove() can be handled by memcpy(). Also memcpy()
includes an optimization for large sizes: it copies a word at a time. So
we can get a speed-up by calling memcpy() to handle our move in this case.
Update memmove() to call also memcpy() if the source don't overlap
the destination (src + count <= dest).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
U-Boot DM model probe only single device at a time
which is enabled and configured using device tree
or platform data method.
PL011 UART IP is SBSA compliant and firmware does the
serial port set-up, initialization and let the kernel use
UART port for sending and receiving characters.
Normally software talk to one serial port time but some
LayerScape platform require all the UART devices enabled
in Linux for various use case.
Adding support to probe all enabled serial devices like SBSA
compliant PL011 UART ports probe and initialization by firmware.
Signed-off-by: Vabhav Sharma <vabhav.sharma@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Support a common method to probe all devices associated with uclass.
This includes data structures and code for finding the first device and
looping for remaining devices associated with uclasses (groups of devices
with the same purpose, e.g. all SERIAL ports will be in the same uclass).
An example is SBSA compliant PL011 UART IP, where firmware does the serial
port initialization and prepare uart device to let the kernel use it for
sending and reveiving the characters.SERIAL uclass will use this function
to initialize PL011 UART ports.
The feature is enabled with CONFIG_DM.
Signed-off-by: Vabhav Sharma <vabhav.sharma@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Remove the #if 0 present since the first version of console.c
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With our optimization settings the linker eliminates unused functions.
But for debugging it is better to compile with -Og or -O0. With -O0
compiling the sandbox fails due to the missing function fixup_cmdtable()
called by dm_reloc() and others.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When the hash check fails on a loadable image, the SPL/TPL simply
jump to the next one. This commit changes this behaviour, when the
hash check fails on a loadable image, the function spl_load_simple_fit
stops and report an error.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There should be no need to insert non-printable characters
and this prevents line editing getting confused.
Signed-off-by: Steve Bennett <steveb@workware.net.au>
The previous patch made the table look bad. Fix it, and leave some
space for a future element being a bit longer than the current
maximum.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
When setting aside a GPT partition for holding the U-Boot environment,
having a partition type GUID [1] indicating "Linux filesystem" (as
most tools default to) is somewhat misleading - and there's no other
well-known type GUID that is better suited. So to have a canonical
value to put into the type field, define
3de21764-95bd-54bd-a5c3-4abe786f38a8
to mean a partition holding a U-Boot environment.
This is a v5 namespace-name GUID [2], generated [3] from a namespace
of "25cbcde0-8642-47c6-a298-1a3a57cd256b" and name "U-Boot
environment".
Should future type GUIDs be defined in the context of U-Boot, it's
sensible to use that same namespace GUID.
[1] https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/GUID_Partition_Table#Partition_type_GUIDs
[2] https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Universally_unique_identifier#Versions_3_and_5_(namespace_name-based)
[3] https://www.uuidtools.com/v5
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
There's no reason to require an appropriately sized output parameter
for the string, that's error-prone should the table ever grow an
element with a longer string. We can just return the const char*
pointer directly.
Update the only caller accordingly, and get rid of pointless ifdeffery
in the header so that the compiler always sees a declaration and can
thus do type-checking, whether or not PARTITION_TYPE_GUID is enabled
or not.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
power/regulator will not be built if just CONFIG_SPL_DM_REGULATOR is
enabled. It needs CONFIG_SPL_POWER_SUPPORT to be enabled as well.
For example, if we just need a GPIO regulator in SPL:
CONFIG_DM_REGULATOR=y
CONFIG_SPL_DM_REGULATOR=y
CONFIG_DM_REGULATOR_GPIO=y
CONFIG_SPL_DM_REGULATOR_GPIO=y
Will not suffice, since the entire regulator build for SPL depends on
CONFIG_SPL_POWER_SUPPORT. Elaborate that information in the Kconfig
dependency.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Align the prefix used in cmd_ut_category function and name of tests
for ut str.
This patch solves the issues detected by "make qcheck" after previous
patch.
Fixes: fdc79a6b12 ("lib: Add a function to convert a string to upper case")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Align the prefix used in cmd_ut_category function and name of tests
for ut mem.
This patch solves the issues detected by "make qcheck" after previous
patch.
Fixes: 550a9e7902 ("cmd: Update the memory-search command")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This test cannot work unless CONFIG_BLOBLIST is enabled. Update it to add
that condition.
Reported-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This tests assumes it is running on sandbox. Add a few functions to handle
silencing the console on any board and use those instead.
Reported-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add eMMC and GPT support.
- GPT partition list and command to create the GPT added to u-boot
environment
- eMMC boot commands added to u-boot environment
- new gpt commands (enumarate and setenv) that are used by broadcom
update scripts and boot commands
- eMMC specific u-boot configurations with environment saved in eMMC
and GPT support
Signed-off-by: Corneliu Doban <cdoban@broadcom.com>
Signed-off-by: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
[trini: Make gpt_setenv initialize ret to -1, given relevant return
error values]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
During build of simple panel driver backlight is needed so let's enable
it:
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: drivers/built-in.o: in function `simple_panel_set_backlight':
u-boot/drivers/video/simple_panel.c:43: undefined reference to `backlight_set_brightness'
aarch64-linux-gnu-ld.bfd: drivers/built-in.o: in function `simple_panel_enable_backlight':
u-boot/drivers/video/simple_panel.c:28: undefined reference to `backlight_enable'
Signed-off-by: Marcin Juszkiewicz <marcin@juszkiewicz.com.pl>
The tests in test/lib/test_print.c fail without CONFIG_CONSOLE_RECORD=y.
Add a build dependency.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Add MBR partition layout writing supporting, clean up code.
- A large number of assorted console/iomux cleanups
- A large number of board_r related cleanups.
- Log enhancements
Two sibling headings can never be the same.
Fix the heading levels.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a 'mbr' command to let users create or verify MBR partition layout
based on the provided text description. The partition layout is
alternatively read from the 'mbr_parts' environment variable. This can be
used in scripts to help system image flashing tools to ensure proper
partition layout.
The syntax of the text description of the partition list is similar to
the one used by the 'gpt' command. Supported parameters are: name
(currently ignored), start (partition start offset in bytes), size (in
bytes or '-' to expand it to the whole free area), bootable (boolean
flag) and id (MBR partition type). If one wants to create more than 4
partitions, an 'Extended' primary partition (with 0x05 ID) has to be
explicitely provided as a one of the first 4 entries.
Here is an example how to create a 6 partitions (3 on the 'extended
volume'), some of the predefined sizes:
> setenv mbr_parts 'name=boot,start=4M,size=128M,bootable,id=0x0e;
name=rootfs,size=3072M,id=0x83;
name=system-data,size=512M,id=0x83;
name=[ext],size=-,id=0x05;
name=user,size=-,id=0x83;
name=modules,size=100M,id=0x83;
name=ramdisk,size=8M,id=0x83'
> mbr write mmc 0
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Add a code for creating and writing MBR partition layout. The code generates
similar layout of EBRs (Exteneded Block Records) and logical volumes as
Linux's fdisk utility.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Make functions not used outside this file static.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
[trini: Use __maybe_unused as there are cases they may not be used]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Add some handy defines for some hardcoded magic numbers related to
extended partition handling.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
write_mbr_partition() function name is a bit misleading, so rename it to
write_mbr_sector(). This is a preparation for adding code for writing a
complete MBR partition layout.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Obviously the following has unnecessary indentation level in 'else' branch.
if (foo) {
...
return;
} else {
...
}
Drop indentation level by removing redundant 'else'.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Refactor iomux_doenv() a bit in order to increase readability.
There is no change in code generation on x86.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It's realloc() 101 to avoid `foo = realloc(foo, ...);` call
due to getting a memory leak.
Actually it's not clear why realloc() has been used here.
If we shrink the array, the memcpy() overwrites it anyway
with the contents of a new array. If it becomes bigger,
same story.
Drop useless realloc() for good and thus preserve console list
in case of failed allocation.
Fixes: 16a28ef219 ("IOMUX: Add console multiplexing support.")
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
search_device() is defined in console.c. Move its declaration
to an appropriate header file.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is no need to call ->start() for already started device. All the same,
there is no need to call ->stop() for devices still in use.
For now enforce this only for IOMUX case.
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the future we would like to stop unused consoles and
also add a reference counting to avoid imbalanced calls
to ->start() and ->stop() in some cases.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the helper function console_has_tstc() and replace the test
#if CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CONSOLE_MUX) to a simple 'if' test to
respect the U-Boot coding rule.
No functional change.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add helper functions to access to gd->console_out and gd->console_in
with membuff API and replace the #ifdef CONFIG_CONSOLE_RECORD test
by if (IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CONSOLE_RECORD)) to respect the U-Boot
coding rule.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new function to access to console_devices only defined if
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CONSOLE_MUX).
This path allows to remove #if CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CONSOLE_MUX)
in console_getc function.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove #ifdef or #ifndef for CONFIG when it is possible to simplify
the console.c code and respect the U-Boot coding rules.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
spl_handoff should only be enabled when CONFIG_HANDOFF is set. Drop the
nested ifdefs and check for CONFIG_HANDOFF instead.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_HANDOFF is used in u-boot proper to locate handoff info from SPL
during pre-relocation init (in setup_spl_handoff). Add explicit dependency
on CONFIG_SPL, to fix the following build error when CONFIG_HANDOFF &&
!CONFIG_SPL:
common/board_f.c: In function ‘setup_spl_handoff’:
common/board_f.c:283:4: error: ‘gd_t {aka struct global_data}’
has no member named ‘spl_handoff’
gd->spl_handoff = bloblist_find(BLOBLISTT_SPL_HANDOFF,
^~
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In order to remove the arch-specific ifdefs around initr_trap, introduce
arch_initr_trap weak initcall. Implementations for ppc/m68k/mips have
been moved to arch/<arch>/lib/traps.c
Default implementation is a nop stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Add a return value to bb_miiphy_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to api_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to jumptable_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to xen_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to noncached_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to pci_init and use it directly in the post-relocation
init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to pci_ep_init and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to post_output_backlog and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a return value to cpu_secondary_init_r and use it directly in the
post-relocation init sequence, rather than using a wrapper stub.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Drop initr_console_record wrapper and call console_record_init directly.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_OF_EMBED) in instead of #ifdefs in reserve_fdt,
reloc_fdt functions.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
setup_bdinfo is used to populate various bdinfo fields, so move
setup_machine code there, as all it does is setting
gd->bd->bi_arch_number.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_TIMER_EARLY) instead of #ifdef in initf_dm. Also,
move timer code to the main ifdef, so that ret is defined.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Drop initf_console_record wrapper and call console_record_init directly.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently, the following #ifdef construct is used to check whether to run
console_record_init() during pre-relocation init:
defined(CONFIG_CONSOLE_RECORD) && CONFIG_VAL(SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN)
Introduce CONFIG_CONSOLE_RECORD_INIT_F Kconfig option to get rid of the
complex ifdef check. Also, use IS_ENABLED() instead of #ifdef.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reduce the log overhead when the traces are filtered,
by moving the vsnprintf call from _log() to log_dispatch().
This patch avoids the printf treatment when LOG features is
activated, but trace is filtered, for example when
MAX_LOG_LEVEL=8 and LOG_DEFAULT_LEVEL=6.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add a new test to check the content of the dropped messages
sent to console puts function.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Allow to record the console output before before U-Boot
has a console ready.
This patch allows to test the console output in sandbox test
based on console record.
It is possible because GD_FLG_RECORD and GD_FLG_SERIAL_READY
are 2 independent flags.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reorder test on gd value and remove the duplicated test (!gd)
in putc and puts function.
This patch is a preliminary step for rework of this function.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add test for dropped trace before log_init, displayed by debug uart.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the console puts functions to output the traces before
the log initialization (when CONFIG_LOG is not activated).
This patch allows to display the first U-Boot traces
(with macro debug) when CONFIG_DEBUG_UART is activated
and not only drop them.
For example for traces in board_f.c requested by the macro debug,
when LOG_DEBUG is defined and CONFIG_LOG is activated.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add a new test to check the dropped messages when LOG is not ready
with log_drop_count and the result of _log().
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update _log function to drop any traces when log is yet initialized:
vsnprintf is no more executed in this case.
This patch allows to reduce the cost for the dropped early debug trace.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add a check of the _log function with LOGL_FORCE_DEBUG flags,
used to force the trace display.
The trace should be displayed for all the level when flags
have LOGL_FORCE_DEBUG bit is set, for any filter.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Something was wrong in the merge process into the mainline.
Some added patches access driver structure fields and functions that
have been modified by previous patches.
The patch renames:
- dev_get_platdata to dev_get_plat
- dev_get_uclass_platdata to dev_get_uclass_plat
- ofdata_to_platdata to of_to_plat
- plat_data_alloc_size to plat_auto
- priv_auto_alloc_size to priv_auto
- video_uc_platdata to video_uc_plat
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The existing socfpgaimage always pads the image to the maximum size of
OCRAM size. This will break in the encryption flow where it expects the
image to be un-padded. The encryption tool will do the encryption for
the whole image and append the signature key at end of the image.
The signature key will append to beyond the size of OCRAM if the image
is padded with the maximum size before encryption.
Move the padding step from socfpgaimage to Makefile and pads with objcopy
command.
socfpgaimage will pad the image with 16 bytes aligned (including CRC word),
this is a requirement in encryption flow.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Add CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO for Gen5 and Arria 10. CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO is set to
size of OCRAM.
This is preparation for image padding change in socfpgaimage.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Print image header information if the header is verified.
Example output from mkimage "-l" option:
$ ./tools/mkimage -l spl/u-boot-spl.sfp
Image Type : Cyclone V / Arria V SoC Image
Validation word : 0x31305341
Version : 0x00000000
Flags : 0x00000000
Program length : 0x00003a59
Header checksum : 0x00000188
$ ./tools/mkimage -l spl/u-boot-spl.sfp
Image Type : Arria 10 SoC Image
Validation word : 0x31305341
Version : 0x00000001
Flags : 0x00000000
Header length : 0x00000014
Program length : 0x000138e0
Program entry : 0x00000014
Header checksum : 0x00000237
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Booting Agilex and Stratix 10 with ATF support.
SPL now loads ATF (BL31), U-Boot proper and DTB from FIT
image. The new boot flow with ATF support is as follow:
SPL -> ATF (BL31) -> U-Boot proper -> OS (Linux)
U-Boot proper now starts at 0x200000 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE).
ATF will occupy the address range starting from 0x1000.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Add binman node to device tree to generate the FIT image for u-boot
(u-boot.itb) and OS kernel (kernel.itb).
u-boot.itb contains arm trusted firmware (ATF), u-boot proper and
u-boot device tree for ATF u-boot flow.
kernel.itb contains Linux Image and Linux device tree.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
SPL already setup the Clock Manager with the handoff data
from OCRAM. When the Clock Manager's driver get probed again
in SSBL, it shall skip the handoff data access in OCRAM.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Since SSBL is running in DRAM, it shall setup the stack in DRAM
instead of OCRAM which is occupied by SPL and handoff data.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
In non-secure mode (EL2), FPGA reconfiguration driver calls the
SMC/PSCI services provided by ATF to configure the FPGA.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
In non-secure mode (EL2), Reset Manager driver calls the
SMC/PSCI service provided by ATF to enable/disable the
SOCFPGA bridges.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
In non-secure mode (EL2), MAC driver calls the SMC/PSCI services
provided by ATF to setup the PHY interface.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
In non-secure mode (EL2), MMC driver calls the SMC/PSCI services
provided by ATF to set SDMMC's DRVSEL and SMPLSEL.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Change 'clksel' callback function to allow the code to return a
status.
This patch is a preparation for enabling Arm-Trusted-Firmware (ATF)
in Intel SoC FPGA. This patch does not change functionality.
When using Arm-Trusted-Firmware (ATF) in Intel SoC FPGA, the MMC clock
related register is secure register which is required to be written
via SMC/PCSI call. It is possible that U-Boot fail to write the
register if there is unexpected error between U-Boot and ATF.
As a result, there maybe signal integrity on MMC connection due to
clock. So, the code should reports error to user when 'clksel' fail.
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
This header file defines the Secure Monitor Call (SMC) message
protocol for ATF (BL31) PSCI runtime services. It includes all
the PSCI SiP function identifiers for the secure runtime services
provided by ATF. The secure runtime services include System Manager's
registers access, 2nd phase bitstream FPGA reconfiguration, Remote
System Update (RSU) and etc.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
invoke_smc() allow U-Boot proper running in non-secure mode (EL2)
to invoke SMC call to ATF's PSCI runtime services such as
System Manager's registers access, 2nd phase bitstream FPGA
reconfiguration, Remote System Update (RSU) and etc.
smc_send_mailbox() is a send mailbox command helper function which invokes
the ATF's PSCI runtime service (function ID: INTEL_SIP_SMC_MBOX_SEND_CMD)
to send mailbox messages to Secure Device Manager (SDM).
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Standard PSCI function "CPU_ON" provided by ATF is now used
by Linux kernel to bring up the secondary CPUs to enable SMP
booting in Linux on SoC 64bits platform.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Override 'lowlevel_init' to make sure secondary CPUs trapped
in ATF instead of SPL. After ATF is initialized, it will signal
the secondary CPUs to jump from SPL to ATF waiting to be 'activated'
by Linux OS via PSCI call.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Instead of loading u-boot proper image (u-boot.img), SPL
now loads FIT image (u-boot.itb) which includes u-boot
proper, ATF and u-boot proper's DTB.
For OS, u-boot now loads FIT images (kernel.itb) which
includes Linux Image and Linux's DTB.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Add board_fit_config_name_match() for matching board name with
device tree files in FIT image. This will ensure correct DTB
file is loaded for different board type. Currently, we are not
supporting multiple device tree files in FIT image therefore this
function basically do nothing for now.
Users are allowed to override this 'weak' function in their
specific board implementation.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-04-rc1
In the UEFI sub-system:
* implement non-blocking file services
* print boot device and file path in helloworld.efi
* improve detection of boot device
* correct argument handling in efivar.py
* implement EFI_DT_FIXUP_PROTOCOL
Bug fixes:
* adjust conitrace command for low baud rates
* check that FIT images are valid FDTs
- Enable logging features for stm32mp15 boards
- Update MAINTAINERS emails for STI and STM32
- Activate OF_LIVE for ST stm32mp15 boards
- Switch to MCO2 for PHY 50 MHz clock for DHCOM boards
- Correction in stm32prog command on uart: always flush DFU on start command
- Update USB-C power detection algorithm on DK boards
- sync amlogic GX & AXG DT to Linux 5.10
- Add new MESON_EE driver support for GXBB & AXG
- Add support for Libretech-CC v2, Wetek Core2, Beelink GT-King/Pro boards
- add driver for TDO tl070wsh30 panel driver
- meson: isolate loading of socinfo
- Add soc_rev to environment
- Enable G12A support for saradc
- Add correct mmcdev on VIM3(L) & Odroid-N2(C4)
- Read MAC from fuses for VIM3 & VIM3L boards
A previous series already update STMicroelectronics emails maintainers
but some files have been omitted (Makefile, .dts, .dtsi and .rst files).
Update Patrick and my email address with the one dedicated to upstream
activities.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Remove the test on data->dfu_seq, because dfu_seq=0 not only when
the DFU is not started (mask with 0xffff). This flush is mandatory
as the final treatment, common with USB, is done in DFU callback.
This patch avoids issue if the received length is a multiple of
the DFU packet.
For example if size of bootfs partition is egual to 0x4000000,
data->dfu_seq=0 at the end of the partition, the flush it not
requested and the phase is not increased in the callback.
U-Boot continue to request the bootfs in the next GetPhase command.
Fixes: 468f0508b5 ("stm32mp: stm32prog: add serial link support")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
Activate the live DT to reduce the DT parsing time.
For example the boot time is reduced by 200ms on STM32MP157C-EV1 board
for stm32mp15_basic_defconfig (boot with SPL) or
stm32mp15_trusted_defconfig (boot with TF-A).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@foss.st.com>
The LAN8710i PHY currently uses 50 MHz clock direct from PLL4P.
To permit PLL4P to run at faster frequency, use MCO2 as a divider.
The PLL4P runs at 100 MHz, supplies MCO2 which divides it by 2 to
50MHz, and supplies the PHY with 50 MHz via pin PG2. The feedback
clock are fed back in via pin PA1.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Change-Id: Ia9bf7119785d49b633a3ae761c3dc4a30b92628a
There shouldn't be a need to use loadables propertyn because u-boot can be
pointed by firmware property. This change should also speedup boot process
because loadables property is list of strings which code is going through.
On the other hand firmware can just point to one image.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
USB-C power supply which are Power Delivery compliant (USB-PD) are able
to provide different voltage/current (for example 5V/3A 9V/3A 12V/2.25A...)
In this case, the power supply need to negotiate the voltage/current to
use with the device using CC1/CC2 USB-C signals.
If this negotiation occurs during ADC measurement (done also on CC1/CC2
USB-C signals) some ADC acquisition can be corrupted which cause wrong
power supply current detection.
To avoid this, the power supply current detection algorithm is updated
as following:
- perform an ADC measurement, if a 3A current is detected, continue the
boot process.
- else, wait 20ms (max tPDDebounce duration) to ensure that USB-PD
negotiation is done and perform another ADC measurement.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Activate the logging features in SPL and U-Boot
(CONFIG_LOG and CONFIG_SPL_LOG) and the command 'log' with
CONFIG_CMD_LOG.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug/pr_* to log_* or dev_* macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug/pr_debug to log_debug or dev_dbg macro and
define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change pr_debug to log_debug or dev_dbg macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug to dev_dbg macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Change debug to dev_dbg macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug to dev_dbg macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug and pr_ macro to dev macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug and pr_ macro to dev macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug and pr_ macro to dev macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY, use dev_ macro when it is possible.
Remove the "%s:" __func__ header as it is managed by dev macro
(dev->name is displayed) or log macro (CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY, use dev_ macro when it is possible
and migrate other trace to log_ macro.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY, change debug to dev_dbg and remove "%s:" __func__
header as it is managed by dev macro (dev->name is displayed)
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY and remove unneeded pr_fmt macro with the dev
macro as dev->name is displayed and CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC can be
activated for log macro.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug to dev_dbg macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove dev->name as it is already displayed by dev macro.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Change debug to log macro and define LOG_CATEGORY.
Remove "%s:" with __func__ as it is managed by log macro
(CONFIG_LOGF_FUNC)
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Define LOG_CATEGORY, change pr_debug to dev_dbg and remove "bsec:"
header as it is managed by log macro (dev->name is displayed)
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
The dtbdump.efi binary can already be used to dump the configuration table
with the device-tree to a file.
With this patch a device-tree file can be loaded. The EFI_DT_FIXUP_PROTOCOL
is called to
* apply U-Boot's fix-ups
* let U-Boot make memory reservations as required by the device-tree
* install the new device-tree as configuration table
In a next step this configuration table can be dumped.
A dtbdump.efi session would look like:
DTB Dump
========
=> load test.dtb
device-tree installed
=> save fixed-up.dtb
fixed-up.dtb written
=> exit
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
A boot manager like GRUB can use the protocol to
* apply U-Boot's fix-ups to the a device-tree
* let U-Boot make memory reservations according to the device-tree
* install the device-tree as a configuration table
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At 9600 baud or less a 1 ms wait is too short to detect the end of an
escape sequence.
Increase the wait duration to 10 ms which will work down to 1200 baud.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In efi_mem_sort() adjacent memory regions of same type are coalesced.
Remove the remark "Merging of adjacent free regions is missing".
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We do not want to use typedefs in U-Boot.
Do not use efi_string_t in the EFI_TEXT_OUTPUT_PROTOCOL.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now the bootefi command used the last file loaded to determine the
boot partition. This has led to errors when the fdt had been loaded from
another partition after the EFI binary.
Before setting the boot device from a loaded file check if it is a PE-COFF
image or a FIT image.
For a PE-COFF image remember address and size, boot device and path.
For a FIT image remember boot device and path.
If the PE-COFF image is overwritten by loading another file, forget it.
Do not allow to start an image via bootefi which is not the last loaded
PE-COFF image.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
fit_check_format() must check that the buffer contains a flattened device
tree before calling any device tree library functions.
Failure to do may cause segmentation faults.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Let helloworld.efi print the device path of the boot device and the file
path as provided by the loaded image protocol.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently when executing 'bootefi hello' we copy helloworld.efi to the
address identified by environment variable loadaddr. This is unexected
behavior for a user. There is no need to copy helloworld.efi before
executing it after relocation.
Remove the copy action.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When deleting a variable we must check that the GUID provided by the
user matches the GUID of the variable.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Paulo Alcantara (SUSE) <pc@cjr.nz>
When tools: efivar.py is called without arguments an error occurs:
Traceback (most recent call last):
File "tools/efivar.py", line 380, in <module>
main()
File "tools/efivar.py", line 360, in main
args.func(args)
AttributeError: 'Namespace' object has no attribute 'func'
Show the online help if the arguments do not specify a function.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Paulo Alcantara (SUSE) <pc@cjr.nz>
- DM support for OMAP PWM backlight
- USB host mode support for AM654
- Minor SPI fixes
- Add support k2g ice board with 1GHz silicon
- Fix GTC programming for K3 devices
First set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.04 cycle
This feature set includes the new board SAMA7G5 EK, the new evaluation
kit for Microchip AT91 SAMA7G5 SoC . The current board support includes
two configurations for booting from eMMC (SDMMC0), SD-Card (SDMMC1), and
support for two Ethernet interfaces.
Fix reading built-in ethernet MAC address from efuse
NOTE: MAC is stored in ASCII format, 1bytes = 2characters by 0 offset
if mac from efuse not valid we use meson_generate_serial_ethaddr
NOTE: remake odroid-n2.c from Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Artem Lapkin <art@khadas.com>
[narmstrong: remove MAC print & spurious new endline]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
ARMv8's generic timer[1] picks up it's graycode from GTC. However,
the frequency of the GTC is supposed to be programmed in CNTFID0[2]
register prior to enabling the GTC in CNTCR[3] register.
In K3 architecture, GTC provides a central time to many parts of the
SoC including graycode to the generic timer in the ARMv8 subsystem.
However, due to the central nature and the need to enable the counter
early in the boot process, the R5 based u-boot enables GTC and
programs it's frequency based on central needs of the system. This
may not be a constant 200MHz based on the system. The bootloader is
supposed to program the FID0 register with the correct frequency it
has sourced for GTC from the central system controller OR from PLLs
as appropriate, and TF-A is supposed[4] to use that as the frequency for
it's local timer.
Currently we are programming just the CNTCR[3] register to enable the
GTC, however we dont let TF-A know the frequency that GTC is actually
running at. A mismatch in programmed frequency and what we program for
generic timer will, as we can imagine, all kind of weird mayhem.
So, program the CNTFID0 register with the clock frequency. Note:
assigned-clock-rates should have set the clock frequency, so the only
operation we need to explicitly do is to retrieve the frequency and
program it in FID0 register.
Since the valid in K3 for GTC clock frequencies are < U32_MAX, we can
just cast the ulong and continue.
[1] https://developer.arm.com/documentation/100095/0002/generic-timer/generic-timer-register-summary/aarch64-generic-timer-register-summary
[2] https://developer.arm.com/docs/ddi0595/h/external-system-registers/cntfid0
[3] https://developer.arm.com/docs/ddi0595/h/external-system-registers/cntcr
[4] 6a22d9ea3c
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
This patch adds a new test which checks that U-Boot for Nokia RX-51 running
in qemu can print test line to serial console and also checks that test
line appeared on qemu serial console.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Those two commands now doing same thing, reading from ext2/3/4 filesystem.
So remove useless duplicated call.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Acked-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
With support for other clock drivers, the potentially supported CDCE913
device can no longer be probed without specifying its DT node name.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The schedule for deprecating the features of the pre-driver-model puts
2019.17 as the deadline for the video subsystem. Furthermore, the latest
patches applied to the am335x-fb.c module have decreased the amount of
code shared with the pre-driver-model implementation. Splitting the two
implementations into two modules improves the readability of the code
and will make it easier to drop the pre-driver-model code.
I have not created a header file with the data structures and the
constants for accessing the LCD controller registers, but I preferred to
keep them inside the two c modules. This is a code replication until the
pre-driver-model version is dropped.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The patch configures the display DPLL using the functions provided by
the driver model API for the clock. The device tree contains everything
needed to get the DPLL clock. The round rate function developed for
calculating the DPLL multiplier and divisor and the platform routines
for accessing the DPLL registers are removed from the LCD driver code
because they are implemented inside the DPLL clock driver.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Enabling the domain clock is performed by the sysc interconnect target
module driver during the video device probing.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The previous version of am335x-fb.c contained the functionalities of two
drivers that this patch has split. It was a video type driver that used
the same registration compatible string that now registers a panel type
driver. The proof of this is that two compatible strings were referred
to within the same driver.
There are now two drivers, each with its own compatible string,
functions and API.
Furthermore, the panel driver, in addition to decoding the display
timings, is now also able to manage the backlight.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The patch adds a function to get display timings from the device tree
node attached to the device.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The TI PWMSS driver is a simple bus driver for providing clock and power
management for the PWM peripherals on TI AM33xx SoCs, namely eCAP,
eHRPWM and eQEP.
For DT binding details see Linux doc:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-tipwmss.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Enhanced high resolution PWM module (EHRPWM) hardware can be used to
generate PWM output over 2 channels. This commit adds PWM driver support
for EHRPWM device present on AM33XX SOC.
The code is based on the drivers/pwm/pwm-tiehrpwm.c driver of the Linux
kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/pwm/pwm-tiehrpwm.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The prescaler (PTV) setting must be taken into account even when the
timer input clock frequency has been set.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The __of_translate_address routine translates an address from the
device tree into a CPU physical address. A note in the description of
the routine explains that the crossing of any level with
since inherited from IBM. This does not happen for Texas Instruments, or
at least for the beaglebone device tree. Without this patch, in fact,
the translation into physical addresses of the registers contained in the
am33xx-clocks.dtsi nodes would not be possible. They all have a parent
with #size-cells = <0>.
The CONFIG_OF_TRANSLATE_ZERO_SIZE_CELLS symbol makes translation
possible even in the case of crossing levels with #size-cells = <0>.
The patch acts conservatively on address translation, except for
removing a check within the of_translate_one function in the
drivers/core/of_addr.c file:
+
ranges = of_get_property(parent, rprop, &rlen);
- if (ranges == NULL && !of_empty_ranges_quirk(parent)) {
- debug("no ranges; cannot translate\n");
- return 1;
- }
if (ranges == NULL || rlen == 0) {
offset = of_read_number(addr, na);
memset(addr, 0, pna * 4);
debug("empty ranges; 1:1 translation\n");
There are two reasons:
1 The function of_empty_ranges_quirk always returns false, invalidating
the following if statement in case of null ranges. Therefore one of
the two checks is useless.
2 The implementation of the of_translate_one function found in the
common/fdt_support.c file has removed this check while keeping the one
about the 1:1 translation.
The patch adds a test and modifies a check for the correctness of an
address in the case of enabling translation also for zero size cells.
The added test checks translations of addresses generated by nodes of
a device tree similar to those you can find in the files am33xx.dtsi
and am33xx-clocks.dtsi for which the patch was created.
The patch was also tested on a beaglebone black board. The addresses
generated for the registers of the loaded drivers are those specified
by the AM335x reference manual.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Tested-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The patch moves the clk-ti-sci.c file to the 'ti' directory along with
all the other TI's drivers, and renames it clk-sci.c.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
This minimal driver is only used to bind child devices.
For DT binding details see Linux doc:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/arm/omap/prcm.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Until now the clkctrl clocks have been enabled/disabled through platform
routines. Thanks to this patch they can be enabled and configured directly
by the probed devices that need to use them.
For DT binding details see Linux doc:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/ti-clkctrl.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Up till this commit passing NULL as input parameter was allowed, but not
handled properly. When a NULL parameter was passed to the function a data
abort was raised.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The patch adds support for TI gate clock binding. The code is based on
the drivers/clk/ti/gate.c driver of the Linux kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/ti/gate.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The patch adds support for TI divider clock binding. The driver uses
routines provided by the common clock framework (ccf).
The code is based on the drivers/clk/ti/divider.c driver of the Linux
kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/ti/divider.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The digital phase-locked loop (DPLL) provides all interface clocks and
functional clocks to the processor of the AM33xx device. The AM33xx
device integrates five different DPLLs:
* Core DPLL
* Per DPLL
* LCD DPLL
* DDR DPLL
* MPU DPLL
The patch adds support for the compatible strings:
* "ti,am3-dpll-core-clock"
* "ti,am3-dpll-no-gate-clock"
* "ti,am3-dpll-no-gate-j-type-clock"
* "ti,am3-dpll-x2-clock"
The code is loosely based on the drivers/clk/ti/dpll.c drivers of the
Linux kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/ti/dpll.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
The driver manages a register-mapped multiplexer with multiple input
clock signals or parents, one of which can be selected as output. It
uses routines provided by the common clock framework (ccf).
The code is based on the drivers/clk/ti/mux.c driver of the Linux
kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/clock/ti/mux.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
It returns the rate which will be set if you ask clk_set_rate() to set
that rate. It provides a way to query exactly what rate you'll get if
you call clk_set_rate() with that same argument.
So essentially, clk_round_rate() and clk_set_rate() are equivalent
except the former does not modify the clock hardware in any way.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
There have been several changes to the am33xx.dtsi, so this patch
re-syncs it with Linux.
Let's add proper interconnect hierarchy for l4 interconnect instances
with the related ti-sysc interconnect module data as documented in
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/bus/ti-sysc.txt of the Linux kernel.
With l4 interconnect hierarchy and ti-sysc interconnect target module
data in place, we can simply move all the related child devices to their
proper location and enable probing using ti-sysc.
The am33xx-clock.dtsi file is the same as that of the Linux kernel,
except for the reg property of the node l4-wkup-clkctrl@0.
As for the am33xx.dtsi file, all the devices with drivers not yet
implemented and those I was able to test with this patch have been moved
to am33xx-l4.dtsi. In case of any regressions, problem devices can be
reverted by moving them back and removing the related interconnect
target module node.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
We can handle the sysc interconnect target module in a generic way for
many TI SoCs. Initially let's just enable domain clocks before the
children are probed.
The code is loosely based on the drivers/bus/ti-sysc.c of the Linux
kernel version 5.9-rc7.
For DT binding details see:
- Documentation/devicetree/bindings/bus/ti-sysc.txt
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Add support for PRUSS SYSC type:
The PRUSS module has a SYSCFG which is unique. The SYSCFG has two
additional unique fields called STANDBY_INIT and SUB_MWAIT in addition
to regular IDLE_MODE and STANDBY_MODE fields. Add the bindings for this
new sysc type.
Add support for MCAN on dra76x:
The dra76x MCAN generic interconnect module has a its own format for the
bits in the control registers.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Export routines that can be used by other drivers avoiding duplicating
code.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As more and more LINUX drivers are modified to use asynchronous probing
instead of synchronous probing, relying on device names being equal in
U-Boot and LINUX is not possible anymore. This is also true for block
device names like mmc0, mmc1 ect.
With LINUX kernel commit a1a4891 the probing type for the sdhci-omap
driver has been set to asynchronous mode too (probe_type is now
PROBE_PREFER_ASYNCHRONOUS).
In the case of the PDU001 board this results in the devices mmc0 and
mmc1 being swapped between U-Boot and LINUX. Device mmc0 in U-Boot
becomes mmc1 in LINUX an vice versa. Hence using device name identifiers
with LINUX kernel parameter root does not work anymore.
This patch changes the LINUX kernel boot parameter root to use the
pseudo (since we use MBR not GPT) partition UUID to locate the partition
hosting the root file system.
Signed-off-by: Felix Brack <fb@ltec.ch>
Update the ddr settings to use the DDR reg config tool rev 0.5.0.
This enables 4266MTs DDR configuration.
Signed-off-by: Praneeth Bajjuri <praneeth@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Kevin Scholz <k-scholz@ti.com>
McSPI IP provides per CS specific speed and mode selection. Therefore it
is possible to apply these settings only after CS is known. But
set_speed and set_mode can be called without bus being claimed, this
would lead driver to set up wrong CS (or previously used CS).
Fix this by apply set_speed and set_mode only if bus is already claimed.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Tested-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
struct ti_qspi_priv->max_hz is declared as unsigned int, so the following
error path check will always be false, even when "spi-max-frequency"
property is invalid/missing:
priv->max_hz = fdtdec_get_int(blob, node, "spi-max-frequency", -1);
if (priv->max_hz < 0) {
...
}
Replace the fdtdec call with dev_read_u32_default() and use 0 as the
default value. Error out if max_hz is zero.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
The value of input pin for bank > 0 is always 0 for input subcommand.
The reason is that gpio_bank variable is computed only for invert and
output subcommands (it depends on number of arguments). The default
value of zero causes to shift the mask away for banks > 0.
Please note that info subcommand works as expected, because the input
pin values are accessed differently.
Fixes: 61c1775f16 ("gpio: tca642x: Add the tca642x gpio expander driver")
Cc: Dan Murphy <dmurphy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Tomas Novotny <tomas@novotny.cz>
In include/dfu.h, if CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE is not defined then it is
defined as CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE. This is 128 KiB for a53 core and
20 KiB for r5 core. If a larger file is transferred using dfu then it
fails.
CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE can not be increased as there is not enough
heap memory to be allocated for the buffer in case of R5 spl.
Fix this by defining CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE as the default
CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE value.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
The sequence number assigned for USB subsystem in a uclass is dependent on
the order of occurrence in the device tree. If the dr_mode of USB3SS0
controller is varied then the sequence number of USB3SS1 controller also
changes. If aliases are added then sequence numbers are assigned using the
alias number. This makes the sequence number of USB3SS1 controller
independent of USB3SS0 controller's dr_mode.
Therefore, add aliases to fix the sequence number assigned to the USB
subsystems.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
It has been observed that setting SERDES0 lane mux to USB prevents USB 2.0
operation on USB0. Setting SERDES0 lane mux to non-USB when USB0 is used in
USB 2.0 only mode solves this issue. However, for USB3.0+2.0 operation this
issue is not present.
Implement this workaround by writing 1 to LANE_FUNC_SEL field in
CTRLMMR_SERDES0_CTRL register.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
- Pinecube board support
- 64-bit FEL support
- mkimage support for eGON images (superseding mksunxiboot)
- Bluetooth BD address generation
- some fixes
Some Bluetooth controllers, like the BCM4345C5 of the Orange Pi 3,
ship with the controller default address.
Add a config option to fix it up so it can function properly.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Ondrej Jirman <megous@megous.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
[rebased]
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
It turns out that in rare cases, current analytical approach to detect
correct DRAM bus width and rank on H6 doesn't work. On some TV boxes
with DDR3, incorrect DRAM configuration triggers write leveling error
which immediately stops initialization process. Exact reason why this
error appears isn't known. However, if correct configuration is used,
initalization works without problem.
In order to fix this issue, simply try another configuration when any
kind of error appears during initialization, not just those related to
rank and bus width.
Signed-off-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Tested-by: Thomas Graichen <thomas.graichen@googlemail.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
For the sake of consistency (*) and order of initialization, i.e.
after we have got the ethernet address, interrupt and timer initialized,
try to initialize USB ethernet gadget.
*) for example, zynqmp uses same order.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
So far we did not support the BootROM based FEL USB debug mode on the
64-bit builds for Allwinner SoCs: The BootROM is using AArch32, but the
SPL runs in AArch64.
Returning back to AArch32 was not working as expected, since the RMR
reset into 32-bit mode always starts execution in the BootROM, but not
in the FEL routine.
After some debug and research and with help via IRC, the CPU hotplug
mechanism emerged as a solution: If a certain R_CPUCFG register contains
some magic, the BootROM will immediately branch to an address stored in
some other register. This works well for our purposes.
Enable the FEL feature by providing early AArch32 code to first save the
FEL state, *before* initially entering AArch64.
If we eventually determine that we should return to FEL, we reset back
into AArch32, and use the CPU hotplug mechanism to run some small
AArch32 code snippet that restores the initially saved FEL state.
That allows the normal AArch64 SPL build to be loaded via the sunxi-fel
tool, with it returning into FEL mode, so that other payloads can be
transferred via FEL as well.
Tested on A64, H5 and H6.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Tested-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Tested-by: Priit Laes <plaes@plaes.org> (on Olimex A64-Olinuxino)
The is_boot0_magic macro is missing parentheses around the macro
argument, breaking any usage with a more complex argument.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Switch the SPL boot image generation from using mksunxiboot to the new
sunxi_egon format of mkimage.
Verified to create identical results for all 152 Allwinner boards.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
So far we used the separate mksunxiboot tool for generating a bootable
image for Allwinner SPLs, probably just for historical reasons.
Use the mkimage framework to generate a so called eGON image the
Allwinner BROM expects.
The new image type is called "sunxi_egon", to differentiate it
from the (still to be implemented) secure boot TOC0 image.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To be able to easily share the Allwinner eGON BROM header structure
between the tools and the SPL code, move the struct definition into a
separate header file.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Jernej Skrabec <jernej.skrabec@siol.net>
Reviewed-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
PineCube is an IP camera development kit released by Pine64.
It comes with the following compoents:
- A mainboard with Sochip S3 SoC, a 16MByte SPI Flash, AXP209 PMIC,
a power-only microUSB connector, a USB Type-A connector, a 10/100Mbps
Ethernet port and FPC connectors for camera and daughter board.
- An OV5640-based camera module which is connected to the parallel CSI
bus of the mainboard.
- A daughterboard with several buttons, a SD slot, some IR LEDs, a
microphone and a speaker connector.
As the device tree is synchronized in a previous commit, just add it to
Makefile, create a new MAINTAINER item and provide a defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Detect eMMC or SD card boot on Odroid-C4/N2 and Khadas VIM3(l) boards and
report proper MMC device for the environment loading code. This allows to
automatically load and store environment variables on the FAT partition
or RAW offset of the MMC device without the need to use different
configurations on eMMC and SD card.
To use this feature with environment stored on FAT partition, one has to
specify an empty device part (i.e. ":1" for the first partition) in
CONFIG_ENV_FAT_DEVICE_AND_PART to let the code to set the device to the
value returned by mmc_get_env_dev() function.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add a defconfig for the Beelink GT-King Pro Android STB, which is based
on the Amlogic W400 reference design.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add a defconfig for the Beelink GT-King Android STB, which is based
on the Amlogic W400 reference design.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Import the Beelink GT-King/Pro and supporting meson-g12b-w400.dtsi file
from Linux 5.10.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Analog to Digital Converter device (Meson SARADC) will be used for
probing 'Function' button state.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
[narmstrong: also updated khadas-vim3l_defconfig]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The driver skips hardware initialization if it is already configured by
the earlier bootloader stage (BL30). Skip the initialization only if the
hardware is really initialized and enabled.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Update the device matrix and add build instructions.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
[narmstrong: added wetek-core2.rst to q200 MAINTAINERS and added blank lines to fix build]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add a config for the WeTek Core2, largely based on the VIM2 config.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
[narmstrong: added wetek-core2_defconfig to q200 MAINTAINERS]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Import the WeTek Core2 and supporting meson-gx-p23x-q20x.dtsi files
from Linux 5.10.
Signed-off-by: Christian Hewitt <christianshewitt@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add support for the Amlogic based libretech cc version 2.
As version 1, it is based on the s905x SoC.
Signed-off-by: Jerome Brunet <jbrunet@baylibre.com>
[narmstrong: Fixed libretech-cc.rst bullet points]
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Sync the libretech cc v2 device tree from Linux v5.10-rc1
commit 3650b228f83a ("Linux 5.10-rc1")
Signed-off-by: Jerome Brunet <jbrunet@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This adds support for the TDO TL070WSH30 TFT-LCD panel module.
The panel has a 1024×600 resolution and uses 24 bit RGB per pixel.
It provides a MIPI DSI interface to the host, a built-in LED backlight
and touch controller.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Linux 5.10-rc1 uses the new generic driver, so switch to it since GXBB and
later is now supported.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
On the XEA board (imx28) one needs in the SPL support for GPIO, MMC and
SPI. Two last ones are necessary for booting the device. The GPIO support
allows deciding which medium will be used. For example the GPIO DTS node
(gpio@0 at imx28.dtsi) has pinctrl parent (pinctrl@80018000) for which we
don't need driver asigned for correct operation.
In the spl/dts/dt-platdata.c the gpio@0 has index 4 and its parent -
pinctrl@80018000 has index 5.
In the bind_drivers_pass() function (at drivers/core/lists.c) call to
device_bind_by_name() for `fsl_imx23_pinctrl` returns -2, which is
expected.
With current setup - when the SPL_OF_PLATDATA_PARENT=y
The gpio@0 node with index 4 is skipped as its parent with 5 is not yet
bound. It cannot be as we don't need and provide the driver for it.
As a result the gpio@0 is never bound and we end up with bricked board in
the SPL stage.
When CONFIG_SPL_OF_PLATDATA_PARENT is NOT set, all entries from
spl/dts/dt-platdata.c are scanned in ascending index order, so gpio@0 is
properly initialized. For `fsl_imx_pinctrl` we simply check 10 times if
the driver for is available (which is not) and exit.
As a result the GPIOs are initialized and can be used in early SPL stage.
This commit fixes XEA regression introduced with e41651fffd.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The usage of the preboot feature is now controlled via a separate Kconfig
option - namely CONFIG_USE_PREBOOT.
It must be enabled for preboot code executing commands now defined in
CONFIG_PREBOOT (also moved to the Kconfig).
After defining both CONFIG_USE_PREBOOT and CONFIG_PREBOOT in
imx28_xea_defconfig the define of CONFIG_PREBOOT shall be removed from
xea.h as it is redundant.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
On the imx287 pin GPMI_WRN (GPIO0_25) no PullUP is available that can be
enabled.
To get the same behavior for both boot select pins (i.e. GPIO0_2{35})
disable pull UPs on both.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
SPI flash on this machine is located on bus 1, default to using bus 1
for SPI flash and stop aliasing it to bus 0.
Signed-off-by: Hugh Cole-Baker <sigmaris@gmail.com>
Suggested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: c4cea2bb ("rockchip: Enable building a SPI ROM image on bob")
TXC line is directly connected from the SoC to the KSZ9131 PHY. There
is a transient state on this signal, before configuring it to RGMII,
which leads to packet transmit being blocked.
Keeping a pull-up when muxing this pin as function A (G0_TXCK) fixes
the issue.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Ferre <nicolas.ferre@microchip.com>
Obtain two MAC addresses from the two EEPROMs and configure the two
available Ethernet interfaces accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add node for flx1 i2c1 subnode (and alias to bus 0)
This bus has two eeprom devices connected.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add new config for storing environment from sdmmc0.
Also clean-up sama7g5ek_emmc1 to point to the proper mmc device.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Clean-up boot command to use the predefined device and part for FAT
environment.
According to this device and partition, select the proper boot media.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Enable sdmmc0 on this board. A non-removable eMMC is connected on this
block.
Configure pincontrol accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
SDMMC1 requires clock specification with assigned-clocks, such that
the PMC will know which parent to assign and the initial start-up frequency.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Get rid of software defined MCK and switch to PMC bindings
for IPs currently present in device tree.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Heap base address is computed based on SYS_INIT_SP_ADDR by
subtracting the SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN value in
board_init_f_init_reserve().
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
As highlighted by Stefan in the commit e074d0f79b ("arm: at91:
gardena-smart-gateway-at91sam: Enable CONFIG_SYS_NAND_USE_FLASH_BBT")
it's important to use BBT when Linux enables it. We use it for a long
time on all our boards.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Ferre <nicolas.ferre@microchip.com>
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Acked-by: Alexander Dahl <ada@thorsis.com>
Xilinx changes for v2021.04
arm64:
- DT updates
microblaze:
- Add support for NOR device support
spi:
- Fix unaligned data write issue
nand:
- Minor code change
xilinx:
- Fru fix in limit calculation
- Fill git repo link for all Xilinx boards
video:
- Add support for seps525 spi display
tools:
- Minor Vitis file support
cmd/common
- Minor code indentation fixes
serial:
- Uartlite debug uart initialization fix
The GPIO hog flags are ignored by gpiolib-of.c now, set the flags to 0.
Due to a change in gpiolib-of.c, setting flags to GPIO_ACTIVE_LOW and
using output-low DT property leads to the GPIO being set high instead.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Driver model: make some udevice fields private
Driver model: Rename U_BOOT_DEVICE et al.
dtoc: Tidy up and add more tests
ns16550 code clean-up
x86 and sandbox minor fixes for of-platdata
dtoc prepration for adding build-time instantiation
Some of these tests don't actually check anything. Add a few more checks
to complete the tests.
Also add a simple scan test that does the basics.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move the tests related to scanning into their own class, updating them
to avoid using dtb_platdata as a pass-through.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Before expanding the scanning features any more, move this into a separate
file. This will make it easier to maintain in the future. In particular,
it reduces the size of dtb_platdata.py and allows us to add tests
specifically for scanning, without going through that file.
The pieces moved are the Driver class, the scanning code and the various
naming functions, since they mostly depend on the scanning results.
So far there is are no separate tests for src_scan. These will be added
as new functionality appears.
This introduces no functional change.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This has not been needed since parent information was added and we started
using indicies for references to other drivers instead of pointers. It was
kept around in the expectation that it might be needed later.
However with the latest updates, it doesn't seem likely that we'll need
this in the foreseeable future.
Drop dm_populate_phandle_data() from dtoc and driver model.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Previously we had to worry about nodes being output before those that they
depended on, thus causing build errors. So the current algorithm is
careful to output nodes in the right order.
We now use a different method for outputting phandles that does not
involve pointers. Also we plan to add a 'declarations' header file to
declare all drivers as 'extern'.
Update the code to drop the dependency checking and output in a simple
loop. This makes the output easier to follow since drivers are in order of
thier indices (0, 1, ...), which is also the order it appears in in the
linker list.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The base directory of U-Boot, where the source is, it currently calculated
from the directory of the dtb_platdata.py script. If this is installed
elsewhere that will not work. Also it is inconvenient for tests.
Add a parameter to allow specifying this base directory.
To test this, pass a temporary directory with some files in it and check
that they are passed to scan_driver().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than the if/else construct, update OutputFile with the method to
call to process each command. This is easier to maintain as the number of
commands increases.
Rename generate_tables to generate_plat since it better describes what is
being generated ('plat' is the U-Boot name for platform data).
With this, each output method needs to have the same signature. Store the
output structures in a member variable instead of using parameters, to
accomplish this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use this new name to be consistent with the rest of U-Boot, which talks
about 'plat' for the platform data, which is what this file holds.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is currently fairly obvious what the two generated files are for, but
this will change as more are added. It is helpful for readers to describe
the purpose of each file.
Add a header commment field to OutputFile and use it to generate a comment
at the top of each file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the standard function for running tests and reported results. This
allows the tests to run in parallel, which is a significant speed-up on
most machines (e.g. 4.5 seconds -> 1.5s on mine).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This gives a warning in some situations:
File "tools/dtoc/../concurrencytest/concurrencytest.py", line 95,
in do_fork
stream = os.fdopen(c2pread, 'rb', 1)
File "/usr/lib/python3.8/os.py", line 1023, in fdopen
return io.open(fd, *args, **kwargs)
RuntimeWarning: line buffering (buffering=1) isn't supported in binary
mode, the default buffer size will be used
Fix this by dropping the line-buffer parameter.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We use the U_BOOT_ prefix (i.e. U_BOOT_DRIVER) to declare a driver but
in every other case we just use DM_. Update the alias macros to use the
DM_ prefix.
We could perhaps rename U_BOOT_DRIVER() to DM_DRIVER(), but this macro
is widely used and there is at least some benefit to indicating it us a
U-Boot driver, particularly for code ported from Linux. So for now, let's
keep that name.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the spirit of using the same base name for all of these related macros,
rename this to have the operation at the end. This is not widely used so
the impact is fairly small.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This does not get a device (struct udevice *) but a struct driver_info *
so the name is confusing.
Rename it accordingly. Since we plan to have several various of these
macros, put GET at the end instead of the middle, so it is easier to spot
the related macros.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current macro is a misnomer since it does not declare a device
directly. Instead, it declares driver_info record which U-Boot uses at
runtime to create a device.
The distinction seems somewhat minor most of the time, but is becomes
quite confusing when we actually want to declare a device, with
of-platdata. We are left trying to distinguish between a device which
isn't actually device, and a device that is (perhaps an 'instance'?)
It seems better to rename this macro to describe what it actually is. The
macros is not widely used, since boards should use devicetree to declare
devices.
Rename it to U_BOOT_DRVINFO(), which indicates clearly that this is
declaring a new driver_info record, not a device.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the Makefile to run dtoc only once, generating all required files.
This saves time since there is a lot of processing in each invocation of
dtoc.
We already have a variable for the object files to build, so use that
instead of repeating the same filenames. Add a C version of this also,
for the same reason.
This makes it easier to add new C files (generated by dtoc) to the build
later, as needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With upcoming changes, dtoc will output several files for different
of-platdata components.
Add a way to output all ava!ilable files at once ('all'), to the
appropriate directories, without needing to specify each one invidually.
This puts the commands in alphabetical order, so update the tests
accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Implement the 'output directory' feature, allowing dtoc to write the
output files separately to the supplied directories. This allows us to
handle the struct and platdata output in one run of dtoc.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present dtoc writes only a single file on each invocation. U-Boot
writes the two files it needs by separate invocations of dtoc. Since dtoc
now scans all U-Boot driver source, this is fairly slow (about 1 second
per file).
It would be better if dtoc could write all the files at once.
In preparation for this, add a way to specify an output directory for the
files.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Normally dtoc outputs to a file but it also offers a way to write output
to stdout. At present the test for that does not actually check that the
output is correct. Add this to the test.
This uses a member variable to hold the expected text, so it can be used
in muitiple places.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present dtoc uses '-' internally to mean that output should go to
stdout. This is not necessary and None is more convenient. Update it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the uclass list head is in global_data. This is convenient
but with the new of-platdata we need the list head to be declared by
the generated code.
Change this over to be a pointer. Provide a 'static' version in
global_data to retain the current behaviour.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move the code related to scanning for devices to bind, into a new
function. This will make it easier to skip this step with the new
of-platdata improvements.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To avoid having people accidentally access this member, add a trailing
underscore. Also remove it when of-platdata is enabled, since it is not
used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present ofnode is present in the device even if it is never used. With
of-platdata this field is not used, so can be removed. In preparation for
this, change the access to go through inline functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We have two functions which do the same thing. Standardise on
dev_has_ofnode() since there is no such thing as an 'invalid' ofnode in
normal operation: it is either null or missing.
Also move the functions into one place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
At present flags are stored as part of the device. In preparation for
storing them separately, change the access to go through inline functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that the sequence-numbering migration is complete, rename this member
back to seq_, adding an underscore to indicate it is internal to driver
model.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Add a new function to handle the allocation of private/platform data for
a device. This will make it easier to skip this feature when using the new
of-platdata.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some devices are not needed in SPL/TPL. For TPL this causes the
generation of unnecessary of-platadata structs. Make some adjustments to
fix this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this driver calls malloc() to start a new platform data
structure, fills it in and tells driver model to use it.
We want to avoid malloc, particularly with the new version of of-platdata.
Create a new struct which encompasses both the dtd struct and the ns16550
one, to avoid this. Unfortunately we must copy the data into the right
place for the ns16550 driver. Add some comments about this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the new of-platdata, these need to be available to dt_platdata.c
so must be in header files. Move them and add the dtd struct too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
With the new of-platdata, these need to be available to dt_platdata.c
so must be in header files. Move them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This construct effectively uses struct spi_nor due to a #define in
spi-nor.h so we may as well use that struct here. This allows dtoc to
parse it correctly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The #define of one struct to another has been around for a while. It
confuses dtoc and makes it think that struct spi_flash does not exist.
Make a few changes to improve things while we wait for migration to be
completed:
- Move the 'struct spi_flash' to column 1 so dtoc scans it
- Remove the #define when compiling dt-platdata.c
- Update the strange mtd_get/set_of_node() functions
- Use struct spi_nor in the drivers, so dtoc sees the correct struct
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This code is a bit odd in that it only reads and updates the livetree
version of the device ofnode. This means it won't work with flattree.
Update the code to work as it was presumably intended.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the new of-platdata, these need to be available to dt_platdata.c
so must be in header files. Move them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the new of-platdata, these need to be available to dt_platdata.c
so must be in header files. Move them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the new of-platdata, these need to be available to dt_platdata.c
so must be in header files. Move them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there are require a few devices in the devicetree which are
not actually used in SPL. This will cause problems with the new
of-platdata, since it will try to instantiate devices which are not
compiled into U-Boot.
Update the devicetree to remove these devices from SPL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this driver does not have a compatible string. For it to be
used with the coming of-platadata, it must have one. Update it
accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move this struct into a header file so that dtoc can include it in its
dt-platdata.c file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Update management of "--rm_memory" sandbox's option and force
this option when U-Boot is loaded by SPL in os_spl_to_uboot()
and remove the ram file after reading in main() as described
in option help message: "Remove memory file after reading".
This patch avoids that the file "/tmp/u-boot.mem.XXXXXX" [created in
os_jump_to_file() when U-Boot is loaded by SPL] is never deleted
because state_uninit() is not called after U-Boot execution
(CtrlC or with running pytest for example).
This issue is reproduced by
> build-sandbox_spl/spl/u-boot-spl
and CtrlC in U-Bot console
> make qcheck
One temp file is created after each SPL and U-Boot execution
(7 tims in qcheck after test_handoff.py, test_ofplatdata.py,
test_spl.py execution).
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These errors are only really for development purposes. Drop them to reduce
the size of TPL. The error numbers are still reported.
This reduces the TPL binary size on coral by about 160 bytes.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update various drivers to use of_match_ptr() and to avoid including debug
strings in TPL. Omit the WiFi driver entirely, since it is not used in
TPL.
This reduces the TPL binary size by about 608 bytes.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present several strings from this file appear in the TPL binary. Add
preprocessor checks to drop them.
This reduces the TPL binary size by about 128 bytes.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present these settings are in the node for host-bridge and so are
visible in TPL as well as SPL. But they are only used for SPL.
Move them to a subnode so that TPL does not included them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When this code is not used (e.g. by TPL) we want it to be excluded from
the image. Put it in its own section so that this happens.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this member holds a simple list of driver names. Update it to
be a dict of DriverInfo, with the name being the key. This will allow more
information to be added about each driver, in future patches.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reduce the length of output_node() futher by moving the struct-output
functionality into a two separate functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is annoying to have this function inside its parent since it makes the
parent longer and hard to read. Move it to the top level.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These have crept in again. Update the file to fix all but these ones:
dtb_platdata.py:143:0: R0902: Too many instance attributes (10/7)
(too-many-instance-attributes)
dtb_platdata.py:713:0: R0913: Too many arguments (6/5)
(too-many-arguments)
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present several test drivers are part of the test file itself. Some of
these are useful for of-platdata tests. Separate them out so we can use
them for other things also.
A few adjustments are needed so this driver can build for sandbox_spl as
well.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the entire test state is effective passed into a test driver
just to record which device was removed. This is unnecessary and makes it
harder to track what is going on.
Use a simple boolean instead.
Also drop the unused 'removed' member while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This error should not happen in normal use. Reduce the length of it to
save space in the image.
Add an empty spl.h file to sh since it appears to lack this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present it is not possible to include spl.h in on these architectures
since the asm/spl.h file is not present. We want to be able to use the
spl_phase() function, so add empty headers to make things build.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These are supposed to be private to driver model, not accessed by any code
outside. Add a trailing underscore to indicate this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use these functions in the core code as much as possible. With this, there
are only two places where each priv/plat pointer is accessed, one for read
and one for write.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Most drivers use these access methods but a few do not. Update them.
In some cases the access is not permitted, so mark those with a FIXME tag
for the maintainer to check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Acked-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add functions so this information is not accessed directly. This will be
needed for of-platdata which stores it in a different place.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This code was kept around after of-platdata started supporting parent
devices. That feature seems stable now, so let's drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the name 'uclass_driver' is used for the uclass linker list.
This does not follow the convention of using the struct name. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the output from this function is hard to read in SPL, due to
(intended) limitations in SPL's printf() function. Add an SPL version so
it is clearer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This uses up space in the SPL binary but it always starts as zero. Also
some boards cannot support data in TPL (e.g. Intel Apollo Lake).
Use malloc() to allocate this structure instead, by moving the init a
little later, after malloc() is inited. Make this function optional since
it pulls in malloc().
This reduces the TPL binary size on coral by about 64 bytes
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The spl-test4 node deliberately has an invalid compatible string. This
causes a warning from dtoc and the check it does is not really necessary.
Drop it, to avoid the warning and associated confusion.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Lower case should be used for function names. Update this driver and its
callers accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Typedefs should not be used in U-Boot and structs should be lower case.
Update the code to use struct ns16550 consistently.
Put a header guard on the file while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
At present the dtoc commmand line is repeated twice in the Makefile. Use a
variable to avoid this, so it is easier to add more conditional arguments.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the SPL_NAME variable to simplify the rules. Drop the SPL targets
clean-files since the SPL and TPL dts/ directories are removed by
existing rules. Move the SPL rules into a new spl_dtbs to avoid the
complicated $(if) construct.
Also drop unused pieces from the 'targets' variable.
With this, SPL and TPL have separate dtbs which respect the various
u-boot,dm-spl / u-boot,dm-tpl tags.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than putting these in the top-level dts/ directory (which is
intended for U-Boot proper), put them in the correct subdirectory for
SPL (either spl/ or tpl/). This is where other SPL targets are kept,
so this is more consistent.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present both SPL and TPL use the same devicetree binary. While there
is logic to run fdtgrep separately on each one, it does not actually
happen.
Add a new TPL rule and use that instead. Make this rule conditional on
there actually being a TPL. Do the same for SPL for consistency.
Note that the SPL and TPL dtbs are build by a Makefule rule used for
U-Boot proper. This is the 'dtbs' target in dts/Makefile. So the check
for CONFIG_TPL_BUILD in cmd_fdtgrep never actually works at present.
We don't support CONFIG_OF_EMBED for TPL at present.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It looks like that i2c bus lot of times timeout on some units. Prior
migration to CONFIG_DM_I2C i2c speed was set to CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED
value which was 100000. Lower speed fixes timeout problems, so change speed
back to its previous value.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Fixes: 8d8c181703 ("Nokia RX-51: Convert to CONFIG_DM_I2C")
Reviewed-by: Pavel Machek <pavel@ucw.cz>
Signed-off-by: Lokesh Vutla <lokeshvutla@ti.com>
Support reusing board_fit_config_name_match() to automatically
select a sensible default configuration for booting fitImages
using 'bootm'.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Replace most #ifdef checks for USE_HOSTCC and CONFIG_*
with normal if instructions.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
All Xilinx SoCs have repository location filled already but boards are
covered by different fragment which is missing this link.
The patch is extending description with adding proper link to the same
repository.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is a need to call sync when anybody asking for clearing display.
For example via cls command.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for the WiseChip Semiconductor Inc. (UG-6028GDEBF02) display
using the SEPS525 (Syncoam) LCD Controller. Syncoam Seps525 PM-Oled is RGB
160x128 display. This driver has been tested through zynq-spi driver.
ZynqMP> load mmc 1 100000 rainbow.bmp
61562 bytes read in 20 ms (2.9 MiB/s)
ZynqMP> bmp info 100000
Image size : 160 x 128
Bits per pixel: 24
Compression : 0
ZynqMP> bmp display 100000
ZynqMP> setenv stdout vidconsole
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some drivers like LCD connected via SPI requires explicit sync function
which copy framebuffer content over SPI to controller to display.
This hook doesn't exist yet that's why introduce it via video operations.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch is preparation for follow up one to support cases where
synchronization can fail.
Suggested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Place description below function parameters to make kernel-doc stript
happy. Also rename dev to vid to be aligned with function parameters.
Fixes: 1acafc73bf ("dm: video: Add a video uclass")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Building xilinx_zynq_virt_defconfig fails on origin/next as reported by
GCC 10.2 (as provided by Debian Bullseye):
CC board/xilinx/common/fru_ops.o
board/xilinx/common/fru_ops.c: In function ‘fru_capture’:
board/xilinx/common/fru_ops.c:173:8:
error: array subscript 284 is outside array bounds of
‘struct fru_table[1]’ [-Werror=array-bounds]
173 | limit = data + sizeof(struct fru_board_data);
| ~~~~~~^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
board/xilinx/common/fru_ops.c:17:18: note: while referencing ‘fru_data’
17 | struct fru_table fru_data __section(.data);
| ^~~~~~~~
When using sizeof(struct fru_board_data) to find the end of the structure
you should add it to the start of the structure.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This sort of code does not make much sense:
if (ondie_ecc_enabled) {
if (ondie_ecc_enabled) {
Remove the inner if.
The problem was indicated by cppcheck.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This patch add ethernet node gem1 to zcu1285 RevB.
GMII to RGMII converter sits between MAC and external
phy connected over GMII to MAC and RGMMI to external phy
Signed-off-by: Harini Katakam <harini.katakam@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This patch add ethernet node gem1 to zcu1275 RevB.
GMII to RGMII converter sits between MAC and external
phy connected over GMII to MAC and RGMMI to external phy.
Signed-off-by: Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu <siva.durga.paladugu@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This commits add a check on the command ubi rename. This check avoids
to rename a volume to with a name that is already used on another ubi
volume. If two volumes has the same name, then the ubi device can't be
mounted anymore.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
My address at Toradex doesn't exist anymore, map this address
to my personal email.
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
There might be hardware configurations where 64-bit data accesses
to NVMe registers are not supported properly. This patch removes
the readq/writeq so always two 32-bit accesses are used to read/write
64-bit NVMe registers, similarly as it is done in Linux kernel.
This patch fixes operation of NVMe devices on RPi4 Broadcom BCM2711 SoC
based board, where the PCIe Root Complex, which is attached to the
system through the SCB bridge.
Even though the architecture is 64-bit the PCIe BAR is 32-bit and likely
the 64-bit wide register accesses initiated by the CPU are not properly
translated to a sequence of 32-bit PCIe accesses.
nvme_readq(), for example, always returns same value in upper and lower
32-bits, e.g. 0x3c033fff3c033fff which lead to NVMe devices to fail
probing.
This fix is analogous to commit 8e2ab05000 ("usb: xhci: Use only
32-bit accesses in xhci_writeq/xhci_readq").
Cc: Sylwester Nawrocki <s.nawrocki@samsung.com>
Cc: Nicolas Saenz Julienne <nsaenzjulienne@suse.de>
Cc: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
When unaligned 3 bytes data write operation is performed, 3rd byte
is being over written by 1st byte of 3 bytes data. This patch
fixes it.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Set script_offset_nor env variable using CONFIG_BOOT_SCRIPT_OFFSET
and nor flash start address to keep bootscript offset configurable.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Endianness detection is checked against uninitialized ret variable.
Assign ret with read value from status register to fix this.
Fixes: 31a359f87e ("serial: uartlite: Add support to work with any endianness")
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for next
* UEFI capsule authentication
* UEFI capsule update on QEMU ARM
* fsuuid command for FAT file system
* bug fixes
Add documentation highlighting the steps for using the uefi capsule
update feature for updating the u-boot firmware image.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Add a efidebug subcommand to initiate a firmware update using the efi
firmware management protocol(fmp) set_image routine.
The firmware update can be initiated through
'efidebug capsule disk-update'
This would locate the efi capsule file on the efi system partition,
and call the platform's set_image fmp routine to initiate the firmware
update.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Add support for enabling uefi capsule authentication. This feature is
enabled by setting the environment variable
"capsule_authentication_enabled".
The following configs are needed for enabling uefi capsule update and
capsule authentication features on the platform.
CONFIG_EFI_HAVE_CAPSULE_SUPPORT=y
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_ON_DISK=y
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_FIRMWARE_MANAGEMENT=y
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_FIRMWARE=y
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_FIRMWARE_RAW=y
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_AUTHENTICATE=y
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Add support for authenticating uefi capsules. Most of the signature
verification functionality is shared with the uefi secure boot
feature.
The root certificate containing the public key used for the signature
verification is stored as part of the device tree blob. The root
certificate is stored as an efi signature list(esl) file -- this file
contains the x509 certificate which is the root certificate.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
The efi_sigstore_parse_sigdb function reads the uefi authenticated
variable, stored in the signature database format and builds the
signature store structure. Factor out the code for building
the signature store. This can then be used by the capsule
authentication routine to build the signature store even when the
signature database is not stored as an uefi authenticated variable
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
The pkcs7 header parsing functionality is pretty generic, and can be
used by other features like capsule authentication. Make the function
an extern, also changing it's name to efi_parse_pkcs7_header
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Prior to writing to an mtd device, mtd_erase is called. This call
fails in case the sector being erased is locked. Call mtd_unlock to
unlock the region which is to be erased and later written to. Lock the
region once the write to the region has completed.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
When building the capsule using scripts in edk2, a fmp header is
added on top of the binary payload. Add logic to detect presence of
the header. When present, the pointer to the image needs to be
adjusted as per the size of the header to point to the actual binary
payload.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
The fsp_types.h header file contains macros for building signatures of
different widths. These signature macros are architecture agnostic,
and can be used in all places which use signatures in a data
structure. Move and rename the fsp_types.h under the common include
header.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The dfu framework uses the dfu_alt_info environment variable to get
information that is needed for performing the firmware update. Add
logic to set the dfu_alt_info for the qemu arm64 platform to reflect
the two mtd partitions created for the u-boot env and the firmware
image. This can be subsequently extended for other qemu architectures
which need this variable set.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Add support for setting the default values for mtd partitions on the
platform. This would be used for updating the firmware image using
uefi capsule update with the dfu mtd backend driver.
Currently, values have been defined for the qemu arm64 platform, with
default values defined for the mtd partitions based on the NOR
flash. This can be subsequently extended for other qemu architectures
which need mtdparts set.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
RFC 2315 Section 9.3 describes the message digesting process. The
digest calculated depends on whether the authenticated attributes are
present. In case of a scenario where the authenticated attributes are
present, the message digest that gets signed and is part of the pkcs7
message is computed from the auth attributes rather than the contents
field.
Check if the auth attributes are present, and if set, use the auth
attributes to compute the hash that would be compared with the
encrypted hash on the pkcs7 message.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
On the qemu arm platform, the virtio devices are initialised in the
board_init function, which gets called before the initr_pci. With
this sequence, the virtio block devices on the pci bus are not
initialised. Move the initialisation of the virtio devices to
board_late_init which gets called after the call to initr_pci.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Add options for embedding the public key esl(efi signature list) file
to the platform's dtb. The esl file is then retrieved and used for
authenticating the capsule to be used for updating firmare components
on the platform.
The esl file can now be embedded in the dtb by invoking the following
command
mkeficapsule -K <pub_key.esl> -D <dtb>
In the scenario where the esl file is to be embedded in an overlay,
this can be done through the following command
mkeficapsule -O -K <pub_key.esl> -D <dtb>
This will create a node named 'signature' in the dtb, and the esl file
will be stored as 'capsule-key'
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
When a new event is queued we have to process the event queue by calling
efi_process_event_queue(). But there is not reason to call the function
when the event is not queueable.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Although the function description states the caller must provide a
sufficient buffer, it's better to have in function checks that the
destination buffer can hold the intended value.
So let's add an extra argument with the buffer size and check that
before doing any copying.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now we install the EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL to load an initrd
unconditionally. Although we correctly return various EFI exit codes
depending on the file status (i.e EFI_NO_MEDIA, EFI_NOT_FOUND etc), the
kernel loader only falls back to the cmdline interpreted initrd if the
protocol is not installed.
This creates a problem for EFI installers, since they won't be able to
load their own initrd and start the installation.
A following patch introduces a different logic where we search for an
initrd path defined in an EFI variable named 'Initrd####'.
If the bootmgr is used to launch the EFI payload, we'll will try to match
the BootCurrent value and find the corresponding initrd
(i.e Boot0000 -> Initrd0000 etc). If the file is found, we'll install
the required protocol which the kernel's efi-stub can use and load our
initrd.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
dm.h and env.h serve no purpose here. Remove them and sort the
remaining in alphabetical order.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Do not use data from the loaded image object after deleting it.
Fixes: 126a43f15b ("efi_loader: unload applications upon Exit()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
load_options passed from do_efibootmgr() to do_bootefi_exec() may contain
invalid data from the stack which will lead to an invalid free().
Fixes: 0ad64007fe ("efi_loader: set load options in boot manager")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now the escape key was not correctly detected in UEFI applications.
We had to hit it twice for a single escape to be recognized.
Use a 10 ms delay to detect if we are dealing with the escape key or an
escape sequence.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
IS_ENABLED() contains parentheses. But we should still put extra
parentheses around it in an if statement for readability.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The FAT file system does not have a UUID but a 4 byte volume ID.
Let the fsuuid command show it in XXXX-XXXX format.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The FAT filesystem implementation uses several marcros referring to a magic
variable name mydata which renders the code less readable. Eliminate one of
them which is only used for a debug() statement.
Use log_debug() instead of debug().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When opening an OP-TEE session we need to check the internal return
value of OP-TEE call arguments as well the return code of the
function itself.
The code was also ignoring to close the OP-TEE session in case the
shared memory registration failed.
Fixes: f042e47e8f ("efi_loader: Implement EFI variable handling via OP-TEE")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently the size of the buffer to keep UEFI variables in memory is fixed
at 16384 bytes. This size has proven to be too small for some use cases.
Make the size of the memory buffer for UEFI variables customizable.
Reported-by: Paulo Alcantara (SUSE) <pc@cjr.nz>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc5 (2)
The following errors in the UEFI sub-system are fixed:
* use after free in efi_exit()
* invalid free when using the boot manager
* pressing escape key once not recognized
Do not use data from the loaded image object after deleting it.
Fixes: 126a43f15b ("efi_loader: unload applications upon Exit()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
load_options passed from do_efibootmgr() to do_bootefi_exec() may contain
invalid data from the stack which will lead to an invalid free().
Fixes: 0ad64007fe ("efi_loader: set load options in boot manager")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Up to now the escape key was not correctly detected in UEFI applications.
We had to hit it twice for a single escape to be recognized.
Use a 10 ms delay to detect if we are dealing with the escape key or an
escape sequence.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
IS_ENABLED() contains parentheses. But we should still put extra
parentheses around it in an if statement for readability.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This reverts commit 828d326216.
This change revers code which asserting PERST# signal when unloading
driver. Driver's remove callback is still there as it is used for other
functionality.
Asserting PERST# signal prior booting kernel is causing that A3720 boards
(Turris MOX and Espressobin) with stable Linux kernel versions 4.14 and
4.19 are not able to detect some PCIe cards (e.g. Compex WLE200 and WLE900)
and anymore. When PERST# signal is not asserted these cards are detected
correctly. As this is regression for existing stable Linux kernel versions
revert this problematic change in U-Boot.
To make cards working with OpenWRT 4.14 kernel it is needed to disable link
training prior booting kernel, which is already done in driver's remove
callback.
Described issue is in Linux kernel pci aardvark driver which is (hopefully)
fixed in latest upstream versions. Latest upstream versions should be able
to initialize PCIe bus and detects cards independently of the link training
and PERST# signal state.
So with this change, U-Boot on A3720 boards should be able to boot OpenWRT
4.14 kernel, stable 4.14 and 4.19 kernels and also latest mainline kernels.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
For correct spi bus detection the spi0 alias is needed in the DT.
Otherwise this error will ocurr in U-Boot:
Invalid bus 0 (err=-19)
Failed to initialize SPI flash at 0:0 (error -19)
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Dennis Gilmore <dgilmore@redhat.com>
Tested-by: Dennis Gilmore <dgilmore@redhat.com>
Add some missing "u-boot,dm-pre-reloc;" properties to UART0, SPI
controller and SPI NOR flash node to enable usage in SPL. Otherwise
these devices will not be available.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Dennis Gilmore <dgilmore@redhat.com>
Tested-by: Dennis Gilmore <dgilmore@redhat.com>
Use 0x%2lx to print the i2c bus base address in hexadecimal format
instead of printing as an integer.
Signed-off-by: Marc Ferland <ferlandm@amotus.ca>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Use %u and not %d for unsigned values.
Print kHz and not khz.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The dart6ul has an i2c eeprom at 0x50 which contains, among other
things, the manufacturing/revision/options info of the SoM. This patch
replaces the current checkboard() implementation with a more
exhaustive one based on the content of the eeprom.
Since this code uses the new driver model, some changes were also
required in the DTS to make the nodes related to i2c available before
relocation.
This code was inspired from the supported u-boot code from Variscite
which can be found here:
https://github.com/varigit/uboot-imx/tree/imx_v2018.03_4.14.78_1.0.0_ga_var02
New output example:
Board: PN: VSM-6UL-705B, Assy: AS1812142257, Date: 2019 Feb 17
Storage: eMMC, Wifi: yes, DDR: 1024 MiB, Rev: 2.4G
Signed-off-by: Marc Ferland <ferlandm@amotus.ca>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The eeprom at address 0x50 is a BR24G04NUX-3TTR. It has a
4Kbit (512x8) capacity, change the compatible string to reflect this
fact.
Also, add an alias to easily refer to this eeprom with
fdt_path_offset() which will be in another commit.
Signed-off-by: Marc Ferland <ferlandm@amotus.ca>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Hand over maintainership of Toradex SoMs (that I was responsible of) to
Oleksandr because of my resignation from Toradex, as such I will
have no immediate involvement with these modules and as a result not
able to continue maintaining these boards.
CC: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
When booting imx8mp-evk the following allocation error
message is seen:
U-Boot 2021.01-rc3-00200-ge668bec96a5f (Dec 21 2020 - 14:36:42 -0300)
alloc space exhausted
Fix it by increasing CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN to 0x10000 like it
is done on other i.MX8MM/8MN boards.
Reported-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Calling ahab_close cmd force the user to interact for confirmation.
This is not user-friendly when using this cmd during factory process.
Allow the user to pass '-y' option to bypass this confirmation.
Signed-off-by: Clément Péron <peron.clem@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Acked-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
The current PHY rework does the following things:
1. Configure 125MHz clock
2. Setup the TX clock delay (RX is enabled by default),
3. Setup reserved bits to avoid voltage peak
The clock delays are nowadays already configured by the
PHY driver (in ar803x_delay_config). The code for that
can simply be dropped. The clock speed can also be
configured by the PHY driver by adding the device tree
property "qca,clk-out-frequency".
What is left is setting up the undocumented reserved bits
to avoid the voltage peak problem. I slightly improved its
documentation while updating the board's PHY rework code.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Instead of hardcoding index magic numbers in the board code,
also rely on board_fit_config_name_match choosing the right
config for the fitImage containing the kernel.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc5
* In the Standalone MM based implementation of UEFI variables
check the internal OP-TEE return code
When opening an OP-TEE session we need to check the internal return
value of OP-TEE call arguments as well the return code of the
function itself.
The code was also ignoring to close the OP-TEE session in case the
shared memory registration failed.
Fixes: f042e47e8f ("efi_loader: Implement EFI variable handling via OP-TEE")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add a host_build() function, so that it's possible to
check for software being build with USE_HOSTCC without
relying on preprocessor conditions. In other words
#ifdef USE_HOSTCC
host_only_code();
#endif
can be written like this instead:
if (host_build())
host_only_code();
This improves code readability and test coverage and
compiler will eleminate this unreachable code.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
After the conversion to device tree the board information becomes
redundant:
Model: Freescale i.MX6 Quad Plus SABRE Smart Device Board
Board: MX6-SabreSD
Remove the printing of the board information.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
i.MX8M series includes support for high speed modes in uSDHC controllers.
Turn on corresponding configuration options for EVK boards, which would
enable high speed modes to be included in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
i.MX8M series provide support for high speed grades in their
usdhc controllers, which has eMMC and SDHC connected to them.
Enable this support across the entire i.MX8M family by providing quirks
to usdhc controllers designated by storage media connected to them.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Some SD Card controller and power circuitry has increased capacitance,
which keeps the internal logic remains powered after regulator is switch
off. This is generally the case when card is switched to SD104 mode,
where a power cycle should be performed. In case if the card internal
logic remains powered, it causes a subsequent failure of mode
transition, effectively leading to failed enumeration.
Introduce a delay of 20 msec in order to provide a possibility for
internal card circuitry to drain voltages and perform a power cycle
correctly.
Similar fix is done in commit c49d0ac38a ("ARM: dts: rmobile: Increase
off-on delay on the SD Vcc regulator") targeted Renesas SOCs.
Signed-off-by: Andrey Zhizhikin <andrey.zhizhikin@leica-geosystems.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
There have been some updates to the device tree since 5.6.
This also includes some clocks, and makes it easier to keep
board device tree files in sync with Linux
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fixed wrong PHY Interface Mode
As per kernel commit 0672d22a1924 ("ARM: dts: imx: Fix the AR803X phy-mode)
the correct phy-mode should be "rgmii-id", so fix it accordingly
to fix the Ethernet regression.
This problem has been exposed by commit:
commit 13114f38e2
Fix the phy-mode accordingly to fix the regression.
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
A recent change to unify the flattree/livetree code introduced a small
size increase in SPL on some boards. For example SPL code size for
px30-core-ctouch2-px30 increased by 40 bytes.
To address this we can take advantage of the fact that some of the ofnode
functions are only called a few times in SPL, so it is worth inlining
them.
Add new Kconfig options to control this. These functions are not inlined
for U-Boot proper, since this increases code size.
Fixes: 2ebea5eaeb ("dm: core: Combine the flattree and livetree binding code")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Buildman reuses build directories from previous builds to avoid the cost
of 'make mrproper' for every build. If the previous build produced an SPL
image but the current one does not, the SPL image will remain and buildman
will think it is a result of building the current board.
Remove these files before building, to avoid this problem.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove setting slave->dev to NULL after the device_remove() call.
The slave pointer points to dev->parent_priv, which has already
been freed by device_free(), called from device_remove() in the
preceding line. Writing to slave->dev may cause corruption of the
dlmalloc free chunk forward pointer of the previously freed chunk.
Signed-off-by: Niel Fourie <lusus@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add testcase for spi_claim_bus(), which checks that sandbox spi bus
speed/mode settings are updated correctly when multiple slaves use
the bus consecutively. The following configurations are used for the
two spi slaves involved:
* different max_hz / different modes
* different max_hz / same modes
* different modes / same max_hz
asm/test.h header is added in order to be able to retrieve the current
speed/mode of the sandbox spi bus, via sandbox_spi_get_{speed, mode}.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently, when different spi slaves claim the bus consecutively using
spi_claim_bus(), spi_set_speed_mode() will only be executed on the first
two calls, leaving the bus in a bad state starting with the third call.
This patch drops spi_slave->speed member and adds caching of bus
speed/mode in dm_spi_bus struct. It also updates spi_claim_bus() to call
spi_set_speed_mode() if either speed or mode is different from what the
bus is currently configured for. Current behavior is to only take into
account the speed, but not the mode, which seems wrong.
Fixes: 60e2809a84 ("dm: spi: Avoid setting the speed with every transfer")
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reported-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reported-by: Moshe, Yaniv <yanivmo@amazon.com>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Introduce sandbox_spi_get_{speed, mode} public interface to retrieve the
sandbox spi bus internal state. They are meant to be used in sandbox spi
testcases.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Implement sandbox_spi_set_{speed, mode} routines, to be able to keep track
of the current bus speed/mode. This will help determine whether the values
passed from dm_spi_claim_bus() are valid.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Place a second spi slave on the sandbox_spi bus, to be used by the
spi_claim_bus() testcase we are about to introduce. We need to make sure
that jumping between slaves calling spi_claim_bus() sets the bus speed and
mode appropriately. Use different max-hz and mode properties for this new
slave.
Also, update sandbox_spi cs_info call to allow activity on CS0/CS1 and
adapt dm_test_spi_find() testcase for this new setup.
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Commit 1289e96797 ("sandbox: spi: Drop command-line SPI option") dropped
support for specifying SPI devices on the command line, removing the only
user of sandbox_spi_parse_spec(). Remove the function too.
Fixes: 1289e96797 ("sandbox: spi: Drop command-line SPI option")
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Before executing code that we have loaded from a file we need to flush the
data cache and invalidate the instruction flash.
Implement functions flush_cache() and invalidate_icache_all().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
While assigning the sequence number to subsystem instances by reading the
aliases property, only DT nodes names are compared and not the complete
path. This causes a problem when there are two DT nodes with same name but
have different paths.
In arch/arm/dts/k3-am65-main.dtsi there are two USB controllers with the
same device tree node name but different path. When aliases are defined for
these USB controllers then fdtdec_get_alias_seq() fails to pick the correct
instance for a given index.
fdt_path_offset() function is slow and this would effect the U-Boot
startup. To avert the time penalty on all boards, apply this extra check
only when required by using a config option.
Fix it by comparing the phandles of DT nodes after the node names match,
under a config option.
Signed-off-by: Aswath Govindraju <a-govindraju@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix whitespace error in Kconfig:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Check for negative return value of fdt_noffset from calling
boot_get_fdt_fit().
Signed-off-by: Hongwei Zhang <hongweiz@ami.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Implement a reset function that we can call after ExitBootServices(),
when all driver model devices are gone.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add CONFIG_DEBUG_UART=y for all sandbox defconfig
as it is already done in sandbox_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add defaults for FSF/GNU projects, such as gcc, that provide sensible
settings for those projects.
Signed-off-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@vrull.eu>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
To enable use of patman with FSF/GNU projects, such as GCC or
Binutils, no Signed-off-by may be added. This adds a command
line flag '--no-signoff' to suppress adding signoffs in patman
when processing commits.
Signed-off-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@vrull.eu>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix patman testBranch() test:
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The fsp_types.h header file contains macros for building signatures of
different widths. These signature macros are architecture agnostic,
and can be used in all places which use signatures in a data
structure. Move and rename the fsp_types.h under the common include
header.
Signed-off-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Travis-CI is changing their support for FOSS (understandably) to have a
limited per-month number of build minutes. Unfortunately for us, the
matrix of jobs we run will exhaust that very quickly. Remove the yml
file. Thanks for all the builds, Travis-CI!
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Since linux commit 2e6cde96873253fd9eb0f20afd8ffd18278cff75 ("arm64:
dts: ls1028a: make the eMMC and SD card controllers use fixed indices")
mmc0 is the eMMC and mmc1 is the SD card. Also swap it in u-boot to
avoid any confusion by the user and to be aligned with linux.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc4
* Provide a tool to create a file with UEFI variables to preseed UEFI
variable store.
* Make size of UEFI variable store configurable.
* Add man pages for commands 'bootefi' and 'button'.
tools/efivar.py allows to prepare a file with UEFI variables to preseed
the UEFI variable store.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently the size of the buffer to keep UEFI variables in memory is fixed
at 16384 bytes. This size has proven to be too small for some use cases.
Make the size of the memory buffer for UEFI variables customizable.
Reported-by: Paulo Alcantara (SUSE) <pc@cjr.nz>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Now that migration to the new sequence numbers is complete, drop the old
fields. Add a test that covers the new behaviour.
Also drop the check for OF_PRIOR_STAGE since we always assign sequence
numbers now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function current deals with req_seq which is deprecated. Update it to
use the new sequence numbers, putting them above existing aliases. Rename
the function to make this clear.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that there is only one sequence number (rather than both requested and
assigned ones) we can simplify this function. Also update its caller to
simplify the logic.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Check that this flag operates as expected. This patch is not earlier in
this series since is uses the new behaviour of dev_seq().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is no-longer any need to check if sequence numbers are valid, since
this is ensured by driver model. Drop the unwanted logic.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that sequence numbers are set up when devices are bound, this code is
not needed. Also, we should use dev_seq() instead of req_seq. Update the
whole file accordingly.
Also fix up APL cpu while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new sequence number in all cases. Since all devices are assigned
a number when bound, this hack should not be needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This hack cannot work in the new sequence-numbering scheme. Remove it
while we wait for the maintainer to complete DM conversion as noted in
the existing comment.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new sequence number in all cases. Drop the rockchip case because
the sequence number should be 0 anyway, and assigning to the sequence
number is not permitted.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that we know the sequence number at bind time, there is no need for
special-case code in dm_pci_hose_probe_bus().
Note: the PCI_CAP_ID_EA code may need a look, but there are no test
failures so I have left it as is.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some buses have their own rules which require assigning sequence numbers
with a bus-specific algorithm. For example, PCI requires that sub-buses
are numbered higher than their parent buses, meaning effectively that
parent buses must be numbered only after all of their child buses have
been numbered.
Add a uclass flag to indicate that driver model should not assign sequence
numbers. In this case, the uclass must do it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Checking for seq == -1 is effectively checking that the device is
activated. The new sequence numbers are never -1 for a bound device, so
update the check.
Also drop the note about valid sequence numbers so it is accurate with the
new approach.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the new sequence number in all cases. Drop the logic to check for a
valid number in designware_i2c, since it will always be valid.
Also drop the numbering in the uclass, since we can rely on driver
model giving us the right sequence numbers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Several Octeon drivers operate by setting the sequence number of their
device. This should not be needed with the new sequence number setup. Also
it is not permitted. Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the core logic to use the new approach. For now the old code is
left as is. Update one test so it still passes.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present each device has two sequence numbers, with 'req_seq' being
set up at bind time and 'seq' at probe time. The idea is that devices
can 'request' a sequence number and then the conflicts are resolved when
the device is probed.
This makes things complicated in a few cases, since we don't really know
what the sequence number will end up being. We want to honour the
bind-time requests if at all possible, but in fact the only source of
these at present is the devicetree aliases. Since we have the devicetree
available at bind time, we may as well just use it, in the hope that the
required processing will turn out to be useful later (i.e. the device
actually gets used).
Add a new 'sqq' member, the bind-time sequence number. It operates in
parallel to the old values for now. All devices get a valid sqq value,
i.e. it is never -1.
Drop an #ifdef while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this is passed a uclass ID and it has to do a lookup. The
callers all have the uclass pointer, except for the I2C uclass where the
code will soon be deleted.
Update the argument to a uclass * instead of an ID since it is more
efficient.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present various drivers etc. access the device's 'seq' member directly.
This makes it harder to change the meaning of that member. Change access
to go through a function instead.
The drivers/i2c/lpc32xx_i2c.c file is left unchanged for now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The linker script uses alphabetic sorting to group the different linker
lists together. Each group has its own struct and potentially its own
alignment. But when the linker packs the structs together it cannot ensure
that a linker list starts on the expected alignment boundary.
For example, if the first list has a struct size of 8 and we place 3 of
them in the image, that means that the next struct will start at offset
0x18 from the start of the linker_list section. If the next struct has
a size of 16 then it will start at an 8-byte aligned offset, but not a
16-byte aligned offset.
With sandbox on x86_64, a reference to a linker list item using
ll_entry_get() can force alignment of that particular linker_list item,
if it is in the same file as the linker_list item is declared.
Consider this example, where struct driver is 0x80 bytes:
ll_entry_declare(struct driver, fred, driver)
...
void *p = ll_entry_get(struct driver, fred, driver)
If these two lines of code are in the same file, then the entry is forced
to be aligned at the 'struct driver' alignment, which is 16 bytes. If the
second line of code is in a different file, then no action is taken, since
the compiler cannot update the alignment of the linker_list item.
In the first case, an 8-byte 'fill' region is added:
.u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testbus_drv
0x0000000000270018 0x80 test/built-in.o
0x0000000000270018 _u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testbus_drv
.u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testfdt1_drv
0x0000000000270098 0x80 test/built-in.o
0x0000000000270098 _u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testfdt1_drv
*fill* 0x0000000000270118 0x8
.u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testfdt_drv
0x0000000000270120 0x80 test/built-in.o
0x0000000000270120 _u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testfdt_drv
.u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testprobe_drv
0x00000000002701a0 0x80 test/built-in.o
0x00000000002701a0 _u_boot_list_2_driver_2_testprobe_drv
With this, the linker_list no-longer works since items after testfdt1_drv
are not at the expected address.
Ideally we would have a way to tell gcc not to align structs in this way.
It is not clear how we could do this, and in any case it would require us
to adjust every struct used by the linker_list feature.
One possible fix is to force each separate linker_list to start on the
largest possible boundary that can be required by the compiler. However
that does not seem to work on x86_64, which uses 16-byte alignment in this
case but needs 32-byte alignment.
So add a Kconfig option to handle this. Set the default value to 4 so
as to avoid changing platforms that don't need it.
Update the ll_entry_start() accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For the proper reboot Odroid-C4 board requires to switch TFLASH_VDD_EN
pin to the high impedance mode, otherwise the board is stuck in the
middle of loading early stages of the bootloader from SD card.
This can be achieved by using the OPEN_DRAIN flag instead if the
ACTIVE_HIGH, what will leave the pin in input to achieve high state (pin
has the pull-up) and solve the issue.
Suggested-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The designware ssi device has "broken" chip select behaviour [1], and needs
specific manipulation to use the built-in chip select. The existing fix is
to use an external GPIO for chip select, but typically the K210 has SPI3
directly connected to a flash chip with dedicated pins. This makes it
impossible to use the spi_xfer function to use spi, since the CS is
de-asserted in between calls. This patch adds an implementation of
exec_op, which gives correct behaviour when reading/writing spi flash.
This patch also rearranges the headers to conform to U-Boot style.
[1] https://lkml.org/lkml/2015/12/23/132
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by Eugeniy Paltsev <Eugeniy.Paltsev@synopsys.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This documentation has been taken from Linux commit 3d7db0f11c7a ("spi: dw:
Refactor mid_spi_dma_setup() to separate DMA and IRQ config"), immediately
before the file was deleted and replaced with a yaml version. Additional
compatible strings from newer versions have been added, as well as a few
U-Boot-specific ones.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
CTRLR0 can have several different layouts depending on the specific device
(dw-apb-ssi vs dwc-ssi), and specific parameters set during synthesis.
Update the driver to support three specific configurations: dw-apb-ssi with
SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE=16, dw-apb-ssi with SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE=32, and dwc-ssi.
dw-apb-ssi is the version of the device on Altera/Intel SoCFPGAs, MSCC
SoCs, and Canaan Kendryte K210 SoCs. This is the only version this driver
supported before this change. The register layout before version 3.23a is:
| 31 .. 16 |
| other stuff |
| 15 .. 10 | 9 .. 8 | 7 .. 6 | 5 .. 4 | 3 .. 0 |
| other stuff | TMOD | MODE | FRF | DFS |
Note that DFS (Data Frame Size) is only 4 bits, limiting transfers to data
frames of 16 bits or less.
In version 3.23a, the SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE parameter was introduced. This
parameter defaults to 16 (resulting in the same layout as prior versions),
but may also be set to 32. To allow setting longer data frame sizes, a new
DFS_32 register was introduced:
| 31 .. 21 | 20 .. 16 |
| other stuff | DFS_32 |
| 15 .. 10 | 9 .. 8 | 7 .. 6 | 5 .. 4 | 3 .. 0 |
| other stuff | TMOD | MODE | FRF | all zeros |
The old DFS field no longer controls the data frame size. To detect this
layout, we try writing 0xF to DFS. If we read back 0x0, then this device
has SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE=32.
dwc-ssi is the version of the device on Intel Keem Bay SoCs and Canaan
Kendryte K210 SoCs. The layout of ctrlr0 is:
| 31 .. 16 |
| other stuff |
| 15 .. 12 | 11 .. 10 | 9 .. 8 | 7 .. 6 | 4 .. 0 |
| other stuff | TMOD | MODE | FRF | DFS_32 |
The semantics of the fields have not changed since the previous version.
However, SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE is effectively always 32.
To support these different layouts, we model our approach on the one
which the Linux kernel has taken. During probe, the driver calls an init
function stored in driver_data. This init function is responsible for
determining the layout of CTRLR0, and supplying the update_cr0 function.
The style of and information behind this commit is based on the Linux MMIO
driver for these devices. Specific reference was made to the series adding
support for Intel Keem Bay SoCs [1].
[1] https://lore.kernel.org/linux-spi/20200505130618.554-1-wan.ahmad.zainie.wan.mohamad@intel.com/
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This adds SoC-specific compatible strings to all users of the designware
spi device. This will allow for the correct driver to be selected for each
device. Where it is publicly documented, a compatible string for the
specific device version has also been added. Devices without
publicly-documented device versions include MSCC SoCs, and Arc Socs. All
compatible strings except those for SoCFPGAs and some of the versioned
strings have been taken from Linux.
Since SSI_MAX_XFER_SIZE is determined at runtime, this is not strictly
necessary. However, it is a good cleanup and brings things closer to Linux.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by Eugeniy Paltsev <Eugeniy.Paltsev@synopsys.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
A few registers had slightly different names from what is in the datasheet.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This allows different log levels to be enabled or disabled depending on the
desired level of verbosity. In particular, it allows for general debug
information to be printed while excluding more verbose logging which may
interfere with timing.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The resting state of MOSI is high when nothing is driving it. If we drive
it low while recieving, it looks like we are transmitting 0x00 instead of
transmitting nothing. This can confuse slaves (like SD cards) which allow
new commands to be sent over MOSI while they are returning data over MISO.
The return of MOSI from 0 to 1 at the end of recieving a byte can look like
a start bit and a transmission bit to an SD card. This will cause the card
to become out-of-sync with the SPI device, as it thinks the device has
already started transmitting two bytes of a new command. The mmc-spi driver
will not detect the R1 response from the SD card, since it is sent too
early, and offset by two bits. This patch fixes transfer errors when using
SD cards with dw spi.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
U-Boot is able to erase bad mtd blocks on raw nand devices, but this
is not true for spinand flashes. Lets enable this feature for spinand
flashes as well. This is extemelly useful for flash testing.
Signed-off-by: Mikhail Kshevetskiy <mikhail.kshevetskiy@oktetlabs.ru>
Currently when marking a block, we use spinand_erase_op() to erase
the block before writing the marker to the OOB area. Doing so without
waiting for the operation to finish can lead to the marking failing
silently and no bad block marker being written to the flash.
In fact we don't need to do an erase at all before writing the BBM.
The ECC is disabled for raw accesses to the OOB data and we don't
need to work around any issues with chips reporting ECC errors as it
is known to be the case for raw NAND.
Fixes: 7529df465248 ("mtd: nand: Add core infrastructure to support SPI NANDs")
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Boris Brezillon <boris.brezillon@collabora.com>
Signed-off-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/linux-mtd/20200218100432.32433-4-frieder.schrempf@kontron.de
When writing the bad block marker to the OOB area the access mode
should be set to MTD_OPS_RAW as it is done for reading the marker.
Currently this only works because req.mode is initialized to
MTD_OPS_PLACE_OOB (0) and spinand_write_to_cache_op() checks for
req.mode != MTD_OPS_AUTO_OOB.
Fix this by explicitly setting req.mode to MTD_OPS_RAW.
Fixes: 7529df465248 ("mtd: nand: Add core infrastructure to support SPI NANDs")
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Boris Brezillon <boris.brezillon@collabora.com>
Signed-off-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/linux-mtd/20200218100432.32433-3-frieder.schrempf@kontron.de
For reading and writing the bad block markers, spinand->oobbuf is
currently used as a buffer for the marker bytes. During the
underlying read and write operations to actually get/set the content
of the OOB area, the content of spinand->oobbuf is reused and changed
by accessing it through spinand->oobbuf and/or spinand->databuf.
This is a flaw in the original design of the SPI NAND core and at the
latest from 13c15e07eedf ("mtd: spinand: Handle the case where
PROGRAM LOAD does not reset the cache") on, it results in not having
the bad block marker written at all, as the spinand->oobbuf is
cleared to 0xff after setting the marker bytes to zero.
To fix it, we now just store the two bytes for the marker on the
stack and let the read/write operations copy it from/to the page
buffer later.
Fixes: 7529df465248 ("mtd: nand: Add core infrastructure to support SPI NANDs")
Cc: stable@vger.kernel.org
Signed-off-by: Frieder Schrempf <frieder.schrempf@kontron.de>
Reviewed-by: Boris Brezillon <boris.brezillon@collabora.com>
Signed-off-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
Link: https://lore.kernel.org/linux-mtd/20200218100432.32433-2-frieder.schrempf@kontron.de
Define LOG_CATEGORY and change printf and pr_*
to dev_ (when dev is available) or log_ macro.
This patch adds the support of logging feature with log command
(filtering, display of device name in trace) and allows to
suppress traces via the syslog driver.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Remove the redundant setting for USB_RX_EARLY_SIZE. Besides, for
RTL8153B, it is necessary to notify the hardware of the changes
of the aggregation settings.
Signed-off-by: Hayes Wang <hayeswang@realtek.com>
The r8152_eth_probe() may allocate a memory for ss->dev_priv.
It has to be freed if r8152_eth_probe() fails finally.
Signed-off-by: Hayes Wang <hayeswang@realtek.com>
For bulk IN transfer, the codes will set ISP flag to request event TRB
being generated by xHC for the case of short packet. So when encountering
buffer-cross-64K-boundary (which we will divide payload and enqueuqe
more than 1 transfer TRB), and the first TRB ends up with a short packet
condition it will trigger an short packet code transfer event per that
flag and cause more than 1 event TRB generated for this transfer.
However, current codes will only handle the first transfer event TRB
then mark current transfer completed, causing next transfer
failure due to event TRB mis-match.
Such issue has been observed on some Layerscape platforms (LS1028A,
LS1088A, etc) with USB ethernet device.
This patch adds a loop to make sure the event TRB for last transfer TRB
has been handled in time.
Signed-off-by: Ran Wang <ran.wang_1@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
DM is the modern default approach for the drivers in U-Boot.
It also allows to configure code via Device Tree.
Move Intel Edison to use DM_USB_GADGET and drop hard coded values.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Use generic Synopsys DesignWare 3 driver on Intel Edison.
For now it's just a stub which allows future refactoring.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The platforms based on Intel Tangier may have different requirements
how to create bootloader bundle to supply to a device. Currently
the BINMAN approach is for Intel Edison only.
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It appears that U-Boot works by luck on Intel Edison board because the amount
of RAM is less than 1 GB and standard way of calculating the top of it work
for this configuration. However, this won't work if the amount of RAM is
different and split differently in address space. We have to find the suitable
window correctly.
Find proper memory region for relocation by scanning MMAP SFI table in
board_get_usable_ram_top() callback.
According to the address map documentation the Main Memory is guaranteed to lie
in the 0..2 GB range, that's why we limit search by this range.
Fixes: e71de54a49 ("x86: Add Intel Tangier support")
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: fixed a typo in the commit message]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Make use of the new bootargs substitution mechanism and zboot command
syntax.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
With the updated changes to bootargs substitution[1], the zboot command
needs to be updated to get its command line from an environment variable
instead of a memory address. This is because the command-line string must
be updated to convert %U to ${uuid}, etc.
In any case it is more flexible to use a environment variable and it is
best to do this before the release to avoid a subsequent change.
Update the command accordingly.
[1] http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/list/?series=212481
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Documentation fixes for v2020.01-rc4
Move several README files to reStructured text for the HTML documentation.
Describe register for global data on x86.
Allow building HTML documentation with Sphinx 3
Set $devtype for DHCP boot, which can be handy for the boot.scr
for detection of devtype used (for example, when the same boot.scr is
used for both mmc/dhcp boot):
if test ${devtype} = "dhcp"; then
...
fi
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Convert README.bootmenu to reStructured text and move it to
usage/bootmenu.rst.
Adjust the text concerning configuration settings as these now are managed
via Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Convert README.trace to reStructured text and move it to develop/trace.rst.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Convert README.NetConsole to reStructured text and move it to
doc/usage/netconsole.rst.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reformat README.commands as reStructured text and add it to the HTML
documentation as develop/commands.rst.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Due to removed function c_funcptr_sig_re building with Sphinx 3 fails.
With the patch building succeeds with a lot of warnings if the '-W' flag is
removed from doc/Makefile. Most of the documentation is correct
This follows the approach taken by the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On x86 the global data pointer is stored in register fs.
On x86_64 no register is used for the global data pointer.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Fix wrong amoswap t1 usage in startup.
- Reset the board after crash.
- Enable distro booting from an attached SCSI disk for QEMU.
- Support the optional header fields in efi header.
This fixes the wrong usage of clrsetbits_le32(), badly setting the set argument.
Fixes: c4c726c26b ("pinctrl: meson: add pinconf support")
Reported-by: Anton Arapov <arapov@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Otto Meier <gf435@gmx.net>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
dwc3_meson_g12a_force_mode() sets the dr-mode of the USB PHY. However
it skips setting the mode if it matches the one done during driver probe
(stored in private structure). This fails if the mode has been changed
to other value and then back to initial one. Fix this by configuring the
dr-mode always, regadless of the one set at the driver probe).
This fixes operation of USB gadget based drivers when they are initialized
for the second time.
Signed-off-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
RV32 should use PE32 format instead of PE32+ as the efi header format.
This requires following changes
1. A different header magic value
2. An additional parameter known as BaseOfData. Currently, it is set to
zero in absence of any usage.
Signed-off-by: Atish Patra <atish.patra@wdc.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
If an exception occurs on ARM or x86, we call panic() which will try to
reset the board. Do the same on RISC-V.
To avoid -Werror=format-zero-length move a '\n' to the string passed to
panic. We don't need a message here as depending on CONFIG_PANIC_HANG we
will either see
### ERROR ### Please RESET the board ###
or
resetting ...
as next message.
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Not s2 register, t1 register is correct
Fortunately, it works because t1 register has a garbage value
Signed-off-by: Brad Kim <brad.kim@semifive.com>
Reviewed-by: Lukas Auer <lukas@auer.io>
Reviewed-by: Leo Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
As a way of keeping the driver declarations more consistent, add a warning
if the struct used does not end with _priv or _plat.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix up the code style for those declarations that should now fit onto one
line, which is all of them that currently do not.
This is needed for dtoc to detect the structs correctly, at present.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This name is far too long. Rename it to remove the 'data' bits. This makes
it consistent with the platdata->plat rename.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We use 'priv' for private data but often use 'platdata' for platform data.
We can't really use 'pdata' since that is ambiguous (it could mean private
or platform data).
Rename some of the latter variables to end with 'plat' for consistency.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This construct is quite long-winded. In earlier days it made some sense
since auto-allocation was a strange concept. But with driver model now
used pretty universally, we can shorten this to 'auto'. This reduces
verbosity and makes it easier to read.
Coincidentally it also ensures that every declaration is on one line,
thus making dtoc's job easier.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this file to reduce the number of pylint warnings. Also add a few
missing comments while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This doesn't need to be passed the devicetree anymore. Drop it.
Also rename the function to drop the _fdt suffix.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there are two copies of this code. With ofnode we can combine
them to reduce duplication. Update the dm_scan_fdt_node() function and
adjust its callers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is needed in at least one place. Avoid the conditional code in root.c
by adding this inline function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is not necessary anymore, since device_bind_ofnode() does
the same thing and works with both flattree and livetree.
Rename it to indicate that it is special.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Test that an exception SIGILL is answered by a reset on the sandbox if
CONFIG_SANDBOX_CRASH_RESET=y or by exiting to the OS otherwise.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide a unit test that causes an illegal instruction to occur.
The test can be run with the following commands:
=> setenv efi_selftest exception
=> bootefi selftest
This might be the output:
Executing 'exception'
EFI application triggers exception.
Illegal instruction
pc = 0x1444d016, pc_reloc = 0xffffaa078e8dd016
UEFI image [0x0000000000000000:0xffffffffffffffff] '/\selftest'
UEFI image [0x000000001444b000:0x0000000014451fff] pc=0x2016 '/bug.efi'
Resetting ...
It would tell us that the exception was triggered by an instruction
0x2016 bytes after the load address of the binary with filename /bug.efi.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Implement the commands
* exception undefined - execute an illegal instruction
* exception sigsegv - cause a segment violation
Here is a possible output:
=> exception undefined
Illegal instruction
pc = 0x55eb8d0a7575, pc_reloc = 0x57575
Resetting ...
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a handler for SIGILL, SIGBUS, SIGSEGV.
When an exception occurs print the program counter and the loaded
UEFI binaries and reset the system if CONFIG_SANDBOX_CRASH_RESET=y
or exit to the OS otherwise.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Rather than implementing our own circular queue, use membuff. This allows
us to read multiple bytes at once into the serial input.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is always enabled for sandbox (as it should be for all
boards), so we can drop it. Also use IS_ENABLED() for the SPL check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update this, mostly to add comments for argument and return types. It is
probably still too early to use type hinting since it was introduced in
3.5.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is useful anymore, since we always want to call chr() in Python 3.
Drop it and adjust callers to use chr().
Also drop ToChars() which is no-longer used.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We don't need these now that everything uses Python 3. Remove them and
the extra code in GetBytes() and ToBytes() too.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use an Enum instead of the current ad-hoc constants, so that there is a
data type associated with each 'type' value.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Second set of u-boot-atmel fixes for 2021.01 cycle
This set includes very important fixes for: MMC booting on several
boards, drive strength on sam9x60ek mmc lines, compile issues for
timer.c old driver, removal of unwanted access to sam9x60 bit for
oscillator bypass mode, and eeproms read on sama5d2_icp.
The correct compatible for this eeproms is microchip,24aa02e48
The previous compatible string was working up to U-boot 2020.04.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Tested-by: Codrin Ciubotariu <codrin.ciubotariu@microchip.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for next
Bug fixes
* avoid corruption of FAT file system when using long names
* correct values for RuntimeServicesSupport concerning UEFI capsule update
* link partition to block device via EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_CHILD_CONTROLLER
New feature
* support EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL in LoadImage() boot service
The USB support is not by default enabled on all designs, so it does not
make seance to have USB specific erratum's enabled on such a designs.
On our internal Hitachi-Powergrids design not using the USB controller
there is a crash when accessing those specific memory locations selected
by the erratum flags.
Signed-off-by: Aleksandar Gerasimovski <aleksandar.gerasimovski@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
If the board isn't strapped to enable USB1 then attempting to access it
will result in a hang. Avoid this by allowing boards to define
CONFIG_USB_MAX_CONTROLLER_COUNT.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
When booting from TF-A there is a logic that attempt to detect if the
default environment is used, if this is the case it then set the
`bootcmd` and `mcinitcmd` depending of the device we booted from.
This detection logic is dubious as it access internals of the env
implementation and it doesn't always work correctly.
First of all it detect any valid environment as not being the
default, so after running `env default -a && saveenv` the board
doesn't boot anymore as `bootcmd` is then empty.
But it also fails in some other ways, for example it always detect a
default environment when redundant env is enabled on MMC, so in that
case `bootcmd` is overwritten on every boot.
Instead of increasing the complexity of the detection just check if
`bootcmd` and `mcinitcmd` are set in the environment and set them if
they are not.
Signed-off-by: Alban Bedel <alban.bedel@aerq.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Check for NULL return value from fdt_getprop() in
fdt_fixup_remove_jr()
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Singh <priyanka.singh@nxp.com>
[Fixed checkpatch errors/warnings]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fixes: commit 8ec619f8fd ("pci: layerscape: Fixup PCIe EP
mode DT nodes for LX2160A rev2")
This added the PCIe EP nodes fixup of LX2160A, but it
didn't update the condition value when there isn't a
property 'apio-wins'.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
[Fixed checkpatch error]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable support to compile OPTEE driver, access AVB TA
and RPMB API's access via RPC from OPTEE for lx2162
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Gaurav Jain <gaurav.jain@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
LX2162 is LX2160 based SoC, it has same die as of LX2160
with different packaging.
LX2162A support 64-bit 2.9GT/s DDR4 memory, i2c, micro-click module,
microSD card, eMMC support, serial console, qspi nor flash, qsgmii,
sgmii, 25g, 40g, 50g network interface, one usb 3.0 and serdes
interface to support three PCIe gen3 interface.
Signed-off-by: Meenakshi Aggarwal <meenakshi.aggarwal@nxp.com>
[Fixed whitespace errors]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Move CORTINA_NO_FW_UPLOAD to Kconfig file so that it can
be controlled via defconfig files.
Signed-off-by: Meenakshi Aggarwal <meenakshi.aggarwal@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
resource "config" is required to have minimum 4KB space
to access all config space of PCI Express EP.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add label to pcie nodes in dts so that these nodes
are easy to refer.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
We provide a UEFI driver for block devices. When ConnectController() is
called for a handle with the EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL this driver creates the
partitions. When DisconnectController() is called the handles for the
partitions have to be deleted. This requires that the child controllers
(partitions) open the EFI_BLOCK_IO_PROTOCOL of the controller (block IO
device) with attribute EFI_OPEN_PROTOCOL_BY_CHILD_CONTROLLER.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
A unit test is supplied to test the support for the EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL
and the EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL by the LoadImage() boot service.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
efi_load_image_from_file() should read via either of:
* EFI_SIMPLE_FILE_SYSTEM_PROTOCOL
* EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL
* EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL
To make the code readable carve out a function to load the image via the
file system protocol.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Implementing support for loading images via the EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL
requires the boot policy as input for efi_load_image_from_path().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL_GUID and EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL_GUID are needed
to complement the implementation of the LoadFile() boot service.
Remove a duplicate declaration of a variable for the
EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL_GUID.
Move the remaining declaration to efi_boottime.c.
Add a variable for the EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL_GUID.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
For implementing support for the EFI_LOAD_FILE_PROTOCOL in the LoadImage()
service we will have to call the LocateDevicePath() service. To avoid a
forward declaration resequence the functions.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Our implementation of the EFI_HII_CONFIG_ROUTING_PROTOCOL is a mere stub,
where all services return an error code. The protocol is neither needed for
the EFI shell nor for the UEFI SCT. To reduce the code size remove it from
the U-Boot binary.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The EFI_RT_PROPERTIES_TABLE configuration table indicates which runtime
services are available at runtime.
Even if CONFIG_EFI_RUNTIME_UPDATE_CAPSULE=y, we neither support
UpdateCapsule() nor QueryCapsuleCapabilities() at runtime. Thus we should
not set the corresponding flags EFI_RT_SUPPORTED_UPDATE_CAPSULE and
EFI_RT_SUPPORTED_QUERY_CAPSULE_CAPABILITIES in RuntimeServicesSupported.
Fixes: 2bc27ca8a0 ("efi_loader: define UpdateCapsule api")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Long file names are stored in multiple directory entries. When deleting a
file we must delete all of them.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
A long name is split over multiple directory entries. When deleting a file
with a long name we need the first directory entry to be able to delete the
whole chain.
Add the necessary fields to the FAT iterator:
* cluster of first directory entry
* address of first directory entry
* remaining entries in cluster
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When deleting a directory entry 0xe5 is written to name[0].
We have a constant for this value and should use it consistently.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Searching for a file is not a write operation. So it should not lead to the
allocation of a new cluster to the directory.
If we reuse deleted entries, we might not even use the new cluster and due
to not flushing it the directory could be corrupted.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When creating new directory entries try to reuse entries marked as deleted.
In fill_dir_slot() do not allocate new clusters as this has already been
done in fat_find_empty_dentries().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide a function to find a series of empty directory entries.
The current directory is scanned for deleted entries.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When handling long file names directory entries may be split over multiple
clusters. We must make sure that new clusters are zero filled on disk.
When allocating a new cluster for a directory flush it.
The flushing should be executed before updating the FAT. This way if
flushing fails, we still have a valid directory structure.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When iterating over a child directory we set itr->start_clust.
Do the same when over the root directory.
When looking for deleted directory entries or existing short names we will
have to iterate over directories a second and third time. With this patch
we do not need any special logic for the root directory.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
For reusing deleted directory entries we have to adjust the function called
to step to the next directory entry.
This patch alone is not enough to actually reuse deleted directory entries
as the fill_dir_slot() is still called with first never used directory
entry.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
File names must be unique within their directory. So before assigning a
short name we must check that it is unique.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
In set_name() we select the short name. Once this is correctly implemented
this will be a performance intensive operation because we need to check
that the name does not exist yet. So set_name should only be called once.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently we pass the short name via the directory iterator.
Pass it explicitly as a parameter.
This removes the requirement to set the short name in the iterator before
writing the long name.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The current function set_name() used to create short names has the
following deficiencies resolved by this patch:
* Long names (e.g. FOO.TXT) are stored even if a short name is enough.
* Short names with spaces are created, e.g. "A ~1.TXT".
* Short names with illegal characters are created, e.g. "FOO++BAR".
* Debug output does not not consider that the short file name has no
concluding '\0'.
The solution for the following bug is split of into a separate patch:
* Short file names must be unique.
This patch only provides the loop over possible short file names.
Fixes: c30a15e590 ("FAT: Add FAT write feature")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Rename function next_cluster() to fat_next_cluster() and export it.
When creating a new directory entries we should reuse deleted entries.
This requires re-scanning the directory.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The FAT specification [1] requires that for a '..' directory entry pointing
to the root directory the fields DIR_FstClusHi and DIR_FstClusLo are 0.
[1] Microsoft FAT Specification, Microsoft Corporation, August 30 2005
Fixes: 31a18d570d ("fs: fat: support mkdir")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Marek Szyprowski <m.szyprowski@samsung.com>
- Manage CONFIG_ENV_EXT4_DEVICE_AND_PART in stm32mp1 board
- Update ARM STI and ARM STM STM32MP Arch maintainers emails
- Enable internal pull-ups for SDMMC1 on DHCOM SoM
The STM32MP1 DHCOM SoM can be built with either bus voltage level shifter
or without one on the SDMMC1 interface. Because the SDMMC1 interface is
limited to 50 MHz and hence SD high-speed anyway, disable the SD feedback
clock to permit operation of the same U-Boot image on both SoM with and
without voltage level shifter.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
The default state of SD bus and clock line is logical HI. SD card IO is
open-drain and pulls the bus lines LO. Always enable the SD bus pull ups
to guarantee this behavior on DHCOM SoM. Note that on SoMs with SD bus
voltage level shifter, the pull ups are built into the level shifter,
however that has no negative impact.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Check whether user has explicitly defined device and partition where
environment file will be located before using 'auto' i.e. bootable
partition
Voids the need to set such partition as bootable to work with the
'dev:auto' tuple
Signed-off-by: Manuel Reis <mluis.reis@gmail.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Tested-by: Michael Opdenacker <michael.opdenacker@bootlin.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@foss.st.com>
Fit images were loaded to a buffer provided by spl_get_load_buffer().
This may work when the FIT image is small and fits between the start
of DRAM and SYS_TEXT_BASE.
One problem with this approach is that the location of the buffer may
be manipulated by changing the 'size' field of the FIT. A maliciously
crafted FIT image could place the buffer over executable code and be
able to take control of SPL. This is unacceptable for secure boot of
signed FIT images.
Another problem is with larger FIT images, usually containing one or
more linux kernels. In such cases the buffer be be large enough so as
to start before DRAM (Figure I). Trying to load an image in this case
has undefined behavior.
For example, on stm32mp1, the MMC controller hits a RX overrun error,
and aborts loading.
_________________
| FIT Image |
| |
/===================\ /=====================\
|| DRAM || | DRAM |
|| || | |
||_________________|| SYS_TEXT_BASE | ___________________ |
| | || FIT Image ||
| | || ||
| _________________ | SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START || _________________ ||
|| malloc() data || ||| malloc() data |||
||_________________|| |||_________________|||
| | ||___________________||
| | | |
Figure I Figure II
One possibility that was analyzed was to remove the negative offset,
such that the buffer starts at SYS_TEXT_BASE. This is not a proper
solution because on a number of platforms, the malloc buffer() is
placed at a fixed address, usually after SYS_TEXT_BASE. A large
enough FIT image could cause the malloc()'d data to be overwritten
(Figure II) when loading.
/======================\
| DRAM |
| |
| | CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE
| |
| |
| ____________________ | CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
|| malloc() data ||
|| ||
|| __________________ ||
||| FIT Image |||
||| |||
||| |||
Figure III
The solution proposed here is to replace the ad-hoc heuristics of
spl_get_load_buffer() with malloc(). This provides two advantages:
* Bounds checking of the buffer region
* Guarantees the buffer does not conflict with other memory
The first problem is solved by constraining the buffer such that it
will not overlap currently executing code. This eliminates the chance
of a malicious FIT being able to replace the executing SPL code prior
to signature checking.
The second problem is solved in conjunction with increasing
CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE. Since the SPL malloc() region is
carefully crafted on a per-platform basis, the chances of memory
conflicts are virtually eliminated.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
- Series to improve "bootm" by allowing variable evaluation within the
cmdline we would be passing. This will help with Chrome OS but can be
useful elsewhere.
- Improve ATF (TF-A) support within SPL.
- Espressobin: Simplify DT handling of board variants (Pali)
- Add Luka Perkov to maintainers of Puzzle-M801 (Luka)
- Armada 38x: Enable board specific USB2 high-speed impedance
threshold configuration (Joshua)
Use the full name of firmware self extracting file to make it run.
Also, don't use sudo when not needed.
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Remove the parsing of atmel,main-osc-bypass DT property as the SAM9X60
have no support for crystal oscillator bypass. Setting this bit might
affect the device functionality.
Fixes: a64862284f ("clk: at91: sam9x60: add support compatible with CCF")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Try to initialize emmc in board_late_init() and if it fails then we know
that emmc device is not connected.
This allows to use in U-Boot just one DTS file for all Espressobin variants
and also to correctly set fdtfile env variable for Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Gérald Kerma <gerald@gk2.net>
Reviewed-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
To simplify setup, configuration and compilation of u-boot, define emmc
node for all Espressobin boards. Espressobin boards without populated emmc
works correctly, just detection and initialization of emmc obviously fails.
Code for emmc is extracted from commit f1a43c84a9 ("arm64: dts: a3720:
add support for espressobin with populated emmc").
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Gérald Kerma <gerald@gk2.net>
Hardware testing of a board using the Armada 385 has shown that an
impedance threshold setting of 0x7 performs better in an eye-diagram
test than with Marvell's recommended value 0x6.
As other boards may still perform better with Marvell's reccomended value,
a configuration option is added with a default value of 0x6.
Signed-off-by: Joshua Scott <joshua.scott@alliedtelesis.co.nz>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Introduce weak function board_mem_get_layout() which allows overriding
the memory layout from board code in runtime, useful for handling
different SKU versions.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
This commit adds initial support for the Toradex Apalis iMX8X 2GB WB
IT V1.1A System on Module support [1].
Boot log:
U-Boot 2020.10-02940-g894aebb7e8-dirty (Oct 22 2020 - 09:43:57 +0300)
CPU: NXP i.MX8QXP RevB A35 at 1200 MHz at 30C
DRAM: 2 GiB
MMC: FSL_SDHC: 0, FSL_SDHC: 1
Loading Environment from MMC... OK
In: serial@5a070000
Out: serial@5a070000
Err: serial@5a070000
Model: Toradex Apalis iMX8 QuadXPlus 2GB Wi-Fi / BT IT V1.1A,
Serial# 06617018
Net: eth0: ethernet@5b040000 [PRIME]
Hit any key to stop autoboot: 0
Functionality wise the following is known to be working:
- eMMC and MMC/SD card
- Ethernet (*)
- GPIOs
- I2C
Unfortunately, there is no USB functionality for the i.MX 8QXP as of
yet.
* With the SCU FW from the latest Toradex BSP 5.0.0 (SCU FW 1.5.1)
ETH PHY encounters bring up problems after reset, this will be fixed
soon on SCU FW side.
[1] https://www.toradex.com/computer-on-modules/apalis-arm-family/nxp-imx-8x
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
the mem_map structure containing the size of SDRAM is used in various
cache functions in cache_v8.c thus we need to update it with the
sdram size the board is configured with as well. Without this
the cache functions do not get setup properly and can hang
in the case where a board reports more SDRAM than defined in
PHYS_SDRAM_SIZE.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Implement board_phys_sdram_size() to automatically detect Verdin iMX8M
Mini DualLite 1GB vs. Verdin iMX8M Mini Quad 2GB.
Note: This only works if we keep using similar RAM chips!
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
Now with them first Verdin iMX8M Mini DualLite modules in for bring-up
we got clarity how is_cpu_type() actually behaves.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Suvorov <oleksandr.suvorov@toradex.com>
The I2C address is 0x25, not 0x35. This according to the datasheet and
tests with a PCA9450A.
Signed-off-by: Max Krummenacher <max.krummenacher@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
For imx usdhc/esdhc, once set the DDR_EN, enable the DDR mode, the
card clock will be divied by 2 automatically by the host. So need
to first config the DDR_EN correctly, then update the card clock.
This will make sure the actual card clock is as our expected.
IC also suggest config the DDR_EN firstly, then config the clock
divider.
For HS400/HS400ES mode, need to config the strobe dll, this need
to based on the correct target clock rate, so need to do this after
clock rate is update.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Set `bootcause' from b850v3 power management watchdog status.
Boot cause "REVERT" is no longer used, remove it.
Signed-off-by: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Use VPD product ID instead of confidx, so that we can easily reuse the
product ID defines and avoid some magic numbers.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Remove pinmux defines, that are no longer used after
converting the code to devicetree.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Commit f692b479f0 changed the VPD partition name from "vpd" to
"vpd@0". Fix the VPD reader code to use the new name, so that
the VPD code keeps working.
Fixes: f692b479f0 ("i2c: eeprom: Use reg property instead of offset and size")
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Fix the following warning:
arch/arm/mach-imx/imx8/ahab.c:105:3: warning: implicit declaration of function ‘flush_dcache_range’ [-Wimplicit-function-declaration]
flush_dcache_range(s, e);
^~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Include cpu_func.h header which declares the flush_dcache_range()
function.
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
arch/arm/mach-imx/imx8/ahab.c: In function ‘authenticate_os_container’:
arch/arm/mach-imx/imx8/ahab.c:96:9: warning: format ‘%x’ expects argument of type
‘unsigned int’, but argument 9 has type ‘ulong {aka long unsigned int}’ [-Wformat=]
debug("img %d, dst 0x%x, src 0x%x, size 0x%x\n",
Fix those by using "%lu" specified.
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
arch/arm/mach-imx/imx8/ahab.c:110:63: warning: format ‘%x’ expects
argument of type ‘unsigned int’, but argument 2 has type ‘u64 {aka long
long unsigned int}’ [-Wformat=]
Fix those by using %llx
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
This patch fixes this clk issue on I2C on imx8qm
=> i2c bus
Bus 3: i2c@5a830000
=> i2c dev 3
Setting bus to 3
Failed to enable ipg clk
Failure changing bus number (-524)
Signed-off-by: Oliver Graute <oliver.graute@kococonnector.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: uboot-imx <uboot-imx@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Removed aristainetos2, 2b, 2b-csl. This boards have been
recalled and destroyed.
Adapt board code to remove stuff not needed anymore.
Fix checkpatch warning, remove fdt_high and initrd_high
from default environment.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
zu remove
In some cases it is necessary to pass parameters to Linux so that it will
boot correctly. For example, the rootdev parameter is often used to
specify the root device. However the root device may change depending on
whence U-Boot loads the kernel. At present it is necessary to build up
the command line by adding device strings to it one by one.
It is often more convenient to provide a template for bootargs, with
U-Boot doing the substitution from other environment variables.
Add a way to substitute strings in the bootargs variable. This allows
things like "rootdev=${rootdev}" to be used in bootargs, with the
${rootdev} substitution providing the UUID of the root device.
For example, to substitute the GUID of the kernel partition:
setenv bootargs "console=/dev/ttyS0 rootdev=${uuid}/PARTNROFF=1
kern_guid=${uuid}"
part uuid mmc 2:2 uuid
bootm
This is particularly useful when the command line from another place. For
example, Chrome OS stores the command line next to the kernel itself. It
depends on the kernel version being used as well as the hardware features,
so it is extremely difficult to devise a U-Boot script that works on all
boards and kernel versions. With this feature, the command line can be
read from disk and used directly, with a few substitutions set up.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present cli_simple_process_macros() requires that the caller provide
an output buffer that is exactly CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE bytes in length. This
makes sense since it is designed to be used from the command line. But we
also want to use it for bootargs substitution.
Update the function to allow the caller to specify the buffer size. Also
return an error if the buffer is exhausted. The caller can ignore that if
preferred.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present zimage does its own command-line processing and does not
support the 'silent console' feature. There doesn't seem to be any good
reason for this.
Add support for silent console to zimage.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we only support updating the 'bootargs' environment
variable. Add another function to update a buffer instead. This will
allow zimage to use this feature.
Also add a lot more tests to cover various cases.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present only one transformation is supported: making the Linux console
silent. To prepare for adding more, convert the boolean parameter into a
flag value.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present bootm_process_cmdline_env() reads the 'bootargs' variable and
then writes it back afterwards. This is painful for tests, which would
rather use a simple buffer.
It is also useful for zimage to use a buffer, since it does not actually
put the Linux command line in the bootargs variable.
Refactor the existing code into two pieces. One handles reading and
writing the environment variable, as well as allocating a buffer for use
by the rest of the code, which now operates on a buffer.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use the size (including terminator) for in this function, rather than
the length. This is arguably easier to follow, with the coming
refactor.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function will soon do more than just handle the 'silent linux'
feature. As a first step, update it to take a boolean parameter,
indicating whether or not the processing is required.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We want to add more processing to this function. Before doing so, rename
it to bootm_process_cmdline_env(), which is more generic.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function fails silently on error. Update it to produce
an error code. Report this error to the user and abort the boot, since it
likely will prevent a successful start.
No tests are added at this stage, since additional refactoring is taking
place in subsequent patches.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function currently has no tests. Export it so that we can implement
a simple test on sandbox. Use IS_ENABLED() to remove the unused code,
instead #ifdef.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function returns 1 on success and 0 on failure. But in
the latter case it provides no indication of what went wrong.
If an attempt is made to delete a non-existent variable, the caller may
want to ignore this error. This happens when setting a non-existent
variable to "", for example.
Update the function to return 0 on success and a useful error code on
failure. Add a function comment too.
Make sure that env_set() does not return an error if it is deleting a
variable that doesn't exist. We could update env_set() to return useful
error numbers also, but that is beyond the scope of this change.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
wip
The BL31 expects the GIC to be uninitialized. Thus, if we are loading
the BL31 by the SPL we must not initialize it. If u-boot is loaded by
the SPL directly, it will initialize the GIC again (in the same
lowlevel_init()).
This was tested on a custom board with SPL loading the BL31 and jumping
to u-boot as BL33 as well as loading u-boot directly by the SPL. In case
the ATF BL1/BL2 is used, this patch won't change anything, because no
SPL is used at all.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
bl2_to_bl31_params_mem is just an implementation detail of the SPL ATF
support and is not needed anywhere else. Move it from the header to the
actual module.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Acked-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Move the actual implementation of the bl2_plat_get_bl31_params() to its
own function. The weak function will just call the default
implementation. This has the advantage that board code can still call
the original implementation if it just want to modify minor things.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
There is no need to have the storage available globally. This is also a
preparation for LOAD_IMAGE_V2 support. That will introduce a similar
generator function which also has its own storage.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Acked-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is SPL_ARMV8_SEC_FIRMWARE_SUPPORT and ARMV8_SEC_FIRMWARE_SUPPORT.
Thus use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() instead of the simple #ifdef.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Acked-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Activate ARCH_SUPPORT_PSCI as other TEGRA124 target and remove
CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI and CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_NR_CPUS in configs file as they
are migrated in Kconfig.
Select CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_1 (the first PSCI version),
because CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_2 and CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_1_0
are not activated in this product.
Hi,
This patch depend on the previous serie [1].
I don't test this patch on real hardware but
after this patch the size of the binary don't change.
In .config we have:
CONFIG_ARCH_SUPPORT_PSCI=y
CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI=y
# CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_1_0 is not set
# CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_2 is not set
CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_1=y
CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_NR_CPUS=4
In u-boot.cfg, this patch only add the 2 lines
#define CONFIG_ARCH_SUPPORT_PSCI 1
#define CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_1 1
[1] "Convert CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_1_0 and CONFIG_ARMV7_PSCI_0_2 to Kconfig"
http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/list/?series=184029
Regards
Patrick
END
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Peter Chubb <peter.chubb@data61.csiro.au>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Upstream linux DT naming doesn't align with the U-Boot DT, which may
not always be the case so this allows using BOOTENV_EFI_SET_FDTFILE_FALLBACK
where it might be appropriate for some boards.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
For booting via UEFI we need to define the fdtfile option so
bootefi has the option to load a fdtfile from disk. For arm64
the kernel dtb is located in a vendor directory so we define
that as nvidia for that architecture.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Use gpio_early_init_uart() function to disable RS232 serial transceiver
ForceOFF# pins on Iris.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Avoid UART input from floating RX pins on UARTB and UARTC (Colibri T30)
and UARTB, UARTC and UARTD (Apalis T30).
Note: Floating pins may cause spurious break conditions potentially
interrupting U-Boot's autoboot.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Fix SPI1 and UART2/3 resp. UARTB/C pinmuxing.
Note: The former was illegally muxing multiple SoC balls onto the same
internal SoC signal which caused rather strange behaviour regarding
the RS232 serial transceiver ForceOFF# pins as available on Iris.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Add pinmuxing comment stating that TRISTATE means the output driver is
tri-stated and INPUT means the input driver is enabled vs. OUTPUT where
it is disabled.
Signed-off-by: Marcel Ziswiler <marcel.ziswiler@toradex.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Signed-off-by: Tom Warren <twarren@nvidia.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for next
This pull request adds:
* eventlog support for TCG2_PROTOCOL
* UEFI capusule updates
It replace printf by log in efi_uclass.c
The test can run on sandbox build and it attempts to execute a firmware
update via a capsule-on-disk, using a raw image capsule,
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_RAW.
To run this test successfully, you need configure U-Boot specifically;
See test_capsule_firmware.py for requirements, and hence it won't run
on Travis CI, at least, for now.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
The test can run on sandbox build and it attempts to execute a firmware
update via a capsule-on-disk, using a FIT image capsule,
CONFIG_EFI_CAPSULE_FIT.
To run this test successfully, you need configure U-Boot specifically;
See test_capsule_firmware.py for requirements, and hence it won't run
on Travis CI, at least, for now.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
This is a utility mainly for test purpose.
mkeficapsule -f: create a test capsule file for FIT image firmware
Having said that, you will be able to customize the code to fit
your specific requirements for your platform.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
"efidebug capsule" is more or less a debugging utility.
efidebug capsule update: invoke UpdateCapsule against data on memory
efidebug capsule show: show a capsule header
efidebug capsule result: dump a capsule result variable
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
In this commit, a very simple firmware management protocol driver
is implemented. It will take a binary image in a capsule file and
apply the data using dfu backend storage drivers via dfu_write_by_alt()
interface.
So "dfu_alt_info" variable should be properly set to specify a device
and location to be updated. Please read README.dfu.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
In this commit, a very simple firmware management protocol driver
is implemented. It will take a common FIT image firmware in a capsule
file and apply the data using dfu backend storage drivers via
update_fit() interface.
So "dfu_alt_info" variable should be properly set to specify a device
and location to be updated. Please read README.dfu.
Fit image is a common file format for firmware update on U-Boot, and
this protocol works neatly just as a wrapper for one.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
A capsule tagged with the guid, EFI_FIRMWARE_MANAGEMENT_CAPSULE_ID_GUID,
is handled as a firmware update object.
What efi_update_capsule() basically does is to load any firmware management
protocol (or fmp) drivers contained in a capsule, find out an appropriate
fmp driver and then invoke its set_image() interface against each binary
in a capsule.
In this commit, however, loading drivers is not supported.
The result of applying a capsule is set to be stored in "CapsuleXXXX"
variable, but its implementation is deferred to a fmp driver.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Memory range capsule gives us a way to notify that some memory regions
should be left untouched across the next reset.
See UEFI specification, section 8.5.3.
Since how we should handle this kind of capsule is totally up to
the system, no implementation will be added in this commit.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Capsule data can be loaded into the system either via UpdateCapsule
runtime service or files on a file system (of boot device).
The latter case is called "capsules on disk", and actual updates will
take place at the next boot time.
In this commit, we will support capsule on disk mechanism.
Please note that U-Boot itself has no notion of "boot device" and
all the capsule files to be executed will be detected only if they
are located in a specific directory, \EFI\UpdateCapsule, on a device
that is identified as a boot device by "BootXXXX" variables.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
In this commit, skeleton functions for capsule-related API's are
added under CONFIG_EFI_UPDATE_CAPSULE configuration.
Detailed implementation for a specific capsule type will be added
in the succeeding patches.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Since update_flash() is used only in update_tftp(), it should be
guarded with appropriate config options.
After the commit 3149e524fc, common/update.c will be built under
either CONFIG_UDATE_TFTP, CONFIG_DFU_TFTP or CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT.
Since CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT, hence fit_update(), doesn't rely on
update_flash(), the compiler may cause an "unused" warning if
CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT=y and CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP=n and CONFIG_DFU_TFTP=n.
This is, for example, the case for sandbox defconfig where
EFI_CAPSULE_FIRMWARE_FIT is enabled for test purpose.
Fixes: 3149e524fc ("common: update: add a generic interface for FIT
image")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
A previous commit is adding EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL, which in it's eventlog
support registers an EFI configuration table.
Let's add the necessary GUID so 'efidebug table' command can display
table names properly.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
In the previous patches we only introduced a minimal subset of the
EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL protocol implementing GetCapability().
So let's continue adding features to it, introducing the
GetEventLog() and HashLogExtendEvent() functions.
In order to do that we first need to construct the eventlog in memory,
specifically in EFI_BOOT_SERVICES_DATA memory and a configuration table
from EFI_ACPI_MEMORY_NVS.
U-Boot won't currently add any events to the log or measure any
components, but will expose the necessary EFI APIs for applications
to do so.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
A following patch introduces support for the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL
eventlog management.
Introduce the necessary tpm related headers
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
The current tpm2_pcr_extend is hardcoded using SHA256.
Let's make the actual command to the TPM2 configurable so we can support
a wider range of algorithms and keep the current command line as-is i.e
limited to SHA256 only
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use logging functions instead of printf() and debug().
Change logging messages for uclass creation and destruction to log_debug().
Reported-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Kontron SMARC-sAL28 board uses that flash.
This is the same change as in the linux commit f3418718c0ec ("mtd:
spi-nor: Add support for w25q32jwm").
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reported-by: Leo Krueger <leo.krueger@zal.aero>
Since update_flash() is used only in update_tftp(), it should be
guarded with appropriate config options.
After the commit 3149e524fc, common/update.c will be built under
either CONFIG_UDATE_TFTP, CONFIG_DFU_TFTP or CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT.
Since CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT, hence fit_update(), doesn't rely on
update_flash(), the compiler may cause an "unused" warning if
CONFIG_UPDATE_FIT=y and CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP=n and CONFIG_DFU_TFTP=n.
This is, for example, the case for sandbox defconfig where
EFI_CAPSULE_FIRMWARE_FIT is enabled for test purpose.
Fixes: 3149e524fc ("common: update: add a generic interface for FIT
image")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
This comment is in the wrong format, so reports an error with
'make htmldocs'. Fix it.
Fixes: a294ead8d2 ("dm: Use an allocated array for run-time device info")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This comment is in the wrong format, so reports an error with
'make htmldocs'. Fix it.
Fixes: b73d61a556 ("x86: zimage: Add a little more logging")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
It seems nobody tested the debug() option in spin_lock_irqsave().
Currently, when #define DEBUG, it spoils the compiler with
In file included from drivers/usb/dwc3/gadget.c:18:
drivers/usb/dwc3/gadget.c: In function ‘dwc3_gadget_set_selfpowered’:
include/log.h:235:4: warning: ‘flags’ is used uninitialized in this function [-Wuninitialized]
235 | printf(pr_fmt(fmt), ##args); \
| ^~~~~~
drivers/usb/dwc3/gadget.c:1347:17: note: ‘flags’ was declared here
1347 | unsigned long flags;
| ^~~~~
and so on...
Drop useless debug() call to make compiler happy.
Fixes: 0c06db5983 ("lib, linux: move linux specific defines to linux/compat.h")
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Oleksandr Andrushchenko <oleksandr_andrushchenko@epam.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
timeout should be in "millisecond" instead of second,
so divided it by 1000 when calculate the load value.
Signed-off-by: Zhao Qiang <qiang.zhao@nxp.com>
This commit add the support of signature check for config node
in spl/tpl when the function spl_load_simple_fit is used.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
USB clocks were completely forgotten as driver would always return 0 even if clock ID was unknown.
This behaviour changed with "IPQ40xx: clk: dont always return 0" and this will now causes the USB-s to fail probing as clock enable will return -EINVAL.
So to fix that lets add all of the USB clocks to the driver.
Fixes: 430e1dcf ("IPQ40xx: Add USB nodes")
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Currently the driver will go through the clock ID-s and set/enable them as needed.
But if the ID is unknown it will fall through the switch case to the default case which will always return 0.
This is not correct and default cases should return a error code since clock ID is unknown.
So lets return -EINVAL instead.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
There is no point in having break statements in the switch case as there is already a return before break.
So lets drop them from the driver.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Lets convert the driver to use dev_read_addr() instead of the devfdt_get_addr().
While we are here, lets also alphabetise the includes.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Move CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2 in Kconfig, depending
on CONFIG_HUSH_PARSER, and remove the default value defined
in cli_hush.c under __U_BOOT__.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is no reason to define default option for this macro which is
already done in common/cli_hush.c.
87 #ifndef CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
88 #define CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2 "> "
89 #endif
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Acked-by: Oleksandr Andrushchenko <oleksandr_andrushchenko@epam.com>
CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is not related to the RTC drivers. It does not make any
sense to let the updating of the RTC by the sntp command depend on it.
Drop the CONFIG_TIMESTAMP checks.
Furthermore function dm_rtc_set() is enabled by CONFIG_DM_RTC. There is no
reason to require CONFIG_CMD_DATE when using a driver model RTC. The UEFI
sub-system can consume the RTC functions even if there is not date command.
Only check CONFIG_CMD_DATE when using a non-driver model RTC.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add support for dealing with string operands, including reading a string
from memory into an environment variable and concatenating two strings.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
At present a ulong is used to hold operand values. This means that
strings cannot be used. While most operations are not useful for strings,
concatenation is. As a starting point to supporting strings, convert the
code to use a struct instead of a ulong for operands.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present when more than one substitution is made this function
overwrites its buffers. Fix this bug and update the tests now that they
can pass.
Also update the debug code to show all substrings, since at present it
omits the final one.
Fixes: 855f18ea0e ("setexpr: add regex substring matching and substitution")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the 'nlen' variable increases with each loop. If the previous
loop had back references, then subsequent loops without back references
use the wrong value of nlen. The value is larger, meaning that the string
terminator from nbuf is copied along to the main buffer, thus terminating
the string prematurely.
This leads to the final result being truncated, e.g. missing the last
(unmatched) part of the string. So "match match tail" become
"replaced replaced" instead of "replaced replaced tail".
Fix this by resetting nlen to the correct value each time around the lop.
Fixes: 855f18ea0e ("setexpr: add regex substring matching and substitution")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add tests to check for buffer overflow using simple replacement as well
as back references. At present these don't fully pass.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function always allocates a large amount of stack, and
selects its own size for buffers. This makes it hard to test the code
for buffer overflow.
Separate out the inner logic of the substitution so that tests can call
this directly. This will allow checking that the algorithm does not
overflow the buffer.
Fix up one of the error lines at the same time, since it should be
printing nbuf_size, not data_size.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add tests for the setexpr regex commands.
Note that these tests currently crash on sandbox due to an existing bug in
the setexpr implementation, so two of the tests are commented out.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function assumes that a size of 4 refers to a ulong. This
is true on 32-bit machines but not commonly on 64-bit machines.
This means that the 'l' specify does not work correctly with setexpr.
Add an explicit case for 32-bit values so that 64-bit machines can still
use the 'l' specifier. On 32-bit machines, 64-bit is still not supported.
This corrects the operation of the default size (which is 4 for setexpr),
so update the tests accordingly.
The original code for reading from memory was included in 47ab5ad145
("cmd_setexpr: allow memory addresses in expressions") but I am not adding
a Fixes: tag since that code was not written with 64-bit machines in mind.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present these values are open-coded in a few places. Add constants so
the meaning is clear.
Also add a comment to cmd_get_data_size()
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This command currently has no tests. Add some for basic assignment and the
integer operations.
Note that the default size for setexpr is ulong, which varies depending on
the build machine. So for sandbox on a 64-bit host, this means that the
default size is 64 bits.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On more places is used pattern 'command > $@ || rm -f $@'. But it does not
propagate failure from 'command' as 'rm -f' returns success.
Fix it by calling 'false' to correctly propagate failure after 'rm -f'.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
- ProxyDHCP allows a second DHCP server to exist alongside your main
DHCP server and supply additional BOOTP related options
- When u-boot sends out a DHCP request, the real DHCP server will
respond with a normal response containing the new client IP address
while simultaneously the ProxyDHCP server will respond with a blank
client IP address and a `bootfile` option
- This patch adds CONFIG_SERVERIP_FROM_PROXYDHCP (default false) to
enable this behavior and CONFIG_SERVERIP_FROM_PROXYDHCP_DELAY_MS
(default 100) which tells u-boot to wait additional time after
receiving the main DHCP response to give the ProxyDHCP response time
to arrive
- The PXE spec for ProxyDHCP is more complicated than the solution
added here as diagramed on page 16:
http://www.pix.net/software/pxeboot/archive/pxespec.pdf:
```
DHCP Discover will be retried four times. The four timeouts are 4, 8, 16
and 32 seconds respectively. If a DHCPOFFER is received without an Option
timeouts in an attempt to receive a PXE response.
```
- Adding a simple delay worked for my purposes but let me know if a
more robust solution is required
Signed-off-by: Lyle Franklin <lylejfranklin@gmail.com>
As FDTDIR label doesn't specify exact file to be loaded, it should
not fail if no file exists in the directory. In this case try to boot
with internal FDT if it exists.
Signed-off-by: Anton Leontiev <aleontiev@elvees.com>
The origin patch didn't have this change and it was caused by manual
resolution where additional backslash was added.
Fixes: 6723b4c6ca ("binman: Call helper function binman_set_rom_offset() to fill offset")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The test should be checking whether $flags are non-zero and $drv_flags
contain specific flags, however these two sets of flags are separate,
and the two tests should be logically ANDed, not bitwise ANDed.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since commit 6900797678 ("cros_ec: Support keyboard scanning with
EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT") the cros-ec-keyb driver has started using this
command, but the sandbox EC emulator does not recognize it and
continuously prints:
** Unknown EC command 0x67
This patch makes the sandbox driver send basic responses to the command,
but the response only supports keyboard scans for now.
The EC side of this command stores and returns events from a queue, and
returns -EC_RES_UNAVAILABLE when there are no new events. This should be
possible to implement by hooking into the SDL event queue (perhaps via
sandbox_sdl_poll_events). Implementing that is a bit harder to do since
the existing sandbox code is discarding pending keyboard events, then
reading the current keyboard state.
Since the EC emulator never explicitly fails to work on this command,
the fallback to the older command will not trigger and will not be
tested anymore.
Fixes: 6900797678 ("cros_ec: Support keyboard scanning with EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT")
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if CROSS_COMPILE contains a tilde, such as
~/.buildman-toolchains/gcc-7.3.0-nolibc/i386-linux/bin/i386-linux-gcc
then binman gives a confusing error:
binman: Error 255 running '~/..buildman-toolchains/gcc-7.3.0- ...
Fix this by expanding it out before running the tool.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a tool to update or insert an Octeon specific header into the U-Boot
image. This is needed e.g. for booting via SPI NOR, eMMC and NAND.
While working on this, move enum cvmx_board_types_enum and
cvmx_board_type_to_string() to cvmx-bootloader.h and remove the
unreferenced (unsupported) board definition.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Using ram_get_info() is complicated and does not work after relocation.
Now that gd->ram_size holds the full RAM size, let's use it instead and
remove the ram_get_size logic completely.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
With this patch, gd->ram_size now holds to full RAM size detected by the
DDR init code. It introduces the get_effective_memsize() function to
report the maximum usable RAM size in U-Boot to the system instead.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Don't use "platdata_auto_alloc_size" but "priv_auto_alloc_size" instead
to auto allocate the private data struct, which is referenced via
dev_get_priv() in this driver. This fixes an ugly bug detected while
trying to boot via SPI NOR.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Octeon has a specific boot header, when booted via SPI NOR, NAND or MMC.
Here the only 2 instructions are allowed in the first few bytes of the
image. And these instructions need to be one branch and a nop. This
patch adds the necessary nop after the nop, to that the common MIPS
image is compatible with this Octeon header.
The tool to patch the Octeon boot header into the image will be send in
a follow-up patch.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
Cc: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc3 (3)
The following errors are corrected:
* Linux crash when accessing UEFI variables at runtime.
* UEFI variable using standalone MM on 32 bit systems
not working due to missing packing of communication
structure
* NULL dereference when FAT16 root directory is full
* FAT files with a short file name starting with 0xE5 (0x05 in directory
entry) where treated as deleted.
The UEFI SetTime() service is enabled on ARM QEMU.
commit 1fabfeef506c ("efi_loader: parameter check in GetNextVariableName()")
introduces a check using u16_strnlen(). This code is used on EFI
runtime variables as well, so unless we mark it as runtime, the kernel
will crash trying to access it.
Fixes: 1fabfeef506c ("efi_loader: parameter check in GetNextVariableName()")
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Enable EFI_SET_TIME on the sandbox and QEMU ARM to ensure that we compile
and test the relevant code.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Using constants instead of anonymous numbers increases code readability.
Fixes: 704df6aa0a ("fs: fat: refactor write interface for a file offset")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
0x05 is used as replacement letter for 0xe5 at the first position of short
file names. We must not skip over directory entries starting with 0x05.
Cf. Microsoft FAT Specification, August 30 2005
Fixes: 39606d462c ("fs: fat: handle deleted directory entries correctly")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When trying to create a file in the full root directory of a FAT32
filesystem a NULL dereference can be observed.
When the root directory of a FAT16 filesystem is full fill_dir_slot() must
return -1 to signal that a new directory entry could not be allocated.
Fixes: cd2d727fff ("fs: fat: allocate a new cluster for root directory of fat32")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At present if CONFIG_RESET is not enabled, this code shows a warning:
designware_i2c_ofdata_to_platdata() i2c_designware_pci i2c2@16,0:
Can't get reset: -524
Avoid this by checking if reset is supported, first.
Fixes: 622597dee4 ("i2c: designware: add reset ctrl to driver")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The hidden I2C slave is also present on the Armada 8k AP806. Testing
shows that this I2C slave causes the same issues as Armada 38x.
Disabling that I2C slave fixes all these issues.
I2C blocks on the Armada 8k CP110 are not affected.
Extend the I2C slave disable to Armada 8k as well.
Cc: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Regulator can be set to "always-on".
It's not error about enable/disable. It needs to check about
its condition.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
For eMMC HS400 mode, the DLL reset is a required step for mmc rescan.
This step has not been documented in reference manual, but the RM will
be fixed sooner or later.
In previous commit to support eMMC HS400,
db8f936 mmc: fsl_esdhc: support eMMC HS400 mode
the steps to configure DLL could be found in commit message,
13. Set DLLCFG0[DLL_ENABLE] and DLLCFG0[DLL_FREQ_SEL].
14. Wait for delay chain to lock.
these would be fixed as,
13. Set DLLCFG0[DLL_ENABLE] and DLLCFG0[DLL_FREQ_SEL].
13.1 Write DLLCFG0[DLL_RESET] to 1 and wait for 1us,
then write DLLCFG0[DLL_RESET]
14. Wait for delay chain to lock.
This patch is to add the step of DLL reset, and make sure delay chain
locked for HS400.
Fixes: db8f93672b ("mmc: fsl_esdhc: support eMMC HS400 mode")
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The initial clock setting should be through sysctl register only,
while the mmc_set_clock() will call mmc_set_ios() introduce other
configurations like bus width, mode, and so on.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
All of the existing quirks add retries to various calls of mmc_send_cmd.
mmc_send_cmd_quirks is a helper function to do this retrying behavior. It
checks if quirks mode is enabled, and if a specific quirk is activated it
retries on error.
This also adds mmc_send_cmd_retry, which retries on error every time
(instead of if a quirk is activated).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
The AT91 architecture now has two possible timer blocks, the old PIT timer
and the new PIT64B.
The timer.c file has an old non DM driver that works for platforms
that do not use the ATMEL_PIT_TIMER DM-based driver.
Update the Makefile to select this old driver in case neither of the
ATMEL_PIT_TIMER and the MCHP_PIT64B_TIMER are selected.
Suggested-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
SAMA7G5 uses CCF driver under drivers/clk/at91/ and not the custom older
at91 clock.c driver. Remove it from the compilation list and adapt cpu.c
arch_cpu_init() to avoid calling at91_clock_init() which is wrong
anyway.
Signed-off-by: Nicolas Ferre <nicolas.ferre@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Align the pin setup for sdhci0 with linux kernel.
This means to have slew rate enable and high drive strength.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
If the clock driver does not offer a clk_enable ops, then the system will
return -ENOSYS.
The clk_enable works with CCF (common clock framework).
Some clocks in some cases (like the generic clock for some products: sama5d2)
do not have the clk_enable primitive, and in this case probing of the driver
will fail.
This patch changes the behavior to return an error in case there is really
an error, and not a missing primitive.
If the clock driver does not have an enable primitive, most likely clocks
are always enabled or enabled in the set_rate primitives.
Fixes: 81f16438d4 ("mmc: atmel-sdhci: enable the required generic clock")
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
- STM32 MCU's DT update
- Add DHCOM based STM32MP15x PicoITX board
- Correct ALIGN macro usage for on syram for SPL dcache support
- Fixes on DHCOM: uSD card-detect GPIO and Drop QSPI CS2
- Fix compilation issue for spl_mmc_boot_partition
- Fix MTD partitions for serial boot
- Add support of MCU HOLD BOOT with reset for stm32 remoteproc
(prepare alligneent with kernel DT)
- Correct bias information and support in STM32 soc and STMFX
- Support optional vbus in usbphyc
- Update FIT examples to avoid kernel zImage relocation before decompression
Update kernel load address for FIT examples to avoid relocation:
- Kernel example uses Image.gz with U-Boot gzip decompression
at final kernel location 0x0xC0008000.
- Copro example loads zImage at a correct location (0xC4000000),
to avoid zImage relocation before decompression by kernel code.
An other solution to avoid zImage relocation is to align
the kernel load and entry address with the real location in FIT
(the relocation of zImage is skipped in U-Boot bootm command for
identical address) but it is less flexible because this offset
depends on FIT content:
For example:
## Loading kernel from FIT Image at c2000000 ...
Using 'ev1' configuration
Trying 'kernel' kernel subimage
Description: Linux kernel
Created: 2020-10-22 9:08:32 UTC
Type: Kernel Image
Compression: uncompressed
Data Start: 0xc20000cc
The kernel offset in FIT is 0xCC in FIT and zImage is decompressed at
0xC0008000 by kernel code:
kernel {
description = "Linux kernel";
data = /incbin/("zImage");
type = "kernel";
arch = "arm";
os = "linux";
compression = "none";
load = <0xC20000cc>;
entry = <0xC20000cc>;
hash-1 {
algo = "sha1";
};
};
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
This patch adds support for optional vbus regulator.
It is managed on phy_power_on/off calls and may be needed for host mode.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Update pin name to avoid duplicated name with SOC GPIO
gpio0...gpio15 / agpio0....agpio7: add a stmfx prefix.
This pin name can be used in pinmux command.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
The device name is used in pinmux command and in log trace
so it is better to use the parent parent name ("stmfx@42" for
example) than a generic name ("pinctrl" or "stmfx-gpio")
to identify the device instance.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Use the bias configuration for all the GPIO configurations and not
only for input GPIO, as indicated in Reference manual
(Table 81. Port bit configuration table).
Fixes: 43efbb6a3e ("gpio: stm32: add ops get_dir_flags")
Fixes: f13ff88b61 ("gpio: stm32: add ops set_dir_flags")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Display the bias information for input gpios or AF configuration,
and not only for output pin, as described in Reference manual
(Table 81. Port bit configuration table).
Fixes: da7a0bb1f2 ("pinctrl: stm32: add information on pin configuration")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
The coprocessor is running as soon as the hold boot is de-asserted.
So indicate this running state and save the resource table even
if the protective assert, to avoid autonomous reboot, is failed.
This error case should never occurs.
Cc: Fabien DESSENNE <fabien.dessenne@st.com>
Cc: Arnaud POULIQUEN <arnaud.pouliquen@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Use the reset function to handle the hold boot bit in RCC
with device tree handle with MCU_HOLD_BOOT identifier.
This generic reset allows to remove the two specific properties:
- st,syscfg-holdboot
- st,syscfg-tz
This patch prepares alignment with kernel device tree.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Fabien DESSENNE <fabien.dessenne@st.com>
Cc: Arnaud POULIQUEN <arnaud.pouliquen@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Handle the register RCC_MP_GCR without SET/CLR registers
but with a direct access to bit BOOT_MCU:
- deassert => set the bit: The MCU will not be in HOLD_BOOT
- assert => clear the bit: The MCU will be set in HOLD_BOOT
With this patch the RCC driver handles the MCU_HOLD_BOOT_R value
added in binding stm32mp1-resets.h
Cc: Fabien DESSENNE <fabien.dessenne@st.com>
Cc: Arnaud POULIQUEN <arnaud.pouliquen@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Remove the update of the MTD partitions in kernel device tree
for serial boot (USB / UART), and the kernel will use the MTD
partitions define in the loaded DTB because U-Boot can't known the
expected flash layout in this case.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
spl_mmc_boot_partition is only defined when
CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_USE_PARTITION is defined.
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add DT for DH PicoITX unit, which is a bare-bones carrier board for
the DHCOM. The board has ethernet port, USB, CAN, LEDs and a custom
board-to-board expansion connector.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Correct the ALIGN macro usage in mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour
call: the address must use ALIGN_DOWN and size can use ALIGN macro.
With STM32_SYSRAM_BASE=0x2FFC0000 and MMU_SECTION_SIZE=0x100000 for
STM32MP15x the computed address was 30000000 instead of 2ff00000.
Fixes: 43fe9d2fda ("stm32mp1: mmu_set_region_dcache_behaviour")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Commit 4b2be78ab6 ("time: Fix get_ticks being non-monotonic")
puts in evidence that get_ticks is called before timer initialization.
Fix it by initializing timer before relocation.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Since kernel v4.8-rc1, commit 05b23ebc2bd9 ("ARM: dts: armv7-m: remove skeleton.dtsi include"),
skeleton.dtsi file is no more included.
This synchronization is needed to avoid to get 2 memory node
in DTB file if, in DTS file, memory node is declared with the correct
syntax as following:
memory@90000000 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x90000000 0x800000>;
};
Then in DTB, we will have the 2 memory nodes, which is incorrect and
cause misbehavior during DT parsing by U-boot:
memory {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x00 0x00>;
};
memory@90000000 {
device_type = "memory";
reg = <0x90000000 0x800000>;
};
Issue found when synchronizing MCU's STM32 DT from kernel v5.10-rc1.
When using fdtdec_setup_mem_size_base() or fdtdec_setup_memory_banksize()
API, first above memory node is found (with reg = <0x00 0x00>), so
gd->ram_size, gd->ram_base, gd->bd->bi_dram[bank].start and
gd->bd->bi_dram[bank].size are all set to 0 which avoid boards to boot.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
If CONFIG_PHY is not enabled then the dwc3_setup_phy()
returns ENOTSUPP which can be still valid and intentional
so modify error check to handle this -ENOTSUPP.
The same error handling exists in drivers/usb/host/xhci-dwc3.c already
added by commit d648a50c0a ("dwc3: move phy operation to core.c").
Signed-off-by: Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu <siva.durga.paladugu@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
On some board, the ID pin is not connected so the B session must be
overridden with "u-boot,force_b_session_valid" but the VBus sensing
must continue to be handle.
To managed it, this patch adds a new DT field
"u-boot,force-vbus-detection" to use with "u-boot,force_b_session_valid"
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This driver supports both RZ/G2H and R-Car H3 SoCs.
Optimize pinctrl image size for RZ/G2H, when support for R-Car H3
(R8A7795) is not enabled
Based on the similar patch on Linux.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
This driver supports both RZ/G2N and R-Car M3-N SoCs.
Optimize pinctrl image size for RZ/G2N, when support for R-Car M3-N
(R8A77965) is not enabled.
Based on the simialr patch on Linux.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
This driver supports both RZ/G2M and R-Car M3-W/W+ SoCs.
Optimize pinctrl image size for RZ/G2M, when support for R-Car M3-W/W+
(R8A7796[01]) is not enabled.
Based on the similar patch on Linux.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Renesas RZ/G2H (r8a774e1) is pin compatible with R-Car H3 (r8a77951),
however it doesn't have several automotive specific peripherals. Add
a r8a77951 specific pin groups/functions along with common pin
groups/functions for supporting both r8a77951 and r8a774e1 SoC.
PFC changes are synced from mainline linux-5.9 commit
bbf5c979011a ("Linux 5.9").
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Renesas RZ/G2N (r8a774b1) is pin compatible with R-Car M3-N (r8a77965),
however it doesn't have several automotive specific peripherals. Add
a r8a77965 specific pin groups/functions along with common pin
groups/functions for supporting both r8a77965 and r8a774b1 SoC.
PFC changes are synced from mainline linux-5.9 commit
bbf5c979011a ("Linux 5.9").
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc3 (2)
The parameter check for UEFI service GetNextVariableName() is corrected.
The dependencies of CONFIG_DFU_TFTP are simplified.
The set of supported hash algorithms reported by the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL is
corrected.
If GetNextVariableName() is called with a non-existing combination of
VariableName and VendorGuid, return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER.
If GetNextVariableName() is called with a string that is not zero
terminated, return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER.
Reformat a line over 80 characters.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Since CONFIG_UPDATE_COMMON always selects CONFIG_DFU_WRITE_ALT, we can
drop the latter from dependencies of CONFIG_DFU_TFTP.
Fixes: 3149e524fc ("common: update: add a generic interface for FIT
image")
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Xilinx changes for v2021.01-rc3
Microblaze:
- Enable GC
- Get rid of xparameters.h and switch to DT for CFI
- Fix config file
tpm:
- Fix TPM code
zynqmp:
- Enable TPM by default
- Remove unused macros
fru:
- Several fixes especially use limit for recording
If customs fields in board area are used it will likely go over allocated
space in struct fru_board_data. That's why calculate limit of this
structure to make sure that different data is not rewritten by accident.
When limit is reached stop to record fields.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
capture variable is bool which is just one byte and it is just causing
unaligned accesses. Better to have it as last entry in the structure.
It also simplify offset calculation for initial header copy.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no reason to have these macros. But record offsets of missing
register in the structure for future use.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no need for GD to be used and priv variable is unused.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove fixed configuration and detect flash based on DT.
Also increase amount of flash sectors to 2048 because on kc705 flash has
1027 sectors.
Bank # 1: CFI conformant flash (16 x 16) Size: 128 MB in 1027 Sectors
Intel Extended command set, Manufacturer ID: 0x89, Device ID: 0x8962
Erase timeout: 4096 ms, write timeout: 2 ms
Buffer write timeout: 5 ms, buffer size: 1024 bytes
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
XIP is not enabled in SPL. SPL_NOR is enabled but any macro setting with
using SYS_FLASH_BASE are wrong because it is not aligned with DM.
That's why change these macro and align them with TEXT_BASE macro.
Information should be find at run time based on DT but implementation is
not done yet.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no need to use this file anymore. Include it in main config file
and simplify logic based on it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable caches by default. For now just simplify config file but it should
be read from DT or PVRs.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
A lot of configs has been moved to Kconfig and it ends up in ifdef mess
with no bodies. That's why remove all of them.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
GCC's garbage collector works for Microblaze for quite a long time but none
has enabled it.
The same change has be done for example by commit fac4790491 ("arc:
Eliminate unused code and data with GCC's garbage collector").
Before:
text data bss dec hex filename
588760 33592 39192 661544 a1828 u-boot
After:
text data bss dec hex filename
504504 32164 38608 575276 8c72c u-boot
Which saves almost 15% of memory footprint.
Also group symbols/functions to proper section.
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
offset is the offset in the file read, not the offset in the destination
buffer.
If the offset is not null, this will lead to a memory corruption.
So, for now, we are returning an error if the offset is used.
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
sqfs_decompressor_init() returns a value, so it's better to use it than
to force the return value to EINVAL (it could be ENOMEM)
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
Resetting the context on error will prevent some checks like:
if (!ctx.cur_dev)
To pass when the probe method has failed
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
finfo.blk_sizes may not be freed in case of error in the for loop
Setting it to null and freeing it at the end makes prevents that from
happening.
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
if sqfs_tokenize(rel_tokens, rc, rel); fails, the function exits
without freeing the array base_tokens.
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
the return value of sqfs_tokenize(rel_tokens, rc, rel); wasn't checked.
(but "ret" value was !)
This is obviouly a typo.
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
sqfs_closedir() should be called to free memory allocated by
sqfs_opendir()
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
path, target, res, rem and sym_tokens were not free on error nor success.
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
Using only one label permits to prevents bugs when moving code around.
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
add missing squashfs function to prevent dangling or null pointers.
For exemple, when calling test [ -e somefile ], squashfs.exists may be
called.
Signed-off-by: Richard Genoud <richard.genoud@posteo.net>
Reviewed-by: Joao Marcos Costa <jmcosta944@gmail.com>
In show_dir() if we hit a ROOT_ITEM, we can exit with uninitialized
@ret.
Fix it by initializing it to 0.
Reported-by: Coverity CID 312955
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
In btrfs_lookup_path() the local variable @type should always be updated
after we hit any file/dir.
But if @filename is NULL from the very beginning, then we don't
initialize it and return it directly.
To prevent such problem from happening, we initialize @type to
BTRFS_FT_UNKNOWN.
For normal execution route, it will get updated for each filename we
resolved.
Buf if we didn't find any path, we check if the type is still FT_UNKNOWN
and ret == 0. If true we know there is something wrong, just return
-EUCLEAN to inform the caller.
Reported-by: Coverity CID 312958
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
I've created a squashfs file system with Yocto (it use squashfs-tools)
and u-boot command sqfsls give the error:'Error while searching inode:
unknown type.'
After some digging in the code I found that the index is off by 1.
This patch fix this issue and I can successful use the sqfsls command.
After search for the squashfs format I found a link talk about a
similar issue but this time in the documentation. The link is:
https://github.com/AgentD/squashfs-tools-ng/commit/e6588526838caece9529
Signed-off-by: Gerard Koskamp <gerard.koskamp@nedap.com>
Tested-by: Joao Marcos Costa <joaomarcos.costa@bootlin.com>
This change sets the output (hardware) polarity register instead of the
input (software) polarity register for the bcm6858 LED controller. The
logic was inverted (a LED configued active high behaved as active low).
Signed-off-by: Steven Lawrance <steven.lawrance@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Also change back SYS_MEMTEST_END to 0x00f00000. 0xe00000 was wrong and
introduced due to the global Kconfig migration of this option in u-boot.
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
The -i option of the dumpimage tool has been removed so it should no
longer be documented in the README file. Refer readers to the tool's
help output rather than maintain a copy of the usage in the README.
Finally, adjust the example dumpfile invocation in imagetool.h to use
the -o option instead of the removed -i option.
Fixes: 12b831879a ("tools: dumpimage: Simplify arguments")
Signed-off-by: Tyler Hicks <tyhicks@linux.microsoft.com>
Cc: Martyn Welch <martyn.welch@collabora.com>
Acked-by: Martyn Welch <martyn.welch@collabora.com>
In the function get_random_data, strerrno is called with
the variable ret (which is the return of the function
clock_gettime). It should be called with errnor. This
commit fixes this mistake.
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312956)
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
According to the manpage of rand, it is recommended
to use random instead of rand. This commit updates
the function get_random_data to use random.
Reported-by: Coverity (CID: 312953)
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Re-submitted because of missing description and signed-off.
flags reset in board_init caused bugs when executing command like editenv
because the reallocated flag was lost.
Tested-by: Michael Opdenacker <michael.opdenacker@bootlin.com>
Signed-off-by: Arnaud Aujon Chevallier <arnaud@intelibre.fr>
The function mmc_offset_try_partition searches the MMC partition for
locating environment data, by comparing the partition names with config
"u-boot,mmc-env-parition". However, it only compares the first word-size
bytes (size of 'const char *'), which may make the function to find
unintended partition.
Correct the function not to partially compare the partition name with
config "u-boot,mmc-env-partition".
Fixes: c9e87ba665 ("env: Save environment at the end of an MMC partition")
Signed-off-by: Hoyeonjiki Kim <jigi.kim@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
I2C and SCCB previously shared defaults. However, SCCB needs OE_INV and
IE_INV set, but I2C cannot have those bits set. This adds a separate
default for SCCB.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Damien Le Moal <Damien.LeMoal@wdc.com>
How to add an emulated disk to QEMU may not be known to the user.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Allow attaching a virtual SATA disk to QEMU RISC-V by implying
AHCI, AHCI_PCI, CMD_SCSI, DM_SCSI, PCI_INIT_R, SCSI, SCSI_AHCI.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Sort implied options in BOARD_SPECIFIC_OPTIONS in the same sequence as in
.config.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
This commit imports device tree files that are related to Allwinner V3
series from Linux commit 3650b228f83a ("Linux 5.10-rc1").
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The reference design of Allwinner V3 series uses an
AXP203 or AXP209 PMIC attached to the I2C0 bus of the SoC, although the
first community-available V3s board, Lichee Pi Zero, omitted it.
Allow to introduce support for the PMIC on boards with it.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
A new compatible string is introduced for V3 CCU, because it has a few
extra features available.
Add the compatible string to the clock driver. As the extra features are
not touched, just share the description struct now.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
A new compatible string is introduced for V3 GPIO, because it has more
pins available than V3s.
Add the compatible string to the GPIO driver.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Allwinner V3/Sochip S3 uses the same die with Allwinner V3s/S3L, but V3 comes
with no co-packaged DDR (DDR3 is usually used externally), and S3L comes
with co-packaged DDR3.
Add support for Allwinner V3/S3 chips by add SoC names to original V3s
choice, and allow to select DDR3.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The PinePhone is a smartphone produced by Pine64, with an A64 SoC,
2 or 3 GiB LPDDR3 RAM, 16 or 32 GiB eMMC, 720x1440 MIPI-DSI panel,
and Quectel EG25-G modem.
There are two main board revisions: 1.1 for early adopters, and 1.2
for mass production. Since there is code to detect the board revision
at boot, one config/image can support both boards.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Import updated device trees from Linux tag v5.9. This picks up new
hardware (PinePhone, PineTab); and it drops the U-Boot specific DTSI
files for the Pinebook and the Teres-I, since the ANX6345 bridge is
now supported upstream.
A couple of headers needed updates for recently-added hardware support.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Previously, fdtfile was always the value in CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE.
This meant that, regardless of the DT chosen by SPL (either by changing
the header in the image or by the selection code at runtime), Linux
always used the default DT.
By using the name from the SPL header (which, because of the previous
commit, always matches the DT used by U-Boot proper), Linux also sees
the same board as U-Boot/SPL, even if the boot script later loads a DT
from disk.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
[Andre: remove no longer needed CONFIG_SPL_LOAD_FIT guards]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
This overwrites the name loaded from the SPL image. It will be different
if there was previously no name provided, or if a more accurate name was
determined by the board variant selection logic. This means that the DT
name in the SPL header now always matches the DT appended to U-Boot.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
[Andre: move function under CONFIG_SPL_LOAD_FIT guard]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
There are two different publicly-released revisions of the PinePhone
hardware, versions 1.1 and 1.2; and they need different device trees.
Since some GPIO pins were rerouted, we can use that to distinguish
between them.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Instead of using an entirely separate matching algorithm, simply update
the name of the DT we want to match. Enabling this logic does not depend
on the FIT config name, only on the initial guess of the board name.
Importantly, the initial guess must be "sun50i-a64-pine64-plus", because
otherwise the logic would trigger when "sun50i-a64-pine64-lts" was
written to the SPL header.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This moves the validity checking and typecasts all to one place away
from the string comparison logic, and it detangles the compile-time
and runtime control flow.
The new helper will also be used by U-Boot proper in a future commit.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
[Andre: protect new function with CONFIG_SPL_LOAD_FIT]
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
The variable "cmp_str" always leaves me wondering if it is the DT name
of the current board (yes) or DT name in the FIT config entry (no).
In preparation for expanding the functionality here, rename it to
something that obviously means "this is the DT name we are looking for".
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
- Clock fix MMC driver for SM1 based platforms
- sync SOC Ids from Linux 5.10-rc1
- fix potential build warning on meson_dw_hdmi and meson-g12a-usb2 phy
- Fix USB support for rk3399 Pinebook Pro;
- Fix SPI boot for rk3399 boards other than Bob;
- Fix 32bit boards firmware build without SPL_OPTEE support;
- Fix rockchip display driver license;
onenand_probe() function is missing to set mtd->type. So set same type as
which sets onenand Linux kernel driver.
After this change 'mtd list' prints correct type instead of 'Unknown'.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
set_gpmc_cs0() sets wrong timings and size for Nokia N900 onenand flash.
Fix that by setting the correct timings and size from the board code
Signed-off-by: Ivaylo Dimitrov <ivo.g.dimitrov.75@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Include emmc/nand suffix into bootmenu script names and fix leaking sleep
processes when asynchronously waiting for them. 'wait -n' is not provided
by /bin/sh, so run script under bash.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
After commit d5243359e1 ("OMAP24xx I2C: Add support for set-speed")
U-Boot is unstable to reset lp5523 led. That commit added pooling for i2c
poll ARDY bit which apparently is never set. It is not known what is
happening here.
Purpose of resetting lp5523 led in Nokia RX-51 code is just to turn off
very bright led which is powered on by NOLO and expects next boot image
(kernel or U-Boot) to turn it off.
After testing we observed that just disabling lp5523 led is working fine.
So as a workaround to this ARDY bit i2c issue we disable lp5523 led instead
of resetting it.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Cc: Ivaylo Dimitrov <ivo.g.dimitrov.75@gmail.com>
After commit 04a2ea248f ("mmc: disable UHS modes if Vcc cannot be
switched on and off") U-Boot started crashing on Nokia RX-51 while
initializing mmc and caused reboot loop.
It looks like that some clocks were not enabled and this patch fixes U-Boot
mmc crash.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Cc: Ivaylo Dimitrov <ivo.g.dimitrov.75@gmail.com>
By default CONFIG_LOGLEVEL seems to be set to 4 which is
too low and doesn't show dev_info/dev_notice/dev_warn
messages on console. This has been deliberately set low
globally to be conservative setting across the board due to
primary bootloader size limitations. It is best to tune
per board config as per user needs.
On K3 we have separate SPL and u-boot configs so we
can afford to set u-boot CONFIG_LOGLEVEL to 7.
On AM65 this patch causes u-boot.img size to change from
932KB to 940KB with 1 line additional print during
MMC boot. i.e. details of Net subsystem
"Net: K3 CPSW: nuss_ver: 0x6BA00102 cpsw_ver: 0x6BA80102 ale_ver: 0x00293904 Ports:1 mdio_freq:1000000"
Similar 8KB difference was seen on J721E.
Signed-off-by: Roger Quadros <rogerq@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Function twl4030_i2c_read() is like twl4030_i2c_read_u8() but instead of
single value it rather returns array of values.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
With commit 6900797678 ("cros_ec: Support keyboard scanning with
EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT") check_for_keys() tries to read keyboard
strokes using EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT. But the sandbox driver does
not understand this command. We need to reply with
-EC_RES_INVALID_COMMAND to force check_for_keys() to fall back to
use EC_CMD_MKBP_STATE. Currently the driver prints
** Unknown EC command 0x67
in this case. With the patch the message is suppressed.
In a future patch we should upgrade the sandbox driver to provide
EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT support.
Fixes: 6900797678 ("cros_ec: Support keyboard scanning with EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Erasing the flash can take over a second on some devices and the EC is
not responsive during this time. Update the timeout to 5 seconds to cope
with this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The EC now requires that the offset field be set correctly when checking
on hash status. Update the code to handle this. Use the same message
struct in both functions to reduce stack space.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a commit tag to allow the Patchwork URL to be specified in a commit.
This can be handy for when you submit code to multiple projects but don't
want to use the -p option.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an argument to allow specifying the the patchwork URL. This also adds
this feature to the settings file, either globally, or on a per-project
basis.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new argument to allow the URL of the patchwork server to be
speciified. For now this is hard-coded in the main file, but future
patches will move it to the settings file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present values from the settings file are only applied to the main
parser. With the new parser structure this means that some settings are
ignored.
Update the implementation to set defaults across the main parser and all
subparsers. Also fix up the comments, since ArgumentParser is being used
now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present patman tries to assume a default subcommand of 'send', to
maintain backwards compatibility. However it does not cope with
arguments added to the default command, so for example 'patman -t'
does not work.
Update the logic to handle this. Also update the CC command to use 'send'
explicitly, since otherwise patman gets confused with the patch-filename
argument.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc3
A part of the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL is implemented.
A unit test is supplied.
The following bugs are fixed:
* incorrect buffer size in efi_file_setinfo() leading to creash in SCT
* a crash in UEFI selftest on the sandbox due to removed drivers
* missing newlines in log message for the UEFI RNG driver
Since U-boot EFI implementation is getting richer it makes sense to
add support for EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL taking advantage of any hardware TPM
available on the device.
This is the initial implementation of the protocol which only adds
support for GetCapability(). It's limited in the newer and safer
TPMv2 devices.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Acked-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
A following patch introduces EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL.
Add the required TPMv2 headers to support it.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When copying a string with must allocate a byte for the terminating '\0' in
the target buffer.
Fixes: fbe4c7df00 ("efi_loader: enable file SetInfo()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add missing newline to log messages in efi_rng_register() otherwise
something like below would be shown
Scanning disk virtio-blk#31...
Found 2 disks
Missing RNG device for EFI_RNG_PROTOCOLNo EFI system partition
Signed-off-by: Paulo Alcantara (SUSE) <pc@cjr.nz>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When calling ExitBootServices during out unit tests we should not detach
devices as we need console output for runtime tests.
Fixes: 529441ca89 ("efi_loader: Disable devices before handing over control")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Rockchip has many 32bit SoCs and some of them are support SPL_OPTEE now,
only boards with SPL_OPTEE support can fit BINMAN well, other boards
will fail at initr_binman() in U-Boot proper after below patch,
eg. rv1108 board.
83187546ae binman: Support multiple images in the library
Fixes: 79030a4861 ("rockchip: Add Single boot image (with binman, pad_cat)")
Signed-off-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Commit c4cea2bbf9 ("rockchip: Enable building a SPI ROM image on bob")
added an alias spi1 referring to spi@ff1d0000, however there was already
an alias spi0 referring to the same node in rockpro64's u-boot.dtsi, and
having both aliases present broke booting from SPI flash for this board.
Remove the spi0 alias, set the default bus for SPI flash to 1, and
enable support for numbered aliases in SPL so that it uses the same bus
numbering as U-Boot proper. This fixes booting from U-Boot in SPI flash
on the rockpro64 board.
Signed-off-by: Hugh Cole-Baker <sigmaris@gmail.com>
Suggested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fixes: c4cea2bbf9 ("rockchip: Enable building a SPI ROM image on bob")
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Commit fe97471632 ("rockchip: rk3288: Allow setting up clocks in
U-Boot proper") fixes some clock issues when chainloading U-Boot on
rk3288 chromebooks. Part of that change is still available in veyron's
board_early_init_r() function. Since chain-loading U-Boot proper from
vendor firmware is possible on gru boards as well, do the same thing for
them too.
On rk3399, this needs to detect whether SPL was run via handoff, so
enable that and bloblist kconfigs it needs for chromebook_bob.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
It's possible to chainload U-Boot proper from the vendor firmware in
rk3399 chromebooks, but the way the vendor firmware sets up clocks is
somehow different than what U-Boot expects. This causes the display to
stay devoid of content even though vidconsole claims to work (with
patches in process of being upstreamed).
This is meant to be a rk3399 version of commit d3cb46aa8c ("rockchip:
Init clocks again when chain-loading") which can detect the discrepancy,
but this patch instead checks whether SPL (and therefore the clock init)
was run via the handoff functionality and runs the init if it was not.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In order to enable the Amlogic SM1 MMC controller fix, we need to add a u-boot specific
MMC controller compatible.
This adds a new meson-sm1-u-boot.dtsi and reworks the other -u-boot.dtsi
to use this for SM1 based boards.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Amlogic SM1 SoCs doesn't work over 50MHz. When phase sets to 270', it's
working fine over 50MHz on Amlogic SM1 SoCs.
Since Other Amlogic SoCs doens't report an issue, phase value is using
to 180' by default.
To distinguish which value is used adds an u-boot only sm1 compatible.
In future, it needs to find what value is a proper about each SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Tested-by: Anand Moon <linux.amoon@gmail.com>
Move the asm/arch-meson/sd_emmc.h to a local meson_gx_mmc.h,
remove the useless if/then and fix the meson_gx_mmc.c include.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This is a combination of upstream libfdt commits to fix warnings about
comparing signed and unsigned integers:
==========
scripts/dtc/libfdt/fdt.c: In function ‘fdt_offset_ptr’:
scripts/dtc/libfdt/fdt.c:137:18: warning: comparison between signed and unsigned integer expressions [-Wsign-compare]
if ((absoffset < offset)
...
==========
For a detailed description of the fixes, see the dtc repo:
https://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/utils/dtc/dtc.git/log/?id=73e0f143b73d808
For this patch the commits between 73e0f143b73d8088 and ca19c3db2bf62000
have been combined and adjusted for the slight differences in U-Boot's
libfdt code base.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
- Avoid using hardcoded number of variable range MTRRs in mtrr_commit()
- coral: Correct max98357 file
- coral: Update smbios tables to latest definition
The accepted binding uses multiple nodes, one for each table type. Update
coral accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Since commit 29d2d64ed5 ("x86: Add support for more than 8 MTRRs"),
the maximum number of variable range MTRRs was increased from 8 to 10.
On the BayTrail platform there are only 8 variable range MTRRs. In
mtrr_commit() it still uses MTRR_MAX_COUNT which caused a #GP during
VESA video driver probe. It should have been updated to use dynamically
probed number.
This fixes the boot failure seen on Intel Minnow Max board.
Fixes: 29d2d64ed5 ("x86: Add support for more than 8 MTRRs")
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc2 (2)
The following bugs are fixed:
* The conitrace command failed to build.
* Non-volatile UEFI variables were not delete form the file store.
The following features are added:
* Support for the FN1 - FN10 keys on crosswire keyboards is added.
* An EFI binary is provided to dump the binary device tree.
tpm2_get_capability() is adjusted in preparation of the implementation
of the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL.
after commit 4ab3817ff1 ("clk: fixed-rate: Enable DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC flag")
Cubieboard7 (based on actions S700 SoC) fails to boot.
It is due to the fact that the default value of CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN (0x400)
would not provide enough memory for clock device to probe (before relocation)
well.
This commit fixes it, by increasing SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN to value 0x2000.
Suggested-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Signed-off-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com>
In case there is an EEPROM attached to the KS8851 MAC and the EEPROM
contains a valid MAC address, the MAC address is loaded into the NIC
registers on power on. Read the MAC address out of the NIC registers
and provide it to U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
For implementing the EFI_TCG2_PROTOCOL we need the count field returned by
the TPM when reading capabilities via tpm2_get_capability().
Adjust the implementation of the 'tpm2 get_capability' command accordingly.
Suggested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
For validating the fixed up device tree we need a tool to need to save it
to a file.
dtbdump.efi copies the configuration table with the device tree to a file
on the same partition from which dtbdump.efi was invoked. The file name can
be entered on the console.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When deleting a non-volatile variable it was deleted from memory but the
deletion was not persisted to the file system.
SetVariable() may be called with attributes == 0 to delete a variable. To
determine if the deletion shall be persisted we have to consider the
non-volatile flag in the attributes of the deleted variable and not the
value passed in the call parameter.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Chromebooks and the sandbox use a crosswire keyboard with function keys
FN1 - FN10. These keys are needed when running UEFI applications like GRUB
or the UEFI SCT.
Add support for these keys when translating from key codes to
ECMA-48 (or withdrawn ANSI 3.64) escape sequences.
All escape sequences start with 0x1b. So we should not repeat this
byte in the kbd_to_ansi364 table.
For testing use:
sandbox_defconfig + CONFIG_EFI_SELFTEST=y
$ ./u-boot -D -l
=> setenv efi_selftest extended text input
=> bootefi selftest
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This command was missed when renaming getc() to getchar().
Fixes: c670aeee3d ("common: rename getc() to getchar()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
patman status subcommand to collect tags from Patchwork
patman showing email replies from Patchwork
sandbox poweroff command
minor fixes in binman, tests
- meson64_android: don't show logo on ROM USB boot
- doc: update support matrix and fix vim3/l build instructions
- meson64: relocate config_distro_bootcmmd header
- Add a new SMBIOS parser and enable it when booting from coreboot
- Fix up various driver names to avoid dtoc warnings
- Fully enable ACPI support on Google Chromebook Coral
- Add a way to set SMBIOS properties using the devicetree
- Update existing boards to use devicetree for SMBIOS using a new
default sysinfo driver
Calling 'make V=1 all' on Ubuntu 18.04 with gcc version 9.2.1 and GNU Make
version 4.1 fails on error:
scripts/Kbuild.include:220: *** Recursive variable 'echo-cmd' references itself (eventually). Stop.
As a workaround expand 'echo-cmd' variable via 'call' construction instead
of expanding it directly.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reported-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Fixes: ae897022d7 ("Makefile: Fix u-boot-nodtb.bin target")
Now that we can use devicetree to specify this information, drop the old
CONFIG options.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a file containing defaults for these, using the existing CONFIG
options. This file must be included with #include since it needs to
be passed through the C preprocessor.
Enable the driver for all x86 boards that generate SMBIOS tables.
Disable it for coral since it has its own driver.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: reword the commit message a little bit]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add settings and enable the default sysinfo driver so that these can come
from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some boards want to specify the manufacturer or product name but do not
need to have their own sysinfo driver.
Add a default driver which provides a way to specify this SMBIOS
information in the devicetree, without needing any board-specific
functionality.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add information about how to set SMBIOS properties using the devicetree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The current tables only support a subset of the available fields defined
by the SMBIOS spec. Add a few more.
We could use CONFIG_SYS_CPU or CONFIG_SYS_SOC as a default for family, but
the meaning of that value relates more to the whole system rather than
just the SoC.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Support a way to put SMBIOS properties in the device tree. These can be
placed in a 'board' device in an 'smbios' subnode.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
As a first step to obtaining SMBIOS information from the devicetree, add
an ofnode parameter to the writing functions.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a simple binding file for this, so that it is clear what this binding
directory is for.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This uclass is intended to provide a way to obtain information about a
U-Boot board. But the concept of a U-Boot 'board' is the whole system,
not just one circuit board, meaning that 'board' is something of a
misnomer for this uclass.
In addition, the name 'board' is a bit overused in U-Boot and we want to
use the same uclass to provide SMBIOS information.
The obvious name is 'system' but that is so vague as to be meaningless.
Use 'sysinfo' instead, since this uclass is aimed at providing information
on the system.
Rename everything accordingly.
Note: Due to the patch delta caused by the symbol renames, this patch
shows some renamed files as being deleted in one place and created in
another.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Much of the output is not very useful. The bootm command is quite a bit
quieter. Convert some output to use log_debug().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
With Chrome OS the kernel setup block is stored in a separate place from
the kernel, so it is not possible to access the kernel version string.
At present, garbage is printed.
Add a sanity check to avoid this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the top of available DRAM is the same as the top of the range
of the low-memory MTRR.
In fact, U-Boot is allowed to use memory up until the start of the FSP
reserved memory. Use that value for low_end, since it makes more memory
available.
Keep the same calculation as before for mtrr_top, i.e. the top of
reserved memory.
A side-effect of this change is that the E820 tables have a single entry
that extends from the bottom of the memory used by U-Boot to the bottom
of the FSP reserved memory. This includes the bloblist, if ACPI tables
are placed there.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This does not necessarily indicate a problem, since some pins are
optional. Let the caller show an error if necessary.
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is useful when using Linux's earlycon since the MMIO address must be
provided on some platforms, e.g.:
earlycon=uart8250,mmio32,0xddffc000,115200n8
However this is only for debugging, so don't show it by default.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This table is not needed if a v2 TPM is in use. Add a condition to avoid
adding it when not needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Quite a few log_info() calls are included in the x86 code which should use
log_debug() instead. Convert them to reduce unwanted output.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Use log_debug() instead of debug() in this file, to enable the extra
features.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a script to boot Chrome OS from the internal MMC. This involved adding
a few commands and options.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Set up a few fields necessarily to make Chrome OS boot without showing a
firmware error.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present CONFIG_CHROMEOS is used to determine whether verified boot is
in use. The code to implement that is not in U-Boot mainline.
However, it is useful to be able to boot a Chromebook in developer mode
in U-Boot mainline without needing the verified boot code.
To allow this, use CONFIG_CHROMEOS_VBOOT to indicate that verified boot
should be used, and CONFIG_CHROMEOS to indicate that the board supports
Chrome OS. That allows us to define CONFIG_CHROMEOS on coral.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is not possible to boot Chrome OS properly without passing some basic
information from U-Boot. This applies even if verified boot is not being
used. Add a structure definition for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present if SSDT and DSDT code is created, only the latter is retained
for examination by the 'acpi items' command. Fix this by only resetting
the list when explicitly requested.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The current implementation for DSDT tables is not correct for the case
where there is generated code, as the length ends up being incorrect.
Also, we want the generated code to go first in the table.
Rewrite this piece to correct these problems.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If there is nothing in the SSDT we should not include it in the tables.
Update the implementation to check this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If there is no reset line, this still emits ACPI code for the reset GPIO.
Fix it by updating the check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
A few functions have changed to return pin numbers or I2C addresses. The
error checking for some of the callers is therefore wrong. Fix them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
It is useful for this command to show the address of the interrupt table.
Add support for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present these tables do not have the correct header, and there is an
occasional incorrect value due to uninited data. Fix these bugs.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present these functions are incorrect. Fix them and add some logging
and checking to avoid future problems.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present all tables are placed starting at address f0000 in memory, and
can be up to 64KB in size. If the tables are very large, this may not
provide enough space.
Also if the tables point to other tables (such as console log or a ramoops
area) then we must allocate other memory anyway.
The bloblist is a nice place to put these tables since it is contiguous,
which makes it easy to reserve this memory for linux using the 820 tables.
Add an option to put some of the tables in the bloblist. For SMBIOS and
ACPI, create suitable pointers from the f0000 region to the new location
of the tables.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: squashed in http://patchwork.ozlabs.org/project/uboot/patch/
20201105062407.1.I8091ad931cbbb5e3b6f6ababdf3f8d5db0d17bb9@changeid/]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
u-boot-imx for 2021.1
---------------------
- new boards : GE (new B1x5v2), phytec phyCORE-i.MX8MM
- converted doc to reST
- fixes for verdin-imx8mm (Toradex)
- fixes for i.MX thermal driver
- mx7ulp: Align the PLL_USB frequency
- mx53: primary/secondary bmode
Travis: https://travis-ci.org/github/sbabic/u-boot-imx/builds/741465284
While reviewing feedback it is helpful to see the review comments on the
command line to check that each has been addressed. Add an option to
support that.
Update the workflow documentation to describe the new features.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for parsing the contents of a patchwork 'patch' web page
containing comments received from reviewers. This allows patman to show
these comments in a simple 'snippets' format.
A snippet is some quoted code plus some unquoted comments below it. Each
review is from a unique person/email and can produce multiple snippets,
one for each part of the code that attracts a comment.
Show the file and line-number info at the top of each snippet if
available.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is tedious to add review tags into the local branch and errors can
sometimes be made. Add an option to create a new branch with the review
tags obtained from patchwork.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Before sending out a new version of a series for review, it is important
to add any review tags (e.g. Reviewed-by, Acked-by) collected by
patchwork. Otherwise people waste time reviewing the same patch
repeatedly, become frustrated and stop reviewing your patches.
To help with this, add a new 'status' subcommand that checks patchwork
for review tags, showing those which are not present in the local branch.
This allows users to see what new review tags have been received and then
add them.
Sample output:
$ patman status
1 Subject 1
Reviewed-by: Joe Bloggs <joe@napierwallies.co.nz>
2 Subject 2
Tested-by: Lord Edmund Blackaddër <weasel@blackadder.org>
Reviewed-by: Fred Bloggs <f.bloggs@napier.net>
+ Reviewed-by: Mary Bloggs <mary@napierwallies.co.nz>
1 new response available in patchwork
The '+' indicates a new tag. Colours are used to make it easier to read.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if we fail to find the upstream then the error output is piped
to wc, resulting in bogus results. Avoid the pipe and check the output
directly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sometimes warnings are associated with a file and sometimes with the
patch as a whole. Update the regular expression to handle both cases,
even in emacs mode. Also add support for detecting new files.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These lines can indicate a continuation of an error and should not be
ignored. Fix this.
Fixes: 666eb15e92 ("patman: Handle checkpatch output with notes and code")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
On balance it is easier to use an iterator here, particularly if we need
to insert lines due to new functionality. The only niggle is the need to
keep the previous iterator value around in one case.
Convert this test to use iter().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The current functional tests run most of patman. Add a smaller test that
just checks tag handling with the PatchStream class.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If the Series-xxx tag is not recognised patman currently reports a fatal
error. This is inconvenient if a new feature is later added to patman that
an earlier version does not support.
Report a warning instead, to allow the user to take action if needed, but
still allow operation to proceed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present warnings are produced across the whole set of patches when
parsing them. It is more useful to associate each warning with the patch
(or commit) that generated it.
Attach warnings to the Commit object and move them out of PatchStream.
Also avoid generating duplicate warnings for the same commit.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new function in PatchStream to collect the warnings generated while
parsing the stream. This will allow us to adjust the logic, such as
dealing with per-commit warnings.
Two of the warnings are in fact internal errors, so change them to raise
and exception.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a new Series-links tag to tell patman how to find the series in
patchwork. Each item is the series ID optionally preceded by the series
version that the link refers to. An empty version indicates this is the
latest series.
For example:
Series-links: 209816 1:203302
Documentation is added in a later patch.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
One test still uses its own function for capturing output. Modify it to
use the standard one in test_util
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This operation was unfortunately broken by a recent change. It is now
necessary to use -i in addition to -n, if there are errors or warnings in
the patches.
Correct this by always showing the summary information.
Fixes: f365375975 ("patman: Move main code out to a control module")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A recent change removed the base offset from the calculation. This is
used on coral to find the FSP-S binary. Fix it.
Fixes: a9fad07d4b ("binman: Avoid reporting image-pos with compression")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With a recent change this entry stores only part of the section data,
leaving out the padding at the end. Fix this by using GetPaddedData() to
get the data. Add this function to the base Entry class also.
Fixes: d1d3ad7d1f ("binman: Move section padding to the parent")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Building U-Boot with unit tests on a non-sandbox systems fails:
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `compress_using_gzip':
test/compression.c:138: undefined reference to `gzip'
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `uncompress_using_bzip2':
test/compression.c:187: undefined reference to `BZ2_bzBuffToBuffDecompress'
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `uncompress_using_lzma':
test/compression.c:222: undefined reference to `lzmaBuffToBuffDecompress'
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `uncompress_using_lzo':
test/compression.c:257: undefined reference to `lzop_decompress'
ld.bfd: test/built-in.o: in function `uncompress_using_lz4':
test/compression.c:292: undefined reference to `ulz4fn
Add the missing dependencies.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Building test/bloblist.c fails for non sandbox devices:
test/bloblist.c:10:10: fatal error: asm/state.h: No such file or directory
#include <asm/state.h>
^~~~~~~~~~~~~
Build the test only on the sandbox.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The cros_ec_keyb driver currently uses EC_CMD_MKBP_STATE to scan the
keyboard, but this host command was superseded by EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT
and unavailable on more recent devices (including gru-kevin), as it was
removed in cros-ec commit 87a071941b89 ("mkbp: Add support for buttons
and switches.") dated 2016-07-06.
The EC_CMD_GET_NEXT_EVENT has been available since cros-ec commit
d1ed75815efe ("MKBP event signalling implementation") dated 2014-10-20,
but it looks like it isn't included in firmware-* branches for at least
link, nyan-big, samus, snow, spring, panther and peach-pit which have
defconfigs in U-Boot. So this patch falls back to the old method if the
EC doesn't recognize the newer command.
The implementation is mostly adapted from Depthcharge commit
f88af26b44fc ("cros_ec: Change keyboard scanning method.").
On a gru-kevin, the current driver before this patch fails to read the
pressed keys with:
out: cmd=0x60: 03 9d 60 00 00 00 00 00
in-header: 03 fc 01 00 00 00 00 00
in-data:
ec_command_inptr: len=-1, din=0000000000000000
check_for_keys: keyboard scan failed
However the keyboard works fine with the newer command:
out: cmd=0x67: 03 96 67 00 00 00 00 00
in-header: 03 ef 00 00 0e 00 00 00
in-data: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
ec_command_inptr: len=14, din=00000000f412df30
key_matrix_decode: num_keys = 0
0 valid keycodes found
out: cmd=0x67: 03 96 67 00 00 00 00 00
in-header: 03 df 00 00 0e 00 00 00
in-data: 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 10 00
ec_command_inptr: len=14, din=00000000f412df30
key_matrix_decode: num_keys = 1
valid=1, row=4, col=11
keycode=28
1 valid keycodes found
{0d}
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is prepared function for filing rom_offset. That's why use it instead
of copying content of it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As we have a working COLD_RESET on the sandbox the sysreset test has to be
adjusted.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Up to now the sandbox would shutdown upon a cold reset request. Instead it
should be reset.
In our coding we use static variables like LIST_HEAD(efi_obj_list). A reset
can occur at any time, e.g. via an UEFI binary calling the reset service.
The only safe way to return to an initial state is to relaunch the U-Boot
binary.
The reset implementation uses execv() to relaunch U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
During a cold reset execv() is used to relaunch the U-Boot binary.
We must ensure that all files are closed in this case.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is the 'poweroff' and not the 'reset' command that should shut down the
sandbox.
Adjust the unit test accordingly
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The command to shut down a device is 'poweroff'. It is a deficit of the
sandbox that it does not support resetting yet but shuts down upong seeing
the 'reset' command.
Once the sandbox properly supports reset we need the 'poweroff' command to
leave the sandbox.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When the sandbox eth-raw device host_lo is removed this leads to closing
the console input.
Do not call close(0).
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Relocate a config_distro_bootcmd header before defined
CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS. Otherwise it can't change to specific
environment.
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This is required by Chrome OS so that the audio and other unibuild
features work correctly. Add it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The bloblist guarantees that blobs are zeroed so there is no need to do
an additional memset(). Drop it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present we create the ACPI context but then drop it after generation of
tables is complete. This is annoying because we have to then search for
tables later.
To fix this, allocate the context and store it in global_data.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present write_tables() can fail but does not report this problem to its
caller. Fix this by changing the return type.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some boards need to include binary data into the image for use during the
boot process. Add a node for these.
An example is the audio-codec configuration used by some audio drivers on
Intel platforms. If no private files are provided, they will be omitted.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add definitions for part of the vboot context used with verified boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Set up MSRs required for Apollo Lake. This enables Linux to use the
timers correctly. Also write the fixed MSRs for this platform.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This file can be included by any header but it includes C code. Guard it
to avoid errors when compiling ASL, etc.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If u-boot gets used as coreboot payload it might be nice to get
vendor, model and bios version from smbios. I am not sure about
the output of all the read information.
With qemu target for coreboot this could look this:
CBFS: Found @ offset 14f40 size 3b188
Checking segment from ROM address 0xffc15178
Checking segment from ROM address 0xffc15194
Loading segment from ROM address 0xffc15178
code (compression=1)
New segment dstaddr 0x01110000 memsize 0x889ef srcaddr 0xffc151b0 filesize 0x3b150
Loading Segment: addr: 0x01110000 memsz: 0x00000000000889ef filesz: 0x000000000003b150
using LZMA
Loading segment from ROM address 0xffc15194
Entry Point 0x01110000
BS: BS_PAYLOAD_LOAD run times (exec / console): 77 / 1 ms
Jumping to boot code at 0x01110000(0x07fa7000)
U-Boot 2020.10-00536-g5dcf7cc590-dirty (Oct 07 2020 - 14:21:51 +0200)
CPU: x86_64, vendor AMD, device 663h
DRAM: 127.1 MiB
MMC:
Video: No video mode configured in coreboot!
Video: No video mode configured in coreboot!
Vendor: QEMU
Model: Standard PC (i440FX + PIIX, 1996)
Bios Version: 4.12-3152-g326a499f6f-dirty
Net: e1000: 52:54:00:12:34:56
eth0: e1000#0
No working controllers found
Finalizing coreboot
Hit any key to stop autoboot: 0
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a very simple API to be able to access SMBIOS strings
like vendor, model and bios version.
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present there are a lot of dtoc warnings reported when building
chromebook_coral, of the form:
WARNING: the driver intel_apl_lpc was not found in the driver list
Correct these by using driver names that matches their compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Fix the dtoc warning in these file by using a driver name that matches the
compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This updates the PPD MAINTAINERS file doing a couple of changes:
* Replace Martyn with myself, since he no longer has the hardware
available and add Ian Ray as maintainer
* Fix the board directory path, which was still listing freescale/
instead of ge/
* Order the list of files alphabetically
* Add board specific device tree files to the file list
Cc: Martyn Welch <martyn.welch@collabora.com>
Cc: Ian Ray <ian.ray@ge.com>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
This updates the Bx50v3 MAINTAINERS file, so that it also catches
changes to the related device tree files. Additionally the list of
files has been sorted alphabetically and I added myself as maintainer.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
CONFIG_NEEDS_MANUAL_RELOC macro was out of Kconfig. Move it there to be
able to use compile-time checks to reduce the number of build paths.
Fixes: f9a882438966 ("dm: core: Convert #ifdef to if() in root.c") for Microblaze
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Michael wrote:
commit 92765f45bb ("env: Access Environment in SPI flashes before
relocation") at least breaks the Kontron sl28 board. I guess it also
breaks others which use a (late) SPI environment.
reason is, that env_init() sets the init bit, if there
is no init function defined in an environment driver,
and use default return value -ENOENT in this case
later for setting the default environment.
Change:
Environment driver can now implement an init
function and return, if this function does nothing,
simply -ENOENT.
env_init() now handles -ENOENT correct by setting the
inited bit for the environment driver. And if there
is no other environment driver whose init function
returns 0, load than the default environment.
This prevents that each environment driver needs to set the
default environment.
Fixes: 92765f45bb ("env: Access Environment in SPI flashes before relocation")
Reported-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Tested-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc> [For the SF environment]
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
First set of u-boot-atmel fixes for 2021.01 cycle:
This specific feature set includes the patches for DT required to fix
the warnings for newer DTC version (1.6.0+), i2c and spi bus unit
address.
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9260ek.dtb.pre.tmp:119.21-123.7: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffc8000/mtd_dataflash@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "1"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9260ek.dtb.pre.tmp:119.21-123.7: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffc8000/mtd_dataflash@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "1"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/sama5d3xmb.dtsi:64.25-83.7: Warning (i2c_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/i2c@f0018000/camera@0x30: I2C bus unit address format error, expected "30"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9g45-gurnard.dtb.pre.tmp:118.21-122.7: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffa4000/mtd_dataflash@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "1"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9g25ek.dtb.pre.tmp:28.25-47.7: Warning (i2c_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/i2c@f8010000/camera@0x30: I2C bus unit address format error, expected "30"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/at91sam9g20ek_common.dtsi:100.21-104.7: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffc8000/mtd_dataflash@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "1"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9g20-taurus.dtb.pre.tmp:79.18-83.4: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffc8000/mtd_dataflash@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "1"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91sam9261ek.dtb.pre.tmp:124.15-144.7: Warning (spi_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/spi@fffc8000/tsc2046@0: SPI bus unit address format error, expected "2"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
w+arch/arm/dts/.at91-vinco.dtb.pre.tmp:131.18-134.7: Warning (i2c_bus_reg): /ahb/apb/i2c@f8024000/rtc@64: I2C bus unit address format error, expected "32"
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc2 (2)
The series contains the following enhancements
* preparatory patches for UEFI capsule updates
* initialization of the emulated RTC using an environment variable
and a bug fix
* If DisconnectController() is called for a child controller that is the
only child of the driver, the driver must be disconnected.
GE B1x5v2 patient monitor series is similar to the CARESCAPE Monitor
series (GE Bx50). It consists of a carrier PCB used in combination
with a Congatec QMX6 SoM. This adds U-Boot support using device model
everywhere and SPL for memory initialization.
Proper configuration is provided as 'ge_b1x5v2_defconfig' and the
combined image u-boot-with-spi.imx can be flashed directly to 1024
byte offset to /dev/mtdblock0. Alternatively SPL and u-boot.imx can
be loaded separately via USB-OTG using e.g. imx_usb.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This separates the I2C specific code from the generic
GE vital product data code, so that the generic parts
can be used on hardware with VPD stored in SPI flash
memory.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
While this code is being used by all GE platforms its useful
to have it behind a config option for hardware bringup of
new platforms.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Add GPIO poweroff driver, which is based on the Linux
driver and uses the same DT binding.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
Allow using disable_ldb_di_clock_sources with just the combined
CONFIG_MX6QDL being enabled.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
In case of empty battery or glitches the oscillator fail
bit might be set. This will reset the bit in the reset
routine.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
This takes care of resetting the 32kHz square wave, which is
used by some boards as clock source for the SoC.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
This driver allows to use SPI flash as backing store for
boot counter values with DM enabled.
Signed-off-by: Sebastian Reichel <sebastian.reichel@collabora.com>
This option is only supported by the IMX watchdog and seems to be
similar to CONFIG_WATCHDOG.
Move it below the IMX watchdog and make it dependent on IMX_WATCHDOG.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
This patch provides information regarding the boot stage with using LEDs.
On the very beginning of U-Boot execution the GREEN LED is turned on.
When the execution is passed to Linux kernel the GREEN LED is off and
RED one is ON.
Afterwards, when Linux takes over the execution, the "heartbeat" driver
provides indication if the board is still alive.
Please also note that this patch uses {set|clr}bits_le32 macros as turning
ON GREEN LED is performed in a _very_ early stage of U-Boot execution
before DM_GPIOs are initialized.
Signed-off-by: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
The command 'clocks' shows the following output:
=> clocks
PLL_A7_SPLL 528 MHz
PLL_A7_APLL 529 MHz
PLL_USB 0 MHz
Add some extra spaces so that the PLL_USB information gets aligned with
the previous reported frequencies.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The command 'clocks' shows the following output:
=> clocks
PLL_A7_SPLL 528 MHz
PLL_A7_APLL 529 MHz
PLL_USB 0 MHz
....
[do_mx7_showclocks] addr = 0x9FFB61F1
The last line is not useful at all, so just remove it.
Signed-off-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
commit c05ed00afb dropped linux/delay.h from common header
add linux/delay.h to avoid compile warning here
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Ensure we terminate the line with a CR if we get an invalid sensor device
or reading.
Signed-off-by: Tim Harvey <tharvey@gateworks.com>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
In order to be able to run the I2C bus at 400Khz, the chip errata[1]
recommends that the peripheral clock runs out of the 24MHz oscillator.
Systems running I2C from OP-TEE before Linux executes - for example to
access a Secure Element [2] providing the cryptographic support - expect
this clock to be configured by the bootloader [3].
[1] IMX6SLCE Rev. 5, 02/2019, ERR007805.
[2] OP-TEE: support for NXP SE05X Plug and Trust (patch on the list).
[3] OP-TEE: check the imx_i2c.c driver (imx6 patch on the list).
Signed-off-by: Jorge Ramirez-Ortiz <jorge@foundries.io>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Convert plain text documentation to reStructuredText format and add
it to Sphinx TOC tree. No essential content change.
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
When using cygwin64 "dd (coreutils) 8.26 Packaged by Cygwin (8.26-2)",
the last not 512bytes aligned data wat cut off and not burned into SD
card.
Saying the flash.bin size is 1085608 bytes, not 512bytes aligned. It only
burned 1085440 bytes, the leaving 168 bytes were not burnned and cause
boot issue.
So update README dd command to add "conv=notrunc"
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
- New PX30 board: Engicam PX30.Core;
- Fix USB HID support for rock960;
- Remove host endianness dependency for rockchip mkimage;
- dts update for rk3288-tinker;
- Enable console MUX for some ROCKPi boards;
- Add config-based ddr selection for px30;
The name of structure element logl_prev is not matched by the
documentation.
%s/logl_pref/logl_prev/
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This would be useful and recommended boot flow for new boards
which has doesn't have the DDR support yet in mainline.
Sometimes it is very useful for debugging mainline DDR support.
Documen it for px30 boot flow.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
PX30.Core is an EDIMM SOM based on Rockchip PX30 from Engicam.
C.TOUCH 2.0 is a general purpose carrier board with capacitive
touch interface support.
PX30.Core needs to mount on top of this Carrier board for creating
complete PX30.Core C.TOUCH 2.0 board.
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Suniel Mahesh <sunil@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Engicam C.TOUCH 2.0 is an EDIMM compliant general purpose
carrier board with capacitive touch interface.
Genaral features:
- TFT 10.1" industrial, 1280x800 LVDS display
- Ethernet 10/100
- Wifi/BT
- USB Type A/OTG
- Audio Out
- CAN
- LVDS panel connector
SOM's like PX30.Core needs to mount on top of this Carrier board
for creating complete PX30.Core C.TOUCH 2.0 board.
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
PX30.Core is an EDIMM SOM based on Rockchip PX30 from Engicam.
EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit is an EDIMM 2.2 Form Factor Capacitive
Evaluation Board from Engicam.
PX30.Core needs to mount on top of this Evaluation board for
creating complete PX30.Core EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit.
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Suniel Mahesh <sunil@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The existing common code for Engicam boards uses i.MX6,
so attach that into i.MX6 Engicam boards so-that adding
new SoC variants of Engicam boards become meaningful.
Add support for it.
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
TARGET_EVB_PX30 can be possible to use other px30 boards.
Add the help text for existing EVB, so-that the new boards
which are resuing this config option can mention their board
help text.
This would help to track which boards are using EVB_PX30 config.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
PX30.Core is an EDIMM SOM based on Rockchip PX30 from Engicam.
General features:
- Rockchip PX30
- Up to 2GB DDR4
- eMMC 4 GB expandible
- rest of PX30 features
PX30.Core needs to mount on top of Engicam baseboards for creating
complete platform boards.
Possible baseboards are,
- EDIMM2.2
- C.TOUCH 2.0
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Engicam EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit is an EDIMM 2.2 Form Factor Capacitive
Evaluation Board.
Genaral features:
- LCD 7" C.Touch
- microSD slot
- Ethernet 1Gb
- Wifi/BT
- 2x LVDS Full HD interfaces
- 3x USB 2.0
- 1x USB 3.0
- HDMI Out
- Mini PCIe
- MIPI CSI
- 2x CAN
- Audio Out
SOM's like PX30.Core needs to mount on top of this Evaluation board
for creating complete PX30.Core EDIMM2.2 Starter Kit.
Add support for it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Signed-off-by: Michael Trimarchi <michael@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
When booting from rom usb, skip the boot logo logic as it's possible
that the partition containing the logo does not exist yet.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Guillaume La Roque <glaroque@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Mattijs Korpershoek <mkorpershoek@baylibre.com>
The Rockchip boot ROM expects little-endian values in the image header.
When running mkimage on a big-endian machine, these values need to be
byteswapped before writing or verifying the header.
This change fixes cross-compiling U-Boot SPL for the RK3399 SoC from a
big-endian ppc64 host machine.
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Enable Console multiplexing in ROCKPi N8 which would is
required to video out the console buffer.
Enable it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Like, rk3399 the rk3288 also supports 4K resolution.
So, enable it for rk3288 with HDMI platforms.
Right now, rockchip video drivers are supporting for rk3288,
rk3399 SoC families, so mark the 4K resolution by default
if it's an HDMI video out.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Cc: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Enable Console multiplexing in ROCKPi N10 which would is
required to video out the console buffer.
Enable it.
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
This updates logging documentation with some examples of the new commands
added in the previous commits. It also removes some items from the to-do
list which have been implemented.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The functions in log.h are already mostly documented, so add them to the
generated documentation.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This exercises a few success and failure modes of the log filter-*
commands. log filter-list is not tested because it's purely informational.
I don't think there's a good way to test it except by testing if the output
of the command exactly matches a sample run.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds several commands to add, list, and remove log filters. Due to the
complexity of adding a filter, `log filter-list` uses options instead of
positional arguments.
These commands have been added as subcommands to log by using a dash to
join the subcommand and subsubcommand. This is stylistic, and they could be
converted to proper subsubcommands if it is wished.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
A few of these tests were inspired by those in glibc. The syntax for
invoking test_getopt is a bit funky, but it's necessary so that the CPP can
parse the arguments correctly.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Some commands can get very unweildy if they have too many positional
arguments. Adding options makes them easier to read, remember, and
understand.
This implementation of getopt has been taken from barebox, which has had
option support for quite a while. I have made a few modifications to their
version, such as the removal of opterr in favor of a separate getopt_silent
function. In addition, I have moved all global variables into struct
getopt_context.
The getopt from barebox also re-orders the arguments passed to it so that
non-options are placed last. This allows users to specify options anywhere.
For example, `ls -l foo/ -R` would be re-ordered to `ls -l -R foo/` as
getopt parsed the options. However, this feature conflicts with the const
argv in cmd_tbl->cmd. This was originally added in 54841ab50c ("Make sure
that argv[] argument pointers are not modified."). The reason stated in
that commit is that hush requires argv to stay unmodified. Has this
situation changed? Barebox also uses hush, and does not have this problem.
Perhaps we could use their fix?
I have assigned maintenance of getopt to Simon Glass, as it is currently
only used by the log command. I would also be fine maintaining it.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This makes the log level command print all valid log levels. The default
log level is annotated. This provides an easy way to see which log levels
are compiled-in.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This allows users to query which categories and drivers are available on
their system. This allows them to construct filter-add commands without
(e.g.) adjusting the log format to show categories and drivers.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Move parsing of log level into its own function so it can be re-used. This
also adds support for using log level names instead of just the integer
equivalent.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This reduces duplicate code, and makes adding new sub-commands easier.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is the complement of the existing behavior to match only messages with
a log level less than a threshold. This is primarily useful in conjunction
with LOGFF_DENY.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds some tests for log filters which deny if they match.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When rebasing this series I had to renumber all my log tests because
someone made another log test in the meantime. This involved updaing a
number in several places (C and python), and it wasn't checked by the
compiler. So I though "how hard could it be to just rewrite in C?" And
though it wasn't hard, it *was* tedious. Tests are numbered the same as
before to allow for easier review.
A note that if a test fails, everything after it will probably also fail.
This is because that test won't clean up its filters. There's no easy way
to do the cleanup, except perhaps removing all filters in a wrapper
function.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Without this flag, log filters can only explicitly accept messages.
Allowing denial makes it easier to filter certain subsystems. Unlike
allow-ing filters, deny-ing filters are added to the beginning of the
filter list. This should do the Right Thing most of the time, but it's
less-universal than allowing filters to be inserted anywhere. If this
becomes a problem, then perhaps log_filter_add* should take a filter number
to insert before/after.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function exposes a way to specify flags when creating a filter.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These functions are required by "cmd: log: Add commands to manipulate
filters" and "test: Add a test for log filter-*".
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Checkpatch complains about using #ifdef for CONFIG variables.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Both these arrays and their members are const. Fixes checkpatch complaint.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Logging category lists are terminated by LOGC_END, not LOGC_NONE.
Fixes: e9c8d49d54 ("log: Add an implementation of logging")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Errors returned should be negative.
Fixes: 45fac9fc18 ("log: Correct missing free() on error in log_add_filter()")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On aristianetos boards the display type is detected
through "panel" environment variable. Dependend on the
display type we detect the board type and this decides which
DTB we have to use for the board.
So we need early spi environment access.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Enable the new Kconfig option ENV_SPI_EARLY if you want
to use Environment in SPI flash before relocation.
Call env_init() and than you can use env_get_f() for
accessing Environment variables.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
split from env_import_redund() the part which checks
which Environment is valid into a separate function
called env_check_redund() and call it from env_import_redund().
So env_check_redund() can be used from places which also
need to do this checks.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function will be used from several places in UEFI subsystem
to generate some specific form of utf-16 variable name.
For example, L"Capsule0001"
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Move function to separate module.
Use char * as argument instead of u16 *.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If this option, CONFIG_EFI_SETUP_EARLY, is enabled, the initialisation
of UEFI subsystem will be done as part of U-Boot initialisation.
Please note that this option won't be enabled explicitly by users,
instead, should be enabled implicitly by other configuration options.
Specifically, this feature will be utilised in implementing capsule-on-disk
feature.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
This function is a variant of dfu_write_by_name() and takes a DFU alt
setting number for dfu configuration.
It will be utilised to implement UEFI capsule management protocol for
raw image in a later commit.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This variable will be utilized to enumerate all dfu entities
for UEFI capsule firmware update in a later commit.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The main purpose of this patch is to separate a generic interface for
updating firmware using DFU drivers from "auto-update" via tftp.
This function will also be used in implementing UEFI capsule update
in a later commit.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The range of an addressable pointer can go beyond 'integer'.
So change the argument type to a void pointer.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This function is essentially independent from tftp, and will also be
utilised in implementing UEFI capsule update in a later commit.
So just give it a more generic name.
In addition, a new configuration option, CONFIG_DFU_WRITE_ALT, was
introduced so that the file will be compiled with different options,
particularly one added in a later commit.
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Up to now the emulated RTC is initialized using the U-Boot build time.
With this patch the environment variable 'rtc_emul_epoch' can be used to
provide a better initial time. The variable is a decimal string with
the number of seconds since 1970-01-01. Here is an example where the RTC
had not been probed yet:
=> setenv rtc_emul_epoch 1610109000
=> date
Date: 2021-01-08 (Friday) Time: 12:30:00
If the variable does not exist, the U-Boot build time is used as fallback.
The environment variable may be set when shutting down the operating system
if the U-Boot environment is exposed to the OS (cf. ENV_IS_IN_FAT and
ENV_IS_IN_EXT4).
Suggested-by: Pablo Sebastián Greco <pgreco@centosproject.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently the emulated RTC is initialized in the emul_rtc_get() get
function. This does not match the design of the driver model.
Move the initialization of the emulated RTC to the probe() function.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
If ChildHandle indicates the sole child of the driver, disconnect the
driver.
This fixes the test results for UEFI SCT 2.6 A
sub-tests 5.1.3.12.43, 5.1.3.12.44, 5.1.3.12.45.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Found this by comparing it to the coreboot driver, a form of this call
was introduced there in their commit b9a7877568cf ("rockchip/*: refactor
edp driver"). This is copy-pasted from U-Boot's link_train_cr() slightly
above it.
Without this on a gru-kevin chromebook, I have:
clock recovery at voltage 0 pre-emphasis 0
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
channel eq failed, ret=-5
link train failed!
rk_vop_probe() Device failed: ret=-5
With this, it looks like training succeeds:
clock recovery at voltage 0 pre-emphasis 0
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 3.5dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 6dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 6dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 6dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 6dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 6dB
requested signal parameters: lane 0 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 0dB
requested signal parameters: lane 1 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 0dB
requested signal parameters: lane 2 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 0dB
requested signal parameters: lane 3 voltage 0.4V pre_emph 0dB
using signal parameters: voltage 0.4V pre_emph 0dB
channel eq at voltage 0 pre-emphasis 0
config video failed
rk_vop_probe() Device failed: ret=-110
The "config video failed" error also goes away when I disable higher
log levels, and it claims to have successfully probed the device.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The SRAM on the PX30 is not big enough to hold multiple DDR configs
so it needs to be selected during build.
So far simply the DDR3 config was always selected and getting DDR4
or LPDDR2/3 initialized would require a code modification.
So add Kconfig options similar to RK3399 to allow selecting the DDR4
and LPDDR2/3 options instead, while DDR3 stays the default as before.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Fix up USB config options so keyboards and other USB devices work.
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang<kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Change-Id: I34b0696e0ac7303186f20c83278dde340399b690
The property reg-shift with the same value is present in the base
device tree already. Remove unnecessary node from rk3288-tinker.dts.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
The I2C EEPROM is present on Tinker Board S as well. Move the i2c node
to the shared, U-Boot specific rk3288-tinker-u-boot.dtsi device tree.
Cc: Jonas Karlman <jonas@kwiboo.se>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Agner <stefan@agner.ch>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
In order to correctly calculate the designware watchdog
timeouts, the watchdog clock is required. Implement required
clocks to facilitate this.
Signed-off-by: Jack Mitchell <ml@embed.me.uk>
Reviewed-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
Refactor the implementation slightly so that section data is not
rebuilt when it is already available.
We still have GetData() set up to rebuild the section, since we don't
currently track when things change that might affect a section. For
example, if a blob is updated within a section, we must rebuild it.
Tracking that would be possible but is more complex, so it left for
another time.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With the previous changes, it is now possible to compress entire
sections. Add some tests to check that compression works correctly,
including updating the metadata.
Also update the documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function adds up the total size of entries to work out the
size of a section's contents. With compression this is no-longer enough.
We may as well bite the bullet and build the section contents instead.
Call _BuildSectionData() to get the (possibly compressed) contents and
GetPaddedData() to get the same but with padding added.
Note that this is inefficient since the section contents is calculated
twice. Future work will improve this.
This affects testPackOverlapMap() since the error is reported with a
different section size now (enough to hold the contents). Update that at
the same time.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function assumes that the size of a section is at least as
large as its contents. With compression this is often not the case. Relax
this constraint by using the uncompressed size, if available.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This method introduces a separation between packing and checking that is
different for sections. In order to handle compression properly, we need
to be able to deal with a section's size being smaller than the
uncompressed size of its contents. It is easier to make this work if
everything happens in the Pack() method.
The only real user of CheckEntries() is entry_Section and it can call it
directly. Drop the call from 'control' and handle it locally.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present CheckSize() is called from the function that packs the entries.
Move it up to the main Pack() function so that _PackEntries() can just
do the packing.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This is only used by entry_Section and that class already calls it. Avoid
calling it twice. Also drop it from the documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present sorting and expanding entries are side-effects of the
CheckEntries() function. This is a bit confusing, as 'checking' would
not normally involve making changes.
Move these steps into the Pack() function instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function just calls CheckEntries() in the only non-trivial
implementation. Drop it and use CheckEntries() directly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When a section is compressed, all entries within it are grouped together
into a compressed block of data. This obscures the start of each
individual child entry.
Avoid reporting bogus 'image-pos' properties in this case, since it is
not possible to access the entry at the location provided. The entire
section must be decompressed first.
CBFS does not support compressing whole sections, only individual files,
so needs no special handling here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Section contents is not set up when ObtainContents() is called, since
packing often changes the layout of the contents. Ensure that the contents
are correctly recorded by making this function regenerate the section. It
is normally only called by the parent section (when packing) or by the
top-level image code, when writing out the image. So the performance
impact is fairly small.
Now that sections have their contents in their 'data' property, update
testSkipAtStartSectionPad() to check it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When compressing an entry, the original uncompressed data is overwritten.
Store it so it is available if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present padding of sections is inconsistent with other entry types, in
that different pad bytes are used.
When a normal entry is padded by its parent, the parent's pad byte is
used. But for sections, the section's pad byte is used.
Adjust logic to always do this the same way.
Note there is still a special case in entry_Section.GetPaddedData() where
an image is padded with the pad byte of the top-level section. This is
necessary since otherwise there would be no way to set the pad byte of
the image, without adding a top-level section to every image.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Each section is padded up to its size, if the contents are not large
enough. Move this logic from _BuildSectionData() to
GetPaddedDataForEntry() so that all the padding is in one place.
With this, the testDual test is working again, so enable it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this function does the padding needed around an entry. It is
easier to understand what is going on if we have a function that returns
the contents of an entry, with padding included.
Refactor the code accordingly, adding a new GetPaddedData() method.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Create a new _BuildSectionData() to hold the code that is now in
GetData(), so that it is clearly separated from entry.GetData() base
function.
Separate out the 'pad-before' processing to make this easier to
understand.
Unfortunately this breaks the testDual test. Rather than squash several
patches into an un-reviewable glob, disable the test for now.
This also affects testSkipAtStartSectionPad(), although it still not
quite what it should be. Update that temporarily for now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Alignment does form part of the entry once the image is written out, but
within binman the entry contents does not include the padding. Add
documentation to make this clear, as well as a test.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Padding becomes part of the entry once the image is written out, but
within binman the entry contents does not include the padding. Add
documentation to make this clear, as well as a test.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Check the contents of each section to make sure it is actually in the
right place.
Also fix a whitespace error in the .dts file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we use 'compress' as the property to set the compression of
a 'files' entry. But this conflicts with the same property for entries,
of which Entry_section is a subclass.
Strictly speaking, since Entry_files is in fact a subclass of
Entry_section, the files can be compressed individually but also the
section (that contains all the files) can itself be compressed. With this
change, it is possible to express that.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this is only used by blobs. To allow it to be used by other
entry types (such as sections), move it into the base class.
Also read the compression type in the base class.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
While a section is the base class of Image, it is more correct to refer
to sections in most places in this file. Fix these comments.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present if 'binman' is typed on the command line, a strange error about
a missing argument is displayed. Fix this.
These does not seem to be standard way to add the 'required' argument in
all recent Python versions, so set it manually.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this feature is tested view the end-at-4gb feature. Add some
tests of its own, including the operation of padding.
The third test here shows binman's current, inconsistent approach to
padding in the top-level section. Future patches in this series will
address this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With of-platdata, the devicetree is supposed to specify all the devices
in the system. So far this hasn't really mattered since of-platdata still
works correctly.
However, new of-platdata features rely on numbering the devices in a
particular order so that they can be referenced by a single integer. It is
tricky to implement this efficiently when other devices are present in the
build.
To address this, disable use of U_BOOT_DEVICE() when of-platdata is
enabled. This seems acceptable as it is not supposed to be used at all,
except in SPL/TPL, where of-platdata is the recommended approach.
This breaks one non-compliant boards at present: mx6cuboxi
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
(disable CONFIG_IMX_THERMAL for mx6cuboxi to avoid a build error)
This feature is incompatble with of-platdata since it uses the
U_BOOT_DEVICE() macro. With of-platdata the only devices permitted are
those created by dtoc.
The driver is not used in SPL anyway, so exclude it from that build.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
At present we use a 'node' pointer in the of-platadata phandle_n_arg
structs. This is a pointer to the struct driver_info for a particular
device, and we can use it to obtain the struct udevice pointer itself.
Since we don't know the struct udevice pointer until it is allocated in
memory, we have to fix up the phandle_n_arg.node at runtime. This is
annoying since it requires that SPL's data is writable and adds a small
amount of extra (generated) code in the dm_populate_phandle_data()
function.
Now that we can find a driver_info by its index, it is easier to put the
index in the phandle_n_arg structures.
Update dtoc to do this, add a new device_get_by_driver_info_idx() to look
up a device by drive_info index and update the tests to match.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that parent devices are supported with of-platadata, we don't need the
messy code to fix up the parent pointers and allocations on Apollo Lake.
Put the code behind a condition.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present, enabling CONFIG_APL_SPI_FLASH_BOOT does not build since SPI
and SPI flash are not enabled for TPL. Add a condition to fix this and
tidy up a build warning in the SPI-flash driver.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a simple test that we can obtain the correct parent for an I2C
device. This requires updating the driver names to match the compatible
strings, adding them to the devicetree and enabling a few options.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present of-platdata does not provide parent information. But this is
useful for I2C devices, for example, since it allows them to determine
which bus they are on.
Add support for setting the parent correctly, by storing the parent
driver_info index in dtoc and reading this in lists_bind_drivers(). This
needs multiple passes since we must process children after their parents
already have been bound.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There is no devicetree with of-platdata. Update a few uclasses to allow
them to be built for sandbox_spl. Also drop the i2c-gpio from SPL to avoid
build errors, since it does not support of-platdata.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we update the driver_info struct with a pointer to the device
that it created (i.e. caused to be bound). This works fine when U-Boot SPL
is stored in read-write memory. But on some platforms, such as Intel
Apollo Lake, it is not possible to update the data memory.
In any case, it is bad form to put this information in a structure that is
in the data region, since it expands the size of the binary.
Create a new driver_rt structure which holds runtime information about
drivers. Update the code to store the device pointer in this instead.
Also update the test check that this works.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We have a test in dtoc for this feature, but not one in U-Boot itself.
Add a simple test that checks that the information comes through
correctly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With of-platdata, the driver_info struct is updated with the device
pointer when it is bound. This makes it easy for a device to be found by
its driver info with the device_get_by_driver_info() function.
Add a test that all devices (except the root device) have such an entry.
Fix a bug that the function does not set *devp to NULL on failure, which
the documentation asserts.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present properties are tested in a roundabout way. The driver's probe()
method writes out the values of the properties and the Python test checks
the output from U-Boot SPL.
Add a C test which checks these values more directly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we have a pytest that covers of-platadata. Add a very simple
unit test that just checks that a device can be found. This shows the
ability to write these tests in C.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a -u flag for U-Boot SPL which requests that unit tests be run. To
make this work, export dm_test_main() and update it to skip test features
that are not used with of-platdata.
To run the tests:
$ spl/u-boot-spl -u
U-Boot SPL 2020.10-rc5 (Oct 01 2020 - 07:35:39 -0600)
Running 0 driver model tests
Failures: 0
At present there are no SPL unit tests.
Note that there is one wrinkle with these tests. SPL has limited memory
available for allocation. Also malloc_simple does not free memory
(free() is a nop) and running tests repeatedly causes driver-model to
reinit multiple times and allocate memory. Therefore it is not possible
to run more than a few tests at a time. One solution is to increase the
amount of malloc space in sandbox_spl. This is not a problem for pytest,
since it runs each test individually, so for now this is left as is.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present DM tests assume that a devicetree is available. This is not the
case with of-platadata.
Update the code to add this condition.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Without resizing the SDL window showed by
./u-boot -D -l
is not legible on a high resolution screen.
Allow resizing the window
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present an integer is converted to bytes incorrectly. The whole 32-bit
integer is inserted as the first element of the byte array, and the other
three bytes are skipped. This was not noticed because the unit test did
not check it, and the functional test was checking for wrong values.
Update the code to handle this as a special case. Add one more test to
cover all code paths.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this option is disabled in SPL, meaning that warnings are not
displayed. It is sometimes useful to see warnings in SPL for debugging
purposes.
Add a new Kconfig option to permit this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the structures are written in name order, but parents have to
be written before their children, so the file does not end up being in
order. The order of nodes in _valid_nodes matches the order of the
devicetree.
Update the code so that _valid_nodes is in sorted order, by C name of
the structure. This allows us to assign a sequential ordering to each
U_BOOT_DEVICE() declaration.
U-Boot's linker lists are also ordered alphabetically, which means that
the order in the driver_info list will match the order used by dtoc. This
defines an index ('idx') for the U_BOOT_DEVICE declarations. They appear
in alphabetical order, numbered from 0 in _valid_nodes and in the
driver_info linker list.
Add a comment against each declaration, showing the idx value.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add documentation to this function as well as generate_structs(), where
the return value is ultimately passed in.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since sandbox's SPL is build with of-platadata, we should not use
U_BOOT_DEVICE() declarations as well. Drop them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tests are easier to run in U-Boot proper. Running them in SPL does not add
test coverage in most cases. Also some tests use features that are not
available in SPL.
Update the build rules to disable these tests in SPL. We still need
test-main to be able to actually run SPL tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we always include test/dm from the main Makefile. We have a
CONFIG_UNIT_TEST that should control whether the test/ directory is built,
so rely on that instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present most of the tests in test/Makefile are dependent on
CONFIG_SANDBOX. But this is not ideal since they rely on commands being
available and SPL does not support commands.
Use CONFIG_COMMAND instead. This has the dual purpose of allowing these
tests to be used on other boards and allowing SPL to skip them.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present this option results in a number of #ifdefs due to the presence
or absence of the global_data of_root member.
Add a few macros to global_data.h to work around this. Update the code
accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for multiple images, since these are used on x86 now. Select
the first image for now, since that is generally the correct one. At some
point we can add a way to determine which image is currently running.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide a function to read the ROM offset so that we can store the value
in one place and clients don't need to store it themselves after calling
binman_set_rom_offset().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Armada 8k: Add NAND support via PXA3xx NAND driver (Baruch)
- Armada 8k: Use ATF serdes init instead of the "old" U-Boot version
(Baruch)
- Minor update to Octeon TX/TX2 defconfig (Stefan)
Xilinx changes for v2021.01-v2
common:
- Add support for 64bit loadables from SPL
xilinx:
- Update documentation and record ownership
- Enable eeprom board detection based legacy and fru formats
- Add support for FRU format
microblaze:
- Optimize low level ASM code
- Enable SPI/I2C
- Enable distro boot
zynq:
- Add support for Zturn V5
zynqmp:
- Improve silicon detection code
- Enable several kconfig options
- Align DT with the latest state
- Enabling security commands
- Enable and support FPGA loading from SPL
- Optimize xilinx_pm_request() calling
versal:
- Some DTs/Kconfig/defconfig alignments
- Add binding header for clock and power
zynq-sdhci:
- Add support for tap delay programming
zynq-spi/zynq-qspi:
- Use clock framework for getting clocks
xilinx-spi:
- Fix some code issues (unused variables)
serial:
- Check return value from clock functions in pl01x
Maxime mentioned that he feels not having the time to be an Allwinner
maintainer anymore. Take over from him.
Maxime, many thanks for your great work in the past! I hope I can still
relay the occasional technical question to you in the future.
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Based on Linux kernel commit fc256f5789cb ("mtd: nand: pxa3xx: enable
NAND controller if the SoC needs it"). This commit adds support for the
Armada 8040 nand controller.
The kernel commit says this:
Marvell recent SoCs like A7k/A8k do not boot with NAND flash
controller activated by default. Enabling the controller is a matter
of writing in a system controller register that may also be used for
other NAND related choices.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Shmuel Hazan <shmuel.h@siklu.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Move board_fit_config_name_match() from Zynq/ZynqMP to common location.
This change will open a way to use it also by Microblaze and Versal.
Through this function there is a way to handle images with multiple DTBs.
For now match it with DEVICE_TREE as is done for Zynq.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Remove setting tapdelays for different speeds separately. Instead use
the ITAP and OTAP delay values which are read from the device tree.
If the DT does not contain tap delay values, the predefined values
will be used for the same.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The kfree() call is unreachable, and is not needed. Remove this call and
the fail_disable_clk label.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Use the generic DT code to find the device compatible property for us.
This makes the driver look more like other current drivers. It also make
it easier to add support for other variants like Armada 8K in a future
commit.
Signed-off-by: Shmuel Hazan <shmuel.h@siklu.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Align node properties to kernel dts node.
The change of compatible property does not affect any currently
supported board.
Keep U-Boot specific nand-enable-arbiter, and num-cs for compatibility
with the current driver.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Align node properties to kernel dts node.
Keep U-Boot specific nand-enable-arbiter, and num-cs for compatibility
with the current driver.
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Shmuel Hazan <shmuel.h@siklu.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
It helps ATF to determine who called power on function (U-boot/Linux).
The corresponding ATF code was added in this commit:
mvebu: cp110: avoid pcie power on/off sequence when called from Linux
55df84f974
Signed-off-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Replace the comphy initialization for PCIe with appropriate SMC call, so
the firmware will perform appropriate comphy initialization.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Signed-off-by: Ken Ma <make@marvell.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Replace all comphy initialization with appropriate smc calls. It will
result with triggering synchronous exception that is handled by Secure
Monitor code in EL3. Then the Secure Monitor code will dispatch each smc
call (by parsing the smc function identifier) and triggers appropriate
comphy initialization.
This patch reworks serdes handling for: SATA, SGMII, HS-SGMII and SFI
interfaces.
Signed-off-by: Grzegorz Jaszczyk <jaz@semihalf.com>
Reviewed-by: Igal Liberman <igall@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Baruch Siach <baruch@tkos.co.il>
Tests tests run the three mux subcommands: list, select, and deselect,
and verify that the commands do what we expect.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This command lets the user list, select, and deselect mux controllers
introduced with the mux framework on the fly. It has 3 subcommands:
list, select, and deselect.
List: Lists all the mux present on the system. The muxes are listed for
each chip. The chip is identified by its device name. Each chip can have
a number of mux controllers. Each is listed in sequence and is assigned
a sequential ID based on its position in the mux chip. It lists details
like ID, whether the mux is currently selected or not, the current
state, the idle state, and the number of states.
A sample output would look something like:
=> mux list
a-mux-controller:
ID Selected Current State Idle State Num States
0 no unknown as-is 0x4
1 no 0x2 0x2 0x10
2 no 0x73 0x73 0x100
another-mux-controller:
ID Selected Current State Idle State Num States
0 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
1 no 0x2 0x2 0x4
Select: Selects a given mux and puts it in the specified state. This
subcommand takes 3 arguments: mux chip, mux ID, state to set
the mux in. The arguments mux chip and mux ID are used to identify which
mux needs to be selected, and then it is selected to the given state.
The mux needs to be deselected before it can be selected again in
another state. The state should be a hexadecimal number.
For example:
=> mux list
a-mux-controller:
ID Selected Current State Idle State Num States
0 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
1 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
=> mux select a-mux-controller 0 0x3
=> mux list
a-mux-controller:
ID Selected Current State Idle State Num States
0 yes 0x3 0x1 0x4
1 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
Deselect: Deselects a given mux and puts it in its idle state. This
subcommand takes 2 arguments: the mux chip and mux ID to identify which
mux needs to be deselected. So in the above example, we can deselect mux
0 using:
=> mux deselect a-mux-controller 0
=> mux list
a-mux-controller:
ID Selected Current State Idle State Num States
0 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
1 no 0x1 0x1 0x4
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Provide tests to check the behavior of the multiplexer framework.
Two sets of tests are added. One is using an emulated multiplexer driver
that can be used to test basic functionality like select, deselect, etc.
The other is using the mmio mux which adds tests specific to it.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The memory is close to full and adding a syscon node in test.dts makes
it go over the limit and makes malloc() fail on startup.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds a driver for mmio-based syscon multiplexers controlled by
bitfields in a syscon register range.
This is heavily based on the linux mmio-mux driver.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
This will probe the multiplexer devices that have a "u-boot,mux-autoprobe"
property. As a consequence they will be put in their idle state.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add a new subsystem that handles multiplexer controllers. The API is the
same as in Linux.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
[trini: Update some error calls to use different functions or pass
correct arguments]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc2
A software RTC driver is supplied for UEFI SCT testing.
The following UEFI related bugs are fixed:
* correct handling of daylight saving time in GetTime() and SetTime()
* handling of the gd register in function tracing on RISC-V
* disable U-Boot devices in ExitBootServices()
The log command has led to NULL dereferences if an unknown category name
name was used due to missing entries in the list of category names.
Add compile time checks for the array sizes of log_cat_name and
log_lvl_name to avoid future mishaps.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Adjust the SetTime() and GetTime() runtime services to correctly convert
the daylight saving time information when communicating with the RTC.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
U-Boot Driver Model is supposed to remove devices with either
DM_REMOVE_ACTIVE_DMA or DM_REMOVE_OS_PREPARE flags set, before exiting.
Our bootm command does that by explicitly calling calling
"dm_remove_devices_flags(DM_REMOVE_ACTIVE_ALL);" and we also disable any
USB devices.
The EFI equivalent is doing none of those at the moment. As a result
probing an fTPM driver now renders it unusable in Linux. During our
(*probe) callback we open a session with OP-TEE, which is supposed to
close with our (*remove) callback. Since the (*remove) is never called,
once we boot into Linux and try to probe the device again we are getting
a busy error response. Moreover all uclass (*preremove) functions won't
run.
So let's fix this by mimicking what bootm does and disconnect devices
when efi_exit_boot_services() is called.
Signed-off-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
An UEFI application may change the value of the register that gd lives in.
But some of our functions like get_ticks() access this register. So we
have to set the gd register to the U-Boot value when entering a trace
point and set it back to the application value when exiting the trace
point.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On a board without hardware clock this software real time clock can be
used. The build time is used to initialize the RTC. So you will have
to adjust the time either manually using the 'date' command or use
the 'sntp' to update the RTC with the time from a network time server.
See CONFIG_CMD_SNTP and CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER. The RTC time is
advanced according to CPU ticks.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide a constant U_BOOT_EPOCH with the number of seconds since
1970-01-01. This constant can be used to initialize a software
real time clock until it is updated via the 'sntp' command.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Provide a unit test checking that a continuation message will use the same
log level and log category as the previous message.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some drivers use macro pr_cont() for continuing a message sent via printk.
Hence if we want to convert printk messaging to using the logging system,
we must support continuation of log messages too.
As pr_cont() does not provide a message level we need a means of
remembering the last log level.
With the patch a pseudo log level LOGL_CONT as well as a pseudo log
category LOGC_CONT are introduced. Using these results in the application
of the same log level and category as in the previous log message.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Replace the static variable processing_msg by a field in the global data.
Make the field bool at it can only be true or false.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
With disabled legacy VIDEO option CONSOLE_MUX is not auto-selected
any more, re-enable it.
Fixes: 9dec5a0ea1 ("nokia_rx51: disable obsolete VIDEO config")
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Define default values for input and output clock phase delays for
Versal. Also define functions for setting tapdelays based on these
clock phase delays.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Define input and output clock phase delays with pre-defined values.
Define arasan_sdhci_clk_data type structure and add it to priv
structure and store these clock phase delays in it.
Read input and output clock phase delays from dt. If these values are
not passed through dt, use pre-defined values.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Define timing macro's for all the available speeds of mmc. This is
done similar to linux. Replace speed macro's used with these new timing
macro's wherever applicable.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
This reverts commit 942b5fc032.
This is partial revert of the above commit.
mmc_of_parse() is reading no-1-8-v from device tree and if set,
it is clearing the UHS speed capabilities of cfg->host_caps.
cfg->host_caps &= ~(UHS_CAPS | MMC_MODE_HS200 |
MMC_MODE_HS400 | MMC_MODE_HS400_ES);
This is still missing to clear UHS speeds like SDHCI_SUPPORT_SDR104,
SDHCI_SUPPORT_SDR50 and SDHCI_SUPPORT_DDR50.
Even if we clear the flags SDHCI_SUPPORT_XXX in mmc_of_parse(),
these speed flags are getting set again in cfg->host_caps in
sdhci_setup_cfg().
The reason for this is, SDHCI_SUPPORT_XXX flags are cleared
only if controller is not capable of supporting MMC_VDD_165_195 volts.
if (caps & SDHCI_CAN_VDD_180)
cfg->voltages |= MMC_VDD_165_195;
if (!(cfg->voltages & MMC_VDD_165_195))
caps_1 &= ~(SDHCI_SUPPORT_SDR104 | SDHCI_SUPPORT_SDR50 |
SDHCI_SUPPORT_DDR50);
It means "no-1-8-v", which is read from DT is not coming in to effect.
So it is better we keep the host quirks(SDHCI_QUIRK_NO_1_8_V) to
clear UHS speeds based on no-1-8-v from device tree.
Hence revert the functionality related to no-1-8-v only, rest is fine
in the patch.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Add function description for zynq_qspi_init_hw and zynq_qspi_chipselect.
Fix zqspi to priv in function descriptions.
Change the description of priv as pointer to zynq_qspi_priv structure.
Fix other function descriptions to kernel-doc style.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Use tabs to be aligned with the rest of the code.
Fixes: 658df8bd94 ("mtd: spi-nor-core: Add octal mode support")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Call generic board_late_init_xilinx() to be aligned with the rest of xilinx
platforms. Also getting rid of initrd_high/fdt_high and use
bootm_low/boot_size instead.
Reported-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Change parameter type to avoid compilation error:
In file included from ./tools/../lib/rsa/rsa-verify.c:23:0,
from tools/lib/rsa/rsa-verify.c:1:
include/u-boot/rsa-mod-exp.h:69:18: error: unknown type name ‘u32’; did you mean ‘__u32’?
int zynq_pow_mod(u32 *keyptr, u32 *inout);
^~~
__u32
include/u-boot/rsa-mod-exp.h:69:31: error: unknown type name ‘u32’; did you mean ‘__u32’?
int zynq_pow_mod(u32 *keyptr, u32 *inout);
^~~
__u32
Fixes: 37e3a36a54 ("xilinx: zynq: Add support to secure images")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add ram base address to scriptaddr env variable to make boot
script address to be a valid address when ddr base address changes.
This works properly if the first memory region is the region where uboot
runs. Also the solution was taken in respect of a lot of jtag script
putting u-boot script to certain address. For standard cases
bd->bi_dram[0].start is 0 all the time. Only for systems with DDR placed
out of this location it does calculation.
This is not the best solution and should be done differently in future but
enough for now till we don't have full solution ready yet.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
For zynqmp qspi, frequencies up to 40MHz will work irrespective
of feedback clock enabled or disabled. If we want higher than
40Mhz the feedback clock should be enabled.
With spi-max-frequency 108MHz it is not working when the feedback
clock is disabled. Change it to 40MHz so that it works irrespective
of feedback clock enabled or disabled.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Acked-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
U-Boot SPL on ZynqMP is using CONFIG_SPL_USE_TINY_PRINTF which doesn't
return any return value and all the time returns 0. That's why
even correct snprintf was returning in SPL chip ID as "unknown".
Change checking condition and allow snprintf to return 0 which is according
manual patch successful return.
"If an output error is encountered, a negative value is returned."
Fixes: 43a138956f7e ("arm64: zynqmp: Get rid of simple_itoa and replace it by snprintf")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Fix hex format from 0x%0X to 0x%0x to show correct numbers.
Fixes: fa793165da ("xilinx: zynqmp: refactor silicon name function")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Idea is to have something what can be used for board bringup from
generic board perspective.
There is a violation compare to spec that FRU ID is ASCII8 instead of
binary format but this is really for having something to pass boot and
boot to OS which has better generating options.
Also time should be filled properly.
For example:
fru board_gen 1000 XILINX versal-x-prc-01-revA serialX partX
There is also support for revision field which is Xilinx specific field.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This patch adds support for fru commands "fru capture" and "fru display".
The fru capture parses the FRU table present at an address and stores in a
structure for later use. The fru display prints the content of captured
structured in a readable format.
As of now, it supports only common header and board area of FRU. Also, it
supports only English language code and ASCII8/BINARY formats.
fru_data variable is placed to data section because fru parser can be
called very early before bss is initialized. And also information needs to
be shared that's why it is exported via header.
Signed-off-by: Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu <siva.durga.paladugu@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no need to reference files in common folder back. Simply adding
Makefile to this folder does the job because this "common" location is
already wired in main Makefile.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no reason to have ZYNQ specific Kconfig macro in generic location
to be visible for all other SoCs. That's why move it to Xilinx common
location to be visible only for us.
Also introduce new bool entry ZYNQ_MAC_IN_EEPROM to have also an option to
disable it or enable. This has connection to code which is reading the
whole content of i2c and also work with the rest of date not just with MAC
address.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The commit 9f45aeb937 ("spl: fit: implement fdt_record_loadable") which
introduced fdt_record_loadable() state there spl_fit.c is not 64bit safe.
Based on my tests on Xilinx ZynqMP zcu102 platform there shouldn't be a
problem to record these addresses in 64bit format.
The patch adds support for systems which need to load images above 4GB.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
SPL is creating fit-images DT node when loadables are recorded in selected
configuration. Entries which are created are using entry-point and
load-addr property names. But there shouldn't be a need to use non standard
properties because entry/load are standard FIT properties. But using
standard FIT properties enables option to use generic FIT functions to
descrease SPL size. Here is result for ZynqMP virt configuration:
xilinx_zynqmp_virt: spl/u-boot-spl:all -82 spl/u-boot-spl:rodata -22 spl/u-boot-spl:text -60
The patch causes change in run time fit image record.
Before:
fit-images {
uboot {
os = "u-boot";
type = "firmware";
size = <0xfd520>;
entry-point = <0x8000000>;
load-addr = <0x8000000>;
};
};
After:
fit-images {
uboot {
os = "u-boot";
type = "firmware";
size = <0xfd520>;
entry = <0x8000000>;
load = <0x8000000>;
};
};
Replacing calling fdt_getprop_u32() by fit_image_get_entry/load() also
enables support for reading entry/load properties recorded in 64bit format.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove fixed reference clk used by plat->frequency and use clk
subsystem to get reference clk. As per spi dt bindings
"spi-max-frequency" property should be used by the slave devices.
This property is read by spi-uclass driver for the slave device.
So avoid reading above property from the platform driver.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Remove fixed reference clk used by plat->frequency and use clk
subsystem to get reference clk. As per spi dt bindings
"spi-max-frequency" property should be used by the slave devices.
This property is read by spi-uclass driver for the slave device.
So avoid reading above property from the platform driver.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There also a need to check return values to make sure that clocks were
enabled and setup properly.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The most of Xilinx evaluation boards have FMC connectors which contain
small eeprom for card identification. That's why read content of eeprom and
record it.
Also generate cardX_ variables for easier script handling.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Starts to use new way how eeproms should be referenced.
Reference is done via nvmem alias nodes. When this new way is specified
code itself read the eeprom and decode xilinx legacy format and fill struct
xilinx_board_description. Then based on information present there board_*
variables are setup.
If variables are saved and content can't be changed information is just
shown on console.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add support for getting a node/property from aliases.
The similar functionality is provided for chosen node and this
implemenatation is copy of it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
By default 48B sha3 hash value is written to srcaddr which is not the best
solution in case of that you want to use data for other operations. That's
why add key_addr optional parameters which enables to write 48B sha3 hash
value to specified address.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Tested-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
This patch adds support for encryption and decryption on a given data
blob using different key sources such as userkey(KUP), device key and
PUF key. Inorder to support this a new zynqmp command(zynqmp aes) has
been introduced.
Command:
zynqmp aes srcaddr ivaddr len aesop keysrc dstaddr [keyaddr]\n"
Encrypts or decrypts blob of data at src address and puts it\n"
back to dstaddr using key and iv at keyaddr and ivaddr\n"
respectively. keysrc values specifies from which source key\n"
has to be used, it can be User/Device/PUF key. A value of 0\n"
for KUP(user key),1 for DeviceKey and 2 for PUF key. The\n"
aesop value would specify the operationwhich can be 0 for\n"
decrypt and 1 for encrypt(1) operation\n";
Signed-off-by: Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu <siva.durga.paladugu@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
SPL DT contains only nodes which are contain u-boot,dm-pre-reloc property.
iommu node is not this case that's why when DT is read DTC reports some
warnings.
$ dtc -I dtb -O dts dts/dt-spl.dtb >/dev/null
<stdout>: Warning (iommus_property): /amba/spi@ff0f0000:iommus: Could not get phandle node for (cell 0)
<stdout>: Warning (iommus_property): /amba/mmc@ff160000:iommus: Could not get phandle node for (cell 0)
<stdout>: Warning (iommus_property): /amba/mmc@ff170000:iommus: Could not get phandle node for (cell 0)
SPL also has an option to remove some DT properties which are useless for
SPL to make DT even smaller.
Default DT properties are pinctrl-0 pinctrl-names interrupt-parent
interrupts which are already removed.
The patch extends this list with iommus to get rid of above warnings.
Also power-domains unused properties can be removed.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Sometimes it is very useful to be able disable/enable cache that's why
enable commands for it by default.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
fpga bitstream needs to be listed in config node in FIT image. Only tested
option is bitstream in BIN format.
Enabling this feature increase code size by almost 4k.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
simple_itoa() is implemented only for !CONFIG_USE_TINY_PRINTF. Tiny printf
is normally used by SPL that's code which uses simple_itoa() has missing
reference. That's why refactor code by using on snprintf() instead of
strncpy()/strncat() combination. This change also descrease code size by
saving 24B based on buildman.
aarch64: (for 1/1 boards) all -22.0 rodata +2.0 text -24.0
xilinx_zynqmp_virt: all -22 rodata +2 text -24
u-boot: add: 0/0, grow: 0/-1 bytes: 0/-24 (-24)
function old new delta
board_init 520 496 -24
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
In case of fpga loading (which can be huge) 100ms is not enough. That's why
extend timeout 10 times to wait maximum 1s to get ACK back.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Don't know reason but in regular flow addr_hi/low are swapped in ATF. It
means when fpga load is done from EL3 there is a need to swap it for PMUFW
to load bitstream.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Mini u-boot timer clock is not updated when u-boot is migrated from
emulator to silicon. Due to this slower clock of 2.72Mhz, delay() functions
are not working accurately. Update CONFIG_COUNTER_FREQUENCY to 100Mhz.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Mini u-boot eMMC dt parameters are not in sync with full u-boot dt.
Frequency for eMMC is fixed to 25Mhz. Due to this, mmc multi-block write
commands are failing. Increase frequency to 200Mhz to fix this issue.
Add bus-width = <8>, non-removable and disable-wp properties to the node
as this is eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add distro boot support for microblaze and enable jtag, qspi,
dhcp, pxe boot targets for distro boot.
Enable DISTRO_DEFAULTS config in microblaze defconfig and also
enable support for spi xilinx driver & spi vendors to access
spi flash by distro boot.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Setup all the distro boot related environment variables at
run time. Add BOOT_SCRIPT_OFFSET config to microblaze board
Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
9cg version was supported before code refactoring. The patch is adding it
back.
Fixes: fa793165da ("xilinx: zynqmp: refactor silicon name function")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Adding Z-turn board V5 to resolve the change between:
"Z-TURNBOARD_schematic.pdf" schematics state version 1 to 4 has Atheros AR8035
"Z-Turn_Board_sch_V15_20160303.pdf" schematics state version 5 has Micrel KSZ9031
At this time the S25FL128SAGNFI003 doesn't work because of bug:
*** Warning - spi_flash_probe_bus_cs() failed, using default environment
zynq-zturn was checked on V5 board, same error.
Maybe Z-turn board have the same problem (board with W25Q128BVFIG).
Signed-off-by: Alexandre GRIVEAUX <agriveaux@deutnet.info>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add missing documentation for Xilinx ZynqMP configuration with steps how
to configure it and run it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Several drivers have been added without updating documentation.
And also some dt bindings have been moved to yaml.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add fragment to cover documenation for Xilinx platforms.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Implement early init by calling generic board_init_f_alloc_reserve and
board_init_f_init_reserve functions:
* drop SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN related code, as allocation and gd->malloc_base
assignment are taken care of by the generic functions
* drop _gd logic
Cc: Michal Simek <monstr@monstr.eu>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Currently, the exceptions setup code is duplicated in pre-relocation and
post-relocation init. Factor out this code to __setup_exceptions asm
routine to get rid of the duplication.
__setup_exceptions is called with a relocation offset parameter (r5)
which is set to zero for pre-reloc init and gd->reloc_off for post-reloc
exception setup.
Cc: Michal Simek <monstr@monstr.eu>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
DM_VIDEO conversion deadline has passed, disable VIDEO config.
Boards should convert to DM_VIDEO if they need video console
support.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
DM_VIDEO conversion deadline has passed, disable VIDEO config.
Signed-off-by: Anatolij Gustschin <agust@denx.de>
Cc: Erik van Luijk <evanluijk@interact.nl>
- No need to check before free in kendryte clk.
- Only enable OF_BOARD_FIXUP if U-Boot is configured for S-Mode.
- Reduce k210 dts DMA block size
- Move timers into drivers/timer
- Correct fu540 dts reg size of clint node
Half of this driver is a DM-based timer driver, and half is RISC-V-specific
IPI code. Move the timer portions in with the other timer drivers. The
KConfig is not moved, since it also enables IPIs. It could also be split
into two configs, but no boards use the timer but not the IPI atm, so I
haven't split it.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
This is a regular timer driver, and should live with the other timer
drivers.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Although the max DMA size supported by the hardware register is 22 bits (or
4M), the Linux driver for this device only supports transfers of up to 2M.
On a device with 8M total memory, I don't think it will make too much of a
difference.
Reported-by: Damien Le Moal <Damien.LeMoal@wdc.com>
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
It is unsafe to enable OF_BOARD_FIXUP only based on OF_SEPARATE.
OF_SEPARATE may indicate that the user wishes U-Boot to use a different
device tree than one obtained via OF_PRIOR_STAGE. However, OF_SEPARATE may
also indicate that the device tree which would be obtained via
OF_PRIOR_STAGE is invalid, nonexistant, or otherwise unusable. In this
latter case, enabling OF_BOARD_FIXUP will result in corruption of the
device tree. To remedy this, only enable OF_BOARD_FIXUP if U-Boot is
configured for S-Mode.
Fixes: 1c17e55594
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
free() checks if its argument is NULL. No need to check it twice.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Highlights:
- Fix a problem with the bootm overlap tests
- Remove duplicated code in fatwrite
- Cleanup our current "misc" command code and add a new one for misc
class devices.
- Various GPIO fixes
It doesn't need to consider start byte address.
If ramdisk size is 0x800000 and start address is 0x2700000, then it's
used until 0x02efffff, not 0x02f00000. But it's detected to overlapt RD
image, when kernel start address is 0x02f00000.
Because it's doing wrong calculation about rd_len.
This patch fixed wrong calculation address position when check
condition.
In addition, it needs to check one more condition about overlapping
entire area.
Fixes: commit fbde7589ce ("common: bootm: add checks to verify if ramdisk / fdtimage overlaps OS image")
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
do_save() function defined in fs.c also supports FAT file system
re-use the same for fatwrite command.
Also fix the FAT test script to match the expected output.
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Enable the command "misc" for accessing miscellaneous devices with
a MISC uclass driver. The command provides listing all MISC devices
as well as read and write functionalities via their drivers.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
The "cmd/Kconfig" has a TODO description for CMD_MISC that it should
really be named as CMD_SLEEP. Change it in the whole source tree.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
This change fixes two issues when building u-boot-nodtb.bin target:
* Remove intermediate binary u-boot-nodtb.bin from disk when static_rela
call (which modifies u-boot-nodtb.bin binary) failed. It is required
because previous objcopy call creates binary and static_rela finish it.
* Do not call static_rela cmd when u-boot-nodtb.bin binary was not
created/updated by previous objcopy call.
Second fix would ensure that u-boot-nodtb.bin binary is not updated when
all prerequisites were up-to-date. And therefore final binary u-boot.bin
is not updated in case all prerequisites were not modified and were
up-to-date.
Now running 'make SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH=0 u-boot.bin' second time now does not
touch u-boot.bin binary in case nothing was modified, so GNU make can
correctly detect that everything is up-to-date.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the size of states_array to avoid overflow for
dev_pdata->voltages[j] and dev_pdata->states[j].
As the size of array is GPIO_REGULATOR_MAX_STATES, the size of
states_array is limited by GPIO_REGULATOR_MAX_STATES * 2 = 4
instead of 8 previously.
The value of the "count" variable is limited by the third parameter of
fdtdec_get_int_array_count.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Enable the CMD_MDIO Kconfig option by removing the "is not set"
indication from all the defconfigs for this SoC.
Signed-off-by: Ioana Ciornei <ioana.ciornei@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
On all newer Layerscape SoCs, only the export-controlled ciphers of the
crypto module are disabled on non-E parts. Thus it doesn't make sense to
completely remove the node. Linux will figure out what is there and what
is not.
Just remove it for older SoCs, where the module is indeed completely
disabled on non-E parts.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Horia Geanta <horia.geanta@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The board supports 16 configuration bits which can be manipulated with
this command. See the board's README for a detailed explanation on each
bit.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Tested-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Add basic support for the Kontron SMARC-sAL28 board. This includes just
the bare minimum to be able to bring up the board and boot linux.
For now, the Single and Dual PHY variant is supported. Other variants
will fall back to the basic variant.
In particular, there is no watchdog support for now. This means that you
have to disable the default watchdog, otherwise you'll end up in the
recovery bootloader. See the board README for details.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The register to enable/disable the write-permission of DBI RO
registers should be accessed via the CFG_ADDR/CFG_DATA registers
instead of accessing directly.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
As per hardware documentation, ECx_PMUX has precedence
over SerDes protocol.
For LX2160/LX2162 if DPMACs 17 and 18 are enabled as SGMII
through SerDes protocol but ECx_PMUX configured them as RGMII,
then the ports will be configured as RGMII and not SGMII.
Signed-off-by: Razvan Ionut Cirjan <razvanionut.cirjan@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable support to compile OPTEE driver, access AVB TA
and RPMB API's access via RPC from OPTEE for lx2160
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable "optee_rpmb" command to write/read named persistent values
created on RPMB by opening session with OPTEE AVB TA.
This provides easy test for establishing a session with OPTEE
TA and storage of persistent data in MMC RPMB.
It includes following subcommands:
optee_rpmb read_pvalue:read persistent values on rpmb via OPTEE AVB TA
optee_rpmb write_pvalue:write persistent values on rpmb via OPTEE AVB
TA
Signed-off-by: Ruchika Gupta <ruchika.gupta@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
In the current implementation, u-boot creates iommu mappings only
for PCI devices enumarated at boot time thus does not take into
account more dynamic scenarios such as SR-IOV or PCI hot-plug.
Add an u-boot env var and a device tree property (to be used for
example in more static scenarios such as hardwired PCI endpoints
that get initialized later in the system setup) that would allow
two things:
- for a SRIOV capable PCI EP identified by its B.D.F specify
the maximum number of VFs that will ever be created for it
- for hot-plug case, specify the B.D.F with which the device
will show up on the PCI bus
More details can be found in the included documentation:
arch/arm/cpu/armv8/fsl-layerscape/doc/README.pci_iommu_extra
Signed-off-by: Laurentiu Tudor <laurentiu.tudor@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fix duplication of this code by placing it in a common function.
Furthermore, the resulting function will be re-used in upcoming
patches.
Signed-off-by: Laurentiu Tudor <laurentiu.tudor@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Move the pci device related fdt fixup in a function in order to
re-use it in a following patch. While at it, improve the error
handling.
Signed-off-by: Laurentiu Tudor <laurentiu.tudor@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
- Assorted updates for Xen, IPQ40xx, ASpeed, Keymile
- Assorted typo / documentation fixes
- Fix default preboot cmd to act like before with USB_STORAGE set
- A number of other bugfixes throughout the code
dev_err has been used for debugging and a few dev_err message are
printed for normal code execution. Make them dev_dbg instead.
Signed-off-by: Fabien Parent <fparent@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
By using a hypervisor call, we can implement DEBUG_UART on xen.
This will allow us to see messages even earlier than serial_init().
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
This new function, xen_debug_putc(), is intended to be used to
enable CONFIG_DEBUG_UART on xen guest.
Please note that the underlying functionality in Xen is available
only when Xen is configured with !NDEBUG but is much simpler than
a generic HYPERVISOR_console_io().
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
At present, DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC is set only if !OF_CONTROL.
It doesn't make sense for this para-virtualized driver.
With this patch applied, you will be able to see early boot messages:
U-Boot 2020.10-00001-ge442e71a6c52-dirty (Oct 15 2020 - 11:02:25 +0900)
xenguest
Xen virtual CPU
Model: XENVM-4.15
DRAM: 128 MiB
PVBLOCK:
(XEN) gnttab_mark_dirty not implemented yet
pvblock: 0
In: hypervisor
Out: hypervisor
Err: hypervisor
xenguest#
Signed-off-by: AKASHI Takahiro <takahiro.akashi@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
1. Rename AST2500 reset driver from ast2500-reset.c
to reset-ast2500.c
2. Rename AST2500 reset kconfig option from AST2500_RESET
to RESET_AST2500
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
The System Control Unit (SCU) controller of Aspeed
SoCs provides the reset control for each peripheral.
This patch refactors the reset method to leverage
the SCU reset control. Thus the driver dependency
on watchdog including dedicated WDT API and reset
flag encoding can be eliminated.
The Kconfig description is also updated accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
The 12d152620d commit fixed the get_rate helper because the set_parent
one did not re-parent the clock device to the new parent. The 4d139f3838
commit allows you to remove this workaround by calling the
clk_get_parent_rate routine.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Fix up the documentation which was lost in a merge conflict in the
conversion to RST.
Fixes: 52d3df7fef ("log: Allow LOG_DEBUG to always enable log output")
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove the default value "usb start" for CONFIG_USB_STORAGE as the USB
storage boot initialization is correctly managed by distro boot command
('usb_boot' defined in include/config_distro_bootcmd.h already include
the command 'usb start').
Fixes: 324d77998e ("Define default CONFIG_PREBOOT with right config option")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Replace 'dev->dev' with '@desc->dev' in the gpio_request_by_name function
desc parameter description.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Instead having a hard coded value for "cramfsaddr" after compile time,
we change it to take the variable "cramfsaddr" for the ubicopy variable.
This makes sure that ubicopy uses the right address, even when
the value for "cramfsaddr" has changed.
CC: Valentin Longchamp <valentin.longchamp@hitachi-powergrids.com>
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Due to increasing kernel image sizes we get problems when decompressing
the kernel image. To fix this we need to change the addresses where we
load and where we extract the kernel. Also we need to adapt the address
where to load the CRAMFS image and where to load the DTB file.
While at it also harmonize all boards for PPC and ARM to have the
same values. Also we add a new variable "env_version", so that the
userspace is able to detect if this is a u-boot binary with updated
values or not.
CC: Valentin Longchamp <valentin.longchamp@hitachi-powergrids.com>
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
[trini: Remove old values from kmp204x.h]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
In the International System of Units (SI) the prefix kilo is abbreviated as
'k' not 'K'. 'K' is the symbol for Kelvin.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Since we now have the driver for Qualcomm PRNG HW, lets use it and add the necessary clocks and nodes.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
This adds the driver for the IPQ40xx built-in MDIO.
This will be needed to support future PHY driver.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Since we have SPI driver for IPQ40xx QUP SPI controller, lets add the necessary nodes, pinctrl and clocks.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
This patch adds support for the Qualcomm QUP SPI controller that is commonly found in most of Qualcomm SoC-s.
Driver currently supports v1.1.1, v2.1.1 and v2.2.1 HW.
FIFO and Block modes are supported, no support for DMA mode is planned.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Signed-off-by: Luka Kovacic <luka.kovacic@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
When building on a 32bit host the following warning occurs:
tools/image-host.c: In function ‘fit_image_read_data’:
tools/image-host.c:296:56: warning: format ‘%ld’ expects argument of
type ‘long int’, but argument 3 has type ‘__off64_t’
{aka ‘long long int’} [-Wformat=]
printf("File %s don't have the expected size (size=%ld, expected=%d)\n",
~~^
%lld
filename, sbuf.st_size, expected_size);
~~~~~~~~~~~~
tools/image-host.c:311:62: warning: format ‘%ld’ expects argument of
type ‘long int’, but argument 4 has type ‘__off64_t’
{aka ‘long long int’} [-Wformat=]
printf("Can't read all file %s (read %zd bytes, expexted %ld)\n",
~~^
%lld
filename, n, sbuf.st_size);
~~~~~~~~~~~~
Fix the format strings.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
As the ownership is now Hitachi Power Grids, change the license string
and adapt the compatible string in DTS files. For kmeter1.dts we
change it to "keymile,KMETER1" for now, as this is then compliant with
what is submitted to the linux kernel. All other boards don't have
a upstreamed version in linux mainline.
Signed-off-by: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
CC: Valentin Longchamp <valentin.longchamp@hitachi-powergrids.com>
CC: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
CC: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
CC: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Convert all the other http:// links to https:// .
www.denx.de/twiki/ seems to move to www.denx.de/wiki/ ,
so change it.
I checked all links in this patch are valid.
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
doc/arch/index.rst is a list of links to each architecture.
As for the sandbox details, doc/arch/sandbox.rst looks better.
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch include these updates
- Git repository has moved to GitLab
- HTTPS access to the file server is allowed
- pre-built images are no longer available
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
No timer drivers return an error from get_count. Instead of possibly
returning an error, just return the count directly.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This adds kerneldocs for <timer.h>.
I don't know who should maintain doc/api/timer.rst, since the timer
subsystem seems to be maintained by SoC maintainers. MAINTAINERS is left
un-updated for the moment.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The sandbox is built with the SDL2 library with invokes the X11 library
which in turn calls getc(). But getc() in glibc is defined as
int getc(FILE *)
This does not match our definition.
int getc(void)
The sandbox crashes when called with parameter -l.
Rename our library symbol getc() to getchar().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This code is intended do prevent one from setting a shell variable abc
by doing
abc=123
if an environment variable named abc already exists. However, the
check is broken, since the env_get is done before the split on =, so
we look up whether an environment variable "abc=123" exists, which is
obviously never the case.
One could move the code to below the split on =, but instead, just
remove it, saving a little .text: The check has never worked as
intended (it goes all the way back to the initial git commit), and it
would anyway not guard against one first setting the shell variable,
then doing 'env set abc xyz'.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
add back again special case: -2
autoboot with no delay and no check for abort
as described in Kconfig option, see common/Kconfig
help text for option BOOTDELAY.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Fix some comments about functions.
Move genimg_get_comp_name() above genimg_get_short_name() because
genimg_get_comp_name() is related to get_table_entry_name().
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In show_valid_options(), this patch introduces checking whether
a category has an entry ID. If not, adding it to a list for output
is skipped before calling qsort().
This patch will affect all kinds of image header categories
(-A, -C, -O and -T flags).
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a generic function which can check whether a category has an
entry ID.
Signed-off-by: Naoki Hayama <naoki.hayama@lineo.co.jp>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_{SPL,TPL}_SIZE_LIMIT are defined as hex (SPL_SIZE_LIMIT was
converted in b51882d0 ("spl: Convert CONFIG_SPL_SIZE_LIMIT to hex"), but
there are still places that reference integer values. Change those to hex
as well. Also, update the Makefile to check for 0x0 instead of 0.
This also fixes the following build error when CONFIG_SPL_SIZE_LIMIT
is set by menuconfig to 0x0:
...
spl/u-boot-spl.bin exceeds file size limit:
limit: 0 bytes
actual: 0x80f0 bytes
excess: 0x80f0 bytes
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
We don't want the debug output to be visible in a normal boot. Silence it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher<hs@denx.de>
It is much easier to read the bloblist addresses if it starts on a 4KB
boundary. Update it to align it accordingly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function can be called when it is not known whether it will find
anything. This results in confusing log messages if the device is not
found. It is better for the caller to log the failure, if necessary.
Drop the logging from this function.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Activate CMD_EXPORTENV/CMD_IMPORTENV/CMD_ELF for STM32MP15 defconfig
- Fix stm32prog command: parsing of FlashLayout without partition
- Update MAINTAINERS for ARM STM STM32MP
- Manage eth1addr on dh board with KS8851
- Limit size of cacheable DDR in pre-reloc stage in stm32mp1
- Use mmc_of_parse() to read host capabilities in mmc:sdmmc2 driver
Remove duplicated stdio print message.
It's already displayed in common/console.c.
Loading Environment from MMC... OK
In: serial
Out: serial
Err: serial
Model: Odroid XU3/XU4/HC1/HC2 based on Exynos5422
Type: xu3
In: serial
Out: serial
Err: serial
Signed-off-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Signed-off-by: Minkyu Kang <mk7.kang@samsung.com>
A64-Teres-I board is a laptop which comes with a builtin keyboard.
The keyboard+trackpad controller pauses for 2 seconds at a firmware
prompt before loading its HID interface.
U-Boot needs to wait equally long to reliably enable the keyboard.
Signed-off-by: Jonas Smedegaard <dr@jones.dk>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Series-Cc: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Series-Cc: Lukasz Majewski <lukma@denx.de>
Series-Cc: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Olimex OLinuXino LIME2 rev. H through L uses Micrel KSZ9031 PHY.
This enables the Micrel PHY for A20-OLinuXino-Lime2-eMMC_defconfig.
Signed-off-by: Jonas Smedegaard <dr@jones.dk>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Allwinner sun50i SoCs contain an OpenRISC 1000 CPU that functions as a
System Control Processor, or SCP. ARM Trusted Firmware (ATF)
communicates with the SCP over SCPI to implement the PSCI system
suspend, shutdown and reset functionality. Currently, SCP firmware is
optional; the system will boot and run without it, but system suspend
will be unavailable.
Since all communication with the SCP is mediated by ATF, the only thing
U-Boot needs to do is load the firmware into SRAM. The SCP firmware
occupies the last 16KiB of SRAM A2, immediately following ATF.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Add an entry type for a firmware blob for a System Control Processor,
given by an entry arg. This firmware is a raw binary blob.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Since commit d879616e9e ("spl: fit: simplify logic for FDT loading for
non-OS boots"), the SPL looks at the "os" properties of FIT images to
determine where to append the FDT.
The "os" property of the "firmware" image also determines how to execute
the next stage of the boot process, as in 1d3790905d ("spl: atf:
introduce spl_invoke_atf and make bl31_entry private"). For this reason,
the next stage must be specified in "firmware", not in "loadables".
To support this additional functionality, and to properly model the boot
process, where ATF runs before U-Boot, add the "os" properties and swap
the firmware/loadable images in the FIT image.
Since this description was copied as an example in commit 70248d6a2916
("binman: Support generating FITs with multiple dtbs"), update those
examples as well for correctness and consistency.
Acked-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Some boards, specifically 64-bit Allwinner boards (sun50i), are
extremely limited on SPL size. One strategy that was used to make space
was to remove the FIT "os" property parsing code, because it uses a
rather large lookup table.
However, this forces the legacy FIT parsing code path, which requires
the "firmware" entry in the FIT to reference the U-Boot binary, even if
U-Boot is not the next binary in the boot sequence (for example, on
sun50i boards, ATF is run first).
This prevents the same FIT image from being used with a SPL with
CONFIG_SPL_FIT_IMAGE_TINY=n and CONFIG_SPL_ATF=y, because the boot
method selection code looks at `spl_image.os`, which is only set from
the "firmware" entry's "os" property.
To be able to use CONFIG_SPL_ATF=y, the "firmware" entry in the FIT
must be ATF, and U-Boot must be a loadable. For this to work, we need to
parse the "os" property just enough to tell U-Boot from other images, so
we can find it in the loadables list to append the FDT, and so we don't
try to append the FDT to ATF (which could clobber adjacent firmware).
So add the minimal code necessary to distinguish U-Boot/non-U-Boot
loadables with CONFIG_SPL_FIT_IMAGE_TINY=y. This adds about 300 bytes,
much less than the 7400 bytes added by CONFIG_SPL_FIT_IMAGE_TINY=n.
Acked-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This consolidates the SoC-specific part at the top of the file to avoid
cluttering it up with preprocessor conditions.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Prior to commit 7f7f8aca8257 ("sunxi: Convert 64-bit boards to use
binman"), if the BL31 environment variable was not defined, the firmware
would be loaded from a file "bl31.bin" in the current directory. Restore
that behavior by providing that as the default filename in case no entry
arg is provided, which will be the case if the environment variable is
unset.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Nodes should have a blank line separating them from sibling nodes and
properties. Add the necessary lines.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Due to an extra level of indentation, the "data" property containing the
FDT was being written repeatedly after every other property in the node.
This caused the generated FIT image to be invalid.
Move the block up one level, so the property is added exactly once.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If neither CONFIG_SPL_FIT_SOURCE nor CONFIG_USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR is
enabled, U_BOOT_ITS will be undefined, and attempting to make u-boot.itb
will pass invalid arguments to mkimage, causing it to print its help
message.
Remove the rule in that case, so it is more obvious that u-boot.itb is
not something that can be made. This will reduce confusion as platforms
move away from CONFIG_USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR, as u-boot.itb was
previously a valid goal for those platforms.
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Samuel Holland <samuel@sholland.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Previously, because we have no source code about the DRAM initialization
of V3s and missing some configurations (delays and MBUS QoS info), our
V3s DRAM initialization sequence is hacked from the H3 one.
As the SDK shipped with PineCube contains source code for V3s libdram,
we can retrieve these information from it and tweak some other magic
bits.
Signed-off-by: Icenowy Zheng <icenowy@aosc.io>
Reviewed-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
This reverts commit eb39d8ba5f.
The commit breaks booting of fitImage by SPL, the system simply hangs.
This is because on arm32, the fitImage and all of its content can be
aligned to 4 bytes and U-Boot expects just that.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Reuben Dowle <reuben.dowle@4rf.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
The current default of 0x400 for SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN is too small if any
additional drivers marked as DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC are loaded before
relocation.
CONFIG_RSA=y which is needed for UEFI secure boot or for FIT image
verification loads the driver mod_exp_sw which has DM_FLAG_PRE_RELOC.
CONFIG_LOG=Y is another setting requiring additional early malloc
area, cf. log_init().
When running pine64-lts_defconfig with CONFIG_RSA=y and debug UART enabled
we see as output in main U-Boot
alloc_simple() alloc space exhausted
With this patch the default values of SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN and
SPL_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN on ARCH_SUNXI are raised to 0x2000.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update email address of Maxime Ripard in git-mailrc to match more
recently updated entry in MAINTAINERS.
commit 9bd9b2bcbe ("MAINTAINERS: Update my email address")
commit bf8f4c4400 ("MAINTAINERS: Update email address for Maxime Ripard")
Signed-off-by: Jonas Smedegaard <dr@jones.dk>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
According to the devicetree and the schematic, the 3.3V power rail for
the PHY is enabled by GPIO PC16. It's wired as active-high, with a
pull-up resistor, so actually works already when the GPIO is in
High-Z state.
However we should not take any chances and explicitly set the GPIO pin
to high, to avoid accidentally losing the PHY power.
The existing MACPWR Kconfig allows to do this easily.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When sending a command via the MDIO bus, the Designware MAC expects some
bits in the CMD register to describe the clock divider value between
the main clock and the MDIO clock.
So far we were omitting these bits, resulting in setting "00", which
means "/ 16", so ending up with an MDIO frequency of either 18.75 or
12.5 MHz.
All the internal PHYs in the H3/H5/H6 SoCs as well as the Gbit Realtek
PHYs seem to be fine with that - although it looks like to be severly
overclocked (the MDIO spec limits the frequency to 2.5 MHz).
However the external 100Mbit PHY on the Pine64 (non-plus) board is
not happy with that, Ethernet was actually never working there, as the
PHY didn't probe.
As we set the EMAC clock (via AHB2) to 300 MHz in ATF (on the 64-bit
SoCs), and use 200 MHz on the H3, we need the highest divider of 128
to let the MDIO clock end up below the required 2.5 MHz.
This enables Ethernet on the Pine64(non-plus).
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The current implementation of sun8i_get_ephy_nodes() makes quite some
assumptions, in general relying on DT path names is a bad idea.
I think the idea of the code was to determine if we are using the
internal PHY, for which there are simpler and more robust methods:
Rewrite (and rename) the existing function to simply lookup the DT node
that "phy-handle" points to, using the device's DT node.
Then check whether the parent of that PHY node is using an "H3 internal
MDIO" compatible string. If we ever get another internal MDIO bus
implementation, we will probably need code adjustments anyway, so this
is good enough for now.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
[jagan: rebase on master]
Signed-off-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The error handling in recv() is somewhat broken, for instance
good_packet isn't really used, and it's hardly readable. Also we try
to check for short or too big packets, but those are actually filtered
out by the hardware.
Simplify the whole routine and improve the error handling:
- Bail out early if the current RX descriptor is not ready.
- Enable propagation of runt, huge and broken packets.
- Check for runt and huge packets, and return 0 to indicate this.
This will force the framework to call free_pkt for cleanup.
- Avoid aligning the packet buffer for invalidation again.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The EMAC soft reset routine was subtly broken, using an open coded
timeout routine without any actual delay.
Remove the unneeded initial reset bit read, and call wait_for_bit_le32()
to handle the timeout correctly.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When iterating over all RX/TX buffers, we were using a rather long "idx"
control variable, which lead to a nasty overlong line.
Replace "idx" with "i" to avoid this.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
To meet the current alignment requirements for our cache maintenance
functions, we were explicitly aligning the *arguments* to those calls.
This is not only ugly to read, but also wrong, as we need to make sure
we are not accidentally stepping on other data.
Provide wrapper functions for the common case of cleaning or
invalidating a descriptor, to make the cache maintenance calls more
readable. This fixes a good deal of the problematic calls.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
There is no reason to invalidate a TX descriptor before we are setting
it up, as we will only write to a field.
Remove the not needed invalidate_dcache_range() call.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When we initialise the TX descriptors, there is no need yet to clean
them all to memory, as they don't contain any data yet. Later we will
touch and clean each descriptor anyway.
However we tell the MAC about the beginning of the chain, so we have to
clean at least the first descriptor, to make it clear that this is empty
and there are no packets to transfer yet.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Before we initialise the RX descriptors, there is no need to *clean*
them from the cache, as we touch them for the first time.
However we should cover the case that those buffers contain dirty cache
lines, which could be evicted and written back to DRAM any time later,
in the worst case *after* the MAC has transferred a packet into them.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
The EMAC driver contains a lot of magic bits, although the manuals
and the Linux driver have all names for them.
Define those names and use them when programming the registers.
Also this replaces a lot of readl/mask/writel operations with the much
easier-to-read setbits_le32() macro.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
Apparently due to copying from some older or converted driver, the
sun8i_emac driver contains pointless wrapper functions to bridge
between a legacy driver and the driver model.
Since sun8i_emac is (and always was) driver model only, there is no
reason to have those confusing wrappers. Just remove them, and use
the driver model prototypes directly.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When preparing the register value for the MDIO command register, we
start with a zeroed register, so there is no need to mask off certain
bits before setting them.
Simplify the sequence, and rename the variable to a more matching
mii_cmd on the way.
Also the open-coded time-out routine can be replaced with a much safer
and easier-to-read call to wait_for_bit_le32().
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When initialising the TX DMA descriptors, we mostly chain them up,
but of course don't know about any data or its length yet.
That means they are still invalid, and the OWN bit should NOT be set
yet.
In fact when we later tell the MAC about the beginning of the chain,
and enable TX DMA in the start() routine, the MAC will start fetching
TX descriptors prematurely, as it can be seen by dumping the TX_DMA_STA
and TX_DMA_CUR_DESC registers.
Clear the owner bit, to not give the MAC the wrong illusion that it
owns the descriptors already.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When phy_startup() returns with an error, because there is no link or
the user interrupted the process, we shall stop the _start() routine
and return with an error, instead of proceeding anyway.
This fixes pointless operations when there is no Ethernet cable
connected, for instance.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Acked-by: Maxime Ripard <mripard@kernel.org>
Tested-by: Amit Singh Tomar <amittomer25@gmail.com> # Pine64+
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
When partitions are not available on a device the command stm32prog raises
an error but a device can have no partition to check in init_device()
and the command need to continue to the next part_id.
This patch correct an issue for ram0 target, when block_dev and mtd
are NULL.
For example with the simple flashlayout file:
Opt Part Name Type Device Offset Binary
- 0x01 fsbl Binary none 0x0 tf-a-serialboot.stm32
- 0x03 ssbl Binary none 0x0 u-boot.stm32
P 0x10 kernel System ram0 0xC2000000 uImage.bin
P 0x11 dtb FileSytem ram0 0xC4000000 stm32mp157f-ev1.dtb
Fixes: ffc405e63b ("stm32mp: stm32prog: add upport of partial update")
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Activate CONFIG_CMD_ELF to accept the command "bootelf".
This patch simplifies the file stm32mp defconfig, as we have
no reason to deactivate this command.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Activate CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV to accept the command "env import".
This command is useful in script to include some variable.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Add the STM32MP1 RNG driver in the list of drivers supported by
the STMicroelectronics STM32MP15x series.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Add files and directories regex "stm32" and "stm" in "ARM STM STM32MP"
platform to avoid missing files or drivers supported by the
STMicroelectronics series STM32MP15x.
This patch adds the rules already used in Linux kernel for
ARM/STM32 ARCHITECTURE.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Cosmetic update of gpio.h:
- remove enumerate: stm32_gpio_port, stm32_gpio_pin
because STM32_GPIO_XXX values are unused
- move STM32_GPIOS_PER_BANK in stm32_gpio.c
as its value is IP dependent and not arch dependent
No functional change as number of banks and number of gpio by banks
is managed by device tree since since DM migration and
commit 8f651ca60b ("pinctrl: stm32: Add get_pins_count() ops").
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
In pre-reloc stage, U-Boot marks cacheable the DDR limited by
the new config CONFIG_DDR_CACHEABLE_SIZE.
This patch allows to avoid any speculative access to DDR protected by
firewall and used by OP-TEE; the "no-map" reserved memory
node in DT are assumed after this limit:
STM32_DDR_BASE + DDR_CACHEABLE_SIZE.
Without security, in basic boot, the value is equal to STM32_DDR_SIZE.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
mmc_of_parse() can populate the 'f_max' and 'host_caps' fields of
struct mmc_config from devicetree.
The same logic is duplicated in stm32_sdmmc2_probe(). Use
mmc_of_parse(), which is more generic.
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
"cap-mmc-highspeed" enables support for 26 MHz MMC, but there is no
additional flag to enable 52 MHz MMC. In Linux. "cap-mmc-highspeed"
is used for MMC HS at both 26MHz and 52MHz.
Use the same approach and enable MMC_CAP(MMC_HS_52) host capability
when "cap-mmc-highspeed" is found in the devicetree. In the event an
MMC card doesn't support 52 MHz, it will be clocked at a speed based
on its EXT CSD, even on 52 MHz host controllers
Signed-off-by: Alexandru Gagniuc <mr.nuke.me@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
An earlier conversion from struct to defines introduced two errors, both
related to setup of EMAC routed via the FPGA. One of the offsets was
incorrect, and the EMAC0/EMAC1 were swapped.
The effect of this was rather odd: both ports could operate at gigabit,
but one of them would fail to transmit when operating at 100Mbit.
Fixes: db5741f7a8 ("arm: socfpga: Convert system manager from struct to defines")
Signed-off-by: Ralph Siemsen <ralph.siemsen@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Add fallback compatibility string for R-Car Gen3 and RZ/G2.
Also sorted the compatible string as per SoC ID.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Add MediaTek USB3 Dual-Role controller driver to ARM MEDIATEK,
and add myself as a maintainer for it.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Enable mtu3, xhci, tphy drivers.
Device mode: enable fastboot;
Host mode: enable USB, FAT commands, and fixed regulator,
mass storage drivers;
Due to device mode is enabled by default, comment out
the host mode config here.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add an entry in usb_gadget_controller_number() for the MTU3
gadget controller. It is used to bind the USB Ethernet driver.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This patch adds support for the MediaTek USB3 DRD controller,
its host side is based on xHCI, this driver supports device mode
and host mode.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Acked-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There is only declaration of usb_speed_string(), but no definition,
so add it to avoid build error when call it.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add dt-binding for MediaTek USB3 DRD Driver which it's ported
from the Linux kernel DTS binding:
Documentation/devicetree/bindings/usb/mediatek,mtu3.txt
Commit ID:
34d0545978b6 ("dt-bindings: usb: mtu3: fix typo of DMA clock name")
Due to Dual-Role switch is not supported in Uboot, some properties
are removed or changed.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add bindings for common properties, include maximum-speed,
dr_mode and phy_type
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
In buffer DMA mode, gadget should re-configure EP 0 to received SETUP
packets when doeptsiz.xfersize is equal to a setup packet size(8 bytes)
and EP 0 is in WAIT_FOR_SETUP state.
Since EP 0 is not enabled in WAIT_FOR_SETUP state, SETUP packets is NOT
received from RxFifo and wriiten to the external memory.
Signed-off-by: Chance.Yang <chance.yang@vatics.com>
With DM enabled the ethernet code will receive a packet, call
the push method that's set by the EFI network implementation
and then free the packet. Unfortunately the push methods only
sets a flag that the packet needs to be handled, but the code
that provides the packet to an EFI application runs after the
packet has already been freed.
To rectify this issue, adjust the push method to accept the packet
and store it in a temporary buffer. The EFI application then gets
the data copied from that buffer. This way the packet is cached
until is is needed.
The DM Ethernet stack tries to receive 32 packets at once, thus
we better allocate as many buffers as the stack.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
With a define for the magic number of packets received as batch
we can make sure that the EFI network stack caches the same amount
of packets.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Wildt <patrick@blueri.se>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Second set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.01 cycle:
This feature set brings the rework of the clock tree for sam9x60 SoC.
This makes the clock tree fully compatible with Common Clock Framework
and allows full clock configuration in U-Boot. This means that the
sam9x60 boards can boot now using U-Boot.
This also includes the definitions for sam9x60 SiPs and a divisor fix
for the clock on sama7g5 SoC.
Use slow clock CCF compatible DT bindings. This will not break
the above functionality as the SoC is not booting with current
PMC bindings.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Heap base address is computed based on SYS_INIT_SP_ADDR by
subtracting the SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN value in
board_init_f_init_reserve().
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Done with:
./tools/moveconfig.py VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
The 3 suspicious migration because CMD_BMP and SPLASH_SCREEN
are not activated in these defconfigs:
- trats_defconfig
- s5pc210_universal_defconfig
- trats2_defconfig
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For levels equal to the maximum value, the duty cycle must be equal to
the period.
Signed-off-by: Dario Binacchi <dariobin@libero.it>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Amlogic D-PHY in the Amlogic AXG SoC Family does support a frequency
higher than 10MHz for the TX Escape Clock, thus make the target rate
configurable.
This is based on the Linux commit [1] and adapted to the U-Boot driver.
[1] a328ca7e4af3 ("drm/bridge: dw-mipi-dsi: permit configuring the escape clock rate")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The timing values for dw-dsi are often dependent on the used display and
according to Philippe Cornu will most likely also depend on the used phy
technology in the soc-specific implementation.
To solve this and allow specific implementations to define them as needed
add a new get_timing callback to phy_ops and call this from the dphy_timing
function to retrieve the necessary values for the specific mode.
This is based on the Linux commit [1] and adapted to the U-Boot driver.
[1] 25ed8aeb9c39 ("drm/bridge/synopsys: dsi: driver-specific configuration of phy timings")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
syslog_test.h is in test/log/, not include/
Fixes: 52d3df7fef ("log: Allow LOG_DEBUG to always enable log output")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Now that linux/compat.h does not define these macros, we do not need to
undefine them.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
All users of these functions now include dm/device_compat.h directly.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This driver doesn't use DM (in the correct places), so we use a device and
not a udevice. We also need to include device_compat.h
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This patch enhances the Octeon TX/TX2 watchdog driver to fully enable
the WDT. With this changes, the "wdt" command is now also supported
on these platforms.
Signed-off-by: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Cc: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Cc: Chandrakala Chavva <cchavva@marvell.com>
- fsl_esdhc_imx cleanup
- not send cm13 if send_status is 0.
- Add reinit API
- Add mmc HS400 for fsl_esdhc
- Several cleanup for fsl_esdhc
- Add ADMA2 for sdhci
- Octeon TX: Add NAND driver (Suneel)
- Octeon TX: Add NIC driver driver (Suneel)
- Octeon TX2: Add NIC driver driver (Suneel)
- Armada 8040: Add iEi Puzzle-M80 board support (Luka)
- Armada A37xx SPI: Add support for CS-GPIO (George)
- Espressobin: Use Linux model/compatible strings (Andre)
- Espressobin: Add armada-3720-espressobin-emmc.dts from Linux (Andre)
- Armada A37xx: Small cleanup of config header (Pali)
Sphinx.override_domain() is deprecated since Sphinx 1.8 and removed in
Sphinx 3.
Use Sphinx.add_domain(, override=True) instead.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Set the defaults on probe for the packet buffer size registers
for the i210.
The TX/RX PBSIZE register of the i210 resets to its default value
only at power-on - see Intel Ethernet Controller I210 Datasheet rev 3.5
chapter 8.3 'Internal Packet Buffer Size Registers'.
If something (another driver, another OS, etc.) modifies this register
from its default value, the e1000 driver doesn't function correctly. It
detects a hang of the transmitter and continuously resets the adapter.
Here we set this value to its default when resetting the i210 to
resolve this issue.
Signed-off-by: Christian Gmeiner <christian.gmeiner@gmail.com>
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() takes the kconfig name without the CONFIG_ prefix,
e.g. CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CLK) for CONFIG_CLK. Make including the prefix
an error in checkpatch.pl so calls in the wrong format aren't
accidentally reintroduced.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
CONFIG_IS_ENABLED() takes the kconfig name without the CONFIG_ prefix,
e.g. CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CLK) for CONFIG_CLK. Some of these were being
fixed every now and then, see:
commit 71ba2cb0d6 ("board: stm32mp1: correct CONFIG_IS_ENABLED usage for LED")
commit a5ada25e42 ("rockchip: clk: fix wrong CONFIG_IS_ENABLED handling")
commit 5daf6e56d3 ("common: console: Fix duplicated CONFIG in silent env callback")
commit 48bfc31b64 ("MIPS: bootm: Fix broken boot_env_legacy codepath")
Fix all files found by `git grep "CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CONFIG"` by running
':%s/CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_\(\w+\))/CONFIG_IS_ENABLED(\1)/g' in vim.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the description of the global data pointer to the generated HTML
documentation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the missing Sphinx documentation for struct global_data and
gd_board_type().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Sphinx documentation is only available for enums not for #defines.
Anyway it is better to keep related definitions in an enum.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Functions that are used in multiple C modules should be defined in an
include.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
get_ticks does not always succeed. Sometimes it can be called before the
timer has been initialized. If it does, it returns a negative errno.
This causes the timer to appear non-monotonic, because the value will
become much smaller after the timer is initialized.
No users of get_ticks which I checked handle errors of this kind. Further,
functions like tick_to_time mangle the result of get_ticks, making it very
unlikely that one could check for an error without suggesting a patch such
as this one.
This patch panics if we ever get an error. There are two cases in which
this can occur. The first is if we couldn't find/probe the timer for some
reason. One reason for this is if the timer is not available so early. This
likely indicates misconfiguration. Another reason is that the timer has an
invalid/missing device tree binding. In this case, panicing is also
correct. The second case covers errors calling get_count. This can only
occur if the timer is missing a get_count function (or on RISC-V, but that
should be fixed soon).
Fixes: c8a7ba9e6a
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This parallels what I added for FAT in commit 6731bef696, allowing the
environment to be found in a specific partition on the device that the
board's mmc_get_env_dev() returns. On the Banana Pi R2 that means the
device that U-Boot was loaded from; either the internal eMMC or an SD
card.
Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <dwmw2@infradead.org>
Since it's so trivial I could just about tolerate this when there were only
two copies of it. But now there are about to be three.
Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <dwmw2@infradead.org>
The EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL is needed for address randomization in Linux.
We should provide it by default on QEMU.
Reported-by: François Ozog <francois.ozog@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
To make the button command useful in a shell script it should return the
status of the button:
* 0 (true) - pressed, on
* 1 (false) - not pressed, off
The button command takes only one argument. Correct maxargs.
Adjust the Python unit test.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
For testing purposes keep the output value when switching to input.
This allows us to manipulate the input value via the gpio command.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Using different strings for the device tree node labels and the label
property of buttons sharpens the button label unit test.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
To simplify configuration and keep synchronized the PStore/Ramoops between
U-Boot and the Linux kernel, this commit dynamically adds the Ramoops
parameters defined in the U-Boot session to the Device Tree.
Signed-off-by: Frédéric Danis <frederic.danis@collabora.com>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Add PStore command to sandbox and sandbox64 defconfigs.
Add test checking:
- 'pstore display' of all records
- 'pstore display' only the 2nd dump record
- 'pstore save' of all records
Signed-off-by: Frédéric Danis <frederic.danis@collabora.com>
[trini: Adjust to always load files from source directory]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This patch adds a new pstore command allowing to display or save ramoops
logs (oops, panic, console, ftrace and user) generated by a previous
kernel crash.
PStore parameters can be set in U-Boot configuration file, or at run-time
using "pstore set" command. Records size should be the same as the ones
used by kernel, and should be a power of 2.
This command allows:
- to display uncompressed logs
- to save compressed or uncompressed logs, compressed logs are saved as a
compressed stream, it may need some work to be able to decompress it,
e.g. adding a fake header:
"printf "\x1f\x8b\x08\x00\x00\x00\x00\x00\x00\x00" |
cat - dmesg-ramoops-0.enc.z | gzip -dc"
- ECC part is not used to check memory corruption
- only 1st FTrace log is displayed or saved
Signed-off-by: Frédéric Danis <frederic.danis@collabora.com>
[trini: Minor updates for current design, correct spacing in rST]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Cc: Wolfgang Denk <wd@denx.de>
Cc: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Newer eSDHC controllers support ADMA2 descriptor tables which support
64bit DMA addresses. One notable user of addresses in the upper memory
segment is the EFI loader.
If support is enabled, but the controller doesn't support ADMA2, we
will fall back to SDMA (and thus 32 bit DMA addresses only).
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
These comments are relict for old, now removed config options.
So remove these obsoleted comments too.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import armada-3720-espressobin-emmc.dts from Linux, but use sdhc1 for
emmc, since our dtsi is still based on downstream and sdhc0 is used for
the sd card.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Move most of the dts to the new common armada-3720-espressobin.dtsi
file, just like Linux, but keep the current, downstream based, version.
The dts itself is imported from Linux.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Fix the actual board vendor and ease synching dts files from Linux.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
The device tree has a way to specify GPIO lines as chip selects. From
the binding docs:
So if for example the controller has 2 CS lines, and the cs-gpios
property looks like this:
cs-gpios = <&gpio1 0 0> <0> <&gpio1 1 0> <&gpio1 2 0>;
Then it should be configured so that num_chipselect = 4 with the
following mapping:
cs0 : &gpio1 0 0
cs1 : native
cs2 : &gpio1 1 0
cs3 : &gpio1 2 0
Add support for this, while retaining backward-compatibility with
existing device trees; the driver will preserve existing behavior if a
cs-gpios list is not given, or if a particular line is specified as <0>
(native).
This implementation is inspired by similar implementations in
neighboring drivers for other platforms: atmega, mxc, etc.
Signed-off-by: George Hilliard <ghilliar@amazon.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add support for the marvell,armada8040-puzzle-m801 compatible string
in the board/Marvell/mvebu_armada-8k/board.c file to initialize the
networking on iEi Puzzle-M801 board (2x CP1 1 Gb ports).
Signed-off-by: Luka Kovacic <luka.kovacic@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add initial U-Boot support for the iEi Puzzle-M801 board based on the
Marvell Armada 88F8040 SoC.
Currently supported hardware:
1x USB 3.0
4x Gigabit Ethernet
2x SFP+ (with NXP PCA9555 and NXP PCA9544)
1x SATA 3.0
1x M.2 type B
1x RJ45 UART
1x SPI flash
1x EPSON RX8010 RTC
Signed-off-by: Luka Kovacic <luka.kovacic@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Adds support for Network Interface controllers found on
OcteonTX2 SoC platforms.
Signed-off-by: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Adds support for Network Interface controllers found on
OcteonTX SoC platforms.
Signed-off-by: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
Adds support for NAND controllers found on OcteonTX or
OcteonTX2 SoC platforms. Also includes driver to support
Hardware ECC using BCH HW engine found on these platforms.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Suneel Garapati <sgarapati@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
- Fix verified boot on BE targets
- Add support for multiple required keys in verified boots
- Add support for Initialization Vectors in AES keys in FIT images
- Assorted fixes in the RSA code
Commit fdf0819afb (rsa: fix alignment issue when getting public
exponent) changed the logic to avoid doing an 8-byte access to a
possibly-not-8-byte-aligned address.
However, using rsa_convert_big_endian is wrong: That function converts
an array of big-endian (32-bit) words with the most significant word
first (aka a BE byte array) to an array of cpu-endian words with the
least significant word first. While the exponent is indeed _stored_ as
a big-endian 64-bit word (two BE words with MSW first), we want to
extract it as a cpu-endian 64 bit word. On a little-endian host,
swapping the words and byte-swapping each 32-bit word works, because
that's the same as byte-swapping the whole 64 bit word. But on a
big-endian host, the fdt32_to_cpu are no-ops, but
rsa_convert_big_endian() still does the word-swapping, breaking
verified boot.
To fix that, while still ensuring we don't do unaligned accesses, add
a little helper that first memcpy's the bytes to a local fdt64_t, then
applies fdt64_to_cpu(). [The name is chosen based on the
[bl]eXX_to_cpup in linux/byteorder/generic.h].
Fixes: fdf0819afb ("rsa: fix alignment issue when getting public exponent")
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The algo name should match between the FIT's signature node and the
U-Boot's control FDT.
If we do not check it, U-Boot's control FDT can expect sha512 hash but
nothing will prevent to accept image with sha1 hash if the signature is correct.
Signed-off-by: Matthieu CASTET <castet.matthieu@free.fr>
This commit add the support in u-boot to read the IV
in the FIT image instead of u-boot device tree.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Binaries may be encrypted in a FIT image with AES. This
algo needs a key and an IV (Initialization Vector). The
IV is provided in a file (pointer by iv-name-hint in the
ITS file) when building the ITB file.
This commits adds provide an alternative way to manage
the IV. If the property iv-name-hint is not provided in
the ITS file, the tool mkimage will generate an random
IV and store it in the FIT image.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
We assign first_deleted = 0. There is no need to check its value without
any further assignment in between.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add documentation about 'required-mode' property in /signature node
in U-Boot's control FDT.
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch adds vboot tests to verify the support for multiple
required keys using new required-mode DTB policy.
This patch also fixes existing test where dev
key is assumed to be marked as not required, although
it is marked as required.
Note that this patch re-added sign_fit_norequire().
sign_fit_norequire() was removed as part of the following:
commit b008677daf ("test: vboot: Fix pylint errors").
This patch leverages sign_fit_norequire() to fix the
existing bug.
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently FIT image must be signed by all required conf keys. This means
Verified Boot fails if there is a signature verification failure
using any required key in U-Boot DTB.
This patch introduces a new policy in DTB that can be set to any required
conf key. This means if verified boot passes with one of the required
keys, U-Boot will continue the OS hand off.
There were prior attempts to address this:
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2019-April/366047.html
The above patch was failing "make tests".
https://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot/2020-January/396629.html
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Minor cleanup on K3 env variables
- Fix OSPI compatible for J721e
- Drop unused property in omap-usb2-phy
- Update Maintainer for am335x-guardian board.
Currently, readl/writel and esdhc_read32/esdhc_write32 are used. To align
the usage, change to only use esdhc_read32/esdhc_write32.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
There are other (non-SDHCI) controllers which supports ADMA2 descriptor
tables, namely the Freescale eSDHC. Instead of copying the code, move it
into an own module.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
First, we need the waterlevel setting for PIO mode only. Secondy, both DMA
setup code is identical for both directions, except for the data pointer.
Thus, unify them.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Use the dma_{map,unmap}_single() calls. These will take care of the
flushing and invalidation of caches.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
SDMA can only do DMA with 32 bit addresses. This is true for all
architectures (just doesn't apply to 32 bit ones). Simplify the code and
remove unnecessary CONFIG_FSL_LAYERSCAPE.
Also make the error message more concise.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
This 1ms delay before sending command already exist from the beginning
of the fsl_esdhc driver added in year 2008. Now this driver has been
split for two files: fsl_esdhc.c and fsl_esdhc_imx.c. fsl_esdhc_imx.c
only for i.MX series. i.MX series esdhc/usdhc do not need this 1ms delay
before sending any command. So remove this 1ms, this will save a lot
time if handling a large mmc data.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
According to the code logic in __mmc_switch, if the parameter 'send_status'
is zero, no need to send cmd13, just wait the stated timeout time, then
can return directly.
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
Add properties related to eMMC HS400 mode.
mmc-hs400-1_8v;
bus-width = <8>;
They had been already in kernel dts file since the first
lx2160ardb dts patch.
b068890 arm64: dts: add LX2160ARDB board support
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
There was a fix-up for eMMC HS400 stability issue in Linux.
Patch link:
https://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/torvalds/linux.git/
commit/?id=58d0bf843b49fa99588ac9f85178bd8dfd651b53
Description:
Currently only LX2160A eSDHC supports eMMC HS400. According to
a large number of tests, eMMC HS400 failed to work at 150MHz,
and for a few boards failed to work at 175MHz. But eMMC HS400
worked fine on 200MHz. We hadn't found the root cause but
setting eSDHC_DLLCFG0[DLL_FREQ_SEL] = 0 using slow delay chain
seemed to resovle this issue. Let's use this as fixup for now.
Introduce the fix-up in u-boot since the issue could be reproduced
in u-boot too.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Fix mmc->clock with actual clock which is divided by the
controller, and record it with priv->clock which was removed
accidentally.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
The process for eMMC HS400 mode for eSDHC is,
1. Perform the Tuning Process at the HS400 target operating frequency.
Latched the clock division value.
2. if read transaction, then set the SDTIMNGCTL[FLW_CTL_BG].
3. Switch to High Speed mode and then set the card clock frequency to
a value not greater than 52Mhz
4. Clear TBCTL[TB_EN],tuning block enable bit.
5. Change to 8 bit DDR Mode
6. Switch the card to HS400 mode.
7. Set TBCTL[TB_EN], tuning block enable bit.
8. Clear SYSCTL[SDCLKEN]
9. Wait for PRSSTAT[SDSTB] to be set
10. Change the clock division to latched value.Set TBCTL[HS 400 mode]
and Set SDCLKCTL[CMD_CLK_CTRL]
11. Set SYSCTL[SDCLKEN]
12. Wait for PRSSTAT[SDSTB] to be set
13. Set DLLCFG0[DLL_ENABLE] and DLLCFG0[DLL_FREQ_SEL].
14. Wait for delay chain to lock.
15. Set TBCTL[HS400_WNDW_ADJUST]
16. Again clear SYSCTL[SDCLKEN]
17. Wait for PRSSTAT[SDSTB] to be set
18. Set ESDHCCTL[FAF]
19. Wait for ESDHCCTL[FAF] to be cleared
20. Set SYSCTL[SDCLKEN]
21. Wait for PRSSTAT[SDSTB] to be set.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Add a mmc_hs400_prepare_ddr() interface for controllers
which needs preparation before switching to DDR mode for
HS400 mode.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Some controllers may have difference between HS200 tuning
and HS400 tuning, such as different registers setting,
different procedure, or different errata.
This patch is to add a hs400_tuning flag to identify the
tuning for HS400 mode.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
For DM_MMC, the controller re-initialization is needed to
clear old configuration for mmc rescan.
Signed-off-by: Yangbo Lu <yangbo.lu@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
"ti,dis-chg-det-quirk" property is not part of Linux kernel DT binding
documentation. Therefore drop this and instead use soc_device_match()
to distinguish b/w AM654 SR1.0 and SR2.0 devices similar to Linux kernel
driver.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Use DEFAULT_LINUX_BOOT_ENV to define the standard addresses used in rest
of TI platforms as defined in ti_armv7_common.h
This avoids the standard pitfalls we've had with kernel images and fdt
addresses stomping on each other.
As part of this process, redefine overlayaddr to be dtboaddr (defined
in ti_armv7_common.h for this very purpose) and get rid of the
definition of overlayaddr..
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Use dtboaddr to define the overlay address common to all TI platforms
instead of creating a new overlayaddr for the purpose.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Use DEFAULT_LINUX_BOOT_ENV to define the standard addresses used in rest
of TI platforms as defined in ti_armv7_common.h
This avoids the standard pitfalls we've had with kernel images and fdt
addresses stomping on each other.
As part of this process, redefine overlayaddr to be dtboaddr (defined
in ti_armv7_common.h for this very purpose).. we will get rid of
overlayaddr later in the series.
Signed-off-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Reset the channel completely during channel release in order to clear
teardown bit before handing over to next user or jumping to Linux.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Grygorii Strashko <grygorii.strashko@ti.com>
Update detect_enable_hyperflash() to look for "ti,am654-ospi" compatible
to match the upstream DT node.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
doc/README.log was already moved to doc/develop/logging.rst but has been
recreated by an incorrect merge.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since the previous patch, net_init now exposes some errors, so check for
them.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
net_init does not always succeed, and there is no existing mechanism to
discover errors. This patch allows callers of net_init (such as net_init)
to handle errors. The root issue is that eth_get_dev can fail, but
net_init_loop doesn't expose that. The ideal way to fix eth_get_dev would
be to return an error with ERR_PTR, but there are a lot of callers, and all
of them just check if it's NULL. Another approach would be to change the
signature to something like
int eth_get_dev(struct udevice **pdev)
but that would require rewriting all of the many callers.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This driver interferes with other sandbox tests since it causes log output
to be interspersed with "No ethernet found." messages. Disable this driver
by default.
Enable it for the syslog tests so that they still pass.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present all log devices are enabled by default. Add a function to allow
devices to be disabled or enabled at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present there is no way to disable a log driver. But the syslog driver
causes (attempted) network traffic in sandbox every time a log message
is printed, which is often.
Add a flag to enable a log driver. Adjust struct log_device to use a short
for next_filter_num so that no more memory is used for devices. Also fix
a missing line in the struct log_driver comment while here.
To maintain compatibility, enable it for all drivers for now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is sometimes useful to output hex dumps in SPL. Add a config option to
allow this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
At present if CONFIG_LOG enabled, putting LOG_DEBUG at the top of a file
(before log.h inclusion) causes _log() to be executed for every log()
call, regardless of the build- or run-time logging level.
However there is no guarantee that the log record will actually be
displayed. If the current log level is lower than LOGL_DEBUG then it will
not be.
Add a way to signal that the log record should always be displayed and
update log_passes_filters() to handle this.
With the new behaviour, log_debug() will always log if LOG_DEBUG is
enabled.
Move log_test_syslog_nodebug() into its own file since it cannot be made
to work where it is, with LOG_DEBUG defined.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present MKIMAGE_DTC_PATH is in the devicetree menu but not within
'devicetree control' since it does not relate to that. As a result it
shows up in the top menu.
It actually relates to the mkimage tool, so create a new tools menu for it
and move it there.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This relates to booting since it is the default devicetree provided to
Linux. Move it under the 'boot options' menu.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are a number of miscellaneous boot images at the top level of the
kconfig menu. Move these into the 'boot options' menu.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the autoboot options are in cmd/Kconfig but they don't really
relate to commands. They relate to booting, so move this menu under the
boot menu.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Most of the boot options are in common/Kconfig but that file is already
extremely large. Create a new Kconfig.boot to hold the boot options.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
There are quite a few boot-related menu options at the top level. Create a
new menu to hold these and move 'Boot images' into it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
- Move ASPEED ram driver, update.
- Exhance pinctrl/gpio support, update Kendryte K210 support
- Enhance qemu_arm64 support for a single binary to work with and
without TF-A
Generate 'u-boot-splx4.sfp' which consist of 4 SPL images required
for booting up Cyclone5/Arria10.
By default, this 'u-boot-splx4.sfp' is generated without extra
padding after each SPL image.
For Cyclone5, 'u-boot-splx4.sfp' contains:
4 x SPL(64KB) = 256KB
For Arria10, 'u-boot-splx4.sfp' contains:
4 x SPL(256KB) = 1024KB
For Cyclone5 using NAND flash image layout for 128 KB memory blocks,
user can 'make' the following target to generate 4 SPL images with
padding:
make u-boot-spl-padx4.sfp
'u-boot-spl-padx4.sfp' contains four 128KB SPL images (each 64KB SPL is
followed by 64KB of zero-padding).
4 x (SPL(64KB) + zero-padding(64KB)) = 512KB
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
CONFIG_OF_EMBED was primarily enabled to support the S10/Agilex
spl hex file requirements. Since this option now produces a
warning during build, and the spl hex can be created using
alternate methods, CONFIG_OF_EMBED is no longer needed.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Add param entry point (ep) support for Arria 10 header. User can pass in
'e' option to mkimage to set the entry point. This is an optional option.
If not specified, default is 0x14.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Move to use generic handoff dtsi (socfpga_arria10-handoff.dtsi) and include
the specify generated _handoff.h header file from qts-filter-a10.sh script.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Add a script to process HPS handoff data and generate a header
for inclusion in u-boot specific devicetree addons. The header
should be included in the top level of u-boot.dtsi.
Signed-off-by: Dalon Westergreen <dalon.westergreen@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Don't invoke 'SYSTEM_RESET' PSCI function because PSCI
function calls are not supported by u-boot running in EL3.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Resend mailbox command for 3 times with 2ms interval in between if
it receives MBOX_RESP_TIMEOUT and MBOX_RESP_DEVICE_BUSY response code.
Add a wrapper function mbox_send_cmd_common_retry() for retry, change
all the callers to use this wrapper function.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Mailbox command which is too large to fit into the mailbox
FIFO command buffer can be sent to SDM in multiple parts.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Mailbox driver should always check for the length of the response
and read the response data before returning the response status to
caller.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Add miliseconds delay when waiting for mailbox event to happen
before timeout. This will ensure the timeout duration is predictive.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Document down the usage of boot_scratch_cold register to avoid
overlapping of usage in the code for S10 & Agilex.
The boot_scratch_cold register is generally used for passing
critical system info between SPL, U-Boot and Linux.
Signed-off-by: Chin Liang See <chin.liang.see@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Siew Chin Lim <elly.siew.chin.lim@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Enable FPGA full reconfiguration support with Intel FPGA SDM
Mailbox driver for Agilex.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Ensure watchdog reset is not triggered if the fpga
reconfiguration is taking too long.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Rename Stratix10 FPGA driver to Intel FPGA SDM Mailbox driver
because it is using generic SDM (Secure Device Manager) Mailbox
interface shared by other platform (e.g. Agilex) as well.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
All SoCFPGA platforms (except Cyclone V) are now switching
to CONFIG_WDT (driver model for watchdog timer drivers)
from CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Print reset state (warm/cold) together with the
source (watchdog/MPU) which has triggered the warm
reset on S10 & Agilex.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Include SDM triggered warm reset bit (BIT1) in Reset Manager's stat
register when checking for HPS warm reset status.
Refactor the warm reset mask macro for clarity purpose.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Rename the driver from S10 to SoC64 because Intel Agilex platform
also using the this SYSRESET SoCFPGA driver for S10.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
In current implementation, any exception would trigger a CPU reset.
But a bad written SPL would cause infinite loop where the system
will reload the same SPL instead of loading factory safe image.
Hence this patch is to ensure any exception will cause a hang. At this
moment, watchdog shall be triggered and Remote System Update mechanism
shall load the next production image or factory safe image.
Signed-off-by: Chin Liang See <chin.liang.see@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Timer only need to be initialized once in SPL.
This patch remove the redundancy of initializing the
timer again in U-Boot proper
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
'dwmac_socfpga' driver will setup the PHY interface during probe.
PHY interface setup in arch_misc_init() is no longer needed.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Add additional membus writes to configure main and peripheral PLL
for Agilex's clock manager.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Since warm reset may optionally set the CLock Manager to'boot mode',
the clock driver should always force the Agilex's Clock Manager to
'boot mode' before the clock driver start configuring the Clock Manager
in SPL.
In SSBL, clock driver will skip the Clock Manager configuration
if it's already being setup by SPL (Clock Manager NOT in 'boot
mode') to prevent any inaccurate clocking issues happened on HPS
peripherals such as UART, MAC and etc.
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Some drivers probing failed if clock enable function is not supported in
clock driver. So, add clock enable function to clock driver to solve it.
Return 0 (success) for *.enable function because all clocks are enabled
by default in clock driver probe.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Chee Hong Ang <chee.hong.ang@intel.com>
Now that PIE works when U-Boot is started from ROM, let's enable
CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT, which allows to load U-Boot also via
ARM Trusted-Firmware's fip.bin to DRAM, without tweaking the
configuration.
To get a writable initial stack, we need to keep the fixed initial
stack pointer, which points to DRAM in our case.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
CONFIG_ARCH_SUPPORT_TFABOOT was used on the qemu-arm64 platform to
guard a tweak to the flash bank configuration. U-Boot now reads the
current flash setup from the devicetree, so there is no need for
this option anymore.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Currently we hard-code the number and initial addresses of QEMU's flash
banks, even though our code is perfectly able to gather the same
information from the DTB provided by QEMU.
This is especially annoying, since we have two slightly different
U-Boot configurations ("bare-metal" vs. loaded via Arm Trusted
Firmware), which need to be selected at build time.
Drop the two hard coded alternatives, and use
CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS_DETECT instead, which relies on the DTB to
figure out the actual flash configuration at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Currently selecting CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT also forces us to use an
initial stack pointer relative to the beginning of the BSS section.
This makes some sense, because this should be writable memory anyway.
However the BSS section is not cleared or used until later in the
setup process (after relocation), so memory nearby might not be
available early enough to host the initial stack. This is an issue if
U-Boot is loaded from (Flash-)ROM, for instance.
Allow CONFIG_INIT_SP_RELATIVE to be turned off by a board's config, to
be able to select a fixed stack pointer, for instance in known good
DRAM.
This will help QEMU utilising PIE, when it's loaded to (Flash-)ROM.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
When the actual offset between link and runtime address is zero, there
is no need for patching up U-Boot early when running with
CONFIG_POSITION_INDEPENDENT.
Skip the whole routine when the distance is 0.
This helps when U-Boot is loaded into ROM, or in otherwise sensitive
memory locations.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
When we build an arm64 target and enable POSITION_INDEPENDENT, we were
skipping our build-time dynamic relocation fixup routine (STATIC_RELA).
This was probably done because we didn't need it in this case, as the
PIE fixup routine in start.S would take care of that at runtime.
However when we now skip this routine (upon detecting that the fixup
offset is 0), this might lead to uninitialised pointers.
Remove the exception, so that we always do the build-time relocation.
NOTE: GNU binutils starting with v2.27.1 do this build-time relocation
automatically, to be in-line with other architecures. So on newer
toolchains our manual fixup is actually not needed. It doesn't hurt to
have it, though, so that we keep compatibility with the popular Linaro
toolchains, which lack this feature.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
The CONFIG_TFABOOT option is more about what U-Boot DOES NOT need to do
than to support some features.
Explain a bit more in the Kconfig help text to avoid misunderstandings.
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Most users don't need the standalone API examples. Distributions like SUSE
do not supply libgcc for cross-compiling and we cannot do without on ARMv8
for building examples/.
Make examples selectable via symbol CONFIG_EXAMPLES. It defaults to
yes on ARCH_QEMU to ensure that we compile the API as part of our
continuous integration.
Cc: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The timeout calculation is based on the clk being in KHz but
the clk api returns the clk value in Hz. Convert this to KHz
to calculate the correct timeout value.
Signed-off-by: Jack Mitchell <ml@embed.me.uk>
This modifies the existing led test to check for default led naming as
added in the previous patch.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This more closely mirrors Linux's behaviour, and will make it easier to
transition to using function+color in the future.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
dm_gpio_ops.get_value can be called when the gpio is either input or
output. The current dw code always returns the input value, which is
invalid if the direction is set to out.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Previously, if there was no bank-name property, it was easy to have
confusing gpio names like "gpio1@08", instead of "gpio1@0_8". This patch
follows the example of the sifive gpio driver.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Change the type of gpio_dwabp_platdata.base from fdt_addr_t to a void
pointer, since we pass it to readl.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The Fully-Programmable Input/Output Array (FPIOA) device controls pin
multiplexing on the K210. The FPIOA can remap any supported function to any
multifunctional IO pin. It can also perform basic GPIO functions, such as
reading the current value of a pin. However, GPIO functionality remains
largely unimplemented (in favor of the dedicated GPIO peripherals).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This extends the pinctrl-sandbox driver to support pin muxing, and adds a
test for that behaviour. The test is done in C and not python (like the
existing tests for the pinctrl uclass) because it needs to call
pinctrl_select_state. Another option could be to add a command that
invokes pinctrl_select_state and then test everything in
test/py/tests/test_pinmux.py.
The pinctrl-sandbox driver now mimics the way that many pinmux devices
work. There are two groups of pins which are muxed together, as well as
four pins which are muxed individually. I have tried to test all normal
paths. However, very few error cases are explicitly checked for.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This normalizes the documentation to conform to kernel-doc style [1]. It
also moves the documentation for pinctrl_ops inline, and adds argument and
return-value documentation. I have kept the usual function style for these
comments. I could not find any existing examples of function documentation
inside structs.
[1] https://www.kernel.org/doc/html/latest/doc-guide/kernel-doc.html
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The pinmux property allows for smaller and more compact device trees,
especially when there are many pins which need to be assigned individually.
Instead of specifying an array of strings to be parsed as pins and a
function property, the pinmux property contains an array of integers
representing pinmux groups. A pinmux group consists of the pin identifier
and mux settings represented as a single integer or an array of integers.
Each individual pin controller driver specifies the exact format of a
pinmux group. As specified in the Linux documentation, a pinmux group may
be multiple integers long. However, no existing drivers use multi-integer
pinmux groups, so I have chosen to omit this feature. This makes the
implementation easier, since there is no need to allocate a buffer to do
endian conversions.
Support for the pinmux property is done differently than in Linux. As far
as I can tell, inversion of control is used when implementing support for
the pins and groups properties to avoid allocating. This results in some
duplication of effort; every property in a config node is parsed once for
each pin in that node. This is not such an overhead with pins and groups
properties, since having multiple pins in one config node does not occur
especially often. However, the semantics of the pinmux property make such a
configuration much more appealing. A future patch could parse all config
properties at once and store them in an array. This would make it easier to
create drivers which do not function solely as callbacks from
pinctrl-generic.
This commit increases the size of the sandbox build by approximately 48
bytes. However, it also decreases the size of the K210 device tree by 2
KiB from the previous version of this series.
The documentation has been updated from the last Linux commit before it was
split off into yaml files.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
the aspeed ddr sdram controller needs to know if the memory chip mounted on
the board is dual x8 die or not. Or it may get the wrong size of the
memory space.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
to improve the maintainability. It is more easier to modify and add
configurations of the driver in the centralized ram driver directory.
Signed-off-by: Dylan Hung <dylan_hung@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
The cfi-flash driver uses an open-coded version of the generic
algorithm to decode and translate multiple frames of a "reg" property.
This starts off the wrong foot by using the address-cells and size-cells
properties of *this* very node, and not of the parent. This somewhat
happened to work back when we were using a wrong default size of 2,
but broke about a year ago with commit 0ba41ce1b7 ("libfdt: return
correct value if #size-cells property is not present").
Instead of fixing the reinvented wheel, just use the generic function
that does all of this properly.
This fixes U-Boot on QEMU (-arm64), which was crashing due to decoding
a wrong flash base address:
DRAM: 1 GiB
Flash: "Synchronous Abort" handler, esr 0x96000044
elr: 00000000000211dc lr : 00000000000211b0 (reloc)
elr: 000000007ff5e1dc lr : 000000007ff5e1b0
x0 : 00000000000000f0 x1 : 000000007ff5e1d8
x2 : 000000007edfbc48 x3 : 0000000000000000
x4 : 0000000000000000 x5 : 00000000000000f0
x6 : 000000007edfbc2c x7 : 0000000000000000
x8 : 000000007ffd8d70 x9 : 000000000000000c
x10: 0400000000000003 x11: 0000000000000055
^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Signed-off-by: Andre Przywara <andre.przywara@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When possible use DMA for reading from CFI flash, this provides upto 5x
improvement in read performance with high speed CFI compliant flashes
like HyperFlash.
Code will gracefully fallback to CPU copy when DMA is unavailable.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Caller would need gracefully handle failures of dma_get_device(),
therefore reduce pr_err() to pr_debug() when DMA device is not found.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Octeon needs a platform specific cmd to boot the Linux kernel, as
specific parameters need to be passed and special handling for the
multiple cores (SMP) is needed.
Co-developed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
[use gd->ram_base instead of gd->bd->bi_memstart]
Signed-off-by: Daniel Schwierzeck <daniel.schwierzeck@gmail.com>
This is needed for Linux booting, as the memory infos need to be passed
in this bootmem format to the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Add header to handle bootinfo support, needed for Octeon Linux kernel
booting.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This header includes the Octeon feature detection used in many Octeon
drivers.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This header includes common register defines and accessor functions.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the necessary lowlevel init code, to enable SMP Linux
booting. This code will be used with the platform specific Octeon Linux
boot command "bootoctlinux", which starts a configurable number of cores
into Linux.
Additionally some erratas and lowlevel register initializations are
copied from the original Cavium / Marvell U-Boot source code, enabling
booting into the Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
As noticed while working on the USB xHCI support, Octeon needs to flush
all pending writes so that the values are present in the memory. Add
this "syncw" instruction (twice) to flush_dcache_range().
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import platform specific mangle-port.h header, allowing a area specific
swapping, which is needed on Octeon for USB & PCI areas.
Imported from Linux v5.7.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Import octeon_should_swizzle_table[] which is needed for the area
specific swapping. It will be used by the platform specific
mangle-port.h header.
Imported from Linux v5.7.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the glue layer for the MIPS Octeon SoCs. It's ported
mainly from the Linux code.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Octeon uses mapped addresses for virtual and physical memory. It's not
that easy to calculate the resulting addresses here. So let's remove
this BUG_ON() completely, as it's not really helpful.
Please also note, that BUG_ON() is not recommended any more in the Linux
kernel.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
On MIPS platforms, mapping of the base address is needed. This patch
switches from dev_get_addr() to dev_remap_addr() to get the mapped base
address of the xHCI controller.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Cc: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
This patch adds the board specific configuration (struct) for the
Octeon 3 EBB7304 EVK. This struct is ported from the 2013er Cavium /
Marvell U-Boot repository. Also, the Octeon RAM driver is enabled in
the board defconfig for its usage.
Tested with one and two DIMMs on the EBB7304 EVK (8 & 16 GiB).
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the initialization call for the Octeon RAM driver to
the Octeon platforms code. So if enabled via Kconfig, the DDR driver
will be called and the RAM will be configured and used. If the RAM
driver is not enabled, the L2 cache is still used as RAM.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This Octeon 3 DDR driver is ported from the 2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot
repository. It currently supports DDR4 on Octeon 3. It can be later
extended to support also DDR3 and Octeon 2 platforms.
Part 3 includes the DIMM SPD handling code and the Kconfig / Makefile
integration.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This Octeon 3 DDR driver is ported from the 2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot
repository. It currently supports DDR4 on Octeon 3. It can be later
extended to support also DDR3 and Octeon 2 platforms.
Part 2 includes the very complex Octeon 3 DDR4 configuration
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This Octeon 3 DDR driver is ported from the 2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot
repository. It currently supports DDR4 on Octeon 3. It can be later
extended to support also DDR3 and Octeon 2 platforms.
Part 1 adds the base U-Boot RAM driver, which will be instantiated by
the DT based probing.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This header will be used by the DDR driver (lmc). Its ported from the
2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot repository.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This header will be used by the DDR driver (lmc). Its ported from the
2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot repository.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This header is used by the upcoming DDR driver and potentially by other
drivers ported from the 2013 Cavium / Marvell U-Boot repository.
Signed-off-by: Aaron Williams <awilliams@marvell.com>
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
This patch adds the memory controller (LMC) DT node to the Octeon 3 dtsi
file. It also adds the L2C DT node, as this is referenced by the DDR
driver.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When using SDL for input the SDL key codes are first converted to Linux key
codes and then to matrix entries of the cross wired keyboard.
We must not map any key code to two different places on the keyboard. So
comment out one backslash position.
Update the rest of the file from Linux 5.7.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The result of fdt_node_offset_by_phandle is negative for error,
so this patch corrects the check of this result in
fdtdec_parse_phandle_with_args.
This patch allows to have the same behavior with or without OF_LIVE
for the function dev_read_phandle_with_args with cell_name = NULL and
with invalid phandle.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The cell_count argument is required when cells_name is NULL.
This patch adds this parameter in live tree API
- of_count_phandle_with_args
- ofnode_count_phandle_with_args
- dev_count_phandle_with_args
This parameter solves issue when these API is used to count
the number of element of a cell without cell name. This parameter
allow to force the size cell.
For example:
count = dev_count_phandle_with_args(dev, "array", NULL, 3);
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Update the test for node.of_offset because an invalid offset is not
always set to -1 because the return value of the libfdt functions are:
+ an error with a value < 0
+ a valid offset with value >=0
For example, in ofnode_get_by_phandle() function, we have:
node.of_offset = fdt_node_offset_by_phandle(gd->fdt_blob, phandle);
and this function can return -FDT_ERR_BADPHANDLE (-6).
Without this patch, the added test dm_test_ofnode_get_by_phandle failed.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Include missing log.h and change _ofnode_to_np() to ofnode_to_np() so
that compiling with OF_CHECKS enabled does not break.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some blobs need a larger alignment than the default. For example, ACPI
tables often start at a 4KB boundary. Add support for this.
Update the size of the test blob to allow these larger records.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The intention which bloblists is that each blob's data is aligned in
memory. At present it is only the headers that are aligned.
Update the code to correct this and add a little more documentation.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When running these tests on sandbox any failures result in very large or
long pointer values which are a pain to work with. Map them to an address
so it is easier to diagnose failures.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
It is helpful to be able to see basic statistics about the bloblist and
also to list its contents. Add a 'bloblist' command to handle this.
Put the display functions in the bloblist modules rather than in the
command code itself. That allows showing a list from SPL, where commands
are not available.
Also make bloblist_first/next_blob() static as they are not used outside
this file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reformat the command line options chapter so that the command line options
clearly stand out.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2021-01-rc1
The following bugs in the UEFI system are resolved:
* illegal free in EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL implementation
* incorrect documentation of EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL implementation
* output of CRC32 as decimal instead hexadecimal in unit test
* use EfiReservedMemoryType for no-map reserved memory
* avoid unnecessary resets in UEFI unit tests
* call EFI bootmgr even without having /EFI/boot
- generate unique mac address from SoC serial on S400 board
- Add USB support for GXL and AXG SoCs
- Update Gadget code to use the new GXL and AXG USB glue driver
- Add a VIM3 board support to add dynamic PCIe enable in OS DT
- Fix AXG pinmux with requesting GPIOs
- Add missing GPIOA_18 for AXG pinctrl
- Add Amlogic PWM driver
The device tree may contain a /reserved-memory node. The no-map property
of the sub-nodes signals if the memory may be accessed by the UEFI payload
or not.
In the EBBR specification (https://github.com/arm-software/ebbr) the
modeling of the reserved memory has been clarified.
If a reserved memory node in the device tree has the no-map property map,
create a EfiReservedMemoryType memory map entry else use
EfiBootServicesData.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
CONFIG_EFI_GRUB_ARM32 is only needed for architectures with caches that are
not managed via CP15 (or for some outdated buggy versions of GRUB). It
makes more sense to disable the setting per architecture than per defconfig.
Move QEMU's CONFIG_EFI_GRUB_ARM32_WORKAROUND=n from defconfig to Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Currently, the EFI bootmgr is only called if there is a EFI binary
inside the path for removable media is found, i.e. /EFI/boot/. This
doesn't make sense. It is the duty of the bootmgr to find out the
path and name of the EFI binary to boot. It should be called even
if there is no /EFI/boot directory.
Thus, call the bootmgr before we try to boot the EFI binary inside
the removable media path.
Also remove the ${fdtcontroladdr} parameter because the fallback is
handled in cmd/bootefi.c and that already takes care of correct settings
if the board has ACPI and thus no device tree at all.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
When we do not execute a test requiring ExitBootServices do not reset the
system after testing.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Print the CRC32 loaded via the EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL as a hexadecimal
number.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
strsep() changes the address that its first argument points to.
We cannot use the changed address as argument of free().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
U-Boot offers a EFI_LOAD_FILE2_PROTOCOL which the Linux EFI stub can use to
load an initial RAM disk. Update the function comments of the
implementation.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
This adds the driver for the PWM controller found in the Amlogic SoCs.
This PWM is only a set of Gates, Dividers and Counters:
PWM output is achieved by calculating a clock that permits calculating
two periods (low and high). The counter then has to be set to switch after
N cycles for the first half period.
The hardware has no "polarity" setting. This driver reverses the period
cycles (the low length is inverted with the high length) for
PWM_POLARITY_INVERSED.
Disabling the PWM stops the output immediately (without waiting for the
current period to complete first).
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The AXG pmx driver gpio request offset needs the pin base to have the
correct pin number.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Mark Kettenis <kettenis@openbsd.org>
The VIM3 on-board MCU can mux the PCIe/USB3.0 shared differential
lines using a FUSB340TMX USB 3.1 SuperSpeed Data Switch between
an USB3.0 Type A connector and a M.2 Key M slot.
The PHY driving these differential lines is shared between
the USB3.0 controller and the PCIe Controller, thus only
a single controller can use it.
This adds this dynamic switching right before booting Linux
and the configuration steps in the boards documentation.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Reviewed-by: Kevin Hilman <khilman@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Kevin Hilman <khilman@baylibre.com>
[narmstrong: fixed warning by replacing min() by min_t()]
Add the correcly architectured USB Glue node for Meson AXG and the
S400 board in -u-boot.dtsi until support in upstream Linux then
backported.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Add the board_usb_init()/cleanup() for USB gadget for AXG based
on the code for the G12A architecture.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The registers which are managed by the meson-gxl-usb3 PHY driver are
actually "USB control" registers (which are "glue" registers which
manage OTG detection and routing of the OTG capable port between the
DWC2 peripheral-only controller and the DWC3 host-only controller).
Drop the meson-gxl-usb3 PHY driver now that the dwc3-meson-gxl-usb
driver supports the USB control registers on GXL and GXM SoCs (these
were previously managed by the meson-gxl-usb3 PHY driver).
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
The USB support was initialy done with a set of PHYs and dwc3-of-simple
because the architecture of the USB complex was not understood correctly
at the time (and proper documentation was missing...).
But with the G12A family, the USB complex was correctly understood and
implemented correctly.
This adds a proper driver for the glue, based on the G12A one, but with
enough changes to require a different driver in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
This imports the AXG, GXL & GXM SoC and boards DT changes from the Linux
commit b3a9e3b9622a ("Linux 5.8-rc1").
This change also removes GXL & GXM u-boot.dtsi hacks for USB gadget.
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
First set of u-boot-atmel features for 2021.01 cycle:
This feature set includes a new CPU driver for at91 family, new driver
for PIT64B hardware timer, support for new at91 family SoC named sama7g5
which adds: clock support, including conversion of the clock tree to
CCF; SoC support in mach-at91, pinctrl and mmc drivers update. The
feature set also includes updates for mmc driver and some other minor
fixes and features regarding building without the old Atmel PIT and the
possibility to read a secondary MAC address from a second i2c EEPROM.
Currently, the return value of dev_read_u32_default is stored in an u32,
causing the subsequent "if (function < 0)" to always be false:
u32 function;
...
function = dev_read_u32_default(config, "brcm,function", -1);
if (function < 0) {
debug("Failed reading function for pinconfig %s (%d)\n",
config->name, function);
return -EINVAL;
}
Make "function" variable an int to fix this.
Cc: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Factor out reading IP base address to ofdata_to_platdata function, which
is designed for this purpose. Also, drop the dev->priv NULL check, since
this is already done by the dm core when allocating space using
priv_auto_alloc_size feature. (in drivers/core/device.c ->
device_ofdata_to_platdata).
Cc: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Yannick Fertré <yannick.fertre@st.com>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Add test on the size of ofnode_phandle_args result to avoid access
to uninitialized elements in args[] field.
This patch avoids the issue when gpio-ranges cell size is not 3 as
expected, for example:
gpio-ranges = <&pinctrl 0>;
instead of
gpio-ranges = <&pinctrl 0 112 16>;
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Move the variables definition at the beggining of the function
gpio_stm32_probe().
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
DT alignment with Linux kernel v5.9-rc4 for the STM32MP15x soc
device tree files and the STMicroelectronics boards device tree files.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
According to doc/README.distro fdt_addr must not be set when DTB is not
available from hardware. So remove this entry.
Use address 32MB above the start of DRAM for kernel_addr_r. This way
we likely can avoid the self-relocation of the compressed kernel image
before it decompresses to offset 0x8000 from start of DRAM.
Use address 128MB above the start of DRAM for fdt_addr_r, since this is
the maximum location for the end of the kernel. So we avoid overwriting
the DTB.
Use 512k above that for ramdisk_addr_r. This should be enough for the
DTB, rest of DRAM can be used for initrd.
Place boot script / extlinux.conf at offset 0 / 1MB from start of DRAM.
This space is available for processing in U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Soeren Moch <smoch@web.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The u-boot,dm-spl DT props are missing on AV96, hence the pinmux and
flash0 nodes are not included in the reduced SPL DT. This prevents
SPI NOR boot from working at all. Fix this by filling them in.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Upon further discussion on the mailing list, we should not get in the
situation where the generic code path to set ethaddr/etc correctly does
not work. Revert this until someone can further debug the smc911x
driver regarding this issue.
This reverts commit 387cbf096e.
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The R8A774A1 is compatible with the generic rcar-gen3-xhci controller.
This patch adds the compatibility flag, to support the xHCI controller.
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Use macros with parameter to fill ep_info2, then some macros
for MASK and SHIFT can be removed
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
For normal TRB fields:
use TRB_LEN(x) instead of ((x) & TRB_LEN_MASK);
and use TRB_INTR_TARGET(x) instead of
(((x) & TRB_INTR_TARGET_MASK) << TRB_INTR_TARGET_SHIFT)
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There some vendor quirks for MTK xHCI 0.96 host controller:
1. It defines some extra SW scheduling parameters for HW
to minimize the scheduling effort for synchronous and
interrupt endpoints. The parameters are put into reserved
DWs of slot context and endpoint context.
2. Its TDS in Normal TRB defines a number of packets that
remains to be transferred for a TD after processing all
Max packets in all previous TRBs.
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Tested-by: Frank Wunderlich <frank-w@public-files.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
xhci versions 1.0 and later report the untransferred data remaining in a
TD a bit differently than older hosts.
We used to have separate functions for these, and needed to check host
version before calling the right function.
Now Mediatek host has an additional quirk on how it uses the TD Size
field for remaining data. To prevent yet another function for calculating
remainder we instead want to make one quirk friendly unified function.
Porting from the Linux:
c840d6ce772d("xhci: create one unified function to calculate TRB TD remainder.")
124c39371114("xhci: use boolean to indicate last trb in td remainder calculation")
Signed-off-by: Chunfeng Yun <chunfeng.yun@mediatek.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The patches changing the compatible strings to the ones used by Linux have
not been merged yet, so fix the checks to use the current in-tree ones.
Reported-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Some Espressobin boards got assigned more than one MAC address. Update
instructions how to correctly store and preserve all MAC addresses.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
commit 7c8f821e5d ("i2c: rcar_i2c: Set the slave address from
rcar_i2c_xfer") blindly called rcar_i2c_set_addr() with read argument
always set to 1 during xfer which introduced read/write errors, whereas
earlier rcar_i2c_read_common() called rcar_i2c_set_addr() with read set to
1 and rcar_i2c_write_common() called rcar_i2c_set_addr() with read set 0.
Fixes: 7c8f821e5d ("i2c: rcar_i2c: Set the slave address from rcar_i2c_xfer")
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
This commits update the support of sntp to use
the framework udp. This change allows to remove
all the reference to sntp in the main network
file net/net.c.
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This commit adds a generic udp protocol framework in the
network loop. So protocol based on udp may be implemented
without modifying the network loop (for example custom
wait magic packet).
Signed-off-by: Philippe Reynes <philippe.reynes@softathome.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Use ofnode_ or dev_ APIs instead of fdt_ and fdtdec_ APIs so that the
driver can support live DT.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Add support for stingray PAXB PHY controller driver.
This driver supports maximum 8 PAXB phys using pipemux data.
Signed-off-by: Srinath Mannam <srinath.mannam@broadcom.com>
Signed-off-by: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
When load the last block, the "len" might not be a block size. This cause
loading the incorrect last block data.
The fix change "len" to tftp_block_size and minus one tftp_block_size
for offset calculation.
Use same offset calculation formula as in store_block().
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
tftp_cur_block start with 1 for first block, but tftp_cur_block counter is
start with zero when block number is rollover. The existing code
"tftp_cur_block - 1" will cause the block number become -1 in store_block()
when tftp_cur_block is 0 when tftp_cur_block is rollover.
The fix pass in tftp_cur_block to store_block() and minus the
tftp_block_size when do the offset calculation.
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Fixes missing update to tftp_prev_block counter before increase
tftp_cur_block counter when do the tftpput operation.
tftp_prev_block counter is used in update_block_number() function to
check whether block number (sequence number) is rollover. This bug
cause the tftpput command fail to upload a large file when block
number is greater than 16-bit (0xFFFF).
Signed-off-by: Ley Foon Tan <ley.foon.tan@intel.com>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
The ethernet controller can read the MAC from EEPROM and display it,
but if ethaddr is not set, the ethernet is still unavailable.
This patch checks will automatically set the MAC address if it has
not already been set.
Signed-off-by: Adam Ford <aford173@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Joe Hershberger <joe.hershberger@ni.com>
ftgmac100 driver is using hard-coded PHY interface address of zero.
Each board can have different PHY interface address (phy_addr).
This commit modifies the driver to make use of board specific address
by leveraging CONFIG_PHY_ADDR.
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Cédric Le Goater <clg@kaod.org>
The Linux kernel does set the clock delays to
- 0.2 ns (their default, and lowest, hardware value) if delays should
not be enabled
- 2.0 ns (which causes the data to be sampled at exactly half way between
clock transitions at 1000 Mbps) if delays should be enabled
depending on the interface mode
See https://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/torvalds/linux.git/tree/drivers/net/phy/mscc/mscc_main.c#n523
So instead of using arbitrary delay values like now, mimic this behaviour.
The behaviour is the same for all of vsc8530/8531/8540/8541 so move that
to a shared function while at it.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Stuebner <heiko.stuebner@theobroma-systems.com>
Reviewed-by: Philipp Tomsich <philipp.tomsich@theobroma-systems.com>
Add tests for SCMI reset controllers. A test device driver
sandbox-scmi_devices.c is used to get reset resources, allowing further
resets manipulation.
Change sandbox-smci_agent to emulate 1 reset controller exposed through
an agent. Add DM test scmi_resets to test this reset controller.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This change introduces a reset controller driver for SCMI agent devices.
When SCMI agent and SCMI reset domain drivers are enabled, SCMI agent
binds a reset controller device for each SCMI reset domain protocol
devices enabled in the FDT.
SCMI reset driver is embedded upon CONFIG_RESET_SCMI=y. If enabled,
CONFIG_SCMI_AGENT is also enabled.
SCMI Reset Domain protocol is defined in the SCMI specification [1].
Links: [1] https://developer.arm.com/architectures/system-architectures/software-standards/scmi
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add tests for SCMI clocks. A test device driver sandbox-scmi_devices.c
is used to get clock resources, allowing further clock manipulation.
Change sandbox-smci_agent to emulate 3 clocks exposed through 2 agents.
Add DM test scmi_clocks to test these 3 clocks.
Update DM test sandbox_scmi_agent with load/remove test sequences
factorized by {load|remove}_sandbox_scmi_test_devices() helper functions.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This change implements a SMCCC transport for SCMI exchanges. This
implementation follows the Linux kernel as references implementation
for SCMI message processing, using the SMT format for communication
channel meta-data.
Use of SMCCC transport in SCMI FDT bindings are defined in the Linux
kernel DT bindings since v5.8. SMCCC with SMT is implemented in OP-TEE
from tag 3.9.0 [2].
Links: [2] https://github.com/OP-TEE/optee_os/commit/a58c4d706d23
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This change implements a mailbox transport using SMT format for SCMI
exchanges. This implementation follows the Linux kernel and
SCP-firmware [1] as references implementation for SCMI message
processing using SMT format for communication channel meta-data.
Use of mailboxes in SCMI FDT bindings are defined in the Linux kernel
DT bindings since v4.17.
Links: [1] https://github.com/ARM-software/SCP-firmware
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This change introduces SCMI agent uclass to interact with a firmware
using the SCMI protocols [1].
SCMI agent uclass currently supports a single method to request
processing of the SCMI message by an identified server. A SCMI message
is made of a byte payload associated to a protocol ID and a message ID,
all defined by the SCMI specification [1]. On return from process_msg()
method, the caller gets the service response.
SCMI agent uclass defines a post bind generic sequence for all devices.
The sequence binds all the SCMI protocols listed in the FDT for that
SCMI agent device. Currently none, but later change will introduce
protocols.
This change implements a simple sandbox device for the SCMI agent uclass.
The sandbox nicely answers SCMI_NOT_SUPPORTED to SCMI messages.
To prepare for further test support, the sandbox exposes a architecture
function for test application to read the sandbox emulated devices state.
Currently supports 2 SCMI agents, identified by an ID in the FDT device
name. The simplistic DM test does nothing yet.
SCMI agent uclass is designed for platforms that embed a SCMI server in
a firmware hosted somewhere, for example in a companion co-processor or
in the secure world of the executing processor. SCMI protocols allow an
SCMI agent to discover and access external resources as clock, reset
controllers and more. SCMI agent and server communicate following the
SCMI specification [1]. This SCMI agent implementation complies with
the DT bindings defined in the Linux kernel source tree regarding
SCMI agent description since v5.8.
Links: [1] https://developer.arm.com/architectures/system-architectures/software-standards/scmi
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Cc: Sudeep Holla <sudeep.holla@arm.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The tests rely on a dummy driver to allocate and initialize the regmaps
and the regmap fields using the managed API. The first test checks if
the regmap config fields like width, reg_offset_shift, range specifiers,
etc work. The second test checks if regmap fields behave properly (mask
and shift are ok) by peeking into the regmap.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When more nodes are added for a uclass the index might go into two or
more digits. This means that there are less spaces printed because they
are used up by the extra digits. Update the regular expression to allow
variable-length spacing between the class name and and index.
This was discovered when adding a simple_bus node in test.dts made
test_bind_unbind_with_uclass() fail because the index went up to 10.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
A regmap field is an abstraction available in Linux. It provides to access
bitfields in a regmap without having to worry about shifts and masks.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Some devices need to calculate the regmap base address at runtime. This
makes it impossible to use device tree to get the regmap base. Instead,
allow devices to specify it in the regmap config. This will create a
regmap with a single range that corresponds to the start and size given
by the driver.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Right now, the base of a regmap can only be obtained from the device
tree. This makes it impossible for devices which calculate the base at
runtime to use a regmap. An example of such a device is the Cadence
Sierra PHY.
Allow creating a regmap with one range whose start and size can be
specified by the driver based on calculations at runtime.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Drivers can configure it to adjust the final read/write location.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Right now, regmap_read() and regmap_write() read/write a 32-bit value
only. To write other lengths, regmap_raw_read() and regmap_raw_write()
need to be used.
This means that any driver ported from Linux that relies on
regmap_{read,write}() to know the size already has to be updated at each
callsite. This makes the port harder to maintain.
So, allow specifying the read/write width to make it easier to port the
drivers, since now the only change needed is when initializing the
regmap.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some fields will be introduced in the regmap structure that should be
set to 0 by default. So, once we allocate a regmap, make sure it is
zeroed out to avoid unexpected defaults for those values.
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Most of new linux drivers are using managed-API to allocate resources. To
ease porting drivers from linux to U-Boot, introduce devm_regmap_init() as
a managed API to get a regmap from the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add a test to verify that GPIOs can be acquired/released using the managed
API. Also check that the GPIOs are released when the consumer device is
removed.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add managed functions to get a gpio from the devce-tree, based on a
property name (minus the '-gpios' suffix) and optionally an index.
When the device is unbound, the GPIO is automatically released and the
data structure is freed.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
The tests are basically the same as for the regular API. Except that
the reset are initialized using the managed API, and no freed manually.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Add managed functions to get a reset_ctl from the device-tree, based on a
name or an index.
Also add a managed functions to get a reset_ctl_bulk (array of reset_ctl)
from the device-tree.
When the device is unbound, the reset controllers are automatically
released and the data structure is freed.
Signed-off-by: Jean-Jacques Hiblot <jjhiblot@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Pratyush Yadav <p.yadav@ti.com>
Move call to optee_copy_fdt_nodes() introduced by commit 6ccb05eae0
before generic changes in kernel FDT so that platform specific changes
are not overridden by the changes made by this function.
Fixes: 6ccb05eae0 ("image: fdt: copy possible optee nodes to a loaded devicetree")
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@linaro.org>
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
- Disable CMD_IRQ for RISC-V.
- Update sipeed/maix doc
- Obtain reg of SiFive RAM via dev_read_addr_index() instead of regmap API.
- Cleans up RISC-V timer drivers and converts them to DM.
- Correctly handle IPIs already pending upon prior stage bootloader (on the K210)
This adorns messages generated by dev_xxx with the device and driver
names. It also redirects dev_xxx to log when it is available. The names
of these functions very roughly take inspiration from Linux, but there is
no deeper correlation.
Both struct udevice and struct device are supported when logging, though
logging with struct device is no better than using log_xxx. The latter is
supported because of the large amount of existing code which logs with
struct device.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This driver does not use DM, so we need to use a struct device instead of a
struct udevice. Not ideal, but it'll have to do for now.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This can conflict with asm/io.h on some archs, and it isn't needed to build
dwc3-generic.c
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This logs with the device from struct dwc3. Some files also need to include
dm.h so fields in udevice can be accessed.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This adds a dev argument to some functions so dev_xxx always has a device
to log with. In one instance we must use use a different log function when
we are compiled without DM_USB.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
ep0.c also need to include dm.h so dev_xxx can access udevice fields.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Usually we can get a device from the current core, but some dev_dbg calls
have been converted to debug, since we are called on a cluster.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This function is never used anywhere, and it also tries to log with a
nonexistant device.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Without DM_ETH, cpsw_priv.dev is an eth_device. Just use its name instead.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
netdev_xxx evaluates to printf in U-Boot, so there is no extra info
printed. mvpp2 one of only two drivers which use these functions in U-Boot.
Convert these functions to dev_xxx where possible (and to log_xxx where
not).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
netdev_xxx evaluates to printf in U-Boot, so there is no extra info
printed. mvneta is one of two drivers which use these functions in U-Boot.
Convert these functions to dev_xxx where possible (and to log_xxx where
not).
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
The name of the device we are working on is `ethdev` and not just `dev`.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This member was presumably dropped when this driver was converted from
Linux. However, it is still used in log statements during initialization.
This patch adds the member back. In addition, allocation of struct
vf610_nfc has been moved to the callers of vf610_nfc_nand_init. This allows
it to be allocated by DM (if it is being used) and for dev to be
initialized.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
There are too many levels of indirection when calling dev_err. This is an
artifact of the conversion of brcmnand_host.pdev from a struct
platform_device (which has a member `dev` pointing to a struct device) to
struct udevice.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This adds a udevice parameter to get_best_delay and msdc_set_mclk so they
can call dev_err properly.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Get it from spinand->slave->dev. Another option would be to use
spinand_to_mtd(spinand)->dev, but this is what the existing code uses.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This fixes dev_xxx() not always being called with a device. In
spi_nor_reg_read, a the slave device may not always be available, so we use
bus and cs instead.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This header is needed so struct udevice can be used in dev_xxx().
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Usually the device is gotten from sunxi_nfc. This is a struct device and
not a struct udevice, but the whole driver seems to be written wihout DM
anyway...
In a few instances, this patch modifies functions to take an nfc to log
with. In once instance we use mtd_info's device since there is no nfc.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Use the device from any mtd already available, or from the active mtd via
pxa3xx_nand_info if one is not.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This converts calls to dev_err to get the device from ti_sci_info where
appropriate.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Nishanth Menon <nm@ti.com>
Tested-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
This ensures constructs like `if (gd & gd->...) { ... }` work when
accessing the global data pointer. Without this change, it was possible for
a very early trap to cause _exit_trap to directly or indirectly (through
printf) to read arbitrary memory. This could cause a second trap,
preventing show_regs from being printed.
printf (and specifically puts) uses gd to determine what function to print
with. These functions in turn use gd to find the serial device, etc.
However, before accessing gd, puts first checks to see if it is non-NULL.
This indicates an existing (perhaps undocumented) assumption that either gd
is NULL or it is completely valid.
Before this patch, gd either points to unexpected data (because it retains
the value it did from the prior-stage) or points to uninitialized data
(because it has not yet been initialized by board_init_f_init_reserve)
until the hart has acquired available_harts_lock. This can cause two
problems, depending on the value of gd->flags. If GD_FLG_SERIAL_READY is
unset, then some garbage data will be printed to stdout, but there will not
be a second trap. However, if GD_FLG_SERIAL_READY is set, then puts will
try to print with serial_puts, which will likely cause a second trap.
After this patch, gd is zero up until either a hart has set it in
wait_for_gd_init, or until it is set by arch_init_gd. This prevents its
usage before its data is initialized because both handle_trap and puts
ensure that gd is nonzero before using it. After gd has been set, it is OK
to access it because its data has been cleared (and so flags is valid).
XIP cannot use locks because flash is not writable. This leaves it
vulnerable to the same class of bugs regarding already-pending IPIs as
before this series. Fixing that would require finding another method of
synchronization, which is outside the scope of this series.
Fixes: 7c6ca03eae ("riscv: additional crash information")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
We can reduce the number of instructions needed to use available_harts_lock
by using the aq and rl suffixes for AMOs.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Even though we no longer call smp_function if an IPI was not sent by
U-Boot, we still need to clear any IPIs which were pending from the
execution environment. Otherwise, secondary harts will busy-wait in
secondary_hart_loop, instead of relaxing.
Along with the previous commit ("riscv: Use a valid bit to ignore
already-pending IPIs"), this fixes SMP booting on the Kendryte K210.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Some IPIs may already be pending when U-Boot is started. This could be a
problem if a secondary hart tries to handle an IPI before the boot hart has
initialized the IPI device.
To be specific, the Kendryte K210 ROM-based bootloader does not clear IPIs
before passing control to U-Boot. Without this patch, the secondary hart
jumps to address 0x0 as soon as it enters secondary_hart_loop, and then
hangs in its trap handler.
This commit introduces a valid bit so secondary harts know when and IPI
originates from U-Boot, and it is safe to use the IPI API. The valid bit is
initialized to 0 by board_init_f_init_reserve. Before this, secondary harts
wait in wait_for_gd_init.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Without a matching barrier on the write side, the barrier in handle_ipi
does nothing. It was entirely possible for the boot hart to write to addr,
arg0, and arg1 *after* sending the IPI, because there was no barrier on the
sending side.
Fixes: 90ae281437 ("riscv: add option to wait for ack from secondary harts in smp functions")
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
Reviewed-by: Leo Liang <ycliang@andestech.com>
Clearing MIP.MSIP is not guaranteed to do anything by the spec. In
addition, most existing RISC-V hardware does nothing when this bit is set.
The following commits "riscv: Use a valid bit to ignore already-pending
IPIs" and "riscv: Clear pending IPIs on initialization" should implement
the original intent of the reverted commit in a more robust manner.
This reverts commit 9472630337.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
We currently do this in a u-boot specific dts, but hopefully we can get
these bindings added in Linux in the future.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@openfive.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
The interrupt controller property is removed from the clint binding because
the clint is not an interrupt-controller. That is, no other devices have an
interrupt which is controlled by the clint.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Another "virtual" clock (in the sense that it isn't configurable). This
could possibly be done as a clock in the device tree, but I think this is a
bit cleaner.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
This converts the clint driver from the riscv-specific interface to be a
DM-based UCLASS_TIMER driver. In addition, the SiFive DDR driver previously
implicitly depended on the CLINT to select REGMAP.
Unlike Andes's PLMT/PLIC (which AFAIK never have anything pass it a dtb),
the SiFive CLINT is part of the device tree passed in by qemu. This device
tree doesn't have a clocks or clock-frequency property on clint, so we need
to fall back on the timebase-frequency property. Perhaps in the future we
can get a clock-frequency property added to the qemu dtb.
Unlike with the Andes PLMT, the Sifive CLINT is also an IPI controller.
RISCV_SYSCON_CLINT is retained for this purpose.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Pragnesh Patel <pragnesh.patel@openfive.com>
This merges the PLIC initialization code from two functions into one.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
This converts the PLMT driver from the riscv-specific timer interface to be
a DM-based UCLASS_TIMER driver.
The clock-frequency/clocks properties are preferred over timebase-frequency
for two reasons. First, properties which affect a device should be located
near its binding in the device tree. Using timebase-frequency only really
makes sense when the cpu itself is the timer device. This is the case when
we read the time from a CSR, but not when there is a separate device.
Second, it lets the device use the clock subsystem which adds flexibility.
If the device is configured for a different clock speed, the timer can
adjust itself.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
To test this function, sandbox CPU must set cpu_platdata.timebase_freq on
bind. It also needs to expose a method to set the current cpu. I also make
some most members of cpu_sandbox_ops static.
On the timer side, the device tree property
sandbox,timebase-frequency-fallback controls whether sandbox_timer_probe
falls back to time_timebase_fallback or to SANDBOX_TIMER_RATE.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This function is designed to be used when a timer used to be initialized by
the cpu (e.g. RISC-V timers), but now is initialized by dm_timer_init. In
such a case, the timer may prefer to use the clocks and clock-frequency
properties, but should be able to fall back on using the cpu's
timebase-frequency.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The riscv-timer driver currently serves as a shim for several riscv timer
drivers. This is not too desirable because it bypasses the usual timer
selection via the driver model. There is no easy way to specify an
alternate timing driver, or have the tick rate depend on the cpu's
configured frequency. The timer drivers also do not have device structs,
and so have to rely on storing parameters in gd_t. Lastly, there is no
initialization call, so driver init is done in the same function which
reads the time. This can result in confusing error messages. To a user, it
looks like the driver failed when trying to read the time, whereas it may
have failed while initializing.
This patch removes the shim functionality from the riscv-timer driver, and
has it instead implement the former rdtime.c timer driver. This is because
existing u-boot users who pass in a device tree (e.g. qemu) do not create a
timer device for S-mode u-boot. The existing behavior of creating the
riscv-timer device in the riscv cpu driver must be kept. The actual reading
of the CSRs has been redone in the style of Linux's get_cycles64.
Signed-off-by: Sean Anderson <seanga2@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
The usage of regmap API in the SiFive RAM driver is not correct.
The reg address should be obtained via dev_read_addr_index() API.
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
In the boot flow description add the RESET and BOOT button as well as the
function of the DTR and RTS lines of the serial interface.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
We should check if the incoming parameter file_mapping is not NULL instead
of checking after adding an offset.
Reported-by: Coverity CID 307210
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Thomas Petazzoni <thomas.petazzoni@bootlin.com>
Fix a typo
%s/interract/interact/
Use Samsung's capitalization of their trademarks
%s/onenand/OneNAND/
%s/Hyperflash/HyperFlash/
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
[trini: Add other Hyperflash cases as noted by Stefan]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
The 44758771ee commit removes CONFIG_PREBOOT but actually sets the USE_PREBOOT
Kconfig option which isn't CONFIG_PREBOOT and is also a bool option which means
we regress because 'usb start' isn't run when expected, it should also be run
for devices that have USB storage because keyboards aren't the only thing we
might need the USB bus for.
Fixes: 44758771ee ("arm: move CONFIG_PREBOOT="usb start" to KConfig")
Signed-off-by: Peter Robinson <pbrobinson@gmail.com>
Cc: Jonas Smedegaard <dr@jones.dk>
Cc: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2020-10-rc6
The following UEFI related issues are fixed:
* restore the global data pointer in the RISC-V trap handler
* install EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL only if we have a random number generator
* display human readable string for EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL in efidebug command
Add support for Microchip PIT64B timer. The timer is 64 bit length and
is used as a free running counter (in continuous mode with highest values
for period registers). The clock feeding the timer would be no more
than 12.5MHz.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
The gp register is used to store U-Boot's global data pointer. We should
not assume that an UEFI application leaves the gp register unchanged as
the UEFI specifications does not define who is the owner of the gp and tp
registers.
So the following sequence should be followed in the trap handler:
* save the caller's gp register
* restore the global data pointer
* serve interrupts or print crash dump and reset
* restore the caller's gp register
Cc: Abner Chang <abner.chang@hpe.com>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bin.meng@windriver.com>
Reviewed-by: Rick Chen <rick@andestech.com>
This fixes HWRNG support on Amlogic GXL, GXM, G12A, G12B & SM1
based boards dues to the lack of the core clock in the device tree.
It was reported breaking EFI boot in the Linux EFI stub, because the
EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL didn't check for the RNG device presence before
installing itself.
The Linux amlogic,meson-rng.yaml doesn't mandate the core clock,
this the clock should be ignores if not present.
Nevertheless, the clock should be present and this should be fixed
on the Linux meson-gxl.dtsi & meson-g12-common.dtsi then synced
with U-Boot.
The change has been tested on a Khadas VIM3, which uses the common
meson-g12-common.dtsi like the Odroid-C4 & Odroid-N2 in Scott's
report, along with the RNG cmd.
Cc: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reported-by: Scott K Logan <logans@cottsay.net>
Fixes: bc40eb278b ("drivers/rng: add Amlogic hardware RNG driver")
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Tested-by: Scott K Logan <logans@cottsay.net>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Having an EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL without a backing RNG device leads to failure
to boot Linux 5.8.
Only install the EFI_RNG_PROTOCOL if we have a RNG device.
Reported-by: Scott K Logan <logans@cottsay.net>
Cc: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Cc: Ard Biesheuvel <ardb@kernel.org>
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Add the Random Number Generator (RNG) protocol to the GUIDs that the
'efidebug dh' protocol can replace by a text.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Renesas Ebisu board is based on R-Car E3 SoC which has dual CA53 and
a CR7.
This patch drops check for cputype from reset_cpu() and also drops the
corresponding CA57 macros. While at it also dropped RST_RSTOUTCR macro
which is unused.
Signed-off-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
The micrel phy driver is already configuring this values from
device tree. So remove the redundant phy configuration call from
this driver.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Renesas Draak board based on R-Car D3 has single CA53.
This patch drops check for cputype from reset_cpu() and also drops the
corresponding CA57 macros. While at it also dropped RST_RSTOUTCR macro
which is unused.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Use "imply" instead of "select" for BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F config option,
and then disable it on boards which don't need it.
Updated grpeach_defconfig to disable CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F option for
RZA1.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
R8A774A1 is part of Renesas RZ/G2 series and not R-Car, reflect the same
for PINCTRL_PFC_R8A774A1 help description
Alongside, sort the PINCTRL_PFC_R8A774A1 config option as per increasing
number of the SoC.
Signed-off-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Lad Prabhakar <prabhakar.mahadev-lad.rj@bp.renesas.com>
Enable the fitImage update options on RCar Gen3 boards.
This permits easy update of multiple bootloader components.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
Enable the RPC Hyperflash driver on R8A7795,R8A7796,R8A77965
Salvator-X,ULCB and R8A77990 Ebisu. Note that to make the HF
accessible, mainline ATF is mandatory and must be built with
RCAR_RPC_HYPERFLASH_LOCKED=0 . Note that this is intended for
development and testing convenience only and must be disabled
in deployment for platform security reasons.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Nobuhiro Iwamatsu <iwamatsu@nigauri.org>
- Enhance the 'zboot' command to be more like 'bootm' with sub-commands
- The last series of ACPI core changes for programmatic generation of
ACPI tables
- Add all required ACPI tables for ApolloLake and enable ACPIGEN on
Chromebook Coral
- A feature minor enhancements to the 'hob' command
- Intel edison: Support for writing an xFSTK image via binman
Call mmc_of_parse at probe time to fetch all the host properties
from the DT.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
The second clock of the IP block (the generic clock), must be explicitly
enabled.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Peng Fan <pengfan@nxp.com>
clk_set_rate will return rate in case of success and zero in case of
error, however it can also return -ev, but it's an ulong function.
To avoid any issues, disregard the return value of this call.
In case this call actually fails, nothing much we can do anyway, but we
can at least try with the previous values (or DT assigned-clocks)
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
It is useful to be able to flash Edison directly without relying on the
installed U-Boot being functional.
Add a binman image for this. It includes a 'OSIP' header (which happens to
look like an MBR / (Master-Boot Record), U-Boot binary and an environment.
I am not able to find a specification for OSIP.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
In some cases it is useful to include a U-Boot environment region in an
image. This allows the board to start up with an environment ready to go.
Add a new entry type for this. The input is a text file containing the
environment entries, one per line, in the format:
var=value
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
The recent support for missing external binaries does not show an error
message when a file is genuinely missing (i.e. it is missing but not
marked as 'external'). This means that when -m is passed to binman, it
will never report a missing file.
Fix this and add a test.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
We already use binman's 'multiple-images' feature with Chrome OS and we
want to use it for Edison. There is no real down-side.
Adjust x86 to always use multiple-images.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Acked-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
At present the 'bdinfo' command shows the framebuffer address, but not the
address of the copy framebuffer, if present. Add support for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the mtrr command only support 8 MTRRs. Some SoCs have more than
that. Update the implementation to support up to 10. Read the number of
MTRRs dynamically instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some HOBs include information that can be decoded. Add a -v option to the
hob command, to allow this to be displayed. Add the ability to decode a
resource descriptor.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
GUIDs are one of the seven evils of the computer world. They obfuscate the
meaning and require people to look up long hex strings to decode it.
Luckily only a miniscule fraction of the 10^38 possible GUIDs are in use.
Add a way to decode the GUIDs known to U-Boot. Add a few more to the list
for good measure.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The 'hob' command currently lists all HOB entries. Add way to list a
single entry, by index.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Enable new features and provide require device-tree config so that U-Boot
produces the correct ACPI tables on Coral.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present linux/bitops.h is included in ACPI code. This is not needed and
can cause a problem in fls64.h since BITS_PER_LONG is not defined. Move
the #include into the part not used by ACPI.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Some boards want to reserve extra regions of memory. Add a 'chosen'
property to support this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
A few fields have an open-coded length. Use the defines for this purpose
instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present this function only supports FSP-M but it is also used to read
FSP-S, in which case FSP-M may be zero. Add support for showing whichever
address is present in the FSP binary.
Also change the debug() statements to log_debug() while here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
If locating the FSP header hangs for whatever reason it is useful to see
where it got stuck. Add a debug print. Also show the address of the FSP-S
entry point as a sanity check.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add files describing the various audio configurations supported on coral.
These are passed to Linux in the ACPI tables.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This file doesn't currently have a log category. Add one so that items
are logged correctly.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This provides information about a v1 TPM in the system. Generate this
table if the TPM is present.
Add a required new bloblist type and correct the header order of one
header file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This file cannot currently be included in ASL files. Add a header guard
to permit this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This is currently in the wrong place, so including the file in the device
tree fails. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Send this notification when U-Boot is about to boot into Linux, as
requested by the FSP.
Currently this causes a crash with the APL FSP, so leave it disabled for
now.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the MTRR registers are programmed with the list the U-Boot
builds up in the same order. In some cases this list may be out of order.
It looks better in Linux to have the registers in order, so sort them,
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This new method is intended to be called when UEFI shuts down the 'boot
services', i.e. any lingering code in the boot loader that might be used
by the OS.
Add a definition for this new method and update the comments a little.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
We don't have CONFIG_PCI in TPL but it is present in SPL, etc. So this
code is not needed. Drop it, and fix a code-style nit just above.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Support generating a DMAR table and add a few helper routines as well.
Also set up NHLT so that audio works.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add support for generating various ACPI tables for Apollo Lake. Add a few
S3 definitions that are needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Allow this header to be included in ASL files by adding a header guard and
a few definitions that are needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Apollo Lake needs to generate a few more table types used on Intel SoCs.
Add support for these into the x86 ACPI code.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These are needed for the CPU tables. Add them into an x86-specific file
since we do not support them on sandbox, or include tests.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an implementation of the DBG2 (Debug Port Table 2) ACPI table.
Adjust one of the header includes to be in the correct order, before
adding more.
Note that the DBG2 table is generic but the PCI UART is x86-specific at
present since it assumes an ns16550 UART. It can be generalised later
if necessary.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an implementation of the HPET (High Precision Event Timer) ACPI
table. Since this is x86-specific, put it in an x86-specific file
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add some more definitions to the iomap. These will be used by
ACPI-generation code as well as the device tree.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add SCI and power-state definitions required by ACPI tables. Fix the
license to match the original source file.
Als update the guard on acpi_pmc.h to avoid an error when buiding ASL.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
U-Boot does not support SMM (System Management Mode) at present, but needs
a few definitions to correctly set up the ACPI table. Add these.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Intel WiFi chips can use a common routine to write the information needed
by linux. Add an implementation of this.
Enable it for coral.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Some devices can wake the system from sleep, e.g opening the lid on a
clamshell or moving a USB mouse.
Add a wake to specify this for USB devices and add the settings for Apollo
Lake.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Many I2C devices produce roughly the same ACPI data with just things like
the GPIO/interrupt information being different.
This can be handled by a generic driver along with some information in the
device tree.
Add a generic i2c driver for this purpose.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
The extra ACPI code increases U-Boot above it current size limit. Move
the start earlier to provide space.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a function to generate ACPI code for a _DSM method for a device.
This includes functions for starting and ending each part of the _DSM.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
[bmeng: fix the "new blank line at EOF" git warning]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
A 'Power Resource for Wake' list the resources a device depends on for
wake. Add a function to generate this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This device has a large set of ACPI tables. Bring these in from coreboot
so that full functionality is available (apart from SMI).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Expand this to 4KB so that it is possible to add custom information to it.
On Chromebooks this is used to pass verified-boot information.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present U-Boot puts a magic number in the ASL for the GNVS table and
searches for it later.
Add a Kconfig option to use a different approach, where the ASL files
declare the table as an external symbol. U-Boot can then put it wherever
it likes, without any magic numbers or searching.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add the definition of this structure common to Intel devices. It includes
some optional Chrome OS pieces which are used when vboot is integrated.
Drop the APL version as it is basically the same.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This value is incorrect and causes problems booting Linux. Fix it.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Recent versions of Chrome OS do not have a kernel in the root disk, to
save space.
With the improvements to the 'zboot' command it is fairly easy to load
the kernel from the raw partition. Add instructions on how to do this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
When booting Chrome OS images the command line is stored separately
from the kernel. Add a way to specify this address so that images boot
correctly.
Also add comments to the zimage.h header.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: adjust maxargs to 8 for 'zboot start']
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
There is a lot of information in the setup block and it is quite hard to
decode manually. Add a 'zboot dump' command to decode it into a
human-readable format.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the setup block is always obtained from the image
automatically. In some cases it can be useful to use a setup block
obtained elsewhere, e.g. if the image has already been unpacked. Add an
argument to support this and update the logic to use it if provided.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: adjust maxargs to 7 for 'zboot start']
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present it is not possible to tell from a script where the setup block
is, or where the image was loaded to. Add environment variables for this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a subcommand that loads the kernel into the right places in memory.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: adjust ZBOOT_STATE_INFO value to match the command order]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add a little subcommand that prints out where the kernel was loaded and
its setup pointer. Run it by default in the normal boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Split out the code that actually boots linux into a separate sub-command.
Add base_ptr to the state to support this.
Show an error if the boot fails, since this should not happen.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Add subcommands to zboot. At present there is only one called 'start'
which does the whole boot. It is the default command so is optional.
Change the 's' string variable to const while we are here.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: reduce maxargs to 6 of 'zboot start' subcommand]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present if an error occurs while setting up the boot, interrupts are
left disabled. Move this call later in the sequence to avoid this problem.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present U-Boot sets a loader type of 8 which means LILO version 8,
according to the spec. Update it to 0x80, which means U-Boot with no
particular version.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
To help reduce the size and complexity of load_zimage(), move the code
that reads the kernel version into a separate function. Update
get_boot_protocol() to allow printing the 'Magic signature' message only
once, under control of its callers.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
At present the 'zboot' command does everything in one go. It would be
better if it supported sub-commands like bootm, so it is possible to
examine what will be booted before actually booting it.
In preparation for this, move the 'state' of the command into a struct.
This will allow it to be shared among multiple functions in this file.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This header is missing a few of the newer features from the specification.
Add these as well as a link to the spec. Also use the BIT() macros where
appropriate.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
LX2160A rev2 uses different PCIe controller, so EP mode DT
nodes also need to be fixed up.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
CONFIG_DM_SPI_FLASH is only supported now with passing of driver
conversion deadline from non-DM to DM model. Hence, it's safe to remove
non-DM code check from pfe_spi_flash_init.
Also use CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE and CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ instead of
reading reading values from DT.
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Fix Coverity issue: RESOURCE_LEAK.
leaked_storage: Variable addr going out of scope leaks the storage it
points to.
Fixes: e0152dbed6 ("net: pfe_eth: Use spi_flash_read API to access
flash memory")
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
All the 10G ports that were working in XFI mode were described as
using XGMII (as PHY_INTERFACE_MODE_XFI was not added at the time).
Add the minimal changes required for the FMan code to support XFI.
Signed-off-by: Madalin Bucur <madalin.bucur@oss.nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
PFE DDR addresses are now stored on to a stack varaiable rather
dynamic allocation.
Signed-off-by: Chaitanya Sakinam <chaitanya.sakinam@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The next DPMAC was always verified if it is enabled. In case of
DPMAC@6, the DPMAC@7 is verified. As DPMAC@7 is disabled, DPMAC@6 will
be considered disabled and not detected by uboot.
Signed-off-by: Grigore Popescu <grigore.popescu@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Ioana Ciornei <ioana.ciornei@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
emc2305 is a common driver. It should not use platform specific
i2c address for slave device.
Pass chip_addr as agrument to emc2305_init() and set_fan_speed()
so that emc2305 driver can be used with different platforms.
Signed-off-by: Wasim Khan <wasim.khan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
According to the reference manual of LS2088A, for a VDD voltage of
0.9V, the entry should be at 01000b.
Fixes: 4911948ec7 ("board/freescale,lsch3: Add entry for 0.9v")
Signed-off-by: Martin Kaistra <martin.kaistra@linutronix.de>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Configure DWC3’s cache type to ‘cacheable’ for better
performance. Actually related register definition and values are SoC
specific, which means this setting is only applicable to Layerscape SoC,
not generic for all platforms which have integrated DWC3 IP.
Signed-off-by: Ran Wang <ran.wang_1@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Xilinx changes for v2021.01
arm64:
- Support for bigger U-Boot images compiled with PIE
microblaze:
- Extend support for LE/BE systems
zynqmp:
- Refactor silicon ID detection code with using firmware interface
- Add support for saving variables based on bootmode
zynqmp-r5:
- Fix MPU mapping and defconfig setting.
xilinx:
- Minor driver changes: names alignment
- Enable UBIFS
- Minor DT and macros fixes
- Fix boot with appended DT
- Fix distro boot
cmd:
- pxe: Add fixing for platforms with manual relocation support
clk:
- fixed_rate: Add DM flag to support early boot on r5
fpga:
- zynqmppl: Use only firmware interface and enable SPL build
serial:
- uartlite: Enable for ARM systems and support endians
mmc:
- zynq: Fix indentation
net:
- gem: Support for multiple phys
- emac: Fix 64bit support and enable it for arm64
kconfig:
- Setup default values for Xilinx platforms
- Fix dependecies for Xilinx drivers
- Source board Kconfig only when platform is enabled
- Fix FPGA Kconfig entry with SPL
- Change some defconfig values
bindings:
- Add binding doc for vsc8531
- Add DM_SPI, DM_SPI_FLASH support for powerpc platforms
- Add DM_ETH support on P1010RDB, P1020RDB, P2020RDB
- Remove some un-maintained powerpc platforms
- Add USB_STORAGE support in config
commit 0cfccb5401 ("configs: Resync with savedefconfig")
removed CONFIG_USB_STORAGE from some powerpc platforms' defconfig
files, whicih would block the use case of system loading rootfs
from USB drives, add them back.
Signed-off-by: Ran Wang <ran.wang_1@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable the DM_ETH and DM_MDIO config.
On P2020RDB, the eTSEC1 is connecting with a switch VSC7385,
so also enable the fixed PHY support.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The board_eth_init() is only used by legacy ethernet driver framework,
so do not compile it when DM_ETH config has been selected.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Enable the DM_ETH and DM_MDIO config.
On P1020RDB, the eTSEC1 is connecting with a switch VSC7385,
so also enable the fixed PHY support.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The board_eth_init() is only used by legacy ethernet driver framework,
so do not compile it when DM_ETH config has been selected.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
Move vsc7835 firmware uploading to board_early_init_r(), so that
the switch also can work in DM eTSEC driver.
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The info of fixed-link PHY is described in DT node instead of
getting from MII, so detect the fixed-link PHY DT node first,
if it doesn't exist then probe the MII.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
[Rebased]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
For the platforms on which the eTSEC driver uses DM_ETH, convert its
MDIO controller code to also use DM_MDIO.
Note that for handling the TBI PHY (the MAC PCS for SGMII), we still
don't register a udevice for it, since we can drive it locally and there
is no point in doing otherwise.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
[Reworked to fix gazerbeam config]
Signed-off-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The MII management register block offset is different between
gianfar and etsec2 compatible devices, this patch is to fix
this issue by adding driver data for different compatible
string.
Fixes: 2932c5a802 ("net: tsec: fsl_mdio: add DM MDIO support")
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
The tsec driver now requires DM_MDIO when DM_ETH is enabled. To avoid
build errors, enable DM_MDIO in these boards' configs before we actually
add DM_MDIO support to tsec.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
It is utterly pointless to require an MDIO bus pointer for a fixed PHY
device. The fixed.c implementation does not require it, only
phy_device_create. Fix that.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Hou Zhiqiang <Zhiqiang.Hou@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
As required by PCI Express spec a delay for at least 100ms after
de-asserting PERST# signal is needed before link training is enabled.
Linux kernels prior to 5.8 version do not automatically disable link
training before de-asserting PERST# signal, therefore this requirement is
not fulfilled.
Above requirement is needed for proper detection of some Compex PCIe WiFi
cards. Otherwise Linux kernel cannot detect it.
To allow using those PCIe cards with older Linux kernel versions booted by
U-Boot compiled with U-Boot a37xx pci driver, disable link training in
U-Boot when unloading this pci driver.
Thanks to DM_FLAG_OS_PREPARE flag, U-Boot automatically unload this driver
when booting Linux kernel.
Signed-off-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Testing on a DNS-325 NAS has shown that in order for the device to work
we need to set CONFIG_NR_DRAM_BANKS to 1 and not 2.
Tested-by: Dmitry N. Kolesnikov <dk.diklab@gmail.com>
Reported-by: Dmitry N. Kolesnikov <dk.diklab@gmail.com>
Cc: Stefan Herbrechtsmeier <stefan@herbrechtsmeier.net>
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Required for the generic distro mechanism.
Linux ships with 4 variants:
marvell/armada-3720-espressobin-v7-emmc.dtb
marvell/armada-3720-espressobin-v7.dtb
marvell/armada-3720-espressobin-emmc.dtb
marvell/armada-3720-espressobin.dtb
Use available information to determine the appropriate filename.
Fixes booting GRUB EFI arm64 on Fedora.
Reported-by: Dennis Gilmore <dennis@ausil.us>
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
The hardware does not provide a MAC address. Enable this so that
network access works with just the default environment.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Increase max gunzip size, required for booting itb recovery images on
uDPU.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Vid <vladimir.vid@sartura.hr>
[a.heider: adapt to mainline]
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Some of Marvell A3700 boards use mx25u12835f, specifically uDPU
and ESPRESSObin v7.
Signed-off-by: Vladimir Vid <vladimir.vid@sartura.hr>
[a.heider: adapt commit message to mainline]
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
The fdt_fixup_pcie_ls() scans all PCI devices and assumes that all PCI
root devices are layerscape PCIe controllers. Unfortunately, this is not
true for the LS1028A. There is one additional static PCI root complex
(this contains the networking devices) which has nothing to do with the
layerscape PCIe controllers. On recent U-Boot versions this results in
the following panic:
"Synchronous Abort" handler, esr 0x96000044
elr: 000000009602fa04 lr : 000000009602f9f4 (reloc)
elr: 00000000fbd73a04 lr : 00000000fbd739f4
x0 : 0080000002000101 x1 : 0000000000000000
x2 : 00000000fbde9000 x3 : 0000000000000001
x4 : 0000000000000000 x5 : 0000000000000030
x6 : 00000000fbdbd460 x7 : 00000000fbb3d3a0
x8 : 0000000000000002 x9 : 000000000000000c
x10: 00000000ffffffe8 x11: 0000000000000006
x12: 000000000001869f x13: 0000000000000a2c
x14: 00000000fbb3d2cc x15: 00000000ffffffff
x16: 0000000000010000 x17: 0000000000000000
x18: 00000000fbb3fda0 x19: 0000000000000800
x20: 0000000000000000 x21: 00000001f0000000
x22: 0000000000000800 x23: 0000000000000009
x24: 00000000fbdc3c1b x25: 00000000fbdc28e5
x26: 00000000fbdcc008 x27: 00000000fbdc16e2
x28: 000000000f000000 x29: 00000000fbb3d3a0
Code: 394072a1 f94006a0 34000041 5ac00a94 (b8336814)
Resetting CPU ...
This bug already existed in former versions, but the spurious write was
never trapped, because the destination address was a valid address (by
pure luck).
Make sure the PCI root is actually one of the expected PCIe layerscape
controllers by matching its compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Michael Walle <michael@walle.cc>
Reviewed-by: Vladimir Oltean <vladimir.oltean@nxp.com>
Tested-by: Heiko Thiery <heiko.thiery@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE disables write protection on various environment
variables like "ethaddr" and "serial".
Enable this config in LS1046A and LS1012A defconfigs. This resolves an
error while setting multiple values of "ethaddr" variable.
Before the change:
=> setenv ethaddr 00:E0:0C:00:06:0
=> setenv ethaddr 00:E0:0C:00:06:1
Error: Can't overwrite "ethaddr"
Error inserting "ethaddr" variable, errno=1
After the change:
=> setenv ethaddr 00:E0:0C:00:06:0
=> setenv ethaddr 00:E0:0C:00:06:1
Signed-off-by: Kuldeep Singh <kuldeep.singh@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
scan_dev_for_efi is supposed to be called from scan_dev_for_boot.
However this call is missing for ls1028ardb and ls1028aqds boards. As
a result EFI boot doesn’t work. Fix this issue by removing custom
definition of scan_dev_for_boot and use the default definition
instead.
Signed-off-by: Mian Yousaf Kaukab <ykaukab@suse.de>
Reviewed-by: andy.tang@nxp.com
Reviewed-by: Priyanka Jain <priyanka.jain@nxp.com>
fixed-rate driver is not different from clk_fixed_factor and it is required
very early in boot that's why setup flag for it.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
pxe sub commands need to be manually relocated for architectures which
enables MANUAL_RELOC as Microblaze.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PXE and DHCP shouldn't be listed when commands are not enabled that's why
handle it in the same way as is done for Zynq and ZynqMP.
Fixes: ec48b6c991 ("arm64: versal: Add support for new Xilinx Versal ACAPs")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Map all resource for R5 to operate properly.
The patch is done based on the commit 23f7b1a776 ("armv7R: K3: am654:
Enable MPU regions") which also map the whole 4GB at first and then change
mapping for DDR.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
ATF support was all the time based on FIT image support but this dependency
is not recorded anywhere.
For !SPL_FIT && SPL_ATF there is compilation error:
common/spl/spl.c: In function 'board_init_r':
common/spl/spl.c:689:26: error: 'struct spl_image_info' has no member named 'fdt_addr'
689 | spl_fixup_fdt(spl_image.fdt_addr);
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Both SOCs shouldn't have any problem with 64bit dma accesses. Also with PIE
enabled when u-boot is placed above 4GB without any memory mapped below 4GB
address space efi_memory_init() call is failing due to missing memory node.
For this two reason disable this option for ZynqMP and Versal.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
if conditions should match.
Fixes: a18d09ea38 ("fpga: zynqmp: Add secure bitstream loading for ZynqMP")
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The patch does sed 's/SPL_FPGA_SUPPORT/SPL_FPGA/g' but also fixing Makefile
and zynqmp.c to simplify if/endif logic in zynqmp.c.
This change is mostly done to be able to use CONFIG_IS_ENABLED macro and
obj-$(CONFIG_$(SPL_)FPGA) in Makefile. For them symbols need to be in sync.
And removing one line from Topic Miami boards which is not needed because
symbol is not enabled via Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
For SPL flow without specifying address for DT loading DTB is automatically
appended behind U-Boot code. Specifically _end symbol is used. Just behind
it there is place for bss section.
It means if early code is using static variable and there is a write to
this variable DTB file is corrupted if variable is located between DTB
start and end.
In this particular case offset of this variable from bss section start is
very small (0x40) that's why DT is currupted which breaks this boot flow.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable position independent pre-relocation to let users options to put
u-boot to different locations.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enabling saving variables to MMC(FAT), NAND, SPI based on primary bootmode.
Maybe that logic can be tuned for more complicated use cases and better
tested for different bootmodes.
Tested on zcu104 to SD(FAT) and JTAG(NOWHERE).
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
There is no reason to have name variable saved in BSS section when it
doesn't need to be really used. That's why remove static from variable
definition and use strdup() to duplicate string with exact size from malloc
area instead.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Current algorithm used to get the silicon name is bit complicated and
hard to follow. Updated to use more straightforward mechanism based on
the Device ID code table (Table 1-2). The full IDCODE register is used
(except device revision bits [31:28]) to get the device name and IDCODE2
value is used for identifying the variant.
Additionally to make the algorithm bit more clear it also save some space
as the devices table is slightly bit smaller.
Signed-off-by: Ibai Erkiaga <ibai.erkiaga-elorza@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
flush_cache() arguments are not type casted to take care of 64 bit
systems. Use phys_addr_t to type cast for it to work properly for 32 bit
and 64 bit systems.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
There are compilation warnings showing up when we compile AXI ethernet
driver for 64bit architectures. Fix them, so that it works on both 32
and 64 bit architectures.
DMA descriptors are not taking care of 64bit addresses. To fix it,
change axidma_bd members as below:
next ==> next_desc
reserverd1 ==> next_desc_msb
phys ==> buf_addr
reserverd2 ==> buf_addr_msb
and update next_desc and buf_addr with lower 32 bits of the addresses,
update next_desc_msb and buf_addr_msb with upper 32 bits of the 64bit
addresses.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Add MSCC header with delay definitions for VSC8531 and associated
family devices.
Signed-off-by: Harini Katakam <harini.katakam@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
It was protected just for SPL_OS_BOOT but this function is only called when
SPL_ATF is enabled that's why change macro name.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
NAND_ARASAN selecting DM_MTD uunconditionally. Driver can be enabled with
!DM that's why Kconfig it showing it as error:
WARNING: unmet direct dependencies detected for DM_MTD
Depends on [n]: DM [=n]
Selected by [y]:
- NAND_ARASAN [=y] && MTD_RAW_NAND [=y]
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Value of shunt resistor for INA226s that monitor VCCINT and VCC_SOC power
rails are incorrect. This patch corrects those values.
Signed-off-by: Saeed Nowshadi <saeed.nowshadi@xilinx.com>
There is 2nd pca9548 mux on I2C1 bus that controls SFP0, SFP1, and QSFP1
ports. Channel 0 and 1 are connected to J287 connector for SFP0 & SFP1, and
channel 2 is connected to J288 connector for QSFP1.
Signed-off-by: Saeed Nowshadi <saeed.nowshadi@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add CONFIG_XILINX_UARTLITE config to versal/zynqmp defconfig to
enable uartlite driver support by default.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This endinness changes are taken from linux uartlite driver.
Reset TX fifo in control register and check TX fifo empty
flag in lower byte of the status register to detect if it
is a little endian system. Based on this check, program the
registers with le32 or be32 through out the driver.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Enable required configs for using ubifs in uboot.
UBIFS testing procedure from u-boot:
Let's say we have two partitions in dt as below and want to format
partition1 "images" with ubifs.
partition@0 {
label = "boot";
reg = <0x0 0x1000000>;
};
partition@1 {
label = "images";
reg = <0x1000000 0x7000000>;
};
We will format the partition from linux and copy some files and access
from uboot later.
First thing, in linux config disable CONFIG_MTD_SPI_NOR_USE_4K_SECTORS.
this is required as ubifs expects min LEB size as 15*1024 bytes.
Use below commands in linux to format "images" partition with ubifs.
ubiformat /dev/mtd1
ubiattach /dev/ubi_ctrl -m 1
ubimkvol /dev/ubi0 -N images -m
mount -t ubifs ubi0:images /mnt
We can copy files to /mnt and unmount it.
To access this ubifs partition from uboot, run below commands.
(Don't forget to probe device before, e.g. sf probe 0 0 0)
setenv mtdids "nor0=nor0"
setenv mtdparts "mtdparts=nor0:16m(boot),112m(images)"
ubi part images
ubifsmount ubi0:images
make sure we match "mtdparts" to whatever is given in dt w.r.t partition
sizes.
"mtdparts" command will list the mtd partitions in u-boot.
Once ubifs is mounted, we can use "ubifsls" to list the files in that
partition and use "ubifsload <addr> <filename>" to load files from ubifs
partition to DDR.
Reading information about mtd layout from DT is not supported.
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Add read/write memory utilities for 16 and 32 bits. Add these
api's for both little and big endian systems similar to arm
architecture.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Reddy Soma <ashok.reddy.soma@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
U-Boot on xilinx boards is checking one address where DTB can be placed as
the first location for DTB. Originally this code was developed for Versal
where QEMU was putting generated DTB for U-Boot to use.
The patch enables changing this address which is necessary for cases where
default address is pointing to location (DDR) which is not present. The
access to this location can cause exception.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Do not source xilinx board Kconfig by other boards. These configs should be
available only when Xilinx platforms are selected.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Zynq/ZynqMP/Versal IPs should be possible to called also from Microblaze in
PL and vice versa. That's why change dependencies and do not limit enabling
just for some platforms.
This is follow up patch based on commit 664e16ce99 ("xilinx: kconfig:
Change Kconfig dependencies for Xilinx drivers").
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Zynq is similar to ZynqMP u-boot feature wise that's why also enable
default option for ENV_FAT_DEVICE_AND_PART Kconfig entry.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Find out MDIO bus and enable MDIO access to it if this is done via
different GEM controller. Only works across GEM instances.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
The most of drivers are using '_' instead of '-' in driver name. That's why
sync up these names to be aligned. It looks quite bad to see both in use.
It is visible via dm tree command.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
The GPIO bank name for banks J and K are not correct when using the
'gpio' command from the console.
The driver derives the bank name from the device tree instance string by
using the instance value and adding 'A': gpio0@xxaddrxx is Bank A,
gpio1@yyaddryy is Bank B and so on.
On the PIC32, there is no Bank I so instances 8 and 9 need to be
incremented as a minimum change.
An alternative (less opaque) implementation would be to use a bank-name
property instead but this would require modifying the driver code too.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
GPIO state cannot be changed via the device tree (e.g. with gpio-hog) or
using the 'gpio' command from the console.
The root cause is a discrepancy between the driver and the device tree:
the driver code expects an absolute I/O address in the <reg> property,
while the device tree defines the address relative to a declaration in
the parent pinctrl node.
Changing the device tree to fix a driver issue would normally be wrong,
however:
- I have run the first version of U-Boot in which this driver appears
(v2016.03) and the same problem exists, so this is not a regression;
- There is no code that references a parent device tree node that might
suggest the intent of the author was to parse the DT as it exists now;
- The equivalent Linux PIC32 GPIO driver also uses absolute addresses
for the GPIO <reg> property. This change brings the U-Boot DT more
into line with Linux.
Additionally, the data sheet (Microchip ref. 60001361H) shows that the
register set to control a GPIO bank spans 0xE0 bytes, but the device
tree specified size is only 0x48 bytes.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
CONFIG_BLK needs to be enabled by default to allow U-Boot to
compile after a 'make pic32mzdask_defconfig'.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
The PIC32MZ DA Starter Kit does not need the card detect workaround
because the SDCD signal line is connected properly. Disable the
workaround in this case.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
The GPIO pins used by the SDHCI controller need to be configured to
allow the interface to work.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
The existing driver is not compatible with the Driver Model.
This patch makes the necessary changes while also removing obsolescent
calls/properties as follows:
- fdtdec_* calls replaced with dev_read_* equivalents;
- 'clock-freq-min-max' property replaced by querying the frequency of
the source clock 'base_clk';
- The card detect erratum workaround is applied during probe rather than
overriding get_cd.
The card detect workaround (Microchip ref. DS80000736E, erratum #15) is
not always needed and can be disabled using a vendor specific DT
property.
Signed-off-by: John Robertson <john.robertson@simiatec.com>
When a message is written by a log driver (e.g. via the network stack) this
may result in the generation of further messages. We cannot allow these
additional messages to be emitted as this might result in an infinite
recursion.
Up to now only the syslog driver was safeguarded. We should safeguard all
log drivers instead.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In the live tree API ofnode_parse_phandle_with_args, the cell_count
argument must be used when cells_name is NULL.
But this argument is not provided to the live DT function
of_parse_phandle_with_args even it is provided to
fdtdec_parse_phandle_with_args.
This patch adds support of the cells_count parameter in dev_ and
of_node API to allow migration and support of live DT:
- of_parse_phandle_with_args
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
OP-TEE reserved memory node must set property "no-map" to prevent
Linux kernel from mapping secure memory unless what non-secure world
speculative accesses of the CPU can violate the memory firmware
configuration.
Fixes: 6ccb05eae0 ("image: fdt: copy possible optee nodes to a loaded devicetree")
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Add a test to verify that the no-map property is added in reserved-memory
node when fdtdec_add_reserved_memory() no-map parameter is set to true.
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add boolean input argument @no_map to helper function
fdtdec_add_reserved_memory() to add or not "no-map" property
for an added reserved memory node.
Property no-map is used by the Linux kernel to not not map memory
in its static memory mapping. It is needed for example for the|
consistency of system non-cached memory and to prevent speculative
accesses to some firewalled memory.
No functional change. A later change will update to OPTEE library to
add no-map property to OP-TEE reserved memory nodes.
Signed-off-by: Etienne Carriere <etienne.carriere@st.com>
Signed-off-by: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When an external blob is missing it can be quite confusing for the user.
Add a way to provide a help message that is shown.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Add a new entry argument to the fit entry which allows selection of the
default configuration to use. This is the 'default' property in the
'configurations' node.
Update the Makefile to pass in the value of DEVICE_TREE or
CONFIG_DEFAULT_DEVICE_TREE to provide this information.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Suggested-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Explain that binman interprets these environment variables in the
"External tools" section to run target/host specific versions of the
tools, and add a new section on how to use CROSS_COMPILE to run the
tests on non-x86 machines.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch lets tools.Run() use host-specific versions with the
for_host keyword argument, based on the host-specific environment
variables (HOSTCC, HOSTOBJCOPY, HOSTSTRIP, etc.).
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently, binman always runs the compile tools like cc, objcopy, strip,
etc. using their literal name. Instead, this patch makes it use the
target-specific versions by default, derived from the tool-specific
environment variables (CC, OBJCOPY, STRIP, etc.) or from the
CROSS_COMPILE environment variable.
For example, the u-boot-elf etype directly uses 'strip'. Trying to run
the tests with 'CROSS_COMPILE=i686-linux-gnu- binman test' on an arm64
host results in the '097_elf_strip.dts' test to fail as the arm64
version of 'strip' can't understand the format of the x86 ELF file.
This also adjusts some command.Output() calls that caused test errors or
failures to use the target versions of the tools they call. After this,
patch, an arm64 host can run all tests with no errors or failures using
a correct CROSS_COMPILE value.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
These test files are currently "intended for use on x86 hosts", but most
of the tests using them can still pass when cross-compiled to x86 on an
arm64 host.
This patch enables non-x86 hosts to run the tests by specifying a
cross-compiler via CROSS_COMPILE. The list of variables it sets is taken
from the top-level Makefile. It would be possible to automatically set
an x86 cross-compiler with a few blocks like:
ifneq ($(shell i386-linux-gnu-gcc --version 2> /dev/null),)
CROSS_COMPILE = i386-linux-gnu-
endif
But it wouldn't propagate to the binman process calling this Makefile,
so it's better just raise an error and expect 'binman test' to be run
with a correct CROSS_COMPILE.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
This patch makes buildman create linked working trees instead of clones
of the source repository, but keeps updating the older clones of the
repository that might already exist. These worktrees share "everything
except working directory specific files such as HEAD, index, etc." with
the source repository. See the git-worktree(1) manual page for more
information.
If git-worktree isn't available, silently falls back to cloning the
repository.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present 64-bit sunxi boards use the Makefile to create a FIT, using
USE_SPL_FIT_GENERATOR. This is deprecated.
Update sunxi to use binman instead.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tested-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
At present binman warns about missing external blobs only when the
BUILD_ROM is defined. Enable this behaviour always, since many boards
are starting to use these (e.g. ARM Trusted Firmware's BL31).
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In some cases it is useful to generate a FIT which has a number of DTB
images, selectable by configuration. Add support for this in binman,
using a simple iterator and string substitution.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add an entry for ARM Trusted Firmware's 'BL31' payload, which is the
device's main firmware. Typically this is U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we have an Entry_blob_ext which implement a blob which holds an
external binary. We need to support other entry types that hold external
binaries, e.g. Entry_blob_named_by_arg. Move the support into the base
Entry class to allow this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present the Python sequential-write interface can produce an error when
it calls fdt_finish(), since this needs to add a terminating tag to the
end of the struct section.
Fix this by automatically expanding the buffer if needed.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Tidy up a few test functions which lack argument comments. Rename one that
has the same name as a different test.
Also fix up the comment for PrepareImagesAndDtbs().
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
If an entry argument is needed by an entry but the entry argument is not
present, then a strange error can occur when trying to read the file.
Fix this by allowing arguments to be required. Select this option for the
cros-ec-rw entry. If a filename is provided in the node, allow that to be
used.
Also tidy up a few related tests to make the error string easier to find,
and fully ignore unused return values.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Currently of_match_ptr is used to avoid referencing compatible strings
when OF_CONTROL is not enabled. This behaviour could be improved by
taking into account also OF_PLATDATA, as when this configuration is
enabled the compatible strings are not used at all.
Signed-off-by: Walter Lozano <walter.lozano@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
At present we look for resources based on the path of the Python module
that wants them. Instead we should use Python's pkg_resources feature
which is designed for this purpose.
Update binman to use this.
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When reading subentries of each image, the FIT entry type directly
concatenates their contents without padding them according to their
offset, size, align, align-size, align-end, pad-before, pad-after
properties.
This patch makes sure these properties are respected by offloading this
image-data building to the section etype, where each subnode of the
"images" node is processed as a section. Alignments and offsets are
respective to the beginning of each image. For example, the following
fragment can end up having "u-boot-spl" start at 0x88 within the final
FIT binary, while "u-boot" would then end up starting at e.g. 0x20088.
fit {
description = "example";
images {
kernel-1 {
description = "U-Boot with SPL";
type = "kernel";
arch = "arm64";
os = "linux";
compression = "none";
u-boot-spl {
};
u-boot {
align = <0x10000>;
};
};
};
}
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reinstate check in testPadInSections(), squash in
"binman: Allow FIT binaries to have missing external blobs"
Signed-off-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Other relevant properties (pad-after, offset, size, align, align-size,
align-end) already work since Pack() sets correct ranges for subentries'
data (.offset, .size variables), but some padding here is necessary to
align the data within this range to match the pad-before property.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Switch to str.startswith for matching like the FIT etype does since the
current version doesn't ignore 'hash-1', 'hash-2', etc.
Signed-off-by: Alper Nebi Yasak <alpernebiyasak@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Setting CONFIG_ENV_ADDR to something other than 0 stops gd->env_addr
from being allocated dynamically. When the environment is in SPI we need
it to be allocated as we can't use a direct memory mapped address.
Signed-off-by: Chris Packham <judge.packham@gmail.com>
Fix build failure, it used to get this implicitly through common.h
until f7ae49fc4f (common: Drop log.h from common header).
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Reviewed-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Somewhere between v2020.04 and v2020.07 the mpc8xxx_spi driver broke,
I'm guessing due to this hunk
@@ -559,6 +560,8 @@ int dm_gpio_set_dir_flags(struct gpio_desc *desc, ulong flags)
if (ret)
return ret;
+ /* combine the requested flags (for IN/OUT) and the descriptor flags */
+ flags |= desc->flags;
ret = _dm_gpio_set_dir_flags(desc, flags);
from commit 695e5fd546 ("gpio: update dir_flags management"). But
the blame is mostly on the driver itself which seems rather confused:
The chip select gpios are requested with GPIOD_ACTIVE_LOW, but then in
each activate/deactivate, dm_gpio_set_dir_flags() is called with
merely GPIOD_IS_OUT, and then the driver call set_value(0) for
activate.
That used to work, but with the above hunk, the ACTIVE_LOW setting
from the request becomes persistent, so the gpio driver ends up being
asked to set the value to 1 in mpc8xxx_spi_cs_activate().
So drop the dm_gpio_set_dir_flags() calls in the activate/deactivate
functions, and use a value of 1 to mean "logically enabled".
Ideally, I think we should also drop the GPIOD_ACTIVE_LOW from the
request and make it up to the list of gpio cs in DT to indicate
whether that CS is enabled when driven low (as is of course usually
the case), but that requires changing
arch/powerpc/dts/gdsys/gazerbeam-base.dtsi among others, and I don't
have that hardware to test on. I have, however, tested our
own (mpc8309-based) hardware with this change, and I have also tested
that removing the GPIOD_ACTIVE_LOW from the request and updating our
DT as
- gpios = <&spisel 0 0>;
+ gpios = <&spisel 0 GPIO_ACTIVE_LOW>;
still works.
Signed-off-by: Rasmus Villemoes <rasmus.villemoes@prevas.dk>
Linking a U-Boot larger than 1MB fails with PIE enabled:
u-boot/arch/arm/cpu/armv8/start.S:71:(.text+0x3c): relocation
truncated to fit: R_AARCH64_ADR_PREL_LO21 against symbol `__rel_dyn_end'
defined in .bss_start section in u-boot.
This extends the supported range by using adrp & add to load symbols
early while starting up.
Signed-off-by: Edgar E. Iglesias <edgar.iglesias@xilinx.com>
Reviewed-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
Tested-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Atmel PIT timer is not available for next products that
have another timer hardware block.
To be able to use the common at91 code, guard the code that uses PIT
by ifdefs.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
We already have a function to retrieve the mac address from one EEPROM.
For boards with a second Ethernet interface, however, we would
require another EEPROM with a second unique MAC address.
Introduce at91_set_eth1addr which will look for a second EEPROM
and set the 'eth1addr' variable with the obtained MAC address.
Signed-off-by: Eugen Hristev <eugen.hristev@microchip.com>
Add UTMI support for SAMA7G5. SAMA7G5's UTMI control is done via
XTALF register. Values written at bits 2..0 in this register
correspond to the on board crystal oscillator frequency.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Add master clock (MCK1..MCK4) support for SAMA7G5. SAMA7G5's PMC has
multiple master clocks feeding different subsystems. One of them
feeds image subsystem and is changeable based on image subsystem
needs.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Add sckc driver compatible with common clock framework. Driver
implements slow clock support for SAM9X60 compatible IPs (in this
list it is also present SAMA7G5's slow clock IP).
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Move clock code to compat.c to allow switching to CCF
without mixing CCF code with non CCF code. This prepares the
field for next commits.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Add helper for clock drivers. These will be used by following
commits in the process of switching AT91 clock drivers to CCF.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Add pre-requisite headers for AT91 clock architecture. These
are based on already present files on Linux and will be used
by following commits for AT91 CCF clock drivers.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
clk_get_by_indexed_prop() retrieves a clock with dev member being set
with the pointer to the udevice for the clock controller driver. But
in case of CCF each clock driver has set in dev member the reference
to its parent (the root of the clock tree is a fixed clock, every
node in clock tree is a clock registered with clk_register()). In this
case the subsequent operations like dev_get_clk_ptr() on clocks
retrieved by clk_get_by_indexed_prop() will fail. For this, get the
pointer to the proper clock registered (with clk_register()) using
clk_get_by_id() before proceeding.
Fixes: 1d7993d1d0 ("clk: Port Linux common clock framework [CCF] for imx6q to U-boot (tag: v5.1.12)")
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Clock re-parenting is not binding the clock's device to its new
parent device, it only calls the clock's ops->set_parent() API. The
changes in this commit re-parent the clock device to its new parent
so that subsequent operations like clk_get_parent() to point to the
proper parent.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
In common clock framework the relation b/w parent and child clocks is
determined based on the udevice parent/child information. A clock
parent could be changed based on devices needs. In case this is happen
the functionalities for clock who's parent is changed are broken. Add
a function that reparent a device. This will be used in clk-uclass.c
to reparent a clock device.
Signed-off-by: Claudiu Beznea <claudiu.beznea@microchip.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add a missing memset to acpi_create_spcr().
The other acpi_create_xxxx() functions perform a memset on their
structures, acpi_create_spcr() does not and as a result the contents of
this table are partly uninitialized (and thus random after every reset).
Fixes: b288cd9600 ("x86: acpi: Generate SPCR table")
Signed-off-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: fix the tags format in the commit message]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Currently, the calculation for the length of the DSDT table includes any
bytes that are added for alignment, but those bytes are not initialized.
This is because the DSDT length is calculated after a call to
acpi_inc_align(). Split this up into the following sequence:
* acpi_inc()
* Calculate DSDT length
* acpi_align()
Signed-off-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
The term eMMC is used inconsistently within the FSP devicetree
bindings (e-mmc and emmc), especially for "emmc-host-max-speed"
documentation and code disagree.
Change all eMMC instances within the FSP bindings to consistently
use "emmc". The term "emmc" is already used a lot within U-Boot,
while "e-mmc" is only used in the FSP bindings.
Signed-off-by: Wolfgang Wallner <wolfgang.wallner@br-automation.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
[bmeng: correct one typo in the commit message]
Signed-off-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
This patch moves the the config SYS_MALLOC_LEN to Kconfig
as it is already done for zynq arch in commit 01aa5b8f05
("Kconfig: Move config SYS_MALLOC_LEN to Kconfig for zynq").
Signed-off-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2020-10-rc5 (2)
The following bugs are fixed:
* incorrect online help for setenv and env
* description of function efi_mem_carve_out()
* replace printf() by log_err() in stm32mp1_rng driver
A unit test is provided to check that the boot hart id is provided in the
RISC-V device-tree.
- SquashFS Coverity fixes
- bitflip fix in the alternate memtest command
- Disable networking on bcmstb boards where we didn't have any network
drivers enabled.
'env -e -i' syntax was changed from "," to ":". Account for this also
in the documentation.
Fixes: 2b3fbcb59f ("efi_loader: use ':' as separator for setenv -i")
Signed-off-by: Maxim Uvarov <maxim.uvarov@linaro.org>
Correct the usage description for setenv -e too.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On RISC-V check that the /chosen node has a boot-hartid property.
To run the test configure with CONFIG_CMD_BOOTEFI_SELFTEST=y and issue
setenv efi_selftest device tree
setenv serial# myserial
bootefi selftest
If the test succeeds, it reports the boot-hartid, e.g.
boot-hartid: 1
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Allow specifying the node on which a property is searched.
Test the device tree consistency more rigorously.
Some efi_st_printf() calls have been converted to efi_st_error().
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Refine text for overlap_only_ram description to
match to what exactly flag does and aling description
with other functions.
Signed-off-by: Maxim Uvarov <maxim.uvarov@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The logging system provides flexible filtering and enhanced output.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Sughosh Ganu <sughosh.ganu@linaro.org>
There are drivers to support built in USB controller and PHY-s now, so lets add the USB nodes to DTSI.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Lot of Qualcomm SoC-s use DWC3 controller for both USB2.0 and USB3.0
ports.
Qualcomm has some custom config registers on top of the generic ones,
but for host mode these are not needed.
So lets add the neccessary compatible string.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Add a driver to setup the USB PHY-s on Qualcomm IPQ40xx series SoCs.
The driver sets up HS and SS phys.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
On Qualcomm IPQ40xx SoC series, GCC clock IP also handles the resets.
So since this will be needed by further drivers, lets add a driver for the reset controller.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
Its common to use dt-bindings instead of hard-coding clocks or resets.
So lets use the imported Linux GCC bindings on IPQ40xx target.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
The bitflip test uses two equal sized memory buffers. This is achieved
by splitting the range of memory into two pieces. The address of the
second buffer, as well as the length of each buffer, were not correctly
calculated. This caused bitflip test to access beyond the end of range.
This patch fixes the pointer arithmetic problem.
A second problem arises because u-boot "mtest" command expects the
ending address to be inclusive. When computing (end - start) this
results in missing 1 byte of the requested length. The bitflip test
expects a count rather than an "ending" address. Thus it fails to test
the last word of the requested range. Fixed by using (end - start + 1).
Added Kconfig option to optionally disable the bitflip test, since it
does add significantly to the time taken for "mtest".
Fixes: 8e434cb705 ("cmd: mem: Add bitflip
memory test to alternate mtest")
Signed-off-by: Ralph Siemsen <ralph.siemsen@linaro.org>
Reviewed-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Silence the "Driver Model for Ethernet drivers" migration warning for
the bcm7445 and bcm7260 ports, neither of which supports networking yet.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Fitzsimmons <fitzsim@fitzsim.org>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This is not required for sysboot (we defined fdtfile), let's save a few
bytes in the binary image without these variables.
Signed-off-by: Soeren Moch <smoch@web.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
mpc83xx, keymile boards: enable DM_ETH and add DTS
- mpc83xx: remove unneeded extern declaration in cpu_init
- powerpc, qe: fix codingstyle issues for drivers/qe
- powerpc, qe: add DTS support for parallel I/O ports
- net, qe: add DM support for QE UEC ethernet
- add DTS for all mpc83xx based boards from keymile
mainly they are not mainlined to linux.
- add u-boot specific dtsi
- add stdout-path
- add missing ucc4 par_io definitions, which were
in board code, but not in linux DTS
- remove not used ethernet nodes
Currently, after config the clock rate, delay 10ms, this is quite a rough
method. Check the clock stable status in the present status register is
enough.
Tested-by: Ji Luo <ji.luo@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Haibo Chen <haibo.chen@nxp.com>
This patch adds support for iMX6UL/ULL/SL/SDL MMDC into the DDR calibration
code. The difference between MX6DQ and MX6UL/ULL/SL is that the later SoCs
have 2 SDQS registers, just like MX6SX, while the MX6DQ/MX6SDL has 8.
Fixes: 4f4c128c65 ("ARM: mx6: ddr: Add support for iMX6SX")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Eric Nelson <eric@nelint.com>
Cc: Fabio Estevam <fabio.estevam@nxp.com>
Cc: Stefano Babic <sbabic@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Fabio Estevam <festevam@gmail.com>
The size of the binary created with the default U-boot config is much
greater than the default offset for environment `0x60000`.
In case if that binary is used for booting via MMC it is overlapped with
the environment stored on MMC.
This leads to U-Boot corruption while saving environment with `saveenv`
command and non-bootable SabreLite board.
The offset for environment `CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET=0x60000` was added in
commit a09fea1 but did not count in the change to `0xC0000` if option
`CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC` is used.
The offset is also used for variant with environment saving onto SPI NOR
flash (with enabled option `CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH`). In that case the
U-Boot binary flashed on SPI NOR is also corrupted after environment
saving with the original 0x60000 offset.
Signed-off-by: Denis Pynkin <denis.pynkin@collabora.com>
Reviewed-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Latest datasheet revE has removed MIMX8ML7D/5D/7C/5C parts, so
update u-boot to remove decoding and support for those parts.
Signed-off-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Fix SSCG_PLL_REFCLK_SEL_x, the offset starts from 0, not 16
Reported-by: Coverity 3448860
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Coverity reported dead code, however it is FRAC_PLL_REFCLK_SEL_MASK
was wrongly set.
Reported-by: Coverity 10045172
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
According to i.MX 7Dual Applications Processor Reference Manual, Rev. 1
The target interface CCM root index ranges [0,124], so the number
should be 125.
Reported-by: Coverity 18045
Signed-off-by: Peng Fan <peng.fan@nxp.com>
Reviewed-by: Ye Li <ye.li@nxp.com>
Provide fdtfile value in default env instead of setting
it dynamically in runtime.
Fixes: 85cb2bc686("apalis/colibri imx6: provide proper fdtfile value")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Provide fdtfile value in default env instead of setting
it dynamically in runtime.
Fixes: 85cb2bc686("apalis/colibri imx6: provide proper fdtfile value")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Enable and set preboot var with fdtfile evaluation.
preboot will be checked and run immediately before starting the
CONFIG_BOOTDELAY countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
entering interactive mode.
This provides possibility to use different boot cmds in interactive mode
without manual setting fdtfile value, as it it's already evaluated
before entering interactive mode.
Fixes: a62c60610f("colibri_imx7_emmc: add Colibri iMX7D 1GB (eMMC) module support")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Enable and set preboot var with fdtfile evaluation.
preboot will be checked and run immediately before starting the
CONFIG_BOOTDELAY countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
entering interactive mode.
This provides possibility to use different boot cmds in interactive mode
without manual setting fdtfile value, as it it's already evaluated
before entering interactive mode.
Fixes: 304042c1f3("colibri_vf: set fdtfile for distroboot")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Enable and set preboot var with fdtfile evaluation.
preboot will be checked and run immediately before starting the
CONFIG_BOOTDELAY countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
entering interactive mode.
This provides possibility to use different boot cmds in interactive mode
without manual setting fdtfile value, as it it's already evaluated
before entering interactive mode.
Fixes: board: 31b1e17f44("toradex: add Colibri iMX6ULL support")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Wrap video specific functionality with ifdefs.
Fixes: 195011b24d("colibri-imx7: fix splash logo drawing")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Drop show_boot_logo legacy function, as splashscreen functionality can
be used instead.
Fixes: d324189772("toradex: common: show boot logo")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Set proper splashscreen env value instead of calling legacy function
to show embed boot logo.
Fixes: 195011b24d("colibri-imx7: fix splash logo drawing")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
Set proper splashscreen env value instead of calling legacy function
to show embed boot logo.
Fixes: 391c712dde("colibri-imx6ull: show boot logo")
Signed-off-by: Igor Opaniuk <igor.opaniuk@toradex.com>
enable DTS support for keymile mpc83xx based boards.
get rid of compile warning:
===================== WARNING ======================
This board does not use CONFIG_DM_ETH (Driver Model
for Ethernet drivers). Please update the board to use
CONFIG_DM_ETH before the v2020.07 release. Failure to
update by the deadline may result in board removal.
See doc/driver-model/migration.rst for more info.
====================================================
Therefore done:
- add DTS for all mpc83xx based boards from keymile
mainly they are not mainlined to linux.
- add u-boot specific dtsi
- add stdout-path
- add missing ucc4 par_io definitions, which were
in board code, but not in linux DTS
- remove not used ethernet nodes
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Patch-cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Patch-cc: Qiang Zhao <qiang.zhao@nxp.com>
Series-to: u-boot
Series-version: 3
Series-changes: 3
- rebase patchset to current mainline commit
c0192950df
- update defconfig files
Series-changes: 2
- add patch which fixes Codingstyle errors in drivers/qe
- add patch which converts the mpc83xx based boards from
keymile to DM_ETH
Cover-letter:
powerpc, mpc83xx: add DM_ETH support
This patch series adds DM ethernet support for mpc83xx based
keymile boards.
Travis build:
END
add DM/DTS support for the UEC ethernet on QUICC Engine
Block.
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Patch-cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Patch-cc: Qiang Zhao <qiang.zhao@nxp.com>
Patch-cc: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Patch-cc: Madalin Bucur <madalin.bucur@oss.nxp.com>
Series-changes: 3
- revert:
commit "3374264df97b" ("drivers: net: qe: deselect QE when DM_ETH is enabled")
as now qe works with DM and DM_ETH support.
- fix mailaddress from Holger
Series-changes: 2
- add comments from Qiang Zhao:
- add device node documentation
- I did not drop the dm_qe_uec_phy.c and use drivers/net/fsl_mdio.c
because using drivers/net/fsl_mdio.c leads in none existent
udevice mdio@3320
instead boards with DM ETH support should use now this
driver.
- remove RFC tag
Commit-notes:
- I let the old none DM based implementation in code
so boards should work with old implementation.
This Code should be removed if all boards are converted
to DM/DTS.
- add the DM based qe uec driver under drivers/net/qe
- Therefore copied the files uccf.c uccf.h uec.h from
drivers/qe. So there are a lot of Codingstyle problems
currently. I fix them in next version if this RFC
patch is OK or it needs some changes.
- The dm based driver code is now under drivers/net/qe/dm_qe_uec.c
Used a lot of functions from drivers/qe/uec.c
- seperated the PHY specific code into seperate file
drivers/net/qe/dm_qe_uec_phy.c
END
add DM support for parallel I/O ports on QUICC Engine Block
Signed-off-by: Heiko Schocher <hs@denx.de>
Patch-cc: Mario Six <mario.six@gdsys.cc>
Patch-cc: Qiang Zhao <qiang.zhao@nxp.com>
Patch-cc: Holger Brunck <holger.brunck@hitachi-powergrids.com>
Series-changes: 2
- remove RFC
- fixed Codingstyle errors, therefore new patch
powerpc, mpc83xx: fix codingstyle issues for qe_io.c
- moved DM part to drivers/pinctrl
Commit-notes:
Open questions / discussion:
- I let the old none DM based implementation in code
so boards should work with old implementation.
This should be removed if all boards are converted to
DM/DTS.
- Unfortunately linux DTS does not use "pinctrl-"
properties, instead "pio-handle" properties.
Even worser old U-Boot code initializes all pins
defined in "const qe_iop_conf_t qe_iop_conf_tab[]"
table in board code. As linux does the same I decided
to also scan through all subnodes containing "pio-map"
property and initialize them too.
The proper solution would be to check for "pio-handle"
when a device is probed.
END
I also followed the development of the SquashFS support in U-Boot
as part of Joao Marcos internship, so I would also appreciate receiving
new contributions and bug reports related to this topic.
Signed-off-by: Miquel Raynal <miquel.raynal@bootlin.com>
As I have followed the development of the SquashFS support in U-Boot
as part of Joao Marcos work, it makes sense to get Cc'ed on
contributions/bug reports related to the squashfs support.
Signed-off-by: Thomas Petazzoni <thomas.petazzoni@bootlin.com>
Repair incorrectly negated condition in the original patch which broke
DT memory node parsing on everything which has more than one DT memory
node, e.g. R-Car3.
In case multiple valid memory nodes are present in the DT, the original
patch would complete parsing cycle for the first memory node, then move
on to the next one, identify it as a valid, and end the parsing. The fix
is to invert the condition, to make the code behave as it did before the
livetree conversion, so it would continue parsing the subsequent memory
nodes as well.
Fixes: c2f0950c33 ("lib: fdt: Convert fdtdes_setup_mem..() to livetree API")
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Cc: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Cc: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Cc: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
Tested-by: Biju Das <biju.das.jz@bp.renesas.com>
Reviewed-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
phy_write() uses bus->write() instead of bus->read(). This means NULL
pointer pre-check needs to happen on bus->write instead of bus->read.
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
Reviewed-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
Pull request for UEFI sub-system for efi-2020-10-rc5
The following bugs are fixed:
* unaligned access in br_i32_decode()
* missing restore of global data pointer in UEFI selftest
* missing restore of global data pointer on RISC-V in UEfI subsystem
* efi_var_mem_notify_exit_boot_services() should not be __efi_runtime
Use board_early_init_f() instead of mach_cpu_init() for board, the
board_early_init_f() is used for board init and after dm_initf, while
the mach_cpu_init() is used for CPU/SOC and before dm_initf()(not able
to use syscon API).
Fixes: 9cec336708 ("rockchip: evb-rv1108: Use syscon API to get grf base")
Fixes: 4aa33690fc {"rockchip: elgin-rv1108: Use syscon API to get grf base")
Signed-off-by: Kever Yang <kever.yang@rock-chips.com>
- Hyperflash boot for J7200
- Update Main R5FSS lockstep mode
- R5F remoteproc support for J7200
- Minor env fixes
- Add SPI boot support for am335x-icev2
am335x internal SRAM is too small to support the addition of
SPI bootmode to the default defconfig. Add a separate spiboot_defconfig
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Add an ofdata_to_platdata() callback to access dts in U-boot and
access all platform data in it. This prepares the driver for supporting
both device tree as well as static platform data structures in SPL.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Add platform data and a device structure for the spi device
present on am335x-icev2. This requires moving all omap3_spi
platform data structures and symbols to an omap3_spi.h so that
the board file can access them.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
There are devices which don't use OF_CONTROL or OF_PLATDATA but instead
rely on statically defined platdata. Block dm_scan_fdt_dev() with both
configs to avoid build failures under this condition.
Signed-off-by: Faiz Abbas <faiz_abbas@ti.com>
Reviewed-by: Jagan Teki <jagan@amarulasolutions.com>
If devtype variable is setted via setenv, then the following devtype=X style is
ignored. Currently, many u-boot commands use devtype variable in the latter
manner:
mmc_boot=if mmc dev ${devnum}; then devtype=mmc; run scan_dev_for_boot_part; fi
Use devtype=mmc instead of setenv devtype mmc to avoid bugs with booting from
another devtype.
Signed-off-by: Matwey V. Kornilov <matwey.kornilov@gmail.com>
Enable the FS_LOADER and associated configs in the j7200_evm_r5_defconfig
so that the R5 SPL can support the loading of firmware files from a boot
media/file system.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Add a generic fs_loader node to the K3 J7200 R5 common board dts
file and use it as the chosen firmware-loader so that it can be
used for loading various firmwares from a boot media/filesystem
in R5 SPL on K3 J7200 EVM.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The R5 SPL on J7200 SoCs will be limited to booting just the
MCU R5FSS0 R5F core in LockStep-mode at present, so add the
two required environment variables 'addr_mcur5f0_0load' and
'name_mcur5f0_0fw' that are needed by the R5 SPL early-boot
logic. The firmware name used is also different from that on
J721E SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The A72 U-boot can support early booting of any of the Main or MCU R5F
remote processors from U-boot prompt to achieve various system usecases
before booting the Linux kernel. Update the default BOOTCOMMAND to provide
an automatic and easier way to start various remote processors through
added environment variables.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The J7200 SoCs has two R5F sub-systems. Enable the TI K3
R5F remoteproc driver and the remoteproc command options
to allow these R5F processors to be booted from A72 U-Boot.
The Kconfigs are added using savedefconfig.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The J7200 SoCs have different number of remote processors, but reuse
the same environment settings as the J721E SoCs. The current env
variable rproc_fw_binaries is geared towards J721E SoCs and is
incorrect for J7200 SoCs. Please see the logic originally added in
commit 0b4ab9c9a7 ("env: ti: j721e-evm: Add support to boot rprocs
including R5Fs and DSPs").
Fix this by defining the DEFAULT_RPROCS macro appropriately using
the corresponding TARGET_EVM Kconfig symbol. This macro is used by
the 'rproc_fw_binaries' env variable in the common remoteproc env
header file k3_rproc.h.
The list of R5F cores to be started before loading and booting the
Linux kernel are as follows, and mainly comprises of the Main R5FSS0
cores in this order:
Main R5FSS0 (Split) Core0 : 2 /lib/firmware/j7200-main-r5f0_0-fw
Main R5FSS0 (Split) Core1 : 3 /lib/firmware/j7200-main-r5f0_1-fw
The MCU R5FSS0 is in LockStep mode and is expected to be booted by
R5 SPL, so it is not included in the list. The order of rprocs to
boot cannot be really modified as only the Main R5FSS0 cores are
involved and Core0 has to be booted first always before the
corresponding Core1.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The J7200 SoCs have 2 dual-core Arm Cortex-R5F processor (R5FSS)
subsystems/clusters. One R5F cluster is present within the MCU
domain (MCU_R5FSS0), and the other one is present within the MAIN
domain (MAIN_R5FSS0). Each of these can be configured at boot time
to be either run in a LockStep mode or in an Asymmetric Multi
Processing (AMP) fashion in Split-mode. These subsystems have 64 KB
each Tightly-Coupled Memory (TCM) internal memories for each core
split between two banks - ATCM and BTCM (further interleaved into
two banks). The TCMs of both Cores are combined in LockStep-mode
to provide a larger 128 KB of memory.
Add the DT node for the MAIN domain R5F cluster/subsystem, the two
R5F cores are added as child nodes to the main cluster/subsystem node.
The cluster is configured to run in Split-mode by default, with the
ATCMs enabled to allow the R5 cores to execute code from DDR with
boot-strapping code from ATCM. The inter-processor communication
between the main A72 cores and these processors is achieved through
shared memory and Mailboxes.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The J7200 SoCs have 2 dual-core Arm Cortex-R5F processor (R5FSS)
subsystems/clusters. One R5F cluster is present within the MCU
domain (MCU_R5FSS0), and the other one is present within the MAIN
domain (MAIN_R5FSS0). Each of these can be configured at boot time
to be either run in a LockStep mode or in an Asymmetric Multi
Processing (AMP) fashion in Split-mode. These subsystems have 64 KB
each Tightly-Coupled Memory (TCM) internal memories for each core
split between two banks - ATCM and BTCM (further interleaved into
two banks). The TCMs of both Cores are combined in LockStep-mode
to provide a larger 128 KB of memory.
Add the DT node for the MCU domain R5F cluster/subsystem, the two
R5F cores are added as child nodes to the main cluster/subsystem node.
The cluster is configured to run in LockStep mode by default, with
the ATCMs enabled to allow the R5 cores to execute code from DDR with
boot-strapping code from ATCM. The inter-processor communication
between the main A72 cores and these processors is achieved through
shared memory and Mailboxes.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The A72 U-Boot code can load and boot a number of the available
R5FSS Cores on the J7200 SoC. Change the memory attributes for the
DDR regions used by the remote processors so that the cores can see
and execute the proper code.
The J7200 SoC has less number of remote processors compared to J721E,
so use less memory for the remote processors. So, a separate table
based on the current J721E table is added for J7200 SoCs, and selected
using the appropriate Kconfig CONFIG_TARGET_J7200_A72_EVM symbol.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The K3 J7200 SoC family has a revised R5F sub-system and contains a
subset of the R5F clusters present on J721E SoCs. The integration of
these clusters is very much similar to J721E SoCs otherwise.
The revised IP has the following two new features:
1. TCMs are auto-initialized during module power-up, and the behavior
is programmable through a MMR bit controlled by System Firmware.
2. The LockStep-mode allows the Core1 TCMs to be combined with the
Core0 TCMs effectively doubling the amount of TCMs available.
The LockStep-mode on previous SoCs could only use the Core0 TCMs.
This combined TCMs appear contiguous at the respective Core0 TCM
addresses.
Add the support to these clusters in the K3 R5F remoteproc driver
using J7200 specific compatibles and revised logic accounting for
the above IP features/differences.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The K3 J7200 SoCs have two dual-core Arm R5F clusters/subsystems, with
2 R5F cores each, one in each of the MCU and MAIN voltage domains.
These clusters are a revised version compared to those present on
J721E SoCs. Update the K3 R5F remoteproc bindings with the compatible
info relevant to these R5F clusters/subsystems on K3 J7200 SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The commit 316c927135 ("include: configs: j721e_evm: Add env variables
for mcu_r5fss0_core0 & main_r5fss0_core0") added four different new env
variables 'addr_mainr5f0_0load', 'name_mainr5f0_0fw', 'addr_mcur5f0_0load'
and 'name_mcur5f0_0fw' to the generic environment, but these are only
needed and used in R5 SPL for early-booting the MCU R5FSS0 and Main
R5FSS0 Core0 on J721E SoCs.
These are not really needed for A72 U-Boot, so limit the scope of
these variables only to R5 SPL. While at this, also fix the loadaddr
variable values to include the hex prefix like with other such env
variables.
Cc: Keerthy <j-keerthy@ti.com>
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
The default rproc list currently used by A72 U-Boot to boot various
remote processors include the Main R5FSS0 (Split-mode) Core1, Main
R5FSS1 (LockStep mode) Core0 and the three DSPs. The Main R5FSS1 cluster
is configured for Split mode by default in the dts now, so add the
Main R5FSS1 Core1 (rproc #5) to the default rproc boot list. This
core is now booted after the Main R5FSS1 Core0 and before the DSPs.
The order of the rprocs to boot can always be changed at runtime if
desired by overwriting the 'rproc_fw_binaries' environment variable
at U-boot prompt. Note that the R5FSS Core1 cannot be booted before
its associated Core0.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Switch the MAIN R5FSS1 cluster to be configured for Split-mode as the
default so that two different applications can be run on each of the
R5F cores in performance mode. LockStep-mode would be available only
on SoCs efused with the appropriate bit, and Split-mode is the mode
that is available on all J721E SoCs.
Signed-off-by: Suman Anna <s-anna@ti.com>
Enable configs required to support HyperFlash boot and detection of
onboard mux switch for HyperFlash selection
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
On J7200 SoC OSPI and HypeFlash are muxed at HW level and only one of
them can be used at any time. J7200 EVM has both HyperFlash and OSPI
flash on board. There is a user switch (SW3.1) that can be toggled to
select OSPI flash vs HyperFlash.
Read the state of this switch via wkup_gpio0_6 line and fixup the DT
nodes to select OSPI vs HyperFlash
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
HBMC controller on TI K3 SoC provides MMIO access to HyperFlash similar
to legacy Parallel CFI NOR flashes. Therefore alias HyperFlash bootmode
to NOR boot to enable SPL to load next stage using NOR boot flow.
Signed-off-by: Vignesh Raghavendra <vigneshr@ti.com>
Add SH4 R2Dplus machine configured to test various U-Boot PCI ethernet
options -- RTL8139, EEPRO100, AMD PCnet, DEC Tulip.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marek.vasut+renesas@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
Use mmc_of_parse() to set the common host properties. That includes
"bus-width", so parsing it can be removed from the driver.
But more importantly, "non-removable" is now respected, which fixes
the usage of eMMC.
Signed-off-by: Andre Heider <a.heider@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Konstantin Porotchkin <kostap@marvell.com>
Tested-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Since the introduction of 'get_cd' callback in sdhci core,
dragonboard410c's MMC interface is broken. It turns out that 'get_cd'
callback checks for the host_caps for validating the chip select. And
since the msm_sdhci driver is not parsing the host_caps from DT, not
all of the cababilities are parsed properly. This results in the MMC
interfaces to be broken.
Hence, fix this by adding a call to 'mmc_of_parse' during driver probe.
Signed-off-by: Manivannan Sadhasivam <manivannan.sadhasivam@linaro.org>
Tested-by: Aníbal Limón <anibal.limon@linaro.org>
Reviewed-By: Ramon Fried <rfried.dev@gmail.com>
Reviewed-by: Jaehoon Chung <jh80.chung@samsung.com>
Before calling do_reset() in the EFI selftest we must restore the global
data pointer.
Fixes: fa63753f86 ("efi_selftest: substitute ResetSystem() by do_reset()")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
On RISC-V the global data pointer is stored in register gp. When a UEFI
binary calls the EFI API we have to restore it.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Function set_gd() is needed in the UEFI sub-system if the global data
pointer is stored in a register.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
efi_var_mem_notify_exit_boot_services() is invoked when ExitBootServices()
is called by the UEFI payload.
efi_var_mem_notify_exit_boot_services() should not be defined as
__efi_runtime as it is invoking EFI_ENTRY() and EFI_EXIT() which themselves
are not __efi_runtime.
Fixes: f1f990a8c9 ("efi_loader: memory buffer for variables")
Fixes: e01aed47d6 ("efi_loader: Enable run-time variable support for tee based variables")
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Ilias Apalodimas <ilias.apalodimas@linaro.org>
Fixes problem for unaligned 32bit big-endian access in
lib/rsa/rsa-keyprop.c.
Exchanges br_i32_decode() with get_unaligned_be32().
This will keep the unaligned access for architectures capable and will do
some byte-shift magic for the not so capable ones.
Reported-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Signed-by: Robert Reither <robert.reither@external.thalesgroup.com>
Remove unused include.
Reviewed-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
The environment variable test uses function validate_empty() to check that
a variable is not defined. If the hush parser is not enabled, we cannot
refer to a variable by $var_name but only by ${var_name}.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Acked-by: Stephen Warren <swarren@nvidia.com>
HTML documentation is generated in doc/output/. This directory shall be
deleted by 'make mrproper'
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Nand writes should skip the bad blocks with "nand write" command.
In case of bad blocks with above 32-bit address, nand_block_isbad()
returns false due to truncated bad block address.
In below code segment,
if (nand_block_isbad(mtd, offset & ~(mtd->erasesize - 1)))
offset is 64-bit and mtd->erasesize is 32-bit, hence the truncation is
happening. Cast 'mtd->erasesize' with loff_t to fix this issue.
Signed-off-by: T Karthik Reddy <t.karthik.reddy@xilinx.com>
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
This patch adds a sanity check that avoids 'size' to overflow and crash when
importing an environment that contains a checksum. Example with the wrong size
that causes the crash:
=> env import -c 0x4100000 3 v1
This assumes that v1 has already been successfully exported with
'env export -c -s 0x100 0x4100000 v1'
Signed-off-by: Pedro Aguilar <pedro.aguilar@vimar.com>
In bootm_load_os() the OS image is decompressed. In later stages of the
boot process we need the decompressed size of the image.
Update images->os.image_len after decompression.
Passing the correct size is necessary if we want to check loaded EFI
binararies for file truncation by comparing the loaded size to the header
field SizeOfImage.
Signed-off-by: Heinrich Schuchardt <xypron.glpk@gmx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Kconfig provides several config options for setting up default variables
but these are unused when variables are passed to U-Boot via file.
That's why cover this dependency in Kconfig.
Signed-off-by: Michal Simek <michal.simek@xilinx.com>
On the mt7623 platform, if one port enable fail and other port
enable succeed. It will hang on when using pci enum
because the resource was not released correctly.
Signed-off-by: Chuanjia Liu <Chuanjia.Liu@mediatek.com>
Tested-by: Frank Wunderlich <frank-w@public-files.de>
Include ast2500-evb.dtb for CONFIG_ASPEED_AST2500 instead of
for all aspeed targets.
ast2400 is based on ARM926EJ-S processor (ARMv5-architecture).
ast2500 is based on ARM1176JZS processor (ARMv6-architecture).
ast2600 is based on Cortex A7 processor (ARMv7-A architecture).
Each of the above SOC is using a different ARM CPU(s) with different ARM
architecture revision. It is not possible to support all 3 of these
families in a single binary. So there is no need to build ast2500-evb.dtb
for other SOC families.
Signed-off-by: Thirupathaiah Annapureddy <thiruan@linux.microsoft.com>
On the mt7623 platform, if one port enable fail and other port
enable succeed. It will hang on when using pci enum
because the resource was not released correctly.
Signed-off-by: Chuanjia Liu <Chuanjia.Liu@mediatek.com>
Tested-by: Frank Wunderlich <frank-w@public-files.de>
Enable options SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to permit HDMI background
screen from white to back, also enable USB_KEYBOARD.
Signed-off-by: Anand Moon <linux.amoon@gmail.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Signed-off-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
Import Qualcomm IPQ4019 GCC bindings from Linux.
This will enable using bindings instead of raw clock numbers both in the driver and DTS like Linux does.
Signed-off-by: Robert Marko <robert.marko@sartura.hr>
Cc: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
v2: modify title description aspeed:clock -> clock:aspeed
Use kernel include/dt-bindings/clock/aspeed-clock.h define
for clock driver.
Signed-off-by: Ryan Chen <ryan_chen@aspeedtech.com>
Reviewed-by: Chia-Wei, Wang <chiawei_wang@aspeedtech.com>
Chimp is a core in Broadcom netxtream controller (bnxt).
Add support to check bnxt's chimp component status.
Signed-off-by: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Add command to update the environmental variables which
are used to read the data from QSPI offsets and load
the binaries to bnxt.
Signed-off-by: Vikas Gupta <vikas.gupta@broadcom.com>
Signed-off-by: Rayagonda Kokatanur <rayagonda.kokatanur@broadcom.com>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
PLL4Q is supplying both FDCAN and LTDC. In case HDMI is in use, the
50 MHz generated from PLL4Q cannot be divided well enough to produce
accurate clock for HDMI pixel clock. Adjust it to generate 74.25 MHz
instead. The PLL4P/PLL4R are generating 99 MHz instead of 100 MHz,
which is in tolerance for the SDMMC.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Gerald Baeza <gerald.baeza@st.com>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
There is no dedicated pull resistor on the AV96 UART4 (console UART)
pin. In case there is no UART adapter installed on the AV96, the line
is floating and can trigger reception of garbage characters, which in
turn can abort U-Boot autoboot. Add default pull up to mitigate this
problem.
Signed-off-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Cc: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Cc: Patrice Chotard <patrice.chotard@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Remove the unnecessary inversion on the eth_env_set_enetaddr() result which
only make complex the code of setup_mac_address() and display an invalid
value in the associated pr_err.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Vasut <marex@denx.de>
Supporting USB keyboards out of the box is both handy for development
and production. Notably if u-boot is used to boot into GRUB. This patch
adds USB keyboard support for 32 bit RPi4 config.
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
The commit 57805f2270 ("net: bcmgenet: Don't set ID_MODE_DIS when
not using RGMII") needed to be extended for the case of using the
rgmii-rxid. The latest version of the Rasbperry Pi4 dtb files for the
5.4 now specify the rgmii-rxid.
Signed-off-by: Jason Wessel <jason.wessel@windriver.com>
Tested-by: Petr Tesarik <ptesarik@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
This commit fixes a serious issue occurring when several network
commands are run on a raspberry pi 4 board: for instance a "dhcp"
command and then one or several "tftp" commands. In this case,
packet recv callbacks were called several times on the same packets,
and send function was failing most of the time.
note: if the boot procedure is made of a single network
command, the issue is not visible.
The issue is related to management of the packet ring buffers
(producer / consumer) and DMA.
Each time a packet is received, the ethernet device stores it
in the buffer and increments an index called RDMA_PROD_INDEX.
Each time the driver outputs a received packet, it increments
another index called RDMA_CONS_INDEX.
Between each pair of network commands, as part of the driver
'start' function, previous code tried to reset both RDMA_CONS_INDEX
and RDMA_PROD_INDEX to 0. But RDMA_PROD_INDEX cannot be written from
driver side, thus its value was actually not updated, and only
RDMA_CONS_INDEX was reset to 0. This was resulting in a major
synchronization issue between the driver and the device. Most
visible behavior was that the driver seemed to receive again the
packets from the previous commands (e.g. DHCP response packets
"received" again when performing the first TFTP command).
This fix consists in setting RDMA_CONS_INDEX to the same
value as RDMA_PROD_INDEX, when resetting the driver.
The same kind of fix was needed on the TX side, and a few variables
had to be reset accordingly (c_index, tx_index, rx_index).
The rx_index and tx_index have only 256 entries so the bottom 8 bits
must be masked off.
Originated-by: Etienne Dublé <etienne.duble@imag.fr>
Signed-off-by: Jason Wessel <jason.wessel@windriver.com>
Tested-by: Petr Tesarik <ptesarik@suse.com>
Signed-off-by: Matthias Brugger <mbrugger@suse.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the pr_err can be change to pr_debug.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Acked-by: Neil Armstrong <narmstrong@baylibre.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the dev_err/pr_err can be change to dev_dbg/pr_debug.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the pr_err can be change to pr_debug.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the pr_err can be change to pr_debug.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the dev_err can be change to dev_dbg.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
As the error message is now displayed by generic phy functions,
the pr_err can be change to pr_idebug.
Signed-off-by: Patrick Delaunay <patrick.delaunay@st.com>
Since the current code base is mostly from btrfs-progs, anyone
contributing to U-Boot btrfs code could also help us to improve
btrfs-progs and btrfs kernel module.
Also add myself as designated reviewer.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This cleans up the now unneeded code from the old btrfs implementation.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch introduces a new function, list_one_subvol(), which will
resolve the path to FS_TREE of one subvolume.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch introduces a new function, get_path_in_subvolume(), which
resolves inode number into path inside a subvolume.
This function will be later used for btrfs subvolume list functionality.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This version of btrfs_file_read() has the following new features:
- Tries all mirrors
- More handling on unaligned size
- Better compressed extent handling
The old implementation doesn't handle compressed extent with offset
properly: we need to read out the whole compressed extent, then
decompress the whole extent, and only then copy the requested part.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This implements lookup_data_extent() function for the incoming
new implementation of btrfs_file_read().
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
These two functions are used to do sector aligned read, which will be
later used to implement btrfs_file_read().
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Rename btrfs_file_read() and its callees to avoid name conflicts with
the incoming new code.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
After this the only remaining function that still utilizes
__btrfs_lookup_path() is btrfs_read().
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Use extent buffer based infrastructure to re-implement btrfs_readdir().
Along this rework, some small corner cases fixed:
- Subvolume tree mtime
Mtime of a subvolume tree is recorded in its root item, since there is
no INODE_ITEM for it.
This needs extra search from tree root.
- Output the unknown type
If the DIR_ITEM is corrupted, at least don't try to access the memory
out of boundary.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This is the extent buffer based path lookup routine.
To implement this, btrfs_lookup_dir_item() is crossported from
btrfs-progs, and implements btrfs_lookup_path() from scratch.
Unlike the existing __btrfs_lookup_path(), since btrfs_read_fs_root()
will check whether a root is a orphan at read time, there is no need to
check root backref, this makes the code a little easier to read.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
All existing next_length() caller handles return value > BTRFS_NAME_LEN,
so there is no need to do BTRFS_NAME_LEN check in next_length().
But still, we want to exit early if we're beyond BTRFS_NAME_LEN, so this
patch makes next_length() exit as soon as we're beyond BTRFS_NAME_LEN.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
The existing __btrfs_readlink() can be easily re-implemented using the
extent buffer based btrfs_readlink().
This is the first step to re-implement U-Boot's btrfs code.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Since the old code is using __btrfs_path/__btrfs_root which is different
from the regular extent buffer based one, we add "__" prefix for the old
implementation to avoid name conflicts for the incoming crossport.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
open_ctree_fs_info() is the main entry point to open btrfs.
This version is a simplfied version of __open_ctree_fd() of btrfs-progs,
the main differences are:
- Parameters on how to specify a block device
Instead of @fd and @path, U-Boot uses blk_desc and disk_partition_t.
- Remove open_ctree flags
There won't be multiple open ctree modes in U-Boot.
Otherwise functions structures are all kept the same.
With open_ctree_fs_info() implemented, also introduce the global
current_fs_info pointer to show the current opened btrfs.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
These two functions play a big role in btrfs bootstrap.
The following function is removed:
- Seed device support
Although in theory we can still support multiple devices, we don't have
a facility in U-Boot to do device scan without opening them.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch copies the core function, btrfs_search_slot(), from
btrfs-progs.
This version has the following functionality removed:
- The ability to COW tree block
Related code is commented out, and can be enabled in the future.
- The readahead functionality
This is abused in kernel. Remove it completely.
With the core function in place, btrfs developers should feel at home now.
This also crossports supporting code like btrfs_previous_item() to
ctree.[ch].
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
Crossport struct btrfs_root to ctree.h from btrfs-progs, with write
related members deleted.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This is to avoid naming conflicts between extent buffer based
btrfs_root.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
To avoid name conflicting between the extent buffer based btrfs_path
from btrfs-progs, rename struct btrfs_path to struct __btrfs_path.
Also rename btrfs_free_path() to __btrfs_free_path() to avoid conflicts.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This is the one of the basic stone function for btrfs, which:
- Resolves the chunk mappings
- Reads data from disk
- Does various sanity check
With read_tree_block(), we can finally crossport needed btrfs btree
operations to U-Boot.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch crossports volumes.[ch] from btrfs-progs, including:
- btrfs_map_block()
The core mechanism to map btrfs logical address to physical address.
This version includes multi-device support, along with RAID56 support.
- btrfs_scan_one_device()
This is the function to register one btrfs device to the list.
This is the main part of the multi-device btrfs assembling process.
Although we're not going to support multiple devices until U-Boot
allows us to scan one device without actually opening it.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
[trini: Use %zu in a debug print to avoid warning]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This brings all structure accessors from btrfs-progs/ctree.h, as in
kernel's ctree.h.
All these accessors handle the endian convert at runtime, and since all
of them are defined as static inline functions, those which aren't used
won't take space in resulting binary.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This brings the extent_io_tree infrastructure, with which we can finally
bring in proper btrfs_fs_info structure to ctree.h.
With read/write_extent_buffer() implemented we also backport
read/write_eb_member() to ctree.h.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch implements an infrastructure to insert/search/merge an extent
range (with variable length).
This provides the basis for later extent buffer cache used in btrfs.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This patch uses generic code from btrfs-progs to read one super block
from block device.
To support the btrfs-progs coding style, the following is also
crossported:
- BTRFS_SETGET_FUNC for btrfs_super_block
- btrfs_check_super() function
- Move btrfs_read_superblock() to disk-io.[ch]
Since super.c only contains pretty small amount of code, and
the extra check will be covered in later root read patches.
Differences between this implementation and btrfs-progs:
- No sbflags/sb_bytenr support
Since we only need to read the primary super block (like kernel),
sbflags/sb_bytenr used by super block recovery is not needed.
This also changes the following behavior of U-Boot btrfs:
- Only reads the primary super block
The old implementation reads all 3 super blocks, and also one
non-existing backup.
This is not correct, especially if there is another filesystem created
on the device but old superblocks are not rewritten.
Just like kernel, we only check the primary super block.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
[trini: Change error to be a define in compat.h]
Signed-off-by: Tom Rini <trini@konsulko.com>
This mostly crossports crypto/hash.[ch] from btrfs-progs.
The differences are:
- No blake2 support
No blake2 related library in U-Boot yet.
- Use uboot xxhash/sha256 directly
No need to implement the code as U-Boot has already provided the
interface.
This adds the support for the following csums:
- SHA256
- XXHASH
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
This version includes all needed on-disk format from kernel.
Only need to modify the include headers for U-Boot, everything else is
untouched.
Also, since U-Boot btrfs is using a different endian convert timing (at
tree block read time), it needs some forced type conversion before
proper crossport.
Signed-off-by: Qu Wenruo <wqu@suse.com>
Reviewed-by: Marek Behún <marek.behun@nic.cz>
bi_memstart & bi_memsize are now not referenced any more. This patch
removes their definitions from the bd_info struct.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove printing of the superseeded (by bi_dram[]) memory values from the
bdinfo command.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Most likely these deprecated (removed) variables are not needed. Lets
remove the assignments completely from all spl.c files.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Tested-by: Oleksandr Zhadan and Michael Durrant
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
All platforms support bi_dram[] since quite some time. Lets remove the
and bi_memsize values completely.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
When this no-op dram_init_banksize() is removed, the weak default will
be used instead, which correctly sets the bi_dram[] banksize values.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
arch_setup_bdinfo() only configures the deprecated bi_memstart &
bi_memsize values, which should not be needed any more. Lets remove
this file completely.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
With the planned removal of bi_memstart & bi_memsize, this patch now
moves the references to the better suiting gd->ram_base/ram_size
variables.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Remove the bi_memstart / bi_memsize assignment in setup_bdinfo() and
make sure, that bd_dram[] is always configured in the weak default
implementation of dram_init_banksize(), when CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE is
not set.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Ovidiu Panait <ovidiu.panait@windriver.com>
Use only gd->ram_base/_size in env_get_bootm_size() instead of bi_dram[]
in some cases and bi_memstart in others.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Simon Glass <sjg@chromium.org>
Since commit 86cf1c8285 ("configs: Migrate CONFIG_NR_DRAM_BANKS") &
commit 999a772d9f ("Kconfig: Migrate CONFIG_NR_DRAM_BANKS"),
CONFIG_NR_DRAM_BANKS is always defined with a value (4 is default).
It makes no sense to still carry code that is guarded with
"#ifndef CONFIG_NR_DRAM_BANKS" (and similar). This patch removes
all these unreferenced code paths.
Signed-off-by: Stefan Roese <sr@denx.de>
Reviewed-by: Pali Rohár <pali@kernel.org>
Reviewed-by: Andy Shevchenko <andriy.shevchenko@linux.intel.com>
Reviewed-by: Bin Meng <bmeng.cn@gmail.com>
2020-08-26 09:19:16 +02:00
11401 changed files with 841732 additions and 321712 deletions
/* Reset the cpu by setting software reset request bit */
writel(0x1,CRU_RESET_OFFSET);
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff
Show More
Reference in New Issue
Block a user
Blocking a user prevents them from interacting with repositories, such as opening or commenting on pull requests or issues. Learn more about blocking a user.